Location via proxy:   [ UP ]  
[Report a bug]   [Manage cookies]                

B737 CL Gen Fam PDF

Download as pdf or txt
Download as pdf or txt
You are on page 1of 1524

 

B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE


AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

 
B737-300/400/500 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION SELF-PACED

This course covers an overview of the Mechanical Systems to include:

• Description and Operation


• Controls and Indications
• Component Location
• Servicing

OBJECTIVES

On completion of this training, using the study guide provided and appropriate Maintenance Manuals, the
student will be able to:

1) Describe the safety precautions to be observed when working on or near the aircraft and its systems

2) Describe the locations of principle components

3) Describe the normal functions of each major system, including terminology and nomenclature

4) Using the proper maintenance manual reference, perform all aircraft system servicing tasks

5) Interpret reports provided by the crew members

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-06 Page 1


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

ATA-06 Page 2 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

 
TABLE OF CONTENTS
B737-300/400/500 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION SELF-PACED
ATA-06

OBJECTIVES........................................................................................................................................................ 1
Manual Arrangement and Numbering System..................................................................................................... 4
Chapter Numbering .................................................................................................................................... 4
Effectivity and Configuration Numbering .................................................................................................... 5
Page Numbering......................................................................................................................................... 8
REFERENCE PLANES AND LINES........................................................................................................................ 9
STANDARD ABBREVIATIONS AND DEFINITIONS........................................................................................... 9
Fuselage ..................................................................................................................................................... 9
Wing ........................................................................................................................................................... 9
Vertical Stabilizer ..................................................................................................................................... 10
Horizontal Stabilizer ................................................................................................................................. 11
Nacelle ..................................................................................................................................................... 11
PRINCIPAL DIMENSIONS AND AREAS.............................................................................................................. 14
Overall Airplane........................................................................................................................................ 14
Wing ......................................................................................................................................................... 14
Horizontal Stabilizer ................................................................................................................................. 14
Vertical Stabilizer ..................................................................................................................................... 15
Fuselage ................................................................................................................................................... 15
Areas ........................................................................................................................................................ 15
BODY STATION DIAGRAM ................................................................................................................................ 19
VERTICAL STABILIZER AND RUDDER STATIONS............................................................................................. 22
HORIZONTAL STABILIZER AND ELEVATOR STATION DIAGRAM...................................................................... 23
WING STATION DIAGRAM................................................................................................................................. 24
ENGINE AND NACELLE STATION DIAGRAM ..................................................................................................... 25
SERVICE INTERPHONE SYSTEM....................................................................................................................... 26
Overview................................................................................................................................................... 26
Remote Electronic Unit ............................................................................................................................. 28
Service Interphone Switch........................................................................................................................ 28
Service Interphone Switch........................................................................................................................ 29
Handsets .................................................................................................................................................. 30
Operation.................................................................................................................................................. 31

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-06 Page 3


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Manual Arrangement and Numbering System


The Maintenance Manual is divided into chapters and groups of chapters. Each group and every chapter has a
tab provided for ease of location. The chapterization separates the manual into the primary functions and
systems of the airplane. The chapters are further divided into sections and subjects to provide for subsystem
and individual unit breakout. Each chapter, section and subject is identified by an assigned number. Each
page carries the assigned subject number, page number, page code and the revision date.

Chapter 49 (Auxiliary Power Unit - APU) is issued in a set or sets (as applicable, if you have more than one
APU type in your model fleet) for the applicable APU manufacturer. These pages are further identified by an
APU sub-logo, for example GTCP85-129 SERIES ENGINES, GTCP36-280 SERIES ENGINES, APS2000 SERIES
ENGINES, etc., placed to the right of the Maintenance Manual logo at the top of the page. The numbering
system is described in detail in the paragraphs that follow.

Power Plant chapters 70 thru 80 are further identified by a sub-logo (CFM56 ENGINES) placed to the right of
the Boeing logo.

Chapter Numbering

Chapterization of the Maintenance Manual has provided a functional breakdown of the entire airplane. The
chapter breakdown numbering system uses a three-element number (XX-XX-XX). It provides for dividing the
material into Chapters, Sections, and Subjects.

The three elements of the indicator each contain two digits.

For example:

ATA-06 Page 4 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

 
Chapter Numbering (Continued):

The chapter number (1st element) and the first number of the section number (2nd element) are assigned by
ATA Specification No. 100. Material which is applicable to a system as a whole uses zeros in the 2nd and 3rd
elements of the numbers, that is, the chapter number followed by "-00-00." For example: AMM 78-00-00
(Exhaust) is used for general description information which provides an outline breakdown of the sections in
the chapter.

As a convenience for the customer, an ATA NUMBER CROSS REFERENCE GUIDE is provided at the end of this
introduction. This guide is a listing of all Maintenance Manual LRUs (i.e. R/I subjects) which have a different
chapter-section for the WDM (Wiring Diagram Manual).

Effectivity and Configuration Numbering

On each page, there is effectivity data at the lower, inner margin (Fig. 1). When a page applies to all airplanes,
the word ALL is in the effectivity block. When a page applies to all APUs, the word ALL will be found in the
effectivity block. If the information does not apply to all engines, the effectivity numbers of the APUs to which
the information does apply will be indicated.

If the data does not apply to all airplanes or APUs, then the effectivity will be one of these types:

1. Physical description - A description of the differences that you can see.


2. Component dash number - The last digits of the identification number that are on an electrical unit.
3. Airplane effectivity numbers - The airline three-letter code, and the numbers or letters that Boeing and
each airline agreed on to identify each airplane. If the effectivity is applicable to all subsequent
airplanes, the last digits will be 999.

For example: 205-999 indicates airplane 205 and all subsequent airplanes.

Immediately after this introduction, there is a cross-reference table of effectivity numbers, customer numbers,
manufacturing serial numbers, and registration numbers.

Each paragraph can have an effectivity. Each effectivity is in upper-case letters, on the first line of the
paragraph.

When effectivity differences are extensive and the preceding method becomes cumbersome and distracts from
the continuity of subject matter, new page blocks are created. These added page blocks are identified by the
addition of a configuration code (CONFIG) immediately above the page number. A previously issued page block
is re-issued to incorporate the configuration code as shown in Fig. 1. Configuration codes are issued at page
block level only. They are usually used when a change to the airplane results in a major change to the manual.
Configuration codes are typically used when there are multiple configurations of page block applicable to a
customer's fleet.

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-06 Page 5


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

 
Effectivity and Configuration Numbering (Continued):

In some instances, you can have CONFIGs that are provided as place holders. These procedures will be
indicated as "NOT USED" in the effectivity block in the lower left corner of the page (Fig. 1).

For the effectivity information in the power plant (70 series) chapters of the manual, two situations can exist:
the word ALL placed in the effectivity block on a page means that the page pertains to either all airplanes or all
engines, whichever the case may be. When the effectivity is limited to a system or component that remains
with the airplane during the power plant replacement, the effectivity is expressed in a manner described in the
preceding paragraphs. When a manual section, page, step, or illustration is limited to an engine type or
component, the effectivity is given using the engine model, physical difference, or part number.

The word ALL in the effectivity block on a page means that the page pertains to all airplanes (if you have only
one engine type in your model fleet) or all APUs (if you have multiple APU types in your model fleet),
whichever the case may be.

When the effectivity is limited to a system or component that remains with the airplane during the APU
replacement, the effectivity is expressed in a manner described in the preceding paragraphs. When a manual
section, page, step, or illustration is limited to an APU type or component, the effectivity is given using the APU
model, physical difference, or part number.

ATA-06 Page 6 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-06 Page 7


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Page Numbering

Each page block has its own page numbers. The page numbers are in the lower right corner of each page.

The page blocks categorize the tasks that they contain. The page blocks are defined by ATA Specification 100:

NOMENCLATURE PAGE BLOCK


DESCRIPTION AND OPERATION (D&O) 1 to 99
TROUBLESHOOTING (TS) 101 to 199
MAINTENANCE PRACTICES (MP) 201 to 299
SERVICING (SRV) 301 to 399
REMOVAL/INSTALLATION (R/I) 401 to 499
ADJUSTMENT/TEST (A/T) 501 to 599
INSPECTION/CHECK (I/C) 601 to 699
CLEANING/PAINTING (C/P) 701 to 799
APPROVED REPAIRS (AR) 801 to 899

When it is convenient for the user to have different types of tasks in one page block, MAINTENANCE
PRACTICES, the 201-to-299 page block is used.

ATA-06 Page 8 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

REFERENCE PLANES AND LINES


The airplane is divided into stations, waterlines, and buttock lines. They are measured in inches. They will
help you quickly identify the location of components, the center of gravity and the weight distribution.

STANDARD ABBREVIATIONS AND DEFINITIONS


Fuselage

B STA, BS, or STA: Body (Fuselage) Station: A plane that is perpendicular to the fuselage
centerline. It is measured from a point 130.00 inches forward of the nose.
BBL or BL: Body (Fuselage) Buttock Line: A vertical plane that is parallel to the vertical
centerline plane, BBL 0.00. It is found by its perpendicular distance from the
fuselage centerline plane (it is a measurement of width).
BRP: Body (Fuselage) Reference Plane: A plane that is perpendicular to the BBL
plane and goes through BWL 208.10 (the top of the main deck floor beams).
BWL or WL: Body (Fuselage) Waterline: A plane that is perpendicular to the BBL plane,
parallel to the fuselage centerline. It is measured from a parallel imaginary
plane, BWL 0.00, 148.5 inches below the lowest fuselage surface.
LBL: Left Buttock Line.
RBL: Right Buttock Line.

Wing

FS or RS: Front Spar or Rear Spar: The principal spanwise transverse member of the
wing structure, perpendicular to the wing reference plane.
FSS or RSS: Front or Rear Spar Station: A plane that is perpendicular to the wing chord
plane and the plane of the front or rear spar.
ISS: Inboard Slat Stations: A plane that is perpendicular to the inboard leading
edge slats. It is measured from the intersection of the slat rotation axis and a
plane perpendicular to the wing reference plane.
LE STA: Leading Edge Station: A plane that is perpendicular to the wing reference
plane and the leading edge. It is measured from the intersection of the
leading edge extension and wing buttock line 0.00.

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-06 Page 9


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

 
MAC: Mean Aerodynamic Chord: A chord of the section of imaginary airfoil on
the wing which would have vectors throughout the flight range identical
to those of the actual wing.
OSS: Outboard Slat Stations: A plane that is perpendicular to the outboard
leading edge slats. It is measured from the intersection of the slat
rotation axis and a plane perpendicular to the wing reference plane.
W STA or WS: Wing Station: A plane that is perpendicular to the wing reference plane
and the plane of the outboard rear spar. It is measured from the
intersection of the extended leading edge and the wing buttock line 0.00.
WBL: Wing Buttock Line: A plane that is perpendicular to the wing reference
plane and parallel to the trace of the fuselage centerline. It is measured
from the intersection of the wing reference plane and the body buttock
line 0.00.
WRP: Wing Reference Plane: The outboard rear spar plane projected inboard.
WCP: Wing Chord Plane: A plane through the trailing and leading edges of the
wing airfoil.
WTS: Wing Tip Station: A plane that is perpendicular to the wing reference
plane and the wing buttock line 0.00. It is measured from the
intersection of the leading edge and the wing buttock line 0.00.

Vertical Stabilizer

FIN STA: Fin Station: A plane that is perpendicular to the centerline of the vertical
stabilizer rear spar. It is measured from Fin Station 0.00, the
intersection of the leading edge line extension and the fin waterline 0.00.
FIN LE STA: Vertical Stabilizer Leading Edge Station: A plane that is perpendicular to
the vertical stabilizer leading edge. It is measured from the leading Edge
Station 0.00, intersection of the leading edge line extension and the
vertical stabilizer waterline 0.00
FIN WL: Vertical Stabilizer Waterline: A horizontal plane that is measured parallel
to a body waterline. Fin waterline 0.00.
RUD STA: Rudder Station: A plane that is perpendicular to the rudder hinge
centerline. It is measured from Rudder Station 0.00, the intersection of
the rudder hinge centerline and vertical stabilizer waterline 0.00.

ATA-06 Page 10 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Horizontal Stabilizer

ELEV STA: Elevator Station: A plane that is perpendicular to the elevator hinge
centerline. It is measured from the intersection of the elevator hinge
centerline and stabilizer buttock line 0.00.
FS STA: Front Spar Station: A plane that is perpendicular to the horizontal stabilizer
front spar. It is measured from the Front Spar Station 0.00, the intersection of
the front spar and trace of body buttock line 0.00 at the horizontal stabilizer
reference plane.
HSBL: Stabilizer Buttock Line: A plane that is perpendicular to the horizontal
stabilizer reference plane and parallel to the trace of the fuselage centerline.
It is measured from stabilizer buttock line 0.00, the intersection of horizontal
stabilizer reference plane and body buttock line 0.00.
SCP: Stabilizer Chord Plane: A plane through the trailing and leading edges of the
stabilizer airfoil.
LE STA: Leading Edge Station: A plane that is perpendicular to the horizontal stabilizer
leading edge. It is measured from the Stabilizer Leading Edge Station 0.00,
the intersection of the leading edge line extension and stabilizer buttock line
0.00.
RS STA: Rear Spar Station: A plane that is perpendicular to the horizontal stabilizer
rear spar. It is measured from the Rear Spar Station 0.00, the intersection of
the rear spar and the trace of body buttock line 0.00 at the horizontal stabilizer
reference plane.
STAB STA: Stabilizer Station: A plane that is perpendicular to the stabilizer rear spar and
horizontal stabilizer reference plane. Stabilizer station 0.00 is at the
intersection of the leading edge extension, body buttock line 0.00 and the
horizontal stabilizer reference plane.

Nacelle

NAC BL: Nacelle Buttock Line: A plane parallel to a wing buttock line. Nacelle buttock
line 0.00 is equivalent to wing buttock line 191.00

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-06 Page 11


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

B STA B STA
130.00 625.60

BODY BUTTOCK MAC


LINE (BBL)

BBL 0

FIN WL
25% CHORD LINE 242.00
FIN LE STA 0.00
BODY STATIONS 35° RUDDER
(B STA) FIN STA 0.00 HINGE LINE
RS

FIN WL 0.00
BWL 300.58)

WBL
RUDD
(208.10)
STA 0.00

TR STA
STATIC GROUND LINE
92.92
BS
130.00

BWL 542.50

BWL 306.50
TRACE OF WRP
AT KEAD EDGE

BWL 208.10 (BRP)

BODY WATER
LINE (BWL) BWL 106.00

BWL 0.00

Reference Planes and Lines

ATA-06 Page 12 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

 
BBL 0.00 STAB BL
STAB BL 0.00
216.00
7° DIHEDRAL
SCP

ELEV
STA 0.00 ELEVATOR HINGE LINE
STAB BS
25% CHORD LINE

VIEW 2
PLANE VIEW OF HORIZONTAL STABILIZER
(NORMAL TO STABILIZER CHORD PLANE) B STA
30° 848.33
STAB LE LEADING EDGE B STA B STA
STA 0.00 AT WCP 796.771 860.595
STAB B STA BWL BWL
STA 0.00 606.247 228.088 228.976
BWL
BRP BWL 208.10 225.267
BWL BWL 195.331 BWL 193.679 TRAILING
183.888
BWL 179.762 EDGE
AT WCP
BBL 70.85 B STA 1° INCIDENCE B STA
516.253 752.63
BBL
0.00 L EF T SI D E V I EW OF B ODY A T W IN G
WBL
71.24 WBL
571.5
WCP

CENTER
SECTION WCP WBL OUTBD RS
6° DIHEDRAL 0.00 BBL 70.85
ENG NAC BL 0
EXTENDED W BL 191.00
TRAILING
WING EDGE
STATIONS INBD
(W STA) RSS OUTBD PS

(WRP) WING REF PLANE

INBD RS
25% CHORD LINE

OUTBD PSS

EXTENDED
25° LEADING
EDGE
INBD
PSS
VIEW 1
W STA 0.00 PLANE VIEW OF WING
0.00
WBL (NORMAL TO WING CHORD PLANE)
0.00
Reference Planes and Lines

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-06 Page 13


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

PRINCIPAL DIMENSIONS AND AREAS


Overall Airplane

• Length - 109 feet-7 inches (737-300)

• Length - 119 feet-7 inches (737-400)

• Length - 101 feet-9 inches (737-500)

• Width - 94 feet-10 inches

• Height (vertical stabilizer tip, top of the fairing to the ground) - 36 feet-6 inches

Wing

• Root Chord (theoretical, at the body centerline) - 288.09 inches

• Basic Chord (theoretical) - 186.72 inches

• Tip Chord (theoretical) - 63.83 inches

• Planform Taper Ratio

• Dihedral (wing reference plane with respect to the body reference plane) - 6 degrees

• Sweepback (25 percent chord line) - 25 degrees

• Aspect Ratio - 9.16

• Mean Aerodynamic Chord (basic wing only) - 134.46 inches

• Body Station at 0% MAC - 625.60

Horizontal Stabilizer

• Tip chord (theoretical) - 60 inches

• Sweepback (25 percent chord line) - 30 degrees

• Dihedral (horizontal stabilizer reference plane with respect to the body reference plane) - 7 degrees

• Aspect Ratio - 4.04

ATA-06 Page 14 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

 
Vertical Stabilizer

• Height - inches

• Root Chord (theoretical, leading edge at body station 971.81) - 205 inches

• Sweepback (25 percent chord line) - 35 degrees

• Aspect Ratio - 1.81

Fuselage

• Height of the body reference plane (top of the floor beam WL 208.10) above the ground at the main
gear - 102.10 inches

• Height (constant cross section) Above the body reference plane - 98.4 inches Below the body reference
plane - 59.60 inches

• Height to the centerline of the windows above the body reference plane - 38 inches

• Length - 1267 inches (737-300)

• Length - 1387 inches (737-400)

• Length - 1173 inches (737-500)

Areas

• Wing (basic) - 980.0 square feet

• Horizontal Stabilizer Surfaces (total, with the area in the fuselage) - 545 square feet

• Vertical Stabilizer Surfaces (total) - 370 square feet

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-06 Page 15


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

12 FT 4 IN.

109 FT 7 IN.

13 FT 2 IN.
36 FT 6 IN.

13 FT
2 IN. 40 FT 10 IN.
105 FT 7 IN.

94 FT 10 IN.
41 FT 8 IN.

17 FT
Sheet 1 of 3 2 IN.

ATA-06 Page 16 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

12 FEET 4 INCHES

119 FEET 7 INCHES

13 FEET 2 INCHES

36 FEET 6 INCHES

13 FEET 2 INCHES
46 FEET 10 INCHES
115 FEET 7 INCHES

94 FEET 10 INCHES
41 FEET 8 INCHES

Sheet 2 of 3 17 FEET 2 INCHES

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-06 Page 17


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

12 FT 4 IN.

101 FT 9 IN.

13 FT 2 IN.

36 FT 6 IN.

13 FT
2 IN. 36 FT 4 IN.
97 FT 9 IN.

94 FT 9 IN.
41 FT 8 IN.

Sheet 3 of 3 17 FT 18 IN

ATA-06 Page 18 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE

FORWARD ENTRY DOOR


30 X 65
ENTRY DOOR
20 INCH USUAL SPACING

 
 
 
 

34 X 72

130
178
196.5
211.8
227.8
243.7
259.5
277
294.5
312
328
344
360
380
400
420
440
460
480
500
500A
500B
500C
500D
520
540

188
203.8
219.8
235.8
251.6
WL 306.5
UPPER 74.0 R
LOBE

WL 246.1 WINDOWS

UPPER RADII
CREASE LINE
WL 208.1 WL 208.1 TOP

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


OF FLOOR BEAM
LOWER
LOBE

WL 148.5
FORWARD ACCESS
DOOR 14 X 27
CARGO DOOR
ELECTRONIC
35 X 48 ABOVE WL 208.1 UPPER LOBE FROM STA
NOSE GEAR ACCESS DOOR
480 TO STA 808
30.5 X 24.5 PRODUCTION BREAK
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource

WHEEL WELL BELOW WL 208.1 LOWER LOBE FROM STA


390 TO STA 540 AND FROM STA 727 TO STA 727E+3
SECTION 41 SECTION 43

REAR VIEW

20 INCH USUAL SPACING PRESSURE BULKHEAD


ESCAPE HATCH
20 X 38

540
559
578
597
616
639
663.75
685
706
727
727A
727B
727C
727D
727E
747
767
787
807
827
847
867
887
907
927
947.5
967
986.5
1006
1016
1040
1064
1088
1104
1121
1138
1156
1217

FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY


BODY STATION DIAGRAM

EXHAUST
SHIELD

PRESSURE
TAILCONE
LEVEL
ACCESS
WING CENTER
APU DOOR
SECTION
ACCESS
ACCESS DOOR
DOOR

ENTRY DOOR (LEFT)


WHEEL CARGO DOOR 30 X 72
WELL 33 X 48 GALLEY DOOR (RIGHT)
30 X 65

SECTION 46 SECTION 48

737-300
(LEFT SIDE VIEW)

ATA-06 Page 19
and Systems Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE

FORWARD ENTRY DOOR


30 X 65
ENTRY DOOR 22 INCH USUAL SPACING
34 X 72
20 INCH USUAL SPACING

 
 
 
 

130
178
196.5
211.8
227.8
243.7
259.5
277
294.5
312
328
344
360
380
400
420
440
460
480
500
500A
500B
500C
500D
500E
500F
500G
520
540

ATA-06 Page 20
188
203.8
219.8
235.8
251.6
WL 306.5
UPPER 74.0 R
LOBE

WL 246.1 WINDOWS

UPPER RADII
CREASE LINE
WL 208.1 WL 208.1 TOP
OF FLOOR BEAM
LOWER
LOBE

WL 148.5
FORWARD ACCESS
DOOR 14 X 27 CARGO DOOR
35 X 48
ELECTRONIC
NOSE GEAR ABOVE WL 208.1 UPPER LOBE FROM STA
ACCESS DOOR PRODUCTION BREAK
WHEEL WELL 480 TO STA 808
30.5 X 24.5
DOOR BELOW WL 208.1 LOWER LOBE FROM STA
390 TO STA 540 AND FROM STA 727 TO STA 727G+3
SECTION 41 SECTION 43
REAR VIEW

20 INCH USUAL SPACING


22 INCH USUAL SPACING
PRESSURE BULKHEAD
20 INCH SPACING

540
559
578
601
616
639
663.75
685
706
727
727A
727B
727C
727D
727E
727F
727G
747
767
787
807
827
847
867
887
907
927
947.5
967
986.5
1006
1016
1040
1064
1088
1104
1121
1138
1156
1217

FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY


EXHAUST
SHIELD

PRESSURE TAILCONE
LEVEL ACCESS
WING CENTER APU DOOR (RIGHT)
SECTION ACCESS
ACCESS DOOR
DOOR

ENTRY DOOR (LEFT)


ESCAPE HATCH WHEEL CARGO DOOR 30 X 72
20 X 38 WELL 33 X 48 GALLEY DOOR (RIGHT)
30 X 65

SECTION 46 SECTION 48

737-400
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource

(LEFT SIDE VIEW)

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE

PRODUCTION BREAK
FORWARD ENTRY DOOR 22-INCH SPACING BETWEEN
30 X 65 FRAMES, THIS AREA
ENTRY DOOR
34 X 72
20 INCH

 
 
 
 

360

328
344

312
294.5
380

277

196.5
211.8
227.8
243.7
259.5
400
420
440
460
482
482A
482B
520

178
540

130
235.8
219.8
251.6

203.8
188
WL 306.5

UPPER
LOBE
74.0 R
WL 246.1 WINDOWS
UPPER RADII
CREASE LINE
WL 208.1 TOP OF
LOWER FLOOR BEAM

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


LOBE WL 208.1

FORWARD ACCESS WL 148.5


DOOR 14 X 27
CARGO DOOR
ELECTRONIC 35 X 48 ABOVE WL 208.1 UPPER LOBE FROM STA 480
NOSE GEAR ACCESS DOOR
TO STA 808
WHEEL WELL 30.5 X 24.5
BELOW WL 208.1 LOWER LOBE FROM STA 390
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource

TO STA 540 AND FROM STA 727 TO STA 727C +3


SECTION 41 SECTION 43

REAR VIEW
ESCAPE HATCH
(LEFT AND RIGHT) 20-INCH SPACING BETWEEN PRESSURE BULKHEAD
20 X 38 FRAMES, THIS AREA

767
787
1217

1040

986.5
1064

967
1016
1088

540
559
578
597
616
639
663.75
685
706
727
727A
727B
727C
747
807
827
847
867
887
907
927
947.5
1138

1104
1156

1121

1006

FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY


EXHAUST
SHIELD

PRESSURE
LEVEL TAILCONE
WING CENTER ACCESS
SECTION DOOR
APU
ACCESS
ACCESS DOOR
DOOR

ENTRY DOOR (LEFT)


CARGO DOOR
30 X 72
WHEEL GALLEY DOOR (RIGHT)
WELL 33 X 48
30 X 65

SECTION 46 SECTION 48

737-500
(LEFT SIDE VIEW)

ATA-06 Page 21
and Systems Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE

_____
NOTE:
62.00
1. THE FIN STATIONS ARE PERPENDICULAR TO THE 55% LINE
46.50
2. THE LEADING EDGE STATIONS ARE PERPENDICULAR TO THE LEADING EDGE PIVOT POINT (EXAMPLE)

 
 
 
 

34.10
3. THE RUDDER STATIONS ARE PERPENDICULAR TO THE 75% LINE
8.00

ATA-06 Page 22
4. THE VERTICAL STABILIZER RIBS FROM FIN STATION 81.10 6.20 1.00
TO FIN STATION 292.70 ARE ON 9.2 INCH CENTERS
5. TO CONVERT THE FIN STATION AT THE FRONT SPAR LE STA 311.12 FWL
(10%) LE STA = FIN STA 1.01756521 + FIN STA 299.15 230.25
FIN STA 292.70
3.59150051 RUD STA
FIN STA 283.50
237.64
6. TANGENT A = 0.52293481 RUD STA
FIN STA 265.10
TANGENT B = 0.78884390 233.09
FIN STA 237.50 RUD STA
TANGENT C = 0.84793481
BALANCE WEIGHT (EXAMPLE) 233.09
FIN STA 209.90 RUDDER SPAR
RUD STA
RUDDER LE 196.46
FIN STA 182.30 FWL 161.0
25% CHORD LINE RUD STA
FIN STA 154.70 174.12
REAR SPAR 55% CHORD
242.00
FRONT SPAR 10% CHORD RUD STA 141.52
FIN STA 127.10 FWL
BWL 378.218 112.356
FIN STA 99.50 RUD STA 121.64
TANGENT POINT
FIN STA 90.30 RUDDER HINGE 75% LINE
FIN STA 81.10
FIN STA 69.44 RUD STA 86.59
FIN STA 57.77
FIN STA 46.10

FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY


FIN STA 9.50 RUD STA
LE STA 0 C 6.50 60.15
RUD STA
A
FIN STA 0 35° 31.65
RUD STA 23.27 RUD STA
B
FIN WL 0 (BWL 300.50) 13.33

BODY
20.0 20.0 20.5 B STA 1016.00 FIN CROWN
VERTICAL STABILIZER AND RUDDER STATIONS

THRUST
20.0 19.5 B STA 1085.56 STA LINE
RIB
19.5 52.248 FIN STA 67.70
FIN
CONNECTION
19.5 STA RUD STA 0.00
POINTS
56.57
1.65
132.617 BODY STA BODY STA
BODY STA 1007.65 1126.56 1177.81
BODY
112.75
STA
840.193 153.75
205.00
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE

 
 
 
 

LE STA 0
STAB STA 0
LE STA 27.75
56.01
15.10
STABILIZER
STAB STA 57.93 CONNECT
BODY STA
POINT "A" 1049.602
STAB STA 68.14 SEE A

25%
STAB STA 75.00 CHORD
LINE

STAB STA 83.50

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


STABILIZER
BODY STA
CONNECT 30°
1096.428
POINT "B" SWEEPBACK
SEE A
STAB STA 83.05
TAB HINGE RIB 67.54
(EXAMPLE) ELEV STA
55% CHORD 151.00
23.10
CONTROL TAB HINGE REAR SPAR
ELEV REAR SPAR
BODY STA
113.25
1146.508
ELEV BALENCE PANEL
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource

LEADING EDGE 75% CHORD


ELEV HINGE
ELEV FRONT SPAR

ELEV 37.75
FRONT SPAR STA 0
STAB BL
252.10
JACK SCREW PIVOT POINT
10% CHORD (STAB NEUTRAL)
BODY BL
ELEV STA 23.40
24.35 35.50
ELEV ELEV STA 24.90 POINT "A" BODY STA 1093.417
STA FRONT SPAR
39.02

FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY


(CENTER)
18.65 SECONDARY
33.21 ELEV STA BEAM
4.43 94.27 SECONDARY BEAM
ELEV ELEV STA 66.54
44.27 STABILIZER PRIMARY BEAM
STA ELEV HINGE RIB
ELEV STA CLOSURE RIB
149.12
176.64 ELEV STA 121.59 REAR SPAR
ELEV STA ELEV PRIMARY BODY STA 1142.495
ELEV HINGE RIB (CENTER)
213.32 HINGE BEAM
ELEV RIB HINGE BODY STA
TRAILING 92.41
HINGE 1154.000
EDGE RIB POINT "B"
ELEV NOSE BODY BL
RADIUS 21.75
STAB STA
HINGE
295.10 108.16 AIRPLANE (SYM)

AIRPLANE (SYM)
A
____
NOTE: HORIZONTAL STABILIZER RIBS FROM STA 83.50
HORIZONTAL STABILIZER AND ELEVATOR STATION DIAGRAM

TO 295.10 HAVE 9.20 INCH CENTERS


STAB SEMI SPAN 252.10 INCHES

ATA-06 Page 23
and Systems Introduction
 

AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource


 
 

WING STATION DIAGRAM


68.83
36.44
21.98
WBL
WBL 571.5
WBL 550.55 560.0
SLAT NO. 1
WBL 541.69
W STA
583.0 WBL 522.00
W STA
557.0
AILERON
CL OUTBOARD FRONT SPAR W STA
531.0
SURGE TANK
W STA
505.0 ACCESS DOOR (EXAMPLE)
W STA
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE

479.0
WBL 417.00
W STA
453.0
SPOILER NO.0
SLAT NO. 2
CL OUTBOARD REAR SPAR
WBL
355.0
WBL SPOILER NO.1
SLAT NO. 3 329.75
WBL
304.5
SPOILER NO.2
WBL
279.25

25% BASIC CORD WBL


25° SWEEPBACK 254.0
WBL SPOILER NO.3
227.0
CL INBOARD FRONT SPAR
W STA 290.07
WBL 204.4 NACELLE
WBL 198.6 CL BL 0.00
LE STA 222.7
WBL 183.4 WBL 181.44 WBL 191.0
LE STA 213.0
WBL
FLAP NO. 1 157.0 SPOILER NO.4
LE STA 169.0
INBOARD FLAP
WBL 135.5
CL INBOARD REAR SPAR
WBL 114.0
FLAP NO. 2
S14
WBL 92.5 S1 WBL 87.75
LWR
LWR WBL 73.00
WBL 71.24
S12,S11
and Systems Introduction

UPR LANDING GEAR


113.1701
DOORS
124.8268 W STA 135.7202
LE STA RSS 135.2384
21.8721
WBL 0.00 CL AIRPLANE (SYM)

W STA 60.9735
WS 55.6989
0 185.60
288.0968
41.5233
SPANWISE BEAM NOTE:
____ 1. BASIC LEADING EDGE ANGLE TAN = 0.53223430
2. SEMI SPAN 47.36 FEET

ATA-06 Page 24 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


 
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

ENGINE AND NACELLE STATION DIAGRAM

KRUEGER FLAP

T/R SLEEVE
AFT
1.8°
TOE IN

NAC

TE
FAIRING
FLAP TRACK
FRONT SPAR REAR SPAR FAIRING
INLET SLAT
COWL FAN
THRUST T/R SLEEVE
COWL
REVERSER FWD

P L A N V I E W E N GI N E N O . 1

NAC STA NAC STA


120.47 343.89
223.42
NAC STA
204.5 AFT MOUNT
FWD MOUNT
59.02
NAC STA
NAC STA 254.52
195.5

76.32 WL 100.0
57.4 NWL
98.5
5.8°

28.78
PLUG
17.95 49.34 30.76
65.78 PRIMARY EXHAUST

166.25

192.61
INLET COWL
FAN COWL THRUST REVERSER

L E F T V I E W E N GI N E N O . 1

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-06 Page 25


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

SERVICE INTERPHONE SYSTEM


Overview

The service interphone system provides interphone communications between the flight crew, the attendants,
and ground crew personnel. The system includes: the remote electronics unit, the service interphone switch,
the attendants handsets, and the service interphone jacks. Also, there is a provision for a control stand
handset.

HANDSET AT AFT
ATTENDANT'S PANEL

HANDSET AT FORWARD
ATTENDANT'S PANEL

SERVICE
INTERPHONE
SWITCH REMOTE
SEE A ELECTRONICS
UNIT

AFT OVERHEAD PANEL, P5

LOAD CONTROL
CENTER, P6-2

EXTERNAL POWER
RECEPTACLE PANEL
SEE B

EXTERNAL INTERPHONE
POWER
HANDSET JACK ON
CONTROL STAND -
AFT FACE

CONN FLIGHT SERVICE


SERVICE NOSE
INTERPHONE WHEELWELL
PILOT
OFF
ON
NORM
CALL LIGHT
NOT
ON IN USE

SERVICE INTERPHONE SWITCH EXTERNAL POWER RECEPTACLE PAN


A B

ATA-06 Page 26 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

 
Overview (Continued):

Handsets are installed in the forward and aft attendant panels for communication between attendants.
Switched service interphone jacks located throughout the airplane are for use by ground crew personnel during
servicing and maintenance. Personnel in the control cabin can communicate with the attendants or ground
crew personnel through the audio selector panels and the headphones and microphones of the flight interphone
system.

The service interphone system gets power from the 28-volts DC battery bus and also the unswitched electronics
bus No. 2, through the INTPH AND WARNING circuit breaker located on the load control center-right panel, P6.

CODE LOCATION AREA

A WING REFUELING STATION EXTERNAL


B FORWARD OF RIGHT WHEEL WELL EXTERNAL
C FORWARD OF LEFT WHEEL WELL EXTERNAL
D AFT CABIN CEILING INTERNAL
E APU ACCESS PANEL EXTERNAL
F ELECTRONICS RACK INTERNAL

B D

F C E

STA STA STA


130 350 1043
STA
1004
STA
664

D
E
F
B,C

Switched Service Interphone Jacks Location

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-06 Page 27


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Remote Electronic Unit

The remote electronic unit (REU) is installed on the E2-1 shelf of the electronic equipment rack. There is an
audio accessory unit (AAU) card inside the REU.

The AAU provides the necessary DC voltage to the system microphones and amplifies the audio signal. Either
carbon or transistorized microphones may be used. Automatic level control ensures a constant output
regardless of the number of microphones connected to the system. Since the system has no ON/OFF switch, it
will operate whenever the battery bus or DC bus No. 2 has power. Gain controls for the service interphone
system are on the audio control panel.

AAU OBS F/O CAPT


SVR INT EXT HDPH HDPH
SVR INT ATT FLT FLT
FLT INT SVR SVR
DME 2

ADJ
D ME 1 A DJ
PA SENS ATTENTION
PA GAIN OBSERVE PRECAUTIONS
PA ST FOR HANDLING
AUDIO POT 1 ELECTROSTATIC
AUDIO POT 2 SENSITIVE
DEVICES

REMOTE ELE ONICS UNIT

ATA-06 Page 28 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

 
Service Interphone Switch

The service interphone switch is located on the aft overhead panel P5. In the ON position, the switch connects
the microphone lines from the external service interphone jacks to the input of the interphone amplifiers. The
OFF position disconnects the microphone lines to isolate the external service interphone jacks during flight.

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-06 Page 29


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Handsets

The handset may be of the press-to-use or press-to-talk type. The button on a press-to-use type handset
completes both microphone and receiver audio circuits when the handset button is pressed. The button on a
press-to-talk type handset completes only the microphone circuits when it is pressed; receiver circuits are
connected directly to the system.

PRESS-TO-TALK
SWITCH

HANDHELD MICROPHONE

ATA-06 Page 30 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Operation

The INTPH AND WARNING circuit breaker on the load control center P6 controls power to the system. The
system is on whenever power is provided to one of the buses.

Setting the service interphone switch (on the aft overhead panel P5) to ON connects the microphone circuits
from the external service interphone jacks to the interphone amplifier. This allows ground crew at the various
maintenance locations to talk with each other.

Attendants may communicate with each other, with the flight crew, and with the ground crew, by using the
handsets installed at their stations.

The flight crew can communicate with the attendants and with crew at maintenance locations by pushing the
ATTEND call switch and SERV INT audio listen switch on the pilots' overhead panel P5. On airplanes with
digital control systems the service interphone switch may be on the audio selector panel.

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-06 Page 31


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Adjustment for gain is with the audio control knobs on the audio selector panel.

No stowage is provided for handsets at the switched service interphone jacks and the control stand jack.
Therefore, to do maintenance, handsets must be furnished by ground crew personnel.

ATA-06 Page 32 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

 
TABLE OF CONTENTS
B737-300/400/500 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION SELF-PACED
ATA-21

AIR CONDITIONING............................................................................................................................................. 5
Overview..................................................................................................................................................... 5
Cooling ....................................................................................................................................................... 8
Temperature Control ................................................................................................................................ 12
Pressurization Control System ................................................................................................................. 14
AIRCONDITIONING COOLING SYSTEM ............................................................................................................. 16
Overview................................................................................................................................................... 16
AIR CYCLE SYSTEM & COMPONENTS B737-300 & 500................................................................................... 20
Overview................................................................................................................................................... 20
Pack Valve ................................................................................................................................................ 22
Primary Heat Exchanger ........................................................................................................................... 23
Secondary Heat Exchanger ....................................................................................................................... 23
Air Cycle Machine..................................................................................................................................... 24
Thermal Sensing Units............................................................................................................................. 25
Check Valves ............................................................................................................................................ 26
Water Separator ....................................................................................................................................... 27
Water Spray Injector................................................................................................................................. 28
Water Separator 35°F Control System...................................................................................................... 30
AIR CYCLE SYSTEM & COMPONENTS B737-400 ......................................................................................... 32
Overview................................................................................................................................................... 32
Pack Valve ................................................................................................................................................ 34
Primary Heat Exchangers ......................................................................................................................... 35
Secondary Heat Exchanger ....................................................................................................................... 35
Air Cycle Machine..................................................................................................................................... 36
Pack Temperature Control Valve .............................................................................................................. 37
Standby Pack Temperature Control Valve................................................................................................. 37
High Pressure Water Separator System.................................................................................................... 38
Water Extractor Duct ................................................................................................................................ 38
Reheater ................................................................................................................................................... 38
Condenser ................................................................................................................................................ 38
Water Extractors ....................................................................................................................................... 38
Thermal Sensing Units............................................................................................................................. 40
Thermal Switches..................................................................................................................................... 40
Temperature Sensors ............................................................................................................................... 40
Temperature Bulb .................................................................................................................................... 40
Pack/Zone Temperature Controller.......................................................................................................... 42
Conditioned Air Check Valve..................................................................................................................... 44
Water Spray Nozzle .................................................................................................................................. 44
Air Cycle Machine - Servicing (Oil Level Check) .......................................................................................... 45

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-21 Page 1


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

 
RAM AIR SYSTEM & COMPONENTS 737-300 & 500 .................................................................................... 48
Overview................................................................................................................................................... 48
Ram Air Inlet ............................................................................................................................................ 50
Ram Air Ducts .......................................................................................................................................... 50
Ram Air Actuator...................................................................................................................................... 52
Ram Air Inlet Modulation Panel Cable and Linkage System..................................................................... 53
Ram Air Controller.................................................................................................................................... 54
Turbofan................................................................................................................................................... 55
Turbofan Valve ......................................................................................................................................... 56
Ram Air Exhaust Louvers ......................................................................................................................... 57
Inspection Doors....................................................................................................................................... 58
RAM AIR SYSTEM & COMPONENTS 737-400 .............................................................................................. 60
Overview................................................................................................................................................... 60
Ram Air Inlet ............................................................................................................................................ 62
Ram Air Ducts .......................................................................................................................................... 63
Ram Air Actuator...................................................................................................................................... 64
Ram Air Inlet Modulation Panel Cable and Linkage System..................................................................... 66
Pack/Zone Temperature Control Module ................................................................................................. 68
Turbofan................................................................................................................................................... 69
Turbofan Valve ......................................................................................................................................... 70
Ram Air Exhaust Louvers ......................................................................................................................... 71
Inspection Doors....................................................................................................................................... 72
Ram Air System Turbofan - Servicing .......................................................................................................... 73
DISTRIBUTION SYSTEM................................................................................................................................... 75
Overview................................................................................................................................................... 75
Ground Service Conditioned Air Connection B737-300/400/500.............................................................. 78
Recirculation Fan...................................................................................................................................... 79
CONTROL CABIN CONDITIONED AIR DISTRIBUTION SYSTEM........................................................................ 82
Overview................................................................................................................................................... 82
Control Cabin Conditioned Air Outlets...................................................................................................... 84
Muffler ..................................................................................................................................................... 84
Windshield Air and Foot Control............................................................................................................... 86
PASSENGER CABIN CONDITIONED AIR DISTRIBUTION SYSTEM .................................................................... 87
Overview................................................................................................................................................... 87
Overhead Supply Riser Ducts ................................................................................................................... 88
Overhead Distribution Duct and Diffusers................................................................................................ 88
Passenger Cabin Air Exhaust.................................................................................................................... 88
Galley Vent System................................................................................................................................... 92
CONDITIONED AIR TEMPERATURE CONTROL SYSTEM B737-300 & 500 ........................................................ 94
Overview................................................................................................................................................... 94
Air Mix Valve ............................................................................................................................................ 96
Thermal Sensing Units............................................................................................................................. 98
Temperature Selectors ........................................................................................................................... 102
Temperature Controller .......................................................................................................................... 103

ATA-21 Page 2 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

 
CONDITIONED AIR TEMPERATURE CONTROL SYSTEM B737-400................................................................. 104
Overview................................................................................................................................................. 104
Trim Air Pressure Regulating and Shut Off Valve .................................................................................. 105
Trim Air Modulating Valves.................................................................................................................... 106
Pack/Zone Temperature Controller........................................................................................................ 108
Trim Air Check Valves............................................................................................................................ 110
Thermal Sensing Units........................................................................................................................... 112
Zone Temperature Sensors .................................................................................................................... 114
Temperature Selectors ........................................................................................................................... 115
PRESSURIZATION SYSTEM ............................................................................................................................ 116
Overview................................................................................................................................................. 116
Pressure Control Panel........................................................................................................................... 118
Pressure Controller................................................................................................................................. 119
Cabin Pressurization Outflow Valve........................................................................................................ 120
Forward Outflow Valve ........................................................................................................................... 121
Safety Relief Valves ................................................................................................................................ 122
PRESSURIZATION INDICATION AND WARNING .............................................................................................. 124
Overview................................................................................................................................................. 124
CARGO COMPARTMENT HEATING.................................................................................................................. 126
Overview................................................................................................................................................. 126
Forward Cargo Compartment Heat Distribution...................................................................................... 126
EQUIPMENT COOLING SYSTEM ..................................................................................................................... 128
Overview................................................................................................................................................. 128
Normal and Alternate Cooling Fans........................................................................................................ 129
Normal and Alternate Check Valves........................................................................................................ 130
Low Flow Sensor .................................................................................................................................... 131
Filter Assembly ...................................................................................................................................... 132

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-21 Page 3


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

ATA-21 Page 4 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

AIR CONDITIONING
Overview

The air conditioning systems provide conditioned air to the control cabin, passenger cabin, electronic
equipment compartment, forward cargo compartment, air conditioning distribution bay and aft cargo
compartment. Air supply to the air conditioning system is furnished by the pneumatic system from either
engine bleed air or the auxiliary power unit (APU) in flight; from engine bleed air, APU bleed air, ground
pneumatic supply cart, or from a ground conditioned air supply cart during ground operation. Part of the
warm air supply from the engines or pneumatic cart is passed through air conditioning packs to be cooled.

The cold air is then mixed with the remainder of the warm air as required to obtain the conditioned air
temperature called for by the temperature control system. This conditioned air then passes into the control
and passenger cabins through the distribution system. Galley and toilet vents, and equipment cooling on the
ground exhaust cabin air without regard for cabin pressurization control requirements. The combined flow
from all outlets is limited to a value less than that which enters the cabin from the air conditioning system.
The outflow valves are regulated to exhaust only that additional quantity of air required to maintain the desired
pressure in the cabin.

This chapter considers the air conditioning system as four subsystems: cooling, distribution, temperature
control and pressurization control.

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-21 Page 5


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

 
B737-300 & 500

OVERBOARD -
OUTFLOW VALVE,
VENTS, DRAINS,
EQUIPMENT COOLING 1

CONTROL CABIN PASSENGER CABIN


DISTRIBUTION DISTRIBUTION

GROUND COND
AIR SERVICE
CONNECTION

CONTROL
CABIN
TRIM AIR MIX MANIFOLD

MIX
MUFF
RECIRCU-
LATION
FAN

COLD AIR HOT AIR HOT AIR COLD AIR

CONT FLOW CONTROL PASS


AIR AIR
CABIN AND SHUTOFF CABIN
COND COND
TEMP VALVE TEMP
PACK PACK
CONTROL CONTROL

(ELECTRIC) (ELECTRIC)

ENG ENG
1 2
ISOLATION
VALVE

APU

1 ON GROUND ONLY

Air Conditioning Simplified Diagram

ATA-21 Page 6 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

 
B737-400

OVERBOARD
OUTFLOW VALVE,
VENTS, DRAINS,
EQUIPMENT COOLING 1

AFT FORWARD
PASSENGER PASSENGER
CABIN CABIN

RECIRCULATION
TRIM AIR FANS
MODULATING
FLIGHT DECK VALVE LEFT RIGHT

MIX MANIFOLD

TRIM AIR TRIM AIR


MODULATING MODULATING
VALVE VALVE

TRIM AIR
PRESSURE
REGULATING
AIR VALVE AIR
COND COND
PACK PACK

PACK PACK
VALVE VALVE

ISOLATION
VALVE

ENG 1 ENG 2

APU
1 ON GROUND ONLY

Air Conditioning Simplified Diagram

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-21 Page 7


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Cooling

All cold air required for air conditioning is provided by air conditioning packs. Passing bleed air through a
primary heat exchanger, an air cycle machine, and a secondary heat exchanger cools the air sufficiently to
handle any cooling situation required. A ram air system provides coolant air for the heat exchangers. A ram
air modulation control system automatically regulates the supply of coolant air during flight to obtain required
cooling with minimum aerodynamic drag from the system. A turbofan draws air through the system for
ground operation and in flight when flaps are extended. On 737-300 and 737-500 airplanes, a water separator
removes excess moisture from the cooled air. On 737-400 airplanes, a high pressure water separator system
removes excess moisture before the air enters the turbine of the air cycle machine. The water is then passed
through a water injector and sprayed on the secondary heat exchanger core to aid in cooling bleed air. Various
thermal switches, thermostats, sensors, and valves are included to provide automatic protection and warning
of an air malfunction.

ATA-21 Page 8 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

 
CONDITIONED AIR

COLD AIR

COOL AIR

WARM AIR

HOT AIR

AIR FLOW

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-21 Page 9


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

 
Distribution

The conditioned air distribution system routes temperature controlled air to the passenger and control cabins.
One duct system supplies the control cabin and a separate duct system supplies the passenger cabin. Both
systems originate at the main distribution manifold. Riser ducts connect to an overhead duct extending fore
and aft the full length of the passenger cabin. A nozzle at the bottom of the duct and outlets at every other
window bay releases a balanced flow of air directly into the cabin. Air for the control cabin is extracted from
the LH air conditioning pack outlet before it enters the main distribution manifold.

A gasper outlet provides each crewmember and passenger a method for ventilating his local area. An
adjustable nozzle at each station allows the individual a choice from no airflow to maximum airflow from the
distribution system.

737-300 AND 737-500 AIRPLANES; One recirculation fan is attached to the main distribution manifold. The
recirculation fan recirculates conditioned air from around the forward cargo compartment into the distribution
system manifold where the air mixes with the air supplied by the air conditioning packs.

737-400 AIRPLANES; Two recirculation fans are attached to the main distribution manifold. The left
recirculation fan is used to recirculate conditioned air from the distribution bay. The right recirculation fan is
used to recirculate air from the forward cargo compartment. The air from both fans is mixed with conditioned
air from the packs.

ATA-21 Page 10 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

DISTRIBUTION
SYSTEM
PASSENGER CABIN

CARGO
COMPARTMENT
AFT

CONTROLS
OVERHEAD
PANEL (P5)

LEFT
COOLING PACK

RIGHT
COOLING PACK

CARGO
COMPARTMENT
ELECTRONICS FWD
MAIN
COMPARTMENT DISTRIBUTION
DISTRIBUTION
SYSTEM MANIFOLD
CONTROL CABIN

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-21 Page 11


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Temperature Control

On 737-300 and 737-500 airplanes, the temperature of the air entering the distribution systems to the
passenger and control cabins is regulated by positioning mix valves. The mix valves proportion hot bleed air
with cold air from the air conditioning packs to provide air conditioned comfort in the passenger and control
cabin. There is one mix valve for each air cycle system. Two sets of controls on the forward overhead panel
provide automatic or manual control and monitoring for each system. The control cabin controls the left air
cycle system and the passenger cabin controls the right air cycle system. Each control system consists of a
temperature controller, temperature selector, temperature indicator, temperature sensors, overheat control and
warning light, mix valve, and mix valve position indicator.

On 737-400 airplanes, the temperature of the air entering the distribution systems of the passenger and the
flight deck compartments is regulated by positioning the pack temperature control valves. The pack
temperature control valves are positioned such that the temperature demand of the zone requiring the most
cooling is satisfied. The pack temperature control valves receive positioning signals from the pack/zone
temperature controllers. The other zones temperature demands are met by allowing small amounts of bleed
air to enter the distribution system. This bleed air, called trim air, enters the distribution ducts by way of a
trim air system. The amount of bleed air entering the system is regulated by the trim air modulating valves.
The trim air modulating valves are also controlled by the pack/zone temperature controllers. Each zone
consists of a temperature selector, temperature indication, overheat indication, various thermal switches,
temperature sensors, and a zone trim air modulating valve. The temperature control system is fully automatic.

CONT CABIN AIR TEMP PASS CABIN

PASS
AIR TEMP
SUPPLY PASS
DUCT CABIN CAB
AIR MIX AIR MIX S FWD
60 D AFT AFT
VALVE VALVE 40 TEMP U
80 P U F
20 P C W R
L T P
D
100 Y A
CONT
°C L C
CAB
K
60 TRIM AIR
40 TEMP OFF
80
DUCT DUCT ON
20
O V E R H E AAT O V E R H E AAT
100
ZONE ZONE ZONE
C TEMP TEMP TEMP

AUTO AUTO CONT CAB FWD CAB AFT CAB


NO AL NO AL AUTO AUTO AUTO

COOL WARM COOL WARM

COOL WARM COOL WARM C W C W C W


OFF OFF
MANUAL MANUAL OFF OFF OFF

B737-300 & 500 B737-400

ATA-21 Page 12 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-21 Page 13


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Pressurization Control System

The pressurization control system includes pressurization control, pressurization relief valves, and
pressurization indicating and warning.

Cabin pressure is controlled by positioning a cabin pressurization outflow valve to meter cabin air exhaust.
The valve operates electrically from three control systems. The control systems are AUTO, STANDBY and
MANUAL. AUTO mode provides automatic pressure control of cabin altitude and rate of altitude change based
on settings made to the pressurization control panel (P5) of flight and landing altitudes. STANDBY mode
provides semi-automatic control of cabin altitude and rate of altitude change based on settings of the
pressurization control panel (P5) of cabin altitude and rate selected. MANUAL mode provides control of cabin
altitude and rate of altitude change by the selection of MAN AC or MAN DC and operation of a three position
(CLOSE-OFF-OPEN) manually operated toggle switch. Normal control is from the AUTO system with the
STANDBY system acting as a backup. The MANUAL system functions as an override over the AUTO and
STANDBY systems.

Pressurization relief valves include two safety relief valves, which prevent over-pressurization of the airplane,
and a vacuum relief valve which prevents pressure inside the airplane becoming appreciably less than
ambient. In addition to the relief valves, pressure equalization valves are installed in both cargo
compartments to provide a quick method of allowing cargo compartment pressure to vary, within limits, with
cabin pressure. Blowout panels are used in both cargo compartments to protect against a sudden differential
in pressure between the cargo compartment interior and exterior.

Indicators are provided to allow monitoring cabin altitude, differential pressure, and rate of pressure change.
A cabin altitude warning system sounds a horn if cabin altitude exceeds approximately 10,000 feet.

ATA-21 Page 14 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

SAFETY RELIEF
VALVE

VACUUM
SEE A RELIEF VALVE

CABIN
PRESSURIZATION
OUTFLOW VALVE
SEE B
EQUALIZATION
VALVE SCREEN
AFT CARGO
FORWARD COMPARTMENT
OVERHEAD PANEL
SEE C
PRESSURE A
CONTROLLER
AURAL WARNING
DEVICE BOX AUXILIARY
STATIC PORT
CABIN
PRESSURE
SWITCH NO. 1 AIR DATA
COMPUTER

0
ALT
10 1
HORN AUTO STANDBY MANUAL
0
9
50
CABIN 2 CUTOUT V
40 ALT 5 A
35 00000
L
30
8 3 FLT ALT DECR INCR V
X 1000 FEET 10 CABIN RATE
25 E
20 15 C
7 4 O
00 000 L
P
6 O
5 CAB ALT E
S
N
00 000 E
PRESS DIFF
LIMIT:TAKE- LAND ALT STBY AC
1 2
OFF & LDG
.125 PSI 3 MAN
UP F G AUTO DC
0 4 L R
DN T D CHECK
3
1 2 -.3 .8 1.9 2.9 3.9 5.0 5.1 6.0 6.8 7.6
CAB .3 1.4 2.4 3.4 4.4 5.0 5.6 6.4 7.2 8.0
18 20 22 24 26 28 30 32 34 36
FLT
ALTITUDE X 1000 FEET-MAX PRESS SCHEDULE

FORWARD OVERHEAD PANEL (P5)


C

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-21 Page 15


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

AIRCONDITIONING COOLING SYSTEM


Overview

The cooling system is divided into two subsystems.

1. Air Cycle System: discusses the path of the air being cooled and the equipment used for cooling it.
2. Ram Air System: describes the system, which employs outside air as a cooling medium for the air
cycle system, and its control.

There are two air cycle systems on each airplane. The systems are virtually identical and are located on either
side of the airplane centerline in a fairing beneath the center fuselage. The left system is considered to supply
the control cabin and the right system the passenger cabin. The systems operate in parallel, however, and
feed to a common manifold. During normal operation the control cabin utilizes only approximately twenty
percent of the left system supply with the balance going to the passenger cabin. Either system operating alone
is capable of maintaining acceptable temperature when necessary.

Cooling includes that portion of the air conditioning system which reduces the temperature of air received from
the pneumatic system enough to meet any cooling requirement of the air conditioning system. The method of
cooling this air consists of air-to-air type heat exchangers and an expansion turbine air cycle machine.

737-300 AND 737-500 AIRPLANES; Air from the pneumatic system can be divided such that all or part of the
air is passed through the cooling system with the remainder passing on to the mixing chamber. The cooled air
is then mixed with the bypassed air to supply properly conditioned air to the distribution system. Two mix
valves, one for each air cycle system, proportion the air.

737-400 AIRPLANES; Air from the pneumatic system can be divided such that all or part of the air is passed
through the cooling system with the remainder passing on to the trim air system. The cooled air leaving the
mix manifold through the zone supply ducts can then be mixed with the proper amount of trim air to supply
conditioned air to meet the individual temperature requirements of the three zones. Three trim air modulating
valves proportion the amount of trim air to the zones.

737-300 AND 737-500 AIRPLANES; The air cycle system supplies the cold air needed for mixture with the
hot compressed engine bleed air to provide a selected temperature in the control and passenger cabins. Air
from the Pneumatic System, Chapter 36, is received into the air conditioning system. The air must be cooled a
variable amount depending upon environmental conditions of the cabin. The temperature of air entering the
cabins is regulated by the two mix valves. These valves send part, or all, of the air through the air cycle
system to be cooled and bypass the remainder to be mixed with the cold air in the mixing chamber.

ATA-21 Page 16 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

 
Overview (Continued):

737-400 AIRPLANES; A high pressure water separator system dehumidifies the pack airflow sufficiently to
allow the pack output air to be below freezing.

737-300 AND 737-500 AIRPLANES; Since airflow through the air cycle system and hot air bypassing the
system are supplied by the same duct, and airflow to the cabin is relatively constant, the mix valves regulate
the quantity of cold air being supplied and also influence the temperature drop across the air cycle system. A
water separator 35°F control system bypasses warm air around the turbine to mix with cold air from the
turbine to prevent freezing in the water separator. As a result, cold air at the water separator is never below
freezing.

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-21 Page 17


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

1. RAM AIR INLET DEFLECTOR DOOR


2. RAM AIR INLET MODULATION PANEL
3. MIXING CHAMBER
4. WATER SEPARATOR 35°F CONTROL
5. RAM AIR DUCT
6. WATER SEPARATOR
7. TURBOFAN VALVE
8. AIR CYCLE MACHINE
9. SECONDARY HEAT EXCHANGER
10. PRIMARY HEAT EXCHANGER
11. PACK VALVE
12. MIX VALVE
13. RAM AIR ACTUATOR
14. TURBOFAN
15. RAM AIR EXHAUST DUCT
16. RAM AIR MODULATION SYSTEM CONTROL CABLES
17. WATER SEPARATOR 35°F CONTROL VALVE
18. PNEUMATIC SUPPLY DUCT
19. ISOLATION VALVE
20. RAM AIR TEMPERATURE SENSOR
21. WATER SPRAY INJECTOR SYSTEM SEE A

14
13
10 15
11 12 FROM APU
9
8 14
20
7
21 15
6
5
4 13

16

5
7
10
9
12
11
20
8
6
4 17
18
21
19

3. (LEFT SIDE ONLY)

B737-300 & 500

ATA-21 Page 18 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

SEE B

TRIM AIR MODULATING VALVES

TURBOFAN CONTROL VALVE

TRIM AIR PRESSURE


REGULATOR VALVE

PACK VALVE

P RESSURE
B ULKHEAD

TEMPERATURE
CONDITIONED CONTROL VALVE
AIR CHECK
VALVE HIGH PRESSURE
WATER SEPARATOR
SYSTEM
STANDBY
TEMPERATURE
CONTROL VALVE

AIR CYCLE
FWD MACHINE

SECONDARY HEAT
EXCHANGER

PRIMARY HEAT
EXCHANGER
TURBOFAN
RAM AIR
EXIT
LOUVERS
NOTE:
____ RIGHT PACK SHOWN
B
LEFT PACK IS OPPOSITE

B737-400

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-21 Page 19


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

AIR CYCLE SYSTEM & COMPONENTS B737-300 & 500


Overview

Air conditioning cooling is provided by two air cycle systems. The system also removes excess moisture from
the air.

Air cycle system equipment is contained in equipment bays located on either side of the airplane centerline at
the underside of the center fuselage.

In each air cycle system air is metered through the Pack (a flow control) Valve. The cooling devices used in
the air cycle system consist of a primary heat exchanger, a secondary heat exchanger, and an air cycle
machine. The heat exchangers are of the air-to-air type, with heat being transferred from the air going through
the air cycle system to air going through the ram air system. The air cycle machine consists of a turbine and
a compressor. Air passing through the secondary heat exchanger and expanding through the turbine drops in
temperature as the energy is extracted. The expanding air releases energy to drive the compressor.

Protection of the air cycle machine is provided by two thermal switches. One thermal switch senses
compressor discharge temperature. The other thermal switch senses turbine inlet temperature. Actuation of
either thermal switch will cause the pack valve to close.

As the air cools, its moisture content condenses. The moisture is atomized so finely however, that it will stay
in suspension without a moisture removing device. The water separator collects this atomized moisture and
removes it from the air cycle system air after it has left the air cycle machine.

Moisture entering the water separator is kept from freezing by a 35°F control system. A 35°F sensor in the
water separator and a 35°F controller regulate the 35°F control valve in a duct between the primary heat
exchanger exit and the water separator inlet. The valve opens to add warm air if the turbine discharge air
temperature is sensed to be 35°F or less.

Water collected by the water separator is sprayed into the ram air inlet duct, upstream of the pack heat
exchangers, through a water spray injector. The spray augments heat exchanger cooling capacity and improves
cooling system performance. When the air conditioning pack is shut off, water collected in the water separator
will be discharged overboard.

ATA-21 Page 20 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-21 Page 21


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Pack Valve

Bleed airflow through each of the air cycle systems is controlled by the pack valve. This valve controls the
mass flow so that a nearly constant volumetric flow (CFM) is supplied to the air conditioning pack.

The pack valve consists of a 3-1/2 inch diameter butterfly valve, an upstream venturi, a pneumatic actuator,
and pneumatic control elements. The assembly also includes solenoids that permit manual closing of the valve
and selection of flow modes by activating an air conditioning pack switch on the overhead (P5-10) panel.

The high flow schedule from the APU is possible when the airplane is on the ground or in flight. When the
PACK switch is at HIGH and the APU BLEED switch is at the ON position on the P5-10 panel.

NOTE: The high flow schedule will occur in flight when a PACK TRIP OFF light comes on or a pack is manually
turned off.

Normal flow operation results from energizing solenoid B (PACK AUTO switch). Energizing solenoid B
inactivates the APU/high flow servo and activates the auto flow servo. Airflow operation is controlled in the
same manner for both servos.

Placing the PACK switch in the OFF position energizes the closing coil of solenoid C, which cuts off air
pressure to the actuator and servo valve.

A pack valve closed limit switch provides a ground for the pack valve closed relay to drive mix valve full cold
after the pack valve closes.

FLOW DIRECTION

CLAMP
(2 LOCATIONS)

TEST PORT

CABIN PRESSURE
PORT CONNECTION

ELECTRICAL
CONNECTOR

ATA-21 Page 22 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Primary Heat Exchanger

The primary heat exchanger is the first unit of the air cycle system through which engine bleed air passes to
be cooled. The heat exchanger is a counter-flow plate-fin type.

Hot air enters one plenum chamber from the pneumatic duct at the aft inboard side of the exchanger. It is
cooled, and then leaves by way of the air cycle machine duct connected to the aft outboard side of the heat
exchanger. There is one primary heat exchanger for each air cycle system.

Secondary Heat Exchanger

The secondary heat exchanger is identical to the primary heat exchanger. It is located in the equipment bay
forward of the primary heat exchanger. Air from the air cycle machine compressor outlet enters the forward
inboard connection of the secondary heat exchanger, then returns to the air cycle machine turbine inlet from
the forward outboard exchanger connection. There is one secondary heat exchanger for each air cycle system.

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-21 Page 23


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Air Cycle Machine

The air cycle machine is a cooling unit consisting of an expansion turbine on a common shaft with a
compressor. The shaft is bearing mounted in a housing to support the rotating turbine and compressor. A
wick extends from the shaft to the bottom of the oil sump formed by the housing for lubrication of the moving
parts. A filler plug and sight gage are provided on each side of the housing with a magnetic oil drain plug on
the bottom.

The air cycle machine is located in the equipment bay between the duct leading from the primary heat
exchanger and the duct to the water separator. A duct from the compressor, and another to the turbine,
connect to the secondary heat exchanger. The turbine mounts are connected to airplane structure through
serrated plates and washers to provide location adjustment. There is one air cycle machine for each air cycle
system.

AIR CONDITIONING
EQUIPMENT BAY
SEE A

ATA-21 Page 24 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Thermal Sensing Units

Two thermal switches are in the cooling system, and directly affect the air cycle system operation. One
thermal switch senses compressor discharge temperature. The other thermal switch senses turbine inlet
temperature. When an overheat condition exists in either position the affected thermal switch will cause the
pack valve to close. Other thermal sensing switches located in the air cycle system are covered under ram air
system and temperature control system.

The turbine inlet overheat switch is located in the transition at the secondary heat exchanger and senses the
temperature of air passing from the heat exchanger to the turbine of the air cycle machine.

The compressor-discharge-overheat switch senses temperature of air being discharged from the compressor to
the secondary heat exchanger. The switch is installed on the compressor scroll.

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-21 Page 25


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Check Valves

Two check valves are provided for each air cycle system. One valve is in the cold air supply duct from the
water separator to the mixing chamber and another is in the hot air supply duct to the mixing chamber. The
two check valves prevent loss of air from the distribution system should a failure occur in the air cycle system
area or the system is shut down in flight.

WATER
SEE A
SEPARATOR
(REF)
AIR CYCLE MACHINE (REF)
CHECK VALVE
SEE B

HOT AIR TO MIX MUFF

CHECK VALVE
SEE B

WATER
SEPARATOR
(REF)

FWD

A
CHECK VALVE

FLOW
ARROW

DUCT

DUCT

FWD

CLAMPS

CHECK VALVE
B

ATA-21 Page 26 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Water Separator

Cold air leaving the air cycle machine passes through a muff to the water separator. Moisture in the air at this
reduced temperature begins to condense. The condensate is so finely atomized however, that it will follow
along in the air stream unless a suitable method is used to collect it. The water separator is used to collect
and remove the excess moisture from the air before it enters the distribution system.

The water separator is a cylindrical chamber consisting of an inlet and outlet shell assembly which houses a
polyester coalescer (bag), a conical-shaped metal coalescer support, a bypass valve assembly, and a valve
support guide. A coupling joins the inlet and outlet shell assemblies and secures the coalescer support. The
outlet shell assembly contains a collection chamber, a baffle, a water spray extractor boss, and an overboard
water drain. A boss is provided for the installation of the 35°F sensor. A bag condition indicator is also
included which consists of a spring loaded piston and disk enclosed in a housing and a color coded cap.

The bypass valve allows air to pass through the water separator to the distribution system without first
passing through the coalescer bag. The valve opens as a result of increased pressure differential should the
coalescer bag become clogged or frozen. The bypass valve opens only when the coalescer bag becomes
excessively clogged to allow passage of sufficient air for proper ventilation and cabin pressure. The bypass
valve assembly is secured to a mounting ring within the inlet shell assembly.

The water separator also has a bag condition indicator. As the bag becomes clogged, the pressure applied to
the bag condition indicator piston is increased, forcing the disk on the piston shaft toward the red colored
window section of the indicator cap. When the disk is positioned within the red colored portion of the cap, it
indicates a dirty bag and the bag should be replaced.

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-21 Page 27


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Water Spray Injector

Water collected by the water separator is drawn to a water spray injector nozzle discharging into the ram air
inlet duct upstream of the pack heat exchangers. Air from the air cycle machine turbine inlet is used to force
the water through the spray injector. This causes a cooling effect across the heat exchanger.

An orifice-controlled drain is provided in parallel with the injector to provide overboard drain after pack
shutdown.

ATA-21 Page 28 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-21 Page 29


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Water Separator 35°F Control System

When cooling requirements are high, the temperature of the air as it leaves the air cycle machine may drop
below the freezing point of water. The water separator 35°F control system regulates air temperature into the
separator to keep moisture from freezing on the water separator coalescer bag.

Keeping water separator temperature above freezing is accomplished by taking hot air from upstream of the
air cycle machine compressor and routing it back into the system at the muff at the air cycle machine turbine
discharge. The water separator 35°F control system regulates the quantity of air being bypassed.

The water separator 35°F control system consists of a water separator 35°F sensor, controller, and valve. The
sensor is located on the right forward side of the water separator, the controller is mounted to the outboard
side of the equipment bay near the forward end of the bay, and the valve is located forward of the air cycle
machine in the duct taking off from the air cycle machine compressor inlet duct.

The 35°F sensor is one element of the 35°F control. The control contains a bridge circuit, an amplifier, and a
silicon-controlled rectifier actuator control. The sensor is utilized as a remotely located variable resistance for
one leg of the bridge circuit. As temperature at the sensor changes, its resistance changes, unbalancing the
bridge. The bridge circuit is connected to the amplifier. The amplifier interprets the signal received and then
signals the actuator control to move the valve open or closed. When the bridge is balanced current is shut off
to the valve and it maintains the position held. The bridge balances with temperature in the separator at
approximately 35°F.

The 35°F controls have built-in test circuits which provide a quick check of the 35°F control system. A test
switch, two indicator lights and a test instruction placard have been added to these units. The test switch is a
rotary type with five test positions and one flight position. When the control system is not being tested, the
switch must be returned to the flight position.

ATA-21 Page 30 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-21 Page 31


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

AIR CYCLE SYSTEM & COMPONENTS B737-400


Overview

Conditioned air for heating and cooling is provided by two air cycle systems. These systems also remove the
excess moisture by passing through a high pressure water separator system contained within each air cycle
system.

The air cycle systems are contained in equipment bays located on either side of the airplane centerline on the
underside of the fuselage.

In each air cycle system, air is metered through a Flow Control and Shutoff Valve (Pack Valve). The air cycle
system consists of a primary heat exchanger, a secondary heat exchanger, a pack temperature control valve, a
conditioned air check valve a standby pack temperature control valve, a high pressure water separator system,
and an air cycle machine. The heat exchangers are of the air-to-air type, with heat being transferred from the
engine bleed air going through the air cycle system to air going through the ram air system. The air cycle
machine consists of a turbine and a compressor. Air, after passing through the high pressure water separator
system, expands through the turbine. This expansion releases energy to drive the compressor.

Protection of the air cycle system is provided by three thermal switches. A compressor discharge overheat
switch, turbine inlet overheat switch, and a pack discharge overheat switch. Actuation of any switch will cause
airplane control logic to close the appropriate pack valve and pack temperature control valve. Airplane control
logic will also illuminate the amber PACK light on the P5 overhead panel.

The air bleed is dehumidified by passing through the high pressure water separator system in the following
order: water extractor duct, reheater, condenser, water extractors, and through the reheater again. The air
then continues on to the turbine of the air cycle machine.

Water collected by the water extractor duct and water extractors is sprayed into the ram air duct. The water is
directed at the secondary heat exchanger by a water spray nozzle. The spray evaporates thereby increasing the
heat exchangers cooling capacity.

A temperature indicating system permits monitoring of either pack temperature as measured in the high
pressure water separator system. The temperature may be read from the temperature indicator on the P5
overhead panel by positioning the AIR TEMP selector to L PACK or R PACK.

Each air cycle system is controlled by its own pack/zone temperature controller that normally controls the
cooling pack discharge temperature by modulating the position of the pack temperature control valve. Each
controller also modulates the position of the ram air doors to limit the compressor discharge temperature.
The pack discharge temperature is controlled to satisfy the zone requiring the most cooling.

ATA-21 Page 32 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-21 Page 33


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Pack Valve

Bleed air entering each of the air cycle systems is controlled by the pack valve. This valve controls the mass
flow rate so that a nearly constant volumetric flow (CFM) is supplied to the air conditioning pack.

The pack valve consists of a 3.5 inch diameter butterfly valve an upstream venturi, a pneumatic actuator,
pneumatic control elements, and a visual position indicator. The assembly also includes solenoids that permit
manual closing of the valve or selection of flow modes by activating an air conditioning pack switch on the P5
overhead panel.

The APU flow schedule is obtained only when the air supply is from the APU, the pack switch is placed to
HIGH and the airplane is on the ground. This allows inlet pressure to ACT on the APU/HIGH flow servo,
resulting in the APU air flow rate.

If the pack is positioned to HIGH but the APU BLEED switch is positioned to OFF, the airflow maintained will
be lower than that with APU operation.

Low flow operation results from placing the PACK switch to AUTO.

The Pack switch in the OFF position allows the pack valve to close.

A pack valve closed limit switch provides signals to the temperature control and turbo fan valves.

ATA-21 Page 34 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Primary Heat Exchangers

The primary heat exchanger is the first unit of the air cycle system through which engine bleed air passes to
be cooled. The heat exchanger is a counter flow plate-fin type.

Hot bleed air enters the heat exchanger from the pneumatic duct at the aft inboard side of the heat exchanger.
The air is cooled by ram air then leaves the heat exchanger by way of the air cycle machine duct connected to
the aft outboard side of the heat exchanger. There is one primary heat exchanger for each air cycle system.

Secondary Heat Exchanger

The secondary heat exchanger is identical to the primary heat exchanger. It is located in the equipment bay
forward of the primary heat exchanger. Air from the air cycle machine compressor outlet enters the forward
inboard connection of the secondary heat exchanger and then exits from the forward outboard connection. The
air then proceeds to the high pressure water separator system.

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-21 Page 35


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Air Cycle Machine

The air cycle machine is a cooling unit consisting of a compressor and turbine on a common shaft. The shaft
is bearing mounted in a housing to support the rotating compressor and turbine. A wick extends to the bottom
of the oil sump formed by the housing for lubrication of the moving parts. A filler plug and sight gauge are
provided on each side of the housing with a magnetic oil drain plug on the bottom.

The air cycle machine is located in the equipment bay just downstream of the primary heat exchanger. A duct
from the compressor connects to the secondary heat exchanger. The air cycle machine mounts to the airplane
structure through serrated plates and washers to provide location adjustment. There is one air cycle machine
for each air cycle system.

AIR CONDITIONING
EQUIPMENT BAY
SEE A

ATA-21 Page 36 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Pack Temperature Control Valve

The pack temperature control valve consists of a flow body and an actuator. The valve may be manually
opened or closed by rotating the manual override knob. The pack/zone temperature controller modulates the
pack temperature control valve to provide the desired pack outlet temperature.

Standby Pack Temperature Control Valve

The standby pack temperature control actuated valve is electrically and pneumatically controlled and
pneumatically actuated. The standby pack temperature control valve consists of a torque motor, high and low
delta P servo, reference pressure regulator, pneumatic actuator and a visual position indicator.

If ice begins to form across either path through the condenser, an increase in differential pressure is sensed
by the respective delta P servo. The increased differential pressure actuates a delta P poppet valve allowing
pressure in the pneumatic actuator to increase. This will cause the valve to open. The flow of hot air into the
condenser will increase and the condenser will deice. As the condenser deices, the differential pressure
decreases and the valve will close.

Electrical control of the valve is part of the standby mode of operation. In this mode, a flapper in the torque
motor is electrically positioned to regulate pressure in the pneumatic actuator.

VISUAL
POSITION
MANUAL
INDICATOR
OVERRIDE
CAPACITOR

ELECTRIC
MOTOR

ACTUATOR
ASSEMBLY

FWD

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-21 Page 37


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

High Pressure Water Separator System

The high pressure water separator system consists of the following components: reheater, condenser, water
extractors, and water extractor duct. These components are located in the equipment bay forward of the air
cycle machine. The reheater, condenser and water extractors are assembled and installed as one unit and is
identified as the High Pressure Water Separator (HPWS). For ease of installation, the HPWS is assembled to
an integral mounting frame which attaches to the airplane at four points.

Water Extractor Duct

The water extractor duct is a split duct water separator that collects water through a perforated collector ring
in an annular section. The water removed is ducted to the sumps of the primary water extractors. The water
extractor duct is located downstream of the secondary heat exchanger and upstream of the reheater.

Reheater

The reheater is a plate-fin cross flow heat exchanger. The primary purpose of the reheater is to increase the
turbine efficiency of the air cycle machine. Bleed air leaving the water extractor duct enters the reheater on
the first of two passes through the unit. This air warms the air coming from the water extractors (second
pass) before entering the turbine. The air exiting the reheater (first pass) then enters the condenser.

Condenser

The condenser is a cross flow plate-fin type heat exchanger. The condenser uses cold exhaust air from the air
cycle machine turbine to cool the air coming from the reheater enough to cause condense the moisture for
subsequent removal by the water extractors.

Water Extractors

The water extractors are in-line, integral, duct type devices that incorporate static swirl vanes and a collector.
Static swirl vanes in each extractor swirl the air so that the water droplets are centrifuged to the outer walls.
An annular section routes the water and air mixture into a sump. The water in the water extractor sumps is
ducted to a collection manifold located on the underside of the high pressure water separator.

The water extractors are located forward and aft of the condenser in the equipment bay.

During some operating conditions, water condensation occurs in the secondary heat exchanger. This moisture
is removed by the water extractor duct.

The water collected by the water extractors and water extractor duct is ducted from the collection manifold to a
water spray nozzle located in the ram air duct. In the event of a clogged nozzle, a port on the collection
manifold will discharge the overflow.

ATA-21 Page 38 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-21 Page 39


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Thermal Sensing Units

Three thermal switches, two temperature sensors, and a temperature bulb are used in the cooling system.

Thermal Switches

The pack discharge overheat switch activates at 250°F (121°C). When the switch activates, a signal is sent to
airplane control logic which will result in the closure of the appropriate pack valve; pack temperature control
valve and illumination of corresponding amber PACK light on the P5 overhead panel. The pack discharge
overheat switch is located forward of the conditioned air check valve.

The turbine inlet overheat switch activates at 210°F (99°C). When the switch is activated, a signal is sent to
airplane control logic which will result in the closure of the appropriate pack valve; pack temperature control
valve and illumination of corresponding amber PACK light on the P5 overhead panel. The turbine overheat
switch is located in the reheater discharge duct.

The compressor discharge overheat switch activates at 390°F (199°C). When the switch is activated, a signal
is sent to airplane control logic which will result in the closure of the appropriate pack valve; temperature
control valve and illumination of corresponding amber PACK light on the P5 overhead panel. The compressor
discharge overheat switch is located in the discharge duct on the right side of the air cycle machine.

Temperature Sensors

The ram air temperature sensor and the pack temperature sensor use variable type resistance elements.
These elements are sensitive to thermal changes. The sensors provide feedback to the pack/zone
temperature controller.

When the airplane is in the air and the flaps are up, the ram air temperature sensor signal is used by the
pack/zone temperature controller. The pack/zone temperature controller uses this signal to drive the ram air
actuator. As a result, the ram air inlet modulating panels and exhaust louvers move to maintain compressor
discharge temperature at 230°F (110°C). The ram air temperature sensor is located in the compressor
discharge duct downstream of the compressor overheat switch.

The pack temperature sensor is a dual element unit which provides feedback to the pack/zone temperature
controller. One element provides temperature signals to primary pack temperature controls and the other
element is used to provide temperature signals for standby pack temperature control. The pack temperature
sensor is located in the aft water extractor discharge duct upstream of the reheater.

Temperature Bulb

The pack temperature bulb also consists of a temperature sensitive resistance element. The bulb provides
temperature information to the control cabin on the P5 overhead panel. The pack temperature bulb is located
in the aft water extractor discharge duct upstream of the reheater.

ATA-21 Page 40 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

SEE D
SEE E

PRESSURE
BULKHEAD

SEE A
SEE B

SEE C

RIGHT SIDE SHOWN,


LEFT SIDE SIMILAR

PACK TEMPERATURE SENSOR PACK TEMPERATURE BULB


A B

TURBINE INLET OVERHEAT SWIT


AND COMPRESSOR DISCHARGE
OVERHEAT SWITCH

PACK DISCHARGE
OVERHEAT SWITCH RAM AIR TEMPERATURE SENSOR

D E

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-21 Page 41


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Pack/Zone Temperature Controller

Two identical and interchangeable pack/zone temperature controllers control the cooling pack output
temperature and form a three zone temperature control system. Each controller includes a primary and
standby pack control and two zone controls: one for the flight deck and one for passenger cabins.

The right pack/zone temperature controller controls the flight deck and forward passenger cabin temperatures.
The left pack/zone controller controls the aft passenger cabin temperature and has a backup temperature
control for the flight deck.

For the cooling packs, each pack/zone temperature controller controls the pack discharge temperature, and the
ram air system. The controller also has the capability to operate the opposite packs functions in the event the
standby mode of operation is activated.

The pack/zone temperature controller processes signals received from various sensors and temperature
selectors to determine heating and/or cooling requirements for each zone. The controller positions the pack
temperature control valve to satisfy the zone requiring the most cooling. The zone temperatures are satisfied
by allowing small amounts of bleed air to enter zones requiring additional heating.

Each pack/zone temperature controller contains full built-in test equipment circuitry (BITE) which enables the
controller to fault isolate and identify components associated with the respective controller. The BITE will
continuously test the components and pack/zone temperature controller for faults in operation. If faults are
sensed, the pack/zone temperature controller will take corrective steps to inhibit faulty items from controlling.
The pack/zone temperature controllers will reconfigure in order to satisfy the cooling and/or heating
requirements.

The pack/zone temperature controllers perform fault isolation on the following components of the air
conditioning system:

1. Ram air temperature sensor


2. Standby pack temperature control valve
3. Pack temperature control valve
4. Pack temperature sensor
5. Ram air actuator
6. Duct air temperature sensor at the mix manifold
7. Cabin zone temperature selectors (normal and backup)
8. Duct air temperature sensors
9. Trim air modulating valves
10. Pack/zone temperature controller

ATA-21 Page 42 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

E1
E3

E2

SEE A
SEE B
PACK/ZONE TEMPERATURE CONT
(E2-3)

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-21 Page 43


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Conditioned Air Check Valve

One conditioned air check valve is installed in each air cycle system. The valve allows conditioned air from the
pack to enter the mix manifold and prevents backflow into an air conditioning pack during single pack
operation.

Water Spray Nozzle

The water spray nozzle discharges an air/water mixture into the ram air duct directed at the secondary heat
exchanger. In the event of a clogged nozzle, an orifice on the collection manifold discharges the overflow.

WATER DRAIN
(PLUGGED) CHECK VALVE
WATER INLET

AIR INLET

AIR/WATER
ATOMIZING
SPRAY OUTBD FWD

WATER SPRAY NOZZLE CONDITIONED AIR CHECK VALVE

ATA-21 Page 44 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Air Cycle Machine - Servicing (Oil Level Check)


Access: Location Zones

212 Left Air Conditioning Equipment Bay


213 Right Air Conditioning Equipment Bay

Access Panels:

3303L Air Conditioning Access Panel


3403R Air Conditioning Access Panel

Open the access doors to the air conditioning bay to get access to the air cycle machine.

Look through the sight glass on the air cycle machine to examine the oil level.

Make sure the oil level in the sight glass is three-fourths full.

Inspect the chip detector plug as follows:

a) Remove the chip detector plug from the drain plug.


b) Inspect the chip detector plug for metal particles.
c) Clean the chip detector plug and install it with a new O-ring into the drain plug.
TURBINE INLET DUCT

TURBINE OUTLET DUCT

DRAIN PLUG
FILLER PORT
CHIP DETECTOR PLUG
(MAGNETIC)

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-21 Page 45


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

CAUTION: THE CHIP DETECTOR PLUG SHOULD NOT HAVE ANY METAL PARTICLES ON IT. THE
PRESENCE OF METAL PARTICLES IS A SIGN OF WEAR IN THE AIR CYCLE MACHINE AND OF
POSSIBLE ACM FAILURE.

Replace the oil in the oil sump if there is water in the sight glass.

Add the oil to the oil sump of the air cycle machine if it is necessary:

a) Remove the filler plug.

NOTE: Loose wires can possibly come out of the filler port when you remove the filler plug. This
condition is satisfactory. Put the wires in the filler port before you install the filler plug.

b) Make sure the oil level in the sight glass is three-fourths full.
c) Install the filler plug.

Close the access doors to the air conditioning bay.

ATA-21 Page 46 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-21 Page 47


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

RAM AIR SYSTEM & COMPONENTS 737-300 & 500


Overview

The ram air system provides for two different methods of operation. During flight, ram air is used as a cooling
medium for the air cycle system heat exchangers. An air cycle system utilizes a turbofan to induce airflow
through the same ducts for ground operation and during flight when flaps are in any position other than
retracted. A ram air system is included for each air cycle system.

The ram air system provides a cooling medium for the air-to-air primary and secondary heat exchangers. The
heat exchangers are located so that air passing through the ram air ducts must pass through the heat
exchangers. A turbofan is installed between duct sections near the aft end of the ram air system.

A ram air modulation system automatically regulates airflow through the ram air system during flight to
minimize drag. The system also moves to provide maximum flow for ground operation and extends a deflector
door to prevent slush injection when the airplane is moving on the ground.

The ram air modulation system equipment includes the ram air inlet modulation panel, a deflector door, ram
air exhaust louvers and their operating mechanism, a ram air actuator, a cable system for the ram air inlet
modulation panel, a ram air controller, a control module, and a ram air temperature sensor. Air cycle system
equipment includes a turbofan, a turbofan valve, and the related ducting for routing pressurized air to run the
turbofan.

ATA-21 Page 48 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

RAM AIR DUCT


ACCESS DOOR
AIR EXIT
A
RAM AIR INLET
SEE A

SEE B
FWD
EQUIPMENT
BAY DOORS

RAM AIR
INLET DUCT

INSPECTION
DOORS PNEUMATIC
CROSSOVER DUCT

RAM AIR TURBOFAN VALVE


CONTROL
RAM AIR
ACTUATOR
WATER SEPARATOR

SECONDARY HEAT
EXCHANGER
PRIMARY HEAT
EXCHANGER
TO PNEUMATIC
SYSTEM

TO APU

ROLLERS
RAM AIR EXIT
LOUVERS EXHAUST
DUCT
RAM AIR
FWD
INLET
TURBOFAN TURBOFAN
VALVE RAM AIR INLET
MODULATION PANEL
A

DEFLECTOR
DOOR

FWD

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-21 Page 49


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Ram Air Inlet

The ram air inlet consists of a scoop, a modulation panel, and a deflector door. A scoop is located on each
side of the airplane at the forward end of the wing to body fairing. The scoop forms the entry for the ram air
ducts.

The ram air inlet modulation panel is made up of two panel sections. The forward end of the forward panel is
hinged to structure and its aft end is hinged to the forward end of the aft panel section. The aft end of the aft
panel section is equipped with rollers which allow movement forward and aft. Two cranks with rollers
attached move the forward end of the aft panel inboard or outboard to open or close the inlet. The cranks are
attached to a shaft which is operated by the ram air actuator through a cable system.

The deflector door is hinged at its forward end to airplane structure and is shaped to fit in the scoop when
retracted to prevent interference with ram airflow into the ram air ducts. A mechanism connected to the
modulation panel cable system causes the deflector door to be extended when the airplane is on the ground
and then to fair on takeoff. The deflector door minimizes the possibility of foreign material entering the ram
air system when the airplane is moving on the ground.

Ram Air Ducts

The ram air ducts are contained in the ram air duct cavity and the equipment bay. A web between the two
compartments helps support the heat exchangers and the inlet ducts. The ram air exit ducts connect to the
inboard side of the heat exchangers then extend to an outlet just aft of the equipment bay doors. A turbofan is
included between duct sections immediately forward of the outlet. Access to the entire ram air duct system is
obtained by opening the ram air duct access door and the air conditioning equipment bay doors.

Ram Air Inlet

ATA-21 Page 50 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

ACCESS DOOR FOR


RAM AIR DUCT

EQUIPMENT BAY DOORS

RAM AIR
DUCT

EXHAUST
DUCT

FWD

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-21 Page 51


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Ram Air Actuator

The ram air actuator is a 115-volt AC motor-operated linear actuator. It operates in either direction and may
be stopped at any position between full extend and full retract. The actuator is used to modulate the ram air
inlet modulation panel and the ram air exhaust louvers, and moves the deflector door.

The ram air actuator is controlled by the ram air controller. The control is automatic and depends on whether
airplane is on the ground, inflight with flaps extended or inflight with flaps positioned full up. When airplane is
inflight with flaps full up, temperature of the air in the air cycle machine compressor discharge is sensed by
the ram air controller to govern actuator position. There are four position switches in the actuator which work
with the control system to obtain proper positioning of the inlet panel and the exhaust louvers. The ram air
actuator is mounted on the aft bulkhead of the ram air duct cavity.

ATA-21 Page 52 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Ram Air Inlet Modulation Panel Cable and Linkage System

The ram air inlet modulation panel and the deflector door are mechanically linked together and are operated by
the ram air actuator through a cable system. The ram air actuator rod connects to a crank on the ram air
modulation torque shaft quadrant assembly to drive the cable system.

Two cables extend forward from the torque shaft quadrant along the inboard side of the ram air duct cavity to
the forward end of the cavity. The cables then pass through the forward end of the cavity and are secured to
the ram air inlet modulation panel quadrant. The ram air inlet modulation panel quadrant drives the inlet
modulation panel shaft which moves the inlet panels.

The deflector door is also driven by the ram air inlet modulation panel quadrant. An arm assembly which
drives the deflector linkage is mounted beside the inlet modulating panel quadrant on the inlet modulating
panel shaft. A lug on the shoulder of the arm assembly fits into a cutout in the shoulder of the quadrant. A
cam link and torsion spring allows additional movement of the quadrant for modulating the inlet panel after
the deflector linkage permits continued movement of the quadrant to the full extend-position, should the
deflector fail to extend.

The ram air modulation torque shaft quadrant assembly and control cables may be reached by opening the
ram air duct access door. Access to the deflector linkage and the ram air inlet modulation panel quadrant
requires removing the air conditioning fairing panel below the ram air inlet. A grease fitting and bushing are
located on the arm assembly which drives the ram air inlet deflector.

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-21 Page 53


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Ram Air Controller

The ram air controller electrically controls the ram air actuator to position the inlet modulation panel and the
exhaust louvers during flight when flaps are up. The control unit is installed on the inboard side of the keel
beam downstream of the turbofan. A temperature sensor is installed in the air cycle machine compressor
discharge duct.
RAM AIR DUCT
ACCESS DOOR

RAM AIR
INLET
RAM AIR
EXIT

EQUIPMENT BAY DOORS


FWD

TEMPERATURE
CONTROLLER
SEE A

SCREW
WASHER
(4 LOCATIONS)

TEMPERATURE
CONTROLLER

ELECTRICAL
CONNECTOR

TEMPERATURE CONTROLLER

ATA-21 Page 54 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Turbofan

The turbofan is a turbine powered fan located between sections of the ram air exhaust ducts. Air from the
pneumatic system is directed through the turbofan case to a small two-stage turbine centrally located inside
the case. A larger diameter fan is located forward of the turbine and is shaft-connected to the turbine. The
turbofan normally operates only during ground air conditioning operation or in flight when the flaps are
extended. Operation is controlled by a turbofan valve.

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-21 Page 55


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Turbofan Valve

The turbofan valve is a solenoid-actuated shutoff and regulating valve requiring 28-volt DC current and is
spring-loaded to the closed position. A closed limit switch in the valve completes a circuit to the ram air
controller when the valve is closed. A manual control rod on the solenoid permits the opening or closing of
the valve manually. Two test ports are provided for checking valve operation under pressure. The left
turbofan valve is located in the left equipment bay inboard of the turbofan. The right turbofan valve is located
in the right pack cold air supply duct.

RAM AIR DUCT


ACCESS DOOR

SEE B

EQUIPMENT BAY DOORS


SEE A
SEE C

CLAMP ELECTRICAL
CONNECTOR FWD

CLAMP
TURBOFAN
VALVE

ELECTRICAL
FWD CONNECTOR
BONDING
BONDING JUMPER
JUMPER INBD
ELECTRICAL
CONNECTOR
ELECTRICAL
CONNECTOR
RIGHT TURBOFAN VALVE
CLAMP
B
TURBOFAN
VALVE
INBD FWD

LEFT TURBOFAN VALVE


C

ATA-21 Page 56 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Ram Air Exhaust Louvers

Louvers are installed at the ram air outlet to restrict airflow through the ram air system during flight. The
louvers are installed parallel to each other and are supported at either end by a support angle. Individual arms
are splined to mate with the outboard end of each louver and are linked together at the other end of the arm to
obtain simultaneous movement of each. The forward arm mates with a torque shaft which extends from the
arm to the ram air actuator located in the ram air duct cavity. As the actuator moves, the louvers rotate to
reduce or increase the exhaust area. Since the torque shaft is connected to the crank which operates the ram
air inlet modulation panel control cables, movement of the exhaust louvers and the inlet modulation panel is
obtained at the same time. The exhaust louvers are the primary restriction to ram airflow while the inlet panel
reduces the possibility of aerodynamic resonance in the ram air ducts.

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-21 Page 57


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Inspection Doors

Two inspection doors in each ram air system permit visually checking for foreign material in the ram air ducts
or heat exchangers. One inspection door is located on the bottom of the ram air duct just outboard of the
secondary heat exchanger. The other door is located on the bottom of the duct outboard of the primary heat
exchanger. Open the ram air duct access door to gain access to either inspection door.

ATA-21 Page 58 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-21 Page 59


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

RAM AIR SYSTEM & COMPONENTS 737-400


Overview

The ram air system provides for two different methods of operation. During flight, ram air is used as a cooling
medium for the air cycle system heat exchangers. An air cycle system utilizes a turbofan to induce airflow
through the same ducts for ground operation and during flight when flaps are in any position other than
retracted. A ram air system is included for each air cycle system.

The ram air system provides a cooling medium for the air-to-air primary and secondary heat exchangers. The
heat exchangers are located so that air passing through the ram air ducts must pass through the heat
exchangers. A turbofan is installed between duct sections near the aft end of the ram air system.

A ram air modulation system automatically regulates airflow through the ram air system during flight to
minimize drag. The system also moves to provide maximum flow for ground operation and extends a deflector
door to prevent slush injection when the airplane is moving on the ground.

The ram air modulation system equipment includes the ram air inlet modulation panel, a deflector door, ram
air exhaust louvers and their operating mechanism, a ram air actuator, a cable system for the ram air inlet
modulation panel, a pack/zone temperature control module, and a ram air temperature sensor. Air cycle
system equipment includes a turbofan, a turbofan valve, and the related ducting for routing pressurized air to
run the turbofan.

ATA-21 Page 60 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

RAM AIR DUCT


ACCESS DOOR
RAM AIR EXIT
SEE A
RAM AIR INLET
SEE A

FWD SEE B
EQUIPMENT
BAY DOORS

RAM AIR
INLET DUCT

INSPECTION
DOORS PNEUMATIC
CROSSOVER DUCT

TURBOFAN VALVE

RAM AIR
ACTUATOR

SECONDARY HEAT
EXCHANGER
PRIMARY HEAT
EXCHANGER
TO PNEUMATIC
SYSTEM

TO APU

ROLLERS
RAM AIR EXIT
LOUVERS EXHAUST
DUCT
RAM AIR
FWD
INLET
TURBOFAN TURBOFAN
VALVE RAM AIR INLET
MODULATION PANEL
A

DEFLECTOR
DOOR

FWD

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-21 Page 61


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Ram Air Inlet

The ram air inlet consists of a scoop, a modulation panel, and a deflector door. A scoop is located on each
side of the airplane at the forward end of the wing to body fairing. The scoop forms the entry for the ram air
ducts.

The ram air inlet modulation panel is made up of two panel sections. The forward end of the forward panel is
hinged to structure and its aft end is hinged to the forward end of the aft panel section. The aft end of the aft
panel section is equipped with rollers which allow movement forward and aft. Two cranks with rollers
attached move the forward end of the aft panel inboard or outboard to open or close the inlet. The cranks are
attached to a shaft which is operated by the ram air actuator through a cable system.

The deflector door is hinged at its forward end to airplane structure and is shaped to fit in the scoop when
retracted to prevent interference with ram airflow into the ram air ducts. A mechanism connected to the
modulation panel cable system causes the deflector door to be extended when the airplane is on the ground
and then to fair on takeoff. The deflector door minimizes the possibility of foreign material entering the ram
air system when the airplane is moving on the ground.

ATA-21 Page 62 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Ram Air Ducts

The ram air ducts are contained in the ram air duct cavity and the equipment bay. A web between the two
compartments helps support the heat exchangers and the inlet ducts. The ram air exit ducts connect to the
inboard side of the heat exchangers then extend to an outlet just aft of the equipment bay doors. A turbofan is
included between duct sections immediately forward of the outlet. Access to the entire ram air duct system is
obtained by opening the ram air duct access door and the air conditioning equipment bay doors.
ACCESS DOOR FOR
RAM AIR DUCT

EQUIPMENT BAY DOORS

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-21 Page 63


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Ram Air Actuator

The ram air actuator is a 115-volt AC motor-operated linear actuator. It operates in either direction and may
be stopped at any position between full extend and full retract. The actuator is used to modulate the ram air
inlet modulation panel and the ram air exhaust louvers, and moves the deflector door.

The ram air actuator is controlled by the pack/zone temperature control module. The control is automatic and
depends on whether the airplane is on the ground, inflight with flaps extended or inflight with flaps positioned
full up. When the airplane is inflight with flaps full up, temperature of the air in the air cycle machine
compressor discharge is sensed by the pack/zone temperature control module to govern actuator position.
There are four position switches in the actuator which work with the control system to obtain proper
positioning of the inlet panel and the exhaust louvers. The ram air actuator is mounted on the aft bulkhead of
the ram air duct cavity.

ATA-21 Page 64 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-21 Page 65


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Ram Air Inlet Modulation Panel Cable and Linkage System

The ram air inlet modulation panel and the deflector door are mechanically linked together and are operated by
the ram air actuator through a cable system. The ram air actuator rod connects to a crank on the ram air
modulation torque shaft quadrant assembly to drive the cable system.

Two cables extend forward from the torque shaft quadrant along the inboard side of the ram air duct cavity to
the forward end of the cavity. The cables then pass through the forward end of the cavity and are secured to
the ram air inlet modulation panel quadrant. The ram air inlet modulation panel quadrant drives the inlet
modulation panel shaft which moves the inlet panels.

The deflector door is also driven by the ram air inlet modulation panel quadrant. An arm assembly which
drives the deflector linkage is mounted beside the inlet modulating panel quadrant on the inlet modulating
panel shaft. A lug on the shoulder of the arm assembly fits into a cutout in the shoulder of the quadrant. A
cam link and torsion spring allows additional movement of the quadrant for modulating the inlet panel after
the deflector linkage permits the continued movement of the quadrant to the full extend-position, should the
deflector fail to extend.

The ram air modulation torque shaft quadrant assembly and control cables may be reached by opening the
ram air duct access door. Access to the deflector linkage and the ram air inlet modulation panel quadrant
requires removing the air conditioning fairing panel below the ram air inlet.

ATA-21 Page 66 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

RAM AIR
ACTUATOR

RAM AIR
EXHAUST
LOUVER

CONTROL
CABLE

CONTROL
CABLE
DEFLECTOR
AFT PANEL
STOP MODULATION
CRANK
FORWARD PANEL PANEL OPEN ROLLER

BODY SKIN

ROD MODULATION
SPRING PANEL CLOSE
INLET SCOOP
EXTENSION ARM
DEFLECTOR
LINK ASSEMBLY

RAM AIR INLET


MODULATION PANEL
GROUND POSITION QUADRANT

DEFLECTOR
STOP

AFTER TAKEOFF TO FLAPS UP POSITION

DEFLECTOR
STOP

CRUISE FULL CLOSED POSITION

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-21 Page 67


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Pack/Zone Temperature Control Module

The pack/zone temperature control module electrically controls the ram air actuator to position the inlet
modulation panel and the exhaust louvers during flight when flaps are up. The two pack/zone temperature
control modules are located in the electronic equipment compartment on the E2-3 rack. A temperature sensor
is installed in the air cycle machine compressor discharge duct.

E1
E3

E2

SEE A
SEE B
PACK/ZONE TEMPERATURE CONT
(E2-3)

ATA-21 Page 68 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Turbofan

The turbofan is a turbine powered fan located between sections of the ram air exhaust ducts. Air from the
pneumatic system is directed through the turbofan case to a small two-stage turbine centrally located inside
the case. A larger diameter fan is located forward of the turbine and is shaft-connected to the turbine. The
turbofan normally operates only during ground air conditioning operation or in flight when the flaps are
extended. Operation is controlled by a turbofan valve.

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-21 Page 69


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Turbofan Valve

The turbofan valve is a solenoid-actuated shutoff and regulating valve requiring 28-volt DC current and is
spring-loaded to the closed position. A closed limit switch in the valve completes a circuit to the ram air
controller when the valve is closed. A manually controlled rod on the solenoid will permit the opening or
closing of the valve. Two test ports are provided for checking valve operation under pressure. The left
turbofan valve is located in the left equipment bay inboard of the turbofan. The right turbofan valve is located
in the right pack cold air supply duct.
RAM AIR DUCT
ACCESS DOOR

SEE B

EQUIPMENT BAY DOORS


SEE A
SEE C

CLAMP ELECTRICAL
CONNECTOR FWD

CLAMP
TURBOFAN
VALVE

ELECTRICAL
FWD CONNECTOR
BONDING
BONDING JUMPER
JUMPER INBD
ELECTRICAL
CONNECTOR
ELECTRICAL
CONNECTOR
RIGHT TURBOFAN VALVE
CLAMP
B
TURBOFAN
VALVE
INBD FWD

LEFT TURBOFAN VALVE


C

ATA-21 Page 70 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Ram Air Exhaust Louvers

Louvers are installed at the ram air outlet to restrict airflow through the ram air system during flight. The
louvers are installed parallel to each other and are supported at either end by a support angle. Individual arms
are splined to mate with the outboard end of each louver and are linked together at the other end of the arm to
obtain simultaneous movement of each. The forward arm mates with a torque shaft which extends from the
arm to the ram air actuator located in the ram air duct cavity. As the actuator moves, the louvers rotate to
reduce or increase the exhaust area. Since the torque shaft is connected to the crank which operates the ram
air inlet modulation panel control cables, movement of the exhaust louvers and the inlet modulation panel is
obtained at the same time. The exhaust louvers are the primary restriction to ram airflow while the inlet panel
reduces the possibility of aerodynamic resonance in the ram air ducts.

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-21 Page 71


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Inspection Doors

Two inspection doors in each ram air system permit visually checking for foreign material in the ram air ducts
or heat exchangers. One inspection door is located on the bottom of the ram air duct just outboard of the
secondary heat exchanger. The other door is located on the bottom of the duct outboard of the primary heat
exchanger. Open the ram air duct access door to gain access to either inspection door.

ATA-21 Page 72 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Ram Air System Turbofan - Servicing


Access: Location Zones

212 Left Air Conditioning Equipment Bay


213 Right Air Conditioning Equipment Bay

Access Panels

3303L Air Conditioning Access Panel


3403R Air Conditioning Access Panel

Open the access doors to the air conditioning bay to get access to the turbofan for the ram air system.

Remove the dipstick from the fitting on the turbofan.

Examine the dipstick for oil discoloration.

NOTE: If the oil has contamination it will turn a white or yellow color.

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-21 Page 73


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

 
Replace the oil in the drain sump if there is oil discoloration on the dipstick.

Add the oil to the overflow holes in the dipstick fitting.

Install the dipstick and then remove it to do a check of the oil level.

Make sure the oil level is above the ADD line on the dipstick.

Install the dipstick.

Close the access doors to the air conditioning bay.

ATA-21 Page 74 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

DISTRIBUTION SYSTEM
Overview

The air conditioning distribution system distributes conditioned air into the passenger and control cabins.
Individual air (Gasper) is supplied to each seat area adjustable outlets.

Conditioned air distribution starts with the main distribution manifold which divides into two separate systems,
control cabin conditioned air and passenger cabin conditioned air.

The control cabin air distribution system receives air from the left pack supply duct upstream from the main
distribution manifold and releases it into the control cabin from several outlets. Outlets are located to provide
optimum flow patterns in the cabin.

The passenger cabin conditioned air distribution system takes the remainder of air supplied to the main
distribution manifold and delivers it to the passenger cabin. Air is released directly into the cabin from an
overhead duct and from diffuser outlets at alternate window bays.

The main distribution manifold is a container where conditioned air from the packs and re-circulated cabin air
mix. On 737-400 airplanes, the manifold includes a ground service connection and two recirculation fans. On
737-300 and 737-500 airplanes, the manifold includes a ground service connection, and one recirculation fan.
The manifold also has sensors, bulbs, and thermal switches required to operate and monitor the temperature
control systems.

Conditioned air supply ducts to the manifold, and distribution ducts from the manifold, are positioned to
provide control cabin conditioned air from the left pack and passenger cabin conditioned air from the right
pack during normal operation. Either pack will provide conditioned air to both systems when the other pack is
off. Since the control cabin does not require all air provided by the left pack during normal operation, part of
its output will be mixed with the right pack supply before going to the passenger cabin.

The main distribution manifold is located aft of the forward cargo compartment aft bulkhead in a pressurized
area.

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-21 Page 75


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

 
B737-300 & 500

ATA-21 Page 76 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

 
B737-400

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-21 Page 77


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Ground Service Conditioned Air Connection B737-300/400/500

A ground service connection is provided to allow use of a ground service cart for conditioned air to the cabin
when airplane air conditioning is off. A check valve in the duct prevents loss of air when airplane air
conditioning is on.

The connection is a short duct section. This is fastened to the pressure skin and the duct and check valve
assembly at its upper flange and it has two slotted holes in its lower flange to match fasteners on the ground
service cart. An access door must be opened to make the connection.

A swing check valve in the duct and check valve assembly opens with pressure from the ground service cart
and closes when air is being supplied from the airplane air conditioning system.

ATA-21 Page 78 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Recirculation Fan

On 737-300 and 737-500 airplanes, the recirculation fan uses a filter and a check valve. On 737-400 airplanes,
each of the two recirculation fans uses a filter and a check valve. On 737-300, 737-400, and 737-500 airplanes,
the recirculation fan(s) are used to maintain proper ventilation to the airplane. Airplane control logic and
switch settings on the air-conditioning control module control the fan(s) operation.

On 737-400 airplanes, one check valve is positioned in each duct connecting a recirculation fan to the
manifold. On 737-300 and 737-500 airplanes, a check valve is positioned in the duct connecting the
recirculation fan to the manifold. The check valve is installed to prevent the loss of airflow when the
recirculation fan is not operating.

Filters prevent the ingestion of dust and debris into the air conditioning distribution system.

Each filter assembly is outboard of the recirculation fan(s), and contains either a high efficiency one-piece
filter, or a two-piece filter (a pre-filter and a particulate HEPA filter).

MIX MANIFOLD

SEE A

CONDITIONED AIR
SUPPLY DUCT

AIR CONDITIONING
MIXING PLENUM

CLAMP
SLEEVE
CHECK
VALVE

ELECTRICAL
CONNECTOR

GROUND STRAP

RECIRCULATION
FAN

B737-300 & 500


A

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-21 Page 79


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

MIX
MANIFOLD
SEE A

FROM LEFT
PACK
RIGHT
RECIRCULATION
FAN
SEE B

LEFT TO FLIGHT
RECIRCULATION COMPARTMENT
FWD
FAN
SEE C

MIX MANIFOLD

B737-400

ATA-21 Page 80 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-21 Page 81


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

CONTROL CABIN CONDITIONED AIR DISTRIBUTION SYSTEM


Overview

The control cabin conditioned air distribution system consists of a series of ducts originating just upstream of
the main distribution manifold and leading forward under the floor, on the left side of the airplane, to the
control cabin, where it branches off into several risers which end at the ceiling, floor and foot level outlets.
Orifices in the system balance the flow. An acoustical muffler is installed in the supply duct to reduce control
cabin duct airflow noise. A small duct is tapped from the mix muff to add warm air to the control cabin
conditioned air supply.

Air from the control cabin is exhausted through miscellaneous openings and grilles in the floor, and is drawn
into the electronic equipment compartment to provide electrical/electronic equipment cooling and forward
cargo compartment heating.

ATA-21 Page 82 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-21 Page 83


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Control Cabin Conditioned Air Outlets

The control cabin conditioned air distribution duct branches into several risers which feed outlets in the
control cabin. The outlets are located to provide optimum flow patterns in the cabin.

The control cabin outlets consist of overhead diffusers, under-seat diffusers, foot air outlets, windshield
outlets and an individual (gasper) air outlet for each pilot. A small muffler is located between the under seat
outlets to reduce air noise.

The overhead diffusers are located on the cabin ceiling, just above and aft of window No. 3. Each of these
outlets can be opened or closed to any desired extent by turning a slotted adjusting screw. Directional control
of airflow is provided by a movable external baffle. An individual (gasper) air outlet is located by the left
overhead diffuser.

The captain's and first officer's diffusers are on the floor, directly under each seat. These outlets cannot be
manually controlled and air flows continuously as long as the distribution system is pressurized.

Muffler

A muffler is provided in the control cabin conditioned air distribution system to minimize airflow noise. A
restrictor located immediately upstream of the muffler ensures balanced airflow from the control cabin outlets,
and must be retained if the muffler is replaced. The muffler is located in the duct which extends from the
distribution bay to the control cabin, below the passenger cabin floor outboard of the nose wheel well. For
access remove the left side aft access panel in nose wheel well.

The small muffler between the under seat outlets is accessed through the forward access door, forward of the
nose wheel well.

ATA-21 Page 84 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

CONDITIONED AIR
SUPPLY DUCT FROM
DISTRIBUTION BAY
GASPER
AIR

CONTROL
CABIN
MUFFLER

SEE A
OVERHEAD
OUTLETS OBSERVER'S
INDIVIDUAL
OUTLET

WINDSHIELD
OUTLETS

FIRST OFFICER'S
INDIVIDUAL OUTLET

FOOT WARMERS

MUFFLER UNDER SEAT


OUTLET (EXAMPLE)
CAPTAIN'S
INDIVIDUAL
OUTLET
A

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-21 Page 85


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Windshield Air and Foot Control

There is a dual purpose valve at the end of the distribution duct behind the rudder pedals for the captain and
one for the first officer. Two cable controlled knobs marked FOOT AIR and WINDSHIELD AIR are fastened on
a bracket below the captain's and first officer's instrument panel. Pulling either knob moves a baffle plate
attached to a lever allowing a choice between no conditioned air and full capacity conditioned air to either the
foot outlets, the windshield duct, or both.

CAPTAIN'S INSTRUMENT PANEL, P1 FIRST OFFICER'S INSTRUMENT PANEL,

WINDSHIELD
AIR
LOWER
INSTRUMENT FOOT
PANEL AIR

SEE A

OPEN
POSITION

CLOSED
POSITION
WINDSHIELD TAB CONTROL
AIR OUTLET CABLES

VALVE
POSITION TAB
(WINDSHIELD OUTLET
SEE B
IN CLOSED POSITION)

FOOT
WARMER
OUTLET
CABLE

WINDSHIELD AIR AND FOOT


OUTLET CONTROL CABLE CABLE

A
SEAM
TAB
(FOOT OUTLET IN
CLOSED POSITION)

VALVE POSITION
B

ATA-21 Page 86 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

PASSENGER CABIN CONDITIONED AIR DISTRIBUTION SYSTEM


Overview

The passenger cabin conditioned air distribution system consists of the main distribution manifold,
distribution manifold duct assembly, riser ducts, overhead distribution duct, and diffuser outlets.

Conditioned air for the passenger cabin originates in the main distribution manifold. From the mixing
chamber, conditioned air is ducted through the distribution manifold duct to both sides of the airplane to riser
ducts in the cabin sidewall. The riser ducts supply conditioned air to the overhead distribution duct.

The overhead distribution duct is mounted along the center line of the airplane, extending forward and aft the
full length of the passenger cabin. Air is directed into the passenger cabin through a nozzle which extends the
length of the overhead duct and from diffuser outlets located in alternate window bays. Temperature of the
conditioned air is automatically controlled.

Passenger cabin exhaust air flows around the walls of the cargo compartments and is discharged overboard
through the pressurization control system outflow valves. A small amount of air is exhausted directly
overboard from the galley and lavatory vents.

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-21 Page 87


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Overhead Supply Riser Ducts

Attached to the distribution manifold duct in the distribution bay, riser ducts go up both walls to supply
conditioned air to the overhead distribution duct. Flexible ducts connect to the distribution manifold duct
assembly and the overhead distribution duct. The flexible ducts are attached to the overhead supply riser
ducts with tape or a clamp.

Overhead Distribution Duct and Diffusers

The overhead distribution duct extends from the forward to the aft end of the curved ceiling along the airplane
centerline. Brackets on the upper surface of the duct attach it to the airplane structure. On the upper surface
of the overhead duct at approximately mid-cabin position is a flexible duct panel. The flexible panel provides
easy access to the upper beacon light.

Conditioned air is directed into the passenger cabin through a nozzle which extends the length of the overhead
duct and from diffuser outlets below the PSUs at alternate window bays.

On some airplanes, at the aft end of the cabin, air enters the cabin through grilles on either side of the ceiling
light fixture.

Acoustic baffles are installed the full length of the overhead duct to decrease air noise.

Passenger Cabin Air Exhaust

Air from the passenger cabin is exhausted through foot level grilles in the main cabin sidewall and is
discharged overboard through cabin pressurization and forward outflow valves.

ATA-21 Page 88 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

OVERHEAD TO LIGHT
DISTRIBUTION FIXTURE
DUCT OUTLET

MAIN CABIN SEE B


SUPPLY RISER

TO LAVATORIES
AND GALLEY

SIDEWALL
OUTLETS
SEE A

MAIN DISTRIBUTION
MANIFOLD TO LIGHT FIXTURE,
MIX
MANIFOLD LAVORATORIES, AND
CAPPED
GALLEY OUTLETS

737-300 AND 737-500


CONTROL CABIN
DISTRIBUTION
SYTEM (REF) OVERHEAD
DISTRIBUTION DUCT
SEE B

AFT PASSENGER CABIN


DISTRIBUTION RISERS

FORWARD PASSENGER CABIN


DISTRIBUTION RISERS

SIDEWALL OUTLETS
SEE A

MIX
MANIFOLD
CONTROL CABIN
DISTRIBUTION
SYSTEM (REF)
737-400

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-21 Page 89


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

FLEXIBLE
DUCTS

TO GASPER
SIDEWALL OUTLET
OUTLET (EXAMPLE)

GRILL

SIDEWALL
MOUNTING CLIPS
OUTLET

CABIN
WINDOW
(REF)

SIDEWALL OUTLET
(EXAMPLE)

A 1/4-TURN
PANEL FASTENER

RESTRICTOR
PLATE DUCT BRACKET
2
RESTRICTOR ASSEMBLY 1
MAIN CABIN OVERHEAD
DISTRIBUTION DUCT

MOUNTING SCREWS

ADAPTER
ACOUSTIC FILLER
ACOUSTIC BAFFLE

CEILING PANEL

MAIN CABIN
CONDITIONED
AIR OUTLET

OVERHEAD DISTRIBUTION DUCT

1 ONLY AT RISER INLET AREA B


STA 500B TO 549.75

2 EXCEPT AT AREA 1

ATA-21 Page 90 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

DIFFUSER
OUTLETS (TYP)

AFT CARGO
FWD CARGO FOR AIRFLOW COMPARTMENT
COMPARTMENT SEE A OR B SEE B
SEE A

DIFFUSER DIFFUSER
OUTLET OUTLET

DIFFUSER, OVERHEAD DIFFUSER, OVERHEAD


FWD OUTFLOW
OUTLETS AND FWD OUTLETS AND AFT
VALVE CLOSED,
CARGO COMPARTMENT CARGO COMPARTMENT
RECIRCULATION
AIRFLOW AIRFLOW
FAN OPERATING
OUTFLOW
VALVE (OPEN)

A B

PASSENGER CABIN AIRFLOW

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-21 Page 91


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Galley Vent System

The galley is ventilated by a system consisting of flexible ducts which connect an inlet vent at the galley
ceiling to an exhaust nozzle in the airplane skin. The nozzle incorporates a flow limit-venturi. An acoustic
muffler is incorporated in the ducts to reduce noise from the system. The muffler is attached to the ducts and
to structure by clamps.

FLEXIBLE DUCT

ACOUSTIC
MUFFLER
GALLEY CEILING PANEL
GALLEY VENT INLET

NOZZLE GALLEY DOOR

ATA-21 Page 92 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-21 Page 93


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

CONDITIONED AIR TEMPERATURE CONTROL SYSTEM B737-300 & 500


Overview

Conditioned air temperature control covers that portion of the air conditioning system which starts, regulates,
and shuts down air conditioning equipment to provide a selected temperature in the control and passenger
cabins. Two sets of controls are provided. One set controls the left mix valve for control cabin temperature
regulation. The other controls the right mix-valve and provides for the passenger cabin. Normally each system
functions automatically according to selections made on the forward overhead panel. Separate manual control
systems are provided as an alternate method for raising or lowering control and passenger cabin temperature.

Controlling the temperature in the cabins is accomplished by controlling the temperature of air entering the
cabins. Air conditioning operation begins when the pack switches are turned on. The switches open the pack
valves permitting bleed air from the pneumatic system to enter the air conditioning system.

When the pack valve is opened, the pack valve closed limit switch opens to de-energize the pack valve closed
relay. When the relay is de-energized, contacts within the relay will close to initiate all temperature control
and overheat protection circuits in the air conditioning system.

Downstream of the pack valves part of the air branches off and passes forward to the mixing chamber and the
remainder passes through the air cycle system to be cooled before going to the mixing chamber. The
proportioning of air through the system depends on the position of the air mix valve. The mix valve regulates
hot air bypassing the air cycle system and air going through the air cycle system. This air is recombined later
in proper proportions at the mix chamber. The position of the valve depends on signals from the temperature
control system controller according to the temperature of the air in the control cabin or passenger cabin
compared with that requested by the temperature selector.

During automatic operation, a regulation system continuously monitors cabin temperature, duct temperature,
and changes in cabin supply air temperature to keep the cabins at the selected temperature level. During
manual operation, the mix valve changes position as a result of direct electrical control. The indicating system
permits monitoring of cabin temperature, cabin supply duct temperature, and mix valve position.

Each temperature control system includes an air mix (temperature control) valve, a 190°F (88°C) duct overheat
thermal switch, a 250°F (121°C) duct overheat thermal switch, a pack switch, and both manual and automatic
temperature regulating circuits.

The manual temperature regulating components consists of two switches located in the temperature selector
assembly, which are electrically connected to the mix valve actuator. The automatic temperature regulating
components include a temperature selector assembly, a controller, cabin temperature sensor, anticipator
sensor, and a duct temperature limiting sensor.

ATA-21 Page 94 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-21 Page 95


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Air Mix Valve

The mix valve consists of two butterfly valves operated by the same actuator through a common shaft. The
115-volt AC actuator mounts on a flange of the hot valve to drive the common shaft. When the hot valve
butterfly is full open the cold valve is full closed and vice versa. As the hot valve moves toward close, the
cold valve moves proportionally toward open. A position potentiometer is connected to the opposite end of the
shaft from the actuator to permit monitoring the valve position from the control cabin. A visual indicator is
also located at the actuator between the potentiometer and the cold valve body.

Limit switches in the actuator housing interrupt current to the actuator monitor at either extremity of travel.
The mix valve is located in the air conditioning equipment bay inboard of the heat exchangers.
SEE A

VALVE POSITION VISUAL


TRANSMITTER POSITION
INDICATOR
SEE B

COLD VALVE

HOT VALVE

TO
AIR CYCLE
MACHINE

TO
MIXING
CHAMBER VALVE
COLD

HOT

VALVE POSITION
ACTUATOR INDICATOR

FWD INBD

ATA-21 Page 96 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-21 Page 97


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Thermal Sensing Units

Thermal sensing units in the temperature control system consist of thermal switches, temperature bulbs, and
temperature sensors. Thermal switches are used to protect against duct overheat, temperature bulbs are used
in conjunction with indicators for monitoring passenger cabin temperature and passenger cabin supply duct
temperature, and temperature sensors are used with the automatic temperature regulation systems to
automatically position the mix valves in obtaining selected temperatures for the cabins.

The thermal switches consist essentially of a bimetal element enclosed in a steel probe. The thermal switch
contacts are normally open. At a predetermined temperature the contacts will close. A 190°F (88°C)
passenger cabin duct overheat thermal switch and a 250°F (121°C) passenger cabin duct overheat thermal
switch are used in each control system. The switches are mounted in the main distribution manifold and in
the overhead distribution manifold adjacent to its union with the RH riser duct.

ATA-21 Page 98 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

TO CONTROL
CABIN

CONT CABIN AIR TEMP PASS CABIN


DUCT LIMIT
SENSOR SUPPLY PASS
DUCT DUCT CABIN
ANTICIPATOR 250°F AIR MIX AIR MIX
SENSOR DUCT OVERHEAT VALVE VALVE

SWITCH
190°F
DUCT OVERHEAT
SWITCH 60
40 TEMP
80
DUCT 20 DUCT
O V E R H E AAT O V E R H E AAT
100
C

AUTO AUTO
NO AL NO AL

COOL WARM COOL WARM

COOL WARM COOL WARM


OFF OFF
FWD MANUAL MANUAL

MAIN DISTRIBUTION MANIFOLD CABIN TEMPERATURE MODULE (P5-17

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-21 Page 99


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Temperature bulbs

Temperature bulbs consist of a temperature sensitive resistance element within a tube. As the temperature of
the element changes, its resistance changes accordingly to cause movement of an indicator pointer.

The passenger cabin temperature bulb is installed with the passenger cabin temperature sensor inside a duct
located below the stowage compartment. An in-line fan downstream of the bulb and sensor draws air from the
cabin across the bulb and sensor.

The passenger cabin temperature bulbs are installed with the passenger cabin temperature sensor inside a
duct located below the stowage compartment. An in-line fan downstream of the bulb and sensor draws air
from the cabin across the bulb and sensor.

The passenger cabin supply duct temperature bulb is mounted in the main distribution manifold.

The temperature sensors also utilize variable resistance type elements. As temperature increases their
resistance decreases and vice versa. The sensors form a part of the automatic regulation system network to
maintain selected temperatures in the control and passenger cabin. A duct limit temperature sensor,
anticipator sensor, and cabin temperature sensor are used with each regulation system. The duct limit
sensors and anticipator sensors are mounted in the main distribution manifold and in the overhead
distribution manifold. The control cabin temperature sensor is located behind a screened opening in the
ceiling, approximately 4 inches left of center, at station 259. The passenger cabin temperature sensor is
installed in the same duct which encloses the passenger cabin temperature bulb.

ATA-21 Page 100 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization
and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-21 Page 101
and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Temperature Selectors

The control and passenger cabin temperature selectors are identical units mounted on the forward overhead
panel. The face dial is divided into an automatic and MANUAL range. Three switches inside the selector are
provided to direct 115-volts AC to the mix valve. Two cams on a cam plate, fixed to the selector knob, close
each switch separately as the knob is turned.

In MANUAL, turning the knob clockwise to COOL causes one of the cams to close a switch connected to the
mix valve actuator motor, and operate the valve to increase the proportion of cold air passing through the
valve. Turning the knob counterclockwise to WARM causes the cam to close a switch that is connected to the
mix valve actuator and operate the valve to increase the proportion of warm air passing through the valve.
When the knob is returned to OFF, both switches are open and the mix valve remains in the position to which
it was last driven.

When the temperature selector knob is turned past the MANUAL range into AUTO, the second cam on the knob
shaft closes a switch which directs power to the automatic temperature control circuit. The cam keeps the
switch closed through the automatic range. In the AUTO range, the knob also drives a potentiometer which
forms one leg of a cabin temperature control bridge circuit.
CABIN TEMPERATURE
MODULE (P5-17) CONT CABIN AIR TEMP PASS CABIN
SEE A
SUPPLY PASS
DUCT CABIN
AIR MIX AIR MIX
VALVE VALVE

60
40TEMP
80
DUCT 20 DUCT
OVERHEAAT OVERHEAAT
100
C

FLIGHT COMPARTMENT AUTO AUTO


NO AL NO AL

COOL WARM COOL WARM

COOL WARM COOL WARM


OFF OFF
MANUAL MANUAL

CABIN TEMPERATURE
SELECTORS
SEE B

ATA-21 Page 102 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization
and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Temperature Controller

Control and passenger cabin automatic temperature regulation is obtained from a single unit located in the
electronic compartment. This unit contains all parts of each regulation system which are not required to be
mounted remotely. Separate identical networks are enclosed for each cabin.

A built-in test circuit in the temperature controller provides a quick electrical check of temperature control
system components. A rotary test switch, two sets of GO, NO GO lights and a test instruction decal are
provided on the face of the controller. When the temperature control system is not being tested the switch
must be returned to START position.

E1
E3

E2

SEE A
SEE B
PACK/ZONE TEMPERATURE CONT
(E2-3)

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-21 Page 103
and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

CONDITIONED AIR TEMPERATURE CONTROL SYSTEM B737-400


Overview

Conditioned air temperature control covers that portion of the air conditioning system which starts, regulates,
and shuts down air conditioning equipment to provide a selected temperature in the passenger and flight
compartments. The system functions automatically according to selections made on the P5 overhead panel.
The temperature control system is configured in such a way that under normal operation, the airplane is
divided into three zones. These zones are the control cabin (flight deck) zone, forward passenger cabin zone,
and aft passenger cabin zone.

Controlling the temperature in the cabins is accomplished by controlling the temperature of the air entering the
cabins. Air conditioning operation begins when the pack switches are positioned to AUTO or HIGH. This
commands the respective pack valve(s) to open allowing bleed air into the pack.

When the pack valve is opened, the pack valve closed limit switch opens. This de-energizes the pack closed
relay switch, which causes contacts within the relay to open, enabling temperature control by the pack/zone
temperature controller.

During normal operation, the pack/zone temperature controller determines cabin (or zone) temperature
requirements. The temperature demand of the zone requiring the most cooling is used to set the pack
discharge temperature. The remaining zones temperature demands are satisfied by a Trim Air System.

The Trim Air System is composed of a trim air pressure regulating and shut off valve, two trim air check
valves, and three trim air modulating valves.

An indicating system permits monitoring of zone temperature for the two-passenger and supply duct
temperature for any zone. The temperature may be read from the temperature indicator on the P5 overhead
panel by using the AIR TEMP source selector.

Each zone of the system is equipped with a trim air modulating valve, 190°F (88°C) zone duct thermal
overheat switch, a duct temperature sensor, a temperature selector switch, a zone temperature sensor, and a
zone/duct temperature bulb.

ATA-21 Page 104 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization
and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Trim Air Pressure Regulating and Shut Off Valve

The trim air pressure regulating and shut off valve is an electrically controlled, pneumatically actuated,
pressure regulating valve. The primary components of the valve are a pneumatic actuator assembly, a servo
regulator, a non-latching solenoid assembly, a manual override position indicator, a relief valve, and the valve
body assembly. The valve is spring loaded to a closed position.

The solenoid valve is energized open when the TRIM AIR switch on the P5 overhead panel is positioned to the
ON. Bleed air is ported to the open side of the pneumatic actuator to overcome the actuator spring force. The
servo regulator senses the differential pressure between the bleed air and the cabin to regulate the trim air to
(+) 4.0 PSI above the cabin pressure. The trim air pressure regulating valve is located in the right equipment
bay.
TRIM AIR
PRESSURE
REGULATION
VALVE
SEE B

SEE A

FWD

BONDING
JUMPER

LEFT SIDE SHOWN


(RIGHT SIDE SIMILAR)
A
ELECTRICAL
CONNECTOR

CLAMP
(2 PLACES)

T FITTING
PRESSURE SENSE LINE TO
DOWN STREAM SENSE PORT

TRIM AIR PRESSURE REGULATING VALVE


B

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-21 Page 105
and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Trim Air Modulating Valves

The trim air modulating valves port hot bleed air into the control cabin (flight deck) and passenger cabin zone
ducts to meet zone temperature requirements. The trim air modulating valves are controlled by the pack/zone
temperature controllers. The aft passenger cabin zone modulating valve receives its signals from the left
controller. The forward passenger cabin and control cabin (flight deck) modulating valves receive positioning
signals from the right controller. The left controller serves as backup to position the control cabin (flight
deck) trim air modulating valve . The passenger compartment valves are located forward in the right
equipment bay. The control cabin (flight deck) valve is located forward in the left air conditioning bay.

The modulating valve operates on 115-volts AC, single-phase power. An electromechanical actuator drives an
output shaft through a slip clutch. A butterfly, visual position indicator, and a cam are connected to the output
shaft. The cam contacts a set of limit switches to provide feedback to the pack/zone temperature controllers.
A manual override drives the output shaft through the slip clutch.
TO THE AFT
PASSENGER TO THE
COMPARTMENT CONTROL
TRIM AIR MODULATING
CABIN
VALVES (3)
TO THE FORWARD
PASSENGER SEE B
COMPARTMENT

T
SEE A
C

FWD

RIGHT AIR CONDITIONING PACK

ATA-21 Page 106 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization
and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-21 Page 107
and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Pack/Zone Temperature Controller

Two identical and interchangeable pack/zone temperature controllers control the cooling pack discharge
temperature and form a three zone temperature control system. Each controller includes a primary and
standby pack control and two zone controls: one for the control cabin (flight deck) and one for passenger
cabins.

The right pack/zone temperature controller controls the control cabin (flight deck) and forward passenger
cabin temperatures. The left pack/zone controller controls the aft passenger cabin temperature and has a
backup temperature control for the control (flight deck).

For zone temperature control, each pack/zone temperature controller controls the position of the trim air
modulating valve necessary to provide the required zone temperature. The pack/zone temperature controller
also has the capability to operate the opposite packs functions in the event the standby mode of operation is
activated.

The pack/zone temperature controller processes signals received from various sensors and temperature
selectors to determine heating and/or cooling requirements for each zone. The pack/zone temperature
controller controls the pack discharge temperature to satisfy the zone requiring the most cooling. The zone
temperatures are satisfied by allowing small amounts of trim air into the supply ducts leading to the zones.
The trim air passes through a trim air modulating valve which is controlled by the pack/zone temperature
controller.

Each pack/zone temperature controller contains full built-in test equipment circuitry (BITE) which enables the
controller to fault isolate and identify components associated with the respective controller. The BITE will
continuously test the components and pack/zone temperature controller for faults in operation. If faults are
identified, the pack/zone temperature controller will take corrective steps to inhibit faulty items from
controlling. The pack/zone temperature controllers will reconfigure to satisfy the cooling and/or heating
requirements.

The pack/zone temperature controllers are located in the electronic equipment compartment on the E2-3 rack.

ATA-21 Page 108 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization
and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

E1
E3

E2

SEE A
SEE B

PACK/ZONE TEMPERATURE CONTROLLER


A

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-21 Page 109
and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Trim Air Check Valves

Two trim air check valves are located upstream of the trim air pressure regulating and shut off valve. The two
check valves are used to prevent bleed air from back-flowing into a pack when single pack conditions exist.
The check valves are located in the aft inboard section of the right air conditioning bay.

ATA-21 Page 110 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization
and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-21 Page 111
and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Thermal Sensing Units

Thermal sensing units in the temperature control system consist of zone temperature sensors, zone duct
overheat switches, zone/duct temperature bulbs, and duct temperature sensors. Zone duct overheat switches
are used to protect ducts against thermal damage. Zone/duct temperature bulbs provide temperature
information to the temperature gage on the P5 overhead panel. The zone duct temperature bulbs are also
used to monitor supply duct temperatures of the flight deck and passenger cabins. Duct and cabin zone
temperature sensors are used to provide information to the pack/zone temperature controllers.

The zone duct overheat switch consists of a bimetal element enclosed in a steel probe. The zone duct
overheat switch contacts are normally open but a predetermined temperature will close the switch. A zone
duct overheat switch is used in each supply duct to the passenger cabins and control cabin (flight deck) zone.
The zone duct overheat switch activates at 190°F (88°C). If the switch is activated, airplane control logic will
instruct the appropriate trim air modulating valve to close.

Zone/duct temperature bulbs consist of a temperature sensitive resistance element within a tube. As the
temperature changes, the resistance changes accordingly in order to cause movement of an indicator pointer.
Zone/duct temperature bulbs are used in the distribution risers and control cabin (flight deck) distribution
duct. Zone/duct temperature bulbs are also used for temperature indication in the forward and aft passenger
cabin zones.

The temperature sensors also utilize variable resistance type elements. As temperature increases, their
resistance decreases and vice versa. The forward passenger cabin and control cabin (flight deck) zone duct
temperature sensors provide information to the right pack/zone temperature controller. The aft passenger
cabin zone duct temperature sensor provides information to the left pack/zone temperature controller.

Each passenger cabin zone has a zone duct overheat switch, a zone/duct temperature bulb, and a duct
temperature sensor installed in the overhead riser. The switch, bulb and sensor are installed on the right side
of the centerline at the point where the riser joins the overhead distribution duct.

ATA-21 Page 112 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization
and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

OVERHEAD
DISTRIBUTION
DUCT

RISERS

DIFFUSER
SEE B OUTLETS

DUCT
SEE A TEMPERATURE
SENSORS
ZONE/DUCT
TEMPERATURE
BULB
SEE D

SEE C SEE E ZONE DUCT


OVHT SWITCH

FWD FWD
ZONE

FLIGHT COMPARTMENT
DISTRIBUTION DUCT

AFT
ZONE

DUCT TEMPERATURE
SENSOR ZONE/DUCT TEMPERATURE B
ZONE DUCT OVHT
SWITCH D E

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-21 Page 113
and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Zone Temperature Sensors

The zone temperature sensors provide compartment temperature information to the pack/zone temperature
controllers. The zone/duct temperature bulbs provide forward and aft cabin temperature information to the
P5 temperature gage on the overhead panel. The zone temperature sensor fans provide a constant air flow
across the zone temperature sensors and the bulbs.

The control cabin (flight deck) zone temperature sensor assembly is located to the left side of the P5 overhead
panel. The passenger compartment zone temperature sensor assemblies are mounted in the bullnose area
below the passenger service units. Both assemblies are on the right side of the airplane.
SEE A SEE B PASSENGER PASSENGER SEE B
SERVICE UNIT SERVICE UNIT

ZONE
TEMPERATURE
SENSOR

AIR INLET

CEILING
FLIGHT PANEL SEE C SEE D
COMPARTMENT
TEMPERATURE
SENSOR FAN FWD

TEMPERATURE
SENSOR FAN

FLIGHT DECK ZONE TEMPERATURE PASSENGER CABIN ZONE


SENSOR ASSEMBLY TEMPERATURE SENSOR ASSEMBLY
A B

ZONE/DUCT TEMPERATURE BULB ZONE TEMPERATURE SENSOR


C D

ATA-21 Page 114 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization
and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Temperature Selectors

Air conditioning begins when one or both of the pack switches on the P5 overhead panel is positioned to AUTO
or HIGH. This commands the respective pack valve(s) to open allowing bleed air to enter the pack.

The primary control for the trim air system is an ON/OFF switch on the P5 overhead panel. The ON/OFF
switch is the only control for the trim air pressure regulating and shut off valve.

The right pack/zone temperature controller controls the control cabin (flight deck) and forward passenger
cabin trim air modulating valves. The left pack/zone temperature controller controls the aft passenger cabin
trim air modulating valve and has backup control for the control cabin (flight deck).

The cooling packs satisfy the zone requiring the most cooling. The trim air modulating valves are positioned
to satisfy the other zones temperature demands.

The ZONE TEMP light on the P5 overhead panel will illuminate and also the master caution and AIR COND
light will illuminate. If the temperature at the switch drops below the switch set point, the zone trim system
will resume operation and the ZONE TEMP light will extinguish when the RESET switch is pressed.

DUAL RAM DOOR RAM DOOR


BLEED FULL OPEN FULL OPEN

L RECIRC FAN R RECIRC FAN


OFF OFF
AIR TEMP
PASS
AUTO AUTO
CAB
S FWD
60 D AFT AFT
40 TEMP U 40 60
80 P U F OVHT
20 P C W R 80
L T P
D
100 Y A PSI
CONT
°C L C 0 100
CAB
K TEST
TRIM AIR
OFF L PACK R PACK
ISOLATION
ON OFF VALVE OFF
AUTO CLOSE AUTO
ZONE ZONE ZONE HIGH AUTO HIGH
TEMP TEMP TEMP

WING WING
CONT CAB FWD CAB AFT CAB ANTI PACK OPEN PACK ANTI
AUTO AUTO AUTO ICE ICE
WING-BODY WING-BODY
TRIP
OVERHEAT OVERHEAT
BLEED BLEED
TRIP OFF TRIP OFF

C W C W C W RESET

OFF OFF OFF OFF OFF

ON ON
1 APU 2
BLEED
AUTO OFF SCHED
STANDBY MANUAL
FAIL DESCENT

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-21 Page 115
and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

PRESSURIZATION SYSTEM
Overview

The pressurization control system is an electrically operated and electronically controlled system, which
meters the exhaust of ventilating air to provide controlled pressurization of the passenger and control cabins,
the electronic compartment, both cargo compartments, and the lower nose compartment. The pressurization
control system consists of a pressure control panel, a pressure controller, and a cabin pressurization outflow
valve.

The system has four operating modes; automatic, standby, AC manual and DC manual. Automatic is the
normal operating mode. Standby is a semiautomatic backup. The AC manual and DC manual modes are
backups for automatic and standby modes. Normal operation is automatic and normally requires no
adjustment by the flight crew throughout the flight except for barometric correction.

Both the AC manual mode and the dc manual mode provide direct control to the outflow valve through
separate electrical actuators. The manual modes back up the automatic and standby systems.

In the automatic mode, the system accepts manual inputs of planned flight altitude and landing altitude before
takeoff. It then determines the lowest possible cabin pressure that can be maintained during airplane high
altitude flight and schedules any necessary change in cabin pressure during the flight without any action by the
crew. The system can also be reset if a change in planned flight altitude or landing field altitude is made.

Cabin pressure rate of change is automatically controlled in AUTO. Rate of change may be manually controlled
in STBY.

Barometric correction for automatic and standby pressure control assures that cabin pressure and landing field
pressure are approximately the same at landing.

A mode selector switch on the control panel permits selection of four modes of operation plus a check position
for system test.

The STANDBY system automatically takes over to control cabin pressure according to cabin altitude and rate
of cabin pressure change settings if certain limits are exceeded in AUTO. In addition, a manual transfer can
be made from AUTO to STBY, if desired, by use of the mode selector switch.

ATA-21 Page 116 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization
and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-21 Page 117
and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Pressure Control Panel

The pressure control panel includes four groupings of dials, switches, and indicators used in the operation of
the pressurization control system. One grouping is for the automatic (AUTO) mode of operation, another is for
the semiautomatic or standby mode, the third is for the manual mode, and the fourth is to allow choosing the
desired mode of control and function available.

For the AUTO mode there is an adjusting knob and indicator (LAND ALT) for setting destination landing field
altitude and another knob and indicator (FLT ALT) for setting cruise altitude.

Instruments for STANDBY consist of a cabin altitude adjusting knob (CAB ALT) and indicator and a cabin rate
of pressure change (CAB RATE) knob. There is an index mark on the panel for the CAB RATE knob which
marks the setting for approximately 300 feet per minute rate of change. CAB RATE range is from 50 to 2000
sea level ft/min.

The manual mode utilizes a three-position self-centering toggle switch for controlling the position of the
outflow valve. The switch has momentary contacts for driving the outflow valve open or closed. Releasing the
switch opens the contacts, stopping outflow valve movement. A position indicator is provided for monitoring
outflow valve position in all modes.

The fourth section of the panel includes a five-position mode selector switch, CHECK, AUTO, STBY, AC and DC
MAN; and a two-position FLT-GRD toggle switch. The FLT-GRD switch is used in conjunction with the mode
selector switch and landing gear sensor switch to control minimum cabin pressurization on the ground when
the mode selector is in AUTO or STBY, and to check the rate limit fault detector of the auto transfer when the
mode selector is in the CHECK position. When the mode selector is in MAN AC or DC position, cabin
pressurization is controlled directly by the use of the manual OPEN-CLOSE switch to actuate the outflow valve
under ac or dc control, depending on the position of the selector switch.

0
ALT
10 1
HORN AUTO STANDBY MANUAL
0
9
50
CABIN 2 CUTOUT V
40 ALT 5 A
35 00000
L
30
8 3 FLT ALT DECR INCR V
X 1000 FEET 10 CABIN RATE
25 E
20 15 C
7 4 O
00 000 L
P
6
O
5 CAB ALT E
S
N
00 000 E
PRESS DIFF
LIMIT:TAKE- LAND ALT STBY AC
1 2
OFF & LDG
.125 PSI 3 MAN
UP F G AUTO DC
0 4 L R
DN T D CHECK
3
1 2 -.3 .8 1.9 2.9 3.9 5.0 5.1 6.0 6.8 7.6
CAB .3 1.4 2.4 3.4 4.4 5.0 5.6 6.4 7.2 8.0
18 20 22 24 26 28 30 32 34 36
FLT
ALTITUDE X 1000 FEET-MAX PRESS SCHEDULE

ATA-21 Page 118 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization
and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Pressure Controller

The pressure controller is an electronic unit which receives inputs from the pressurization control panel,
airplane ambient pressure and cabin pressure, then positions the outflow valve to maintain proper differential
pressure.

Two completely independent pressure control system networks are contained within the pressure controller.
The automatic system operates as a function of destination landing field altitude and cruise altitude while the
standby system operates according to the selected cabin altitude and selected rate of cabin pressure change.

All outputs from the pressure controller operate the cabin pressurization outflow valve. The controller will
operate either under the automatic system or the standby system, but never both systems simultaneously. The
FLT-GRD switch is used to modify both outputs for cabin pressurization control on the ground. When the
switch is moved to FLT position with the mode selector in AUTO the valve will move to a position which will
cause cabin pressure to rise slightly above (approximately 0.1 PSI) that of the takeoff field. With the selector
in STBY the valve will be positioned to control the pressure to the selected standby cabin altitude. With mode
selector switch in either AUTO or STBY and FLT-GRD switch is moved to GRD (airplane on ground), the
outflow valve will move to the full open position at the rate required to completely depressurize the airplane at
rate limit.

On the front of the controller, there are test points under a cover which are used for trouble shooting the
pressurization control system. On the rear of the controller, the upper connection is used only for bench test.

The pressure controller is installed in the electronic equipment compartment on the forward top shelf. There
is a delta P module installed adjacent to the pressure controller, which provides a maximum of 7.45 PSI with
the pressurization mode selector in AUTO and 28,000 ft. or below selected with the FLT ALT selector. A 7.80
D P is provided when FLT ALT above 28,000 ft. is selected with the pressurization mode selector in AUTO.
STANDBY maximum pressure differential is 7.8 PSI.

PRESSURE CONTROLLER

E1 RACK (REF)

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-21 Page 119
and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Cabin Pressurization Outflow Valve

The outflow valve is a thrust recovery, rotating gate valve which is driven by either a rotary DC electrical
actuator or a rotary AC electrical actuator. Each actuator connects to the gate shaft with an electrically
operated spring-loaded clutch. AUTO and AC MANUAL modes operate the AC actuator. STANDBY and DC
MANUAL modes operate the dc actuator. When either actuator is in operation the clutch to the other actuator
is disengaged.

WARNING: OUTFLOW VALVE IS MOTOR-OPERATED. DO NOT INSERT HAND OR TOOLS IN


OUTLET DURING ANY GROUND OPERATION OR INJURY TO PERSONNEL MAY
OCCUR.

The outflow valve is installed so its outlet is flush with the body skin. The valve is located to the right of the
airplane centerline, at the underside of the airplane, approximately below the aft right service door.

ATA-21 Page 120 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization
and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Forward Outflow Valve

The forward outflow valve is located at the forward left side of the forward cargo compartment. The forward
outflow valve is a component of the cargo heating system and does not affect the cabin pressurization control
system. This is assured by an electrical circuit that closes the forward outflow valve whenever the cabin
pressurization outflow valve is nearly closed. There is a limit switch installed in each actuator of the cabin
pressurization outflow valve. The forward outflow valve will close when the cabin pressurization outflow valve
is within 0.5 degrees of closed and will open when the pressurization outflow valve opens approximately 4.5
degrees. An electrical circuit also closes the forward outflow valve any time the cabin air recirculation fan is
operating.

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-21 Page 121
and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Safety Relief Valves

Two safety relief valves acting independently of each other and all other systems prevent the cabin-to-ambient
pressure differential from exceeding 8.50 PSI.

The safety relief valves are installed under the fuselage approximately below the aft right service door. One
safety relief valve is installed on each side of the outflow valve.

ATA-21 Page 122 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization
and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-21 Page 123
and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

PRESSURIZATION INDICATION AND WARNING


Overview

The pressurization indication and warning system, which consists of lights, indicators and a cabin altitude
warning system, permits monitoring of the cabin pressurization control system during its operation and
provides aural and visual warning in case of pressurization system malfunction.

The following indicator lights are installed on the forward overhead panel and obtain power through 28-volt DC
Bus No. 1.

The AUTO FAIL light indicates a failure in the automatic pressurization control mode. STANDBY light
illuminated indicates automatic transfer to STBY mode.

The OFF SCHED DESCENT light indicates that the airplane is descending prior to obtaining the cruise altitude
selected, with mode selector in AUTO.

The STANDBY light indicates that the pressurization control system is operating in the standby mode.

The MANUAL light indicates that the pressurization control system is operating in the manual AC or DC mode.

The outflow valve position indicator is installed on the forward overhead panel and is powered from the
precision 20-volt supply in the pressure controller.

The cabin altimeter and differential pressure indicator are combined in one instrument on the forward
overhead panel, and powered directly by sensed pressure changes. The altimeter and differential pressure
indicator registers cabin altitude and pressure difference between cabin and ambient.

The cabin rate of climb indicator is installed on the forward overhead panel and registers rate of pressure
change in the airplane.

The cabin altitude warning system is activated by a pressure switch which is connected to the aural warning
devices box. The system provides an intermittent sound signal when cabin altitude exceeds approximately
10,000 feet.

ATA-21 Page 124 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization
and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

AUTO OFF SCHED


DESCENT A STANDBY MANUAL
FAIL A G G

0
ALT
10 1
HORN AUTO STANDBY MANUAL
0
9
50
CABIN 2 CUTOUT V
40 ALT 5 A
35 00000
L
30
8 3 FLT ALT DECR INCR V
X 1000 FEET 10 CABIN RATE
25 E
20 15 C
7 4 O
00 000 L
P
6 O
5 CAB ALT E
S
N
00 000 E
PRESS DIFF
LIMIT:TAKE- LAND ALT STBY AC
1 2
OFF & LDG
.125 PSI 3
MAN
UP F G AUTO DC
0 4 L R
DN T D CHECK
3
2 -.3 .8 1.9 2.9 3.9 5.0 5.1 6.0 6.8 7.6
1 CAB .3 1.4 2.4 3.4 4.4 5.0 5.6 6.4 7.2 8.0
18 20 22 24 26 28 30 32 34 36
FLT
ALTITUDE X 1000 FEET-MAX PRESS SCHEDULE

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-21 Page 125
and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

CARGO COMPARTMENT HEATING


Overview

Cargo compartment heating is accomplished by exhausting passenger cabin air around the compartment walls.

Air from the passenger cabin, after picking up heat from the passenger cabin, is exhausted through foot level
grilles in the passenger cabin sidewall. This air then flows around the walls to keep the cargo compartment
from becoming cold as a result of outside air temperature. Air is induced through the walls of the aft cargo
compartment by exhausting the air through the cabin pressurization outflow valve located to the right of the
airplane centerline, at the underside of the airplane, approximately below the aft right service door.

Forward Cargo Compartment Heat Distribution

Control cabin air is drawn through ducts located in the P6 circuit breaker panel, behind the instrument panels
and is utilized for equipment cooling. This duct, on the right side of the airplane connects into a system of
ducts and manifolds that lead to an inlet plenum. Blowers are installed in the inlet plenum to act as air
movers. During ground operation or when the airplane is un-pressurized, air is drawn through the ducts past
a flow control valve, and is discharged overboard through the exhaust port.

In flight, normal operation of the pressurization system will cause the automatic flow control valve to go
closed. As a result all air passing through and around the equipment will be discharged under the cargo
compartment floor. From under the floor the air, heated from passing through and around the equipment,
travels up the sidewalls and circulates between the outer skin insulation and the cargo compartment lining,
heating the cargo compartment. This air is then collected in collector shrouds and is exhausted overboard
through the forward outflow valve or recirculated in the airplane by the recirculation fan. The forward outflow
valve is closed when the cabin air recirculation fan is operating.

ATA-21 Page 126 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization
and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

P6 PANEL

MUFFLERS

FLOOR

INLET PLENUM

BLOWERS

PANEL FORWARD CARGO


COOLING COMPARTMENT
DUCT
CARGO DOOR

EQUIPMENT
RACKS
FORWARD TO CABIN AIR
OUTFLOW RECIRCULATION FAN
VALVE
EXHAUST
PORT

CARGO FLOOR
COLLECTOR
SHROUD

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-21 Page 127
and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

EQUIPMENT COOLING SYSTEM


Overview

The EFIS Cooling System cools the Captain's and First Officer's EHSI and EADI in the control cabin and the
IRUs (Inertial Reference Units) in the E/E compartment.

Cabin air from the E/E compartment is the cooling medium. Air is drawn through a filter by one of two fans
through a check valve and delivered to the using units over a low flow sensor. A portion of the fan air is
discharged into the open area beside the wheel well through a fixed orifice.

Air passes through the EHSI, EADI and is discharged below the floor to prevent smoke incursion into the
control cabin in the event of an electrical problem with the fans or with units in the E/E compartment.

ADI HSI ADI HSI

CONTROL CABIN

FLOOR

LOW FLOW CHECK AIR


SENSOR VALVES CLEANER

TO IRU
FIXED BLEED SUPPLY
ORIFICE FANS
LOWER LOBE E/E COMPARTMENT PURGE
LINE

ATA-21 Page 128 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization
and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Normal and Alternate Cooling Fans

The normal and alternate cooling fans are single stage vaneaxial fans integrating the motor into the fan. The
fan contains an inner housing which encases the three-phase motor. The rotating impeller pushes air over the
motor housing and through de-swirl vanes before exiting the fan. Three miniature thermostats serve as
thermal protective devices for the fan. The thermostats are connected in series with one located over a coil in
each phase.

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-21 Page 129
and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Normal and Alternate Check Valves

A two section swing check valve, spring loaded closed, is located down stream of each fan to prevent back
flow of air through the fan that is not operating.

EFIS COOLING
CHECK VALVES
SEE A

E1 RACK
(REF)

NOSE WHEEL
WELL (REF)

FLEXIBLE ALTERNATE FAN


CHECK
COUPLING (REF)
VALVE
COUPLING CLAMP CLAMP

DUCT AIR CLEANER


(REF)

DIRECTION
OF AIRFLOW

COUPLING CHECK CLAMP CLAMP OUTBD


VALVE FLEXIBLE NORMAL
COUPLING FAN (REF)
FWD
EFIS COOLING CHECK VALVES
A

ATA-21 Page 130 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization
and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Low Flow Sensor

The low flow sensor provides warning when the EFIS cooling system is not supplying enough cooling air for
safe electronic equipment operation. The airflow detection system consists of an equipment cooling supply OFF
warning light and an airflow sensor. Electrical power for operation of the airflow sensor and OFF light press-
to-test circuit is taken from the 28-volt DC bus on circuit breaker panel P18. The OFF light is also connected
to the master test circuit.

The low flow sensor is a heated probe with associated electronic circuitry to measure the current required to
heat the probe when the proper amount of cooling air flows past. Loss of air flow will change the current
required to heat the probe, triggering the transistorized monitoring circuit which supplies a ground to the EFIS
indication control relay.

Actuation of EFIS indication control relay sends a discrete signal to the EFIS system to downgrade the picture
enhancement.

On the ground with either IRU powered, loss of supply cooling will actuate the crew call horn in the nose wheel
well.

FORWARD ACCESS
DOOR, 1103L

SEE A
DUCT

EFIS COOLING SYSTEM


LOW FLOW SENSOR
O-RING
LOCKWIRE

LOW FLOW
SENSOR

ELECTRICA
CONNECTOR

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-21 Page 131
and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Filter Assembly

The filter assembly is a box containing a cleanable, centrifugal element. Air flowing through the filter is
swirled with the denser particles being thrown to the outside and purged through a line connected to the
equipment cooling exhaust port.

SEE A

CLAMPS
SUPPLY AIR CLEANER
FANS HOUSING
AIR CLEANER
SEE B

OB

FWD

A
RELEASE
LATCH

HOUSING
AIR CLEANER 90° EXHAUST
PLENUM ANGLE
AIR
RELEASE INLET
LATCH

TO
CLAMP
EXHAUST
PLENUM

EXHAUST PLENUM
CLAMP

AIR CLEANER 0.25 IN. MIN.


PURGE TUBE

CLAMP FLEX
HOSE
B

ATA-21 Page 132 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization
and Systems
  Introduction
B737 GENERALUNITED AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
AUTOFLIGHT AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE AUTOFLIGHT AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
TABLE OF CONTENTS TABLE OF CONTENTS

DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION


FLIGHT MANAGEMENT SYSTEM INTRODUCTION .....................22-2 FLIGHT MANAGEMENT SYSTEM INTRODUCTION ..................... 22-2
INTRODUCTION .......................................................................................22-2 INTRODUCTION ....................................................................................... 22-2
FMS Built-In Test Equipment (BITE) ..................................................22-4 FMS Built-In Test Equipment (BITE) .................................................. 22-4
FMS Subsystems BITE Locations ........................................................22-4 FMS Subsystems BITE Locations ........................................................ 22-4
Pin Programming ...................................................................................22-4 Pin Programming................................................................................... 22-4
Standard Option Pins .............................................................................22-4 Standard Option Pins ............................................................................. 22-4
Engineering Codes ................................................................................22-5 Engineering Codes ................................................................................ 22-5
AUTOMATIC FLIGHT CONTROL SYSTEM .......................................22-6 AUTOMATIC FLIGHT CONTROL SYSTEM....................................... 22-6
CAT II/CAT III EQUIPMENT REQUIREMENTS ...............................22-8 CAT II/CAT III EQUIPMENT REQUIREMENTS ............................... 22-8
CAT II Equipment Requirements .........................................................22-8 CAT II Equipment Requirements ......................................................... 22-8
CAT IIIa Equipment Requirements ......................................................22-8 CAT IIIa Equipment Requirements ...................................................... 22-8
YAW DAMPER SYSTEM DESCRIPTION & OPERATION .............22-8 YAW DAMPER SYSTEM DESCRIPTION & OPERATION ............. 22-8
Introduction ..........................................................................................22-8 Introduction ......................................................................................... 22-8
System Components ..............................................................................22-8 System Components ............................................................................. 22-8
OPERATING MODES ..............................................................................22-10 OPERATING MODES ............................................................................. 22-10
Yaw Damper BITE Operation................................................................22-10 Yaw Damper BITE Operation ............................................................... 22-10
DIGITAL FLIGHT CONTROL SYSTEM ...............................................22-12 DIGITAL FLIGHT CONTROL SYSTEM............................................... 22-12
Introduction ...........................................................................................22-12 Introduction .......................................................................................... 22-12
System Components ..............................................................................22-12 System Components ............................................................................. 22-12
OPERATING MODES................................................................................22-14 OPERATING MODES ............................................................................... 22-14
Mode Control Panel ...............................................................................22-14 Mode Control Panel............................................................................... 22-14
Mode Annunciation .............................................................................22-14 Mode Annunciation ............................................................................. 22-14
FLIGHT SELECTABLE MODES.............................................................22-15 FLIGHT SELECTABLE MODES ............................................................ 22-15
Roll CWS .............................................................................................22-15 Roll CWS ............................................................................................. 22-15
Roll Attitude Hold ................................................................................22-17 Roll Attitude Hold ............................................................................... 22-17
Heading Hold ........................................................................................22-17 Heading Hold ........................................................................................ 22-17
Pitch CWS..............................................................................................22-17 Pitch CWS ............................................................................................. 22-17
Pitch Attitude Hold ................................................................................22-17 Pitch Attitude Hold ................................................................................ 22-17
Roll Command Modes ..........................................................................22-18 Roll Command Modes .......................................................................... 22-18
Heading Select Mode ............................................................................22-18 Heading Select Mode ............................................................................ 22-18
VOR/LOC Mode....................................................................................22-18 VOR/LOC Mode ................................................................................... 22-18
Lateral Navigation (LNAV) Mode.........................................................22-18 Lateral Navigation (LNAV) Mode......................................................... 22-18
Pitch Command Modes..........................................................................22-18 Pitch Command Modes ......................................................................... 22-18
Altitude Hold Mode .............................................................................22-18 Altitude Hold Mode ............................................................................. 22-18
Altitude Acquire Mode ..........................................................................22-19 Altitude Acquire Mode .......................................................................... 22-19
Vertical Speed (VS) Mode ....................................................................22-19 Vertical Speed (VS) Mode .................................................................... 22-19
Level Change Mode ..............................................................................22-19 Level Change Mode .............................................................................. 22-19
Vertical Navigation (VNAV) Mode ......................................................22-20 Vertical Navigation (VNAV) Mode ...................................................... 22-20
Approach (APP) Mode .........................................................................22-20 Approach (APP) Mode ......................................................................... 22-20
Autoland Dual Channel Approach.........................................................22-21 Autoland Dual Channel Approach ........................................................ 22-21
Localizer and Glideslope Armed ..........................................................22-21 Localizer and Glideslope Armed .......................................................... 22-21

and
OCT 99Systems Introduction 22-i OCT 99 22-i
UNITED
B737 GENERAL AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
AUTOFLIGHT AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE AUTOFLIGHT AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
TABLE OF CONTENTS TABLE OF CONTENTS

Localizer Capture .................................................................................. 22-22 Localizer Capture ..................................................................................22-22


Glideslope Capture .............................................................................. 22-22 Glideslope Capture ...............................................................................22-22
Autoland Dual Channel Approach Sequence ....................................... 22-22 Autoland Dual Channel Approach Sequence ........................................22-22
COMMAND SPEED LIMITING AND REVERSION MODES ............ 22-27 COMMAND SPEED LIMITING AND REVERSION MODES.............22-27
Command Speed Limiting .................................................................. 22-27 Command Speed Limiting ..................................................................22-27
Reversion Modes ................................................................................. 22-27 Reversion Modes ..................................................................................22-27
ROLL & PITCH CHANNEL OPERATION ........................................... 22-28 ROLL & PITCH CHANNEL OPERATION ...........................................22-28
Mode Control Panel Logic..................................................................... 22-28 Mode Control Panel Logic .....................................................................22-28
Autopilot System ................................................................................... 22-29 Autopilot System....................................................................................22-29
Control Wheel Steering (CWS) ............................................................ 22-29 Control Wheel Steering (CWS) .............................................................22-29
Flight Director System .......................................................................... 22-30 Flight Director System ..........................................................................22-30
Master FCC ........................................................................................... 22-31 Master FCC ...........................................................................................22-31
Independent FCC ................................................................................... 22-31 Independent FCC....................................................................................22-31
FCC Cross Channel Bus ....................................................................... 22-31 FCC Cross Channel Bus ........................................................................22-31
Radio Altimeter ..................................................................................... 22-32 Radio Altimeter ......................................................................................22-32
AP Actuator Operation ......................................................................... 22-32 AP Actuator Operation ..........................................................................22-32
ROLL CHANNEL OPERATION ............................................................ 22-35 ROLL CHANNEL OPERATION ............................................................22-35
AUTOPILOT STABILZER TRIM SYSTEM ......................................... 22-37 AUTOPILOT STABILZER TRIM SYSTEM ..........................................22-37
Stabilizer Trim Systems Warning Light .............................................. 22-37 Stabilizer Trim Systems Warning Light ...............................................22-37
SPEED TRIM SYSTEM ........................................................................... 22-40 SPEED TRIM SYSTEM ...........................................................................22-40
Single Channel Fault.............................................................................. 22-40 Single Channel Fault ..............................................................................22-40
Dual Channel Fault ................................................................................ 22-40 Dual Channel Fault.................................................................................22-40
MACH TRIM SYSTEM ........................................................................... 22-40 MACH TRIM SYSTEM ............................................................................22-40
Single Channel Fault.............................................................................. 22-42 Single Channel Fault ..............................................................................22-42
Dual Channel Fault ................................................................................ 22-42 Dual Channel Fault.................................................................................22-42
ALTITUDE ALERT SYSTEM................................................................... 22-42 ALTITUDE ALERT SYSTEM ...................................................................22-42
PITCH CHANNEL OPERATION............................................................. 22-44 PITCH CHANNEL OPERATION .............................................................22-44
IAS/MACH Display ............................................................................. 22-45 IAS/MACH Display ..............................................................................22-45
ENGAGE AND WARNING MONITORS ................................................ 22-60 ENGAGE AND WARNING MONITORS.................................................22-60
AP Engage Interlock Operation ............................................................ 22-47 AP Engage Interlock Operation ............................................................22-47
Typical AP Engagement Criteria .......................................................... 22-47 Typical AP Engagement Criteria ...........................................................22-47
A/P Roll/Pitch Mode Disengage General Information.......................... 22-47 A/P Roll/Pitch Mode Disengage General Information ..........................22-47
AP Disengagement Criteria .................................................................. 22-49 AP Disengagement Criteria ...................................................................22-49
Electrical Power Loss ........................................................................... 22-49 Electrical Power Loss ............................................................................22-49
AP Red Warning Lights Operation ....................................................... 22-49 AP Red Warning Lights Operation .......................................................22-49
Press to Test .......................................................................................... 22-49 Press to Test ...........................................................................................22-49
AP Warning Light Illuminates Flashing Red ........................................ 22-49 AP Warning Light Illuminates Flashing Red ........................................22-49
AP Warning Light Illuminates Steady Red ........................................... 22-50 AP Warning Light Illuminates Steady Red ...........................................22-50
FD Warning Flag and Bars Out Of View .............................................. 22-50 FD Warning Flag and Bars Out Of View ..............................................22-50
SYSTEM TESTING ................................................................................... 22-52 SYSTEM TESTING ...................................................................................22-52
DFCS Built-In Maintenance Features ................................................... 22-52 DFCS Built-In Maintenance Features ....................................................22-52
DFCS BITE - Overview ............................................................................. 22-52 DFCS BITE - Overview ..............................................................................22-52
DFCS BITE Introduction Block Diagram ............................................. 22-53 DFCS BITE Introduction Block Diagram..............................................22-53

22-ii and Systems Introduction OCT 99 22-ii OCT 99


B737 GENERALUNITED AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
AUTOFLIGHT AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE AUTOFLIGHT AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
TABLE OF CONTENTS TABLE OF CONTENTS

BITE Fault Isolation .............................................................................22-54 BITE Fault Isolation ............................................................................. 22-54


BITE Verification Tests .........................................................................22-54 BITE Verification Tests ........................................................................ 22-54
Standard Option Pins ............................................................................22-54 Standard Option Pins ............................................................................ 22-54
Engineering Codes ................................................................................22-55 Engineering Codes ................................................................................ 22-55
System Troubleshooting .......................................................................22-55 System Troubleshooting ....................................................................... 22-55
Using the DFCS BITE Flow Chart .......................................................22-56 Using the DFCS BITE Flow Chart ....................................................... 22-56
AUTOTHROTTLE SYSTEM ...................................................................22-57 AUTOTHROTTLE SYSTEM ................................................................... 22-57
Introduction ...........................................................................................22-57 Introduction .......................................................................................... 22-57
System Components .............................................................................22-57 System Components ............................................................................ 22-57
Autothrottle Pictorial Block Diagram ...................................................22-58 Autothrottle Pictorial Block Diagram ................................................... 22-58
OPERATING MODES................................................................................22-59 OPERATING MODES ............................................................................... 22-59
Mode Control .......................................................................................22-59 Mode Control ....................................................................................... 22-59
Automatic AT Operating Limits & Control Modes Minimum Speed .22-59 Automatic AT Operating Limits & Control Modes Minimum Speed . 22-59
Reversion Mode ...................................................................................22-59 Reversion Mode ................................................................................... 22-59
Flight Selectable Modes ........................................................................22-59 Flight Selectable Modes ....................................................................... 22-59
N1 Mode ..............................................................................................22-60 N1 Mode .............................................................................................. 22-60
Speed/Mach Modes ...............................................................................22-60 Speed/Mach Modes .............................................................................. 22-60
AT Mode Annunciation ........................................................................22-60 AT Mode Annunciation ....................................................................... 22-60
SYSTEM OPERATION ..............................................................................22-62 SYSTEM OPERATION.............................................................................. 22-62
Input Interface Signals ..........................................................................22-62 Input Interface Signals .......................................................................... 22-62
Analog Inputs .......................................................................................22-62 Analog Inputs ...................................................................................... 22-62
Discrete Logic Inputs ............................................................................22-62 Discrete Logic Inputs ............................................................................ 22-62
AT Computer Mode Logic Inputs .........................................................22-62 AT Computer Mode Logic Inputs ......................................................... 22-62
Digital Inputs ........................................................................................22-63 Digital Inputs ........................................................................................ 22-63
Interface Outputs ...................................................................................22-63 Interface Outputs .................................................................................. 22-63
Thrust Mode Annunciator (TMA) ........................................................22-63 Thrust Mode Annunciator (TMA) ........................................................ 22-63
N1 Indicator .........................................................................................22-63 N1 Indicator ......................................................................................... 22-63
Servo Drive ..........................................................................................22-63 Servo Drive .......................................................................................... 22-63
Electromagnetic Clutch Control ..........................................................22-65 Electromagnetic Clutch Control .......................................................... 22-65
Torque Limiter Switch ..........................................................................22-65 Torque Limiter Switch .......................................................................... 22-65
Torque Limiter Switch Bypass ..............................................................22-65 Torque Limiter Switch Bypass ............................................................. 22-65
Torque Switch Mechanism ..................................................................22-65 Torque Switch Mechanism .................................................................. 22-65
ADI Fast/Slow Indicators .....................................................................22-65 ADI Fast/Slow Indicators ..................................................................... 22-65
Throttle Director Operation ................................................................22-65 Throttle Director Operation ................................................................ 22-65
ENGAGE AND WARNING MONITORS ................................................22-67 ENGAGE AND WARNING MONITORS ................................................ 22-67
Interlock Monitors ................................................................................22-67 Interlock Monitors ................................................................................ 22-67
Arm Mode Logic ..................................................................................22-67 Arm Mode Logic ................................................................................. 22-67
Disengage .............................................................................................22-67 Disengage ............................................................................................ 22-67
AT Red Warning Lights Operation ......................................................22-69 AT Red Warning Lights Operation ...................................................... 22-69
Press To Test .........................................................................................22-69 Press To Test ......................................................................................... 22-69
SYSTEM TESTING ...................................................................................22-69 SYSTEM TESTING................................................................................... 22-69
System BITE .......................................................................................22-69 System BITE ....................................................................................... 22-69
Current Status Tests .............................................................................22-69 Current Status Tests ............................................................................. 22-69

and
OCT 99Systems Introduction 22-iii OCT 99 22-iii
UNITED
B737 GENERAL AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
AUTOFLIGHT AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE AUTOFLIGHT AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
TABLE OF CONTENTS TABLE OF CONTENTS

In Flight Faults ...................................................................................... 22-69 In Flight Faults ..................................................................................... 22-69


LRU Interface Tests .............................................................................. 22-69 LRU Interface Tests .............................................................................. 22-69
AT Range Check ................................................................................... 22-69 AT Range Check ................................................................................... 22-69
AT Rigging Adjust ................................................................................ 22-69 AT Rigging Adjust ................................................................................ 22-69
Engineering Codes ............................................................................... 22-71 Engineering Codes ............................................................................... 22-71
System Troubleshooting ....................................................................... 22-71 System Troubleshooting ....................................................................... 22-71

CONTROLS & INDICATIONS CONTROLS & INDICATIONS


EADI...................................................................................................... 22-73 EADI...................................................................................................... 22-73
FLIGHT MODE ANNUNCIATIONS - ADI........................................ 22-74 FLIGHT MODE ANNUNCIATIONS - ADI........................................ 22-74
EHSI ...................................................................................................... 22-75 EHSI ...................................................................................................... 22-75
MACH AIRSPEED INDICATOR ........................................................ 22-76 MACH AIRSPEED INDICATOR ....................................................... 22-76
ALTITUDE ALERTING SYSTEM ..................................................... 22-77 ALTITUDE ALERTING SYSTEM ..................................................... 22-77
AFDS ..................................................................................................... 22-78 AFDS..................................................................................................... 22-78
AUTOPILOT & AUTOTHROTTLE DISENGAGE LIGHTS ............. 22-79 AUTOPILOT & AUTOTHROTTLE DISENGAGE LIGHTS............. 22-79
CONTROL STAND .............................................................................. 22-80 CONTROL STAND .............................................................................. 22-80
P5 FLIGHT CONTROL MODULE ..................................................... 22-81 P5 FLIGHT CONTROL MODULE ..................................................... 22-81
MODE CONTROL PANEL ................................................................. 22-82 MODE CONTROL PANEL ................................................................. 22-82
THRUST MODE ANNUNCIATOR ..................................................... 22-88 THRUST MODE ANNUNCIATOR ..................................................... 22-88

COMPONENT LOCATIONS COMPONENT LOCATIONS


DFCS Control Component Locations ................................................... 22-89 DFCS Control Component Locations .................................................. 22-89
Yaw Damper Components .................................................................... 22-90 Yaw Damper Components .................................................................... 22-90
DFCS Components ............................................................................... 22-91 DFCS Components ............................................................................... 22-91
DFCS Components ............................................................................... 22-92 DFCS Components ............................................................................... 22-92
Pitch & Roll Force Transducers and Aileron Force Limiter ................. 22-93 Pitch & Roll Force Transducers and Aileron Force Limiter ................ 22-93
A&B Aileron A/P Actuators & Spoiler / Aileron Position Sensors ..... 22-94 A&B Aileron A/P Actuators & Spoiler / Aileron Position Sensors ..... 22-94
Pitch Control A/P Actuators & Sensors ............................................... 22-95 Pitch Control A/P Actuators & Sensors .............................................. 22-95
Flap Control Unit & Limit Switches .................................................. 22-96 Flap Control Unit & Limit Switches .................................................. 22-96
Elevator Aft Quadrant Components ..................................................... 22-97 Elevator Aft Quadrant Components ..................................................... 22-97
Stab Trim Motors & Limit / Warning Switches..................................... 22-98 Stab Trim Motors & Limit / Warning Switches .................................... 22-98
Autothrottle Components-Flight Deck ................................................. 22-99 Autothrottle Components-Flight Deck ................................................. 22-99
Autothrottle Components - E&E Compartment & Flight Deck ........... 22-100 Autothrottle Components - E&E Compartment & Flight Deck ........... 22-100
Autothrottle Components- PLA Synchro, AOA Sensor ....................... 22-101 Autothrottle Components- PLA Synchro, AOA Sensor ....................... 22-101

22-iv and Systems Introduction OCT 99 22-iv OCT 99


UNITED AIRLINES COURSE
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
AUTOFLIGHT AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE AUTOFLIGHT AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

B737-322/522 B737-322/522
AUTOFLIGHT AUTOFLIGHT

and
OCT 99Systems Introduction 22-1 OCT 99 22-1
UNITED
B737 GENERAL AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
AUTOFLIGHT AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE AUTOFLIGHT AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

FLIGHT MANAGEMENT SYSTEM The FMS is designed to decrease work- FLIGHT MANAGEMENT SYSTEM The FMS is designed to decrease work-
INTRODUCTION load and increase fuel efficiency and INTRODUCTION load and increase fuel efficiency and
The Flight Management System (FMS) is safety. This can mean simply using the The Flight Management System (FMS) is safety. This can mean simply using the
a combined flight control, guidance, navi- Control Display Units (CDU) to provide a combined flight control, guidance, navi- Control Display Units (CDU) to provide
gation, and Built In Test Equipment reference information during manual gation, and Built In Test Equipment reference information during manual
(BITE) system. It provides integrated flight, using the AP Flight Director Sys- (BITE) system. It provides integrated flight, using the AP Flight Director Sys-
operation and control of five independent tem (AFDS), or selecting full FMS opera- operation and control of five independent tem (AFDS), or selecting full FMS opera-
subsystems to provide automatic vertical tion for completely automatic flight. On subsystems to provide automatic vertical tion for completely automatic flight. On
navigation (VNAV) and lateral navigation the 737-300/500, the AFDS is known as navigation (VNAV) and lateral navigation the 737-300/500, the AFDS is known as
(LNAV) for optimum flight profiles and the Digital Flight Control System (DFCS). (LNAV) for optimum flight profiles and the Digital Flight Control System (DFCS).
performance management. System inte- The crew may select any degree of auto- performance management. System inte- The crew may select any degree of auto-
gration for data exchange, control, and mation desired. This automation versatil- gration for data exchange, control, and mation desired. This automation versatil-
testing using BITE is provided by ARINC ity of operating modes provides the crew testing using BITE is provided by ARINC ity of operating modes provides the crew
429 digital data busses. There is no single with the tools to obtain optimum perfor- 429 digital data busses. There is no single with the tools to obtain optimum perfor-
component or control panel that can be mance in most regimes of flight. Even component or control panel that can be mance in most regimes of flight. Even
labeled as the Flight Management System. with full FMS operation, management and labeled as the Flight Management System. with full FMS operation, management and
The FMS is comprised of, and formed by, operation is always under the total control The FMS is comprised of, and formed by, operation is always under the total control
the integration of five independent sub- of the flight crew. Certain functions can the integration of five independent sub- of the flight crew. Certain functions can
systems mentioned below. Included are only be implemented by the crew. These systems mentioned below. Included are only be implemented by the crew. These
the Maintenance Manual chapters to be are: brake release, thrust initiation, air- the Maintenance Manual chapters to be are: brake release, thrust initiation, air-
consulted for more detail: plane steering and rotation during takeoff consulted for more detail: plane steering and rotation during takeoff
* Flight Management Computer System roll, speed brake, flap, and landing gear * Flight Management Computer System roll, speed brake, flap, and landing gear
(FMCS) see Ch. 34 operation, altitude selection, ILS tuning, (FMCS) see Ch. 34 operation, altitude selection, ILS tuning,
* Digital Flight Control System (DFCS) thrust reversal, and landing rollout steer- * Digital Flight Control System (DFCS) thrust reversal, and landing rollout steer-
see Ch 22 ing. see Ch 22 ing.
* Autothrottle (AT) see Ch 22 * Autothrottle (AT) see Ch 22
* Inertial Reference System (IRS) * Inertial Reference System (IRS)
see Ch 34 see Ch 34
* Electronic Flight Instrument System * Electronic Flight Instrument System
(EFIS) see Ch 34 (EFIS) see Ch 34

22-2 and Systems Introduction OCT 99 22-2 OCT 99


UNITED AIRLINES COURSE
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
AUTOFLIGHT AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE AUTOFLIGHT AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

FMS FMS
Flight Flight
Management Management
System System

AFCS AFCS
Automatic Automatic
Flight Flight
Control Control
System System

FMCS IRS EFIS YD DFCS AT FMCS IRS EFIS YD DFCS AT


Flight Inertial Electronic Yaw Digital Auto Flight Inertial Electronic Yaw Digital Auto
Management Reference Flight Damper Flight Throttle Management Reference Flight Damper Flight Throttle
Computer System Instrument System Control System Computer System Instrument System Control System
System System System System System System

FMC IRU EFIS SG FCC FMC IRU EFIS SG FCC


Flight Inertial Symbol Yaw Flight Auto Flight Inertial Symbol Yaw Flight Auto
Management Reference Generator Damper Control Throttle Management Reference Generator Damper Control Throttle
Computer Unit Coupler Computer Computer Computer Unit Coupler Computer Computer

CDU ISDU EFIS CP MCP CDU ISDU EFIS CP MCP


Control Inertial Control Mode Control Inertial Control Mode
Display System Panel Control Display System Panel Control
Unit Display Panel Unit Display Panel
Unit Unit

AFDS AFDS
Autopilot Autopilot
Flight Flight
Director Director
System System

AP FD AP FD
Autopilot Flight Mach Speed Altitude Autopilot Flight Mach Speed Altitude
Director Trim Trim Alert Director Trim Trim Alert

Block Diagram of Flight Management System Block Diagram of Flight Management System

and
OCT 99Systems Introduction 22-3 OCT 99 22-3
UNITED
B737 GENERAL AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
AUTOFLIGHT AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE AUTOFLIGHT AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

FMS Built-In Test Equipment (BITE) blocks in the E&E compartment. These FMS Built-In Test Equipment (BITE) blocks in the E&E compartment. These
Self-contained in-flight monitoring and connections are much easier to configure Self-contained in-flight monitoring and connections are much easier to configure
ground test capabilities are provided for than the -300's radio rack connectors. ground test capabilities are provided for than the -300's radio rack connectors.
the FMS subsystems: FMCS, DFCS, AT, Standard Option Pins the FMS subsystems: FMCS, DFCS, AT, Standard Option Pins
IRS and EFIS. The FMC coordinates the Pin programming options to determine air- IRS and EFIS. The FMC coordinates the Pin programming options to determine air-
BITE testing of each subsystem and must plane configurations most frequently BITE testing of each subsystem and must plane configurations most frequently
be functional for access to any sub- ordered by customers are grouped into be functional for access to any sub- ordered by customers are grouped into
systems' BITE. BITE for the five FMS Standard Option Pins (SOP's). Several systems' BITE. BITE for the five FMS Standard Option Pins (SOP's). Several
subsystems is accessed from either Con- SOP's are displayed using CDU BITE. subsystems is accessed from either Con- SOP's are displayed using CDU BITE.
trol Display Unit (CDU) in the flight deck. Check Wiring Diagram Manual for cur- trol Display Unit (CDU) in the flight deck. Check Wiring Diagram Manual for cur-
Each major FMS subsystem runs its own rent configurations. Each major FMS subsystem runs its own rent configurations.
system tests, including comprehensive system tests, including comprehensive
tests for its own computer, its sensor tests for its own computer, its sensor
inputs, and other interfaces. In Flight Fault inputs, and other interfaces. In Flight Fault
data is automatically stored for analysis on data is automatically stored for analysis on
the ground, accessed through the BITE the ground, accessed through the BITE
system. FMS system integration for data system. FMS system integration for data
exchange, control, and testing using BITE exchange, control, and testing using BITE
is provided by ARINC 429 digital data is provided by ARINC 429 digital data
busses. busses.
FMS Subsystems BITE Locations FMS Subsystems BITE Locations
These FMS subsystems have BITE run by These FMS subsystems have BITE run by
and In Flight Faults stored in that systems' and In Flight Faults stored in that systems'
major box, as follows: major box, as follows:
SYSTEM: BOX: SYSTEM: BOX:
FMCS FMC FMCS FMC
DFCS FCC DFCS FCC
AT AT Computer AT AT Computer
IRS DAA IRS DAA
EFIS Symbol Generator EFIS Symbol Generator
Pin Programming Pin Programming
Pin programming is a changeable orienta- Pin programming is a changeable orienta-
tion of hard wiring in the E & E compart- tion of hard wiring in the E & E compart-
ment radio rack connectors. Pin ment radio rack connectors. Pin
programming defines the system's opera- programming defines the system's opera-
tional configuration. Configuration is tional configuration. Configuration is
established by Standard Option Pins and established by Standard Option Pins and
other wiring changes called out by Change other wiring changes called out by Change
Order Authorizations (COA's). Be sure to Order Authorizations (COA's). Be sure to
stay aware of aircraft effectivity when stay aware of aircraft effectivity when
considering the status of the ships wiring. considering the status of the ships wiring.
NOTE: -500's have some pin program- NOTE: -500's have some pin program-
ming done with high density Burndy ming done with high density Burndy

22-4 and Systems Introduction OCT 99 22-4 OCT 99


UNITED AIRLINES COURSE
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
AUTOFLIGHT AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE AUTOFLIGHT AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

Engineering Codes Engineering Codes


The following codes may be entered on the CDU followed by pressing Line Select Key The following codes may be entered on the CDU followed by pressing Line Select Key
(LSK) 6R, following BITE failure, for each of the FMS subsytems shown. (LSK) 6R, following BITE failure in the system shown.

CODE SYSTEM PURPOSE CODE SYSTEM PURPOSE

100 FMCS Access to current status diagnostic 100 FMCS Access to current status diagnostic
DFCS failures DFCS failures
AT AT
300 FMCS Access to inflight faults engineering 300 FMCS Access to inflight faults engineering
DFCS data DFCS data
AT AT
200 DFCS Access to memory locations used for 200 DFCS Access to memory locations used for
discrete input words storage discrete input words storage
27E DFCS Access to non-volatile memory used 27E DFCS Access to non-volatile memory used
for In Flight Faults storage of LRU for In Flight Faults storage of LRU
UNKNOWN or WRAP messages UNKNOWN or WRAP messages
900 DFCS Delete recorded inflight faults 900 DFCS Delete recorded inflight faults
CLR/ALL AT Delete recorded inflight faults CLR/ALL AT Delete recorded inflight faults

Table 1: Engineering Codes


Table 1: Engineering Codes

and
OCT 99Systems Introduction 22-5 OCT 99 22-5
UNITED
B737 GENERAL AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
AUTOFLIGHT AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE AUTOFLIGHT AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

AUTOMATIC FLIGHT CONTROL These systems provide automatic air- AUTOMATIC FLIGHT CONTROL These systems provide automatic air-
SYSTEM plane stabilization about the pitch, roll, SYSTEM plane stabilization about the pitch, roll,
INTRODUCTION and yaw axis. The DFCS and AT sys- INTRODUCTION and yaw axis. The DFCS and AT sys-
The Automatic Flight Control System tems control the airplane with selected The Automatic Flight Control System tems control the airplane with selected
(AFCS), also known as Auto Flight Sys- Mode Control Panel guidance from N1, (AFCS), also known as Auto Flight Sys- Mode Control Panel guidance from N1,
tem (AFS), consists of three independent radio, heading, Flight Management tem (AFS), consists of three independent radio, heading, Flight Management
systems: Computer, Inertial Reference System, systems: Computer, Inertial Reference System,
* A single Yaw Damper system (YD) and Air Data Computer inputs. These * A single Yaw Damper system (YD) and Air Data Computer inputs. These
* A dual Digital Flight Control System three subsystems are in ATA chapter 22 * A dual Digital Flight Control System three subsystems are in ATA chapter 22
(DFCS) and comprise the content of this chapter. (DFCS) and comprise the content of this chapter.
* A single Autothrottle system (AT) * A single Autothrottle system (AT)

LOW WEATHER MINIMUMS / AFCS CAPABILITIES CHARTS


LOW WEATHER MINIMUMS / AFCS CAPABILITIES CHARTS

Decision
Decision Category Alert Height Minimum RVR
Category Alert Height Minimum RVR Height
Height
I 200 ft. 0 ft. 2600 ft.
I 200 ft. 0 ft. 2600 ft.
II Restricted 150 ft 0 ft 1600 ft.
II Restricted 150 ft 0 ft 1600 ft.
II 100 ft 0 ft 1200 ft.
II 100 ft 0 ft 1200 ft.
II Autoland 100 ft 0 ft 1200 ft.
II Autoland 100 ft 0 ft 1200 ft.
IIIa 50 ft 100 ft 700 ft.
IIIa 50 ft 100 ft 700 ft.
IIIb 0 ft 100 ft 300 ft.
IIIb 0 ft 100 ft 300 ft.

Table 2: LOW WEATHER MINIMUMS - All Fleets


Table 2: LOW WEATHER MINIMUMS - All Fleets

22-6 and Systems Introduction OCT 99 22-6 OCT 99


UNITED AIRLINES COURSE
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
AUTOFLIGHT AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE AUTOFLIGHT AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

Turn Turn
Coordinati Coordinati
on, Nose on, Nose
whell whell
Weather # of Axis Steering Weather # of Axis Steering
Type of Type of
category # of A/P controlled for Rollout Decision category # of A/P controlled for Rollout Decision
Approach Fail Mode Approach Fail Mode
shown on Channels by each Mode, height shown on Channels by each Mode, height
/ Landing / Landing
placard channel Pre- placard channel Pre-
touchdow touchdow
n Crab n Crab
Angle Angle
Correction Correction

CAT IIIa 2 2 Axis AP, Coupled None 50 ft. Fail Pas- CAT IIIa 2 2 Axis AP, Coupled None 50 ft. Fail Pas-
Pitch & Approach / sive Pitch & Approach / sive
Roll Autoland Roll Autoland
with Auto- with Auto-
throttle throttle

Table
B737
3: B737
- 322/522
- 322/522
AFCSAFCS
CAPABILITIES
CAPABILITIES Table 3: B737 - 322/522 AFCS CAPABILITIES

CAT IIIb 3 3 Axis AP, Coupled All of the None. Fail Opera- CAT IIIb 3 3 Axis AP, Coupled All of the None. Fail Opera-
Pitch Roll Approach / above tional Pitch Roll Approach / above tional
& Yaw Autoland & Yaw Autoland
with Auto- with Auto-
throttle throttle

Table
OTHER
4: OTHER
GLASS
GLASS
COCKPIT
COCKPIT
AIRCRAFT
AIRCRAFT
AFCS
AFCS
CAPABILITIES
CAPABILITIES Table 4: OTHER GLASS COCKPIT AIRCRAFT AFCS CAPABILITIES

and
OCT 99Systems Introduction 22-7 OCT 99 22-7
UNITED
B737 GENERAL AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
AUTOFLIGHT AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE AUTOFLIGHT AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

CAT II/CAT III EQUIPMENT profile, including takeoff and landing. It is CAT II/CAT III EQUIPMENT profile, including takeoff and landing. It is
REQUIREMENTS series connected, being connected to the REQUIREMENTS series connected, being connected to the
CAT II Equipment Requirements actuator so that no rudder feedback is CAT II Equipment Requirements actuator so that no rudder feedback is
Per the Minimum Equipment List (MEL), applied to the pedals. This allows the Yaw Per the Minimum Equipment List (MEL), applied to the pedals. This allows the Yaw
in order for the airplane to operate to Damper system to operate independently in order for the airplane to operate to Damper system to operate independently
CATEGORY II weather minimums, the without interfering with crew initiated CATEGORY II weather minimums, the without interfering with crew initiated
following equipment must be operational: rudder commands. The yaw direction and following equipment must be operational: rudder commands. The yaw direction and
* One AP in CMD rate are detected with a rate sensor in a * One AP in CMD rate are detected with a rate sensor in a
* Both Flight Directors Yaw Damper coupler. The rudder is dis- * Both Flight Directors Yaw Damper coupler. The rudder is dis-
* Both EFIS Systems, displaying: placed at the proper time to dampen out * Both EFIS Systems, displaying: placed at the proper time to dampen out
- Attitude any Dutch roll before it can significantly - Attitude any Dutch roll before it can significantly
- Glideslope & LOC Deviation affect the flight path of the airplane. The - Glideslope & LOC Deviation affect the flight path of the airplane. The
- Radio Altitude Yaw Damper authority is plus and minus 3 - Radio Altitude Yaw Damper authority is plus and minus 3
- Decision Height degrees rudder deflection. The yaw axis - Decision Height degrees rudder deflection. The yaw axis
- AP Status Engaged Pitch & Roll has no runway tracking. The Yaw Damper - AP Status Engaged Pitch & Roll has no runway tracking. The Yaw Damper
modes actuator gets no turning commands from modes actuator gets no turning commands from
- Both ILS systems the roll axis autopilot (AP). This aircraft - Both ILS systems the roll axis autopilot (AP). This aircraft
- Both Radio Altimeter systems does not have a three axis AP, only pitch - Both Radio Altimeter systems does not have a three axis AP, only pitch
- Both Inertial Reference systems and roll axis control. There is no turn - Both Inertial Reference systems and roll axis control. There is no turn
- Marker Beacon coordination on this aircraft. A roll com- - Marker Beacon coordination on this aircraft. A roll com-
* Two Generators mand causing aircraft banking sends a * Two Generators mand causing aircraft banking sends a
* Both Air Data Systems crossfeed signal, in proportion to bank * Both Air Data Systems crossfeed signal, in proportion to bank
* Both Windshield Wipers angle, to the Yaw Damper to prevent * Both Windshield Wipers angle, to the Yaw Damper to prevent
CAT IIIa Equipment Requirements undesirable opposition to roll attitude. CAT IIIa Equipment Requirements undesirable opposition to roll attitude.
In order for the airplane to operate to System Components In order for the airplane to operate to System Components
CATEGORY IIIa weather minimums, all The Yaw Damper System consists of Yaw CATEGORY IIIa weather minimums, all The Yaw Damper System consists of Yaw
of the equipment listed above for CAT II Damper engage switch, Warning annunci- of the equipment listed above for CAT II Damper engage switch, Warning annunci-
must be operational, plus: ator, Yaw Damper coupler, AFC acces- must be operational, plus: ator, Yaw Damper coupler, AFC acces-
* Both Autopilots sory unit, Yaw Damper engage solenoid, * Both Autopilots sory unit, Yaw Damper engage solenoid,
* The Autothrottle transfer valve and position transducer on * The Autothrottle transfer valve and position transducer on
* Both Hydraulic Systems the rudder Power Control Unit, and a Yaw * Both Hydraulic Systems the rudder Power Control Unit, and a Yaw
Damper position indicator. Damper position indicator.
YAW DAMPER SYSTEM CAUTION: The Yaw Damper Coupler YAW DAMPER SYSTEM CAUTION: The Yaw Damper Coupler
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION is an Electrostatic Discharge Sensitive DESCRIPTION & OPERATION is an Electrostatic Discharge Sensitive
Introduction unit (ESDS). Observe proper precau- Introduction unit (ESDS). Observe proper precau-
The purpose of the Yaw Damper System tions. Do not remove Yaw Damper Cou- The purpose of the Yaw Damper System tions. Do not remove Yaw Damper Cou-
is to reduce airplane periodic oscillations pler for at least 3 minutes after is to reduce airplane periodic oscillations pler for at least 3 minutes after
of the yaw axis that are associated with removing power to allow the rate gyro of the yaw axis that are associated with removing power to allow the rate gyro
Dutch roll. The rudder deflects as required to spin down without damage. Dutch roll. The rudder deflects as required to spin down without damage.
in proportion to, and opposite direction of, in proportion to, and opposite direction of,
the yaw rate. It is a full-time stability aug- the yaw rate. It is a full-time stability aug-
mentation system, providing yaw axis mentation system, providing yaw axis
damping available for the complete flight damping available for the complete flight

22-8 and Systems Introduction OCT 99 22-8 OCT 99


UNITED AIRLINES COURSE
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
AUTOFLIGHT AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE AUTOFLIGHT AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

TEST TEST

PASS FAIL PASS FAIL

GO LAMP TEST GO LAMP TEST

BITE BITE
OFF ARM OFF ARM

RUDDER RUDDER
SPERRY
PCU SPERRY
PCU
YAW DAMPER COUPLER YAW DAMPER COUPLER
YAW DAMPER YAW DAMPER
TEST POINTS TEST POINTS

YAW DAMPER YAW DAMPER


INDICATOR INDICATOR
YAW YAW
DAMPER DAMPER
COUPLER COUPLER
1 1
A/P A/T FMC A/P A/T FMC
2 2
P/RST P/RST P/RST P/RST P/RST P/RST
BITE TEST BITE TEST

AUTOFLIGHT AUTOFLIGHT
STATUS STATUS
YAW DAMPER ANNUNCIATORS YAW DAMPER ANNUNCIATORS
LIGHT LIGHT
YAW YAW
DAMPER DAMPER
ON ENGAGE ON ENGAGE

OFF OFF
INTEGRATED INTEGRATED
FLIGHT SYSTEM FLIGHT SYSTEM
ON ACCESSORY UNIT ON ACCESSORY UNIT
OR AFC ACCESSORY UNIT OR AFC ACCESSORY UNIT
P5 FLIGHT CONTROL MODULE P5 FLIGHT CONTROL MODULE
Yaw Damper System Pictorial Diagram Yaw Damper System Pictorial Diagram

and
OCT 99Systems Introduction 22-9 OCT 99 22-9
UNITED
B737 GENERAL AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
AUTOFLIGHT AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE AUTOFLIGHT AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

OPERATING MODES then applied to the transfer valve, located OPERATING MODES then applied to the transfer valve, located
Operation is confined to synchronization inside the Yaw Damper actuator. The Operation is confined to synchronization inside the Yaw Damper actuator. The
mode, engaged mode interlocks and logic, transfer valve ports hydraulic pressure to mode, engaged mode interlocks and logic, transfer valve ports hydraulic pressure to
and engaged mode operation. Prior to yaw deflect the rudder and reduce the yaw and engaged mode operation. Prior to yaw deflect the rudder and reduce the yaw
axis engagement, the Yaw Damper cou- oscillation. The Yaw Damper actuator axis engagement, the Yaw Damper cou- oscillation. The Yaw Damper actuator
pler is in the synchronization mode for 2 output is summed with rudder pedal man- pler is in the synchronization mode for 2 output is summed with rudder pedal man-
seconds. The purpose of synchronization ual input to move the main rudder PCU seconds. The purpose of synchronization ual input to move the main rudder PCU
is to provide a null output to the electro- actuator which controls the rudder. As the is to provide a null output to the electro- actuator which controls the rudder. As the
hydraulic transfer valve to prevent Yaw Yaw Damper actuator moves, the LVDT hydraulic transfer valve to prevent Yaw Yaw Damper actuator moves, the LVDT
Damper coupler engage transients. Syn- supplies the position feedback signal to Damper coupler engage transients. Syn- supplies the position feedback signal to
chronization is accomplished by routing cancel the signal from the yaw rate gyro. chronization is accomplished by routing cancel the signal from the yaw rate gyro.
the controlled signal back to the output When the yaw oscillation stops, the feed- the controlled signal back to the output When the yaw oscillation stops, the feed-
amplifier. The valve amplifier output is back signal returns the rudder to the origi- amplifier. The valve amplifier output is back signal returns the rudder to the origi-
reduced to a null as the integrator output nal position. The feedback signal is also reduced to a null as the integrator output nal position. The feedback signal is also
increases and cancels the signal. Prior to applied to the Yaw Damper position indi- increases and cancels the signal. Prior to applied to the Yaw Damper position indi-
Yaw Damper engagement, the Yaw cator, located on the P2 panel. However, Yaw Damper engagement, the Yaw cator, located on the P2 panel. However,
Damper actuator remains centered which during normal operation, the signals are of Damper actuator remains centered which during normal operation, the signals are of
nulls the position feedback to the Yaw insufficient value to be monitored by the nulls the position feedback to the Yaw insufficient value to be monitored by the
Damper coupler. The Yaw Damper Sys- position indicator. The Yaw Damper posi- Damper coupler. The Yaw Damper Sys- position indicator. The Yaw Damper posi-
tem is engaged by placing the Yaw tion indicator shows LVDT position, not tem is engaged by placing the Yaw tion indicator shows LVDT position, not
Damper switch on the flight control mod- rudder position. Damper switch on the flight control mod- rudder position.
ule to ON. The "B" flight control switch NOTE: -500's use flap position from ule to ON. The "B" flight control switch NOTE: -500's use flap position from
must be ON, and "B" system hydraulic switch S245 on the flap control unit in must be ON, and "B" system hydraulic switch S245 on the flap control unit in
power must be available, to power the the right wheel well to set part of its YD power must be available, to power the the right wheel well to set part of its YD
Yaw Damper actuator portion of the rud- gain. Flaps must be not up in order for Yaw Damper actuator portion of the rud- gain. Flaps must be not up in order for
der PCU (Ref Chapter 27). Two seconds the YD BITE to pass all tests. der PCU (Ref Chapter 27). Two seconds the YD BITE to pass all tests.
after the Yaw Damper is ON, the YAW System Testing after the Yaw Damper is ON, the YAW System Testing
DAMPER Light extinguishes. The Auto- System testing includes Yaw Damper DAMPER Light extinguishes. The Auto- System testing includes Yaw Damper
matic Flight Control accessory unit (AFC indicator lights, Yaw Damper interlock, matic Flight Control accessory unit (AFC indicator lights, Yaw Damper interlock,
accessory unit on -300's, or Integrated flight control switches interlock, Yaw accessory unit on -300's, or Integrated flight control switches interlock, Yaw
Flight Systems Accessory Unit (IFSAU Damper continuity, self-test switches and Flight Systems Accessory Unit (IFSAU Damper continuity, self-test switches and
on -500's); contain the logic to engage the warning lights, and Yaw Damper self-test on -500's); contain the logic to engage the warning lights, and Yaw Damper self-test
Yaw Damper system, monitor engage- (BITE). The Yaw Damper system compo- Yaw Damper system, monitor engage- (BITE). The Yaw Damper system compo-
ment, and illuminate the amber Yaw nents can be tested at the Yaw Damper ment, and illuminate the amber Yaw nents can be tested at the Yaw Damper
Damper disengaged annunciator light. If coupler. AP P/RST (AP Disengage) Light Damper disengaged annunciator light. If coupler. AP P/RST (AP Disengage) Light
ac power is lost for over 2 seconds, the will be steady red (no horn) if the Yaw ac power is lost for over 2 seconds, the will be steady red (no horn) if the Yaw
YAW DAMPER Light illuminates and the Damper system is under TEST, or if the YAW DAMPER Light illuminates and the Damper system is under TEST, or if the
Yaw Damper switch returns to OFF. The Yaw Damper coupler switch is left in the Yaw Damper switch returns to OFF. The Yaw Damper coupler switch is left in the
Yaw rate gyro, located inside the Yaw BITE ARM position. Yaw rate gyro, located inside the Yaw BITE ARM position.
Damper Coupler, senses oscillations in the Yaw Damper BITE Operation Damper Coupler, senses oscillations in the Yaw Damper BITE Operation
yaw axis. The coupler responds only to The BITE system simultaneously checks yaw axis. The coupler responds only to The BITE system simultaneously checks
those yaw rates that produce Dutch roll. the overall operation of each electronic those yaw rates that produce Dutch roll. the overall operation of each electronic
Command signals are filtered, amplified, unit and its interface with other systems' Command signals are filtered, amplified, unit and its interface with other systems'

22-10 and Systems Introduction OCT 99 22-10 OCT 99


UNITED AIRLINES COURSE
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
AUTOFLIGHT AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE AUTOFLIGHT AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

components. BITE is performed at the Manually initiated automatic go/no-go components. BITE is performed at the Manually initiated automatic go/no-go
Yaw Damper coupler in the E & E com- testing checks dynamic circuits for gain Yaw Damper coupler in the E & E com- testing checks dynamic circuits for gain
partment. Each series of tests can be com- and frequency and mode sensors for partment. Each series of tests can be com- and frequency and mode sensors for
pleted in spite of individual test failures. proper threshold levels. Each test is initi- pleted in spite of individual test failures. proper threshold levels. Each test is initi-
The BITE portion utilizes both analog and ated with a single push button switch and The BITE portion utilizes both analog and ated with a single push button switch and
digital circuitry to test a high percentage evaluated by one of two colored PASS or digital circuitry to test a high percentage evaluated by one of two colored PASS or
of the computation and logic circuits. FAIL indicators. These indicators provide of the computation and logic circuits. FAIL indicators. These indicators provide
the status of each test without requiring the status of each test without requiring
any meter movement interpretation. any meter movement interpretation.

STBY
RUDDER
STBY OR
RUDDER OFF OFF
OR YD
OFF OFF 28V DC
YD ELEX
28V DC PWR 1
ELEX YAW 'B' FLIGHT
PWR 1 DAMPER CONTROL
YAW 'B' FLIGHT YD ON ON SWITCH
DAMPER CONTROL 115V AC
YD ON ON SWITCH ELEX
115V AC PWR 1
ELEX AFC ACCESSORY
PWR 1 AFC ACCESSORY YAW OFF UNIT (OR INTEGRATED
OFF UNIT (OR INTEGRATED DAMPER FLIGHT SYSTEM
YAW
DAMPER FLIGHT SYSTEM ACCESSORY UNIT)
ACCESSORY UNIT) YAW DAMPER
YAW DAMPER WARNING
WARNING ANNUNCIATOR
ANNUNCIATOR POWER
RELAY
POWER POWER MONITOR CONTROL
RELAY
POWER MONITOR POWER AC ON / OFF LOGIC
CONTROL
SUPPLY DC B
POWER AC ON / OFF LOGIC
SUPPLY SYSTEM
DC B
HYDRAULIC
SYSTEM LRRA-1
PRESSURE
HYDRAULIC
LRRA-1 RATE
PRESSURE
<900 FT=0 GYRO
RATE FCC-A
<900 FT=0 GYRO ENGAGE
FCC-A FCC-B SOLENOID
ENGAGE
FCC-B SOLENOID
WASHOUT TRANSFER
ROLL ATT VALVE
WASHOUT TRANSFER
YAW DAMPER
ROLL ATT VALVE
YAW DAMPER L DAA YAW DAMPER
L DAA YAW ACTUATOR
YAW DAMPER
YAW ACTUATOR DAMPER
DAMPER INDICATOR POSITION
INDICATOR POSITION
XDUCER
XDUCER YAW DAMPER COUPLER RUDDER
YAW DAMPER COUPLER RUDDER PEDALS
PEDALS MAIN
ACTUATOR
MAIN
ACTUATOR
RUDDER PCU
RUDDER PCU RUDDER
RUDDER

Yaw Damper System Block Diagram


Yaw Damper System Block Diagram

and
OCT 99Systems Introduction 22-11 OCT 99 22-11
UNITED
B737 GENERAL AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
AUTOFLIGHT AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE AUTOFLIGHT AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

DIGITAL FLIGHT CONTROL SYS- hand fly the airplane, following these FD DIGITAL FLIGHT CONTROL SYS- hand fly the airplane, following these FD
TEM commands, with the AP and AP actuators TEM commands, with the AP and AP actuators
Introduction selected to OFF, or with the AP and AP Introduction selected to OFF, or with the AP and AP
The model SP300 DFCS system is part of actuators selected to Control Wheel Steer- The model SP300 DFCS system is part of actuators selected to Control Wheel Steer-
the Flight Management System (FMS). ing (CWS). AP and FD share roll and the Flight Management System (FMS). ing (CWS). AP and FD share roll and
The DFCS consists of five subsystems, pitch sensors, MCP, BITE, and compute The DFCS consists of five subsystems, pitch sensors, MCP, BITE, and compute
and integrates and coordinates their opera- similar commands. These two DFCS sub- and integrates and coordinates their opera- similar commands. These two DFCS sub-
tion. Each subsystem has dual channels, A systems are referred to as the Autopilot tion. Each subsystem has dual channels, A systems are referred to as the Autopilot
and B. The five subsystems are: Flight Director System (AFDS). Mach and B. The five subsystems are: Flight Director System (AFDS). Mach
* Autopilot (AP) trim system provides automatic nose up * Autopilot (AP) trim system provides automatic nose up
* Flight director (FD) elevator trim commands, to maintain the * Flight director (FD) elevator trim commands, to maintain the
* Mach trim correct attitude, when high cruise speeds * Mach trim correct attitude, when high cruise speeds
* Speed trim cause airplane Mach tuck (nose down). * Speed trim cause airplane Mach tuck (nose down).
* Altitude alert The Speed Trim system ensures that the * Altitude alert The Speed Trim system ensures that the
System A of all DFCS subsystems is aircraft maintains positive speed stability System A of all DFCS subsystems is aircraft maintains positive speed stability
inside FCC A. System B of all DFCS sub- during low speed, high thrust flight condi- inside FCC A. System B of all DFCS sub- during low speed, high thrust flight condi-
systems is inside FCC B. Two indepen- tions with the AP OFF. This is during systems is inside FCC B. Two indepen- tions with the AP OFF. This is during
dent Flight Control Computers (FCC's) Take Off, Go Around, and occasionally dent Flight Control Computers (FCC's) Take Off, Go Around, and occasionally
and a single Mode Control Panel (MCP), Approach, if a higher than normal engine and a single Mode Control Panel (MCP), Approach, if a higher than normal engine
receive crew requests and airplane sensor speed is used. The FCC's drive the AP sta- receive crew requests and airplane sensor speed is used. The FCC's drive the AP sta-
inputs. The DFCS system uses these to bilizer trim actuator to maintain the cor- inputs. The DFCS system uses these to bilizer trim actuator to maintain the cor-
generate FD displays, mode annuncia- rect airspeed, based on the flap speed generate FD displays, mode annuncia- rect airspeed, based on the flap speed
tions, various warnings, AP flight control schedule. The Altitude Alert function pro- tions, various warnings, AP flight control schedule. The Altitude Alert function pro-
surface commands, AP stabilizer trim, vides visual and aural warning to the crew surface commands, AP stabilizer trim, vides visual and aural warning to the crew
Mach trim, and Speed trim operation. The when the airplane baro corrected altitude Mach trim, and Speed trim operation. The when the airplane baro corrected altitude
MCP provides a centralized location for from the DADC is approaching or deviat- MCP provides a centralized location for from the DADC is approaching or deviat-
AP and FD control selections. Each AP ing from the selected altitude on the MCP. AP and FD control selections. Each AP ing from the selected altitude on the MCP.
channel has its own AP aileron and eleva- System Components channel has its own AP aileron and eleva- System Components
tor actuators. Each FCC commands its AP The DFCS components are Flight Control tor actuators. Each FCC commands its AP The DFCS components are Flight Control
pitch and roll actuators when the MCP is Computers (FCC), Mode Control Panel pitch and roll actuators when the MCP is Computers (FCC), Mode Control Panel
selected to Command (CMD) or Control (MCP), Automatic Flight Control (AFC) selected to Command (CMD) or Control (MCP), Automatic Flight Control (AFC)
Wheel Steering (CWS). The computer Accessory Unit, and Control Wheel Steer- Wheel Steering (CWS). The computer Accessory Unit, and Control Wheel Steer-
sends control signals to a transfer valve on ing (CWS) Force Transducers, an Aileron sends control signals to a transfer valve on ing (CWS) Force Transducers, an Aileron
each of its actuators. The AP actuators Force Limiter, and Autopilot Actuators. It each of its actuators. The AP actuators Force Limiter, and Autopilot Actuators. It
then drive the flight controls through both also contains A/P Surface Position Sen- then drive the flight controls through both also contains A/P Surface Position Sen-
the A and B flight control PCU's. For FD sors, Auto Stabilizer Trim Servo, and the A and B flight control PCU's. For FD sors, Auto Stabilizer Trim Servo, and
operation, each system is turned on by its Mach Trim Actuator (MTA). Other parts operation, each system is turned on by its Mach Trim Actuator (MTA). Other parts
two position, ON-OFF, FD switch, on the include Autopilot Disengage Switches and two position, ON-OFF, FD switch, on the include Autopilot Disengage Switches and
MCP. Each FCC then positions the FD Bar, Auto Stab Trim Cutout Switch, and MCP. Each FCC then positions the FD Bar, Auto Stab Trim Cutout Switch, and
command bars on the respective ADI. The Annunciators for STAB OUT OF TRIM, command bars on the respective ADI. The Annunciators for STAB OUT OF TRIM,
airplane is manually guided according to ALTITUDE ALERT, SPEED TRIM fail, airplane is manually guided according to ALTITUDE ALERT, SPEED TRIM fail,
FCC computations that satisfy the MCP MACH TRIM fail, and Autopilot discon- FCC computations that satisfy the MCP MACH TRIM fail, and Autopilot discon-
selected mode of operation. The crew may nect. Many other systems interface with selected mode of operation. The crew may nect. Many other systems interface with

22-12 and Systems Introduction OCT 99 22-12 OCT 99


B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE

DESCRIPTION & OPERATION


OCT 99

AUTOFLIGHT
COURSE A/T IAS/MACH V NAV HEADING L NAV ALTITUDE VERT SPEED A/P ENGAGE COURSE
ARM + A B
CMD
MA 30 10 DN MA
VOR LOC CWS F/D
OFF SEL ON
ON C/O
10 30
N1 SPEED LVL CHG HDG SEL APP ALT HOLD V/S DISENGAGE
OFF OFF
UP

EFIS
Digital Flight Control System Pictorial Block Diagram

CAPT EADI
SYMBOL
EFIS F/O EADI
GENERATOR
SYMBOL
GENERATOR
FCC B TO CAPT
L EHSI
AIRPLANE SYSTEM TO EFIS TO F/O
SYMBOL R
INPUTS EHSI
GEN
PED (EIS) A/T COMPUTER

UNITED AIRLINES
1
IRS 1 MODE,STATUS,F/D COMMANDS FAIL/WARN STATUS A/P
P/RST
A/T FMC
P/RST P/RST
2
TEST
IRS 2
AIR DATA CMPTR AUTOFLIGHT
FMC ALTITUDE FROM FCC B STATUS
VHF NAV ALERT
ANNUNCIATOR
LRRA
REU
DME

AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE


B737-322/522
ALPHA VANE ALTITUDE
FLAP POSITION ALERT

( P1&P3 )

DFCS INPUTS
TO AIL A/P ACTUATOR
A/P DISENGAGE
FROM FCC B
SWITCHES
TO/GA SWITCHES TO AIL STAB TRIM SERVO
ELEV POS TOELEV A/P ACTUATOR
AIL POS
SPOILER POS
22-13

NSS FROM FCC B INTEGRATED FLIGHT SYSTEMS


STAB POS ACCESSORY UNIT (-522) OR AFC ACCESSORY
FCC A
and Systems Introduction
UNIT (-322)

DESCRIPTION & OPERATION


OCT 99

AUTOFLIGHT
COURSE A/T IAS/MACH V NAV HEADING L NAV ALTITUDE VERT SPEED A/P ENGAGE COURSE
ARM + A B
CMD
MA 30 10 DN MA
VOR LOC CWS F/D
OFF SEL ON
ON C/O
10 30
N1 SPEED LVL CHG HDG SEL APP ALT HOLD V/S DISENGAGE
OFF OFF
UP

EFIS
Digital Flight Control System Pictorial Block Diagram

CAPT EADI
SYMBOL
EFIS F/O EADI
GENERATOR
SYMBOL
GENERATOR
FCC B TO CAPT
L EHSI
AIRPLANE SYSTEM TO EFIS TO F/O
SYMBOL R
INPUTS EHSI
GEN
PED (EIS) A/T COMPUTER

UNITED AIRLINES
1
IRS 1 MODE,STATUS,F/D COMMANDS FAIL/WARN STATUS A/P
P/RST
A/T FMC
P/RST P/RST
2
TEST
IRS 2
AIR DATA CMPTR AUTOFLIGHT
FMC ALTITUDE FROM FCC B STATUS
VHF NAV ALERT
ANNUNCIATOR
LRRA
REU
DME
B737-322/522
AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE

ALPHA VANE ALTITUDE


FLAP POSITION ALERT

( P1&P3 )

DFCS INPUTS
TO AIL A/P ACTUATOR
A/P DISENGAGE
FROM FCC B
SWITCHES
TO/GA SWITCHES TO AIL STAB TRIM SERVO
ELEV POS TOELEV A/P ACTUATOR
AIL POS
SPOILER POS
22-13

NSS FROM FCC B INTEGRATED FLIGHT SYSTEMS


STAB POS ACCESSORY UNIT (-522) OR AFC ACCESSORY
FCC A UNIT (-322)
UNITED
B737 GENERAL AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
AUTOFLIGHT AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE AUTOFLIGHT AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

the DFCS, sending information to or MACH selection is from 110 kts. to 399 the DFCS, sending information to or MACH selection is from 110 kts. to 399
receiving commands from the DFCS. kts. or 0.60M to 0.89M, in movements of receiving commands from the DFCS. kts. or 0.60M to 0.89M, in movements of
OPERATING MODES 1 kt. to 0.01M. IAS/MACH display is lim- OPERATING MODES 1 kt. to 0.01M. IAS/MACH display is lim-
Mode Control Panel ited to the existing VMO or MMO do not Mode Control Panel ited to the existing VMO or MMO do not
The MCP provides a centralized location exceed speeds. These controls and dis- The MCP provides a centralized location exceed speeds. These controls and dis-
for AP and FD control mode selections. plays are used for DFCS and AT system for AP and FD control mode selections. plays are used for DFCS and AT system
LNAV, VNAV, heading, VOR/LOC, alti- control. The command mode selector LNAV, VNAV, heading, VOR/LOC, alti- control. The command mode selector
tude, vertical speed, airspeed/Mach, and switches are pushed to select desired com- tude, vertical speed, airspeed/Mach, and switches are pushed to select desired com-
takeoff modes are available. Roll, pitch, mand modes for the AFDS and AT. takeoff modes are available. Roll, pitch, mand modes for the AFDS and AT.
and thrust are automatically controlled in Speed, heading, altitude, vertical speed and thrust are automatically controlled in Speed, heading, altitude, vertical speed
a compatible fashion. Automatic and mode selections to both FCC's are a compatible fashion. Automatic and mode selections to both FCC's are
Approach, dual channel CAT III autoland, made from the MCP. Roll modes use Approach, dual channel CAT III autoland, made from the MCP. Roll modes use
and Go Around modes are provided for inputs such as attitude, heading, VOR or and Go Around modes are provided for inputs such as attitude, heading, VOR or
terminal area operations. Automatic con- Localizer radio deviation, or FMC latitude terminal area operations. Automatic con- Localizer radio deviation, or FMC latitude
trol of the FMCS flight plan guidance and longitude, and radio altitude. Pitch trol of the FMCS flight plan guidance and longitude, and radio altitude. Pitch
commands is initiated on this panel. The modes use inputs such as attitude, DADC commands is initiated on this panel. The modes use inputs such as attitude, DADC
DFCS normally selects the AT mode. Two or FMC altitude, FMC speed or selected DFCS normally selects the AT mode. Two or FMC altitude, FMC speed or selected
course selectors and course windows, for MCP speed, Glide Slope radio deviation, course selectors and course windows, for MCP speed, Glide Slope radio deviation,
use in the VOR/LOC or APP modes, are radio altitude. The mode switch legends use in the VOR/LOC or APP modes, are radio altitude. The mode switch legends
located on the MCP. Rotating the Cap- use mode engaged digital data to operate located on the MCP. Rotating the Cap- use mode engaged digital data to operate
tain's course selector sets the desired the respective engaged legend (ON) when tain's course selector sets the desired the respective engaged legend (ON) when
course in the display window, and pro- the mode is engaged. Pressing the mode course in the display window, and pro- the mode is engaged. Pressing the mode
vides selected course information to the switch again deselects the mode. Modes vides selected course information to the switch again deselects the mode. Modes
Captain's HSI course pointer. The First may be also be disengaged by selecting Captain's HSI course pointer. The First may be also be disengaged by selecting
Officer's course selector sets the desired another command mode, or by disconnect- Officer's course selector sets the desired another command mode, or by disconnect-
course in the display window, and pro- ing the AP and switching both FD's off. It course in the display window, and pro- ing the AP and switching both FD's off. It
vides selected course information to the is not necessary to disengage an active vides selected course information to the is not necessary to disengage an active
First Officer's HSI course pointer. The mode prior to selecting another mode. First Officer's HSI course pointer. The mode prior to selecting another mode.
ALTITUDE display and control provides Mode Annunciation ALTITUDE display and control provides Mode Annunciation
altitude data for use by AFDS, altitude Active AT, AP and FD modes are dis- altitude data for use by AFDS, altitude Active AT, AP and FD modes are dis-
alert, and FMCS systems. The display played at the bottom of both ADI's. This alert, and FMCS systems. The display played at the bottom of both ADI's. This
readout is from 0 to 50,000' and is area of the ADI is referred to as the Flight readout is from 0 to 50,000' and is area of the ADI is referred to as the Flight
adjusted by the control knob in increments Mode Annunciator (FMA). The armed adjusted by the control knob in increments Mode Annunciator (FMA). The armed
of 100'. The altitude window reads the modes always appear in white, while the of 100'. The altitude window reads the modes always appear in white, while the
altitude knob setting at initial system turn engaged modes are green. When an AT, altitude knob setting at initial system turn engaged modes are green. When an AT,
on. The MCP IAS/MACH display and FD or an AP command mode is first on. The MCP IAS/MACH display and FD or an AP command mode is first
select knob consist of the speed display engaged, a green rectangle appears around select knob consist of the speed display engaged, a green rectangle appears around
window, the rotary speed control knob and the mode annunciator for 10 seconds, as window, the rotary speed control knob and the mode annunciator for 10 seconds, as
the following pushbutton switches: C/O an attention highlight symbol. The picture the following pushbutton switches: C/O an attention highlight symbol. The picture
(changeover), N1 (engine speed), SPEED of the FMA on the ADI, is in the Controls (changeover), N1 (engine speed), SPEED of the FMA on the ADI, is in the Controls
(Selected air speed or FMC speed), LVL and Indication section of this chapter. (Selected air speed or FMC speed), LVL and Indication section of this chapter.
CHG (Level Change), and VNAV (verti- NOTE: The FMA is only on the ADI bot- CHG (Level Change), and VNAV (verti- NOTE: The FMA is only on the ADI bot-
cal navigation from the FMC). IAS/ tom on -300/500's before COA 9-2657 has cal navigation from the FMC). IAS/ tom on -300/500's before COA 9-2657 has

22-14 and Systems Introduction OCT 99 22-14 OCT 99


UNITED AIRLINES COURSE
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
AUTOFLIGHT AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE AUTOFLIGHT AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

been accomplished. This COA changes knots. Controlled by the AT or the been accomplished. This COA changes knots. Controlled by the AT or the
the ADI displays. Started in Summer of FMC, if either is compatible with the the ADI displays. Started in Summer of FMC, if either is compatible with the
1996, the FMA, Glideslope scales, Radio current FCC mode of operation, or the 1996, the FMA, Glideslope scales, Radio current FCC mode of operation, or the
Altitude, and Decision Height have been FCC. This may control AP, FD, and/or Altitude, and Decision Height have been FCC. This may control AP, FD, and/or
moved. The FMA is moved to the top of AT operation. moved. The FMA is moved to the top of AT operation.
the ADI. The Fast Slow indicator / throttle - TOGA - Take Off, Go Around - Take the ADI. The Fast Slow indicator / throttle - TOGA - Take Off, Go Around - Take
director has been removed. An Airspeed Off Mode is a FD and AT mode only, director has been removed. An Airspeed Off Mode is a FD and AT mode only,
scale has been added. The ground speed Autothrottle-only mode selections: scale has been added. The ground speed Autothrottle-only mode selections:
and True airspeed have been moved to the -N1 - Engine speed. Controlled by the and True airspeed have been moved to the -N1 - Engine speed. Controlled by the
HSI. The picture of the new ADI displays, AT computer. Only available if the AT HSI. The picture of the new ADI displays, AT computer. Only available if the AT
is in the Controls and Indication section of is armed. is in the Controls and Indication section of is armed.
this chapter. Sometimes, a mode is active, AP-only mode selections: this chapter. Sometimes, a mode is active, AP-only mode selections:
but manual disengagement is inhibited. - CWS - Control Wheel Steering but manual disengagement is inhibited. - CWS - Control Wheel Steering
This is indicated by the MCP switch light Roll CWS This is indicated by the MCP switch light Roll CWS
going off, even though the FMA mode is The roll AP FMA annunciates CWS going off, even though the FMA mode is The roll AP FMA annunciates CWS
still active (green). The Altitude Hold and ROLL when one of the following three still active (green). The Altitude Hold and ROLL when one of the following three
Approach modes may be engaged, even conditions occur. Approach modes may be engaged, even conditions occur.
though the associated mode switch is not * A CWS switch is pushed and illumi- though the associated mode switch is not * A CWS switch is pushed and illumi-
illuminated. Therefore, the FMA, not the nated. illuminated. Therefore, the FMA, not the nated.
MCP, is the primary reference for mode * A CMD switch is pressed and illumi- MCP, is the primary reference for mode * A CMD switch is pressed and illumi-
annunciation of AP, FD, CMD and CWS nated, and a roll command mode has not annunciation of AP, FD, CMD and CWS nated, and a roll command mode has not
status, and active (engaged) or armed AT, been selected or was deselected. status, and active (engaged) or armed AT, been selected or was deselected.
AP and FD modes. * A CMD switch is pressed and illumi- AP and FD modes. * A CMD switch is pressed and illumi-
FLIGHT SELECTABLE MODES nated, a roll command mode has been FLIGHT SELECTABLE MODES nated, a roll command mode has been
Flight mode selection is made with selected, and more than 80 inch pounds Flight mode selection is made with selected, and more than 80 inch pounds
momentary push-buttons located on the (high detent) of control wheel force is momentary push-buttons located on the (high detent) of control wheel force is
MCP and throttles. Annunciation of the applied. This is called CWS Override. AP MCP and throttles. Annunciation of the applied. This is called CWS Override. AP
current mode of operation is shown on the CMD mode reverts to CWS ROLL. The current mode of operation is shown on the CMD mode reverts to CWS ROLL. The
Flight Mode Annunciator (FMA) on the AP CMD switch stays ON and the FMA Flight Mode Annunciator (FMA) on the AP CMD switch stays ON and the FMA
ADI. Command modes may be selected annunciation shows CMD and CWS ADI. Command modes may be selected annunciation shows CMD and CWS
only when an AP is engaged to CMD and/ ROLL. Roll CWS override is inhibited only when an AP is engaged to CMD and/ ROLL. Roll CWS override is inhibited
or one or both FD switches are ON. The during APP mode. or one or both FD switches are ON. The during APP mode.
AP and/or FD CMD modes, as determined When a CWS mode is annunciated, the AP and/or FD CMD modes, as determined When a CWS mode is annunciated, the
by the FCC and MCP, are: roll AP can be operating in one of three by the FCC and MCP, are: roll AP can be operating in one of three
-V/S - Vertical Speed modes; CWS, Heading Hold, or Attitude -V/S - Vertical Speed modes; CWS, Heading Hold, or Attitude
-ALT HOLD - Altitude Hold Hold. The actual operating mode while the -ALT HOLD - Altitude Hold Hold. The actual operating mode while the
-V NAV - Vertical Navigation AP CWS switch is ON is determined by -V NAV - Vertical Navigation AP CWS switch is ON is determined by
-LVL CHG - Level Change control wheel pressure and roll attitude. -LVL CHG - Level Change control wheel pressure and roll attitude.
-HDG SEL - Heading Select Although the AP may annunciate CWS -HDG SEL - Heading Select Although the AP may annunciate CWS
-L NAV - Lateral Navigation ROLL, the AP is not operating in CWS -L NAV - Lateral Navigation ROLL, the AP is not operating in CWS
-VOR/LOC - VOR, Localizer mode, (changing roll attitude), until con- -VOR/LOC - VOR, Localizer mode, (changing roll attitude), until con-
-APP - Approach trol wheel pressure, as sensed by the roll -APP - Approach trol wheel pressure, as sensed by the roll
-SPEED - Aircraft forward speed in force transducer, is greater than the low -SPEED - Aircraft forward speed in force transducer, is greater than the low

and
OCT 99Systems Introduction 22-15 OCT 99 22-15
UNITED AIRLINES UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
AUTOFLIGHT AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE AUTOFLIGHT AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE

and Systems Introduction


DFCS Operations Scenario DFCS Operations Scenario
22-16 OCT 99 22-16 OCT 99
UNITED AIRLINES COURSE
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
AUTOFLIGHT AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE AUTOFLIGHT AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

detent pressure of 3 pounds. This is called Pitch CWS detent pressure of 3 pounds. This is called Pitch CWS
CWS OD (Out of Detent). Roll attitude The pitch AP annunciates CWS PITCH CWS OD (Out of Detent). Roll attitude The pitch AP annunciates CWS PITCH
changes until transducer forces are less when one of the following three condi- changes until transducer forces are less when one of the following three condi-
than 3 pounds. tions occur. A CWS switch is pushed and than 3 pounds. tions occur. A CWS switch is pushed and
Roll Attitude Hold illuminated. A CMD switch is pressed and Roll Attitude Hold illuminated. A CMD switch is pressed and
If the AP is engaged to CMD with no illuminated, and a pitch command mode If the AP is engaged to CMD with no illuminated, and a pitch command mode
command mode selected, or CWS with has not been selected or was deselected. A command mode selected, or CWS with has not been selected or was deselected. A
more than 6 degrees of bank angle, roll CMD switch is pressed and illuminated, a more than 6 degrees of bank angle, roll CMD switch is pressed and illuminated, a
Attitude Hold mode is engaged. This pitch command mode has been selected, Attitude Hold mode is engaged. This pitch command mode has been selected,
remains the active roll AP mode as long as and less than 21 pounds (high detent) of remains the active roll AP mode as long as and less than 21 pounds (high detent) of
control wheel pressure stays less than low control wheel force is applied. This is control wheel pressure stays less than low control wheel force is applied. This is
detent. called Pitch CWS Override. The AP CMD detent. called Pitch CWS Override. The AP CMD
Heading Hold switch stays ON and the FMA annuncia- Heading Hold switch stays ON and the FMA annuncia-
If the AP is engaged to CMD or CWS tion shows CMD and CWS PITCH. Pitch If the AP is engaged to CMD or CWS tion shows CMD and CWS PITCH. Pitch
with less than 6 degrees of bank angle, CWS override is effective in APP mode with less than 6 degrees of bank angle, CWS override is effective in APP mode
Heading Hold mode is engaged. The AP until dual AP engage. When a CWS mode Heading Hold mode is engaged. The AP until dual AP engage. When a CWS mode
initiates a wings leveling command, by is annunciated, the pitch AP can be operat- initiates a wings leveling command, by is annunciated, the pitch AP can be operat-
using the existing residual bank angle, at ing in one of two modes; CWS or Attitude using the existing residual bank angle, at ing in one of two modes; CWS or Attitude
the time the control wheel is returned to Hold. The mode is determined by control the time the control wheel is returned to Hold. The mode is determined by control
less than low detent pressure. The residual column pressure and pitch attitude. less than low detent pressure. The residual column pressure and pitch attitude.
bank angle is reduced linearly to zero over Although the AP may annunciate CWS bank angle is reduced linearly to zero over Although the AP may annunciate CWS
a three second period, rolling the wings PITCH, the AP is not operating in CWS a three second period, rolling the wings PITCH, the AP is not operating in CWS
level. After the three second delay, the mode, (changing pitch attitude) until con- level. After the three second delay, the mode, (changing pitch attitude) until con-
Heading Hold mode is established using trol column pressure, as sensed by both Heading Hold mode is established using trol column pressure, as sensed by both
the airplane heading as the reference. This pitch force transducers, is greater than the the airplane heading as the reference. This pitch force transducers, is greater than the
remains the active roll AP mode as long as low detent pressure of 5 pounds. This is remains the active roll AP mode as long as low detent pressure of 5 pounds. This is
control wheel pressure stays less than low called CWS OD (Out of Detent). Pitch control wheel pressure stays less than low called CWS OD (Out of Detent). Pitch
detent, even if the bank angle exceeds 6 attitude changes until transducer forces are detent, even if the bank angle exceeds 6 attitude changes until transducer forces are
degrees. Heading Hold mode is inhibited less than 5 pounds. degrees. Heading Hold mode is inhibited less than 5 pounds.
when any of the following conditions Pitch Attitude Hold when any of the following conditions Pitch Attitude Hold
exist: Below 1,500' Radio Altitude, with If the AP is engaged to CMD or CWS, exist: Below 1,500' Radio Altitude, with If the AP is engaged to CMD or CWS,
the landing gear down. After FD VOR pitch Attitude Hold mode is engaged. This the landing gear down. After FD VOR pitch Attitude Hold mode is engaged. This
capture, with TAS 250 knots or less. After remains the active pitch AP mode as long capture, with TAS 250 knots or less. After remains the active pitch AP mode as long
FD LOC capture in the APP mode. as control column pressure stays less than FD LOC capture in the APP mode. as control column pressure stays less than
NOTE: There is no HDG HOLD or detent. NOTE: There is no HDG HOLD or detent.
ATT HOLD mode annunciation on this NOTE: There is no ATT HOLD mode ATT HOLD mode annunciation on this NOTE: There is no ATT HOLD mode
airplane. For these conditions, the roll annunciation on this airplane. For these airplane. For these conditions, the roll annunciation on this airplane. For these
AP mode annunciation will be CWS conditions, the pitch AP mode annunci- AP mode annunciation will be CWS conditions, the pitch AP mode annunci-
ROLL mode as annunciated on the ation will be CWS PITCH mode, as ROLL mode as annunciated on the ation will be CWS PITCH mode, as
FMA, even though the AP Engage annunciated on the FMA, even though FMA, even though the AP Engage annunciated on the FMA, even though
Switch may be in CMD or CWS. the AP Engage Switch may be in CMD Switch may be in CMD or CWS. the AP Engage Switch may be in CMD
or CWS. or CWS.

and
OCT 99Systems Introduction 22-17 OCT 99 22-17
UNITED
B737 GENERAL AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
AUTOFLIGHT AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE AUTOFLIGHT AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

Roll Command Modes either engaged, or not engaged. If the air- Roll Command Modes either engaged, or not engaged. If the air-
The AP roll command modes are heading plane position or heading is within the The AP roll command modes are heading plane position or heading is within the
select, VOR/Localizer, LNAV, and LNAV capture criteria, LNAV will select, VOR/Localizer, LNAV, and LNAV capture criteria, LNAV will
Approach. engage when the switch is pressed, and the Approach. engage when the switch is pressed, and the
Heading Select Mode LNAV switch will illuminate. The LNAV Heading Select Mode LNAV switch will illuminate. The LNAV
Pressing the Heading Select switch acti- mode is engaged when airborne, and Pressing the Heading Select switch acti- mode is engaged when airborne, and
vates the Heading Select mode. Engage- clearance to fly the active route has been vates the Heading Select mode. Engage- clearance to fly the active route has been
ment is indicated by the switch being received. If conditions satisfy LNAV cap- ment is indicated by the switch being received. If conditions satisfy LNAV cap-
illuminated, and by HDG SEL appearing ture criteria, and one AP is engaged in illuminated, and by HDG SEL appearing ture criteria, and one AP is engaged in
on the FMA. Rotating the round Heading CMD or one or both FD's turned ON, on the FMA. Rotating the round Heading CMD or one or both FD's turned ON,
Select knob while in the Heading Select pressing the LNAV switch engages the Select knob while in the Heading Select pressing the LNAV switch engages the
mode provides AFDS roll commands to LNAV mode. Mode engagement is indi- mode provides AFDS roll commands to LNAV mode. Mode engagement is indi-
turn to and maintain the desired set head- cated by the LNAV switch coming ON, turn to and maintain the desired set head- cated by the LNAV switch coming ON,
ing shown in the MCP heading window. and the FMC roll commands then turn the ing shown in the MCP heading window. and the FMC roll commands then turn the
VOR/LOC Mode airplane to intercept and track the active VOR/LOC Mode airplane to intercept and track the active
The VOR mode provides AFDS roll com- route. The FMA shows LNAV. The VOR mode provides AFDS roll com- route. The FMA shows LNAV.
mands to capture and track the selected Pitch Command Modes mands to capture and track the selected Pitch Command Modes
VOR course. The LOC mode provides The pitch command modes are Altitude VOR course. The LOC mode provides The pitch command modes are Altitude
AFDS roll commands to capture and track Hold, Altitude Select, Vertical Speed, AFDS roll commands to capture and track Hold, Altitude Select, Vertical Speed,
the selected Localizer inbound front Level Change, Vertical Navigation and the selected Localizer inbound front Level Change, Vertical Navigation and
course. A back course approach has no Approach. course. A back course approach has no Approach.
Glideslope capabilities, and neither the AP Altitude Hold Mode Glideslope capabilities, and neither the AP Altitude Hold Mode
or FD do back course tracking. Pushing The Altitude Hold mode engages for or FD do back course tracking. Pushing The Altitude Hold mode engages for
the VOR/LOC switch selects the VOR either of two conditions; it holds the pres- the VOR/LOC switch selects the VOR either of two conditions; it holds the pres-
mode if a VOR frequency is manually sure altitude at which the ALT HOLD mode if a VOR frequency is manually sure altitude at which the ALT HOLD
tuned, or the LOC mode if a Localizer fre- switch was pushed, or holds the altitude tuned, or the LOC mode if a Localizer fre- switch was pushed, or holds the altitude
quency is manually tuned. The VOR/LOC selected on the MCP. If the Altitude Hold quency is manually tuned. The VOR/LOC selected on the MCP. If the Altitude Hold
switch illuminates, and VOR/LOC armed mode switch is pressed while climbing or switch illuminates, and VOR/LOC armed mode switch is pressed while climbing or
is annunciated. The VOR/LOC mode but- descending, the airplane will level-off, and is annunciated. The VOR/LOC mode but- descending, the airplane will level-off, and
ton is inhibited if the associated VHF then return to the altitude at which the ton is inhibited if the associated VHF then return to the altitude at which the
NAV receiver is selected to AUTO tuning Altitude Hold switch was pressed. The NAV receiver is selected to AUTO tuning Altitude Hold switch was pressed. The
Lateral Navigation (LNAV) Mode altitude selected on the MCP is referenced Lateral Navigation (LNAV) Mode altitude selected on the MCP is referenced
When the LNAV mode is engaged, the to the Captain's barometric altimeter set- When the LNAV mode is engaged, the to the Captain's barometric altimeter set-
FMC provides roll steering commands to ting for the AP A, and to the F/O baromet- FMC provides roll steering commands to ting for the AP A, and to the F/O baromet-
the AFDS to intercept and track the active ric setting for the AP B. After ALT HOLD the AFDS to intercept and track the active ric setting for the AP B. After ALT HOLD
FMC flight plan route entered into the engages, changing the altimeter baromet- FMC flight plan route entered into the engages, changing the altimeter baromet-
FMC. The flight plan route is entered, ric setting does not change the selected FMC. The flight plan route is entered, ric setting does not change the selected
activated or modified through either of the altitude reference. The ALTITUDE SEL activated or modified through either of the altitude reference. The ALTITUDE SEL
two FMC Computer Display Units control is used to set the altitude to which two FMC Computer Display Units control is used to set the altitude to which
(CDU's). The FMC supplies the AP, ED, Air Traffic Control has cleared the air- (CDU's). The FMC supplies the AP, ED, Air Traffic Control has cleared the air-
and various flight instrument displays plane to fly. Rotating the knob will change and various flight instrument displays plane to fly. Rotating the knob will change
when in the LNAV mode. There is no the displayed altitude in 100 foot incre- when in the LNAV mode. There is no the displayed altitude in 100 foot incre-
armed state for the LNAV mode; it is armed state for the LNAV mode; it is

22-18 and Systems Introduction OCT 99 22-18 OCT 99


UNITED AIRLINES COURSE
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
AUTOFLIGHT AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE AUTOFLIGHT AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

ments. MCP ALTITUDE SEL knob has a 1000'/minute above 1000'/minute and ments. MCP ALTITUDE SEL knob has a 1000'/minute above 1000'/minute and
synchro with mechanical stops at 0 and increments of 50'/minute below 1000'/ synchro with mechanical stops at 0 and increments of 50'/minute below 1000'/
50,000'. Once the aircraft gets to the minute. The display is blank when VS 50,000'. Once the aircraft gets to the minute. The display is blank when VS
selected altitude, it goes to Altitude Hold mode is neither engaged or armed. The VS selected altitude, it goes to Altitude Hold mode is neither engaged or armed. The VS
mode. Changing the selected altitude mode becomes armed automatically if mode. Changing the selected altitude mode becomes armed automatically if
resets the altitude reference for the altitude while in the ALT HOLD mode at the resets the altitude reference for the altitude while in the ALT HOLD mode at the
alert system. MCP selected altitude, a new altitude is alert system. MCP selected altitude, a new altitude is
NOTE: Due to a COA, do not push in selected which is more than 100' different NOTE: Due to a COA, do not push in selected which is more than 100' different
on the knob, or force rotation past the than the previously selected altitude. VS on the knob, or force rotation past the than the previously selected altitude. VS
mechanical stops. armed (in white) is annunciated. The Alti- mechanical stops. armed (in white) is annunciated. The Alti-
tude Hold switch comes ON, because the tude Hold switch comes ON, because the
Altitude Acquire Mode AP is now in the Altitude Hold mode, but Altitude Acquire Mode AP is now in the Altitude Hold mode, but
The Altitude Acquire mode is a transi- the airplane is not at the altitude selected The Altitude Acquire mode is a transi- the airplane is not at the altitude selected
tional maneuver from a climb or descent on the MCP. The vertical speed display tional maneuver from a climb or descent on the MCP. The vertical speed display
to an automatic level-off at the altitude set window will remain blanked at this time. to an automatic level-off at the altitude set window will remain blanked at this time.
on the MCP. There is no way to manually Selecting the Vertical Speed mode will on the MCP. There is no way to manually Selecting the Vertical Speed mode will
select the ALT ACQ mode. When nearing automatically engage the AT in the MCP select the ALT ACQ mode. When nearing automatically engage the AT in the MCP
a selected altitude from either a climb or SPEED mode, if the AT is armed. The AT a selected altitude from either a climb or SPEED mode, if the AT is armed. The AT
descent, the AP will automatically engage will then adjust the throttles to maintain descent, the AP will automatically engage will then adjust the throttles to maintain
in Altitude Acquire and level-off at the the selected airspeed or Mach. This is a in Altitude Acquire and level-off at the the selected airspeed or Mach. This is a
selected altitude. This mode is indicated mode where speed is controlled by the selected altitude. This mode is indicated mode where speed is controlled by the
by the ALT ACQ annunciation. To pre- throttles. This is known as a "speed on by the ALT ACQ annunciation. To pre- throttles. This is known as a "speed on
vent altitude overshoot, the point of Alti- throttles" mode. vent altitude overshoot, the point of Alti- throttles" mode.
tude Acquire engagement is variable, as a Level Change Mode tude Acquire engagement is variable, as a Level Change Mode
function of vertical speed. After level-off The Level Change mode executes a climb function of vertical speed. After level-off The Level Change mode executes a climb
at the selected altitude, Altitude Acquire is or descent to a newly selected altitude, and at the selected altitude, Altitude Acquire is or descent to a newly selected altitude, and
deactivated and Altitude Hold is automati- levels off at the altitude selected on the deactivated and Altitude Hold is automati- levels off at the altitude selected on the
cally engaged. If armed, the AT will oper- MCP. Pitch and thrust are coordinated to cally engaged. If armed, the AT will oper- MCP. Pitch and thrust are coordinated to
ate in the MCP SPEED mode. maintain the MCP selected airspeed or ate in the MCP SPEED mode. maintain the MCP selected airspeed or
Vertical Speed (VS) Mode Mach. A LVL CHG climb or descent is Vertical Speed (VS) Mode Mach. A LVL CHG climb or descent is
The VS mode gives pitch commands to initiated by selecting a new altitude on the The VS mode gives pitch commands to initiated by selecting a new altitude on the
hold the selected vertical speed. The VER- MCP, then engaging the LVL CHG mode hold the selected vertical speed. The VER- MCP, then engaging the LVL CHG mode
TICAL SPEED (VS) display and control by pushing the LVL CHG switch. The AP TICAL SPEED (VS) display and control by pushing the LVL CHG switch. The AP
provides climb and crescent reference by will hold the MCP selected speed by vary- provides climb and crescent reference by will hold the MCP selected speed by vary-
synchronizing the VS thumbwheel to the ing the pitch attitude. The AP annunciates synchronizing the VS thumbwheel to the ing the pitch attitude. The AP annunciates
current vertical speed prior to mode MCP SPEED, and the light in the Level current vertical speed prior to mode MCP SPEED, and the light in the Level
engagement, or by manually adjusting the Change switch will come ON. This is a engagement, or by manually adjusting the Change switch will come ON. This is a
VS thumbwheel control after engagement. mode where speed is controlled by the ele- VS thumbwheel control after engagement. mode where speed is controlled by the ele-
A vertical speed can be selected which vators. This is known as a "speed on ele- A vertical speed can be selected which vators. This is known as a "speed on ele-
climbs or descends toward or away from vators" mode. When making a Level climbs or descends toward or away from vators" mode. When making a Level
the MCP selected altitude. The VS can Change climb or descent, the AP will the MCP selected altitude. The VS can Change climb or descent, the AP will
display between plus 6000'/minute and automatically engage in Altitude Acquire display between plus 6000'/minute and automatically engage in Altitude Acquire
minus 7900'/minute in increments of when nearing the selected altitude. Upon minus 7900'/minute in increments of when nearing the selected altitude. Upon

and
OCT 99Systems Introduction 22-19 OCT 99 22-19
UNITED
B737 GENERAL AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
AUTOFLIGHT AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE AUTOFLIGHT AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

reaching the selected altitude, the AP will nates. VNAV mode is engaged by pushing reaching the selected altitude, the AP will nates. VNAV mode is engaged by pushing
engage in Altitude Hold. If the AT is the VNAV mode switch. The VNAV engage in Altitude Hold. If the AT is the VNAV mode switch. The VNAV
armed, it will automatically engage in switch illuminates and the MCP speed armed, it will automatically engage in switch illuminates and the MCP speed
MCP SPEED, and will then maintain the window blanks (this indicates that speed MCP SPEED, and will then maintain the window blanks (this indicates that speed
selected airspeed or Mach. commands are being provided by the selected airspeed or Mach. commands are being provided by the
Vertical Navigation (VNAV) Mode FMC). The FMC commands a pro- Vertical Navigation (VNAV) Mode FMC). The FMC commands a pro-
The VNAV mode controls AP/FD pitch, grammed climb schedule of 250 knots to The VNAV mode controls AP/FD pitch, grammed climb schedule of 250 knots to
AT thrust and various flight instrument 10,000', then economy climb speed to AT thrust and various flight instrument 10,000', then economy climb speed to
displays to guide the airplane through the cruise altitude. The airspeed target cursors displays to guide the airplane through the cruise altitude. The airspeed target cursors
vertical profile speed and altitude entered on the Mach/airspeed indicators are posi- vertical profile speed and altitude entered on the Mach/airspeed indicators are posi-
into the FMC. This profile can include the tioned by the FCC, using FMC com- into the FMC. This profile can include the tioned by the FCC, using FMC com-
flight segments of departure, climb, manded airspeed. The AT engages in N1 flight segments of departure, climb, manded airspeed. The AT engages in N1
cruise, descent, altitude constraints at mode, VNAV SPEED is annunciated for cruise, descent, altitude constraints at mode, VNAV SPEED is annunciated for
specified waypoints, and terminal area AFDS pitch (a "speed on elevators" specified waypoints, and terminal area AFDS pitch (a "speed on elevators"
arrival. The profile is not used past the ILS mode), and the N1 limit on the TMA arrival. The profile is not used past the ILS mode), and the N1 limit on the TMA
final approach fix to the destination air- changes to CLIMB. Approaching the final approach fix to the destination air- changes to CLIMB. Approaching the
port. The possible FMA displays in level-off altitude, during a VNAV climb port. The possible FMA displays in level-off altitude, during a VNAV climb
VNAV mode are VNAV SPD or VNAV to a FMC altitude, Altitude Acquire is not VNAV mode are VNAV SPD or VNAV to a FMC altitude, Altitude Acquire is not
PATH for AFDS pitch, and FMC SPD, annunciated, and the engaged pitch annun- PATH for AFDS pitch, and FMC SPD, annunciated, and the engaged pitch annun-
N1, RETARD or ARM for the AT. To ciation is VNAV PATH. Instead, the AT N1, RETARD or ARM for the AT. To ciation is VNAV PATH. Instead, the AT
engage VNAV, an AP must be engaged in mode annunciation changes from N1 to engage VNAV, an AP must be engaged in mode annunciation changes from N1 to
CMD or a FD turned ON. The AT should FMC SPEED. The TMA annunciation N1 CMD or a FD turned ON. The AT should FMC SPEED. The TMA annunciation N1
be armed, and completion of the FMC limit remains CLIMB. Upon leveling off be armed, and completion of the FMC limit remains CLIMB. Upon leveling off
Preflight including Position Initialization, at the FMC altitude, the N1 limit changes Preflight including Position Initialization, at the FMC altitude, the N1 limit changes
Route and Performance pages must be from CLIMB to CRUISE. Note that Route and Performance pages must be from CLIMB to CRUISE. Note that
completed. VNAV climbs and descents VNAV PATH is annunciated instead of completed. VNAV climbs and descents VNAV PATH is annunciated instead of
are constrained by the selected MCP alti- ALT HOLD, and the AP flies the airplane are constrained by the selected MCP alti- ALT HOLD, and the AP flies the airplane
tude; i.e., the AFDS will level-off when along the FMC vertical profile. The AT is tude; i.e., the AFDS will level-off when along the FMC vertical profile. The AT is
the altitude set on the MCP is reached. maintaining the FMC SPEED (a speed on the altitude set on the MCP is reached. maintaining the FMC SPEED (a speed on
The AP will not fly through the selected throttles mode). This speed may be The AP will not fly through the selected throttles mode). This speed may be
MCP altitude. Two exceptions are during changed with entries into the FMC CDU. MCP altitude. Two exceptions are during changed with entries into the FMC CDU.
approach, when the AP will begin descent During a VNAV PATH descent, VNAV approach, when the AP will begin descent During a VNAV PATH descent, VNAV
away from MCP altitude upon Glideslope remains engaged until one of the follow- away from MCP altitude upon Glideslope remains engaged until one of the follow-
capture, and AP GA, if the stab hasn't fin- ing four conditions occur; Glideslope cap- capture, and AP GA, if the stab hasn't fin- ing four conditions occur; Glideslope cap-
ished trimming for single AP cruise opera- ture, another pitch mode is selected, flaps ished trimming for single AP cruise opera- ture, another pitch mode is selected, flaps
tion before reaching the missed approach are extended beyond 15, or LNAV is dis- tion before reaching the missed approach are extended beyond 15, or LNAV is dis-
altitude selected on the MCP. VNAV engaged without Localizer capture. altitude selected on the MCP. VNAV engaged without Localizer capture.
commanded speeds may be changed Approach (APP) Mode commanded speeds may be changed Approach (APP) Mode
through either CDU. After takeoff, and The Approach mode is used to fly an ILS through either CDU. After takeoff, and The Approach mode is used to fly an ILS
when cleared to fly the planned route, the approach, and can be used with either a when cleared to fly the planned route, the approach, and can be used with either a
next altitude is first selected in the MCP single or dual AP engaged. The AT, if next altitude is first selected in the MCP single or dual AP engaged. The AT, if
altitude window to match the FMC alti- used, will maintain a selected airspeed in altitude window to match the FMC alti- used, will maintain a selected airspeed in
tude, the Altitude Hold switch light illumi- MCP SPD mode. This is a speed on throt- tude, the Altitude Hold switch light illumi- MCP SPD mode. This is a speed on throt-

22-20 and Systems Introduction OCT 99 22-20 OCT 99


UNITED AIRLINES COURSE
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
AUTOFLIGHT AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE AUTOFLIGHT AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

tles mode. The AT and both AP's must be gory III, or Autoland approach, known to tles mode. The AT and both AP's must be gory III, or Autoland approach, known to
used for automatic landings. After touch- the flight crews as the "Low Visibility used for automatic landings. After touch- the flight crews as the "Low Visibility
down, the AP's must be manually disen- Autoland Approach" procedure. The low- down, the AP's must be manually disen- Autoland Approach" procedure. The low-
gaged, the AT disengages automatically. est weather minimums certified for this gaged, the AT disengages automatically. est weather minimums certified for this
Sometimes, a mode may be engaged, airplane is Category IIIa, with a Runway Sometimes, a mode may be engaged, airplane is Category IIIa, with a Runway
while the respective mode switch is not Visual Range (RVR) of 700'. This dictates while the respective mode switch is not Visual Range (RVR) of 700'. This dictates
illuminated. When APP is engaged, the that both AP channels of the DFCS must illuminated. When APP is engaged, the that both AP channels of the DFCS must
APP switch light goes out after Glideslope be engaged in Command (CMD) status, in APP switch light goes out after Glideslope be engaged in Command (CMD) status, in
has captured, indicating that the mode the APP mode, and perform the approach, has captured, indicating that the mode the APP mode, and perform the approach,
may not be disengaged by pressing the flare and autolanding. Only use of AT and may not be disengaged by pressing the flare and autolanding. Only use of AT and
switch. For this reason, the Flight Mode dual AP's provides for automatic landing switch. For this reason, the Flight Mode dual AP's provides for automatic landing
Annunciator on the ADI, not the Mode and automatic go around capabilities. The Annunciator on the ADI, not the Mode and automatic go around capabilities. The
Control Panel, is the primary reference for crew sets the airplane up for a dual chan- Control Panel, is the primary reference for crew sets the airplane up for a dual chan-
mode engagement and current operating nel AP approach. They may not discon- mode engagement and current operating nel AP approach. They may not discon-
mode. The VHF NAV control panel auto- nect the AP and hand fly the approach mode. The VHF NAV control panel auto- nect the AP and hand fly the approach
manual switch, respective to the AP which until the runway environment comes into manual switch, respective to the AP which until the runway environment comes into
is in command operation, must be in the view. This must occur before a decision is in command operation, must be in the view. This must occur before a decision
Manual (MAN) position before the height of 50' is reached, or else a GA is Manual (MAN) position before the height of 50' is reached, or else a GA is
Approach mode can be selected, (NAV 1 initiated. The Approach mode (APP) Approach mode can be selected, (NAV 1 initiated. The Approach mode (APP)
for AP A, NAV 2 for AP B). One NAV allows both AP's to be engaged at the for AP A, NAV 2 for AP B). One NAV allows both AP's to be engaged at the
receiver must be manually tuned to an ILS same time. Dual AP operation provides receiver must be manually tuned to an ILS same time. Dual AP operation provides
frequency before the Approach mode may fail passive control through landing flare frequency before the Approach mode may fail passive control through landing flare
be selected. Pressing the APP button and touchdown or an automatic go around. be selected. Pressing the APP button and touchdown or an automatic go around.
selects the Approach mode. The Approach During "fail passive" operation, the flight selects the Approach mode. The Approach During "fail passive" operation, the flight
mode arms the AFDS to capture and track controls respond to the AP system that mode arms the AFDS to capture and track controls respond to the AP system that
the Localizer and Glideslope. It may be commands the lesser control movement, the Localizer and Glideslope. It may be commands the lesser control movement,
engaged for dual or single AP operation. and both disconnect if a single channel engaged for dual or single AP operation. and both disconnect if a single channel
Either the LOC or Glideslope may be cap- failure occurs, or either AP sees a differ- Either the LOC or Glideslope may be cap- failure occurs, or either AP sees a differ-
tured first. Upon capture of the second ence between its command and actuator tured first. Upon capture of the second ence between its command and actuator
radio signal, an automatic transition is output. radio signal, an automatic transition is output.
made to the ILS APP mode and continuing Localizer and Glideslope Armed made to the ILS APP mode and continuing Localizer and Glideslope Armed
through Autoland. To start a dual channel approach, engage through Autoland. To start a dual channel approach, engage
NOTE: When operating in the APP one AP by pressing CMD status switch, NOTE: When operating in the APP one AP by pressing CMD status switch,
mode, the local course selection must be and press the APP switch on the MCP to mode, the local course selection must be and press the APP switch on the MCP to
within 90 degrees of the aircraft head- select the Approach mode. When APP is within 90 degrees of the aircraft head- select the Approach mode. When APP is
ing in order to keep the Glideslope selected, the ILS UP/LT, DN/RT tests are ing in order to keep the Glideslope selected, the ILS UP/LT, DN/RT tests are
pointer in view on the ADI and HSI. inhibited. The APP switch light comes pointer in view on the ADI and HSI. inhibited. The APP switch light comes
ON, and VOR/LOC and GS annunciate ON, and VOR/LOC and GS annunciate
Autoland Dual Channel Approach armed. LOC receivers switch from the aft Autoland Dual Channel Approach armed. LOC receivers switch from the aft
The airport is under low visibility condi- VOR antenna assembly in the vertical fin The airport is under low visibility condi- VOR antenna assembly in the vertical fin
tions if the weather is below the standard tip, to the forward dual LOC antenna tions if the weather is below the standard tip, to the forward dual LOC antenna
ILS minimums (generally 200' ceiling and under the nose radome. One AP must be ILS minimums (generally 200' ceiling and under the nose radome. One AP must be
1/2 mile visibility). This requires a Cate- engaged to CMD and be in the Approach 1/2 mile visibility). This requires a Cate- engaged to CMD and be in the Approach

and
OCT 99Systems Introduction 22-21 OCT 99 22-21
UNITED
B737 GENERAL AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
AUTOFLIGHT AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE AUTOFLIGHT AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

mode, before engaging the second AP. have been used to capture Glideslope. At mode, before engaging the second AP. have been used to capture Glideslope. At
Remember that if the APP mode is not Glideslope captured, the VNAV mode dis- Remember that if the APP mode is not Glideslope captured, the VNAV mode dis-
engaged, pressing the second AP engage engages, the VNAV and APP mode engaged, pressing the second AP engage engages, the VNAV and APP mode
button will engage the second AP and dis- switches extinguish, indicating that the button will engage the second AP and dis- switches extinguish, indicating that the
connect the first AP. This is called chan- APP mode may no longer be deselected by connect the first AP. This is called chan- APP mode may no longer be deselected by
nel swap. The only time both AP's will pressing the APP mode switch again. nel swap. The only time both AP's will pressing the APP mode switch again.
remain engaged is when the APP or GA After LOC and Glideslope are both cap- remain engaged is when the APP or GA After LOC and Glideslope are both cap-
modes are engaged. Pushing the second tured, the APP mode may be disengaged modes are engaged. Pushing the second tured, the APP mode may be disengaged
AP CMD switch causes the light in that only by pushing a TOGA switch, or disen- AP CMD switch causes the light in that only by pushing a TOGA switch, or disen-
switch to come ON, arming the second AP gaging the AP and turning OFF both FD switch to come ON, arming the second AP gaging the AP and turning OFF both FD
for automatic capture and engagement. switches. The FMA annunciates VOR/ for automatic capture and engagement. switches. The FMA annunciates VOR/
Engage the second AP to CMD prior to LOC captured, and G/S captured for Engage the second AP to CMD prior to LOC captured, and G/S captured for
descending to 800' Radio Altitude, to DFCS. The pitch AP commands a descent descending to 800' Radio Altitude, to DFCS. The pitch AP commands a descent
allow dual channel approach. Roll CWS is to make a smooth transition to intercept, allow dual channel approach. Roll CWS is to make a smooth transition to intercept,
inhibited when in APP, and both AP's then track the Glideslope. The IAS/ inhibited when in APP, and both AP's then track the Glideslope. The IAS/
engaged to CMD. This only occurs after MACH display is activated on the MCP, engaged to CMD. This only occurs after MACH display is activated on the MCP,
FLARE mode is annunciated armed. For changing from blank to the current air- FLARE mode is annunciated armed. For changing from blank to the current air-
Localizer back course, the course selec- speed. Command speed for the remainder Localizer back course, the course selec- speed. Command speed for the remainder
tion is set to the front course to provide of the approach may now be controlled tion is set to the front course to provide of the approach may now be controlled
proper sensing on the course bar. The from the MCP. The AT holds the MCP proper sensing on the course bar. The from the MCP. The AT holds the MCP
AFDS will not track a back course in speed. The published missed approach AFDS will not track a back course in speed. The published missed approach
VOR/LOC or APP modes. The crews altitude is selected on the MCP in case go VOR/LOC or APP modes. The crews altitude is selected on the MCP in case go
would use HDG SEL and VS modes. This around is necessary. would use HDG SEL and VS modes. This around is necessary.
is a non precision approach, not Cat II or is a non precision approach, not Cat II or
III. Autoland Dual Channel Approach III. Autoland Dual Channel Approach
Localizer Capture Sequence Localizer Capture Sequence
At Localizer capture, LNAV is disen- Sequence by Radio Altitude (RA) for FCC At Localizer capture, LNAV is disen- Sequence by Radio Altitude (RA) for FCC
gaged and the LNAV mode switch extin- Internal Discretes: gaged and the LNAV mode switch extin- Internal Discretes:
guishes. The FMA no longer annunciates -Above 2,000 Feet Radio Altitude guishes. The FMA no longer annunciates -Above 2,000 Feet Radio Altitude
LNAV and changes from VOR/LOC One AP is engaged, and the APP mode LNAV and changes from VOR/LOC One AP is engaged, and the APP mode
armed to VOR/LOC captured. The AP switch pushed. The second AP may be armed to VOR/LOC captured. The AP switch pushed. The second AP may be
turns the aircraft onto the Localizer selected to CMD now, but must be turns the aircraft onto the Localizer selected to CMD now, but must be
course. The AP tracks the Localizer and selected prior to descending to 800' course. The AP tracks the Localizer and selected prior to descending to 800'
maintains the VNAV PATH altitude. The RA. maintains the VNAV PATH altitude. The RA.
AT continues to hold the FMC command -Below 2,000 Feet Radio Altitude AT continues to hold the FMC command -Below 2,000 Feet Radio Altitude
speed. The VNAV and APP mode The AT and FD GA modes are now speed. The VNAV and APP mode The AT and FD GA modes are now
switches remain illuminated and the FMA available. Pressing either TOGA switches remain illuminated and the FMA available. Pressing either TOGA
annunciates VOR/LOC captured, G/S switch puts the AT into the GA mode, annunciates VOR/LOC captured, G/S switch puts the AT into the GA mode,
armed, and VNAV. sets thrust to a reduced GA level, puts armed, and VNAV. sets thrust to a reduced GA level, puts
Glideslope Capture the FD into GA, and causes the Glideslope Capture the FD into GA, and causes the
The Glideslope may be captured from engaged channel of the AP to The Glideslope may be captured from engaged channel of the AP to
above or below. Either ALT HOLD, disconnect. above or below. Either ALT HOLD, disconnect.
VERT SPD, CWS, or VNAV mode could VERT SPD, CWS, or VNAV mode could

22-22 and Systems Introduction OCT 99 22-22 OCT 99


UNITED AIRLINES COURSE
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
AUTOFLIGHT AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE AUTOFLIGHT AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

-1500 Feet Radio Altitude Any system test failure, large error, or -1500 Feet Radio Altitude Any system test failure, large error, or
-Approach On Course (AOC) occurs. if any monitor detects a failure, will -Approach On Course (AOC) occurs. if any monitor detects a failure, will
Both FCC's, only if both are in CMD, result in FLARE not armed, and both Both FCC's, only if both are in CMD, result in FLARE not armed, and both
perform an internal and cross channel AP's disengage. This is Fail Passive perform an internal and cross channel AP's disengage. This is Fail Passive
BITE test. This test is indicated by the operation. BITE test. This test is indicated by the operation.
LOC and Glideslope deviation scales -800 Feet Radio Altitude LOC and Glideslope deviation scales -800 Feet Radio Altitude
on the ADI turning yellow and -The airplane should be stabilized on on the ADI turning yellow and -The airplane should be stabilized on
flashing for approximately 3 seconds the ILS in the landing configuration flashing for approximately 3 seconds the ILS in the landing configuration
(this occurs twice; once for the test of before reaching 800'. The second AP (this occurs twice; once for the test of before reaching 800'. The second AP
each system). If the tests are must be engaged in CMD by this each system). If the tests are must be engaged in CMD by this
successful, both FCC's are equalized point. If not, the second CMD engage successful, both FCC's are equalized point. If not, the second CMD engage
by transferring system information switch becomes inhibited and a dual by transferring system information switch becomes inhibited and a dual
from the first AP to CMD, to the other channel approach is not possible. If a from the first AP to CMD, to the other channel approach is not possible. If a
FCC. The 2nd AP's roll and pitch disconnect occurs above 800', both FCC. The 2nd AP's roll and pitch disconnect occurs above 800', both
actuators are synchronized to the first channels can be reengaged if the actuators are synchronized to the first channels can be reengaged if the
AP, then detent pistons are normal engage logic is satisfied. AP, then detent pistons are normal engage logic is satisfied.
pressurized, fully engaging the 2nd AP Below 800' only a single channel can pressurized, fully engaging the 2nd AP Below 800' only a single channel can
to the flight controls. The FMA be reengaged. The AP Warning light to the flight controls. The FMA be reengaged. The AP Warning light
annunciates VOR/LOC captured, GS on each FMS Warning annunciator annunciates VOR/LOC captured, GS on each FMS Warning annunciator
captured and FLARE armed. FLARE illuminates steady red whenever the captured and FLARE armed. FLARE illuminates steady red whenever the
armed is annunciated only after both AP is unable to trim the stabilizer, if armed is annunciated only after both AP is unable to trim the stabilizer, if
AP's pass self tests. AP GA is only this out of trim condition exists for 10 AP's pass self tests. AP GA is only this out of trim condition exists for 10
possible after FLARE armed is seconds, below 800' RA, and in a dual possible after FLARE armed is seconds, below 800' RA, and in a dual
annunciated. The FCC monitors channel approach. The AP disengage annunciated. The FCC monitors channel approach. The AP disengage
during dual channel are activated 5 lights go out when the out of trim during dual channel are activated 5 lights go out when the out of trim
seconds after the second AP is condition no longer exists, or when the seconds after the second AP is condition no longer exists, or when the
engaged, called "monitors active". AP's are disengaged. engaged, called "monitors active". AP's are disengaged.
One monitor compares AP actuator -400 Feet Radio Altitude One monitor compares AP actuator -400 Feet Radio Altitude
position against surface position. A -The stabilizer is automatically position against surface position. A -The stabilizer is automatically
second monitor compares surface trimmed an additional amount nose up second monitor compares surface trimmed an additional amount nose up
position against AP command. A third (Flare Spring Bias) in preparation for position against AP command. A third (Flare Spring Bias) in preparation for
compares internal command the flare maneuver, or in case a go compares internal command the flare maneuver, or in case a go
computations against a model around is necessary. To counteract computations against a model around is necessary. To counteract
computation. During the remainder of this, the AP applies down elevator to computation. During the remainder of this, the AP applies down elevator to
the Autoland, an equalization circuit maintain tracking of the Glideslope. the Autoland, an equalization circuit maintain tracking of the Glideslope.
cancels any small differences in (In all other modes of operation, this cancels any small differences in (In all other modes of operation, this
command from the FCC's. This circuit constant displacement of the elevator command from the FCC's. This circuit constant displacement of the elevator
utilizes any difference between the would be considered an out of trim utilizes any difference between the would be considered an out of trim
actuator as an addition feedback for condition. The Approach mode actuator as an addition feedback for condition. The Approach mode
the equalization. The mechanical expects this for a dual approach, the equalization. The mechanical expects this for a dual approach,
design of the AP actuators output however, and at this time the airplane design of the AP actuators output however, and at this time the airplane
crank prevent large differences from is not considered to be out of trim.) crank prevent large differences from is not considered to be out of trim.)
being reflected in surface movement. Part of this trim is added gradually at being reflected in surface movement. Part of this trim is added gradually at

and
OCT 99Systems Introduction 22-23 OCT 99 22-23
UNITED
B737 GENERAL AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
AUTOFLIGHT AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE AUTOFLIGHT AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

400' RA. The remainder is added as power and touchdown simultaneously. 400' RA. The remainder is added as power and touchdown simultaneously.
Flare mode engages. Should an AP -Touchdown Flare mode engages. Should an AP -Touchdown
fault occur, the AP's subsequently -At squat, the AT transitions to ARM fault occur, the AP's subsequently -At squat, the AT transitions to ARM
disengage, and the elevator would and is annunciated on the FMA. At disengage, and the elevator would and is annunciated on the FMA. At
return to neutral. Forward control squat plus 2 seconds, as sensed by the return to neutral. Forward control squat plus 2 seconds, as sensed by the
column force will be required to hold air/ground relay, the AT disconnects column force will be required to hold air/ground relay, the AT disconnects
the desired pitch attitude and and the FMA displays blanks for AT. the desired pitch attitude and and the FMA displays blanks for AT.
Glideslope path due to the nose up There is no warning for AT disconnect Glideslope path due to the nose up stab There is no warning for AT disconnect
stab trim. at touchdown. When on the ground, trim. at touchdown. When on the ground,
-350 Feet Radio Altitude after disengagement, and the ground -350 Feet Radio Altitude after disengagement, and the ground
-If FLARE arm does not occur before speed is reduced to less than 20 knots, -If FLARE arm does not occur before speed is reduced to less than 20 knots,
descending to 350' RA, both AP's will the FMA and the Thrust Mode descending to 350' RA, both AP's will the FMA and the Thrust Mode
disengage. The AP cannot be Annunciator (TMA) blank. This disengage. The AP cannot be Annunciator (TMA) blank. This
reengaged. airplane has no AP runway tracking reengaged. airplane has no AP runway tracking
-50 Feet Radio Altitude rollout guidance, (no AP servo on the -50 Feet Radio Altitude rollout guidance, (no AP servo on the
-This is the CAT IIIa Decision Height. rudder, only a Yaw Damper). After -This is the CAT IIIa Decision Height. rudder, only a Yaw Damper). After
The crew must decide if the runway touchdown, the AP must be manually The crew must decide if the runway touchdown, the AP must be manually
environment is in view, in order to disengaged, by pressing the AP environment is in view, in order to disengaged, by pressing the AP
allow the AP to Autoland. The AP disconnect switch on either control allow the AP to Autoland. The AP disconnect switch on either control
FLARE maneuver begins. The FMA wheel, the disengage bar on the MCP, FLARE maneuver begins. The FMA wheel, the disengage bar on the MCP,
annunciates VOR/LOC and FLARE or by pressing a TOGA switch on annunciates VOR/LOC and FLARE or by pressing a TOGA switch on
engaged. There is no FLARE mode for either throttle. The flight crew must engaged. There is no FLARE mode for either throttle. The flight crew must
FD, the command bars are biased out manually control the rollout steering FD, the command bars are biased out manually control the rollout steering
of view from the ADI. Localizer (Category IIIa). The AP red warning of view from the ADI. Localizer (Category IIIa). The AP red warning
signals are not used during the flare light on the FMA flashes and an aural signals are not used during the flare light on the FMA flashes and an aural
maneuver. The AP will control roll to warning is heard. Press either control maneuver. The AP will control roll to warning is heard. Press either control
maintain the current ground track. wheel disconnect switch a second time maintain the current ground track. wheel disconnect switch a second time
Glideslope signals are not used during or either AP Warning light assembly to Glideslope signals are not used during or either AP Warning light assembly to
the flare maneuver. The AP raises the reset the warning. The FD switches are the flare maneuver. The AP raises the reset the warning. The FD switches are
nose of the airplane, the goal being to turned off, removing the VOR/LOC nose of the airplane, the goal being to turned off, removing the VOR/LOC
achieve a descent rate of 2 1/2' per and GS annunciation and FD status. achieve a descent rate of 2 1/2' per and GS annunciation and FD status.
second (150' per minute) at -Go Around Mode second (150' per minute) at -Go Around Mode
touchdown. -A missed approach is required if the touchdown. -A missed approach is required if the
-27 Feet Radio Altitude Captain cannot determine that the -27 Feet Radio Altitude Captain cannot determine that the
-At 27' RA or 2.5 seconds after flare touchdown will occur in the -At 27' RA or 2.5 seconds after flare touchdown will occur in the
(whichever comes first), the AT enters touchdown zone. When less than (whichever comes first), the AT enters touchdown zone. When less than
the Retard mode, the FMA 2,000' RA and prior to dual channel the Retard mode, the FMA 2,000' RA and prior to dual channel
annunciates RETARD. The SPEED Flare mode armed, the Go Around annunciates RETARD. The SPEED Flare mode armed, the Go Around
mode switch extinguishes. The AT (GA) mode is available only for AT mode switch extinguishes. The AT (GA) mode is available only for AT
begins closing the throttles, and FD operation. Pressing either begins closing the throttles, and FD operation. Pressing either
programmed to reduce power from the TOGA switch, located on each programmed to reduce power from the TOGA switch, located on each
current setting to the idle stop in 6 throttle, gives AT reduced Go Around current setting to the idle stop in 6 throttle, gives AT reduced Go Around
seconds. This should result in idle thrust and the FMA shows GA mode. seconds. This should result in idle thrust and the FMA shows GA mode.

22-24 and Systems Introduction OCT 99 22-24 OCT 99


UNITED AIRLINES COURSE
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
AUTOFLIGHT AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE AUTOFLIGHT AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

Pressing a TOGA switch a second stabilizer trim is not satisfactory for Pressing a TOGA switch a second stabilizer trim is not satisfactory for
time gives AT full Go Around thrust single AP operation, ALT ACQ is time gives AT full Go Around thrust single AP operation, ALT ACQ is
and the FMA shows N1 mode. The inhibited, the STAB OUT OF TRIM and the FMA shows N1 mode. The inhibited, the STAB OUT OF TRIM
AFDS annunciates TOGA. Pressing a light on the Captain's instrument panel AFDS annunciates TOGA. Pressing a light on the Captain's instrument panel
TOGA switch when above 2,000' RA will illuminate, the AP disengage TOGA switch when above 2,000' RA will illuminate, the AP disengage
will result in no change in FD or AT lights come on steady red, and pitch will result in no change in FD or AT lights come on steady red, and pitch
operation, but will cause AP AP will remain in GA. This is one of operation, but will cause AP AP will remain in GA. This is one of
disconnect. If the RA is invalid, FD only two conditions in which the disconnect. If the RA is invalid, FD only two conditions in which the
and AT GA is possible below 15,000' AFDS will fly through the MCP and AT GA is possible below 15,000' AFDS will fly through the MCP
baro altitude. The AP GA mode selected altitude. The other is at baro altitude. The AP GA mode selected altitude. The other is at
requires dual AP operation, and is Glideslope capture. No other AP requires dual AP operation, and is Glideslope capture. No other AP
available only after FLARE armed is modes will be available until auto stab available only after FLARE armed is modes will be available until auto stab
annunciated. FLARE armed is trimming takes out the Flare Spring annunciated. FLARE armed is trimming takes out the Flare Spring
annunciated only after successful FCC Bias, or both AP's are disconnected. annunciated only after successful FCC Bias, or both AP's are disconnected.
self tests and cross channel checks. The warning lights can be turned off self tests and cross channel checks. The warning lights can be turned off
This test begins after descending by manually disconnecting the AP's, This test begins after descending by manually disconnecting the AP's,
through 1,500' RA, if both AP or by selecting a higher altitude on the through 1,500' RA, if both AP or by selecting a higher altitude on the
switches are in CMD before reaching MCP. switches are in CMD before reaching MCP.
800' RA. -AT Go Around Control 800' RA. -AT Go Around Control
-AP Go Around Roll Control -The AT, if engaged, will advance the -AP Go Around Roll Control -The AT, if engaged, will advance the
-With the GA mode engaged, the AP's throttles to reduced Go Around N1 -With the GA mode engaged, the AP's throttles to reduced Go Around N1
control roll to maintain the airplane limit, based on airplane weight and control roll to maintain the airplane limit, based on airplane weight and
ground track existing at GA altitude, calculated by the AT ground track existing at GA altitude, calculated by the AT
engagement. Other AP roll modes are computer. Maximum Go Around engagement. Other AP roll modes are computer. Maximum Go Around
available above 400' RA. thrust may be selected by pushing available above 400' RA. thrust may be selected by pushing
-AP Go Around Pitch Control either Take Off Go Around (TOGA) -AP Go Around Pitch Control either Take Off Go Around (TOGA)
-During AP GA, the AP will initially switch a second time. This maximum -During AP GA, the AP will initially switch a second time. This maximum
command 15 degrees nose up, and the N1 limit is calculated by the FMC. If command 15 degrees nose up, and the N1 limit is calculated by the FMC. If
MCP speed window will blank. After the AT is armed at the point of altitude MCP speed window will blank. After the AT is armed at the point of altitude
a positive climb is established, the AP acquisition, the AT will engage in a positive climb is established, the AP acquisition, the AT will engage in
will maintain a maneuvering speed MCP SPD, and will hold the current will maintain a maneuvering speed MCP SPD, and will hold the current
schedule based upon manually airspeed displayed on the MCP. schedule based upon manually airspeed displayed on the MCP.
retracted flap positions. With pitch -Leaving the GA mode retracted flap positions. With pitch -Leaving the GA mode
engaged in GA, and the stabilizer -If a TOGA switch is pressed when engaged in GA, and the stabilizer -If a TOGA switch is pressed when
position satisfactory for single AP below 2,000', but before FLARE position satisfactory for single AP below 2,000', but before FLARE
operation, ALT ACQ engages when armed is annunciated (at or below operation, ALT ACQ engages when armed is annunciated (at or below
approaching the previously selected 1,500'), the AT will enter the TOGA approaching the previously selected 1,500'), the AT will enter the TOGA
missed approach altitude. The 2nd AP mode, and set thrust to a reduced Go missed approach altitude. The 2nd AP mode, and set thrust to a reduced Go
engaged into CMD will disengage. At Around level. The AP, if engaged, will engaged into CMD will disengage. At Around level. The AP, if engaged, will
altitude acquisition, the current disconnect, because the AP GA mode altitude acquisition, the current disconnect, because the AP GA mode
airspeed will appear in the MCP speed is inhibited before FLARE armed is airspeed will appear in the MCP speed is inhibited before FLARE armed is
window. The AP will annunciate ALT annunciated, or if 2 seconds has window. The AP will annunciate ALT annunciated, or if 2 seconds has
ACQ, and then ALT HOLD. If elapsed since touchdown, as sensed by ACQ, and then ALT HOLD. If elapsed since touchdown, as sensed by

and
OCT 99Systems Introduction 22-25 OCT 99 22-25
UNITED
B737 GENERAL AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
AUTOFLIGHT AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE AUTOFLIGHT AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

wheel spin up of more than 60 knots. disconnected the AP to manually fly wheel spin up of more than 60 knots. disconnected the AP to manually fly
When the Approach mode is engaged the landing. If a TOGA switch is When the Approach mode is engaged the landing. If a TOGA switch is
with one AP, pushing either TOGA pressed during a single channel with one AP, pushing either TOGA pressed during a single channel
switch will cause the AP to approach, the AP disconnects. FD Go switch will cause the AP to approach, the AP disconnects. FD Go
disconnect. When a new pitch mode is Around mode is armed for disconnect. When a new pitch mode is Around mode is armed for
selected, the 2nd AP engaged into engagement when below 2,000', both selected, the 2nd AP engaged into engagement when below 2,000', both
command will automatically FD's on, and not in the takeoff mode. command will automatically FD's on, and not in the takeoff mode.
disconnect. If another roll mode has Single AP approach operation is the disconnect. If another roll mode has Single AP approach operation is the
not been selected, the remaining AP same as dual, with the following not been selected, the remaining AP same as dual, with the following
will revert to CWS roll. The light in exceptions: will revert to CWS roll. The light in exceptions:
the CMD switch will remain ON -Full automatic flare and touchdown the CMD switch will remain ON -Full automatic flare and touchdown
because the first AP to CMD remains capability is not available. FLARE is because the first AP to CMD remains capability is not available. FLARE is
engaged. If the roll mode is changed not annunciated. engaged. If the roll mode is changed not annunciated.
first, roll control reverts to single -The stabilizer Flare Spring Bias is not first, roll control reverts to single -The stabilizer Flare Spring Bias is not
channel authority. Pitch control is still applied during approach. channel authority. Pitch control is still applied during approach.
under dual channel operation, in the -If the AP disconnects above 400', the under dual channel operation, in the -If the AP disconnects above 400', the
Go Around mode. AP can be reengaged if engage criteria Go Around mode. AP can be reengaged if engage criteria
-Approach (APP) Mode - Single AP are met. Below 400', the AP cannot be -Approach (APP) Mode - Single AP are met. Below 400', the AP cannot be
-The lowest weather minimums reengaged. -The lowest weather minimums reengaged.
allowable for a single channel, or -An AP Go Around is not available. If allowable for a single channel, or -An AP Go Around is not available. If
Category II approach, is a RVR of at a TOGA switch is pressed when only Category II approach, is a RVR of at a TOGA switch is pressed when only
least 1,200'. A CAT II, or single one AP is engaged, the AP will least 1,200'. A CAT II, or single one AP is engaged, the AP will
channel AP approach, is not normally disconnect. channel AP approach, is not normally disconnect.
used by the crew. Single AP -The AP is manually disconnected at used by the crew. Single AP -The AP is manually disconnected at
approaches are limited to Category II or before reaching 100' RA. The approaches are limited to Category II or before reaching 100' RA. The
operations only, known to the crews as remainder of the approach and landing operations only, known to the crews as remainder of the approach and landing
"Monitored Approach Manual Land". or Go Around is flown by the crew. "Monitored Approach Manual Land". or Go Around is flown by the crew.
The only time the crew is allowed to -Flight Director Go Around Mode The only time the crew is allowed to -Flight Director Go Around Mode
plan for and execute a single channel -Several criteria must be met before plan for and execute a single channel -Several criteria must be met before
approach is when either the crew, the FD will engage in the Go Around approach is when either the crew, the FD will engage in the Go Around
airplane or airport is certified only for mode: airplane or airport is certified only for mode:
CAT II operations. An example of this -In flight, below 2,000' RA, and not in CAT II operations. An example of this -In flight, below 2,000' RA, and not in
would be if one AP is inoperative. the takeoff mode. would be if one AP is inoperative. the takeoff mode.
This would place the airplane in CAT -One or neither AP engaged to CMD. This would place the airplane in CAT -One or neither AP engaged to CMD.
II-only status. During single channel -TOGA switch pressed. II-only status. During single channel -TOGA switch pressed.
AP approach, use of Auto-Manual -FD switches may be ON or OFF. If AP approach, use of Auto-Manual -FD switches may be ON or OFF. If
switch, ILS tuning, Course selection, OFF, the FD bars come into view switch, ILS tuning, Course selection, OFF, the FD bars come into view
use of APP switch, LOC and GS automatically, (called a pop-up use of APP switch, LOC and GS automatically, (called a pop-up
capture, and FD operation are the feature). TOGA is annunciated for the capture, and FD operation are the feature). TOGA is annunciated for the
same as for dual AP APP. At CAT II FD pitch mode, the MCP Speed same as for dual AP APP. At CAT II FD pitch mode, the MCP Speed
Decision Height of 100', the AP window blanks, and the Mach/ Decision Height of 100', the AP window blanks, and the Mach/
manual disconnect point is reached. Airspeed indicator cursors are manual disconnect point is reached. Airspeed indicator cursors are
By now the crew must have positioned to the maneuvering speed By now the crew must have positioned to the maneuvering speed

22-26 and Systems Introduction OCT 99 22-26 OCT 99


UNITED AIRLINES COURSE
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
AUTOFLIGHT AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE AUTOFLIGHT AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

for the existing flap setting. to 15 knots above the minimum speed. for the existing flap setting. to 15 knots above the minimum speed.
-Flight Director Takeoff Mode Overspeed is displayed when the airplane -Flight Director Takeoff Mode Overspeed is displayed when the airplane
-Both FD's must be ON to engage the speed is greater than the VMO limit or -Both FD's must be ON to engage the speed is greater than the VMO limit or
takeoff mode prior to starting the speed is within 2 knots of the flap or gear takeoff mode prior to starting the speed is within 2 knots of the flap or gear
takeoff. The FD Takeoff mode is placard. takeoff. The FD Takeoff mode is placard.
engaged by pressing the TOGA switch NOTE: Operation is independent of the engaged by pressing the TOGA switch NOTE: Operation is independent of the
on either throttle. The AFDS stall warning and Mach airspeed warn- on either throttle. The AFDS stall warning and Mach airspeed warn-
annunciation is TOGA. Initial FD ing systems. annunciation is TOGA. Initial FD ing systems.
commands are 10 degrees nose-down commands are 10 degrees nose-down
for pitch, and wings level for roll. At Command Speed Limiting for pitch, and wings level for roll. At Command Speed Limiting
60 knots IAS, the FD pitch command The AFCS provides pitch and thrust speed 60 knots IAS, the FD pitch command The AFCS provides pitch and thrust speed
changes to 15 degrees nose-up and roll commands to avoid exceeding the VMO/ changes to 15 degrees nose-up and roll commands to avoid exceeding the VMO/
remains wings level. If the FD MMO limit speeds, wing flap placard remains wings level. If the FD MMO limit speeds, wing flap placard
switches are OFF, the FD bars come speeds, landing gear placard speed, and switches are OFF, the FD bars come speeds, landing gear placard speed, and
into view automatically during the minimum speed (maximum angle of into view automatically during the minimum speed (maximum angle of
takeoff roll, (called a pop-up feature). attack). The command speed may be equal takeoff roll, (called a pop-up feature). attack). The command speed may be equal
The FD provides pitch commands to, but will not exceed, a limit speed. Dif- The FD provides pitch commands to, but will not exceed, a limit speed. Dif-
after lift-off. It continues to command ferent flap settings have different placard after lift-off. It continues to command ferent flap settings have different placard
15 degrees pitch up until a positive speed limits. Minimum speed is based on 15 degrees pitch up until a positive speed limits. Minimum speed is based on
climb rate is achieved. It then angle of attack and is approximately 1.3 climb rate is achieved. It then angle of attack and is approximately 1.3
commands pitch to maintain 20 knots times the stalling speed for the current flap commands pitch to maintain 20 knots times the stalling speed for the current flap
above the MCP speed (V2+20). FD configuration. It is sensed by the angle of above the MCP speed (V2+20). FD configuration. It is sensed by the angle of
roll commands after takeoff are to hold attack (alpha) vanes. If a speed greater roll commands after takeoff are to hold attack (alpha) vanes. If a speed greater
the wings level or go to HDG SEL than a placard speed, or less than mini- the wings level or go to HDG SEL than a placard speed, or less than mini-
mode. To terminate the takeoff mode mum speed is selected, the AFCS allows mode. To terminate the takeoff mode mum speed is selected, the AFCS allows
when below 400' RA, both FD acceleration or deceleration to slightly when below 400' RA, both FD acceleration or deceleration to slightly
switches must be turned OFF. Above short of the limit, then commands the limit switches must be turned OFF. Above short of the limit, then commands the limit
400' RA, the takeoff mode may be speed. The overspeed or underspeed sym- 400' RA, the takeoff mode may be speed. The overspeed or underspeed sym-
terminated by selecting other pitch bol, as appropriate, appears in the MCP terminated by selecting other pitch bol, as appropriate, appears in the MCP
modes. speed window. Either pitch or thrust, modes. speed window. Either pitch or thrust,
whichever is engaged in a speed mode, whichever is engaged in a speed mode,
COMMAND SPEED LIMITING AND attempts to hold the limit speed. COMMAND SPEED LIMITING AND attempts to hold the limit speed.
REVERSION MODES Reversion Modes REVERSION MODES Reversion Modes
AFCS command limiting and reversion is During some flight situations, speed con- AFCS command limiting and reversion is During some flight situations, speed con-
designed to prevent the AFCS from creat- trol by the AFDS or AT alone may be designed to prevent the AFCS from creat- trol by the AFDS or AT alone may be
ing an overspeed or underspeed condition. insufficient to prevent exceeding a limit ing an overspeed or underspeed condition. insufficient to prevent exceeding a limit
The MCP IAS/MACH window has flash- speed. If this occurs, AFDS and/or AT The MCP IAS/MACH window has flash- speed. If this occurs, AFDS and/or AT
ing warning flags for underspeed and modes automatically revert to a more ing warning flags for underspeed and modes automatically revert to a more
overspeed in the left most LCD position. effective combination. The reversion overspeed in the left most LCD position. effective combination. The reversion
Underspeed (A) is displayed if the air- modes are either placard limit reversion, Underspeed (A) is displayed if the air- modes are either placard limit reversion,
plane speed is decreased to the minimum performance limit reversion, or minimum plane speed is decreased to the minimum performance limit reversion, or minimum
speed except in TO or GA. The "A" airspeed reversion. Mode reversion occurs speed except in TO or GA. The "A" airspeed reversion. Mode reversion occurs
remains until the speed has been increased slightly before reaching the limit speed. remains until the speed has been increased slightly before reaching the limit speed.

and
OCT 99Systems Introduction 22-27 OCT 99 22-27
UNITED
B737 GENERAL AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
AUTOFLIGHT AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE AUTOFLIGHT AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

Both the AFDS and the AT have reversion and control parameter selection for alti- Both the AFDS and the AT have reversion and control parameter selection for alti-
modes which activate according to the tude alert, AP, FD, AT, and to a limited modes which activate according to the tude alert, AP, FD, AT, and to a limited
condition causing the reversion. extent, the FMCS. All FCC signals to or condition causing the reversion. extent, the FMCS. All FCC signals to or
from the FMC and AT pass through the from the FMC and AT pass through the
ROLL AND PITCH CHANNEL MCP. The master FCC, selected by the ROLL AND PITCH CHANNEL MCP. The master FCC, selected by the
OPERATION MCP, controls the mode for the AFDS OPERATION MCP, controls the mode for the AFDS
System A interfaces with the #1 electrical active mode. An FCC's AP and FD cap- System A interfaces with the #1 electrical active mode. An FCC's AP and FD cap-
power system, system A hydraulic power ture logic is the same, but each FCC ini- power system, system A hydraulic power ture logic is the same, but each FCC ini-
and the Captain's instruments, compass, tiates its own mode capture. Two course and the Captain's instruments, compass, tiates its own mode capture. Two course
air data and navigation systems. System B selectors and course windows, for use in air data and navigation systems. System B selectors and course windows, for use in
interfaces #2 electrical power system, sys- the VOR/LOC or APP modes, are located interfaces #2 electrical power system, sys- the VOR/LOC or APP modes, are located
tem B hydraulic power and the First on the MCP. Rotating the Captain's course tem B hydraulic power and the First on the MCP. Rotating the Captain's course
Officer's instruments, compass, air data selector sets the desired course in the dis- Officer's instruments, compass, air data selector sets the desired course in the dis-
and navigation systems. Both DFCS sys- play window, and provides selected and navigation systems. Both DFCS sys- play window, and provides selected
tems receive L and R IRS attitude and course information to FCC A, the No. 1 tems receive L and R IRS attitude and course information to FCC A, the No. 1
heading sources. Although the operation VHF NAV receiver and the Captain's HSI heading sources. Although the operation VHF NAV receiver and the Captain's HSI
of the AP's and FD's are highly integrated, course pointer. The First Officer's course of the AP's and FD's are highly integrated, course pointer. The First Officer's course
they may be used separately. The systems selector sets the desired course in the dis- they may be used separately. The systems selector sets the desired course in the dis-
A & B are isolated to provide two com- play window, and provides selected A & B are isolated to provide two com- play window, and provides selected
pletely independent systems. Indepen- course information to FCC B, the No. 2 pletely independent systems. Indepen- course information to FCC B, the No. 2
dence of each system channel is assured VHF NAV receiver and to the First dence of each system channel is assured VHF NAV receiver and to the First
by isolation of power supplies, sensors, Officer's HSI course pointer. The HEAD- by isolation of power supplies, sensors, Officer's HSI course pointer. The HEAD-
computers, airplane wire bundles and ING control knob provides 360 degrees of computers, airplane wire bundles and ING control knob provides 360 degrees of
shelf wiring harnesses. Each FCC inter- heading setting per revolution. The shelf wiring harnesses. Each FCC inter- heading setting per revolution. The
faces with analog, discrete, and digital smaller concentric knob selects the faces with analog, discrete, and digital smaller concentric knob selects the
data signals, digitally processed to provide HEADING and the larger knob selects the data signals, digitally processed to provide HEADING and the larger knob selects the
guidance commands for the AP and FD BANK LIMIT. Each knob detent provides guidance commands for the AP and FD BANK LIMIT. Each knob detent provides
systems. Analog to digital (A/D) and digi- 1 degree of heading setting. Both HSI systems. Analog to digital (A/D) and digi- 1 degree of heading setting. Both HSI
tal to analog (D/A) converters within the heading bugs display the selected heading. tal to analog (D/A) converters within the heading bugs display the selected heading.
computer provide system analog sensor The BANK LIMIT control is a 5 position computer provide system analog sensor The BANK LIMIT control is a 5 position
compatibility with the digital computer. switch for selection of desired bank angle compatibility with the digital computer. switch for selection of desired bank angle
The computer internally processes mode limit in 5 degree steps between 10 and 30 The computer internally processes mode limit in 5 degree steps between 10 and 30
control and command computations using degrees, used in the Heading Select or control and command computations using degrees, used in the Heading Select or
ARINC 429 digital data. VOR mode. The MCP utilizes both analog ARINC 429 digital data. VOR mode. The MCP utilizes both analog
NOTE: FCC's in -300's and -500's are and digital means for signal interface. An NOTE: FCC's in -300's and -500's are and digital means for signal interface. An
not interchangeable. Part number -912 ARINC 429 data bus sends digital FCC not interchangeable. Part number -912 ARINC 429 data bus sends digital FCC
and -913 may only be used on -300’s. - and MCP mode annunciation information and -913 may only be used on -300’s. - and MCP mode annunciation information
914 may only be used on -500’s. directly to both EFIS Symbol Generators 914 may only be used on -500’s. directly to both EFIS Symbol Generators
for display on the respective side ADI's. for display on the respective side ADI's.
Mode Control Panel Logic The MCP pushbutton switches each con- Mode Control Panel Logic The MCP pushbutton switches each con-
Mode selection is determined as a func- tain two replaceable lamps. The pushbut- Mode selection is determined as a func- tain two replaceable lamps. The pushbut-
tion of both the FCC and the MCP. The ton switches have hinged lens caps that tion of both the FCC and the MCP. The ton switches have hinged lens caps that
MCP provides for mode selection control can be opened to replace the lamps. Lamp MCP provides for mode selection control can be opened to replace the lamps. Lamp

22-28 and Systems Introduction OCT 99 22-28 OCT 99


UNITED AIRLINES COURSE
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
AUTOFLIGHT AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE AUTOFLIGHT AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

replacement tool, Honeywell part number any mode except dual channel Approach replacement tool, Honeywell part number any mode except dual channel Approach
4066608, may be used to replace the or Go Around, only one AP may be 4066608, may be used to replace the or Go Around, only one AP may be
lamps. Insert the flat bladed screwdriver engaged at one time. If the second AP is lamps. Insert the flat bladed screwdriver engaged at one time. If the second AP is
end of the tool into the top or bottom of selected to CMD or CWS during any end of the tool into the top or bottom of selected to CMD or CWS during any
the pushbutton switch lens cap and pull modes but APP or GA, it will synchronize the pushbutton switch lens cap and pull modes but APP or GA, it will synchronize
switch lamp assembly out of the MCP. through the cross channel data bus linking switch lamp assembly out of the MCP. through the cross channel data bus linking
CAUTION: Remove electrical power to both FCC's, to the mode and flight condi- CAUTION: Remove electrical power to both FCC's, to the mode and flight condi-
the MCP before replacing the lamps. tions of the first AP. The first AP will dis- the MCP before replacing the lamps. tions of the first AP. The first AP will dis-
See the MM for circuit breaker loca- engage. The second AP remains engaged. See the MM for circuit breaker loca- engage. The second AP remains engaged.
tion. Use correct pushbutton switch This channel swap is inhibited during APP tion. Use correct pushbutton switch This channel swap is inhibited during APP
lamps, part number #6839, to avoid mode. Both AP channels may be engaged lamps, part number #6839, to avoid mode. Both AP channels may be engaged
MCP damage. See MM 22-11-34. Use simultaneously to accomplish automatic MCP damage. See MM 22-11-34. Use simultaneously to accomplish automatic
correct lamps for the MCP FD MAS- approaches, Autoland and Go Around. correct lamps for the MCP FD MAS- approaches, Autoland and Go Around.
TER lights, part number # During dual channel operation, the ILS TER lights, part number # During dual channel operation, the ILS
OL7182BPE, to avoid MCP damage. Localizer deviation from left and right OL7182BPE, to avoid MCP damage. Localizer deviation from left and right
See MM 22-11-79. Don't scratch MCP navigation receivers is brought into both See MM 22-11-79. Don't scratch MCP navigation receivers is brought into both
face as cracks or light leaks may occur. FCC's to be averaged. This decreases nui- face as cracks or light leaks may occur. FCC's to be averaged. This decreases nui-
sance disengagements due to ILS receiver sance disengagements due to ILS receiver
Autopilot System tolerances. The CWS transducers are used Autopilot System tolerances. The CWS transducers are used
For AP operation, separate hydraulic sys- by the FCC's for low detent forces (to For AP operation, separate hydraulic sys- by the FCC's for low detent forces (to
tems supply pressure for the AP actuators determine engage interlock or initiation of tems supply pressure for the AP actuators determine engage interlock or initiation of
as well as the flight control Power Control CWS attitude changes) and high detent as well as the flight control Power Control CWS attitude changes) and high detent
Units (PCU's). AP "A" is powered by forces (to determine CWS override of a Units (PCU's). AP "A" is powered by forces (to determine CWS override of a
hydraulic system A, and AP "B" by CMD mode). The roll and pitch transduc- hydraulic system A, and AP "B" by CMD mode). The roll and pitch transduc-
hydraulic system B. AP actuators for pitch ers are physically interchangeable but they hydraulic system B. AP actuators for pitch ers are physically interchangeable but they
and roll are connected to the appropriate have different part numbers. and roll are connected to the appropriate have different part numbers.
control system linkage. Either AP A and/ Control Wheel Steering (CWS) control system linkage. Either AP A and/ Control Wheel Steering (CWS)
or AP B can be engaged for AP control of Control Wheel Steering (CWS) is used for or AP B can be engaged for AP control of Control Wheel Steering (CWS) is used for
the airplane to crew selected guidance manual control of the airplane through the the airplane to crew selected guidance manual control of the airplane through the
commands on the Mode Control Panel AP system. Pushing a CWS switch commands on the Mode Control Panel AP system. Pushing a CWS switch
(MCP). The autopilots operate in one of engages the respective AP to the CWS (MCP). The autopilots operate in one of engages the respective AP to the CWS
two status modes: COMMAND or CON- mode, and displays CWS PITCH and two status modes: COMMAND or CON- mode, and displays CWS PITCH and
TROL WHEEL STEERING. The CMD CWS ROLL on the FMA's. The AP TROL WHEEL STEERING. The CMD CWS ROLL on the FMA's. The AP
and CWS switches are push/light type maneuvers the airplane to select new pitch and CWS switches are push/light type maneuvers the airplane to select new pitch
switches, illuminated when pressed, indi- and roll attitudes, in response to control switches, illuminated when pressed, indi- and roll attitudes, in response to control
cating AP engage status. This status is wheel or control column forces applied by cating AP engage status. This status is wheel or control column forces applied by
shown on the FMA as either CWS, or either crew, and sensed by roll or pitch shown on the FMA as either CWS, or either crew, and sensed by roll or pitch
CMD. Pressing the switch again deselects transducers. The control pressures CMD. Pressing the switch again deselects transducers. The control pressures
engagement. If a CMD switch is pressed required to change attitude are similar to engagement. If a CMD switch is pressed required to change attitude are similar to
after one or both FD systems are operating that required for manual flight. When con- after one or both FD systems are operating that required for manual flight. When con-
in a roll and/or pitch command mode, that trol pressure is released, the AP holds the in a roll and/or pitch command mode, that trol pressure is released, the AP holds the
AP engages into the same mode as the FD, existing roll attitude or holds the heading, AP engages into the same mode as the FD, existing roll attitude or holds the heading,
if the existing FD command is small. In and holds pitch attitude. Pushing a CMD if the existing FD command is small. In and holds pitch attitude. Pushing a CMD

and
OCT 99Systems Introduction 22-29 OCT 99 22-29
UNITED
B737 GENERAL AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
AUTOFLIGHT AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE AUTOFLIGHT AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

switch engages the respective AP to the respectively. switch engages the respective AP to the respectively.
CWS mode, until an roll or pitch com- Flight Director System CWS mode, until an roll or pitch com- Flight Director System
mand mode switch is pressed. Roll AP can Each FCC processes its own FD com- mand mode switch is pressed. Roll AP can Each FCC processes its own FD com-
be in CWS while the pitch AP can be in a mands. If command roll and/or pitch be in CWS while the pitch AP can be in a mands. If command roll and/or pitch
command mode, or vice versa. Pressing a modes are engaged and the FD switch is command mode, or vice versa. Pressing a modes are engaged and the FD switch is
command mode switch on the MCP ON, roll and/or pitch command bars, command mode switch on the MCP ON, roll and/or pitch command bars,
engages the AP into that roll or pitch com- respectively, display the FCC command engages the AP into that roll or pitch com- respectively, display the FCC command
mand mode. Then the AP maneuvers the on the local ADI. The master FCC con- mand mode. Then the AP maneuvers the on the local ADI. The master FCC con-
airplane to fly according to computations trols the mode display on both FMA's. airplane to fly according to computations trols the mode display on both FMA's.
needed to satisfy the selected flight roll or Both FMA's annunciate the same status. needed to satisfy the selected flight roll or Both FMA's annunciate the same status.
pitch mode conditions. Pushing the roll or When the pitch or roll AP is operating in a pitch mode conditions. Pushing the roll or When the pitch or roll AP is operating in a
pitch command mode switch again will command mode, the FD, if ON, operates pitch command mode switch again will command mode, the FD, if ON, operates
disengage the command mode and return in the same pitch or roll mode as the AP, disengage the command mode and return in the same pitch or roll mode as the AP,
the AP to CWS ROLL or CWS PITCH, except the Takeoff mode. No AP TO is the AP to CWS ROLL or CWS PITCH, except the Takeoff mode. No AP TO is

FMC
FMC CDUs
CDUs

A/P ENGAGE
A/P ENGAGE A B
CMD
A B
CMD V NAV L NAV
MA MA
V NAV L NAV F/D F/D
MA MA CWS
F/D CWS F/D ON ON
ON ON

AFDS MCP
AFDS MCP

A B
A B FCC FCC
FCC FCC FD FD
FD FD COMMAND COMMAND
COMMAND COMMAND BARS BARS
BARS BARS

A HYD B HYD
A HYD B HYD SERVO SERVO
SERVO SERVO

HYD
HYD FLIGHT CONTROL
FLIGHT CONTROL ACTUATORS
ACTUATORS

FLIGHT CONTROL SURFACES


FLIGHT CONTROL SURFACES

Autopilot Flight Director System Block Diagram Autopilot Flight Director System Block Diagram

22-30 and Systems Introduction OCT 99 22-30 OCT 99


UNITED AIRLINES COURSE
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
AUTOFLIGHT AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE AUTOFLIGHT AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

possible, it is only a FD and AT mode. -With neither AP engaged in CMD, possible, it is only a FD and AT mode. -With neither AP engaged in CMD,
The FD's may be operated with or without the FCC for the first FD turned ON is The FD's may be operated with or without the FCC for the first FD turned ON is
the AP and AT. FD command modes may the master. the AP and AT. FD command modes may the master.
be used when an AP is operating in CWS. -With one or both AP's engaged in be used when an AP is operating in CWS. -With one or both AP's engaged in
In this case, the FMA will display FD, CMD, the FCC for the first AP in In this case, the FMA will display FD, CMD, the FCC for the first AP in
CWS PITCH and CWS ROLL, and the CMD is the master FCC, regardless of CWS PITCH and CWS ROLL, and the CMD is the master FCC, regardless of
selected command modes are being used which FD is turned on first. selected command modes are being used which FD is turned on first.
by the FD. The crew may fly the airplane -FCC failure causes the other FCC to by the FD. The crew may fly the airplane -FCC failure causes the other FCC to
manually using the FD with LNAV and be master. manually using the FD with LNAV and be master.
VNAV modes selected. In these modes, -DADC failure causes its foreign FCC VNAV modes selected. In these modes, -DADC failure causes its foreign FCC
all FMS optimization data are available to be master. all FMS optimization data are available to be master.
through the CDU and EHSI, with appro- Independent FCC through the CDU and EHSI, with appro- Independent FCC
priate bugs on the airspeed and thrust set- Upon glide slope capture, the FCC's start priate bugs on the airspeed and thrust set- Upon glide slope capture, the FCC's start
ting indicators, and FD guidance independent pitch operation with each ting indicators, and FD guidance independent pitch operation with each
commands on the EADI. The FD has no FCC controlling its respective FMA. The commands on the EADI. The FD has no FCC controlling its respective FMA. The
FLARE mode. FD command bars are Flight Directors may operate indepen- FLARE mode. FD command bars are Flight Directors may operate indepen-
removed from view at approximately 50' dently under certain conditions. Indepen- removed from view at approximately 50' dently under certain conditions. Indepen-
RA on an ILS approach. dent FD operation is indicated by both FD RA on an ILS approach. dent FD operation is indicated by both FD
NOTE: When operating in the VOR/ MA (master) lights coming on. This inde- NOTE: When operating in the VOR/ MA (master) lights coming on. This inde-
LOC mode, if both crew's VHF NAV pendent FD operation occurs when: LOC mode, if both crew's VHF NAV pendent FD operation occurs when:
frequencies and/or courses have not -Neither AP is engaged in CMD frequencies and/or courses have not -Neither AP is engaged in CMD
been set the same, their FD commands -Both FD switches are on been set the same, their FD commands -Both FD switches are on
will not agree. -And one of the following conditions will not agree. -And one of the following conditions
exist: exist:
Master FCC - 1) APP mode engaged with LOC and Master FCC - 1) APP mode engaged with LOC and
The master FCC is indicated by the MCP G/S captured, or The master FCC is indicated by the MCP G/S captured, or
local master (MA) light on. It performs the - 2) GA mode engaged and below 400' local master (MA) light on. It performs the - 2) GA mode engaged and below 400'
following: RA, or following: RA, or
-Drives MCP IAS/MACH and vertical - 3) T/O mode engaged and below 400' -Drives MCP IAS/MACH and vertical - 3) T/O mode engaged and below 400'
speed displays. RA. speed displays. RA.
-Selects both A & B FD cruise modes When independent operation is termi- -Selects both A & B FD cruise modes When independent operation is termi-
and either AP's mode. The master FCC nated, the FD light goes OFF on the non and either AP's mode. The master FCC nated, the FD light goes OFF on the non
drives both FMA's to annunciate the master side. Normally, both FD's must be drives both FMA's to annunciate the master side. Normally, both FD's must be
same AFDS status. ON to engage the Takeoff or Go Around same AFDS status. ON to engage the Takeoff or Go Around
-Enables the AT fast/slow output, mode. If a generator is lost during a FD -Enables the AT fast/slow output, mode. If a generator is lost during a FD
computed by the AT computer and takeoff or go around, the FCC on the unaf- computed by the AT computer and takeoff or go around, the FCC on the unaf-
shown on the ADI. fected side positions the FD command shown on the ADI. fected side positions the FD command
-Sends information to and from the bars on both ADI's. If the FD master light -Sends information to and from the bars on both ADI's. If the FD master light
FMC and AT. on the affected side had been on, it goes FMC and AT. on the affected side had been on, it goes
The master FCC is determined by the FCC off upon electrical bus transfer. The master FCC is determined by the FCC off upon electrical bus transfer.
bus select as follows: FCC Cross Channel Bus bus select as follows: FCC Cross Channel Bus
-With no FD or AP on, FCC A is Four ARINC 429 digital data buses carry -With no FD or AP on, FCC A is Four ARINC 429 digital data buses carry
master by default. information directly between both FCC's. master by default. information directly between both FCC's.

and
OCT 99Systems Introduction 22-31 OCT 99 22-31
UNITED
B737 GENERAL AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
AUTOFLIGHT AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE AUTOFLIGHT AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

These perform functions such as single AP limiting the maximum flow to the pressure These perform functions such as single AP limiting the maximum flow to the pressure
engaged channel swap, FLARE mode self regulator, and provides a time delay dur- engaged channel swap, FLARE mode self regulator, and provides a time delay dur-
tests for 2nd engaged AP, ground mainte- ing synchronization. The AP surface posi- tests for 2nd engaged AP, ground mainte- ing synchronization. The AP surface posi-
nance BITE, continuous monitoring, and tion sensor is switched into the FCC servo nance BITE, continuous monitoring, and tion sensor is switched into the FCC servo
maintenance monitoring for Inflight amplifier/transfer valve loop. This sensor maintenance monitoring for Inflight amplifier/transfer valve loop. This sensor
Faults. sees the position of the output crank. The Faults. sees the position of the output crank. The
Radio Altimeter FCC tells the transfer valve to move the Radio Altimeter FCC tells the transfer valve to move the
The radio altimeter (RA) drive signal is main piston to a position that coincides The radio altimeter (RA) drive signal is main piston to a position that coincides
used during final approach for AP and AT with the position of the AP surface posi- used during final approach for AP and AT with the position of the AP surface posi-
gain control, flare control, GA logic, and tion sensor. The FCC gets main actuator gain control, flare control, GA logic, and tion sensor. The FCC gets main actuator
dual channel engage logic. A valid local piston position from the LVDT. Second, dual channel engage logic. A valid local piston position from the LVDT. Second,
RA signal is required to engage the FCC after a short delay during this synchroniza- RA signal is required to engage the FCC after a short delay during this synchroniza-
into the APP mode. tion, the detent solenoid is energized. This into the APP mode. tion, the detent solenoid is energized. This
AP Actuator Operation pressurizes the detent pistons and move AP Actuator Operation pressurizes the detent pistons and move
The output cranks of both AP aileron actu- them into contact with the internal crank. The output cranks of both AP aileron actu- them into contact with the internal crank.
ators are linked together and connected to Since the main piston is synchronized to ators are linked together and connected to Since the main piston is synchronized to
the aileron input torque tube and upper the output crank prior to engagement, the aileron input torque tube and upper the output crank prior to engagement,
power control unit crank on the aileron rapid movement of the surface (kick) is power control unit crank on the aileron rapid movement of the surface (kick) is
quadrant assembly shaft. They control prevented when the AP is engaged. The quadrant assembly shaft. They control prevented when the AP is engaged. The
both aileron PCU's input rods. The AP ele- hydraulic pressure to the detent pistons is both aileron PCU's input rods. The AP ele- hydraulic pressure to the detent pistons is
vator actuators are linked together to the maintained greater than 615 psi by a pres- vator actuators are linked together to the maintained greater than 615 psi by a pres-
lower elevator torque tube and control sure regulator. The detent pressure switch lower elevator torque tube and control sure regulator. The detent pressure switch
input rods to both elevator PCU's. An AP now sees this pressure, completing the input rods to both elevator PCU's. An AP now sees this pressure, completing the
actuator, via the transfer valve, converts required FCC engage hold circuit. Now actuator, via the transfer valve, converts required FCC engage hold circuit. Now
an electrical signal from the FCC to a the AP is fully engaged. If hydraulic an electrical signal from the FCC to a the AP is fully engaged. If hydraulic
hydraulic signal which drives the main switch pressure is lost, the AP will disen- hydraulic signal which drives the main switch pressure is lost, the AP will disen-
piston. The actuator position transducer gage. Any command to the transfer valve piston. The actuator position transducer gage. Any command to the transfer valve
(LVDT), provides a feedback signal to the positions a jetpipe. The jetpipe then posi- (LVDT), provides a feedback signal to the positions a jetpipe. The jetpipe then posi-
FCC. Prior to AP engage, the actuator tions a control spool to direct the hydraulic FCC. Prior to AP engage, the actuator tions a control spool to direct the hydraulic
solenoid and the detent solenoid are deen- pressure to operate the main piston. This solenoid and the detent solenoid are deen- pressure to operate the main piston. This
ergized. Without hydraulic pressure avail- rotates the output crank. The rate orifices ergized. Without hydraulic pressure avail- rotates the output crank. The rate orifices
able, the detent piston springs keep the limit the rate of movement of the main pis- able, the detent piston springs keep the limit the rate of movement of the main pis-
detent pistons away from the output crank. tons. LVDT gives a position feedback sig- detent pistons away from the output crank. tons. LVDT gives a position feedback sig-
The crank is free to move as the flight con- nal to the FCC. Linkage connects the The crank is free to move as the flight con- nal to the FCC. Linkage connects the
trol system moves. Actuator engagement output from either AP actuator to the input trol system moves. Actuator engagement output from either AP actuator to the input
is in two stages. When the CWS or CMD torque tube at both PCU's. The crew can is in two stages. When the CWS or CMD torque tube at both PCU's. The crew can
AP switch is pushed, that switch light physically override the AP, with force AP switch is pushed, that switch light physically override the AP, with force
assembly illuminates. This energizes the applied through the detent piston via the assembly illuminates. This energizes the applied through the detent piston via the
actuator solenoid valve, pressurizes the output crank. The relief valve opens, rout- actuator solenoid valve, pressurizes the output crank. The relief valve opens, rout-
transfer servo valve and the pressure port ing fluid from the detent piston to return. transfer servo valve and the pressure port ing fluid from the detent piston to return.
of the detent solenoid. A flow restrictor Two shear pins on each AP actuator crank of the detent solenoid. A flow restrictor Two shear pins on each AP actuator crank
located between the engage solenoids pro- allows the crew to override a jammed located between the engage solenoids pro- allows the crew to override a jammed
vides protection against overpressure by actuator by applying extra force to the vides protection against overpressure by actuator by applying extra force to the

22-32 and Systems Introduction OCT 99 22-32 OCT 99


UNITED AIRLINES COURSE
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
AUTOFLIGHT AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE AUTOFLIGHT AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

control wheel. During dual channel opera- degrees of aileron and B commands 20 control wheel. During dual channel opera- degrees of aileron and B commands 20
tion, both channels normally produce degrees, the two AP actuators, move the tion, both channels normally produce degrees, the two AP actuators, move the
identical commands and move the control surface 5 degrees. When B tries to move identical commands and move the control surface 5 degrees. When B tries to move
surface. If the commands differ, the actua- the surface the extra 15 degrees, it cannot surface. If the commands differ, the actua- the surface the extra 15 degrees, it cannot
tor override feature prevents hardover overcome the feel force and the detent tor override feature prevents hardover overcome the feel force and the detent
maneuvers by limiting surface movement pressure in the A actuator. Therefore, the maneuvers by limiting surface movement pressure in the A actuator. Therefore, the
to the channel with the smaller command. detent piston pressure in channel AP B to the channel with the smaller command. detent piston pressure in channel AP B
This is called "fail-passive" operation. For actuator is relieved through the pressure This is called "fail-passive" operation. For actuator is relieved through the pressure
example, if channel A commands 5 relief valve and the control surface posi- example, if channel A commands 5 relief valve and the control surface posi-

RATE LIMITING RATE LIMITING


ORIFICES DETENT CONTROL ORIFICES DETENT CONTROL
DETENT ENGAGE ORIFICE DETENT ENGAGE ORIFICE
SOLENOID SOLENOID
CONTROL SPOOL ACTUATOR SOLENOID CONTROL SPOOL ACTUATOR SOLENOID

AUTOPILOT FILTER AUTOPILOT FILTER


TRANSFER TRANSFER
VALVE FILTER VALVE FILTER

PRESSURE PORT PRESSURE PORT

A/P SIGNAL RETURN PORT A/P SIGNAL RETURN PORT


INPUT JET INPUT JET
PIPE PIPE
PRESSURE PRESSURE
SWITCH DETENT SWITCH DETENT
PISTONS PISTONS

ACTUATOR ACTUATOR
POSITION POSITION
SENSOR SENSOR
( LVDT ) ( LVDT )

INTERNAL INTERNAL
PRESSURE REGULATOR OUTPUT PRESSURE REGULATOR OUTPUT
AND RELIEF VALVE CRANK AND RELIEF VALVE CRANK

DETENT EXTERNAL DETENT EXTERNAL


SPRINGS OUTPUT SPRINGS OUTPUT
CRANK CRANK

AP Actuator Operation Schematic AP Actuator Operation Schematic

and
OCT 99Systems Introduction 22-33 OCT 99 22-33
UNITED
B737 GENERAL AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
AUTOFLIGHT AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE AUTOFLIGHT AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

tion remains at 5 degrees. The main piston condition and results in dual channel dis- tion remains at 5 degrees. The main piston condition and results in dual channel dis-
in the B actuator moves to a position rep- connect. The monitor circuit is discussed in the B actuator moves to a position rep- connect. The monitor circuit is discussed
resenting 20 degrees. The dual channel further in the engage and warning moni- resenting 20 degrees. The dual channel further in the engage and warning moni-
monitor circuits compare the surface posi- tors section. monitor circuits compare the surface posi- tors section.
tion of 5 degrees with the AP B actuator tion of 5 degrees with the AP B actuator
LVDT of 20 degrees. This is a camout LVDT of 20 degrees. This is a camout

22-34 and Systems Introduction OCT 99 22-34 OCT 99


UNITED AIRLINES COURSE
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
AUTOFLIGHT AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE AUTOFLIGHT AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION
ROLL CHANNEL OPERATION with the AP not engaged or engaged in ROLL CHANNEL OPERATION with the AP not engaged or engaged in
The purpose of both FCC's roll control, is CWS. The FCC also provides AP com- The purpose of both FCC's roll control, is CWS. The FCC also provides AP com-
to provide lateral axis, flight directed con- mands to automatically operate the flight to provide lateral axis, flight directed con- mands to automatically operate the flight
trol, using manual operated flight controls controls using the AP in CMD. The "A" trol, using manual operated flight controls controls using the AP in CMD. The "A"

Roll Control Block Diagram Roll Control Block Diagram

and
OCT 99Systems Introduction 22-35 OCT 99 22-35
UNITED
B737 GENERAL AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
AUTOFLIGHT AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE AUTOFLIGHT AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

and "B" FCC's have separate AP com- hydraulic signal. This is used in the AP and "B" FCC's have separate AP com- hydraulic signal. This is used in the AP
mand signal processing to operate their actuator to drive an output arm, to mand signal processing to operate their actuator to drive an output arm, to
respective system aileron AP actuator. mechanically move the input torque tube respective system aileron AP actuator. mechanically move the input torque tube
Either provides the same mechanical input of both PCU's. Aileron actuator position Either provides the same mechanical input of both PCU's. Aileron actuator position
to both aileron PCU's. The FCC uses both transducer (LVDT) feedback signal tells to both aileron PCU's. The FCC uses both transducer (LVDT) feedback signal tells
input and output signals. The analog the FCC that the actuator answered the AP input and output signals. The analog the FCC that the actuator answered the AP
inputs to the FCC originate from the roll command. The aileron surface position inputs to the FCC originate from the roll command. The aileron surface position
force transducer, VHF navigation receiver sensor signal tells the FCC when the aile- force transducer, VHF navigation receiver sensor signal tells the FCC when the aile-
and Low Range Radio Altimeter (LRRA). rons are faired, and how much to move the and Low Range Radio Altimeter (LRRA). rons are faired, and how much to move the
These are connected to an analog to digital ailerons to get them back to faired, once These are connected to an analog to digital ailerons to get them back to faired, once
(A/D) converter inside the FCC for inter- the mode required corrections are accom- (A/D) converter inside the FCC for inter- the mode required corrections are accom-
nal processing. The signals for all compu- plished. Operation from this point is the nal processing. The signals for all compu- plished. Operation from this point is the
tation processing, gain control, AP and FD same as manual flight control operation. tation processing, gain control, AP and FD same as manual flight control operation.
commands, from the IRU, FMC, DADC, The AP roll command computer deter- commands, from the IRU, FMC, DADC, The AP roll command computer deter-
MCP, are digital processed by ARINC mines the roll command and roll rate, MCP, are digital processed by ARINC mines the roll command and roll rate,
429 receivers, within the FCC, for internal using spoiler position signals at flaps 429 receivers, within the FCC, for internal using spoiler position signals at flaps
use. Roll attitude and roll acceleration are greater than 27 units. An Aileron Force use. Roll attitude and roll acceleration are greater than 27 units. An Aileron Force
normally from the local IRU for FD oper- Limiter is installed on -300's to reduce the normally from the local IRU for FD oper- Limiter is installed on -300's to reduce the
ation, and from the foreign IRU for AP AP aileron output when the flaps are full ation, and from the foreign IRU for AP AP aileron output when the flaps are full
operation. The system uses both digital up, to prevent over control. This unit also operation. The system uses both digital up, to prevent over control. This unit also
and analog inputs for operating mode con- can prevent AP from engaging, even when and analog inputs for operating mode con- can prevent AP from engaging, even when
trol. Digital outputs are sent to an EFIS BITE says a flap switch is bad. trol. Digital outputs are sent to an EFIS BITE says a flap switch is bad.
Symbol Generator for EADI Flight Direc- NOTE: -500's have no Aileron Force Symbol Generator for EADI Flight Direc- NOTE: -500's have no Aileron Force
tor (FD) roll command bar movement and Limiter. -500's perform this function tor (FD) roll command bar movement and Limiter. -500's perform this function
to visually inform the crew of the mode with internal FCC software. This is one to visually inform the crew of the mode with internal FCC software. This is one
and status of the DFCS system. An inter- reason why only the part number -914 and status of the DFCS system. An inter- reason why only the part number -914
lock signal is sent to the Autoflight Status FCC may go into -500’s. lock signal is sent to the Autoflight Status FCC may go into -500’s.
Annunciator, to visually display for AP The FD signal processing is very similar Annunciator, to visually display for AP The FD signal processing is very similar
warning, failed, or BITE conditions. AP to the AP signal processing. AP Command warning, failed, or BITE conditions. AP to the AP signal processing. AP Command
engage logic is processed both in the MCP mode logic is used, but the FD command engage logic is processed both in the MCP mode logic is used, but the FD command
and the FCC, to determine mode selection. processing is accomplished as a separate and the FCC, to determine mode selection. processing is accomplished as a separate
Hydraulic solenoids in the AP actuator are control. The digital output is transmitted Hydraulic solenoids in the AP actuator are control. The digital output is transmitted
energized to activate AP control. The aile- to the EFIS Symbol Generator where it is energized to activate AP control. The aile- to the EFIS Symbol Generator where it is
ron position sensor is used prior to engag- processed to be displayed on the EADI. ron position sensor is used prior to engag- processed to be displayed on the EADI.
ing the AP, to allow the FCC to Each FCC provides an output to its ing the AP, to allow the FCC to Each FCC provides an output to its
synchronize the AP actuator to the surface selected EADI. However, in TOGA, or in synchronize the AP actuator to the surface selected EADI. However, in TOGA, or in
position. Once engaged, the digital roll AP an approach below 800', if a bus transfer position. Once engaged, the digital roll AP an approach below 800', if a bus transfer
command, computed to satisfy engaged takes place, the FD command is relayed command, computed to satisfy engaged takes place, the FD command is relayed
mode requirements, is converted to an from the other FCC. This information is mode requirements, is converted to an from the other FCC. This information is
analog command. The signal is then transmitted over the cross channel bus, analog command. The signal is then transmitted over the cross channel bus,
amplified and applied to the aileron AP received by the local FCC, and then con- amplified and applied to the aileron AP received by the local FCC, and then con-
actuator transfer/servo valve. The transfer verted to analog to be used as the FD com- actuator transfer/servo valve. The transfer verted to analog to be used as the FD com-
valve converts the electrical signal to a mand. valve converts the electrical signal to a mand.

22-36 and Systems Introduction OCT 99 22-36 OCT 99


UNITED AIRLINES COURSE
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
AUTOFLIGHT AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE AUTOFLIGHT AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

Autopilot Stabilizer Trim System of the flap position. Auto stab trim is Autopilot Stabilizer Trim System of the flap position. Auto stab trim is
The autopilot stabilizer trim system main- inhibited if the pitch force transducer The autopilot stabilizer trim system main- inhibited if the pitch force transducer
tains proper airplane trim with the AP stab senses Out of Detent (PCWS OD). AP tains proper airplane trim with the AP stab senses Out of Detent (PCWS OD). AP
trim actuator, under varying flight condi- stab trim authority is 0.25-14.0 units. The trim actuator, under varying flight condi- stab trim authority is 0.25-14.0 units. The
tions. These commands are provided by stab trim (AP) cutout switch, located on tions. These commands are provided by stab trim (AP) cutout switch, located on
the FCC using the speed trim system with the control stand, disconnects power to the the FCC using the speed trim system with the control stand, disconnects power to the
AP disengaged, or the AP automatic trim AP stabilizer trim servo motor. The AP is AP disengaged, or the AP automatic trim AP stabilizer trim servo motor. The AP is
used at all times that the AP is engaged. disengaged and AP engage is inhibited, if used at all times that the AP is engaged. disengaged and AP engage is inhibited, if
The AP provides AP Stab Trim System the auto stab trim cutout switch is placed The AP provides AP Stab Trim System the auto stab trim cutout switch is placed
inputs to the stabilizer at any time that it is to the CUTOUT position. The trim valid inputs to the stabilizer at any time that it is to the CUTOUT position. The trim valid
engaged. Different trim detection circuits logic monitor is used in the engage inter- engaged. Different trim detection circuits logic monitor is used in the engage inter-
are used depending on the mode of opera- lock circuit. If a trim up and trim down are used depending on the mode of opera- lock circuit. If a trim up and trim down
tion. A STAB OUT OF TRIM Warning exist at the same time, the AP disengages. tion. A STAB OUT OF TRIM Warning exist at the same time, the AP disengages.
light is illuminated if the stabilizer is out This logic is effective at all times; how- light is illuminated if the stabilizer is out This logic is effective at all times; how-
of trim while the AP is engaged. When the ever, the main use is during dual channel of trim while the AP is engaged. When the ever, the main use is during dual channel
elevator is at neutral, it is usually not operation. During dual channel operation elevator is at neutral, it is usually not operation. During dual channel operation
faired to the stabilizer. Neutral has been stabilizer trim commands are paralleled. faired to the stabilizer. Neutral has been stabilizer trim commands are paralleled.
shifted away from a faired position with Therefore, if one unit commands trim up shifted away from a faired position with Therefore, if one unit commands trim up
the stabilizer. This shifted neutral is used and the other trim down, both AP’s disen- the stabilizer. This shifted neutral is used and the other trim down, both AP’s disen-
in the design of this airplane to allow a gage. in the design of this airplane to allow a gage.
smaller horizontal stabilizer, creating a Stabilizer Trim Systems Warning smaller horizontal stabilizer, creating a Stabilizer Trim Systems Warning
lighter airframe. This system will auto- Lights lighter airframe. This system will auto- Lights
matically trim the horizontal stabilizer to The FCC's provide an output to warning matically trim the horizontal stabilizer to The FCC's provide an output to warning
maintain a neutral position of the elevator. light circuits based on operational status of maintain a neutral position of the elevator. light circuits based on operational status of
If the flaps are up, the FCC monitors the FCC controlled stabilizer trim systems. If the flaps are up, the FCC monitors the FCC controlled stabilizer trim systems.
AP pitch command to the AP elevator The SPEED TRIM FAIL caution annunci- AP pitch command to the AP elevator The SPEED TRIM FAIL caution annunci-
actuator. If the flaps are not up, the FCC ator, on the overhead P5 panel, only illu- actuator. If the flaps are not up, the FCC ator, on the overhead P5 panel, only illu-
compares the elevator position sensor minates when both FCC's provide fault compares the elevator position sensor minates when both FCC's provide fault
against the neutral shift sensor. These logic to speed trim light circuits. Warning against the neutral shift sensor. These logic to speed trim light circuits. Warning
inputs are used to determine the amount of light logic is based on input sensors being inputs are used to determine the amount of light logic is based on input sensors being
standing error command that is being sent valid. This includes N1 inputs, stabilizer standing error command that is being sent valid. This includes N1 inputs, stabilizer
to the stabilizer. Regardless of flap config- position, computed airspeed and altitude to the stabilizer. Regardless of flap config- position, computed airspeed and altitude
uration, the FCC strives to keep the eleva- rate. There must not be a simultaneous uration, the FCC strives to keep the eleva- rate. There must not be a simultaneous
tor in a neutral position, with regard to the trim up and trim down command. Stab tor in a neutral position, with regard to the trim up and trim down command. Stab
stabilizer. If the AP displaces the elevator, trim clutch wrap around must be present. stabilizer. If the AP displaces the elevator, trim clutch wrap around must be present.
the FCC controls the AP stabilizer trim The amber STAB OUT OF TRIM caution the FCC controls the AP stabilizer trim The amber STAB OUT OF TRIM caution
servo to drive the stabilizer nose up or light on the Captain's instrument panel servo to drive the stabilizer nose up or light on the Captain's instrument panel
nose down to bring the elevator back to will illuminate, if the FCC is unable to nose down to bring the elevator back to will illuminate, if the FCC is unable to
neutral. A flare spring bias is added. This maintain proper AP stabilizer trim. The neutral. A flare spring bias is added. This maintain proper AP stabilizer trim. The
signal is used to provide a nose up trim in light goes off if trim is reestablished. The signal is used to provide a nose up trim in light goes off if trim is reestablished. The
the event that the AP is disconnected dur- Stabilizer Out of Trim Light is illuminated the event that the AP is disconnected dur- Stabilizer Out of Trim Light is illuminated
ing a dual approach. The flap position by any of three different detectors. A ing a dual approach. The flap position by any of three different detectors. A
input is used to vary the bias as a function delay of 10 seconds prevents nuisance input is used to vary the bias as a function delay of 10 seconds prevents nuisance

and
OCT 99Systems Introduction 22-37 OCT 99 22-37
UNITED
B737 GENERAL AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
AUTOFLIGHT AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE AUTOFLIGHT AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

warnings. The stabilizer warning detector thrust flight conditions. This is during warnings. The stabilizer warning detector thrust flight conditions. This is during
conditions are: takeoff, go around, and occasionally conditions are: takeoff, go around, and occasionally
-Detector 1. This unit detects a approach if a higher than normal engine -Detector 1. This unit detects a approach if a higher than normal engine
difference of 3 degrees between the speed is used. The FCC's provides servo difference of 3 degrees between the speed is used. The FCC's provides servo
elevator position and elevator AP command signals to the AP stab trim actu- elevator position and elevator AP command signals to the AP stab trim actu-
actuator. This detector also activates a ator, to position the stabilizer. This main- actuator. This detector also activates a ator, to position the stabilizer. This main-
holding circuit which requires that the tains the correct airspeed, based on the holding circuit which requires that the tains the correct airspeed, based on the
elevator AP actuator commands be flap speed schedule. Positive speed stabil- elevator AP actuator commands be flap speed schedule. Positive speed stabil-
reduced to within 0.5 degrees of the ity is achieved when the combination of reduced to within 0.5 degrees of the ity is achieved when the combination of
neutral shift position. angle of attack, thrust, altitude and air- neutral shift position. angle of attack, thrust, altitude and air-
-Detector 2. This unit detects speed rate, flap and stabilizer position. -Detector 2. This unit detects speed rate, flap and stabilizer position.
movement of the stabilizer after the The FCC's contain a Speed Trim schedule movement of the stabilizer after the The FCC's contain a Speed Trim schedule
command is initiated. A stabilizer which determines the incremental stabi- command is initiated. A stabilizer which determines the incremental stabi-
movement of greater than 0.5 degrees lizer deviation from the stabilizer's last movement of greater than 0.5 degrees lizer deviation from the stabilizer's last
in 10 seconds is required to prevent a trimmed position as a function of airspeed in 10 seconds is required to prevent a trimmed position as a function of airspeed
warning. and rate parameters. If required, the stabi- warning. and rate parameters. If required, the stabi-
-Detector 3. This unit detects an lizer is then retrimmed, leading edge UP -Detector 3. This unit detects an lizer is then retrimmed, leading edge UP
elevator AP actuator position of or DOWN, using the AP stabilizer trim elevator AP actuator position of or DOWN, using the AP stabilizer trim
greater than 0.5 degrees from the servo. If the system trims the stabilizer greater than 0.5 degrees from the servo. If the system trims the stabilizer
neutral shift position. leading edge UP, the aircraft pitches nose neutral shift position. leading edge UP, the aircraft pitches nose
If the STAB OUT OF TRIM Light illumi- down, increasing airspeed for the pitch If the STAB OUT OF TRIM Light illumi- down, increasing airspeed for the pitch
nates with both pitch channels engaged in profile. If the system trims the stabilizer nates with both pitch channels engaged in profile. If the system trims the stabilizer
APP mode, and descended below 800' but leading edge DOWN, the aircraft pitches APP mode, and descended below 800' but leading edge DOWN, the aircraft pitches
prior to 100', a parallel circuit also turns nose up, decreasing airspeed for the pitch prior to 100', a parallel circuit also turns nose up, decreasing airspeed for the pitch
on the AP Warning light steady red. If the profile. on the AP Warning light steady red. If the profile.
AP red light is ON when descending Speed Trim Activation Requirements (all AP red light is ON when descending Speed Trim Activation Requirements (all
below 100', the AP Warning light remains must be met): below 100', the AP Warning light remains must be met):
ON unless the STAB OUT OF TRIM -AP NOT engaged (not in CMD or ON unless the STAB OUT OF TRIM -AP NOT engaged (not in CMD or
Light is extinguished. The STAB OUT OF CWS) Light is extinguished. The STAB OUT OF CWS)
TRIM Light is inhibited when both -N1 above 60% TRIM Light is inhibited when both -N1 above 60%
Glideslope and FLARE mode are engaged -Flaps not up (737-322), Flaps up or Glideslope and FLARE mode are engaged -Flaps not up (737-322), Flaps up or
(50' RA). However, this inhibit logic does not up (737-522) (50' RA). However, this inhibit logic does not up (737-522)
not extinguish the light if illuminated prior -Airspeed 90 to 250 Knots IAS (737- not extinguish the light if illuminated prior -Airspeed 90 to 250 Knots IAS (737-
to flare. The stabilizer trim warning light 322) Airspeed 90 Knots to 0.6 Mach to flare. The stabilizer trim warning light 322) Airspeed 90 Knots to 0.6 Mach
is only for a fault in AP stabilizer trim. It (737-522) is only for a fault in AP stabilizer trim. It (737-522)
does not indicate a problem with the -At lease 1 IRU aligned (737-522) does not indicate a problem with the -At lease 1 IRU aligned (737-522)
Speed Trim system, or with the Main -FCC speed trim circuit valid Speed Trim system, or with the Main -FCC speed trim circuit valid
Electric trim. -10 seconds have elapsed since liftoff Electric trim. -10 seconds have elapsed since liftoff
SPEED TRIM SYSTEM -5 seconds have elapsed since release SPEED TRIM SYSTEM -5 seconds have elapsed since release
The purpose of the Speed Trim system is of the main electric trim switches The purpose of the Speed Trim system is of the main electric trim switches
to ensure that during manually controlled -Sensing of a trim requirement to ensure that during manually controlled -Sensing of a trim requirement
flight (AP off), the aircraft maintains posi- The Speed Trim function is performed by flight (AP off), the aircraft maintains posi- The Speed Trim function is performed by
tive speed stability during low speed, high FCC A or B, only one channel is opera- tive speed stability during low speed, high FCC A or B, only one channel is opera-

22-38 and Systems Introduction OCT 99 22-38 OCT 99


UNITED AIRLINES COURSE
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
AUTOFLIGHT AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE AUTOFLIGHT AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

Speed Trim System Schematic Speed Trim System Schematic

and
OCT 99Systems Introduction 22-39 OCT 99 22-39
UNITED
B737 GENERAL AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
AUTOFLIGHT AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE AUTOFLIGHT AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

tional at any one time. If both FCC's are ming in the aircraft nose down direction tional at any one time. If both FCC's are ming in the aircraft nose down direction
operational and keep a continuous D.C. while on descent. The system is nor- operational and keep a continuous D.C. while on descent. The system is nor-
power source, the system select will alter- mally inactive during this phase of power source, the system select will alter- mally inactive during this phase of
nate between FCC's on each flight leg, as flight, because N1 is usually less than 60 nate between FCC's on each flight leg, as flight, because N1 is usually less than 60
a function of the squat switch input. That percent. However, if N1 was greater a function of the squat switch input. That percent. However, if N1 was greater
is, FCC A will handle Speed Trim on one than 60 percent during descent, uncom- is, FCC A will handle Speed Trim on one than 60 percent during descent, uncom-
flight leg, and FCC B will perform this manded stabilizer trim positioning may flight leg, and FCC B will perform this manded stabilizer trim positioning may
function on the next flight. be experienced. The system may trim in function on the next flight. be experienced. The system may trim in
Single Channel Fault either direction, depending upon its Single Channel Fault either direction, depending upon its
If one Speed Trim system senses a fault, computation of the examined flight If one Speed Trim system senses a fault, computation of the examined flight
the Speed Trim function will be automati- parameters. These occurrences may be the Speed Trim function will be automati- parameters. These occurrences may be
cally handed off to the other FCC. This normal operation of the system. Consult cally handed off to the other FCC. This normal operation of the system. Consult
single-channel fault is transparent to the MM service tips. single-channel fault is transparent to the MM service tips.
flight crew until a Master Caution recall is MACH TRIM SYSTEM (MTS) flight crew until a Master Caution recall is MACH TRIM SYSTEM (MTS)
accomplished. At that point, the MASTER The FCC provides automatic nose up ele- accomplished. At that point, the MASTER The FCC provides automatic nose up ele-
CAUTION light and the FLIGHT CON- vator trim commands, to maintain the cor- CAUTION light and the FLIGHT CON- vator trim commands, to maintain the cor-
TROLS annunciator on the Captain's rect attitude, when high cruise speeds TROLS annunciator on the Captain's rect attitude, when high cruise speeds
glareshield will remain illuminated. In cause airplane Mach tuck (nose down). glareshield will remain illuminated. In cause airplane Mach tuck (nose down).
addition, the SPEED TRIM light on the Displacement of the Mach Trim Actuator addition, the SPEED TRIM light on the Displacement of the Mach Trim Actuator
Flight Controls module (on the overhead (MTA) is a function of the FCC computed Flight Controls module (on the overhead (MTA) is a function of the FCC computed
P5 panel) will illuminate. signal, based on Mach data from the P5 panel) will illuminate. signal, based on Mach data from the
NOTE: The airplane may be dispatched DADC. This changes the position of the NOTE: The airplane may be dispatched DADC. This changes the position of the
with one Speed Trim system inopera- control column neutral point (neutral with one Speed Trim system inopera- control column neutral point (neutral
tive. Check the MEL. shift), without altering feel and force char- tive. Check the MEL. shift), without altering feel and force char-
acteristics. The MTA retrims the elevator acteristics. The MTA retrims the elevator
Dual Channel Fault through the elevator feel and centering Dual Channel Fault through the elevator feel and centering
In the event of a dual channel fault, the unit, the elevator lower torque tube, then In the event of a dual channel fault, the unit, the elevator lower torque tube, then
Master Caution light, FLIGHT CON- the elevator PCU's. The elevator PCU's Master Caution light, FLIGHT CON- the elevator PCU's. The elevator PCU's
TROLS annunciator, and SPEED TRIM position the upper torque tube to move the TROLS annunciator, and SPEED TRIM position the upper torque tube to move the
light will all illuminate immediately. elevator. Mach trim is functional whether light will all illuminate immediately. elevator. Mach trim is functional whether
These lights can be reset with the MAS- the AP is engaged or not. A nose up com- These lights can be reset with the MAS- the AP is engaged or not. A nose up com-
TER CAUTION light switch. The MCP mand output is provided proportionally to TER CAUTION light switch. The MCP mand output is provided proportionally to
recall can be pressed to verify that a Speed the MTA from 0.615 Mach until the max recall can be pressed to verify that a Speed the MTA from 0.615 Mach until the max
trim failure remains. If so, the SPEED input of 0.83M. The output passes through trim failure remains. If so, the SPEED input of 0.83M. The output passes through
TRIM light again illuminates. the AFC accessory unit (or IFSAU on - TRIM light again illuminates. the AFC accessory unit (or IFSAU on -
NOTE: The airplane cannot be dis- 500's) to the MTA. FCC A or B controls NOTE: The airplane cannot be dis- 500's) to the MTA. FCC A or B controls
patched with both Speed Trim systems the Mach trim system, only one channel is patched with both Speed Trim systems the Mach trim system, only one channel is
inoperative. Check the MEL. operational at any one time. The MTS inoperative. Check the MEL. operational at any one time. The MTS
NOTE: Flight crews have occasionally SEL (select) logic is used to determine NOTE: Flight crews have occasionally SEL (select) logic is used to determine
written up uncommanded stabilizer which FCC provides the Mach trim con- written up uncommanded stabilizer which FCC provides the Mach trim con-
trim in the aircraft nose up direction trol. When the FCC's are first powered up, trim in the aircraft nose up direction trol. When the FCC's are first powered up,
during climbout. Crews have also wit- channel A will be selected to provide during climbout. Crews have also wit- channel A will be selected to provide
nessed uncommanded stabilizer trim- Mach trim. If both FCC's are operational nessed uncommanded stabilizer trim- Mach trim. If both FCC's are operational

22-40 and Systems Introduction OCT 99 22-40 OCT 99


UNITED AIRLINES UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
AUTOFLIGHT AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE AUTOFLIGHT AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE

and Systems Introduction


Mach Trim System Schematic Mach Trim System Schematic
OCT 99 22-41 OCT 99 22-41
UNITED
B737 GENERAL AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
AUTOFLIGHT AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE AUTOFLIGHT AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

and keep a continuous D.C. power source, ALTITUDE ALERT SYSTEM and keep a continuous D.C. power source, ALTITUDE ALERT SYSTEM
an input from the squat switch after land- The altitude alert function provides visual an input from the squat switch after land- The altitude alert function provides visual
ing provides a toggle input which selects and aural warning to the crew when the ing provides a toggle input which selects and aural warning to the crew when the
B, if A was used on the last flight, and airplane baro corrected altitude from the B, if A was used on the last flight, and airplane baro corrected altitude from the
vice versa. If the local MTS valid logic is FCC computed altitude is approaching or vice versa. If the local MTS valid logic is FCC computed altitude is approaching or
not true, then the foreign channel provides deviating the selected altitude on the not true, then the foreign channel provides deviating the selected altitude on the
Mach trim. MCP. An FCC altitude accumulator com- Mach trim. MCP. An FCC altitude accumulator com-
Single Channel Fault putes altitude developed from DADC Single Channel Fault putes altitude developed from DADC
If one Mach Trim system senses a fault, information. The FCC sends a discrete If one Mach Trim system senses a fault, information. The FCC sends a discrete
the Mach Trim function will be automati- that illuminates visual altitude alert lights the Mach Trim function will be automati- that illuminates visual altitude alert lights
cally handed off to the other FCC. The P5- on the P1 and P2 panels, adjacent to each cally handed off to the other FCC. The P5- on the P1 and P2 panels, adjacent to each
3 Flight Control Module contains the light primary altimeter. It also gives an aural 3 Flight Control Module contains the light primary altimeter. It also gives an aural
for indicating a Mach trim failure. The warning tone to the Remote Electronics for indicating a Mach trim failure. The warning tone to the Remote Electronics
ground for the MACH TRIM fail light Unit, to be sent to the flight deck speakers. ground for the MACH TRIM fail light Unit, to be sent to the flight deck speakers.
passes through the two relaxed contacts of No warnings are issued while the airplane passes through the two relaxed contacts of No warnings are issued while the airplane
relays K1 and K2. If either FCC Mach is within prescribed limits from the relays K1 and K2. If either FCC Mach is within prescribed limits from the
trim system fails, the respective relay (K1 selected altitude. The altitude alert func- trim system fails, the respective relay (K1 selected altitude. The altitude alert func-
or K2) relaxes. This single channel failure tion is inhibited when making an approach or K2) relaxes. This single channel failure tion is inhibited when making an approach
is annunciated only when the Master Cau- to land as sensed by the Glideslope mode is annunciated only when the Master Cau- to land as sensed by the Glideslope mode
tion recall is pushed. Then the MACH captured, or by the flaps being lowered to tion recall is pushed. Then the MACH captured, or by the flaps being lowered to
TRIM light illuminates, showing the 20 units or greater. Loss of valid selected TRIM light illuminates, showing the 20 units or greater. Loss of valid selected
Mach trim failure status. baro corrected altitude, with neither Mach trim failure status. baro corrected altitude, with neither
NOTE: The airplane may be dispatched Glideslope captured nor Go Around mode NOTE: The airplane may be dispatched Glideslope captured nor Go Around mode
with one Mach Trim system inopera- engaged, will cause that channel's AP to with one Mach Trim system inopera- engaged, will cause that channel's AP to
tive. Check the MEL. disengage if in the CMD position. Also, tive. Check the MEL. disengage if in the CMD position. Also,
that channel's FD bars will Bias Out Of that channel's FD bars will Bias Out Of
Dual Channel Fault View and reset all modes. This is to Dual Channel Fault View and reset all modes. This is to
Both Mach trim system failures are emphasize to the crew that the automatic Both Mach trim system failures are emphasize to the crew that the automatic
required to illuminate the MACH TRIM MCP Altitude Acquire mode and the local required to illuminate the MACH TRIM MCP Altitude Acquire mode and the local
light without pressing the Recall Switch. altitude alert will not operate and that he is light without pressing the Recall Switch. altitude alert will not operate and that he is
This failure indication will also cause the now required to control and maintain the This failure indication will also cause the now required to control and maintain the
MASTER CAUTION and FLIGHT CON- clearance altitude. MASTER CAUTION and FLIGHT CON- clearance altitude.
TROLS annunciator lights to illuminate. Failure of the MCP, FCC, data bus, or TROLS annunciator lights to illuminate. Failure of the MCP, FCC, data bus, or
These lights can be reset with the MAS- both DADC's while in the air, may cause These lights can be reset with the MAS- both DADC's while in the air, may cause
TER CAUTION light switch. The MCP any of the following: TER CAUTION light switch. The MCP any of the following:
recall can be pressed to verify that a Mach -Altitude alert aural warning to sound recall can be pressed to verify that a Mach -Altitude alert aural warning to sound
trim failure remains. If so, the MACH every 10 seconds (Reset by rotating trim failure remains. If so, the MACH every 10 seconds (Reset by rotating
TRIM light again illuminates. the altitude select knob) TRIM light again illuminates. the altitude select knob)
NOTE: The airplane may be dispatched -Altitude alert lights to flash every 10 NOTE: The airplane may be dispatched -Altitude alert lights to flash every 10
with both Mach Trim systems inopera- seconds (Reset by rotating the altitude with both Mach Trim systems inopera- seconds (Reset by rotating the altitude
tive, provided elevator position is veri- select knob) tive, provided elevator position is veri- select knob)
fied. The airplane will have a speed -Selected Altitude display window to fied. The airplane will have a speed -Selected Altitude display window to
restriction. Check the MEL. stay at 50,000'. restriction. Check the MEL. stay at 50,000'.

22-42 and Systems Introduction OCT 99 22-42 OCT 99


UNITED AIRLINES COURSE
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
AUTOFLIGHT AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE AUTOFLIGHT AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

Altitude Alert System Operation Chart Altitude Alert System Operation Chart

and
OCT 99Systems Introduction 22-43 OCT 99 22-43
UNITED
B737 GENERAL AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
AUTOFLIGHT AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE AUTOFLIGHT AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

When approaching to within 900' of the of airflow), flap position sensor, VHF When approaching to within 900' of the (angle of airflow), flap position sensor,
altitude selected on the MCP, both amber NAV receiver, MCP, and LRRA. In addi- altitude selected on the MCP, both amber VHF NAV receiver, MCP, and LRRA. In
altitude alert lights come on steady, and a tion, inputs from the elevator position sen- altitude alert lights come on steady, and a addition, inputs from the elevator position
one second tone sounds. When approach- sor, and neutral shift sensor provide one second tone sounds. When approach- sensor, and neutral shift sensor provide
ing to within 300' of the selected altitude, command feedback for AP elevator con- ing to within 300' of the selected altitude, command feedback for AP elevator con-
both alert lights go off. trol. An input from the stabilizer position both alert lights go off. trol. An input from the stabilizer position
Upon deviating from the selected altitude sensor provides stabilizer information for Upon deviating from the selected altitude sensor provides stabilizer information for
by more than 300', a momentary tone stab trim commands. These are connected by more than 300', a momentary tone stab trim commands. These are connected
sounds, and the altitude alert lights flash. to an analog to digital (A/D) converter sounds, and the altitude alert lights flash. to an analog to digital (A/D) converter
The lights continue to flash until one of the inside the FCC for internal processing. The lights continue to flash until one of inside the FCC for internal processing.
following occurs: The signals for all computation process- the following occurs: The signals for all computation process-
-Altitude deviation is less than 300', ing, gain control, AP and FD commands, -Altitude deviation is less than 300', ing, gain control, AP and FD commands,
or; from the IRU, FMC, DADC, MCP, are or; from the IRU, FMC, DADC, MCP, are
-Altitude deviation is greater than 900', digital processed by ARINC 429 receiv- -Altitude deviation is greater than 900', digital processed by ARINC 429 receiv-
or; ers, within the FCC, for internal use. Pitch or; ers, within the FCC, for internal use. Pitch
-A new altitude is selected on the attitude and pitch acceleration are nor- -A new altitude is selected on the attitude and pitch acceleration are nor-
MCP. mally from the local IRU, for AP and FD MCP. mally from the local IRU, for AP and FD
The bus select allows only FCC A to oper- operation. Digital outputs are sent to an The bus select allows only FCC A to oper- operation. Digital outputs are sent to an
ate this system unless both of the follow- EFIS Symbol Generator for EADI FD ate this system unless both of the follow- EFIS Symbol Generator for EADI FD
ing are true: pitch command bar movement, and to ing are true: pitch command bar movement, and to
-FD A is OFF visually inform the crew of the mode and -FD A is OFF visually inform the crew of the mode and
-FD B is ON status of the DFCS system. An interlock -FD B is ON status of the DFCS system. An interlock
PITCH CHANNEL OPERATION signal is sent to the Autoflight Status PITCH CHANNEL OPERATION signal is sent to the Autoflight Status
The purpose of both Flight Control Com- Annunciator, for AP warning, failed, or The purpose of both Flight Control Com- Annunciator, for AP warning, failed, or
puters (FCC's) pitch control, is to provide BITE conditions, to be visually displayed. puters (FCC's) pitch control, is to provide BITE conditions, to be visually displayed.
longitudinal axis, flight directed control, Analog outputs are sent to the AP actuator, longitudinal axis, flight directed control, Analog outputs are sent to the AP actua-
using manual operated flight controls with the stabilizer trim servo, and the Mach using manual operated flight controls with tor, the stabilizer trim servo, and the Mach
the AP not engaged or engaged in CWS. trim actuator. AP engage logic is pro- the AP not engaged or engaged in CWS. trim actuator. AP engage logic is pro-
The FCC also provides AP commands to cessed both in the MCP and the FCC, to The FCC also provides AP commands to cessed both in the MCP and the FCC, to
automatically operate the flight controls determine mode selection. Hydraulic sole- automatically operate the flight controls determine mode selection. Hydraulic sole-
using the AP in CMD. The "A" and "B" noids in the AP actuator are energized to using the AP in CMD. The "A" and "B" noids in the AP actuator are energized to
FCC's have separate AP command signal activate AP control. The elevator position FCC's have separate AP command signal activate AP control. The elevator position
processing to operate their respective sys- sensor is used prior to engaging the AP, to processing to operate their respective sys- sensor is used prior to engaging the AP, to
tem elevator AP actuator. Either actuator allow the FCC to synchronize the AP actu- tem elevator AP actuator. Either actuator allow the FCC to synchronize the AP actu-
provides the same mechanical input to ator to the surface position. Once engaged, provides the same mechanical input to ator to the surface position. Once engaged,
both elevator PCU's. The FCC uses both the digital pitch AP command, computed both elevator PCU's. The FCC uses both the digital pitch AP command, computed
input and output signals. The analog to satisfy engaged mode requirements, is input and output signals. The analog to satisfy engaged mode requirements, is
inputs to the FCC originate from the pitch converted to an analog command. The sig- inputs to the FCC originate from the pitch converted to an analog command. The sig-
force transducers, alpha vane sensor (angle nal is then amplified and applied to the force transducers, alpha vane sensor nal is then amplified and applied to the

22-44 and Systems Introduction OCT 99 22-44 OCT 99


UNITED AIRLINES COURSE
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
AUTOFLIGHT AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE AUTOFLIGHT AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

elevator AP actuator transfer/servo valve. for the EADI command bars is very simi- elevator AP actuator transfer/servo valve. for the EADI command bars is very simi-
AP elevator authority is 6 degrees max at lar to the AP signal processing. AP com- AP elevator authority is 6 degrees max at lar to the AP signal processing. AP com-
low speeds, 2.5 degrees at high speeds, mand mode logic is used, but the FD low speeds, 2.5 degrees at high speeds, mand mode logic is used, but the FD
based on the FCC inputs of elevator feel, command processing is accomplished as a based on the FCC inputs of elevator feel, command processing is accomplished as a
using airspeed vs. stabilizer position, and separate control. using airspeed vs. stabilizer position, and separate control.
DADC airspeed. The DADC provides IAS/MACH Display DADC airspeed. The DADC provides IAS/MACH Display
total and static pressure inputs which are The MCP IAS/MACH display is initial- total and static pressure inputs which are The MCP IAS/MACH display is initial-
combined to generate differential pres- ized or blanked as modes are changed. combined to generate differential pres- ized or blanked as modes are changed.
sure. This signal is combined with tabular The initial display is 110 knots when sure. This signal is combined with tabular The initial display is 110 knots when
feel pressure calculated as a result of stabi- power is first applied to the FCC. The dis- feel pressure calculated as a result of stabi- power is first applied to the FCC. The dis-
lizer position and used to calculate total play is changed by the IAS/MACH select lizer position and used to calculate total play is changed by the IAS/MACH select
elevator authority. The transfer valve con- knob. When preparing for takeoff, this is elevator authority. The transfer valve con- knob. When preparing for takeoff, this is
verts the electrical signal to a hydraulic normally V2. A movement of the select verts the electrical signal to a hydraulic normally V2. A movement of the select
signal. This is used in the AP actuator to knob after liftoff or a selection of a pitch signal. This is used in the AP actuator to knob after liftoff or a selection of a pitch
drive an output arm, to mechanically mode other than VNAV, results in the drive an output arm, to mechanically mode other than VNAV, results in the
move the input torque tube of both PCU's. IAS/MACH display adding 20 knots. move the input torque tube of both PCU's. IAS/MACH display adding 20 knots.
Elevator actuator position transducer When a speed is displayed, the value may Elevator actuator position transducer When a speed is displayed, the value may
(LVDT) feedback signal tells the FCC, be manually changed using the IAS/ (LVDT) feedback signal tells the FCC, be manually changed using the IAS/
whether the actuator answered the AP MACH selector knob. Selection between whether the actuator answered the AP MACH selector knob. Selection between
command. The elevator surface position IAS and Mach is made by the C/O command. The elevator surface position IAS and Mach is made by the C/O
sensor signal tells the FCC when the ele- (changeover) pushbutton switch on the sensor signal tells the FCC when the ele- (changeover) pushbutton switch on the
vators are at neutral, and how much to MCP, if above 26,000’. A change is auto- vators are at neutral, and how much to MCP, if above 26,000’. A change is auto-
move the elevators to get them back to matic from IAS to MACH at an altitude of move the elevators to get them back to matic from IAS to MACH at an altitude of
neutral, once the mode required correc- 26,250' when climbing, and a return to neutral, once the mode required correc- 26,250' when climbing, and a return to
tions are accomplished. Either actuator, as IAS when descending at an altitude of tions are accomplished. Either actuator, as IAS when descending at an altitude of
selected, may be used for single channel 25,750'. A symbol in the first block of the selected, may be used for single channel 25,750'. A symbol in the first block of the
operation or both are used for dual channel display warns of underspeed or overspeed operation or both are used for dual channel display warns of underspeed or overspeed
operation. Operation from this point is the conditions. The Electric Mach Airspeed operation. Operation from this point is the conditions. The Electric Mach Airspeed
same as manual flight control operation. Indicator (MASI) provides an indication same as manual flight control operation. Indicator (MASI) provides an indication
The FCC also provides outputs to the sta- of computed airspeed and target airspeed. The FCC also provides outputs to the sta- of computed airspeed and target airspeed.
bilizer for maintaining proper pitch atti- This target speed is displayed on the IAS/ bilizer for maintaining proper pitch atti- This target speed is displayed on the IAS/
tude. A combination of stabilizer position MACH display and, in normal operation, tude. A combination of stabilizer position MACH display and, in normal operation,
and elevator output command is used to the Mach Airspeed Indicator (MASI) IAS and elevator output command is used to the Mach Airspeed Indicator (MASI) IAS
determine when the stabilizer should be target cursor. The target airspeed cursor, determine when the stabilizer should be target cursor. The target airspeed cursor,
repositioned. The output to the Mach trim cursor inop flag, and manual mode flag repositioned. The output to the Mach trim cursor inop flag, and manual mode flag
actuator is used to reposition the elevators are controlled by the FCC. When the actuator is used to reposition the elevators are controlled by the FCC. When the
as a function of Mach number. This is MASI knob is normally pushed in, the as a function of Mach number. This is MASI knob is normally pushed in, the
accomplished by mechanical connections cursor is driven automatically from the accomplished by mechanical connections cursor is driven automatically from the
to the elevator feel and centering unit. The FCC, using FMC or FCC signals. The tar- to the elevator feel and centering unit. The FCC, using FMC or FCC signals. The tar-
neutral shift sensor provides feedback to get airspeed is supplied by the FMC in the neutral shift sensor provides feedback to get airspeed is supplied by the FMC in the
determine the elevator neutral position, VNAV mode, and computed by the DFCS determine the elevator neutral position, VNAV mode, and computed by the DFCS
based on the sum of stabilizer and Mach using MCP selected speed, in all other based on the sum of stabilizer and Mach using MCP selected speed, in all other
trim positions. The FD signal processing modes. The cursor inop flag is in view trim positions. The FD signal processing modes. The cursor inop flag is in view

and
OCT 99Systems Introduction 22-45 OCT 99 22-45
UNITED AIRLINES UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
AUTOFLIGHT AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE AUTOFLIGHT AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE

and Systems Introduction


Pitch Channel Block Diagram Pitch Channel Block Diagram
22-46 OCT 99 22-46 OCT 99
UNITED AIRLINES COURSE
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
AUTOFLIGHT AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE AUTOFLIGHT AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

when the target airspeed cursor drive cir- CMD position (light in the switch goes when the target airspeed cursor drive cir- CMD position (light in the switch goes
cuits are inoperative or when operating off). Any loss of the engage hold logic cuits are inoperative or when operating off). Any loss of the engage hold logic
DFCS BITE. The MASI cursor knob con- or presence of a disengage discrete DFCS BITE. The MASI cursor knob con- or presence of a disengage discrete
trols the target airspeed cursor when the causes the light to go off and the AP to trols the target airspeed cursor when the causes the light to go off and the AP to
knob is pulled out and manually rotated. disengage. knob is pulled out and manually rotated. disengage.
The Manual mode flag is in view whenever Typical AP Engagement Criteria The Manual mode flag is in view whenever Typical AP Engagement Criteria
the knob is pulled out. Some of the crew controlled conditions the knob is pulled out. Some of the crew controlled conditions
ENGAGE AND WARNING MONI- required to allow selection of CWS or ENGAGE AND WARNING MONI- required to allow selection of CWS or
TORS CMD: TORS CMD:
AP Engage Interlock Operation -Less than 3# of force is applied to the AP Engage Interlock Operation -Less than 3# of force is applied to the
Engage and warning monitor circuits in the control wheel. (Low Detent; this Engage and warning monitor circuits in the control wheel. (Low Detent; this
FCC's monitor vital DFCS functions and insures that the airplane is in trim in the FCC's monitor vital DFCS functions and insures that the airplane is in trim in the
provide a warning if the functions are not roll axis.) provide a warning if the functions are not roll axis.)
valid. The two AP's, "A" and "B", each -Less than 5# of force applied to the valid. The two AP's, "A" and "B", each -Less than 5# of force applied to the
have 2 pushbutton engage switches, control column. (Low Detent; this have 2 pushbutton engage switches, control column. (Low Detent; this
labeled CWS (Control Wheel Steering) and insures that the airplane is in trim in the labeled CWS (Control Wheel Steering) insures that the airplane is in trim in the
CMD (Command). An AP is engaged by pitch axis.) and CMD (Command). An AP is engaged pitch axis.)
pressing one of the 2 pushbutton engage -The AP stabilizer trim cutout switch is by pressing one of the 2 pushbutton engage -The AP stabilizer trim cutout switch is
switches (CMD or CWS). The switches NORMAL. switches (CMD or CWS). The switches NORMAL.
can only be selected if certain conditions -The Main Electric Trim switch is not can only be selected if certain conditions -The Main Electric Trim switch is not
are satisfied, and no system failures exist. pressed. are satisfied, and no system failures exist. pressed.
A switch may be in one of four states: -The MCP DISENGAGE bar is full UP. A switch may be in one of four states: -The MCP DISENGAGE bar is full
-Locked out: Note: A common write-up is bumping -Locked out: UP.
-Selection of CWS or CMD engage upon engagement or porpoising after -Selection of CWS or CMD engage Note: A common write-up is bumping
inhibited (light in the switch won't engaged. This may be caused by defec- inhibited (light in the switch won't upon engagement or porpoising after
come on when pressed). One or more tive actuators or misadjusted actuator come on when pressed). One or more engaged. This may be caused by defec-
conditions required for unlock are not or actuator position sensor linkages. See conditions required for unlock are not tive actuators or misadjusted actuator
satisfied. MM 22-01-11, pg 14 for starters. Do not satisfied. or actuator position sensor linkages. See
-Unlocked: adjust the AP surface position sensors or -Unlocked: MM 22-01-11, pg 14 for starters. Do not
-Selection of the CWS or CMD engage actuators unless you use the MM, first -Selection of the CWS or CMD engage adjust the AP surface position sensors or
permitted (light in the switch comes check the flight controls rig. permitted (light in the switch comes actuators unless you use the MM, first
ON when pressed). All unlock ON when pressed). All unlock check the flight controls rig.
conditions must be satisfied. AP Roll/Pitch Mode Disengage General conditions must be satisfied.
-Hold: Information -Hold: AP Roll/Pitch Mode Disengage General
- AP engages into CWS or CMD (light The pushbutton AP engage switch light - AP engages into CWS or CMD (light Information
in the switch stays ON after released). illuminates ON to indicate that the switch in the switch stays ON after released). The pushbutton AP engage switch light
The engaged switch(es) remain lit and has been engaged. Each switch may be dis- The engaged switch(es) remain lit and illuminates ON to indicate that the switch
the operational status remains in CWS engaged by pressing the switch again. Loss the operational status remains in CWS has been engaged. Each switch may be dis-
or CMD, if all hold interlocks are of 28v power or ground to the relay will or CMD, if all hold interlocks are engaged by pressing the switch again. Loss
maintained and no disengage discrete is cause it to deenergize and the pushbutton maintained and no disengage discrete of 28v power or ground to the relay will
present. switch light will go out. If CWS or CMD is is present. cause it to deenergize and the pushbutton
-Disengaged: pressed while either power or ground for -Disengaged: switch light will go out. If CWS or CMD is
-Electrically released from CWS or the relay is not provided, the relay will not -Electrically released from CWS or pressed while either power or ground for

and
OCT 99Systems Introduction 22-47 OCT 99 22-47
UNITED
B737 GENERAL AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
AUTOFLIGHT AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE AUTOFLIGHT AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

energize and the pushbutton light will not solenoid from the relay and connect it to a the relay is not provided, the relay will not channel B. These switches disconnect the
illuminate. AP engagement is inhibited. ground thus preventing the relay from energize and the pushbutton light will not solenoid from the relay and connect it to a
An additional means for disengaging the energizing or the switches from engaging. illuminate. AP engagement is inhibited. ground thus preventing the relay from
AP is provided by the disengage bar, Operating the disengage bar will expose An additional means for disengaging the energizing or the switches from engaging.
located at the bottom of the MCP. Pulling an orange light behind the bar, indicating AP is provided by the disengage bar, Operating the disengage bar will expose
the disengage bar down will disconnect it is in the disengaged position. The disen- located at the bottom of the MCP. Pulling an orange light behind the bar, indicating
the AP's. When pressed down, they will gage bar must be pushed up before reen- the disengage bar down will disconnect it is in the disengaged position. The disen-
operate switches for both channel A and gaging the AP's. the AP's. When pressed down, they will gage bar must be pushed up before reen-
channel B. These switches disconnect the NOTE: The disengage bar must be full operate switches for both channel A and gaging the AP's.
up before the AP's will reengage. NOTE: The disengage bar must be full
AP Disengagement Criteria: up before the AP's will reengage.

A/P ENGAGE A/P ENGAGE


A/P ENGAGE A/P ENGAGE
SW A SW A

BAR BIAS BAR BIAS


COMPUTER VALID COMPUTER VALID
FLIGHT CONTROL EFIS SYMBOL A
A/P ENGAGE
B
FLIGHT CONTROL EFIS SYMBOL A
A/P ENGAGE
B
CMD CMD
COMPUTER A GENERATOR L COMPUTER A GENERATOR L
CWS CWS

CROSS CHANNEL CROSS CHANNEL


DISENGAGE DISENGAGE
INFORMATION INFORMATION
BUS BUS

BAR BIAS BAR BIAS


COMPUTER VALID COMPUTER VALID

EFIS SYMBOL EFIS SYMBOL


GENERATOR R GENERATOR R

A/P ENGAGE A/P ENGAGE A/P ENGAGE A/P ENGAGE


SW B SW B
FLIGHT CONTROL DFCS MODE CONTROL FLIGHT CONTROL DFCS MODE CONTROL
COMPUTER B PANEL COMPUTER B PANEL

Engage And Warning Monitors Block Diagram Engage And Warning Monitors Block Diagram

22-48 and Systems Introduction OCT 99 22-48 OCT 99


UNITED AIRLINES COURSE
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
AUTOFLIGHT AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE AUTOFLIGHT AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

Here is a partial list of reasons for AP dis- -Selected IRU roll angle failure AP Disengagement Criteria: transfer switch.
connects: (normally from foreign IRU). Here is a partial list of reasons for AP dis- -Selected IRU roll angle failure
-FCC failure -Selected IRU pitch angle failure connects: (normally from foreign IRU).
-Pushing the AP disengage switch on (normally from local IRU). -FCC failure -Selected IRU pitch angle failure
either control wheel. Electrical Power Loss -Pushing the AP disengage switch on (normally from local IRU).
-Depressing the AP disengage switch Each FCC uses its own electrical ac and either control wheel. Electrical Power Loss
on the MCP. D.C. busses. Dual channel AP (APP -Depressing the AP disengage switch Each FCC uses its own electrical ac and
-Pushing either TOGA switch with a mode) operation is possible only when on the MCP. D.C. busses. Dual channel AP (APP
single AP engaged in CMD. separate generators power the ac transfer -Pushing either TOGA switch with a mode) operation is possible only when
-Pressing either TOGA switch before busses. Power interruption or loss will single AP engaged in CMD. separate generators power the ac transfer
the flare mode is armed. operate an automatic switch over to the -Pressing either TOGA switch before busses. Power interruption or loss will
-Pressing either TOGA switch after good AC transfer bus, causing disengage- the flare mode is armed. operate an automatic switch over to the
touchdown, with both AP's engaged in ment of the AFDS. Dual channel reen- -Pressing either TOGA switch after good AC transfer bus, causing disengage-
CMD. gagement is possible after isolated power touchdown, with both AP's engaged in ment of the AFDS. Dual channel reen-
-Activating either crew's control wheel sources are restored. CMD. gagement is possible after isolated power
main electric stabilizer trim switch. AP Red Warning Lights Operation -Activating either crew's control wheel sources are restored.
-Moving the AP stabilizer trim cutout The AP Warning light is one of three FMS main electric stabilizer trim switch. AP Red Warning Lights Operation
switch to CUTOUT. warning lights on each of two FMS Warn- -Moving the AP stabilizer trim cutout The AP Warning light is one of three FMS
-Loss of local hydraulic system ing Annunciators on the P1 and P2 panels. switch to CUTOUT. warning lights on each of two FMS Warn-
pressure. The AP Warning lights shows the fail or -Loss of local hydraulic system ing Annunciators on the P1 and P2 panels.
-Loss or transfer of local ac transfer warning status of the AP. The light circuit pressure. The AP Warning lights shows the fail or
bus. AP may be reengaged except in is armed when the AP switch is in the -Loss or transfer of local ac transfer warning status of the AP. The light circuit
APP mode with foreign in CMD. CWS or CMD position. The AP Warning bus. AP may be reengaged except in is armed when the AP switch is in the
-Loss of a sensor input to the FCC, lights are connected in parallel. APP mode with foreign in CMD. CWS or CMD position. The AP Warning
which prevents proper operation of the Press To Test -Loss of a sensor input to the FCC, lights are connected in parallel.
engaged AP mode. One test switch on each FMS Warning which prevents proper operation of the Press To Test
-Excessive signal difference between Annunciator self tests its lights, including engaged AP mode. One test switch on each FMS Warning
navigation receivers, in the Approach the AP Warning light. Each light has sepa- -Excessive signal difference between Annunciator self tests its lights, including
mode. rate press to reset capability. In position navigation receivers, in the Approach the AP Warning light. Each light has sepa-
-Loss of DADC uncorrected Baro one, amber is tested; in position two, red is mode. rate press to reset capability. In position
altitude, except in GS capture or GA tested. -Loss of DADC uncorrected Baro one, amber is tested; in position two, red is
mode, with offside FCC in CMD. AP Warning Light Illuminates Flashing altitude, except in GS capture or GA tested.
-A valid local RA signal is required to Red mode, with offside FCC in CMD. AP Warning Light Illuminates Flashing
engage the FCC into the LOC and GS Both AP Warning lights flash red and an -A valid local RA signal is required to Red
modes. Both required for dual channel aural warning horn sounds if either AP is engage the FCC into the LOC and GS Both AP Warning lights flash red and an
monitors active, (FLARE mode automatically or manually disengaged. modes. Both required for dual channel aural warning horn sounds if either AP is
armed). The AP engage switch changes from monitors active, (FLARE mode automatically or manually disengaged.
-Use of IRS or EFIS transfer switch on CMD or CWS to OFF. One way to manu- armed). The AP engage switch changes from
the flight deck overhead panel. ally disengage the AP's is to push down -Use of IRS or EFIS transfer switch on CMD or CWS to OFF. One way to manu-
-The following conditions will cause the disengage bar. An orange light is then the flight deck overhead panel. ally disengage the AP's is to push down
disconnect, but the AP may be visible above the bar. The disengage bar -The following conditions will cause the disengage bar. An orange light is then
reengaged upon use of IRS or EFIS must be pushed up before reengaging the disconnect, but the AP may be visible above the bar. The disengage bar
transfer switch. AP's. The AP may be manually disen- reengaged upon use of IRS or EFIS must be pushed up before reengaging the

and
OCT 99Systems Introduction 22-49 OCT 99 22-49
UNITED
B737 GENERAL AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
AUTOFLIGHT AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE AUTOFLIGHT AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

gaged by pushing and releasing the AP Around will result in a steady AP's. The AP may be manually disen- CMD) during dual channel AP Go
release switch on either yoke, the warn- illumination of the red AP disengage gaged by pushing and releasing the AP Around will result in a steady
ings will also activate. The flashing lights warning light. release switch on either yoke, the warn- illumination of the red AP disengage
and intermittent warning horn can be reset FD Warning Flag and Bars Out Of ings will also activate. The flashing lights warning light.
after 2 seconds, by pushing either control View and intermittent warning horn can be reset FD Warning Flag and Bars Out Of
wheel AP release switch, or by pressing When the local (LCL) FD switch is ON, after 2 seconds, by pushing either control View
either crew's AP Warning light. the local side FD commands are normally wheel AP release switch, or by pressing When the local (LCL) FD switch is ON,
AP Warning Light Illuminates Steady supplied to the local EFIS Symbol Gener- either crew's AP Warning light. the local side FD commands are normally
Red ator (SG). This information is displayed AP Warning Light Illuminates Steady supplied to the local EFIS Symbol Gener-
The steady red AP Warning light indicates by the EADI command bars. The foreign Red ator (SG). This information is displayed
BITE is in progress or an AP Warning (FGN) commands are sent to the local SG The steady red AP Warning light indicates by the EADI command bars. The foreign
from the master FCC, alerting the crew if an AC bus transfer is made during FD BITE is in progress or an AP Warning (FGN) commands are sent to the local SG
that they should manually disconnect the approach, with no AP, while G/S and LOC from the master FCC, alerting the crew if an AC bus transfer is made during FD
AP. The AP Warning light illuminates are engaged, and a RA of less than 800', or that they should manually disconnect the approach, with no AP, while G/S and LOC
steady red for one of the following: TO or GA modes. However, if a roll or AP. The AP Warning light illuminates are engaged, and a RA of less than 800', or
-DFCS BITE in progress. pitch bar Bias Out Of View (RBOV or steady red for one of the following: TO or GA modes. However, if a roll or
-Yaw Damper armed for BITE. PBOV) occurs, because of such reasons as -DFCS BITE in progress. pitch bar Bias Out Of View (RBOV or
-When on the ground and the FCC loss of a pitch or roll mode, is received by -Yaw Damper armed for BITE. PBOV) occurs, because of such reasons as
power up test fails. the SG, the respective command bar is -When on the ground and the FCC loss of a pitch or roll mode, is received by
-If the STAB OUT TRIM Light removed. FD has a comparator that pro- power up test fails. the SG, the respective command bar is
illuminates when on a dual approach duces BOV if the A and B systems FD -If the STAB OUT TRIM Light removed. FD has a comparator that pro-
with both pitch channels engaged, and commands are too far apart during TO, illuminates when on a dual approach duces BOV if the A and B systems FD
descended below 800' but prior to GA, or APP modes. The FD flag is in with both pitch channels engaged, and commands are too far apart during TO,
100'. view on the ADI if the FCC fails or is in descended below 800' but prior to GA, or APP modes. The FD flag is in
-If the AP red light is on when BITE. FCC A gives RBOV and PBOV if 100'. view on the ADI if the FCC fails or is in
descending below 100', the light the EFIS transfer switch is BOTH ON 2, -If the AP red light is on when BITE. FCC A gives RBOV and PBOV if
remains on unless the STAB TRIM no AP in CMD, and both FD's ON. descending below 100', the light the EFIS transfer switch is BOTH ON 2,
WARN Light is extinguished. If an AP SYSTEM TESTING remains on unless the STAB TRIM no AP in CMD, and both FD's ON.
Go Around is at greater than 400' RA, WARN Light is extinguished. If an AP
transition to Altitude Acquire is Go Around is at greater than 400' RA,
inhibited. This inhibit is due to the transition to Altitude Acquire is
elevator position exceeding the single inhibited. This inhibit is due to the
channel authority. The AP will not elevator position exceeding the single
have time to retrim the stabilizer to channel authority. The AP will not
take out the flare spring bias added have time to retrim the stabilizer to
below 400' RA. The AP's remain take out the flare spring bias added
engaged. The warning lights are reset below 400' RA. The AP's remain
by manually disconnecting the AP's, engaged. The warning lights are reset
or by selecting a higher altitude on the by manually disconnecting the AP's,
MCP. or by selecting a higher altitude on the
-Loss of valid selected baro corrected MCP.
altitude in the master FCC (1st to -Loss of valid selected baro corrected
CMD) during dual channel AP Go altitude in the master FCC (1st to

22-50 and Systems Introduction OCT 99 22-50 OCT 99


UNITED AIRLINES COURSE
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
AUTOFLIGHT AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE AUTOFLIGHT AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

CWS R GND FAULT CWS R GND FAULT


CWS P CWS P
F/D FLAG F/D FLAG
FD FD
SENSORS SENSORS
A/P CRZ MODE A/P CRZ MODE

R BOV R BOV
P BOV P BOV

EADI EADI

ENGAGE A
A/P ENGAGE
B A/P DISC ENGAGE A
A/P ENGAGE
B A/P DISC
CMD CMD
INTERLOCKS ENG ATT INTERLOCKS ENG ATT
CWS CWS

DISENGAGE DISENGAGE
A/P A/P
P/RST P/RST

DFCS MODE DFCS MODE


CONTROL PANEL CONTROL PANEL

STAB STAB
OUT OF STAB TRIM OUT OF STAB TRIM
TRIM TRIM

SPEED TRIM SPEED TRIM


FAIL SPD TRIM FAIL SPD TRIM

MACH TRIM MACH TRIM


FAIL MACH TRIM FAIL MACH TRIM

FLIGHT CONTROL FLIGHT CONTROL


COMPUTER COMPUTER

Flight Deck Effects Pictorial Block Diagram Flight Deck Effects Pictorial Block Diagram

and
OCT 99Systems Introduction 22-51 OCT 99 22-51
UNITED
B737 GENERAL AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
AUTOFLIGHT AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE AUTOFLIGHT AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

DFCS Built-In Maintenance Features records the causes of DFCS related Flight SYSTEM TESTING Fault storage The maintenance monitor
The DFCS has three built-in maintenance Deck Effects (FDE). These include on- DFCS Built-In Maintenance Features records the causes of DFCS related Flight
features: line faults detected by the continuous The DFCS has three built-in maintenance Deck Effects (FDE). These include on-
• Ground Maintenance, using extensive- monitor and system failures. Some fail- features: line faults detected by the continuous
BITE capability embedded within the ures are FD Flag, AP disconnect, prevent • Ground Maintenance, using extensive- monitor and system failures. Some fail-
DFCS, for on-ground system checkout. AP engagement, FD bar out-of-view bias, BITE capability embedded within the ures are FD Flag, AP disconnect, prevent
BITE is primarily intended for line main- or Mach trim/speed trim failures. The sys- DFCS, for on-ground system checkout. AP engagement, FD bar out-of-view bias,
tenance fault isolation to a single Line tem records the Flight Deck Effect (FDE), BITE is primarily intended for line main- or Mach trim/speed trim failures. The sys-
Replaceable Unit (LRU) within 5 min- the LRU diagnostic, the monitor that tenance fault isolation to a single Line tem records the Flight Deck Effect (FDE),
utes. Fast and accurate diagnostics mean tripped, and if the fault is repeated in the Replaceable Unit (LRU) within 5 minutes. the LRU diagnostic, the monitor that
fewer delays and smaller spares invento- flight segment. This data is retrieved on Fast and accurate diagnostics mean fewer tripped, and if the fault is repeated in the
ries. With BITE, line maintenance the ground through ground maintenance delays and smaller spares inventories. flight segment. This data is retrieved on
becomes a one person operation from the BITE by selecting Inflight Faults. Up to With BITE, line maintenance becomes a the ground through ground maintenance
CDU on the flight deck. All system BITE 10 flights of information is available. A one person operation from the CDU on the BITE by selecting Inflight Faults. Up to
communicates to the technician, via the new flight number is created when both flight deck. All system BITE communi- 10 flights of information is available. A
CDU, in English. No additional test FD switches are ON and TOGA switch is cates to the technician, via the CDU, in new flight number is created when both
equipment is required. The technician operated, the aircraft is in the air for 6 sec- English. No additional test equipment is FD switches are ON and TOGA switch is
simply selects from a menu of test onds, or IRS ground speed is greater than required. The technician simply selects operated, the aircraft is in the air for 6 sec-
options, and supplies interactive operator 100 knots. See 22-03-10 and 22-03-11 for from a menu of test options, and supplies onds, or IRS ground speed is greater than
responses via the CDU. BITE runs the complete details of the DFCS BITE oper- interactive operator responses via the 100 knots. See 22-03-10 and 22-03-11 for
tests and provides corrective action diag- ation. CDU. BITE runs the tests and provides complete details of the DFCS BITE opera-
nostics. BITE utilizes software and cir- DFCS BITE - Overview corrective action diagnostics. BITE uti- tion.
cuitry which is not flight critical (i.e., does referenced to MM 22-03-10, Page 110, lizes software and circuitry which is not DFCS BITE - Overview
not influence in-flight system DFCS oper- figure 101) flight critical (i.e., does not influence in- referenced to MM 22-03-10, Page 110,
ation). Group test and library test numbers are flight system DFCS operation). figure 101)
• Continuous monitoring, for system veri- shown in the top right corner of the CDU • Continuous monitoring, for system veri- Group test and library test numbers are
fication. The continuous monitor provides as the tests are running. All library tests fication. The continuous monitor pro- shown in the top right corner of the CDU
on-line monitoring to determine the health are grouped into one of three categories, vides on-line monitoring to determine the as the tests are running. All library tests
of the FCC's and system input/output Quick, Interactive, or Surface. Letter in health of the FCC's and system input/out- are grouped into one of three categories,
operation. When a fault is detected, a fault parenthesis is abbreviation of each library put operation. When a fault is detected, a Quick, Interactive, or Surface. Letter in
reaction occurs, either a mode dropout, an test category seen during use of engineer- fault reaction occurs, either a mode drop- parenthesis is abbreviation of each library
AP disconnect, or FD bars bias out of ing codes. These are used following test out, an AP disconnect, or FD bars bias out test category seen during use of engineer-
view. In the DFCS, this monitoring covers failures, accessed by code 100 and Line of view. In the DFCS, this monitoring ing codes. These are used following test
the computation, the RAM/ROM memo- Select Key 6R. covers the computation, the RAM/ROM failures, accessed by code 100 and Line
ries and partly the power supplies. Contin- -Quick (Q) is a manually initiated auto memories and partly the power supplies. Select Key 6R.
uous system monitoring is also provided test. Continuous system monitoring is also pro- -Quick (Q) is a manually initiated auto
to detect failures on incoming digital sig- -Interactive (I) does tests that prompt vided to detect failures on incoming digi- test.
nals, and in the actuator position feedback the mechanic to move aircraft tal signals, and in the actuator position -Interactive (I) does tests that prompt
loops. If power-up test fails 7 times, the switches and controls during the tests. feedback loops. If power-up test fails 7 the mechanic to move aircraft
MCP displays will go inactive and the -Surface (S) tests uses hydraulics times, the MCP displays will go inactive switches and controls during the tests.
altitude window will display 50,000'. applied to cause flight control surface and the altitude window will display -Surface (S) tests uses hydraulics
• Maintenance monitoring, for In Flight movement. Follow safety procedures. 50,000'. applied to cause flight control surface
Fault storage The maintenance monitor Overnight Maintenance tests are run for • Maintenance monitoring, for In Flight movement. Follow safety procedures.

22-52 and Systems Introduction OCT 99 22-52 OCT 99


UNITED AIRLINES COURSE
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
AUTOFLIGHT AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE AUTOFLIGHT AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION
Line Mainenance group tests are run to Currrent Status, Inflight Faults, LRU Line Mainenance group tests are run to Currrent Status, Inflight Faults, LRU
quickly troubleshoot writeups and test the Interface, and Land Verify. quickly troubleshoot writeups and test the Interface, and Land Verify.
system following a box change. These are system following a box change. These are

MAINT BITE INDEX 1/1 DFCS BITE TEST 1/2 DFCS BITE TEST 2/2 MAINT BITE INDEX 1/1 DFCS BITE TEST 1/2 DFCS BITE TEST 2/2
NEXT NEXT
LINE MAINT OVERNIGHT MAINT LINE MAINT PAGE
OVERNIGHT MAINT
1L <FMCS 1L PAGE 1L 1L <FMCS 1L 1L <GROUND FUNC TEST
2L <CURRENT STATUS <GROUND FUNC TEST 2L <CURRENT STATUS
2L <DFCS 2L <INFLIGHT FAULTS 2L <RIGGING 2L <DFCS 2L <INFLIGHT FAULTS 2L <RIGGING
3L <A/T 3L <LRU INTERFACE 3L <SENSOR VALUES 3L <A/T 3L <LRU INTERFACE 3L <SENSOR VALUES
4L <IRS 4L <LAND VERIFY 4L 4L <IRS 4L <LAND VERIFY 4L
5L <EFIS 5L PREV 5L 5L <EFIS 5L PREV 5L
6L <INDEX 6L <INDEX PAGE 6L <INDEX 6L <INDEX 6L <INDEX PAGE 6L <INDEX

I I
S S
GP10 GP10
F O INTERACTIVE SURFACE F O CURRENT INTERACTIVE SURFACE
CURRENT
A L A L STATUS
STATUS
U A U A TEST
TEST
L T L T
T I PG 1 LSK 1L AUTO FLIGHT MACH SPEED ALTITUDE T I PG 1 LSK 1L AUTO FLIGHT MACH SPEED ALTITUDE
O PILOT DIRECTOR TRIM TRIM ALERT O PILOT DIRECTOR TRIM TRIM ALERT
N GP 11 GP 12 GP 13 GP 14 GP 12 N GP 11 GP 12 GP 13 GP 14 GP 12

INFLIGHT INFLIGHT
FAULTS INFLIGHT FLT 01 FLT 10 FAULTS CODE 300 INFLIGHT FLT 01 FLT 10
LAST FLT CODE 300 LAST FLT
TEST FAULTS AND TEST FAULTS AND
FAULT LSK 6R FAULT LSK 6R
GP20 SUMMARY GROUND GP20 SUMMARY GROUND
CHA A / B STATUS PG 1 LSK 2L CHA A / B STATUS
PG 1 LSK 2L
GROUND COMPLETE GROUND COMPLETE
FUNC TEST SELECT SEE LIBRARY TEST LIST FUNC TEST SELECT SEE LIBRARY TEST LIST
TEST TEST DELETE TEST TEST DELETE
GP60 GP60
PG 2 LSK 1L PG 2 LSK 1L
MACHIAS GP 31 FCC GP 35 HSI GP 39 A/T GP 43 MACHIAS GP 31 FCC GP 35 HSI GP 39 A/T GP 43
LRU LRU
INTERFACE MCP GP 32 VOR/ILS GP 36 LRRA GP 40 DADC GP 44 INTERFACE MCP GP 32 VOR/ILS GP 36 LRRA GP 40 DADC GP 44
TEST TEST
GP30 IRU GP 33 DME GP 37 LNAV GP 41 ALPHA VANE GP 45 GP30 IRU GP 33 DME GP 37 LNAV GP 41 ALPHA VANE GP 45
PG 1 LSK3L PG 1 LSK3L
FMC GP 34 ADI GP 38 EFIS GP 48 N1 SENSE GP 46 FMC GP 34 ADI GP 38 EFIS GP 48 N1 SENSE GP 46
LAND LAND 1
1
VERIFY ACT POS SENS GP 47 VERIFY ACT POS SENS GP 47
CH A/B ONLY CH A/B ONLY
GP49 GP49
PG 2 LSK 4L PG 2 LSK 4L

CH A/B ONLY CH A/B ONLY


RIGGING RIGGING
ELEVATOR AILERON FLAPS STABILIZER CWS MACH ELEVATOR AILERON FLAPS STABILIZER CWS MACH
PG 2 LSK 2L GP 51 GP 53 GP 54 TRIM PG 2 LSK 2L GP 51 GP 52 GP 53 GP 54 GP 55 TRIM
GP 52 GP 55
SENSOR GP 51 SENSOR GP 51
VALUES ANLG SIG 56.1 RIGGING 51.00 PITCH 55.00 VALUES ANLG SIG 56.1 RIGGING 51.00 PITCH 55.00

GP56 DIGITAL SIG 56.14 AUTH SING 51.20 ROLL 55.30 GP56 DIGITAL SIG 56.14 AUTH SING 51.20 ROLL 55.30

PG 2 LSK 3L OPTIONS (SOP) 56.20 AUTH DUAL 51.40 COMPLETE PG 2 LSK 3L OPTIONS (SOP) 56.20 AUTH DUAL 51.40 COMPLETE

COMPLETE COMPLETE COMPLETE COMPLETE

DISCRETE INPUT WORDS DISCRETE INPUT WORDS


VERIFICATION FOR NON-EIS AIRCRAFT THIS VERIFICATION 1 FOR NON-EIS AIRCRAFT THIS
1 FMA GP 54 FMA GP 54
TESTS GROUP TEST IS REPLACED BY TESTS GROUP TEST IS REPLACED BY

DFCS BITE Introduction Block Diagram DFCS BITE Introduction Block Diagram
and
OCT 99Systems Introduction 22-53 OCT 99 22-53
UNITED
B737 GENERAL AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
AUTOFLIGHT AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE AUTOFLIGHT AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

extensive group tests, engineering investi- and outputs between Flight Overnight Maintenance tests are run for discretes, analog, and digital interfaces
gating, trouble shooting, or when a CAT Management System subsystems extensive group tests, engineering investi- and outputs between Flight
III test is performed. These are Ground (DFCS, AT, EFIS, etc.) and associated gating, trouble shooting, or when a CAT Management System subsystems
Functional Test, Rigging, and Sensor Val- LRU's. III test is performed. These are Ground (DFCS, AT, EFIS, etc.) and associated
ues. -Land Verify, Group 49 - A land Functional Test, Rigging, and Sensor Val- LRU's.
BITE Fault Isolation mode verification feature is available ues. -Land Verify, Group 49 - A land
After considering crew reports and flight for autoland reinstatement after system BITE Fault Isolation mode verification feature is available
deck evidence, fault isolation is accom- LRU replacement. Performs all Q, I, After considering crew reports and flight for autoland reinstatement after system
plished through BITE. BITE enables you and S tests for autoland critical sensors deck evidence, fault isolation is accom- LRU replacement. Performs all Q, I,
to troubleshoot and locate the defective and dual channel operation and plished through BITE. BITE enables you and S tests for autoland critical sensors
part. The BITE submenus are: functions. to troubleshoot and locate the defective and dual channel operation and
-Current status, Group 10 - Performs -Rigging, Group 50 - While adjusting part. The BITE submenus are: functions.
all Q tests. Some failures are real time sensors, a "-" may be displayed on the -Current status, Group 10 - Performs -Rigging, Group 50 - While adjusting
and other failures are the status at test CDU. This refers to the phase of the all Q tests. Some failures are real time sensors, a "-" may be displayed on the
initiation. If Q tests pass, you may AC signal from the sensor. If the and other failures are the status at test CDU. This refers to the phase of the
select I tests for each of the five DFCS signal phase is +, it is not shown. initiation. If Q tests pass, you may AC signal from the sensor. If the
subsystem groups, 11 - 15. If I tests Adjust the sensor to correct position select I tests for each of the five DFCS signal phase is +, it is not shown.
pass, BITE starts S tests automatically. by phase AND amplitude of signal. subsystem groups, 11 - 15. If I tests Adjust the sensor to correct position
Tailor the tests to those needed for the This checks that sensors are properly pass, BITE starts S tests automatically. by phase AND amplitude of signal.
reported fault. This saves time over the adjusted by checking flight controls Tailor the tests to those needed for the This checks that sensors are properly
Ground Functional Test. Altitude alert response to test signals. reported fault. This saves time over the adjusted by checking flight controls
Group 15 has no surface test. -Sensor Values, Group 56 - "Options Ground Functional Test. Altitude alert response to test signals.
-In Flight Faults, Group 20 - This tests (SOP)" verify Standard Options Group 15 has no surface test. -Sensor Values, Group 56 - "Options
are run by the maintenance monitor Programming to the FCC. Discrete -In Flight Faults, Group 20 - This tests (SOP)" verify Standard Options
continuously, storing all Flight Deck Input Words check FCC input are run by the maintenance monitor Programming to the FCC. Discrete
Effects (FDE) in non-volatile memory. discretes to assist in troubleshooting continuously, storing all Flight Deck Input Words check FCC input
Access to flights 2-10 are with use of bad component and wiring paths. Effects (FDE) in non-volatile memory. discretes to assist in troubleshooting
Code 300 and Line Select Key 6R. Access to flights 2-10 are with use of bad component and wiring paths.
-Ground Functional Test, Group 60 - Standard Option Pins Code 300 and Line Select Key 6R.
GFT runs all Q, I, and S tests. This is Airplane compatibility to the FCC's is -Ground Functional Test, Group 60 - Standard Option Pins
the CAT III test. Select COMPLETE determined by the three Standard Option GFT runs all Q, I, and S tests. This is Airplane compatibility to the FCC's is
TEST and SYS A&B for the CAT III Pins (SOP) in the FCC radio rack connec- the CAT III test. Select COMPLETE determined by the three Standard Option
test. This can be run as a group test tors. These pins are used to compare TEST and SYS A&B for the CAT III Pins (SOP) in the FCC radio rack connec-
following a box change. Test Deletion against the SOP allowable combinations test. This can be run as a group test tors. These pins are used to compare
and Test Selection runs fewer tests of FCC and the airplane. The failure to following a box change. Test Deletion against the SOP allowable combinations
that save time during troubleshooting. pass the compatibility check shall result in and Test Selection runs fewer tests of FCC and the airplane. The failure to
BITE Verification Tests the computer failing the power up test. that save time during troubleshooting. pass the compatibility check shall result in
Verification tests check box interfaces, The airplane compatibility is displayed on BITE Verification Tests the computer failing the power up test.
performed following replacement of LRU the CDU in the Sensor Value Group of Verification tests check box interfaces, The airplane compatibility is displayed on
or wire repair. The BITE submenu’s are: DFCS BITE. Many other SOP's are uti- performed following replacement of LRU the CDU in the Sensor Value Group of
-LRU Interface, Group 30 - Performs lized. Check Wiring Diagram 22-11-75 or wire repair. The BITE submenu’s are: DFCS BITE. Many other SOP's are uti-
some Q and some I. This checks for current configurations. -LRU Interface, Group 30 - Performs lized. Check Wiring Diagram 22-11-75
discretes, analog, and digital interfaces Engineering Codes some Q and some I. This checks for current configurations.

22-54 and Systems Introduction OCT 99 22-54 OCT 99


UNITED AIRLINES COURSE
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
AUTOFLIGHT AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE AUTOFLIGHT AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

The following codes may be entered on Engineering Codes


Key (LSK) 6R, following BITE failure,
for each of the FMS subsytems shown. The following codes may be entered on
the CDU followed by pressing Line Select for each of the FMS subsytems shown.
Key (LSK) 6R, following BITE failure,
System Troubleshooting the CDU followed by pressing Line Select

CODE SYSTEM PURPOSE CODE SYSTEM PURPOSE

100 FMCS Access to current status diagnostic 100 FMCS Access to current status diagnostic
AT failures AT failures
DFCS DFCS

300 DFCS Access to in-flight faults engineer- 300 DFCS Access to in-flight faults engineer-
FMCS ing data FMCS ing data

200 DFCS Access to memory locations used for 200 DFCS Access to memory locations used for
discrete input words storage discrete input words storage

27E DFCS Access to non-volatile memory used 27E DFCS Access to non-volatile memory used
for in-flight faults storage for in-flight faults storage

900 DFCS Delete recorded in-flight faults 900 DFCS Delete recorded in-flight faults

For troubleshooting information, see: FCC's between two channels, or when System Troubleshooting Note: When permanently interchanging
-Autoflight System Troubleshooting, replacing an FCC with a robbed unit, a For troubleshooting information, see: FCC's between two channels, or when
MM 22-11-01 message ERROR FCC A (B) may be -Autoflight System Troubleshooting, replacing an FCC with a robbed unit, a
-Digital Flight Control System-Built displayed on the CDU Inflight Faults MM 22-11-01 message ERROR FCC A (B) may be
In Test Equipment, Troubleshooting, page. The message pertains to faults -Digital Flight Control System-Built displayed on the CDU Inflight Faults
MM 22-03-10 (CAT IIIa test) stored while the FCC was in the oppo- In Test Equipment, Troubleshooting, page. The message pertains to faults
-Remember to consult service tips site channel (or other aircraft). The In MM 22-03-10 (CAT IIIa test) stored while the FCC was in the oppo-
located in many places throughout the Flight Fault history should be deleted -Remember to consult service tips site channel (or other aircraft). The In
MM. These are predominately in Ch. from the computer by performing the located in many places throughout the Flight Fault history should be deleted
22 for AFCS systems. following steps: Select DFCS BITE MM. These are predominately in Ch. from the computer by performing the
Note: Some service tips for DFCS are in Select In Flight Faults Access engineer- 22 for AFCS systems. following steps: Select DFCS BITE
Ch. 34, navigation; others are in Ch. 27, ing code 900, (Enter 900 in scratch pad Note: Some service tips for DFCS are in Select In Flight Faults Access engineer-
flight controls. and press Line Select Key 6R) Clear the Ch. 34, navigation; others are in Ch. 27, ing code 900, (Enter 900 in scratch pad
Note: When permanently interchanging flight controls.

and
OCT 99Systems Introduction 22-55 OCT 99 22-55
UNITED
B737 GENERAL AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
AUTOFLIGHT AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE AUTOFLIGHT AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

PREFERRED
PREFERRED ORDER OF FMS
ORDER OF FMS FLIGHT DECK EFFECT BITE TESTS
FLIGHT DECK EFFECT BITE TESTS
PILOT REPORT (PIREP) FLIGHT DECK EVIDENCE
PILOT REPORT (PIREP) FLIGHT DECK EVIDENCE
ALL WARNINGS, CAUTIONS AND ABNORMALITIES OF
ALL WARNINGS, CAUTIONS AND ABNORMALITIES OF A. AUTOPILOT AND/OR FLIGHT DIRECTOR 1. DFCS
A. AUTOPILOT AND/OR FLIGHT DIRECTOR 1. DFCS 2. FMCS
B. MACH AND/OR SPEED TRIM (STABILIZER)
B. MACH AND/OR SPEED TRIM (STABILIZER) 2. FMCS SELECT MOST APPROPRIATE SUBSYSTEM BITE C. ALTITUDE ALERT 3. A/T
SELECT MOST APPROPRIATE SUBSYSTEM BITE C. ALTITUDE ALERT 3. A/T 4. EFIS
4. EFIS
ACCESS INFLIGHT FAULTS ON CDU SCREEN DISPLAY
ACCESS INFLIGHT FAULTS ON CDU SCREEN DISPLAY DFCS BITE TEST
DFCS BITE TEST CHECK FOR LRU FAULTS ON FLIGHT CORRESPONDING
CHECK FOR LRU FAULTS ON FLIGHT CORRESPONDING LAST FLIGHT - A / -B 20.
LAST FLIGHT - A / -B 20. TO PIREP
TO PIREP
PROBABLE DADC - 1 A/P DISC
PROBABLE DADC - 1 A/P DISC { { FLIGHT DECK

PERFORM CURRENT STATUS BITE TESTS LRU { DADC - 1 ENG ATT


{ FLIGHT
EFFECT
DECK PERFORM CURRENT STATUS BITE TESTS LRU DADC - 1 ENG ATT EFFECT

CONTINUE INDEX
CONTINUE INDEX
CURRENT
CURRENT STATUS LIBRARY INFLIGHT FAULTS
STATUS LIBRARY INFLIGHT FAULTS FAILURES TEST GROUP NUMBER
FAILURES TEST GROUP NUMBER
NAME
NAME DFCS BITE TEST
DFCS BITE TEST DADC -CHAN A 10.03 LIBRARY TEST
DADC -CHAN A 10.03 LIBRARY TEST YES * TEST FAILED * NUMBER
YES * TEST FAILED * NUMBER MOST PROBABLE CAUSE(S):
MOST PROBABLE CAUSE(S): WAS DADC-1
WAS DADC-1 INFLIGHT
INFLIGHT FAULT
FAULT CONFIRMED
CONFIRMED
CONTINUE INDEX
CONTINUE INDEX YES
YES
OPERATE SELF-TEST ON LRU, OR TEST LRU ON OTHER CURRENT STATUS RESULTS
OPERATE SELF-TEST ON LRU, OR TEST LRU ON OTHER CURRENT STATUS RESULTS SUBSYSTEM BITE
SUBSYSTEM BITE
DFCS BITE TEST
DFCS BITE TEST SUMMARY -CHAN A 44.
SUMMARY -CHAN A 44.
YES NO * DFCS TEST PASSED *
YES NO * DFCS TEST PASSED * TEST PASSED
TEST PASSED * CONTINUE TO INIT A/C *
* CONTINUE TO INIT A/C *

CONTINUE
CONTINUE
INTERCHANGE LRU (IF POSSIBLE) REPLACE LRU
INTERCHANGE LRU (IF POSSIBLE) REPLACE LRU WITH LRU ON OTHER CHANNEL/ REVERIFY INTERFACE
REVERIFY INTERFACE LRU INTERFACE
WITH LRU ON OTHER CHANNEL/ LRU INTERFACE SYSTEM. THEN REVERIFY
SYSTEM. THEN REVERIFY INTERFACE
INTERFACE OR
OR IF LRU HAS ELECTRICAL CONN:
IF LRU HAS ELECTRICAL CONN: OPEN LRU CIRCUIT BREAKERS.
OPEN LRU CIRCUIT BREAKERS. REMATE LRU IN ELECTRICAL CONN.
REMATE LRU IN ELECTRICAL CONN. CLOSE LRU CIRCUIT BREAKERS
CLOSE LRU CIRCUIT BREAKERS REVERIFY INTERFACE
REVERIFY INTERFACE

Using the DFCS BITE Flow Chart


Using the DFCS BITE Flow Chart

22-56 and Systems Introduction OCT 99 22-56 OCT 99


UNITED AIRLINES COURSE
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
AUTOFLIGHT AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE AUTOFLIGHT AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

computer non-volatile memory per the designed for maximum fuel conservation, and press Line Select Key 6R) Clear the and components. The AT system is
menu driven instructions. Exit engi- operational and cost benefits, reducing computer non-volatile memory per the designed for maximum fuel conservation,
neering code 900. crew workload, and ease of maintenance. menu driven instructions. Exit engi- operational and cost benefits, reducing
Note: Code 27E is used after seeing The AT system achieves these goals neering code 900. crew workload, and ease of maintenance.
fault history that shows LRU through automatic, smooth, and precise Note: Code 27E is used after seeing The AT system achieves these goals
UNKNOWN or DISC WRAP messages. thrust control and optimum performance fault history that shows LRU through automatic, smooth, and precise
If the message is LRU UNKNOWN go from each engine, for all flight regimes UNKNOWN or DISC WRAP messages. thrust control and optimum performance
to a engineering book available from from takeoff to touchdown. It is tailored If the message is LRU UNKNOWN go from each engine, for all flight regimes
our Engineering or Boeing. If the mes- specifically for use with any intermix of to a engineering book available from from takeoff to touchdown. It is tailored
sage is DISC WRAP go to troubleshoot- CFM56-3B1, -3B-2, and -3C-1 engines. It our Engineering or Boeing. If the mes- specifically for use with any intermix of
ing procedure MM 22-03-10, pg 111, computes the necessary throttle position sage is DISC WRAP go to troubleshoot- CFM56-3B1, -3B-2, and -3C-1 engines. It
and use chart on pg 116 to get LRU wir- and drives both servo assemblies to posi- ing procedure MM 22-03-10, pg 111, computes the necessary throttle position
ing pinouts. tion the engine thrust levers. The AT com- and use chart on pg 116 to get LRU wir- and drives both servo assemblies to posi-
Note: When troubleshooting a sus- puter will command a maximum throttle ing pinouts. tion the engine thrust levers. The AT com-
pected AP actuator, power down the levers split of 8 degrees in an attempt to Note: When troubleshooting a sus- puter will command a maximum throttle
system, pull the DFCS CB's, and con- match N1 of both engines. Throttle lever pected AP actuator, power down the levers split of 8 degrees in an attempt to
nect both AP actuator connectors from position is controlled to maintain either system, pull the DFCS CB's, and con- match N1 of both engines. Throttle lever
the suspect system into the good system. the engine N1 speed (MCP N1 mode), the nect both AP actuator connectors from position is controlled to maintain either
In order to reach the other system's aircraft IAS/Mach forward speed (MCP the suspect system into the good system. the engine N1 speed (MCP N1 mode), the
aileron or elevator actuator, manufac- SPD mode), or RETARD mode. The AT In order to reach the other system's aircraft IAS/Mach forward speed (MCP
ture actuator jumper assy per drawing maintains a minimum safe airspeed; and aileron or elevator actuator, manufac- SPD mode), or RETARD mode. The AT
3SF6519. retards the thrust levers during automatic ture actuator jumper assy per drawing maintains a minimum safe airspeed; and
Note: All the engage logic is bypassed in landing flare. The AT provides mode 3SF6519. retards the thrust levers during automatic
DFCS BITE. If the autopilot does not annunciation on the EADI's via the EFIS Note: All the engage logic is bypassed in landing flare. The AT provides mode
engage in DFCS BITE, it indicates a Symbol Generators, and AT disengage DFCS BITE. If the autopilot does not annunciation on the EADI's via the EFIS
problem with the hardware. The MCP, warning on the FMS Warning Annuncia- engage in DFCS BITE, it indicates a Symbol Generators, and AT disengage
the FCC, or the airplane wiring are tors. AT status and data is provided to the problem with the hardware. The MCP, warning on the FMS Warning Annuncia-
possible problems. FCC's and FMC. the FCC, or the airplane wiring are tors. AT status and data is provided to the
System Components possible problems. FCC's and FMC.
AUTOTHROTTLE SYSTEM The AT system consists of a digital AT System Components
Introduction computer, which controls the thrust levers AUTOTHROTTLE SYSTEM The AT system consists of a digital AT
The AT system is part of the Flight Man- individually through two independent AT Introduction computer, which controls the thrust levers
agement System (FMS). It is designed to servo-mechanisms, an AT engage switch, The AT system is part of the Flight Man- individually through two independent AT
operate primarily in conjunction with the AT disengage and Takeoff/Go Around agement System (FMS). It is designed to servo-mechanisms, an AT engage switch,
Digital Flight Control System (DFCS), switches. The AT system also contains a operate primarily in conjunction with the AT disengage and Takeoff/Go Around
and the Flight Management Computer Thrust Mode Annunciator (TMA), one AT Digital Flight Control System (DFCS), switches. The AT system also contains a
(FMC). AT operation is controlled warning light on each Autoflight Status and the Flight Management Computer Thrust Mode Annunciator (TMA), one AT
through the DFCS Mode Control Panel Annunciator, mode annunciation on each (FMC). AT operation is controlled warning light on each Autoflight Status
(MCP). The DFCS normally selects the EADI, and two Power Lever Angle (PLA) through the DFCS Mode Control Panel Annunciator, mode annunciation on each
AT mode. Interfacing also takes place synchros. (MCP). The DFCS normally selects the EADI, and two Power Lever Angle (PLA)
with the IRS and several other systems NOTE: The AT computer has an alpha AT mode. Interfacing also takes place synchros.
and components. The AT system is with the IRS and several other systems

and
OCT 99Systems Introduction 22-57 OCT 99 22-57
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE

DESCRIPTION & OPERATION


AUTOFLIGHT
22-58

MODE CONTROL PANEL THROTTLE LEVER ENGINE


CABLES CONTROL
INTEGRATED
A/T IAS/MACH V NAV
SERVOS
ARM

OFF
C/O

N1 SPEED LVL CHG


ENGINES
Autothrottle System Pictorial Diagram

SENSORS

A/T DISENGAGE

UNITED AIRLINES
TO/GA SWITCH ALT DH100
1700
N 1 /PLA GS 347
TAS 322 20
20
F
A/T MODES 10
10
AUTOTHROTTLE
TARGET SPEED COMPUTER
N1 LIMIT 10 S
10
FD
FLIGHT CONTROL N1
G/S VOR/LOC
HDG SEL
COMPUTERS MCP SPD
CWS PITCH CWS ROLL
A/T LIMIT LIGHT WARNINGS

B737-322/522
AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
AND ALERTS
THRUST MODE
ANNUNCIATOR A/T LIM EADI

N1

FLIGHT MANAGEMENT CRZ


COMPUTER
1888 MAN SET 1888
M 0

60
N1 1
80
400 MACH
% RPM A/P A/T FMC 78 100
P/RST P/RST P/RST
2 350 7
12 0 12 0
5 5 TEST 120
10 93. 4 2 10 93. 4 2 300 1
OCT 99

8
3 8
3 27 0 140
4 4 250 KNOTS
6 6 0 160
200 180
AUTOFLIGHT STATUS PULL TO SET

N1 DISPLAY ANNUNCIATOR
MACH/AIRSPEED

and Systems Introduction


22-58

DESCRIPTION & OPERATION


AUTOFLIGHT
MODE CONTROL PANEL THROTTLE LEVER ENGINE
CABLES CONTROL
INTEGRATED
A/T IAS/MACH V NAV
SERVOS
ARM

OFF
C/O

N1 SPEED LVL CHG


ENGINES
Autothrottle System Pictorial Diagram

SENSORS

A/T DISENGAGE

UNITED AIRLINES
TO/GA SWITCH ALT DH100
1700
N 1 /PLA GS 347
TAS 322 20
20
F
A/T MODES 10
10
AUTOTHROTTLE
TARGET SPEED COMPUTER
N1 LIMIT 10 S
10
FD
FLIGHT CONTROL N1
G/S VOR/LOC
HDG SEL
COMPUTERS MCP SPD
CWS PITCH CWS ROLL
A/T LIMIT LIGHT WARNINGS
B737-322/522
AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE

AND ALERTS
THRUST MODE
ANNUNCIATOR A/T LIM EADI

N1

FLIGHT MANAGEMENT CRZ


COMPUTER
1888 MAN SET 1888
M 0

60
N1 1
80
400 MACH
% RPM A/P A/T FMC 78 100
P/RST P/RST P/RST
2 350 7
12 0 12 0
5 5 TEST 120
93. 43 2 93. 43 2 1
OCT 99

10 10 300
8 4 8
27 0 140
4 250 KNOTS
6 6 0 160
200 180
AUTOFLIGHT STATUS PULL TO SET

N1 DISPLAY ANNUNCIATOR
MACH/AIRSPEED
UNITED AIRLINES COURSE
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
AUTOFLIGHT AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE AUTOFLIGHT AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

numeric readout on its front face, reversion mode during the takeoff mode, NOTE: The AT computer has an alpha the TMA. If the AT attempts to enter the
intended for bench (not flightline level) the AT will disengage. numeric readout on its front face, reversion mode during the takeoff mode,
troubleshooting only. The AT Computer Flight Selectable Modes intended for bench (not flightline level) the AT will disengage.
has a front mounted circuit breaker for AT mode selection must be compatible troubleshooting only. The AT Computer Flight Selectable Modes
PLA synchros excitation. with the DFCS mode engaged. If the FD is has a front mounted circuit breaker for AT mode selection must be compatible
OFF, and the AP is OFF or PCWS, either PLA synchros excitation. with the DFCS mode engaged. If the FD is
OPERATING MODES N1 or SPEED can be selected for the AT. OFF, and the AP is OFF or PCWS, either
Mode Control As a basic rule, with a DFCS pitch mode OPERATING MODES N1 or SPEED can be selected for the AT.
The desired mode of AT operation is man- selected, and the AT in ARM, airspeed is Mode Control As a basic rule, with a DFCS pitch mode
ually selected on the MCP. The FCC directly controlled by either engine thrust The desired mode of AT operation is man- selected, and the AT in ARM, airspeed is
allows the AT to go into a mode that is (N1 modes) or DFCS controlled elevators, ually selected on the MCP. The FCC directly controlled by either engine thrust
compatible with the pitch mose of opera- but never by both at the same time. During allows the AT to go into a mode that is (N1 modes) or DFCS controlled elevators,
tion. During Take Off and Go Around FD controlled Take Off and FD or AP Go compatible with the pitch mose of opera- but never by both at the same time. During
modes, and during certain abnormal con- Around modes, the AFDS is controlling tion. During Take Off and Go Around FD controlled Take Off and FD or AP Go
ditions, the AT mode is controlled by the forward speed of the aircraft. This is modes, and during certain abnormal con- Around modes, the AFDS is controlling
mode logic within the AT computer. The referred to as a "speed on elevators" mode. ditions, the AT mode is controlled by the forward speed of the aircraft. This is
engaged AT mode is displayed on the The AT system is controlling the rota- mode logic within the AT computer. The referred to as a "speed on elevators" mode.
FMA of both EADI's. tional speed of the engines, by automati- engaged AT mode is displayed on the The AT system is controlling the rota-
The engine thrust limit is automatically cally positioning both thrust levers within FMA of both EADI's. tional speed of the engines, by automati-
selected by the FMC. engine design parameters, as calculated by The engine thrust limit is automatically cally positioning both thrust levers within
Automatic AT Operating Limits and the FMCS, to maintain computed engine selected by the FMC. engine design parameters, as calculated by
Control Modes Minimum Speed thrust level (N1) limits. When the FD or Automatic AT Operating Limits and the FMCS, to maintain computed engine
A minimum speed command is provided AP controls the vertical flight profile Control Modes Minimum Speed thrust level (N1) limits. When the FD or
to prevent the airspeed command from (path); in Vertical Speed, Altitude Hold, A minimum speed command is provided AP controls the vertical flight profile
producing a low airspeed or an excessive or Glideslope modes, the AT system con- to prevent the airspeed command from (path); in Vertical Speed, Altitude Hold,
angle of attack. The minimum speed trols the forward speed of the aircraft. This producing a low airspeed or an excessive or Glideslope modes, the AT system con-
value, computed within the AT, is used is referred to as a "speed on throttles" angle of attack. The minimum speed trols the forward speed of the aircraft. This
when the AP is in any mode other than mode. The thrust levers follow a manually value, computed within the AT, is used is referred to as a "speed on throttles"
VNAV. When the AP is in VNAV, a min- selected (via the DFCS Mode Control when the AP is in any mode other than mode. The thrust levers follow a manually
imum speed value computed by the FMC Panel) or FMC computed airspeed (IAS or VNAV. When the AP is in VNAV, a min- selected (via the DFCS Mode Control
is used. Mach). During climb or descent, the imum speed value computed by the FMC Panel) or FMC computed airspeed (IAS or
Reversion Mode AFDS can be in either a vertical speed or is used. Mach). During climb or descent, the
If the AT detects a failure in FMC data, or airspeed mode. If the AFDS is in a vertical Reversion Mode AFDS can be in either a vertical speed or
if the selected N1 limit or target is invalid speed mode, the AT is in an airspeed If the AT detects a failure in FMC data, or airspeed mode. If the AFDS is in a vertical
or exceeds the maximum N1 limit, the AT mode. If the AFDS is in an airspeed mode, if the selected N1 limit or target is invalid speed mode, the AT is in an airspeed
will transfer to the reversion mode. In the the AT is in a N1 mode while in a climb, or exceeds the maximum N1 limit, the AT mode. If the AFDS is in an airspeed mode,
reversion mode, the AT computer reverts or RETARD mode while in a descent. will transfer to the reversion mode. In the the AT is in a N1 mode while in a climb,
to calculating the maximum N1 authority TAKEOFF - airspeed is maintained by reversion mode, the AT computer reverts or RETARD mode while in a descent.
and commands a forward throttle position following the FD pitch commands, and to calculating the maximum N1 authority TAKEOFF - airspeed is maintained by
limit of between 36 and 57 degrees, the AT sets engine thrust (N1), either and commands a forward throttle position following the FD pitch commands, and
depending on altitude, temperature, and full or reduced. limit of between 36 and 57 degrees, the AT sets engine thrust (N1), either
PMC status. AT LIM is annunciated on CLIMB - when the DFCS is maintaining depending on altitude, temperature, and full or reduced.
the TMA. If the AT attempts to enter the airspeed (MCP SPD or VNAV SPD), the PMC status. AT LIM is annunciated on CLIMB - when the DFCS is maintaining

and
OCT 99Systems Introduction 22-59 OCT 99 22-59
UNITED
B737 GENERAL AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
AUTOFLIGHT AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE AUTOFLIGHT AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

AT maintains N1 to the CLIMB N1 automatically selected by the DFCS when airspeed (MCP SPD or VNAV SPD), the through the DFCS Mode Control Panel or
limit. When the DFCS maintains vertical the DFCS is controlling airspeed and the AT maintains N1 to the CLIMB N1 automatically selected by the DFCS when
speed, the AT maintains MCP SPD. flight segment is such that engine thrust is limit. When the DFCS maintains vertical the DFCS is controlling airspeed and the
ALT ACQ - the DFCS acquires the required. speed, the AT maintains MCP SPD. flight segment is such that engine thrust is
selected altitude, and the AT maintains Speed/Mach Modes ALT ACQ - the DFCS acquires the required.
either MCP SPD, or if the DFCS climb The speed mode may be selected through selected altitude, and the AT maintains Speed/Mach Modes
is accomplished in VNAV SPD, the AT the MCP or it is automatically selected by either MCP SPD, or if the DFCS climb The speed mode may be selected through
maintains FMC SPD. the DFCS when the DFCS is not in a is accomplished in VNAV SPD, the AT the MCP or it is automatically selected by
CRUISE - the DFCS maintains the speed mode. The speed target is set and maintains FMC SPD. the DFCS when the DFCS is not in a
selected altitude, and the AT maintains displayed through the MCP (MCP SPD CRUISE - the DFCS maintains the speed mode. The speed target is set and
MCP SPD or FMC SPD. mode). When VNAV is selected for DFCS selected altitude, and the AT maintains displayed through the MCP (MCP SPD
DESCENT - with the DFCS controlling operation the speed target is provided by MCP SPD or FMC SPD. mode). When VNAV is selected for DFCS
vertical speed, the AT maintains MCP the FMC (FMC SPD mode) through the DESCENT - with the DFCS controlling operation the speed target is provided by
SPD. If the DFCS is in a speed mode AFDS. vertical speed, the AT maintains MCP the FMC (FMC SPD mode) through the
(MCP SPD or VNAV PATH), the AT AT Mode Annunciation SPD. If the DFCS is in a speed mode AFDS.
retards the throttle levers towards the aft Seven of eight possible engaged AT mode (MCP SPD or VNAV PATH), the AT AT Mode Annunciation
stop and annunciates RETARD. It then annunciations are displayed on both the retards the throttle levers towards the aft Seven of eight possible engaged AT mode
inhibits throttle control after reaching the Captain's and the First Officer's FMA, on stop and annunciates RETARD. It then annunciations are displayed on both the
aft stop and annunciates ARM the EADI's, to indicate current mode of inhibits throttle control after reaching the Captain's and the First Officer's FMA, on
APPROACH - after G/S engage, the AT operation. These N1 limits are pro- aft stop and annunciates ARM the EADI's, to indicate current mode of
DFCS controls the descent rate to main- vided by the FMC, and shown on both N1 APPROACH - after G/S engage, the AT operation. These N1 limits are pro-
tain the glide slope, and the AT main- indicators. When the AT is engaged, and DFCS controls the descent rate to main- vided by the FMC, and shown on both N1
tains the selected approach airspeed no modes are selected, the ARM annunci- tain the glide slope, and the AT main- indicators. When the AT is engaged, and
(MCP SPD). At less than 27' RA, the AT ation is displayed. The annunciation is tains the selected approach airspeed no modes are selected, the ARM annunci-
retards the throttles to the aft stop MCP SPEED, when the AT is maintaining (MCP SPD). At less than 27' RA, the AT ation is displayed. The annunciation is
(RETARD, then ARM), then disengages a target airspeed generated by the MCP. retards the throttles to the aft stop MCP SPEED, when the AT is maintaining
2 seconds after touchdown. When the AP mode is VNAV, the annun- (RETARD, then ARM), then disengages a target airspeed generated by the MCP.
GO AROUND - the DFCS controls air- ciation is FMC SPEED, and the AT main- 2 seconds after touchdown. When the AP mode is VNAV, the annun-
speed, and the AT maintains either tains a target airspeed generated by the GO AROUND - the DFCS controls air- ciation is FMC SPEED, and the AT main-
reduced or full GA N1. Reduced Go FMC. THR HOLD is annunciated during speed, and the AT maintains either tains a target airspeed generated by the
Around thrust is engaged by pressing the takeoff after CAS reaches 84 knots. THR reduced or full GA N1. Reduced Go FMC. THR HOLD is annunciated during
TOGA switch one time. The FMA HOLD terminates 17.5 seconds after lift- Around thrust is engaged by pressing the takeoff after CAS reaches 84 knots. THR
shows GA mode. A second push of the off. GA is annunciated during reduced Go TOGA switch one time. The FMA HOLD terminates 17.5 seconds after lift-
TOGA switch engages full Go Around Around operation, following the first press shows GA mode. A second push of the off. GA is annunciated during reduced Go
thrust. The FMA shows N1 mode. Other of the TOGA switch. N1 is the annuncia- TOGA switch engages full Go Around Around operation, following the first press
modes can be selected after engines have tion during maximum Go Around, follow- thrust. The FMA shows N1 mode. Other of the TOGA switch. N1 is the annuncia-
achieved the selected N1 limit and RA is ing the second press of the TOGA. modes can be selected after engines have tion during maximum Go Around, follow-
greater than 100'. RETARD mode is the active mode when achieved the selected N1 limit and RA is ing the second press of the TOGA.
N1 Mode throttles are driven aft at a predetermined greater than 100'. RETARD mode is the active mode when
During N1 mode, the AT controls throttle rate. The throttles retard to the aft limit N1 Mode throttles are driven aft at a predetermined
position to maintain the selected N1 target and the mode transitions to ARM. This During N1 mode, the AT controls throttle rate. The throttles retard to the aft limit
or limit. The N1 mode may be selected occurs during landing flare, or when AP position to maintain the selected N1 target and the mode transitions to ARM. This
through the DFCS Mode Control Panel or descent is engaged with speed on the ele- or limit. The N1 mode may be selected occurs during landing flare, or when AP

22-60 and Systems Introduction OCT 99 22-60 OCT 99


UNITED AIRLINES COURSE
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
AUTOFLIGHT AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE AUTOFLIGHT AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

vators. The eighth mode, AT Limit, is the the AT. This reversion mode occurs if the descent is engaged with speed on the ele- throttle lever position limit established by
N1 limit, if the throttle limit becomes a selected N1 limit from the FMC is invalid, vators. The eighth mode, AT Limit, is the the AT. This reversion mode occurs if the
throttle lever position limit established by or the AT is engaged and actual N1 is N1 limit, if the throttle limit becomes a selected N1 limit from the FMC is invalid,

Autothrottle Flight Modes Scenario Autothrottle Flight Modes Scenario

and
OCT 99Systems Introduction 22-61 OCT 99 22-61
UNITED
B737 GENERAL AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
AUTOFLIGHT AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE AUTOFLIGHT AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

invalid. valid logic for take-off and Approach. or the AT is engaged and actual N1 is • Radio Altimeter No. 1 provides RA
NOTE: AT Limit mode is shown as A/T • Landing gear lever position switch invalid. valid logic for take-off and Approach.
LIM, on the Thrust Mode Annunciator gives gear lever position up/down logic, NOTE: AT Limit mode is shown as A/T • Landing gear lever position switch
(TMA), installed on the first 50 -300's, logic 0 = handle down. LIM, on the Thrust Mode Annunciator gives gear lever position up/down logic,
and as an A/T LIM light above the • Flare logic comes from both Flight (TMA), installed on the first 50 -300's, logic 0 = handle down.
Engine Instrument System (EIS), Control Computers (FCC's). and as an A/T LIM light above the • Flare logic comes from both Flight
installed on all other -300's and all - • Power Management Computer (PMC) Engine Instrument System (EIS), Control Computers (FCC's).
500's. See Controls and Indications sec- on/off logic sent from flight deck over- installed on all other -300's and all - • Power Management Computer (PMC)
tion for the MASI and EIS indicators, head switch panel. 500's. See Controls and Indications sec- on/off logic sent from flight deck over-
and FMA and TMA displays. • Type of engines intermix installed on tion for the MASI and EIS indicators, head switch panel.
SYSTEM OPERATION the airplane, established by pin program- and FMA and TMA displays. • Type of engines intermix installed on
Input Interface Signals ming. SYSTEM OPERATION the airplane, established by pin program-
The AT computer is provided with signals • Thrust reverser not stowed and idle Input Interface Signals ming.
for mode control and commands, from its logic provided by the engine accessory The AT computer is provided with signals • Thrust reverser not stowed and idle
system sensors and interfacing systems. unit. for mode control and commands, from its logic provided by the engine accessory
The AT computer receives input signals in AT Computer Mode Logic Inputs system sensors and interfacing systems. unit.
analog, discrete, digital and digital dis- The following are discrete input signals The AT computer receives input signals in AT Computer Mode Logic Inputs
crete words format. which are used for mode logic in the AT analog, discrete, digital and digital dis- The following are discrete input signals
Analog Inputs computer: crete words format. which are used for mode logic in the AT
Analog inputs are provided to the AT • Air/Gnd Relay - Indicates when the Analog Inputs computer:
computer as follows: airplane is on the ground (high). The Analog inputs are provided to the AT • Air/Gnd Relay - Indicates when the
• Servo rate generators in both AT servo relay is operated from a teleflex cable on computer as follows: airplane is on the ground (high). The
actuator assemblies provide servo rate the right main gear. Logic in the landing • Servo rate generators in both AT servo relay is operated from a teleflex cable on
feedback. gear accessory unit provides an in-air/ actuator assemblies provide servo rate the right main gear. Logic in the landing
• Low Range Radio Altimeter No. 1 on-ground discrete. feedback. gear accessory unit provides an in-air/
provides radio altitude. • AT disengage switch is located on • Low Range Radio Altimeter No. 1 on-ground discrete.
• Left angle of airflow ALPHA vane each throttle - These switches provide provides radio altitude. • AT disengage switch is located on
provides for maximum angle of attack disengagement and AT warning light • Left angle of airflow ALPHA vane each throttle - These switches provide
and minimum safe speed reset. provides for maximum angle of attack disengagement and AT warning light
• Left flap position transmitter provides • DFCS Mode Control Panel - An AT and minimum safe speed reset.
for maximum angle of attack and mini- ARM switch on the MCP allows engag- • Left flap position transmitter provides • DFCS Mode Control Panel - An AT
mum safe speed. ing the AT. for maximum angle of attack and mini- ARM switch on the MCP allows engag-
• N1 transmitter provide N1 tach speed • Air Data Computer - An ADC air mum safe speed. ing the AT.
signals from each engine. speed valid logic discrete is provided for • N1 transmitter provide N1 tach speed • Air Data Computer - An ADC air
• Power Lever Angle (PLA) synchros use in the takeoff mode. signals from each engine. speed valid logic discrete is provided for
provide engine power lever position • PMC operational - Two discretes from • Power Lever Angle (PLA) synchros use in the takeoff mode.
feedback. engine module (P5) provide a high logic provide engine power lever position • PMC operational - Two discretes from
Discrete Logic Inputs if the PMC switch is ON and opera- feedback. engine module (P5) provide a high logic
Discrete logic is provided to the AT com- tional. This allows 65 degrees of forward Discrete Logic Inputs if the PMC switch is ON and opera-
puter as follows: throttle limit with the PMC ON and 55 Discrete logic is provided to the AT com- tional. This allows 65 degrees of forward
• Torque switch assembly provides degrees of forward throttle limit with the puter as follows: throttle limit with the PMC ON and 55
torque switch logic. PMC OFF. • Torque switch assembly provides degrees of forward throttle limit with the
• Radio Altimeter No. 1 provides RA • Low Idle (engine idle speed decreases torque switch logic. PMC OFF.

22-62 and Systems Introduction OCT 99 22-62 OCT 99


UNITED AIRLINES COURSE
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
AUTOFLIGHT AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE AUTOFLIGHT AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

to approximately 23 percent N1) - This NOTE: -300's, Ship # 's -1 through -50, • Low Idle (engine idle speed decreases tive operation of the engines.
discrete is provided four seconds after have conventional engine instruments to approximately 23 percent N1) - This NOTE: -300's, Ship # 's -1 through -50,
on the ground or if the flaps are between on the P2 panel. The TMA is a separate discrete is provided four seconds after have conventional engine instruments
0 to 15 units and the cowling anti-ice indicator above the engine instruments. on the ground or if the flaps are between on the P2 panel. The TMA is a separate
switches are in the OFF position. -300's, Ship # 's -51 and higher, and all - 0 to 15 units and the cowling anti-ice indicator above the engine instruments.
• TOGA Switches - These switches 500's, have CRT's for engine instru- switches are in the OFF position. -300's, Ship # 's -51 and higher, and all -
located on each throttle provide discrete ments, called Engine Instrument Sys- • TOGA Switches - These switches 500's, have CRT's for engine instru-
logic to enter the Takeoff or Go Around tem (EIS). These incorporate the TMA located on each throttle provide discrete ments, called Engine Instrument Sys-
mode. into the top of the EIS display. On these logic to enter the Takeoff or Go Around tem (EIS). These incorporate the TMA
Digital Inputs aircraft, one of the seven FMC calcu- mode. into the top of the EIS display. On these
The Autothrottle system receives digital lated N1 limits shows on EIS. A/T LIM Digital Inputs aircraft, one of the seven FMC calcu-
inputs from the MCP, FMC, DADC 1&2, shows as a separate light above the EIS. The Autothrottle system receives digital lated N1 limits shows on EIS. A/T LIM
and IRS 1&2. inputs from the MCP, FMC, DADC 1&2, shows as a separate light above the EIS.
Interface Outputs N1 Indicator and IRS 1&2.
• Clutch control is provided to the AT N1 limits for each flight profile and an N1 Interface Outputs N1 Indicator
servo actuator. A detailed schematic of target are provided by the FMC. The AT is • Clutch control is provided to the AT N1 limits for each flight profile and an N1
this circuit is shown on the AT servo provided with N1 limit select logic from servo actuator. A detailed schematic of target are provided by the FMC. The AT is
actuator control schematic. the DFCS or the FMC. The limits in use this circuit is shown on the AT servo provided with N1 limit select logic from
• EFIS Symbol Generators - the throttle are displayed by a N1 target cursor on actuator control schematic. the DFCS or the FMC. The limits in use
hold mode discrete is provided to the each N1 indicator. Actual N1 feedback is • EFIS Symbol Generators - the throttle are displayed by a N1 target cursor on
EFIS Symbol Generators. Also a dis- provided by a N1 transmitter on each hold mode discrete is provided to the each N1 indicator. Actual N1 feedback is
crete is provided to the Symbol Genera- engine. See Controls and Indications sec- EFIS Symbol Generators. Also a dis- provided by a N1 transmitter on each
tors to show that an AT is installed by tion for the EIS indicator, and FMA and crete is provided to the Symbol Genera- engine. See Controls and Indications sec-
sensing a ground. This logic is provided TMA displays. tors to show that an AT is installed by tion for the EIS indicator, and FMA and
for BITE diagnostic capability of the Servo Drive sensing a ground. This logic is provided TMA displays.
Symbol Generator. Airspeed and N1 command errors are for BITE diagnostic capability of the Servo Drive
• FMS Warning Annunciators, also computed by their respective command Symbol Generator. Airspeed and N1 command errors are
known as Autoflight Status Annuncia- functions. The servo drive function gener- • FMS Warning Annunciators, also computed by their respective command
tors (ASA) - AT Warning discretes are ates the throttle commands, then drives the known as Autoflight Status Annuncia- functions. The servo drive function gener-
provided to the ASA. throttle servo until the Power Lever Angle tors (ASA) - AT Warning discretes are ates the throttle commands, then drives the
Thrust Mode Annunciator (TMA) synchros (PLA) position feedback agrees provided to the ASA. throttle servo until the Power Lever Angle
The TMA shows one of seven different with the command. The PLA's are Thrust Mode Annunciator (TMA) synchros (PLA) position feedback agrees
thrust levels of FMC calculated N1 limit. mounted on the engines. Next the operat- The TMA shows one of seven different with the command. The PLA's are
These modes are used by the AT. Only if ing mode (SPEED or N1) is satisfied. thrust levels of FMC calculated N1 limit. mounted on the engines. Next the operat-
the FMC fails or gets invalid sensor data, Next throttle position monitors look at These modes are used by the AT. Only if ing mode (SPEED or N1) is satisfied.
will the AT control the N1 limit as a both N1's. If a throttle position error the FMC fails or gets invalid sensor data, Next throttle position monitors look at
backup. This condition is called AT Limit exists, the servo drive repositions the will the AT control the N1 limit as a both N1's. If a throttle position error
mode and annunciates A/T LIM on the throttles. Throttle rate feedback is pro- backup. This condition is called AT Limit exists, the servo drive repositions the
TMA in place of a FMC N1 limit modes. vided by generators in the servo assem- mode and annunciates A/T LIM on the throttles. Throttle rate feedback is pro-
N1 Limit gives less power than a FMC blies. The difference between each TMA in place of a FMC N1 limit modes. vided by generators in the servo assem-
mode, due to loss of FMC calculated N1 throttle's position commands is limited. N1 Limit gives less power than a FMC blies. The difference between each
information necessary to ensure conserva- With PMC ON, or 20 seconds after mode, due to loss of FMC calculated N1 throttle's position commands is limited.
tive operation of the engines. Glideslope captured during a dual channel information necessary to ensure conserva- With PMC ON, or 20 seconds after

and
OCT 99Systems Introduction 22-63 OCT 99 22-63
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE

DESCRIPTION & OPERATION


AUTOFLIGHT
22-64

A/T LIMIT
A/T IAS/MACH V NAV 2
ARM A/T LIMIT ANNUNCIATION R - TO R - CLB
CRZ G/A CON A/T LIMIT CRZ
A/T LIMM
ANNUNCIATOR 1888 MAN SET 1888
MODE SELECT 1 (FIG 15) N1
OFF
C/O % RPM
12 0 12 0
N1 SPEED LVL CHG THRUST MODE 1 5 5
A/P A/T FMC 10 93. 43 2 10 93. 43 2
ANNUNCIATOR P/RST P/RST P/RST
2
2 8 4 8 4
6 6
TEST
A/T DISENGAGE WARNING
(FIG 9)
DFCS MODE CONTROL PANEL
A/T ARM(ENGAGE) AUTOFLIGHT STATUS PRI ENGINE DISPLAY
ANNUNCIATOR(DUAL)
A/T FAST/SLOW(F/S)DATA
AIRSPEED, MACH, A/T MODE ANNUNCIATION: N1,FMC,SPD,
(FIG 6) EFIS SYMBOL ALT DH100
Autothrottle System Block Diagram

ALT,TAT(DUAL) MCP SPD,ARM,THR HOLD,GA,RETARD GS 347 1700


AIR DATA COMPUTER(DUAL) GENERATOR(DUAL)
TAS 322
20
20
F
10
10

BITE,ALT COUPLING (FIG 16)


ATTITUDE,ACCEL(DUAL) 10 S
(FIG 6) FLIGHT CONTROL % RPM X 10 10
FD
N1

UNITED AIRLINES
INERTIAL REF SYSTEM(DUAL) COMPUTER(DUAL) G/S
MCP SPD
VOR/LOC
HDG SEL
12 0 CWS PITCH CWS ROLL
N1 1
10 2
N1 SIGNAL(DUAL) 8 4
(FIG 10)
N1 TRANSMITTER(DUAL) (FIGS 6,16) N1 INDEX PULL TO SET ELECTRONIC ATTITUDE DIRECTOR
BITE,N1 LIMITS FLIGHT MANAGEMENT SETTINGS INDICATOR (DUAL)
COMPUTER
(FIG 7 ) ANGLE OF ATTACK
N1 INDICATOR(DUAL)
ANGLE OF ATTACK VANE-LEFT
A/T DISENGAGE SWITCH LOGIC (DUAL) (FIG 9)
TO/GA SWITCH LOGIC (DUAL) (FIG 10)

B737-322/522
AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
FLAP POSITION
FLAP XMTR-LEFT (FIG 7 )
TRAILING EDGE THROTTLE POSITION 1 (FIG 14)
PLA TO ENGINE 1
SYNCHRO POWER LEVER
(FIG 7 ) RADIO ALTITUDE & VALID (FIG 14)
LRRA-(LEFT) SERVO POSTION 1 THRUST LEVER 1
LOGIC
TACH 1 FWD
AIR/GRD LOGIC ACTUATOR ASSEMBLY TORQUE SWITCH
(FIG 15 )
SQUAT SWITCH MECHANISM
THROTTLE POSITION 2 (FIG 14) TO ENGINE 2
PLA POWER LEVER
REVERSER THRUST SYNCHRO
LOGIC(DUAL)
THRUST REVERSER (FIG 8 ) SERVO POSTION 2
(FIG 14)
RELAYS(DUAL) THRUST LEVER 2
OCT 99

OP/INOP LOGIC(DUAL) TACH 2 LOGIC


1 AIRPLANES WITHOUT EIS
POWER MANAGEMENT (FIG 8 )
ACTUATOR ASSEMBLY TORQUE SWITCH
COMPUTER SWITCHES(DUAL) 2 AIRPLANES WITH EIS
AUTOTHROTTLE COMPUTER MECHANISM

and Systems Introduction


22-64

DESCRIPTION & OPERATION


AUTOFLIGHT
A/T LIMIT
A/T IAS/MACH V NAV 2
ARM A/T LIMIT ANNUNCIATION R - TO R - CLB
CRZ G/A CON A/T LIMIT CRZ
A/T LIMM
ANNUNCIATOR 1888 MAN SET 1888
MODE SELECT 1 (FIG 15) N1
OFF
C/O % RPM
12 0 12 0
N1 SPEED LVL CHG THRUST MODE 1 5 5
A/P A/T FMC 10 93. 43 2 10 93. 43 2
ANNUNCIATOR P/RST P/RST P/RST
2
2 8 4 8 4
6 6
TEST
A/T DISENGAGE WARNING
(FIG 9)
DFCS MODE CONTROL PANEL
A/T ARM(ENGAGE) AUTOFLIGHT STATUS PRI ENGINE DISPLAY
ANNUNCIATOR(DUAL)
A/T FAST/SLOW(F/S)DATA
AIRSPEED, MACH, A/T MODE ANNUNCIATION: N1,FMC,SPD,
(FIG 6) EFIS SYMBOL ALT DH100
Autothrottle System Block Diagram

ALT,TAT(DUAL) MCP SPD,ARM,THR HOLD,GA,RETARD GS 347 1700


AIR DATA COMPUTER(DUAL) GENERATOR(DUAL)
TAS 322
20
20
F
10
10

BITE,ALT COUPLING (FIG 16)


ATTITUDE,ACCEL(DUAL) 10 S
(FIG 6) FLIGHT CONTROL % RPM X 10 10
FD
N1

UNITED AIRLINES
INERTIAL REF SYSTEM(DUAL) COMPUTER(DUAL) G/S
MCP SPD
VOR/LOC
HDG SEL
12 0 CWS PITCH CWS ROLL
N1 1
10 2
N1 SIGNAL(DUAL) 8 4
(FIG 10)
N1 TRANSMITTER(DUAL) (FIGS 6,16) N1 INDEX PULL TO SET ELECTRONIC ATTITUDE DIRECTOR
BITE,N1 LIMITS FLIGHT MANAGEMENT SETTINGS INDICATOR (DUAL)
COMPUTER
(FIG 7 ) ANGLE OF ATTACK
N1 INDICATOR(DUAL)
ANGLE OF ATTACK VANE-LEFT
A/T DISENGAGE SWITCH LOGIC (DUAL) (FIG 9)
TO/GA SWITCH LOGIC (DUAL) (FIG 10)
B737-322/522
AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE

FLAP POSITION
FLAP XMTR-LEFT (FIG 7 )
TRAILING EDGE THROTTLE POSITION 1 (FIG 14)
PLA TO ENGINE 1
SYNCHRO POWER LEVER
(FIG 7 ) RADIO ALTITUDE & VALID (FIG 14)
LRRA-(LEFT) SERVO POSTION 1 THRUST LEVER 1
LOGIC
TACH 1 FWD
AIR/GRD LOGIC ACTUATOR ASSEMBLY TORQUE SWITCH
(FIG 15 )
SQUAT SWITCH MECHANISM
THROTTLE POSITION 2 (FIG 14) TO ENGINE 2
PLA POWER LEVER
REVERSER THRUST SYNCHRO
LOGIC(DUAL)
THRUST REVERSER (FIG 8 ) SERVO POSTION 2
(FIG 14)
RELAYS(DUAL) THRUST LEVER 2
OCT 99

OP/INOP LOGIC(DUAL) TACH 2 LOGIC


1 AIRPLANES WITHOUT EIS
POWER MANAGEMENT (FIG 8 )
ACTUATOR ASSEMBLY TORQUE SWITCH
COMPUTER SWITCHES(DUAL) 2 AIRPLANES WITH EIS
AUTOTHROTTLE COMPUTER MECHANISM
UNITED AIRLINES COURSE
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
AUTOFLIGHT AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE AUTOFLIGHT AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

approach, the command split is limited to indicators are referenced to the command Glideslope captured during a dual channel computed by the AT computer. The FS
8 degrees. This prevents disengagement speed shown by the airspeed cursors on approach, the command split is limited to indicators are referenced to the command
due to differing commands, as would the Mach/Airspeed indicators. This refer- 8 degrees. This prevents disengagement speed shown by the airspeed cursors on
occur during an engine failure. AT discon- ence airspeed is limited by the AT mini- due to differing commands, as would the Mach/Airspeed indicators. This refer-
nect occurs if the throttle levers split by 10 mum, maximum and placard speed occur during an engine failure. AT discon- ence airspeed is limited by the AT mini-
degrees, and less during a high split rate. monitoring, and may be data from either nect occurs if the throttle levers split by 10 mum, maximum and placard speed
Electromagnetic Clutch Control the MCP speed selector, or the FMC. The degrees, and less during a high split rate. monitoring, and may be data from either
The AT servo actuator is connected to the FS indicators display the difference Electromagnetic Clutch Control the MCP speed selector, or the FMC. The
throttle cables through an electromagnetic between actual airspeed and commanded The AT servo actuator is connected to the FS indicators display the difference
clutch. When the AT is engaged, the airspeed. The display is centered when the throttle cables through an electromagnetic between actual airspeed and commanded
clutch is energized unless the thrust levers actual airspeed agrees with the com- clutch. When the AT is engaged, the airspeed. The display is centered when the
are restrained, or during throttle hold manded airspeed. The upper and lower clutch is energized unless the thrust levers actual airspeed agrees with the com-
mode. Restraint may result from the thrust limits of the display are 10 knots. If the are restrained, or during throttle hold manded airspeed. The upper and lower
levers being driven into the aft stop or by airplane is 10 knots below the commanded mode. Restraint may result from the thrust limits of the display are 10 knots. If the
action of the crew. Restraint is detected by airspeed, the FS cursor will be at the lower levers being driven into the aft stop or by airplane is 10 knots below the commanded
the torque switches. diamond, marked "S". Conversely, if the action of the crew. Restraint is detected by airspeed, the FS cursor will be at the lower
Torque Limiter Switch cursor is on the upper, "F" diamond, the the torque switches. diamond, marked "S". Conversely, if the
If approximately 5 #'s torque is sensed airspeed is 10 knots higher than the com- Torque Limiter Switch cursor is on the upper, "F" diamond, the
through the torque switch mechanism, the manded airspeed. If the AT is engaged in a If approximately 5 #'s torque is sensed airspeed is 10 knots higher than the com-
torque switch opens. When the torque speed mode (FMC SPD or MCP SPD), the through the torque switch mechanism, the manded airspeed. If the AT is engaged in a
switch opens, the clutch is deenergized. FS is enabled. The AT need not be torque switch opens. When the torque speed mode (FMC SPD or MCP SPD), the
When the AT is ready to drive the throttle engaged to display the FS indicators. For switch opens, the clutch is deenergized. FS is enabled. The AT need not be
levers away from the aft stop, the torque example, with the AT OFF, both FD's When the AT is ready to drive the throttle engaged to display the FS indicators. For
switch, if open, must be bypassed to per- OFF, and neither AP engaged in CMD, the levers away from the aft stop, the torque example, with the AT OFF, both FD's
mit clutch engagement. fast-slow indicators are in view and are switch, if open, must be bypassed to per- OFF, and neither AP engaged in CMD, the
Torque Limiter Switch Bypass referenced to the speed manually selected mit clutch engagement. fast-slow indicators are in view and are
If the throttles are aft of 6 degrees (thrust in the MCP speed window. The FS pointer Torque Limiter Switch Bypass referenced to the speed manually selected
lever angle) when the torque switch is is not displayed when the AT is engaged If the throttles are aft of 6 degrees (thrust in the MCP speed window. The FS pointer
open, the AT mode is ARM. This allows in the N1 mode or RETARD mode, the lever angle) when the torque switch is is not displayed when the AT is engaged
an automatic advance of the throttles upon pitch axis controlling airspeed (TAKE- open, the AT mode is ARM. This allows in the N1 mode or RETARD mode, the
AT command. OFF, GO AROUND, LVL CHG or an automatic advance of the throttles upon pitch axis controlling airspeed (TAKE-
Torque Switch Mechanism VNAV SPD modes), or if the AT or AT command. OFF, GO AROUND, LVL CHG or
The torque switch mechanism is mounted AFDS has failed. Torque Switch Mechanism VNAV SPD modes), or if the AT or
between the AT servo and torque limiter Throttle Director Operation The torque switch mechanism is mounted AFDS has failed.
switch. With 18 #'s of force, the crew is When speed is being held with manual between the AT servo and torque limiter Throttle Director Operation
able to override a jammed servo motor throttle control, the FS indicator operation switch. With 18 #'s of force, the crew is When speed is being held with manual
mechanism. It is connected to the throttle provides a slightly different type of dis- able to override a jammed servo motor throttle control, the FS indicator operation
cables and requires rigging of the cables play. With the AT OFF or ARM and the mechanism. It is connected to the throttle provides a slightly different type of dis-
upon replacement. AFDS not engaged in a speed mode (not cables and requires rigging of the cables play. With the AT OFF or ARM and the
ADI Fast/Slow Indicators in TOGA, MCP SPD or VNAV SPD), the upon replacement. AFDS not engaged in a speed mode (not
The Fast/Slow (FS) indications on the FS indicators give anticipatory indica- ADI Fast/Slow Indicators in TOGA, MCP SPD or VNAV SPD), the
ADI's are enabled by the master FCC and tions, and the throttles should be moved to The Fast/Slow (FS) indications on the FS indicators give anticipatory indica-
computed by the AT computer. The FS ADI's are enabled by the master FCC and

and
OCT 99Systems Introduction 22-65 OCT 99 22-65
UNITED AIRLINES UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
AUTOFLIGHT AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE AUTOFLIGHT AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE

and Systems Introduction


Autothrottle Servo Actuator Control Schematic Autothrottle Servo Actuator Control Schematic
22-66 OCT 99 22-66 OCT 99
UNITED AIRLINES COURSE
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
AUTOFLIGHT AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE AUTOFLIGHT AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

keep the fast-slow indicators centered. The AT ARM mode is enabled when the tions, and the throttles should be moved to if the ADC, N1, or N1 target is invalid.
The indicators center when airspeed is AT is engaged and no AT mode has been keep the fast-slow indicators centered. The AT ARM mode is enabled when the
changing with proper direction and rate to selected and Throttle Hold mode is not set. The indicators center when airspeed is AT is engaged and no AT mode has been
capture the commanded speed, even The AT is engaged and ready to control changing with proper direction and rate to selected and Throttle Hold mode is not set.
though actual speed does not yet equal the throttles; however, no active made has capture the commanded speed, even The AT is engaged and ready to control
commanded speed. Excessive or insuffi- been selected. The output to the servos is though actual speed does not yet equal the throttles; however, no active made has
cient thrust settings are shown as fast or inhibited. commanded speed. Excessive or insuffi- been selected. The output to the servos is
slow indications. A SPEED flag covers Disengage cient thrust settings are shown as fast or inhibited.
each FS scale to indicate power loss or If a disengage event occurs, the AT com- slow indications. A SPEED flag covers Disengage
system failure. puter opens the engage interlock circuit. each FS scale to indicate power loss or If a disengage event occurs, the AT com-
NOTE: The ADI FS indicator and The AT switch returns to OFF, and flash- system failure. puter opens the engage interlock circuit.
throttle director only operate on -300/ ing red AT Disengage lights alternately NOTE: The ADI FS indicator and The AT switch returns to OFF, and flash-
500's before COA 9-2657 has been flash. The AT system will disengage if: throttle director only operate on -300/ ing red AT Disengage lights alternately
accomplished. This COA changes the • The AT computer fails or loses inter- 500's before COA 9-2657 has been flash. The AT system will disengage if:
ADI displays. Started in Summer of nal circuitry valid or logic valid signal. accomplished. This COA changes the • The AT computer fails or loses inter-
1996, the FS indicator and throttle • Loss of interfacing system valid. The ADI displays. Started in Summer of nal circuitry valid or logic valid signal.
director are removed. An Airspeed input sensor signals in use become 1996, the FS indicator and throttle • Loss of interfacing system valid. The
scale is added. The Flight Mode Annun- invalid. Loss of N1 during takeoff mode. director are removed. An Airspeed input sensor signals in use become
ciator, glideslope scales, Radio altitude, • Loss of both DADC's. #1 DADC is scale is added. The Flight Mode Annun- invalid. Loss of N1 during takeoff mode.
and Decision Height are moved. The normally used. If it fails, #2 DADC is ciator, glideslope scales, Radio altitude, • Loss of both DADC's. #1 DADC is
ground speed and true airspeed have automatically used. and Decision Height are moved. The normally used. If it fails, #2 DADC is
been moved to the HSI. A graphic of the • Loss of both IRU's. If one IRU fails, ground speed and true airspeed have automatically used.
new ADI displays, is in the Controls and the other is automatically used. been moved to the HSI. A graphic of the • Loss of both IRU's. If one IRU fails,
Indication section of this chapter. • Pressing either AT disengage switch new ADI displays, is in the Controls and the other is automatically used.
on the forward thrust levers. Indication section of this chapter. • Pressing either AT disengage switch
ENGAGE AND WARNING MONI- • Disengage also occurs if the AT on the forward thrust levers.
TORS ARM-OFF switch is moved to OFF. ENGAGE AND WARNING MONI- • Disengage also occurs if the AT
Interlock Monitors • Throttle lever monitor - Rate compen- TORS ARM-OFF switch is moved to OFF.
Various AT interlocks must be satisfied sated throttle positions split by more Interlock Monitors • Throttle lever monitor - Rate compen-
before the AT ARM-OFF switch will than 10 degrees with dual AP after Various AT interlocks must be satisfied sated throttle positions split by more
latch in the ARM position. Also, Outside FLARE armed. before the AT ARM-OFF switch will than 10 degrees with dual AP after
Air Temperature must be entered into the • The interlock circuit automatically latch in the ARM position. Also, Outside FLARE armed.
Computer Display Unit. The AT will only disengages the AT two seconds after Air Temperature must be entered into the • The interlock circuit automatically
stay engaged in ARM or another mode if touchdown, if not in Go Around mode. Computer Display Unit. The AT will only disengages the AT two seconds after
all required conditions are satisfied. This function is inhibited when less than stay engaged in ARM or another mode if touchdown, if not in Go Around mode.
Arm Mode Logic 60 knots and the FMC is in the Takeoff all required conditions are satisfied. This function is inhibited when less than
The AT is engaged by placing the sole- mode. Arm Mode Logic 60 knots and the FMC is in the Takeoff
noid held AT switch to the ARM position. • N1 maximum speed limit N1 seen by The AT is engaged by placing the sole- mode.
To engage the AT on the ground, the FMC an overspeed monitor, used with the noid held AT switch to the ARM position. • N1 maximum speed limit N1 seen by
must have temperature added to the CDU PMC OFF. To engage the AT on the ground, the FMC an overspeed monitor, used with the
Takeoff page, or AT BITE in progress. • Validity inhibit - if the engaged mode must have temperature added to the CDU PMC OFF.
AT engagement on the ground is inhibited becomes invalid, the AT disengages. Takeoff page, or AT BITE in progress. • Validity inhibit - if the engaged mode
if the ADC, N1, or N1 target is invalid. The necessary valids are: Mach, TAT AT engagement on the ground is inhibited becomes invalid, the AT disengages.

and
OCT 99Systems Introduction 22-67 OCT 99 22-67
UNITED
B737 GENERAL AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
AUTOFLIGHT AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE AUTOFLIGHT AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

(except TO mode) barometric altitude Retard (landing) or Throttle Hold The necessary valids are: Mach, TAT will not cause a disconnect during
and CAS (both). Loss of these valids modes. (except TO mode) barometric altitude Retard (landing) or Throttle Hold
will not cause a disconnect during • Circuit monitor sees poor update rate and CAS (both). Loss of these valids modes.

A/T IAS/MACH A/T IAS/MACH


ARM ARM

OFF OFF
C/O C/O

N1 SPEED N1 SPEED

DFCS MODE CONTROL PANEL DFCS MODE CONTROL PANEL


SENSORS SENSORS
A/T LIM A/T LIMIT A/T LIM A/T LIMIT

MAN SET MAN SET

% RPM % RPM

0 0 0 0
12
2
12
2
N1 1 BLOOM 12
2
12
2
N1 1 BLOOM
10 10 10 10
8 4 8 4 8 4 8 4
6 6 6 6

N1 N1

PRIMARY ENGINE DISPLAY PRIMARY ENGINE DISPLAY

PERFORM PERFORM

ENGAGE ENGAGE
INTERLOCKS INTERLOCKS

S S
P P
D D

AUTOTHROTTLE F/S FLAG AUTOTHROTTLE F/S FLAG


COMPUTER COMPUTER

Autothrottle Flight Deck Effects Block Diagram Autothrottle Flight Deck Effects Block Diagram

22-68 and Systems Introduction OCT 99 22-68 OCT 99


UNITED AIRLINES COURSE
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
AUTOFLIGHT AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE AUTOFLIGHT AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

of the processor, or the relative position This routine provides quick tests of the • Circuit monitor sees poor update rate Current Status Tests
of the thrust levers. computer and its interfaces. It provides of the processor, or the relative position This routine provides quick tests of the
AT Red Warning Lights Operation fault identification, and enables the inter- of the thrust levers. computer and its interfaces. It provides
The AT Warning light is one of three active tests. AT Red Warning Lights Operation fault identification, and enables the inter-
warning lights on each of two FMS Warn- In Flight Faults The AT Warning light is one of three active tests.
ing Annunciators, on the P1 and P2 pan- The AT computer records the fault history warning lights on each of two FMS Warn- In Flight Faults
els. The light circuit is armed when the AT for the last 10 flights, in non-volatile ing Annunciators, on the P1 and P2 pan- The AT computer records the fault history
switch is in the ARM position. The AT memory. This routine provides access to els. The light circuit is armed when the AT for the last 10 flights, in non-volatile
Warning lights are connected in parallel, the record. In addition to the fault isolation switch is in the ARM position. The AT memory. This routine provides access to
and shows the fail or warning status of the routines described above, the AT BITE Warning lights are connected in parallel, the record. In addition to the fault isolation
AT. A disengage warning circuit provides program contains routines for the rigging and shows the fail or warning status of the routines described above, the AT BITE
red alternating flashing AT Warning of the throttle system. The rigging routines AT. A disengage warning circuit provides program contains routines for the rigging
lights, if the disengagement is due to an consist of the AT range check and AT rig- red alternating flashing AT Warning of the throttle system. The rigging routines
invalid condition. The warning light is ging adjust. lights, if the disengagement is due to an consist of the AT range check and AT rig-
reset by pressing either AT Warning light, LRU Interface Tests invalid condition. The warning light is ging adjust.
either AT disengage switch, or positioning This test routine provides the evaluation of reset by pressing either AT Warning light, LRU Interface Tests
the AT ARM switch to ARM. test data from interfacing systems and sen- either AT disengage switch, or positioning This test routine provides the evaluation of
Press To Test sors. The routines do not test the interfac- the AT ARM switch to ARM. test data from interfacing systems and sen-
One test switch on each FMS Warning ing systems, only the electrical interface. Press To Test sors. The routines do not test the interfac-
Annunciator self tests its lights. Each light AT Range Check One test switch on each FMS Warning ing systems, only the electrical interface.
has separate press to reset capability. The This routine provides instructions to per- Annunciator self tests its lights. Each light AT Range Check
Test switch on the Autoflight Status form the throttle range check, and displays has separate press to reset capability. The This routine provides instructions to per-
Annunciator tests the AT warning lights. the corresponding throttle position values. Test switch on the Autoflight Status form the throttle range check, and displays
In position one, amber is tested; in posi- AT Rigging Adjust Annunciator tests the AT warning lights. the corresponding throttle position values.
tion two, red is tested. This routine provides instructions to set up In position one, amber is tested; in posi- AT Rigging Adjust
SYSTEM TESTING and adjust for the correct rigging posi- tion two, red is tested. This routine provides instructions to set up
System BITE tions; and displays the Power Lever Angle SYSTEM TESTING and adjust for the correct rigging posi-
The AT Built In Test Equipment (BITE) synchro output. Consult the MM for com- System BITE tions; and displays the Power Lever Angle
provides for the ground maintenance test- plete details of the AT BITE operation. The AT Built In Test Equipment (BITE) synchro output. Consult the MM for com-
ing of the AT system. AT BITE is con- Engineering Codes provides for the ground maintenance test- plete details of the AT BITE operation.
tained in the AT computer, and is accessed ing of the AT system. AT BITE is con-
through the Flight Management Computer tained in the AT computer, and is accessed
System CDU. As the BITE routines, through the Flight Management Computer
stored in the AT computer, are accessed, System CDU. As the BITE routines,
instructions and test results are displayed stored in the AT computer, are accessed,
on the FMC CDU. In order to minimize instructions and test results are displayed
ground test time, the BITE computer pro- on the FMC CDU. In order to minimize
gram is divided into three fault isolation ground test time, the BITE computer pro-
routines: Current Status, LRU Interface gram is divided into three fault isolation
tests, and In Flight Faults storage and dis- routines: Current Status, LRU Interface
play. tests, and In Flight Faults storage and dis-
Current Status Tests play.

and
OCT 99Systems Introduction 22-69 OCT 99 22-69
UNITED
B737 GENERAL AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
AUTOFLIGHT AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE AUTOFLIGHT AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

AT BITE Introduction Block Diagram AT BITE Introduction Block Diagram

22-70 and Systems Introduction OCT 99 22-70 OCT 99


UNITED AIRLINES COURSE
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
AUTOFLIGHT AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE AUTOFLIGHT AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

The following codes may be entered on for each of the FMS subsytems shown. Engineering Codes Key (LSK) 6R, following BITE failure,
the CDU followed by pressing Line Select The following codes may be entered on for each of the FMS subsytems shown.
Key (LSK) 6R, following BITE failure, the CDU followed by pressing Line Select

CODE SYSTEM PURPOSE CODE SYSTEM PURPOSE

100 FMCS Access to current status diagnostic 100 FMCS Access to current status diagnostic
AT failures AT failures
DFCS DFCS

300 DFCS Access to inflight faults engineering 300 DFCS Access to inflight faults engineering
FMCS data FMCS data

CLR/ALL AT Delete recorded inflight faults CLR/ALL AT Delete recorded inflight faults

System Troubleshooting 10. Remember to consult service tips AT-Built In Test Equipment, MM 22-04-
For troubleshooting information, see: AT located in many places throughout the System Troubleshooting 10. Remember to consult service tips
System Troubleshooting, MM 22-31-00 MM. For troubleshooting information, see: AT located in many places throughout the
AT-Built In Test Equipment, MM 22-04- System Troubleshooting, MM 22-31-00 MM.

and
OCT 99Systems Introduction 22-71 OCT 99 22-71
UNITED AIRLINES COURSE
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
AUTOFLIGHT AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE AUTOFLIGHT AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
CONTROLS & INDICATIONS CONTROLS & INDICATIONS
EADI - Electronic Attitude Direction Indicator EADI - Electronic Attitude Direction Indicator
Location: Captains and First Officer’s Forward Instru- Location: Captains and First Officer’s Forward Instru-
ment Panels ment Panels

MCP SPD G/S VOR/LOC CMD MCP SPD G/S VOR/LOC CMD

DH100 DH100
1700 1700
180 20 180 20
20 20
F F
160 10 160 10
10 10
140 140
9 9
120 120
10 10
10 S 10 S
100 DH200 100 DH200
1700 1700

1ST LINE - A/T ENGAGED 1ST LINE - A/P STATS 1ST LINE - A/T ENGAGED 1ST LINE - A/P STATS
N1 (G) CMD (G) N1 (G) CMD (G)
GA (G) PFD (G) GA (G) PFD (G)
RETARD (G) RETARD (G)
FMC SPD (G) FMC SPD (G)
MCP SPD (G) MCP SPD (G)
THR HLD (G) THR HLD (G)
ARM (W) ARM (W)

2ND LINE - PITCH ARMED 2ND LINE - ROLL ARMED 2ND LINE - PITCH ARMED 2ND LINE - ROLL ARMED
G/S (W) VOR/LOC (W) G/S (W) VOR/LOC (W)
V/S (W) V/S (W)
FLARE (W) FLARE (W)

3RD LINE - PITCH ENGAGED 3RD LINE - ROLL ENGAGED 3RD LINE - PITCH ENGAGED 3RD LINE - ROLL ENGAGED
TO/GA (G) HDG SEL (G) TO/GA (G) HDG SEL (G)
V/S (G) VOR/LOC (G) V/S (G) VOR/LOC (G)
ALT ACQ (G) LNAV (G) ALT ACQ (G) LNAV (G)
ALT HOL (G) ALT HOL (G)
VNAV SPD (G) VNAV SPD (G)
VNAV PATH (G) VNAV PATH (G)
MCP SPD (G) MCP SPD (G)
G/S (G) G/S (G)
FLARE (G) FLARE (G)

4TH LINE - CWS PITCH ENGAGED 4TH LINE - CWS ROLL ENGAGED 4TH LINE - CWS PITCH ENGAGED 4TH LINE - CWS ROLL ENGAGED
CWS PITCH (A) CWS ROLL (A) CWS PITCH (A) CWS ROLL (A)

and
OCT 99Systems Introduction 22-73 OCT 99 22-73
UNITED
B737 GENERAL AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
AUTOFLIGHT AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE AUTOFLIGHT AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
CONTROLS & INDICATIONS CONTROLS & INDICATIONS
FLIGHT MODE ANNUNCIATIONS (FMA) FLIGHT MODE ANNUNCIATIONS (FMA)
ADI ADI

Mode Change Highlight Symbol Mode Change Highlight Symbol


A mode change highlight symbol(rectangle) A mode change highlight symbol(rectangle)
is drawn around esch pitch, roll, CWS, and is drawn around esch pitch, roll, CWS, and
thrust engaged mode annunciation for a thrust engaged mode annunciation for a
period of 10 seconds after each engagement. period of 10 seconds after each engagement.

The color of the rectangle corresponds to the The color of the rectangle corresponds to the
color of the displayed annunciation. color of the displayed annunciation.

A/T ENGAGED A/T ENGAGED


A/P STATUS A/P STATUS
N1 (G) N1 (G)
ALT DH150 ALT DH150
GA (G) 1780 CMD (G) GA (G) 1780 CMD (G)
GS347 GS347
RETARD (G) TAS322 FD (G) RETARD (G) TAS322 FD (G)
20 20
FMC SPD (G) 20 TEST (G) FMC SPD (G) 20 TEST (G)
MCP SPD (G) MCP SPD (G)
THR HLD (G) 10 THR HLD (G) 10
ARM (W) 10 ARM (W) 10

PITCH ARMED ROLL ARMED PITCH ARMED ROLL ARMED


G/S (W) 1.0
0.8
0.6
0.4
0.2
0.0
G/S (W) 1.0
0.8
0.6
0.4
0.2
0.0

V/S (W) 10 VOR/LOC (W) V/S (W) 10 VOR/LOC (W)


G/S V/S (W) FMC SPD 10 G/S V/S (W) FMC SPD 10
FD FD
FLARE (W) G/S VOR/LOC FLARE (W) G/S VOR/LOC
VNAV SPD HGD SEL VNAV SPD HGD SEL
CWS PITCH CWS ROLL CWS PITCH CWS ROLL

ROLL ENGAGED ROLL ENGAGED


PITCH ENGAGED HDG SEL (G) PITCH ENGAGED HDG SEL (G)
TO/GA (G) VOR/LOC (G) TO/GA (G) VOR/LOC (G)
V/S (G) LNAV (G) V/S (G) LNAV (G)
ALT ACQ (G) ALT ACQ (G)
ALT HOLD (G) ALT HOLD (G)
VNAV SPD (G) VNAV SPD (G)
VNAV PATH (G) CWS ROLL ENGAGED VNAV PATH (G) CWS ROLL ENGAGED
MCP SPD (G) MCP SPD (G)
CWS ROLL (Y) CWS ROLL (Y)
G/S (G) G/S (G)
FLARE (G) (G) - GREEN FLARE (G) (G) - GREEN
(W)- WHITE (W)- WHITE
CWS PITCH ENGAGED (Y) - YELLOW CWS PITCH ENGAGED (Y) - YELLOW
CWS PITCH (Y) CWS PITCH (Y)

Location: Lower Corners of each ADI Location: Lower Corners of each ADI

22-74 and Systems Introduction OCT 99 22-74 OCT 99


UNITED AIRLINES COURSE
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
AUTOFLIGHT AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE AUTOFLIGHT AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
CONTROLS & INDICATIONS CONTROLS & INDICATIONS
EHSI - Electronic Horizontal EHSI - Electronic Horizontal
Situation Indicator Situation Indicator
Location: Captains and First Officer’s For- Location: Captains and First Officer’s For-
ward Instrument Panels ward Instrument Panels

DME 13.5 HDG 127 M SELECTED HDG DME 13.5 HDG 127 M SELECTED HDG

12 15 12 15
9 9
SELECTED SELECTED
COURSE COURSE

40 40
VOR VOR
DEVIATION DEVIATION

TO/FROM TO/FROM
0 0
120 /20 TO ANNUNCIATION 120 /20 TO ANNUNCIATION
VOR 2 116.80 VOR 2 116.80

VOR FREQUENCY VOR FREQUENCY

and
OCT 99Systems Introduction 22-75 OCT 99 22-75
UNITED
B737 GENERAL AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
AUTOFLIGHT AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE AUTOFLIGHT AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
CONTROLS & INDICATIONS CONTROLS & INDICATIONS

AIRSPEED AIRSPEED
CURSOR CURSOR
INOP FLAG INOP FLAG

MANUAL MODE FLAG MANUAL MODE FLAG

M 0 M 0

60 60
TARGET
80 TARGET
80
400 MACH 400 MACH
AIRSPEED
CURSOR
7
MACH
8 100
AIRSPEED
CURSOR
7
MACH
8 100
350 7 350 7
IN IN
V MO OP 120 V MO OP 120
300 1 300 1
27
A/S0 140 27
A/S0 140
250 KNOTS 250 KNOTS
0 160 0 160
200 180 200 180

PULL TO SET PULL TO SET

TARGET AIRSPEED TARGET AIRSPEED


CURSOR KNOB MANUAL CURSOR KNOB MANUAL
SET (PULL OUT) SET (PULL OUT)
EXTERNAL SOURSE - AUTO (PUSHED IN) EXTERNAL SOURSE - AUTO (PUSHED IN)

ELECTRIC MACH AIRSPEED INDICATOR (FMCS) ELECTRIC MACH AIRSPEED INDICATOR (FMCS)

22-76 and Systems Introduction OCT 99 22-76 OCT 99


UNITED AIRLINES COURSE
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
AUTOFLIGHT AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE AUTOFLIGHT AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
CONTROLS & INDICATIONS CONTROLS & INDICATIONS

ALTITUDE ALERTING SYSTEM ALTITUDE ALERTING SYSTEM

ALTITUDE ALTITUDE

ALTITUDE SEL ALTITUDE SEL


Selects reference altitude for altitude Selects reference altitude for altitude
alerting and autopilot altitude acquisition. alerting and autopilot altitude acquisition.

SEL SEL
a) a)

ALTITUDE ALERT Light ALTITUDE ALERT Light


ON- Indicates approach to within 900 ON- Indicates approach to within 900
feet of selected altitude. feet of selected altitude.
OFF- Indicates approach is within 300 OFF- Indicates approach is within 300
feet of selected altitude. feet of selected altitude.

ALTITUDE ALTITUDE
ALERT ALERT

b) b)

Location:a) Glareshield Location:a) Glareshield


b) Captian and F/O's Instrument Panel b) Captian and F/O's Instrument Panel

and
OCT 99Systems Introduction 22-77 OCT 99 22-77
UNITED
B737 GENERAL AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
AUTOFLIGHT AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE AUTOFLIGHT AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
CONTROLS & INDICATIONS CONTROLS & INDICATIONS
AFDS AFDS

Autopilot disengage switch (2) Autopilot disengage switch (2)


Disengages both A/Ps when pushed. A/P disengage Disengages both A/Ps when pushed. A/P disengage
lights flash and A/P disengage warnig tone sounds lights flash and A/P disengage warnig tone sounds
for a minimum of two seconds. Second push causes for a minimum of two seconds. Second push causes
disengage lights to go off and silences disengage disengage lights to go off and silences disengage
warning tone. A/P disengage lights go off and A/P warning tone. A/P disengage lights go off and A/P
warning tone is silenced after automatic A/P warning tone is silenced after automatic A/P
disengagement. disengagement.

a) a)

Autothrottle disengage switches Autothrottle disengage switches


disengages A/T when pushed. A/T disengage lights disengages A/T when pushed. A/T disengage lights
flash and A/T ARM awitch trips OFF. A/T disengage flash and A/T ARM awitch trips OFF. A/T disengage
lights go off on the second push. A/T disengage lights go off on the second push. A/T disengage
lights go off after automatic A/T disengagement. lights go off after automatic A/T disengagement.

Takeoff/ Go-Around switches Takeoff/ Go-Around switches


engages AFDS and A/t in takeoff or go-around engages AFDS and A/t in takeoff or go-around
b) mode if previously armed. b) mode if previously armed.

Thrust Mode Annunciator Panel Thrust Mode Annunciator Panel

Displays active N 1 limit reference mode. Displays active N 1 limit reference mode.

R-TO R-CLB R - Reduced. Can appear with TO and CLB. R-TO R-CLB R - Reduced. Can appear with TO and CLB.
CRZ G/A CON TO - Takeoff CRZ G/A CON TO - Takeoff
c) c)
CLB - Climb CLB - Climb
A/T LIM CRZ - Cruise A/T LIM CRZ - Cruise
G/A - Go-around G/A - Go-around
CON - Continuious CON - Continuious

A/T LIM - Autothrottle limit. Indicates that A/T A/T LIM - Autothrottle limit. Indicates that A/T
Location: a) Captain and F/Os control column computer is calculating thrust limit modes instead of Location: a) Captain and F/Os control column computer is calculating thrust limit modes instead of
b) Center Pedestal FMC. b) Center Pedestal FMC.
c) Center Instrument Panel c) Center Instrument Panel

22-78 and Systems Introduction OCT 99 22-78 OCT 99


UNITED AIRLINES COURSE
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
AUTOFLIGHT AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE AUTOFLIGHT AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
CONTROLS & INDICATIONS CONTROLS & INDICATIONS
AUTOPILOT AND AUTOTHROTTLE DISENGAGE LIGHTS AUTOPILOT AND AUTOTHROTTLE DISENGAGE LIGHTS

TEST 1 TEST 1
Lights come on steady amber with Lights come on steady amber with
1 TEST switch in position 1. 1 TEST switch in position 1.

A/P A/T FMC TEST Switch A/P A/T FMC TEST Switch
Spring loaded to the center position Spring loaded to the center position
P/RST P/RST P/RST 2 P/RST P/RST P/RST 2
TEST TEST
TEST 2 TEST 2
A/P and A/T lights come on steady A/P and A/T lights come on steady
red and FMC light comes on steady red and FMC light comes on steady
amber with TEST switch in position 2. amber with TEST switch in position 2.

A/P P/RST(Autopilot Disengage) Light(red/ A/P P/RST(Autopilot Disengage) Light(red/


amber)(2) amber)(2)
FLASHES RED AND TONE SOUNDS- FLASHES RED AND TONE SOUNDS-
Indicates autopilot has disengaged. Can Indicates autopilot has disengaged. Can
A/P be reset by pushing either disengage light
or eiher A/P disengage switch.
A/P be reset by pushing either disengage light
or eiher A/P disengage switch.

P/RST STEADY RED-Indicates stabilizer is out of P/RST STEADY RED-Indicates stabilizer is out of
trim below 800 feet on a dual channel approach trim below 800 feet on a dual channel approach
or go-around. Altitude acquire mode is inhibited or go-around. Altitude acquire mode is inhibited
during an A/P go-around. during an A/P go-around.

Test switch is held in position 2. Test switch is held in position 2.

STEADY AMBER- Indicates flight mode STEADY AMBER- Indicates flight mode
annunciator test switch held at position 1. annunciator test switch held at position 1.

FLASHES ABER- Indicates A/P automatically FLASHES ABER- Indicates A/P automatically
reverted to CWS pitch or roll while in CMD. reverted to CWS pitch or roll while in CMD.
Resets when either light is pushed or another Resets when either light is pushed or another
mode engaged. mode engaged.

A/T P/RST(Autothrottle Disengage) Light A/T P/RST(Autothrottle Disengage) Light


(red/amber) (2) (red/amber) (2)

FLASHING RED-Indicates autothrottle has FLASHING RED-Indicates autothrottle has

A/T disengaged.

STEADY RED-Indicates when flight mode


A/T disengaged.

STEADY RED-Indicates when flight mode


annunciator test switch is held at position 2. annunciator test switch is held at position 2.
P/RST P/RST
STEADY AMBER- Indicates when flight mode STEADY AMBER- Indicates when flight mode
annunciator test switch is held at position 1. annunciator test switch is held at position 1.

Location: Captain and F/O's Instrument Panel Location: Captain and F/O's Instrument Panel

and
OCT 99Systems Introduction 22-79 OCT 99 22-79
UNITED
B737 GENERAL AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
AUTOFLIGHT AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE AUTOFLIGHT AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
CONTROLS & INDICATIONS CONTROLS & INDICATIONS

STAB STAB
STAB TRIM STAB TRIM
TRIM APL TRIM APL
NOSE NOSE
APL DOWN APL DOWN
NOSE 0 NOSE 0
DOWN DOWN

CG -% MAC

CG -% MAC
TAKE-OFF

TAKE-OFF
10 20 30

10 20 30
0 0
5 5

CG -% MAC

CG -% MAC
TAKE-OFF

TAKE-OFF
30 20 10

30 20 10
5 5
STAB TRIM 10 STAB TRIM 10
NORMAL 10 NORMAL 10
15 15
APL APL
15 NOSE UP 15 NOSE UP
APL APL
NOSE UP NOSE UP
CUT CUT
OUT STABILIZER OUT STABILIZER
MAIN AUTO
TRIM INDICATORS MAIN AUTO
TRIM INDICATORS
ELECT PILOT ELECT PILOT

OVERRIDE OVERRIDE
MANUAL MANUAL
STABILIZER STABILIZER
TRIM WHEELS TRIM WHEELS

NORMAL NORMAL

STABILIZER STABILIZER
TRIM CUTOUT TRIM CUTOUT
SWITCHES SWITCHES

CONTROL STAND CONTROL STAND

22-80 and Systems Introduction OCT 99 22-80 OCT 99


UNITED AIRLINES COURSE
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
AUTOFLIGHT AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE AUTOFLIGHT AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
CONTROLS & INDICATIONS CONTROLS & INDICATIONS

FLT CONTROL STANDBY FLT CONTROL STANDBY


A B HYD A B HYD
LOW LOW
QUANTITY QUANTITY
STBY STBY STBY STBY
RUD RUD LOW RUD RUD LOW
OFF OFF PRESSURE OFF OFF PRESSURE

A ON B ON A ON B ON
ALTERNATE FLAPS ALTERNATE FLAPS
OFF OFF
UP UP
LOW LOW LOW LOW
PRESSURE PRESSURE PRESSURE PRESSURE
OFF OFF
SPOILER SPOILER
DOWN DOWN
A B ARM A B ARM

OFF OFF OFF OFF


SPEED TRIM SPEED TRIM
YAW DAMPER FEEL DIFF YAW DAMPER FEEL DIFF
PRESS FAIL ANNUNCIATOR PRESS FAIL ANNUNCIATOR
FAIL ANNUNCIATOR ON ON FAIL ANNUNCIATOR ON ON
SPEED TRIM SPEED TRIM
FAIL FAIL
MACH TRIM MACH TRIM
YAW DAMPER FAIL YAW DAMPER FAIL
MACH TRIM MACH TRIM
YAW AUTO SLAT YAW AUTO SLAT
DAMPER FAIL FAIL ANNUNCIATOR DAMPER FAIL FAIL ANNUNCIATOR

OFF OFF

ON ON

FLIGHT CONTROL MODULE (P5) FLIGHT CONTROL MODULE (P5)

MASTER CAUTION MASTER CAUTION


MASTER MASTER
ANNUNCIATOR CAUTION ANNUNCIATOR CAUTION
STAB STAB
OUT OF PUSH TO RESET OUT OF PUSH TO RESET
TRIM TRIM
FLIGHT CONTROL SYSTEM FLT CONT ELEC
FLIGHT CONTROL SYSTEM FLT CONT ELEC
WARNING ANNUNCIATOR WARNING ANNUNCIATOR
IRS APU IRS APU

FUEL OVHT/DET FUEL OVHT/DET


STABILIZER OUT OF TRIM STABILIZER OUT OF TRIM
ANNUNCIATOR (P1) ANNUNCIATOR (P1)
MASTER CAUTION ANNINCIATORS (P7) MASTER CAUTION ANNINCIATORS (P7)

and
OCT 99Systems Introduction 22-81 OCT 99 22-81
IASB737
MACH GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
INDICATOR

22-82
2 L NAV MODE
AUTOTHROTTLE
ARM SWITCH HEADING SELECT
SWITCH COURSE 2
INDICATOR VERTICAL
VARIABLE INDICATOR
AUTOTHROTTLE ALTITUDE SELECT SPEED
AUTOFLIGHT

V NAV
COURSE 1 ARM LIGHT BANK ANGLE CONTROL AND INDICATOR
MODE
INDICATOR IAS/MACH SELECTOR INDICATOR
SELECT MASTER
MASTER CHANGE/OVER SWITCH LIGHT
LIGHT SENSOR
LIGHT SWITCH

COURSE A/T IAS/MACH V NAV HEADING L NAV ALTITUDE VERT SPEED A/P ENGAGE COURSE
ARM + A B
CMD
CONTROLS & INDICATIONS

30 10 DN
VOR LOC CWS F/D
F/D SEL
ON OFF ON
C/O
10 30
N1 SPEED LVL CHG HDG SEL APP ALT HOLD V/S DISENGAGE
OFF OFF
UP

SPEED A/P ENGAGE


LIGHT CAPT F/D VERTICAL
SELECT HEADING SWITCHES COURSE
SENSOR SWITCH SPEED
CONTROL SELECT RADIO SELECT 2
MODE SELECT F/O F/D
CONTROL NAV MODE CONTROL
UNITED AIRLINES

AUTOTHROTTLE LEVEL CHANGE SELECT SWITCH SWITCH


COURSE MODE DELECT 1
SELECT 1
N 1 MODE SELECT SWITCHES VERTICAL
SWITCH
CONTROL SPEED
HEADING ALTITUDE HOLD
B737-322/522

CONTROL
AUTOTHROTTLE SELECT MODE SELECT
SPEED MODE MODE SELECT SWITCH
SELECT SWITCH
2 WARNING FLAGS IN LEFT POSITION
1 OPTIONS
- ALPHA AND PERFORMANCE LIMIT

OCT 99
DFCS MODE CONTROL PANEL - VMO/MMO, V GAER, V FLAPS AND V NAV OVERSPEED
AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE

and Systems Introduction

IAS MACH
INDICATOR

22-82
2 L NAV MODE
AUTOTHROTTLE
ARM SWITCH HEADING SELECT
SWITCH COURSE 2
INDICATOR VERTICAL
VARIABLE INDICATOR
AUTOTHROTTLE ALTITUDE SELECT SPEED
AUTOFLIGHT

V NAV
COURSE 1 ARM LIGHT BANK ANGLE CONTROL AND INDICATOR
MODE
INDICATOR IAS/MACH SELECTOR INDICATOR
SELECT MASTER
MASTER CHANGE/OVER SWITCH LIGHT
LIGHT SENSOR
LIGHT SWITCH

COURSE A/T IAS/MACH V NAV HEADING L NAV ALTITUDE VERT SPEED A/P ENGAGE COURSE
ARM + A B
CMD
CONTROLS & INDICATIONS

30 10 DN
VOR LOC CWS F/D
F/D SEL
ON OFF ON
C/O
10 30
N1 SPEED LVL CHG HDG SEL APP ALT HOLD V/S DISENGAGE
OFF OFF
UP

SPEED A/P ENGAGE


LIGHT CAPT F/D VERTICAL
SELECT HEADING SWITCHES COURSE
SENSOR SWITCH SPEED
CONTROL SELECT RADIO SELECT 2
MODE SELECT F/O F/D
CONTROL NAV MODE CONTROL
UNITED AIRLINES

AUTOTHROTTLE LEVEL CHANGE SELECT SWITCH SWITCH


COURSE MODE DELECT 1
SELECT 1
N 1 MODE SELECT SWITCHES VERTICAL
SWITCH
CONTROL SPEED
HEADING ALTITUDE HOLD
B737-322/522

CONTROL
AUTOTHROTTLE SELECT MODE SELECT
SPEED MODE MODE SELECT SWITCH
SELECT SWITCH
2 WARNING FLAGS IN LEFT POSITION
1 OPTIONS
- ALPHA AND PERFORMANCE LIMIT
OCT 99

DFCS MODE CONTROL PANEL - VMO/MMO, V GAER, V FLAPS AND V NAV OVERSPEED
AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
UNITED AIRLINES COURSE
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
AUTOFLIGHT AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE AUTOFLIGHT AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
CONTROLS & INDICATIONS CONTROLS & INDICATIONS

MODE CONTROL PANEL (MCP) MODE CONTROL PANEL (MCP)

HEADING Indicator HEADING Indicator


Displays selected heading or Displays selected heading or
same heading as HSI heading same heading as HSI heading
markers. markers.

ALTITUDE Indicator ALTITUDE Indicator


displays selected altitudes from 0 displays selected altitudes from 0
to 50,000 feet in 100 foot incrementes to 50,000 feet in 100 foot incrementes

Bank Angle Selector Displayed altitude is reference for Bank Angle Selector Displayed altitude is reference for
Sets maximum bank angle for altitude alerting and automatic level- Sets maximum bank angle for altitude alerting and automatic level-
AFDS operation in HDG SEL offs. AFDS operation in HDG SEL offs.
and VOR modes. and VOR modes.
Indicates 10,000 feet when power Indicates 10,000 feet when power
Bank angles of 10, 15, 20, 25, is first applied. Bank angles of 10, 15, 20, 25, is first applied.
and 30 can be selected. and 30 can be selected.

HEADING L NAV ALTITUDE VERT SPEED A/P ENGAGE HEADING L NAV ALTITUDE VERT SPEED A/P ENGAGE
+ A B + A B
CMD CMD
30 10 DN 30 10 DN
VOR LOC CWS VOR LOC CWS
SEL SEL

10 30 10 30
HDG SEL APP ALT HOLD V/S DISENGAGE HDG SEL APP ALT HOLD V/S DISENGAGE
UP UP

Heading Selector Heading Selector


When rotated, sets heading in When rotated, sets heading in
heading indicator and positions heading indicator and positions
heading markers on both HSI's. Disengage Bar heading markers on both HSI's. Disengage Bar
UP - Arms autopilot UP - Arms autopilot

DOWN - Disengages A/P DOWN - Disengages A/P


Altitude Selector Altitude Selector
if engaged, yellow stripe is if engaged, yellow stripe is
When rotated, sets altitude in When rotated, sets altitude in
exposed when bar is down. exposed when bar is down.
altitude indicator, in either 100 altitude indicator, in either 100
foot units with selector pushed in foot units with selector pushed in
or 1,000 foot units with selector or 1,000 foot units with selector
out. Arms vertical speed mode if out. Arms vertical speed mode if
rotated while in ALT HOLD at rotated while in ALT HOLD at
selected altitude. selected altitude.

Location: Glareshield Location: Glareshield

and
OCT 99Systems Introduction 22-83 OCT 99 22-83
UNITED
B737 GENERAL AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
AUTOFLIGHT AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE AUTOFLIGHT AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
CONTROLS & INDICATIONS CONTROLS & INDICATIONS

MODE CONTROL PANEL (MCP) MODE CONTROL PANEL (MCP)

Vertical Speed Selector Vertical Speed Selector


UP/DN - Sets vertical speed in UP/DN - Sets vertical speed in
VERT SPEED display. VERT SPEED display.

HEADING L NAV ALTITUDE VERT SPEED A/P ENGAGE HEADING L NAV ALTITUDE VERT SPEED A/P ENGAGE
+ A B + A B
CMD CMD
30 10 DN 30 10 DN
VOR LOC CWS VOR LOC CWS
SEL SEL

10 30 10 30
HDG SEL APP ALT HOLD V/S DISENGAGE HDG SEL APP ALT HOLD V/S DISENGAGE
UP UP

VERICAL SPEED Indicator A/P ENGAGE Switches(PUSH TO ENGAGE) VERICAL SPEED Indicator A/P ENGAGE Switches(PUSH TO ENGAGE)
Displays selected vertical speeds Engage the switches one at a time, or both can be Displays selected vertical speeds Engage the switches one at a time, or both can be
from-7900 to +6000 fpm.Blank engaged in CMD while in APP mode. Selecting from-7900 to +6000 fpm.Blank engaged in CMD while in APP mode. Selecting
when V/S mode not active. second switch disengages first if not in APP mode. when V/S mode not active. second switch disengages first if not in APP mode.
Present when V/S mode is Present when V/S mode is
engaged with V/S mode switch. CMD - Enables all command modes for AFDS in engaged with V/S mode switch. CMD - Enables all command modes for AFDS in
Indicates 50 fpm units if less addition to CWS. With no pitch or roll commanded Indicates 50 fpm units if less addition to CWS. With no pitch or roll commanded
than 1,000 fpm or 100 fpm units mode active, autopilot pitch and roll will be in CWS. than 1,000 fpm or 100 fpm units mode active, autopilot pitch and roll will be in CWS.
if 1,000 fpm or greater. if 1,000 fpm or greater.
CWS - Controls autopilot pitch and roll through CWS - Controls autopilot pitch and roll through
control wheel and column pressures. control wheel and column pressures.

If attitudes acquired exceed autopilot limits, autopilot If attitudes acquired exceed autopilot limits, autopilot
returns to attitude limits when control force is released. returns to attitude limits when control force is released.

If roll control force is released with less than 6 If roll control force is released with less than 6
degrees of bank, autopilot rolls wing level and holds degrees of bank, autopilot rolls wing level and holds
existing heading. existing heading.

Command modes are available for F/O operation Command modes are available for F/O operation
through the mode selector switches. through the mode selector switches.

OFF - Disengages respective autopilot. OFF - Disengages respective autopilot.

Location: Glareshield Location: Glareshield

22-84 and Systems Introduction OCT 99 22-84 OCT 99


UNITED AIRLINES COURSE
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
AUTOFLIGHT AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE AUTOFLIGHT AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
CONTROLS & INDICATIONS CONTROLS & INDICATIONS

MODE CONTROL PANEL (MCP) MODE CONTROL PANEL (MCP)

A/T ARM Switch A/T ARM Switch


ARM- Arms A/T for engagement. Autothrottle Indicator Light (Green) ARM- Arms A/T for engagement. Autothrottle Indicator Light (Green)
Solenoid held at ARM. ON - A/T ARM switch in ARM position. Solenoid held at ARM. ON - A/T ARM switch in ARM position.

OFF - Disengages A/T and prevents OFF - Disengages A/T and prevents
A/T engagement. IAS/MACH Indicator A/T engagement. IAS/MACH Indicator
Displays selected speed when speed selector Displays selected speed when speed selector
is controlling airspeed cursors. is controlling airspeed cursors.
Master FCC F/D Lights Master FCC F/D Lights
ON - Indicates which FCC is con- Displays 110 knots when first powered on ON - Indicates which FCC is con- Displays 110 knots when first powered on
trolling F/D modes. ground. trolling F/D modes. ground.

BOTH LIGHTS ON - ach FCC is Indicator is blank when V NAV mode BOTH LIGHTS ON - ach FCC is Indicator is blank when V NAV mode
controlling modes for respective F/D. engaged, or during a 2 engine AFDS go- controlling modes for respective F/D. engaged, or during a 2 engine AFDS go-
around or when A/T engaged in FMC SPD around or when A/T engaged in FMC SPD
OFF - Indcates F/D modes are con- mode. OFF - Indcates F/D modes are con- mode.
trolled from opposite FCC. trolled from opposite FCC.

COURSE A/T IAS/MACH V NAV COURSE A/T IAS/MACH V NAV


ARM ARM

F/D F/D
ON OFF ON OFF
C/O C/O

N1 SPEED LVL CHG N1 SPEED LVL CHG


OFF OFF

Course Selector Speed Selector Course Selector Speed Selector


Sets course in course indicator for Sets speed in IAS/MACH indicator and Sets course in course indicator for Sets speed in IAS/MACH indicator and
respective VHF NAV receiver, AFDS positions airspeed cursors. respective VHF NAV receiver, AFDS positions airspeed cursors.
and HSI. and HSI.
Selected speed is reference speed for AFDS Selected speed is reference speed for AFDS
and A/T. and A/T.
Flight Director Switch Flight Director Switch
ON - Activates command bar display on respective Not operative when IAS/MACH indicator is ON - Activates command bar display on respective Not operative when IAS/MACH indicator is
pilot's ADI. Both pitch and roll command must be blank. pilot's ADI. Both pitch and roll command must be blank.
active before respective command bars can appear. active before respective command bars can appear.
Command bars are postioned from the respective C/O (Change Over) Switch Command bars are postioned from the respective C/O (Change Over) Switch
FCC. Push - Changes IAS/MACH indicator be- FCC. Push - Changes IAS/MACH indicator be-
tween IAS and MACH. tween IAS and MACH.
OFF - Retracts command bars from respective OFF - Retracts command bars from respective
pilot's ADI. Automatic changeover occurs at approxi- pilot's ADI. Automatic changeover occurs at approxi-
mately FL260. mately FL260.

Location: Glareshield Location: Glareshield

and
OCT 99Systems Introduction 22-85 OCT 99 22-85
UNITED
B737 GENERAL AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
AUTOFLIGHT AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE AUTOFLIGHT AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
CONTROLS & INDICATIONS CONTROLS & INDICATIONS
MODE CONTROL PANEL (MCP) MODE CONTROL PANEL (MCP)

A/T IAS/MACH V NAV HEADING L NAV ALTITUDE VERT SPEED A/T IAS/MACH V NAV HEADING L NAV ALTITUDE VERT SPEED
ARM + ARM +
30 10 DN 30 10 DN
VOR LOC VOR LOC
SEL SEL
OFF OFF
C/O C/O
10 30 10 30
N1 SPEED LVL CHG HDG SEL APP ALT HOLD V/S N1 SPEED LVL CHG HDG SEL APP ALT HOLD V/S
UP UP

V NAV V NAV
Mode Selector Switches Mode Selector Switches
Permits AFDS and A/T to follow thrust and Permits AFDS and A/T to follow thrust and
All mode selector switches are momentary All mode selector switches are momentary
speed commands from the FMC. speed commands from the FMC.
contactswitches. contactswitches.
In V NAV climb, A/T holds FMC thrust limit, In V NAV climb, A/T holds FMC thrust limit,
Push - Selects mode. Push - Selects mode.
and AFDS holds FMC target speed. and AFDS holds FMC target speed.
Mode switch light comes on to indicate the Mode switch light comes on to indicate the
mode can be deactivated by pushing mode mode can be deactivated by pushing mode
During V NAV SPD descent,A/T retards During V NAV SPD descent,A/T retards
switch a second time. switch a second time.
thrust to idle and AFDS holdsFMC target thrust to idle and AFDS holdsFMC target
speed. speed.
Pushing a lighted mode switch disengages Pushing a lighted mode switch disengages
the mode and the light goes off.. the mode and the light goes off..
During V NAV PATH descent, AFDS tracks During V NAV PATH descent, AFDS tracks
FMC descent path. A/T starts with idle-ARM, FMC descent path. A/T starts with idle-ARM,
Switch lights do not indicate operating modes. Switch lights do not indicate operating modes.
but can be commanded to FMC SPD if but can be commanded to FMC SPD if
Mode ststus is shown on the FMA panels. Mode ststus is shown on the FMA panels.
actual speed becames too slow. actual speed becames too slow.
N1 N1
During a V NAV speed climb or a V NAV During a V NAV speed climb or a V NAV
Holds A/T N 1 limit(TO, GA, CLB, CRZ or CON) Holds A/T N 1 limit(TO, GA, CLB, CRZ or CON)
PATH descent, automatic level off occurs PATH descent, automatic level off occurs
sent from the FMC.N 1 is displayed for A/T mode. sent from the FMC.N 1 is displayed for A/T mode.
at MCP selected altitude or at V NAV altitude, at MCP selected altitude or at V NAV altitude,
which ever is reached first. During a V NAV which ever is reached first. During a V NAV
SPEED speed descent, automatic level off occurs SPEED speed descent, automatic level off occurs
Holds A/T speed shown in IAS/MACH indicator only at the MCP selected altitude. Holds A/T speed shown in IAS/MACH indicator only at the MCP selected altitude.
or a performance or limit speed. or a performance or limit speed.
In V NAV cruise, AFDS holds altitude, and In V NAV cruise, AFDS holds altitude, and
NOTE A/T holds FMC target speed. NOTE A/T holds FMC target speed.

N1 and SPEED mode switches select A/T V NAV can be terminated by selecting a N1 and SPEED mode switches select A/T V NAV can be terminated by selecting a
modes only.These modes cannot engage different pitch mode, selecting N 1 or SPEED modes only.These modes cannot engage different pitch mode, selecting N 1 or SPEED
if incompatible with AFDS modes atready mode G/S capture, or extending wing flaps if incompatible with AFDS modes atready mode G/S capture, or extending wing flaps
engaged. They will engage automatically beyond 15 with APP mode engaged. engaged. They will engage automatically beyond 15 with APP mode engaged.

with selection of certain pitch modes. LVL CHG with selection of certain pitch modes. LVL CHG
Permits AFDS and A/T to execute auto- Permits AFDS and A/T to execute auto-
matic climbs and descents to MCP selected matic climbs and descents to MCP selected
altitude at selected airspeed. altitude at selected airspeed.

AFDS holds selected airspeed. A/T holds AFDS holds selected airspeed. A/T holds
limit thrust for climbs and idle thrust for limit thrust for climbs and idle thrust for
descents. descents.
Location: Glareshield Location: Glareshield
Airspeed can be changed with speed selector. Airspeed can be changed with speed selector.

22-86 and Systems Introduction OCT 99 22-86 OCT 99


UNITED AIRLINES COURSE
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
AUTOFLIGHT AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE AUTOFLIGHT AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
CONTROLS & INDICATIONS CONTROLS & INDICATIONS

MODE CONTROL PANEL (MCP) MODE CONTROL PANEL (MCP)

IAS/MACH V NAV HEADING L NAV ALTITUDE VERT SPEED IAS/MACH V NAV HEADING L NAV ALTITUDE VERT SPEED
+ +
30 10 DN 30 10 DN
VOR LOC VOR LOC
SEL SEL
C/O C/O
10 30 10 30
SPEED LVL CHG HDG SEL APP ALT HOLD V/S SPEED LVL CHG HDG SEL APP ALT HOLD V/S
UP UP

Mode Selector Switches Mode Selector Switches


APP APP
HDG SEL Permits single or dual operation. HDG SEL Permits single or dual operation.
Permits AFDS to turn to and maintain Permits AFDS to turn to and maintain
heading set in the heading indicator. Allows pushing second A/P CMD switch heading set in the heading indicator. Allows pushing second A/P CMD switch
for arming and subsequent engagement. for arming and subsequent engagement.
Is effective in any radio mode prior to Is effective in any radio mode prior to
radio course capture, is automatically Selectable after LOC frequency tuned. radio course capture, is automatically Selectable after LOC frequency tuned.
deactivated at radio course capture,and deactivated at radio course capture,and
bank is limited by bank angle selector. LOC or GS can be captured first. bank is limited by bank angle selector. LOC or GS can be captured first.
VOR LOC AFDS intercepts and captures LOC as in VOR LOC AFDS intercepts and captures LOC as in
Permits AFDS to intercept selected VOR VOR LOC mode. Permits AFDS to intercept selected VOR VOR LOC mode.
or localizer course in either heading select or localizer course in either heading select
mode or in CMD CWS. AFDS captures GS at 2/5 dot,then mode or in CMD CWS. AFDS captures GS at 2/5 dot,then
commands a descent rate and tracks GS. commands a descent rate and tracks GS.
Course capture point varies depending on Course capture point varies depending on
course deviation, closure rate and intercept After LOC and GS captured and below course deviation, closure rate and intercept After LOC and GS captured and below
angle. 1500 feet RA, second A/P engages, FLARE angle. 1500 feet RA, second A/P engages, FLARE
armed annunciates and APP mode switch armed annunciates and APP mode switch
V/S light goes off. V/S light goes off.
Permits activation by pushing the V/S Permits activation by pushing the V/S
mode switch or when a new altitude is APP mode remains active until A/Ps are dis- mode switch or when a new altitude is APP mode remains active until A/Ps are dis-
selected while ALT ACQ is annunciated. engaged and both F/Ds turn OFF of a TO/GA selected while ALT ACQ is annunciated. engaged and both F/Ds turn OFF of a TO/GA
switch is pushed. switch is pushed.
Armed if a new altitude is selected while Armed if a new altitude is selected while
ALT HOLD mode is active at previously Additionally, if in single A/P operation, CWS ALT HOLD mode is active at previously Additionally, if in single A/P operation, CWS
selected altitude. can be engaged by manually overriding selected altitude. can be engaged by manually overriding
pitch or roll. pitch or roll.
Moving V/S selector then activates V/S Moving V/S selector then activates V/S
mode, starting at zero fpm rate. ALT HOLD mode, starting at zero fpm rate. ALT HOLD
Permits AFDS to command pitch to hold MCP Permits AFDS to command pitch to hold MCP
Is not selectable while ALT HOLD mode is selected altitude. Is not selectable while ALT HOLD mode is selected altitude.
active at selected altitude or after glide active at selected altitude or after glide
slope capture in APP mode. AFDS holds altitude at which switch is pushed. slope capture in APP mode. AFDS holds altitude at which switch is pushed.
LNAV Mode selector switch goes off if altitude being LNAV Mode selector switch goes off if altitude being
Permits AFDS to follow FMC roll commands held is within 100 feet of selected altitude.ALT Permits AFDS to follow FMC roll commands held is within 100 feet of selected altitude.ALT
to intercept and track the active FMC route. HOLD is annunciated at all times mode is ac- to intercept and track the active FMC route. HOLD is annunciated at all times mode is ac-
tive. Inhibied after GS captured. tive. Inhibied after GS captured.
LNAV mode terminates when HDG SEL mode LNAV mode terminates when HDG SEL mode
is engaged or upon VOR or LOC capture. Location: Glareshield is engaged or upon VOR or LOC capture. Location: Glareshield

and
OCT 99Systems Introduction 22-87 OCT 99 22-87
UNITED
B737 GENERAL AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
AUTOFLIGHT AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE AUTOFLIGHT AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
CONTROLS & INDICATIONS CONTROLS & INDICATIONS

THRUST MODE ANNUNCIATOR THRUST MODE ANNUNCIATOR


Shown on the Primary Engine Display (PFD) Shown on the Primary Engine Display (PFD)
Annunciates the FMC limit in use by the A/T computer. Annunciates the FMC limit in use by the A/T computer.
Annunciations are Annunciations are
- TO - Takeoff - TO - Takeoff
- R-TO - Reduced Takeoff - R-TO - Reduced Takeoff
- CLB - Climb - CLB - Climb
- R-Climb - Reduced Climb - R-Climb - Reduced Climb
- CRZ - Cruise - CRZ - Cruise
- GA - Go Around - GA - Go Around
- CON - Continuous - CON - Continuous
The A/T LIM light above the PED A/T LIMIT The A/T LIM light above the PED A/T LIMIT
turns on if the A?T Computer limit LIGHT turns on if the A?T Computer limit LIGHT
is bsing used instead of the FMC is bsing used instead of the FMC
limit. limit.
Pushing the PED Bite switch Pushing the PED Bite switch
turns on all 16 segments of each turns on all 16 segments of each
character. The units are also tested character. The units are also tested
during the FMC Bite. A/T LIM during the FMC Bite. A/T LIM

THRUST MODE THRUST MODE


ANNUNCIATION ANNUNCIATION
MAN SET ----NCD MAN SET ----NCD
TO TO
R-TO R-TO
N1 LIMIT OR CLB N1 LIMIT OR CLB
MANUAL SET % RPM R-CLB MANUAL SET % RPM R-CLB
POINTER CRZ POINTER CRZ
12 0 12 0 CON 12 0 12 0 CON
(AMBER) (AMBER)
10 2 10 2 GA 10 2 10 2 GA

8 4 8 4 8 4 8 4
6 6 6 6

N1 N1
N1 TACHOMETER N1 TACHOMETER
POINTER POINTER
(YELLOW-GREEN) (YELLOW-GREEN)

x 1000 x 1000
12 0 12 0 12 0 12 0

10 2 10 2 10 2 10 2
PULL PULL PULL PULL
TO 8 4 8 4 TO TO 8 4 8 4 TO
SET 6 6 SET SET 6 6 SET
N1 N1 N1 N1
FF/FU FF/FU

PUSH PUSH
PPH LB FUEL USED PPH LB FUEL USED
RESET RESET

BITE-TEST BITE-TEST
Location: P2 Center Instrument Panel SWITCH Location: P2 Center Instrument Panel SWITCH

22-88 and Systems Introduction OCT 99 22-88 OCT 99


UNITED AIRLINES COURSE
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
AUTOFLIGHT AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE AUTOFLIGHT AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
COMPONENT LOCATIONS COMPONENT LOCATIONS

LOWER CABIN AREA LOWER CABIN AREA


- CONTROL WHEEL STEERING - CONTROL WHEEL STEERING
PITCH FORCE TRANSDUCERS PITCH FORCE TRANSDUCERS
- CONTROL WHEEL STEERING - CONTROL WHEEL STEERING
ROLL FORCE TRANSDUCERS ROLL FORCE TRANSDUCERS
- AILERON FORCE LIMITER - AILERON FORCE LIMITER
- COLUMN SWITCHING MODULE - COLUMN SWITCHING MODULE
SPOILER POSITION SPOILER POSITION
ANGLE OF SESNOR ANGLE OF SESNOR
ATTACK AIRFLOW ATTACK AIRFLOW
SENSORS SENSORS
FLAP POSITION FLAP POSITION
TRANSMITTER TRANSMITTER
WHEEL WELL WHEEL WELL
- AILERON A/P - AILERON A/P
ACTUATORS ACTUATORS
- AILERON - AILERON
POSITION POSITION
SENSOR SENSOR

MACH TRIM MACH TRIM


ACTUATOR ACTUATOR
ELEVATOR ELEVATOR
POSITION POSITION
SENSORS SENSORS

FLIGHT FLIGHT
CONTROL CONTROL
COMPUETRS COMPUETRS
A/P ACCY. STAB POS A/P ACCY. STAB POS
UNIT SENSORS UNIT SENSORS
(2) (2)
FLAP FLAP
SWITCHES SWITCHES
SPOILER PITCH A/P SPOILER PITCH A/P
POSITION ACTUATORS (2) POSITION ACTUATORS (2)
SENSOR SENSOR
ELEVATOR ELEVATOR
FLAP AUTOPILOT NEUTRAL FLAP AUTOPILOT NEUTRAL
POSITION STABILIZER SHIFT SENSOR POSITION STABILIZER SHIFT SENSOR
TRANSMITTER TRIM STAB TRIM TRANSMITTER TRIM STAB TRIM
SERVOMOTOR LIMIT SERVOMOTOR LIMIT
SWITCHES SWITCHES

DFCS Control Component Locations DFCS Control Component Locations

and
OCT 99Systems Introduction 22-89 OCT 99 22-89
UNITED
B737 GENERAL AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
AUTOFLIGHT AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE AUTOFLIGHT AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
COMPONENT LOCATIONS COMPONENT LOCATIONS
P18-1 CIRCUIT BREAKER PANEL P18-1 CIRCUIT BREAKER PANEL
* YAW DAMPER AC ELECTRONIC * YAW DAMPER AC ELECTRONIC
* YAW ADMPER DC EQUIPMENT * YAW ADMPER DC EQUIPMENT
RACK E1 RACK E1

TEST 1 TEST 1

2 2
P18-1 PASS FAIL
3 1 P18-1 PASS FAIL
3 1
NAV GO LAMP TEST 2 NAV GO LAMP TEST 2
3 3
BITE 1 BITE 1
4 4
OFF ARM OFF ARM
2 2
3 3
SPERRY 4 SPERRY 4
YAW DAMPER COUPLER YAW DAMPER COUPLER

TEST POINTS TEST POINTS

YAW YAW
DAMPER DAMPER
COUPLER COUPLER

P6-1 P6-1
AURAL WARNING P6-3 LANDING GEAR AURAL WARNING P6-3 LANDING GEAR
CIRCUIT BREAKER SAFETY RELAY CIRCUIT BREAKER SAFETY RELAY
AND LIGHTS AND LIGHTS
CIRCUIT BREAKER INTEGRATED CIRCUIT BREAKER INTEGRATED
ACTUATOR FLIGHT SYSTEM ACTUATOR FLIGHT SYSTEM
SOLENOID ACCESSORY UNIT SOLENOID ACCESSORY UNIT

1 1
A/P A/T FMC A/P A/T FMC
2 2
P/RST P/RST P/RST P/RST P/RST P/RST
TEST TEST

AUTOFLIGHT AUTOFLIGHT
STATUS STATUS
ANNUNCIATORS ANNUNCIATORS

TRANSFER TRANSFER
POSITION VALVE POSITION VALVE
RUDDER TRANSDUCER RUDDER TRANSDUCER
ATTACHMENT ATTACHMENT

FLT CONTROL STANDBY FLT CONTROL STANDBY


A B HYD A B HYD
LOW LOW
QUANTITY QUANTITY
STBY STBY STBY STBY
RUD RUD LOW RUD RUD LOW
OFF OFF PRESSURE
YAW DAMPER OFF OFF PRESSURE
YAW DAMPER
A ON B ON A ON B ON
ALTERNATE FLAPS WARNING ALTERNATE FLAPS WARNING
LOW LOW
OFF
UP ANNUNCIATOR LOW LOW
OFF
UP ANNUNCIATOR
PRESSURE PRESSURE PRESSURE PRESSURE
OFF OFF
SPOILER
A B ARM
DOWN YAW DAMPER SPOILER
A B ARM
DOWN YAW DAMPER
ENGAGE ENGAGE
OFF OFF
FEEL DIFF SWITCH YAW DAMPER
OFF OFF
FEEL DIFF SWITCH YAW DAMPER
PRESS PRESS
ON ON ON ON
SPEED TRIM SPEED TRIM
FAIL FAIL
MACH TRIM MACH TRIM
YAW DAMPER FAIL YAW DAMPER FAIL
YAW AUTO SLAT YAW AUTO SLAT
DAMPER FAIL DAMPER FAIL

OFF
YAW DAMPER OFF
YAW DAMPER
ON INDICATOR ON INDICATOR

Yaw Damper Components Yaw Damper Components

22-90 and Systems Introduction OCT 99 22-90 OCT 99


UNITED AIRLINES COURSE
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
AUTOFLIGHT AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE AUTOFLIGHT AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
COMPONENT LOCATIONS COMPONENT LOCATIONS

SEE B SEE B
ELECTRONIC ELECTRONIC
EQUIPMENT EQUIPMENT
RACK E1 RACK E1

SEE C SEE C

SEE A SEE A

1 1

2 2

3 1 3 1
MCP SPD 1 G/S VOR/LOC CMD 2 MCP SPD 1 G/S VOR/LOC CMD 2
3 3
DH100 1 DH100 1
1700 4 1700 4
180 20 2 180 20 2
20 3
20 3
F F
160 4 160 4
10 10
10 10
140 140
9 9

120 120
10 10
10 S 10 S
100 DH200 100 DH200
1700 1700

ELECTRONIC ATTITUDE DIRECTOR INDICATOR ALTITUDE ELECTRONIC ATTITUDE DIRECTOR INDICATOR ALTITUDE
ALERT ALERT
A ALTITUDE ALERT LIGHT A ALTITUDE ALERT LIGHT
A A

STAB OUT A/P A/T FMC


1 STAB OUT A/P A/T FMC
1

OF TRIM P/RST P/RST P/RST


TEST
2
OF TRIM P/RST P/RST P/RST
TEST
2

STABILZER OUT OF STABILZER OUT OF


AUTOFLIGHT STATUS ANNUNCIATORS AUTOFLIGHT STATUS ANNUNCIATORS
TRIM ANNUNCIATOR TRIM ANNUNCIATOR
C C
B B

DFCS Components DFCS Components

and
OCT 99Systems Introduction 22-91 OCT 99 22-91
UNITED
B737 GENERAL AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
AUTOFLIGHT AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE AUTOFLIGHT AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
COMPONENT LOCATIONS COMPONENT LOCATIONS

DISENGAGE & WARNING DISENGAGE & WARNING


LIGHT RESET SWITCHES LIGHT RESET SWITCHES

SEE D SEE D

CONTROL STAND CONTROL STAND


SEE C FLIGHT CONTROL SEE C FLIGHT CONTROL
1 1
COMPUTERS A&B COMPUTERS A&B
2 2

SEE A 3 1
SEE A 3 1

2 2
3 3
1 1
4 4
2 2
AFCS ACCESSORY UNIT(-300) 3
AFCS ACCESSORY UNIT(-300) 3

OR INTEGRATED SYSTEM 4 OR INTEGRATED SYSTEM 4

ACCESSORY UNIT (-500_ ACCESSORY UNIT (-500_


SEE B SEE B

TO/GA SWITCHES DISCONNECT TO/GA SWITCHES DISCONNECT


SWITCH SWITCH

STABILIZER DISENGAGE & WARNING STABILIZER DISENGAGE & WARNING


TRIM CUTOUT LIGHT RESET SWITCHES TRIM CUTOUT LIGHT RESET SWITCHES
SWITCHES SWITCHES
D D

CONTROL STAND C CONTROL STAND C

FLT CONTROL STANDBY FLT CONTROL STANDBY


A B HYD A B HYD
LOW LOW
QUANTITY QUANTITY
STBY STBY STBY STBY
RUD RUD LOW
PRESSURE
FLIGHT CONTROL RUD RUD LOW
PRESSURE
FLIGHT CONTROL
OFF OFF OFF OFF
COMPUTERS COMPUTERS
A ON B ON A ON B ON
ALTERNATE FLAPS BENCH TEST ALTERNATE FLAPS BENCH TEST
OFF CONNECTORS A OFF CONNECTORS A
UP UP
LOW LOW LOW LOW
PRESSURE PRESSURE PRESSURE PRESSURE
OFF OFF
SPOILER SPOILER
DOWN DOWN
A B ARM A B ARM

SPEED TRIM SPEED TRIM


OFF OFF FAIL ANNUNCIATOR OFF OFF FAIL ANNUNCIATOR
FEEL DIFF FEEL DIFF
PRESS PRESS
ON ON
SPEED TRIM
MACH TRIM -300-AFCAU ON ON
SPEED TRIM
MACH TRIM -300-AFCAU
FAIL
FAIL ANNUNCIATOR -500-INTEGRATED
FAIL
FAIL ANNUNCIATOR -500-INTEGRATED
MACH TRIM MACH TRIM
YAW DAMPER FAIL
FLIGHT YAW DAMPER FAIL
FLIGHT
YAW AUTO SLAT YAW AUTO SLAT
DAMPER FAIL SYSTEM DAMPER FAIL SYSTEM
OFF
ACCESSORY UNIT OFF
ACCESSORY UNIT
E E
ON B ON B

DFCS Components DFCS Components

22-92 and Systems Introduction OCT 99 22-92 OCT 99


UNITED AIRLINES COURSE
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
AUTOFLIGHT AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE AUTOFLIGHT AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
COMPONENT LOCATIONS COMPONENT LOCATIONS

CAPTAIN'S CAPTAIN'S
CONTROL CONTROL
WHEEL WHEEL

BUS DRUM BUS DRUM

TO F/O TO F/O
BUS BUS
DRUM DRUM

CABLES CABLES
TO PWR TO PWR
CONTROL CONTROL
UNIT UNIT

AILERON DRUM AILERON DRUM


CWS CWS
ROLL FORCE AILERON FORCE ROLL FORCE AILERON FORCE
TRANSDUCER LIMITER (-300'S ONLY) TRANSDUCER LIMITER (-300'S ONLY)

Pitch & Roll Force Transducers and Aileron Force Limiter Pitch & Roll Force Transducers and Aileron Force Limiter

and
OCT 99Systems Introduction 22-93 OCT 99 22-93
UNITED
B737 GENERAL AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
AUTOFLIGHT AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE AUTOFLIGHT AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
COMPONENT LOCATIONS COMPONENT LOCATIONS

SPOILER
SPOILER INPUT CRANK
INPUT CRANK POSITION
POSITION
SENSOR
SENSOR INPUT ROD
INPUT ROD

REAR SPAR
REAR SPAR

AILERON
AILERON DETENT
DETENT HYDRAULIC 'B'
HYDRAULIC 'B' SOLENOID
SOLENOID PRESSURE
PRESSURE VALVE ACTUATOR
VALVE ACTUATOR SWITCH
SWITCH TRANSFER SOLENOID VALVE
TRANSFER SOLENOID VALVE INPUT
INPUT VALVE
VALVE ACTUATOR TORQUE
ACTUATOR TORQUE
SOLENOID TUBE
SOLENOID TUBE AILERON
AILERON VALVE
VALVE HYDRAULIC 'A'
HYDRAULIC 'A'
DETENT PRESSURE AILERON
DETENT PRESSURE AILERON
SOLENOID SWITCH POSITION
SOLENOID SWITCH POSITION
VALVE SENSOR
VALVE SENSOR

ACTUATOR
ACTUATOR
POSITION
POSITION
TRANSDUCER
TRANSDUCER
( LVDT )
( LVDT ) A/P AILERON
A/P AILERON
ACTUATOR 'A'
ACTUATOR 'A'

A/P AILERON
A/P AILERON
ACTUATOR 'B'
ACTUATOR 'B'

A&B Aileron Autopilot Actuators & Spoiler / Aileron Position Sensors A&B Aileron Autopilot Actuators & Spoiler / Aileron Position Sensors

22-94 and Systems Introduction OCT 99 22-94 OCT 99


UNITED AIRLINES COURSE
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
AUTOFLIGHT AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE AUTOFLIGHT AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
COMPONENT LOCATIONS COMPONENT LOCATIONS

FLAP POSITION FLAP POSITION


TRANSMITTER TRANSMITTER
(BOTH WINGS) (BOTH WINGS)

DETENT DETENT
PRESSURE PRESSURE
SWITCH SWITCH
TRANSFER TRANSFER
VALVE A/P ELEVATOR VALVE A/P ELEVATOR
ACTUATOR ACTUATOR 'B' ACTUATOR ACTUATOR 'B'
SOLENOID SOLENOID
VALVE VALVE

DETENT DETENT
SOLENOID SOLENOID
(HIDDEN BY (HIDDEN BY
ACT. SOLENOID) ACT. SOLENOID)

DETENT SHEAR DETENT SHEAR


PRESSURE RIVETS PRESSURE RIVETS
SWITCH SWITCH
ELEVATOR ELEVATOR
ACTUATOR ACTUATOR
A/P ELEVATOR POSITION A/P ELEVATOR POSITION
ACTUATOR 'A' TRANSDUCER ACTUATOR 'A' TRANSDUCER
( LVDT ) ( LVDT )

Pitch Control A/P Actuators & Pitch Control A/P Actuators & Sensors

and
OCT 99Systems Introduction 22-95 OCT 99 22-95
UNITED
B737 GENERAL AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
AUTOFLIGHT AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE AUTOFLIGHT AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
COMPONENT LOCATIONS COMPONENT LOCATIONS

Flap Control Unit & Limit Switches Flap Control Unit & Limit Switches

22-96 and Systems Introduction OCT 99 22-96 OCT 99


UNITED AIRLINES COURSE
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
AUTOFLIGHT AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE AUTOFLIGHT AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
COMPONENT LOCATIONS COMPONENT LOCATIONS

A/P A/P A/P A/P


ACTUATOR ACTUATOR ACTUATOR ACTUATOR
'B' 'A' (BEHIND MACH TRIM ACTUATOR) 'B' 'A' (BEHIND MACH TRIM ACTUATOR)
NEUTRAL NEUTRAL
SHIFT SHIFT
SENSOR SENSOR
(DUAL) (DUAL)

TO ELEVATOR TO ELEVATOR

ELEVATOR ELEVATOR
POWER POWER
CONTROL CONTROL
UNIT 'A' UNIT 'A'
FEEL & FEEL &
CENTERING CENTERING
UNIT TO ELEVATOR UNIT TO ELEVATOR

MACH MACH
TRIM TRIM
ACTUATOR ACTUATOR
DUAL FEEL DUAL FEEL
ACTUATOR ACTUATOR
'B' STABILIZER 'B' STABILIZER
POSITION SENSOR POSITION SENSOR
('A' SENSOR ON ('A' SENSOR ON
OPPOSITE SIDE OF OPPOSITE SIDE OF
FEEL AND CENTERING ELEVATOR POWER FEEL AND CENTERING ELEVATOR POWER
UNIT) CONTROL UNIT 'B' UNIT) CONTROL UNIT 'B'
ELEVATOR ELEVATOR
POSTION POSTION
SENSOR LOWER SENSOR LOWER
(DUAL) TORQUE (DUAL) TORQUE
TUBE TUBE

FWD FWD

Elevator Aft Quadrant Components Elevator Aft Quadrant Components

and
OCT 99Systems Introduction 22-97 OCT 99 22-97
UNITED
B737 GENERAL AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
AUTOFLIGHT AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE AUTOFLIGHT AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
COMPONENT LOCATIONS COMPONENT LOCATIONS

Stab Trim Motors & Limit / Warning Switches Stab Trim Motors & Limit / Warning Switches

22-98 and Systems Introduction OCT 99 22-98 OCT 99


UNITED AIRLINES COURSE
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
AUTOFLIGHT AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE AUTOFLIGHT AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
COMPONENT LOCATIONS COMPONENT LOCATIONS

SEE C & D SEE C & D

SEE SEE
A A

1 1

2 2
1 1
SEE B 3
2 SEE B 3
2
3 3
1 1
4 4
2 2
3 3
4 4

A/T IAS/MACH V NAV HEADING L NAV ALTITUDE VERT SPEED A/T IAS/MACH V NAV HEADING L NAV ALTITUDE VERT SPEED
ARM + ARM +
30 10 DN 30 10 DN
VOR LOC VOR LOC
SEL SEL
OFF OFF
C/O C/O
10 30 10 30
N1 SPEED LVL CHG HDG SEL APP ALT HOLD V/S N1 SPEED LVL CHG HDG SEL APP ALT HOLD V/S
UP UP

DFCS MODE CONTROL PANEL DFCS MODE CONTROL PANEL


A A

MCP SPD 1 G/S VOR/LOC CMD MCP SPD 1 G/S VOR/LOC CMD

DH100 DH100
1700 1700
180 20 180 20
20 20
F F
160 10 160 10
10 10
140 140
9 1 9 1
A/P A/T FMC A/P A/T FMC
120 2 120 2
P/RST P/RST P/RST P/RST P/RST P/RST
10 TEST 10 TEST
10 S 10 S
100 DH200 100 DH200
1700 1700
AUTOFLIGHT STATUS D AUTOFLIGHT STATUS D
ANNUNCIATORS ANNUNCIATORS

ELECTRONIC ATTITUDE DIRECTOR INDICATOR B ELECTRONIC ATTITUDE DIRECTOR INDICATOR B

R - TO R - CLB R - TO R - CLB
CRZ G/A CON CRZ G/A CON
A/T LIMM A/T LIMM

THRUST MODE ANNUNCIATORS C A/T LIMIT ANNUNCIATOR C THRUST MODE ANNUNCIATORS C A/T LIMIT ANNUNCIATOR C

Autothrottle Components-Flight Deck Autothrottle Components-Flight Deck

and
OCT 99Systems Introduction 22-99 OCT 99 22-99
UNITED
B737 GENERAL AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
AUTOFLIGHT AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE AUTOFLIGHT AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
COMPONENT LOCATIONS COMPONENT LOCATIONS

AUTOTHROTTLE AUTOTHROTTLE
DISENGAGE DISENGAGE
SWITCHES SWITCHES

TO/GA TO/GA
SWITCHES SWITCHES

DS DS
ES ES
ALPHA/NUMERIC N ALPHA/NUMERIC N
IO IO
TEST READOUT UT TEST READOUT UT
CA CA

AUTOTHROTTLE SYSTEM COMPUTER AUTOTHROTTLE SYSTEM COMPUTER

Autothrottle Components - E&E Compartment & Flight Deck Autothrottle Components - E&E Compartment & Flight Deck

22-100 and Systems Introduction OCT 99 22-100 OCT 99


UNITED AIRLINES COURSE
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
AUTOFLIGHT AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE AUTOFLIGHT AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
COMPONENT LOCATIONS COMPONENT LOCATIONS

Autothrottle Components- PLA Synchro, AOA Sensor Autothrottle Components- PLA Synchro, AOA Sensor

and
OCT 99Systems Introduction 22-101 OCT 99 22-101
UNITED AIRLINES COURSE
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
COMMUNICATIONS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE COMMUNICATIONS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION


COMMUNICATION SYSTEMS...............................................................23-2 COMMUNICATION SYSTEMS............................................................... 23-2
Speakers .................................................................................................23-3 Speakers................................................................................................. 23-3
Handheld PA Microphones....................................................................23-4 Handheld PA Microphones ................................................................... 23-4
Boom Microphones................................................................................23-5 Boom Microphones ............................................................................... 23-5
Control Wheel Push-To-Talk Switch.....................................................23-5 Control Wheel Push-To-Talk Switch .................................................... 23-5
Pendant PTT Switch ..............................................................................23-6 Pendant PTT Switch .............................................................................. 23-6
Handsets.................................................................................................23-6 Handsets................................................................................................. 23-6
Static Discharge Wicks ..........................................................................23-6 Static Discharge Wicks.......................................................................... 23-6
Interfaces................................................................................................23-8 Interfaces ............................................................................................... 23-8
LRU Box Removal & Replacement ......................................................23-8 LRU Box Removal & Replacement ...................................................... 23-8
ESDS......................................................................................................23-8 ESDS ..................................................................................................... 23-8
Safety .....................................................................................................23-8 Safety ..................................................................................................... 23-8
Troubleshooting .....................................................................................23-9 Troubleshooting..................................................................................... 23-9
AUDIO INTEGRATION ............................................................................23-11 AUDIO INTEGRATION............................................................................ 23-11
Audio Intergration Panel........................................................................23-11 Audio Intergration Panel ....................................................................... 23-11
Volume Control Switches ......................................................................23-12 Volume Control Switches...................................................................... 23-12
PTT Switch ............................................................................................23-12 PTT Switch ............................................................................................ 23-12
BOOM/MASK Switch...........................................................................23-12 BOOM/MASK Switch .......................................................................... 23-12
EMER/NORM Switch ...........................................................................23-12 EMER/NORM Switch ........................................................................... 23-12
V-B-R Filter Switch...............................................................................23-12 V-B-R Filter Switch............................................................................... 23-12
SPKR Switches ......................................................................................23-12 SPKR Switches...................................................................................... 23-12
REMOTE ELECTRONICS UNIT ............................................................23-13 REMOTE ELECTRONICS UNIT ............................................................ 23-13
Operation................................................................................................23-14 Operation ............................................................................................... 23-14
Radio Inputs ...........................................................................................23-14 Radio Inputs........................................................................................... 23-14
Microphone Inputs .................................................................................23-14 Microphone Inputs................................................................................. 23-14
Audio Outputs........................................................................................23-14 Audio Outputs........................................................................................ 23-14
Muting....................................................................................................23-14 Muting ................................................................................................... 23-14
Synthesized Audio .................................................................................23-15 Synthesized Audio ................................................................................. 23-15
Microphone Selection (Normal Mode)..................................................23-15 Microphone Selection (Normal Mode).................................................. 23-15
Oxygen Mask Microphone selection .....................................................23-15 Oxygen Mask Microphone selection ..................................................... 23-15
Verification of Radio Navigation Identification ....................................23-15 Verification of Radio Navigation Identification.................................... 23-15
Alternate Mode ......................................................................................23-16 Alternate Mode ...................................................................................... 23-16
Interfaces................................................................................................23-16 Interfaces ............................................................................................... 23-16
FLIGHT INTERPHONE............................................................................23-17 FLIGHT INTERPHONE............................................................................ 23-17
Operation................................................................................................23-17 Operation ............................................................................................... 23-17
Maintenance Practices ...........................................................................23-18 Maintenance Practices ........................................................................... 23-18
Troubleshooting .....................................................................................23-18 Troubleshooting..................................................................................... 23-18
CREW CALL SYSTEM .............................................................................23-19 CREW CALL SYSTEM ............................................................................. 23-19
Pilots' Call Panel ....................................................................................23-20 Pilots' Call Panel.................................................................................... 23-20
Flight Attendant's Panel .........................................................................23-21 Flight Attendant's Panel......................................................................... 23-21
Flight Attendant Call Lights ..................................................................23-21 Flight Attendant Call Lights .................................................................. 23-21
Pilot Call Switch ....................................................................................23-22 Pilot Call Switch .................................................................................... 23-22

and99Systems
MAY Introduction 23-i MAY 99 23-i
UNITED
B737 GENERAL AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-222/291 B737-322/522
COMMUNICATIONS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE COMMUNICATIONS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

Ground Crew Call Horn......................................................................... 23-22 Ground Crew Call Horn......................................................................... 23-22
Interfaces................................................................................................ 23-23 Interfaces................................................................................................ 23-23
Operation ............................................................................................... 23-23 Operation ............................................................................................... 23-23
Testing ................................................................................................... 23-23 Testing ................................................................................................... 23-23
Troubleshooting ..................................................................................... 23-24 Troubleshooting..................................................................................... 23-24
SERVICE INTERPHONE ......................................................................... 23-26 SERVICE INTERPHONE ......................................................................... 23-26
Service Interphone Switch ..................................................................... 23-27 Service Interphone Switch..................................................................... 23-27
Functional Description........................................................................... 23-27 Functional Description........................................................................... 23-27
Operation ............................................................................................... 23-27 Operation ............................................................................................... 23-27
Maintenance Practices ........................................................................... 23-27 Maintenance Practices ........................................................................... 23-27
Testing ................................................................................................... 23-27 Testing ................................................................................................... 23-27
Troubleshooting ..................................................................................... 23-28 Troubleshooting..................................................................................... 23-28
PASSENGER ADDRESS SYSTEM .......................................................... 23-30 PASSENGER ADDRESS SYSTEM .......................................................... 23-30
PA Amplifier ......................................................................................... 23-31 PA Amplifier ......................................................................................... 23-31
Speakers................................................................................................. 23-32 Speakers................................................................................................. 23-32
Interfaces................................................................................................ 23-33 Interfaces................................................................................................ 23-33
Operation ............................................................................................... 23-33 Operation ............................................................................................... 23-33
Maintenance Practices ........................................................................... 23-33 Maintenance Practices ........................................................................... 23-33
Testing ................................................................................................... 23-33 Testing ................................................................................................... 23-33
Troubleshooting ..................................................................................... 23-34 Troubleshooting..................................................................................... 23-34
PASSENGER ENTERTAINMENT .......................................................... 23-35 PASSENGER ENTERTAINMENT .......................................................... 23-35
Tape Reproducer.................................................................................... 23-36 Tape Reproducer.................................................................................... 23-36
Multiplexer ............................................................................................ 23-37 Multiplexer ............................................................................................ 23-37
Seat Electronics Unit (SEU) .................................................................. 23-37 Seat Electronics Unit (SEU) .................................................................. 23-37
Terminators............................................................................................ 23-38 Terminators............................................................................................ 23-38
Passenger Control Units (PCU) ............................................................. 23-39 Passenger Control Units (PCU) ............................................................. 23-39
Interfaces................................................................................................ 23-40 Interfaces................................................................................................ 23-40
Operation ............................................................................................... 23-40 Operation ............................................................................................... 23-40
Testing ................................................................................................... 23-40 Testing ................................................................................................... 23-40
Troubleshooting ..................................................................................... 23-40 Troubleshooting..................................................................................... 23-40
VHF COMMUNICATION SYSTEM ....................................................... 23-41 VHF COMMUNICATION SYSTEM ....................................................... 23-41
Frequency Selection............................................................................... 23-42 Frequency Selection............................................................................... 23-42
Transmit................................................................................................. 23-42 Transmit................................................................................................. 23-42
Receive .................................................................................................. 23-42 Receive .................................................................................................. 23-42
VHF Control Panel ................................................................................ 23-43 VHF Control Panel ................................................................................ 23-43
VHF Transceiver ................................................................................... 23-44 VHF Transceiver ................................................................................... 23-44
VHF Antenna......................................................................................... 23-45 VHF Antenna......................................................................................... 23-45
Interfaces................................................................................................ 23-46 Interfaces................................................................................................ 23-46
Operation ............................................................................................... 23-46 Operation ............................................................................................... 23-46
Maintenance Practices ........................................................................... 23-46 Maintenance Practices ........................................................................... 23-46
Self-Test................................................................................................. 23-46 Self-Test................................................................................................. 23-46
Frequency Check ................................................................................... 23-47 Frequency Check ................................................................................... 23-47
Transmit Check...................................................................................... 23-47 Transmit Check...................................................................................... 23-47

23-ii and Systems Introduction MAY 99 23-ii MAY 99


UNITED AIRLINES COURSE
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
COMMUNICATIONS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE COMMUNICATIONS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

Receive Check .......................................................................................23-47 Receive Check ....................................................................................... 23-47


Troubleshooting .....................................................................................23-48 Troubleshooting..................................................................................... 23-48
ACARS..........................................................................................................23-49 ACARS ......................................................................................................... 23-49
Interactive Display .................................................................................23-51 Interactive Display................................................................................. 23-51
ACARS Data Printer..............................................................................23-53 ACARS Data Printer ............................................................................. 23-53
Interfaces................................................................................................23-53 Interfaces ............................................................................................... 23-53
Troubleshooting 53 Troubleshooting 53
COCKPIT VOICE RECORDER...............................................................23-56 COCKPIT VOICE RECORDER .............................................................. 23-56
Voice Recorder Unit ..............................................................................23-57 Voice Recorder Unit .............................................................................. 23-57
Underwater Locator Beacon (ULB).......................................................23-58 Underwater Locator Beacon (ULB) ...................................................... 23-58
Voice Recorder Control Panel ...............................................................23-58 Voice Recorder Control Panel ............................................................... 23-58
Interfaces................................................................................................23-59 Interfaces ............................................................................................... 23-59
Operation................................................................................................23-59 Operation ............................................................................................... 23-59
Erasure ...................................................................................................23-60 Erasure ................................................................................................... 23-60
Self Test .................................................................................................23-60 Self Test ................................................................................................. 23-60
Operational Testing................................................................................23-60 Operational Testing ............................................................................... 23-60
Troubleshooting .....................................................................................23-62 Troubleshooting..................................................................................... 23-62
HF COMMUNICATIONS..........................................................................23-64 HF COMMUNICATIONS ......................................................................... 23-64
HF Comm Tuning Panel ........................................................................23-64 HF Comm Tuning Panel........................................................................ 23-64
HF Comm Transceiver...........................................................................23-64 HF Comm Transceiver .......................................................................... 23-64
Antenna Coupler ....................................................................................23-66 Antenna Coupler.................................................................................... 23-66
Interfaces................................................................................................23-67 Interfaces ............................................................................................... 23-67
Operation................................................................................................23-67 Operation ............................................................................................... 23-67
Maintenance Practices ...........................................................................23-67 Maintenance Practices ........................................................................... 23-67
Testing....................................................................................................23-67 Testing ................................................................................................... 23-67
Troubleshooting .....................................................................................23-67 Troubleshooting..................................................................................... 23-67
SELCAL .......................................................................................................23-68 SELCAL ....................................................................................................... 23-68
SELCAL Decoder..................................................................................23-68 SELCAL Decoder.................................................................................. 23-68
SELCAL Panel.......................................................................................23-69 SELCAL Panel ...................................................................................... 23-69
Interfaces................................................................................................23-69 Interfaces ............................................................................................... 23-69
Operation................................................................................................23-69 Operation ............................................................................................... 23-69
Testing....................................................................................................23-69 Testing ................................................................................................... 23-69
AIRFONE.....................................................................................................23-70 AIRFONE..................................................................................................... 23-70
Cabin Handset Holder (CHH)................................................................23-70 Cabin Handset Holder (CHH) ............................................................... 23-70
Cordless handset (CH) ...........................................................................23-70 Cordless handset (CH)........................................................................... 23-70
Airborne Control Unit (ACU)................................................................23-70 Airborne Control Unit (ACU) ............................................................... 23-70
Common Unit (CMN)............................................................................23-71 Common Unit (CMN) ........................................................................... 23-71
Radio Transceiver (R/T) ........................................................................23-71 Radio Transceiver (R/T) ........................................................................ 23-71
L-Band Antenna (ANT).........................................................................23-71 L-Band Antenna (ANT)......................................................................... 23-71
Ceiling Antennas....................................................................................23-71 Ceiling Antennas ................................................................................... 23-71
Wired Tray Assembly (TRAY) .............................................................23-71 Wired Tray Assembly (TRAY) ............................................................. 23-71
Maintenance Practices ...........................................................................23-72 Maintenance Practices ........................................................................... 23-72

and99Systems
MAY Introduction 23-iii MAY 99 23-iii
UNITED
B737 GENERAL AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-222/291 B737-322/522
COMMUNICATIONS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE COMMUNICATIONS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

CONTROLS & INDICATIONS CONTROLS & INDICATIONS


AUDIO SELECTOR PANEL .................................................................... 23-73 AUDIO SELECTOR PANEL .................................................................... 23-73
PA MICROPHONE AND SERVICE INTERPHONE HANDSET........ 23-74 PA MICROPHONE AND SERVICE INTERPHONE HANDSET........ 23-74
EXTERNAL INTERPHONE PANEL ...................................................... 23-74 EXTERNAL INTERPHONE PANEL ...................................................... 23-74
AIR LINK MICROPHONE ....................................................................... 23-74 AIR LINK MICROPHONE ....................................................................... 23-74
COCKPIT VOICE RECORER ................................................................. 23-75 COCKPIT VOICE RECORER ................................................................. 23-75
FLIGHT ATTENDANT AND GROUND CREW CALL ....................... 23-75 FLIGHT ATTENDANT AND GROUND CREW CALL ....................... 23-75
HF COMM CONTROL PANEL ............................................................... 23-76 HF COMM CONTROL PANEL ............................................................... 23-76
SELCAL CONTROL PANEL ................................................................... 23-77 SELCAL CONTROL PANEL ................................................................... 23-77
OBS AUDIO ENTERTAINMENT SWITCH........................................... 23-77 OBS AUDIO ENTERTAINMENT SWITCH........................................... 23-77
COMPONENT LOCATION COMPONENT LOCATION
Electronic Equipment Racks.................................................................. 23-78 Electronic Equipment Racks.................................................................. 23-78
Antenna Locations ................................................................................. 23-79 Antenna Locations ................................................................................. 23-79

23-iv and Systems Introduction MAY 99 23-iv MAY 99


B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE

DESCRIPTION & OPERATION


OCT 99

COMMUNICATIONS
VOICE
RECORDER
VHF-1 VHF-2 VHF-3 ACARS SYSTEM
SYSTEM SYSTEM SYSTEM

PASSENGER
ENTERTAINMENT
SYSTEM (AUDIO)
Communication Systems

UNITED AIRLINES
INTERPHONE
HANDSETS FLT-GND CREW
AUDIO CALL SYSTEMS
INTEGRATING
AND
FLIGHT
INTERPHONE
ATT CALL
SYSTEM

AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE


B737-322/522
CONTROL CABIN
MICROPHONES
AND PA SYSTEM
HEADPHONES SELECTED
ENTERTAINMENT

SERVICE
INTERPHONE PA MICROPHONES
JACKS
23-1

and Systems Introduction

DESCRIPTION & OPERATION


OCT 99

COMMUNICATIONS
VOICE
RECORDER
VHF-1 VHF-2 VHF-3 ACARS SYSTEM
SYSTEM SYSTEM SYSTEM

PASSENGER
ENTERTAINMENT
Communication Systems

SYSTEM (AUDIO)

INTERPHONE
UNITED AIRLINES
HANDSETS FLT-GND CREW
AUDIO CALL SYSTEMS
INTEGRATING
AND
FLIGHT
INTERPHONE
ATT CALL
B737-322/522
AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE

SYSTEM

CONTROL CABIN
MICROPHONES
AND PA SYSTEM
HEADPHONES SELECTED
ENTERTAINMENT

SERVICE
INTERPHONE PA MICROPHONES
JACKS
23-1
UNITED
B737 GENERAL AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
COMMUNICATIONS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE COMMUNICATIONS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

COMMUNICATION SYSTEMS The PA (passenger address) system pro- COMMUNICATION SYSTEMS The PA (passenger address) system pro-
The aircraft has systems for transmitting vides the pilots and flight attendants with a The aircraft has systems for transmitting vides the pilots and flight attendants with
and receiving voice and data communica- way to send announcements and boarding and receiving voice and data communica- a way to send announcements and board-
tions with ground stations or voice com- music to passengers over cabin speakers. tions with ground stations or voice com- ing music to passengers over cabin speak-
munications with other airplanes, The system is also used to produce chime munications with other airplanes, ers. The system is also used to produce
additionally systems are provided for signals over the cabin speakers. additionally systems are provided for chime signals over the cabin speakers.
communication within the airplane. Static The Passenger Audio Entertainment sys- communication within the airplane. Static The Passenger Audio Entertainment sys-
dischargers are installed at the trailing tem provides the means for the passengers dischargers are installed at the trailing tem provides the means for the passengers
edge extremities of the airplane to reduce to select a music program to listen to dur- edge extremities of the airplane to reduce to select a music program to listen to dur-
radio interference by static buildup. ing the flight. The music is from a tape radio interference by static buildup. ing the flight. The music is from a tape
The Flight Interphone system provides reproducer to the individual seats and is The Flight Interphone system provides reproducer to the individual seats and is
facilities for interphone communication multiplexed. The passengers listen to the facilities for interphone communication multiplexed. The passengers listen to the
among flight compartment crewmembers music on a set of headphones. among flight compartment crewmembers music on a set of headphones.
and also ground crew, and provides the The VHF communications systems pro- and also ground crew, and provides the The VHF communications systems pro-
means for the pilots to key, transmit, and vide short range(radio line-of-sight) voice means for the pilots to key, transmit, and vide short range(radio line-of-sight) voice
receive on communication radio systems communication. The systems are desig- receive on communication radio systems communication. The systems are desig-
and to receive the audio from navigation nated No. 1, No. 2 and No. 3. The Aircraft and to receive the audio from navigation nated No. 1, No. 2 and No. 3. The Aircraft
radio systems. Communications Addressing and Report- radio systems. Communications Addressing and Report-
The Ground Crew Call system provides a ing System (ACARS) provides a means The Ground Crew Call system provides a ing System (ACARS) provides a means
signaling capability (through the ground for transferring data between an airplane signaling capability (through the ground for transferring data between an airplane
crew call horn) between the flight com- and our ground-based computer systems. crew call horn) between the flight com- and our ground-based computer systems.
partment and nose landing gear area. The Data may be transmitted automatically or partment and nose landing gear area. The Data may be transmitted automatically or
crew call system allows signaling capabil- manually by the pilot. The VHF No. 3 crew call system allows signaling capabil- manually by the pilot. The VHF No. 3
ity between the flight deck and passenger transceiver is used for the data transmis- ity between the flight deck and passenger transceiver is used for the data transmis-
cabin. sion. cabin. sion.
The Attendant/Service Interphone system The Voice Recorder system records flight The Attendant/Service Interphone system The Voice Recorder system records flight
provides the ground crew with interior and compartment communications and con- provides the ground crew with interior and compartment communications and con-
exterior communication capability. Cir- versations. The latest 30 minutes of exterior communication capability. Cir- versations. The latest 30 minutes of
cuits in the system connect service inter- recorded conversation is available on tape. cuits in the system connect service inter- recorded conversation is available on tape.
phone jacks with the flight deck and flight Overwater aircraft are equipped with HF phone jacks with the flight deck and flight Overwater aircraft are equipped with HF
attendant's stations. Communications and SELCAL. The HF attendant's stations. Communications and SELCAL. The HF
Communications system is used for long Communications system is used for long
range two way communication for over range two way communication for over
water operations. Only the No. 1 HF sys- water operations. Only the No. 1 HF sys-
tem is operational. They also are tem is operational. They also are
equipped with Selective Calling (SEL- equipped with Selective Calling (SEL-
CAL) for communications signaling. CAL) for communications signaling.
There are many components that are com- There are many components that are com-
mon to several different communications mon to several different communications
systems. There are also many interfaces systems. There are also many interfaces
between the communication system and between the communication system and
other systems of the aircraft. other systems of the aircraft.

23-2 and Systems Introduction OCT 99 23-2 OCT 99


UNITED AIRLINES COURSE
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
COMMUNICATIONS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE COMMUNICATIONS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

Speakers the cabin are 6.5 inch diameter speakers Speakers the cabin are 6.5 inch diameter speakers
Interphone speakers are installed in the with matching transformer is installed in Interphone speakers are installed in the with matching transformer is installed in
flight compartment ceiling over the Cap- the Passenger Service Unit (PSU) assem- flight compartment ceiling over the Cap- the Passenger Service Unit (PSU) assem-
tain's and First Officer's seats. Each unit bly for approximately every other row of tain's and First Officer's seats. Each unit bly for approximately every other row of
contains a speaker. They are usually seats. These speakers provide PA contains a speaker. They are usually seats. These speakers provide PA
referred to as the Overhead Speakers. The announcements and boarding music to the referred to as the Overhead Speakers. The announcements and boarding music to the
volume control for each speaker is located passengers. A five inch diameter speaker volume control for each speaker is located passengers. A five inch diameter speaker
on the Audio Selector Panel (ASP) for the and matching transformer is mounted in on the Audio Selector Panel (ASP) for the and matching transformer is mounted in
corresponding pilot position. The speak- the ceiling of each lavatory. The speakers corresponding pilot position. The speak- the ceiling of each lavatory. The speakers
ers receive audio signals from the Remote at the Flight Attendant stations are muted ers receive audio signals from the Remote at the Flight Attendant stations are muted
Electronics Unit (REU). The speakers are when a PA announcement is made from Electronics Unit (REU). The speakers are when a PA announcement is made from
muted whenever a PTT switch is pushed at that particular station. muted whenever a PTT switch is pushed at that particular station.
the Captain's or First Officer's station for Note: There are several terminal con- the Captain's or First Officer's station for Note: There are several terminal con-
transmission using the boom micro- nections on the speakers for impedance transmission using the boom micro- nections on the speakers for impedance
phone. There is no speaker muting when matching. Be sure to attach the wires to phone. There is no speaker muting when matching. Be sure to attach the wires to
the oxygen mask microphone is keyed . the correct terminal on installation. the oxygen mask microphone is keyed . the correct terminal on installation.
The Passenger Address (PA) speakers for The Passenger Address (PA) speakers for

SCREW SCREW
(4 LOCATIONS) (4 LOCATIONS)

A A

A A
A-A A-A

Cockpit Speaker Cockpit Speaker

and
OCT 99Systems Introduction 23-3 OCT 99 23-3
UNITED
B737 GENERAL AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
COMMUNICATIONS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE COMMUNICATIONS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

Handheld PA Microphones Boom Microphones Handheld PA Microphones Boom Microphones


The handheld microphones contain Push- The boom microphones are part of a small The handheld microphones contain Push- The boom microphones are part of a small
To-Talk (PTT) switches which complete headset with a earphone and microphone. To-Talk (PTT) switches which complete headset with a earphone and microphone.
audio circuits and provide a ground for The microphone is placed in front of the audio circuits and provide a ground for The microphone is placed in front of the
control circuits. mouth by means of a boom connected to control circuits. mouth by means of a boom connected to
Attendant microphones are located in the the headset. A control wheel, pendant, or Attendant microphones are located in the the headset. A control wheel, pendant, or
passenger cabin at the forward and aft Audio Selector Panel PTT switch must be passenger cabin at the forward and aft Audio Selector Panel PTT switch must be
attendant stations. The pilots' microphone pushed before transmission can take place. attendant stations. The pilots' microphone pushed before transmission can take place.
is located at the aft end of the pedestal. The boom microphone headset is plugged is located at the aft end of the pedestal. The boom microphone headset is plugged
All microphones are identical. The PTT into jacks at each flight crew member's All microphones are identical. The PTT into jacks at each flight crew member's
switch on the microphone must be pressed station. They are sometimes referred to as switch on the microphone must be pressed station. They are sometimes referred to as
to complete microphone audio and control Mini-Tel headsets. to complete microphone audio and control Mini-Tel headsets.
circuits to the PA system. Each micro- circuits to the PA system. Each micro-
phone is equipped with a plug connector phone is equipped with a plug connector
so that it may be easily replaced or used at so that it may be easily replaced or used at
another station having a PA microphone another station having a PA microphone
receptacle. receptacle.

Handheld PA and Boom Microphones Handheld PA and Boom Microphones

23-4 and Systems Introduction OCT 99 23-4 OCT 99


UNITED AIRLINES COURSE
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
COMMUNICATIONS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE COMMUNICATIONS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

Oxygen Mask Microphones Control Wheel Push-To-Talk Switch Oxygen Mask Microphones Control Wheel Push-To-Talk Switch
The oxygen mask has a microphone built The Push-To-Talk (PTT) switch on the The oxygen mask has a microphone built The Push-To-Talk (PTT) switch on the
into the mask. Each mask is equipped control wheel provides PTT input from the into the mask. Each mask is equipped control wheel provides PTT input from the
with an oxygen connection and a micro- boom or oxygen mask microphones. The with an oxygen connection and a micro- boom or oxygen mask microphones. The
phone plug. A control wheel, pendant, or PTT switch is a three position switch on phone plug. A control wheel, pendant, or PTT switch is a three position switch on
Audio Selector Panel PTT switch must be the outboard horn of the Captain's and the Audio Selector Panel PTT switch must be the outboard horn of the Captain's and the
pushed before transmission can take place. First Officer's control wheel. In the MIC pushed before transmission can take place. First Officer's control wheel. In the MIC
The mask microphone is plugged into (up)position, microphone audio is directed The mask microphone is plugged into (up)position, microphone audio is directed
jacks at each flight crew member's station. to the selected communication system. In jacks at each flight crew member's station. to the selected communication system. In
the INT (down) position, microphone the INT (down) position, microphone
audio is connected directly to the Flight audio is connected directly to the Flight
Interphone system without making micro- Interphone system without making micro-
phone selection on the Audio Selector phone selection on the Audio Selector
Panel. The switch is spring loaded to the Panel. The switch is spring loaded to the
center "OFF" position. center "OFF" position.

Oxygen Mask Microphones Oxygen Mask Microphones

Control Wheel Push-To-Talk Switch Control Wheel Push-To-Talk Switch

and
OCT 99Systems Introduction 23-5 OCT 99 23-5
UNITED
B737 GENERAL AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
COMMUNICATIONS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE COMMUNICATIONS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

Pendant PTT Switch Static Discharge Wicks Pendant PTT Switch Static Discharge Wicks
The pendant PTT switch is a clip-on hand As the airplane flies through moisture, The pendant PTT switch is a clip-on hand As the airplane flies through moisture,
held Push-To-Talk switch at each of the corona discharge from precipitation static held Push-To-Talk switch at each of the corona discharge from precipitation static
pilots positions and is plugged into a jack and engine charging is emitted from the pilots positions and is plugged into a jack and engine charging is emitted from the
at each pilot position. airplane extremities. The precipitation at each pilot position. airplane extremities. The precipitation
Handsets static is the result of an electric charge Handsets static is the result of an electric charge
The Attendant/Service Interphone hand- accumulated by the airplane striking The Attendant/Service Interphone hand- accumulated by the airplane striking
sets are located at each flight attendant charged air and moisture particles. Static sets are located at each flight attendant charged air and moisture particles. Static
position and at the aft end of the pedestal usually discharges at the wing and tail position and at the aft end of the pedestal usually discharges at the wing and tail
for the pilots. The handset may be of the extremities, and may be coupled into the for the pilots. The handset may be of the extremities, and may be coupled into the
press-to-use or press-to-talk type. The radio receiver antennas, causing radio press-to-use or press-to-talk type. The radio receiver antennas, causing radio
button on a press-to-use type handset interference. button on a press-to-use type handset com- interference.
completes both microphone and receiver Static dischargers are installed on the air- pletes both microphone and receiver audio Static dischargers are installed on the air-
audio circuits when the handset button is plane to reduce radio receiver interfer- circuits when the handset button is plane to reduce radio receiver interfer-
pressed. The button on a press-to-talk ence. The static discharges are designed pressed. The button on a press-to-talk ence. The static discharges are designed
type handset completes only the micro- to discharge the static at points which are a type handset completes only the micro- to discharge the static at points which are
phone circuits when it is pressed, receiver critical distance away from the wing and phone circuits when it is pressed, receiver a critical distance away from the wing and
circuits are connected directly to the sys- tail extremities, where there is little or no circuits are connected directly to the sys- tail extremities, where there is little or no
tem. The service interphone amplifier coupling into the radio receiver antennas. tem. The service interphone amplifier coupling into the radio receiver antennas.
provides the necessary voltage for opera- The vertical fin and each wing have tip provides the necessary voltage for opera- The vertical fin and each wing have tip
tion of carbon or transistorized handsets. dischargers and three trailing edge dis- tion of carbon or transistorized handsets. dischargers and three trailing edge dis-
chargers. Each side of the horizontal sta- chargers. Each side of the horizontal sta-
bilizer has a tip discharger and two trailing bilizer has a tip discharger and two trailing
edge dischargers. edge dischargers.
Tip dischargers are smaller than the trail- Tip dischargers are smaller than the trail-
ing edge dischargers, but have the same ing edge dischargers, but have the same
general construction and are attached in general construction and are attached in
the same way. Each discharger consists of the same way. Each discharger consists of
a carbon fiber tip at the end of a slender a carbon fiber tip at the end of a slender
rod. The rod incorporates a resistive (con- rod. The rod incorporates a resistive (con-
ductive) material and is attached to a metal ductive) material and is attached to a
base. The base is fastened and bonded to metal base. The base is fastened and
the skin of the airplane. It should be noted bonded to the skin of the airplane. It
that the entire airplane must be electrically should be noted that the entire airplane
bonded to reduce static interference must be electrically bonded to reduce
Note: A broken or poorly connected static interference
bonding strap to a component or flight Note: A broken or poorly connected
control surface may cause radio static, bonding strap to a component or flight
even when all static dischargers are control surface may cause radio static,
intact and functioning normally. even when all static dischargers are
Note: The minimum number of static intact and functioning normally.
discharge wicks is determined by the Note: The minimum number of static
Configuration Deviation List (CDL). discharge wicks is determined by the
Configuration Deviation List (CDL).

23-6 and Systems Introduction OCT 99 23-6 OCT 99


UNITED AIRLINES COURSE
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
COMMUNICATIONS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE COMMUNICATIONS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

DISCHARGER DISCHARGER
BASE 3 TRAILING EDGE DISCHARGERS AND BASE 3 TRAILING EDGE DISCHARGERS AND
1 TIP DISCHARGER ON VERTICAL 1 TIP DISCHARGER ON VERTICAL
STABILIZER STABILIZER
SET SCREW VERTICAL STABILIZER SET SCREW VERTICAL STABILIZER
DISCHARGER DISCHARGER
ROD ROD
FWD FWD

TIP DISCHARGER TIP DISCHARGER

2 TRAILING EDGE 2 TRAILING EDGE


DISCHARGERS AND DISCHARGERS AND
1 TIP DISCHARGER 1 TIP DISCHARGER
PER HORIZONTAL PER HORIZONTAL
STABILIZER STABILIZER

HORIZONTAL HORIZONTAL
STABILIZER STABILIZER

3 TRAILING EDGE 3 TRAILING EDGE


SET SCREW DISCHARGERS AND SET SCREW DISCHARGERS AND
1 TIP DISCHARGER 1 TIP DISCHARGER
PER WING PER WING
DISCHARGER ROD WINGS DISCHARGER ROD WINGS

DISCHARGER FWD DISCHARGER FWD


BASE BASE
TRAILING EDGE DISCHARGER TRAILING EDGE DISCHARGER

Static Discharge Wicks Static Discharge Wicks

and
OCT 99Systems Introduction 23-7 OCT 99 23-7
UNITED
B737 GENERAL AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
COMMUNICATIONS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE COMMUNICATIONS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

Interfaces ESDS Interfaces ESDS


The various communications systems Many boxes installed in the aircraft are The various communications systems Many boxes installed in the aircraft are
interface with each other and with other Electro Static Discharge Sensitive interface with each other and with other Electro Static Discharge Sensitive
systems of the aircraft. The Flight Data (ESDS). These boxes are placarded with systems of the aircraft. The Flight Data (ESDS). These boxes are placarded with
Recorder receives Key Event signals from black on yellow stickers. Proper handling Recorder receives Key Event signals from black on yellow stickers. Proper handling
the VHF communications system. The of these boxes is essential. The damage the VHF communications system. The of these boxes is essential. The damage
air/ground sensing circuits and parking from ESD cannot be seen or noticed when air/ground sensing circuits and parking from ESD cannot be seen or noticed when
brake system provide signals for the Voice it occurs. Follow the procedures in brake system provide signals for the Voice it occurs. Follow the procedures in
Recorder. Navigation radio systems have MM20-40-12 p201. Recorder. Navigation radio systems have MM20-40-12 p201.
their audio controlled by the Audio Selec- Safety their audio controlled by the Audio Selec- Safety
tor Panels. The ACARS unit receives Antennas and static wicks can be a safety tor Panels. The ACARS unit receives Antennas and static wicks can be a safety
information from various aircraft systems hazard if personnel are not aware of their information from various aircraft systems hazard if personnel are not aware of their
such as, doors, gear, engine and others. positions when working around the air- such as, doors, gear, engine and others. positions when working around the air-
LRU Box Removal & Replacement craft or moving equipment. These protru- LRU Box Removal & Replacement craft or moving equipment. These protru-
Proper installation of rack mounted LRU sions are hard to see in any lighting Proper installation of rack mounted LRU sions are hard to see in any lighting
boxes is important for their proper opera- condition. boxes is important for their proper opera- condition.
tion and reliability. Some malfunctions Warning: Transmitting on the HF Com- tion and reliability. Some malfunctions Warning: Transmitting on the HF Com-
have been attributed to improper mainte- munications system should not be done have been attributed to improper mainte- munications system should not be done
nance practices. when fueling operations are in progress. nance practices. when fueling operations are in progress.
When removing or installing a box, follow Warning: Transmitting on the HF Com- When removing or installing a box, follow Warning: Transmitting on the HF Com-
the procedures set forth in MM20-10-07 munications system should not be done the procedures set forth in MM20-10-07 munications system should not be done
p201. Inspect the pins and sockets of the when personnel are in close proximity p201. Inspect the pins and sockets of the when personnel are in close proximity
connectors of the box and receptacle of to the antenna or antenna coupler area. connectors of the box and receptacle of the to the antenna or antenna coupler area.
the rack. Corrosion, pitting and bent pins Caution: Transmitting of the HF Com- rack. Corrosion, pitting and bent pins can Caution: Transmitting of the HF Com-
can cause malfunctioning or intermittent munications system should not be done cause malfunctioning or intermittent oper- munications system should not be done
operation of the systems. when another aircraft in close proxim- ation of the systems. when another aircraft in close proxim-
Caution: Many boxes are Electro Static ity with its HF Communications system Caution: Many boxes are Electro Static ity with its HF Communications system
Discharge Sensitive (ESDS). Do not receiving. Discharge Sensitive (ESDS). Do not receiving.
touch the pins of these boxes. touch the pins of these boxes.

23-8 and Systems Introduction OCT 99 23-8 OCT 99


UNITED AIRLINES COURSE
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
COMMUNICATIONS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE COMMUNICATIONS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

Troubleshooting Troubleshooting
Many Maintenance Manual procedures Many Maintenance Manual procedures
have troubleshooting information. Some have troubleshooting information. Some
communication radio problems have been communication radio problems have been
attributed to improper installation of the attributed to improper installation of the
antennas, not maintaining the bonding antennas, not maintaining the bonding
wires of the control surfaces per MM27- wires of the control surfaces per MM27-
00-99 p201, kinked or damaged antenna 00-99 p201, kinked or damaged antenna
cables, corrosion of the antenna connec- cables, corrosion of the antenna connec-
tors, and forgetting to reattach the antenna tors, and forgetting to reattach the antenna
connectors. connectors.
Since there are multiple systems and mul- Since there are multiple systems and mul-
tiple components, isolating the cause of tiple components, isolating the cause of
the problem can be accomplished by the problem can be accomplished by
checking the faulty system against another checking the faulty system against another
system or swapping components of a sys- system or swapping components of a sys-
tem. tem.
Note: Be sure to return components to Note: Be sure to return components to
their original positions or complete the their original positions or complete the
proper documentation for recording the proper documentation for recording the
new positions of components. new positions of components.

and
OCT 99Systems Introduction 23-9 OCT 99 23-9
UNITED
B737 GENERAL AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
COMMUNICATIONS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE COMMUNICATIONS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

PA SPEAKERS PA SPEAKERS

PA AMPL PA AMPL

PWR PWR

CAPT CAPT
SPEAKER SPEAKER
SERV/ATT SERV/ATT
INPH & CAPT R/T/INT PTT INPH & CAPT R/T/INT PTT
WARN ON CONTROL WHL WARN ON CONTROL WHL
CAPT CAPT
DATA BUS & POWER ASP DATA BUS & POWER ASP
CAPT FLT INPH CABIN/SERVICE CAPT FLT INPH CABIN/SERVICE
AMPL AMPL OXY MASK AMPL AMPL OXY MASK
F/O F/O
JACKS JACKS

OBS OBS
F/O F/O
SPEAKER SPEAKER
P6 REMOTE P6 REMOTE
ELECTRONICS F/O R/T/INT PTT ELECTRONICS F/O R/T/INT PTT
UNIT ON CONTROL WHL UNIT ON CONTROL WHL
F/O F/O
DATA BUS & POWER ASP DATA BUS & POWER ASP

RADIO XCVRS & OXY MASK RADIO XCVRS & OXY MASK
NAV RADIOS NAV RADIOS
JACKS JACKS

DATA BUS & POWER OBS DATA BUS & POWER OBS
COCKPIT VOICE ASP COCKPIT VOICE ASP
RECORDER RECORDER
OXY MASK OXY MASK

(E2-1 ELECTRONICS SHELF) JACKS (E2-1 ELECTRONICS SHELF) JACKS

ATTENDANT ALT ALERT ATTENDANT ALT ALERT


HANDSETS HANDSETS
SERVICE SERVICE
JACKS AUX INPUTS JACKS AUX INPUTS
GND PROX GND PROX
RADIO ALT RADIO ALT
FLT INPH NOSE FLT INPH NOSE
WHEEL JACK WHEEL JACK

REU REU

23-10 and Systems Introduction OCT 99 23-10 OCT 99


UNITED AIRLINES COURSE
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
COMMUNICATIONS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE COMMUNICATIONS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

AUDIO INTEGRATION AUDIO SELECTOR PANEL AUDIO INTEGRATION Audio Selector Panel
The integration of all the audio in the The Audio Selector Panels (ASP) enable The integration of all the audio in the The Audio Selector Panels (ASP) enable
flight deck is done by the flight interphone the flight crew members to transmit or flight deck is done by the flight interphone the flight crew members to transmit or
system. The system consists of the Audio receive on the VHF or the HF radio com- system. The system consists of the Audio receive on the VHF or the HF radio com-
Selector Panels (ASP), the Remote Elec- munication systems, communicate using Selector Panels (ASP), the Remote Elec- munication systems, communicate using
tronics Unit (REU), jack panels, push-to- the flight and service interphone systems, tronics Unit (REU), jack panels, push-to- the flight and service interphone systems,
talk (PTT) switches, mics, headsets, oxy- or make announcements over the PA sys- talk (PTT) switches, mics, headsets, oxy- or make announcements over the PA sys-
gen mask mics and overhead speakers. tem. Airplane VHF navigation, DME, gen mask mics and overhead speakers. tem. Airplane VHF navigation, DME,
The equipment located on the E2-1 rack in marker beacon, and ADF receivers may The equipment located on the E2-1 rack in marker beacon, and ADF receivers may
the E&E compartment is referred to as the also be monitored. the E&E compartment is referred to as the also be monitored.
Audio Integration Shelf . Audio selector panels are located in the Audio Integration Shelf . Audio selector panels are located in the
flight compartment. Two Audio Selector flight compartment. Two Audio Selector
Panels are on the P8 aft control stand for Panels are on the P8 aft control stand for
the Captain and the First Officer, and one the Captain and the First Officer, and one
on the P5 aft overhead panel for the first on the P5 aft overhead panel for the first
observer. observer.

MIC SELECTOR MIC SELECTOR

1 - VHF -2 - VHF - 3 INOP INOP F - INPH - S PA 1 - VHF -2 - VHF - 3 INOP INOP F - INPH - S PA

PTT 1- NAV -2 INOP ADF -2 MKR SPKR


MASK PTT 1- NAV -2 INOP ADF -2 MKR SPKR
MASK

V BOOM V BOOM
EMER EMER
B B

R NORM R NORM

Audio Selector Panel Audio Selector Panel

and
OCT 99Systems Introduction 23-11 OCT 99 23-11
UNITED
B737 GENERAL AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
COMMUNICATIONS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE COMMUNICATIONS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

The front panel of the Audio Selector BOOM/MASK Switch The front panel of the Audio Selector BOOM/MASK Switch
Panel has the following switches: The BOOM/MASK select switch is a two- Panel has the following switches: The BOOM/MASK select switch is a two-
Microphone Selector Switches position toggle switch. The switch con- Microphone Selector Switches position toggle switch. The switch con-
The microphone selector switches are nects the boom mic (headset) or the mask The microphone selector switches are nects the boom mic (headset) or the mask
used to connect the boom, oxygen mask, (oxygen mask) to the input. When the used to connect the boom, oxygen mask, (oxygen mask) to the input. When the
or hand microphone to the interphone, oxygen mask is selected, the flight deck or hand microphone to the interphone, oxygen mask is selected, the flight deck
passenger address (PA), or any of the speakers cannot be muted. passenger address (PA), or any of the speakers cannot be muted.
selectable transmitters. The microphone EMER/NORM Switch selectable transmitters. The microphone EMER/NORM Switch
selector switches are momentary contact The EMER/NORM switch is normally selector switches are momentary contact The EMER/NORM switch is normally
switches. The switches are mechanically placed in the NORM position. In the switches. The switches are mechanically placed in the NORM position. In the
and electronically interlocked to permit EMER position, the MIC selection and electronically interlocked to permit EMER position, the MIC selection
only one switch to be selected at a time. A assumes a fixed configuration consistent only one switch to be selected at a time. A assumes a fixed configuration consistent
light in each switch comes on when the with an emergency mode regardless of the light in each switch comes on when the with an emergency mode regardless of the
switch is selected, and the related receive selection made. The Captain's or switch is selected, and the related receive selection made. The Captain's or
audio channel will become active. observer's PTT will then key VHF-1 and audio channel will become active. observer's PTT will then key VHF-1 and
Volume Control Switches the First Officer's PTT will key VHF-2. Volume Control Switches the First Officer's PTT will key VHF-2.
The volume control switches are located V-B-R Filter Switch The volume control switches are located V-B-R Filter Switch
directly below each microphone selector The V-B-R filter switch controls filtering directly below each microphone selector The V-B-R filter switch controls filtering
switch. The switches are turned ON/OFF of the received navigation system audio. switch. The switches are turned ON/OFF of the received navigation system audio.
by moving the lever in a fully up or fully In the V (Voice) position, only voice by moving the lever in a fully up or fully In the V (Voice) position, only voice
down position. The control switches audio will be heard. In the R (Range) down position. The control switches audio will be heard. In the R (Range)
move up for increasing volume and down position, only range audio (Morse code move up for increasing volume and down position, only range audio (Morse code
for decreasing volume. identifier) will be heard. In the B (Both) for decreasing volume. identifier) will be heard. In the B (Both)
PTT Switch position, both voice and range audio will PTT Switch position, both voice and range audio will
The Push-To-Talk (PTT) switch is a sys- be heard. The Push-To-Talk (PTT) switch is a sys- be heard.
tem keying switch. When pushed, the SPKR switches tem keying switch. When pushed, the SPKR switches
switch will key the communication system The SPKR switch is the off-on/volume switch will key the communication system The SPKR switch is the off-on/volume
as selected by the microphone selector control for the interphone speaker. This as selected by the microphone selector control for the interphone speaker. This
switch. The PTT switch on the ASP is control is not used on the observer Audio switch. The PTT switch on the ASP is control is not used on the observer Audio
connected in parallel to the PTT switch on Selector Panel. connected in parallel to the PTT switch on Selector Panel.
the control wheel and pendant switch, the control wheel and pendant switch,
which serve a similar function. The flight which serve a similar function. The flight
deck speakers are muted when the micro- deck speakers are muted when the micro-
phone, with the exception of the oxygen phone, with the exception of the oxygen
mask microphone, is keyed at the Audio mask microphone, is keyed at the Audio
Selector Panel, at the control wheels, or at Selector Panel, at the control wheels, or at
the hand microphone. the hand microphone.

23-12 and Systems Introduction OCT 99 23-12 OCT 99


UNITED AIRLINES COURSE
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
COMMUNICATIONS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE COMMUNICATIONS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

REMOTE ELECTRONICS UNIT REMOTE ELECTRONICS UNIT


The Remote Electronic Unit (REU) The Remote Electronic Unit (REU)
is a digitally controlled, multiplexer is a digitally controlled, multiplexer
audio management unit. The REU audio management unit. The REU
manages the communication manages the communication between
between the flight deck stations, ser- AAU OBS F/O CAPT the flight deck stations, service and AAU OBS F/O CAPT
vice and flight interphone, and all SVR INT EXT HDPH HDPH flight interphone, and all related SVR INT EXT HDPH HDPH
related communication, radio, navi- SVR INT ATT FLT
SVR
FLT
SVR
communication, radio, navigation, SVR INT ATT FLT
SVR
FLT
SVR
gation, and recorder system. The FLT INT and recorder system. The REU FLT INT

REU determines which selections DME 2


ADJ determines which selections have DME 2
ADJ
DME 1 ADJ DME 1 ADJ
have been made on the ASP, and PA SENS been made on the ASP, and then PA SENS
PA GAIN PA GAIN
then sends appropriate signals to the PA ST sends appropriate signals to the PA ST
selected systems. selected systems.
AUDIO POT 1 AUDIO POT 1
AUDIO POT 2 AUDIO POT 2
The REU contains: The REU contains:
Three identical station cards for Cap- ATTENTION
OBSERVE PRECAUTIONS Three identical station cards for Cap- ATTENTION
OBSERVE PRECAUTIONS
tain, First Officer and observer. The FOR HANDLING tain, First Officer and observer. The FOR HANDLING
ELECTROSTATIC ELECTROSTATIC
station cards provide response to SENSITIVE station cards provide response to SENSITIVE
inputs from three Audio Selector DEVICES
inputs from three Audio Selector DEVICES

Panels. Panels.
One Audio Accessory Unit (AAU) One Audio Accessory Unit (AAU)
card which contains circuitry for an REMOTE ELECTRONICS UNIT card which contains circuitry for an REMOTE ELECTRONICS UNIT
altitude alert warning tone, flight and altitude alert warning tone, flight and
service interphone, and various service interphone, and various audio
audio accessory functions. accessory functions.
One mother board which contains One mother board which contains
and provides interconnection for the and provides interconnection for the
Captain's, First Officer's and Captain's, First Officer's and
observer's station cards and AAU observer's station cards and AAU
card. card.
One connector card which provides One connector card which provides
an interconnection between the an interconnection between the exter-
external connector and the mother nal connector and the mother board.
board. The outside of the REU case contains
The outside of the REU case con- several screw adjustments.
tains several screw adjustments. Note: These are designed for in-
Note: These are designed for in- shop test station adjustment only
shop test station adjustment only and should not be adjusted on the
and should not be adjusted on the airplane.
airplane. Power to the REU is 28V dc dual
Power to the REU is 28V dc dual power sources (battery bus and Bus
power sources (battery bus and Bus No. 2). The REU provides dc power
No. 2). The REU provides dc power to the ASPs.
to the ASPs. REU REU

and
OCT 99Systems Introduction 23-13 OCT 99 23-13
UNITED
B737 GENERAL AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
COMMUNICATIONS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE COMMUNICATIONS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

Operation Radio Inputs Operation Radio Inputs


All audio inputs from the flight interphone Audio inputs are provided from each of All audio inputs from the flight interphone Audio inputs are provided from each of
system, service interphone system, radio the communication radio receivers and system, service interphone system, radio the communication radio receivers and
communication systems, and radio navi- from each of the navigation radio receiv- communication systems, and radio navi- from each of the navigation radio receiv-
gation systems are connected directly to ers. gation systems are connected directly to ers.
the Remote Electronic Unit where they are Microphone Inputs the Remote Electronic Unit where they are Microphone Inputs
processed into multiplex channels. The An input is wired from each flight crew processed into multiplex channels. The An input is wired from each flight crew
flight crew can then use their Audio Selec- member's boom, mask or hand micro- flight crew can then use their Audio Selec- member's boom, mask or hand micro-
tor Panels to select the multiplex channel phone to the Remote Electronic Unit. tor Panels to select the multiplex channel phone to the Remote Electronic Unit.
they wish to hear on their headphones or Additional inputs are connected from the they wish to hear on their headphones or Additional inputs are connected from the
headsets. They can also connect the PA service interphone system, and from the headsets. They can also connect the PA service interphone system, and from the
channel to the PA amplifier. external power panel. channel to the PA amplifier. external power panel.
The flight interphone system handheld, Audio Outputs The flight interphone system handheld, Audio Outputs
boom, and oxygen mask microphones Audio outputs from the Remote Electronic boom, and oxygen mask microphones pro- Audio outputs from the Remote Electronic
provide the microphone audio inputs from Unit are provided to each flight crew sta- vide the microphone audio inputs from the Unit are provided to each flight crew sta-
the flight crew to the Remote Electronic tion and to the external power panel. One flight crew to the Remote Electronic Unit. tion and to the external power panel. One
Unit. The MIC SELECTOR switches on output is for the boom microphone/head- The MIC SELECTOR switches on each output is for the boom microphone/head-
each Audio Selector Panel determine sets and one output is for the headphone Audio Selector Panel determine which one sets and one output is for the headphone
which one of the communication or inter- jacks. of the communication or interphone sys- jacks.
phone systems will receive the micro- Two audio outputs are used to drive the tems will receive the microphone input for Two audio outputs are used to drive the
phone input for transmission. All Audio pilots' overhead speakers. transmission. All Audio Selector Panels pilots' overhead speakers.
Selector Panels functions are connected in An audio output is provided to the No. 1 functions are connected in parallel to the An audio output is provided to the No. 1
parallel to the REU. The same communi- input of the PA amplifier when a pilot has REU. The same communications are input of the PA amplifier when a pilot has
cations are monitored by all flight crew selected PA and keys his boom/micro- monitored by all flight crew members. selected PA and keys his boom/micro-
members. phone headset. The REU accepts boom microphone, oxy- phone headset.
The REU accepts boom microphone, oxy- Amplifiers in the Remote Electronic Unit gen mask microphone, and handheld Amplifiers in the Remote Electronic Unit
gen mask microphone, and handheld provide the drive for the audio outputs. microphone inputs, and provides output to provide the drive for the audio outputs.
microphone inputs, and provides output to There are two audio amplifiers in the the flight compartment headphones and There are two audio amplifiers in the
the flight compartment headphones and Remote Electronic Unit; one used with the speakers. The REU contains service inter- Remote Electronic Unit; one used with the
speakers. The REU contains service inter- flight interphone and one used with the phone, flight interphone and speaker flight interphone and one used with the
phone, flight interphone and speaker service interphone. External volume con- amplifiers to provide the necessary audio service interphone. External volume con-
amplifiers to provide the necessary audio trol adjustments are installed for each of amplification between stations. The REU trol adjustments are installed for each of
amplification between stations. The REU the amplifiers. routes ground proximity warnings and the amplifiers.
routes ground proximity warnings and Muting internally generated altitude alert tones to Muting
internally generated altitude alert tones to The pilot overhead speaker is muted the speakers. Any audio selected on the The pilot overhead speaker is muted
the speakers. Any audio selected on the whenever a microphone is keyed from the ASP will be recorded on the voice whenever a microphone is keyed from the
ASP will be recorded on the voice same pilot position (left or right) except recorder for each crew member. In the same pilot position (left or right) except
recorder for each crew member. In the when the pilot Audio Selector Panel event of a loss of REU power, an ALT/ when the pilot Audio Selector Panel
event of a loss of REU power, an ALT/ MASK/BOOM switch is in the MASK NORM relay de-energizes, thus providing MASK/BOOM switch is in the MASK
NORM relay de-energizes, thus provid- position. back-up VHF communications. position.
ing back-up VHF communications.

23-14 and Systems Introduction OCT 99 23-14 OCT 99


UNITED AIRLINES COURSE
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
COMMUNICATIONS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE COMMUNICATIONS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

Synthesized Audio Oxygen Mask Microphone selection Synthesized Audio Oxygen Mask Microphone selection
A voice synthesizer will provide the atti- The oxygen mask microphone can be A voice synthesizer will provide the atti- The oxygen mask microphone can be
tude alert audio messages when so input- selected by setting the BOOM/MASK to tude alert audio messages when so input- selected by setting the BOOM/MASK to
ted by the altitude alert system. A two MASK position on the ASP. Flight Deck ted by the altitude alert system. A two MASK position on the ASP. Flight Deck
wire input is provided to receive the audio speakers cannot be muted when oxygen wire input is provided to receive the audio speakers cannot be muted when oxygen
warning tone from the Ground Proximity mask is selected. warning tone from the Ground Proximity mask is selected.
Warning System. Verification of Radio Navigation Identi- Warning System. Verification of Radio Navigation Identi-
Microphone Selection (Normal Mode) fication Microphone Selection (Normal Mode) fication
Selection of which system will receive the Identification of navigation ground station Selection of which system will receive the Identification of navigation ground station
microphone input from each flight crew is accomplished by selecting the appropri- microphone input from each flight crew is accomplished by selecting the appropri-
station is made at the Audio Selector ate navigation selector, switch, pushing station is made at the Audio Selector ate navigation selector, switch, pushing
Panel. The last MIC SELECTOR push- and turning the switch to adjust the vol- Panel. The last MIC SELECTOR push- and turning the switch to adjust the vol-
button which is pushed will determine the ume. button which is pushed will determine the ume.
communication system to be keyed by a Selecting the Voice-Both-Range (V-B-R) communication system to be keyed by a Selecting the Voice-Both-Range (V-B-R)
PTT switch at that flight crew station. filter switch connects audio filters for the PTT switch at that flight crew station. filter switch connects audio filters for the
Flight crew members can access the flight NAV and ADF radio received signals. In Flight crew members can access the flight NAV and ADF radio received signals. In
interphone system by pressing the control Voice (V), the 1020 Hz coded identifica- interphone system by pressing the control Voice (V), the 1020 Hz coded identifica-
wheel PTT switch to the INT position. tion signals are filtered out leaving the wheel PTT switch to the INT position. tion signals are filtered out leaving the
Flight crew members key a selected air- broader voice spectrum essentially Flight crew members key a selected air- broader voice spectrum essentially
plane radio system from an ASP by push- unchanged. In Range (R), the 1020 Hz plane radio system from an ASP by push- unchanged. In Range (R), the 1020 Hz
ing the system MIC SELECTOR switch. coded identification signals are passed ing the system MIC SELECTOR switch. coded identification signals are passed
This connects the boom or oxygen mask while the remaining audio is attenuated. This connects the boom or oxygen mask while the remaining audio is attenuated.
microphone and a control line to the In Both (B), no filters are used. microphone and a control line to the In Both (B), no filters are used.
selected radio system. The PTT function selected radio system. The PTT function
can also be completed at either pilot's sta- can also be completed at either pilot's sta-
tion by holding the control wheel PTT tion by holding the control wheel PTT
switch to the MIC position. All flight switch to the MIC position. All flight
compartment PTT switches are connected compartment PTT switches are connected
to a speaker mute line so both cockpit to a speaker mute line so both cockpit
speakers will be muted when a PTT switch speakers will be muted when a PTT switch
is actuated, except when the MASK/ is actuated, except when the MASK/
BOOM switch is in the MASK position or BOOM switch is in the MASK position or
oxygen mask is in use. This prevents oxygen mask is in use. This prevents
audio feedback from the speakers to the audio feedback from the speakers to the
microphones. microphones.
All audio warning messages from ground All audio warning messages from ground
proximity and altitude alert are heard by proximity and altitude alert are heard by
all flight crew members without being all flight crew members without being
selected on the Audio Selector Panel. selected on the Audio Selector Panel.

and
OCT 99Systems Introduction 23-15 OCT 99 23-15
UNITED
B737 GENERAL AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
COMMUNICATIONS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE COMMUNICATIONS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

Alternate Mode Interfaces Alternate Mode Interfaces


All selections on all Audio Selector Panels The Flight Data recorder receives mike All selections on all Audio Selector Panels The Flight Data recorder receives mike
are made with the EMER/NORM switch keying inputs from the communications are made with the EMER/NORM switch keying inputs from the communications
in the NORM position. system. The navigation radio receivers in the NORM position. system. The navigation radio receivers
When power has lost to the REU or ASPs, provide audio to the REU. When power has lost to the REU or ASPs, provide audio to the REU.
the EMER/NORM can be switched to the EMER/NORM can be switched to
EMER position on the ASP. This will set EMER position on the ASP. This will set
the REU is a back-up mode of operation. the REU is a back-up mode of operation.
This mode is intended only as a backup This mode is intended only as a backup
operating mode to be used in the event of operating mode to be used in the event of
failure of the normal operating mode. failure of the normal operating mode.
When in the EMER (backup) mode, only When in the EMER (backup) mode, only
one VHF communications radio is usable one VHF communications radio is usable
at any crew station with the Audio Selec- at any crew station with the Audio Selec-
tor Panel positioned to EMER. In the case tor Panel positioned to EMER. In the case
of the Captain or observer station the VHF of the Captain or observer station the VHF
radio is VHF No. 1. In the case of the radio is VHF No. 1. In the case of the
First Officer station the VHF radio is No. First Officer station the VHF radio is No.
2. Only earphone audio, sidetone or 2. Only earphone audio, sidetone or
receiver from the designated VHF radio, receiver from the designated VHF radio,
would be available at this crew member would be available at this crew member
station. Only the communications at the station. Only the communications at the
flight crew member's position switched to flight crew member's position switched to
EMER are affected. EMER are affected.
The VHF 1 (VHF 2 for First Officer) MIC The VHF 1 (VHF 2 for First Officer) MIC
SEL button will turn on regardless of the SEL button will turn on regardless of the
selection made at that crew station and the selection made at that crew station and the
only audio received at that station will be only audio received at that station will be
to the earphones from the working VHF to the earphones from the working VHF
radio. radio.

23-16 and Systems Introduction OCT 99 23-16 OCT 99


UNITED AIRLINES COURSE
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
COMMUNICATIONS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE COMMUNICATIONS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

FLIGHT INTERPHONE jacks for a headset and a handheld micro- FLIGHT INTERPHONE jacks for a headset and a handheld micro-
The Flight Interphone system provides the phone. The Flight Interphone system provides the phone.
flight crew with capabilities to communi- The first observer has an Audio Selector flight crew with capabilities to communi- The first observer has an Audio Selector
cate with each other and provides the Panel, an oxygen mask microphone, a cate with each other and provides the Panel, an oxygen mask microphone, a
means for them to transmit and receive on handheld microphone and a headphone. means for them to transmit and receive on handheld microphone and a headphone.
airplane communication radio systems, The second observer has a headphone airplane communication radio systems, The second observer has a headphone
receive on airplane navigation radio sys- jack. The audio selected by the first receive on airplane navigation radio sys- jack. The audio selected by the first
tems and communicate with ground crew observer is heard at both observer stations. tems and communicate with ground crew observer is heard at both observer stations.
personnel. The Flight Interphone system receives personnel. The Flight Interphone system receives
The Flight Interphone system consists of power from the dual power source of 28v The Flight Interphone system consists of power from the dual power source of 28v
Audio Selector Panels (ASP), a Remote dc battery bus and 28v dc bus No. 2, Audio Selector Panels (ASP), a Remote dc battery bus and 28v dc bus No. 2,
Electronic Unit (REU), jack panels, push- through circuit breakers and diodes to Electronic Unit (REU), jack panels, push- through circuit breakers and diodes to
to-talk (PTT) switches on the control allow either bus to power all circuits on to-talk (PTT) switches on the control allow either bus to power all circuits on
wheel, handheld microphones, headsets, load control center P6. wheel, handheld microphones, headsets, load control center P6.
boom microphone/headsets, oxygen mask Operation boom microphone/headsets, oxygen mask Operation
microphones, and overhead speakers. Ground crew personnel access the Flight microphones, and overhead speakers. Ground crew personnel access the Flight
The Captain and First Officer each have Interphone system by plugging a headset The Captain and First Officer each have Interphone system by plugging a headset
an Audio Selector Panel, a Flight Deck into the FLIGHT INTERPHONE jack on an Audio Selector Panel, a Flight Deck into the FLIGHT INTERPHONE jack on
speaker, a control wheel PTT switch, a external power receptacle panel P19. This speaker, a control wheel PTT switch, a external power receptacle panel P19. This
pendant switch, a boom microphone head- allows the ground crew to communicate pendant switch, a boom microphone head- allows the ground crew to communicate
set and oxygen mask microphone, plus with the flight crew. set and oxygen mask microphone, plus with the flight crew.

EXTERNAL INTERPHONE EXTERNAL INTERPHONE


POWER POWER

CONN FLIGHT SERVICE CONN FLIGHT SERVICE


NOSE NOSE
PILOT WHEEL WELL PILOT WHEEL WELL
ON ON
NORM NORM
CALL CALL
NOT LIGHT NOT LIGHT
IN USE IN USE

External Power Panel External Power Panel

and
OCT 99Systems Introduction 23-17 OCT 99 23-17
UNITED
B737 GENERAL AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
COMMUNICATIONS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE COMMUNICATIONS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

The Flight Interphone may be monitored Maintenance Practices The Flight Interphone may be monitored Maintenance Practices
on the flight deck by raising the Flight Adjustments and tests of the Flight Inter- on the flight deck by raising the Flight Adjustments and tests of the Flight Inter-
Interphone volume lever. To talk on the phone system should be accomplished per Interphone volume lever. To talk on the phone system should be accomplished per
Flight Interphone, push the F-INPH mic MM23-51-00 p501 Flight Interphone, push the F-INPH mic MM23-51-00 p501
selector button on the Audio Selector Troubleshooting selector button on the Audio Selector Troubleshooting
Panel, then press any PTT switch. Troubleshooting the Flight Interphone Panel, then press any PTT switch. Troubleshooting the Flight Interphone
system is easy due to the duplication of system is easy due to the duplication of
components within the system. Inter- components within the system. Inter-
changing suspected faulty components changing suspected faulty components
with known good components will quickly with known good components will
isolate the faulty components. If the quickly isolate the faulty components. If
Flight Interphone system is completely the Flight Interphone system is completely
inoperable, the Remote Electronics Unit is inoperable, the Remote Electronics Unit is
faulty. faulty.
Interphone speaker failure can usually be Interphone speaker failure can usually be
detected by comparison between head- detected by comparison between head-
phone audio and the speaker audio. If phone audio and the speaker audio. If
audio is not available to either one, the audio is not available to either one, the
audio selector panel is faulty. audio selector panel is faulty.
Isolation of a faulty control wheel PTT Isolation of a faulty control wheel PTT
switch can be determined by first making switch can be determined by first making
a comparison with the PTT switch on the a comparison with the PTT switch on the
Control Wheel PTT Switch Audio Selector Panel or the PTT switch on Control Wheel PTT Switch Audio Selector Panel or the PTT switch
the handheld microphone. If microphone on the handheld microphone. If micro-
A rocker type mic switch on each control can be keyed using the control panel PTT A rocker type mic switch on each control phone can be keyed using the control
wheel will also allow communications on switch and the handheld microphone PTT wheel will also allow communications on panel PTT switch and the handheld micro-
the Flight Interphone. The switch has switch but not when using the control the Flight Interphone. The switch has phone PTT switch but not when using the
three positions: MIC-OFF-INT. It is wheel PTT switch, the control wheel PTT three positions: MIC-OFF-INT. It is control wheel PTT switch, the control
spring loaded to the OFF position. In the switch is defective. spring loaded to the OFF position. In the wheel PTT switch is defective.
INT position, the ASP is bypassed and Bleed through problems of the Flight INT position, the ASP is bypassed and Bleed through problems of the Flight
either the oxygen mic or the boom mic is Interphone system can be addressed with either the oxygen mic or the boom mic is Interphone system can be addressed with
keyed on the Flight Interphone. In the MM23-51-00 p200. keyed on the Flight Interphone. In the MM23-51-00 p200.
MIC position, the mic switch keys either MIC position, the mic switch keys either
the oxygen mic or boom mic as selected the oxygen mic or boom mic as selected
on the Audio Selector Panel. on the Audio Selector Panel.
Note: Be sure to plug into the Flight Note: Be sure to plug into the Flight
Interphone jack and not the Service Interphone jack and not the Service
Interphone jack at the External Power Interphone jack at the External Power
Receptacle panel when communicating Receptacle panel when communicating
with the flight crew. with the flight crew.

23-18 and Systems Introduction OCT 99 23-18 OCT 99


UNITED AIRLINES COURSE
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
COMMUNICATIONS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE COMMUNICATIONS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

CREW CALL SYSTEM The system includes the call switches on CREW CALL SYSTEM The system includes the call switches on
The flight and ground crew call system the pilots' call panel, on the attendant pan- The flight and ground crew call system the pilots' call panel, on the attendant pan-
provides for call signals between the flight els, and on the external power receptacle. provides for call signals between the flight els, and on the external power receptacle.
deck and cabin attendant stations, between It also includes the ground crew call horn deck and cabin attendant stations, between It also includes the ground crew call horn
the flight deck and ground crew, and in the nose wheel well, the attendant call the flight deck and ground crew, and in the nose wheel well, the attendant call
between cabin attendant stations. The sys- lights on the cabin exit signs and attendant between cabin attendant stations. The sys- lights on the cabin exit signs and attendant
tem is used to signal personnel that they panels. The flight and ground crew call tem is used to signal personnel that they panels. The flight and ground crew call
are wanted on the interphone system. system is powered by the PASS & CREW are wanted on the interphone system. system is powered by the PASS & CREW
CALL or PASS & CREW CALL/LAV CALL or PASS & CREW CALL/LAV
SMK DET circuit breaker on P18. Power SMK DET circuit breaker on P18. Power
to the circuit breaker comes from the 28v to the circuit breaker comes from the 28v
dc bus No. 1. The CREW CALL HORN dc bus No. 1. The CREW CALL HORN
circuit breaker on the P6 panel powers the circuit breaker on the P6 panel powers the
ground crew horn in the nose wheel well ground crew horn in the nose wheel well
area. area.

FLIGHT FLIGHT
COMPARTMENT COMPARTMENT

CABIN CREW CABIN CREW


GROUND GROUND
CREW CREW
FWD ATTN AFT ATTN FWD ATTN AFT ATTN
PANEL PANEL PANEL PANEL

Crew Call Block Crew Call Block

and
OCT 99Systems Introduction 23-19 OCT 99 23-19
UNITED
B737 GENERAL AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
COMMUNICATIONS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE COMMUNICATIONS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

Pilots' Call Panel Pilots' Call Panel


The flight deck, forward overhead panel The flight deck, forward overhead panel
(P5) contains an ATTEND CALL switch, (P5) contains an ATTEND CALL switch,
a GRD CALL switch, and a Captain's Call a GRD CALL switch, and a Captain's Call
Light. The ATTEND CALL switch sig- Light. The ATTEND CALL switch sig-
nals the flight attendants and the GRD nals the flight attendants and the GRD
CALL switch signals the ground crew. CALL switch signals the ground crew.
The blue CALL light illuminates when the The blue CALL light illuminates when the
flight crew is called by either the flight flight crew is called by either the flight
attendants or the ground crew. attendants or the ground crew.

NO FASTEN NO FASTEN
SMOKING BELTS SMOKING BELTS
OFF OFF
AUTO AUTO
ON ON

GRD GRD
ATTEND CALL ATTEND CALL

CALL CALL

Pilot’s Call Switches Pilot’s Call Switches

23-20 and Systems Introduction OCT 99 23-20 OCT 99


UNITED AIRLINES COURSE
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
COMMUNICATIONS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE COMMUNICATIONS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

Flight Attendant's Panel Flight Attendant Call Lights Flight Attendant's Panel Flight Attendant Call Lights
The forward attendant panel (Pl3) and the The forward and aft attendant call lights The forward attendant panel (Pl3) and the The forward and aft attendant call lights
aft attendant panel (Pl4) are located near are located on the underside of the exit aft attendant panel (Pl4) are located near are located on the underside of the exit
the entry doors. Each panel contains a locator signs. The Attendant Call Lights the entry doors. Each panel contains a locator signs. The Attendant Call Lights
CAPTAIN, ATTENDANT, and RESET are pink. CAPTAIN, ATTENDANT, and RESET are pink.
momentary push-button switch. The momentary push-button switch. The
CAPTAIN call switch is used to signal the CAPTAIN call switch is used to signal the
flight deck crew, the ATTENDANT call flight deck crew, the ATTENDANT call
switch signals the flight attendants, and switch signals the flight attendants, and
the RESET switch turns off the attendant the RESET switch turns off the attendant
call lights. call lights.

CALL SYSTEM LIGHTS CALL SYSTEM LIGHTS


BRT ON ON
BRT ON ON

DIM
DIM

CAPTAIN ATTENDANT RESET CAPTAIN ATTENDANT RESET OFF OFF OFF


OFF OFF OFF
WORK GROUND ENTRY WORK GROUND
ENTRY LIGHTS
LIGHTS SERVICE OFF DIM SERVICE
OFF DIM
ON BRT
ON BRT BRT ON BRT
BRT ON BRT
NIGHT DIM
NIGHT DIM DIM
DIM
NORM
NORM OFF
OFF OFF OFF
OFF OFF CEILING
CEILING WINDOW ENTRY WORK EMER EXIT WINDOW
ENTRY WORK EMER EXIT
MUSIC MUSIC
AFT ATTNEDANTS PANEL AFT ATTNEDANTS PANEL

OFF
OFF

CALL SYSTEM CALL SYSTEM

CAPTAIN ATTENDANT RESET CAPTAIN ATTENDANT RESET

ATTENDANT'S CALL LIGHT (PINK) ATTENDANT'S CALL LIGHT (PINK)


FWD ATTNEDANTS PANEL FWD ATTNEDANTS PANEL

EXIT LOCATOR SIGN EXIT LOCATOR SIGN

Forward and Aft Attendant Panels and Exit Locator Sign Forward and Aft Attendant Panels and Exit Locator Sign

and
OCT 99Systems Introduction 23-21 OCT 99 23-21
UNITED
B737 GENERAL AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
COMMUNICATIONS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE COMMUNICATIONS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

Pilot Call Switch Ground Crew Call Horn Pilot Call Switch Ground Crew Call Horn
The PILOT CALL momentary push-but- The ground crew call horn is an electro- The PILOT CALL momentary push-but- The ground crew call horn is an electro-
ton switch is located in the external power mechanical device located in the nose ton switch is located in the external power mechanical device located in the nose
receptacle panel, P19. The PILOT CALL wheel well, station 230. The flight crew receptacle panel, P19. The PILOT CALL wheel well, station 230. The flight crew
switch is used by the ground crew to sig- uses the horn to signal the ground crew to switch is used by the ground crew to sig- uses the horn to signal the ground crew to
nal the flight crew. use the interphone system. The ground nal the flight crew. use the interphone system. The ground
crew call horn also serves as an audible crew call horn also serves as an audible
warning device for the IRU (Inertial Ref- warning device for the IRU (Inertial Ref-
erence Unit). With the air-ground relay erence Unit). With the air-ground relay
set to ground, the horn sounds whenever set to ground, the horn sounds whenever
the IRU is powered by its battery, or the IRU is powered by its battery, or
whenever the IRU is on and the equipment whenever the IRU is on and the equipment
cooling fan is not operating (Ref 34-28-01 cooling fan is not operating (Ref 34-28-01
Honeywell IRU or 34-28-02 Litton IRU). Honeywell IRU or 34-28-02 Litton IRU).

EXTERNAL INTERPHONE EXTERNAL INTERPHONE


POWER POWER

CONN FLIGHT SERVICE CONN FLIGHT SERVICE

NOSE NOSE
PILOT WHEEL WELL PILOT WHEEL WELL
ON
ON
NORM
NORM
CALL CALL
LIGHT NOT LIGHT
NOT
IN USE IN USE

External Power Panel External Power Panel

23-22 and Systems Introduction OCT 99 23-22 OCT 99


UNITED AIRLINES COURSE
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
COMMUNICATIONS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE COMMUNICATIONS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

Interfaces Pressing the GRD CALL switch on the Interfaces Pressing the GRD CALL switch on the
The Crew Call system interfaces with the forward overhead panel P5 applies 28v dc The Crew Call system interfaces with the forward overhead panel P5 applies 28v dc
P.A. amplifier, and the aural warning power to the ground crew call horn. The P.A. amplifier, and the aural warning power to the ground crew call horn. The
devices unit in the flight deck. horn will sound as long as the switch is devices unit in the flight deck. horn will sound as long as the switch is
Operation pressed. Operation pressed.
Pressing the PILOT CALL switch on the When a passenger presses the Flight Pressing the PILOT CALL switch on the When a passenger presses the Flight
P19 external power receptacle panel, or Attendant Call button on the Passenger P19 external power receptacle panel, or Attendant Call button on the Passenger
the CAPTAIN call switch on either flight Service Unit (PSU), the P.A. amplifier the CAPTAIN call switch on either flight Service Unit (PSU), the P.A. amplifier
attendant panel, applies 28v dc power to will sound a single chime in the cabin, and attendant panel, applies 28v dc power to will sound a single chime in the cabin, and
the pilots' CALL light and to the aural the flight attendant blue call lights will the pilots' CALL light and to the aural the flight attendant blue call lights will
warning devices unit. The blue CALL illuminate. The lights go out when the call warning devices unit. The blue CALL illuminate. The lights go out when the call
light comes on and stays on only while the switch on the PSU is pressed a second light comes on and stays on only while the switch on the PSU is pressed a second
call switch is pressed. The aural warning time. An amber light indicates a lavatory call switch is pressed. The aural warning time. An amber light indicates a lavatory
devices unit sounds a single chime. call. devices unit sounds a single chime. call.
Pressing the ATTEND call switch on the Testing Pressing the ATTEND call switch on the Testing
forward overhead panel P5, or the To test the Flight and Ground Crew Call forward overhead panel P5, or the To test the Flight and Ground Crew Call
ATTENDANT call switch on either of the system, an operational test is done per ATTENDANT call switch on either of the system, an operational test is done per
flight attendant panels, applies 28v dc MM 23-43-00 p501. flight attendant panels, applies 28v dc MM 23-43-00 p501.
power to the attendant pink call lights, to power to the attendant pink call lights, to
the attendant call relay, and to the chime the attendant call relay, and to the chime
in the P.A. amplifier. The PA amplifier in the P.A. amplifier. The PA amplifier
sounds a two tone chime over the PA sys- sounds a two tone chime over the PA sys-
tem. Also, the attendant call relay holds tem. Also, the attendant call relay holds
the call lights on until reset with the the call lights on until reset with the
RESET switch on either flight attendant RESET switch on either flight attendant
panel. The RESET switches on the atten- panel. The RESET switches on the atten-
dant panels are connected in series, press- dant panels are connected in series, press-
ing one removes power from the attendant ing one removes power from the attendant
relay and the call lights go off. relay and the call lights go off.

and
OCT 99Systems Introduction 23-23 OCT 99 23-23
UNITED
B737 GENERAL AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
COMMUNICATIONS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE COMMUNICATIONS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

Troubleshooting Troubleshooting
If there is a write-up or discrepancy found If there is a write-up or discrepancy found
during the operational check, reference during the operational check, reference
MM 23-43-00 p101. MM 23-43-00 p101.

PROBLEM CAUSE PROCEDURE CORRECTION PROBLEM CAUSE PROCEDURE CORRECTION


Pilot’s CALL CAPTAIN call Call from a different Replace the Pilot’s CALL CAPTAIN call Call from a different Replace the
light and chime switch on that station. If both the CAPTAIN call light and chime switch on that station. If both the CAPTAIN call
do not operate. panel. call light & chime switch at the inop do not operate. panel. call light & chime switch at the inop
operate-- station. operate-- station.
Pilot’s chime does Aural warning unit Remove connector Replace the module Pilot’s chime does Aural warning unit Remove connector Replace the module
not operate from module, M315. from module, check not operate from module, M315. from module, check
any station. for voltage, if present-- any station. for voltage, if present--
CALL light does CALL light Push MASTER Replace CALL CALL light does CALL light Push MASTER Replace CALL
not operate from DIM & TEST, if no light bulbs not operate from DIM & TEST, if no light bulbs
any station . light-- any station . light--
Attendant call ATTENDANT call Call from another Replace Attendant call ATTENDANT call Call from another Replace
lights & chime inop. switch at station. station, if chime & ATTENDANT lights & chime inop. switch at station. station, if chime & ATTENDANT
lights are OK-- call switch lights are OK-- call switch
Call lights stay RESET switch Push & hold the P5 Replace the Call lights stay RESET switch Push & hold the P5 Replace the
on only as long as in attendant panel. ATTEND call switch. RESET switch on on only as long as in attendant panel. ATTEND call switch. RESET switch on
you push the If same result-- the inop attendant you push the If same result-- the inop attendant
ATTENDANT panel. They are ATTENDANT panel. They are
call switch. wired in series. call switch. wired in series.
Attendant call Diode M54 Push the Replace M54 in Attendant call Diode M54 Push the Replace M54 in
lights do not ATTENDANT call P13 fwd attendant lights do not ATTENDANT call P13 fwd attendant
come on. switch. If chime panel. come on. switch. If chime panel.
sounds, but lights sounds, but lights
don’t-- don’t--
Call lights stay R400 attendant Push & release the Replace the R400 Call lights stay R400 attendant Push & release the Replace the R400
lit only as long call relay. ATTENDANT call relay In the P13, lit only as long call relay. ATTENDANT call relay In the P13,
as you push the switch. If light comes fwd attendant panel. as you push the switch. If light comes fwd attendant panel.
ATTENDANT on then goes off-- ATTENDANT on then goes off--
call switch. call switch.
The chime in PA amplifier, M63. Push ATTEND Replace the PA The chime in PA amplifier, M63. Push ATTEND Replace the PA
cabin does not and ATTENDANT amplifier. cabin does not and ATTENDANT amplifier.
sound when call switches. If light sound when call switches. If light
making attendant comes on, but no making attendant comes on, but no
call. chime-- call. chime--

23-24 and Systems Introduction OCT 99 23-24 OCT 99


UNITED AIRLINES COURSE
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
COMMUNICATIONS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE COMMUNICATIONS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

PROBLEM CAUSE PROCEDURE CORRECTION PROBLEM CAUSE PROCEDURE CORRECTION


Ground crew call GRD CALL Check switch for Replace switch, S32. Ground crew call GRD CALL Check switch for Replace switch, S32.
horn does not switch, S32. continuity when horn does not switch, S32. continuity when
sound when you pushed. If open-- sound when you pushed. If open--
push the GRD push the GRD
CALL switch on CALL switch on
the P5. the P5.

Ground crew Check voltage at Replace horn, M53. Ground crew Check voltage at Replace horn, M53.
call horn, M53 horn when pushing call horn, M53 horn when pushing
switch. If voltage-- switch. If voltage--

CREW CALL If no voltage at horn-- Check breaker, CREW CALL If no voltage at horn-- Check breaker,
HORN C/B replace if necessary. HORN C/B replace if necessary.
on P6-1. on P6-1.

Integrated flight If no voltage at horn-- Replace Integrated flight If no voltage at horn-- Replace
instrument unserviceable instrument unserviceable
accessory unit, unit, M1474 or accessory unit, unit, M1474 or
M1474 or flight M160 as M1474 or flight M160 as
instrument applicable. instrument applicable.
accessory unit, accessory unit,
M160. M160.

See MM 23-43-00 p102-105 See MM 23-43-00 p102-105

and
OCT 99Systems Introduction 23-25 OCT 99 23-25
UNITED
B737 GENERAL AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
COMMUNICATIONS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE COMMUNICATIONS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

SERVICE INTERPHONE panels, and the control cabin for commu- SERVICE INTERPHONE panels, and the control cabin for commu-
The Service Interphone system provides nication between attendants and the flight The Service Interphone system provides nication between attendants and the flight
interphone communications between the crew. Switched Service Interphone jacks interphone communications between the crew. Switched Service Interphone jacks
flight crew, the attendants, and ground located throughout the airplane are for use flight crew, the attendants, and ground located throughout the airplane are for use
crew personnel. The system includes: the by ground crew personnel during servic- crew personnel. The system includes: the by ground crew personnel during servic-
Remote Electronics Unit (REU), the Ser- ing and maintenance. The flight crew can Remote Electronics Unit (REU), the Ser- ing and maintenance. The flight crew can
vice Interphone switch, the attendants communicate with the attendants or vice Interphone switch, the attendants communicate with the attendants or
handsets, the control cabin handset and ground crew personnel through the Audio handsets, the control cabin handset and the ground crew personnel through the Audio
the Service Interphone jacks. Handsets are Selector Panels and the headphones and Service Interphone jacks. Handsets are Selector Panels and the headphones and
installed in the forward and aft attendant microphones of the flight interphone sys- installed in the forward and aft attendant microphones of the flight interphone sys-
tem. tem.

FORWARD
FORWARD
ATTENDANT
ATTENDANT
AFT
AFT
ATTENDANT
ATTENDANT
FLIGHT COMPARTMENT
FLIGHT COMPARTMENT AUDIO
AUDIO CONTROL STAND (PROV)
CONTROL STAND (PROV) CONNECTIONS
CONNECTIONS
AND
AND
AMPLIFIER
AMPLIFIER

AUDIO CONTROL
AUDIO CONTROL
PANELS
PANELS
MICROPHONES
MICROPHONES
HEADSETS
HEADSETS
SPEAKERS
SPEAKERS

AIRPLANE SERVICING STATIONS


AIRPLANE SERVICING STATIONS

Service Interphone System Service Interphone System

23-26 and Systems Introduction OCT 99 23-26 OCT 99


UNITED AIRLINES COURSE
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
COMMUNICATIONS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE COMMUNICATIONS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

Service Interphone Switch Flight attendants may communicate with Service Interphone Switch Flight attendants may communicate with
The Service Interphone switch is located each other, with the flight crew, and with The Service Interphone switch is located each other, with the flight crew, and with
on the aft overhead panel P5. In the ON the ground crew, by using the handsets on the aft overhead panel P5. In the ON the ground crew, by using the handsets
position, the switch connects the micro- installed at their stations. position, the switch connects the micro- installed at their stations.
phone lines from the external Service The flight crew can signal and communi- phone lines from the external Service The flight crew can signal and communi-
Interphone jacks to the input of the inter- cate with the attendants and with crew at Interphone jacks to the input of the inter- cate with the attendants and with crew at
phone amplifiers. The OFF position dis- maintenance locations by pushing the phone amplifiers. The OFF position dis- maintenance locations by pushing the
connects the microphone lines to isolate ATTEND call switch and SERV INT connects the microphone lines to isolate ATTEND call switch and SERV INT
the external Service Interphone jacks dur- audio listen switch on the Pilots' overhead the external Service Interphone jacks dur- audio listen switch on the Pilots' overhead
ing flight. panel P5. ing flight. panel P5.
Operation Operation
To communicate on the Service Inter- To communicate on the Service Inter-
phone system, lift up the handset at the phone system, lift up the handset at the
flight deck or Flight Attendant stations. flight deck or Flight Attendant stations.
SERVICE Press the PTT switch on the handset to SERVICE Press the PTT switch on the handset to
INTERPHONE talk. For the other position jacks, the P5 INTERPHONE talk. For the other position jacks, the P5
OFF SERVICE INTERPHONE switch must be SERVICE INTERPHONE switch must be
OFF
on. Connect a ground headset to the jack on. Connect a ground headset to the jack
and push the PTT switch to talk. The con- and push the PTT switch to talk. The con-
trol cabin handset overrides the selection trol cabin handset overrides the selection
ON of the Audio Selector Panel. To talk on ON of the Audio Selector Panel. To talk on
the Service Interphone system using the the Service Interphone system using the
boom mic, press the INPH-S selector boom mic, press the INPH-S selector
switch and move the volume slider switch switch and move the volume slider switch
forward. forward.
Service Interphone Switch Maintenance Practices Service Interphone Switch Maintenance Practices
NOTE: Clean all handset plugs before NOTE: Clean all handset plugs before
Functional Description you put the plug into the jack. Dirt can Functional Description you put the plug into the jack. Dirt can
The INTPH AND WARNING circuit cause the jack to operate intermittently. The INTPH AND WARNING circuit cause the jack to operate intermittently.
breaker on load control center P6 controls Dirty jacks are a common problem of breaker on load control center P6 controls Dirty jacks are a common problem of
power to the system. The system is on intermittent or weak communication on power to the system. The system is on intermittent or weak communication on
whenever power is provided to one of the the system. whenever power is provided to one of the the system.
buses. The Service Interphone system gets Gain adjustments of the system may be buses. The Service Interphone system gets Gain adjustments of the system may be
power from the 28v dc battery bus and done on the REU; SVC INT EXT sets the power from the 28v dc battery bus and done on the REU; SVC INT EXT sets the
also the unswitched electronics bus No. 2. volume level of the audio heard at the also the unswitched electronics bus No. 2. volume level of the audio heard at the
Setting the SERVICE INTERPHONE switched service jacks, SVC INT ATT Setting the SERVICE INTERPHONE switched service jacks, SVC INT ATT
switch (on the aft overhead panel P5) to sets the volume level of the audio for the switch (on the aft overhead panel P5) to sets the volume level of the audio for the
ON connects the microphone circuits from unswitched jacks. ON connects the microphone circuits from unswitched jacks.
the external Service Interphone jacks to Testing the external Service Interphone jacks to Testing
the interphone amplifier. This allows Testing of the Service Interphone system the interphone amplifier. This allows Testing of the Service Interphone system
ground crew at the various maintenance is accomplished by an operational check. ground crew at the various maintenance is accomplished by an operational check.
locations to talk with each other. Reference MM 23-41-00 p501. locations to talk with each other. Reference MM 23-41-00 p501.

and
OCT 99Systems Introduction 23-27 OCT 99 23-27
UNITED
B737 GENERAL AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
COMMUNICATIONS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE COMMUNICATIONS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

Troubleshooting Troubleshooting
The Service Interphone system is made up The Service Interphone system is made up
of attendants' handsets and a control stand of attendants' handsets and a control stand
handset jack. Each component is directly handset jack. Each component is directly
connected to the Remote Electronic Unit. connected to the Remote Electronic Unit.
If nothing is heard at a given station, If nothing is heard at a given station,
Remote Electronics Unit failure is appar- Remote Electronics Unit failure is appar-
ent. If only the interphone jacks con- ent. If only the interphone jacks con-
nected through the Service Interphone nected through the Service Interphone
switch are not working then the jack or switch are not working then the jack or
handset can be found when a handset is handset can be found when a handset is
moved from station to station If the Ser- moved from station to station If the Ser-
vice Interphone system is not working at vice Interphone system is not working at
all, check that power is available and the all, check that power is available and the
INTPH AND WARNING circuit breaker INTPH AND WARNING circuit breaker
on the load control center P6 is closed. If on the load control center P6 is closed. If
power is available, replace the Remote power is available, replace the Remote
Electronic Unit. Electronic Unit.
Intermittent problems at the flight atten- Intermittent problems at the flight atten-
dant stations can be caused by broken dant stations can be caused by broken
wires in the handset cord. Moving the wires in the handset cord. Moving the
cord while communicating will usually cord while communicating will usually
find the problem. Intermittent problems at find the problem. Intermittent problems at
the external positions can be due to dirty the external positions can be due to dirty
jacks, clean the jack and retry. jacks, clean the jack and retry.

23-28 and Systems Introduction OCT 99 23-28 OCT 99


B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE

DESCRIPTION & OPERATION


OCT 99

COMMUNICATIONS
M545 T D6013
28V DC D25018 R RIGHT WING REFUELING
BAT BUS S STATION (STA 78)
H1 POWER
24-00-01 C561 C84 SUPPLY
INPH PWR H2 T D6057
INPH AMPL R
F/O BAT & WARNING S
RIGHT WHEEL WELL
28V DC (STA 655)
BUS 2
24-00-01 C560 T D6011
FLIGHT CREW R
INPH PWR AUDIO LEFT WHEEL WELL
F/O NO. 2 BUS M544 S (STA 655)
T D6017
R APU
S (STA 1040)
SERVICE T D6015
ATTENDANT/SERVICE INTERPHONE R AFT CABIN
CODE INTERPHONE STATIONS TYPE
EXTERNAL S (STA 1004)
AUDIO D2501B
A EXTERNAL POWER PANEL JACK D6025
E7 T
B ELECTRONIC EQUIPMENT RACK JACK R ELECTRONIC
D7 S EQUIPMENT RACK
C WING REFUELING STATION JACK (STA 350)
D FORWARD OF RIGHT WHEEL WELL JACK
Service Interphone

E FORWARD OF LEFT WHEEL WELL JACK D6007

UNITED AIRLINES
T
SERVICE R SERVICE
F AFT CABIN CEILLING JACK INTERPHONE S INTERPHONE
G APU ACCESS PANEL JACK
ATTENDANT'S
AUDIO
H FORWARD ATTENDANT'S PANEL HANDSET G8 P19 EXTERNAL POWER
J AFT ATTENDANT'S PANEL HANDSET G9 F7
RECEPTACLE PANEL
K CONTROL STAND JACK
D6
TO SERVICE PHONE HI
INTERPHONE 1
LEVEL PHONE LO
2
CONTROL MIC HI
3
MIC LO 4
AAU CARD
C
P13 FWD ATTTENDANTS

AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE


B737-322/522
M1353 REMOTE ELECTRONICS UNIT (E2-1) PANEL

SERVICE
PHONE HI
A INTERPHONE
D F OFF PHONE LO 1
K
MIC HI 2
B E 3
H MIC LO
J ON 4

P14 AFT ATTTENDANTS


PANEL

S50 SERVICE PHONE HI


INTERPHONE SWITCH (P5 AFT) PHONE LO 1
MIC HI 2
3
MIC LO 4
F
P8 CONTROL STAND
J AFT FACE
K H
B G
A
D,E
23-29

and Systems Introduction

DESCRIPTION & OPERATION


OCT 99

COMMUNICATIONS
M545 T D6013
28V DC D25018 R RIGHT WING REFUELING
BAT BUS S STATION (STA 78)
H1 POWER
24-00-01 C561 C84 SUPPLY
INPH PWR H2 T D6057
INPH AMPL R
F/O BAT & WARNING S
RIGHT WHEEL WELL
28V DC (STA 655)
BUS 2
24-00-01 C560 T D6011
FLIGHT CREW R
INPH PWR AUDIO LEFT WHEEL WELL
F/O NO. 2 BUS M544 S (STA 655)
T D6017
R APU
S (STA 1040)
SERVICE T D6015
ATTENDANT/SERVICE INTERPHONE R AFT CABIN
CODE INTERPHONE STATIONS TYPE
EXTERNAL S (STA 1004)
AUDIO D2501B
A EXTERNAL POWER PANEL JACK D6025
E7 T
B ELECTRONIC EQUIPMENT RACK JACK R ELECTRONIC
D7 S EQUIPMENT RACK
C WING REFUELING STATION JACK (STA 350)
D FORWARD OF RIGHT WHEEL WELL JACK
Service Interphone

UNITED AIRLINES
E FORWARD OF LEFT WHEEL WELL JACK T D6007
SERVICE R SERVICE
F AFT CABIN CEILLING JACK INTERPHONE S INTERPHONE
G APU ACCESS PANEL JACK
ATTENDANT'S
AUDIO
H FORWARD ATTENDANT'S PANEL HANDSET G8 P19 EXTERNAL POWER
J AFT ATTENDANT'S PANEL HANDSET G9 F7
RECEPTACLE PANEL
K CONTROL STAND JACK
D6
TO SERVICE PHONE HI
INTERPHONE 1
LEVEL PHONE LO
2
CONTROL MIC HI
3
MIC LO 4
AAU CARD
C
P13 FWD ATTTENDANTS
B737-322/522
AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE

M1353 REMOTE ELECTRONICS UNIT (E2-1) PANEL

SERVICE
PHONE HI
A INTERPHONE
D F OFF PHONE LO 1
K
MIC HI 2
B E 3
H MIC LO
J ON 4

P14 AFT ATTTENDANTS


PANEL

S50 SERVICE PHONE HI


INTERPHONE SWITCH (P5 AFT) PHONE LO 1
MIC HI 2
3
MIC LO 4
F
P8 CONTROL STAND
J AFT FACE
K H
B G
A
D,E
23-29
UNITED
B737 GENERAL AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
COMMUNICATIONS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE COMMUNICATIONS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

PASSENGER ADDRESS SYSTEM PASSENGER ADDRESS SYSTEM


The Passenger Address (PA) system pro- The Passenger Address (PA) system pro-
vides prioritized voice announcements to vides prioritized voice announcements to
the passengers over the cabin and lavatory the passengers over the cabin and lavatory
speakers. It provides chime signals for the speakers. It provides chime signals for the
flight attendants and passengers. It also flight attendants and passengers. It also
provides boarding music from the tape provides boarding music from the tape
reproducer. The system consists of the PA reproducer. The system consists of the PA
microphones at the flight attendant and microphones at the flight attendant and
pilot stations, PA amplifier, and the various pilot stations, PA amplifier, and the vari-
speakers in the cabin and lavatories. ous speakers in the cabin and lavatories.

FORWARD
FORWARD FLIGHT
FLIGHT ATTENDANT
ATTENDANT STATION
STATION

AFT
AFT FLIGHT PA
FLIGHT PA AMPLIFIER
AMPLIFIER ATTENDANT
ATTENDANT STATION
STATION

CABIN & LAV


CABIN & LAV SPEAKERS
SPEAKERS

FLIGHT
FLIGHT DECK
DECK PA MIC
PA MIC

PA System Block Diagram PA System Block Diagram

23-30 and Systems Introduction OCT 99 23-30 OCT 99


UNITED AIRLINES COURSE
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
COMMUNICATIONS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE COMMUNICATIONS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

Power to the system is provided by the PA Amplifier Power to the system is provided by the PA Amplifier
115v ac and 28v dc systems. Circuit The PA amplifier unit contains the circuits 115v ac and 28v dc systems. Circuit The PA amplifier unit contains the circuits
breakers are located on the P6 panel. for amplifying and generating chime breakers are located on the P6 panel. for amplifying and generating chime
The highest priority of announcements is tones. It is located on the E2-1 rack. The highest priority of announcements is tones. It is located on the E2-1 rack.
from the flight deck crew. The second pri- There are three LEDs and a three position from the flight deck crew. The second pri- There are three LEDs and a three position
ority of announcements is from the flight rotary selector on the front of the unit. ority of announcements is from the flight rotary selector on the front of the unit.
attendant stations. The lowest priority is Note: The selector switch should always attendant stations. The lowest priority is Note: The selector switch should always
the boarding music. be returned to the NORM position the boarding music. be returned to the NORM position
Chime signals are superimposed over the when finished with any calibration or Chime signals are superimposed over the when finished with any calibration or
announcement audio. A low chime test of the system. This position is announcement audio. A low chime test of the system. This position is
sounds when the Fasten Seatbelt or No required for proper system operation. sounds when the Fasten Seatbelt or No required for proper system operation.
Smoking signs are switched on or off. A There is a MASTER GAIN adjustment at Smoking signs are switched on or off. A There is a MASTER GAIN adjustment at
high chime sounds when a passenger the lower left corner of the front of the high chime sounds when a passenger the lower left corner of the front of the
pushes an Attendant Call button from a unit. pushes an Attendant Call button from a unit.
seat or lavatory. A high/low chime sounds seat or lavatory. A high/low chime sounds
when the flight crew uses the Attendant when the flight crew uses the Attendant
Call system. Call system.
Boarding music is controlled by the Boarding music is controlled by the
MUSIC CHANNEL/ON/OFF/VOLUME MUSIC CHANNEL/ON/OFF/VOLUME
selectors on the forward flight attendant's -1 0 db +1 selectors on the forward flight attendant's -1 0 db +1
panel, these are two concentric knobs. panel, these are two concentric knobs.
The On/Off/Volume inner knob turns on NORM The On/Off/Volume inner knob turns on NORM
TEST
power to the tape reproducer and controls TEST CAL power to the tape reproducer and controls CAL

the volume of the cabin speakers. The the volume of the cabin speakers. The
outer knob selects the tape supplying the outer knob selects the tape supplying the
boarding music. Positions 1 & 2 use the boarding music. Positions 1 & 2 use the
same tape and positions 3 & 4 use the same tape and positions 3 & 4 use the
same tape. same tape.
Note: The ON/OFF/VOLUME control Note: The ON/OFF/VOLUME control
and the IFE switch on the forward and the IFE switch on the forward
flight attendant panel operate indepen- flight attendant panel operate indepen-
dently of each other. dently of each other.
When the No. 1 engine is started and the When the No. 1 engine is started and the
oil pressure switch senses pressure, a oil pressure switch senses pressure, a
ground is removed from the PA amplifier ground is removed from the PA amplifier
which increases the amplifier gain by 6db which increases the amplifier gain by 6db
to compensate for engine noise. to compensate for engine noise.

PA Amplifier PA Amplifier

and
OCT 99Systems Introduction 23-31 OCT 99 23-31
UNITED
B737 GENERAL AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
COMMUNICATIONS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE COMMUNICATIONS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

Speakers A five inch diameter speaker and match- Speakers A five inch diameter speaker and match-
The Passenger Address (PA) speakers for ing transformer is mounted in the ceiling The Passenger Address (PA) speakers for ing transformer is mounted in the ceiling
the cabin are 6.5 inch diameter speakers of each lavatory. The speakers at the the cabin are 6.5 inch diameter speakers of each lavatory. The speakers at the
with matching transformer is installed in Flight Attendant stations are muted when with matching transformer is installed in Flight Attendant stations are muted when
the Passenger Service Unit (PSU) assem- a PA announcement is made from that par- the Passenger Service Unit (PSU) assem- a PA announcement is made from that
bly in approximately every other row of ticular station. bly in approximately every other row of particular station.
seats. These speakers provide PA Note: There are several terminal con- seats. These speakers provide PA Note: There are several terminal con-
announcements and boarding music to the nections on the speakers for impedance announcements and boarding music to the nections on the speakers for impedance
passengers. matching. Be sure to attach the wires to passengers. matching. Be sure to attach the wires to
the correct terminal on installation. the correct terminal on installation.

Cabin Speaker and Lav Speaker Cabin Speaker and Lav Speaker

23-32 and Systems Introduction OCT 99 23-32 OCT 99


UNITED AIRLINES COURSE
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
COMMUNICATIONS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE COMMUNICATIONS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

Interfaces Testing Interfaces Testing


The PA system interfaces with the Passen- Testing can be performed by the proce- The PA system interfaces with the Passen- Testing can be performed by the proce-
ger Entertainment system and the engine dures in MM23-31-00 p501. Turning the ger Entertainment system and the engine dures in MM23-31-00 p501. Turning the
oil pressure system. TEST/NORM/CAL selector to the TEST oil pressure system. TEST/NORM/CAL selector to the TEST
Operation position sounds a high chime on all the PA Operation position sounds a high chime on all the PA
PA announcements can be made from the system speakers. Turning the selector to PA announcements can be made from the system speakers. Turning the selector to
flight deck or either flight attendant panel. the CAL position applies a load to the sys- flight deck or either flight attendant panel. the CAL position applies a load to the sys-
From the flight deck, press the PA MIC tem. The -1 and 0 db LEDs should come From the flight deck, press the PA MIC tem. The -1 and 0 db LEDs should come
Select button on the Adio Selector Panel on. If they do not come on, adjust the Select button on the Adio Selector Panel on. If they do not come on, adjust the
and use a PTT switch to make an MASTER GAIN potentiometer until they and use a PTT switch to make an MASTER GAIN potentiometer until they
announcement. The PA microphone at the do. announcement. The PA microphone at the do.
aft end of the pedestal can also be used, it Note: Return the TEST/NORM/CAL aft end of the pedestal can also be used, it Note: Return the TEST/NORM/CAL
bypasses the ASP. selector to the NORM position to allow bypasses the ASP. selector to the NORM position to allow
PA announcements can be made from the normal functioning of the system. PA announcements can be made from the normal functioning of the system.
flight attendant stations from their respec- flight attendant stations from their respec-
tive PA microphone. When an announce- tive PA microphone. When an announce-
ment is made from a flight attendant ment is made from a flight attendant
station, that set of speakers is muted to station, that set of speakers is muted to
prevent feedback. prevent feedback.
Maintenance Practices Maintenance Practices
Replacements of the cabin speakers is Replacements of the cabin speakers is
accomplished per MM23-31-11 p401. accomplished per MM23-31-11 p401.
Note: When replacing an speaker be sure Note: When replacing an speaker be sure
to attach the wires to the proper terminals. to attach the wires to the proper terminals.

and
OCT 99Systems Introduction 23-33 OCT 99 23-33
UNITED
B737 GENERAL AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
COMMUNICATIONS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE COMMUNICATIONS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

Troubleshooting Other problems can be identified by mak- Troubleshooting Other problems can be identified by mak-
Many reports of intermittent PA ing announcements from other positions Many reports of intermittent PA ing announcements from other positions
announcements can be caused by broken and by swapping microphones. Note: The announcements can be caused by broken and by swapping microphones. Note: The
wires in the microphone cords. This is IFE switch on the forward flight attendant wires in the microphone cords. This is IFE switch on the forward flight attendant
easily identified by shaking the cord while panel does not test the PA system. Refer- easily identified by shaking the cord while panel does not test the PA system. Refer-
making an announcement. ence MM23-31-00 p101 for troubleshoot- making an announcement. ence MM23-31-00 p101 for troubleshoot-
ing procedures. ing procedures.

POOR OR NO AUDIO FROM PA SPEAKERS WHEN PA SYSTEM OPERATIED FROM POOR OR NO AUDIO FROM PA SPEAKERS WHEN PA SYSTEM OPERATIED FROM
ATTENDANTS STATION - Operate PA system using control stand PA mike. IF - ATTENDANTS STATION - Operate PA system using control stand PA mike. IF -

NO AUDIO AVAILABLE - Replace AUDIO AVAILABLE - Replace NO AUDIO AVAILABLE - Replace AUDIO AVAILABLE - Replace
PA amplifier. attendant’s PA mike and test system PA amplifier. attendant’s PA mike and test system
from attendant’s station. IF - from attendant’s station. IF -

NO AUDIO AVAILABLE - Replace PA amplifier. NO AUDIO AVAILABLE - Replace PA amplifier.

POOR OR NO AUDIO FROM PA SPEAKERS WHEN PA SYSTEM OPERATIED FROM POOR OR NO AUDIO FROM PA SPEAKERS WHEN PA SYSTEM OPERATIED FROM
CONTROL STAND PA MIKE - Operate PA system thru audio selector panel. IF - CONTROL STAND PA MIKE - Operate PA system thru audio selector panel. IF -

NO AUDIO AVAILABLE - Replace AUDIO AVAILABLE - Replace NO AUDIO AVAILABLE - Replace AUDIO AVAILABLE - Replace
PA amplifier. control stand PA mike. PA amplifier. control stand PA mike.

POOR OR NO AUDIO FROM PA SPEAKERS WHEN TAPE REPRODUCER IS TURNED POOR OR NO AUDIO FROM PA SPEAKERS WHEN TAPE REPRODUCER IS TURNED
ON - Operate PA system using attendants PA mike. IF - ON - Operate PA system using attendants PA mike. IF -

NO AUDIO AVAILABLE - Replace AUDIO AVAILABLE - Replace NO AUDIO AVAILABLE - Replace AUDIO AVAILABLE - Replace
PA amplifier. tape reproducer. IF - PA amplifier. tape reproducer. IF -

NO MUSIC AVAILABLE - Replace PA amplifier. IF - NO MUSIC AVAILABLE - Replace PA amplifier. IF -

NO MUSIC AVAILABLE - Repair or replace defective wiring. NO MUSIC AVAILABLE - Repair or replace defective wiring.

23-34 and Systems Introduction OCT 99 23-34 OCT 99


UNITED AIRLINES COURSE
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
COMMUNICATIONS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE COMMUNICATIONS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

PASSENGER ENTERTAINMENT controls for volume and channel selection. PASSENGER ENTERTAINMENT controls for volume and channel selection.
The Passenger Entertainment provides PA announcements will automatically The Passenger Entertainment provides PA announcements will automatically
each passenger the capabilities of 12 chan- interrupt the selected program. When the each passenger the capabilities of 12 chan- interrupt the selected program. When the
nels of audio entertainment. The airplanes announcement is completed the entertain- nels of audio entertainment. The airplanes announcement is completed the entertain-
are configured to provide entertainment on ment program will resume. are configured to provide entertainment on ment program will resume.
8 channels. Mono audio is provided on The mono channels are also selectable as 8 channels. Mono audio is provided on The mono channels are also selectable as
channels 6, 7, 8 and 9. Stereo entertain- boarding music. channels 6, 7, 8 and 9. Stereo entertain- boarding music.
ment is provided on channels 2, 3, 4 and 5. The Passenger Entertainment system con- ment is provided on channels 2, 3, 4 and 5. The Passenger Entertainment system con-
The remaining channels are blank. Tape sists of a tape reproducer, a multiplexer, The remaining channels are blank. Tape sists of a tape reproducer, a multiplexer,
audio is only provided on PCU channels 2, Seat Electronics Units (SEU) for each seat audio is only provided on PCU channels 2, Seat Electronics Units (SEU) for each seat
3, 4, 5, and 9. PCU channel 9 audio is group, a Passenger Control Unit (PCU) for 3, 4, 5, and 9. PCU channel 9 audio is group, a Passenger Control Unit (PCU) for
switchable between observer's audio and each seat, two terminator plugs, an IFE switchable between observer's audio and each seat, two terminator plugs, an IFE
tape audio. test switch on the forward flight attendant tape audio. test switch on the forward flight attendant
Each passenger has a connection for a panel and the associated wiring for the Each passenger has a connection for a panel and the associated wiring for the
stethoscope headset, electrical headset and system. stethoscope headset, electrical headset and system.

PA PA
AMPLIFIER AMPLIFIER

MAIN SEAT PASSENGER MAIN SEAT PASSENGER


MULTIPLEXER ELECTRONICS CONTROL MULTIPLEXER ELECTRONICS CONTROL
UNIT UNIT UNIT UNIT

TAPE TAPE
REPRODUCER REPRODUCER

Passenger Entertainment System Passenger Entertainment System

and
OCT 99Systems Introduction 23-35 OCT 99 23-35
UNITED
B737 GENERAL AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
COMMUNICATIONS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE COMMUNICATIONS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

Tape Reproducer in the forward direction and the other two Tape Reproducer in the forward direction and the other two
The entertainment tape reproducer is a tracks play in the reverse direction. The The entertainment tape reproducer is a tracks play in the reverse direction. The
shelf mounted unit on the E2-3 equipment cassettes are self reversing whenever a shelf mounted unit on the E2-3 equipment cassettes are self reversing whenever a
rack in the main equipment center. tape end is reached. Thus each cassette rack in the main equipment center. tape end is reached. Thus each cassette
The tape reproducer uses six C90 cassettes will play two channels of continuous The tape reproducer uses six C90 cassettes will play two channels of continuous
for its programs. The six cassettes are entertainment. Each complete program for its programs. The six cassettes are entertainment. Each complete program
mounted on tape drives on the sides of the will last approximately 90 minutes and mounted on tape drives on the sides of the will last approximately 90 minutes and
reproducer, three on each side. A fold then be repeated. Each mono program reproducer, three on each side. A fold then be repeated. Each mono program
down door on each side of the reproducer plays off of one tape track and each stereo down door on each side of the reproducer plays off of one tape track and each stereo
provides access to the cassettes. Each cas- program from two tape tracks. Thus, each provides access to the cassettes. Each cas- program from two tape tracks. Thus, each
sette has two channels recorded on four cassette can provide two mono programs sette has two channels recorded on four cassette can provide two mono programs
tracks using a special format. Two of the or one stereo program. tracks using a special format. Two of the or one stereo program.
tracks will play when the cassette is driven tracks will play when the cassette is driven

VU METER VU METER

TAPE TAPE
TRANSPORT TRANSPORT
MODULE MODULE
(3 EACH SIDE) (3 EACH SIDE)

HEADSET BITE HEADSET BITE


JACK FUNCTION JACK FUNCTION
TAPE ACCESS DOOR SELECTOR TAPE ACCESS DOOR SELECTOR
(SAME ON OPPOSITE SIDE) (SAME ON OPPOSITE SIDE)

Tape Reproducer
Tape Reproducer

23-36 and Systems Introduction OCT 99 23-36 OCT 99


UNITED AIRLINES COURSE
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
COMMUNICATIONS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE COMMUNICATIONS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

Multiplexer Seat Electronics Unit (SEU) Multiplexer Seat Electronics Unit (SEU)
The main multiplexer is mounted on the A seat electronic unit is fastened to the The main multiplexer is mounted on the A seat electronic unit is fastened to the
E2-3 equipment rack in the main equip- under side of each seat group. Each unit E2-3 equipment rack in the main equip- under side of each seat group. Each unit
ment center next to the tape reproducer. can provide up to 12 audio programs to ment center next to the tape reproducer. can provide up to 12 audio programs to
The main multiplexer formats the music three passenger control units. The seat The main multiplexer formats the music three passenger control units. The seat
channel programs from the tape repro- electronic units are connected in parallel channel programs from the tape repro- electronic units are connected in parallel
ducer to serial digital data for transmission to a coaxial output from the main multi- ducer to serial digital data for transmission to a coaxial output from the main multi-
by coaxial cable. There are two outputs plexer. The last seat group in each series by coaxial cable. There are two outputs plexer. The last seat group in each series
from the multiplexer; one for the right side contains the terminating resistor for multi- from the multiplexer; one for the right side contains the terminating resistor for multi-
passenger seats and the other for the left plexer output. The seat electronics unit passenger seats and the other for the left plexer output. The seat electronics unit
seats. All seat electronic units on each side contains the demultiplexing electronics for seats. All seat electronic units on each side contains the demultiplexing electronics for
are connected in parallel to one of the mul- the passenger entertainment system. The are connected in parallel to one of the mul- the passenger entertainment system. The
tiplexer outputs. Terminations are seat electronics unit has coaxial connec- tiplexer outputs. Terminations are seat electronics unit has coaxial connec-
installed on the output of the last seat elec- tors that provide signal interface with installed on the output of the last seat elec- tors that provide signal interface with
tronic unit on each side. adjacent units. The other connectors inter- tronic unit on each side. adjacent units. The other connectors inter-
face with the passenger control units in the face with the passenger control units in the
seat group. The audio from the multi- seat group. The audio from the multi-
plexer is serial digital and is demulti- plexer is serial digital and is demulti-
plexed to analog audio as selected by the plexed to analog audio as selected by the
passenger control unit for each seat. passenger control unit for each seat.
SEAT Interseat cabling connects each seat elec- SEAT Interseat cabling connects each seat elec-
ELECTRONICS tronics unit to the seats fore and aft, except ELECTRONICS tronics unit to the seats fore and aft, except
BOX BOX
SEB CCT BRKR
CIRCUIT for the last unit which holds the termina- SEB CCT BRKR
CIRCUIT for the last unit which holds the termina-
BREAKERS tion. Seat to seat cables are laid in the BREAKERS tion. Seat to seat cables are laid in the
raceways adjacent to the seat tracks. raceways adjacent to the seat tracks.
LEFT RIGHT LEFT RIGHT

HANDLE HANDLE

NAMEPLATE NAMEPLATE

MOUNTING MOUNTING
LUG LUG

Multiplexer Seat Electronics Unit (SEU) Multiplexer Seat Electronics Unit (SEU)

and
OCT 99Systems Introduction 23-37 OCT 99 23-37
UNITED
B737 GENERAL AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
COMMUNICATIONS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE COMMUNICATIONS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

Terminators Terminators
Terminators erminator plugs are installed Terminators erminator plugs are installed
at the last position of the two rows of seat at the last position of the two rows of seat
electronics units. They contain a 100 electronics units. They contain a 100
ohm, 1/4 watt resistor and must be ohm, 1/4 watt resistor and must be
installed for proper operation of the sys- installed for proper operation of the sys-
tem. tem.

TERM. RESISTOR TERM. RESISTOR

100 OHM 1/4W 100 OHM 1/4W

(SCHEMATIC) (SCHEMATIC)

TERMINATING TERMINATING
RESISTOR RESISTOR

CONNECTOR CONNECTOR

(PICTRORIAL VIEW) (PICTRORIAL VIEW)

Terminator Plug Terminator Plug

23-38 and Systems Introduction OCT 99 23-38 OCT 99


UNITED AIRLINES COURSE
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
COMMUNICATIONS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE COMMUNICATIONS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

Passenger Control Units (PCU) Passenger Control Units (PCU)


Each seat is equipped with a passenger Each seat is equipped with a passenger
control unit (PCU) for each passenger to control unit (PCU) for each passenger to
make the desired channel selection and make the desired channel selection and
adjust volume. Each control unit has a adjust volume. Each control unit has a
connection for a stethoscope or an electri- connection for a stethoscope or an electri-
cal headset, an up and a down volume cal headset, an up and a down volume
adjust, and an up and down channel con- adjust, and an up and down channel con-
trol for up to 12 channels. trol for up to 12 channels.

1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12

CHANNEL CHANNEL
VOLUME VOLUME

Passenger Control Units Passenger Control Units

and
OCT 99Systems Introduction 23-39 OCT 99 23-39
UNITED
B737 GENERAL AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
COMMUNICATIONS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE COMMUNICATIONS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

Interfaces Note: On airplanes with an observer's Interfaces Note: On airplanes with an observer's
The Passenger Entertainment system oxygen mask containing a microphone, The Passenger Entertainment system oxygen mask containing a microphone,
interfaces with the Passenger Address flight deck conversation will be heard interfaces with the Passenger Address flight deck conversation will be heard
(PA) system. on channel 9, if the OBS AUDIO (PA) system. on channel 9, if the OBS AUDIO
Operation ENTMT switch is ON and the MASK/ Operation ENTMT switch is ON and the MASK/
The only operator control is the In Flight BOOM switch on the Observer's audio The only operator control is the In Flight BOOM switch on the Observer's audio
Entertainment (IFE) switch on the forward selector panel is in the MASK position. Entertainment (IFE) switch on the forward selector panel is in the MASK position.
attendant panel to provide the ON, OFF, This occurs even when all volume con- attendant panel to provide the ON, OFF, This occurs even when all volume con-
or TEST mode of operation. The boarding trols on the observer's audio selector or TEST mode of operation. The boarding trols on the observer's audio selector
MUSIC program selector is also on the panel are turned down. MUSIC program selector is also on the panel are turned down.
forward attendant panel. The four selec- Testing forward attendant panel. The four selec- Testing
tions for boarding music are the four The IFE switch on the forward flight tions for boarding music are the four mono The IFE switch on the forward flight
mono entertainment programs. attendant panel in the TEST position will entertainment programs. attendant panel in the TEST position will
The entertainment tape reproducer can be produce a 400 Hz tone at each headset The entertainment tape reproducer can be produce a 400 Hz tone at each headset
powered by placing either the MUSIC connection and illuminate the channel 12 powered by placing either the MUSIC connection and illuminate the channel 12
control or the IFE switch on the forward indicator or dashes at each passenger con- control or the IFE switch on the forward indicator or dashes at each passenger con-
attendant panel to ON. The music control trol unit to validate the test. The test attendant panel to ON. The music control trol unit to validate the test. The test
operates R365 and the IFE switch R364 switch position is spring loaded to ON. operates R365 and the IFE switch R364 on switch position is spring loaded to ON.
on the E2-3 rack. R364 also powers the On 737-500s, the IFE TEST switch will the E2-3 rack. R364 also powers the mul- On 737-500s, the IFE TEST switch will
multiplexer which is not required for make the PCU TEST LED come on. tiplexer which is not required for boarding make the PCU TEST LED come on.
boarding music. Adjustments and testing of the systems music. Adjustments and testing of the systems
A switch on the aft overhead panel (OBS should be done per MM23-34-00 p501. A switch on the aft overhead panel (OBS should be done per MM23-34-00 p501.
AUDIO ENTMT) allows passengers to Troubleshooting AUDIO ENTMT) allows passengers to Troubleshooting
listen to the Observers audio system. Troubleshooting should be accomplished listen to the Observers audio system. Troubleshooting should be accomplished
Anything heard on the Observer's audio is per MM23-34-00 p101. Many problems Anything heard on the Observer's audio is per MM23-34-00 p101. Many problems
sent to the passenger entertainment system of the passenger entertainment system are sent to the passenger entertainment system of the passenger entertainment system are
when the OBS AUDIO ENTMT switch is due to SEU connectors and terminators when the OBS AUDIO ENTMT switch is due to SEU connectors and terminators
turned ON. When this switch is turned being kicked loose. Half-splitting may be turned ON. When this switch is turned being kicked loose. Half-splitting may be
ON, the crew normally leaves the used to isolate the cause of the problem. ON, the crew normally leaves the used to isolate the cause of the problem.
Observer's Audio Selector Panel MIC Note: The flight attendant panel IFE Observer's Audio Selector Panel MIC Note: The flight attendant panel IFE
selector in the F-INPH position, and raise switch must be out of the TEST position selector in the F-INPH position, and raise switch must be out of the TEST position
the VHF-1 volume lever. To hear this for the system to operate normally. the VHF-1 volume lever. To hear this for the system to operate normally.
audio, passengers must select channel 9 audio, passengers must select channel 9 on
on their seat control unit their seat control unit

23-40 and Systems Introduction OCT 99 23-40 OCT 99


UNITED AIRLINES COURSE
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
COMMUNICATIONS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE COMMUNICATIONS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

VHF COMMUNICATION SYSTEM control panels on the P8 panel provide the VHF COMMUNICATION SYSTEM control panels on the P8 panel provide the
The VHF (Very High Frequency) Com- controls for frequency selection. VHF No. The VHF (Very High Frequency) Com- controls for frequency selection. VHF No.
munication system provides short-range 3 transceiver interfaces with and is dedi- munication system provides short-range 3 transceiver interfaces with and is dedi-
(radio line-of-sight) two-way voice and cated to ACARS (ARINC Communica- (radio line-of-sight) two-way voice and cated to ACARS (ARINC Communica-
data communication in the frequency tions Addressing and Reporting System). data communication in the frequency tions Addressing and Reporting System).
range of 118.000 through 136.975 MHz. Each VHF system interfaces with the range of 118.000 through 136.975 MHz. Each VHF system interfaces with the
The VHF communication system (referred SELCAL (selective calling) system on The VHF communication system (referred SELCAL (selective calling) system on
to as the VHF Comm system) receives overwater aircraft. The VHF system uses to as the VHF Comm system) receives overwater aircraft. The VHF system uses
VHF radio signals, processes them, and 28-volt power obtained from circuit break- VHF radio signals, processes them, and 28-volt power obtained from circuit break-
sends the resulting audio to the Remote ers on load control centers P18 and P6. sends the resulting audio to the Remote ers on load control centers P18 and P6.
Electronics Unit (REU). During transmis- VHF No. 1 system power is obtained from Electronics Unit (REU). During transmis- VHF No. 1 system power is obtained from
sion, microphone audio from the REU is the hot battery bus on load control center sion, microphone audio from the REU is the hot battery bus on load control center
processed and transmitted by the VHF P18. VHF No. 2 system power is obtained processed and transmitted by the VHF P18. VHF No. 2 system power is obtained
system. There are three VHF systems from switched electronics bus No. 2 on system. There are three VHF systems from switched electronics bus No. 2 on
installed in the airplane. The communica- load control center P6. VHF No. 3 system installed in the airplane. The communica- load control center P6. VHF No. 3 system
tion (comm) equipment for each VHF sys- power is obtained from bus No. 1 on load tion (comm) equipment for each VHF sys- power is obtained from bus No. 1 on load
tem includes a VHF transceiver, a VHF control center P18. tem includes a VHF transceiver, a VHF control center P18.
control panel, and a VHF antenna. VHF control panel, and a VHF antenna. VHF

VHF ANTENNA VHF ANTENNA

AUDIO OUT TO AUDIO OUT TO


FLIGHT DECK FLIGHT DECK

VHF COMM VHF COMM


TRANSCEIVER TRANSCEIVER
REMOTE REMOTE
ELECTRONICS ELECTRONICS
UNIT UNIT

VHF COMM MICROPHONE VHF COMM MICROPHONE


CONTROL INPUT FROM CONTROL INPUT FROM
PANEL FLIGHT DECK PANEL FLIGHT DECK

VHF Communication System VHF Communication System

and
OCT 99Systems Introduction 23-41 OCT 99 23-41
UNITED
B737 GENERAL AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
COMMUNICATIONS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE COMMUNICATIONS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

Frequency Selection Receive Frequency Selection Receive


The frequency selection data originates in When the VHF transceiver is not keyed, The frequency selection data originates in When the VHF transceiver is not keyed,
the VHF control panel, formatted into an the output from the frequency synthesizer the VHF control panel, formatted into an the output from the frequency synthesizer
ARINC 429 word and transmitted to the is connected to the receiver mixer and the ARINC 429 word and transmitted to the is connected to the receiver mixer and the
VHF transceiver over an ARINC 429 data VHF antenna is connected to the receiver VHF transceiver over an ARINC 429 data VHF antenna is connected to the receiver
bus. input. With no signal input, the receiver bus. input. With no signal input, the receiver
Transmit noise output from the detector is filtered Transmit noise output from the detector is filtered
Transmission is initiated by grounding the and compared to a squelch threshold volt- Transmission is initiated by grounding the and compared to a squelch threshold volt-
PTT line in the voice mode. This acti- age in the squelch comparator. The com- PTT line in the voice mode. This activates age in the squelch comparator. The com-
vates the antenna switch and switches the parator output turns off the voice audio the antenna switch and switches the fre- parator output turns off the voice audio
frequency synthesizer output to the trans- output to the flight interphone system. quency synthesizer output to the transmit- output to the flight interphone system.
mitter section. The frequency synthesizer When a signal is received, it is amplified ter section. The frequency synthesizer When a signal is received, it is amplified
output is amplitude modulated by audio in the rf section and fed to the first mixer. output is amplitude modulated by audio in the rf section and fed to the first mixer.
from the interphone system and amplified from the interphone system and amplified
for transmission. The forward power out- for transmission. The forward power out-
put is sampled to generate a feed-back sig- put is sampled to generate a feed-back sig-
nal to generate sidetone audio for the nal to generate sidetone audio for the
voice audio output. The rf output is then voice audio output. The rf output is then
routed through the antenna switch to the routed through the antenna switch to the
VHF antenna. VHF antenna.
The PTT signal is also routed out of the The PTT signal is also routed out of the
VHF transceiver as a key event signal. VHF transceiver as a key event signal.
This is used by the Digital Flight Data This is used by the Digital Flight Data
Recorder system to record the times dur- Recorder system to record the times dur-
ing which the VHF transceiver is keyed. ing which the VHF transceiver is keyed.

23-42 and Systems Introduction OCT 99 23-42 OCT 99


UNITED AIRLINES COURSE
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
COMMUNICATIONS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE COMMUNICATIONS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

VHF Control Panel VHF Control Panel


The VHF Control Panel provides fre- The VHF Control Panel provides fre-
quency selection and frequency transfer of quency selection and frequency transfer of
the associated VHF transceiver. The two the associated VHF transceiver. The two
VHF control panels are located on P8 ped- VHF control panels are located on P8 ped-
estal, the left panel is for the No. 1 VHF estal, the left panel is for the No. 1 VHF
Comm system and the right is for the No. Comm system and the right is for the No.
2 system. The VHF control panel pro- 2 system. The VHF control panel pro-
vides frequency selection and frequency vides frequency selection and frequency
indication. Each VHF control panel con- indication. Each VHF control panel con-
tains a dual set of frequency select knobs, tains a dual set of frequency select knobs,
two LCD frequency displays, two fre- two LCD frequency displays, two fre-
quency-in-use lights, and a transfer (TFR) quency-in-use lights, and a transfer (TFR)
switch. Each set of two concentric knobs switch. Each set of two concentric knobs
are used to select a desired frequency. are used to select a desired frequency.
The outer knob selects ones, tens, and The outer knob selects ones, tens, and
hundreds units; the inner knob selects hundreds units; the inner knob selects
tenths and hundredths units. The TFR tenths and hundredths units. The TFR
switch allows selection of either displayed switch allows selection of either displayed
frequency. When set, the selected fre- frequency. When set, the selected fre-
quency display is illuminated and the fre- quency display is illuminated and the fre-
quency-in-use light above the display quency-in-use light above the display
comes on. comes on.

TFR TFR

V C V C
H FREQ SEL O H FREQ SEL O
F M F M
M M

COMM Tuning Panel COMM Tuning Panel

and
OCT 99Systems Introduction 23-43 OCT 99 23-43
UNITED
B737 GENERAL AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
COMMUNICATIONS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE COMMUNICATIONS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

VHF Transceiver The PHONE and MlC jack allow a head- VHF Transceiver The PHONE and MlC jack allow a head-
The VHF Comm Transceiver generates, phone and microphone to be connected The VHF Comm Transceiver generates, phone and microphone to be connected
transmits, receives, and demodulates rf directly to the VHF transceiver. The transmits, receives, and demodulates rf directly to the VHF transceiver. The
signals for voice and data transmission. TEST switch enables a self-test of the crit- signals for voice and data transmission. TEST switch enables a self-test of the crit-
The VHF transceivers are located on the ical circuits in the VHF system. The SQL/ The VHF transceivers are located on the ical circuits in the VHF system. The SQL/
E2-1 rack. The solid state VHF trans- LAMP TEST switch disables the squelch E2-1 rack. The solid state VHF trans- LAMP TEST switch disables the squelch
ceiver provides two-way voice and data circuits and tests the front panel LEDS. ceiver provides two-way voice and data circuits and tests the front panel LEDS.
communications in the 118.000-through The two status LEDs indicate LRU PASS communications in the 118.000-through The two status LEDs indicate LRU PASS
136.975-MHz frequency range. and frequency CONTROL INPUT FAIL. 136.975-MHz frequency range. and frequency CONTROL INPUT FAIL.
The front panel of the VHF transceiver The RFL (reflected)/FWD (forward)/OFF The front panel of the VHF transceiver The RFL (reflected)/FWD (forward)/OFF
contains a PHONE and MIC jack, a TEST (normal) switch checks rf power to the contains a PHONE and MIC jack, a TEST (normal) switch checks rf power to the
switch, a SQL/LAMP TEST switch, two VHF antennas and displays the result in switch, a SQL/LAMP TEST switch, two VHF antennas and displays the result in
status LEDS, a three position (RFL/FWD/ watts on the two-digit display. status LEDS, a three position (RFL/FWD/ watts on the two-digit display.
OFF) switch, and a two-digit digital dis- OFF) switch, and a two-digit digital dis-
play. play.

SOL/LAMP SOL/LAMP
TEST OFF TEST OFF

RFL FWD RFL FWD

CONTROL LRU CONTROL LRU


INPUT PASS INPUT PASS
FAIL FAIL
PHONE MIC PHONE MIC

TEST TEST
VHF-700 VHF-700

VHF Transceiver VHF Transceiver

23-44 and Systems Introduction OCT 99 23-44 OCT 99


UNITED AIRLINES COURSE
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
COMMUNICATIONS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE COMMUNICATIONS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

VHF Antenna VHF Antenna


The VHF antenna is a blade-type antenna The VHF antenna is a blade-type antenna
with an omnidirectional radiation pattern. with an omnidirectional radiation pattern.
The purpose of the VHF antenna is to The purpose of the VHF antenna is to
transmit and receive radio signals in the transmit and receive radio signals in the
VHF frequency range. Each VHF antenna VHF frequency range. Each VHF antenna
is impedance-matched to the coaxial trans- is impedance-matched to the coaxial trans-
mission line. A coaxial cable connector on mission line. A coaxial cable connector on
the VHF antenna provides interconnection the VHF antenna provides interconnection
between the VHF antenna and VHF trans- between the VHF antenna and VHF trans-
ceiver. ceiver.

VHF Antenna VHF Antenna

and
OCT 99Systems Introduction 23-45 OCT 99 23-45
UNITED
B737 GENERAL AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
COMMUNICATIONS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE COMMUNICATIONS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

Interfaces the system will return to the receive condi- Interfaces the system will return to the receive condi-
The VHF Communication system inter- tion. The VHF Communication system inter- tion.
faces with the ACARS, Flight Data Maintenance Practices faces with the ACARS, Flight Data Maintenance Practices
Recorder, Voice Recorder, and SELCAL The VHF Comm antenna should be Recorder, Voice Recorder, and SELCAL The VHF Comm antenna should be
systems on overwater aircraft. installed per MM23-21-11 p401. Sealant systems on overwater aircraft. installed per MM23-21-11 p401. Sealant
Operation should not be used between the antenna Operation should not be used between the antenna
VHF No. 1 and 2 systems are identical for base and aircraft structure. It should be VHF No. 1 and 2 systems are identical for base and aircraft structure. It should be
voice communication. The VHF No. 3 applied after the mounting screws. Note: voice communication. The VHF No. 3 applied after the mounting screws. Note:
system is dedicated to ACARS and is nor- Do not let the connector fall when replac- system is dedicated to ACARS and is nor- Do not let the connector fall when replac-
mally used for data transmission and ing the No. 1 antenna on top of the fuse- mally used for data transmission and ing the No. 1 antenna on top of the fuse-
reception. Receiving and transmitting are lage. reception. Receiving and transmitting are lage.
completed on the same frequency. Self-Test completed on the same frequency. Self-Test
Note: Always monitor a frequency The VHF transceiver has a built in self test Note: Always monitor a frequency The VHF transceiver has a built in self test
before attempting to transmit to avoid system that is initiated by push-to-test before attempting to transmit to avoid system that is initiated by push-to-test
interference with communications switches in the front panel of the VHF interference with communications switches in the front panel of the VHF
already in progress. transceiver. already in progress. transceiver.
Note: Two frequencies can be set in the The SQL/LAMP TEST switch is used to Note: Two frequencies can be set in the The SQL/LAMP TEST switch is used to
control panel, but only the one selected disable transceiver squelch, and to check control panel, but only the one selected disable transceiver squelch, and to check
by the TFR switch is the active one. the front panel lights prior to system self- by the TFR switch is the active one. the front panel lights prior to system self-
To receive, adjust the volume control on testing. To receive, adjust the volume control on testing.
the audio selector panel to obtain a com- The red CONTROL INPUT FAIL and the audio selector panel to obtain a com- The red CONTROL INPUT FAIL and
fortable listening level and select the green LRU PASS lights come on when the fortable listening level and select the green LRU PASS lights come on when the
appropriate frequency on the Comm Tun- SQL/LAMP TEST switch is pushed. appropriate frequency on the Comm Tun- SQL/LAMP TEST switch is pushed.
ing Panel To transmit over the VHF sys- The TEST switch is used to initiate the ing Panel To transmit over the VHF sys- The TEST switch is used to initiate the
tems, the mic selector switch on the audio CONTROL INPUT FAIL and LRU PASS tems, the mic selector switch on the audio CONTROL INPUT FAIL and LRU PASS
selector panel must be pressed in for the tests. The CONTROL INPUT FAIL test selector panel must be pressed in for the tests. The CONTROL INPUT FAIL test
desired VHF system. Pressing the micro- checks that the VHF transceiver is receiv- desired VHF system. Pressing the micro- checks that the VHF transceiver is receiv-
phone PTT (push-to-talk) button of the ing valid frequency tuning data from the phone PTT (push-to-talk) button of the ing valid frequency tuning data from the
fight interphone system will operate con- VHF control panel. If the tuning data is fight interphone system will operate con- VHF control panel. If the tuning data is
trol circuits in the VHF transceiver which not valid, the red CONTROL INPUT trol circuits in the VHF transceiver which not valid, the red CONTROL INPUT
disconnect the receiver circuits and con- FAIL light comes on indicating a VHF disconnect the receiver circuits and con- FAIL light comes on indicating a VHF
nect the transmitter circuits to the VHF Control panel failure. The light remains nect the transmitter circuits to the VHF Control panel failure. The light remains
antenna. Amplitude modulated transmis- on for about four seconds after TEST antenna. Amplitude modulated transmis- on for about four seconds after TEST
sion will begin when audio signals are switch is pressed. sion will begin when audio signals are switch is pressed.
present on the microphone circuits. The LRU PASS test identifies a failure on present on the microphone circuits. The LRU PASS test identifies a failure on
Sidetone is rectified from the modulated rf the VHF transceiver. After pressing the Sidetone is rectified from the modulated rf the VHF transceiver. After pressing the
to the VHF antenna and returned to the TEST switch, the green LRU PASS to the VHF antenna and returned to the TEST switch, the green LRU PASS
headphones of the flight interphone sys- should light for approximately one to four headphones of the flight interphone sys- should light for approximately one to four
tem to indicate proper operation of the seconds. At the same time, the digital dis- tem to indicate proper operation of the seconds. At the same time, the digital dis-
transmitter. The audio selector panel vol- play should show a value of less than 2.1. transmitter. The audio selector panel vol- play should show a value of less than 2.1.
ume control may be used to adjust the This value is the voltage standing wave ume control may be used to adjust the This value is the voltage standing wave
sidetone audio to a comfortable listening ratio (VSWR). After the CONTROL sidetone audio to a comfortable listening ratio (VSWR). After the CONTROL
level. When the PTT button is released, INPUT FAIL/LRU PASS tests are com- level. When the PTT button is released, INPUT FAIL/LRU PASS tests are com-

23-46 and Systems Introduction OCT 99 23-46 OCT 99


UNITED AIRLINES COURSE
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
COMMUNICATIONS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE COMMUNICATIONS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

pleted, turning the power test switch to the flight interphone system operates cor- pleted, turning the power test switch to the flight interphone system operates cor-
FWD or RFL displays the forward or rectly. A problem with the VHF system FWD or RFL displays the forward or rectly. A problem with the VHF system
reflected power values on the digital. dis- can be a result of a defective component in reflected power values on the digital. dis- can be a result of a defective component in
play. The FWD position should display a an Audio Selector Panel. Some checks to play. The FWD position should display a an Audio Selector Panel. Some checks to
minimum value of 25. The RFL position make before you change components in minimum value of 25. The RFL position make before you change components in
should display 11 percent or less of the the VHF system are: A loose coaxial con- should display 11 percent or less of the the VHF system are: A loose coaxial con-
forward power value. nector will cause intermittent operation forward power value. nector will cause intermittent operation
Follow the procedures of MM23-21-01 and noise in the system. Make sure all Follow the procedures of MM23-21-01 and noise in the system. Make sure all
p501 to perform adjustments or tests of the connectors are tight. p501 to perform adjustments or tests of the connectors are tight.
VHF Comm system. Frequency Check VHF Comm system. Frequency Check
Troubleshooting Set the frequency several times from Troubleshooting Set the frequency several times from
For troubleshooting the VHF Comm sys- above and below the problem frequency. For troubleshooting the VHF Comm sys- above and below the problem frequency.
tem, reference MM23-21-01 p101. Each Wafer switch contacts in the VHF control tem, reference MM23-21-01 p101. Each Wafer switch contacts in the VHF control
VHF Comm system uses a different power panel are possibly bent. Compare the VHF Comm system uses a different power panel are possibly bent. Compare the
source. operation of the problem VHF system source. operation of the problem VHF system
Sometimes large metal structures or with the operation of another VHF system Sometimes large metal structures or with the operation of another VHF system
ground equipment near the antennas in the airplane. ground equipment near the antennas in the airplane.
affects the reception and transmission of Transmit Check affects the reception and transmission of Transmit Check
the VHF Comm system. You can use The transmitter sidetone is demodulated the VHF Comm system. You can use The transmitter sidetone is demodulated
equivalent components from a different RF output. If the sidetone is good, the equivalent components from a different RF output. If the sidetone is good, the
VHF system to perform trouble-shooting transmitter modulated output is usually VHF system to perform trouble-shooting transmitter modulated output is usually
of the defective VHF system. also good. Do this procedure to do a of the defective VHF system. also good. Do this procedure to do a
Change the possibly defective component check of the frequency when the VHF sys- Change the possibly defective component check of the frequency when the VHF sys-
with the equivalent component from a dif- tem transmits: transmit the frequency on with the equivalent component from a dif- tem transmits: transmit the frequency on
ferent VHF system. If the system operates one VHF system while you receive the ferent VHF system. If the system operates one VHF system while you receive the
correctly after the component is changed, same frequency on a different VHF sys- correctly after the component is changed, same frequency on a different VHF sys-
you have found the defective component. tem. you have found the defective component. tem.
If a VHF system does not operate, make Receive Check If a VHF system does not operate, make Receive Check
sure the proper voltages are available to Do this procedure to do a check of the fre- sure the proper voltages are available to Do this procedure to do a check of the fre-
the system. Make sure all VHF circuit quency and operation when the VHF sys- the system. Make sure all VHF circuit quency and operation when the VHF sys-
breakers on load control centers P6 and tem receives: listen to the received voice breakers on load control centers P6 and tem receives: listen to the received voice
P18 are closed (pushed in). Make sure the from ground stations, other airplanes, or P18 are closed (pushed in). Make sure the from ground stations, other airplanes, or
power is supplied. from a different VHF system. For VHF-3, power is supplied. from a different VHF system. For VHF-3,
To prevent troubleshooting that is not nec- use the ACARS interactive display unit to To prevent troubleshooting that is not nec- use the ACARS interactive display unit to
essary, make sure the specified problem transmit and receive. essary, make sure the specified problem transmit and receive.
continues to occur. If the flight report continues to occur. If the flight report
says that a VHF system does not operate says that a VHF system does not operate
on one or two specific frequencies, try to on one or two specific frequencies, try to
operate the VHF system at those frequen- operate the VHF system at those frequen-
cies. Airplane location or other conditions cies. Airplane location or other conditions
in the area at the time possibly caused the in the area at the time possibly caused the
problem to occur. Make sure the problem problem to occur. Make sure the problem
occurs at your location. Also make sure occurs at your location. Also make sure

and
OCT 99Systems Introduction 23-47 OCT 99 23-47
UNITED
B737 GENERAL AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
COMMUNICATIONS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE COMMUNICATIONS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

THE TRANSMITTED AND RECEIVED THE TRANSMITTED OR RECEIVED THE TRANSMITTED AND RECEIVED THE TRANSMITTED OR RECEIVED
VOICE IS UNSATIFACTORY ON VOICE IS UNSATIFACTORY ON VOICE IS UNSATIFACTORY ON VOICE IS UNSATIFACTORY ON
VHF-1 - Operate the VHF-2 system from VHF-2 OR VHF-3 - Do troubleshooting VHF-1 - Operate the VHF-2 system from VHF-2 OR VHF-3 - Do troubleshooting
the same audio selector panel that you equivalent to VHF-1. the same audio selector panel that you equivalent to VHF-1.
used for VHF-1. IF -- used for VHF-1. IF --

THE VHF-2 TRANSMITTED AND VHF-2 IS OK - Remove the VHF-1 and THE VHF-2 TRANSMITTED AND VHF-2 IS OK - Remove the VHF-1 and
RECEIVED VOICE IS UNSATIFAC- VHF-2 transceivers. Install the VHF-2 RECEIVED VOICE IS UNSATIFAC- VHF-2 transceivers. Install the VHF-2
TORY - Do troubleshooting of the key transceiver for the VHF-1 system. IF -- TORY - Do troubleshooting of the key transceiver for the VHF-1 system. IF --
and audio circuits of the flight interphone and audio circuits of the flight interphone
system. system.

THE TRANSMITTED AND RECEIVED THE TRANSMITTED OR RECEIVED THE TRANSMITTED AND RECEIVED THE TRANSMITTED OR RECEIVED
VOICE IS OK - Replace the defective VOICE IS UNSATIFACTORY - VOICE IS OK - Replace the defective VOICE IS UNSATIFACTORY -
VHF transceiver. Remove the VHF-2 control panels. VHF transceiver. Remove the VHF-2 control panels.
Install the VHF-2 control panel for the Install the VHF-2 control panel for the
VHF-1 system. Open the VHF-1 circuit VHF-1 system. Open the VHF-1 circuit
breaker. Then close the VHF-1 circuit breaker. Then close the VHF-1 circuit
breaker. IF -- breaker. IF --

THE TRANSMITTED AND RECEIVED THE TRANSMITTED AND RECEIVED THE TRANSMITTED AND RECEIVED THE TRANSMITTED AND RECEIVED
VOICE IS OK - Replace the defective VOICE IS UNSATISFACTORY - Do a VOICE IS OK - Replace the defective VOICE IS UNSATISFACTORY - Do a
VHF control panel. check of the cozxial cable for continuity VHF control panel. check of the cozxial cable for continuity
between the VHF-1 transceiver and the between the VHF-1 transceiver and the
VHF-1 antenna. IF -- VHF-1 antenna. IF --

THE CONTINUITY IS OK - Replace THE CONTINUITY IS UNSATISFAC- THE CONTINUITY IS OK - Replace THE CONTINUITY IS UNSATISFAC-
the defective VHF antenna. TORY - Repair or replace the coaxial the defective VHF antenna. TORY - Repair or replace the coaxial
cable. cable.

23-48 and Systems Introduction OCT 99 23-48 OCT 99


UNITED AIRLINES COURSE
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
COMMUNICATIONS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE COMMUNICATIONS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

AIRCRAFT COMMUNICATIONS AIRCRAFT COMMUNICATIONS


ADDRESSING AND REPORTING ADDRESSING AND REPORTING
SYSTEM (ACARS) SYSTEM (ACARS)
The Aircraft Communications Addressing The Aircraft Communications Addressing
and Reporting System (ACARS) transmits and Reporting System (ACARS) transmits
and receives digital messages in conjunc- and receives digital messages in conjunc-
tion with a ground station. Messages are tion with a ground station. Messages are
received and transmitted via the No. 3 received and transmitted via the No. 3
VHF Communication system. By auto- VHF Communication system. By auto-
matically transmitting such data as depar- matically transmitting such data as depar-
ture station, destination, estimated time of ture station, destination, estimated time of
arrival, crew payroll numbers, material arrival, crew payroll numbers, material
requests, fuel, engine data and flight num- requests, fuel, engine data and flight num-
ber, the crew workload is lessened. ber, the crew workload is lessened.
ACARS consists of a management unit ACARS consists of a management unit
(MU) and an interactive display unit (MU) and an interactive display unit
(IDU). (IDU).

ACARS ACARS
Interactive Interactive
Display Display
Unit Unit
VHF-3 VHF-3
COMM COMM
Transceiver Transceiver

ACARS ACARS
Management Management
Unit ACARS Unit ACARS
Printer Printer

Aircraft Systems Aircraft Systems

ACARS System ACARS System

and
OCT 99Systems Introduction 23-49 OCT 99 23-49
UNITED
B737 GENERAL AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
COMMUNICATIONS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE COMMUNICATIONS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

The system consists of a Management The No. 3 VHF COMM radio is dedicated The system consists of a Management The No. 3 VHF COMM radio is dedicated
Unit (MU), an interactive display unit to ACARS, and is used to transmit air-to- Unit (MU), an interactive display unit to ACARS, and is used to transmit air-to-
(IDU) a digital flight data acquisition unit ground (down link), and receive ground- (IDU) a digital flight data acquisition unit ground (down link), and receive ground-
(DFDAU), and the No. 3 VHF COMM to-air (uplink) digital messages. (DFDAU), and the No. 3 VHF COMM to-air (uplink) digital messages.
radio. ACARS transmits selected company radio. ACARS transmits selected company
The MU performs data processing and reports, system and flight data at high The MU performs data processing and reports, system and flight data at high
message management functions and con- speed using a discrete VHF frequency. message management functions and con- speed using a discrete VHF frequency.
tains the system memory, a UTC clock ACARS transmission occurs: tains the system memory, a UTC clock ACARS transmission occurs:
and transmission logic. -automatically for OUT, OFF, ON and and transmission logic. -automatically for OUT, OFF, ON and
The IDU provides for crew input and con- IN reports. The IDU provides for crew input and con- IN reports.
trol of ACARS, and consists of a touch -when SEND is selected. trol of ACARS, and consists of a touch -when SEND is selected.
sensitive screen. IDU display functions -during a link test. sensitive screen. IDU display functions -during a link test.
include system status annunciation, -when ENT is selected for certain include system status annunciation, -when ENT is selected for certain
uplinked messages, and display pages. reports. uplinked messages, and display pages. reports.
The DFDAU automatically gathers The DFDAU automatically gathers
selected information relating to flight selected information relating to flight
parameters and airplane system operation parameters and airplane system operation
for downlink transmission via ACARS. for downlink transmission via ACARS.

M A I N M E N U P G 1 / 2 M A I N M E N U P G 1 / 2

> P R E - F L I G H T > P R E - F L I G H T
> T I M E D I S P L A Y > T I M E D I S P L A Y
> 0 0 0 1 T I M E S > 0 0 0 1 T I M E S
> E N R O U T E > E N R O U T E
> E N G I N E R E P O R T > E N G I N E R E P O R T
> P O S I T I O N R E P O R T > P O S I T I O N R E P O R T
> C O M P A N Y C O M M > C O M P A N Y C O M M
> W E A T H E R R E Q U E S T > W E A T H E R R E Q U E S T

/ / / / V O X / / / / V O X

IDU IDU

23-50 and Systems Introduction OCT 99 23-50 OCT 99


UNITED AIRLINES COURSE
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
COMMUNICATIONS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE COMMUNICATIONS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

Whenever a message is received by either The IN time reported is the last time the Whenever a message is received by either The IN time reported is the last time the
ACARS or a ground station, a reply is sent parking brake is set, prior to opening any ACARS or a ground station, a reply is sent parking brake is set, prior to opening any
to acknowledge that the message was cabin entry or service door. If any cabin to acknowledge that the message was cabin entry or service door. If any cabin
received. Any message not acknowledged entry or service door is opened before the received. Any message not acknowledged entry or service door is opened before the
by a ground station remains in the ACARS parking brake is set, a letter replaces the by a ground station remains in the ACARS parking brake is set, a letter replaces the
memory and is sent again with the next first digit of the IN time, and ARINC may memory and is sent again with the next first digit of the IN time, and ARINC may
transmission. request verification of the IN time by transmission. request verification of the IN time by
Some items are always transmitted auto- voice. Transmission of the IN report is Some items are always transmitted auto- voice. Transmission of the IN report is
matically, but only after certain entries are delayed up to two minutes to allow entry matically, but only after certain entries are delayed up to two minutes to allow entry
made on the initialization page of of the fuel on board and pilot landing. If made on the initialization page of of the fuel on board and pilot landing. If
ACARS. The minimum requirement for the entries are not made during this two ACARS. The minimum requirement for the entries are not made during this two
automatic transmission is entry of the des- minute period, the IN report is transmitted automatic transmission is entry of the des- minute period, the IN report is transmitted
tination station. The airplane number is without this information. After the IN tination station. The airplane number is without this information. After the IN
programmed into the management unit report is transmitted, the previously programmed into the management unit report is transmitted, the previously
wiring programming pins at the MU bench entered destination station automatically wiring programming pins at the MU bench entered destination station automatically
plug. Time comes from the UTC clock becomes new the departure station. Until plug. Time comes from the UTC clock becomes new the departure station. Until
which is synchronized with ARINC time a new destination station is entered, which is synchronized with ARINC time a new destination station is entered,
during a link test, or when the CLK ACARS cannot record or transmit auto- during a link test, or when the CLK ACARS cannot record or transmit auto-
UPDATE prompt on the UTC TIME page matic reports. UPDATE prompt on the UTC TIME page matic reports.
is pushed. OUT, OFF, ON and IN reports If an OFF or IN time has not been trans- is pushed. OUT, OFF, ON and IN reports If an OFF or IN time has not been trans-
are automatically transmitted using signals mitted by ACARS within 15 minutes of are automatically transmitted using signals mitted by ACARS within 15 minutes of
from landing gear air/ground sensing, the the transmission of an OUT time, a from landing gear air/ground sensing, the the transmission of an OUT time, a
parking brake, and cabin doors. The OUT DELAY advisory is displayed on the CU parking brake, and cabin doors. The OUT DELAY advisory is displayed on the CU
time sent is the time of first parking brake to prompt the crew to send a departure time sent is the time of first parking brake to prompt the crew to send a departure
release, after all cabin entry and service ground delay report. release, after all cabin entry and service ground delay report.
doors are closed. If the parking brake is Interactive Display doors are closed. If the parking brake is Interactive Display
released before all cabin entry and service Unit The IDU uses an infrared LED released before all cabin entry and service Unit The IDU uses an infrared LED
doors, a letter replaces the first digit of the matrix to detect touches on the screen. doors, a letter replaces the first digit of the matrix to detect touches on the screen.
OUT time, and ARINC may request veri- There are no hard keys on the IDU. Dis- OUT time, and ARINC may request veri- There are no hard keys on the IDU. Dis-
fication of the OUT time by voice. play pages and keyboards are shown on fication of the OUT time by voice. play pages and keyboards are shown on
If fuel on board and boarded fuel have not the IDU. Menu pages act as an index to If fuel on board and boarded fuel have not the IDU. Menu pages act as an index to
been entered, the OUT report is delayed function pages or other menu pages. been entered, the OUT report is delayed function pages or other menu pages.
up to two minutes to allow fuel entries. If When a area is touched on the IDU, the up to two minutes to allow fuel entries. If When a area is touched on the IDU, the
the fuel entries are not made during the selection will highlight in reverse video. the fuel entries are not made during the selection will highlight in reverse video.
two minute period, the OUT report is Moving the finger to another area without two minute period, the OUT report is Moving the finger to another area without
transmitted without this information. breaking contact with the screen will transmitted without this information. breaking contact with the screen will
Entry of fuel information at a later time is return the first selection touched back to Entry of fuel information at a later time is return the first selection touched back to
not possible. normal and will then highlight the new not possible. normal and will then highlight the new
The OFF time is sensed by air/ground selection being touched. Releasing the The OFF time is sensed by air/ground selection being touched. Releasing the
relays, recorded at liftoff, and transmitted selectionwhen it is highlighted, activates relays, recorded at liftoff, and transmitted selectionwhen it is highlighted, activates
shortly thereafter. The ON time is sensed the selection. shortly thereafter. The ON time is sensed the selection.
by air/ground relays, recorded at touch- by air/ground relays, recorded at touch-
down, and transmitted shortly thereafter. down, and transmitted shortly thereafter.

and
OCT 99Systems Introduction 23-51 OCT 99 23-51
UNITED
B737 GENERAL AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
COMMUNICATIONS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE COMMUNICATIONS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

There are several keys on the various - PWR - Loss of data due to power inter- There are several keys on the various - PWR - Loss of data due to power inter-
pages which always perform the same ruption. Touching the key displays the pages which always perform the same ruption. Touching the key displays the
function: initialization page. function: initialization page.
- The MENU key returns the display - MSG - SELCAL chime sounds. - The MENU key returns the display - MSG - SELCAL chime sounds.
back to the main menu page. Touching the key displays the page that back to the main menu page. Touching the key displays the page that
- The RTN key returns the display back initiated the advisory. - The RTN key returns the display back initiated the advisory.
to the last active main page. - SELCAL - An uplink message has to the last active main page. - SELCAL - An uplink message has
- The ENT key will store all the display been received. Touching the key dis- - The ENT key will store all the display been received. Touching the key dis-
contents of an underlined entry and plays the CALL COMPANY page. - contents of an underlined entry and plays the CALL COMPANY page. -
move the underline cursor to the next MSG (Flashing) move the underline cursor to the next MSG (Flashing)
entry required. - An uplink message has not been dis- entry required. - An uplink message has not been dis-
- If the entry is the last on a page, the played. Touching the key will display - If the entry is the last on a page, the played. Touching the key will display
next page of a multi-entry page format the oldest message not displayed. next page of a multi-entry page format the oldest message not displayed.
will appear, or it will display the SUM- - DATA - A downlink message has not will appear, or it will display the SUM- - DATA - A downlink message has not
MARY/SEND page if it was the last been sent because the system is in the MARY/SEND page if it was the last been sent because the system is in the
entry of the message voice mode, or the system has been in entry of the message voice mode, or the system has been in
- The CLR key will clear the last entry to the voice mode for 2 minutes. Touching - The CLR key will clear the last entry to the voice mode for 2 minutes. Touching
the fight of the cursor the key puts ACARS in the data mode. - the fight of the cursor the key puts ACARS in the data mode. -
- The SEND key, on appropriate func- NOCOMM - The SEND key, on appropriate func- NOCOMM
tion pages, queues the indicated message - A message has been sent the required tion pages, queues the indicated message - A message has been sent the required
for transmission and returns to the last number of times but no acknowledgment for transmission and returns to the last number of times but no acknowledgment
menu page used received. Touching the key activates re- menu page used received. Touching the key activates re-
- The RE-DO key on the data summary transmission of the message. - The RE-DO key on the data summary transmission of the message.
page returns back to the first data entry - VOICE - ACARS is in the voice mode page returns back to the first data entry - VOICE - ACARS is in the voice mode
page, for the summarized data, to allow but has no messages to send. Touching page, for the summarized data, to allow but has no messages to send. Touching
changes to be made the key displays the voice mode page. changes to be made the key displays the voice mode page.
The VOX key calls up the VOICE MODE The ACARS time display is normally The VOX key calls up the VOICE MODE The ACARS time display is normally
page and places ACARS in the voice updated while the airplane is at the gate. page and places ACARS in the voice updated while the airplane is at the gate.
mode. The second key from the left at the ACARS furnishes trip and gate informa- mode. The second key from the left at the ACARS furnishes trip and gate informa-
bottom of each display is reserved for the tion to the airplane's flight recorder. bottom of each display is reserved for the tion to the airplane's flight recorder.
advisory key. advisory key.
Advisory keys in order of priority are: Advisory keys in order of priority are:
- FAIL - Failure detected. Touching the - FAIL - Failure detected. Touching the
keys displays the maintenance menu keys displays the maintenance menu
page. page.
- SEND (Flashing) - A message is ready - SEND (Flashing) - A message is ready
to send. Touching the key queues the to send. Touching the key queues the
message for transmission. message for transmission.
- SEND (Steady) - A message has been - SEND (Steady) - A message has been
sent and is awaiting acknowledgment. sent and is awaiting acknowledgment.
No response when key is touched. No response when key is touched.

23-52 and Systems Introduction OCT 99 23-52 OCT 99


UNITED AIRLINES COURSE
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
COMMUNICATIONS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE COMMUNICATIONS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

ACARS DATA PRINTER has a problem, the aircraft ACARS may ACARS DATA PRINTER has a problem, the aircraft ACARS may
A printer for use with ACARS is installed not operate correctly. A NO COMM indi- A printer for use with ACARS is installed not operate correctly. A NO COMM indi-
on the right side of the aft control pedestal cator will be present in this situation. on the right side of the aft control pedestal cator will be present in this situation.
printer can provide hard copy printouts of Also, other aircraft which try to use the printer can provide hard copy printouts of Also, other aircraft which try to use the
messages received through ACARS. same ground station will have the same messages received through ACARS. same ground station will have the same
Interfaces problem. A display of NO COMM does Interfaces problem. A display of NO COMM does
The ACARS system interfaces with the not necessarily indicate an aircraft fail- The ACARS system interfaces with the not necessarily indicate an aircraft fail-
No. 3 VHF Comm system, parking brake, ure. It does indicate that the data-link air/ No. 3 VHF Comm system, parking brake, ure. It does indicate that the data-link air/
entry door and air/ground sensing sys- ground network was not completed. This entry door and air/ground sensing sys- ground network was not completed. This
tems. can be the result of ground station prob- tems. can be the result of ground station prob-
Troubleshooting lems or aircraft failures. The ACARS Troubleshooting lems or aircraft failures. The ACARS
When the ACARS system is inoperative, a transmits over the VHF-3 system. If this When the ACARS system is inoperative, a transmits over the VHF-3 system. If this
component failure is usually the cause. system is inoperative, or the VHF path component failure is usually the cause. system is inoperative, or the VHF path
Replace the component that you think is between the airplane and the ground sta- Replace the component that you think is between the airplane and the ground sta-
failed and make sure the system operates tion receiving antennas is blocked, the failed and make sure the system operates tion receiving antennas is blocked, the
correctly. If the ground-based supplier of system will go NO COMM. correctly. If the ground-based supplier of system will go NO COMM.
the ACARS/AIRCOM data-link service the ACARS/AIRCOM data-link service

SLEW RESET TEST MSG PAPER FAIL SLEW RESET TEST MSG PAPER FAIL

DATA PRINTER DATA PRINTER

FULL FULL

EMPTY EMPTY
PAPER PAPER

ACARS Printer ACARS Printer

and
OCT 99Systems Introduction 23-53 OCT 99 23-53
UNITED
B737 GENERAL AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
COMMUNICATIONS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE COMMUNICATIONS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

PROBLEM POSSIBLE CAUSE ISOLATION PROCEDURE CORRECTION PROBLEM POSSIBLE CAUSE ISOLATION PROCEDURE CORRECTION

MU FAIL MU failure Open and then close the Replace the MU MU FAIL MU failure Open and then close the Replace the MU
light is on ACARS AC circuit breaker. light is on ACARS AC circuit breaker.
*[1] *[1]
LRU FAIL LRU FAIL
light is on light is on
*[2] *[2]
CU FAIL IDU failure Open and then close the Replace the IDU CU FAIL IDU failure Open and then close the Replace the IDU
light is on ACARS AC circuit breaker. light is on ACARS AC circuit breaker.
*[1] *[1]
CONTROL CONTROL
FAIL light is FAIL light is
on *[2] on *[2]
NO COMM VHF Multipath Transmit from a different Change the NO COMM VHF Multipath Transmit from a different Change the
is shown distortion or dead location. location of the is shown distortion or dead location. location of the
spot airplane. Tell the spot airplane. Tell the
ground station ground station
about the dead about the dead
spot. spot.
Failed transmission Make sure the ground Advise the Failed transmission Make sure the ground Advise the
from the ground station’s transceivers are ground station from the ground station’s transceivers are ground station
station. operational. If the ground if necessary. station. operational. If the ground if necessary.
station has a problem with This is not an station has a problem with This is not an
their equipment, many aircraft problem. their equipment, many aircraft problem.
other aircraft that use the other aircraft that use the
data link will have the same data link will have the same
symptoms. symptoms.

Failed VHF Make sure the VHF-3 Replace the Failed VHF Make sure the VHF-3 Replace the
transceiver transceiver is powered and VHF transceiver transceiver transceiver is powered and VHF transceiver
is keyed when the MU is keyed when the MU
tranmits. Another procedure tranmits. Another procedure
is to tune a second VHF is to tune a second VHF
transceiver (VHF 1 or 2) to transceiver (VHF 1 or 2) to
the dataa frequency the dataa frequency
(131.725 MHz, Europe or (131.725 MHz, Europe or
131.550 MHz, USA and 131.550 MHz, USA and
listen when you push SEND. listen when you push SEND.
If the data is transmitted you If the data is transmitted you
will hear the usual data link will hear the usual data link
"chirp" sound. You can also "chirp" sound. You can also
temporarily replace the temporarily replace the
VHF-3 transceiver with one VHF-3 transceiver with one
of the other transceivers. of the other transceivers.

23-54 and Systems Introduction OCT 99 23-54 OCT 99


UNITED AIRLINES COURSE
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
COMMUNICATIONS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE COMMUNICATIONS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

PROBLEM POSSIBLE CAUSE ISOLATION PROCEDURE CORRECTION PROBLEM POSSIBLE CAUSE ISOLATION PROCEDURE CORRECTION

VHF transceiver is Make sure that the ACARS Set the correct VHF transceiver is Make sure that the ACARS Set the correct
not tuned to the is set to the correct data link frequency. not tuned to the is set to the correct data link frequency.
local data frequency. frequency. Refer to vendor local data frequency. frequency. Refer to vendor
infomation. infomation.

OUT/OFF/IN Failed sensor Do a test of the 000I sensors. Replace failed OUT/OFF/IN Failed sensor Do a test of the 000I sensors. Replace failed
event(s) did circuit on aircraft. Refer to 23-27-00.501. switch. event(s) did circuit on aircraft. Refer to 23-27-00.501. switch.
not register. not register.
Failed sensor Make sure that the sensor Replace MU Failed sensor Make sure that the sensor Replace MU
circuits in the MU. circuits on the aircraft are circuits in the MU. circuits on the aircraft are
O.K. (see above). O.K. (see above).

Cannot do Aircraft not in the Make sure that a door is Open a door Cannot do Aircraft not in the Make sure that a door is Open a door
GMT auto "IN" configuration. open and the parking brake and set the GMT auto "IN" configuration. open and the parking brake and set the
update and is set parking brake. update and is set parking brake.
NO COMM NO COMM
is not shown. is not shown.

Loss of all Failed circuit Remove the MU. Close the Replace circuit Loss of all Failed circuit Remove the MU. Close the Replace circuit
data during breaker. ACARS DC circuit breaker. breaker. data during breaker. ACARS DC circuit breaker. breaker.
airplane Make suree +28VDC is airplane Make suree +28VDC is
power available at pin 10 on power available at pin 10 on
transfer connector D1967C (pin 11 transfer connector D1967C (pin 11
is ground). is ground).
Note: Due to the very low Note: Due to the very low
current, the DC circuit current, the DC circuit
circuit breaker can become circuit breaker can become
contaminated. contaminated.

*[1] AIRPLANES WITH TELEDYNE ACARS *[1] AIRPLANES WITH TELEDYNE ACARS
*[2] AIRPLANES WITH COLLINS ACARS *[2] AIRPLANES WITH COLLINS ACARS

and
OCT 99Systems Introduction 23-55 OCT 99 23-55
UNITED
B737 GENERAL AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
COMMUNICATIONS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE COMMUNICATIONS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

COCKPIT VOICE RECORDER Panel output (headset audio) and transmis- COCKPIT VOICE RECORDER Panel output (headset audio) and transmis-
The cockpit voice recorder uses four inde- sions (microphone audio) from the Cap- The cockpit voice recorder uses four inde- sions (microphone audio) from the Cap-
pendent channels to record flight deck tain, First Officer and Observer. Hot mic pendent channels to record flight deck tain, First Officer and Observer. Hot mic
audio on a 30 minute continuous loop recording is used, any audio picked up by audio on a 30 minute continuous loop recording is used, any audio picked up by
tape, recordings older than 30 minutes are the boom microphones is recorded on the tape, recordings older than 30 minutes are the boom microphones is recorded on the
automatically erased. One channel tape, even without keying a PTT. The sys- automatically erased. One channel tape, even without keying a PTT. The sys-
records flight deck area conversations tem consists of the voice recorder, located records flight deck area conversations tem consists of the voice recorder, located
using the area microphone located on the in the aft baggage compartment, and a using the area microphone located on the in the aft baggage compartment, and a
Voice Recorder panel. The other 3 chan- control panel, located on the forward over- Voice Recorder panel. The other 3 chan- control panel, located on the forward over-
nels record individual Audio Selector head panel. nels record individual Audio Selector head panel.

VOICE RCDR VOICE RCDR


115V AC POWER INPUT 115V AC POWER INPUT
ELEX BUS-1 ELEX BUS-1
ALL CHANNEL AUDIO ALL CHANNEL AUDIO
TEST SWITCH MONITOR TEST SWITCH MONITOR
TEST METER TEST OUTPUT TEST METER TEST OUTPUT
AUDIO JACK TEST INTPUT AUDIO JACK TEST INTPUT
AREA MIC CHANNEL 4 AREA MIC CHANNEL 4
BULK ERASE BULK ERASE

FLIGHT BULK GROUND FLIGHT BULK GROUND


COMPARTMENT ERASE SENSING & COMPARTMENT ERASE SENSING &
SWITCH PARKING ERASE VOLTAGE SWITCH PARKING ERASE VOLTAGE
AREA SOUND AREA SOUND
BRAKE BRAKE
INTERLOCK INTERLOCK

VOICE RECORDER LANDING GEAR VOICE RECORDER LANDING GEAR


CONTROL PANEL ACCY UNIT CONTROL PANEL ACCY UNIT
CAPT CHANNEL 3 CAPT CHANNEL 3
FROM AUDIO FROM AUDIO
INTEGRATING F/O CHANNEL 2 INTEGRATING F/O CHANNEL 2
SYSTEM 1 OBS CHANNEL 1 SYSTEM 1 OBS CHANNEL 1
VOICE RECORDER VOICE RECORDER

Voice Recorder System Voice Recorder System

23-56 and Systems Introduction OCT 99 23-56 OCT 99


UNITED AIRLINES COURSE
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
COMMUNICATIONS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE COMMUNICATIONS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

Voice Recorder Unit previously recorded information prior to Voice Recorder Unit previously recorded information prior to
The voice recorder is installed in the E6 recording. A 30-minute length of closed The voice recorder is installed in the E6 recording. A 30-minute length of closed
equipment shelf on the right side of the aft loop magnetic tape provides a record of equipment shelf on the right side of the aft loop magnetic tape provides a record of
cargo compartment, aft of the cargo door. the previous 30 minutes of conversation. cargo compartment, aft of the cargo door. the previous 30 minutes of conversation.
In addition to the tape drive mechanism An internal monitoring circuit ensures In addition to the tape drive mechanism An internal monitoring circuit ensures
and tape, the tape transport contains the proper operation of the recording mecha- and tape, the tape transport contains the proper operation of the recording mecha-
recording heads, the erase head, the moni- nism and circuits. recording heads, the erase head, the moni- nism and circuits.
tor head, and the bulk erase coil. The erase A monitor jack is located on the front tor head, and the bulk erase coil. The erase A monitor jack is located on the front
head in the recorder automatically erases panel of the recorder. head in the recorder automatically erases panel of the recorder.

UNDERWATER UNDERWATER
LOCATING LOCATING
DEVICE (ULD) DEVICE (ULD)

Voice Recorder Unit Voice Recorder Unit

and
OCT 99Systems Introduction 23-57 OCT 99 23-57
UNITED
B737 GENERAL AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
COMMUNICATIONS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE COMMUNICATIONS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

Underwater Locator Beacon (ULB) Voice Recorder Control Panel Underwater Locator Beacon (ULB) Voice Recorder Control Panel
Attached to the front panel of the Voice The voice recorder control panel is located Attached to the front panel of the Voice The voice recorder control panel is located
Recorder is an Underwater Locator Bea- in the pilots' overhead panel P5. It con- Recorder is an Underwater Locator Bea- in the pilots' overhead panel P5. It con-
con (ULB). This device is also known as tains a microphone and preamplifier, a con (ULB). This device is also known as tains a microphone and preamplifier, a
an Underwater Locator Device, or (ULD). meter, a test push-button, a headphone an Underwater Locator Device, or (ULD). meter, a test push-button, a headphone
The ULB is an acoustic beacon that ener- jack, and an erase push-button. It allows The ULB is an acoustic beacon that ener- jack, and an erase push-button. It allows
gizes when it is immersed in water, remote monitoring and testing of the gizes when it is immersed in water, remote monitoring and testing of the
thereby assisting with location of the Voice Recorder Unit, detects flight com- thereby assisting with location of the Voice Recorder Unit, detects flight com-
recorder in case of an accident in water. partment sounds and conversations, and recorder in case of an accident in water. partment sounds and conversations, and
The ULB has no external connections, and controls bulk erasure of the recording The ULB has no external connections, and controls bulk erasure of the recording
is powered by an internal battery. The tape. is powered by an internal battery. The tape.
battery has a definite shelf life, and the Audible and visible indications derived battery has a definite shelf life, and the Audible and visible indications derived
expiration date of the battery is printed on from the monitoring circuits are presented expiration date of the battery is printed on from the monitoring circuits are presented
a sticker on the ULB. If the date on the at a meter and a jack on the control panel a sticker on the ULB. If the date on the at a meter and a jack on the control panel
sticker shows that the battery is out of when the test switch on the control panel sticker shows that the battery is out of when the test switch on the control panel
date, the entire ULB is removed from the is pushed. The microphone and the pream- date, the entire ULB is removed from the is pushed. The microphone and the pream-
voice recorder, and a new one is installed. plifier pick up the conversation in the voice recorder, and a new one is installed. plifier pick up the conversation in the
The ULB on the Voice Recorder is the flight compartment and supply audio to The ULB on the Voice Recorder is the flight compartment and supply audio to
same part as that installed on the Flight channel four of the voice recorder. When same part as that installed on the Flight channel four of the voice recorder. When
Data Recorder. the TEST push-button is pushed, it acti- Data Recorder. the TEST push-button is pushed, it acti-
vates a test circuit in the recorder. If all vates a test circuit in the recorder. If all
channels are recording properly, the meter channels are recording properly, the meter
needle indicates in the green area and a needle indicates in the green area and a
600-Hz test tone is supplied to the HEAD- 600-Hz test tone is supplied to the HEAD-
SET jack. SET jack.
The ERASE push-button will erase the The ERASE push-button will erase the
entire tape in the recorder if held for a entire tape in the recorder if held for a
minimum of two seconds. However, the minimum of two seconds. However, the
bulk erase circuit will operate only with bulk erase circuit will operate only with
the airplane on the ground, power applied the airplane on the ground, power applied
to the airplane, and the parking brake set. to the airplane, and the parking brake set.

23-58 and Systems Introduction OCT 99 23-58 OCT 99


UNITED AIRLINES COURSE
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
COMMUNICATIONS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE COMMUNICATIONS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

GO
GO

O
D

O
D
TEST ERASE TEST ERASE

HEADSET HEADSET
600OHMS 600OHMS
COCKPIT VOICE RECORDER COCKPIT VOICE RECORDER

Interfaces NOTE: Hot microphone recording is Interfaces NOTE: Hot microphone recording is
The Voice recorder system interfaces with used, audio from the Captain's, First The Voice recorder system interfaces with used, audio from the Captain's, First
the flight interphone system, the air/ Officer's, and Observer's boom or oxy- the flight interphone system, the air/ Officer's, and Observer's boom or oxy-
ground sensing and parking brake sys- gen mask microphone will be recorded ground sensing and parking brake sys- gen mask microphone will be recorded
tems. even with all control wheel, pendant, tems. even with all control wheel, pendant,
Operation and Audio Selector Panel PTT switches Operation and Audio Selector Panel PTT switches
The voice recorder system automatically in the off positions. The voice recorder system automatically in the off positions.
records the latest 30 minutes of communi- The playback head and monitor amplifier records the latest 30 minutes of communi- The playback head and monitor amplifier
cations and conversation in the flight com- are used to monitor information recorded cations and conversation in the flight com- are used to monitor information recorded
partment. The system is in operation on all tracks of the tape. The audio output partment. The system is in operation on all tracks of the tape. The audio output
whenever 115-volt ac power is applied to of the monitor amplifier is available at the whenever 115-volt ac power is applied to of the monitor amplifier is available at the
ac bus No. 1. Communications and inter- MONITOR jack on the front panel of the ac bus No. 1. Communications and inter- MONITOR jack on the front panel of the
phone audio from the first observer's, the voice recorder and at the HEADSET jack phone audio from the first observer's, the voice recorder and at the HEADSET jack
First Officer's and the Captain's micro- on the voice recorder control panel. This First Officer's and the Captain's micro- on the voice recorder control panel. This
phones are applied to channels 1 through 3 audio is also supplied to the test meter on phones are applied to channels 1 through 3 audio is also supplied to the test meter on
respectively of the Voice Recorder. Con- the voice recorder control panel. respectively of the Voice Recorder. Con- the voice recorder control panel.
versation in the flight compartment is versation in the flight compartment is
picked up and amplified by the micro- picked up and amplified by the micro-
phone and preamplifier in the voice phone and preamplifier in the voice
recorder control panel and applied to recorder control panel and applied to
channel 4. channel 4.

and
OCT 99Systems Introduction 23-59 OCT 99 23-59
UNITED
B737 GENERAL AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
COMMUNICATIONS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE COMMUNICATIONS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

Erasure Operational Testing Erasure Operational Testing


The bulk erase module contains timing, To perform an operational test of the The bulk erase module contains timing, To perform an operational test of the
relays, and erase circuits which apply 115 Voice Recorder system, reference MM relays, and erase circuits which apply 115 Voice Recorder system, reference MM
volts, 400 Hz ac to the erase coil in the 23-71-00 p501. When listening to the volts, 400 Hz ac to the erase coil in the 23-71-00 p501. When listening to the
tape transport. A 400 Hz tone can be audio through the control panel, a half to tape transport. A 400 Hz tone can be audio through the control panel, a half to
heard on the monitoring jacks on the voice two second delay will be noticed, this is heard on the monitoring jacks on the voice two second delay will be noticed, this is
recorder control panel and the Voice normal due to the placement of the record recorder control panel and the Voice normal due to the placement of the record
Recorder Unit. The bulk erase circuits and playback heads. Recorder Unit. The bulk erase circuits and playback heads.
erase all audio on the recorder tape within erase all audio on the recorder tape within
ten seconds after the ERASE button on the ten seconds after the ERASE button on the
control panel is released. The bulk erase control panel is released. The bulk erase
circuits will function only when the air- circuits will function only when the air-
plane is on the ground and the parking plane is on the ground and the parking
brake is set. The ERASE button should be brake is set. The ERASE button should be
pushed for at least ten seconds to erase all pushed for at least ten seconds to erase all
audio recorded on the tape. audio recorded on the tape.
Self Test Self Test
Pushing the TEST push-button on the Pushing the TEST push-button on the
voice recorder control panel causes the voice recorder control panel causes the
test module to apply a 600-Hz signal to test module to apply a 600-Hz signal to
each channel in sequence, thereby testing each channel in sequence, thereby testing
all channels. If they are functioning prop- all channels. If they are functioning prop-
erly, the control panel meter reads in the erly, the control panel meter reads in the
green area, but fluctuates, and the 600-Hz green area, but fluctuates, and the 600-Hz
tone is present at the jack on the panel and tone is present at the jack on the panel and
the Voice Recorder Unit. The tone will the Voice Recorder Unit. The tone will
be in intervals of 0.8 seconds. be in intervals of 0.8 seconds.

23-60 and Systems Introduction OCT 99 23-60 OCT 99


UNITED AIRLINES COURSE
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
COMMUNICATIONS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE COMMUNICATIONS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

VOICE VOICE
RECORDER BIAS GEN RECORDER BIAS GEN
UNIT 65 KHz UNIT 65 KHz
RECORDING RECORDING
CHANNEL 1 AMPLIFIERS CHANNEL 1 AMPLIFIERS
OBSERVER OBSERVER
ERASE ERASE
CHANNEL 2 CHANNEL 2
FLIGHT F/O FLIGHT F/O
INTERPHONE INTERPHONE
SYSTEM SYSTEM
CHANNEL 3 CHANNEL 3
CAPT. RECORDING HEADS CAPT. RECORDING HEADS
P5 OVERHEAD PANEL P5 OVERHEAD PANEL

CHANNEL 4 CHANNEL 4
PREAMP AREA MIC PREAMP AREA MIC
BULK BULK
PLAYBACK ERASE PLAYBACK ERASE
MIC MIC
TEST MONITOR TEST MONITOR
METER AMPLIFIER METER AMPLIFIER
TAPE TRANSPORT TAPE TRANSPORT
TEST (PROTECTED) TEST (PROTECTED)
TEST TEST
MODULE MODULE
(600 Hz) (600 Hz)
ERASE ERASE

MONITOR JACK MONITOR JACK

POWER BULK POWER BULK


SUPPLY ERASE SUPPLY ERASE

TO INTERNAL TO INTERNAL
CIRCUITS CIRCUITS
VOICE VOICE
RECOREDER RECOREDER
AFT CARGO COMPARTMENT AFT CARGO COMPARTMENT

115V AC 115V AC
UNSWITCHED UNSWITCHED
ELECTRONICS ELECTRONICS
BUS BUS
P18-2 P18-2

PARKING BRAKE SET PARKING BRAKE SET


PLANE ON GROUND PLANE ON GROUND
LANDING GEAR LANDING GEAR
ACCESSORY UNIT ACCESSORY UNIT

Voice Recorder System Schematic Voice Recorder System Schematic

and
OCT 99Systems Introduction 23-61 OCT 99 23-61
UNITED
B737 GENERAL AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
COMMUNICATIONS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE COMMUNICATIONS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

Troubleshooting Troubleshooting
Reference MM23-71-00 p101 when trou- Reference MM23-71-00 p101 when trou-
bleshooting the Voice Recorder System. bleshooting the Voice Recorder System.
Since there is only one system and no Since there is only one system and no
redundant circuits. Replacement of the redundant circuits. Replacement of the
specified unit, then retesting is the trou- specified unit, then retesting is the trouble-
bleshooting technique utilized. shooting technique utilized.

Prepare the system for troubleshooting as described in paragraph 2. Plug a head- Prepare the system for troubleshooting as described in paragraph 2. Plug a head-
set into the HEADSET jack on the voice recorder control panel, push the TEST set into the HEADSET jack on the voice recorder control panel, push the TEST
pushbutton for at least 5 seconds, listen for a 600-Hz tone at intervals of 0.8 pushbutton for at least 5 seconds, listen for a 600-Hz tone at intervals of 0.8
second and observe that the meter needle remains in the green area but fluctuates. second and observe that the meter needle remains in the green area but fluctuates.
IF -- IF --

THERE IS NO TONE THE TONE IS PRES- THE TONE IS PRES- THERE IS NO TONE THE TONE IS PRES- THE TONE IS PRES-
AND THE METER IS ENT AT UNEQUAL ENT AND THE METER AND THE METER IS ENT AT UNEQUAL ENT AND THE METER
NOT IN THE GREEN INTERVALS - Replace IS OUT OF THE NOT IN THE GREEN INTERVALS - Replace IS OUT OF THE
AREA - Replace the the voice recorder GREEN AREA. AREA - Replace the the voice recorder GREEN AREA.
voice recorder (MM 23-71-11/401) and voice recorder (MM 23-71-11/401) and
(MM 23-71-11/401) and do the specified test. Replace the voice recor- (MM 23-71-11/401) and do the specified test. Replace the voice recor-
do the specified test. der (MM 23-71-11/401) do the specified test. der (MM 23-71-11/401)
and do the specified and do the specified
test. test.

THE TONE IS PRESENT AND THE METER REMAINS IN THE GREEN THE TONE IS PRESENT AND THE METER REMAINS IN THE GREEN
AREA - Push the ERASE pushbutton on the voice recorder control panel for 3 AREA - Push the ERASE pushbutton on the voice recorder control panel for 3
seconds, release and listen for a 400-Hz tone present for 5 to10 seconds. IF -- seconds, release and listen for a 400-Hz tone present for 5 to10 seconds. IF --

THE TONE IS PRESENT - Push THE TONE IS NOT PRESENT - THE TONE IS PRESENT - Push THE TONE IS NOT PRESENT -
the ERASE pushbutton on the Replace the voice recorder the ERASE pushbutton on the Replace the voice recorder
voice recorder control panel for one (MM 23-71-11/401) and do the voice recorder control panel for one (MM 23-71-11/401) and do the
half second, release it and make sure specified test. half second, release it and make sure specified test.
that a 400-Hz tone is not present that a 400-Hz tone is not present
after release of the pushbutton. IF -- after release of the pushbutton. IF --

CONTINUED ON THE CONTINUED ON THE


FOLLOWING PAGE FOLLOWING PAGE

23-62 and Systems Introduction OCT 99 23-62 OCT 99


UNITED AIRLINES COURSE
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
COMMUNICATIONS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE COMMUNICATIONS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

CONTINUED FROM CONTINUED FROM


PRECEDING PAGE PRECEDING PAGE

THE TONE IS NOT PRESENT - THE TONE IS PRESENT -Replace THE TONE IS NOT PRESENT - THE TONE IS PRESENT -Replace
Continue to monitor the voice recorder the voice recorder (MM 23-71-11/401) Continue to monitor the voice recorder the voice recorder (MM 23-71-11/401)
audio with a headset, speak in a normal and do the specified test. audio with a headset, speak in a normal and do the specified test.
voice in the flight compartment, and voice in the flight compartment, and
make sure that the spoken audio is make sure that the spoken audio is
played back by the voice recoreder played back by the voice recoreder
after a one half second delay. IF -- after a one half second delay. IF --

THE AUDIO IS PLAYED BACK THE AUDIO IS NOT PRESENT - THE AUDIO IS PLAYED BACK THE AUDIO IS NOT PRESENT -
AFTER A ONE HALF SECOND Replace the voice recorder control AFTER A ONE HALF SECOND Replace the voice recorder control
DELAY - Cover the area microphone panel (MM 23-71-11/401) and do the DELAY - Cover the area microphone panel (MM 23-71-11/401) and do the
on the voice recorder control panel to specified test on the voice recorder control panel to specified test
prevent pickup of any sound. In turn, prevent pickup of any sound. In turn,
do a check of the captain’s, the first do a check of the captain’s, the first
officer’s, and the observers recorder officer’s, and the observers recorder
channels as follows: channels as follows:
1.On the audio selector panel, select 1.On the audio selector panel, select
the flight interphone operation. the flight interphone operation.
2.While monitoring the voice recor- 2.While monitoring the voice recor-
der audio, transmit a test message der audio, transmit a test message
using a handheld microphone. using a handheld microphone.
3.Make sure that the test message is 3.Make sure that the test message is
played back by the voice recorder played back by the voice recorder
after a one half second delay. after a one half second delay.
IF -- IF --

THE MESSAGE IS PLAYED BACK THE TEST MESSAGE IS NOT THE MESSAGE IS PLAYED BACK THE TEST MESSAGE IS NOT
BY ALL THE CHANNELS - The PLAYED BACK - Replace the voice BY ALL THE CHANNELS - The PLAYED BACK - Replace the voice
system is OK. recorder (MM 23-71-11/401) and do system is OK. recorder (MM 23-71-11/401) and do
the specifiec test. the specifiec test.

and
OCT 99Systems Introduction 23-63 OCT 99 23-63
UNITED
B737 GENERAL AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
COMMUNICATIONS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE COMMUNICATIONS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

HF COMMUNICATIONS HF Comm Tuning Panel HF COMMUNICATIONS HF Comm Tuning Panel


For long-range communications, one HF The HF Communication Control Panel is For long-range communications, one HF The HF Communication Control Panel is
Communications system is found on air- located on the P9 forward electronic panel Communications system is found on air- located on the P9 forward electronic panel
planes equipped for overwater operation. between the CDUs. It has two sets of fre- planes equipped for overwater operation. between the CDUs. It has two sets of fre-
It is controlled by a single HF COMM quency selector knobs to set the desired It is controlled by a single HF COMM quency selector knobs to set the desired
control panel located in the forward center frequency in the single frequency window. control panel located in the forward center frequency in the single frequency window.
pedestal. The Mode selector knob has three posi- pedestal. The Mode selector knob has three posi-
The HF Communication system consists tions. OFF turns the transceiver off. USB The HF Communication system consists tions. OFF turns the transceiver off. USB
of a transceiver unit, a control panel, an selects Upper Side Band operation, this is of a transceiver unit, a control panel, an selects Upper Side Band operation, this is
antenna coupler, and an antenna. the usual mode used for HF Communica- antenna coupler, and an antenna. the usual mode used for HF Communica-
The HF transceiver is powered by the No. tions. AM selects Amplitude Modulation The HF transceiver is powered by the No. tions. AM selects Amplitude Modulation
1 ac transfer bus. The usable frequency mode of operation. The RF SENS knob 1 ac transfer bus. The usable frequency mode of operation. The RF SENS knob
range is 2.8 MHz to 24.0 MHz. controls the receiver squelch to eliminate range is 2.8 MHz to 24.0 MHz. controls the receiver squelch to eliminate
The HF Communication systems uses the static noise. The HF Communication systems uses the static noise.
antenna coupler to match the antenna to HF Comm Transceiver antenna coupler to match the antenna to HF Comm Transceiver
the frequency selected. The antenna cou- The HF Communication system trans- the frequency selected. The antenna cou- The HF Communication system trans-
pler requires tuning whenever a new fre- ceiver unit is located in the E3-4 rack. pler requires tuning whenever a new fre- ceiver unit is located in the E3-4 rack.
quency is selected. The unit has a jack for mic and headphone quency is selected. The unit has a jack for mic and headphone
Warning: Do not operate the HF Com- connections. There is a SQL/LAMP Warning: Do not operate the HF Com- connections. There is a SQL/LAMP
munication system while fuel opera- TEST button and three status lights on the munication system while fuel operations TEST button and three status lights on the
tions are being accomplished. The fire front of the unit. The status lights are; are being accomplished. The fire haz- front of the unit. The status lights are;
hazard can cause injury to personnel or LRU FAIL, KEY INTERLOCK and ard can cause injury to personnel or LRU FAIL, KEY INTERLOCK and
damage to equipment. CONTROL OUTPUT FAIL. There is an damage to equipment. CONTROL OUTPUT FAIL. There is an
Warning: Do not operate the HF Com- internal blower fan installed. Warning: Do not operate the HF Com- internal blower fan installed.
munication system with personnel in Note: The internal blower fan should be munication system with personnel in Note: The internal blower fan should be
close proximity to the antenna or operating whenever the transceiver unit close proximity to the antenna or operating whenever the transceiver unit
antenna coupler. HF transmission can is powered. antenna coupler. HF transmission can is powered.
cause an electrical shock and injure cause an electrical shock and injure
personnel. personnel.
Caution: Do not transmit on the HF Caution: Do not transmit on the HF
Communication system with another Communication system with another
aircraft in close proximity with its HF aircraft in close proximity with its HF
Communication system in the receive Communication system in the receive
mode. This can damage the receiver in mode. This can damage the receiver in
the other aircraft. the other aircraft.

23-64 and Systems Introduction OCT 99 23-64 OCT 99


UNITED AIRLINES COURSE
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
COMMUNICATIONS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE COMMUNICATIONS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

RF SENS RF SENS

H H
F F

USB USB
OFF AM OFF AM

HF Tuning Panel HF Tuning Panel

COLLINS COLLINS

LRU FAIL LRU FAIL

KEY INTERLOCK KEY INTERLOCK

CONTROL INPUT FAIL CONTROL INPUT FAIL

SOL/LAMP TEST SOL/LAMP TEST

MFS-700
MFS-700
PHONE MIC PHONE MIC

HF Transceiver HF Transceiver

and
OCT 99Systems Introduction 23-65 OCT 99 23-65
UNITED
B737 GENERAL AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
COMMUNICATIONS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE COMMUNICATIONS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

Antenna Coupler coupler is attached to the antenna by a Antenna Coupler coupler is attached to the antenna by a
The antenna coupler is located near the feedline assembly. The unit is pressurized The antenna coupler is located near the feedline assembly. The unit is pressurized
base of the vertical stabilizer. It is with 5-7 psig of dry air. It has several base of the vertical stabilizer. It is with 5-7 psig of dry air. It has several
accessed through panels near the base of covered connectors on the front of the accessed through panels near the base of covered connectors on the front of the
the horizontal stabilizer. The antenna cou- unit. the horizontal stabilizer. The antenna cou- unit.
pler is housed in an HF coupler tray. The pler is housed in an HF coupler tray. The

HF ANTENNA HF ANTENNA
FEEDLINE ASSY FEEDLINE ASSY

HF COUPLER TRAY HF COUPLER TRAY

TEST TEST
CONNECTOR CONNECTOR

J3 J3
TRANSCEIVER J1 TRANSCEIVER J1
RF CONNECTOR RF CONNECTOR
HF ANTENNA HF ANTENNA
COUPLER PNEUMATIC J2 COUPLER J2
PNEUMATIC
VALVE VALVE

INTERCONNECT INTERCONNECT
CONNECTOR CONNECTOR

Antenna Coupler Antenna Coupler

23-66 and Systems Introduction OCT 99 23-66 OCT 99


UNITED AIRLINES COURSE
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
COMMUNICATIONS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE COMMUNICATIONS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

Interfaces Warning: Do not operate the HF Com- Interfaces Warning: Do not operate the HF Com-
The HF Communications system inter- munication system while fuel operations The HF Communications system inter- munication system while fuel operations
faces with the Selective Calling (SEL- are being accomplished. The fire haz- faces with the Selective Calling (SEL- are being accomplished. The fire haz-
CAL) system. ard can cause injury to personnel or CAL) system. ard can cause injury to personnel or
Operation damage to equipment. Operation damage to equipment.
Whenever a new frequency is selected, the Warning: Do not operate the HF Com- Whenever a new frequency is selected, the Warning: Do not operate the HF Com-
antenna coupler must be re-tuned. This is munication system with personnel in antenna coupler must be re-tuned. This is munication system with personnel in
required whether transmitting or receiving close proximity to the antenna or required whether transmitting or receiving close proximity to the antenna or
on the newly selected frequency. There antenna coupler. HF transmission can on the newly selected frequency. There antenna coupler. HF transmission can
will be a 1000 Hz tone heard as the cou- cause an electrical shock and injure will be a 1000 Hz tone heard as the cou- cause an electrical shock and injure
pler is tuning. When the tone stops, the personnel. pler is tuning. When the tone stops, the personnel.
coupler is tuned. Caution: Do not transmit on the HF coupler is tuned. Caution: Do not transmit on the HF
Note: It may take as long as 15 seconds for Communication system with another Note: It may take as long as 15 seconds for Communication system with another
the coupler to re-tune itself. aircraft in close proximity with its HF the coupler to re-tune itself. aircraft in close proximity with its HF
Basic operation of the HF Communica- Communication system in the receive Basic operation of the HF Communica- Communication system in the receive
tions consists of: mode. This can damage the receiver in tions consists of: mode. This can damage the receiver in
Selecting either USB or AM mode of the other aircraft. Selecting either USB or AM mode of the other aircraft.
operation. Testing operation. Testing
Tune to the desired HF frequency. Slid- Testing of the HF Communication system Tune to the desired HF frequency. Slid- Testing of the HF Communication system
ing the ASP 1-HF volume switch for- is accomplished per MM23-10-99 p501. ing the ASP 1-HF volume switch for- is accomplished per MM23-10-99 p501.
ward. Pressing the SQL/LAMP TEST button on ward. Pressing the SQL/LAMP TEST button on
Adjusting the squelch with the RF SENS the front of the transceiver unit should Adjusting the squelch with the RF SENS the front of the transceiver unit should
knob. illuminate the three status lights on the knob. illuminate the three status lights on the
Pressing 1-HF MIC selector button on unit. When releasing the button the lights Pressing 1-HF MIC selector button on unit. When releasing the button the lights
the ASP. should go out. If a light stays on, it indi- the ASP. should go out. If a light stays on, it indi-
Pressing a PTT to tune the coupler. Fol- cates the fault condition. Pressing a PTT to tune the coupler. Fol- cates the fault condition.
low the procedures and cautions in Troubleshooting low the procedures and cautions in Troubleshooting
MM23-10-99 p501. Problems with the HF Communication MM23-10-99 p501. Problems with the HF Communication
Maintenance Practices system that are static interference related Maintenance Practices system that are static interference related
Adjustments and testing of the HF Com- or reported as weak can be caused by Adjustments and testing of the HF Com- or reported as weak can be caused by
munications system can be found in faulty electrical connections and bonding munications system can be found in faulty electrical connections and bonding
MM23-10-99 p501. Removal and instal- of the antenna and coupler system. Corro- MM23-10-99 p501. Removal and instal- of the antenna and coupler system. Corro-
lation of the tuning panel can be found in sion has occurred at the connections at the lation of the tuning panel can be found in sion has occurred at the connections at the
MM23-14-99 p201. Information on the antenna coupler and feedline assembly. MM23-14-99 p201. Information on the antenna coupler and feedline assembly.
antenna coupler and feedline assembly can Reference MM23-15-99 p200. antenna coupler and feedline assembly can Reference MM23-15-99 p200.
be found in MM23-15-99 and MM23-15- be found in MM23-15-99 and MM23-15-
98. 98.
If the rain erosion coating on the antenna If the rain erosion coating on the antenna
requires restoring, reference SRM55-30- requires restoring, reference SRM55-30-
01 p108. 01 p108.

and
OCT 99Systems Introduction 23-67 OCT 99 23-67
UNITED
B737 GENERAL AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
COMMUNICATIONS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE COMMUNICATIONS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

SELCAL tor light on the SELCAL panel. SELCAL tor light on the SELCAL panel.
The Selective Calling (SELCAL) system The SELCAL alert may be canceled by The Selective Calling (SELCAL) system The SELCAL alert may be canceled by
allows a ground station, with tone trans- the crew by pressing the illuminated SEL- allows a ground station, with tone trans- the crew by pressing the illuminated SEL-
mitting equipment, to call a specific air- CAL panel annunciator, or by keying the mitting equipment, to call a specific air- CAL panel annunciator, or by keying the
plane. The system eliminates the appropriate comm transmitter. plane. The system eliminates the appropriate comm transmitter.
necessity of continuous monitoring of the The SELCAL system is integrated with necessity of continuous monitoring of the The SELCAL system is integrated with
communications systems by the flight the VHF 1, VHF 2, VHF 3 and HF communications systems by the flight the VHF 1, VHF 2, VHF 3 and HF
crew. It consists of a SELCAL Decoder COMM Systems, and is installed only on crew. It consists of a SELCAL Decoder COMM Systems, and is installed only on
Unit and a SELCAL panel. The 4 letter airplanes equipped for overwater opera- Unit and a SELCAL panel. The 4 letter airplanes equipped for overwater opera-
SELCAL code for the aircraft is usually tion. Airplane calling is handled by SELCAL code for the aircraft is usually tion. Airplane calling is handled by
placarded on the front instrument panel. ACARS for domestic operations. SEL- placarded on the front instrument panel. ACARS for domestic operations. SEL-
The SELCAL system receives 28v dc CAL is generally needed only when the The SELCAL system receives 28v dc CAL is generally needed only when the
from the DC Essential bus. Circuit break- airplane is operated out of the range of the from the DC Essential bus. Circuit break- airplane is operated out of the range of the
ers are located on the P18-2 panel. VHF COMM system. ers are located on the P18-2 panel. VHF COMM system.
Each SELCAL equipped airplane is SELCAL Decoder Each SELCAL equipped airplane is SELCAL Decoder
assigned its own specified 4 tone identi- The SELCAL Decoder Unit is installed in assigned its own specified 4 tone identi- The SELCAL Decoder Unit is installed in
fier. When the correct tone combination the E2-4 rack. The specific SELCAL fier. When the correct tone combination is the E2-4 rack. The specific SELCAL
is received from the ground station, the code for the aircraft is determined by the received from the ground station, the air- code for the aircraft is determined by the
airplane SELCAL decoder unit alerts the aircraft wiring. plane SELCAL decoder unit alerts the aircraft wiring.
flight crew with a chime and an annuncia- flight crew with a chime and an annuncia-

SE
SE TE LCA
TE LCA AM L
AM L

SELCAL Decoder SELCAL Decoder

23-68 and Systems Introduction OCT 99 23-68 OCT 99


UNITED AIRLINES COURSE
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
COMMUNICATIONS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE COMMUNICATIONS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

SELCAL Panel Operation SELCAL Panel Operation


The SELCAL Panel is located on the P9 A ground station sends the four tone code The SELCAL Panel is located on the P9 A ground station sends the four tone code
forward electronic panel, just aft of the HF over the VHF or HF communication sys- forward electronic panel, just aft of the HF over the VHF or HF communication sys-
Comm Tuning panel. It contains the tem. The communication radio system Comm Tuning panel. It contains the tem. The communication radio system
annunciators for which communication sends the signal to the SELCAL decoder. annunciators for which communication sends the signal to the SELCAL decoder.
radio has received a SELCAL. The If the four tones match the aircraft's code, radio has received a SELCAL. The If the four tones match the aircraft's code,
annunciator switch/light is also used for the decoder sends signals to illuminate the annunciator switch/light is also used for the decoder sends signals to illuminate the
resetting the system. appropriate annunciator light on the SEL- resetting the system. appropriate annunciator light on the SEL-
Interfaces CAL Panel and the Aural Warning system Interfaces CAL Panel and the Aural Warning system
The SELCAL system interfaces with the sounds a chime. The SELCAL Panel light The SELCAL system interfaces with the sounds a chime. The SELCAL Panel light
VHF Comm system, HF Comm System is reset by pressing the appropriate button VHF Comm system, HF Comm System is reset by pressing the appropriate button
and the Aural Warning System. or keying the appropriate communication and the Aural Warning System. or keying the appropriate communication
system. system.
Testing Testing
To perform a test of the SELCAL system, To perform a test of the SELCAL system,
follow the procedures in MM23-24-99 follow the procedures in MM23-24-99
p201. p201.

SELCAL SELCAL

VHF-1 VHF-2 VHF-3 HF-1 HF-2 VHF-1 VHF-2 VHF-3 HF-1 HF-2
PRESS TO RESET PRESS TO RESET

SELCAL Panel SELCAL Panel

and
OCT 99Systems Introduction 23-69 OCT 99 23-69
UNITED
B737 GENERAL AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
COMMUNICATIONS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE COMMUNICATIONS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

AIRFONE Cabin Handset Holder also keeps the bat- AIRFONE Cabin Handset Holder also keeps the bat-
The Airfone System operates in the 900 teries charged in the The Airfone System operates in the 900 teries charged in the
KHz band using comparable single side Cordless handset (CH) KHz band using comparable single side Cordless handset (CH)
band. The Airfone Aircraft System works The Cordless Handset is powered by a band. The Airfone Aircraft System works The Cordless Handset is powered by a
in conjunction with a network of approxi- rechargeable battery. After the handset is in conjunction with a network of approxi- rechargeable battery. After the handset is
mately 60 ground stations. Each ground released by the Cabin Handset Holder, it mately 60 ground stations. Each ground released by the Cabin Handset Holder, it
station has a pilot channel and as many as can be carried back to a customer's seat. station has a pilot channel and as many as can be carried back to a customer's seat.
31 sub-channels. The pilot channel When a customer makes a call, the hand- 31 sub-channels. The pilot channel When a customer makes a call, the hand-
enables the Airfone Aircraft System to set transmits through the ceiling antenna enables the Airfone Aircraft System to set transmits through the ceiling antenna
search and, using the doppler technique, to the Airborne Control Unit. The call is search and, using the doppler technique, to the Airborne Control Unit. The call is
select the best ground station relative to transmitted through the L-Band Antenna select the best ground station relative to transmitted through the L-Band Antenna
the aircraft's present position and the down to a ground station, where it is the aircraft's present position and the down to a ground station, where it is inter-
direction of flight. interconnected to local telephone com- direction of flight. connected to local telephone company
Airborne telephone handsets are installed pany lines. The call follows the same Airborne telephone handsets are installed lines. The call follows the same path in
in various seatbacks throughout the cabin. path in reverse to be received by the in various seatbacks throughout the cabin. reverse to be received by the Cordless
Each outgoing call requires a receiver/ Cordless Handset. The Cordless Handset Each outgoing call requires a receiver/ Handset. The Cordless Handset 4's turned
transmitter. With four receiver/transmit- 4's turned on and off by means of the transmitter. With four receiver/transmit- on and off by means of the "Dial- Tone"
ters installed on the airplane, a maximum "Dial- Tone" and "Hang Up" buttons. ters installed on the airplane, a maximum and "Hang Up" buttons.
of four simultaneous phone calls may be Airborne Control Unit (ACU) of four simultaneous phone calls may be Airborne Control Unit (ACU)
made. The telephone system may be deac- The Airborne Control Unit (ACU) con- made. The telephone system may be deac- The Airborne Control Unit (ACU) con-
tivated by pulling a circuit breaker located trols all of the Airfone equipment tivated by pulling a circuit breaker located trols all of the Airfone equipment
behind the First Officer's seat. installed in an aircraft by means of a behind the First Officer's seat. installed in an aircraft by means of a built-
All AIRFONE equipment is maintained built-in microprocessor. If functions as a All AIRFONE equipment is maintained in microprocessor. If functions as a base
by GTE and should not be serviced by base station for the Cordless Handsets by GTE and should not be serviced by station for the Cordless Handsets and
UAL personnel. When a problem is noted and communicates with the Cabin Hand- UAL personnel. When a problem is noted communicates with the Cabin Handset
with the AIRFONE system, call AIR- set Holders through those handsets. with the AIRFONE system, call AIR- Holders through those handsets.
FONE service at 1-800-323-7641(708- The ACU evaluates credit card data sent FONE service at 1-800-323-7641(708- The ACU evaluates credit card data sent
575-1405 in Illinois), and report the air- by the Cabin Handset Holder will deter- 575-1405 in Illinois), and report the air- by the Cabin Handset Holder will deter-
plane number, station code, number and mine whether to release a handset or to plane number, station code, number and mine whether to release a handset or to
location of inoperative units, and the serial reject the credit card. The ACU matches location of inoperative units, and the serial reject the credit card. The ACU matches
number of the logbook write-up. The Air- the handset to an available radio trans- number of the logbook write-up. The Air- the handset to an available radio trans-
fone Aircraft System is comprised of the ceiver. When a call is completed, the fone Aircraft System is comprised of the ceiver. When a call is completed, the
following units: (Ref. Figure 1). ACU notes the length of the call for bill- following units: (Ref. Figure 1). ACU notes the length of the call for bill-
Cabin Handset Holder (CHH) ing purposes. Cabin Handset Holder (CHH) ing purposes.
The Cabin Handset Holder reads customer Common Unit (CMN) The Cabin Handset Holder reads customer Common Unit (CMN)
credit cards, sends the card information to credit cards, sends the card information to
the Airborne Control Unit (ACU) for eval- the Airborne Control Unit (ACU) for eval-
uation and releases the handset at the uation and releases the handset at the
ACU's command. When the handset is ACU's command. When the handset is
returned to the holder, the ACU notes the returned to the holder, the ACU notes the
duration of the call (for billing purposes) duration of the call (for billing purposes)
and commands the Cabin Handset Holder and commands the Cabin Handset Holder
to release the customer's credit card. The to release the customer's credit card. The

23-70 and Systems Introduction OCT 99 23-70 OCT 99


UNITED AIRLINES COURSE
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
COMMUNICATIONS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE COMMUNICATIONS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

The Air Common Unit (CMN) contains The Matching Assembly is mounted in the The Air Common Unit (CMN) contains The Matching Assembly is mounted in the
the power supply for all of the Airfone ceiling of the aircraft (Sta 375) with the the power supply for all of the Airfone ceiling of the aircraft (Sta 375) with the
equipment installed in the aircraft, except Ceiling Antennas. The Matching Assem- equipment installed in the aircraft, except Ceiling Antennas. The Matching Assem-
for the Cabin Handset Holder and the bly is tuned to match the impedances of for the Cabin Handset Holder and the bly is tuned to match the impedances of
Cordless Handset. The CMN operates off the Feeder Cables and the Ceiling Cordless Handset. The CMN operates off the Feeder Cables and the Ceiling
115 volt AC power from the 115v AC Bus Antenna. Matching Assemblies are pre- 115 volt AC power from the 115v AC Bus Antenna. Matching Assemblies are pre-
No. 1. The CMN power supply is inter- tuned by Airfone for the lengths of feeder No. 1. The CMN power supply is inter- tuned by Airfone for the lengths of feeder
nally fused to prevent damage to the air- cables and ceiling antenna in each particu- nally fused to prevent damage to the air- cables and ceiling antenna in each particu-
craft's power system. The Airfone lar type of aircraft. craft's power system. The Airfone lar type of aircraft.
equipment consumes 120 to 400 watts of Ceiling Antennas equipment consumes 120 to 400 watts of Ceiling Antennas
power, dependent on the load. The Ceiling Antennas extends the whole power, dependent on the load. The Ceiling Antennas extends the whole
Radio Transceiver (R/T) length of the aircraft cabin. The Ceiling Radio Transceiver (R/T) length of the aircraft cabin. The Ceiling
The Radio Transceiver (R/T) is installed Antennas receives the 49 MHz signal from The Radio Transceiver (R/T) is installed Antennas receives the 49 MHz signal from
in the Airfone tray assembly located in the the Cordless Handset and transmits the 1.7 in the Airfone tray assembly located in the the Cordless Handset and transmits the 1.7
E & E bay. The R/T's operate using com- MHz signal from the Airborne Control E & E bay. The R/T's operate using com- MHz signal from the Airborne Control
patible single sideband transmission. The Unit back to the Cordless Handset. patible single sideband transmission. The Unit back to the Cordless Handset.
transmitter transmits at 900 MHz and is Wired Tray Assembly (TRAY) transmitter transmits at 900 MHz and is Wired Tray Assembly (TRAY)
connected to the antenna through an The tray assembly is wired to receive the connected to the antenna through an The tray assembly is wired to receive the
antenna combining network. Airborne Control Unit (ACU), the Air- antenna combining network. Airborne Control Unit (ACU), the Air-
L-Band Antenna (ANT) borne Common Unit (CMN) the Radio L-Band Antenna (ANT) borne Common Unit (CMN) the Radio
Two aluminum L-Band antennas are is Transceivers (R/T's), the APLC and the Two aluminum L-Band antennas are is Transceivers (R/T's), the APLC and the
used to transmit and receive air-to-ground. cavity filler The Airfone tray assembly is used to transmit and receive air-to-ground. cavity filler The Airfone tray assembly is
These are standard DME, ATC type of installed in the E & E bay. It is attached to These are standard DME, ATC type of installed in the E & E bay. It is attached to
antenna which have been modified electri- the cabin floor beams just forward of the antenna which have been modified electri- the cabin floor beams just forward of the
cally to Airfone frequencies. E3 rack. It has been designated as the E3-6 cally to Airfone frequencies. E3 rack. It has been designated as the E3-6
Matching Assembly (MA) shelf. Matching Assembly (MA) shelf.
Maintenance Practices Maintenance Practices

and
OCT 99Systems Introduction 23-71 OCT 99 23-71
UNITED
B737 GENERAL AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
COMMUNICATIONS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE COMMUNICATIONS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

All Airfone/Seatfone equipment is main- All Airfone/Seatfone equipment is main-


tained by GTE Airfone and should not be tained by GTE Airfone and should not be
serviced by UAL personnel. Maintenance serviced by UAL personnel. Maintenance
of seat assemblies, seat backs, and other of seat assemblies, seat backs, and other
cabin furnishings are still the responsibil- cabin furnishings are still the responsibil-
ity of UAL and should be accomplished ity of UAL and should be accomplished
per the applicable Maintenance Manuals. per the applicable Maintenance Manuals.
When an airplane arrives at a line station When an airplane arrives at a line station
with an open logbook report that one or with an open logbook report that one or
more Airfone/Seatfone units are inopera- more Airfone/Seatfone units are inopera-
tive, accomplish the following: tive, accomplish the following:
(1) Call Airfone service (In Illinois 708- (1) Call Airfone service (In Illinois 708-
575-1405, all other locations 1-800-323- 575-1405, all other locations 1-800-323-
7641) and report the following: 7641) and report the following:
- (a) Airplane number - (a) Airplane number
- (b) Station code of the station - (b) Station code of the station
making the call making the call
- (c) Number of inoperative unit(s) - (c) Number of inoperative unit(s)
- (d) Location of inoperative unit(s) - (d) Location of inoperative unit(s)
- (e) Serial number of the logbook - (e) Serial number of the logbook
write-up write-up
(2) Place an Airfone Out of Service plac- (2) Place an Airfone Out of Service plac-
ard on the inoperative unit(s). ard on the inoperative unit(s).
(3) If Airfone technicians are not available (3) If Airfone technicians are not available
to correct the defect, defer logbook entry to correct the defect, defer logbook entry
write-up. Include date and time that prob- write-up. Include date and time that prob-
lem was reported to Airfone. lem was reported to Airfone.
(4) When Airfone completes the repair(s), (4) When Airfone completes the repair(s),
it will be their responsibility to remove the it will be their responsibility to remove the
Airfone Out of Service placard(s) from the Airfone Out of Service placard(s) from the
unit(s) and provide documentation to unit(s) and provide documentation to UAL
UAL maintenance personnel. maintenance personnel.
(5) UAL maintenance personnel clear (5) UAL maintenance personnel clear
deferred item after documentation is deferred item after documentation is
received from Airfone. received from Airfone.
NOTE: Airfone personnel may replace NOTE: Airfone personnel may replace
Airfone unique components only. They Airfone unique components only. They
may not replace antennas, circuit may not replace antennas, circuit
breakers, do aircraft system wiring breakers, do aircraft system wiring
repairs or perform maintenance on any repairs or perform maintenance on any
other parts of the airplane (Ref. BKl 2- other parts of the airplane (Ref. BKl 2-
0-25-1). 0-25-1).
AUDIO SELECTOR PANEL AUDIO SELECTOR PANEL

23-72 and Systems Introduction OCT 99 23-72 OCT 99


UNITED AIRLINES COURSE
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
COMMUNICATIONS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE COMMUNICATIONS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
CONTROLS & INDICATIONS CONTROLS & INDICATIONS

Location: Center Pedestal Location: Center Pedestal

Transmit MIC Selector Transmit MIC Selector


Switches channel as switch is moved forward. Any Switches channel as switch is moved forward. Any
Selects desired transmit channel. or all channels can be monitored. Selects desired transmit chan- or all channels can be monitored.
Only one channel can be selected MASK/BOOM Switch nel. Only one channel can be MASK/BOOM Switch
at a time. When selected channel Selects which microphone (boom or oxy- selected at a time. When Selects which microphone (boom or oxy-
switch light comes on. selected channel switch light
PTT (Push-To-Talk) Switch comes on.
PTT (Push-To-Talk) Switch
MIC SELECTOR
MIC SELECTOR
Keys boom or oxygen Keys boom or oxygen
mask microphone mask microphone (based
(based on the position of 1 - VHF -2 - VHF - 3 INOP INOP F - INPH - S PA on the position of the
the MASK/BOOM MASK/BOOM switch) 1 - VHF -2 - VHF - 3 INOP INOP F - INPH - S PA

switch) and transmits and transmits via chan-


via channel selected by nel selected by the mic
the mic selector switch. selector switch. Per-
Performs same function PTT INOP ADF -2 MASK forms same function as
1- NAV -2 MKR SPKR
as the pendant switch the pendant switch and PTT 1- NAV -2 INOP ADF -2 MKR SPKR
MASK

and mic position of the mic position of the con-


control wheel mic/inter- V BOOM
EMER trol wheel mic/inter-
BOOM
phone switch B phone switch V EMER

Filter Switch Filter Switch B


R NORM
Controls the reception Controls the reception R NORM

gen mask) is used when the mic gen mask) is used when the mic
position of the control wheel position of the control wheel
mic/interphone switch, the PTT mic/interphone switch, the PTT
switch, or the pendant switch is switch, or the pendant switch is
pushed. pushed.
from the NAV and ADF radios. from the NAV and ADF radios.
The following identifies the type Emergency Degrade Switch The following identifies the type Emergency Degrade Switch
of audio received in the posi- of audio received in the positions
tions available: available:
V: Voice only NORM - Allows the REU to automatically V: Voice only NORM - Allows the REU to automatically
B: Both voice and station identi- revert to the degrade mode if the respec- B: Both voice and station identi- revert to the degrade mode if the respec-
fier range code tive ASP fails. fier range code tive ASP fails.
R: Station identifier range code EMER - Manually degrades respective R: Station identifier range code EMER - Manually degrades respective
only ASP. only ASP.
Volume Control Switches PA MICROPHONE AND SERVICE Volume Control Switches PA MICROPHONE AND SERVICE
Increases volume of respective INTERPHONE HANDSET Increases volume of respective INTERPHONE HANDSET

and
OCT 99Systems Introduction 23-73 OCT 99 23-73
UNITED
B737 GENERAL AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
COMMUNICATIONS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE COMMUNICATIONS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
CONTROLS & INDICATIONS CONTROLS & INDICATIONS

Location: Aft Pedestal Location: Aft Pedestal


Passenger Address Microphone Passenger Address Microphone
Provides communication to the cabin via Provides communication to the cabin via

the PA system. Overrides the flight atten- the PA system. Overrides the flight atten-
dant PA microphones. Bypasses the ASP dant PA microphones. Bypasses the ASP
EXTERNAL INTERPHONE PANEL EXTERNAL INTERPHONE PANEL
Location: External Power Receptacle, Attendants or ground personnel vial the Location: External Power Receptacle, Attendants or ground personnel vial the
service interphone system. Cannot be used service interphone system. Cannot be used
for PA announcements. Bypasses the for PA announcements. Bypasses the
ASP. ASP.
FLIGHT INTERPHONE Jack FLIGHT INTERPHONE Jack
Connects headset or hand-held mic to Connects headset or hand-held mic to
Right Forward Fuselage Right Forward Fuselage
PILOT CALL Button PILOT CALL Button
Sounds single chime in cockpit. Blue Sounds single chime in cockpit. Blue

EXTERNAL INTERPHONE
flight interphone system. This is EXTERNAL INTERPHONE
flight interphone system. This is
POWER normal source of communication POWER normal source of communication
for pushback. for pushback.

CONN FLIGHT SERVICE SERVICE INTERPHONE CONN FLIGHT SERVICE SERVICE INTERPHONE
NOSE NOSE
PILOT WHEEL WELL Jack PILOT WHEEL WELL Jack
ON Connects headset or had-held ON Connects headset or had-held mic
CALL
NORM
mic to service interphone sys- CALL
NORM
to service interphone system.
NOT
IN USE
LIGHT tem. SERVICE INTERPHONE NOT
IN USE
LIGHT SERVICE INTERPHONE switch
switch on overhead panel must on overhead panel must bo ON to
bo ON to allow two-way com- allow two-way communication.
CALL light on overhead panel is illumi- munication. CALL light on overhead panel is illumi- COCKPIT VOICE RECORER
nated while button is pushed. COCKPIT VOICE nated while button is pushed.
RECORER
AIR LINK MICROPHONE AIR LINK MICROPHONE
Location: Cockpit Location: Cockpit

Dual Tone Multi-Frequency (DTMF) Dual Tone Multi-Frequency (DTMF) Air-Link

Air-Link
Keypad Keypad QZ
1
ABC
2
DEF
3

Allows dialing of ground based telephone Allows dialing of ground based telephone
QZ ABC DEF GHI JKL MNO
1 2 3 4 5 6
GHI JKL MNO PRS TUV WXY

interconnect system and CALSEL calling interconnect system and CALSEL calling
4 5 6 7 8 9
OPER
PRS
7
TUV
8
WXY
9 * 0 #
of LDOC facilities. *
OPER
0 # of LDOC facilities.
Handset Handset
Provides communication with Flight Provides communication with Flight

23-74 and Systems Introduction OCT 99 23-74 OCT 99


UNITED AIRLINES COURSE
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
COMMUNICATIONS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE COMMUNICATIONS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
CONTROLS & INDICATIONS CONTROLS & INDICATIONS

Location: Forward Overhead Panel PUSH (and hold) - Tests opera- Location: Forward Overhead Panel PUSH (and hold) - Tests opera-
MICROPHONE tion of all four channels. A tone is MICROPHONE tion of all four channels. A tone is
audible through the headset when audible through the headset when
plugged into the headset jack. plugged into the headset jack.
Picks up cockpit are conversations Monitor indicator pointer should Picks up cockpit are conversations Monitor indicator pointer should
(one of the four channels) any time (one of the four channels) any time
point to green band. point to green band.
115V AC is applied to the airplane. 115V AC is applied to the airplane.
Monitor Indicator ERASE Button Monitor Indicator ERASE Button
Erases recorder tape when the air- Erases recorder tape when the air-
plane is on the ground and the plane is on the ground and the
parking brake is set. Must be held parking brake is set. Must be held
GO
in approximately 10 seconds; all GO
in approximately 10 seconds; all
O

O
D

D
TEST ERASE four channels are simultaneously TEST ERASE four channels are simultaneously
erased. erased.
HEADSET HEADSET
600OHMS 600OHMS
COCKPIT VOICE RECORDER HEADSET Jack COCKPIT VOICE RECORDER HEADSET Jack
Allows headset to be plugged in Allows headset to be plugged in
to monitor tone during test, or to to monitor tone during test, or to
monitor playback of voice monitor playback of voice
Pointer deflects to the right when record- recorder. Pointer deflects to the right when record- recorder.
ing or erasing all four channels. Pointer ing or erasing all four channels. Pointer
points to green band while TEST button is points to green band while TEST button is
held in. held in.

FLIGHT ATTENDANT AND FLIGHT ATTENDANT AND


GROUND CREW CALL GROUND CREW CALL
Location: Forward Overhead Panel ATTENDANT CALL Button Location: Forward Overhead Panel ATTENDANT CALL Button
TEST Button PUSH - Sounds a two tone chime TEST Button PUSH - Sounds a two tone chime
in the passenger cabin and both in the passenger cabin and both
pink master call lights come on. pink master call lights come on.

GROUND CALL Button GROUND CALL Button


GRD PUSH - Sounds a horn in the nose GRD PUSH - Sounds a horn in the nose
ATTEND CALL wheel well until released. ATTEND wheel well until released.
CALL
COCKPIT CALL Light (blue) COCKPIT CALL Light (blue)
When illuminated, indicates cock- When illuminated, indicates
pit is being called by the fight cockpit is being called by the
attendants or ground personnel. fight attendants or ground person-
Remains illuminated until the nel. Remains illuminated until the
CALL Captan Call or Pilot Call switch is Captan Call or Pilot Call switch is
released.
CALL released.
HF COMM CONTROL HF COMM CONTROL

and
OCT 99Systems Introduction 23-75 OCT 99 23-75
UNITED
B737 GENERAL AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
COMMUNICATIONS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE COMMUNICATIONS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
CONTROLS & INDICATIONS CONTROLS & INDICATIONS

PANEL PANEL
Location: Aft Control Pedastal Location: Aft Control Pedastal

Frequency Indicator Frequency Indicator


Indicates frequency selected with Controls receiver squelch to eliminate Indicates frequency selected with Controls receiver squelch to eliminate
frequency selectors. static. frequency selectors. static.
Frequency Selector (Left) Frequency Selector (Right) Frequency Selector (Left) Frequency Selector (Right)

RF SENS RF SENS

H H
F F

USB USB
OFF AM OFF AM

Outer knob selects 10 kHz.


Outer Knob selects whole MHz. Outer knob selects 10 kHz. Outer Knob selects whole MHz.
Inner knob selects 100 kHz. Inner knob selcts 1 kHz. Inner knob selects 100 kHz. Inner knob selcts 1 kHz.
RF SENS Knob Mode Selector RF SENS Knob Mode Selector

OFF - Removes all power from unit. OFF - Removes all power from unit.
USB - Selects single (upper) side band mode. USB - Selects single (upper) side band mode.
AM - Selects amplitude modulation mode. AM - Selects amplitude modulation mode.
SELCAL CONTROL PANEL SELCAL CONTROL PANEL

23-76 and Systems Introduction OCT 99 23-76 OCT 99


UNITED AIRLINES COURSE
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
COMMUNICATIONS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE COMMUNICATIONS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
CONTROLS & INDICATIONS CONTROLS & INDICATIONS

Location: Aft of HF radio control panel on Location: Aft of HF radio control panel on
center pedestal. center pedestal.

SELCAL Control Panel SELCAL Control Panel


Illuminates appropriate switch and sounds a Illuminates appropriate switch and sounds
chime to alert crew to incoming messages. a chime to alert crew to incoming mes-
Press switch to reset system. sages.
HF-2 position is inoperative. Press switch to reset system.
Refer to International Supplement in FOM HF-2 position is inoperative.
for SELCAL testing procedure. Refer to International Supplement in FOM
OBS AUDIO ENTERTAINMENT for SELCAL testing procedure.
OBS AUDIO ENTERTAINMENT

SELCAL SELCAL

VHF-1 VHF-2 VHF-3 HF-1 HF-2 VHF-1 VHF-2 VHF-3 HF-1 HF-2
PRESS TO RESET PRESS TO RESET

SWITCH SWITCH
Location: Aft Overhead Panel OFF Location: Aft Overhead Panel OFF
ON - Allows passengers to monitor ON - Allows passengers to monitor
any or all channels selected on the OBS any or all channels selected on the OBS
observer ASP. AUDIO observer ASP. AUDIO
Note: System not available if the for- ENTMT Note: System not available if the for- ENTMT
ward flilght attendant Passenger Enter- ward flilght attendant Passenger Enter-
tainment switch is in TEST position ON tainment switch is in TEST position ON
Electronic Equipment Racks Electronic Equipment Racks

and
OCT 99Systems Introduction 23-77 OCT 99 23-77
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
23-78

COMPONENT LOCATIONS
COMMUNICATIONS
CBN TEMP CONT
AIR DATA AUTO DGIL DGIL AUTO AUTO EXEX AIR DATA WXR
CMPTR THROTTLE STALL STALL SLAT SLAT PRESS CMPTR

(M345)
NO. 1 CMPTR WRN WRN CMPTR CMPTR CONT NO. 2 TRANSCEIVER
CMPTR CMPTR NO. 1 NO. 2
NO. 1 NO. 2
(M196) (M917) (M1222) (M1223) (M325) (M368)
E1-1

IRS EFIS
FLIGHT FLIGHT RLY TRMFR DIGITAL ENG DIGITAL
MANAGEMENT INST NO. 1 RLY 1 ANALOG VIB ANALOG
VOICE COMPUTER ACCESS ADAPTER SIG ADAPTER
RCDR IRS EFIS NO. 1 COND NO. 2 E1
RLY TRMFR
(M1175) (M160) NO. 2 RLY 2 (M1163) (M1240) (M1163) STA 322.9
E1-2
E2 E3
ACARS FLIGHT CONT CMPTR YAW AFC FLIGHT CONT CMPTR
CHANNEL "A" DAMPER ACCESS CHANNEL "B"
CPLR UNIT
E6 RACK
STA 887 - STA 907, AFT CARGO COMP. (M1109) (M924) (M177) (M1194) (M923)
Antenna Locations

UNITED AIRLINES
E1-3
E1 RACK

TRANS TRANS TRANS BATTERY STATIC


P/A REU VHF VHF VHF FORMER FORMER FORMER CHARGER INVERTER
AMPL COMM COMM COMM RECT RECT RECT
NO. 3 NO. 1 NO. 2 IFIER IFIER IFIER
NO. 1 NO. 2 NO. 3
(M63) (M411) (M149) (M150) (T11) (T12) (T13) (M5) (M9)
E3-1

AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE


B737-322/522
E2-1

FLAP & SLAT


OVERHEAT

SWITCHES
AUTO ANTI AIR ENG

SWITCHES
POSITION
MISC
ATC ATC FDAU DME DME SPEED SKID COND ACCESS

DET
NO. 1 NO. 2 NO. 1 NO. 2 ELECTRONIC BRAKE TION
BOX EXTRACTOR RLY

(M163) (M381) (M675) (M164) (M165)


IN BRACKET ON (M980) (M316)(M324) (M528) (M237) (M278) (M229)
FWD INBD STANCHION E3-2
E2-2 IRU IRU
NO. 1 NO. 2 APU FIRE WINDOW WINDOW WINDOW WINDOW
ENT MULTI EFIS EFIS CONT DETECTOR CONT CONT CONT CONT
TAPE PLEXER SYMBOL SYMBOL NO. 1 NO. 2 NO. 3 NO. 4
REPRO GENERATOR GENERATOR (M1161) (M1162)

(R280)
RELAYS
NO. 1 NO. 2 R10
(M1319) (M1321) BLACK BOX (M279) R11 (M320) (M321) (M322) (M323)
E3-3
E2-3 EXTRACTOR
BATTERY VHF VHF VHF VOR AFCS
RADIO RADIO GND ADF ADF NAV NAV NAV ILS ILS
ALTIMETER ALTIMETER PROX NO. NO. NO. 1 SW NO. 2 NAV RLYS
NO. 1 NO. 2 2 1 NO.1 REL NO.1
ELECTROSTATIC
OCT 99

(PROV) MKR NO.2 (REF) NO.2


BKN
GROUND JACK (M154) (REF) (M155)
(M50) (M415)
INTERPHONE E3-4
E2-4
SERVICE
E2 RACK E3 RACK

and Systems Introduction


23-78

COMPONENT LOCATIONS
COMMUNICATIONS
CBN TEMP CONT

AIR DATA AUTO DGIL DGIL AUTO AUTO EXEX AIR DATA WXR
CMPTR THROTTLE STALL STALL SLAT SLAT PRESS CMPTR
(M345)

NO. 1 CMPTR WRN WRN CMPTR CMPTR CONT NO. 2 TRANSCEIVER


CMPTR CMPTR NO. 1 NO. 2
NO. 1 NO. 2
(M196) (M917) (M1222) (M1223) (M325) (M368)
E1-1

IRS EFIS
FLIGHT FLIGHT RLY TRMFR DIGITAL ENG DIGITAL
MANAGEMENT INST NO. 1 RLY 1 ANALOG VIB ANALOG
VOICE COMPUTER ACCESS ADAPTER SIG ADAPTER
RCDR IRS EFIS NO. 1 COND NO. 2 E1
RLY TRMFR
(M1175) (M160) NO. 2 RLY 2 (M1163) (M1240) (M1163) STA 322.9
E1-2
E2 E3
ACARS FLIGHT CONT CMPTR YAW AFC FLIGHT CONT CMPTR
CHANNEL "A" DAMPER ACCESS CHANNEL "B"
CPLR UNIT
E6 RACK
STA 887 - STA 907, AFT CARGO COMP. (M1109) (M924) (M177) (M1194) (M923)
Antenna Locations

UNITED AIRLINES
E1-3
E1 RACK

TRANS TRANS TRANS BATTERY STATIC


P/A REU VHF VHF VHF FORMER FORMER FORMER CHARGER INVERTER
AMPL COMM COMM COMM RECT RECT RECT
NO. 3 NO. 1 NO. 2 IFIER IFIER IFIER
NO. 1 NO. 2 NO. 3
(M63) (M411) (M149) (M150) (T11) (T12) (T13) (M5) (M9)
E3-1
B737-322/522
AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE

E2-1
FLAP & SLAT
OVERHEAT

SWITCHES

AUTO ANTI AIR ENG


SWITCHES
POSITION
MISC

ATC ATC FDAU DME DME SPEED SKID COND ACCESS


DET

NO. 1 NO. 2 NO. 1 NO. 2 ELECTRONIC BRAKE TION


BOX EXTRACTOR RLY

(M163) (M381) (M675) (M164) (M165)


IN BRACKET ON (M980) (M316)(M324) (M528) (M237) (M278) (M229)
FWD INBD STANCHION E3-2
E2-2 IRU IRU
NO. 1 NO. 2 APU FIRE WINDOW WINDOW WINDOW WINDOW
ENT MULTI EFIS EFIS CONT DETECTOR CONT CONT CONT CONT
TAPE PLEXER SYMBOL SYMBOL NO. 1 NO. 2 NO. 3 NO. 4
REPRO GENERATOR GENERATOR (M1161) (M1162)
(R280)

RELAYS
NO. 1 NO. 2 R10
(M1319) (M1321) BLACK BOX (M279) R11 (M320) (M321) (M322) (M323)
E3-3
E2-3 EXTRACTOR
BATTERY VHF VHF VHF VOR AFCS
RADIO RADIO GND ADF ADF NAV NAV NAV ILS ILS
ALTIMETER ALTIMETER PROX NO. NO. NO. 1 SW NO. 2 NAV RLYS
NO. 1 NO. 2 2 1 NO.1 REL NO.1
ELECTROSTATIC
OCT 99

(PROV) MKR NO.2 (REF) NO.2


BKN
GROUND JACK (M154) (REF) (M155)
(M50) (M415)
INTERPHONE E3-4
E2-4
SERVICE
E2 RACK E3 RACK
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE

COMPONENT LOCATIONS
OCT 99

COMMUNICATIONS
DUAL
VOR/LOC

DUAL ADF ADF


GLIDESLOPE LOOP-1 LOOP-2 MARKER
BEACON HF COMM

UPPER
TCAS VHF
COMM-1 SKY RADIO
WEATHER UPPER
RADAR ATC

UNITED AIRLINES
AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
B737-322/522
DUAL
VHF COMM-3
LOCALIZER
LOWER ADF SENSE
ANTENNA DME-1
ATC VHF LH AND RH
COMM-2 1 2
RADIO RADIO
ALTIMETER-2 ALTIMETER-1
LOWER
TCAS
23-79

and Systems Introduction

COMPONENT LOCATIONS
OCT 99

COMMUNICATIONS
DUAL
VOR/LOC

DUAL ADF ADF


GLIDESLOPE LOOP-1 LOOP-2 MARKER
BEACON HF COMM

UPPER
TCAS VHF
COMM-1 SKY RADIO
WEATHER UPPER

UNITED AIRLINES
RADAR ATC
B737-322/522
AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE

DUAL
VHF COMM-3
LOCALIZER
LOWER ADF SENSE
ANTENNA DME-1
ATC VHF LH AND RH
COMM-2 1 2
RADIO RADIO
ALTIMETER-2 ALTIMETER-1
LOWER
TCAS
23-79
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

 
TABLE OF CONTENTS
B737-300/400/500 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION SELF-PACED
ATA-24

ELECTRICAL POWER SYSTEM ............................................................................................................................ 2


Overview..................................................................................................................................................... 2
AC EXTERNAL POWER ........................................................................................................................................ 4
Overview..................................................................................................................................................... 4
APPLYING ELECTRICAL POWER ......................................................................................................................... 6
Overview..................................................................................................................................................... 6
Supply External Power to the Buses........................................................................................................... 6
Remove External Power from the Buses..................................................................................................... 9
Supply External Power to the Ground Service Buses Only ....................................................................... 11
Remove External Power from the Ground Service Buses Only ................................................................. 13
Supply APU Generator Power to the Buses .............................................................................................. 14
Remove APU Generator Power from the Buses Fig. 201........................................................................... 16
AC GENERATOR DRIVE SYSTEM....................................................................................................................... 18
Overview (Configuration 1 Constant Speed Drives CSD) .......................................................................... 18
Generator Drive Disconnect ...................................................................................................................... 20
Overview (Configuration 2 Variable Speed Constant Frequency Generator/Converters VSCF) ................. 22
Generator Manual Controls....................................................................................................................... 24
Generator Control Relay (GCR) ................................................................................................................. 25
Generator Control Unit (GCU) ................................................................................................................... 26
Test Module and Annunciator Lights Module ........................................................................................... 26
DC GENERATION SYSTEM ................................................................................................................................ 28
Overview................................................................................................................................................... 28
Transformer - Rectifier (T-R) Units ......................................................................................................... 30
Storage Battery......................................................................................................................................... 31
Battery Charger ........................................................................................................................................ 32
DC System Meters.................................................................................................................................... 33
DC Annunciator Lights.............................................................................................................................. 33
STANDBY POWER SYSTEM.............................................................................................................................. 36
Overview................................................................................................................................................... 36
Static Inverter........................................................................................................................................... 38
Voltage Sensor Module............................................................................................................................. 38
Standby Power Switch.............................................................................................................................. 38
Battery Switch .......................................................................................................................................... 38
Standby Power Relays .............................................................................................................................. 38
Standby Power Off Light .......................................................................................................................... 38

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-24 Page 1


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

ELECTRICAL POWER SYSTEM


Overview

The electrical power system consists of 28-volt DC, 28-volt AC, and 115-volt AC systems.

AC Electrical Power

Three isolated generators supply 115/200-volt, 3-phase, 400-Hz power. These generators are the primary
sources of power for the main ac buses and the whole electrical power system. Two generators are driven by
the engines and one generator is driven by the auxiliary power unit (APU).

External power, provided via the external power receptacle, supplies 115/200-volt, 3-phase, 400-Hz power.

Transformers provide power to the 28-volt AC buses by reducing 115-volt AC power to 28-volt AC power.
Transformers are on shields J4 and J5.

A static inverter converts 28-volt DC battery power to 115-volt AC power. It supplies the flight critical loads on
the AC standby bus when the primary power sources are off. The static inverter is in the electronics
compartment on the electrical equipment shelf.

DC Electrical Power

Three transformer-rectifier (T-R) units provide 28-volt DC power by converting 115-volt AC power to 28-volt
DC power. T-R units are on electrical equipment shelf E3-1.

A battery provides 28-volt DC power to start the APU. Loads on the battery bus are powered by the battery
when other power sources are de-energized. The battery is in electrical equipment area near the electrical
equipment shelves.

ATA-24 Page 2 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE

 
B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization

AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource


 

 
 
GENERATOR
GENERATOR EXTERNAL POWER EXTERNAL POWER 2 ENGINE 2
ENGINE 1 GENERATOR
1 CONTACTOR 1 CONTACTOR 2
GENERATOR BREAKER 2
BREAKER 1

APU GENERATOR APU GENERATOR


BREAKER 1 BREAKER 2

AUXILIARY
APU
POWER
GENERATOR
115V AC 115V AC 115V AC UNIT 115V AC 115V AC
MAIN BUS 1 GEN BUS 1 EXT AC BUS 1 AC EXT PWR GEN BUS 2 MAIN BUS 2
RECEPTACLE

R6 R4
NORM ALT GROUND TRANSFER
R3 SERVICE
ALT NORM
TRANSFER 1
115V AC
GRD SERVICE
FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY

BUSSES R89
BATTERY CHARGER
TRANSFER

115V AC 115V AC 115V AC


115V AC 115V AC TRANSFER
TRANSFER ELEX BUS 2
STANDBY BUS ELEX BUS 1 BUS 1 BUS 2
BATTERY
OVERHEAT
WDM
24-31-21
28V AC 28V AC 28V AC 28V AC 28V AC
APU START TRANSFER
BUS 1 TRANSFER GRD SERVICE INTERLOCK BUS 2
BUS 1 BUSSES BUS 2

R37
STANDBY POWER
AUTO

EXT PWR
STATIC TRANSFORMER BATTERY TRANSFORMER TRANSFORMER
TRANSFORMER BATTERY
INVERTER RECTIFIER 1 WDM CHARGER RECTIFIER 2 RECTIFIER 3
RECTIFIER 1
24-34-01
INVERTER R9 TR 3
CONTROL DISCONNECT
R328
STANDBY POWER
TRANSFER MANUAL

28V DC 28V DC 28V DC SWITCHED 28V DC 28V DC 28V DC 28V DC


28V DC BUS 1 ELEX BUS 1 HOT BAT. BUS R41 HOT BAT BUS BATTERY BUS BUS 2 ELEX BUS 2
STANDBY BUS GEN PWR
CONTROL
BATTERY BUS
R356 RELAYS WDM
STANDBY 24-56-01
AIR
POWER OFF
DC EXT PWR
GRD RECEPTACLE
ATA-24 Page 3

and Systems Introduction


 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

AC EXTERNAL POWER
Overview

AC external power, when provided to the external power receptacle, can power the entire electrical power
system or only the ground service buses. The components of the AC external power system are the external
power panel, bus protection panel, external power contactors, external power relay, ground service relay, and
manual control devices.

External Power Panel

The external power panel P19 is forward and right of the nose wheel well. The external power receptacle and
EXTERNAL POWER CONN and NOT IN USE lights are in the external power panel.

The external power receptacle has four long pins, for connecting phases A, B, C, and N, and two short pins, for
connecting the DC control interlock. If external power is removed from the receptacle while energized, the
interlock is opened and the electrical system is de-energized, preventing arcing at panel P19.

External Power Distribution

External power provides 115-volt, 3-phase, 400-Hz power to airplane power system when the GRD PWR switch
is set to ON or to the ground service buses when the GROUND SERVICE switch is set to ON.

External power provides power directly to the lavatory mirror lights and the refueling power select relay R10.
Relay, contactor, and switch settings do not control this power distribution.

Power to refueling power select relay is from the external power T-R and ground to the relay is from the BPP.
When external power is connected to the receptacle and there are no faults, the relay is energized. The closed
relay completes the circuit to power the fuel quantity gages and opens the battery charger mode control.

ATA-24 Page 4 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Bus Protection Panel (BPP)

The bus protection panel (BPP) is in the P6 panel. The BPP provides control and protection for the external
power system. The external power T-R, in the BPP, changes 115-volt AC external power to 28-volt DC power.

The BPP protects against over-voltage (130 ±3 volts), under-voltage (100 ±3 volts), and negative sequence
voltage. The BPP trips the external power contactors when a fault is detected. The BPP also has anti-cycling
protection, which prevents the external power system from cycling when a fault exists and a manual control
device is held to ON.
EXTERNAL
GROUND
GRD POWER
POWER SW AVAILABLE

100 100
50 150 GRD 50 150
AC PWR AC
0 A M P E R E S200 ON 0 A M P E R E S200

OFF

GRD PWR Switch

The GRD PWR switch is three-position, momentary, and spring-loaded to the center position. Setting the
switch to ON opens GBs closes EPCs, and deactivates GROUND SERVICE switch. Setting the switch to OFF
opens EPCs.

GROUND SERVICE Switch

The GROUND SERVICE switch is two-position, solenoid-held to ON, and spring-loaded to OFF. Setting the
switch to ON closes the ground service relay and activates the solenoid, holding the switch to ON. The switch
cannot be held to ON if the GRD PWR switch is set to ON. Setting the switch to OFF will open the solenoid
and ground service relay. The switch automatically trips to OFF when the BPP signals EPCs to close or when
the EPCs close.

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-24 Page 5


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

 
APPLYING ELECTRICAL POWER
Overview

We will be covering the fowling procedures:

• Supply external power to the buses

• Remove external power from the buses

• Supply power to the ground service buses only

• Remove power from the ground service buses only

• Supply the APU generator power to the buses

• Remove the APU generator power from the buses

Each procedure that removes power gives instructions to move the BAT switch to the OFF position. If you let
the BAT switch stay in the ON position without ac power, the electrical power of the battery will decrease. The
electrical power of the battery can decrease at a rate of 30 to 40 amps. At this rate, the battery will have no
electrical power after one to two hours.

When the external air temperature is more than 100°F (37.8°C), electrical equipment can become too hot. If
you supply electrical power for more than 20 minutes, you should supply conditioned air to keep the electrical
equipment cool.

Supply External Power to the Buses

The airplane has an external power receptacle near the nose wheel well. You will connect external AC power
to the receptacle to connect electrical power to the buses.

Access Location Zone - Lower Nose Compartment, Access Panel External, Power Receptacle Door

ATA-24 Page 6 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

WARNING: MAKE SURE THE EXTERNAL POWER SUPPLY OPERATES CORRECTLY BEFORE YOU
SUPPLY EXTERNAL POWER TO THE AIRPLANE. IF THE EXTERNAL POWER SUPPLY
HAS AN EARTH GROUNDED NEUTRAL, THERE MUST NOT BE AN OPEN OR
FLOATING GROUND IN THE NEUTRAL CIRCUIT WIRING OF THE SUPPLY OR THE
AIRPLANE. IF AN OPEN OR FLOATING GROUND IS PRESENT, THE AIRPLANE CAN
BE PUT AT AN ELECTRICAL POTENTIAL ABOVE THE EARTH GROUND. THIS
ELECTRICAL POTENTIAL CAN RESULT IN ELECTRIC SHOCK WITH POSSIBLE SEVERE
INJURY TO PERSONNEL WHO CONTACT THE AIRPLANE. IF THE GROUND RETURN
(NEUTRAL) CIRCUIT ON THE EXTERNAL POWER SUPPLY, OR THE EXTERNAL POWER
RECEPTACLE, DOES NOT OPERATE CORRECTLY, REPAIR THE EXTERNAL POWER
SUPPLY OR INSPECT THE EXTERNAL POWER RECEPTACLE NEUTRAL GROUND.

WARNING: MAKE SURE THAT THE ELECTRICAL SYSTEM IS CLEAR OF OTHER PERSONS
BEFORE YOU SUPPLY POWER TO THE AIRPLANE. HIGH VOLTAGES CAN CAUSE
INJURIES.

Open the door for the external power receptacle.

Examine the external power supply cord and the airplane external power supply receptacle before you connect
the external power supply to the receptacle. If you find excessive arc erosion, corrosion and heat damage or
discoloration to the pins or receptacles, repair the problems that you find.

WARNING: REMOVE THE ELECTRICAL POWER FROM THE POWER CABLE BEFORE YOU PUT THE
POWER CABLE INTO THE EXTERNAL POWER RECEPTACLE. ELECTRICAL ARCS CAN
CAUSE INJURIES.

Put the connector of the power cable into the external power receptacle on the P19 panel.

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-24 Page 7


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Energize the power cable.

Make sure the EXTERNAL POWER CONN light on the P19 panel comes on.

NOTE: The NOT IN USE light will not come on if the refuel panel door is open.

EXTERNAL
INTERPHONE
POWER

CONN FLIGHT SERVICE

NOSE
PILOT WHEEL WELL
ON
NORM
NOT CALL LIGHT
IN USE

Make sure that the GRD POWER AVAILABLE light on the P5 panel comes on.

Make sure that the BUS TRANS switch on the P5 panel is in the AUTO position.

Make sure that the STANDBY POWER switch on the P5 panel is in the AUTO position.

ATA-24 Page 8 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

 
Move the BAT switch on the P5 panel to
the ON position.

Make sure that these lights above the GEN 1


and GEN 2 switches on the P5 panel come on:

TRANSFER BUS OFF light


BUS OFF light
GEN OFF BUS light

Supply power to the buses:

Move the AC meter selector switch on the


P5 panel to the GRD PWR position.

Make sure that the voltmeter shows 115 ±5 volts AC.

Make sure that the frequency meter shows 400 ± 5 Hz.

Supply power to 115-volt AC generator bus 1


and 115-volt AC generator bus 2:

Move the GRD PWR switch on the P5 panel


to the ON position.

Make sure that the NOT IN USE light on the P19 go off.

Make sure that the TRANSFER BUS OFF and


BUS OFF lights on the P5 panel go off.

Remove External Power from the Buses

Move the GRD PWR switch on the P5 panel to


the OFF position.

Make sure that the TRANSFER BUS OFF


and BUS OFF lights on the P5 panel come on.

Move the BAT switch on the P5 panel to


the OFF position.

Make sure that the TRANSFER BUS OFF


and BUS OFF lights on the P5 panel go off.

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-24 Page 9


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

 
Make sure that the NOT IN USE light on the P19 panel comes on.

EXTERNAL
INTERPHONE
POWER

CONN FLIGHT SERVICE

NOSE
PILOT WHEEL WELL
ON
NORM
NOT CALL LIGHT
IN USE

Turn the DC meter switch on the P5-13 panel to the TR1 position.

NOTE: The electrical power of the battery will decrease, if the DC meter switch stays in the
BAT position for too much time.

WARNING: REMOVE THE ELECTRICAL POWER FROM THE POWER CABLE BEFORE YOU REMOVE
THE POWER CABLE FROM THE EXTERNAL POWER RECEPTACLE. ELECTRICAL ARCS
CAN CAUSE INJURIES.

Remove power from the external power cable.

Remove the power cable from the external power receptacle.

Make sure that the EXTERNAL POWER CONN and NOT IN USE lights on the P19 panel go off.

Make sure that the GRD POWER AVAILABLE light on the P5 panel goes off.

Close the door for the external power receptacle.

ATA-24 Page 10 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Supply External Power to the Ground Service Buses Only

Ground service buses energize ground service circuits (such as ceiling lights and service outlets). This
procedure energizes only the ground service buses.

The airplane has an external power receptacle near the nose wheel well. You will connect external AC power
to the receptacle to connect electrical power to the ground service buses.

Access Lower Nose Compartment, External Power Receptacle Door

WARNING: MAKE SURE THAT THE ELECTRICAL SYSTEM IS CLEAR OF OTHER PERSONS
BEFORE YOU SUPPLY POWER TO THE AIRPLANE. HIGH VOLTAGES CAN CAUSE
INJURIES.

Open the door for the external power receptacle.

WARNING: REMOVE THE ELECTRICAL POWER FROM THE POWER CABLE BEFORE YOU PUT THE
POWER CABLE INTO THE EXTERNAL POWER RECEPTACLE. ELECTRICAL ARCS CAN
CAUSE INJURIES.

Install the power cable.

Energize the power cable.

Make sure the EXTERNAL POWER CONN light on the P19 panel come on.

EXTERNAL
INTERPHONE
POWER

CONN FLIGHT SERVICE

NOSE
PILOT WHEEL WELL
ON
NORM
NOT CALL LIGHT
IN USE

NOTE: The NOT IN USE light will not come on if the re-fuel panel door is open.

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-24 Page 11


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

 
Make sure that the GRD POWER AVAILABLE
light on the P5 panel come on.

Make sure that the BUS TRANS switch on the


P5 panel is in the AUTO position.

Make sure the GRD PWR switch on the P5 panel


is in the OFF position.

NOTE: When the GRD PWR switch


is in the ON position, the
GROUND SERVICE switch
does not operate.

Move the GROUND SERVICE switch on the forward attendant's panel (P13) to the ON position.

NNECTED
NLY ON
GRD 10 RISE 20

0 30 LIGHTS OFF DIM


80 IN 120 BRT ON ON BRT NIGHT BRT
40 160 DIM DIM
GEN DRIVE
OFF OFF OFF OFF
OIL TEMP
ENTRY WORK GROUND WINDOW CEILING
°C SERVICE
MUSIC
CALL SYSTEM
POWER
OFF
ILABLE
CAPTAIN ATTENDANT RESET
100
GRD 50 150

ATA-24 Page 12 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Remove External Power from the Ground Service Buses Only

Move the GROUND SERVICE switch on the forward attendant's panel (P13) to the OFF position.
GROUND
SERVICE
SWITCH

LIGHTS OFF DIM


BRT ON ON BRT NIGHT BRT
DIM DIM

OFF OFF OFF OFF


ENTRY WORK GROUND WINDOW CEILING
SERVICE
MUSIC
CALL SYSTEM

OFF
CAPTAIN ATTENDANT RESET

WARNING: REMOVE THE ELECTRICAL POWER FROM THE POWER CABLE BEFORE YOU REMOVE
THE POWER CABLE FROM THE EXTERNAL POWER RECEPTACLE. ELECTRICAL ARCS
CAN CAUSE INJURIES.

Remove power from the external power cable.

Remove the power cable from the external power receptacle.

Make sure that the EXTERNAL POWER CONN and NOT IN USE lights on the P19 panel go off.

Make sure that the GRD POWER AVAILABLE light on the P5 panel goes off.

Close the door for the external power receptacle. EXTERNAL


INTERPHONE
POWER

CONN FLIGHT SERVICE

NOSE
PILOT WHEEL WELL
ON
NORM
NOT CALL LIGHT
IN USE

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-24 Page 13


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Supply APU Generator Power to the Buses

You can use APU power for these (if the airplane is on the ground):

1. 115-volt AC generator bus 1


2. 115-volt AC generator bus 2

WARNING: MAKE SURE THAT THE ELECTRICAL SYSTEM IS CLEAR OF OTHER PERSONS BEFORE
YOU SUPPLY POWER TO THE AIRPLANE. HIGH VOLTAGES CAN CAUSE INJURIES.

CAUTION: KEEP TO A LIMIT THE CONTINUOUS CURRENT DRAIN FROM THE GENERATOR TO 150
AMPS. TOO MUCH CURRENT CAN CAUSE DAMAGE TO THE GENERATOR.

Turn the BAT switch on the electrical systems control panel, P5,
to ON.

Make sure that the BUS TRANS switch on the P5-4 panel is in
the AUTO position.

Make sure that the STANDBY POWER switch on the P5-5 panel
is in the AUTO position.

Push the APU GEN No. 1 or No. 2 switch momentarily to ON.

Start the APU.

Make sure that the TRANSFER BUS OFF, BUS OFF,


and GEN OFF BUS lights on the panel P5 come on.

NOTE: The lights are above the GEN 1 and GEN 2 switches.

Make sure that the APU GEN OFF BUS light on the panel P5
comes on after 15-30 seconds.

NOTE: The APU will have usual speed in 15-30 seconds.

ATA-24 Page 14 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

 
Turn the AC meter selector switch on the panel P5 to APU GEN.

Make sure that the voltmeter shows 115 ± 5 volts AC.

Make sure the CPS FREQ meter shows:

GTCP85-129 APU; UNLOADED 405-410 Hz, LOADED 397-417 Hz. GTCP36-280 APU; UNLOADED 395-405 Hz,
LOADED 395-405 Hz. APS2000 APU; UNLOADED 395-405 Hz, LOADED 395-405 Hz.

OLDER AIRCRAFT NEWER AIRCRAFT

Put the APU GEN No. 1 switch on the panel P5 to ON.

NOTE: This will supply power to the AC generator bus 1.

Put the APU GEN No. 2 switch on the panel P5 to ON.

NOTE: This will supply power to the AC generator bus 2.

Make sure that the TRANSFER BUS OFF, BUS OFF, and APU GEN OFF BUS lights on the panel P5 go off.

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-24 Page 15


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Remove APU Generator Power from the Buses Fig. 201

WARNING: MAKE SURE THAT THE ELECTRICAL SYSTEM IS CLEAR OF OTHER PERSONS BEFORE YOU
SUPPLY POWER TO THE AIRPLANE. HIGH VOLTAGES CAN CAUSE INJURIES.

Put the two APU GEN switches to OFF.

Make sure that the TRANSFER BUS OFF, BUS OFF,


and APU GEN OFF BUS lights on the panel P5 come on.

Stop the APU.

Turn the BAT switch on the panel P5 to the OFF position.

Turn the DC meter switch on the P5-13 panel to the TR1 position.

OLDER AIRCRAFT NEWER AIRCRAFT

NOTE: The electrical power of the battery will decrease, if the DC meter switch stays in the
BAT position for too much time.

ATA-24 Page 16 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-24 Page 17


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

AC GENERATOR DRIVE SYSTEM


Overview (Configuration 1 Constant Speed Drives CSD)

The two engine-driven generators are driven by constant speed drives to obtain a generator speed of 6000
RPM. The drive is a mechanical, differential, hydraulically controlled unit attached to the engine accessory
gearbox. The drive supports the ac generator.

Manual control, monitoring lights and dial indicators for the drives are on the forward overhead panel in the
control cabin. Lights indicate drive low oil pressure and high oil temperature. Dial indicator show drive oil-in
temperature or drive oil-rise temperature, which is determined by DRIVE TEMP switch setting. Charge
pressure, oil-in temperature, and oil-out temperature sensors are in the drive. A disconnect switch controls an
electrical solenoid-operated mechanical disconnect in the drive unit.

The oil in the drive unit absorbs heat, lubricates, and transmits torque as the hydraulic medium. The normal
temperature rise of the oil through the drive unit is about 10°C at continuous full load with an inlet oil
temperature of 120°C at normal input speeds.

The input shaft accepts torque supplied by the engine at various speeds and delivers torque to the input end
of the planetary differential gear unit in the drive. Depending on the difference between output speed and
6000 RPM, the variable displacement hydraulic unit will boost or retard the speed of the planetary differential
output gear to maintain a 6000 RPM output speed, as required by the governor.

Each engine-driven generator is supported by and driven through an in-line, variable ratio drive unit which
transmits the torque to drive the generator at a constant speed from the variable speed accessory drive pad on
the airplane engine. The drive unit or constant speed drive (CSD) is attached to the engine with a quick-
attach-detach (QAD) device consisting of three interlocking threaded rings. The CSD output end attaches to
the AC generator by means of 12 studs. The generator mounting nuts only need to be loosened to remove the
generator. The accessory mounted ring of the QAD device is attached to the drive unit with screws. The
engine-mounted ring is fastened to the accessory drive pad on the engine with screws.

Heat generated within the drive causes the drive oil temperature to rise. The scavenge pump forces the heated
oil through the scavenge or line oil filter then through the external oil cooler and into the all-attitude reservoir.
The oil is cooled by fan air from the engine passing over the inside portion of the cooler. A line oil filter,
which filters scavenge oil, is in the oil out line between the drive unit and the CSD oil cooler. The filter
prevents contamination of the oil cooler in the event of drive failure.

ATA-24 Page 18 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

CONSTANT
SPEED
DRIVE QAD
RING

ACCESSORY
LINE OIL FILTER
GEARBOX

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-24 Page 19


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Generator Drive Disconnect

The CSD disconnect is an electrically-actuated device which disconnects the input shaft from the input spline
shaft. When the disconnect solenoid is activated, a spring-loaded pawl moves into contact with threads on the
input shaft.

The input shaft acts as a screw in a threaded hole, and input rotation causes the input shaft to move away
from the input spline shaft, separating the driving dogs on the two shafts. When the driving dogs have been
separated, the input spline shaft, which is still being driven by the aircraft engine, spins freely in the
transmission without causing transmission rotation. Reset may be accomplished only on the ground, following
engine shutdown, by pulling out on the reset handle until the solenoid nose pin snaps into position.

DOG TOOTH CLUTCH


SEPARATION POINT

RESET SPRING

INPUT SHAFT

INPUT SPLINE
SHAFT

THREADED PAWL

INPUT GEAR
NOSE PIN

SOLENOID

PAWL
SPRING

HANDLE
SPRING

TRANSMISSION CASE

RESET HANDLE

ATA-24 Page 20 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-24 Page 21


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Overview (Configuration 2 Variable Speed Constant Frequency Generator/Converters VSCF)

The AC generator drive system changes shaft energy from the engine to electrical power for the airplane.

These are the components of the AC generator drive system:

1. The variable speed constant frequency (VSCF) generator/converter


2. The oil cooler
3. The line oil filter
4. The quick attach-detach (QAD) ring
5. The oil overheat switch

Variable Speed Constant Frequency Generator/Converter changes mechanical energy from a variable speed
shaft on the accessory gearbox to constant frequency electrical power.

The VSCF is on the left side of the engine at the 8 o'clock position. A quick attach-detatch (QAD) adapter kit
holds the VSCF to the front of the accessory gearbox.

The VSCF is interchangeable with the constant speed drive and generator assembly.

The VSCF weighs approximately 140 pounds (63.5 kg).

There is a sight glass on the gearbox. The sight glass lets you see the oil level in the VSCF.

The heat exchanger lets cool air from the engine fan remove the heat from the oil in the VSCF.

ATA-24 Page 22 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

VSCF
GENERATOR/
CONVERTER LINE OIL FILTER
SEE A AND OIL COOLER
SEE B

ENGINE
OIL TANK
(REF)
STARTER
OIL
(REF)
OVERHEAT
SWITCH

QAD
RING
LINE OIL
FILTER
VSCF
GENERATOR/CONVERTER
ACCESSORY
GEARBOX
OIL COOLER

FWD FWD

ENGINE - LEFT SIDE ENGINE - RIGHT SIDE


A B

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-24 Page 23


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Generator Manual Controls

Manual controls and monitoring devices for the electrical power system are on the forward overhead panel P5.
The switches for latching contactors are momentary. There is an AC ammeter for each engine. The DC
ammeter, DC voltmeter, AC voltmeter, and frequency meter monitor various systems as determined by the
selector switches below the meters.

OLDER AIRCRAFT NEWER AIRCRAFT

ATA-24 Page 24 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Generator Control Relay (GCR)

The generator field control relay (GCR), in the generator control unit (GCU), energizes the generator field. The
GCR and the generator field circuit are normally closed. The GCRs may be opened or closed by the GEN
switches on the pilot's forward overhead panel or opened by signals from the GCU protective circuits.

With the GCR closed, the generator voltage will build up with engine or APU speed and the voltmeter and
frequency meter will read approximately 115-volts and 400 Hz at normal speed. The GCR trips with the
generator breaker (GB) from differential fault or abnormal voltage and any time the generator switch is moved
to OFF.

If an engine or APU is started with the GCR tripped or open, the generator voltage will not build up with engine
speed, the voltmeter will not indicate at normal engine speed, and the frequency meter will read low. Moving
the generator switch to ON before engine start will close a tripped GCR and ensure voltage buildup during
engine acceleration. Moving the generator switch to ON after the engine is running will close a tripped GCR,
causing the voltage to build up and the generator breaker to close, connecting the generator to the bus.

BUS TRANS
O A
TRANSFER F U TRANSFER
BUS OFF F T BUS OFF
O
BUS BUS
OFF OFF
GEN OFF APU GEN GEN OFF
BUS OFF BUS BUS

OFF OFF

ON ON
GEN 1 APU GEN GEN 2
APU

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-24 Page 25


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Generator Control Unit (GCU)

The generator control unit (GCU) provides automatic operation of the control functions for each generator
system and provides signals to open the generator field by tripping the GCR and to trip the generator breaker.

The GCU controls the DC voltage indicator, generator breaker, field relay, bus voltage, and underspeed
conditions.

The GCU protects the generator system from overvoltage, undervoltage, overfrequency, underfrequency, and
feeder faults (differential and overcurrent).

Overvoltage, undervoltage, and feeder faults are indicated on the M238 annunciator panel.

Test Module and Annunciator Lights Module

The power system test module M400 is a switch panel for testing the airplane power system with current
transformer selecting relays and portable meter jacks. It permits measuring DC voltages and current values,
and AC voltages, current values and frequency at various electrical system component connections throughout
the electrical system. The module is at the top of the load control center panel P6. Calibrated portable meters
may be connected to check the accuracy of meters on the pilots' overhead panel P5.

ATA-24 Page 26 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-24 Page 27


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

DC GENERATION SYSTEM
Overview

115-volt AC power is converted to 28-volt DC power by three transformer-rectifier (T-R) units. A battery is
used as a standby power supply for certain essential circuits and for short period DC loads when no basic
power source is available. Other components of the DC generation system are the battery charger, DC system
meters, DC annunciator lights, and the DC external power receptacle.

T-R 1 provides power to 28-volt DC bus 1 and T-R 2 provides power to 28-volt DC bus 2. T-R 3 provides
power to 28-volt DC bat bus through bat bus relay R1 and bat bus relay manual R326; T-R 3 also provides
power to 28-volt DC bus 1 through diode M1220 and energized contact of T-R 3 disconnect relay R9; and T-R 3
provides power to 28-volt DC bus 2 through diode M1220.

When the battery switch, located on the P5 panel, is set to the ON position, the GEN POWER CONTROL relay
closes connecting the battery to the HOT SWITCHED BATTERY BUS.

When the STANDBY POWER switch is set to BAT, relay R326 is energized, and the battery provides power to
the 28-volt DC bat bus.

ATA-24 Page 28 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE

 
B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization

AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource


FROM 115V AC GND FROM 115V AC
SERVICE BUS MAIN BUS 2
 

 
 
BATTERY
CHARGER
TRANSFER

WDM 24-31-21 WDM 24-31-21


BAT OVHT BATTERY
& APU START CHARGER
INTERLOCK CONTROL MODE

FROM 115V AC
DC EXT
FROM 115V AC FROM 115V AC 1 TRANSFER FROM 115V AC
POWER
TRANSFER BUS 1 EXT PWR BUS BUS 2 MAIN BUS 2
RECEPTACLE

EXT PWR BATTERY


TRU 1 BATTERY TRU 2 TRU 3
FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY

TRU 1 CHARGER

R9
TR 3
DISCONNECT

R41
GEN PWR
CONTRA
28V DC 28V DC 28V DC SWITCHED 28V DC 28V DC 28V DC 28V DC
BUS 1 ELEX BUS 1 HOT BAT BUS HOT BAT BUS BAT BUS BUS 2 ELEX BUS 2

BAT SWITCH
ON P5 (ON
POS- CONNECTS WDM STANDBY POWER
SWITCHED HOT 24-56-01 SWITCH ON P5
BAT BUS TO BATTERY (BAT POS- CONNECTS
BATTERY) BUS RELAYS HOT BAT BUS &
28V DC BAT BUS)
ATA-24 Page 29

1 IF INSTALLED

and Systems Introduction


 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Transformer - Rectifier (T-R) Units

The three T-R units are in the electronic compartment on shelf E3-1. T-R 1 and 2 receive 3-phase, 115-volt AC
power from transfer buses 1 and 2, respectively. T-R 3 is fed from main bus 2, and provides power through
DC tie bus to 28-volt DC buses 1 and 2. The three T-R units each have an output rating of 50 amps at 28-volts
DC.

ATA-24 Page 30 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Storage Battery

A 40 amp-hour nickel-cadmium storage battery is in the lower forward compartment outboard of the electronic
compartment access door. The battery is charged from a charger adjacent to T-R 3 on shelf E3-1 of the
electrical rack.

BATTERY CASE
COVER

BATTERY
SEE A

ELECTRONIC
COMPARTMENT
ACCESS DOOR

THERMOSTAT

BATTERY CASE

BATTERY
RECEPTACLE

THERMOSTAT
ASSEMBLY
CONNECTOR

20-CELL 40-AMP HR SAFT BATTERY


A

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-24 Page 31


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Battery Charger

The battery charger is a regulated system to charge nickel-cadmium storage batteries. It operates from 115-
volt, 400-Hz, 3-phase power.

The battery charger is on shelf E3-1 in the electronic compartment. The battery charger is capable of charging
a completely discharged battery to 100 percent charge state within 75 minutes. The battery charger operates
in the charge mode or in the transformer-rectifier (T-R) mode.

In the transformer-rectifier (T-R) mode, the charge provides 28-volts DC to maintain battery charge, and meets
load demands on the battery bus. Internal current limiting circuitry reduces the output voltage to limit current
to 60 amps.

In the charge mode, the battery charger delivers a constant current of 38 amps to the battery. The output
voltage will vary with battery state-of-charge and load resistance. When battery voltage reaches a threshold
voltage, charging stops. The threshold voltage is automatically temperature adjusted by a temperature sensor
in the battery.

Input power to the battery charger is from the 115-volt AC ground service bus or, if this bus loses power, from
the 115-volt AC main bus 2.

The APU start interlock relay R39 is used to lock the battery charger in TR (constant voltage) mode while the
APU starter motor is turning.

The battery overheat function is contained in the battery charger. The battery charger monitors the temperature
sensor in the battery. If the battery temperature exceeds 145°F the battery charger will stop supplying 28-volts
DC to the battery. When the battery temperature drops below 130°F, the battery charger will automatically
begin supplying 28-volts DC to the battery.

BATTERY CHARGER

E3-1 RACK

ELECTRONIC
COMPARTMENT
ACCESS DOOR

ATA-24 Page 32 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

DC System Meters

A dc ammeter and voltmeter are on the forward overhead panel P5. The ammeter operates in conjunction with
shunts in the output circuits of the three T-R units. The ammeter may be used to determine current drain on
the battery and to observe the performance of the battery charger.

The meters display amps and volts of the standby power, battery bus (volts only), battery, T-R 1, T-R 2, and
T-R 3, which is determined by the setting of S956 DC selector switch on panel P5. Setting the switch to TEST
connects the voltmeter to the M400 Power System Test Module.

DC Annunciator Lights

Lights on the Annunciator Lights Module M238 will illuminate when power is on the 28-volt DC bus 1, 28-volt
DC bus 2, 28-volt DC standby bus, and 28-volt DC bat bus; when the external power T-R is energized; and
when T-R 3 has output power. The INDICATE/TEST switch S2 on the module must be set to INDICATE in
order for the lights to illuminate.

When the INDICATE-TEST switch is set to TEST, all the lights except EXT PWR TR are grounded and
connected to the 28-volt DC bat bus. The EXT PWR TR light, which is always connected to 28-volt DC hot bat
bus, is grounded. This verifies that all lamps in the M238 module are operable.

OLDER AIRCRAFT NEWER AIRCRAFT

DC METERS

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-24 Page 33


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

DC ANNUNCIATOR LIGHTS

ATA-24 Page 34 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-24 Page 35


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

STANDBY POWER SYSTEM


Overview

The standby system is used to supply power to essential AC and DC systems. Under normal conditions (in
flight), the standby power switch is in the AUTO position, the standby AC bus is energized from the 115-volt
transfer bus No. 1, and the standby DC bus is energized from DC bus No. 1. In the event of losing either the
AC or DC normal power, the auto standby power relay (R37) is deactivated, connecting the DC standby bus to
the battery bus and connecting the AC standby bus to the static inverter.

During checkout of the system on the ground, or refueling the aircraft on battery power only, the standby
system is activated by placing the standby power switch in the BAT position. This activates the manual
standby power relay (R328) which connects the DC standby bus to the battery bus and the AC standby bus to
the static inverter.

The AC standby power bus is a single-phase, 115-volt AC power source which is used to supply 400-Hz power
to essential AC systems. A static inverter, energized by 28 volts DC from the storage battery through the
battery bus, is the alternate source of single-phase, 400-Hz, 115-volt power to the AC standby bus. The power
is used for essential communication and navigation equipment, so that the pilot's essential flight instruments
will not be deactivated in the event all 400-Hz generated power becomes unavailable during flight.

Components of the standby power system are the voltage sensor module, static inverter, standby power switch,
battery switch, standby power relays, and the standby power off light.

Power to the AC standby power bus is received from 115-volt AC transfer bus 1 through energized relay R37
and relaxed relay R328. Relay R37 receives power from the 28-volt DC bus 1 and is grounded through
transistor Q1 and standby power switch in AUTO position. Transistor Q1 is biased to ground when the voltage
of 115-volt AC transfer bus 1 is 100 volts or more.

When the DC bus 1 loses power or the 115-volt AC transfer bus 1 voltage is less than 100 volts AC, Q1 is
unbiased, R37 relaxes and connects the inverter output through normally closed contacts in R37 and R328 to
the 115-volt AC standby bus.

With the STANDBY POWER switch the BAT position, R328 is energized by the hot battery bus and connects the
inverter output to the AC standby bus.

The standby power off light L5 comes on when standby power indication light relay R330 relaxes, indicating the
loss of power on the standby bus.

With the STANDBY POWER switch in the OFF position the system is de-energized.

ATA-24 Page 36 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE

 
B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization

AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource


 

 
 
TO STANDBY
28V DC HORIZON
BAT BUS INDICATOR
STANDBY
POWER BATTERY

28V DC 28V DC
BUS 1 STANDBY BUS
STANDBY
POWER TR
115V AC 115V AC
TRANS BUS 1 STANDBY BUS
STANDBY BUS
POWER AC
28V DC
BUS 1
STBY PWR
RELAY
AUTO R37 STANDBY
R328 STANDBY
CONTROL IN SENSE
POWER AUTO
POWER MANUAL R389
INVERTER
FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY

VOLTAGE OUT TO R327 CONTROL RELAY


SENSOR
Q1

VOLTAGE SENSOR
28V DC
HOT BAT
BUS BAT BUS ELECTRICAL SHELF
CONTROL
MANUAL

R397 AUX STANDBY


28V DC POWER AUTO
BAT BUS AUTO BAT
INVERTER
OUT (115 VAC)
CONTROL

28V DC S4 STANDBY POWER SWITCH


IN (28 VDC)
BAT BUS
INVERTER STATIC INVERTER
POWER MASTER DIM
AND TEST
E3-1 ELECTRICAL SHELF
OFF
R3 (NORMAL)
R356 TRANSFER 1
STANDBY A
AIR POWER OFF ON
R38 L5 STANDBY POWER OFF LIGHT
BATTERY
AIR/GRD
SWITCH
GRD
P5 PANEL
28V DC
HOT BAT
BUS STANDBY
POWER
IND LIGHT
R330 STANDBY AC STANDBY
POWER IND BUS INDICATION
LIGHT 1 R397 INSTALLED ONLY ON DLH D-ABXA THRU D-ABXL
P6 LOAD CONTROL CENTER RIGHT
ATA-24 Page 37

and Systems Introduction


 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Static Inverter

The static inverter converts 28-volt DC power to 115-volt AC power. It can supply 1000 watts of power to the
AC standby bus. The static inverter is energized whenever the battery switch is set to ON. The static inverter
is on electrical equipment shelf E3-1.

Voltage Sensor Module

The voltage sensor module receives power from 28-volt DC bus 1 and senses power from 115-volt AC transfer
bus 1. When either power source fails, the voltage sensor signals standby power relay auto R37 to de-
energize, which connects static inverter output to 115-volt AC standby power bus. The voltage sensor module
is in panel P6.

Standby Power Switch

The standby power switch on panel P5 arms the standby power system when set to AUTO, activates the
standby power system when set to BAT, and deactivates the system when set to OFF.

Battery Switch

The battery switch on panel P5, when set to ON, energizes the battery bus, which provides power to the
standby power system, and provides power to the standby power off light.

Standby Power Relays

Standby power relay auto R37, standby power relay manual R328, auxiliary power standby auto relay R397 (if
installed), standby power off relay R356, and standby power IND light relay R330 are in panel P6. Standby
power relay manual directs static inverter output power to the115-volt AC standby power bus. Standby power
relay auto directs either static inverter output power or the 115-volt AC transfer bus power to the 115-volt AC
standby power bus. When the airplane is on the ground with the standby power switch in AUTO, ground
sensing relay R38 is energized, providing a ground path to energize the standby power off relay (R356). With
the standby power off relay energized, and the standby power switch in the AUTO or OFF position, the
connection between the DC standby bus and the battery bus is broken, and the static inverter will not turn on
because the turn-on signal path is disabled. Standby power IND light relay directs power to the standby power
off light.

Standby Power OFF Light

The standby power off light on panel P5 illuminates whenever the standby power bus is de-energized.

ATA-24 Page 38 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-24 Page 39


and Systems
  Introduction
B737 GENERALUNITED AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
EQUIPMENT/FURNISHINGS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE EQUIPMENT/FURNISHINGS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
TABLE OF CONTENTS TABLE OF CONTENTS

DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION


EQUIPMENT/FURNISHINGS .................................................................25-1 EQUIPMENT/FURNISHINGS ................................................................ 25-1
FLIGHT COMPARTMENT ......................................................................25-2 FLIGHT COMPARTMENT...................................................................... 25-2
Captain’s and First Officer’s Sidewalls .................................................25-3 Captain’s and First Officer’s Sidewalls................................................. 25-3
Pilot Seat Adjustment ............................................................................25-5 Pilot Seat Adjustment ............................................................................ 25-5
First Observer’s Seat..............................................................................25-6 First Observer’s Seat ............................................................................. 25-6
Lining and Insulation .............................................................................25-7 Lining and Insulation............................................................................. 25-7
PASSENGER COMPARTMENT..............................................................25-8 PASSENGER COMPARTMENT ............................................................. 25-8
Sidewall Panels ......................................................................................25-9 Sidewall Panels...................................................................................... 25-9
Sidewall Riser Panels and Air Grilles....................................................25-11 Sidewall Riser Panels and Air Grilles ................................................... 25-11
Sculptured Ceiling Panels ......................................................................25-12 Sculptured Ceiling Panels...................................................................... 25-12
Passenger Seats ......................................................................................25-13 Passenger Seats...................................................................................... 25-13
Attendant Seats ......................................................................................25-13 Attendant Seats ...................................................................................... 25-13
Passenger Service Units.........................................................................25-14 Passenger Service Units......................................................................... 25-14
Overhead Stowage Bins.........................................................................25-15 Overhead Stowage Bins......................................................................... 25-15
GALLEYS ....................................................................................................25-16 GALLEYS .................................................................................................... 25-16
Electrical Service ...................................................................................25-16 Electrical Service ................................................................................... 25-16
Water Service.........................................................................................25-16 Water Service ........................................................................................ 25-16
Galley Simplified Schematic .................................................................25-17 Galley Simplified Schematic ................................................................. 25-17
LAVATORIES.............................................................................................25-18 LAVATORIES............................................................................................. 25-18
CARGO COMPARTMENTS.....................................................................25-19 CARGO COMPARTMENTS .................................................................... 25-19
Anchorplates ..........................................................................................25-20 Anchorplates .......................................................................................... 25-20
Tiedown Tracks .....................................................................................25-20 Tiedown Tracks ..................................................................................... 25-20
Stanchions ..............................................................................................25-20 Stanchions.............................................................................................. 25-20
Webbing.................................................................................................25-20 Webbing................................................................................................. 25-20
Lining and Insulation .............................................................................25-20 Lining and Insulation............................................................................. 25-20
EMERGENCY EQUIPMENT ...................................................................25-22 EMERGENCY EQUIPMENT ................................................................... 25-22
Escape Slides .........................................................................................25-22 Escape Slides ......................................................................................... 25-22
Escape Straps/Lanyards .........................................................................25-23 Escape Straps/Lanyards ......................................................................... 25-23
Miscellaneous Emergency Equipment...................................................25-23 Miscellaneous Emergency Equipment .................................................. 25-23
737-300 Emergency Equipment Locations............................................25-24 737-300 Emergency Equipment Locations ........................................... 25-24
737-300 Emergency Equipment Locations(Overwater Equipped)........25-25 737-300 Emergency Equipment Locations(Overwater Equipped)........ 25-25
737-500 Emergency Equipment Locations............................................25-26 737-500 Emergency Equipment Locations ........................................... 25-26

and
OCT 99 Systems Introduction 25-i OCT 99 25-i
B737 GENERALUNITED AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
EQUIPMENT/FURNISHINGS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE EQUIPMENT/FURNISHINGS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

EQUIPMENT/FURNISHINGS EQUIPMENT/FURNISHINGS
Equipment and furnishings provide for the Equipment and furnishings provide for the
comfort and convenience of passengers comfort and convenience of passengers
and crew members, for handling and stow- and crew members, for handling and stow-
ing cargo, and for ensuring passenger and ing cargo, and for ensuring passenger and
crew safety in an emergency. crew safety in an emergency.

PASSENGER SERVICE UNIT PASSENGER SERVICE UNIT


FWD SERVICE DOOR FWD SERVICE DOOR
AFT SERVICE DOOR AFT SERVICE DOOR

FWD CARGO AFT CARGO FWD CARGO AFT CARGO


COMPT FWD CARGO AFT CARGO DOOR COMPT FWD CARGO AFT CARGO DOOR
DOOR COMPT DOOR COMPT

SERVICE DOOR SERVICE DOOR


PASSENGER PASSENGER
SEATS AFT RIGHT SEATS AFT RIGHT
CONTROL CONTROL
CABIN GALLEY LAVATORY CABIN GALLEY LAVATORY

GALLEY GALLEY
WINDSCREEN (TYP) WINDSCREEN (TYP)
FWD AFT FWD AFT
LAVATORY ENTRY LAVATORY ENTRY
DOOR AFT LEFT DOOR AFT LEFT
FWD ENTRY DOOR LAVATORY FWD ENTRY DOOR LAVATORY

Equipment and Furnishings Equipment and Furnishings

and
OCT 99 Systems Introduction 25-1 OCT 99 25-1
UNITED
B737 GENERAL AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
EQUIPMENT/FURNISHINGS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE EQUIPMENT/FURNISHINGS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

FLIGHT COMPARTMENT There are two cuneiforms of green trans- FLIGHT COMPARTMENT There are two cuneiforms of green trans-
Flight compartment equipment includes parent plastic at each pilots station. They Flight compartment equipment includes parent plastic at each pilots station. They
flight crew seats, furnishings at each crew attach above the no. 1 and no. 2 left and flight crew seats, furnishings at each crew attach above the no. 1 and no. 2 left and
station, instrument panels, circuit breaker right windows or fit into the eyebrow win- station, instrument panels, circuit breaker right windows or fit into the eyebrow win-
panels, lightshield, lining, insulation, drip dows. panels, lightshield, lining, insulation, drip dows.
pan, oxygen equipment, fire extinguishers, CAUTION: Sunvisor should not be pan, oxygen equipment, fire extinguishers, CAUTION: Sunvisor should not be
smoke goggles, crash axe, escape and lan- placed between window and thermal smoke goggles, crash axe, escape and lan- placed between window and thermal
yards. switch, as overheating may result. yards. switch, as overheating may result.
There are provisions for stowage of hats, Certificate and licence holders are attached There are provisions for stowage of hats, Certificate and licence holders are attached
coats, flight crew kits, manuals, map hold- to the forward side of the control cabin coats, flight crew kits, manuals, map hold- to the forward side of the control cabin
ers, cups, refuse bags and note pads. door. ers, cups, refuse bags and note pads. door.
The compartment floor, where exposed, The compartment floor, where exposed,
has a nonskid paint finish. has a nonskid paint finish.

AFT OVERHEAD PANEL FWD OVERHEAD PANEL AFT OVERHEAD PANEL FWD OVERHEAD PANEL
MAP LIGHT MAP LIGHT
MAP LIGHT MAP LIGHT

WINDSHIELD (REF) WINDSHIELD (REF)


WINDSHIELD (REF) WINDSHIELD (REF)
LIGHTSHIELD LIGHTSHIELD
CAPTAIN‘S PANEL CENTER PANEL CAPTAIN‘S PANEL CENTER PANEL

FWD ELECTRONIC PANEL FIRST OFFICER‘S PANEL FWD ELECTRONIC PANEL FIRST OFFICER‘S PANEL

CAPTAIN’S SEAT AFT ELECTRONIC PANEL AFT ELECTRONIC PANEL


CAPTAIN’S SEAT

CONTROL STAND FIRST OFFICER’S SEAT CONTROL STAND FIRST OFFICER’S SEAT
(THREE MODULE WIDE) (THREE MODULE WIDE)

CONTROL WIDE-ANGLE CONTROL WIDE-ANGLE


MIRROR CABIN DOOR MIRROR CABIN DOOR
OBSERVATION LENS OBSERVATION LENS
DOME LIGHT DOME/EMERG DOME LIGHT DOME/EMERG
LIGHT LIGHT
HAT HOLDER COAT STOWAGE HAT HOLDER COAT STOWAGE
(4 PLACES) (4 PLACES)

LOAD CONTROL LOAD CONTROL LOAD CONTROL LOAD CONTROL


CENTER P6 CENTER P18 CENTER P6 CENTER P18

FIRST FIRST
OBSERVER’S OBSERVER’S
SEAT RECESS SEAT RECESS

FWD FWD
FIRE FIRST OBSERVER’S SEAT FIRE FIRST OBSERVER’S SEAT
EXTINGUISHER (UNFOLDED POSITION) CRASH AXE LUGGAGE STOWAGE EXTINGUISHER (UNFOLDED POSITION) CRASH AXE LUGGAGE STOWAGE

Control Cabin Equipment Control Cabin Equipment

25-2 and Systems Introduction OCT 99 25-2 OCT 99


B737 GENERALUNITED AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
EQUIPMENT/FURNISHINGS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE EQUIPMENT/FURNISHINGS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

ESCAPE LANYARD CLIP BOARD ESCAPE LANYARD CLIP BOARD

NOSE NOSE
GEAR GEAR
FWD STEERING FWD STEERING
WHEEL WHEEL

HAND MIKE HAND MIKE

ASH TRAY ASH TRAY


GASPER GASPER

OXYGEN MASK OXYGEN MASK


STOWAGE BOX STATIC STOWAGE BOX STATIC
SELECT SELECT
CLIP FOR SWITCH CLIP FOR SWITCH
REFUSE BAGS REFUSE BAGS
SUN VISOR SUN VISOR
STOWAGE STOWAGE
FLIGHT KIT STOWAGE READING LIGHT FLIGHT KIT STOWAGE READING LIGHT

CAPTAIN CAPTAIN

ESCAPE LANYARD CLIP BOARD ESCAPE LANYARD CLIP BOARD

FWD FWD

UTILITY/FLIGHT UTILITY/FLIGHT
HAND MIKE KIT LIGHT HAND MIKE KIT LIGHT

SPARE BULB SPARE BULB


STOWAGE STOWAGE
OXYGEN MASK OXYGEN MASK
ASH TRAY STOWAGE BOX ASH TRAY STOWAGE BOX

CLIP FOR CLIP FOR


GASPER REFUSE BAGS GASPER REFUSE BAGS

STATIC SELECT STATIC SELECT


SWITCH BOOK SWITCH BOOK
STOWAGE STOWAGE

SUN VISOR STOWAGE FLIGHT KIT STOWAGE SUN VISOR STOWAGE FLIGHT KIT STOWAGE
FIRST OFFICER FIRST OFFICER

Captain’s and First Officer’s Sidewalls Captain’s and First Officer’s Sidewalls

and
OCT 99 Systems Introduction 25-3 OCT 99 25-3
UNITED
B737 GENERAL AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
EQUIPMENT/FURNISHINGS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE EQUIPMENT/FURNISHINGS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

Captain’s and First Officer’s Seats Manual seat adjustments include release Captain’s and First Officer’s Seats Manual seat adjustments include release
The captain’s and first officer’s seats are for fore and aft adjustment, seat height, The captain’s and first officer’s seats are for fore and aft adjustment, seat height,
opposite assemblies. The main compo- thigh pad height, with automatic override opposite assemblies. The main compo- thigh pad height, with automatic override
nents are a base, bottom, back and safety of spring tension when seat occupant uses nents are a base, bottom, back and safety of spring tension when seat occupant uses
harness. foot operated flight controls, seat back re- harness. foot operated flight controls; seat back re-
Four bogie units retain the seat base to the cline, armrest height and foldback, and Four bogie units retain the seat base to the cline, armrest height and foldback, and
seat track. Bogie rollers enable easy fore back cushion height and lumbar adjust- seat track. Bogie rollers enable easy fore back cushion height and lumbar adjust-
and aft adjustment. ment. and aft adjustment. ment.
The seat has inertia shoulder harness with The seat has inertia shoulder harness with
manual lock, crotch strap and lap belt. manual lock, crotch strap and lap belt.
NOTE: Stop bracket prevents inadvert- NOTE: Stop bracket prevents inadvert-
ent actuation of switches by Captain’s ent actuation of switches by Captain’s
seat back. seat back.

LUMBAR ARMREST SHOULDER HARNESS LUMBAR ARMREST SHOULDER HARNESS


SUPPORT LAP BELT AND SUPPORT LAP BELT AND
(STOWED) SEAT BACK ROTARY BUCKLE (STOWED) SEAT BACK ROTARY BUCKLE
IN-OUT IN-OUT
CONTROL CONTROL
HANDWHEEL ARMREST HEIGHT HANDWHEEL ARMREST HEIGHT
LUMBAR CONTROL KNOB LUMBAR CONTROL KNOB
SUPPORT SUPPORT
INERTIA INERTIA
REEL LOCK REEL LOCK
SEAT BOTTOM CUSHION SEAT BOTTOM CUSHION
FORE-AFT FORE-AFT
CONTROL LEVER CROTCH STRAP CONTROL LEVER CROTCH STRAP
THIGH SUPPORT THIGH SUPPORT
CONTROL FORWARD LIFT ARM CONTROL FORWARD LIFT ARM
HANDWHEEL HANDWHEEL
SEAT PAN SEAT PAN

BOGIE UNIT HEIGHT LOCKING PLATE BOGIE UNIT HEIGHT LOCKING PLATE
FLOOR TRACK BASE FLOOR TRACK BASE
(4 PLACES) LIFE VEST STOWAGE (4 PLACES) LIFE VEST STOWAGE
STRUCTURE STRUCTURE

FWD CAPTAIN’S SEAT - FRONT VIEW FWD CAPTAIN’S SEAT - FRONT VIEW
INBD INBD

SEAT BACK CUSHION SEAT BACK CUSHION

FWD FWD FWD FWD


INBD ARMREST INBD ARMREST
BOGIE (LOWERED) BOGIE (LOWERED)
UNIT TAPERED UNIT TAPERED
ROLLER OUTBD ROLLER OUTBD
TRACK LOCK TRACK LOCK
FLOOR BUTTON FLOOR BUTTON
ARMREST ARMREST
(RAISED) (RAISED)
BOOK BOOK
STOWAGE STOWAGE
VERTICAL VERTICAL
CONTROL CONTROL
LEVER LEVER
LUMBAR LUMBAR
SUPPORT SUPPORT
SEAT BACK UP-DOWN SEAT BACK UP-DOWN
RECLINE CONTROL RECLINE CONTROL
ADJUSTMENT NUT TRAVEL LIMIT STOP CONTROL LEVER HANDWHEEL ADJUSTMENT NUT TRAVEL LIMIT STOP CONTROL LEVER HANDWHEEL
CAPTAIN’S SEAT - REAR VIEW CAPTAIN’S SEAT - REAR VIEW

Captain’s and First Officer’s Seats Captain’s and First Officer’s Seats

25-4 and Systems Introduction OCT 99 25-4 OCT 99


B737 GENERALUNITED AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
EQUIPMENT/FURNISHINGS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE EQUIPMENT/FURNISHINGS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

Pilot Seat Adjustment The following sight references are used to Pilot Seat Adjustment The following sight references are used to
Seat adjustment is required for proper establish an appropriate eye reference po- Seat adjustment is required for proper establish an appropriate eye reference po-
brake pedal operation and correct line of sition: brake pedal operation and correct line of sition:
sight when ever aircraft is moved (taxi or - Sight along the upper surface of the sight when ever aircraft is moved (taxi or - Sight along the upper surface of the
tow). glareshield with a small amount of the tow). glareshield with a small amount of the
Adjust the seat position with the appropri- airplane nose structure visible. Adjust the seat position with the appropri- airplane nose structure visible.
ate controls to obtain the optimum eye ref- - Sight under the lightshield to view the ate controls to obtain the optimum eye ref- - Sight under the lightshield to view the
erence position. The handhold above the A/P-A/T-FMC lights panel. erence position. The handhold above the A/P-A/T-FMC lights panel.
forward window is used to assist. - Sight over the control column until the forward window is used to assist. - Sight over the control column until the
bottom of the EHSI is visible. bottom of the EHSI is visible.

A/P—A/T—FMC LIGHTS PANEL EYE REFERENCE POSITION A/P—A/T—FMC LIGHTS PANEL EYE REFERENCE POSITION

A A

B B

I I
EAD EAD
C C
I
EHS
I EHS

Pilot Seat Adjustment Pilot Seat Adjustment

and
OCT 99 Systems Introduction 25-5 OCT 99 25-5
UNITED
B737 GENERAL AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
EQUIPMENT/FURNISHINGS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE EQUIPMENT/FURNISHINGS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

First Observer’s Seat The seat back is hinged to the seat bottom. First Observer’s Seat The seat back is hinged to the seat bottom.
The first observer’s seat when used is in An upper cushion can slide up and down The first observer’s seat when used is in An upper cushion can slide up and down
front of the cockpit door. with respect to lower cushion. The seat front of the cockpit door. with respect to lower cushion. The seat
The seat bottom is hinged at the right side. back has pins at left and right which en- The seat bottom is hinged at the right side. back has pins at left and right which en-
Pins at the left side engage latch plates at gage catch plates at adjacent walls. Pins at the left side engage latch plates at gage catch plates at adjacent walls.
the adjacent wall. The seat has a fixed shoulder harness, the adjacent wall. The seat has a fixed shoulder harness,
crotch strap and lap belt. crotch strap and lap belt.

SEAT BEING SEAT BEING


UNFOLDED SEAT BACK UNFOLDED SEAT BACK
(OUT OF RECESS) FOLDED DOWN (OUT OF RECESS) FOLDED DOWN

HEADREST HEADREST
WITH HANDLE WITH HANDLE

FWD FWD

RETRACTABLE RETRACTABLE
PINS PINS

FIRST OBSERVER’S FIRST OBSERVER’S


SEAT SEAT

VIEW LOOKING AFT VIEW LOOKING AFT

First Observer’s Seat First Observer’s Seat

25-6 and Systems Introduction OCT 99 25-6 OCT 99


B737 GENERALUNITED AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
EQUIPMENT/FURNISHINGS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE EQUIPMENT/FURNISHINGS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

Lining and Insulation The drip pan is an assembly which is bolt- Lining and Insulation The drip pan is an assembly which is bolt-
Lining panels cover wall and ceiling areas, ed to structure above the overhead instru- Lining panels cover wall and ceiling areas, ed to structure above the overhead instru-
except areas covered by instrument panels, ment panel to insulate the area and insure except areas covered by instrument panels, ment panel to insulate the area and insure
circuit breaker panels and the flight com- drainage. Condensation collected on the circuit breaker panels and the flight com- drainage. Condensation collected on the
partment bulkhead. outboard side of the drip pan drains thru partment bulkhead. outboard side of the drip pan drains thru
Insulation is provided by fiberglass blan- tubing into the airplane drain system. Insulation is provided by fiberglass blan- tubing into the airplane drain system.
kets, some of which are part of a drip pan kets, some of which are part of a drip pan
assembly. assembly.

NOTE: AFT CENTER NOTE: AFT CENTER


AFT EDGE OF GLARESHIELD CEILING PANEL AFT EDGE OF GLARESHIELD CEILING PANEL
HAS CRASH PAD HAS CRASH PAD

UPPER FWD MID CENTER UPPER FWD MID CENTER


CEILING PANEL CEILING PANEL CEILING PANEL CEILING PANEL

LOWER FWD LOWER FWD


CEILING PANEL CEILING PANEL
DELTA DELTA
PANEL PANEL
UPPER SIDEWALL UPPER SIDEWALL
PANEL PANEL
CONTROL CONTROL
STAND STAND
PANEL PANEL

FWD FWD

LINING PANELS LINING PANELS


WITH CRASH STA WITH CRASH STA
PADDING 254 LOWER SIDEWALL PANEL PADDING 254 LOWER SIDEWALL PANEL

SIDEWALLS AND CEILING SIDEWALLS AND CEILING

DRIP PAN DRIP PAN

DRAIN TUBE DRAIN TUBE

Lining and Insulation Lining and Insulation

and
OCT 99 Systems Introduction 25-7 OCT 99 25-7
UNITED
B737 GENERAL AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
EQUIPMENT/FURNISHINGS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE EQUIPMENT/FURNISHINGS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

PASSENGER COMPARTMENT Service units are at all seats, attendant pan- PASSENGER COMPARTMENT Service units are at all seats, attendant pan-
Equipment and furnishings are in the pas- els and in all lavatories. Closets store coats Equipment and furnishings are in the pas- els and in all lavatories. Closets store coats
senger compartment for passenger and at- during flight. Seats are provided for pas- senger compartment for passenger and at- during flight. Seats are provided for pas-
tendant comfort and utility. Sidewall sengers and attendants. Full height stow- tendant comfort and utility. Sidewall sengers and attendants. Full height stow-
panels line the sidewalls of the passenger age partitions store miscellaneous panels line the sidewalls of the passenger age partitions store miscellaneous
compartment. Lowered ceiling, moveable equipment. Overhead stowage bins store compartment. Lowered ceiling, moveable equipment. Overhead stowage bins store
ceiling panels, and sculptured ceiling pan- luggage. Service outlets provide 115V AC ceiling panels, and sculptured ceiling pan- luggage. Service outlets provide 115V AC
els line the ceiling. power and 28V DC power. els line the ceiling. power and 28V DC power.

GAL L E Y S E R V I C E D O O R G A L L E Y S E RV I C E D O O R AFT G A L L E Y S E R V I C E D OOR GAL L E Y SE R VIC E DOOR AFT


CENTERLINE C E NT E R L INE
GALLEY No.2 G A L L E Y No . 3 STOWAGE G AL L E Y No .2 GAL L E Y No .3 ST OWAGE
GALLEY ST A F O L D I N G A T T E N D A N T S E A T ( D O U BL E ) S TA CLOSET GALLEY S TA FOL DING AT T E NDANT SE AT (DOUB L E ) S TA C L OSE T
No .1 270 993 No.1 270 993

GALLEY No.6 LAVATORY GAL L E Y No .6 L AVAT OR Y


ATTENDANT ST A CLASS DIVIDER (2) ATTENDANT S TA C L ASS DIVIDE R (2 )
PANEL 304 AFT ENTRY DOOR PANEL 304 AFT E NT R Y DOOR
LAVATORY ATTENDANT PANEL L A V A T OR Y AT T E NDANT PANE L
8 FIRST CLASS/120 TOURIST PASSENGERS 1 (737-300) 8 F IRS T CLASS/1 2 0 TOURIST PASSENGERS 1 (7 3 7 -3 0 0 )

1 AIR PL A N E S WIT H G A L L E Y 7 1 AI R P LANES W I TH GALLEY 7


2 ALL EX CE PT 1 AFT 2 ALL EXC EP T 1 AFT
GALLEY SERVICE CENTERLINE GAL L E Y SE R VIC E C E NT E R L INE
SINGLE FOLDING DOOR SINGL E FOL DING DOOR
FOLDING ATTENDANT SEAT STOWAGE F OL DING AT T E NDANT SE AT ST OWAGE
GA L L E Y N o. 2 GALLEY CLOSET GALLEY No.2 GAL L E Y C L OSE T
ATTENDANT (LEFT AND A T T E NDANT (L E FT AND
GALLEY S E R V I C E SEAT RIGHT SIDE) No.3 GALLEY SERVICE S E AT R IGHT SIDE ) No .3
DOOR LAVATORY DOOR L AVAT OR Y
ST A W I N D S CRE E N S TA WINDSC R E E N
270 270
GALLEY GALLEY
No .1 No.1
LAVATOR Y LAVATORY

S TA S TA
ATTENDA N T STA CLASS DIVIDER GALLEY No.6 993 ATTENDANT S TA C L ASS DIVIDE R GAL L E Y No .6 993
PANEL 304 F O R W A RD E N T R Y D O O R A F T E N T RY D O O R ATTENDANT PANEL PANEL 304 F O R W AR D E NT R Y DOOR AFT E NT R Y DOOR AT T E NDANT PANE L
8 F I R ST CLASS/120 TOURIST PASSENGER CONFIGURATI ON (737-300) 2 8 F IRS T CL AS S /120 TOURIST PASSENGER CONFIGURATION (7 3 7 -3 0 0 ) 2

FOLDING FOLDING GALLEY AFT FOL DING FOL DING GAL L E Y AFT
GALLEY S E R V I C E GALLEY SERVICE GALLEY SERVICE GAL L E Y SE R VIC E
DOOR GALLEY ATTENDANT ATTENDANT No.3 CENTERLINE DOOR GALLEY AT T E NDANT AT T E NDANT No .3 C E NT E R L INE
SEAT SEATS DOOR STOWAGE SE AT SE AT S DOOR ST OWAGE
GALLEY N o. 2 GALLEY No.2
ST A CL A S S D I V I D E R CLOSET S TA C L ASS DIVIDE R C L OSE T
No .1 270 No.1 270

LAVATOR Y LAVATORY

LAVATORY L AVAT OR Y
GALLEY No.7 GALLEY No.6 GAL L E Y No .7 GAL L E Y No .6
ATTENDA N T ATTENDANT
PANEL F O R W A R D E N T RY D O O R AFT ENTRY DOOR ATTENDANT PANEL F O R W AR D E NT R Y DOOR AFT E NT R Y DOOR AT T E NDANT
PANEL PANE L

8 FIRST CLASS/100 TOURIST PASSENGER CONFIGURAT ION (737-500) 8 F IRS T CL AS S /10 0 TOURIST PASSENGER CONFIGURATION (7 3 7 -5 0 0 )

Passenger Compartment Arrangement Passenger Compartment Arrangement

25-8 and Systems Introduction OCT 99 25-8 OCT 99


B737 GENERALUNITED AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
EQUIPMENT/FURNISHINGS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE EQUIPMENT/FURNISHINGS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

Sidewall Panels Fiberglass blankets with moisture impervi- Sidewall Panels Fiberglass blankets with moisture impervi-
The sidewall panels are fire-resistant fiber- ous coverings are in the sidewall. The blan- The sidewall panels are fire-resistant fiber- ous coverings are in the sidewall. The blan-
glass-fabric covered. The window lights fit kets thermally and acoustically insulate the glass-fabric covered. The window lights fit kets thermally and acoustically insulate the
through a cutout near the top of the panel. compartment. through a cutout near the top of the panel. compartment.
Passenger reveal assemblies mount in the To remove the panel, pull the decorative Passenger reveal assemblies mount in the To remove the panel, pull the decorative
cutouts near the middle of each panel and strip down and out of each side of the panel cutouts near the middle of each panel and strip down and out of each side of the panel
are removeable with the panel and seats in to be removed. Release the five fasteners are removeable with the panel and seats in to be removed. Release the five fasteners
place. The sidewall panels attach to struc- on each side securing the panel to the air- place. The sidewall panels attach to struc- on each side securing the panel to the air-
ture with support brackets on each panel plane structure. The panel can now be lift- ture with support brackets on each panel plane structure. The panel can now be lift-
retainer along the vertical sides. Decora- ed to clear the bottom retaining spring clips retainer along the vertical sides. Decora- ed to clear the bottom retaining spring clips
tive trim strips fit in grooves in the panel then pull out and down to slip the top out of tive trim strips fit in grooves in the panel then pull out and down to slip the top out of
retainer and cover the fasteners. The in- the channel in the air conditioning extru- retainer and cover the fasteners. The in- the channel tin the air conditioning extru-
board edge of the panel slides into the air sion. Disconnect all window light electri- board edge of the panel slides into the air sion. Disconnect all window light electri-
conditioning extrusion. cal connections. conditioning extrusion. cal connections.

GALLEY SERVICE DOOR GALLEY SERVICE DOOR AFT INSULATION W I N D OW L IGHT C UT OUT
CENTERLINE
GALLEY No.2 GALLEY No.3 STOWAGE BLANKETS
GALLEY STA STA CLOSET SHOC KM OUNT
FOLDING ATTENDANT SEAT (DOUBLE)
No.1 270 993

PANE L
R E T AINE R
(1 0 PL AC E S) FAST E NE R /
WASHE R
STA GALLEY No.6 LAVATORY
ATTENDANT CLASS DIVIDER (2)
304 AFT ENTRY DOOR
PANEL LAVATORY ATTENDANT PANEL WINDOW
R E VE AL
8 FIRST CLASS/120 TOURIST PASSENGERS 1 (737-300) ASSE M B L Y
1 AIRPLANES WITH GALLEY 7
2 ALL EXCEPT 1 AFT
GALLEY SERVICE CENTERLINE
SINGLE FOLDING DOOR
FOLDING ATTENDANT SEAT STOWAGE
GALLEY No.2 GALLEY CLOSET
ATTENDANT (LEFT AND
GALLEY SERVICE SEAT RIGHT SIDE) No.3
DOOR LAVATORY SPR ING C L IPS (T YP) PANE L
STA WINDSCREEN
270 R E T AINE R
GALLEY S IDE WALL PANEL
No.1
LAVATORY
SUPPORT BRACKET INSTALLATION
AIR (VIEW ED OUTBOARD)
C ONDIT IONING
STA
E XT R USION
ATTENDANT STA CLASS DIVIDER GALLEY No.6 993
PANEL 304 FORWARD ENTRY DOOR AFT ENTRY DOOR ATTENDANT PANEL B AL L AST
8 FIRST CLASS/120 TOURIST PASSENGER CONFIGURATION (737-300) 2 (R E F)
B ODY FR AM E (R E F) SHOC K M OUNT (R E F)
L AM P
FOLDING FOLDING GALLEY AFT HOUSING SIDE WAL L PANE L
GALLEY SERVICE GALLEY
DOOR GALLEY ATTENDANT ATTENDANT No.3
SERVICE CENTERLINE (R E F) PANE L R E T AINE R
SEAT SEATS DOOR STOWAGE
GALLEY No.2
STA CLASS DIVIDER CLOSET
No.1 270
L E NS
LAVATORY INB D
OUT B D
DE C OR AT IVE
T R IM ST R IP FAST E NE R /WASHE R
LAVATORY (R E T AINE D AT B OT T OM )
GALLEY No.7 GALLEY No.6
ATTENDANT
PANEL FORWARD ENTRY DOOR AFT ENTRY DOOR ATTENDANT
PANEL
(E ND VIE W) WIND OW LIGHT CUTOUT SUPPORT BRACKET INSTALLATION
8 FIRST CLASS/100 TOURIST PASSENGER CONFIGURATION (737-500) (WIT H L IGH T ASSEM BLY) (TOP VIEW — LOOKING DOW N)

Sidewall Linings Sidewall Linings

and
OCT 99 Systems Introduction 25-9 OCT 99 25-9
UNITED
B737 GENERAL AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
EQUIPMENT/FURNISHINGS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE EQUIPMENT/FURNISHINGS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

Window Reveal Assembly To remove the reveal assembly, insert Window Reveal Assembly To remove the reveal assembly, insert
The window reveal assembly consist of the latch release tool (3/32 inch rod) down- The window reveal assembly consist of the latch release tool (3/32 inch rod) down-
trim ring, shade, inner pane and reveal. It ward into the hole on the bottom of the trim trim ring, shade, inner pane and reveal. It ward into the hole on the bottom of the trim
can be removed without removing the ring. Push down firmly to release the latch. can be removed without removing the ring. Push down firmly to release the latch.
sidewall panel. Normally, there are two With the latch released, pull the window sidewall panel. Normally, there are two With the latch released, pull the window
window reveal assemblies per sidewall shade full down. Lower the assembly window reveal assemblies per sidewall shade full down. Lower the assembly
panel. enough to clear the two top securing stops panel. enough to clear the two top securing stops
from the sidewall panel. from the sidewall panel.
To install the reveal, use the reverse proce- To install the reveal, use the reverse proce-
dure. dure.

INSULATION WINDOW LIGHT CUTOUT SHADE


BLANKETS
SHOCKMOUNT

PANEL
RETAINER
(10 PLACES) FASTENER/
WASHER
TRIM
STOPS RING
WINDOW
REVEAL
ASSEMBLY
A

SPRING CLIPS (TYP) PANEL


RETAINER REVEAL
SIDEWALL PANEL
SUPPORT BRACKET INSTALLATION
AIR (VIEWED OUTBOARD)
CONDITIONING
INNER LATCH
EXTRUSION PANE RELEASE
TOOL (REF)
BALLAST
(REF)
BODY FRAME (REF) SHOCK MOUNT (REF) TRIM
RING
LAMP
HOUSING SIDEWALL PANEL LATCH RELEASE
(REF) PANEL RETAINER TOOL HOLE

SIDEWALL PANEL
REVEAL
LENS
INBD
OUTBD
DECORATIVE
TRIM STRIP FASTENER/WASHER SIDEWALL
(RETAINED AT BOTTOM) LATCH INBD PANEL (REF)
(CLOSED
POSITION)
PAN
(END VIEW) WINDOW LIGHT CUTOUT SUPPORT BRACKET INSTALLATION
(WITH LIGHT ASSEMBLY) (TOP VIEW — LOOKING DOWN) SECTION A — A

Window Reveal Window Reveal

25-10 and Systems Introduction OCT 99 25-10 OCT 99


B737 GENERALUNITED AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
EQUIPMENT/FURNISHINGS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE EQUIPMENT/FURNISHINGS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

Sidewall Riser Panels and Air Grilles To remove the panel, remove the carpet to Sidewall Riser Panels and Air Grilles To remove the panel, remove the carpet to
The riser panel is a honeycomb panel with expose the screws, the panel is lifted slight- The riser panel is a honeycomb panel with expose the screws, the panel is lifted slight-
the exposed surface covered with carpet. ly to clear the floor carpet. Pull the bottom the exposed surface covered with carpet. ly to clear the floor carpet. Pull the bottom
The panel is secured to the airplane struc- out and lower the panel to free it from the The panel is secured to the airplane struc- out and lower the panel to free it from the
ture with two screws at each circumferen- spring clips on the lower edge of the side- ture with two screws at each circumferen- spring clips on the lower edge of the side-
tial. wall panel. The panel is replaced in reverse tial. wall panel. The panel is replaced in reverse
Air grilles are located in the majority of the order. The grille is removed by two push- Air grilles are located in the majority of the order. The grille is removed by two push-
riser panels. They permit air from the pas- push fasteners. riser panels. They permit air from the pas- push fasteners.
senger compartment to circulate around senger compartment to circulate around
the cargo compartment. The back of the air the cargo compartment. The back of the air
grille is covered with a screen to prevent grille is covered with a screen to prevent
lint and debris from being drawn through lint and debris from being drawn through
into the space between the fuselage and the into the space between the fuselage and the
cargo compartment. cargo compartment.

SHADE SIDEWALL PANEL (REF)

SPRING
CLIPS

CARPET
(REF)
TRIM
STOPS RING

RISER
SIDEWALL
A

A AIR GRILL
(POLYCARBONATE)

REVEAL SIDEWALL RISER

SCREEN

INNER LATCH
PANE RELEASE
TOOL (REF)

TRIM PUSH — PUSH


RING FASTENER FLOOR
CARPET
LATCH RELEASE (REF)
TOOL HOLE UP

SIDEWALL PANEL
REVEAL
INBD

UP
SIDEWALL
LATCH INBD PANEL (REF)
(CLOSED
POSITION) INBD
PAN
SECTION A — A AIR GRILL

Sidewall Riser Panels and Air Grilles Sidewall Riser Panels and Air Grilles

and
OCT 99 Systems Introduction 25-11 OCT 99 25-11
UNITED
B737 GENERAL AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
EQUIPMENT/FURNISHINGS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE EQUIPMENT/FURNISHINGS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

Sculptured Ceiling Panels A lanyard connected between the airplane Sculptured Ceiling Panels A lanyard connected between the airplane
Sculptured panels line the ceiling over the structrue and the panel limits downward Sculptured panels line the ceiling over the structrue and the panel limits downward
passsenger compartment aisles. The panels movement when opened. The panel can be passsenger compartment aisles. The panels movement when opened. The panel can be
pivot on releasable hinge mechanisms on removed by disconnecting the lanyard and pivot on releasable hinge mechanisms on removed by disconnecting the lanyard and
the two outboard corners. The inboard releasing the two hinges. the two outboard corners. The inboard releasing the two hinges.
edge slides into and is secured by a groove To lower the sculptured ceiling panels re- edge slides into and is secured by a groove To lower the sculptured ceiling panels re-
in the conditioned air outlet extrusion. lease the hinge by pressing down on the in the conditioned air outlet extrusion. lease the hinge by pressing down on the
release lever. release lever.

CO N D I T I O N E D A I R O U T L E T C ONDIT IONE D AIR OUT L E T

CEILING PANEL C E IL ING PANE L


AIR OUTLET AIR OUT L E T
EXTRUSION E XT R USION
S CU L P T U RE D SC UL PT UR E D
CEILING C E IL ING
HI N G E PANEL HINGE PANE L
(2 PLACES) (2 PLACES)

LANYARD L ANYAR D

INBD INB D

C EI LI NG P A N E L CE I L I N G CEILING PANEL C E IL ING


HI NGE — H A L F PANEL HINGE — HALF PANE L
CEILING PANEL C E IL ING PANE L
HINGE — HALF HINGE — HAL F
S T O W A G E BI N S T OWAGE B IN
HINGE — HALF ADJUSTING H INGE — HAL F ADJ UST ING
SCREW SC R E W

STOWAGE RELEASE ST OWAGE R E L E ASE


BIN LEVER B IN L E VE R

STOWAGE BIN ST OWAGE B IN


HINGE — HALF HINGE — HAL F

CEILING PANEL CEILING P ANE L CE IL ING P AN EL CEILING PANEL


OUTBOARD POSITION INBOARD P OS IT ION OUT BOARD P OS I TION INBOARD POSITION

Sculptured Ceiling Panels Sculptured Ceiling Panels

25-12 and Systems Introduction OCT 99 25-12 OCT 99


B737 GENERALUNITED AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
EQUIPMENT/FURNISHINGS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE EQUIPMENT/FURNISHINGS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

Passenger Seats The back and bottom dress cover assem- Passenger Seats The back and bottom dress cover assem-
Passenger seats are attached to seat tracks blies are seperate and can be removed in- Passenger seats are attached to seat tracks blies are seperate and can be removed in-
in the floor and may be rearranged for dif- dependently. Seat backs recline in the floor and may be rearranged for dif- dependently. Seat backs recline
ferent configurations by moving the seats individually and can be returned to full up ferent configurations by moving the seats individually and can be returned to full up
froward or aft on the seat tracks. Seat position without use of the recline mecha- froward or aft on the seat tracks. Seat position without use of the recline mecha-
tracks are beams of special cross section nism. Seat bottom cushions or supports are tracks are beams of special cross section nism. Seat bottom cushions or supports are
and are bolted to the floor structure. Tracks not articulated and will not move when the and are bolted to the floor structure. Tracks not articulated and will not move when the
are provided with circular cutouts for seat back rest is reclined. The recline control is are provided with circular cutouts for seat back rest is reclined. The recline control is
studs and lock pins, which lock the seats in located on the side of the armrest. Push studs and lock pins, which lock the seats in located on the side of the armrest. Push
position. Cutouts in the tracks are spaced pull linkage connects the recline control position. Cutouts in the tracks are spaced pull linkage connects the recline control
one inch apart. with the recline mechanism. one inch apart. with the recline mechanism.
The passenger seat provides seats on a Attendant Seats The passenger seat provides seats on a Attendant Seats
common seat base. The seat consists of re- An attendant seat is mounted on the aft common seat base. The seat consists of re- An attendant seat is mounted on the aft
clinable seat back, seat cushions, safety wall structure of the forward lavatory. One clinable seat back, seat cushions, safety wall structure of the forward lavatory. One
belts, and armrests. The seats are also seat mounts on the forward side of each aft belts, and armrests. The seats are also seat mounts on the forward side of each aft
equipped with integral tables. There are lavatory. equipped with integral tables. There are lavatory.
double and triple seat assemblies. Every The seat bottom folds vertically when double and triple seat assemblies. Every The seat bottom folds vertically when
seat is equipped with plug-in sockets. Ash- stowed. Each attendant seat has a shoulder seat is equipped with plug-in sockets. Ash- stowed. Each attendant seat has a shoulder
trays and escutcheons are located in the in- harness and a lap belt, flashlight and life trays and escutcheons are located in the in- harness and a lap belt, flashlight and life
board and removeable armrests only. vest stowage is in a compartment below board and removeable armrests only. vest stowage is in a compartment below
the seat bottom. The headrest can be used the seat bottom. The headrest can be used
as a flotation device. A communication as a flotation device. A communication
handset is installed adjacent to the handset is installed adjacent to the
headrest. headrest.
TURN TABLE TURN TABLE
LATCH TO FOLDED LATCH TO FOLDED
RELEASE RELEASE
TABLE TABLE

TABLE SEAT TABLE SEAT


EXTENDED TRACK EXTENDED TRACK
SEAT TRACK SEAT TRACK STUD
STUD
ADJUSTMENT ADJUSTMENT
LITERATURE FITTING LITERATURE FITTING
POCKET POCKET SEAT TRACK ATTACHMENTS
SEAT TRACK ATTACHMENTS
TRIPLE SEAT TRIPLE SEAT

RESTRAINT RESTRAINT
SYSTEM SYSTEM

FLASHLIGHT FLASHLIGHT
AND LIFE VEST AND LIFE VEST
STOWAGE STOWAGE
COMPARTMENT COMPARTMENT
SEAT SEAT BELT ATTENDANT SEAT SEAT
SEAT BELT ATTENDANT SEAT
ATTACHMENT (WALL MOUNTED) TRACKS ATTACHMENT (WALL MOUNTED) TRACKS PASSENGER SEATS
PASSENGER SEATS

Passenger Compartment Seats Passenger Compartment Seats

and
OCT 99 Systems Introduction 25-13 OCT 99 25-13
UNITED
B737 GENERAL AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
EQUIPMENT/FURNISHINGS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE EQUIPMENT/FURNISHINGS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

Passenger Service Units The PSU can be positioned longitudinally Passenger Service Units The PSU can be positioned longitudinally
Passenger service units (PSU) are above in one inch increments. PSUs are inter- Passenger service units (PSU) are above in one inch increments. PSUs are inter-
each passenger seat row. Each PSU con- changeable only forward and aft, not form each passenger seat row. Each PSU con- changeable only forward and aft, not form
tains emergency oxygen equipment, left to right sides. tains emergency oxygen equipment, left to right sides.
speaker, reading lights, air outlets, and in- Individual reading lights are controlled by speaker, reading lights, air outlets, and in- Individual reading lights are controlled by
formation signs. switches on the PSU. An attendant call formation signs. switches on the PSU. An attendant call
The PSU panel assembly is hinged out- light and switch is located between the The PSU panel assembly is hinged out- light and switch is located between the
board and has a lanyard to limit the lower- reading lights. board and has a lanyard to limit the lower- reading lights.
ing distance when opened. The latches are There are also attendant service units ing distance when opened. The latches are There are also attendant service units
on the inboard side and are released by in- (ASU) located in the lowered ceiling pan- on the inboard side and are released by in- (ASU) located in the lowered ceiling pan-
serting a small round rod through the two els at entryways containing emergency serting a small round rod through the two els at entryways containing emergency
small holes in the panel and pushing up on equipment. small holes in the panel and pushing up on equipment.
the latch. The speaker, information sings Lavatory service units (LSU) have emer- the latch. The speaker, information sings Lavatory service units (LSU) have emer-
(NO SMOKING, FASTEN SEAT BELT), gency oxygen only and are mounted on the (NO SMOKING, FASTEN SEAT BELT), gency oxygen only and are mounted on the
air outlet and reading light assemblies are ceiling. The passenger advisory lights and air outlet and reading light assemblies are ceiling. The passenger advisory lights and
all on one panel. speakers are separately mounted. all on one panel. speakers are separately mounted.

FRAME 1 I N C H SP A CE D OVERHEAD STOWAGE FRAME 1 I N C H SPAC E D OVE R HE AD ST OWAGE


INDEX HOLES C O M P A RT M E N T I N D E X HOL E S C OM PAR T M E NT
P S U S U P P O RT PSU SUPPOR T
EXTRUSION E XT R USION

PSU PSU
(END (E ND
VIEW VIE W
OPEN) OPE N)

PSU PSU

CONDITIONED C ONDIT IONE D


C ONDI T I O N E D A I R AIR OUTLET CONDITIONED AIR AIR OUT L E T
OUTLET E X T R U S I O N PSU OUTLET EXTRUSION PSU
EXTRUSION E XT R USION
P S U HINGE PSU HINGE
AS S E MBL Y CL AMP ASSEM BLY CLAM P
READNG RE A D N G READNG R E ADNG
LATC H LIGHT SWITCH LIGHTS LATCH L I G H T S W I T C H L IGHT S
R ELEAS E OXYGEN GENERATOR RELEASE OXYGE N GE NE R AT OR
AC C ESS ATTENDANT ACCESS AT T E NDANT
CA L L S W I T CH SPEAKER C AL L SWIT C H SPE AKE R

OXYGEN OXYGE N
MASK M ASK

LIFE VEST L IFE VE ST


S T O RA G E ST OR AGE
NSFB GASPER NSFB GASPE R
SPEAKE R SIGN AIR SPEAKER SIGN AIR
OXYGEN O XYGE N
MANIFOLD M ANIFOL D
LIFE VEST DOOR LIFE VEST D OOR
ST O R A G E OUTBD RE A D N G STORAGE OUT B D R E ADNG
PSU FWD LIGHTS P S U (T OP VIE W) PSU FWD L IGHT S PSU (TOP VIEW )

Passenger Service Units Passenger Service Units

25-14 and Systems Introduction OCT 99 25-14 OCT 99


B737 GENERALUNITED AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
EQUIPMENT/FURNISHINGS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE EQUIPMENT/FURNISHINGS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

Overhead Stowage Bins The door is attached by hinges to the bin. Overhead Stowage Bins The door is attached by hinges to the bin.
The overhead stowage compartments ex- The latch handle, when pressed, rotates a The overhead stowage compartments ex- The latch handle, when pressed, rotates a
tend the length of the passenger compart- torque tube that releases the latches at both tend the length of the passenger compart- torque tube that releases the latches at both
ment above the seats. They vary in length ends of the door. A mechanical actuator on ment above the seats. They vary in length ends of the door. A mechanical actuator on
and width depending on the installation lo- each hinge assembly assists in door and width depending on the installation lo- each hinge assembly assists in door
cations. opening and maintains the door in the cations. opening and maintains the door in the
The compartments are secured to structure open position. The compartments are secured to structure open position.
with turnbuckles. A diagonal turnbuckle with turnbuckles. A diagonal turnbuckle
prevents forward and aft movement. The prevents forward and aft movement. The
bins are correctly positioned with align- bins are correctly positioned with align-
ment pins. ment pins.
BODY FRAME (REF) BODY FRAME (REF)

TURNBUCKLE TURNBUCKLE

DOOR DOOR
DIAGONAL (OPEN) DIAGONAL (OPEN)
T U RN B U C K L E TURNBUCKLE

STOWAGE STOWAGE
CO M P A RT M E N T COMPARTMENT

T U RN B U C K L E TURNBUCKLE

LOWER LOWER
S U P P O RT SUPPORT
ALIGNMENT STOWAGE ALIGNMENT STOWAGE
BRA C K E T PSU SUPPORT BRACKET PSU SUPPORT
PIN COMPARTMENT PIN COMPARTMENT
E X T RU S I O N ( RE F ) EXTRUSION (REF)
DOOR DOOR

MEC H A N I C A L MECHANICAL
AC TU A T O R ACTUATOR

SH SH
PU PU
LATCH HANDLE LATCH HANDLE

TORQUE TUBE TORQUE TUBE


HI N G E HINGE

LATCH ASSEMBLY LATCH ASSEMBLY

Overhead Stowage Bins Overhead Stowage Bins

and
OCT 99 Systems Introduction 25-15 OCT 99 25-15
UNITED
B737 GENERAL AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
EQUIPMENT/FURNISHINGS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE EQUIPMENT/FURNISHINGS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

GALLEYS Electrical Service GALLEYS Electrical Service


Galleys are located in the passenger cabin Electricity for the galleys is 115V AC 400 Galleys are located in the passenger cabin Electricity for the galleys is 115V AC 400
so as to provide convenient and rapid ser- Hz supplied from the airplane generator so as to provide convenient and rapid ser- Hz supplied from the airplane generator
vice to the passengers. They are installed busses and controlled by a switch on the vice to the passengers. They are installed in busses and controlled by a switch on the
in the cabin adjacent to the forward and aft overhead panel in the cockpit. Circuit the cabin adjacent to the forward and aft overhead panel in the cockpit. Circuit
galley service doors. breakers are located on the galleys and on galley service doors. breakers are located on the galleys and on
In general the equipment of the galley unit the P-6 circuit breaker panel. In general the equipment of the galley unit the P-6 circuit breaker panel.
consists of the following main items: high Water Service consists of the following main items: high Water Service
speed ovens, hot beverage containers, hot Water is supplied to the galleys from the speed ovens, hot beverage containers, hot Water is supplied to the galleys from the
cup receptacles, refrigeration and main airplane pressurized water system and, in cup receptacles, refrigeration and main airplane pressurized water system and, in
storage compartments. Electrical control an emergency, may be shutoff at the gal- storage compartments. Electrical control an emergency, may be shutoff at the gal-
panel switches and circuit breakers to op- leys (see chapter 38). panel switches and circuit breakers to oper- leys (see chapter 38).
erate the above equipment are convenient- ate the above equipment are conveniently
ly located. Storage space, miscellaneous located. Storage space, miscellaneous
drawers and waste containers are also inte- drawers and waste containers are also inte-
grated in the galley units. grated in the galley units.

HEADER AND HEADER AND


CURTAIN TRACK CURTAIN TRACK

AFT SERVICE AFT SERVICE


LAVATORY LAVATORY
DOOR DOOR
(REF) (REF)

GALLEY No.3 GALLEY No.3

HEADER AND HEADER AND


CURTAIN CURTAIN
TRACK TRACK

AFT ENTRY AFT ENTRY


FORWARD DOOR FORWARD DOOR
SERVICE SERVICE
DOOR DOOR

GALLEY No.6 GALLEY No.6

GALLEY No.7 GALLEY No.7


(NOT ON ALL AIRPLANES) (NOT ON ALL AIRPLANES)
GALLEY No.1 GALLEY No.2 GALLEY No.1 GALLEY No.2

Galley Locations Galley Locations

25-16 and Systems Introduction OCT 99 25-16 OCT 99


B737 GENERALUNITED AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
EQUIPMENT/FURNISHINGS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE EQUIPMENT/FURNISHINGS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

C 291 B1 C 2 91 B1
115V AC 115V AC
GEN B U S 2 C 292 B2 GEN BUS 2 C292 B2

C 293 B3 C293 B3
GALLEY 3 G A LL E Y 3
T5 CURRENT T5 CURRENT
P 6—11 CIRCUIT TRANSFORMER P 6— 11 CIRCUIT TRANSFORM ER
B REAKER PANEL (P6) GAL L E Y 3 BRE AKE R P ANEL (P6 ) GALLEY 3
R62 R6 2
GAL L E Y GALLEY
28V DC RE L AY 2 28V DC RELAY 2
(P 6) (P6 )
C889 APU C 8 8 9 APU
G 3 GEN CONT G E N BK R N o . 2 G3 GE N CONT GE N B KR No .2
UNIT 1 R349 UNIT 1 R3 4 9
XFR XFR
CONT GAL L E Y 7 CONT GALLEY 7
RLY 2 1 RLY 2 1
C8 9 1 E X T P W R C 8 9 1 E XT PWR
CONTACTOR No.1 C ONT AC T OR No .1
PANEL PANE L
TO BE TO BE
FURNISHED FUR NISHE D
C 801 G E N OFF C 8 0 1 GE N OFF
BKR No.2 T O R3 X F R R L Y 1 B KR No .2 T O R 3 XFR R L Y 1
T O R4 X F R R L Y 2 T O R 4 XFR R L Y 2

28V DC ON 28V DC ON
S 958 S9 5 8
C889 APU GAL L E Y C 8 8 9 APU GALLEY
G 4 GEN CONT P OWE R G4 GE N CONT POW ER
G E N BK R N o . 2 R350 GE N B KR No .2 R3 5 0
UNIT 2 S WIT CH UNIT 2 SW ITCH
XFR XFR
CONT CONT
RLY 1 RLY 1
C8 9 2 E X T P W R C 8 9 2 E XT PWR
1 CONTACTOR No.2 1 C ONT AC T OR No .2
GAL L E Y 1 GALLEY 1
NOT O N A L L NOT ON ALL
AI R PL A N E S AIRPLANES

C 80 2 G E N C 8 0 2 GE N
BKR No.2 B KR No .2

C 288 B1 C288 B1
115V AC 115V AC
GEN B U S 1 C 289 B2 GEN BUS 1 C289 B2

C 290 B3 C290 B3
GALLEY 1 G A LL E Y 1
AND 6 R61 GAL L E Y 6 AND 6 R6 1 GALLEY 6
T4 CURRENT T4 CURRENT
GAL L E Y GALLEY
P 6—12 CIRCUIT TRANSFORMER P 6— 12 CIRCUIT TRANSFORM ER
REL AY 1 (P 6) RELAY 1 (P6 )
B REAKER PANEL (P6) BRE AKE R P ANEL (P6 )

Galley Simplified Schematic Galley Simplified Schematic

and
OCT 99 Systems Introduction 25-17 OCT 99 25-17
UNITED
B737 GENERAL AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
EQUIPMENT/FURNISHINGS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE EQUIPMENT/FURNISHINGS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

LAVATORIES Air exhausts through overboard vents in LAVATORIES Air exhausts through overboard vents in
Lavatories are located in the forward and each lavatory. Structure in the lavatory Lavatories are located in the forward and each lavatory. Structure in the lavatory
aft ends of the passenger compartment. area is painted with a protective coating to aft ends of the passenger compartment. area is painted with a protective coating to
Each lavatory contains a toilet, wash basin, prevent corrosion. Each lavatory contains a toilet, wash basin, prevent corrosion.
mirror, and all the necessary vanity items Water is supplied from the potable water mirror, and all the necessary vanity items Water is supplied from the potable water
and disposal units. Ventilation is provided system. Water and waste systems will be and disposal units. Ventilation is provided system.Water and waste systems will be
through the service unit. discussed in detail in chapter 38. through the service unit. discussed in detail in chapter 38.

DOME CL E A N I N G FLUORESCENT DOM E C L E ANING FL UOR E SC E NT


PAPER L IGHT PAPE R PAPE R L IGHT
LIGHT PAPER TISSUE LIGHT T ISSUE
TOWELS C UPS T OWE L S
SP E A K E R CU P S SPEAKER

MIRROR M IR R OR

SMOKE SMOKE
DETECT O R DETECTOR

DISPENSER DISPE NSE R


OXYGEN PANEL OXYGEN PANE L
B OX BOX

BAR B AR
ASHTR A Y ASHTRAY
SOAP SOAP

TOI LET TOILET


CALL FLUSH C AL L
FLUSH
PANEL SWITCH PANE L
SWI TCH

TOI LET TOILET


SEAT SEAT
FAUCET FAUC E T
B UMPER BUMPER

TOI LET TOILET


B AC K WASH BACK WASH
SHROUD BASIN SHROUD B ASIN

R OT A T E D 1 8 0 ¡ R OT AT E D 1 8 0 ¡

TOILET TOILET SE AT
SEAT
TOILET T OIL E T
CO V E RS C OVE R S SINK C AB INE T
PAPER SINK CABINET PAPE R

FWD FWD
I NBD INBD

A I RS I CK BA G S A N D S A N I T A RY N A P K I N S AIR SIC K B AGS AND SANIT AR Y NAPKINS


O N I N S I D E O F H I N G E D CO V E R ON INSIDE OF HINGE D C OVE R

Aft LH Lavatory Compartment Aft LH Lavatory Compartment


(Equipment similiar in other lavatories) (Equipment similiar in other lavatories)

25-18 and Systems Introduction OCT 99 25-18 OCT 99


B737 GENERALUNITED AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
EQUIPMENT/FURNISHINGS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE EQUIPMENT/FURNISHINGS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

CARGO COMPARTMENTS A pressure equalization valve is in the aft CARGO COMPARTMENTS A pressure equalization valve is in the aft
The lower cargo compartments provide bulkhead of each compartment. The valves The lower cargo compartments provide bulkhead of each compartment. The valves
space for carrying luggage, freight, equip- let only enough air flow into or out of the space for carrying luggage, freight, equip- let only enough air flow into or out of the
ment, and cargo. cargo compartment to keep the pressures ment, and cargo. cargo compartment to keep the pressures
The cargo compartments are located below nearly the same as the cabin pressure. The cargo compartments are located below nearly the same as the cabin pressure.
the passenger compartment. One compart- Blowout panels in the lower cargo com- the passenger compartment. One compart- Blowout panels in the lower cargo com-
ment is forward of the center wing section, partments provide pressure relief at a ment is forward of the center wing section, partments provide pressure relief at a
and the other is aft of the main wheel well. greater rate than the pressure equalization and the other is aft of the main wheel well. greater rate than the pressure equalization
The compartments are designed to com- valve in case the airplane should suddenly The compartments are designed to com- valve in case the airplane should suddenly
pletely confine a fire without endangering lose pressurization. pletely confine a fire without endangering lose pressurization.
the safety of the airplane or its occupants. Tiedown tracks, anchorplates, and web- the safety of the airplane or its occupants. Tiedown tracks, anchorplates, and web-
The compartments are sealed and pressur- bing are provided to secure the cargo from The compartments are sealed and pressur- bing are provided to secure the cargo from
ized but do not have fresh air circulation shifting. ized but do not have fresh air circulation shifting.
and temperature control. and temperature control.

BULKHEAD COMPARTMENT ACCESS PANEL CEILING BLOWOUT PANEL BULKHEAD COMPARTMENT ACCESS PANEL CEILING BLOWOUT PANEL
BLOWOUT BLOWOUT
PANEL PANEL

CARGO CARGO
DOOR DOOR

FORWARD CARGO FORWARD CARGO


COMPARTMENT COMPARTMENT

PRESSURE PRESSURE
EQUALIZATION EQUALIZATION
VALVE VALVE

AFT CARGO AFT CARGO


COMPARTMENT COMPARTMENT

OUTWARD OPENING VALVE OUTWARD OPENING VALVE

INWARD OPENING VALVE INWARD OPENING VALVE

Cargo Compartments Cargo Compartments

and
OCT 99 Systems Introduction 25-19 OCT 99 25-19
UNITED
B737 GENERAL AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
EQUIPMENT/FURNISHINGS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE EQUIPMENT/FURNISHINGS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

Anchorplates The upper ends of the stanchions are held Anchorplates The upper ends of the stanchions are held
Anchorplates are on the sidewalls of both in place by fittings on the ceiling. The low- Anchorplates are on the sidewalls of both in place by fittings on the ceiling. The low-
cargo compartments and on the aft com- er ends of the stanchions are held in place cargo compartments and on the aft com- er ends of the stanchions are held in place
partment ceiling. Each anchorplate has a by the tiedown tracks or by fittings on the partment ceiling. Each anchorplate has a by the tiedown tracks or by fittings on the
flat mounting surface on one side and slot sidewalls. flat mounting surface on one side and slot sidewalls.
and lips on the other side. The anchorplates Some of the webbing straps are attached to and lips on the other side. The anchorplates Some of the webbing straps are attached to
hold outboard edges of webbing when the stanchions when the webbing is in hold outboard edges of webbing when the stanchions when the webbing is in
webbing is in place. Each anchorplate is place. A stanchion can be removed by re- webbing is in place. Each anchorplate is place. A stanchion can be removed by re-
fastened to body structure by screws. tracting the piston at its upper end. fastened to body structure by screws. tracting the piston at its upper end.
Tiedown Tracks Webbing Tiedown Tracks Webbing
A pair of tiedown tracks run fore and aft Sections of webbing can be suspended be- A pair of tiedown tracks run fore and aft for Sections of webbing can be suspended be-
for the full length of the compartment. The tween the anchorplates and a stanchion or the full length of the compartment. The up- tween the anchorplates and a stanchion or
upper surfaces of the tracks are nearly between two stanchions. Each compart- per surfaces of the tracks are nearly flush between two stanchions. Each compart-
flush with the deck panels and are fastened ment has door net which reaches from the with the deck panels and are fastened to ment has door net which reaches from the
to airplane body by lockbolts. doorsill to the ceiling and is approximately airplane body by lockbolts. doorsill to the ceiling and is approximately
Upper surface of each track has stanchion the width of the door. Upper surface of each track has stanchion the width of the door.
sockets and tiedown holes. Lower ends of Fabric straps are sewed together to form sockets and tiedown holes. Lower ends of Fabric straps are sewed together to form
cargo net stanchions fit in tiedown holes or the webbing. Solid cloth panels are sewed cargo net stanchions fit in tiedown holes or the webbing. Solid cloth panels are sewed
stanchion sockets in the upper surface of to the straps is some areas to fill the open- stanchion sockets in the upper surface of to the straps is some areas to fill the open-
the track. Quick release fasteners can also ings between straps. Quick release tiedown the track. Quick release fasteners can also ings between straps. Quick release tiedown
be held by retraining slots in spaces be- fasteners are sewed to the strap end in be held by retraining slots in spaces be- fasteners are sewed to the strap end in
tween tiedown holes. some placed on the outboard edges of the tween tiedown holes. some placed on the outboard edges of the
Stanchions nets. Other strap ends have snap latches or Stanchions nets. Other strap ends have snap latches or
The forward compartment has four stan- buckles. The forward compartment has four stan- buckles.
chions and the aft compartment has six. Lining and Insulation chions and the aft compartment has six. Lining and Insulation
The stanchions stand upright when they Ceilings and sidewalls are lined with fiber- The stanchions stand upright when they are Ceilings and sidewalls are lined with fiber-
are in place and reach between deck or glass panels sealed at the edges with fiber- in place and reach between deck or side- glass panels sealed at the edges with fiber-
sidewall and the ceiling. glass tape. Bulkheads are lined with wall and the ceiling. glass tape. Bulkheads are lined with
An aluminum tube forms the main part of aluminum or fiberglass panels. An aluminum tube forms the main part of aluminum or fiberglass panels.
the stanchion. A latch mechanism is at the Insulation blankets are outboard of the the stanchion. A latch mechanism is at the Insulation blankets are outboard of the
upper end of the tube has a pistion which sidewall lining and below the compart- upper end of the tube has a pistion which sidewall lining and below the compart-
can slide in or out along the axis of the meant deck. Plastic studs and clips and can slide in or out along the axis of the meant deck. Plastic studs and clips and
tube. A spring pushes the piston to the ex- "velcro" tape are used to secure the tube. A spring pushes the piston to the ex- "velcro" tape are used to secure the
tended position. The upper end of the pis- blankets. tended position. The upper end of the pis- blankets.
ton matches a ceiling fitting. The lower ton matches a ceiling fitting. The lower end
end of the stanchion has an indexing pin of the stanchion has an indexing pin which
which fits tiedown track holes. Loop fit- fits tiedown track holes. Loop fittings
tings provide places suitable for attaching provide places suitable for attaching
webbing. webbing.

25-20 and Systems Introduction OCT 99 25-20 OCT 99


B737 GENERALUNITED AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
EQUIPMENT/FURNISHINGS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE EQUIPMENT/FURNISHINGS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

SOLID C L O T H P A N E L SIDEWALL ANCHOR PLATE SOLID CLOTH PANEL SIDE WAL L ANC HOR PL AT E
( BRO K E N F O R (BROKEN FOR
CLAR I T Y ) CLARITY)

STANCHION ST ANC HION

CEI LIN G CEILING


LOOP LOOP QUICK—RELEASE
QUICK— RE L E AS E FITTING
FI TTI N G T IE DOWN F IT T ING TIEDOW N FITTING
( 2 PLA C E S ) (2 PLACES)

UPPE R UPPER
ROD ROD

FOLD I N G FOLDING
R OD ROD

C AR G O CARGO
DOOR N E T DOOR NET
W E B BI N G S T R A P WE B B ING ST R AP
INBD IN B D
F WD FWD

CARGO COMPARTMENT W EBBING (EXAMP L E ) CARGO COM PARTM ENT W EBBING (EXAM PLE)

CEILING FITTING C E I L I N G FIT T ING

PISTON PIST ON

S P RI N G SPR ING
STANCHION ST ANC HION

LOOP FITTING L O O P F I T T ING

SNAP LATCH SNAP LATCH

TIEDOWN RACK T IE DOWN R AC K

INDEXING PIN I N D E XING PIN

Cargo Compartment Equipment Cargo Compartment Equipment

and
OCT 99 Systems Introduction 25-21 OCT 99 25-21
UNITED
B737 GENERAL AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
EQUIPMENT/FURNISHINGS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE EQUIPMENT/FURNISHINGS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

EMERGENCY EQUIPMENT The escape slide package consists of an es- EMERGENCY EQUIPMENT The escape slide package consists of an es-
The emergency equipment provides a cape slide, a detachable girt, girt bar, gas The emergency equipment provides a cape slide, a detachable girt, girt bar, gas
means for the flight attendants to assist the cylinder, and valise. The gas cylinder con- means for the flight attendants to assist the cylinder, and valise. The gas cylinder con-
passengers and passengers to assist them- tains high pressure gas for inflating the passengers and passengers to assist them- tains high pressure gas for inflating the
selves in the event of an emergency. slide. The valise holds the slide in the selves in the event of an emergency. slide. The valise holds the slide in the
Escape Slides stowed position, and opens to deploy the Escape Slides stowed position, and opens to deploy the
One door mounted escape slide is on the slide. One door mounted escape slide is on the slide.
lower inboard face of each entry and galley The escape slide girt bar is stowed in re- lower inboard face of each entry and galley The escape slide girt bar is stowed in re-
door. tainers on the compartment cover. To door. tainers on the compartment cover. To
The escape slides provide a means of make a slide ready for use, the girt bar is re- The escape slides provide a means of make a slide ready for use, the girt bar is re-
emergency egress from the airplane. moved from the retainers and installed in emergency egress from the airplane. moved from the retainers and installed in
Each escape slide assembly consists of an the floor brackets. Opening the door will Each escape slide assembly consists of an the floor brackets. Opening the door will
escape slide package, an escape slide com- then pull the slide package out of the com- escape slide package, an escape slide com- then pull the slide package out of the com-
partment, and two floor brackets. The es- parment, to deploy while inflating auto- partment, and two floor brackets. The es- parment, to deploy while inflating auto-
cape slide package is stowed in the escape matically. A manual inflation handle is cape slide package is stowed in the escape matically. A manual inflation handle is
slide cmpartment which is fastened to the furnished, which can by used if the auto- slide cmpartment which is fastened to the furnished, which can by used if the auto-
lower inboard face of each entry and ser- matic inflation system should fail. lower inboard face of each entry and ser- matic inflation system should fail.
vice door. The floor brackets are located at NOTE: To ensure the slide is ready for vice door. The floor brackets are located at NOTE: To ensure the slide is ready for
the forward and aft ends fo the doorways, use, bottle pressure is checked at regu- the forward and aft ends fo the doorways, use, bottle pressure is checked at regu-
inboard of the sill. lar intervals by reading the pressure inboard of the sill. lar intervals by reading the pressure
gage that can be seen through the slide gage that can be seen through the slide
compartmet window. Gage needle compartmet window. Gage needle
should be in the green band. (Pressures should be in the green band. (Pressures
will vary with temperature). will vary with temperature).
ESCAPE SLIDE DOOR LATCH COVER LATCH LATCH ESCAPE SLIDE DOOR LATCH COVER LATCH LATCH
GIRT CABLE BRACKET GIRT CABLE BRACKET

FLOOR FLOOR
BRACKET BRACKET
(2 PLACES) (2 PLACES)

STOWAGE GIRT BRACKET PAN LATCH BRACKET STOWAGE GIRT BRACKET PAN LATCH BRACKET
HOOK (2 PLACES) HOOK (2 PLACES) BAR
BAR FWD DOOR FWD DOOR
ARMED LATCH ASSEMBLY ARMED
STOWED LATCH ASSEMBLY STOWED

SLIDE SLIDE
WEBBING COMPARTMENT WEBBING COMPARTMENT
LATCH LATCH
BLOCK COVER BLOCK COVER
ASSEMBLY ASSEMBLY

BRACKET BRACKET
ASSEMBLIES ASSEMBLIES

AFT DOOR CABLE BACKING AFT DOOR CABLE BACKING


FLOOR BRACKET LATCH ASSEMBLY ASSEMBLY PAN FLOOR BRACKET LATCH ASSEMBLY ASSEMBLY PAN

Door Mounted Escape Slides Door Mounted Escape Slides

25-22 and Systems Introduction OCT 99 25-22 OCT 99


B737 GENERALUNITED AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
EQUIPMENT/FURNISHINGS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE EQUIPMENT/FURNISHINGS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

Escape Straps/Lanyards Miscellaneous Emergency Equipment Escape Straps/Lanyards Miscellaneous Emergency Equipment
Escape straps are stowed above each of the There is also miscellaneous equipment Escape straps are stowed above each of the There is also miscellaneous equipment
overwing emergency exits in the passenger (life vests,smoke goggles, first aid kits, overwing emergency exits in the passenger (life vests,smoke goggles, first aid kits,
cabin. Escape lanyards are above the Cap- flashlights, extinguishers, megaphone) in- cabin. Escape lanyards are above the Cap- flashlights, extinguishers, megaphone) in-
tain’s and First Officer’s sliding windows stalled throughout the interior. tain’s and First Officer’s sliding windows stalled throughout the interior.
in the control cabin. in the control cabin.
COCKPIT ESCAPE STRAP COCKPIT ESCAPE STRAP

STRAP STRAP

ATTACHMENT ATTACHMENT
FITTING FITTING
1 ESCAPE 1 ESCAPE
STRAP STRAP
TRAP TRAP
COMPARTMENT COMPARTMENT
LATCH LATCH

1 1

ESCAPE STRAP ESCAPE STRAP


I N STOWED I N STOWED
CONDITION CONDITION

STOWAGE STOWAGE
TUBE TUBE

HOOK RETAINER HOOK RETAINER


1 AS INSTALLED 1 AS INSTALLED

1 1 OVERWING ESCAPE STRAP


OVERWING ESCAPE STRAP

Emergency Equipment and Escape Devices Emergency Equipment and Escape Devices

and
OCT 99 Systems Introduction 25-23 OCT 99 25-23
UNITED
B737 GENERAL AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
EQUIPMENT/FURNISHINGS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE EQUIPMENT/FURNISHINGS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

SLI DI NG W I N D O W SLIDING WINDOW SLIDING WINDOW SL IDING WINDOW


ESC APE L I N E ESCAPE LINE ESCAPE LINE E SC APE L INE
SMOKE GO G G L E S SMOKE GOGGLES SMOKE GOGGLES SM OKE GOGGL E S

HALON EXTINGUISHER HAL ON E XT INGUISHE R


PBE PBE

SMOKE GOGGLES SM OKE GOGGL E S


G1 G1
L L

AA AA
AXE AXE C G2
C G2
DOOR 1R DOOR 1 R
ESCAPE SLIDE E SC APE SL IDE
HALON EXTINGUISHER HAL ON E XT INGUISHE R
D O O R 1L WATER EXTINGUISHER DOOR 1L WAT E R E XT INGUISHE R
ESCAPE S L I D E ESCAPE SLIDE
EMERGEN C Y EMERGENCY
FLASHLI G H T ( 2) FLASHLIGHT (2)
F ORWARD CL OS E T FORW ARD CLOSET
PBE PB E

O H B I N 1 AB OH BIN 1 AB
FI R ST AI D K I T R IGHT CL AS S DIVIDE R FIRST AID KIT RIGHT CLASS DIVIDER
MEDI CAL K I T OXYGEN BOTTLE MEDICAL KIT OXYGE N B OT T L E
MEGAPHO N E MEGAPHONE

OVE RWING E ME R E XIT OVERW ING EM ER EXIT


ESCAPE LINE L E F T CL AS S DIVIDER E SC APE L INE
L E FT C LASS DIVIDER
OXYGEN B O T T L E OXYGEN BOTTLE

OH B I N 3 AB OH BIN 12 DE F OH BIN 3 AB OH BIN 1 2 DEF


OXYGEN B O T T L E OXYGEN BOTTLE OXYGEN BOTTLE OXYGE N B OT T L E

OH BIN 22 DE F OH BIN 2 2 DEF


OXYGEN BOTTLE (2) OXYGE N B OT T L E (2 )
O V E R WING EMER EXIT OVE RWING E ME R E XIT
ESCAPE L I N E ESCAPE LINE

AF T GAL L E Y COMP T AFT GALLEY COM PT


OXYGEN MASK (2) OXYGE N M ASK (2 )
OH B I N 22 ABC OH BIN 22 ABC
FI RST AI D K I T FIRST AID KIT
MEGAPHO N E MEGAPHONE

DOOR 2R DOOR 2 R
ESCAPE SLIDE E SC APE SL IDE
DOOR 2 L HALON EXTINGUISHER
DOOR 2L HAL ON E XT INGUISHE R
ESCAPE SLIDE
ESC APE S L I D E
*EMERGE N C Y F L A S H L I G H T
A A
*
EMERGENCY FLASHLIGHT
*E M E R G E N C Y F L A S H L IGHT
A A
*
E M E R GE NC Y FL ASHL IGHT
L L L L

AF T CL OS E T AFT CLOSET
* 2 FLASH L I G H T S A R E L O C A T E D A T D O O R 2 L
AND NO N E A T D O O R 2R O N R E CO N F I G U RE D
HALON EXTINGUISHER
WATER EXTINGUISHER *2A NF LDANSOHNLEI GAHTT SD OAOR RE L2 ROCONATRE EDCATONFIGUR
DOOR 2 L
ED
HAL ON E XT INGUISHE R
WAT E R E XT INGUISHE R
7 3 7 —3 0 0 A I R P L A N E S ( #13/ 1 4 / 1 5 X X RE D E S I G N E D G A L L E Y S ) . PBE 7 3 7 —3 0 0 A I R P L A N E S (# 1 3 /1 4 /1 5 XX R E DE SIGNE D GAL L E YS). PB E

737-300 Emergency Equipment Locations 737-300 Emergency Equipment Locations

25-24 and Systems Introduction OCT 99 25-24 OCT 99


B737 GENERALUNITED AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
EQUIPMENT/FURNISHINGS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE EQUIPMENT/FURNISHINGS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

SLI D I N G W I N D O W SLIDING WINDOW SLIDING WINDOW SL IDING WINDOW


ESC A P E L I N E ESCAPE LINE ESCAPE LINE E SC APE L INE
SMO K E G O G G L E S SMOKE GOGGLES SMOKE GOGGLES SM OKE GOGGL E S

LI FE V E S T ( 2) HALON EXTINGUISHER LIFE VEST (2) HAL ON E XT INGUISHE R


LIFE VESTS (2) L IFE VE ST S (2 )
PBE PBE

SMOKE GOGGLES SM OKE GOGGL E S


G1 G1
L L

AA AA
AXE C G2 AXE C G2
DOOR 1R DOOR 1 R
ESCAPE SLIDE E SC APE SL IDE
HALON EXTINGUISHER HAL ON E XT INGUISHE R
D OOR 1L WATER EXTINGUISHER DOOR 1L WAT E R E XT INGUISHE R
ESC A P E S L I D E ESCAPE SLIDE
CRE W L I F E V E S T ( 2) C R E W L I F E V E S T ( 2)
EM E R G E N C Y F L A S H L IG H T ( 2 ) E M E R G E N C Y F L A S HL IGHT (2 )
F ORWARD CL OS E T FORW ARD CLOSET
PBE PB E

O H BIN 1 AB OH BIN 1 AB
FI R S T A I D K I T RIGHT CL AS S DIVIDE R FIRST AID KIT RIGHT CLASS DIVIDER
ME D I C A L K I T OXYGEN BOTTLE MEDICAL KIT OXYGE N B OT T L E
ME G A P H O N E MEGAPHONE

OH BIN 3 DE F OH BIN 3 DEF


RAFT #1 R AFT # 1
L EFT CLASS DIVIDER L E F T CL AS S DIVIDER
OXY G E N B O T T L E OVE RWING E ME R E XIT OXYGEN BOTTLE OVERW ING EM ER EXIT
ESCAPE LINE E SC APE L INE

OH BIN 3 AB OH BIN 10/11 DE F OH BIN 3 AB OH BIN 1 0 /1 1 DEF


OXY G E N B O T T L E RAFT #2 OXYGEN BOTTLE R AFT # 2

OH BIN 12 DE F OH BIN 1 2 DEF


OXYGEN BOTTLE OXYGE N B OT T L E

O VERWING EMER EXIT OH BIN 21 DE F OVE RWING E MER EXIT OH BIN 2 1 DEF
ESC A P E L I N E RAFT #4 ESCAPE LINE R AFT # 4

OH BIN 12/13 ABC OH BIN 22 DE F OH BIN 12/13 ABC OH BIN 2 2 DEF


R AF T #3 OXYGEN BOTTLE (2) RAFT #3 OXYGE N B OT T L E (2 )
ADULT LIFE VEST (6) ADUL T L IFE VE ST (6 )

OH BIN 22 ABC OH BIN 22 ABC


FI RS T A I D K I T AF T GAL L E Y COMP T FIRST AID KIT AFT GALLEY COM PT
MEG A P H O N E OXYGEN MASK (2) MEGAPHONE OXYGE N M ASK (2 )
C HI L D L I F E V E S T ( 20) C H I L D L I F E V E S T ( 20 )

DOOR 2L DOOR 2R DOOR 2L DOOR 2 R


A A ESCAPE SLIDE A A E SC APE SL IDE
HALON EXTINGUISHER HAL ON E XT INGUISHE R
L L L L

NOTE AF T CL OS E T NOT E AFT CLOSET


IN ADDITION TO THE LIFE VESTS LISTED, HALON EXTINGUISHER I N A D D I T I O N T O T HE L IFE VE ST S L IST E D, HAL ON E XT INGUISHE R
THE R E A R E L I F E V E S T S U N D E R E A CH WATER EXTINGUISHER T H E R E A R E L I F E V EST S UNDE R E AC H WAT E R E XT INGUISHE R
PAS S E N G E R S E A T . PBE PASSENGER SEAT. PB E

737-300 Emergency Equipment Locations (Overwater Equipped) 737-300 Emergency Equipment Locations (Overwater Equipped)

and
OCT 99 Systems Introduction 25-25 OCT 99 25-25
UNITED
B737 GENERAL AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
EQUIPMENT/FURNISHINGS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE EQUIPMENT/FURNISHINGS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION
SLI DI NG W I N D O W SLIDING WINDOW SLIDING WINDOW SL IDING WINDOW
ESCAPE L I N E ESCAPE LINE ESCAPE LINE E SC APE L INE
SMOKE G O G G L E S SMOKE GOGGLES SMOKE GOGGLES SM OKE GOGGL E S

HALON EXTINGUISHER HAL ON E XT INGUISHE R


PB E PBE

SMOKE GOGGLES SM OKE GOGGL E S


G1 G1
L L

AA AA
AX E C G2 AXE C G2
DOOR 1R DOOR 1 R
ESCAPE SLIDE E SC APE SL IDE
HALON EXTINGUISHER HAL ON E XT INGUISHE R
D O O R 1L WATER EXTINGUISHER DOOR 1L WAT E R E XT INGUISHE R
ESCAPE S L I D E ESCAPE SLIDE
EMERGE N C Y F L A S H L I G H T (2 ) E M E R G E N C Y F L A S H L I G HT (2 )
F ORWARD CL OS E T FORW ARD CLOSET
PBE PB E

O H B I N 1 AB OH BIN 1 AB
FI R ST A I D K I T RIGHT CL AS S DIVIDE R FIRST AID KIT RIGHT CLASS DIVIDER
MEDI CA L K I T OXYGEN BOTTLE MEDICAL KIT OXYGE N B OT T L E
MEGAPH O N E MEGAPHONE

OVE RWING E ME R E XIT OVERW ING EM ER EXIT


L E F T CLASS DIVIDER ESCAPE LINE L E F T CL AS S DIVIDER E SC APE L INE
OXYGEN B O T T L E OXYGEN BOTTLE

O H B I N 3 AB OH BIN 3 AB
OXYGEN B O T T L E OXYGEN BOTTLE
OH BIN 20 DE F OH BIN 2 0 DEF
OXYGEN BOTTLE (2) OXYGE N B OT T L E (2 )

O V E R WING EMER EXIT OVE RWING E ME R E XIT


ESCAPE L I N E ESCAPE LINE

AF T GAL L E Y COMP T AFT GALLEY COM PT


OXYGEN MASK (2) OXYGE N M ASK (2 )
O H B I N 20 ABC OH BIN 20 ABC
FI R ST AI D K I T FIRST AID KIT
MEGAPH O N E MEGAPHONE

DOOR 2R DOOR 2 R
ESCAPE SLIDE E SC APE SL IDE
D O O R 2L HALON EXTINGUISHER DOOR 2L HAL ON E XT INGUISHE R
ESCAPE S L I D E A A ESCAPE SLIDE A A
EMERGENCY FLASHLIGHT E M E R GE NC Y FL ASHL IGHT
EMERGE N C Y F L A S H L I G H T (2 ) E M E R G E N C Y F L A S H L I G HT (2 )
L L L L

AF T CL OS E T AFT CLOSET
HALON EXTINGUISHER HAL ON E XT INGUISHE R
WATER EXTINGUISHER WAT E R E XT INGUISHE R
PBE PB E

737-500 Emergency Equipment Locations 737-500 Emergency Equipment Locations

25-26 and Systems Introduction OCT 99 25-26 OCT 99


 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

 
TABLE OF CONTENTS
B737-300/400/500 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION SELF-PACED
ATA-26

FIRE PROTECTION .............................................................................................................................................. 3


Overview..................................................................................................................................................... 3
FIRE/OVERHEAT DETECTION SYSTEM .............................................................................................................. 8
Overview..................................................................................................................................................... 8
ENGINE FIRE DETECTION SYSTEM .................................................................................................................. 12
Engine Fire/Overheat Detectors ............................................................................................................... 12
Engine and APU Fire Detection Accessory Unit ........................................................................................ 14
Engine and APU Fire Control Panel .......................................................................................................... 15
APU FIRE DETECTION SYSTEM........................................................................................................................ 16
APU Fire Detector Elements ..................................................................................................................... 16
Engine and APU Fire Control Panel .......................................................................................................... 18
Engine and APU Fire Detection Accessory Unit M279............................................................................... 20
APU Ground Control Panel........................................................................................................................ 21
SMOKE DETECTION SYSTEM - CARGO COMPARTMENT................................................................................. 23
Overview................................................................................................................................................... 23
Cargo Smoke Detector .............................................................................................................................. 24
Cargo Electronic Unit (CEU) ..................................................................................................................... 25
Cargo Fire Control Panel .......................................................................................................................... 26
WHEEL WELL OVERHEAT DETECTION SYSTEM............................................................................................... 28
Overheat ................................................................................................................................................... 28
Engine and APU Fire Control Module ....................................................................................................... 29
Compartment Overheat Accessory Unit Components (Airplanes with Boeing M237 compartment overheat
accessory unit) ......................................................................................................................................... 30
Compartment Overheat Accessory Unit Components (Airplanes with Fenwal electronic compartment
overheat accessory unit)........................................................................................................................... 31
Sensing Element....................................................................................................................................... 32
WING AND LOWER AFT BODY OVERHEAT DETECTION SYSTEM..................................................................... 33
Overview................................................................................................................................................... 33
Air Conditioning Module........................................................................................................................... 35
Master Caution Lights Control Section ..................................................................................................... 36
Compartment Overheat Accessory Unit Components (Airplanes with Boeing M237 compartment overheat
accessory unit) ......................................................................................................................................... 37
Compartment Overheat Accessory Unit Components (Airplanes with Fenwal M237 compartment overheat
accessory unit) ......................................................................................................................................... 38
Sensing Elements ..................................................................................................................................... 40
FIRE EXTINGUISHING SYSTEM......................................................................................................................... 42
Overview................................................................................................................................................... 42
ENGINE FIRE EXTINGUISHING SYSTEM ....................................................................................................... 43
Overview................................................................................................................................................... 43

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-26 Page 1


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

 
Engine Fire Extinguisher Bottle ................................................................................................................ 44
Engine and APU Fire Control Panel .......................................................................................................... 46
APU FIRE EXTINGUISHING SYSTEM............................................................................................................. 47
Overview................................................................................................................................................... 47
APU Fire Extinguisher Bottle .................................................................................................................... 48
Engine and APU Fire Control Panel .......................................................................................................... 49
APU Ground Control Panel........................................................................................................................ 50
EXTINGUISHING SYSTEM - CARGO COMPARTMENT FIRE........................................................................... 51
Overview................................................................................................................................................... 51
Cargo Fire Extinguishing Bottle ................................................................................................................ 52
Cargo Fire Control Panel .......................................................................................................................... 54
LAVATORY FIRE EXTINGUISHING SYSTEM .................................................................................................. 55
Overview................................................................................................................................................... 55
Fire Extinguisher Bottle ............................................................................................................................ 56
Temperature Indicator.............................................................................................................................. 56
PORTABLE FIRE EXTINGUISHERS ................................................................................................................ 58
Overview................................................................................................................................................... 58
Halon Extinguishers.................................................................................................................................. 58
Pressurized Water Extinguishers .............................................................................................................. 58

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-26 Page 2


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

FIRE PROTECTION
Overview

Fire protection consists of fire extinguishing and fire/overheat detection.

The detection systems warn of fire or overheat in each engine, auxiliary power unit (APU), main wheel well,
wings, lower aft body and lavatories (airplanes with lavatory smoke detection system). Lights on the engine
and APU fire control module, master warning lights on the lightshield module, and an alarm bell provide fire
indication. On some airplanes, there is a light on the overhead panel in the control cabin which provides fire
indication. Additional indications for the APU are a fire warning light on APU ground control panel and a
warning horn in the right main wheel well. Lights on the air conditioning module and master caution lights on
the lightshield module provide wing/body overheat indication. Lights on the light shield module and on the
overhead panel provide lavatory smoke indication (airplanes with lavatory smoke detection system).

The extinguishing systems are a fixed engine fire extinguishing system, a fixed APU fire extinguishing system,
a fixed lavatory fire extinguishing system, and portable fire extinguishers.

The fixed engine fire extinguishing system consists of two fire extinguisher bottles, providing two-shot
extinguishing at either engine. The bottles are connected to each engine by manifolds and tubing. A discharge
switch for each engine is on the engine and APU fire control module.

The fixed APU fire extinguishing system consists of an extinguisher bottle connected by tubing to the APU
shroud. The APU discharge switches are on the engine and APU fire control module and on the APU ground
control panel.

The fixed lavatory fire extinguishing system consists of a heat activated fire extinguisher bottle in each lavatory
to extinguish fires under the sink counter and in the towel chute.

Portable fire extinguishers are located in various positions in the crew and passenger cabins. They provide
fire extinguishing capability in these cabins and other areas accessible from them.

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-26 Page 3


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Engine and APU Fire Control Module

The engine and APU fire control module P8-1 contains components to monitor the fire and overheat detection
systems and to control and test the fire extinguishing system. The engine and APU fire control module is on
the control stand aft electronic control panel P8.

The front of the module contains the following components for extinguishing and detection: fire switch
handles with fire warning lights for each engine and the APU, discharge lights for each engine and APU,
overheat lights for each engine, wheel well overheat light, engine detector fault light, fire/overheat detector
selector switch for each engine, an APU detector inoperative light, a bell cutout switch, test switches, and three
fire extinguisher test lights. Master caution lights control circuits and fire extinguisher bottle test circuits are
on cards in the module.

OVHT DET WHEEL BELL CUTOUT OVHT DET L BOTTLE R BOTTLE


WELL R DISCHARGE DISCHARGE
A B A B A A

FAULT ENGINES
DISCH DISCH DISCH ET
NORMAL A NORMAL
XE 1 2
ENG 1 ENG 2 L R TS
L R APU DET OVERHEAT
OVERHEAT T
A INOP A A R
TEST L G G
F APU BOTTLE FIRE SWITCHES
I O F
A DISCHARGED (FUEL SHUTOFF)
U N V I
A PULL WHEN ILLUMINATED
L O H R LOCK OVERRIDE: PRESS
G
T P T E R R BUTTON UNDER HANDLE R APU

ENGINE AND APU FIRE CONTROL MODULE

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-26 Page 4


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Lightshield Module

The lightshield module P7 contains master fire warning, master caution, and annunciator lights.

FIRE MASTER
WARN CAUTION
BELL CUTOUT PUSH TO RESET

MASTER CAUTION AND


FIRE WARN LIGHTS
(TYPICAL)

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-26 Page 5


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

APU Ground Control Panel

The APU ground control panel P28 contains a fire warning light, a handle to arm the APU fire extinguishing
system, and bottle discharge and bell cutout switches. The panel is on the aft bulkhead of the right main
wheel well.

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-26 Page 6


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Air Conditioning Module

The air conditioning module P5-10 on the forward overhead panel has overheat lights and a test switch for the
wing and lower aft body detection system.

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-26 Page 7


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

FIRE/OVERHEAT DETECTION SYSTEM


Overview

Fire and overheat detection systems provide aural and visual alerts when overheat or fire are detected.

Engine Fire Detection

Dual-loop fire and overheat detection systems are in each engine area. Both loops of a system must sense fire
in order for a fire alarm to be given. If one loop is inoperative, then the system may be set to operate on the
operative loop.

APU Fire Detection

A single-loop fire detection system is in the APU compartment.

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-26 Page 8


and Systems
  Introduction
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE

 
B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization

AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource


 

 
 
FIRE MASTER MASTER FIRE
WARN CAUTION CAUTION WARN
A.P.U.
BELL CUTOUT P US H TO R E S ET P U S H TO RE S E T BELL CU TOUT
FIRE
CONTROL
1 . P U L L H A N D L E D O W N
2 . D I S C H A R G E B O T T L E

B O T T L E D I S C H A R G E

ENG 2 CORE
DETECTOR
PILOTS LIGHTSHIELD
BOTTLE HORN
DISCHARGE CUTOUT

ENG 2 OVHT SIGNAL ENG 2 FAN


UPPER DETECTOR
UNLOCK
HANDLE ENG 2 ENG 2
OVHT FIRE AND ENG 2 FAN
L R OVERHEAT LWR DETECTOR
DETECTION P28 APU REMOTE CONTROL PANEL
CIRCUITS (RIGHT WHEEL WELL)
ENG 2 FIREWALL
RIGHT FIRE ENG 2 FIRE SIGNAL
FIRE WARN DETECTOR
WARN LIGHT
LIGHT
FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY

FIRE SWITCH-
ENGINE 2
28V
DC APU
UNLOCK APU DET REMOTE APU REMOTE
HANDLE INOP WARN LIGHT HORN WARN
APU EXHAUST APU TAILPIPE
L R APU FIRE DET FIRE DET
DC
FIRE
DETECTION HORN DRIVER
CIRCUITS APU FIRE
APU FIRE SIGNAL DET
FIRE WARN
LIGHT
AIR
28V FIRE SWITCH-
DC APU GND
ENG 1 OVHT SIGNAL
LANDING GEAR
LEFT FIRE WARN UNLOCK ACCESSORY UNIT
LIGHT HANDLE ENG 1 ENG 1 ENG 1 CORE
OVHT FIRE AND DETECTOR
L R OVERHEAT
28V DETECTION
DC FIREBELL CIRCUITS ENG 1 FAN
UPPER DETECTOR
AURAL WARN FIRE WARN ENG 1 FIRE SIGNAL
ACCESSORY UNIT LIGHT
FIRE SWITCH- ENG 1 FAN
ENGINE 1 LWR DETECTOR
ENGINE AND APU FIRE MASTER OVHT DET WHEEL OVHT DET
BELL CUTOUT L BOTTLE R BOTTLE

CONTROL MODULE WARNING A B


WELL R
A B
DISCHAR GE
A
DISCHARGE
A

LOGIC ENG 1 FIREWALL ENGINES


DIS CH
FAULT
DETECTOR NORMAL DISCH NORMAL DISCH ET
CIRCUITS A
XE
ENG 1 ENG 2 TS
1 2
L R APU DET L R
OVERHEAT OVERHEAT T
A INOP A A R
TEST L G G
F
I O F APU BOT TLE
FIRE SWITCHES
A DISCHAR GED ( FUEL SHUTO FF)
N V I
U A PULL WHE N ILLUMINA TED
G
O H R LOC K OVERRIDE : PRESS
L
P T E R R BUTTON UND ER HANDLE R
T APU
FLASHER
ENGINE AND APU FIRE CONTROL MODULE
ENGINE AND APU FIRE
ATA-26 Page 9

DETECTION UNIT MODULE

Engine and APU Fire/Overheat Detection System Simplified Schematic

and Systems Introduction


 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Wheel Well Fire Detection

A single-loop fire detection system is in the main landing gear wheel well.

Wing and Lower Aft Body Overheat Detection

Two single-loop overheat detection systems are located in the wings, the air conditioning bays, the aft cargo
compartment, the keel beam, and the APU area.

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-26 Page 10


and Systems
  Introduction
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE

 
B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization

AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource


 

 
 
OVHT DET WHEEL BELL CUTOUT OVHT DET L BO TTL E R BOTTLE
WELL R DISCH ARG E DISC HAR GE
A B A B A A

FAULT ENGINES FWD KEEL BEAM


DISCH
NORMAL DISCH NORMAL DISCH ET
A
XE
1 2 DET FAULT OVHT DET
ENG 1 L R APU DET ENG 2 L R TS
OVERHEAT A INOP OVERHEAT A
T
R
ISOL CHECK
A
TEST L G G
F
O F FIRE SWITCHES
A I
APU BOTTLE
DIS CHARGED (FUEL SH UT OFF )
U N V I
H R
A P ULL WHEN ILLUM INA TED
G NORMAL
L O LOCK OVERRI DE: PR ESS
T P T E R R B UTT ON UNDER HANDL E R
APU FWD A/C PACK LEFT AFT A/C
P8-1 ENGINE FIRE CONTROL PANEL DET FAULT OVHT DET PACK OVHT DET DET CONT
ISOL CHECK CHECK

NORMAL SW 2
LEFT WING OVHT
DET INBD DET CONT AFT KEEL BEAM
CHECK
DET FAULT OVHT DET
ISOL CHECK
SW 1
LEFT WING OVHT
DET OUTBD NORMAL
OVHT DET AFT OVHT DET
SECTION 58 SECTION 56 DET CONT
DET FAULT CHECK
UP
ISOL CHECK
SW 1
FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY

SW 2 NORM LEFT WING, SW 3


SW 3
BODY, APU
DET CONT
DN
CHECK
OVERHEAT OVERHEAT M237 COMPARTMENT OVERHEAT
CONTROL LEFT ACCESSORY UNIT
CONT ENG 1 STRUT CIRCUITS
UNIT
SW3
CAVITY OVHT DET
WING,BODY
OVERHEAT OVERHEAT OVERHEAT
TEST
LEFT SEC AIR CONDITIONING
S658 AFT MODULE
CARGO

DET
AFT & FWD
KEEL BEAM

L. WING
DET

DET

RIGHT RECIRC FAN


RIGHT OFF
SW2 SW1 ENG 2 STRUT
WING,
CAVITY OVHT DET
BODY WING,BODY AUTO

A/C PACK DET


OVERHEAT OVERHEAT
CONTROL
AIR CONDITIONING 40 60 OVHT
CIRCUITS
COMPARTMENT
MODULE
20 80
OVERHEAT
UNIT PSI
BOEING TEST
0 100
EQUIP NO. M237
WHEEL L PACK R PACK
MAIN WHEEL WELL OFF OFF
WHEEL ISOLATION VALVE
WELL OVHT DET OVERHEAT AUTO AUTO
CLOSE
CONTROL WELL
WHEEL WELL ON ON
TEST CIRCUITS AUT0
ENGINE AND APU
COMPARTMENT FIRE CONTROL WING WING
OVERHEAT ACCESSORY ANTI OPEN ANTI
MODULE ICE
PACK PACK
ICE
UNIT TRIP OFF TRIP OFF
(E3-2) M237 COMPARTMENT OVERHEAT ACCESSORY UNIT WING-BODY WING-BODY
RIGHT WING OVHT OVERHEAT TRIP OVERHEAT
DET OUTBD BLEED BLEED
TRIP OFF TRIP OFF

RESET
OFF OFF

RIGHT WING OVHT RIGHT FWD A/C RIGHT AFT A/C


ON ON
DET INBD PACK OVHT DET PACK OVHT DET 1 APU 2
BLEED
ATA-26 Page 11

AIR CONDITIONING MODULE (P5-10)


Wheel Well and Wing and Lower Aft Body Overheat Detection System

and Systems Introduction


 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

ENGINE FIRE DETECTION SYSTEM


Engine Fire/Overheat Detectors

The engine fire detection system monitors engine and nacelle temperature for fire and overheat conditions.
Dual-loop fire/overheat detectors are located in each engine area.

The system uses power from the 28-volt DC battery bus. The circuit breakers are on panel P6.

Engine fire detection system components are fire detectors, engine and APU fire detection accessory unit, and
engine and APU fire control panel.

A detector consists of two identical sensing elements attached to a support tube by quick-release mounting
clamps.

Each sensing element contains an inert gas and gas-emitting core, and has a responder on one end. The
responder contains three pressure switches for sensing fire, overheat, and integrity (fault).

The inert gas in a sensing element expands as a function of average gas temperature. The gas-emitting core
expels gas due to high localized temperatures. Both actions cause an increase in pressure in the element,
which causes an alarm pressure switch in the responder to close, activating an alarm signal. Both actions are
completely reversible - as the temperature decreases, the pressure decreases, and the alarm switch
deactivates. When a sensing element is damaged allowing the inert gas to leak, the integrity pressure switch
opens, activating a fault signal. The pressure switches provide alarm and integrity signals to the appropriate
detector control card.

The detectors are identical except for length, temperature trip and reset settings of the pressure switches.

Each engine has four Engine Fire Detector Elements; one detector is located on the right side of the strut above
the fan case, one detector is located on the upper left side of the fan case, one detector is located on the
underside of the fan case, and one detector is located around the engine core. You can access the three
detectors in the fan area by opening the fan cowl panel. You can access the core detector by opening the fan
duct cowl and thrust reviser halves.

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-26 Page 12


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

STRUT DETECTOR
SEE B

CORE DETECTOR
LOWER FAN SEE D
DETECTOR
SEE C
UPPER FAN DETECTOR
SEE A

SENSOR
CLAMP

SUPPORT TUBE
CLAMP

UPPER FAN DETECTOR


A

SENSOR
CLAMP

SUPPORT TUBE
CLAMP

STRUT DETECTOR
B

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-26 Page 13


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Engine and APU Fire Detection Accessory Unit

Engine fire detection system components of the engine and APU fire detection accessory unit are engine 1 and
2 control cards and accessory control card. The unit is on shelf E3-3 of the electronics rack.

ELECTRONIC
EQUIPMENT
DETECTOR SYSTEM
RACK E3
FAULT/INOP TEST

ENGINE AND APU FIRE


DETECTION ACCESSORY ENGINE NO 1
UNIT
SEE A

A - LOOP - B
ENGINE NO 2

A - LOOP - B
APU FAULT/INOP

TEST

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-26 Page 14


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Engine and APU Fire Control Panel

Engine fire detection system components of the engine and APU fire control panel are two fire/overheat
detector selector switches, test switch, engine 1 and 2 overheat lights, engine fault light, and engine 1 and 2
fire switch handles. The panel is on the aft electronics panel of the control stand.

There is one fire/overheat detector selector switch for each engine. Setting the switch to NORMAL enables
both loops to operate in AND - logic. Setting the switch to A or B enables the indicated loop and disables the
other.

Setting the TEST switch to OVHT/FIRE checks the integrity of the sensing and warning circuits. The engine
fire switch handle lights, OVERHEAT lights, master FIRE WARN lights, and bell activate.

Setting the TEST switch to FAULT/INOP checks the fault discrimination circuit. The FAULT and MASTER
CAUTION lights illuminate.

The fire, overheat and fault lights illuminate when the appropriate signals from the accessory unit are sent.

OVHT DET WHEEL BELL CUTOUT OVHT DET L BOTTLE R BOTTLE


DISCHARGED DISCHARGED
WELL
A B A B
DISCH FAULT DISCH DISCH ENGINES
NORMAL L R NORMAL L ET
R
ENG 1 ENG 2 XE 1 2
OVERHEAT APU DET OVERHEAT TS
R
TEST INOP T
FIRE SWITCHES L
F I O F
A N V I APU BOTTLE
(FUEL SHUTOFF)
PULL WHEN ILLUMINATED
U O H R DISCHARGED
LOCK OVERRIDE PRESS
L P T E BUTTON UNDER HANDLE
T APU

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-26 Page 15


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

APU FIRE DETECTION SYSTEM


APU Fire Detector Elements

Detector elements are located in the engine and exhaust areas of the APU. Detector elements are located in the
engine compartment, exhaust heat shield, and muffler assembly.

The sensing elements are attached to a support tube by quick-release mounting clamps. Each sensing
element contains an inert gas, a gas-emitting core material, and has a responder on one end. The responder
contains two pressure switches, alarm and integrity, and provides the electrical interface with the airplane
wiring.

The inert gas in a sensing element expands as temperature increases. The gas-emitting core material expels
gas due to high localized temperature. Both actions cause a pressure increase in the element, which causes
the alarm pressure switch to close, activating an alarm signal. When the temperature decreases, the pressure
decreases, and the alarm switch opens. If a sensing element is damaged and the inert gas leaks, the integrity
pressure switch opens, activating a fault signal. The pressure switches provide alarm and integrity signals to
the APU fire detection card.

ELECTRICAL
TERMINALS
WIRE BUNDL
CLAMP

DETECTOR
RESPONDER

SUPPORT TUBE

DETECTOR WITH TERMINAL LUG TYPE RESPONDERS

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-26 Page 16


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

EXHAUST DUCT
COOLING AIR
INTAKE

FELT METAL
LINER

DETECTOR
AFT SEE C
FAIRING
APU EXHAUST
AREA MUFFLER DRIP PAN

SEE A
APU
SEE B

SEE E

HEAT SHIELD
DETECTOR
APU
SHROUD
FWD DETECTOR
SEE D
BONDING
JUMPER TURBINE
EXHAUST
PORT

APU EXHAUST COMPARTMENT


A

APU FIRE DETECTOR LOCATION


(AIRPLANES WITH GARRETT GTCP85-129 APU)
(EXAMPLE)

B
DETECTOR

SEE E

APU FIRE DETECTOR LOCATION


(AIRPLANES WITH SUNSTRAND APS 2000 APU)
(EXAMPLE)

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-26 Page 17


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Engine and APU Fire Control Panel

The engine and APU fire control panel P8-1 is on the pilots' control stand. Components of P8-1 applicable to
APU fire detection are APU DET INOP light, fire switch handle warning light, TEST switch, and BELL CUTOUT
switch.

The DET INOP light provides an indication of a wiring fault or sensor loss of pressure. The DET INOP-light
circuitry is also connected to the master caution lights.

A fire warning light in the APU fire switch handle provides APU area fire warning. The APU fire warning light
is connected to the APU fire detection card. A fire or overheat condition in the APU area will cause steady
illumination of the warning light. The fire warning light consists of several bulbs covered by a red translucent
plastic lens cap in the fire switch handle.

The TEST switch has three positions:


FAULT/INOP-off-FIRE/OVHT; the switch is spring-loaded to the off position. The switch permits testing of the
APU fire detection system by checking sensor continuity and simulating a fire condition when positioned to
FIRE/OVHT. During fire/overheat test the APU automatic shutdown circuitry is inhibited. When in the
FAULT/INOP position, the fault discrimination circuit of the APU fire detection card is tested and the
inoperative light will illuminate.

A switch is provided for alarm bell control. Pressing the switch provides 28-volts DC to the signal condition
control card in the fire detection accessory unit. The control circuit silences the bell and extinguishes the
master fire warning lights on P7.

Master Fire Warning Lights

The master fire warning lights are on lightshield module P7. When a fire condition occurs, the fire warning
lights illuminate.

The master fire warning lights are controlled by the signal condition control card of the engine and APU fire
detection accessory unit. Either light may be pressed for bell or remote horn cutout and for extinguishing the
lights.

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-26 Page 18


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

CAPTAIN'S LIGHT FIRST OFFICER'S


MODULE (P7) LIGHT MODULE (P7)
SEE F SEE G

FIRE PROTECTION CONTROL


SYSTEM MODULE (P8) STAND
SEE E
FLIGHT COMPARTMENT

OVHT DET WHEEL BELL CUTOUT OVHT DET L BOTTLE R BOTTLE


WELL R DISCHARGE DISCHARGE
A B A B A A

FAULT
ENGINES
DISCH DISCH DISCH E T
NORMAL A NORMAL
X E
ENG 1 ENG 2 1 2
L R APU DET L R T S
OVERHEAT OVERHEAT T
A INOP A R
A
TEST L G G
F FIRE SWITCHES
I O F APU BOTTLE
A (FUEL SHUTOFF)
N V I DISCHARGED
U A PULL WHEN ILLUMINATED
O H R G
L LOCK OVERRIDE: PRESS
P T E R R R
T BUTTON UNDER HANDLE APU

ENGINE AND APU FIRE CONTROL MODULE (P8)


E

FIRE MASTER MASTER FIRE


WARN CAUTION CAUTION WARN
BELL CUTOUT PUSH TO RESET PUSH TO RESET BELL CUTOUT

CAPTAIN'S LIGHT MODULE (P7) FIRST OFFICER'S LIGHT MODULE (P7


(EXAMPLE) (EXAMPLE)
F G

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-26 Page 19


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Engine and APU Fire Detection Accessory Unit M279

The engine and APU fire detection accessory unit M279 is on electronic equipment rack E3. Components of
M279 applicable to APU fire detection are the APU fire detection card and the accessory control card.

ELECTRONIC
EQUIPMENT
DETECTOR SYSTEM
RACK E3
FAULT/INOP TEST

ENGINE AND APU FIRE


DETECTION ACCESSORY ENGINE NO 1
UNIT
SEE A

A - LOOP - B
ENGINE NO 2

A - LOOP - B
APU FAULT/INOP

TEST

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-26 Page 20


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

APU Ground Control Panel

The remote horn warns of a fire or overheat in the APU. The remote horn is in the right main wheel well
adjacent to the APU ground control panel. The horn is turned on and off by the signal condition control card of
the engine and APU fire detection accessory unit. The horn will operate only when the airplane is on the
ground.

The APU ground control panel P28 contains APU fire warning light and the horn cutout switch.

The horn cutout switch can be used to extinguish the master fire warning lights and cut off the fire warning
horn and bell.

A fire in the APU will cause pulsating illumination of the fire warning light. The warning light is controlled
through the accessory control card. When a bell or horn cutout switch is pressed, the light illuminates
continuously until the fire warning signal is gone.

P28 is on the right side of the main wheel well.

A.P.U.
FIRE
CONTROL
1. PULL HANDLE DOWN
2. DISCHARGE BOTTLE
APU GROUND
BOTTLE DISCHARGE
CONTROL PANEL
SEE I

BOTTLE HORN
DISCHARGE CUTOUT

APU GROUND CONTROL PANEL


I

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-26 Page 21


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-26 Page 22


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

SMOKE DETECTION SYSTEM - CARGO COMPARTMENT


Overview

The cargo compartment smoke detection system is used to monitor smoke in the forward and aft cargo
compartments.

The system includes these parts:

1. Smoke Detectors
2. Cargo Electronic Units (CEU)
3. Cargo Fire Control Panel

The cargo compartment smoke detection system uses 28-volts DC power. The power is supplied through the
circuit breakers on the P6 or P18 panel.

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-26 Page 23


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Cargo Smoke Detector

Cargo Smoke detectors are installed in the ceiling of the forward and aft cargo compartment. A screen is
installed over the smoke detector to keep it from being damaged. The smoke detectors are controlled and
monitored by the Cargo Electronic Units (CEUs). The smoke detectors send alarm signals and status signals
to the CEUs.

The smoke detectors monitor the air for presence of smoke or equivalent contaminants. When the
concentration of smoke gets to a preset threshold, the detector sends a signal to the applicable CEU.

AFT CARGO
COMPARTMENT

FORWARD
CARGO
COMPARTMENT
SMOKE
DETECTOR
SEE D

SMOKE
DETECTOR
SEE D

CARGO
CEILING
(REF)

SCREEN

SMOKE
DETECTOR

(EXAMPLE)

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-26 Page 24


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Cargo Electronic Unit (CEU)

One Cargo Electronic Unit (CEU) is installed in the ceiling of each cargo compartment. An access panel is
installed over the CEU to keep it from being damaged. The CEU in the aft cargo compartment controls and
monitors the smoke detectors in the aft cargo compartment. The CEU in the forward cargo compartment
controls and monitors the smoke detectors in the forward cargo compartment.

The CEU has two test buttons. The LAMP TEST button will make sure that all the indication lamps on the
CEU will come on. The PRESS TO TEST button will initiate a signal to do a test of all the smoke detectors in
its cargo compartment.

The CEU has lamps for each smoke detector in its cargo compartment. If a smoke detector fails or a smoke
alarm is initiated by a smoke detector, then the lamp for that smoke detector will come on.

CARGO ELECTRONIC UNIT


PRESS- WKA PN: 473925
TO-TEST SER NO:

DESIGN ACTIVITY/MFR 61423

MFD DATE:
FT XX/XX

LAMP WALTER KIDDE Aerospace


Division of KIDDE Technologies, Inc.

TEST Wilson, North Carolina 27896-9643 U.S.A.


CAGE CODE 61423
TSO-CIC

1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
A A CAUTION

B B

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-26 Page 25


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Cargo Fire Control Panel

The Cargo Fire Control Panel is installed in the P5 or P8 panel in the Flight Compartment. The control panel
is used to initiate a test of the cargo smoke detection system and to indicate when a failure or a smoke alarm
has been initiated.

The TEST switch, on the control panel, will initiate a test of the cargo smoke detection system. The test will
make sure that the Cargo Electronic Unit and the smoke detectors are operating correctly.

The DETECTOR FAULT light will come on whenever a smoke detector or a CEU has a power failure. The light
will also come on if a detector fails to respond to the test.

The DET SELECT switches control whether the system will operate in dual loop mode or single loop mode.
When the switch is in the NORM position, the system will operate in the dual loop mode. When the switch is
in the A position or the B position, then the system will operate in the single loop mode.

The applicable FWD or AFT warning light (red) will come on when smoke is sensed in one of the cargo
compartments.

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-26 Page 26


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

MASTER CAUTION
AND FIRE WARN
LIGHTS (P7)
FIRE MASTER
SEE A WARN CAUTION
BELL CUTOUT PUSH TO RESET

ENGINE AND APU


FIRE CONTROL
MODULE (P8)
SEE C

MASTER CAUTION AND


FIRE WARN LIGHTS (P7)
(EXAMPLE)

CARGO FIRE
A
CONTROL PANEL (P8)
SEE B
FLIGHT COMPARTMENT EXT DET SELECT
FWD AFT NORM NORM DETECTOR
A B A B FAULT
C g g
F
A
I
R FWD AFT DISCH
ARMED R
G TEST
E
O
ARMED ARMED

r r
DISCH

CARGO FIRE CONTROL PANEL (P8)


B

OVHT DET WHEEL BELL CUTOUT OVHT DET L BOTTLE R BOTTLE


WELL R DISCHARGE DISCHARGE
A B A B A A

FAULT
ENGINES
DISCH DISCH DISCH ET
NORMAL A NORMAL
XE
ENG 1 ENG 2 1 2
L R APU DET L R TS
OVERHEAT OVERHEAT T
A INOP A A R
TEST L G G
F APU BOTTLE FIRE SWITCHES
I O F
A DISCHARGED (FUEL SHUTOFF)
U N V I
A PULL WHEN ILLUMINATED
L O H R LOCK OVERRIDE: PRESS
G
P T E R R R
T BUTTON UNDER HANDLE APU

ENGINE AND APU FIRE CONTROL MODULE (P8)


C

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-26 Page 27


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

WHEEL WELL OVERHEAT DETECTION SYSTEM


Overheat

The wheel well overheat detection system provides overheat detection in the main wheel well area. The
detection system is an electrical, heat sensing system that responds to overheat by activating fire warning
lights and an alarm bell.

The wheel well overheat detection system consists of the engine and APU fire control module P8-1,
compartment overheat accessory unit M237, alarm bell, master fire warning lights, and a sensing element.
The sensing element is connected to the compartment overheat accessory unit, which monitors the resistance
of the sensing element. When a temperature rise causes the element resistance to drop to the value
corresponding to the alarm temperature, the compartment overheat accessory unit will provide a signal to the
wheel well warning light and alarm bell and a ground to the master fire warning lights.

The overheat detection system can be tested by operation of the TEST switch on the engine and APU fire
control module. The switch tests continuity through the wheel well system by simulating an overheat condition
and energizing the alarm bell and warning lights.

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-26 Page 28


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Engine and APU Fire Control Module

Wheel Well Warning Light

A warning light indicates overheat in the wheel well area.

Test Switch

Holding the switch to the fire position operates control circuits in the accessory unit which simulate overheat
in the wheel well. The wheel well overheat warning components are then energized.

Bell Cutout Switch

The switch can be pressed to silence the fire alarm bell and extinguish the master fire warning lights.

FIRE MASTER
WARN CAUTION
BELL CUTOUT PUSH TO RESET

MASTER CAUTION AND


FIRE WARN LIGHTS (P7)
(EXAMPLE)

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-26 Page 29


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Compartment Overheat Accessory Unit Components


(Airplanes with Boeing M237 compartment overheat accessory unit)

The compartment overheat accessory unit is on electronic equipment rack E3 in the electronic compartment.

The temperature control unit contains circuitry to continuously monitor the sensing element resistance and
provide an alarm signal when the element resistance drops to the trip level. When the overheat condition has
passed, the system returns to its standby condition.

The compartment overheat unit is a printed circuit card which plugs into the compartment overheat accessory
unit and is held in place by screws. The card provides turn-on and cutout control of the alarm bell and master
fire warning lights.

A wheel well overheat test relay is in the wheel well test circuit. When the test circuit is operated, the relay
closes and connects a resistor and ground to the sensing circuits, thus simulating a fire condition.

BOEING MODULE

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-26 Page 30


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Compartment Overheat Accessory Unit Components


(Airplanes with Fenwal electronic compartment overheat accessory unit)

The compartment overheat accessory unit is on electronic equipment rack E3-2 in the electronic compartment.

The compartment overheat accessory unit has a cover plate which contains a numeric LED display, a
maintenance advisory LED, and four BITE pushbutton controls identified as; MEM READ, MEM CLEAR, LOC
TEST, DISP TEST.

The compartment overheat accessory unit contains a power supply card, a control card and a relay card. The
compartment overheat accessory unit also serves the functions of the wing and lower aft body overheat
detection system.

FENWAL MODULE

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-26 Page 31


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Sensing Element

A sensing element provides overheat detection in the main wheel well. The sensing element is attached to
structure in the ceiling of the wheel well. The element is attached by quick-release fasteners.

The sensing element is a thermistor type with resistance inversely proportional to temperature. As the
element temperature rises, its resistance is lowered. The sensing element consists of a single nickel wire
embedded in insulation, which is impregnated with a salt compound and is sheathed in an Inconel tube.

If any portion of the sensing element is heated above alarm temperature, the element resistance drops sharply
from a relatively high to an extremely low level. The single wire that is embedded in the center of the core is
the power lead and the outside tubing is grounded. The insulating resistance of the core material decreases
abruptly at the alarm temperature. Current flows through the core material to ground when alarm temperature
is sensed.

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-26 Page 32


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

WING AND LOWER AFT BODY OVERHEAT DETECTION SYSTEM


Overview

The wing and lower aft body overheat detection system provides overheat detection for the wings and lower aft
body. The detection system is an electrical, heat sensing system that responds to overheat by activating
warning lights.

Airplanes with Boeing M237 compartment overheat accessory unit:

The wing and lower aft body overheat detection system consists of an overheat test switch and overheat lights
on air conditioning module P5-10, compartment overheat accessory unit, master caution lights, and sensing
elements. The sensing elements are connected to the compartment overheat accessory unit. The accessory
unit contains left and right temperature control units and test circuits. The temperature control units monitor
the resistance of the sensing elements. When a temperature rise causes the resistance to drop to value
corresponding to the alarm temperature, the temperature control unit will provide a signal to the applicable
warning light and the master caution light control section in the air conditioning module.

The wing and lower aft body overheat detection system is divided into left and right sections. The right
overheat section consists of sensing elements that are connected in series with the right temperature control
unit and overheat test relay K1 to form a closed circuit sensing loop. The left overheat section consists of
sensing elements connected in series through three test switches to the left and APU overheat temperature
unit to form a closed circuit sensing loop. Test switches on the compartment overheat accessory unit enable a
malfunction in the left overheat section to be isolated.

The overheat detection system can be tested by an overheat test switch on the air conditioning module. The
overheat test switch tests continuity through the sensing loops by simulating an overheat condition. If the left
detection system fails to test, the area of the malfunction can be isolated by operating the switches on the
compartment overheat accessory unit.

The right sensing loop elements are at engine 2 strut cavity, right wing bleed air duct, right wing leading edge,
and right air conditioning packs. The left sensing loop elements are at engine 1 strut cavity, left wing bleed
air duct, left wing leading edge, left air conditioning packs, keel beam, aft cargo compartment, and APU cavity.

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-26 Page 33


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

 
Airplanes with electronic Fenwal M237 compartment overheat accessory unit:

The wing and lower aft body overheat detection system consists of an overheat test switch and overheat lights
on air conditioning module P5-10, compartment overheat accessory unit, master caution lights, and sensing
elements. The sensing elements are connected to the compartment overheat accessory unit. The accessory
unit contains a control card which has a microprocessor and a relay board which monitor the resistance of the
sensing elements. When a temperature rise causes the resistance to drop to a value corresponding to the
alarm temperature, the compartment overheat accessory unit will provide a signal to the applicable warning
light and the master caution light control section in the air conditioning module. When an alarm/fault
condition is found, the condition is stored in the non-volatile memory of the Fenwal compartment overheat
accessory unit. The MAINT ADV light will illuminate when a condition is stored in memory. The MAINT ADV
light will not extinguish until the condition is corrected and the memory is cleared.

The wing and lower aft body overheat detection system is divided into left and right sections. The right
overheat section consists of a single detector loop with sensing elements connected in series. The left overheat
section consists of four separate detector loops with sensing elements connected in series. All five loops are
monitored by the control card in the compartment overheat accessory unit. The compartment overheat
accessory unit can isolate an alarm/fault condition to each of the five loops, which can be displayed as a code
on the LED display. The codes, as defined on the compartment overheat accessory unit cover plate; isolate the
condition to the specific location and condition; an alarm, an open loop fault, or a short circuit loop fault.

The right sensing loop elements are at the engine 2 strut cavity, right wing bleed air duct, right wing leading
edge, and right air conditioning packs. The left sensing loop elements are at engine 1 strut cavity, left wing
bleed air duct, left wing leading edge, left air conditioning packs, keel beam, aft cargo compartment, and APU
cavity.

The wing and lower aft body overheat detection system can be tested by an overheat test switch on the air
conditioning module. The overheat test switch tests continuity through the sensing loops by simulating an
overheat condition.

NOTE: With the Fenwal compartment overheat accessory unit, the alarm indications require
approximately 4 seconds to appear during wing and aft body overheat test.

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-26 Page 34


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Air Conditioning Module

Overheat Warning Lights

Two overheat warning lights are on the air conditioning module. Overheat will cause either the left or right
overheat warning light and the master caution lights to illuminate.

The warning lights may be tested individually by a press-to-test feature or are tested when the master caution
test switch is closed.

Test Switch

A switch is provided for testing the wing and lower aft body-overheat detection system. Pressing the test
switch grounds the sensing elements. If all circuits are operating correctly, the overheat warning lights will
illuminate.

NOTE: On airplanes with the Fenwal M237 compartment overheat accessory unit, the
overheat warning indications require holding the test switch for approximately 4
seconds.

DUAL RAM DOOR RAM DOOR


BLEED FULL OPEN FULL OPEN
A B B

RECIRC FAN
OFF

AUTO

40 60
OVHT S1 OVHT
80 TEST SWITC

PSI
0 100
TEST

L PACK ISOLATION R PACK


OFF VALVE OFF
AUTO CLOSE AUTO
HIGH AUTO HIGH

WING PACK PACK WING


ANTI OPEN ANTI
TRIP OFF TRIP OFF
A A
ICE ICE
L1 WING-BODY WING-BODY L3
OVERHEAT
TRIP OVERHEAT
A A

BLEED BLEED
TRIP OFF TRIP OFF
A A

RESET

OFF OFF

ON ON
1 APU 2
BLEED
AUTO OFF SCHED
STANDBY MANUAL
FAIL A D E S C E N TA G G

P5-10 AIR CONDITIONING MODULE

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-26 Page 35


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Master Caution Lights Control Section

The master caution lights control section provides control of the master caution lights and air condition
annunciator light on the lightshield module P7.

When an overheat warning occurs, the compartment overheat accessory unit provides a ground to the control
section. The ground completes switching circuits which allows the master caution lights and master caution
air conditioning annunciator light on P7 to illuminate. Either master caution light may be pressed to reset the
master caution lights and annunciator lights.

FIRE MASTER
WARN CAUTION
BELL CUTOUT PUSH TO RESET

MASTER CAUTION AND


FIRE WARN LIGHTS (P7)
(EXAMPLE)

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-26 Page 36


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Compartment Overheat Accessory Unit Components


(Airplanes with Boeing M237 compartment overheat accessory unit)

The compartment overheat accessory unit is on electronic equipment rack E3 in the electronic compartment.

Each control unit contains circuitry to continuously monitor sensing element resistance and provide an alarm
signal when the element resistance drops to the trip level. When the overheat condition has passed, the
system returns to its standby condition.

The overheat light is controlled by the left and APU temperature control unit. Either an overheat or simulated
overheat condition in the left overheat section will energize the output relay of the left and APU overheat
control unit and provide a signal for the steady illumination of the light. The light has a press-to-test feature.
The test light will also illuminate whenever the left overheat light on the air conditioning module illuminates.

Test Switches

Three switches in the left sensing loop facilitate isolating and locating a malfunction. Each switch has three
positions and is spring-loaded to center position.

The test switches are in series with the sensing elements. Each test switch may be actuated in turn to
determine which section of the detection system has malfunctioned. When a test switch is pushed up, the
applicable part of the detector circuit is tested for a ground fault (fault alarm). The overheat light will
illuminate if a sensor circuit is grounded. The overheat light will remain off if the sensor circuit is broken.
Pushing a test switch down checks the applicable part of the detector circuit for continuity.

BOEING MODULE
C

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-26 Page 37


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Compartment Overheat Accessory Unit Components (Airplanes with Fenwal M237 compartment
overheat accessory unit)

The compartment overheat accessory unit is on electronic equipment rack E3 in the electronic compartment.

The cover plate of the M237 compartment overheat accessory unit contains an LED display, a MAINT ADV
light, and four BITE pushbutton controls as follows:

(1) MEM READ - Accesses the non-volatile memory.


(2) MEM CLEAR - Clears the non-volatile memory.
(3) LOC TEST - Initiates self-test of the control circuits and sensing elements.
(4) DISP TEST - Initiates self-test of the control circuits and the LED display.

FENWAL MODULE

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-26 Page 38


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-26 Page 39


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Sensing Elements

The sensing element is a thermistor type device with a resistance inversely proportional to the alarm
temperature. As the element temperature rises above the alarm temperature, its resistance is lowered. The
sensing element consists of a single nickel wire embedded in insulation, impregnated with a salt compound
and sheathed in an Inconel tube. Elements actuate at approximately 255°F for aft cargo compartment, right
and left A/C pack, forward and aft keelbeam, sec 56 and sec 58, left and right wing leading edge bleed
airducts, and left and right wing inboards, and 310°F for left and right engine strut cavities, leading edge
overheat detectors.

If any portion of the sensing element is heated above alarm temperature, the element resistance drops sharply
from a relatively high to an extremely low level. The single wire embedded in the center of the core is the
power lead and the outside tubing is grounded. The insulating resistance of the core material decreases
abruptly at the alarm temperature. Current flows through the core material to ground when an alarm
temperature is sensed.

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-26 Page 40


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

SECTION 58
OVERHEAT
OVERHEAT
DETECTORS
DETECTOR,
SEE A M276

AFT CARGO
AIR CONDITIONING RIGHT AIR COMPARTMENT
MODULE (P5) CONDITIONING OVERHEAT DETECTORS,
PACK OVERHEAT M347, M348, M1147
SEE B DETECTORS, AFT
M356, M271 KEEL BEAM
OVERHEAT
DETECTOR,
M273
BLEED AIR DUCT
RIGHT WING
LEADING EDGE
OVERHEAT DETECTOR,
M1204

RIGHT ENGINE
STRUT CAVITY
OVERHEAT DETECTOR,
SECTION 56
M488
OVERHEAT
DETECTOR,
M275

BLEED AIR
RIGHT WING
DUCT LEFT
OVERHEAT FORWARD KEEL WING LEADING
DETECTOR, BEAM OVERHEAT EDGE OVERHEAT
M269, M371 DETECTORS, DETECTOR,
M272 LEFT WING M1205
OVERHEAT LEFT ENGINE
DETECTORS, STRUT CAVITY
M370, M268 OVERHEAT
DETECTOR,
LEFT AIR CONDITIONING M487
PACK OVERHEAT DETECTORS,
M355, M274
A

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-26 Page 41


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

FIRE EXTINGUISHING SYSTEM


Overview

Fire extinguishing consists of engine fire extinguishing, APU fire extinguishing, portable fire extinguishing, and
lavatory fire extinguishing.

Engine Fire Extinguishing

Two fire extinguishing bottles distribute extinguishing agent to either engine. Both bottles are in the main
wheel well.

APU Fire Extinguishing

One fire extinguishing bottle distributes extinguishing agent to the APU. The bottle is on the lower right side
of the empennage section.

Portable Fire Extinguishing

Portable fire extinguishers are located throughout the flight and passenger compartment areas.

Lavatory Fire Extinguishing

The lavatory fire extinguishing system consists of a heat-activated fire extinguisher bottle in each lavatory to
extinguish fires under the sink counter and in the towel chute.

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-26 Page 42


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

ENGINE FIRE EXTINGUISHING SYSTEM


Overview

The engine fire extinguishing system has controls that release one or two applications of fire extinguishing
agent to either engine.

The engine fire extinguishing system consists of two engine fire extinguisher bottles and an engine and APU
fire control panel.

The engine fire extinguishing system receives power from the 28-volt DC hot battery bus through L FIRE EXT
BOTTLE (2 places) and R FIRE EXT BOTTLE (2 places) circuit breakers on panel P6.

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-26 Page 43


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Engine Fire Extinguisher Bottle

Engine fire extinguisher bottles are in the main landing gear wheel well. The extinguisher bottle includes two
squib cartridges, a pressure switch, a pressure gauge, two discharge ports, and a filling port.

One squib cartridge is on the discharge port of each extinguisher bottle. Plumbing from each discharge port to
either engine is direct. When detonated, the cartridge ruptures a retaining disc in the port releasing the
extinguishing agent.

The pressure switch closes and activates the bottle discharge lights when the bottle is discharged or bottle
pressure decreases.

The filling port is plugged by a stainless steel disc that acts as the primary safety relief device. The disc
ruptures when bottle pressure is 2050 to 2150 PSIG at 70°F.

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-26 Page 44


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

DISCHARGE
NOZZLE (TYP)

FWD (L) FIRE


EXTINGUISHER
PRESSURE BOTTLE
GAGE/SWITCH

AFT (R) FIRE


EXTINGUISHER MOUNTING
BOTTLE BOLT (TYP)

FIRE EXTINGUISHER
BOTTLE INSTALLATION TO ENGINE 2
SEE A SEE B
SQUIB
DISCHARGE ELECTRICAL
PLUG 1 CONNECTORS

DISCHARGE
DISCHARGE PLUG 1
PLUG 2 DISCHARGE
PLUG 2

FWD

TO ENGINE 1

FWD (L) FIRE SQUIB ELECTRICAL


EXTINGUISHER CONNECTORS
BOTTTLE

A
TO ENGINE
MOUNTING
BOLT (TYP)

PRESSURE
TO ENGINE GAGE/SWITCH

PRESSURE SWITCH
AFT (R) FIRE CONNECTOR
EXTINGUISHER
DISCHARGE
BOTTTLE
PLUG 1
PRESSURE
GAGE/SWITCH
DISCHARGE
PLUG 2 DISCHARGE
DISCHARGE PLUG 2
PLUG 1
FWD SQUIB ELECTRICAL
CONNECTORS

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-26 Page 45


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Engine and APU Fire Control Panel

Engine fire extinguishing system components of the engine and APU fire control panel are engine 1 and 2 fire
switch handles, left and right bottle discharge lights, test switch, and left and right bottle test light. The
engine and APU fire control panel is on the aft electronics panel of the control stand.

Engine Fire Switches

When an engine fire is detected, the engine fire switch handle light comes on. A solenoid energizes, releasing
a mechanical interlock on the fire switch handle shaft. When the mechanical interlock is released, the fire
switch handle can be operated by pulling the handle out and rotating it. Rotating the handle releases the
extinguishing agent from the indicated bottle. To push the handle back in, it must be in the center position.
The fire switch handle can be manually unlocked by pressing the button behind the handle.

Bottle Discharge Lights

The bottle discharge lights are activated by the pressure switches. When the bottle discharges or bottle
pressure decreases, the pressure switch closes and the bottle discharge light comes on.

Test Switch and Test Lights

The test switch checks extinguisher bottle squib continuity and bottle pressure switch continuity. When set to
1 or 2, the test switch checks circuit continuity through the squib and the L and R test lights and L and R
BOTTLE DISCHARGE lights come on for a successful test.

OVHT DET WHEEL BELL CUTOUT OVHT DET L BOTTLE R BOTTLE


WELL R DISCHARGE DISCHARGE
A B A B A A

FAULT ENGINES
DISCH DISCH DISCH ET
NORMAL A NORMAL
XE 1 2
ENG 1 ENG 2 L R TS
L R APU DET OVERHEAT
OVERHEAT T
A INOP A A R
TEST L G G
F APU BOTTLE FIRE SWITCHES
I O F
A DISCHARGED (FUEL SHUTOFF)
U N V I
A PULL WHEN ILLUMINATED
L O H R LOCK OVERRIDE: PRESS
G
T P T E R R BUTTON UNDER HANDLE R APU

ENGINE AND APU FIRE CONTROL MODULE

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-26 Page 46


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

APU FIRE EXTINGUISHING SYSTEM


Overview

The APU fire extinguishing system has controls in two locations that release one application of fire
extinguishing agent in the APU compartment.

The APU fire extinguishing system includes the fire extinguisher bottle, the engine and APU fire control panel,
and the APU ground control panel.

The APU fire extinguishing system receives power from the 28-volt DC hot battery bus through APU FIRE EXT
BOTTLE circuit breaker on main power distribution panel P6.

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-26 Page 47


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

APU Fire Extinguisher Bottle

The APU fire extinguisher bottle is on the lower right side of empennage section. The extinguisher bottle
includes a squib, pressure switch, pressure gage, filling port and discharge port.

The squib, when detonated, ruptures a retaining disc in the discharge port releasing the extinguishing agent.

The fire extinguishing agent is non-corrosive and will not damage the APU. There are no special inspections or
cleaning procedures required if the agent is discharged in the APU compartment when there is no fire.

The pressure gage indicates pressure in the extinguisher bottle. The gage also contains a pressure switch that
will close and activate the bottle discharge lights when the bottle is discharged or pressure drops.

The filling port plug is a metal plug with a fusible metal core which acts as a safety relief valve. From the
safety relief valve on the bottle, a tube leads to the lower fuselage skin near the bottle where it is capped with
a red indicator disk. If the bottle temperature rises to approximately 266°F, the fusible core will melt and the
bottle pressure will rupture the indicator disk, dumping the extinguishing agent overboard.

DISCHARGE
APU FIRE PORT
EXTINGUISHER SQUIB ELECTRICAL
CONNECTOR
MOUNTING BOLT
(3 LOCATIONS)

PRESSURE
TO APU GAGE
ENGINE SHROUD INSPECTION
(UPPER) WINDOW

PRESSURE SWITCH
SYSTEM
DISCHARGE INDICATOR ELECTRICAL CONNECTOR
(YELLOW DISC)
APU FIRE
EXTINGUISHER
THERMAL RELIEF
BOTTLE
INDICATOR
INBD FWD (RED DISC)

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-26 Page 48


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Engine and APU Fire Control Panel

The APU fire extinguishing system components of the engine and APU fire control panel are; the APU fire
switch handle, extinguisher test switch, APU bottle discharge light, and APU extinguisher test light. The engine
and APU fire control panel is on the aft electronics panel of the pilots' control stand.

When a fire is detected in the APU compartment, the APU fire switch handle light comes on. A solenoid
energizes, releasing a mechanical interlock on the fire switch handle shaft. When the interlock is released, the
fire switch handle can be operated by pulling the handle out and rotating it. Rotating the handle releases the
extinguishing agent. The fire switch handle can be manually unlocked by pressing the button behind the
handle.

The extinguisher test switch, when set to either 1 or 2, checks squib and pressure switch continuity. The APU
extinguisher test light illuminates if there is continuity to the squib. The fire extinguisher discharge light
illuminates if there is continuity to the pressure switch.

The APU bottle discharge light is connected to pressure switch. When the bottle pressure drops, the pressure
switch closes, and the APU bottle discharge light illuminates.

OVHT DET WHEEL BELL CUTOUT OVHT DET L BOTTLE R BOTTLE


WELL R DISCHARGE DISCHARGE
A B A B A A

FAULT ENGINES
DISCH DISCH DISCH ET
NORMAL A NORMAL
XE
ENG 1 ENG 2 1 2
L R APU DET L R TS
OVERHEAT OVERHEAT T
A INOP A A R
TEST L G G
F APU BOTTLE FIRE SWITCHES
I O F
A DISCHARGED (FUEL SHUTOFF)
U N V I
A PULL WHEN ILLUMINATED
L O H R LOCK OVERRIDE: PRESS
G
T P T E R R BUTTON UNDER HANDLE R APU

ENGINE AND APU FIRE CONTROL MODULE

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-26 Page 49


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

APU Ground Control Panel

The APU ground control panel is in the right wheel well. Components of the APU ground control panel are the
APU fire light, fire switch, and bottle discharge switch. When a fire is detected in the APU compartment, the
APU fire light comes on and a warning horn sounds. Pulling the fire switch shuts down the APU and arms the
bottle discharge switch. Pressing the bottle discharge switch discharges the APU fire bottle.

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-26 Page 50


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

EXTINGUISHING SYSTEM - CARGO COMPARTMENT FIRE


Overview

The cargo compartment fire extinguishing system is used to control or extinguish fires that occur in the
forward or aft cargo compartments. The system uses Halon as the extinguishing agent. The system includes
these parts:

1. Fire Extinguishing Bottle - which has squibs and a pressure indication switch
2. Tubing - to distribute the Halon to the applicable area
3. Nozzles - to release the Halon efficiently
4. Cargo Fire Control Panel - to test the system and control the release of the Halon

The cargo compartment fire extinguishing system uses 28-volts DC power. The power is supplied through the
circuit breaker CARGO FIRE EXTINGUISHING, installed on the P6 or P18 panel.

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-26 Page 51


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Cargo Fire Extinguishing Bottle

One cargo fire extinguishing bottle is installed in the Mix Manifold Bay, located in the aft end of the forward
cargo compartment. The bottle is a hermetically sealed container which is filled with bromotriflouromethane
(Halon) and nitrogen. The nitrogen is added to increase the pressure in the bottle. The bottle includes two
discharge heads, a temperature compensated pressure switch, and a filler/safety port.

Two Discharge Heads are installed on the bottle to release the Halon to the applicable areas. The FWD head
will release Halon into the tubing that goes to the forward cargo compartment. The AFT head will release
Halon into the tubing that goes to the aft cargo compartment. The FWD discharge port is a different size than
the AFT discharge port to prevent cross connecting the tubing. Also, the electrical receptacle on the FWD and
AFT squib are different sizes to prevent cross connection of the wiring. The discharge heads contain a disc
that holds the Halon in the bottle. When the disc is broken, then the Halon from the bottle is released through
the discharge ports into the tubing. The disc is ruptured by an electrically stimulated squib. The squib breaks
the disc using shock wave propagation (a small explosion) not a mechanical cutting device.

The Pressure Switch monitors the pressure in the bottle. The switch will be open when the bottle is fully
charged. If the pressure in the bottle is below 300 PSIG (at 70°F), then the switch will close and will send a
signal to the flight compartment that the pressure in the bottle is too low. The pressure switch compensates
for the temperature of the bottle to maintain an accurate pressure indication.

The Safety Port will break off of the bottle and release the contents of the bottle if the pressure in the bottle
gets too high. The safety port is also used to fill the bottle.

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-26 Page 52


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

MIX BAY
COMPARTMENT

CARGO FIRE
EXTINGUISHER
BOTTLE ELECTRICAL
CONNECTOR
SEE A

PRESSURE
SWITCH

1. CARGO FIRE
EXTINGUISHER
BOTTLE

SERVICE HANDLE
(2 LOCATIONS)
SUPPORT
BRACKET
(REF)

2. BOLT
3. WASHER
(3 LOCATIONS)

DISCHARGE HEAD
GLAND NUT
(2 LOCATIONS)

DISCHARGE TUBE
(2 LOCATIONS) GROUND STRAP
(2 LOCATIONS)

DISCHARGE PORT
(2 LOCATIONS)

5. LOCKWIRE

FORWARD
SQUIB
ELECTRICAL 4. NUT
AFT SQUIB (2 LOCATIONS)
CONNECTOR
(2 LOCATIONS)
FWD
CARGO FIRE EXTINGUISHER BOTTLE
A

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-26 Page 53


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Cargo Fire Control Panel

The Cargo Fire Control Panel is installed in the flight compartment in the P8 panel. The components on the
panel that control and monitor the cargo fire extinguishing system are the TEST switch, the ARM switches, the
DISCH switch and the EXT lights.

The TEST switch is used to initiate a test of the squib circuit and the cargo smoke detection system. When
the TEST switch is pushed, a low circuit (1 amp) signal is sent through the FWD and AFT squibs to check for
continuity. If the squib circuit is continuous, then the FWD EXT and AFT EXT lights will come on.

When smoke is detected in the forward or aft cargo compartments, then the applicable ARM light will come on.
The ARM switch must be pushed to the ARMED position before the bottles can be discharged. When the
ARMED switch is pushed and the DISCH switch is pushed, then a signal is sent to the applicable squib to fire
the squib and release the Halon to the applicable area.

When the cargo fire extinguishing bottle is discharged, or the pressure in the bottle is too low, then the DISCH
light will come on. The DISCH light is only tested by the Master Dim and Test switch.

The DISCH switch is a guarded, momentary action switch. The ARMED switch is an alternate (latched) action
switch.

MASTER CAUTION
AND FIRE WARN
FIRE MASTER LIGHTS (P7)
WARN CAUTION
BELL CUTOUT PUSH TO RESET
SEE A

MASTER CAUTION AND


FIRE WARN LIGHTS (P7)
(EXAMPLE) CARGO FIRE
CONTROL PANEL (P8)
A SEE B

FLIGHT COMPARTMENT
EXT DET SELECT
FWD AFT NORM NORM DETECTOR
A B A B FAULT
C g g F
A
I
R FWD AFT DISCH R
G TEST ARMED E
O
ARMED ARMED

r r
DISCH

CARGO FIRE CONTROL PANEL (P8)


B

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-26 Page 54


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

LAVATORY FIRE EXTINGUISHING SYSTEM


Overview

The lavatory fire extinguishing system provides fire extinguishing for the lavatory waste compartment by
flooding the compartment with inert gas.

The fire extinguishing agent is non-corrosive. There are no special inspection sor cleaning procedures
required if the agent is discharged when there is no fire in the lavatory.

The system is a heat-activated extinguisher bottle and a temperature indicator.

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-26 Page 55


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Fire Extinguisher Bottle

The bottle is a steel container, about 2.5 inches in diameter with volume of approximately 10 cubic inches,
with discharge tubes, fusible tips, and mounting bracket. The container is filled with Freon.

The fire extinguisher bottle is mounted inside the lavatory cabinet.

Temperature Indicator

The temperature indicator is a thin vinyl plate containing four heat sensitive patches. Each patch changes
color from grey to black when exposed to temperatures from 180 to 250°F.

The temperature indicator is inside the lavatory cabinet.

LAVATORY
TOWEL CHUTE
MOUNTING
BRACKET
LAVATORY FIRE
EXTINGUISHER
BOTTLE
BLACK WHEN EXPOSED
TO TEMPERATURE MARKED

SEE A
TEMPERATURE INDICATOR

180°F 200°F 230°F 250°F

HEAT
FUSIBLE A
TIPS

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-26 Page 56


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-26 Page 57


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

PORTABLE FIRE EXTINGUISHERS


Overview

Portable fire extinguishers are installed in several general locations in the passenger compartment. If the
extinguisher is not easy to see, the location will be identified with a placard. The extinguishers are usually
installed in one or more of these areas: galley or lavatory stowage areas, closets, doghouses, or near
attendant seats. A fire extinguisher is also installed in the flight compartment.

The portable extinguishers are attached to wall-mounted brackets by quick-release mounting straps.

Halon Extinguishers

Halon extinguishers are used to extinguish electrical and flammable liquid fires.

The Halon extinguisher is rechargeable. A pressure gage shows when you must recharge or replace the fire
extinguisher.

To operate the extinguisher, pull the handle locking pin. Hold the extinguisher upright and squeeze the handle
and lever together. Point the nozzle flow at the base of the fire. The Halon extinguishing agent leaves no
residue after discharge.

Pressurized Water Extinguishers

Pressurized water extinguishers are used to extinguish non-electrical fires.

The water extinguisher is rechargeable. Antifreeze is added to the water to prevent freezing.

A carbon dioxide cartridge is mounted on the handle of the extinguisher. To operate the extinguisher, turn the
cartridge. This punctures the cartridge and pressurizes the water container. Push the trigger and aim the
nozzle flow at the base of the fire.

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-26 Page 58


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

HANDLE
LOCK-PIN

PRESSURE
GAGE

QUICK-
RELEASE
STRAP

HALON FIRE
EXTINGUISHER

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-26 Page 59


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

 
TABLE OF CONTENTS
B737-300/400/500 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION SELF-PACED
ATA-27

FLIGHT CONTROLS.............................................................................................................................................. 5
Overview...................................................................................................................................................... 5
AILERON AND AILERON TRIM CONTROL SYSTEM ............................................................................................. 8
Overview...................................................................................................................................................... 8
Aileron........................................................................................................................................................10
Aileron Balance Tab ...................................................................................................................................11
Aileron Balance Panels and Seals ..............................................................................................................12
Aileron Trim Control System......................................................................................................................14
Aileron Artificial Feel, Centering and Trim Mechanism..............................................................................16
Aileron Transfer Mechanism ......................................................................................................................17
Aileron Power Control Unit .........................................................................................................................18
RUDDER AND RUDDER TRIM CONTROL SYSTEM ..............................................................................................19
Overview.....................................................................................................................................................19
Rudder........................................................................................................................................................22
Rudder Pedals ............................................................................................................................................23
Rudder Pedal Adjustment Crank.................................................................................................................24
Rudder Aft Control Quadrant ......................................................................................................................25
Rudder Control Torque Tube......................................................................................................................25
Rudder Trim Control Mechanism................................................................................................................27
Rudder Trim Actuator.................................................................................................................................27
Rudder Feel and Centering Mechanism ......................................................................................................30
Rudder Power Control Unit .........................................................................................................................31
Standby Rudder Actuator Shutoff Valve......................................................................................................32
Standby Rudder Actuator............................................................................................................................33
ELEVATOR AND TAB CONTROL SYSTEM...........................................................................................................34
Overview.....................................................................................................................................................34
Elevator ......................................................................................................................................................36
Elevator Tabs .............................................................................................................................................37
Control Columns.........................................................................................................................................38
Elevator Forward Control Quadrants...........................................................................................................38
Elevator Aft Control Quadrants...................................................................................................................40
Elevator Feel Computer ..............................................................................................................................41
Elevator Feel and Centering Unit ................................................................................................................42
Elevator Power Control Unit .......................................................................................................................43
Elevator Tab Control Mechanism................................................................................................................44
HORIZONTAL STABILIZER TRIM CONTROL SYSTEM.........................................................................................45
Overview.....................................................................................................................................................45
Horizontal Stabilizer ...................................................................................................................................46
Stabilizer Forward Control Mechanism.......................................................................................................48

ATA-27 Page 1 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

 
Stabilizer Jackscrew and Gearbox Assembly ..............................................................................................50
Electric Actuator Trim Actuator or Primary Stabilizer Trim Actuator.........................................................52
Stabilizer Trim Limit Switches...................................................................................................................54
TRAILING EDGE FLAP SYSTEM..................................................................................................................56
Overview.....................................................................................................................................................56
Trailing Edge Flap ......................................................................................................................................58
Flap Tracks ................................................................................................................................................60
Flap Control Lever ......................................................................................................................................62
Flap Control Unit ........................................................................................................................................63
Flap Control Valve ......................................................................................................................................63
Priority Valve ..............................................................................................................................................64
Flap Bypass Valve ......................................................................................................................................65
Flap Hydraulic Motor..................................................................................................................................66
Flap Power Unit..........................................................................................................................................67
Flap Transmission Assembly......................................................................................................................68
Flap Alternate Drive Unit............................................................................................................................69
TRAILING EDGE FLAP POSITION INDICATING SYSTEM.....................................................................................70
Overview.....................................................................................................................................................70
Flap Position Indicator ...............................................................................................................................70
Flap Position Transmitter Assembly...........................................................................................................70
FLIGHT SPOILER CONTROL SYSTEM .................................................................................................................72
Overview.....................................................................................................................................................72
Flight Spoilers ............................................................................................................................................74
Spoiler Ratio Changer.................................................................................................................................76
Spoiler Mixer..............................................................................................................................................76
Flight Spoiler Actuators..............................................................................................................................78
Spoiler Control Quadrant............................................................................................................................79
SPEED BRAKE CONTROL SYSTEM.....................................................................................................................81
Overview.....................................................................................................................................................81
Ground Spoiler Panel..................................................................................................................................84
Speed Brake Control Lever.........................................................................................................................86
Speed Brake Forward Drum Mechanism ....................................................................................................86
Ground Spoiler Control Valve......................................................................................................................88
Ground Spoiler Interlock Valve ...................................................................................................................88
Ground Spoiler Actuator .............................................................................................................................91
Spoiler Control Quadrant............................................................................................................................94
LEADING EDGE FLAP AND SLAT CONTROL SYSTEM.........................................................................................96
Overview.....................................................................................................................................................96
Leading Edge Flaps ....................................................................................................................................98
Leading Edge Slats.....................................................................................................................................99
Leading Edge Flap and Slat Control Valve................................................................................................100
Leading Edge Flap Actuator......................................................................................................................101
Leading Edge Slat Actuator ......................................................................................................................102
Flow Limiting Valve ..................................................................................................................................103

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-27 Page 2


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

 
Leading Edge Standby Drive Shutoff Valve...............................................................................................104
POSITION INDICATING SYSTEM - LEADING EDGE FLAP AND SLAT ...............................................................105
Overview...................................................................................................................................................105
Proximity Sensors.....................................................................................................................................105
Leading Edge Flap and Slat Position Indicator .........................................................................................105
Leading Edge Flap and Slat Position Indication Module...........................................................................108

ATA-27 Page 3 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-27 Page 4


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

FLIGHT CONTROLS
Overview

The primary flight controls are the ailerons, elevators, and rudder. These hydraulically-powered control
surfaces provide flight control in roll, pitch, and yaw. The auxiliary flight controls are the trailing edge flaps,
leading edge flaps and slats, the spoilers, and an adjustable horizontal stabilizer.

Lateral (roll) trim is provided by repositioning the aileron null detent to deflect the ailerons. Longitudinal
(pitch) trim is provided by positioning the adjustable horizontal stabilizer. Directional (yaw) trim is provided
by repositioning rudder neutral to deflect the rudder.

Roll Control System

The roll (lateral) control surfaces consist of the two ailerons and the four flight spoilers. These surfaces are
controlled by rotation of the captain's and first officer's control wheels. With hydraulic power on, the control
wheel forces are provided by an artificial feel mechanism as all these surfaces are fully hydraulic powered.
Balance tabs and balance panels aerodynamically reduce the forces required for aileron movement. In the
event of hydraulic failure, motion of the pilots' control wheels mechanically positions the ailerons.

Lateral (roll) trim is accomplished by the aileron trim control switches located on the control stand.

Flight spoilers and ground spoilers are located on the upper surface of the wing. Two flight spoilers are
outboard of each nacelle. Two ground spoilers are outboard of the flight spoilers, and one ground spoiler is
inboard of each nacelle. The flight spoilers are hydraulically actuated in response to inputs from the aileron
control system. All flight spoilers may also be used as speed brakes by aft movement of the speed brake
control lever. The speed brake control lever actuates the spoiler control system, which causes all the flight
spoiler panels to be raised in unison.

Pitch Control System

The elevators provide primary response of the airplane in pitch control. Fore and aft movement of the captain's
and first officer's control columns positions the elevators. Balance panels and tabs aerodynamically reduce
the forces required for elevator movement. In the event of hydraulic failure, motion of the pilots' control
columns mechanically positions the elevators. Also, the elevator balance tabs reduce the forces required to
operate the elevator.

The adjustable horizontal stabilizer provides pitch (longitudinal) trim. The stabilizer is controlled by stabilizer
trim control switches located on the outboard horn of both the captain's and first officer's control wheels.
Manual operation of the stabilizer is accomplished by rotating the stabilizer trim control wheels located on the
control stand.

ATA-27 Page 5 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Rudder Control

The hydraulically-powered rudder is controlled by the captain's and first officer's rudder pedals. In the event
of hydraulic system A or B failure, the standby hydraulic system will drive a rudder standby power unit to
move the rudder.

Rudder trim is controlled by a rudder trim control switch located on the control stand. Motion from the trim
control unit shifts rudder control system neutral providing trim correction by positioning the rudder.

Lift Devices

The lift devices consist of two pairs of triple slotted trailing edge flaps, three pairs of leading edge slats, and
two pairs of leading edge flaps. Fore and aft movement of the flap control lever on the control stand sets the
position of the trailing edge flaps. The trailing edge flap system is protected from excessive airloads by a flap
load limiter system. The load limiter system automatically retracts the flaps from 40 to 30 units at airspeeds
in excess of 162 knots.

The leading edge slats are located outboard of the engines and extend forward from the wing leading edge.
The leading edge flaps are located inboard of the engines and extend by rotating downward from the lower
surface of the wing leading edge. The motion of the trailing edge flap drive system actuates the leading edge
flaps. In the event of system B hydraulic failure, the leading edge flaps and slats may be driven to the fully
extended position using power from the standby hydraulic system. An autoslat system automatically extends
the leading edge slats from the intermediate position to the fully extended position at a predetermined angle of
attack. The slats automatically retract to the intermediate position when angle of attack is reduced.

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-27 Page 6


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

RUDDER

ELEVATTOR
AILERON
TAB

ELEVATOR

AILERON BALANCE TAB

GROUND SPOILERS

9
8 FLIGHT SPOILERS

STABILIZER
7 6
OUTBOARD
FLAP

SLATS
GROUND
(SHOWN
SPOILER INBOARD FLAP
EXTENDED) 5
GROUND SPOILER

FLIGHT SPOILERS
4
GROUND SPOILER
3 2
1 0

LEADING EDGE FLAPS


(SHOWN EXTENDED)

ATA-27 Page 7 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

AILERON AND AILERON TRIM CONTROL SYSTEM


Overview

The aileron and aileron trim control system provides airplane lateral control. The ailerons are assisted by the
flight spoilers. There is one aileron and balance tab on each wing. The rotation of either aileron control wheel
will result in movement of the ailerons and movement of the flight spoilers. The ailerons are powered by two
independent hydraulic power control units connected to separate hydraulic systems. Either power unit is
capable of providing full power control response to aileron control system inputs. In the event of total
hydraulic failure, lateral control is maintained manually. Manual control forces are minimized by aileron
balance tabs and hinged balance panels. The balance tabs are mechanically connected by rods to the wing
structure.
The aileron control system is actuated by rotation of either the captain's or first officer's aileron control wheel.
The control wheels rotate the control wheel drum and aileron control bus drums. Aileron control bus cables
(ACBA and ACBB) between the aileron control bus drums provide an interconnect between the captain's and
the first officer's aileron control wheels. Aileron control cables (AA and AB) from the captain's control wheel
drum attach to an aileron control quadrant, which, through a shaft, drives two cranks and two input rods. Each
input rod connects to a power control unit. A cam is mounted on the control quadrant shaft to engage with a
spring-loaded roller for the purpose of centering and trim. Each aileron power control unit is connected to a
crank on a bus drum to which aileron bus system cables are fastened. The aileron bus system cables (ABSA
and ABSB) lead to left and right aileron wing quadrants. The ailerons are actuated through a control rod by
the aileron wing quadrants. During manual operation, the ailerons are manually operated by pilot effort. The
forces are transmitted from the control wheel through the power unit input linkage stops. This establishes a
direct mechanical link from the control wheel to effect aileron displacement.
Hydraulic power is furnished to the aileron control system by two functionally independent 3000 PSI systems.
Hydraulic power from both systems is controlled by the flight control shutoff valves in the flight control
hydraulic modular packages. The modular packages are located in the left and right main wheel wells where
the absence of wheel well doors assures quick and convenient access. Two FLT CONTROLS shutoff valve
switches together with two low pressure warning lights are located on the overhead panel.
The ailerons are constructed of graphite/epoxy over a nomex honeycomb core for weight savings. The
ailerons with aileron balance tabs are mounted outboard of the outboard flaps behind the rear spar of each
wing.
The base of the first officer's control column is equipped with a transfer mechanism. The transfer mechanism
allows normal control wheel motion to be transmitted through the cables on the captain's control column only.
If a malfunction occurs which jams the aileron control system, lateral control is achieved by the spoiler system
operated directly by cables from the first officer's control column. When this occurs, the first officer will have
to exert a maximum force of 117 pounds to overcome the spring in the transfer mechanism and operate the
spoilers.
The aileron trim system repositions the ailerons and control wheels electrically to a neutral or trimmed (wings
level) position. The trim indicator on the control wheels shows the amount of trim in trim units.

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-27 Page 8


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

SPEED TRANSFER
BRAKE MECHANISM
HANDLE

SPOILER CONTROL FLIGHT


ACBA
DRUM SPOILER AILERON BUS
AILERON CONTROL SYSTEM CABLES
AILERON QUADRANT
AB
CONTROL
WHEEL
DRUM ACBB AA
AA AB

ABSA
ABSB

SPOILER
AILERON MIXER
TRIM AILERON
AILERON AILERON
ACTUATOR SPRING
FLIGHT BALANCE
CARTRIDGE
SPOILER ABSA TAB
AILERON POWER
ABSB CONTROL UNITS
ARTIFICIAL FEEL
CENTERING AND TRIM
MECHANISM

CABLE AILERON
SLACK BALANCE
TAKEUP TAB

AILERON AILERON
WING
QUADRANT

ATA-27 Page 9 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Aileron

The ailerons are of graphite/epoxy construction with upper and lower skins of graphite/epoxy tape and nomex
honeycomb core. An aileron balance tab is attached to the rear spar of the aileron by four hinge bearings.
The aileron is provided with four hinge bearings attached to the front spar. Access panels are provided for
each hinge bearing. Individual bearings may be replaced without removing the aileron. The leading edge of the
aileron extends forward between the hinge bearings and is connected to one balance panel in bay No. 3.

The aileron control rod connects the aileron to the aileron wing quadrant. Dual pushrods that connect the
balance tab to the wing structure pass through the aileron.

The aileron and balance tab are independently balanced. The aileron is statically balanced as a component.
The balance tab is statically balanced by adding or installing weights to the balance panel. The number of
weights required is subject to the weight of the balance tab.

In No. 1, 2, and 4 bays, the aileron leading edge extension does not have a balance panel, but has a polyamide
nylon seal mounted upon the nose extension coming into contact with a seal baffle. The seals, along with a
similar seal on the balance panel, control the airflow around the front of the aileron. A clearance between the
aileron leading edge and the wing structure provides the controlled airflow area necessary for balance panel
operation.

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-27 Page 10


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Aileron Balance Tab

The aileron balance tab functions to reduce the force required to position the aileron. Motion of the tab is
controlled by dual tab pushrods which provide attachment between tab and wing structure. Balance tab travel
is opposite to aileron travel, that is, a downward movement of the aileron produces an upward movement of
the balance tab.

The aileron balance tab is a thin tapered light weight control surface attached to the aileron rear spar by four
hinge bearings. The balance tab is of graphite/epoxy construction with a nomex honeycomb core. Left and
right balance tabs are identical except for mounting of the mast fittings and related fairing.

The aileron balance tab may be replaced without rebalancing the aileron. Each tab is furnished with adjust
weights that bolt to the balance panel. The required number of adjust weights is stamped on a data plate
attached to each balance tab.

ATA-27 Page 11 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Aileron Balance Panels and Seals

Aileron balance panels reduce the force required to position the ailerons in flight. Each aileron has one
balance panel located at No. 3 bay. The balance panel is connected to the aileron leading edge by a
continuous hinge at the aft edge. The forward edge of each balance panel is attached to the wing structure by
an idler hinge which provides the necessary articulation of movement of the balance panel. Seals are installed
along the inboard and outboard edges of the balance panel.

BALANCE PANEL
HINGE
VENT GAP
BALANCE PANEL AILERON HINGE POINT

AILERON
BALANCE PANEL BALANCE TAB
SEALS VENT GAP
AILERON
WING TRAILING
EDGE

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-27 Page 12


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

ATA-27 Page 13 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Aileron Trim Control System

Aileron Trim Switches: The aileron trim switches are located on the aft electronic control panel (P8). The
trim switches must be operated simultaneously to provide electrical input to the trim actuator.

Aileron Trim Actuator: The aileron trim actuator connected to the feel and centering mechanism receives
electrical signals from the trim switches. The trim actuator extends or retracts, repositioning the feel and
centering mechanism null detent.

SEE A

RIGGING
PIN A/S-4

CENTERING
SPRING

AILERON
TRIM
ACTUATOR
SEE B

FWD INBD

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-27 Page 14


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

  AILERON TRIM
SWITCHES

RUDDER TRIM
15 10 5 0 5 10 15

LEFT RIGHT

AILERON
NOSE NOSE
LEFT RIGHT

LEFT RIGHT
WING WING
DOWN DOWN

FWD

AILERON PCU
INPUT TORQUE
TUBE
CAM ROLLER
ARM CAM HUB

CENTERING
CAM

ROLLER ARM AND


CENTERING SPRING
SUPPORT

AILERON TRIM
ACTUATOR, M1124

L WING
L WING DN
DN
115V AC
XFR BUS 1 L WING
C786 R WING
AILERON DN
DN
TRIM CONTROL

P6-2 CIRCUIT BREAKER R WING


PANEL DN
R WING
M1126 AILERON/ AILERON
DN
RUDDER TRIM
CONTROL M1124 AILERON TRIM
(P8-43) ACTUATOR
LEFT RIGHT
WING WING
DOWN DOWN

ATA-27 Page 15 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Aileron Artificial Feel, Centering and Trim Mechanism

The aileron artificial feel, centering, and trim mechanism provides aileron control system centering, trim, and
artificial feel. The aileron centering mechanism consists of a cam, roller arm support, and two springs. The
centering cam is bolted to the control quadrant shaft. The roller is mounted on the roller arm and the roller
arm is mounted on the support. Two springs are attached between the roller arm and the support to provide
the force necessary to hold the roller against the cam; thus providing aileron control system centering and
artificial feel.

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-27 Page 16


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Aileron Transfer Mechanism

A transfer mechanism is located in the base of the first officer's column. The mechanism incorporates both
the transfer mechanism and the lost motion device. The transfer device consists of a preloaded torsion spring
whose ends are held against two identical halves of a spring container. The two halves of the spring container
are locked to preload the spring.

The aileron control bus drum is attached to the upper half of the spring container and the spoiler control drum
is attached to the lower half of the spring container. In normal operation, motion is transmitted between the
two drums through the preloaded torsion spring. If a malfunction occurs, the other system can be operated
independently by jamming either the aileron, or the spoiler control system. In this case, the captain or the
first officer, depending on the jammed system, will have to exert a maximum force of 117 pounds to overcome
the spring preload in the transfer mechanism and operate the other system to maintain lateral control of the
airplane. In case the aileron cables are jammed, the first officer will have to exert a force to overcome the
spring preload in the transfer mechanism and operate the spoilers. When the first officer's control wheel
starts turning, it will turn through 12 degrees before motion is picked up by the spoiler control drum through
the lost motion device. The control drum then operates the spoilers through the right hand aileron control
cables AA and AB to the spoiler mixer.

In case the spoiler cables are jammed, the captain will, similarly, have to exert a force to overcome the spring
preload in the transfer mechanism and operate the ailerons

AILERON CONTROL
BUS DRUM

TORSION SPOILER
SPRING CONTROL DRUM

SPRING
CONTAINERS

PICK-UP LUG LOST MOTION


DEVICE PICK-UP
INBD

AFT

TRANSFER MECHANISM

ATA-27 Page 17 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Aileron Power Control Unit

Two aileron power control units provide actuation of the ailerons in response to manual inputs from the
control columns. The power control units are mounted horizontally in the main wheel well. The two power
control units operate independently from separate hydraulic systems; the lower unit from hydraulic system A
pressure and the upper unit from hydraulic system B pressure. Failure of either hydraulic system will render
one power control unit inoperative. The remaining unit will continue to operate both ailerons through full
range of travel.

The upper power control unit and autopilot share the same input rod crank on the aileron control shaft
assembly.

SEE A

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-27 Page 18


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

 
RUDDER AND RUDDER TRIM CONTROL SYSTEM
Overview

Yaw control of the airplane is provided by a single conventional rudder without tab. There are two separate
hydraulic systems powering one main power control unit. Rudder control backup is provided by a standby
power unit, which is driven by a third hydraulic system. Any one of the three hydraulic systems will provide
effective rudder control. Rudder trim is accomplished by operating a trim control knob which repositions the
rudder centering unit.

The rudder control system is pedal operated by the captain or the first officer. Pedal movement rotates the
forward quadrants, which are cable connected to the aft quadrant. Rotation of the aft quadrant moves a
control rod connected to a torque tube. Rotation of the torque tube moves a crank connected to the rudder
power control unit linkage. This admits hydraulic fluid to the actuating cylinder, which moves the rudder.

The rudder trim is initiated by the rudder trim knob located on the aisle stand. The rudder trim knob activates
arming and control switches which direct electrical input to the rudder trim actuator motor. Rotating the trim
knob arms the trim motor circuit and selects either the extend mode for left rudder trim or the retract mode
for right trim. Extension or retraction of the trim actuator jackscrew causes the feel unit frames to rotate. This
moves linkages which rotate the torque tube, causing rudder power control unit input.

Rudder feel is provided by a rudder feel unit. The feel unit is connected to the rudder control torque tube,
which connects through linkage and cables to the rudder pedals.

The rudder is fully power operated through the entire travel. The rudder power control unit is hydraulically
operated by hydraulic systems A and B simultaneously. The A and B systems can be independently activated
by switches located on the overhead panel. Either of the A and B switches can be used to activate the standby
hydraulic system and supply pressure to the standby actuator. The standby hydraulic system is automatically
activated in the event of the loss of the A or B hydraulic system on takeoff.

System A and system B pressure is supplied by engine-driven hydraulic pumps on each engine and electric
motor driven hydraulic pumps (one for each system). A and B flight control hydraulic modular units are
identical in components and operation. Pressurized hydraulic fluid flows through the modular unit which
consists of a spoiler shutoff valve, a flight controls shutoff valve, low pressure warning switch, compensator,
and check valve. The flight controls shutoff valve controls the flow of hydraulic fluid to the ailerons, elevator,
and rudder. When either the A or B flight control switch on the overhead panel is moved to STBY RUD, or if
the automatic standby function is activated, the standby hydraulic system pump will start. The standby rudder
actuator shutoff valve located in the standby hydraulic module will also open, porting hydraulic fluid to the
standby actuator.

ATA-27 Page 19 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

 
Overview (Continued):

A rudder isolation shutoff valve is installed in the system A and the system B hydraulic lines between the
respective system A and system B flight controls hydraulic modular units and the rudder power unit. The
valve is part of the hydraulic isolation shutoff valve module, which consists of six hydraulic isolation valves.
The valves are individually operated and provide a means of isolating individual hydraulic components for
ground leakage and flow tests.
RUDDER
STANDBY RUDDER
SEE B ACTUATOR
RUDDER
RUDDER AFT
POWER UNIT
CONTROL
QUADRANT

FEEL AND CENTERING


MECHANISM
RUDDER
TRIM ACTUATOR

RUDDER TRIM
KNOB

STANDBY RUDDER ACTUATOR


SHUTOFF VALVE

RA RB
RUDDER CONTROL
CABLES
SEE A

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-27 Page 20


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

RUDDER
STANDBY RUDDER
SEE B ACTUATOR
RUDDER
RUDDER AFT
POWER UNIT
CONTROL
QUADRANT

FEEL AND CENTERING


MECHANISM
RUDDER
TRIM ACTUATOR

RUDDER TRIM
KNOB

STANDBY RUDDER ACTUATOR


SHUTOFF VALVE

RA RB
RUDDER CONTROL
CABLES
SEE A
STANDBY RUDDER ACTUATOR

STANDBY INPUT ROD

EXTERNAL
SUMMING LEVER
TRIM AND
FEEL ROD

RIG PIN
INPUT LINK
INPUT CRANK
RUDDER POWER UNIT

INPUT ROD

TORQUE TUBE
CONTROL ROD
LOWER CRANK
(BELL CRANK)
FEEL AND CENTERING
MECHANISM CRANK
FEEL AND CENTERING
MECHANISM
FWD

RUDDER TRIM
ACTUATOR
RB RUDDER AFT
RA
CONTROL QUADRANT B

ATA-27 Page 21 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Rudder

The rudder provides yaw control for the airplane. The rudder is of graphite/composite construction. The skin
is made of graphite reinforced epoxy. There is no rudder tab. There are seven rudder hinges, the bottom one
being a thrust hinge. Balance weights are fastened to the rudder nose. The balance weights are made of
tungsten. There is a body seal attached to the bottom rib of the rudder. The body seal is made of honeycomb
nomex core material. This seals the gap between the rudder and the body.

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-27 Page 22


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Rudder Pedals

The captain and first officer are each provided with a pair of rudder pedals used for controlling the airplane
about the vertical axis. Each pair of pedals consists of right and left pedals mounted on a shaft. The pedal
shaft is attached to the upper end of the pedal arm assembly. The lower end of the pedal arm assembly is
mounted on a support shaft attached to the structure below the floor. The rudder pedals are located below the
captain's and first officer's instrument panel. Rudder pedal support and quadrant assemblies are accessible
through the lower nose compartment.

Fore and aft movement of the pedals is transmitted by the two pushrods to the jackshaft yoke. The rotary
motion of the jackshaft yoke is passed to the forward quadrant by means of the jackshaft. The two sets of
rudder pedals are bussed together by means of a bus pushrod connecting the two jackshaft assemblies. Toe
pressure on the rudder pedals causes pedals to rotate about the shafts and initiate braking action.

FORWARD QUADRANT
SEE C

BRAKE
PUSHROD

SEE B
SEE A
QUADRANT
PEDAL ARM PUSHROD
(EXAMPLE) (EXAMPLE)

CABIN FWD
FLOOR
BEAM
PIN
SEE D (R-1 ON THE CAPTAIN'S PEDALS)
(R-2 ON THE FIRST OFFICER'S
PEDALS)
BELLCRANK A
(EXAMPLE)

ATA-27 Page 23 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Rudder Pedal Adjustment Crank

The two pairs of rudder pedals can be adjusted independently to suit the captain and first officer. This is
accomplished by means of the rudder pedal adjust shaft. The rudder pedal adjustment mechanism consists of
an adjustment crank, adjustment shaft, a jackscrew, and pedal adjustment nut attached to the jackshaft
assembly.

The adjustment crank is located on the instrument panel forward of the control wheel. The crank is connected
to a flexshaft that is routed forward under the instrument panel, then down under the floor, and aft to the
universal joint in the rudder control jackshaft assembly. Rotation of the rudder pedal adjustment crank
actuates the jackscrew which causes the yoke, containing the pedal adjustment nut, to move fore and aft.

Rudder pedal adjustment crank and crank handle stops are installed to prevent the rudder pedal adjustment
screw from being backdriven by heavy foot pressure simultaneously applied to both rudder pedals. The crank
incorporates a spring-loaded pin within the knob. The stops are incorporated into the crank housing bearing
retainer. Rotation of the crank handle is prevented in either direction beyond the stop blocks, by contact of the
spring-loaded pin that protrudes from the crank handle. To permit crank rotation for rudder pedal adjustment,
the knob must be pulled aft so the pin clears the stops.

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-27 Page 24


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Rudder Aft Control Quadrant

The rudder aft control quadrant transmits the motion of the rudder control cables to the dual path torque tube.
The assembly consists of a quadrant bolted to a shaft. The shaft is mounted horizontally in the vertical
stabilizer.

Rotation of the quadrant pushes or pulls the quadrant input rod attached to a crank on the rudder control
torque tube.

Rudder Control Torque Tube

The rudder control torque tube provides a dual load path for rudder control linkage inputs. The tube is
mounted in a vertical position in the vertical fin. Three cranks are bolted to the tube. The lower crank is
connected to the input rod from the aft control quadrant and to the feel and centering mechanism. The center
crank is connected to the main rudder power control unit linkage. The upper crank is connected to the
standby power unit control linkage. The cranks are of dual construction with the two halves bonded and
riveted together.

Rudder pedal input causes the torque tube and cranks to rotate. This provides input to the rudder power unit,
the feel and centering unit, and the standby actuator.
STANDBY POWER
INPUT ROD

UPPER CRANK

SEE A TORQUE TUBE

TRIM AND FEEL ROD


CENTER CRANK

AFT QUADRANT RUDDER POWER


CONTROL UNIT
INPUT ROD

LOWER CRANK
(BELL CRANK)
QUADRANT INPUT
ROD

CABLE RB

A
CABLE RA

ATA-27 Page 25 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-27 Page 26


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Rudder Trim Control Mechanism

The rudder trim control mechanism provides a means for controlling the directional trim of the airplane and
indicates the units of rudder trim. The control mechanism consists of a rudder trim knob and rudder trim
indicator on the aft end of the control stand.

The trim indicator is driven electrically by a transmitter in the rudder trim actuator on the feel and centering
mechanism. The indicator shows up to 17 units of left or right trim. Each unit represents approximately one
degree of rudder trim. The indicator is located on panel P8 next to the rudder trim knob and is powered by
115-volts AC from bus XFR BUS-1. The RUDDER TRIM control circuit breaker is located on circuit breaker
panel P6.

The rudder trim knob is located on center console panel P8 and activates arming and control switches which
direct electrical input to the rudder trim actuator motor. The knob is spring-loaded to return to neutral. The
RUDDER TRIM circuit breaker is located on circuit breaker panel P6.

Rudder Trim Actuator

The rudder trim actuator consists of an acme screw driven ram, coupled to a motor-brake and position sensor
(RVDT) through a gear reduction, and limit switches enclosed by aluminum housing. The motor drive is
controlled by the rudder trim knob or by activation of an internal limit switch. An electromagnetic brake
prevents actuator overrun and internal mechanical stops prevent overtravel in case of a limit switch
malfunction.

Trim commands from the trim knob cause the actuator to extend or retract, which rotates the feel and
centering mechanism. This provides a new zero force pedal position corresponding to the trimmed rudder
position. The actuator provides the ground point for the feel and centering mechanism.

ATA-27 Page 27 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

RUDDER TRIM
15 10 5 0 5 10 15

LEFT RIGHT

NOSE NOSE
AILERON LEFT RIGHT

LEFT RIGHT
WING WING
DOWN DOWN

M159 RUDDER TRIM


INDICATOR
28V AC (P8)
XFR BUS 1 C788
RUDDER TRIM
INDICATOR
115V AC
XFR BUS 1 C787
RUDDER TRIM
CONTROL
NOSE NOSE
P6-2 CIRCUIT BREAKER PANEL
LEFT RIGHT

M1126 AILERON AND


RUDDER TRIM
CONTROL MODULE (P8)

M1125 RUDDER TRIM


ACTUATOR

CENTERING
SPRING SHAFT CAM ROLLER ARM

CRANK

RUDDER CONTROL
INPUT FROM QUADRANT

CAM ROLLER FIN

M1125 RUDDER
TRIM ACTUATOR

TORQUE
TUBE
FWD

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-27 Page 28


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

ATA-27 Page 29 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Rudder Feel and Centering Mechanism

The rudder feel and centering mechanism consists of the feel and centering unit which provides artificial feel
to the pilots' pedals and centers the rudder. The feel and centering unit is located below the rudder power
unit in the vertical fin. The feel and centering unit has a support shaft, a feel and centering crank, two
frames, an arm and roller with a spring assembly, and a cam. When the rudder pedals are displaced, the
torque tube rotates causing offset of the trim and feel rod and in turn rotation of the feel and centering crank,
the support shaft, and the cam. As the cam rotates, the arm and roller are displaced out of the detent position
to extend the spring assembly and provide artificial feel. Rudder trim input through the rudder trim actuator
rotates the two frames with the arm and roller and spring assembly. The force of the spring assembly holds
the arm and roller in the cam detent and causes the cam to rotate. Rotation of the cam causes subsequent
motion of the support shaft, the feel and centering crank, the trim and feel rod, the lower crank and the torque
tube which then causes input to the rudder power unit, repositioning the rudder. At the same time, the lower
crank causes input to the rudder control system with movement of the pilots' pedals.

PILOT'S INPUT

FEEL AND
CENTERING
TRIM ACTUATOR UNIT

FIN STRUCTURE

RUDDER PEDAL (TYP) CONTROL ROD

AFT
QUADRANT

TORQUE TUBE

LOWER CRANK
FORWARD
(BELL CRANK)
QUADRANT

BUS ROD

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-27 Page 30


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Rudder Power Control Unit

The rudder power control unit moves the rudder right or left when actuated by rudder pedal input and provides
wind gust snubbing when the airplane is parked. The unit is located in the vertical fin. The body is fixed to fin
structure and the power head to the rudder. The control unit is separately powered by hydraulic systems A
and B. Either system acting alone will provide full rudder control.

Power control unit yaw damper function is to minimize Dutch roll during manually and automatically controlled
flight. The yaw damper provides rudder displacement proportional to the yaw rate, and opposing the yaw
direction of the airplane. The yaw damper input is in series with the pilots' input and is not felt at the rudder
pedals.

ATA-27 Page 31 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Standby Rudder Actuator Shutoff Valve

The standby rudder actuator shutoff valve is located on the aft bulkhead of the main wheel well. The unit is
mounted on the standby system modular unit by four bolts. The valve is electrically operated from a 28-volt
DC source. The valve is equipped with a manual override lever and position indicator. The manual override
allows the valve to be positioned with electrical power off. The valve is off when the lever is in position 1, and
on when the lever is in position 2.

If hydraulic systems A and B are not available to power the rudder, standby power may be turned on, and the
rudder operated with the standby actuator. The rudder will also operate automatically on standby power when
all of these conditions occur: system A or B hydraulic pressure drops below 1200 PSI, the flaps are extended,
and the wheel speed is greater than 60 knots or the airplane is in the air.

SEE A

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-27 Page 32


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Standby Rudder Actuator

The standby rudder actuator positions the rudder when hydraulic system A and B are not available. The
actuator consists of a bypass valve, control valve, and the actuating cylinder. Standby hydraulic power for the
standby actuator is controlled by system A and B switches on the overhead flight controls panel or by
activation of the automatic standby function.

Hydraulic pressure supplied from the standby system operates the actuator. Rotation of the input crank will
position the control valve to port fluid to the actuating cylinder.

ATA-27 Page 33 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

ELEVATOR AND TAB CONTROL SYSTEM


Overview

The elevators provide primary pitch control of the airplane about the airplane lateral axis and respond to
control column inputs through two independent hydraulic systems. In the event of dual hydraulic failure, a
manual reversion mode will allow the elevators to be driven directly through a mechanical control system.
Aerodynamic elevator tabs are provided to assist elevator movement. Air loads on the system are further
reduced by aerodynamic balance panels attached to each elevator.

The elevator control system is activated by fore and aft motion of the captain's and first officer's control
columns. A torque tube, with a forward control quadrant mounted at each end, interconnects the control
columns. A pair of elevator control cables attach to each forward control quadrant. The elevator up cables
(EB) are secured at the quadrants and then routed aft under the floor to the aft control quadrants. The
elevator down cables (EA) are routed forward from the control quadrants, around a pair of pulleys, then aft
along the fuselage to the aft control quadrants. The control cables are rigged over pulleys to minimize flexing
and prevent chafing. The aft quadrants are mounted on the input torque tube in the empennage aft of the
stabilizer rear spar. The elevator hydraulic power control units for left and right elevators are linked between
the input torque tube and the output torque tube and provide power to rotate the elevators during power mode.

The elevator control system is also activated by the autopilot.

Hydraulic power is supplied to the elevator control system from hydraulic systems A and B at a pressure of
3000 PSI. Hydraulic fluid flow is controlled by flight control shutoff valves located in the flight controls
modular packages in the main wheel well.

Elevator feel is provided by a feel computer and a feel and centering unit. The feel computer provides varying
hydraulic system A and hydraulic system B pressure inputs to the feel and centering unit. The feel and
centering unit then applies a resistance at the aft control quadrants to simulate elevator aerodynamic forces.

The power control units respond to control system inputs to rotate the elevators. The control units provide the
stops which limit elevator rotation and tab displacement and also provide snubbing action on the ground to
protect the elevators from wind gust damage.

A tab control mechanism acts to assist elevator movement with a different gear ratio.

A flight controls hydraulic low pressure warning system provides an indication of elevator, aileron, and rudder
low pressure. Common warning lights are displayed on the forward overhead control panel and on the
lightshield. A feel pressure differential amber light is provided on the forward overhead control panel. The
light will come on when an undesirable pressure difference exists between the feel computer output pressures.
A stall warning shaker is fitted to the control columns.

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-27 Page 34


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

 
Additional reliability is provided by duplication of certain mechanical and hydraulic components within the
elevator and tab control system.

SEE A
ELEVATOR TAB

ELEVATOR

EA
EB

AUTOPILOT OUTPUT
B ACTUATOR TORQUE TUBE

NEUTRAL
ELEVATOR FORWARD SHIFT SENSOR
CONTROL QUADRANT

MACH TRIM
ACTUATOR
AUTOPILOT
A ACTUATOR

ELEVATOR
ELEVATOR
A PCU
ELEVATOR FEEL
AND CENTERING UNIT

STABILIZER ELEVATOR
POSITION SENSOR B PCU

INPUT TORQUE TUBE

ELEVATOR AFT
CONTROL QUADRANTS

FWD

ELEVATOR
A POSITION SENSOR

ATA-27 Page 35 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Elevator

Each elevator is a honeycomb structure consisting of leading and trailing edge spars, ribs, and a
graphite/epoxy skin. A rectangular cutout is provided toward the inboard portion of the elevator trailing edge
for installation of the tab. A balance horn is incorporated forward of the hinge line at the outboard tip of each
elevator for the purpose of installing balance weights.

Each elevator is attached to the stabilizer by means of six hinge fittings, the first and second hinge from
inboard serving as a thrust hinge. The leading edge of each elevator extends forward between the hinge
fittings and connects to the three balance panels. The two elevators are physically linked together through the
output torque tube.

The elevator and elevator tab are independently balanced. The elevator is statically balanced as a component.
The elevator tab is balanced into the elevator by adding or removing tab-adjust weights on the elevator nose.
The number of weights required is a function of the weight of the elevator tab.

Seals are situated along each elevator inboard rib, between the elevator and tail cone. The seals are a Dacron
and silicone rubber composition and are used to minimize airflow between the upper and lower surfaces of the
elevator.

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-27 Page 36


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Elevator Tabs

The elevator tabs are of honeycomb construction with a graphite/epoxy skin. No balancing is required for the
tab.

The elevator tab may be replaced without rebalancing the elevator. Each tab is furnished with adjust weights
that bolt to the elevator nose. The required number of tab adjust weights is stamped on a data plate attached
to each elevator tab. The number of weights required is a function of the weight of the elevator tab.

ATA-27 Page 37 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Control Columns

The two control columns provide primary control of the airplane about the pitch and roll axes. Forward and aft
motion of either control column actuates the elevators to provide control of the airplane about the lateral axis.
Rotating a control wheel on either column operates the ailerons and spoilers to provide control about the
longitudinal axis.

The control columns are mounted at each end of the quadrant torque tube. Motion is transmitted from the
column to the torque tube through mating face splines. Inside each column outer housing, the lower end of a
shaft is connected to the aileron and spoiler control systems through a spade universal. A bevel gear, located
at the upper end of this shaft, is driven by a mating bevel gear connected to the control wheel. The control
column wiring harness originates at a terminal block in the lower nose section and is routed up through a
conduit inside the control column outer housing. At the top of the column, the wires for the stabilizer trim
control switch, autopilot disengage switch, and microphone switch are routed to the outboard horn of the
control wheel. At the outboard horn, the wires are then connected to the appropriate switches. A stall warning
shaker is mounted on the forward face of the captain's and first officer's control columns. Wiring provisions
for the stall warning shaker are also included in the control column. Felt dust seals are fastened to the control
cabin floor. A spherical dust cover fastened to the column, contacts these seals to restrict airflow around the
base of the control column.

Elevator Forward Control Quadrants

The elevator forward control quadrants are aluminum alloy forgings suspended from the quadrant torque tube
and located in the lower nose section. The elevator control cables are located in grooves along the lower
surface of each forward control quadrant. Each cable is secured at the quadrant. A pitch transducer is
installed in each forward control quadrant. Access to the forward control quadrants is through the forward
access door at station 211, just forward of the nose wheel well door.

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-27 Page 38


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

MICROPHONE SWITCH

MEMORY
DEVICE AUTOPILOT
CONTROL DISENGAGE
WHEEL SWITCH

STABILIZER TRIM
CONTROL SWITCH

CAPTAIN'S
CONTROL STALL WARNING
COLUMN CONTROL COLUMN FIRST OFFICER'S
SHAKER CONTROL COLUMN

WIRE
HARNESS

CABIN FLOOR

DUST COVER STALL WARNING


CONTROL COLUMN
SHAKER

QUADRANT
TORQUE TUBE

ELEVATOR FORWARD
CONTROL QUADRANT

CONTROL CABLE EA
WEIGHT BLOCKS

CONTROL CABLE EB
AUTOPILOT
PITCH
TRANSDUCER

ATA-27 Page 39 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Elevator Aft Control Quadrants

The elevator aft control quadrants are four individual segments mounted on the input torque tube in the
empennage. The two upper segments are connected to the elevator up cables (EB) and the lower segments to
the elevator down cables (EA). Aft movement of the control column will displace the elevator up cables (EB)
forward, and forward movement of the control column will displace the elevator down cables (EA) forward.

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-27 Page 40


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Elevator Feel Computer

The elevator feel computer supplies controlled system A and system B hydraulic pressure to the elevator feel
control unit. The feel computer is mounted to structure within the empennage adjacent to the stabilizer front
spar. The computer is a dual unit, the housing divided to accommodate identical components for system A as
for system B.

Inputs to the feel computer are hydraulic system A and hydraulic system B pressure at 3000 PSI, pitot
pressure, static pressure, and a stabilizer position mechanical input. Pitot pressures are directed to each
system from individual pitot tubes on the vertical fin. The outputs from the feel computer are two controlled
hydraulic pressures, 200 to 2100 PSI, to the feel control unit. The internal feel differential pressure switch
turns on an amber light on the overhead panel when an undesirable pressure difference exists between the two
feel computer output pressures.

ATA-27 Page 41 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Elevator Feel and Centering Unit

The elevator feel and centering unit provides artificial feel to the pilot and centering for the elevator control
system. The feel and centering unit is mounted to structure aft of the stabilizer rear spar and pivots about a
lateral axis. The unit consists of a centering cam and roller assembly, centering linkage, and an externally
mounted dual feel actuator. The feel and centering unit receives two hydraulic inputs from the feel computer.
The inputs act upon pistons within the free-floating dual feel actuator. A rod from one piston attaches to the
feel and centering unit body. A rod from the opposing piston attaches, by means of centering linkage, to the
feel control centering cam and roller assembly. The feel and centering unit neutral position changes as
stabilizer attitude varies.

Actuation of the control columns in either direction will rotate the centering cam and force the roller up the
face of the cam. A change in stabilizer position with the control columns held fixed, will rotate the feel and
centering unit body and force the roller up the face of the cam. Either action places a load on the control
system and artificially provides feel at the control columns. The resulting load is removed by rotating the
control columns forward or aft to run the roller back into the cam detent. A change in stabilizer position with
the control columns free to move will allow the roller to remain in the cam detent and cause the control
columns to move to the new neutral position.

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-27 Page 42


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Elevator Power Control Unit

The elevator power control units provide actuation of the elevators in response to manual inputs from the
control columns. The control units are mounted vertically in the empennage above the aft elevator control
quadrant torque tube. The two control units operate independently from separate hydraulic systems, the left
unit from hydraulic system A pressure and the right unit from hydraulic system B pressure. The upper
mounting terminals attach to lugs on the output torque tube, which is directly linked by pushrods to each
elevator. Failure of either hydraulic system will render one control unit inoperable. The remaining unit will
then drive both elevators through the full range of travel.

Two autopilot actuators drive the elevator input torque tube, which then provides an input to the power control
unit input cranks.

ATA-27 Page 43 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Elevator Tab Control Mechanism

The elevator tab control linkage provides tab-assisted elevator movement when the elevators are operated.
There are two tab control linkage mechanisms, one for each elevator, consisting of a pushrod and crank
mechanism. The mechanism is located inside the horizontal stabilizer aft of the stabilizer rear spar. The
mechanism is attached at the forward end to the inside upper surface structure of the stabilizer and at the aft
end to the elevator front spar. The forces are transmitted by the bellcranks and pushrods to the elevator tab.

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-27 Page 44


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

HORIZONTAL STABILIZER TRIM CONTROL SYSTEM


Overview

The horizontal stabilizer trim control system provides longitudinal trim of the airplane by varying the angle of
attack of the horizontal stabilizer. The horizontal stabilizer is moved through 17 degrees of travel by means of
a jackscrew with ball nut. The main electric actuator or the primary stabilizer trim actuator and the cable
drum on the jackscrew gearbox provide for trim control from three separate control systems. The normal
control is an electrical system, which actuates the jackscrew through the main electrical actuator or primary
stabilizer trim actuator. For airplanes with the main electric actuator and autopilot actuator, autopilot control
is provided by the autopilot actuator on the gearbox. For airplanes with the primary stabilizer trim actuator,
autopilot control is provided by the primary stabilizer trim actuator. A manual control system drives through
cables to the cable drum on the jackscrew gearbox. The manual system remains engaged at all times and is
therefore back-driven by the main electric actuator or autopilot actuator during normal operation. Manual
system operation will disengage both the normal electrical and autopilot actuators if these systems become
jammed. A continuous indication of stabilizer position is provided by trim position indicators adjacent to trim
wheels on the control stand. The indicators are positioned by the manual system. A takeoff warning system
indicates any unsafe stabilizer position for takeoff. The control column actuated cutout switch located under
the cockpit floor, stops electric trimming of the stabilizer when opposed by the motion of the elevator control.

Normal electric trimming of the stabilizer is done at one of two rates as controlled by flap position. Trim rate
with flaps retracted is 1/3 the trim rate with flaps extended. The autopilot actuator also trims at one of two
rates as controlled by flap position. High speed autopilot rate is equal to the normal electric low speed rate.
The low speed autopilot rate is 1/2 the rate of the high speed autopilot rate.

ATA-27 Page 45 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Horizontal Stabilizer

The horizontal stabilizer assembly consists of a left and a right section attached to a center section. The
center section jackscrew support, hinge supports, front spar, and rear spar members are all truss-type
forgings. Good accessibility for maintenance is provided by the use of a star-shaped pattern of beams for the
center section.

STABILIZER
(LH SHOWN)

JACKSCREW
SUPPORT

FWD

HINGE
SUPPORT

STABILIZER
ATTACH FITTINGS

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-27 Page 46


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

ATA-27 Page 47 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Stabilizer Forward Control Mechanism

The stabilizer forward control mechanism provides the means of manual control for the stabilizer in the event
of electrical malfunction. The forward control mechanism extends from a stabilizer trim wheel on each side of
the control stand to a forward trim mechanism in the lower nose compartment. The stabilizer trim wheels and
a sprocket are splined to a control wheel shaft that extends through the control stand. Rotation of the
stabilizer trim wheels transmits motion to a forward trim mechanism spocket by a chain assembly. The
forward trim mechanism spocket drives the forward cable drum which is cable-connected to the stabilizer
jackscrew gearbox cable drum. The stabilizer jackscrew gearbox cable drum drives the jackscrew to position
the stabilizer. The forward trim mechanism is attached to the lower nose compartment by support linkages
which can be adjusted to align the trim mechanism and obtain proper chain and cable tension.

Stabilizer Position Indicator

A stabilizer position indicator provides continuous indication of stabilizer trim. The stabilizer position
indicator operates through a flexible shaft connected to the forward trim mechanism, a jackshaft, and a linkage
to the indicator. The flexible shaft transmits motion to the indicator linkage through the jackshaft and
positions the indicator. During normal electrical operation, the stabilizer trim cables drive the forward trim
mechanism which operates the trim position indicator and rotates the trim wheels. A scale on the control
stand is calibrated in units of trim to indicate the proper takeoff stabilizer range and is referred to as the
GREEN BAND.

Column Actuated Cutout Switch

A column actuated cutout switch assembly stops powered stabilizer trim when either control column is moved
in the direction opposing the stabilizer trim. The assembly located below the cockpit floor contains a set of
cam operated switches which de-energizes the main trim actuator clutches and the main control relay which
interrupts motor power. The assembly also contains switches which will interrupt power to the autopilot
actuator motor and clutch when column motion input opposes the trim direction. The switches are wired so
that when column motion input is the same as the trim direction, either main electric or autopilot trim will
continue.

A shear out lever on the input shaft of the assembly prevents a jammed switch assembly from jamming the
control columns.

A column actuated stab trim switch override located on the aisle stand will bypass the column actuated switch
assembly. When this switch is placed in this override position, the main electric trim will operate when
commanded regardless of control column position. This switch is guarded to ensure normal operation of the
column actuated cutout switch.

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-27 Page 48


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

ATA-27 Page 49 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Stabilizer Jackscrew and Gearbox Assembly

The stabilizer jackscrew and gearbox assembly positions the stabilizer by converting electric actuator, autopilot
actuator, or cable drum rotary motion to linear motion. The stabilizer jackscrew and gearbox assembly
consists of a ball nut and jackscrew, a gimbal assembly, a cable drum, and the gearbox consisting of gearing
and brakes. The gearbox is connected to a bulkhead in the fuselage by a lower gimbal which allows fore and
aft angular motion as the stabilizer is positioned. An upper gimbal connects the ball nut to the stabilizer front
spar fitting. This gimbal prevents any binding of the screw while the ball nut positions the stabilizer. A safety
rod is installed in the jackscrew shaft to support the stabilizer in the event of jackscrew failure.

The primary brake system in the stabilizer trim gearbox prevents any aerodynamic loads on the stabilizer from
rotating the jackscrew when the control system is not being operated. When the jackscrew shaft is driven by
the jackscrew gearbox in a direction which increases the airloads on the stabilizer, a brake plate rotates
through a ratchet producing a clicking sound in the assembly.

The auxiliary brake system is provided in case of primary brake system failure. When the jackscrew is turned
by the jackscrew gearbox, the auxiliary brake system is released through a gear driven by the gearbox. If the
primary brake system fails, the jackscrew shaft rotation applies the auxiliary brake to prevent any additional
shaft rotation.

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-27 Page 50


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

SAFETY ROD

JACKSCREW
STABILIZER
BALLNUT
STRUCTURE

PRIMARY LOWER STOP


STABILIZER (UPPER STOP
ELECTRIC GREASE
TRIM ACTUATOR UMBRELLA NOT SHOWN BUT
ACTUATOR FITTING
ASSEMBLY EQUIVALENT)

UPPER GIMBAL UMBRELLA


GEARBOX ASSEMBLY

COVER
PLATE

AUTOPILOT
ACTUATOR

LOWER
GIMBAL

STB CABLE
STB CABLE

STA CABLE
STA CABLE

2 1

LOWER GEARBOX
GEARBOX COVER CABLE DRUM
PLATE GIMBAL
CABLE DRUM
FWD

STABILIZER ACTUATOR MECHANISM

1 AIRPLANES WITHOUT PRIMARY STABILIZER TRIM ACTUATOR


2 AIRPLANES WITH PRIMARY STABILIZER TRIM ACTUATOR

ATA-27 Page 51 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Electric Actuator Trim Actuator or Primary Stabilizer Trim Actuator

The main electric actuator or the primary stabilizer trim actuator provides power to actuate the stabilizer
during normal operation. Actuator consists of a two speed, three phase induction motor, two electromagnetic
clutches, a speed change relay and a torque limiting clutch. The trim motor is powered by 115-volt, three
phase, 400 cycle power and is capable of emergency operation on two phase power supply. Electromagnetic
clutches control the direction of rotation of the output shaft and are powered by 28-volts DC. The speed
change relay, is also powered by 28-volts DC, determines output shaft speed as a function of flap position.
High speed (with flaps extended beyond zero degrees) is three times faster than low speed (for flaps
retracted). A mechanical clutch on the output shaft limits the maximum output torque to protect components
in jackscrew gearbox.

Airplanes with primary stabilizer trim actuator: The primary stabilizer trim actuator also provides an
electrical means for actuating the stabilizer. Control is provided by the autopilot.

The autopilot actuator or primary stabilizer trim actuator provides an electrical means for actuating the
stabilizer. Control is provided by the autopilot. The autopilot actuator consists of a three-phase reversible two
speed induction servomotor, an electromagnetic clutch, a mechanical torque limiting clutch output shaft to
drive the jackscrew gearbox. The servomotor is energized by 115-volt, three phase, 400-Hz AC power and is
capable of emergency operation by a two-phase supply. Reversing is accomplished by phase reversing through
the use of a direction relay. Separate servomotor windings provide a speed change ratio of two to one.
Selection of the servomotor speed is by a speed change relay. The high speed mode is selected when an input
signal is received from the flap switches and the low speed mode is selected with no flap switch input. The
flap switches are actuated when flaps are extended beyond zero degrees. The electromagnetic clutch and the
control relays are energized by 28-volt DC power. A mechanical clutch on the output shaft limits maximum
output torque to protect the main electric trim actuator.

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-27 Page 52


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

SEE A

PRIMARY MOUNTING
MOUNTING ELECTRIC
STABILIZER BOLTS
BOLTS ACTUATOR
TRIM ACTUATOR

JACKSCREW
GEARBOX
JACKSCREW
GEARBOX

2 1

FWD

1 AIRPLANES WITHOUT PRIMARY STABILIZER TRIM ACTUATOR


2 AIRPLANES WITH PRIMARY STABILIZER TRIM ACTUATOR

ATA-27 Page 53 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Stabilizer Trim Limit Switches

Stabilizer trim limit switches limit the up and down travel of the horizontal stabilizer leading edge during
either normal electric actuator trimming operation or autopilot trimming operation of the horizontal stabilizer.
The lever operated microswitches are mounted in a vertical row on brackets on the stabilizer jackscrew
compartment aft bulkhead.

All switches are operated by the same cam. The cam is mounted by a support tube to the horizontal stabilizer
center section jackscrew attach fitting. The cam moves with the stabilizer to actuate the limit switches to the
open position at the desired stabilizer travel limits. Opening of the switches removes power to the respective
actuator to terminate stabilizer travel.

Main electric nose down travel is limited by one of two limit switches as selected by flap position.

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-27 Page 54


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

STAB TAKEOFF WARNING


SWITCH (S546)
(REF 31-26-24)

LIMIT SWITCHES
(AIRPLANE NOSE DOWN)
SEE A
LIMIT SWITCHES STAB AUTOPILOT AND
(AIRPLANE NOSE UP) ELEC ACTUATOR LIMIT
SEE A SWITCH (S145)

STAB ELEC ACTUATOR


LIMIT SWITCH (S844)

SWITCH
MOUNTING
BRACKETS

CAM

STAB TAKEOFF
WARNING
SWITCH (S132)
(REF 31-26-24)

FWD
STAB ELEC ACTUATOR STAB AUTOPILOT LIMIT
LIMIT SWITCH (S115) SWITCH (S144)

ATA-27 Page 55 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

TRAILING EDGE FLAP SYSTEM

Overview

The trailing edge flap system provides additional lift during takeoff and landing by increasing the camber of
the wing. This is accomplished with four triple-slotted trailing edge flaps operating in conjunction with four
leading edge flaps and six leading edge slats.

Each trailing edge flap is a triple-slotted structure consisting of a foreflap, a midflap, and an aftflap. Each
midflap is connected to two flap carriages which travel on tracks attached to the lower wing surface. The flaps
are faired with the wing when retracted and are mechanically separated to form slots when extended. The
slots provide increased lift by reducing stagnation of air flowing over the flap surface. With the flaps
extended, the area of the flaps is greatly increased.

The trailing edge flaps are actuated either hydraulically or electrically by one drive system. During normal
operation, the flap drive system is hydraulically powered. During alternate flap operation, the drive system is
electrically powered. Each trailing edge flap is actuated by two flap transmission assemblies. A friction brake
installed in the inboard transmission assembly on each flap prevents flap retraction due to airloads. Eight
transmission assemblies are connected through torque tubes and gearboxes to a flap power unit. Both the
hydraulic and electric drive motors are attached to the power unit. The flap system is normally controlled by a
manually operated flap control lever on the pilots' control stand. The lever operates a cable system connected
to a quadrant on a control valve mechanism. The control valve supplies system B hydraulic fluid to the flap
hydraulic motor to drive the flap system. A priority valve installed upstream of the control valve regulates the
speed of the hydraulic motor by limiting fluid flow. A flap control lever cable failure shutoff switch is located
near the control valve quadrant. A cable failure will activate the switch and provide electrical power to the
bypass valve which will shut off hydraulic power to the flap drive motor. A flap load limiter system partially
retracts the trailing edge flaps when airspeed becomes excessive. Mechanical follow-up is incorporated in the
flap system to close the control valve when the flaps reach the desired position.

The flap alternate drive system may be used if the flaps cannot be operated hydraulically. The flap alternate
system operation is controlled by the alternate flaps arm switch and the control switch on the overhead panel.
Energizing the alternate flaps arm switch supplies power to actuate a motor-operated bypass valve. Actuating
the valve to the bypass position interconnects the inlet ports on the flap hydraulic motor. This allows fluid to
circulate within the motor, thus preventing a hydraulic lock opposing alternate flap operation. The alternate
flaps control switch is used to actuate the flaps down and up electrically.

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-27 Page 56


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

ATA-27 Page 57 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Trailing Edge Flap

Each trailing edge flap consists of a midflap with an attached hinged exhaust gate segment, a foreflap, and an
aftflap. The three flap segments are mechanically separated during flap extension. Each trailing edge flap is
supported by two flap carriages which travel on tracks mounted under the wing. The trailing edge flap is
driven by two transmission assemblies attached to the midflap.

Inboard Midflap

The inboard midflap consists of ribs, three spars, a honeycomb trailing edge, and clad aluminum skins. A
hinged exhaust gate segment is attached to the outboard aft edge of the midflap. Four tracks mounted on the
rear spar of the midflap support the aftflap. A drive mechanism for the aftflap is contained in the midflap. An
actuation mechanism for the exhaust gate is contained in the midflap.

The exhaust gate actuation mechanism is installed on the outboard end of the inboard midflap. As the midflap
and the foreflap separate between the 25 and 40 Unit position, the actuation mechanism opens the exhaust
gate.

The midflap is supported by two flap carriages which ride on the main flap tracks.

Outboard Midflap

The outboard midflap consists of ribs, two spars, a trailing edge beam, two honeycomb trailing edge panels,
and clad aluminum skins. A hinged exhaust gate segment is attached to the inboard aft edge of the midflap.
Four tracks mounted on the rear spar protrude through the trailing edge beam to support the aftflap.

The exhaust gate actuation mechanism installed on the inboard end of the outboard midflap. As the midflap
and the foreflap separate between the 25 and 40 Unit position, the actuation mechanism opens the exhaust
gate.

The foreflap is a monospar structure with a honeycomb trailing edge panel and clad aluminum skins. Three
curved support beams extend through the lower surface and connect to three foreflap tracks. The foreflap
tracks slide on roller bearings mounted to midflap structure.

The aftflap is a monospar structure with a honeycomb trailing edge panel and clad aluminum skins. Four
carriages are installed on the leading edge of the aftflap.

Each trailing edge flap is driven by two transmission assemblies attached to the midflap. As the flaps extend,
the aftflap immediately moves relative to the midflap to form a slot between the two segments. The inboard aft
flap is actuated by the drive mechanism contained in the midflap. Midflap extension rotates the aftflap drive
mechanism cable drum. Rotation of the cable drum moves the bellcranks to which the aftflap pushrods are
attached, thus positioning the aftflap.

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-27 Page 58


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

ATA-27 Page 59 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Flap Tracks

The flap tracks are curved forged steel beams mounted on the lower surface of the wing. A flap transmission
assembly is mounted on each flap track. The tracks and the transmission assemblies are housed in
aerodynamic fairings.

Each outboard flap track is contained in a two piece fairing made from aluminum frames covered with graphite
reinforced Kevlar skins. The forward section of the fairing is rigidly attached to the wing. The aft fairing
section rotates about a hinge support mounted on the main flap track. Two fairing actuator tracks and an aft
flap sequencing track are mounted in the aft fairing section. Rollers on a support arm on the midflap carriage
engage in the two fairing actuator tracks. The tracks act as cams to rotate the aft fairing downward as the
outboard flap extends. A retractable landing light mounted in the aft outboard fairing extends as the fairing
rotates downward. The aftflap sequencing track is used as a cam for the aftflap actuating mechanism. The
rear portion of the aft fairing is detachable.

The tracks for the inboard flap are contained in fixed fairings. The inboard flap outboard track is contained in
the flap track fairing. The inboard flap inboard track is contained in the wing-to-body fairing. Torque tubes
between the midflap carriages and the midflap pass through openings in the fairings. The openings are curved
slots which allow fore and aft motion of the midflap. The inboard flap outboard track fairing has a closure
door to seal the opening when the flaps are retracted. The door is located at the aft end of the opening. The
door is opened by pressure from the carriage torque tube when the flaps are extended.

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-27 Page 60


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

SEE A

TORQUE TUBE

UNIVERSAL JOINT

OUTBOARD MIDFLAP

FLAP TRACK

TORQUE LIMITER HOUSING

TRANSMISSION GEARBOX

BALL NUT AND


SCREW ACTUATOR
FWD

INBD

ATA-27 Page 61 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Flap Control Lever

A flap control lever located on the upper right side of the control stand regulates the position of the trailing
edge flaps. The lever assembly consists of a spring-loaded telescoping handle and a cable drum. The cable
drum rotates around a shaft in the control stand. A flap control cable attaches to the cable drum. The lever
rotates around a quadrant which has detents at the flap positions. The lever is spring loaded to lock in each
detent. Lifting the lever about 1/4 of an inch releases the lock and allows rotation. The quadrant contains
gates at the 1- and 15-unit detents which prevent inadvertent lever movement past the detent position. The
lever must be lowered into the detent and passed under the gate before further rotation can occur. The flap
control lever actuates the cable system to drive a cable drum and flap control quadrant in the right wheel well.

FLAP CONTROL LEVER

FLAP QUADRANT

CONTROL STAND

FWD

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-27 Page 62


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Flap Control Unit

The flap control unit contains the mechanical linkage that operates the flap control valves. The control unit
consists of an input linkage, two cams connected by a shaft, and a cable drum.

A flap control quadrant located directly above the flap control unit transfers cable motion through a shaft, a
link, and a bellcrank to position the trailing edge flap control valve slide. Pressurized fluid from the control
valve drives the flap hydraulic motor. As the hydraulic motor drives the flap system, it also drives the power
unit follow-up drum. Follow-up motion is transmitted by flap follow-up cables (WFFA and WFFB) to the
control valve follow-up drum. Rotation of the control valve follow-up drum transmits motion through a cam,
cam roller, and link to the bellcrank. Rotary motion from the bellcrank returns the control valve to the neutral
position preventing fluid flow to the flap hydraulic motor. The control valve follow-up drum also transmits
motion through a second cam and cam roller to control the leading edge flap control valve.

The flap control unit is mounted on the right wheel well ceiling near the aft bulkhead. Mounted on the forward
end of the follow-up shaft is an actuating cam for the flap limit switches, the landing gear warning horn
switches, the takeoff warning switch, the mach trim switch, and the flap 10-degree switch.

Flap Control Valve

The flap control valve is a mechanically-operated slide valve used to control directional movement of the
trailing edge flaps. The valve is attached to the flap control unit located in the right wheel well. The control
valve is driven by the control unit linkage.

The control valve includes a hydraulic solenoid valve activated by the flap load limiter system. The solenoid
valve, when energized, repositions the flap control valve to the 30-unit position from the 40-unit position.

FLAP CONTROL CABLE TENSION


QUADRANT SWITCH

INPUT SHAFT

WFB CABLE FOLLOW-UP SHAFT

FOLLOW-UP DRUM
WFA CABLE

FLAP 10-DEGREE WFFA CABLE


SWITCH S584 BELLCRANK
CAM ROLLER WFFB CABLE
FLAPS UP LIMIT TE FLAP
SWITCH S245 CONTROL VALVE

STALL WARNING S856

FLAPS DOWN LIMIT


CAM
SWITCH S246
ROLLER FLAP LOAD LIMITER
TAKEOFF WARNING SOLENOID VALVE
MACH TRIM
SWITCH S130 LANDING SWITCH S290
WARNING LE FLAP
SWITCH TE FLAP CONTROL CONTROL VALVE
S138 VALVE LINK

Flap Control Unit

ATA-27 Page 63 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Priority Valve

The operating speed of the trailing edge flaps is controlled by a flow limiting valve installed in the pressure
line to the flap control valve upstream from the control valve. A priority valve controls the rate of fluid flow to
the flap hydraulic motor. The priority valve reduces the flow of hydraulic fluid to flaps when pressure drops
below the level required to maintain all airplane systems. At normal temperatures with hydraulic pressure
between 2700 and 3000 PSI fluid flow to the motor is regulated at 10.0 GPM. When pressure drops to 2400 to
2700 PSI, fluid flow is rapidly decreased. Below 2400 PSI, the flow of the hydraulic fluid drops to 0.7 GPM.

PRIORITY
VALVE
SEE A

BOLT
(3 LOCATIONS)

PRIORITY
VALVE

FWD

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-27 Page 64


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Flap Bypass Valve

The flap bypass valve is a motor-operated two position valve which interconnects the flap hydraulic motor
pressure and return ports during operation of the flap alternate drive system. The valve is mounted on the aft
bulkhead in the right wheel well. The valve contains three ports from which hydraulic lines extend to the flap
control valve and flap hydraulic motor. The valve is controlled by the alternate flaps arm switch which, when
moved to ARM, supplies 28-volt DC power to move the valve to the bypass position. In this position, the down
line from the flap control valve is blocked and the flap hydraulic motor ports are connected together to allow
fluid circulation within the motor. Moving the alternate flaps arm switch to OFF moves the bypass valve to the
normal position and restores hydraulic operation of the flap system.

The bypass valve is also controlled by the flap asymmetry shutoff relay which moves the valve to the bypass
position to stop flap movement when left and right wing flap extension or retraction is not symmetrical.

The bypass valve is also controlled by the flap control cable tension switch system which moves the valve to
the bypass position to stop flap movement if the control cable breaks.

ATA-27 Page 65 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Flap Hydraulic Motor

A reversible hydraulic motor attached to the flap power unit drives the flap system during normal operation.
The nine cylinder piston-type motor converts hydraulic pressure to mechanical energy. The externally splined
motor driveshaft mates with the power unit input shaft. Two hydraulic lines from the flap control valve
connect to inlet ports on the motor. A case drain line connecting the motor to the hydraulic fluid return
system through a check valve allows lubrication of the motor. The flow of pressurized fluid through the motor
actuates the pistons and rotates the output shaft. Rotation of the output shaft drives the power unit.

SEE A

FLAP
HYDRAULIC
MOTOR
SHAFT

SHAFT
RETAINER

CHECK
VALVE

MOUNTING BOLTS
(4 LOCATIONS)

FLAP
POWER
FWD
UNIT

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-27 Page 66


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Flap Power Unit

The flap power unit transfers mechanical energy from the flap hydraulic motor and alternate drive unit to the
flap drive system. The power unit is an aluminum housing containing a reduction gear, two pinion gears, an
output shaft with a worm gear, a worm wheel, and a worm wheel shaft. The reduction gear is splined to the
output shaft. The flap hydraulic motor and the flap alternate drive unit are attached to the power unit.
During normal flap system operation, power from the hydraulic motor is transmitted through a pinion gear to
the reduction gear. During flap alternate drive operation, power from the alternate drive unit is transmitted
through a second pinion gear to the reduction gear. Rotation of the reduction gear drives the flap system
through the power unit output shaft.

SEE A

FWD

FLAP ALTERNATE
DRIVE UNIT

WFFB CABLE
WFA CABLE
TORQUE
WFFA CABLE
TUBE
SEE B

FLAP POWER
TE FLAP UNIT
BYPASS VALVE
TE FLAP
CONTROL VALVE

FLAP LOAD LIMITER


SOLENOID VALVE

FLAP CONTROL UNIT


LE FLAP
CONTROL VALVE

ATA-27 Page 67 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Flap Transmission Assembly

The flap transmission assembly converts flap torque tube rotation into linear motion to extend or retract the
trailing edge flaps. Each transmission assembly consists of a transmission gearbox, a universal joint, and a
ball nut and screw actuator.

The transmission assemblies are mounted on the flap tracks just aft of the landing gear support beam and the
wing rear spar. Each transmission assembly is enclosed in a flap track fairing. Flap drive system torque
tubes attach to the input shafts on the transmission gearbox.

SEE A

TORQUE TUBE

UNIVERSAL JOINT

OUTBOARD MIDFLAP

FLAP TRACK

TORQUE LIMITER HOUSING

TRANSMISSION GEARBOX

BALL NUT AND


SCREW ACTUATOR
FWD

INBD

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-27 Page 68


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Flap Alternate Drive Unit

The flap alternate drive unit uses electric power to drive the flap system if a failure prevents normal hydraulic
operation of the flap system. The unit is mounted on the flap power unit located on the aft bulkhead in the
right wheel well. The alternate drive unit is energized by actuating the alternate flaps arm switch and the
control switch located on the overhead panel. A 115/200-volt AC motor and a gearbox are the primary
alternate drive unit components. The gearbox incorporates a double planetary reduction gear train and a
disconnect and overload clutch.

FLAP
HYDRAULIC
MOTOR
SEE A
SHAFT

SHAFT RETAINER

SEE B

FWD

FLAP ALTERNATE
DRIVE UNIT

MOUNTING BOLTS

MOUNTING BOLT

TORQUE TUBE
SPLINE COUPLING

FLAP ALTERNATE
DRIVE UNIT

ELECTRICAL
FWD INBD
CONNECTOR

ATA-27 Page 69 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

TRAILING EDGE FLAP POSITION INDICATING SYSTEM


Overview

The trailing edge flap position indicating system provides visible indication of the angular position of the
trailing edge flaps. The synchro-type system consists of two position transmitter assemblies and one flap
position indicator. The flap position indicator shows angular position of the two outboard trailing edge flaps.
Each position transmitter installation consists of a gearbox and a synchro-type transmitter. The gearbox is
driven by the flap torque tubes and, in turn, rotates the transmitter shaft. This varies the electrical signal to
the flap position indicator.

Flap Position Indicator

A flap position indicator shows the position of the trailing edge flaps. It is a dual synchro-type indicator which
registers flap position in units. The indicator receives 3-phase electrical signals from the two flap position
transmitters and moves two pointers to indicate flap position. The flap position indicator is mounted on the
center instrument panel in the control cabin.

Flap Position Transmitter Assembly

A flap position transmitter assembly relays the angular position of each outboard trailing edge flap to a
position indicator in the cabin. The position transmitter assembly consists of a synchro-type transmitter
mounted on a gearbox. The gearbox contains a pair of spur gears driven by the outboard flap torque tubes.
The pinion gear has splines at each end which are assembled with torque tube coupling halves. The output
gear has an internal spline which drives the flap position transmitter mounted on the gearbox housing.

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-27 Page 70


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

 
SEE A

SEE B

2
5
1
10

UP 15

FLAPS
25
30
40
NOTE: BLACK INDICATOR DIAL WITH WHITE
MARKINGS REVERSED FOR CLARITY
POSITION INDICATOR
A

FLAP POSITION
TRANSMITTER

FWD INBD

OUTBOARD FLAP
TORQUE TUBE

GEARBOX

LEFT WING SHOWN-RIGHT WING OPPOSITE


B

ATA-27 Page 71 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

FLIGHT SPOILER CONTROL SYSTEM


Overview

The flight spoiler control system supplements the ailerons in providing lateral control. The spoilers are
numbered 0 thru 9 from left to right. The flight spoilers, 2, 3, 6, and 7 are located outboard of the engines.
The ground spoilers 0, 1, 8, and 9 are located farthest outboard on the wings. The ground spoilers, No. 4 and
5, are located inboard of the engines. The spoilers lie flush with the upper wing surface when not in use, and
can be raised to various angles when in use. The flight spoilers may also act as speed brakes. Spoiler
position sensors are installed on spoilers No. 2 and 7 to provide an electrical signal to indicate spoiler
position.

When functioning as spoilers, the flight spoiler panels raise on the wing on which the aileron rotates up. The
spoiler panels on the down aileron wing remain faired. When used as speed brakes, the spoiler panels on
both wings raise. With speed brakes on, the spoiler panels on the up aileron wing will be raised more than
those on the down aileron wing. This allows the flight spoilers to provide lateral control and speed brake
operation simultaneously.

A spoiler ratio changer reduces the magnitude of the lateral control input to the spoiler control system when
speed brakes are used. The amount of reduction depends upon the speed brake lever position, with zero
speed brakes giving maximum input. A spoiler mixer combines the lateral control inputs with speed brake
inputs to move control cables routed along the rear spars of the wings to spoiler actuator quadrants. The
spoiler actuator quadrants position control valves in spoiler actuators and allow hydraulic pressure to position
the spoilers.

An auxiliary set of control cables runs from a transfer mechanism at the base of the first officer's control
column to a spoiler control quadrant which also drives the spoiler ratio changer. If a malfunction occurs to
restrict operation of the aileron control system, the first officer may transmit lateral control signals to the ratio
changer through these cables. When spoiler control is obtained in this manner, the first officer is required to
override a spring in the transfer mechanism. If a malfunction occurs to restrict operation of the spoiler
control system, the captain may override the spring in the transfer mechanism to provide aileron control.

Each spoiler is operated by its own actuator. Hydraulic power to operate the spoilers is obtained from
hydraulic system B for the outboard flight spoiler on each wing, and from hydraulic system A for the inboard
flight spoiler on each wing. Maximum hinge moment on the spoilers is limited by a check valve in each
actuator, permitting the spoiler panels to blow down if limiting speed is exceeded with spoilers up.

Electric motor-driven shutoff valves, located in the flight controls hydraulic modular packages, allow the flight
crew to shut off spoiler hydraulic power from system A, system B, or both systems. The system A flight
controls hydraulic modular package is in the left wheel well and the system B flight controls hydraulic modular
package is in the right wheel well. Control switches for these two shutoff valves are on the pilots' overhead
panel.

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-27 Page 72


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

FLIGHT CONTROLS FLIGHT SPOILERS


HYDRAULIC MODULAR
PACKAGE - SYSTEM B
SPOILER 7
WHEEL WELL
CONTROL 6
CEILING
QUADRANT
WING REAR SPAR

CABIN FLOOR
SPOILER RATIO CHANGER AND MIXER
AILERON
CONTROL
CABLES - AB
FLIGHT SPOILERS
AILERON
2 3 CONTROL
CABLES - AA

SPOILER ACTUATOR AILERON


SPRING
ACTUATOR QUADRANT
CARTRIDGE
FLIGHT CONTROLS
HYDRAULIC MODULAR AILERON CAPTAIN'S AILERON TRANSFER
PACKAGE - SYSTEM A BUS DRUMS CONTROL WHEEL MECHANISM

WHEEL WELL FIRST OFFICER'S


FORWARD AILERON CONTROL
BULKHEAD WHEEL

ATA-27 Page 73 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Flight Spoilers

The spoilers are constructed of graphite epoxy over a nomex honeycomb core for weight saving. A continuous
phenolic rub strip is bonded to the lower surface at the trailing edge. Dacron covered silicone rubber seals are
installed at each end and at the forward edge. The seals at each end are adjustable. The flight spoilers (No.
2, 3, 6, and 7) and the outboard ground spoilers (No. 0, 1, 8, and 9 are interchangeable among themselves).

Spoilers are attached to the wing structure by four hinge fittings equipped with self-aligning bearings. The
flight spoilers are located forward of the outboard flaps and are attached to wing structure aft of the rear spar.
The four flight spoiler actuators are attached between the spoilers and wing structure at the spanwise center
of each spoiler. Bonding jumpers provide an electrical bond between spoilers and wing structure. On some
airplanes, a blade seal along the bottom length of the spoiler acts as a dam to limit excessive air leakage
through the flaps.

When the spoilers are down, the down limit is provided by bottoming the piston in the actuator. In this
position, a clearance is maintained between the spoilers and the outboard flap. In flight, the flap will move up
due to airloads, and the phenolic rub strip may contact the abrasion resistant finish on the upper surface of
the flap.

SEE A

SPOILER PHENOLIC RUB


ACTUATOR STRIP

ADJUSTABLE
SEAL

BLADE
SEAL

BONDING SPOILER HINGE ACTUATOR


JUMPER BEARING ROD END

A FWD INBD

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-27 Page 74


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

ATA-27 Page 75 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Spoiler Ratio Changer

The spoiler ratio changer is a mechanical device which receives an input from the aileron control system and
transfers the input to the spoiler mixer to initiate spoiler action. For a given magnitude of input from the
aileron system, the ratio changer varies the magnitude of the output to the spoiler mixer, depending on speed
brake lever setting. The output decreases as speed brakes are raised.

The spoiler ratio changer is mounted on the forward bulkhead of the right wheel well. The ratio changer case
supports spoiler output quadrants and a speed brake quadrant.

In the event that the ratio changer should jamb, the bungee will allow the two part link to become longer as
the speed brake quadrant is rotated in the down direction. The speed brake quadrant has a fixed stop in the
speed brake down position and an adjustable stop in the speed brake up direction.

Spoiler Mixer

The spoiler mixer combines aileron input from the spoiler ratio changer with speed brake lever position. The
mixer allows the flight spoilers to augment lateral control of the airplane even when simultaneously being used
as speed brakes. The spoiler mixer contains a no-back device to ensure that spoiler authority for lateral
control is maintained if speed brake cable failure occurs.

The spoiler mixer assembly is mounted on the spoiler ratio changer located on the forward bulkhead of the
right wheel well.

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-27 Page 76


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

CABLES TO
TRANSFER
MECHANISM

SEE A WHEEL WELL


FORWARD
BULKHEAD
SPOILER
CONTROL
QUADRANT

GROUND SPOILER
CONTROL VALVE
RATIO
FWD
CHANGER
INPUT ROD
SPOILER
RATIO
CHANGER

SPOILER MIXER

WHEEL WELL
CEILING

SHEAR RIVETS
(4 PLACES)

SPOILER OUTPUT
QUADRANTS

AILERON SPRING
CARTRIDGE

AILERON BUS
DRUMS

ATA-27 Page 77 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Flight Spoiler Actuators

A spoiler actuator is used to position each of the flight spoilers. Each actuator is trunnion mounted to a
support fitting on the wing rear spar. An actuator link provides control inputs to the actuator from a spoiler
control quadrant mounted on the support fitting. Hydraulic power is directed to the actuator through trunnion
fittings. The piston rod end of the actuator is attached to the spoiler. Rotation of the spoiler control quadrant
displaces an actuator input lever and the control valve, allowing hydraulic fluid at 3000 PSI to be ported to one
side of the piston and rod assembly. The input lever remains stationary after the initial displacement, but the
actuator rotates on its trunnion as it positions the spoiler. Rotation of the actuator returns the control valve to
the neutral position, stopping hydraulic fluid flow as the desired spoiler position.

Hydraulic power to the flight spoiler power control units is controlled by spoiler shutoff valves in the flight
controls hydraulic modular packages. Switches for these electrically-operated valves are located on the pilots'
forward overhead panel. Hydraulic system A powers flight spoilers 3 and 6. Hydraulic system B powers flight
spoilers 2 and 7.

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-27 Page 78


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Spoiler Control Quadrant

The spoiler control quadrant located in the floor beam space above the main wheel well provides a control
path from the first officer's control column to the ratio changer. The quadrant shaft projects through the wheel
well ceiling to connect, by two cranks, to the aileron spring cartridge and the spoiler ratio changer input rod.
The quadrant is connected by cables to the transfer mechanism at the base of the first officer's control
column. The quadrant shaft rotates on two ball bearings. The upper bearing is enclosed in a ball fitting
which incorporates a rotary air pressure seal. The lower crank, to which the aileron spring cartridge connects,
is secured to the quadrant shaft by four shear rivets.

ATA-27 Page 79 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

THIS PAGE INTENTIONALLY LEFT BLANK

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-27 Page 80


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

SPEED BRAKE CONTROL SYSTEM


Overview

The speed brake control system actuates the flight and ground spoilers on both wings to increase drag and
reduce lift. The ground spoilers are used only on the ground to aid braking after touchdown. The flight
spoilers are used for lateral control, reducing airspeed and to aid braking after touchdown. The spoiler panels
are numbered 0 thru 9 from left to right. The flight spoilers 2, 3, 6, and 7 are located outboard of the engines.
Ground spoilers 0, 1, 8, and 9 are located outboard of the flight spoilers. Ground spoilers 4 and 5 are located
inboard of the engines. With lateral controls in neutral, application of speed brakes will cause the
corresponding flight spoilers on both wings to be raised equally. When speed brakes are applied on the
ground, the ground spoilers will also raise.

System control is applied to a speed brake control lever located on the captain's side of the control stand.
Moving the speed brake control lever operates control rods which rotate a speed brake forward drum
mechanism. The forward drum mechanism is connected by cables to a speed brake quadrant in the right
wheel well. The speed brake quadrant operates a ratio changer and provides an input to a spoiler mixer. The
spoiler mixer directs the speed brake signals to a ground spoiler control valve and to flight spoiler actuators.
A ground spoiler interlock valve is installed in the hydraulic line between the up ports of the ground spoiler
actuators and the ground spoiler control valve. The interlock valve is operated by a push-pull cable from the
right main gear upper torsion link. With the airplane airborne, the shock strut is extended and the upper
torsion link positions the push-pull cable to close the valve. When the airplane touches down, the shock strut
is compressed and the push-pull cable opens the valve to actuate the ground spoilers.

System control also may be applied by a speed brake lever actuator. The actuator electrically drives the speed
brake control lever to cause the speed brakes to raise or lower. Placing the speed brake control lever in an
ARMED detent will prepare the actuator for operation. When the main gear wheels begin rotation at
touchdown, the actuator will move the speed brake control lever to full up position raising the ground and
flight spoilers. If either engine thrust lever is positioned 25 degrees forward from engine idle position, the
actuator will move the speed brake control lever into the DOWN detent, lowering the ground and flight spoilers.
Indicator lights are provided on the center instrument panel to verify that the system is properly armed. On
airplanes with speed brake test switches three pushbutton test switches are provided on the center instrument
panel. Actuating the switches will test the indicator light control circuit and the actuator circuit.

The ground spoilers have two positions, fully retracted or fully raised. The fully raised position for all the
ground spoilers is 60 degrees. Ground spoilers 0, 1, 8, and 9 are each actuated directly by a single locking
actuator. Ground spoilers 4 and 5 are each actuated by two locking actuators which drive individual linkages.
Hydraulic power for all ground spoilers is from hydraulic system A. This ground spoiler hydraulic pressure
does not pass through the spoiler valves on the flight controls hydraulic modular package. Thus, the spoiler
switches which control these valves have no effect on ground spoiler operation.

ATA-27 Page 81 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

 
The flight spoilers will be positioned between 0 degrees and full up depending on speed brake lever position.
The full up position for all flight spoilers is 40 degrees.

A speed brake warning system provides an aural warning to prevent takeoff with the speed brakes raised or
speed brake control lever in ARMED position.

GROUND SPOILER
ACTUATOR LINKAGE
TO GROUND
SPOILERS NO. 8
AND 9 TO GROUND
SPOILERS NO. 0,
1 AND 4
GROUND SPOILER NO. 5

GROUND UP
SPOILER
DOWN TO SYSTEM A
ACTUATOR
RETURN
FROM SYSTEM
A PRESSURE
GROUND SPOILER
RIGHT CONTROL VALVE
LANDING FLEXIBLE
GEAR DRIVE ROD

SPOILER
MIXER

RATIO CHANGER
GROUND
SPOILER
INTERLOCK
VALVE SBB
CONTROL
UPPER
SPEED BRAKE CABLES
TORSION LINK
INPUT QUADRANT SBA
TO FORWARD
DRUM MECHANISM
SEE A

FWD

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-27 Page 82


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

ATA-27 Page 83 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Ground Spoiler Panel

Ground spoilers 0, 1, 8, and 9 are located outboard of the flight spoilers. Ground spoilers 4 and 5 are located
inboard of the engines. The ground spoilers are constructed of graphite/epoxy over a nomex honeycomb core
for weight savings. A continuous phenolic rub strip is bonded to the lower surface at the trailing edge.
Dacron covered silicon rubber seals are installed at each end and at the forward edge. The seals at each end
are adjustable. Ground spoilers 4 and 5 are interchangeable between themselves. Ground spoilers 0, 1, 8, and
9 are interchangeable between themselves.

The ground spoilers are attached to wing structure by four hinge fittings equipped with self-aligning bearings.
Ground spoilers 0, 1, 8, and 9 are located forward of the outboard flaps and are attached to wing structure aft
of the rear spar. Ground spoilers 4 and 5 are located forward of the inboard flaps and are attached to wing
structure aft of the rear spar and landing gear support beam. The actuators for ground spoilers 0, 1, 8, and 9
are attached directly to the spoilers and wing structure at the center of each spoiler. The actuators for ground
spoilers 4 and 5 are attached directly to wing structure and through an actuator linkage to the spoilers.
Bonding jumpers provide an electrical bond between the ground spoilers and wing structure.

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-27 Page 84


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

ATA-27 Page 85 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Speed Brake Control Lever

Manual control signals to the speed brake control system are applied at a speed brake control lever. The
speed brake control lever is located on the left side of the control stand. The control lever handle extends
above the control stand through a cutout in the cover. An indicator on the lever follows a plate on the stand.
The plate is marked at the DOWN and UP positions with additional markings at the ARMED detent and FLIGHT
detent.

AIRPLANES WITH SPEED BRAKE LEVER POSITION SENSOR: a speed brake lever position sensor,
mechanically linked to the forward drum quadrant by an adjustable control rod provides lever handle position
information to the flight data recorder for continuous monitoring of the lever and to a test connector for use
during automatic testing of the speed brake system.

The speed brake control lever has a compression spring in the telescoping handle. A small latch lug projects
inward from the control lever. Lever movement aft of the DOWN position is prevented until the handle is lifted
to raise the latch lug out of a detent. During a refused takeoff (RTO), application of the reverse thrust levers
mechanically lifts the speed brake lever out of the down and locked detent.

Speed Brake Forward Drum Mechanism

A speed brake forward drum mechanism in the fuselage lower nose compartment transfers speed brake lever
motion and speed brake lever actuator motion into cable motion. Speed brake lever input to the mechanism is
through two control rods and an idler link. The mechanism also provides control lever braking, a speed brake
armed detent, and a speed brake inflight detent. It consists of a lever brake mechanism, a speed brake lever
actuator, a speed brake forward drum, a detent roller arm, and three switches.

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-27 Page 86


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

ATA-27 Page 87 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Ground Spoiler Control Valve

A ground spoiler control valve controls hydraulic pressure to ground spoiler actuators. The valve is located in
the right main wheel well and is bolted to a bracket on the outboard part of the wheel well forward bulkhead.

Moving the speed brake control lever causes the speed brake crank on the spoiler mixer to transmit motion
through the pushrod and lever to position the valve piston.

When the speed brake control lever is in the DOWN position, the ground spoiler control valve directs hydraulic
pressure directly to the down port of the ground spoiler actuator. As the speed brake control lever is moved
aft, the control valve moves through a neutral position where pressure is blocked and all other ports connected
to return. As the speed brake lever is moved further aft, the control valve applies hydraulic pressure to the up
ports of the ground spoiler actuators through the ground spoiler interlock valve. The down port of the ground
spoiler actuator is connected to return through the ground spoiler control valve.

Ground Spoiler Interlock Valve

A ground spoiler interlock valve limits use of the ground spoilers to ground operation. The valve is located
above the right main gear trunnion and is secured to a bracket on the aft side of the wing rear spar.

With the landing gear in the retracted position, the shock strut inner cylinder is fully extended. This positions
the upper torsion link to cause the valve to block hydraulic pressure to the ground spoiler actuator up ports.

With the landing gear in the extended position, the hydraulic pressure remains blocked until the airplane
touches the ground and the right main landing gear shock strut is compressed. As the shock strut inner
cylinder is compressed, the upper torsion link moves the push-pull cable to open the interlock valve. The
interlock valve then connects hydraulic pressure from the ground spoiler control valve with the up ports of the
ground spoiler actuators.

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-27 Page 88


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

GROUND SPOILER
CONTROL VALVE

SEE A

SEE B

FWD INBD

INTERLOCK VALVE
CONTROL CABLE

GROUND SPOILER
INTERLOCK VALVE

ATA-27 Page 89 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

THIS PAGE INTENTIONALLY LEFT BLANK

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-27 Page 90


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Ground Spoiler Actuator

All ground spoilers are positioned by actuators powered by hydraulic system A. The actuators used on ground
spoilers 0, 1, 8, and 9 are identical as are ground spoiler 4 and 5 actuators. However, the actuators used on
ground spoilers 0, 1, 8, and 9 are not identical with the actuators used on ground spoilers 4 and 5.

No. 0, 1, 8, and 9 Ground Spoiler Actuators

The actuators are attached at the piston rod end to the spoiler and at the cylinder end to a support on the wing
rear spar.

The actuator contains a locking mechanism which locks the actuator in the retract position. The locking
mechanism consists of a spring-loaded tapered locking piston and two locking segments or keys. When the
actuator reaches the retract position, the spring-loaded piston is forced downward by hydraulic pressure. This
forces the locking segments in a radial direction into a cavity whose diameter is slightly larger than the
cylinder inside diameter, thus locking the actuator. If hydraulic pressure is lost, the spring will hold the piston
in the locked position. Directing hydraulic pressure to cause reverse actuation provides a force on the piston
greater than the spring force thus moving the piston inward. This allows the locking segments to move inward
to unlock the actuator.

Swivel joints in the hydraulic lines allow the actuators to rotate as the spoilers are raised.

No. 4 and 5 Ground Spoiler Actuators

Two identical actuators and actuator linkages are used to position each ground spoiler. The actuators are
attached at the cylinder end to a support on the wing rear spar. The actuator piston rod end is attached to the
ground spoiler actuator linkage.

The actuators for ground spoilers 4 and 5 are similar to the actuators used on ground spoilers 0, 1, 8, and 9
except the locking mechanism locks the actuator in the extend position.

No. 4 and 5 Ground Spoiler Actuator Linkage

A ground spoiler actuator linkage connects each ground spoiler actuator to the ground spoiler. The actuator
linkage consists of an idler crank and pushrod. The idler crank is pivoted in the actuator support. The
actuator piston rod end is attached to one end of the idler crank and the pushrod to the other end. The ground
spoiler is attached to the end of the pushrod.

When the actuator is retracted, the idler crank pivots pushing the pushrod to move the ground spoiler to the
raised position.

ATA-27 Page 91 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

SEE A

GROUND
SPOILER

IDLER
CRANK

PISTON
ROD END

MOUNTING
BOLT
FWD
HYDRAULIC TUBES
(2 LOCATIONS)
MOUNTING
BOLT
ACTUATOR
A

No. 4 and 5 Ground Spoiler Actuator Installation


B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-27 Page 92
and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

1 8
NO. 0 9
GROUND SPOILER
ACTUATOR (EXAMPLE)

ATA-27 Page 93 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Spoiler Control Quadrant

The spoiler control quadrant located in the floor beam space above the main wheel well provides a control
path from the first officer's control column to the ratio changer. The quadrant shaft projects through the wheel
well ceiling to connect, by two cranks, to the aileron spring cartridge and the spoiler ratio changer input rod.
The quadrant is connected by cables to the transfer mechanism at the base of the first officer's control
column. The quadrant shaft rotates on two ball bearings. The upper bearing is enclosed in a ball fitting which
incorporates a rotary air pressure seal. The lower crank, to which the aileron spring cartridge connects, is
secured to the quadrant shaft by four shear rivets.

CABLES TO
TRANSFER
MECHANISM

SEE A WHEEL WELL


FORWARD
BULKHEAD
SPOILER
CONTROL
QUADRANT

GROUND SPOILER
CONTROL VALVE
RATIO
FWD
CHANGER
INPUT ROD
SPOILER
RATIO
CHANGER

SPOILER MIXER

WHEEL WELL
CEILING

SHEAR RIVETS
(4 PLACES)

SPOILER OUTPUT
QUADRANTS

AILERON SPRING
CARTRIDGE

AILERON BUS
DRUMS

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-27 Page 94


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

THIS PAGE INTENTIONALLY LEFT BLANK

ATA-27 Page 95 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

LEADING EDGE FLAP AND SLAT CONTROL SYSTEM


Overview

High lift leading edge devices are used in combination with the trailing edge flaps to allow airplane operation
from short runways. The use of leading edge devices allows a change in wing camber which greatly increases
lift. The leading edge lift devices consist of four Krueger flaps and six slats.

Three leading edge slats are installed outboard of the engine and two leading edge flaps are installed inboard
of the engine on each wing. The slats and flaps are numbered from left to right. Leading edge slats 1 thru 6
are actuated by a three-position hydraulic actuator. If hydraulic pressure is low, a blocking valve will create a
hydraulic lock to prevent actuator movement. This locking action will hold the slat in the position at which the
loss of hydraulic pressure occurs. Each leading edge flap is actuated by a two-position hydraulic actuator.
The flap actuator will also lock in position if hydraulic pressure is low. Locking the actuators prevents
blowback of the flaps and slats if hydraulic pressure is lost during takeoff or landing. Restrictors installed in
the flap and slat actuator hydraulic pressure lines limit the actuating speed of the leading edge devices.

The leading edge flaps and slats are normally powered by hydraulic system B. A three-position spool-type
control valve is operated by the flap control unit. The control valve ports hydraulic fluid to the leading edge
flap and slat actuators. When the trailing edge flaps are between 1 and 5 units, the control valve ports
pressure to fully extend the leading edge flaps and extend all leading edge slats to the intermediate position.
When the trailing edge flaps are positioned to 10 units or more, the control valve ports pressure to fully extend
all leading edge slats.

On flap retraction, all leading edge flaps and slats remain fully extended until the trailing edge flaps are
retracted to less than 10-unit extension. Between 10 units and 5 units, all leading edge slats retract to
intermediate positions, and all leading edge flaps remain fully extended. As the trailing edge flaps move from
1 unit to fully retracted position, all leading edge flaps and slats move to the fully retracted position. Control
lever movement toward the UP detent is stopped momentarily at the 1-unit position by a gate on the flap
control quadrant.

A standby hydraulic system is provided to extend the leading edge flaps and slats in the event hydraulic
system B fails. The system is controlled by the alternate trailing edge flap switches on the overhead panel.
Actuating the switches automatically pressurizes the standby hydraulic system. Pressurized fluid from the
standby system is directed to the flap and slat actuators by a motor-operated shutoff valve in the standby
system modular package. Fluid flow to the actuators is regulated by a flow limiting valve and a hydraulic fuse.

An autoslat system is provided to automatically extend the leading edge slats from the intermediate position to
the fully extended position at a predetermined angle of attack. The slats automatically retract to the
intermediate position when the angle of attack is reduced.

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-27 Page 96


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

ATA-27 Page 97 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Leading Edge Flaps

Two Krueger-type leading edge flaps are installed on each wing. The flaps are numbered 1 thru 4. Each flap
is a machined aluminum casting containing integral ribs and stiffeners. Flaps 1 and 4 each have three
gooseneck hinges and flaps 2 and 3 each have five gooseneck hinges attached to fittings in the leading edge of
the wing. A fitting is also provided on each flap for connecting the flap to a hydraulic actuator. A seal door
and a hinged door are installed on the outboard end of flaps 1 and 4. The seal door and hinge door open to
provide space for the thrust reverser to move aft. The seal door and hinge door are spring loaded and
actuated by contact with the moving thrust reverser. A hinged tailgate is installed on the trailing edge of flaps
1 and 4 and two tailgates are installed on the trailing edge of flaps 2 and 3. A single linkage rotates the
hinged tailgate as the leading edge flap 1 and 4 extend. Three linkages rotate the two hinged tailgates as the
leading edge flaps 2 and 3 extend. Each linkage consists of two pushrods and a differential bar attached to a
bracket on the flap casting. One pushrod extends from the tailgate to the differential bar and the other
pushrod connects the bar to the fixed leading edge of the wing. When the leading edge flap retracts, the
linkage folds the tailgate inward against the flap. When the leading edge flap extends, the tailgate also
extends, allowing air to flow smoothly over the surface of the flap.

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-27 Page 98


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Leading Edge Slats

Three leading edge slats are installed on each wing outboard of the engine. The slats are numbered 1 thru 6.
The slats consist of ribs attached to a beam, inner and outer clad aluminum skins, and a honeycomb trailing
edge. A void between the inner and outer skins provides a path for thermal anti-icing. Anti-icing ducts
installed in the slat leading edge connect with hot air supply lines through a telescoping tube. A three-position
hydraulic actuator is attached at the center of all leading edge slats (1 thru 6). Each slat has two main tracks
and two auxiliary tracks which ride on rollers in the wing leading edge. A third auxiliary track is installed at
the outboard end of slats number 1 and 6. Structural stops are provided in both the extended and retracted
slat positions. The downstops are attached to the slat tracks and contact with track guides in the extended
position. The upstops consist of three adjustable plates which contact with the slat beam when the slats are
retracted. All slats (1 thru 6) are stabilized at the intermediate position by a torsion rod and support arm
assembly attached to the front spar between the auxiliary slat tracks. In the fully extended position, the
number 1 and 6 slats do not extend as far as the other four slats.

ATA-27 Page 99 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Leading Edge Flap and Slat Control Valve

A three-position control valve regulates operation of the leading edge flaps and slats. The control valve is
mounted on the trailing edge flap follow-up mechanism located in the right wheel well. The valve consists of a
sliding piston enclosed in a valve housing. Drilled passages are provided in the valve housing for a pressure
port, a return port, and two cylinder ports. A pushrod connects the control valve to the trailing edge flap
follow-up mechanism. With the trailing edge flaps retracted, the control valve slide blocks pressure to the
leading edge flap and slat actuator extend ports. When the trailing edge flaps extend to the 1- to 5-unit
position, pressurized fluid is ported through one of the cylinder ports to extend the leading edge flaps and to
extend the leading edge slats to the intermediate position. When the trailing edge flaps reach the 10-unit
position, pressurized fluid is ported through both control valve cylinder ports to fully extend all leading edge
slats.

SEE A

FLAP CONTROL
QUADRANT QUADRANT
STOP SEE C

TRAILING EDGE
FLAP CONTROL
VALVE

LEADING EDGE
SEE B FLAP AND SLAT
CONTROL VALVE

FWD
NOTE: FLAP CONTROL UNIT
SHOWN WITH LOWER
PAN REMOVED
A

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-27 Page 100
and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Leading Edge Flap Actuator

A two-position hydraulic actuator mounted on the front spar of the wing is used to extend and retract each
leading edge flap. A blocking valve will hydraulically lock the actuator pistons in position if hydraulic pressure
drops below 2000 PSI. If a loss of pressure occurs, a compression spring moves the blocking valve slide to
prevent flow of hydraulic fluid through the valve. One blocking valve is used for hydraulic system B while the
second blocking valve is used for the standby hydraulic system.

During standby hydraulic system extension, the standby blocking valve is opened by standby pressure to
pressurize both extend and retract sides of piston. Standby pressure is also applied to close the B system
blocking valve preventing loss of fluid to normal system. The actuator will remain in the fully extended
position until system B hydraulic pressure is restored.

ATA-27 Page 101 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization
and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Leading Edge Slat Actuator

A three-position hydraulic actuator mounted on the front spar of the wing is used to extend and retract leading
edge slats 1 thru 6. The three actuator positions are retracted, intermediate extension, and full extension.
Each actuator housing contains two blocking valves, an internal mechanical locking mechanism, an outer
piston, and an inner piston and rod assembly. A reed switch is installed in the actuator inner piston rod and
is actuated by movement of the locking piston within the inner rod. The actuator outer piston slides within the
actuator housing and the inner piston slides within the outer piston. The internal mechanical locking
mechanism consists of a spring-loaded piston and locking segments. The mechanism locks the actuator in the
retracted position in the absence of extend pressure. When extend pressure is applied, the locking piston
moves against spring force to retract the locking segments and allow the actuator to extend. The blocking
valves hydraulically lock the actuator pistons in position if hydraulic pressure drops below 2000 PSI. If a loss
of pressure occurs, a compression spring moves the blocking valve slide to prevent flow of hydraulic fluid
through the valve. One blocking valve is used for hydraulic system B while the second blocking valve is used
for the standby hydraulic system.

During standby system operation, the actuator blocking valves port standby hydraulic pressure to the
intermediate actuator piston and to the fully extend actuator piston. The actuator will remain in the extended
position until system B hydraulic pressure is restored.

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-27 Page 102
and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Flow Limiting Valve

A flow limiting valve is installed in the standby system hydraulic line downstream of the standby system
modular package. The valve is located on the keel beam in the left wheel well just below the standby
hydraulic system reservoir. The flow limiting valve controls the rate of standby system fluid flow to the
leading edge flap and slat actuators. At normal temperatures with a hydraulic pressure of 200 to 3000 PSI,
fluid flow to the actuators is regulated at 1.35 to 1.58 gallons per minute.

SEE A

HYDRAULIC
RESERVOIR
(REF)

LEADING EDGE FLAP


FLOW-LIMITING
VALVE

LEADING EDGE
FLAP AND SLAT
HYDRAULIC FUSE
(REF)

FWD

HYDRAULIC
PUMP (REF)

STANDBY SYSTEM

ATA-27 Page 103 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization
and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Leading Edge Standby Drive Shutoff Valve

Operation of the leading edge flap and slat alternate hydraulic system is controlled by the standby drive
shutoff valve. The motor-operated, two-position valve is contained in the standby modular package. The valve
is located on the wheel well aft bulkhead above the keel beam. The standby drive shutoff valve connects the
standby system pressure line to the leading edge flap and slat actuators. The shutoff valve is actuated by
arming the alternate flap master switch and by moving the alternate flap drive control switch to DOWN. This
positions the standby drive shutoff valve to allow standby pressure to extend the leading edge flaps and slats.
Moving the alternate flap master switch to OFF closes the standby drive shutoff valve, thus connecting the
leading edge flap and slat actuator standby pressure lines to standby return. However, the leading edge flap
and slat actuators will remain extended until system B hydraulic pressure is restored.

SEE A

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-27 Page 104
and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

POSITION INDICATING SYSTEM - LEADING EDGE FLAP AND SLAT


Overview

A position indicating system provides visible indication of the position of the leading edge flaps and slats. The
system includes system indicator lights on the center instrument panel and individual flap and slat indicator
lights on an annunciator panel in the aft overhead panel. This provides indication of normal operation on the
center panel and enables the pilots to easily determine which flap or slat is not in the proper position when
normal indications do not appear. The indicating system consists of reed switches in the slat actuator or the
bullnose, proximity sensors, a leading edge flap and slat position indication module, the pilots' indicator light
panel, and the annunciator panel.

Proximity Sensors

Proximity sensors indicate the position of each leading edge flap and slat. Each proximity sensor consists of
an induction coil and an actuating bar. Each sensor coil is connected electrically to a transistorized switch
card (switch) in the leading edge flap and slat position indication module (module). Each sensor coil is
mounted on fixed leading edge structure and each actuating bar moves with a flap or slat. When the system is
on, a constant current flow exists through each coil to ground. When an actuating bar is brought into position
adjacent to the coil, the current flow is increased and a switch in the module is triggered. Two sensor coils
are mounted adjacent to the inboard hinges of the leading edge flaps. The actuation bars are mounted on the
inboard hinges. One sensor coil is installed adjacent to each leading edge slat inboard auxiliary track and an
actuation bar is mounted on each inboard auxiliary track arm. At slats 1 thru 6, a sensor coil and actuation
bar is mounted at the middle auxiliary track.

Leading Edge Flap and Slat Position Indicator

The leading edge flap and slat position indicator provides an indication of normal flap and slat operation. The
position indicator is located on the pilots' center instrument panel and consists of an amber LE FLAPS
TRANSIT light and a green LE FLAPS EXT light. Each light includes a fuse and a press-to-test switch. The
indicators receive 28-volt DC power from the airplane lighting system. Individual lamp circuits are completed
in the transistorized control circuitry in the module.

SEE F

SEE G

SEE H

SEE H SEE G SEE F

ATA-27 Page 105 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization
and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

AUXILIARY
SLAT TRACK

PROXIMITY
SENSORS
PROXIMITY
SENSORS

FWD

A
A-A
LEADING EDGE SLAT PROXIMITY
S EN SOR NO. 1 AND 6
F

AUXILIARY
SLAT TRACK

PROXIMITY
SENSORS

PROXIMITY
SENSORS

SLAT
EXTENDED

FWD

B-B
B
LEADING EDGE SLAT PROXIMITY
SENSOR NO. 2 AND 5
G

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-27 Page 106
and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

 
AUXILIARY
SLAT TRACK

PROXIMITY
SENSORS
PROXIMITY
SENSORS

FWD

C C-C
LEADING EDGE SLAT PROXIMITY
SENSOR NO. 3 AND 4
H

2 5
1
10

UP 15 LE DEVICES
TRANSIT FLAPS TRANSIT
A 1 4 A
EXT A 2 3 A EXT
A A
G
FLAPS
25 FULL G A A G
G
FULL
EXT G A A EXT
G G G
G G
1 6
30 2 G
G G
G
5
40 3 G G
4

SLATS SLATS

TEST

LE FLAPS LE FLAPS
TRANSIT A
EXT G

CENTER INSTRUMENT PANEL. AFT OVERHEAD PANEL

Leading Edge Flap and Slat Position Indicator

ATA-27 Page 107 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization
and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Leading Edge Flap and Slat Position Indication Module

A leading edge flap and slat position indication module controls the operation of the position indicating
system. The module consists primarily of plug-in switch and logic cards in the LE DEVICES annunciator panel
light circuits, additional transistor circuits that work with the plug-in cards to control the pilots' indicating
lights, and interconnecting circuitry. The module receives 28-volt AC power from the 28-volt AC transfer bus
and 28-volt DC power from the No. 1 DC bus and provides a reduced DC voltage to the proximity sensor coils.
The module is located on equipment rack shelf E3-2.

The flap and slat position indication module with the built-in-test equipment (BITE) will help you with the
trouble shooting, test the proximity sensor, and test the system configuration.
LE DEVICES
ANNUNCIATOR
LE FLAP AND PANEL
SLAT POSITION
INDICATOR

LE FLAP AND
SLAT POSITION
INDICATION
MODULE
SEE A

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-27 Page 108
and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

 
TABLE OF CONTENTS
B737-300/400/500 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION SELF-PACED
ATA-28

FUEL SYSTEM .................................................................................................................................................... 3


Overview..................................................................................................................................................... 3
Integral Fuel Tanks .................................................................................................................................... 7
Fuel Tank Access Panels.......................................................................................................................... 10
Overwing Fill Ports................................................................................................................................... 12
Fuel Sump Drain Valves ........................................................................................................................... 12
Fuel Sump Drain Valves ........................................................................................................................... 13
Baffle Check Valves.................................................................................................................................. 16
FUEL VENT SYSTEM......................................................................................................................................... 18
Overview................................................................................................................................................... 18
Fuel Vent Float Valves .............................................................................................................................. 18
Fuel Vent Scoop........................................................................................................................................ 18
Surge Tank Flame Arrester Pressure Relief Valve.................................................................................... 20
Shroud Drain Line .................................................................................................................................... 20
CENTER TANK FUEL SCAVENGE SYSTEM........................................................................................................ 22
Overview................................................................................................................................................... 22
Fuel Scavenge Shutoff Valve .................................................................................................................... 22
Fuel Scavenge Jet Pump........................................................................................................................... 22
PRESSURE FUELING SYSTEM........................................................................................................................... 24
Overview................................................................................................................................................... 24
Fueling Shutoff Valve................................................................................................................................ 26
Fueling Receptacle.................................................................................................................................... 28
Refuel Panel ............................................................................................................................................. 30
Fueling Power Control Switch................................................................................................................... 30
Fueling Receptacle Manifold..................................................................................................................... 30
Fueling Float Switch ................................................................................................................................. 30
ENGINE FUEL FEED SYSTEM............................................................................................................................ 32
Overview................................................................................................................................................... 32
Engine Fuel Shutoff Valve......................................................................................................................... 34
Fuel Crossfeed Valve ................................................................................................................................ 35
Fuel Boost Pump...................................................................................................................................... 36
Fuel Boost Pump Bypass Valve ................................................................................................................ 38
APU Fuel Shutoff Valve ............................................................................................................................ 39
APU DC Boost Pump ................................................................................................................................ 40
DEFUELING SYSTEM......................................................................................................................................... 40
DEFUELING SYSTEM......................................................................................................................................... 41
Overview................................................................................................................................................... 41
Defueling Valve......................................................................................................................................... 42

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-28 Page 1


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

 
FUEL QUANTITY INDICATING SYSTEM ............................................................................................................ 45
Overview................................................................................................................................................... 45
Tank Unit.................................................................................................................................................. 46
Compensator Unit..................................................................................................................................... 46
Fuel Quantity Indicator ............................................................................................................................. 48
Refuel Quantity Indicaton ......................................................................................................................... 49
Fuel Summation Unit................................................................................................................................ 50
Capacitance Trimmers.............................................................................................................................. 51
FUEL FEED LOW PRESSURE INDICATING SYSTEM .......................................................................................... 54
Overview................................................................................................................................................... 54
FUEL TEMPERATURE INDICATING SYSTEM..................................................................................................... 56
Overview................................................................................................................................................... 56
Fuel Temperature Bulb ............................................................................................................................ 56
Fuel Temperature Indicator ...................................................................................................................... 56

ATA-28 Page 2 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

FUEL SYSTEM
Overview

The fuel system stores fuel and delivers fuel to the engines and APU. Additional components and controls in
the system provide rapid fueling and defueling capabilities. The tanks, lines, fittings, and operating
components in the system are compatible with all fuels meeting the engine and APU manufacturer's
specifications.

All fuel is stored within vented areas of the wings and wing center section. The fuel storage area is divided
into three integral fuel tanks that comprise a three-cavity center tank and two wing tanks (tanks No. 1 and 2).
All three tanks utilize a sealed-wing structure to retain the fuel. The center tank has a secondary fuel barrier
coating on the outer surfaces of the upper panel and front spar for additional protection against fuel leaks into
pressurized areas of the airplane.

Fuel is loaded on airplane from a ground source through a fueling receptacle in the pressure fueling station.
The tanks can be filled simultaneously or separately. Fuel can also be loaded into tanks No. 1 and 2 through
overwing fueling ports.

Electric motor-driven boost pumps and fuel lines deliver fuel from any tank to one or both engines.
Electrically-operated valves control fuel crossfeed and engine fuel shutoff. Pump and valve controls, along
with instruments and indicating lights for monitoring the system, are arranged on a system control panel
located on the forward overhead panel.

Fuel from boost pumps can also be delivered through a defueling valve into fueling manifold for removal from
the airplane.

Fuel scavenge pumps energize after the center tank is emptied by boost pumps during defueling or engine fuel
feed. The scavenge pumps reduce the quantity of unusable fuel in the center tank.

Fuel quantity indicators, in the flight compartment, and fueling quantity indicators, at the pressure fueling
station, indicate the quantity of fuel on the airplane. Measuring sticks, installed on the underside of each
integral tank, can also be used to determine fuel quantity.

Fuel feed low pressure indicating lights, on the forward overhead panel, indicate low engine boost pump outlet
pressure.

A fuel temperature indicator, (on the forward overhead panel), indicates fuel temperature in tank No. 1.

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-28 Page 3


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

 
Overview (Continued):

Fuel is delivered to the APU from tank No. 1 either through an independent fuel inlet or through a connection
to the engine fuel feed system. The engine AC boost pumps can be used to pressurize the APU fuel feed
system. A check valve in each inlet line prevents reverse flow through the inactive inlet line. An electrically-
operated shutoff valve, downstream from the inlet tee, prevents pressurization of the APU fuel line during APU
shutdown.

All fuel to be used by the engines and the auxiliary power unit is kept in the No. 1 and No. 2 tanks in the wing
and the center tank.

No. 1 and No. 2 Tanks

The No. 1 and No. 2 tanks are found in the wings between the front and rear spars from the wingtip surge
tank inboard to the tank end rib just inboard and forward of the main landing gear.

Center Tank

The center tank is found in the airplane fuselage, between LBBL 70.54, RBBL 70.59 and the extension of the
front and rear wing spar. Two beams are along the span between the No. 1 and No. 2 tank ends and supply
three cavities to keep the fuel. The three cavities are interconnected at the top and bottom of the beams along
the span by fuel flow equalizing holes.

ATA-28 Page 4 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

USABLE FUEL QUANTITY IS


5311 U.S. GALLONS

SURGE TANK

NO. 2 TANK
(1499 U.S. GALLONS)

SURGE TANK

NO. 1 TANK
CENTER TANK (1499 U.S. GALLONS)
(2313 U.S. GALLONS)

Fuel Tank Arrangement

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-28 Page 5


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

ATA-28 Page 6 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Integral Fuel Tanks

Integral fuel tanks, No. 1, No. 2, and center, keep fuel that is necessary to operate the engines and the
auxiliary power unit. A surge tank, outboard of the No. 1 and No. 2 tank, collects fuel overflow and includes
equipment to vent the fuel tanks overboard.

The fuel tanks hold the necessary equipment for the refuel operation, defueling, and engine fuel feed.
Equipment necessary for fuel quantity indicating system is also contained in the fuel tank structure.

Fuel Tank Construction

Primary wing structure is used for the airplane fuel tanks. The tanks are found between the front and rear
wing spars and between the upper and lower wing skin. Solid "tank end" ribs close the ends of each tank,
while all other wing ribs act as fuel baffles to minimize fuel slosh.

The wing structure let fuel flow inboard. Fuel sump areas are found at the lowest point of each tank. Sump
drain valves at these sump areas allow contaminants to be drained from the fuel tank. The sump drain valves
also lets all fuel that remains after a tank is defueled to be removed.

All fuel tanks are fluid tight. Close metal-to-metal fit of all parts forms the basic seal. Sealing compounds
and sealed fasteners are used on all joints to complete the fluid tight seal.

No. 1 and No. 2 Tanks

The No. 1 tank (left wing) and the No. 2 tank (right wing) are found in the interspar area of each wing. Two
of the wing ribs contain a series of baffle check valves to prevent fuel flow away from the boost pumps.

Access panels on the wing lower surface supply access to each tank. Access openings in the tank ribs are
supplied for areas not accessible directly through the access panels.

An overwing fill port, found on the upper wing surface, permits gravity-feed fueling if pressure fueling
equipment is not available.

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-28 Page 7


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

 
Center Tank

The center tank is contained in the fuselage. It is divided into three cavities by spanwise beams. The cavities
are numbered 1, 2 and 3 starting with the forward cavity. The spanwise beams contain fuel flow equalizing
holes to permit flow of fuel between the beams.

An access panel in the lower left surface of cavity No. 1 supplies access to the center tank. Man-size
openings in the spanwise beams supply access between the cavities.

The center tank has a secondary external barrier coating on the upper panel and front spar to prevent fuel
vapor from entering the pressurized section of the fuselage.

Surge Tank

A surge tank found outboard of each fuel tank in the wing contains any fuel overflow from the tanks and
supplies tank venting. A surge tank drain check valve lets the fuel overflow drain back into the center tank but
prevents fuel flow from the center tank to the surge tank.

ATA-28 Page 8 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

SURGE TANK

NO. 2 TANK

NO. 1 TANK
SURGE TANK

CENTER
TANK

Integral Fuel Tank Location

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-28 Page 9


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Fuel Tank Access Panels

Access panels permit entry into the airplane fuel tanks for inspection or component repair. The access panels
in positions No. 1 and 2 are molded aluminum honeycomb. All other wing tank access panels are cast
aluminum. The access panels are installed in the tank. The panels are installed by inserting screws through a
clamp ring on the outside, flush with wing panel and threading the screws into captive nuts in the access
panel. A molded rubber seal ring, fitted into a groove in the panel seal face, supplies a static-type fluid seal
between the access panel and the wing skin. Fuel tank access panels are electrically bonded to the wing
structure by coating the gasket and clamp ring with anticorrosion grease.

The center tank has one access panel. Each surge tank has two access panels. The No. 1 and No. 2 tanks
have 12 access panels each. In addition, two smaller panels in each wing supply access to the fuel boost
pumps.

Rib and Beam Access Openings

Access to some equipment in the fuel tanks is not directly possible through the access panels. For the wing
tanks, rib access openings are supplied for the areas either side of access panel No. 1. For the center tank,
spanwise beam access openings are supplied for access to aft cavities.

ATA-28 Page 10 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

SPANWISE BEAM
ACCESS HOLE

WING CENTER
SECTION
1 ACCESS PANEL
2 BOOST PUMP
ACCESS
3
PANEL NO. 1

NO. 1
NO. 2
FUEL TANK NO. 3
ACCESS NO. 4
PANEL NO. 1 NO. 5
NO. 6
RIB ACCESS OPENINGS NO. 7
NO. 8
NO. 9
NO. 10
NO. 11
NO. 12
NO. 13
NO. 14

BOOST PUMP
ACCESS APL
FWD PANEL NO. 2

SEE A INBD

HEX NUT

MOLDED RUBBER SEAL


ACCESS PANEL

NUT RETAINING PLUG

CLAMP RING

GASKET IMPREGNATED WITH


ANTICORROSION GREASE

PHENOLIC ANTICHAFE STRIP 1

WING LOWER SKIN

ACCESS PANEL ATTACHMENT


1 NOT INSTALLED ON MOLDED
ALUMINUM HONEYCOMB DOOR (EXAMPLE)

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-28 Page 11


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Overwing Fill Ports

An overwing fill port is supplied for No. 1 and No. 2 tanks. Each port is found on the upper wing surface. The
ports permit an alternate way of fueling the wing tanks if pressure fueling equipment is not available.

Each overwing fill port contains an adapter, seal ring, two O-rings, a retaining nut, and a quick release filler
cap. Lift and turn the handle on the filler cap in the counter-clockwise direction to unlock the filler cap. It is
then lifted from the adapter. Installation reverses the procedure and the downward turn of the handle locks
and seals the filler cap against the adapter.

OVERWING
FILL PORT
SEE A

OVERWING FILL PORT


SEE A

FILLER CAP

HANDLE

LANYARD

ADAPTER

O-RINGS

ING NUT

SEAL RING

OVERWING FILL PORT


A

ATA-28 Page 12 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

 
Fuel Sump Drain Valves

Fuel sump drain valves are installed at the low points of the fuel and surge tanks to drain accumulated
moisture or to drain trapped fuel remaining after defueling.

The sump drain valves for the No. 1 and No. 2 tank are spring-loaded closed, poppet-type valves flush-
mounted in the wing lower skin. A screen over each valve inlet protects the unit from contaminants which can
block the drain passages. The valve primary seal can be replaced without draining or entering the fuel tank by
placing the valve in the seal service position. Removal of valve assembly requires draining and entering of
tank. To drain the fuel sump, the poppet is pushed up to open the valve and let fuel drain through the drain
hole in the center of the valve.

The sump drain valve for the center tank is a spring-loaded closed, flapper-type check valve installed in the
wing lower skin in the center section. A sump drain assembly connects the valve upper housing with the lower
body section of the airplane through the keel beam area. Access to the valve is through an access door
stenciled SUMP DRAIN on the lower body section.

The sump is drained as follows:

• If the sump drain valve does not have an actuating rod, insert a broad-bladed screwdriver in slot, turn
clockwise and push up on the plunger. To close, release the plunger, let the slot align fore and aft,
and close the access door.

• If the sump drain valve has an actuating rod, pull on the actuating rod. To close, release the rod and
close the access door.

• The sump drain valves for the surge tanks are spring-loaded closed, poppet-type valves flush-mounted
in the wing lower skin. A screen over each valve inlet protects the unit from contaminants which can
block the drain passages. The valve has a flapper valve which lets the poppet assembly be removed
without draining the fuel tank. To drain a surge tank fuel sump, the poppet is pushed up to open the
valve and let fuel drain through the drain hole in the center of the valve.

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-28 Page 13


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

SUMP DRAIN VALVE


FOR THE SURGE TANK
SEE A

SUMP DRAIN VALVE


FOR THE NO. 2 TANK
SUMP DRAIN VALVE
SEE B
FOR THE SURGE TANK
SEE A

SUMP DRAIN VALVE


FOR THE NO. 1 TANK
SUMP DRAIN VALVE
SEE B FOR THE CENTER TANK
SEE C

VALVE BODY
FLAPPER
VALVE
VALVE
BODY GUIDE
SCREEN PIN
IN THE SURGE
TANK

O-RING JAMNUT

SCREEN
SPRING

POPPET WING LOWER SKIN


VALVE

SUMP DRAIN VALVE FOR THE SURGE TANK SUMP DRAIN VALVE FOR
THE NO. 1 AND NO. 2 TANK
A
B

ATA-28 Page 14 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

SUMP DRAIN FLAPPER


VALVE ASSEMBLY

LOWER WING
SKIN PANEL

PLUNGER

UPPER
HOUSING

VALVE
ACTUATING
CAM

FWD
DRAIN TUBE
ASSEMBLY DRAIN TUBE

SUMP
DRAIN
ASSEMBLY

ACTUATING ROD

ACTUATING
ROD ACCESS DOOR
SEE D

A-A
RETAINING
PLATE

SUMP DRAIN
PULL TO DRAIN.
A
A RELEASE TO CLOSE.
VERIFY THAT HANDLE
RETURNS TO CLOSED
DRAIN POSITION.
TUBE
DOOR ACCESS
LOWER BODY FASTENER
SKIN DOOR
D
SUMP DRAIN VALVE
FOR THE CENTER TANK
C

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-28 Page 15


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Baffle Check Valves

Baffle check valves are found on the bottom of wing ribs at wing buttock line 157.0, 227.0 and 557.0. The
baffle check valves prevent fuel flow in the outboard direction but permit fuel flow in the inboard direction.
Thus, the baffle check valves prevent the boost pump inlets from being uncovered and improve airplane
stability.

Each baffle check valve is a free swinging flow actuated valve. Inboard fuel flow opens the baffle check valves
and outboard flow forces the baffle check valves closed.
BAFFLE
CHECK VALVE
(5 LOCATIONS)
(WBL 157.0)
SEE A
BAFFLE
CHECK VALVE
(6 LOCATIONS)
(WBL 227.0)
SEE A

SURGE TANK

VALVE BODY
BAFFLE
CHECK VALVE
(1 LOCATION)
(WBL 557.0)
SEE A

INBD

BAFFLE CHECK VALVE


A

ATA-28 Page 16 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-28 Page 17


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

FUEL VENT SYSTEM


Overview

Air and fuel vapors flow in and out of the fuel tanks through the fuel vent system. This prevents excess
pressure or vacuum from developing within the fuel tanks. Two parallel vent channels extend into the main
and center tanks from the surge tanks. Two stringers attached to the wing upper skin form each hat section
channel. The channels open into each surge tank. The aft channel terminates near the wing root in the wing
tanks and is connected to a vent tube. The forward channel passes through the center tank and forms a
continuous channel connecting the left and right surge tanks. The center tank is vented by tubing runs
connected to the forward channel in cavity No. 2.

A vent tube is mounted to the inboard channel in tanks No. 1 and 2. In the center tank, venting tubing is
mounted to the forward channel at two places. The vent tubes provide venting when the float valves open.
Two drain check valves are installed in the center tank vent tubing to drain the tubing/channel/surge tanks.

A surge tank, located at the end of each wing, collects any overflow fuel passed through the vent channels.
The overflow fuel will flow through a surge tank drain line into the center tank vent channel and into the
center tank. A vent scoop on the wing lower surface creates a positive pressure during flight.

Fuel Vent Float Valves

A fuel vent float valve allows fuel tank venting while preventing fuel from entering the vent channels/tubing.
The valve opens and closes corresponding to the fuel level in the tanks and airplane attitude changes. As the
fuel level rises to support the float the valves begin to close. The valves close fully when fuel covers the float.
As the fuel level lowers during defueling or normal airplane attitude change, the float is exposed and the valve
begins to open. The valve opens fully when no fuel supports the float. A float stop supports the float in its
fully open position.

Tank No. 1 and 2 float valves are located in the outboard channel of the wing tanks. The center tank float
valve is in the vent tubing in cavity No. 3.

Fuel Vent Scoop

The fuel vent scoops, located in the outboard half of the vent surge tanks, are the overboard vents for the vent
system. Each scoop consists of a recessed ram air scoop mounted in a lower wing surface access panel and a
five inch standpipe assembly. The diverging walls of the standpipe act as a plenum chamber ensuring that
ram air will be applied to the vent system during all flight attitudes of the airplane. A stainless steel, cellular-
core flame arrester is installed at the top of the standpipe to suppress flame transmission into the tanks and
vent system from an external ignition source. The flame arrester also serves as a debris screen which may be
subject to airflow restriction caused by debris or severe icing conditions. A surge tank flame arrester pressure
relief valve is used to provide the necessary venting when airflow through the flame arrester is restricted.

ATA-28 Page 18 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 

 
 
 
 

and Systems
RELIEVES TRAPPED
AIR DURING FUELING

Introduction
VENT DUCT
(UPPER WING
STRINGER)
HINGE
VALVE STOP
CHECK
VALVE

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


FLOAT
CHECK
VALVES
(TYP 2
PLACES)
FLOAT VALVE
CHECK VALVE
(NORMAL VENT)
(TYP 2 PLS) UPPER SURFACE
(SEALED) VALVE STOP
STRINGER 11 VENT
CLIMB LINE
VENTS
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource

FWD

VENT FLOAT
DRAIN
SCOOP SURGE TANK HOLE
INBD GRAVITY O-RING
DRAIN LINE
CROSS-
OVER
TUBE
OVERBOARD
VENT & RAM
PRESSURE
INLET
(LWR SURF) FLOAT VALVE
(NORMAL VENTS)

FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY


DEFLECTOR

CENTER TANK
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE

UPPER SURFACE
TANK 1 (SEALED) TANK 2
STRINGER 9

SURGE TANK SURGE TANK

CHECK

ATA-28 Page 19
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Surge Tank Flame Arrester Pressure Relief Valve

A positive and negative pressure relief valve is used to bypass the fuel vent scoop for fuel system venting if
the surge tank flame arrester core cells are plugged such as from severe icing conditions. The relief valve is
installed on the access panel for the inboard half of the surge tank.

A spring-loaded poppet, on the relief valve, with outer surface flush with the wing lower skin is triggered open
through a latching mechanism by a pressure or vacuum force acting on a diaphragm. The upper chamber of
the diaphragm is vented to the atmosphere through three ambient air holes in the lower outer surface of the
valve while the lower chamber is vented to the interior of the surge tank. When the poppet opens, it is raised
about 1 inch above the wing lower skin surface which causes a manual reset knob and stem to protrude about
the same distance downward out of the center of the poppet. Once actuated open, the poppet must be
manually reset to the closed position at the conclusion of the flight. Manual reset is accomplished by pulling
reset knob downward until the poppet is relatched in the closed position. The relief valve is designed to open
at 2.0 to 2.7 PSI increasing positive pressure and -4 to -10 inches of water increasing negative pressure or
vacuum.

Shroud Drain Line

A shroud drain line is provided to prevent an accumulation of fluid from condensation or leakage in the APU
fuel line shroud. The drain line contains a flame arrester and terminates at a drain mast located in the left
wing-body fillet fairing (Fig. 2). A drain cock is provided in the wheel well to check for and drain any fluid
while on ground. The drain cock must be closed for flight.

ATA-28 Page 20 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-28 Page 21


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

CENTER TANK FUEL SCAVENGE SYSTEM


Overview

A fuel scavenge system is installed to decrease the quantity of fuel that you cannot use in the center tank by
approximately 15 gallons. A fuel scavenge shutoff valve, a fuel scavenge jet pump and a fuel scavenge flow
indicator/check valve (not installed on all airplanes) are installed on the front spar of the No. 1 tank. A fuel
scavenge transfer line goes along into the center tank. On airplanes without a fuel scavenge flow
indicator/check valve, a flapper check valve is installed on the fuel scavenge transfer line in the center tank.

Fuel Scavenge Shutoff Valve

An electrically controlled fuel scavenge shutoff valve controls the flow of fuel from the fuel boost pumps for
the No. 1 tank to the fuel scavenge jet pump to drain fuel from the center tank.

Fuel Scavenge Jet Pump

The fuel scavenge jet pump causes a low pressure in the fuel scavenge transfer line when the fuel boost
pumps for the No. 1 tank puts fuel through the fuel scavenge jet pump. The fuel scavenge jet pump drains
fuel from the center tank into the No. 1 tank.

Fuel Scavenge Flow Indicator/Check Valve (Not on all airplanes)

The fuel scavenge flow indicator/check valve has a window that you can see from out of the No. 1 tank. The
indicator needle in the blue band shows no fuel flow. The indicator needle in the green band shows usual fuel
flow. The indicator needle in the red band shows marginal fuel flow. Marginal fuel flow condition will occur
when either the center tank fuel level is below the fuel scavenge pickup (air in the fuel scavenge transfer line),
or when there is a component failure.

AIRPLANES WITHOUT FUEL SCAVENGE FLOW INDICATOR/CHECK VALVE (Fuel Scavenge Flapper
Check Valve)

The flapper check valve installed in the fuel scavenge transfer line in the center tank has a flapper gate which
prevents the transfer of fuel back into the center tank.

ATA-28 Page 22 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

 
FUEL BOOST
FUEL SCAVENGE
PUMP (REF)
FLOW INDICATOR/
CHECK VALVE
SEE A 1

FUEL SCAVENGE
JET PUMP
FUEL SCAVENGE SEE A
SHUTOFF VALVE
SEE B

ENGINE SHUTOFF
VALVE (REF)

CENTER TANK

FLAPPER
N O. 1 TA NK CHECK VALVE 2

FUEL SCAVENGE
JET PUMP

FUEL SCAVENGE
FLOW INDICATOR/
CHECK VALVE
1

FRONT SPAR

CAP
1
FWD

A
1 NOT INSTALLED ON ALL AIRPLANES
2 NOT INSTALLED ON AIRPLANES WITH FUEL
SCAVENGE FLOW INDICATOR/CHECK VALVE

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-28 Page 23


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

PRESSURE FUELING SYSTEM


Overview

The pressure fueling system supplies a fast procedure to fill the fuel tanks in the airplane.

The refuel station, which is found on the right wing leading edge, has a refuel panel, fueling receptacle
manifold, fueling power control switch, and a fueling receptacle. Three panel lights are installed to supply
lighting for the fueling bay, one on each side of the control panel, and one outboard of the fueling receptacle.

Pressure fueling shutoff valves are installed between the fueling manifold and its branch lines. The branch
lines direct fuel into each fuel tank. The pressure fueling shutoff valves control the flow of fuel from the
fueling manifold to its branch lines. A defueling valve connects the engine fuel feed manifold with the
pressure fueling manifold.

The refuel panel (P15) controls the fueling system. The refuel panel has all the switches and indicators
necessary to do the refuel operation.

Each fuel tank has a fueling float switch to supply automatic fueling shutoff when the tank is full. The refuel
quantity indicators are used to fill the fuel tanks to a predetermined level when a full fuel load is not
necessary.

ATA-28 Page 24 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE

 
B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization

AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource


 

 
 
ELECTRICAL
CONNECTION
(EXAMPLE)
THE FUELING FLOAT
CENTER TANK
ITCH FOR THE NO. 1 TANK
BOOST PUMPS
PRIME LINE

FUELING
FLOAT
SWITCH
FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY

DEFUELING VALVE
(REF 28-23-00)

CENTER FUELING RECEPTACLE


TANK FUELING MANIFOLD
SUPPLY
FUELING SHUTOFF
VALVES (3 LOCATIONS)

CENTER TANK

FUELING
FLOAT SWITCH
NO. 2 TANK
ATA-28 Page 25

and Systems Introduction


 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Fueling Shutoff Valve

Fueling shutoff valves are installed in the fueling receptacle manifold to control fuel distribution to the fuel
tanks during the refuel operation. Each valve is an electric, solenoid-actuated, shutoff valve. The fueling
shutoff valve is spring-loaded to the closed position with a manual override pushbutton. The manual override
pushbutton on the valve solenoid supplies a manual procedure to open the fueling shutoff valve when it is not
energized.

The fueling shutoff valves are operated on 28-volt DC power and are controlled by the fueling float switch
when a full tank is sensed, or by individual switches on the refuel panel for fueling control at any fuel level.
Valve position lights installed on the refuel panel come on when the valve solenoid is energized.

ATA-28 Page 26 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

FUELING
STATION
SEE A

FUELING
STATION

FWD INBD

SEE B
FUELING SHUTOFF VALVE

ELECTRICAL
PLUG

BONDING FUELING
JUMPER SHUTOFF
VALVE

ATTACHING BOLT

WASHER
0-RING WING FRONT
SPAR
BACKUP 0-RING
RINGS FUELING
MANIFOLD

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-28 Page 27


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Fueling Receptacle

A single fueling receptacle, installed on a manifold on the forward face of the wing front spar, connects the
fueling hose to the pressure fueling system. The receptacle has a fueling hose adapter connected to the
fueling receptacle manifold and a cap and a spring-loaded valve. The fueling hose adapter has mating lugs
which connect with and attach the fueling hose. When the fueling hose is connected to the fueling hose
adapter, a plunger in the hose nozzle opens the spring-loaded valve to let fuel flow into the fuel tanks.

When not in use, the fueling receptacle is covered and sealed by a cap. The cap connects to the lugs on the
fueling hose adapter like the fueling hose; when the cap is in the position, the seal in the cap is forced against
the fueling hose adapter to seal the inlet to the fueling hose adapter. To prevent loss, the cap is attached to
the fueling hose adapter with a piece of chain.

ATA-28 Page 28 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-28 Page 29


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Refuel Panel

The refuel panel (P15) is found in the fueling bay and has all the controls necessary for operation of the
pressure fueling system. Components installed on the refuel panel are refuel quantity indicators, fueling
shutoff valve switches, fueling shutoff valve OPEN indicator lights, and a fueling indicator and fueling shutoff
test switch.

The refuel quantity indicators show the fuel quantity in each fuel tank. The fuel quantity indicators are
connected to their corresponding fuel quantity indicators on the P1 panel. The indicators test switch supplies
a check to find if the fuel quantity indicators operate. If you put the switch to TEST GAGES position it will
cause the refuel quantity indicator to count down to zero and then show an error code. The test switch can be
put to AUX FUELING POWER CONTROL to bypass the fueling power control switch should it not operate.

The fueling shutoff valve switches control the operation of the fueling shutoff valves. Valve open lights
installed adjacent to the shutoff valve switches come on when the applicable fueling shutoff valve is open.

Fueling Power Control Switch

The fueling power control switch automatically supplies 28-volt DC electric power to the fueling shutoff valve
switches when the access door for the refuel station is opened. When you close the access door it removes
electric power from the valve switches which lets the fueling shutoff valves close in case the switches were
accidentally left in the valve open position after fueling. The fueling power control switch is found at the
forward, outboard corner of the refuel station and has a fixed sensor and a magnetic actuator which moves
with the hinged access door for the refuel station.

Fueling Receptacle Manifold

The fueling receptacle manifold is installed on the forward surface of the wing front spar and is the collection
and distribution center for the pressure fueling system. The fueling receptacle manifold has a cast aluminum
unit with one inlet and four outlet ports. The inlet port is connected to the fueling receptacle. The inboard
outlet port is connected to the crossfeed line and the three outboard outlet ports are connected to the fueling
lines.

Fueling Float Switch

Fueling float switches, one for each fuel tank, prevent the fuel tanks from being overfilled. During pressure
fueling, with a fueling shutoff valve switch in the OPEN position and the fuel tank less than full, the fueling
float switch closes the fueling circuit to open the fueling shutoff valve and cause the light to come on. When
the fueling float switch senses a full fuel tank, power is removed from the fueling shutoff valve. The fueling
shutoff valve closes and the valve OPEN light goes off.

ATA-28 Page 30 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

FUELING FLOAT SWITCH


FOR THE CENTER TANK
SEE C
REFUEL
STATION
FUELING FLOAT SWITCH
SEE A FOR THE NO. 2 TANK
(NO. 1 TANK OPPOSITE)
FUELING FUELING SHUTOFF
SEE B RECEPTACLE VALVE (3 LOCATIONS)
MANIFOLD

FUELING
RECEPTACLE FUELING
POWER
CONTROL
SWITCH
REFUEL PANEL
(P15 PANEL)
SEE D WING
FUELING LEADING
FLOAT EDGE
SWITCH

ACCESS
DOOR

FWD

PANEL
LIGHTS
REFUEL STATION

A
FUELING FLOAT SWITCH
B

VALVE POSITION LIGHTS


TEST
GAGES & b b b
FUELING
TANK No.2 CENTER TANK TANK No.1
TEST GAGES OPEN OPEN OPEN
OFF
CLOSED CLOSED CLOSED
AUX FUELING
POWER CONTROL

FUELING
FLOAT
SWITCH

FUELING FLOAT SWITCH FOR THE CENTER TANK REFUEL PANEL


C D

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-28 Page 31


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

ENGINE FUEL FEED SYSTEM


Overview

The fuel feed system supplies fuel to the engines and APU from the fuel tanks. For ground operations only,
the system can be used for transferring fuel from one tank to another or for defueling the tanks.

The fuel feed system consists of two boost pumps in each tank, a check valve downstream of each boost
pump, a boost pump removal valve for each boost pump, a boost pump bypass valve for tanks No. 1 and 2, an
engine fuel shutoff valve for each engine, a fuel crossfeed valve, and an APU fuel valve.

The fuel control panel, on pilot's overhead panel P5, contains the controls and indicators for the fuel feed
system. They are a boost pump control switch and low pressure indicating light for each boost pump, a fuel
shutoff valve position indicating light, filter bypass lights, a fuel temperature indicator, and a fuel crossfeed
valve switch and position indicating light.

Power for the boost pumps is 115-volts AC. The APU fuel, engine shutoff and crossfeed valves require 28-
volts DC power.

ATA-28 Page 32 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE

 
B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization

AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource


 

 
 
BOOST BOOST
PUMP PUMP

BOOST
BOOST PUMP
PUMP CENTER
P TANK P

TO ENGINE
FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY

NO. 1

TO ENGINE
NO. 2

FUEL
P P
SHUTOFF
FUEL
VALVE
SHUTOFF
VALVE

P DEFUELING
BOOST PUMP VALVE
P
FRONT SPAR BYPASS
VALVE

BOOST PUMP
APU FUEL BYPASS
CROSSFEED
SHUTOFF VALVE
VALVE
TANK 1 VALVE
TO APU
APU DC
BOOST TANK 2
PUMP

REAR SPAR
ATA-28 Page 33

and Systems Introduction


 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Engine Fuel Shutoff Valve

Two engine fuel shutoff valves mounted on the wing front spar provide the means of shutting off the fuel
supply to the engines. Each valve is an electric motor-driven slide shutoff valve with a manual override
handle. The manual override handle provides a visual check of the valve position and a manual method of
positioning the valve when the electric motor is not energized. To limit the pressure buildup in the fuel lines,
the valve housing incorporates a thermal relief valve.

The valves are operated by 28-volt DC power and are controlled by the fire switches on the aft electronics
panel and through a mechanically operated switch on the aisle stand. Whenever the engine start lever is in the
cutoff position the mechanically operated switch is actuated to close the shutoff valve. The engine fuel shutoff
valve position light is illuminated bright when valve is in transit. It is dim when valve is closed and
extinguished when valve is open.

ATA-28 Page 34 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Fuel Crossfeed Valve

The engine fuel feed lines are connected by use of the crossfeed valve. It provides the means of directing fuel
to both engines from any tank. The valve is located on the rear spar of tank No. 2. It is the same design as
the engine fuel shutoff valve.

The crossfeed valve position light is illuminated bright while valve is in transit. It is dim when valve is open
and extinguished when valve is closed.

ENGINE
NO. 2

CROSSFEED VALVE
SEE A

WING
REAR SPAR

VALVE
SEE B POSITION
INDICATOR

CROSSFEED
VALVE
INBD

CROSSFEED VALVE

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-28 Page 35


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Fuel Boost Pump

The fuel boost pumps deliver fuel under pressure from a tank to its respective engine or through the crossfeed
valve to the other engine. Each pump is a centrifugal-type pump driven by an ac motor controlled by a
separate switch on the overhead panel. Each pump is isolated from the fuel tank by being installed in a pump
housing within a tank or on the forward side of the front spar.

Fuel enters the pump through a wire mesh screen at the suction tube inlet then flows through a manually
operated pump removal valve. The pump removal valve allows removal of a pump without draining the tank.
A portion of the fuel being pumped is circulated through the pump to act as a lubricant for the bearings and a
coolant for the motor. Fuel is discharged from the pump through the boost pump check valve. A small vent
valve vents the pump casing to the fuel tank. Boost pump reprime lines prime center tank boost pumps
whenever center tank is refueled.

The low pressure lights for the boost pumps will come on if the boost pump pressure is low and the pump
switch is ON. For the boost pumps in the No. 1 tank and No. 2 tank, the low pressure lights will come on if
the boost pump switch is OFF. For the boost pumps in the center tank, the low pressure lights are off if the
boost pump switch is OFF. Thus, no low pressure lights are on during the usual part of the flight when the
center tank is empty and the boost pumps in the center tank do not operate.

Fuel Boost Pump Check Valve

The fuel boost pump check valve closes the boost pump outlet line when the pressure drops below a
predetermined amount, thus preventing reverse fuel flow to the boost pump. Main tank boost pump check
valves differ from center tank boost pump check valves as the cracking pressure for main tank boost pump
check valves is approximately 12 PSI and cracking pressure for center wing tank boost check valves is
approximately 1.3 PSI. The valve consists of a spring-loaded-closed flapper valve mounted in a housing. The
housing has three ports which comprise fuel in, fuel out and a pressure sensing port. The pressure sensing
port is located upstream of the flapper valve and is connected to the boost pump low pressure switch. The
valves are located inside the fuel tank on the wall of the boost pump housing.

Fuel Boost Pump Removal Valve

The fuel boost pump removal valve permits removing the fuel boost pump without defueling the tank. The
valves are manually operated slide shutoff valves and are located in the inlet line to each fuel boost pump. The
valve control shaft passes through the wall of the boost pump housing so that the valve may be operated from
the outside of the fuel tank.

ATA-28 Page 36 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-28 Page 37


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Fuel Boost Pump Bypass Valve

A boost pump bypass valve allows the engines to draw fuel from tank No. 1 or 2 by suction in case of
complete boost pump failure in that tank. The valve also allows defueling the tanks by suction through the
manually- operated defueling valve.

Boost pump bypass valves are located at the inboard end of tanks No. 1 and No. 2, installed in-line between
the suction inlet and the crossfeed manifold. Valves are not installed in the center tank.

With boost pump pressure applied, the bypass valve will be closed, preventing fuel in the fuel manifold from
re-entering the fuel tank. With suction applied, the bypass valve will be open, allowing the engine to draw fuel
from the tank.

ATA-28 Page 38 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

APU Fuel Shutoff Valve

The APU fuel valve is mounted on the left wing rear spar and controls delivery of fuel from tank No. 1 to the
APU. The valve is an electric motor-driven rotary gate valve with a manual override handle. The manual
override handle provides a visual check of the valve position and a manual method of positioning the valve
when the electric motor is not energized. To limit pressure buildup in the fuel lines, the valve housing
incorporates a thermal relief valve. The valve is operated by 28 -volt DC power and is controlled by the APU
master switch.

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-28 Page 39


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

APU DC Boost Pump

The APU DC boost pump supplies fuel under pressure from tank No. 1 to the APU fuel feed line as necessary
for cold starting or after air has entered the fuel feed line.

The boost pump is mounted on the left lower inboard trailing edge panel and pumps fuel through tube lines
which penetrate the left wing rear spar. The pump operates on 28-volt DC power and will run for
approximately 1 minute during APU ground or in-flight starting.

SEE A FWD APL

INBD

BONDING
ELECTRICAL JUMPER
CONNECTOR

APU DC
BOOST PUMP

OUTLET

INLET

LEFT LOWER
INBOARD TRAILING
EDGE PANEL

ATA-28 Page 40 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

 
DEFUELING SYSTEM
Overview

The fuel system is designed to permit complete or partial defueling of one or more tanks, or to permit fuel
transfer to other tanks while the airplane is on the ground. To do the defueling or fuel transfer, parts of the
pressure fueling, engine fuel feed, and defueling systems are used in combination.

The fastest defueling of one or more tanks done if you attach a fuel truck hose nozzle to the fueling station
(right wing) receptacle, put the applicable fuel system valves in position, and operate the fuel truck defueling
pumps and the respective airplane fuel tank boost pumps. Fuel remaining in the tanks (unusable, trapped)
after the pumps stop drawing fuel, is drained into containers when you open the sump drain valves.

BOOST
PUMP

BOOST
PUMP
CENTER
TANK P

TO ENGINE
NO. 2

P
FUEL
SHUTOFF
VALVE

P DEFUELING
VALVE

BOOST PUMP
BYPASS
CROSSFEED
VALVE
VALVE
TO APU
TANK 2

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-28 Page 41


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Fuel Tank Defueling

There are four different procedures that you can use to defuel the fuel tanks:

1. Defuel through the pressure fueling receptacle with the airplane boost pumps and the defueling
(suction) pump on the refuel truck. This procedure defuels all of the tanks at the same time. It is the
fastest procedure to defuel the tanks.
2. Defuel through the pressure fueling receptacle with the airplane boost pumps only.
3. Defuel through the pressure fueling receptacle with the defueling (suction) pump on the fuel truck
only. Use this procedure only if it is necessary. It is a very slow procedure.
4. Defuel through the pressure fueling receptacle with the external power control unit (PCU). You must
have special ground support equipment to do this procedure.

With pressure defueling (boost pumps operate), or with pressure and suction together, you can defuel all of
the fuel tanks to the level of the sump drain valves.

The airplane usually must have the correct attitude (0-degree roll, 0.15 degree nose down) to defuel it
correctly.

You can open and close all of the valves manually if it is necessary. To defuel with the external power control
unit, you must open and close all of the valves manually.

Defueling Valve

The defueling valve is manually operated, semi-submerged, slide-type shutoff valve which controls fuel flow
from the engine fuel feed line to the pressure fueling receptacle. It is installed on the wing front spar of the
right wing. The handle of the defueling valve is such that its access door cannot be closed while the defueling
valve is in the open position.

ATA-28 Page 42 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

 
SUMP DRAIN
SUMP DRAIN VALVE FOR THE
VALVE FOR THE NO. 1 SURGE TANK
NO. 1 MAIN TANK

SUMP DRAIN
VALVE FOR THE
CENTER TANK

DEFUELING
VALVE
SEE A

SUMP DRAIN
VALVE FOR THE
NO. 2 MAIN TANK
SUMP DRAIN
VALVE FOR THE
NO. 2 SURGE TANK

WING
FRONT
SPAR

DEFUELING
VALVE
ACTUATING HANDLE
(SHOWN IN THE
CLOSED POSITION)

DEFUELING VALVE

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-28 Page 43


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

ATA-28 Page 44 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

FUEL QUANTITY INDICATING SYSTEM


Overview

The fuel quantity indicating system measures the weight of usable fuel in the fuel tanks. Fuel quantity
indicators located on the pilots' instrument panels and at the refuel quantity indicators in the refuel station on
the wing, supply visual indication of the fuel weight in each fuel tank. In addition, a fuel summation unit
found on the first officer's auxiliary panel supplies a continuous summation signal input to an on-board
computer where it is converted to an on-demand display of combined tank total remaining fuel or is used by
the computer in various performance parameters. In the No. 1 and No. 2 tanks, five fuel measuring sticks are
supplied to find the fuel quantity of the applicable fuel tank by mechanical means.

The overall system is has a subsystem for each fuel tank, with components found in the control cabin, in the
fuel tank, and at the refuel station at the wing.

Components in the control cabin include a fuel quantity indicator and a capacitance trimmer for each fuel tank,
an indicator test switch found above the fuel quantity indicators, and a fuel summation unit.

Components at the refuel station on the wing include a refuel quantity indicator for each fuel tank and an
indicator test switch. The refuel quantity indicators repeat the fuel quantity shown by the fuel quantity
indicators in the control cabin. The refuel quantity indicators operate only when the access door for the refuel
station is open.

Fuel and refuel quantity indicators can be interchangeable.

Components in the fuel tanks include a compensator unit and a number of tank units for each fuel tank. Fuel
measuring sticks are installed in the No. 1 and No. 2 tanks. The tank units in each fuel tank are connected in
parallel and positioned so that only usable fuel is measured. Capacitance values of the tank units in each fuel
tank are added to give a single capacitance value, which is transmitted to the fuel quantity indicator.

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-28 Page 45


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Tank Unit

The tank units are cylindrical capacitors which are installed throughout each fuel tank to sense fuel level
variations and, as a result of capacitance change, transmit electrical signals to the fuel quantity indicators.
The tank units have two coaxial cylinders which are rigidly spaced at intervals throughout their length by
insulating centering spacers. The inner electrode is a variable diameter nickel alloy tube and is connected to
the amplifier input. The outer electrode is an aluminum alloy tube of constant diameter and is connected to
the excitation voltage lead. The diameter of the inner electrode is profiled to supply an output signal which is
linear with respect to the volume of fuel in the fuel tank. Openings at the ends of tank units let fuel assume
the same level between the two cylinders as that in the fuel tank.

Changes in airplane attitude can cause errors in the fuel quantity measurement. The tank units are installed
in locations in the fuel tank that keep these errors to a minimum. The large number of tank units in different
locations in the fuel tank also keeps these errors to a minimum.

Tank units are installed on the wing ribs in the No. 1 and No. 2 tanks and to the spanwise beams in the center
tank. Access to the tank units is through fuel tank access openings. Electrical connections to the tank units
are made at the tank unit terminals. Tank unit leads in a given tank, form a harness which terminates at a
receptacle. The receptacles for the No. 1 and No. 2 tanks are found in the applicable wing front spar, and for
the center tank in the left forward bulkhead in the wheel well for the main landing gear. Attached to each
receptacle is a bussing plug assembly. The plug assembly connects the tank units in parallel.

Compensator Unit

The compensator unit in each fuel tank acts as a sensing element to maintain a linear relationship between
fuel dielectric properties and fuel density. Each compensator unit has a low impedance plate and two high
impedance plates, which are protected by a mechanical shield. The compensators are attached to the same
wing structure as tank units and are installed so that they are completely submerged in fuel at all times.
Access to the compensator units is through the fuel tank access openings. Leads from the compensator units
are contained in the same harness used for the tank units

ATA-28 Page 46 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

TANK UNITS CENTER TANK


(EXAMPLE)
SEE H

COMPENSATOR
UNITS
(1 EACH TANK)
SEE H

NO. 1 TANK SHOWN


(NO. 2 TANK OPPOSITE)
ELECTRICAL
TERMINAL
UPPER WING
SKIN

FWD

COMPENSATOR
UNIT

TANK UNIT LOWER


WING SKIN

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-28 Page 47


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Fuel Quantity Indicator

Digital fuel quantity indicators show the weight of fuel and percentage of full capacity in each fuel tank. Each
fuel quantity indicator has a single chip microcomputer system and a digital liquid crystal display (LCD). The
microcomputer measures capacitive and resistive current in the tank units. The microcomputer also monitors
the leakage current and other circuit parameters. When a parameter reaches an unacceptable level, the fuel
quantity indicator shows either normal or zero fuel quantity, the word ERR, and an error code between 0 and 9.
The error code can be used to help in troubleshooting the system.

If you push the FUEL QTY TEST switch on the P1-3 panel in the flight compartment, this makes an entry of
error code 4 into the fuel quantity indicators.

To clear any stored error codes, including those stored by activating the self-test switches, cycle indicator
power from ON to OFF to ON again, with the EP GND FUELING and fuel QTY circuit breakers on the P6 panel.

QTY TEST

INDICATOR TEST SWITCH


A

CTR
FUEL

ERR

FUEL FUEL

ERR ERR

% %
FUEL QUANTITY INDICATORS
B

ATA-28 Page 48 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Refuel Quantity Indication

Refuel quantity indicators on the P15 panel show the weight of fuel in the fuel tanks. The refuel quantity
indicators help the ground crew in refuel or defueling operations. The refuel quantity indicators are
interchangeable with the fuel quantity indicators. The refuel quantity indicators operate only when the access
door for the refuel station is open. When the access door is closed, power to the refuel quantity indicators is
interrupted by a proximity switch.

The fueling quantity indicators monitor the signal received from the fuel quantity indicators and display an
error code if a system malfunction exists.

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-28 Page 49


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Fuel Summation Unit

The fuel summation unit takes the voltage signals from each fuel quantity indicator and sums them for an
output voltage signal representative of the total fuel remaining. This output signal is one of several inputs to a
flight management computer system which has a control display unit (CDU). The flight management computer
converts these inputs into a display of total fuel remaining.

FUEL
SUMMATION
UNIT
SEE A

FUEL SUMMATION UNIT


A

ATA-28 Page 50 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Capacitance Trimmers

Capacitance trimmers, found on the forward left side of the control stand above the hand mike jack, can be
adjusted to standardize the total tank capacitance. This adjustment permits replacement of fuel quantity
indicators without recalibrating the indicator itself.

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-28 Page 51


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Fuel Measuring Sticks

The fuel measuring sticks are used to measure the fuel quantity in the No. 1 and No. 2 tanks by mechanical
means. Each main tank has five fuel measuring sticks, calibrated in kilograms, found in the tank access doors
No. 1, 4, 6, 8, and 10. The fuel measuring stick unit of calibration is marked on each stick approximately 1
inch from the end.

The value on the fuel measuring stick and the applicable fuel measuring stick conversion document help the
ground crew in refuel operations when electrical power for the fuel quantity indicators is not available. The
fuel measuring sticks are also used to compare the fuel weight shown by the fuel quantity indicators to the
value shown by the fuel measuring sticks to make sure the fuel quantity indicator operates correctly.

AIRPLANES WITH THE OPEN TUBE TYPE OF FUEL MEASURING STICK (DRIPSTICKS); To operate the
fuel measuring stick, apply a slight pressure and turn the fuel measuring stick 90 degrees in the
counterclockwise direction. Slowly lower the fuel measuring stick until fuel appears from the drip hole. Read
the fuel quantity on the fuel measuring stick to find the quantity of fuel in the fuel tank.

AIRPLANES WITH THE MAGNETIC FLOAT TYPE OF FUEL MEASURING STICK; To operate the fuel
measuring stick, it is unlocked from the base by applying a slight pressure and a 90-degree counterclockwise
turn to the end of the stick. When the fuel measuring stick is unlocked, it is lowered to the fully extended
position. Depending on fuel level, a bearing found on top of the stick will magnetically latch onto a magnet in
the float before full extension. In this event, a slight pressure should be applied to assure a full extension. At
the fully extended position, the fuel measuring stick stops against a cushion giving a soft firm feel.

To find the fuel level, the fuel measuring stick is gently raised until the magnetic latch is felt to engage. There
is a positive feel in this position since the magnetic latch is strong and will jerk the fuel measuring stick into
its position. The fuel measuring stick is now read to find the fuel level in the fuel tank.

If the fuel measuring stick is being monitored during a refuel or defueling operation, the float and stick sub
assembly will move with the fuel level. However, since the magnetic attachment between the magnets of the
stick sub assembly and float causes a small friction against the housing, the stick sub assembly and float will
not move up smoothly with the fuel level, but in distinct jumps as the fuel level rises on the float to overcome
the static friction. On declining fuel levels when defueling, friction will occur in the opposite direction.
Calibration marks on the stick sub assembly are set to read on rising fuel levels and the most accurate reading
will be immediately after a jump of the stick sub assembly.

ATA-28 Page 52 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

FUEL MEASURING STICK


(IN TANK ACCESS DOORS
NO. 1,4,6,8 AND 10)
SEE I

NO. 2 TANK SHOWN


(NO. 1 TANK OPPOSITE)

CALIBRATED ROD FLAPPER


VALVE
SLEEVE

SPRING
BODY
RETAINING
SCREW

BAYONET

LOCKING
PIN

SEE J DRIP
HOLE
TANK ACCESS
DOOR

FUEL MEASURING STICK (EXAMPLE) CALIBRATION


PLANE
I
FUEL MEASURING STICK (EXAMPLE)
J

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-28 Page 53


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

FUEL FEED LOW PRESSURE INDICATING SYSTEM


Overview

The fuel feed low-pressure indicating system provides an indication when the output pressure of any fuel
boost pump falls below a preset value. The system consists of six pressure actuated switches and six indicator
lights, one for each fuel boost pump, together with connecting fuel lines. If the outlet fuel pressure of a fuel
boost pump falls to the preset value, its fuel low pressure switch will be actuated; this will illuminate the
appropriate indicator light on the overhead panel.

Fuel Feed Low Pressure Switches

Fuel feed low pressure switches control the fuel low pressure indicating lights on the overhead panel. Each
switch assembly consists of a cylindrical housing containing a diaphragm and a switch. Each switch has one
inlet port for a pressure sensing line coming from a fuel boost pump. The switch is vented to atmosphere.
The fuel feed low pressure switches are located on wing front spar.

The fuel feed low pressure indicating lights for tanks No. 1 and No. 2 will illuminate when the boost pump
output pressure drops to 5 PSI. As the pressure is increased, the indicator light will extinguish at 7 PSI.

The fuel feed low pressure indicating lights for the center tank will illuminate when the boost pump output
pressure drops to 14 PSI. As the pressure is increased, the indicator light will extinguish at 16 PSI.

ATA-28 Page 54 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

OVERHEAD PANEL
SEE A

FUEL VALVE FUEL VALVE


CLOSED B CLOSED B
0
-20 FUEL +20
TEMP

-40 +40

°C
BOOST PUMP FUEL
LOW PRESSURE SWITCHES

FILTER VALVE FILTER


SEE B
BYPASS B OPEN B BYPASS B

CROSS FEED

LOW LOW
PRESSURE PRESSURE
A A

FUEL PUMPS
OFF
L R
ON
CTR FUEL LOW PRESSURE
LOW LOW LOW LOW INDICATING LIGHTS FRONT SPAR
PRESSURE PRESSURE PRESSURE PRESSURE
A A A A

AFT FWD FWD AFT


OFF OFF
FUEL
PUMPS
ON ON
1 2

SEE D

FWD
SEE C

(LEFT WING SHOWN, RIGHT WING OPPOSITE)


B

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-28 Page 55


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

FUEL TEMPERATURE INDICATING SYSTEM


Overview

The fuel temperature indicating system allows the fuel temperature in tank No. 1 to be read on the indicator
located on the forward overhead panel. A temperature sensing bulb is located in fuel tank No. 1.

The temperature bulb contains a resistance element whose resistance varies in proportion to changes in
temperature. This element controls the current passing through the meter movement of the fuel temperature
indicator. Power is supplied to the system through 28-volt AC bus No. 2 in the P6 panel.

Fuel Temperature Bulb

The temperature bulb is an armored, bayonet locking-type bulb. It has a temperature range of -50°C to
+300°C. The bulb is contained in a housing which projects into tank No. 1 through the rear spar. The
housing is integral with the tank wall, and allows the bulb to be removed without draining the tank.

Fuel Temperature Indicator

The fuel temperature indicator, located on the P5 panel is a resistance ratio meter instrument. The indicator
is operated by the ratio of the currents through two coils in the meter movement. One of these currents is
determined by the resistance of the temperature bulb. The indicator dial is calibrated in degrees centigrade
and reads from -56°C to +56°C. With power off, the pointer remains off scale at the low temperature end.

ATA-28 Page 56 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

FUEL VALVE FUEL VALVE


C L O S E DB C L O S E DB
0
- 2 0 F U E L+ 2 0
TEMP
FUEL TEMPERATURE
-40 +40
TANK NO. 1
INDICATOR

°C

FILTER VALVE FILTER


B Y P A S SA OPEN B B Y P A S SA

CROSS FEED

FORWARD OVERHEAD PANEL

FUEL
TEMPERATURE
BULB
SEE A

WING REAR SPAR


FUEL TANK NO. 1
TEMPERATURE
BULB LEADS

TEMPERATURE BULB
LOCKING CAP

FUEL TEMPERATURE
BULB (SHOWN IN
INSTALLED POSITION -
BULB NOT VISIBLE)

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-28 Page 57


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

 
TABLE OF CONTENTS
B737-300/400/500 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION SELF-PACED
ATA-29

HYDRAULIC POWER ............................................................................................................................................ 3


Overview..................................................................................................................................................... 3
HYDRAULIC SYSTEMS A, B, AND STANDBY ..................................................................................................... 7
Overview..................................................................................................................................................... 7
Engine Driven Pump (EDP) ...................................................................................................................... 12
Electric Motor-Driven Pump (EMDP)........................................................................................................ 13
Standby Electric Motor-Driven Pump (EMDP).......................................................................................... 14
Hydraulic Reservoir .................................................................................................................................. 15
Return Filter Module................................................................................................................................. 18
System Pressure Module.......................................................................................................................... 20
Case Drain Filters..................................................................................................................................... 22
EDP Supply Shutoff Valve......................................................................................................................... 23
Heat Exchanger......................................................................................................................................... 24
Ground Service Disconnect....................................................................................................................... 25
Hydraulic Control Panels .......................................................................................................................... 26
SERVICING HYDRAULIC RESERVOIR ................................................................................................................. 27
Access Location Zones: Right Main Wheel Well ...................................................................................... 27
POWER TRANSFER UNIT (PTU) - HYDRAULIC ................................................................................................. 30
Overview................................................................................................................................................... 30
Power Transfer Unit (PTU) ...................................................................................................................... 31
PTU Pressure Filter Module ..................................................................................................................... 31
PTU Control Valve .................................................................................................................................... 32
EDP Pressure Switch................................................................................................................................ 33
HYDRAULIC PRESSURE INDICATING SYSTEM ................................................................................................. 34
Overview................................................................................................................................................... 34
System Pressure Transmitter................................................................................................................... 34
System Pressure Indicator ....................................................................................................................... 34
HYDRAULIC FLUID OVERHEAT WARNING SYSTEM .......................................................................................... 36
Overview................................................................................................................................................... 36
Overheat Lights ........................................................................................................................................ 36
Overheat Light Temperature Switches...................................................................................................... 36
HYDRAULIC FLUID QUANTITY INDICATING SYSTEM....................................................................................... 38
Overview................................................................................................................................................... 38
Fluid Quantity Transmitters and Indicators.............................................................................................. 38
Standby Low Quantity Switch................................................................................................................... 38
PUMP LOW PRESSURE WARNING SYSTEM...................................................................................................... 40
Overview................................................................................................................................................... 40

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-29 Page 1


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

ATA-29 Page 2 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

HYDRAULIC POWER
Overview

Three separate hydraulic systems provide fluid at 3000 PSI to operate the airplane systems. The hydraulic
systems are identified as system A, system B and standby.

The standby hydraulic system provides reserve power for critical systems, a ground servicing system fills all
hydraulic reservoirs from one location, The indicating systems provide information for crew monitoring of the
operating conditions of each hydraulic system.

Main Hydraulic Systems

The A and B system components are located on each engine and within the main gear wheel well forward
section. The pressure source for each of the A and B systems consists of one engine driven pump (EDP) and
one electric motor driven pump (EMDP). The EDP is directly coupled to the engine accessory gearbox and
runs all the time that the engine is running. When an ELEC pump switch is ON, the respective EMDP runs all
the time.

Each hydraulic system has a fluid reservoir which is pressurized by air from the pneumatic system. Filter
modules clean the fluid after being pressurized or after passing through the pump case drain and after
returning from user systems. Heat exchangers in the fuel tanks cool the pump case drain fluid before it
returns to the reservoir.

Ground hydraulic power connections are provided on the aft bulkhead of the left and right air conditioning
bays.

Standby Hydraulic System

The standby system components are located on the keel beam in the main gear wheel well. The pressure
source for the standby system is an electric motor driven pump (EMDP). The standby EMDP is turned on
automatically if system A or B fails during takeoff or landing, or it can be turned on manually by operating the
FLT CONTROL A, FLT CONTROL B, or the ALTERNATE FLAPS switches on the overhead flight control panel
P5.

Power Transfer Unit

The power transfer unit (PTU) is located on the keel beam just forward of the standby reservoir. The PTU
operates if system B EDP pressure is lost, flaps are not up but less than 15° and airplane is in the air. The
PTU consists of a hydraulic motor connected to a hydraulic pump. The motor is driven by system A hydraulic
pressure and the pump supplies pressure to the leading edge devices using system B hydraulic fluid. There is
no fluid interchange between the A and B hydraulic systems.

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-29 Page 3


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Ground Servicing System

A central ground servicing station is located in the right main gear wheel well on the lower outboard forward
bulkhead. Hydraulic fluid is added to the reservoirs of all three systems from this station. A fill valve selects
which reservoir(s) will receive fluid. Port A selects system A reservoir. Port B selects the standby and
system B reservoirs. Quantity indicators at systems A and B reservoirs show fluid level. Fluid can be added
under pressure from a ground service cart or with the manual fill pump installed at the servicing station.

Indicating Systems

The indicating system consists of warning lights and gages located in the wheel well and on cockpit panels.
Fluid pressure, temperature (overheat) and reservoir quantity are monitored in the cockpit while reservoir
quantity and pressure are indicated in the wheel well.

ATA-29 Page 4 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

RESERVOIR
PRESS MOD FROM
PNEU
SYSTEM A SYSTEM (2 PLACES) SYSTEM B
STANDBY
SYSTEM
RESERVOIR
BALANCE LINE
FILL SELECT
VALVE
RESERVOIR RESERVOIR
RESERVOIR

EMDP EDP EMDP EDP EMDP


POWER
TRANSFER
UNIT
MOTOR PUMP
SYS
SYS PRESS SYS
PRESS MOD PRESS
MOD MOD
CV
STANDBY
RUDDER

RUDDER

LEADING
RIGHT EDGE
THRUST SLATS/FLAPS
REVERSER SV

LEFT
SV THRUST
REVERSER

LANDING
GEAR TRFR
FLT VALVE FLT
SPOILERS CV SPOILERS
3 & 6 MAIN 2 & 7
GEAR
GRD
TRAILING
SPOILERS PV
NOSE GEAR EDGE FLAPS
(0,1,4,5,8,9)
& STEERING
A
ALT BRAKES
BRAKES ALT BRAKE
SELECTOR
VALVE
CV CONTROL VALVE
PV PRIORITY VALVE AILERONS
SV SHUTTLE VALVE
AUTOPILOT
CHECK VALVE

A ACCUMULATOR ELEVATOR
& ELEV
FLOW RESTRICTOR FEEL

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-29 Page 5


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

ATA-29 Page 6 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

HYDRAULIC SYSTEMS A, B, AND STANDBY


Overview

The main hydraulic system consists of systems A and B. The auxiliary hydraulic system is the standby
system. These systems provide fluid under pressure of 3000 PSI to the flight control, auto flight, landing gear,
and thrust reverser systems.

Each system contains a reservoir, pump(s), pressure module, and appropriate filters. Systems A and B also
have heat exchangers to cool system fluid.

The pressure sources for systems A and B are one engine driven pump (EDP) and one electric motor-driven
pump (EMDP) installed in parallel. The EDP runs all the time that the engine is running. When the ELEC
pump switch is ON, the EMDP runs all the time.

Systems A and B operate in the same manner. The system reservoir supplies fluid under pneumatic pressure
to the pumps. Fluid flows directly to the EMDP, and through the shutoff valve to the EDP. The output of the
pumps flows through filters in the system pressure modules before going to the operating systems. Return
fluid from the operating systems flows through a filter in the return module before entering the reservoir.

If system pressure becomes too high, a pressure relief valve in the system A and B filter modules opens to
route fluid to the system return line.

Fluid flows through the EMDP and EDP cases for cooling and lubrication. This case drain fluid is filtered by
the EMDP or EDP case drain filters and is cooled by the system heat exchanger before its return to the system
reservoir.

The ENG 1 and ENG 2 pump select switch on the hydraulic control panel (P5) controls the on/off condition of
the respective system A or B EDP. With the switch in the ON position, the depressurization valve is de-
energized and the pump outlet port is open. The pump supplies fluid flow as demanded by the operating
systems. Placing the switch in the OFF position energizes the valve to block fluid flow from the pump. The
only output is the case drain flow for pump cooling and lubrication. Pulling the engine fire switch on the aft
electronic control panel P8 to the FIRE position closes the EDP supply shutoff valve to block fluid flow to the
pump.

If system B EDP hydraulic power is lost, the PTU pressure switch senses the loss of hydraulic pressure and
causes system A to drive the power transfer unit (PTU) to provide system B pressure for operation of leading
edge flaps/slats.

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-29 Page 7


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

 
Standby System

The pressure source for the standby system is one EMDP.

The standby system reservoir supplies fluid under pneumatic pressure to the EMDP. The pneumatic pressure
is provided through the balance line from system B reservoir. The output of the pump flows through a filter in
the standby system pressure module before going to the operating systems. Fluid from the operating systems
returns directly to the reservoir.

If system pressure becomes too high, a pressure relief valve in the system pressure module opens to allow
fluid to return to the standby reservoir.

Fluid flows through the case of the EMDP for pump cooling and lubrication. This case drain fluid is filtered by
the case drain filter and returned directly to the standby system reservoir.

The standby hydraulic pump relay is of dual coil construction, reacting to the power sensing relay to provide
115-volt, 400 Hz, three phase power to the EMDP from generator 1, or from generator 2 if generator 1 fails.

The standby EMDP runs when:

1. The FLT CONTROL A switch is positioned to STDBY RUD, or

2. The FLT CONTROL B switch is positioned to STDBY RUD, or

3. The ALTERNATE FLAPS switch is positioned to ARM, or

4. Automatically, with the following conditions:

a. Either FLT CONTROL A or FLT CONTROL B switch positioned to ON, and

b. Either flight control A or flight control B low pressure switch activated (low pressure in
system), and

c. A wheel speed of greater than 60 knots, or an AIR mode at AIR SENSING relay (R278, E-11
panel), and

d. Flaps not up

ATA-29 Page 8 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE

 
B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization

AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource


 

 
 
2
TO B
RETURN
AIR
PRESSURE
RDV GAGE
RESERVOIR POWER TRANSFER
PRESSURIZATION FROM B UNIT
MODULE RESERVOIR PUMP MOTOR ALTERNATE
BRAKE
SELECTOR TO
B VALVE BRAKES
TO LEADING PRESS
EDGE DEVICES
GROUND SERVICE
DISCONNECT
QUANTITY GROUND
TRANSMITTER SPOILERS

RESERVOIR

LANDING GEAR
TRANSFER
OVERHEAT OVERHEAT VALVE B
B
FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY

RETURN
LOW LOW LOW LOW PRESS
PRESSURE PRESSURE PRESSURE PRESSURE

LANDING GEAR
ENG 1 ELEC 2 ELEC 1 ENG 2 SYS AND NOSE WHEEL
PRESS STEERING
ON ON TRANS

OFF OFF
A HYD PUMPS B FLIGHT AILERONS AND
CONTROL MODULE AUTOPILOT B
1 B RETURN
PRESS

3 1
__ EMDP EDP
3
__
HYD SYS 2
4
ELEVATOR AND
1
__
PRESS 4 HYD QTY RFL ELEVATOR FEEL
4 B
B AND AUTOPILOT
RETURN
LOW PRESS
0 F RETURN FILTER MODULE
PSI X 1000 SYS A PRESS
E
SWITCH
1
LOW
RUDDER
PRESS B
SWITCH B RETURN
PRESS
OVHT DET WHEEL
WELL FLIGHT
A B SPOILERS
3 AND 6
FAULT
NORMAL DISCH

ENG 1 L R SYSTEM PRESSURE MODULE


APU DET
OVERHEAT REF FIG. 20 FOR
INOP FUEL LEFT THRUST
SYMBOL DEFINITION
REVERSER STBY
F TEST STBY
I O F APU BOTTLE HEAT RETURN
A 1 AIRPLANES WITHOUT ENGINE PRESS
N V I DISCHARGE EXCHANGER
U INSTRUMENT SYSTEM
O H R
L
T
P T E r 2 AIRPLANES WITH ENGINE
INSTRUMENT SYSTEM

Hydraulic System A
ATA-29 Page 9

and Systems Introduction


B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE

 
ATA-29 Page 10
 

 
 
RESERVOIR POWER TRANSFER
PRESSURE TO A
UNIT
RDV GAGE RETURN
RESERVOIR PUMP MOTOR
PRESSURIZATION
MODULE
A PRESS
BRAKES

TO STBY 3
RESORVOIR

TRAILING EDGE
FLAPS
TO LEADING
EDGE DEVICES
QUANTITY
TRANS-
MITTER
LANDING GEAR
FUEL TRANSFER
OVERHEAT OVERHEAT A
VALVE A
FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY

HEAT PRESS
RETURN
LOW LOW LOW LOW EXCHANGER 2
PRESSURE PRESSURE PRESSURE PRESSURE

OVERHEAT LANDING GEAR


ENG 1 ELEC 2 ELEC 1 ENG 2 AND NOSEWHEEL
SWITCH
STEERING
ON ON 1
A

OFF OFF FLIGHT


A HYD PUMPS B A CONTROL MODULE AILERONS
AND AUTOPILOT A
1 1 A RETURN
PRESS

AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource


3 1
__ EMDP EDP
3
__
HYD SYS 2 ELEVATOR AND
1
__ 4 ELEVATOR FEEL
PRESS 4 HYD QTY RFL
4 AND AUTOPILOT A
TO PTU A RETURN
C.V. PRESS
0 F RETURN FILTER MODULE
PSI X 1000 SYS B
E
1 LOW
RUDDER
PRESS A
SWITCH A RETURN
LOW PRESS
B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization

PRESS
OVHT DET SWITCH
L BOTTLE R BOTTLE
DISCHARGE DISCHARGE FLIGHT
A B SPOILERS
ENGINES 2 AND 7
NORMAL DISCH E T
X E
1 2 SYSTEM PRESSURE MODULE
ENG 2 L R T S
OVERHEAT T
R RIGHT THRUST
1 AIRPLANES WITH T-FITTING AND CHECK VALVE REVERSER
L REF FIG. 20 FOR UPSTREAM OF OVERHEAT SWITCH STBY STBY
FIRE SWITCHES
SYMBOL DEFINITION PRESS RETURN
(FUEL SHUTOFF) 2 ALL EXCEPT 1
PULL WHEN ILLUMINATED
LOCK OVERRIDE: PRESS 3 CHECK VALVE LOCATIONS ARE DIFFERENT FOR GROUND SERVICE
BUTTON UNDER HANDLE APU DIFFERENT AIRPLANE CONFIGURATIONS (AMM 29-22-00/001) DISCONNECT

Hydraulic System B

and Systems Introduction


B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE

 
B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization

AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource


 

 
 
FLT CONTROL STANDBY
A B HYD
LOW
QUANTITY
A ON B ON
LOW
OFF OFF PRESSURE

STDBY STDBY
RUD RUD
ALTERNATE FLAPS FROM GROUND
ARM
UP
SERVICING QUANTITY
LOW LOW
PRESSURE PRESSURE STATION TRANSMITTER
OFF

P5 OFF
DOWN

BALANCE LINE STANDBY


TO SYSTEM B RESERVOIR
RESERVOIR

STANDBY PRESSURE MODULE


FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY

CASE
DRAIN
FILTER

STANDBY 2
EMDP
TO LEADING
EDGE DEVICES

STANDBY
RUDDER

PRESSURE
FILTER

1 PRESSURE
TO LEFT SWITCH TO RIGHT
THRUST THRUST
REVERSER REVERSER

1 NOT ON ALL APLS


2 ON SOME AIRPLANES,
THE ORDER OF THE
REF. FIG. 20 FOR FLOW LIMITER AND
SYMBOL DEFINITION THE FUSE IS DIFFERENT.

Standby Hydraulic System


ATA-29 Page 11

and Systems Introduction


 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Engine Driven Pump (EDP)

The engine driven pumps (EDP) are one of the two pressure sources for each of the A and B hydraulic
systems. An EDP supplies about 22 GPM at 3000 PSI through a variable displacement pump mounted on the
lower left side of the engine. The EDP is driven through a splined shaft by the engine accessory drive gearbox.
A barrel cylinder containing nine pistons is revolved adjacent to a cam plate (and yoke) holding the piston
shoes in a cam track. As the pistons reciprocate traveling in the cam track, they are forced to discharge fluid
at working pressure. This pressure is sensed by a compensator piston calibrated to drive the yoke (cam plate)
to a ramp angle which will maintain a supply of approximately 22 GPM at 3000 PSI. The pump also moves
fluid through its case to lubricate and cool the pump. A case drain port directs this fluid to a heat exchanger
in the fuel tank before returning to the reservoir.

The output of the EDP can be shut off by a depressurization valve on the pump. This valve closes the pump
outlet port when the engine pump switch on the hydraulic control panel is moved to OFF.

The supply line to the EDP is shut off by the EDP supply shut off valve when the engine fire switch is pulled to
the FIRE position.

MOUNTING
PAD

QAD
SEE A 1 CLAMP

CASE
PUMP DRAIN
DEPRESSURIZATION LINE
VALVE

ELECTRICAL
CONNECTOR

PRESSURE
LINE

SUPPLY
FWD
LINE

VICKERS EDP

A
1 NO. 1 ENGINE SHOWN
NO. 2 ENGINE SIMILAR

ATA-29 Page 12 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Electric Motor-Driven Pump (EMDP)

Systems A and B each have one EMDP. An EMDP supplies 6.0 GPM at 2700 PSI to each A and B hydraulic
system. Each pump assembly is composed of an oil-cooled three phase 115-volt AC motor, a centrifugal pump
and a single stage, variable displacement, pressure-compensated hydraulic pump. The pump assemblies are
attached on vibration absorbing mounts and are located in left and right forward wheel well area. They are
controlled by switches on the P5 panel. The hydraulic fluid enters the pump by way of the electric motor
housing providing cooling to the rotor and stator assemblies, before entering the centrifugal boost cavity.
From the centrifugal boost pump, the fluid is driven into a pump already described as very similar to the EDP.

An acoustic filter is fitted in the pressure line of each EMDP to suppress the noise and vibration of pump
operation.

SYSTEM A EMDP
SEE A

FWD

SYSTEM B EMDP
SEE A
KEEL BEAM (REF)
CASE DRAIN LINE
WHEEL WELL VICKERS EMDP
SUPPLY LINE

PRESSURE LINE

ACOUSTIC FILTER

ELECTRICAL
CONNECTOR
1 SYSTEM B EMDP SHOWN
SYSTEM A EMDP SIMILAR
2 AIRPLANES WITH VICKERS PUMPS
A 1 2

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-29 Page 13


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Standby Electric Motor-Driven Pump (EMDP)

The motor/pump assembly is mounted behind the standby reservoir on the keel beam.

The standby EMDP supplies a maximum of 3 GPM regulated to a nominal 3000 PSI. The pump is a variable
delivery, positive displacement pump driven by a 3-phase, 115-volt motor and controlled by 28-volt DC relays.

A compensator within the pump reacts to discharge pressures and varies the ratio of fluid delivered to the
system to fluid recirculated within the pump. Case drain fluid for cooling and lubrication is discharged to the
return line through piston bypass holes.

MOTOR

SUPPLY LINE

ELECTRICAL
CONNECTION

PRESSURE
LINE

PUMP
KEEL BEAM
CASE
DRAIN FWD
LINE

ATA-29 Page 14 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Hydraulic Reservoir

The hydraulic reservoir for each system supplies hydraulic fluid for the flow demands of the user systems.
The reservoirs for systems A and B are in the center and right main wheel wells, respectively. The standby
system reservoir is mounted on the keel beam between the wheel wells and is attached by a balance line to
the system B reservoir. The balance line permits filling and pressurizing the standby and system B reservoirs.

The three reservoirs are round tanks of the same design but of different size. The system A reservoir holds
4.8 U.S. gallons; the system B reservoir holds 7.2 U.S. gallons; and the standby system reservoir holds 2.8 U.S.
gallons. The reservoirs are pressurized to approximately 45 PSI by the pneumatic system to assure a supply
of fluid to the pumps, to prevent fluid foaming, and to maintain normal return pressure in the hydraulic
system.

Systems A and B reservoirs have a quantity indicator/transmitter on the reservoir, and a quantity indicator at
the P3 panel. Systems A and B reservoirs also have overpressure relief, depressurization, and drain sampling
valves connected to them.

The standby reservoir has a low quantity switch on the reservoir and a light on the P5 panel.

A pressure relief valve is near the top of systems A and B reservoirs. The pressure relief valve opens under
high air or fluid pressure (60 to 65 PSI) to protect the reservoir. The drain/sampling valve is a manual valve
at the bottom of the reservoir.

A common vent line is connected between the systems A and B reservoir pressure relief valves to allow
venting of fluid residue and to prevent fluid backflow into the pneumatic system.

On airplanes not incorporating SB 29-1061, fluid residue from the systems A and B reservoirs is vented in the
wheel well.

On airplanes incorporating SB 29-1061, fluid residue from the systems A and B reservoirs is vented through an
overboard drain mast.

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-29 Page 15


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

 
SYSTEM A
RESERVOIR
SEE A
FORWARD
BULKHEAD (REF)
SYSTEM B
RESERVOIR
SEE B
STANDBY
RESERVOIR
SEE C

FWD

KEEL BEAM (REF)

VENT RESERVOIR PRESSURE


LINE RELIEF VALVE

FROM RESERVOIR
PRESSURIZATION
MODULE

QUANTITY
INDICATOR/
TRANSMITTER

FILL LINE

RETURN LINE

DRAIN/SAMPLING VALVE

EMDP SUPPLY LINE


EDP SUPPLY LINE

POWER TRANSFER
UNIT SUPPLY LINE
SYSTEM B RESERVOIR
B

ATA-29 Page 16 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

 
VENT
LINE
RESERVOIR PRESSURE
RELIEF VALVE

FROM RESERVOIR
PRESSURIZATION
MODULE

QUANTITY
INDICATOR/
TRANSMITTER

RETURN AND
FILL LINE

DRAIN/SAMPLING VALVE
EDP SUPPLY LINE
EMDP SUPPLY LINE

SYSTEM A RESERVOIR
A

BALANCE LINE
TO SYSTEM B
RESERVOIR
LOW QUANTITY
SWITCH

FROM FLUID
FILLING
STATION

RETURN LINE

STANDBY EMDP
SUPPLY LINE

STANDBY RESERVOIR

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-29 Page 17


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Return Filter Module

The return filter module in systems A and B filters fluid returning from the user systems to the respective
reservoir. Systems A and B return filter modules are in the wheel well on the lower left and right forward
bulkhead, respectively. The standby system fluid filtration is through the standby system pressure filter
module on the aft center bulkhead.

Each return filter module includes a throw-away filter. A red indicator button mounted on the module reacts to
a differential pressure of 65 ±8 PSI, and pops up to show when the filter is blocked. An internal by-pass valve
routes fluid around a blocked filter. A spring-loaded shutoff poppet in the module prevents fluid loss when the
filter element is removed. Check valves prevent backflow through the filter.

SYSTEM A
RETURN FILTER MODULE
SEE B
SYSTEM A
RESERVOIR (REF)

SYSTEM B
RESERVOIR (REF)

SYSTEM B
RETURN FILTER MODULE
SEE C

FWD

ATA-29 Page 18 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-29 Page 19


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

System Pressure Module

Each system pressure module filters fluid under pressure from its respective pumps.

Systems A and B modules each include two throw-away filters, one for fluid from each pump.

Each system A and B module contains two pump low pressure switches. The module also has two check
valves and the system pressure relief valve.

The standby system pressure module includes two manual/electric motor operated shutoff valves and a
replaceable filter.

SYSTEM A
PRESSURE MODULE
SEE A

STANDBY SYSTEM
PRESSURE MODULE
SEE C

FWD

KEEL BEAM (REF) SYSTEM B


PRESSURE MODULE
SEE B
WHEEL WELL
TO ENGINE NO. 1
THRUST REVERSER
TO SYSTEM PRESSURE
TRANSMITTER
EDP LOW PRESSURE SWITCH
TO FLIGHT CONTROL MODULE

TO ENGINE NO. 1 EMDP LOW PRESSURE SWITCH


THRUST REVERSER
TO ALTERNATE BRAKE SOURCE
SELECTOR VALVE AND
SPOILER CONTROL VALVE
FROM EDP (NOT SHOWN)

EDP CHECK VALVE

EMDP CHECK VALVE

EDP PRESSURE FILTER

FROM FLIGHT CONTROL MODULE TO LANDING GEAR


(NOT SHOWN) TRANSFER VALVE
EMDP PRESSURE FILTER FROM EMDP
TO RETURN FILTER MODULE
FROM PTU TO PTU FWD

ATA-29 Page 20 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

 
TO LEADING EDGE DEVICES,
BRAKES, AND FLAP PRIORITY VALVE

EMDP LOW PRESSURE SWITCH

TO SYSTEM PRESSURE
TRANSMITTER
EDP LOW PRESSURE SWITCH

O ENGINE NO. 2 THRUST TO ENGINE NO. 2 THRUST


EVERSER AND LANDING REVERSER AND PTU
EAR TRANSFER VALVE PRESSURE SWITCH

FROM EMDP (NOT SHOWN)

EMDP CHECK VALVE

FROM EDP
EDP CHECK VALVE

EMDP PRESSURE FILTER

TO FLIGHT CONTROL MODULE


TO RETURN FILTER MODULE
EDP PRESSURE FILTER
FWD

LEADING EDGE DEVICES


MOTOR-OPERATED SHUTOFF VALVE STANDBY RUDDER
MOTOR-OPERATED SHUTOFF VALVE

TO THRUST REVERSERS TO STANDBY RUDDER


STANDBY SYSTEM
RETURN LINE
LOW PRESSURE
SENSOR
FROM STANDBY EMDP
TO LEADING
EDGE DEVICES SELF-SEALING
DISCONNECT

STANDBY PRESSURE
FILTER

REAR BULKHEAD
WHEEL WELL (REF)

RETURN LINE
TO RESERVOIR
UP
FROM STANDBY STANDBY CASE DRAIN
FILTER MODULE (REF) FWD
EMDP CASE DRAIN

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-29 Page 21


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Case Drain Filters

Each EDP and EMDP deliver case drain fluid to separate throw-away filters placed in the line leading from the
pump. The EDP case drain filters are in their respective left and right wing trailing edges, just forward of the
number 4 and 5 spoilers. The systems A and B EMDP case drain filters are mounted directly beneath their
respective EMDP on the left and right wheel well forward wall. The standby EMDP case drain filter is on the
forward wall of the aft wheel well bulkhead. A thermal switch is installed in each system A and B EMDP case
drain line en route to the filter. The included overheat light is on the P5 panel. A check valve is located at
each case drain filter outflow.

ATA-29 Page 22 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

EDP Supply Shutoff Valve

The supply shutoff valve controls fluid supply to the EDP and is normally in the open position. The valve is
operated by a 28-volt DC motor which is controlled by the engine fire switch. A position indicator on the valve
provides a valve CLOSED or OPEN indication. The valve is installed in the EDP supply line in the fairing area
on the aft side of the wheel well forward bulkhead.

SEE A

EDP SUPPLY
SHUTOFF
VALVE
(TYPICAL)

OVHT DET WHEEL BELL CUTOUT OVHT DET


L BOTTLE R BOTTLE
WELL DISCHARGE DISCHARGE
A B A B

FAULT
ENGINES
DISCH DISCH DISCH E T
NORMAL NORMAL
X E
1 2
ENG 1 L R APU DET ENG 2 L R T S
OVERHEAT OVERHEAT T
INOP R

TEST L
F APU BOTTLE FIRE SWITCHES
I O F
A (FUEL SHUTOFF)
N V I DISCHARGE
U PULL WHEN ILLUMINATED
O H R LOCK OVERRIDE: PRESS
L
P T E BUTTON UNDER HANDLE
T APU

P8

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-29 Page 23


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Heat Exchanger

Separate heat exchangers for systems A and B cool pump case drain fluid as the fluid returns to the reservoir.
The two heat exchangers are composed of coils of finned aluminum tubing located in the wing fuel tanks using
fuel as a coolant. The system heat exchangers are at the inboard end of the left and right main fuel tanks,
respectively. The standby system is not fitted with a heat exchanger. A minimum of 250 gallons (1675
pounds/761 kilograms) of fuel is required in each main tank to provide hydraulic fluid cooling.

ATA-29 Page 24 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Ground Service Disconnect

Hydraulic systems A and B can each be pressurized from a hydraulic test bench that is connected to the
ground service disconnects. Systems A and B disconnects are located on the aft wall of the respective left and
right air conditioning bays, forward of the wheel well forward bulkhead. At each location are quick-
disconnects for pressure and return lines, and a filter containing a replaceable element. Each connector is
fitted with a dust cover and retaining chain.

AIR CONDITIONING BAY


(TYPICAL)

SEE A

AFT BULKHEAD,
AIR CONDITIONING BAY
PRESSURE TO
AIRPLANE SYSTEMS

GROUND SERVICE
DISCONNECT MODULE

PRESSURE CONNECTION

RETURN CONNECTION

RETURN FLUID
FROM SYSTEMS FILTER
BOWL FWD

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-29 Page 25


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Hydraulic Control Panels

The control panels are on the P5 panel and contain the pump select switches and system warning lights.

The pump select switch for each EDP and EMDP is an ON/OFF toggle type and is accompanied by a pump low
pressure light. EMDP case drain fluid overheat lights are also mounted.

The P5 panel has warning lights for low pressure and low fluid quantity in the standby system.

FLT CONTROL STANDBY


A B HYD
LOW
QUANTITY
A ON B ON
LOW
PRESSURE
OFF OFF
STDBY STDBY
RUD RUD
ALTERNATE FLAPS
ARM
UP
LOW LOW
PRESSUREPRESSURE
OFF

SPOILER
DOWN
A B OFF

ON ON
FEEL DIFF
PRESS
OFF OFF
SPEED TRIM
FAIL
MACH TRIM
YAW DAMPER FAIL
YAW AUTO SLAT
DAMPER FAIL

ON

OFF

STANDBY HYDRAULIC SYSTEM


CONTROL AND INDICATION

OVERHEAT OVERHEAT

LOW LOW LOW LOW


PRESSURE PRESSURE PRESSURE PRESSURE

ENG 1 ELEC 2 ELEC 1 ENG 2


ON ON

OFF OFF
A HYD PUMPS B

SYSTEMS A AND B
PUMP CONTROLS & FAULT INDICATION

ATA-29 Page 26 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

SERVICING HYDRAULIC RESERVOIR


The equipment that is necessary to fill the hydraulic fluid is on the forward bulkhead of the right wheel well.
The equipment includes a hand pump, a pressure fill connection, a filter for the hydraulic fluid, and a selector
valve.

There is a fluid quantity indicator on the system A and B reservoirs. The system B reservoir is filled through
the standby reservoir. When the fluid quantity indicator for system B shows full, the system B reservoir and
the standby reservoir are full.

The fluid chilling at high altitude and the large ambient temperature changes between departure and arrival
locations can result in a decrease in fluid levels. These cold soak effects will not have an impact on the
operation of the systems but it can shrink the fluid sufficiently to indicate a need for servicing, even if you
serviced the reservoirs at a warm location before the previous flight. Under such circumstances, if you service
the airplane "high" at the cold location before the airplane is sent back to the warm location, it is possible that
you will cause an overfill of the reservoir and fluid can overflow from the drain line.

If the ambient temperature on the ground is 20° F or lower at an arrival location and a fluid level is below
"REFILL", service the reservoir to just above "REFILL" to avoid the overflow of fluid at the next warmer location.

Access Location Zones: Right Main Wheel Well

Remove hydraulic power.

NOTE: It is not necessary to remove the air pressure from the hydraulic reservoirs before you
fill them.

Make sure the flaps and the leading edge devices are up.

Before you fill the system B reservoir, make sure the brake accumulator has a minimum of 2800 PSI of
pressure in it (with the hydraulic pumps off).

Right Main Wheel Well (Continued):

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-29 Page 27


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

If you use the hand pump, put the end of the suction hose in the hydraulic fluid container.

NOTE: All currently qualified BMS 3-11, Type IV hydraulic fluids are interchangeable and
intermixable in any proportion.

CAUTION: DO NOT SUPPLY HYDRAULIC FLUID AT MORE THAN 75 PSI TO THE PRESSURE FILL
CONNECTION. A PRESSURE OF MORE THAN 75 PSI CAN CAUSE DAMAGE TO THE
HYDRAULIC SYSTEM.

If you use a service cart, connect the hose from the service cart to the pressure fill connection.

Turn the selector valve to the reservoir to be filled.

NOTE: PORT A fills reservoir A, and PORT B fills the standby reservoir and reservoir B

ATA-29 Page 28 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

 
WARNING: DO NOT GET HYDRAULIC FLUID ON YOU. HYDRAULIC FLUID, BMS 3-11 CAN CAUSE
INJURY TO PERSONS. IF YOU GET HYDRAULIC FLUID ON YOUR SKIN, FLUSH YOUR
SKIN WITH WATER. IF YOU GET HYDRAULIC FLUID IN YOUR EYES, FLUSH YOUR
EYES WITH WATER AND GET MEDICAL AID. IF YOU EAT OR DRINK HYDRAULIC
FLUID, GET MEDICAL AID.

CAUTION: USE CLEAN HYDRAULIC FLUID AND CLEAN EQUIPMENT WHEN YOU FILL THE
HYDRAULIC RESERVOIRS. DIRT CAN CAUSE DAMAGE TO THE HYDRAULIC SYSTEM.

Add hydraulic fluid until the indicator on the reservoir shows FULL.

Put the selector valve in the CLOSED position.

Put the handle and the filler hose for the hand pump in their usual positions, or disconnect the pressure cart.

Look at the gages, for the hydraulic fluid quantity, that are in the flight compartment.

Make sure the gages show the hydraulic fluid quantity is above refill.

1 1
2 3 2 3
4 4
1 H Y D Q T YRFL 1 H Y D Q T YRFL
4 4

F F
SYS A SYS B
E E

P3 FIRST OFFICER'S INSTRUMENT PANEL

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-29 Page 29


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

POWER TRANSFER UNIT (PTU) - HYDRAULIC


Overview

The power transfer unit (PTU) system provides an alternate power source for autoslat operation if system B
EDP pressure is lost. This alternate power system applies to only the leading edge devices. The PTU uses
system A pressure to drive system B fluid without transferring fluid between the two systems. The PTU
contains in one integral assembly, a hydraulic motor and a hydraulic pump joined by a driveshaft.

An electric motor operated control valve opens to provide system A pressure to drive the motor. The motor
drives the pump which uses system B fluid from the reservoir to provide pressure for extending leading edge
devices between the retract and full extend positions.

A filter, hydraulic fuse, and check valve are placed in the pump pressure line to provide filtration, emergency
shutoff, and back-flow control.

The PTU is an integral motor/pump unit using system A pressure to operate wing leading edge devices upon
loss of system B EDP pressure. The PTU control valve circuit reacts to air/ground, flap and system B EDP
conditions to automatically provide system A pressure to the PTU. The circuit requires the following in order
to provide 28-volts DC current to operate the control valve motor:

1. An air sensing at the NOSE GEAR AIR/GROUND sensing relay


2. A trailing edge flap position indication greater than zero and less than fifteen
3. A system B EDP low pressure sensing below 2350 PSI minimum for at least 0.5 seconds

A reversal of any sensing, except system B EDP low pressure, will cause the PTU control valve to close,
shutting off system A pressure to the PTU motor.

ATA-29 Page 30 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Power Transfer Unit (PTU)

The power transfer unit consists of a hydraulic motor and a hydraulic pump joined to an integral support
housing. The motor and pump are joined by a driveshaft inside the housing. The hydraulic motor uses 9.8
GPM at 2400 PSI (pounds per square inch differential) to provide a pump output of 6.5 GPM minimum at 2400
PSI minimum. The PTU is mounted on the keel beam forward of the standby reservoir in the center wheel
well.

PTU Pressure Filter Module

The PTU pressurized fluid is filtered upon entering the system B lines. The filter module is mounted forward
of the PTU on the system B EMDP support structure in the right center wheel well. The filter has a disposable
element. Hydraulic fuses and check valves are mounted downstream of the filter in the pressure line.

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-29 Page 31


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

PTU Control Valve

The control valve is an electric motor operated shutoff valve in the PTU motor pressure line from the A
system. The valve is on the lower forward wall of the left wheel well. The two-position normally closed valve
is electrically operated to direct system A hydraulic pressure to the PTU. A flow limiter is installed upstream
of the control valve to limit flow to the PTU.

STANDBY
RESERVOIR
(REF)

PTU CONTROL
VALVE
SEE A

PTU
(REF)
FWD
WHEEL WELL
HYDRAULIC
CONNECTOR MOUNTING
BOLTS

HYDRAULIC
CONNECTOR

TO PTU

FROM SYSTEM A
PRESSURE
POSITION
INDICATOR

INBD ELECTRICAL
CONNECTOR

PTU CONTROL VALVE


(VIEW FROM THE FRONT)
A

ATA-29 Page 32 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

EDP Pressure Switch

The pressure switch senses the loss of system B EDP pressure and provides one of the electrical signals
necessary to open the control valve. The pressure switch is located on the right side of the wheel well forward
bulkhead.

SEE A

SYSTEM B
RESERVOIR
(REF)

EDP PRESSURE
SWITCH
SEE B

SYSTEM B RETURN
FILTER (REF)

MOUNTING BOLT
WASHER
(4 LOCATIONS) A

CLAMP

HYDRAULIC
LINE

EDP PRESSURE ELECTRICAL


SWITCH CONNECTOR

EDP PRESSURE SWITCH


B

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-29 Page 33


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

HYDRAULIC PRESSURE INDICATING SYSTEM


Overview

The hydraulic pressure indicating system shows the pressure that is in the two main hydraulic systems to the
pilots. The pilots see the pressure on the pressure indicators. The pressure indicators get their signals
electrically from the pressure transmitters.

The system uses 28-volt AC electrical power from the transfer bus through the circuit breakers on the P6
panel.

System Pressure Transmitter

There is a pressure transmitter on the left and right side of the forward bulkhead of the main wheel well. The
pressure transmitters are downstream of the A and B system pressure modules, thus they read the system
pressure. The transmitter changes the pressure into an electrical signal and sends the signal to the pressure
indicator.

System Pressure Indicator

The dual needle pressure indicator (gage) is on the lower part of the P3 panel. The pressure indicator shows
from 0 to 4000 PSI. The pressure indicator gets its signals from the pressure transmitters and shows the
system A and B pressures.
SYSTEM B
PRESSURE
TRANSMITTER 3
HYD SYS
PRESS
RED 4

SYSTEM A GREEN
PRESSURE 0
YELLOW PSI X 1000
TRANSMITTER
1

P3 PANEL

FWD
WHEEL WELL

28V AC
XFR BUS
NO. 1

REAR POINTER (B)


SYSTEM B PRESSURE
TRANSMITTER
28V AC
XFR BUS
NO. 2

FRONT POINTER (A)


P6 SYSTEM A PRESSURE
TRANSMITTER HYD SYS PRESS IND (DUAL)

ATA-29 Page 34 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-29 Page 35


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

HYDRAULIC FLUID OVERHEAT WARNING SYSTEM


Overview

An overheat warning system is provided to monitor the fluid operating temperatures of each system A and B
EMDP. The standby pump is not fitted with an overtemperature sensing device. A switch placed in each
EMDP case drain line is connected to a respective amber light on the P5 panel. The circuit uses 28-volts DC
power routed through circuit breakers on the P6 panel.

ON AIRPLANES WITH VICKERS ELECTRIC MOTOR-DRIVEN PUMPS (EMDPs); the system A and B
EMDPs have a thermal cut-off switch which stops the pump if the cooling fluid for the pump motor reaches
210--230-F.

ON AIRPLANES WITH ABEX ELECTRIC MOTOR-DRIVEN PUMPS (EMDPs); The system A and B EMDPs
have a built-in temperature switch which operates in parallel with the case drain switch and is connected to
the same OVERHEAT light on the P5 panel.

Overheat Lights

An overheat light for each EMDP is located above its respective control switch and low pressure light on the P5
panel.

Overheat Light Temperature Switches

The temperature switches react to temperatures exceeding 220° ±5° to make contact and turn on the warning
light. When the temperature at the switch drops to 165°F, the switch breaks contact turning off the lights. The
A and B system switches are located in the wheel well adjacent to the EMDPs in their case drain lines leading
to respective case drain filters.

ATA-29 Page 36 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

OVERHEAT OVERHEAT

LOW LOW LOW LOW


PRESSURE PRESSURE PRESSURE PRESSURE

ENG 1 ELEC 2 ELEC 1 ENG 2


ON ON

OFF OFF
A HYD PUMPS B

SYS B EMDP
OVERHEAT SWITCH
MD&T
28/16V DC
SYS B ELEC-1
PUMP OVERHEAT
C317 LIGHT

SYS B CASE DRAIN


TO MASTER OVERHEAT SWITCH
TEST SWITCH
MD&T
28/16V DC
SYS A ELEC-2
PUMP OVERHEAT
C318 LIGHT

P6-3 PANEL LOAD SYS A CASE DRAIN


CONTROL CENTER TO MASTER OVERHEAT SWITCH
TEST SWITCH

SYS A EMDP
OVERHEAT SWITCH

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-29 Page 37


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

HYDRAULIC FLUID QUANTITY INDICATING SYSTEM


Overview

The hydraulic fluid quantity indicating system shows the quantity of fluid in the A and B reservoirs. There are
indicators in the control cabin for the pilots and indicators in the main wheel well (on the side of the
reservoirs) for the ground crew.

The standby reservoir has a low quantity switch that makes a warning light come on.

The indicating systems use 28-volt DC power.

Fluid Quantity Transmitters and Indicators

There is a transmitter on the side of each hydraulic reservoir. It uses a float to find the fluid level in the
reservoir. The float mechanically moves the indicator that is on the transmitter. The float also moves a
synchro which gives a signal equal to the fluid level in the reservoir. The indicator in the control cabin gets the
signal from the transmitter and shows the fluid level.

The transmitters for system A and B are calibrated differently because the capacities of the reservoirs are
different. The mounting holes for the two transmitters are different.

Standby Low Quantity Switch

The standby low quantity switch is on the top of the standby reservoir. It is a probe type unit that uses a
magnet in a float ring to find the fluid level. At a specified level, the magnet operates a reed switch to make
the low quantity light on the P5 panel come on.

ATA-29 Page 38 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

1 1
2 3 2 3
1 4
H Y D Q T YRFL 1 4
H Y D Q T YRFL
4 4

F F
SYS A SYS B
E E

P3 FIRST OFFICER'S INSTRUMENT PANEL


DIRECT READING
QUANTITY INDICATOR

SYSTEM A QUANTITY
TRANSMITTER

28V DC SYSTEM A QUANTITY INDICATOR


(FRONT POINTER)

C307
SYS A HYD
QUANTITY

SYSTEM B QUANTITY
TRANSMITTER

28V DC SYSTEM B QUANTITY INDICATOR


(REAR POINTER)

C766
SYS B HYD P3 FIRST OFFICERS INSTRUMENT PANEL
QUANTITY

P6 LOAD CONTROL CTR MD&T


STANDBY
28/16V DC
HYDRAULIC
SYSTEM LOW
C316 QUANTITY LIGHT

P6 LOAD STANDBY SYSTEM


CONTROL CTR TO MASTER RESERVOIR
TEST SWITCH QUANTITY SW

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-29 Page 39


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

PUMP LOW PRESSURE WARNING SYSTEM


Overview

A low pressure warning system is provided for each hydraulic pump. Low pressure sensing switches are
mounted appropriately on each system pressure module. The switches are connected to amber low pressure
lights on the P5 panel.

Two low pressure warning switches, one for the EDP and one for the EMDP, are installed on each system A
and B pressure module. The standby low pressure warning switch is installed on the standby system pressure
module. Each switch is upstream of the pump check valve.

NOTE: If you stop an engine driven pump (EDP) when the electric motor driven pump
(EMDP) is on, it is possible the LOW PRESSURE light for the EDP will not come on for
two minutes or more. This is because pressure is caught in the line between the EDP
and the pressure module. With the EMDP in operation, this pressure can only bleed
back through the blocking valve in the EDP.

System A and B low pressure lights are on the P5 panel above the respective control switches. The standby
low pressure light is located on the P5 panel, near the flight control switches.

Each low pressure warning circuit is powered by 28-volt DC power through circuit breakers on the P6 panel.
Circuits from EDP low pressure switches are routed through respective engine fire circuits to deactivate the
circuit with the engine fire switch on FIRE. The standby hydraulic low pressure circuit is not connected until
the standby pump is commanded on.

Activation of a low hydraulic pressure warning circuit will cause the Master Caution and hydraulic annunciator
lights to illuminate on the pilot's lightshield.

OVERHEAT OVERHEAT

LOW LOW LOW LOW


PRESSURE PRESSURE PRESSURE PRESSURE

ENG 1 ELEC 2 ELEC 1 ENG 2


ON ON

OFF OFF
A HYD PUMPS B

ATA-29 Page 40 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

A
C316
28/16V DC
MD & T A
C317 STANDBY
RUDDER
C318 OFF
SYSTEM A MASTER
ON CONTROL SW
P6-3 LOAD CONTR CTR TEST
STANDBY HYDRAULIC
LOW PRESSURE LIGHT

STANDBY
RUDDER
OFF
SYSTEM B
ON CONTROL SW

AUTO STANDBY
STANDBY HYD OFF SYSTEM RELAY
LOW PRESSURE
SEE MASTER
ALT FLAP MASTER CAUTION
ARM ARMING SW CIRCUITRY

P5 PANEL

NORM
A A
P

FIRE
SYS A ENG 1 LOW PRESSURE ENG FIRE SW 1 SYS A EDP
LOW PRESS SW
NORM
A A
P

FIRE
SYS B ENG 2 LOW PRESSURE ENG FIRE SW 2 SYS B EDP
LOW PRESS SW
P8 AFT ELECTRONIC
CONTROL PANEL
A A
P

SYS B ELEC 1 LOW PRESSURE


GRD SEEKING SYS B EMDP
MASTER TEST LOW PRESS SW

A A
P

SYS A ELEC 2 LOW PRESSURE


P5 PANEL SYS A EMDP
LOW PRESS SW

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-29 Page 41


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

 
TABLE OF CONTENTS
B737-300/400/500 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION SELF-PACED
ATA-30

ICE AND RAIN PROTECTION............................................................................................................................... 2


Overview..................................................................................................................................................... 2
Wing Anti-Ice Control Valves ...................................................................................................................... 6
Wing Anti-Ice Control Components............................................................................................................. 8
Wing Anti-Ice Indicating Components....................................................................................................... 10
INLET COWL ANTI-ICING SYSTEM................................................................................................................... 11
Overview................................................................................................................................................... 11
Thermal Anti-Ice (TAI) Valve ................................................................................................................... 12
Thermal Anti-Ice (TAI) Pressure Switch .................................................................................................. 13
Thermal Anti-Ice (TAI) Overheat Switch .................................................................................................. 14
PITOT-STATIC TUBES, TEMPERATURE PROBE, AND ALPHA VANE ANTI-ICING SYSTEM.............................. 16
CONTROL CABIN WINDOW ANTI-ICING SYSTEM............................................................................................. 18
Overview................................................................................................................................................... 18
Window Conductive Coating...................................................................................................................... 20
Window Heat Sensor ................................................................................................................................ 21
Control Switches....................................................................................................................................... 22
Control Unit .............................................................................................................................................. 23
Indicating Lights....................................................................................................................................... 25
Motor-Converter Assembly ....................................................................................................................... 30
Wiper Assembly........................................................................................................................................ 30
Control Switch .......................................................................................................................................... 32
Resistor Box ............................................................................................................................................. 33
RAIN REPELLENT SYSTEM............................................................................................................................... 34
Overview................................................................................................................................................... 34
Container and Receptacle ......................................................................................................................... 36
Visual Reservoir and Plumbing................................................................................................................. 36
Solenoid and Spray Nozzles ..................................................................................................................... 38
Time Delay Module .................................................................................................................................. 39
WATER AND TOILET DRAIN ANTI-ICING SYSTEM ........................................................................................... 40
Toilet Drain Heaters ................................................................................................................................. 40
Drain Mast Heaters .................................................................................................................................. 40

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-30 Page 1


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

ICE AND RAIN PROTECTION


Overview

The following systems are used to protect the airplane and aid the pilots when operating under ice and rain
conditions:

Thermal anti-icing (TAI) systems using engine bleed air are provided for the wing, engine, and engine cowls.

Electrical anti-icing systems are provided for the control cabin windows, pitot and temperature probe sensors,
and the alpha vanes.

There is also anti-icing provided for the water and toilet drains.

Rain removal is provided for the No. 1 control cabin windows by a windshield wiper system. A rain repellent
system is also provided to be used in conjunction with the wiper system.

Thermal Anti-Icing (TAI) Systems

The wing thermal anti-icing (TAI) system de-ices the leading edge slats. The air for the TAI system is
supplied from engine bleed air (Ref Chapter 36, Engine Bleed Air Distribution System).

The engine thermal anti-ice (TAI) system de-ices the engine nose dome and engine inlet cowl.

Electrical Anti-Icing Systems

The control cabin window anti-icing system de-ices and provides bird proofing of the No. 1, 2, 4, and 5 control
cabin windows on each side of the control cabin. The windows are heated by the use of a transparent
electrical resistance coating incorporated as an integral part of the windows.

The pitot-static and temperature probe anti-icing system de-ices the left and right pitot tubes, the elevator feel
left and right pitot tubes, and the temperature probe. The sensors are heated by electrical resistance elements
installed within the sensing head of the units.

The alpha vane sensors are de-iced by electrical resistance elements installed within the sensor weathervane.

The waste water and toilet drain anti-icing system de-ices the fore and aft toilet drain connectors. The toilet
drain connectors are heated by electrical resistance elements installed as an integral part of the connector
gasket. The heaters are controlled directly by respective circuit breakers and are heated whenever the airplane
has electrical power.

ATA-30 Page 2 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Rain Removal Systems

The windshield wiper system maintains clear areas on the No. 1 control cabin windows during takeoff,
approach, and landing in rain or snow. The wipers are driven independently by electric motors which are
controlled by a common switch.

The rain repellent system sprays a rain repellent solution on the No. 1 control cabin windows and is used in
conjunction with the windshield wiper system to improve visibility during heavy rain. The repellent solution
for both windows is supplied from a common pressurized container, but is controlled independently by
separate control switches for each window.

ELEVATOR FEEL
PITOT TUBES
(LEFT AND RIGHT)

AFT TOILET
WING THERMAL DRAIN
ANTI-ICING (TAI)
SYSTEM
AFT WASTE
WATER DRAIN
MAST

CONTROL CABIN WINDOWS


WINDOW HEAT PNEUMATIC
WINDOW WIPERS MANIFOLD
RAIN REPELLENT

RIGHT
ALPHA
VANE

LEADING EDGE
FORWARD FWD WASTE
SLATS (REF)
TOILET WATER DRAIN
MAST ENGINE AND
DRAIN
ENGINE COWL (TAI)
LEFT, RIGHT
PITOT-STATIC TEMPERATURE (TAT)
TUBES PROBE
(2 EACH SIDE)
LEFT ALPHA VANE

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-30 Page 3


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Wing Anti-Ice Ducting

The pneumatic air duct is connected to each of the wing leading edge supply ducts through a control valve
located in the wing leading edge just inboard of the wing strut closure rib on each side of the airplane. The
wing supply ducts are connected to each of the wing leading edge slats by telescoping ducts.

The telescoping ducts consist of two tubes, one of which slides within the other as the slats are extended or
retracted and are sealed by an O-ring between them. The inner telescoping duct is connected to the wing TAI
supply manifold ducts by a swivel T-connection to allow rotational movement of the telescoping duct around
the wing supply duct. The T-connection is sealed by an O-ring between each end of the T and the supply
duct. The outer telescoping duct is connected to a slat anti-icing spray duct by a swivel T-connection to allow
rotational movement of the telescoping duct about the slat anti-icing spray duct. A support bracket in the slat
leading edge supports the ends of the slat spray ducts and the telescoping duct and prevents the TAI air from
flowing back through the telescoping duct cutout in the slat beam. The slat anti-icing spray duct runs the full
length of the slat and has perforations to direct the air towards the slat leading edge. The air then flows
between the slat upper skin and the slat beam where it is exhausted overboard through openings in the slat
lower skin.

To compensate for wing flexing, duct misalignment, and thermal expansion, the ducts inboard of approximate
slat station 175 are rigidly held and duct movement is absorbed by the swivel joints at each telescoping duct
connection and by expansion bends in the duct routing. The ducts outboard of slat station 175 use slip type
expansion joints.

ATA-30 Page 4 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

WING ANTI-ICE
CONTROL VALVE
GROUND OVERHEAT
THERMAL SWITCH
SEE A WING TAI AIR
SUPPLY MANIFOLD
A

SEE B A
PNEUMATIC
DUCT

L VALVE R VALVE
OPEN B OPEN B

WING ANTI-ICE
GRD TEST
O-RING
DUCT BEARING OFF

ON

TAI SUPPLY FORWARD OVERHEAD PANEL


MANIFOLD
A

INNER
TELESCOPING DUCT DUCT WING
BEARINGS FRONT
SPAR
CAP NUT
SEAL WITH
BACKUP RINGS
OUTER
TELESCOPING INNER
DUCT TELESCOPING DUCT TELESCOPING
AND SPRAY DUCT DUCT
SUPPORT BRACKET
IN SLAT LEADING EDGE

OUTER
WING TAI SUPPLY
TELESCOPING
MANIFOLD DUCT
DUCT
TELESCOPING
DUCT DOOR

SLAT REMOVABLE SLAT INNER SKIN PANEL


BEARING SPRAY DOUBLER AND COVER PLATE
DUCT
A-A SLAT INNER SKIN
OVERBOARD EXHAUST
THRU LOWER SKIN
TAI AIRFLOW BETWEEN BEAM
AND SLAT UPPER SKIN
SLAT
SPACERS BETWEEN SKIN AND BEAM
SPRAY DUCT
SLAT BEAM

SLAT TELESCOPING
SLAT DUCT ACCESS DOOR
B

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-30 Page 5


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Wing Anti-Ice Control Valves

The flow of air into the wing TAI system is controlled by a wing TAI shutoff valve for each wing supply duct.
The valves are located in the wing leading edge just inboard of each engine strut outboard seal rib, and are 2-
1/2 inch diameter electric motor-driven butterfly valves which operate on 115-volt AC power. Access to the
valves is through access doors in the lower fixed leading edge. The valves are equipped with limit switches to
prevent overrunning of the motor, and valve position indicator switches which are used in the valve position
indicator circuits. Each valve is also equipped with an external valve position indicator to verify valve position
and have manual override.

SEE A

WING ANTI-ICE
VALVE

ELECTRICAL
CONNECTOR LEADING EDGE
FLAP

ENGINE
NACELLE

CLAMPS BONDING
WIRE

FWD
INBD

ATA-30 Page 6 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-30 Page 7


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Wing Anti-Ice Control Components

The wing anti-ice control valves are governed by the following electrical control components; a pair of contacts
on the landing gear safety relay, a WING ANTI-ICE control switch, a valve control relay, two overheat thermal
switches, and two transistorized circuit cards.

The safety relay is energized by the main gear safety sensor when the airplane is on the ground. The relay is
used to inhibit operation of the system on the ground.

The WING ANTI-ICE control switch is located on the P5 overhead panel. The switch is a three-position six-pole
toggle switch; two poles are used in the valve control circuit and the other four poles are used in the valve
position indicating circuits. It has an ON position, an OFF position and a momentary GRD TEST position. The
control switch is used to control the operation of the wing anti-ice system.

The valve control relay is located behind the P5 overhead panel. The relay directs 115-volt AC power from the
WING A/I circuit breakers to open the wing anti-ice control valves when energized and to close the valves
when the relay is de-energized. The relay is controlled by the safety relay, the control switch, and the overheat
thermal switches.

The transistorized circuitry is used to control the indicating lights. It also controls the valve control relay in the
event an overheat condition occurs. The system can be tested on the ground and in the air.

The overheat thermal switches are located at the root end of each wing leading edge distribution manifold.
The switch is a temperature sensitive bimetallic type switch with normally open contact points which close at
the correct temperature. Thermal switches with part numbers 975-0062-002 or 3000-46-27 close at 125°C
(257°F). Thermal switches with part numbers 975-0062-001 or 3000-46-28 close at 93°C (200°F). The
actuation of a thermal switch in either wing while the switch is in the TEST or OFF position will complete a
circuit to close both wing anti-ice valves.

ATA-30 Page 8 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

ANTI-ICING HOT AIR


DUCT EXHAUSTED
115V AC
THROUGH EXHAUST
XFR BUS C146 HOLES IN
WING ANTI-ICE LOWER SLAT
M SKIN
28V DC
BAT BUS C148
ENG 1 & WING
SLAT RETRACTED
ANTI-ICE CONT
AIR DISTRIBUTION
P18 LOAD CONTROL CENTER V30 RIGHT WING (TYPICAL)
ANTI-ICE VALVE DUCT
CAVITY
S117
TAI FROM
ENGINE
M
CONNECTOR

RD
OA
AIR TB
V29 LEFT WING OU

ANTI-ICE VALVE
GND
WING ANTI-ICE THERMAL
R279 GROUND SHUTOFF VALVE SWITCH
SENSING RLY HOT

S117
CONTROL VALVE AND THERM
E11 LANDING GEAR SWITCH INSTALLATION
RIGHT WING
LOGIC SHELF
GROUND THERMAL (LEFT SIDE OPPOSITE)
WING
ANTI-ICE SW
TAI AIR
PNEUMATIC
L VALVE R VALVE
O P E Nb O P E Nb MANIFOLD

WING ANTI-ICE HOT


GRD TEST WING TAI
S118 SUPPLY
OFF MANIFOLD
LEFT WING
GROUND THERMAL DUCT
ON
OW
ANTI-ICE SW FL
AIR

MASTER DIM & TEST


TAI FROM
ENGINE

S118
P5-11
ENGINE AND WING
ANTI-ICE MODULE TELESCOPING
FEEDER DUCT
(TYPICAL)

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-30 Page 9


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Wing Anti-Ice Indicating Components

The wing anti-ice system is provided with a blue light for each control valve to indicate valve position. The
lights are of the press-to-test type and are located on the overhead panel adjacent to the WING ANTI-ICE
system control switch. The L VALVE OPEN and R VALVE OPEN indicating lights are illuminated dimly
whenever their respective valve is in the open position, and brightly whenever their respective valve position
does not agree with the control switch position due to a system malfunction or during valve transit. The lights
may be tested through the use of the master light test switch.

Each valve indicating light is controlled by a transistorized control switch, two poles of the system control
switch, and the valve position limit switches in its respective control valve. The transistorized control switches
are on printed circuit cards mounted behind the overhead panel. The transistorized light control switches are
supplied 28-volt DC power from the A/I control circuit breaker.

SEE A

L VALVE R VALVE
OPEN B OPEN B

WING ANTI-ICE
GRD TEST

OFF

ON

FORWARD OVERHEAD PANEL


A
ATA-30 Page 10 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization
and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

INLET COWL ANTI-ICING SYSTEM


Overview

The inlet cowl anti-icing system is a thermal system using engine hot bleed air from the 5th and 9th-stages of
the high pressure compressor (HPC) section. The function of the system is to maintain ice free inlet cowl
surfaces during flight and ground operations.

The system consists of ducting, a dual purpose pressure regulating and shutoff valve, a pressure switch and
an overheat switch downstream of the valve, an anti-icing distribution spray ring located in the lip of the inlet
cowl, and an exhaust port located at the 6 o'clock position on the inlet cowl.

Each engine anti-ice system operates independently. Each valve is pneumatically operated and electrically
controlled by a switch located on the pilots' overhead panel. The associated valve position indicator lights and
warning lights are located adjacent to the switches.

SEE A

TAI VALVE TAI


PRESSURE
SWITCH

TAI DUCT
TO 5TH
STAGE
DUCT

TAI
OVERHEAT
FWD
SWITCH

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-30 Page 11


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Thermal Anti-Ice (TAI) Valve

The TAI valve, located at the 1:30 o'clock position (aft looking forward) on the fan frame, is line mounted in
the TAI ducting and is secured with V-band couplings. The valve is air operated and is set to regulate outlet
pressure at 50 ±3 PSI. The valve is fully open at inlet pressures of 10 to 47 PSI. The unit consists of a
normally closed butterfly shutoff valve, a normally open pressure regulator butterfly valve, a servo pilot valve
and associated components which form an insulated air duct section. If the pressure regulator valve fails to
regulate the pressure, the shutoff valve will maintain the pressure at 75 ±10 PSI.

A manual override provision is incorporated in the valve for direct mechanical operation and for locking the
valve in a partially open position in the event of system malfunction. The valve is designed to fail in the
closed position. The valve incorporates two position switches to provide valve position indication in the
cockpit.

The pressure regulator valve and shutoff valve both have provisions for manual override by means of external
wrenching flats on the valve position indicators. The pressure regulator may be locked in the open position by
replacing the closed position adjustment setscrew with a locking screw. The shutoff valve may be locked in
either the closed or mid-position by inserting a quick-release pin into the lock hole provided in the valve cover.

To lock the pressure regulator valve in the open position, first the valve clamps must be loosened and the
valve hardware must be removed. Then the valve must be turned until the closed position adjustment setscrew
can be removed and replaced with the locking screw. After the locking screw is installed, the valve must be
aligned and the hardware and clamps installed.
PRIMARY
UPSTREAM REGULATOR OPEN STOP
POSITION ADJUSTMENT ADJUSTMENT
SWITCH COVER
CLOSED STOP
ADJUSTMENT
DOWNSTREAM
OPEN

RETAINING
POSITION SCREW
SWITCH COVER

HEX SHAFT

CLOSED

PRESSURE REGULATOR VALVE MANUAL OVER


SECONDARY
REGULATOR
ADJUSTMENT
CLOSED

FWD RETAINING
SCREW

ALLIED SIGNAL
TAI VALVE MID
HEX SHAFT
POSITION

OPEN

SHUTOFF VALVE MANUAL OVERRIDE

ATA-30 Page 12 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Thermal Anti-Ice (TAI) Pressure Switch

The TAI pressure switch senses pressure from a pressure tap in the TAI ducting downstream of the valve.
The function of the switch is to act as a check on the operation of the valve to prevent overpressurizaton of the
inlet cowl. The switch is set to activate at 65 ±3 PSI, and provides cowl overpressure warning indication by
illuminating an amber COWL ANTI-ICE warning light in the cockpit.

TAI PRESSURE
SWITCH
TAI
VALVE

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-30 Page 13


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Thermal Anti-Ice (TAI) Overheat Switch

The TAI overheat switch senses temperature in the TAI ducting downstream of the valve. The switch is set to
activate at 825 ±20°F and will indicate an overtemperature condition by illuminating the master caution, anti-
ice annunciator lights, and an amber COWL ANTI-ICE warning light in the cockpit. The unit consists of a
thermostatic sensor that actuates a single-pole, single-throw switch.

ATA-30 Page 14 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-30 Page 15


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

PITOT-STATIC TUBES, TEMPERATURE PROBE


AND ALPHA VANE ANTI-ICING SYSTEM
The left and right pitot-static tubes, the elevator feel left and right pitot tubes, the temperature probe, and the
left and right alpha vanes are heated to prevent the formation of ice which could affect sensing accuracy. The
heating is accomplished by electrical heaters installed as an integral part of the units. The heaters consist of
resistance elements which operate on 115-volt AC.

The heaters are controlled by two switches on the P5-9 module in the overhead panel. The control switches
are four-pole two-position (ON-OFF) toggle switches. The system has an indicating circuit consisting of a
current transformer, an electronic switch, and an indicating light for each sensor. The electronic switches and
indicating light circuits are installed on printed cards. The transformer is installed in the line to the heater.

One switch controls the heating of the upper and lower left pitot-static heater, temperature probe heater, left
alpha vane heater, and the left elevator feel pitot heater. The other switch controls the heating of the upper
and lower right pitot-static heaters, right alpha vane heater and the right elevator feel pitot heater. When the
transformer does not sense current flow, the electronic switch provides a ground for the indicating light.

The light circuits receive 28-volt DC power through the master dim relay from the INDICATOR DIM BUS NO. 1
DC and NO. 2 DC circuit breakers on the P6 panel. The lights are of the press-to-test type and may be tested
individually or through the use of the master light test switch. The lights may also be dimmed through the use
of the master dim switch.

The P5-9 module located in the pilots' P5 overhead panel contains the control switches, indicating lights,
transformers, and printed circuit cards. The P5-9 module also contains the switches and indicating lights for
the control cabin window anti-icing system.

The system provides dual level Total Air Temperature Probe heating through Air/Ground logic circuits in the
E-11 Landing Gear Logic shelf and relay K1 in the P5-9 module. When on the ground the system removes the
voltage from the Total Air Temperature Probe thus prolonging probe element life.

When on the ground, testing of the Total Air Temperature Probe Heater is provided by a Total Air Temperature
Probe test switch S8. The switch is located on the P5-9 Module in the overhead panel it is a two pole, two
position (ON-OFF) press to test switch. When the switch is pressed to the test position it controls the heating
of the Total Air Temperature Probe on the ground.

ATA-30 Page 16 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

ELEVATOR FEEL
PITOT TUBES
(LEFT AND RIGHT)

SEE A

LEFT, RIGHT
PITOT-STATIC
TUBES
(2 EACH SIDE)

TEMPERATURE (TAT)
RIGHT PROBE
ALPHA
VANE LEFT
ALPHA
VANE

CAPT P/S PITOT STATIC F/O P/S


1 AUX STATIC 2 AUX STATIC
A A B A
ON
F/O STATIC CAPT STATIC
2 AUX P/S 1 AUX P/S
A A

L ELEV OFF R ELEV


PITOT PITOT
A HEAT A

L ALPHA R ALPHA
VANE VANE
A TAT TEST A

TEMP
PROBE
A

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-30 Page 17


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

CONTROL CABIN WINDOW ANTI-ICING SYSTEM


Overview

Windows No. 1, 2, 3, 4, and 5 on each side of the control cabin are provided with electrical heating window
anti-icing and defogging. Heating of the control cabin windows also improves the impact strength of the
windows and is used for bird proofing the windows when flying at altitudes where bird strikes are possible.
Power to the left No. 1, 3, 4, and 5 windows and the right No. 2 window is supplied from the left generator and
the right No. 1, 3, 4, and 5 and left No. 2 window is supplied from the right generator. In the event of a power
failure from one generator, the No. 2 window on that side and the No. 1, 3, 4, and 5 windows on the other side
will still be supplied power from the other generator, thus ensuring that reasonable forward vision from each
side will be maintained.
The forward No. 1 windshield and the No. 2 sliding window on each side of the cabin have a separate control
system for each window. The control system maintains the respective window at the required temperature by
the use of automatic controls. Each system consists of the heated window, a window heat sensor, a control
switch, a heat control unit, a power indicating light, and an overheat indicating light. A power and an overheat
test switch are used in common with all four systems. The No. 3, 4, and 5 windows receive power through the
side window heat switch. Power to windows No. 4 and 5 is regulated by a thermal switch located on the No. 5
window. Power to window No. 3 is regulated by a thermal switch located on the edge of the window. While
the system is in operation, the temperature of the windows is regulated at 107 ±7°F for the No. 1 and 2
windows, from 65 to 105°F for the No. 3 windows, and from 80 to 120°F for the No. 4 and 5 windows. The
control system turns off the power to the No. 1 and 2 windows when an overheat condition of approximately
145°F is detected. When the system is first energized, a ramp function in the heat control unit causes the
power delivered to the No. 1 and No. 2 windows to increase gradually from zero to full power in approximately
3 minutes, unless it is controlled at a lesser level by the window reaching control temperature before the ramp
time runs out. This reduces the thermal shock to the pane when the power is applied to a cold window. A
power interruption of five seconds or more will cause the ramp function to start over from zero, while for
lesser interruptions the ramp will start over a fraction that is proportional to the time off.
The window heat sensor provides a temperature control signal to the heat control unit which in turn modulates
the amount of power to the window to maintain the window at the required operating temperature. The power
indicating light will illuminate OFF when power is not being supplied to the window. If an overheat condition
is detected, the heat control unit will cut off power to the windows, turn off the power indicating light, and
turn on the overheat indicating light and the master caution and anti-ice lights of the master caution system
(Ref Chapter 33, Master Warning and Caution Lights). While the system is in operation, the heat control unit
may be functionally tested by the use of the system test switch. Holding the test switch in the POWER position
will force the control unit to supply power to the window and turn on the power indicating light. If the
operational confidence check is performed under conditions where the window temperature is within the
overheat cutoff range, whether by outside environment or by excessively long testing, an overheat cutoff will
occur. An overheat condition can be simulated by holding the test switch in the OVERHEAT position. The
system is returned to normal by momentarily placing the control switch in the OFF position. The temperature
of the No. 4 and 5 windows is controlled by the thermal switch on the No. 5 window.

ATA-30 Page 18 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-30 Page 19


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Window Conductive Coating

The control cabin windows are of laminated glass-vinyl construction. Refer to Chapter 56, Control Cabin
Windows, for details of window construction. The No. 1 and 2 windows have a conductive coating between the
outer glass panes and vinyl core where it is most effective for window anti-icing, whereas the No. 3, 4, and 5
windows have the conductive coating between the inner glass pane and the vinyl core where it will be most
effective for window defogging. All five windows have electrical terminals connected to bus bars which are
molded into the upper and lower edges of the window in contact with the conductive coating. The windows are
heated by allowing current to flow through the conductive coating between the upper and lower bus bars. The
resistance of the conductive coating increases with age and higher voltages are required across the bus bars to
maintain equivalent heat output.

ATA-30 Page 20 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Window Heat Sensor

The No. 1 and 2 windows each have a heat sensor consisting of a filament of non-insulated resistance wire.
The wire is arranged in a single plane coil and imbedded in a thin plastic wafer installed near the lower edge
of the window ( Fig. 1 and 2) between the outer pane and plastic core. The resistance of the wire is sensitive
to temperature and increases as the temperature increases. A change in window temperature causes a
change in sensor resistance, providing a signal for the heat control unit. No. 1 and 2 windows have a spare
heat sensor mounted adjacent to the primary heat sensor. If the primary sensor fails, the spare sensor may be
used.

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-30 Page 21


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Control Switches

There are four window heat control switches, one for each of the No. 1 and 2 windows on each side of the
cabin. The switches are four-pole two position ON-OFF toggle switches and are on the overhead panel. The
No. 3, 4 and 5 windows are controlled by the respective left or right side window heat switch.

ATA-30 Page 22 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Control Unit

There are four window heat control units, one for each of the window No. 1 and 2 heating systems. The units
are located in the E3-3 electrical rack.

The temperature control unit is a solid state device which performs three functions: overheat control,
temperature control including ramp control and shorted sensor protection, and power indication.

The control unit overheat circuit, when energized, directs 115-volt AC power from the window anti-ice circuit
breaker to the control unit temperature control circuit.

The terminal strip on the E3-3 electrical shelf is provided a selection of voltages from an autotransformer
within the control unit to suit the resistance of the conductive coating on the windows. Selection of voltage is
accomplished by moving the window power lead to the appropriate tap on the terminal strip located on the
outboard end of the control unit tray.

MAIN EQUIPMENT
CENTER
SEE A

WINDOW HEAT
FWD CONTROL UNITS
M321 SEE B
(LEFT FRONT)
M322 M320
(RIGHT SIDE)
A
(LEFT SIDE)
E3-3 SHELF
M323
(RIGHT FRONT) DISCONNECT
PANEL

TERMINAL STRIP
(4 LOCATIONS)
FWD

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-30 Page 23


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

ATA-30 Page 24 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Indicating Lights

There are two indicating lights for each of the No. 1 and 2 window heating systems; one is for power indication
and the other is for overheat indication. The circuit for the overheat indication also controls a master caution
indicating circuit for the anti-ice (A/I) and master caution annunciators on the pilots' lightshield. Both
indicating lights are located adjacent to the respective control switch on the overhead panel and the master
caution control circuit is on three printed circuit cards mounted behind the pane. The lights receive 28-volt DC
power from the IND LIGHTS circuit breaker on the No. 1 and 2 DC bus, and the master caution control circuit
receives 28-volt DC power from the window heat control circuit breaker on Bus No. 2. The lights are of the
press-to-test type and may be tested individually or through the use of the master light test switch. The
lights may also be dimmed through the use of the master dim switch.

The power indicating light is controlled by the power on lamp driver short circuit protector circuit in the
respective window heat control unit. When 28-volt DC power is available, the light is on whenever the power-
on lamp driver circuit in the control unit exceeds approximately 5 watts of power.

The overheat indicating light is controlled by the respective window heat control switch and the auxiliary
contacts of the overheat light relay in the window heat control unit. When 28-volt DC power is available, the
light comes on if the overheat light relay is de-energized while the control switch is in the ON position (switch
on - relay energized, switch off - relay de-energized.)

The master caution warning system consists of four time delay circuits, one for each of the overheat indication
circuits, and a warning latch circuit. The reaction time of the overheat relay may cause a momentary overheat
signal when the control switch is turned on. To avoid nuisance trips of the master caution system, the signal
is directed first to the delay circuit. If the signal persists for approximately one second, the delay circuit
provides an impulse to the latch circuit which then provides a ground for the master caution lights through the
overheat relay. The latch circuit will remain conductive until the power is interrupted either through the use of
the master caution light reset or by resetting the window heat control system. The warning latch circuit may
also be tripped by the master caution light recall switch or master light test switch and complete a circuit to
ground through these switches for the master caution indicating lights.

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-30 Page 25


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Test Switch

The window heat test switch is an eight-pole, double-throw, with center OFF position and momentarily on at
both extremes, toggle actuated switch. The switch has momentary POWER and OVERHEAT positions and is
located between the window heat control switches on the overheat panel. The switch provides a ground for the
power test input on each of the four window heat control units (pin 19) when placed in a POWER position, and
similarly provides a ground for each of the overheat test inputs (pin 12) when placed in the OVERHEAT
position.

Window No. 3 and 5 Thermal Switch

Window No. 3 and 5 thermal switches are temperature sensitive, bimetallic, single pole, snap action switch
with normally closed contact points. The contact points on the No. 3 thermal switch open at 95° ±10°F and
close at 75° ±10°F. The contact points on the No. 5 thermal switch open at 110° ±10°F and close at 90°
±10°F. The switches are spring mounted near the lower edge of each of the No. 5 windows and regulate the
application of power to the No. 4 and 5 windows of the respective side. The No. 3 window thermal switch is
mounted on the lower edge of the number 3 windows and regulates power to the window. On some airplanes,
the No. 3 window thermal switch is mounted on the upper edge of the No. 3 window.

ATA-30 Page 26 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE

 
B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization

AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource


 

 
 
115V AC
GEN BUS 1 1
C228
2 HEATER
±15V ±30V 3
WINDOW ANTI-ICE 4
LEFT FRONT 5
NC 6
P6-11 CIRCUIT BREAKER
LOGIC POWER
PANEL T270 TERMINAL
POWER DEMAND
ON SUPPLY DETECTOR STRIP
115V AC
BUS 1
C224
K1 OVHT
WINDOW HEAT
RELAY
LEFT FWD-AC
A
FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY

P18-3 CIRCUIT BREAKER OFF


PANEL A POWER
S4 L FORWARD DRIVE
WINDOW SW
L8 OVHT LT L FWD WINDOW

K2 OVHT LT
RELAY
A

A SPARE SENSOR
(IF INSTALLED)

L7 OFF LT L FWD WINDOW CONT PROPORTIONAL


CONTROL
L9 L10 L8 L7
PWR HEAT
SENSOR
OVERHEAT OVERHEAT OVERHEAT OVERHEAT
OVHT TEMPERATURE
SENSOR
OFF OFF OFF OFF AMPLIFIER

S7 WINDOW HEAT
L WINDOW HEAT R TEST SW
SIDE FWD OVHT SIDE FWD
OFF OFF
M321 LEFT FRONT WINDOW HEAT CONTROL UNIT (E3-3) A6 LEFT FORWARD WINDOW NO.1

ON PWR ON
TEST

S3 S4 S7

P5-9 WINDOW AND PITOT HEAT PANEL


ATA-30 Page 27

and Systems Introduction


 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

WINDSHIELD WIPER SYSTEM


Overview

Windshield wipers are provided to maintain a clear area on the pilots' No. 1 windows during takeoff, approach
and landing in rain or snow. Each wiper is operated by a separate system to ensure that clear vision through
one of the windows will be maintained in the event of a system failure. The wiper blades clear a patch
approximately 13-1/2 inches wide through an arc of 84 ±4 degrees.

Both wiper systems are operated by a switch located on the overhead panel. The switch provides selection of
the wiper action speeds. The switch also controls the PARK position when the system is not in use.

Each windshield wiper system consists of these components:

1. Drive motor and torque converter assembly


2. A control switch assembly
3. Windshield wiper assembly
4. Resistor box

Speed control is achieved by changing the voltage applied to the windshield wiper motor by means of resistors.
The required resistance is connected into the motor circuit by turning the windshield wiper switch to a
selected position. The rotary motion of the drive motor is transmitted to the converter which reduces the shaft
speed and changes rotary motion to an oscillating motion of the windshield wiper arm.

A second method for maintaining clear windows in heavy rain is by the use of rain repellant.

Operation

The operation of both windshield wiper systems is controlled by turning the windshield wiper control switch
located on the overhead panel to the rate of wiper action desired. When switch position LOW or HIGH is
selected, power will be directed from the respective system bus through the control switch to the motor, back
through the control switch for resistance or speed selection, then to selected resistance to ground (Fig. 2).
The amount of resistance selected determines the motor speed and therefore the rate of wiper action.

When the control switch is turned to the PARK position and the wiper is in any position other than PARK, the
switch completes a circuit through the PARK contacts of the control switch and through the N C contacts of the
cam operated switch in the motor to ground. This will shunt the resistor box out of the control circuit and drive
the motor at high speed until the motor reaches the PARK position of the wiper cycle and the switch cam
moves the switch to close the N O contacts of the cam operated switch. With the cam operated switch in the N
O position, the motor armature is shunted out by the cam operated switch and the circuit is completed to
ground through the PARK contact of the control switch and the full resistor load. With the motor field coil still
energized and the motor armature shorted by the cam operated switch, dynamic braking is provided to stop
the motor from coasting. This stops the motor with the wiper blades in the PARK position.

ATA-30 Page 28 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE

 
B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization

AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource


 

 
 
OFF
LOW M23
HIGH
PARK

M24 RIGHT RESISTOR


BOX (STA 180,
RBL 30, WL 185)

THERMAL OVERHEAT
OFF PROTECTOR SWITCH
300 F°
LOW
28V DC PARK HIGH
BUS 1 S22
C55
FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY

M
WIPERS
RIGHT

CALL

RAIN REPEL
M22 R WINDSHIELD
WIPER MOTOR
(STA 188)
L R SILL BEAM
WIPER
OFF
PARK LOW

HIGH

THERMAL OVERHEAT
PROTECTOR SWITCH
OFF
300 F°
LOW
28V DC PARK HIGH
BUS 2
C54
WIPERS M
LEFT

OFF
P18-3 CIRCUIT BREAKER
PANEL LOW
PARK HIGH
M21 L WINDSHIELD
WIPER MOTOR
(STA 188)
ATA-30 Page 29

S22 WINDSHIELD WIPER M23 LEFT RESISTOR


CONTROL SWITCH (P5) BOX (STA 180,
RBL 30, WL185)

and Systems Introduction


 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Motor-Converter Assembly

The wiper assembly for each system is driven by a motor-converter assembly. The motor-converter assembly
consists of a 28-volt DC variable speed electric motor and torque converter coupled together by a connector
sleeve and assembled on a support fitting. Each assembly is mounted on a bracket on the respective window
sill close to the inner surface of the skin.

Each motor is equipped with two radio noise filters, an automatically resetting thermal overload switch, and a
cam actuated switch. The thermal switch temporarily opens the motor field circuit when the motor
temperature exceeds 300°F, or when the field current exceeds 8 to 10 amps. The cam actuated switch is a
two-pole two-position micro switch. The operating cam is driven by reduction gearing in the motor to coincide
with the wiper cycle. One pole of the switch is closed when the motor is in any part of the wiper cycle other
than PARK. The other pole of the switch is closed only when the motor is in the PARK position of the cycle.
The switch is used in conjunction with the system control switch to stop the motor with the wipers in the
PARK position when the system is not in use.

The converter has a serrated drive shaft which protrudes through the skin just forward of the windshield for
attachment of the wiper assembly. The converter changes the high speed low torque rotary motion of the
motor to a low speed high torque circular oscillating motion for the wiper arm by the use of a worm gear and
eccentric drive mechanism. The motor and converter are synchronized with respect to the wiper cycle before
the units are coupled together.

Wiper Assembly

The windshield wiper assembly consists of a wiper blade and wiper arm. The wiper arm has a serrated sleeve
at the hub to provide angular adjustment between the arm and the converter drive shaft and is attached to the
shaft by a bolt through the hub. The wiper tension of the arm can be adjusted by a tension adjusting nut near
the hub of the arm. The wiper blade is bolted to the end of the wiper arm and the angle between the blade
and the arm can be adjusted by means of a serrated disc attached to each part.

ATA-30 Page 30 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

2-3 LBS
OF FORCE
A

SEE A

SEE B

PARK POSITION
A 1
DISK (WITH
SERRATIONS)

WIPER BLADE WIPER


ARM
BLADE NUT

23 ±1°
SILL BEAM
WIPER ARM CONVERTER
SHAFT

ADJUSTMENT NUT

ARM ATTACH
BOLT
CLAMP
ADJUSTMENT SLEEVE BOLT
(WITH SERRATIONS)
WINDSHIELD WIPER BLADE
(IN THE PARK POSITION) B
CONVERTER SHAFT

PARK POSITION
A 2

0.06
INCH
WINDSHIELD
FRAME

1 SHOWN WITH THE 2-3 POUND


FORCE SUPPLIED
2 SHOWN WITHOUT THE FORCE
SUPPLIED A-A

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-30 Page 31


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Control Switch

The windshield wiper control switch is a four-position switch. The switch is located on the overhead panel
and is used to control the action of both windshield wiper motors by changing the motor circuitry.

The switch has a momentary PARK position and three detent positions, OFF, LOW, and HIGH.

ATA-30 Page 32 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Resistor Box

Each windshield wiper system has a resistor box for the motor. The box contains three resistors which may be
selected by the control switch to be added in series with the motor circuit to control the motor speed.

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-30 Page 33


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

RAIN REPELLENT SYSTEM


Overview

A rain repellent system is provided to be used in conjunction with the windshield wiper system to improve
windshield visibility through the pilots' No.1 windshields during heavy rain. The system is controlled
independently for each window by separate control switches located on the overhead panel and, when actuated,
the system sprays a rain repellent solution on the respective window as selected. The maximum quantity of
solution sprayed per system actuation (approx 6cc) is predetermined by the setting on a time delay relay and
cannot be exceeded by extended duration of switch actuation. The solution is spread over almost the entire
window by the rain and air stream, however spreading is enhanced within the wiped area of the windows by
the action of the wiper blades. The length of time that an application remains effective varies inversely with
the rain intensity and will last longer in the wiped area than in the unwiped area. Reapplication is repeated as
required to maintain repellent effectiveness.

The rain repellent system should not be operated on dry windows, as heavy undiluted solution will restrict
window visibility. In the event of inadvertent dry window application, do not operate the windshield wipers as
this tends to increase smearing. Also, the rain repellent residues caused by application in dry weather or very
light rain may cause staining or minor corrosion of the airplane skin. To prevent this, any concentrated
repellent or residue should be removed by a thorough fresh water rinse at the earliest opportunity, preferably
within a few hours after exposure. Repellent residues allowed to dry or "cure" on the surface will require
polishing with an approved aluminum polish to remove the stain. To remove residue from glass windows, use
a repellent remover pad.

The rain repellent system consists of a pressurized container of rain repellent fluid, a container receptacle, a
visual reservoir, a pressure gage, two solenoid valves, two nozzles, associated plumbing, and two electrical
control circuits.

ATA-30 Page 34 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE

 
B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization

AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource


 

 
 
AT

F
S24
CALL

RAIN REPELLENT
GEN 2

L R PRESS
S23
WIPER
PARK OFF LOW

STA
28V DC
190
BUS 2
C57 REF
RIGHT RAIN
FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY

REPELLENT S24 RIGHT RAIN


REPELLENT
SWITCH
RAIN REPELLENT
FLUID SUPPLY LINE
CONTAINER
M576 RIGHT RAIN V2 RIGHT RAIN RESERVOIR
REPELLENT REPELLENT
TIME DELAY VALVE
CONTAINER
(STA 186)

CLAMP
28V DC
BUS 1 CONTAINER
C56
RECEPTACLE
LEFT RAIN
REPELLENT S23 LEFT RAIN SHUTOFF VALVE
REPELLENT
SWITCH
CAN
P18-3 CIRCUIT BREAKER P5 OVERHEAD PANEL - NOZZLE RESERVOIR REPLACEMENT
PANEL FORWARD LEVEL

M575 LEFT RAIN V1 LEFT RAIN


REPELLENT REPELLENT
TIME DELAY VALVE SOLENOID
(STA 186) VALVE SHUT-OFF VALVE, VISUAL RESERVOIR,
RAIN REPELLENT CONTAINER (STA 259)

ACCESS HOLE

RAIN REPELLENT
FLUID SUPPLY LINE
RAIN REPELLENT VALVE AND NOZZLE (TYPICAL)
ATA-30 Page 35

and Systems Introduction


 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Container and Receptacle

The rain repellent fluid is packaged in a pressurized disposable-type container (Fig. 1) which is replaced when
empty. Each container has a self-sealing valve with a threaded boss for attaching the container to the system
receptacle.

There are two types of fluid presently in use, type I and type III, which are packaged in different size
containers. Type III is preferred due to longer shelf life and repellent effectiveness. The two types of fluid are
miscible, however when mixed, the resultant solution tends to reflect the properties of the type I fluid.
Therefore, when converting from type I fluid to type III fluid, it is recommended that the system be emptied of
all type I fluid before introducing the type III fluid.

NOTE: The useful service life of type I rain repellent fluid is dependent upon the temperature to
which it is exposed. Stored at room temperature, 65 to 75°F, a service life of about one year
may be expected. Exposure to higher temperatures shortens the service life. The time rain
repellent cans are installed on airplanes must be accredited to the one year useful service life
storage period. Type III rain repellent fluid is not service life limited.

Contact with the rain repellent fluid can cause irritation of the skin or eyes. Precautions should be taken to
prevent contact with the skin or eyes and to avoid breathing the fluid vapors.

The fluid in rain repellent container P/N 65-38196-5 has a citrus scent.

The system receptacle has a valve actuating pin which opens the container valve as the container is attached
to the receptacle. As the pin enters the valve assembly, it is sealed by an O-ring in the valve prior to
unseating of the valve to prevent fluid leakage. The pin is hollow and has inlet ports near the tip of the pin to
allow fluid to enter the system from the container. The container and receptacle are mounted to the left of the
second observer's station.

Visual Reservoir and Plumbing

The container receptacle is connected by an adapter and fittings, through a shutoff valve to a translucent
fiberglass fluid reservoir mounted below the receptacle. The container, receptacle and reservoir are all
supported by a common bracket. The can valve adapter, shutoff valve, and plumbing are enclosed in a plastic
cover with cutouts for access to the shutoff valve and for viewing the reservoir. The reservoir contains a red
float level indicator which is visible through the side of the reservoir. A decal on the cover indicates the fluid
level at which the container should be replaced. Approximately ten individual repellent applications of fluid
are left in the reservoir and plumbing leading to the spray nozzles when the level of the fluid is at the
container replacement level.

From the reservoir connection, a Teflon supply line is routed below the control cabin floor to a stainless steel
T-connection mounted forward of the windshield. The T is connected by stainless steel tubing to a solenoid
control valve for each window.

ATA-30 Page 36 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-30 Page 37


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Solenoid and Spray Nozzles

The solenoid valves are normally closed electrically operated 28-volt DC valves. The valves control the flow of
the repellent fluid that is released into the spray nozzles and are coupled directly to the nozzles.

The spray nozzles are mounted externally at the base of each No. 1 window inboard of the windshield wiper
drive shaft. Each nozzle has four spray holes which direct the repellent fluid onto the windshield.

SEE A

NOZZLE
JAMNUT

NUT AND
WASHER

SPRAY NOZZLE
ASSEMBLY
SEAL

BULKHEAD
FITTING

JAMNUT
BACK-UP RING
AND O-RING

FWD
SOLENOID
VALVE

ATA-30 Page 38 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Time Delay Module

Each solenoid valve is controlled by an independent electrical control circuit. The electrical control components
of each circuit consist of a system control switch and a time delay circuit. The control switches are pushbutton
type momentary switches and are located on the overhead panel. The time delay circuit is mounted within the
delay module which is connected to the solenoid valve electrical connector. A resistor in the time delay circuit
is variable and may be adjusted to change the time required to charge a capacitor and thus control the time
delay action. The delay is adjusted to open the circuit to the solenoid valve after the required amount of
repellent has been sprayed on the window, allowing the valve to close.

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-30 Page 39


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

WATER AND TOILET DRAIN ANTI-ICING SYSTEM


Toilet Drain Heaters

The aft toilet drain has a heater to stop ice formation. The heater is in the drain gasket. The heater operates
with 115-volts AC current. The DRAIN HEATER circuit breaker on the P18 panel controls the heater.

On some airplanes, the forward toilet drain has a heater in the drain gasket. The DRAIN HEATER circuit
breaker controls the heater. The heater operates with 115-volts AC current.

A ribbon heater tape wrapped around the galley drain line which routes around the forward airstairs
compartment prevents freezing of the drain line. The heater is controlled by the FWD DRAIN HTR circuit
breaker on the P18-4 panel.

Drain Mast Heaters

The forward and aft water drain masts are electrically heated to prevent ice from forming and blocking the
drain. The heating elements operate on either 28-volts AC for low heat ground operation or 115-volts AC for
high heat during airborne operation. Low heat power is supplied from the 28-volt AC main bus No. 2 through
the DRAIN MAST HEATER-GROUND circuit breaker, and high heat power is supplied from the 115-volt AC main
bus No. 1 through the DRAIN MAST HEATER-AIR AIR circuit breaker. Both circuit breakers are located on the
P18 load control center.

For low heat ground operation of the drain masts, 28-volt AC power is provided by two relays, a landing gear
air sensing relay in the landing gear logic shelf, and an external power sensing relay on the bus protection
panel. When the airplane is in the air, 115-volt AC power is used for heating the drain masts; but, upon
landing, the landing gear air sensing relay is de-energized, thereby switching to the 28-volt AC power supply
for low heat ground operation to prevent the heater from overheating and possibly burning out the heating
element. Additional protection against overheating of the drain masts is provided by the external power
sensing relay which prevents inadvertent application of 115-volts AC to the heater during maintenance in the
event the airplane is raised on jacks. The external power sensing relay is energized when external power is
supplied to the airplane.

ATA-30 Page 40 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

HEATING
ELEMENT DRAIN
TUBE

SEE A
SEE C
SEE B

DRAIN MAST

SEE A A

TOILET DRAIN TOILET DRAIN


OUTLET FITTING OUTLET FITTING

SEE D

SEE D

INBD FWD

AFT TOILET SERVICE PANEL FORWARD TOILET SERVICE PANEL


B C
GASKET 1

1 AIRPLANES PRE-SB 38-1026


D

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-30 Page 41


and Systems
  Introduction
FOR TRAINING PURPOSSES ONLY
FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE

and Systems Introduction


B737 - 3-4-500 Revision 1 08.12.03 ATA 34/22 1
FOR TRAINING PURPOSSES ONLY
FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE

and Systems Introduction


ATA 34/22 12 B737 - 3-4-500 Revision 1 08.12.03
FOR TRAINING PURPOSSES ONLY
FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE

and Systems Introduction


ATA 34/22 2 B737 - 3-4-500 Revision 1 08.12.03
FOR TRAINING PURPOSSES ONLY
FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE

and Systems Introduction


B737 - 3-4-500 Revision 1 08.12.03 ATA 34/22 3
FOR TRAINING PURPOSSES ONLY
FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE

and Systems Introduction


ATA 34/22 4 B737 - 3-4-500 Revision 1 08.12.03
FOR TRAINING PURPOSSES ONLY
FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE

and Systems Introduction


B737 - 3-4-500 Revision 1 08.12.03 ATA 34/22 5
FOR TRAINING PURPOSSES ONLY
FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE

and Systems Introduction


B737 - 3-4-500 Revision 1 08.12.03 ATA 34/22 7
FOR TRAINING PURPOSSES ONLY
FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE

and Systems Introduction


ATA 34/22 8 B737 - 3-4-500 Revision 1 08.12.03
FOR TRAINING PURPOSSES ONLY
FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE

and Systems Introduction


B737 - 3-4-500 Revision 1 08.12.03 ATA 34/22 9
FOR TRAINING PURPOSSES ONLY
FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE

and Systems Introduction


ATA 34/22 10 B737 - 3-4-500 Revision 1 08.12.03
FOR TRAINING PURPOSSES ONLY
FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE

and Systems Introduction


B737 - 3-4-500 Revision 1 08.12.03 ATA 34/22 11
FOR TRAINING PURPOSSES ONLY
FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE

and Systems Introduction


B737 - 3-4-500 Revision 1 08.12.03 ATA 34/22 13
FOR TRAINING PURPOSSES ONLY
FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE

and Systems Introduction


ATA 34/22 14 B737 - 3-4-500 Revision 1 08.12.03
FOR TRAINING PURPOSSES ONLY
FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE

and Systems Introduction


B737 - 3-4-500 Revision 1 08.12.03 ATA 34/22 15
FOR TRAINING PURPOSSES ONLY
FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE

and Systems Introduction


ATA 34/22 16 B737 - 3-4-500 Revision 1 08.12.03
FOR TRAINING PURPOSSES ONLY
FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE

and Systems Introduction


B737 - 3-4-500 Revision 1 08.12.03 ATA 34/22 17
FOR TRAINING PURPOSSES ONLY
FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE

and Systems Introduction


ATA 34/22 18 B737 - 3-4-500 Revision 1 08.12.03
FOR TRAINING PURPOSSES ONLY
FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE

and Systems Introduction


B737 - 3-4-500 Revision 1 08.12.03 ATA 34/22 19
FO R TR PURPOSSES ONLY
AININGFAMILIARIZATION
B737 GENERAL COURSE

and Systems Introduction


ATA 34/22 20
FOR TRAINING PURPOSSES ONLY
FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE

and Systems Introduction


B737 - 3-4-500 Revision 1 08.12.03 ATA 34/22 21
FOR TRAINING PURPOSSES ONLY
FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE

and Systems Introduction


ATA 34/22 22 B737 - 3-4-500 Revision 1 08.12.03
FOR TRAINING PURPOSSES ONLY
FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE

and Systems Introduction


ATA 34/22 28 B737 - 3-4-500 Revision 1 08.12.03
FOR TRAINING PURPOSSES ONLY
FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE

and Systems Introduction


B737 - 3-4-500 Revision 1 08.12.03 ATA 34/22 29
FOR TRAINING PURPOSSES ONLY
FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE

and Systems Introduction


ATA 34/22 34 B737 - 3-4-500 Revision 1 08.12.03
FOR TRAINING PURPOSSES ONLY
FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE

and Systems Introduction


B737 - 3-4-500 Revision 1 08.12.03 ATA 34/22 35
FOR TRAINING PURPOSSES ONLY
FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE

and Systems Introduction


ATA 34/22 36 B737 - 3-4-500 Revision 1 08.12.03
FOR TRAINING PURPOSSES ONLY
FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE

and Systems Introduction

B737 - 3-4-500 Revision 1 08.12.03 ATA 34/22 37


FOR TRAINING PURPOSSES ONLY
FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE

and Systems Introduction


ATA 34/22 38 B737 - 3-4-500 Revision 1 08.12.03
FOR TRAINING PURPOSSES ONLY
FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE

and Systems Introduction


ATA 34/22 46 B737 - 3-4-500 Revision 1 08.12.03
FOR TRAINING PURPOSSES ONLY
FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE

and Systems Introduction


B737 - 3-4-500 Revision 1 08.12.03 ATA 34/22 47
FOR TRAINING PURPOSSES ONLY
FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE

and Systems Introduction


B737
B7373-4-500
- 3-4-500
B2 Revision
Revision12 08.12.03
20.04.04 ATA 77/ 1
FOR TRAINING PURPOSSES ONLY
FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE

and Systems Introduction


ATA 77/ 2 B737
B7373-4-500
- 3-4-500
B2 Revision
Revision12 08.12.03
20.04.04
FOR TRAINING PURPOSSES ONLY
FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE

and Systems Introduction


B737
B7373-4-500
- 3-4-500
B2 Revision
Revision12 08.12.03
20.04.04 ATA 77/ 3
FOR TRAINING PURPOSSES ONLY
FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE

and Systems Introduction


ATA 77/ 4 B737
B7373-4-500
- 3-4-500
B2 Revision
Revision12 08.12.03
20.04.04
FOR TRAINING PURPOSSES ONLY
FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE

and Systems Introduction

B737
B7373-4-500
- 3-4-500
B2 Revision
Revision12 08.12.03
20.04.04 ATA 77/ 5
FOR TRAINING PURPOSSES ONLY
FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE

and Systems Introduction


ATA 77/ 6 B737
B7373-4-500
- 3-4-500
B2 Revision
Revision12 08.12.03
20.04.04
FOR TRAINING PURPOSSES ONLY
FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE

and Systems Introduction


B737
B7373-4-500
- 3-4-500
B2 Revision
Revision12 08.12.03
20.04.04 ATA 77/ 7
FOR TRAINING PURPOSSES ONLY
FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE

and Systems Introduction


ATA 77/ 8 B737
B7373-4-500
- 3-4-500
B2 Revision
Revision12 08.12.03
20.04.04
FOR TRAINING PURPOSSES ONLY
FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE

and Systems Introduction

B737
B7373-4-500
- 3-4-500
B2 Revision
Revision12 08.12.03
20.04.04 ATA 77/ 9
FOR TRAINING PURPOSSES ONLY
FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE

and Systems Introduction


ATA 77/ 10 B737
B7373-4-500
- 3-4-500
B2 Revision
Revision12 08.12.03
20.04.04
FOR TRAINING PURPOSSES ONLY
FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE

and Systems Introduction

B737
B7373-4-500
- 3-4-500
B2 Revision
Revision12 08.12.03
20.04.04 ATA 77/ 11
FOR TRAINING PURPOSSES ONLY
FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE

and Systems Introduction


ATA 34/22 12 B737 - 3-4-500 Revision 1 08.12.03
UNITED AIRLINES COURSE
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
INSTRUMENTS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE INSTRUMENTS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
TABLE OF CONTENTS TABLE OF CONTENTS

DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION


CLOCKS ......................................................................................................31-1 CLOCKS ...................................................................................................... 31-1
Clock Displays .......................................................................................31-2 Clock Displays....................................................................................... 31-2
Upper Display ........................................................................................31-2 Upper Display........................................................................................ 31-2
GMT Switch...........................................................................................31-2 GMT Switch .......................................................................................... 31-2
Bottom Display ......................................................................................31-3 Bottom Display...................................................................................... 31-3
ET Switch...............................................................................................31-3 ET Switch .............................................................................................. 31-3
CHR Switch ...........................................................................................31-3 CHR Switch ........................................................................................... 31-3
AURAL WARNING SYSTEM ..................................................................31-5 AURAL WARNING SYSTEM .................................................................. 31-5
Aural Warning Devices Unit .................................................................31-5 Aural Warning Devices Unit ................................................................. 31-5
Priority Sound ........................................................................................31-5 Priority Sound........................................................................................ 31-5
DIGITAL FLIGHT DATA RECORDER SYSTEM................................31-6 DIGITAL FLIGHT DATA RECORDER SYSTEM ............................... 31-6
Flight Data Acquisition Unit..................................................................31-7 Flight Data Acquisition Unit ................................................................. 31-7
Digital Flight Data Recorder .................................................................31-8 Digital Flight Data Recorder ................................................................ 31-8
Accelerometer ........................................................................................31-9 Accelerometer........................................................................................ 31-9
Flight Recorder & Mach/Airspeed Warning Test Module ...................31-10 Flight Recorder & Mach/Airspeed Warning Test Module ................... 31-10
CONTROLS & INDICATIONS CONTROLS & INDICATIONS
CLOCK.........................................................................................................31-11 CLOCK ........................................................................................................ 31-11
FLIGHT RECORDER................................................................................31-12 FLIGHT RECORDER................................................................................ 31-12
COMPONENT LOCATIONS COMPONENT LOCATIONS
Instruments Component Locations ........................................................31-13 Instruments Component Locations ........................................................ 31-13

and
OCT 99 Systems Introduction 31-i OCT 99 31-i
UNITED AIRLINES COURSE
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
INSTRUMENTS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE INSTRUMENTS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

CLOCKS 28 VDC hot battery bus. Power for the CLOCKS 28 VDC hot battery bus. Power for the
The Captain's and First Officer's instru- displays comes from the 28VDC battery The Captain's and First Officer's instru- displays comes from the 28VDC battery
ment panels each contains one electronic bus. Each clock and the display of each ment panels each contains one electronic bus. Each clock and the display of each
clock. The Captain's clock transmits clock operate when the CLOCKS and clock. The Captain's clock transmits clock operate when the CLOCKS and
Greenwich Mean Time (GMT) data to the CLOCKS DISPLAY circuit breakers on Greenwich Mean Time (GMT) data to the CLOCKS DISPLAY circuit breakers on
flight management computer (FMC). The the P6 load control center are closed. flight management computer (FMC). The the P6 load control center are closed.
clocks receive operating power from the clocks receive operating power from the

CHR DATE CHR DATE

60 60
28V DC DAY MO/YR 28V DC DAY MO/YR
HOT BAT. 50 HOT BAT. 50
BUS 0 BUS 0
GMT
FLIGHT GMT
FLIGHT
MANAGEMENT MANAGEMENT
ET/CHR COMPUTER ET/CHR COMPUTER
40 20 40 20
28V DC RUN
30 RUN 28V DC RUN
30 RUN

BATTERY HLD T HLD BATTERY HLD T HLD


ET

ET
M M SS
G SS G
BUS RESET
FS BUS RESET
FS

CAPTAIN'S CLOCK CAPTAIN'S CLOCK

CHR DATE CHR DATE

60 60
DAY MO/YR DAY MO/YR

50 0 50 0
GMT GMT
ET/CHR ET/CHR

40 20 40 20
RUN RUN RUN RUN
30 T HLD
30 T HLD
HLD HLD
ET

ET
M M SS
G SS G
FS FS
RESET RESET

FIRST OFFICER'S CLOCK FIRST OFFICER'S CLOCK

Clock System Clock System

and
OCT 99 Systems Introduction 31-1 OCT 99 31-1
UNITED
B737 GENERAL AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
INSTRUMENTS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE INSTRUMENTS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

CHR DATE CHR DATE CHR DATE CHR DATE

60 60 60 60
DAY MO/YR DAY MO/YR DAY MO/YR DAY MO/YR

50 0 50 0 50 0 50 0
GMT GMT GMT GMT
ET/CHR ET/CHR ET/CHR ET/CHR

40 20 40 20 40 20 40 20
RUN RUN RUN RUN RUN RUN RUN RUN
30 T HLD
30 T HLD
30 T HLD
30 T HLD
HLD HLD HLD HLD
ET

ET

ET

ET
M M M M
G SS G SS G SS G SS
FS FS FS FS
RESET RESET RESET RESET

CAPTAIN'S CLOCK FIRST OFFICER'S CLOCK CAPTAIN'S CLOCK FIRST OFFICER'S CLOCK
P/N 2600-03-1 P/N2610-07-1 P/N 2600-03-1 P/N2610-07-1

Clock Displays GMT. Setting the switch to this position Clock Displays GMT. Setting the switch to this position
Each clock has a display for the GMT, a will hold the display at its present indi- Each clock has a display for the GMT, a will hold the display at its present indi-
display for the Elapsed Time (ET)/Chro- cated value. The internal circuits of the display for the Elapsed Time (ET)/Chro- cated value. The internal circuits of the
nograph (CHR) functions, and a sweep clock will stop until the switch is set back nograph (CHR) functions, and a sweep clock will stop until the switch is set back
second hand. The upper display on each to. RUN. The HLD function is useful for second hand. The upper display on each to. RUN. The HLD function is useful for
clock shows GMT. The bottom display synchronizing the clock with another time clock shows GMT. The bottom display synchronizing the clock with another time
shows elapsed time and chronograph time. source. The SS (slow slew) setting is used shows elapsed time and chronograph time. source. The SS (slow slew) setting is used
The sweep second hand shows CHR sec- for slow slew operation. When set to this The sweep second hand shows CHR sec- for slow slew operation. When set to this
onds. position, the minute display advances at a onds. position, the minute display advances at a
Upper Display rate of 1 minute in each second. The hours Upper Display rate of 1 minute in each second. The hours
The upper display provides GMT display display is stopped. The FS (fast slew) set- The upper display provides GMT display display is stopped. The FS (fast slew) set-
continuously from 00 hours 00 minutes to ting is used for fast slew operation. When continuously from 00 hours 00 minutes to ting is used for fast slew operation. When
23 hours 59 minutes. The GMT display is in this position, the hours display 23 hours 59 minutes. The GMT display is in this position, the hours display
controlled by the GMT switch located in advances at a rate of 1 hour in each sec- controlled by the GMT switch located in advances at a rate of 1 hour in each sec-
the lower right corner of the clock. ond. The minutes display is stopped. the lower right corner of the clock. ond. The minutes display is stopped.
GMT Switch On airplanes with P/N 2610-07-1 clocks; GMT Switch On airplanes with P/N 2610-07-1 clocks;
The GMT switch controls the GMT dis- The top display also functions as a date The GMT switch controls the GMT dis- The top display also functions as a date
play. The RUN position is the normal display. When the DATE button on the play. The RUN position is the normal display. When the DATE button on the
operating position for the clock, the GMT clock is pushed, the date will come into operating position for the clock, the GMT clock is pushed, the date will come into
operates normally while in this mode. The view. When the DATE button is pushed operates normally while in this mode. The view. When the DATE button is pushed
HLD (hold) position is used to stop the again, the top display will switch back to HLD (hold) position is used to stop the again, the top display will switch back to

31-2 and Systems Introduction OCT 99 31-2 OCT 99


UNITED AIRLINES COURSE
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
INSTRUMENTS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE INSTRUMENTS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

the GMT. When the date is displayed, the CHR Switch the GMT. When the date is displayed, the CHR Switch
GMT switch controls the setting of the The CHR switch is located in the upper GMT switch controls the setting of the The CHR switch is located in the upper
date. The date control functions are D, M, left corner. The first press of the switch date. The date control functions are D, M, left corner. The first press of the switch
and Y, which are in the same position as starts the chronograph running. A second and Y, which are in the same position as starts the chronograph running. A second
the FS, SS, and HLD settings. The D set- press of the switch stops the chronograph the FS, SS, and HLD settings. The D set- press of the switch stops the chronograph
ting is used for changing the day display. at the current displayed value. A third ting is used for changing the day display. at the current displayed value. A third
When in this position, the day display press of the switch resets the CHR accu- When in this position, the day display press of the switch resets the CHR accu-
advances at a rate of 1 day in each second. mulator to zero. The contents of the ET advances at a rate of 1 day in each second. mulator to zero. The contents of the ET
The M setting is used for changing the accumulator is then displayed. If the ET The M setting is used for changing the accumulator is then displayed. If the ET
month display. When in this position, the accumulator contains zero, the elapsed month display. When in this position, the accumulator contains zero, the elapsed
month display advances at a rate of 1 time display is blanked with the sweep month display advances at a rate of 1 time display is blanked with the sweep
month in each second up to a maximum second hand to zero. Chronograph opera- month in each second up to a maximum second hand to zero. Chronograph opera-
value of 12. The Y setting is used for tion replaces the display of the elapsed value of 12. The Y setting is used for tion replaces the display of the elapsed
changing the year display. When in this time, but does not affect the internal oper- changing the year display. When in this time, but does not affect the internal oper-
position, the year display advances at a ation of the ET accumulator. position, the year display advances at a ation of the ET accumulator.
rate of 1 year in each second up to a maxi- rate of 1 year in each second up to a maxi-
mum value of 99. mum value of 99.
Bottom Display Bottom Display
The bottom display provides elapsed time The bottom display provides elapsed time
(ET) from 00 hours 00 minutes to 99 hours (ET) from 00 hours 00 minutes to 99 hours
59 minutes and chronographic time (CHR) 59 minutes and chronographic time (CHR)
from 00 minutes to 99 minutes. (The from 00 minutes to 99 minutes. (The
sweep second hand shows the seconds for sweep second hand shows the seconds for
chronographic time.) control of this dis- chronographic time.) control of this dis-
play is provided by the ET and CHR play is provided by the ET and CHR
switches. switches.
ET Switch ET Switch
The elapsed time (ET) control switch is The elapsed time (ET) control switch is
located in the lower left corner of the located in the lower left corner of the
clock. In the RESET position, the ET dis- clock. In the RESET position, the ET dis-
play is blanked and the elapsed time indi- play is blanked and the elapsed time indi-
cation is set to zero. The RESET position cation is set to zero. The RESET position
is spring loaded to return the switch to the is spring loaded to return the switch to the
HLD position. The HLD (hold) position of HLD position. The HLD (hold) position of
the switch freezes the current ET display. the switch freezes the current ET display.
In the RUN position, time is accumulated In the RUN position, time is accumulated
from the last hold or reset condition. The from the last hold or reset condition. The
display advances from this value. display advances from this value.

and
OCT 99 Systems Introduction 31-3 OCT 99 31-3
UNITED
B737 GENERAL AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
INSTRUMENTS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE INSTRUMENTS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

AURAL WARN
AURAL WARN BATT BUS
BATT BUS
VOLTAGE REG 17V DC
VOLTAGE REG 17V DC
HI CHIME 28V DC TO PWR AMPL
HI CHIME 28V DC TO PWR AMPL CAPT CALL FROM
CAPT CALL FROM FWD ATTENDANT
FWD ATTENDANT AFT ATTENDANT HI
AFT ATTENDANT HI EXT PWR PNL CHIME
EXT PWR PNL CHIME

HI- LO CHIME
HI- LO CHIME SELCAL TONE RECEIVED AMPL
SELCAL TONE RECEIVED AMPL
0.5 LO
0.5 LO TIME CHIME
TIME CHIME INTERMITTENT HORN DELAY
INTERMITTENT HORN DELAY AIRPLANE IN FLIGHT - LOSS OF
AIRPLANE IN FLIGHT - LOSS OF CABIN PRESSURE
CABIN PRESSURE AIRPLANE ON GROUND WITH EITHER
AIRPLANE ON GROUND WITH EITHER TRHOTTLE ADVANCED WHEN:
TRHOTTLE ADVANCED WHEN: (1) SPEED BRAKES NOT DOWN
(1) SPEED BRAKES NOT DOWN (2) STABILIZER NOT IN GREEN BAND
(2) STABILIZER NOT IN GREEN BAND (3) FLAPS NOT IN TAKEOFF RANGE MULTI
(3) FLAPS NOT IN TAKEOFF RANGE MULTI (4) LE FLAPS NOT EXTENDED HORN DRIVER
HORN VIBRATOR OSC
(4) LE FLAPS NOT EXTENDED VIBRATOR DRIVER 2/SEC
OSC
2/SEC

STEADY HORN
STEADY HORN GEAR NOT DOWN & LOCKED WITH:
GEAR NOT DOWN & LOCKED WITH: *(1) FLAPS IN POSITION BETWEEN
*(1) FLAPS IN POSITION BETWEEN 1 AND 15 AND EITHER THRUST
1 AND 15 AND EITHER THRUST MODULE A2
MODULE A2 LEVER IN IDLE
LEVER IN IDLE (2) FLAPS IN POSITION 15 AND
(2) FLAPS IN POSITION 15 AND BOTH THRUST LEVERS LESS POWER
BOTH THRUST LEVERS LESS POWER THAN 30 DEGREES AMPL
THAN 30 DEGREES AMPL (3) FLAPS GREATER THAN 15 AND
(3) FLAPS GREATER THAN 15 AND THRUST LEVERS IN ANY
THRUST LEVERS IN ANY POSITION
POSITION
* SILENCEABLE BY HORN CUTOUT
* SILENCEABLE BY HORN CUTOUT SWITCH
SWITCH SPEAKER
SPEAKER

CLACKER
CLACKER 28V DC
28V DC

CLACKER
CLACKER MACH AIRPSPEED WARN
MACH AIRPSPEED WARN ING WHEN LIMITS EXCEDED
ING WHEN LIMITS EXCEDED
1 8/SEC
1 8/SEC BELL
BELL FIRE ALARM: WHEN ENGINES
FIRE ALARM: WHEN ENGINES 1 OR 2 400 DEGREES ELEMENT
1 OR 2 400 DEGREES ELEMENT OR 750 DEGREES ELEMENT 22
OR 750 DEGREES ELEMENT 22 IS GROUNDED, WHEN APU OR
IS GROUNDED, WHEN APU OR WHEEL WELL 400 DEGREES
WHEEL WELL 400 DEGREES ELEMENT IS GROUNDED MULTI
ELEMENT IS GROUNDED MULTI VIBRATOR GATE
VIBRATOR GATE 60/SEC
60/SEC 1
1 BELL
BELL
MODULE A2
MODULE A2 28V DC
28V DC

AURAL WARNING DEVICES BOX (M315)


AURAL WARNING DEVICES BOX (M315)
1 ALL AIRPLANES EXCEPT THOSE WITH 65-5499-7, -12, -15 AWM
1 ALL AIRPLANES EXCEPT THOSE WITH 65-5499-7, -12, -15 AWM
2 AIRPLANES WITH 65-5499-7, -12, -15 AWM
2 AIRPLANES WITH 65-5499-7, -12, -15 AWM

Aural Warning System Aural Warning System

31-4 and Systems Introduction OCT 99 31-4 OCT 99


UNITED AIRLINES COURSE
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
INSTRUMENTS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE INSTRUMENTS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

AURAL WARNING SYSTEM A priority is established within certain cir- AURAL WARNING SYSTEM A priority is established within certain cir-
The control cabin aural warning system cuits to prevent different sounds from The control cabin aural warning system cuits to prevent different sounds from
provides characteristic audio signals to occurring at the same time and becoming provides characteristic audio signals to occurring at the same time and becoming
alert the pilots to; an abnormal takeoff garbled. The clacker and bell are not in the alert the pilots to; an abnormal takeoff garbled. The clacker and bell are not in the
condition, landing condition, pressuriza- priority circuits; therefore, they may oper- condition, landing condition, pressuriza- priority circuits; therefore, they may oper-
tion condition, mach/airspeed condition, ate with each other or with any of the other tion condition, mach/airspeed condition, ate with each other or with any of the other
an engine, APU, or wheel well fire, and sounds. Those sounds in the following pri- an engine, APU, or wheel well fire, and sounds. Those sounds in the following pri-
calls from the crew call or SELCAL sys- ority list will be turned off by control cir- calls from the crew call or SELCAL sys- ority list will be turned off by control cir-
tems. The aural warning and call devices cuits of sounds in a higher priority. tems. The aural warning and call devices cuits of sounds in a higher priority.
are installed in an aural warning devices Priority Sound are installed in an aural warning devices Priority Sound
unit. The unit is on the right side of the 1 Intermittent Horn unit. The unit is on the right side of the 1 Intermittent Horn
forward section of the control stand in the 2 Steady (Continuous) Horn forward section of the control stand in the 2 Steady (Continuous) Horn
control cabin. 3 Wailer control cabin. 3 Wailer
NOTE: The aural warning devices unit 4 Buzzer (if used) NOTE: The aural warning devices unit 4 Buzzer (if used)
is also referred to as the aural warning is also referred to as the aural warning
devices box. devices box.
Inputs to the aural warning devices unit Inputs to the aural warning devices unit
are from: the flight and ground crew call are from: the flight and ground crew call
and SELCAL systems (Chapter 23), the and SELCAL systems (Chapter 23), the
mach-airspeed warning system (Chapter mach-airspeed warning system (Chapter
34), the engine, APU and wheel well fire 34), the engine, APU and wheel well fire
detection systems (Chapter 26), cabin alti- detection systems (Chapter 26), cabin alti-
tude warning system (Chapter 21), the tude warning system (Chapter 21), the
takeoff warning system (Chapter 27), and takeoff warning system (Chapter 27), and
the landing gear warning system (Chapter FORWARD ELEX the landing gear warning system (Chapter FORWARD ELEX
32). SECTION CONTROL 32). SECTION CONTROL
STAND STAND
The intermittent takeoff warn horn will The intermittent takeoff warn horn will
sound when the airplane is in a takeoff sound when the airplane is in a takeoff
configuration, thrust levers are advanced configuration, thrust levers are advanced
into takeoff range, and the parking brakes into takeoff range, and the parking brakes
are engaged (not released). are engaged (not released).
Aural Warning Devices Unit Aural Warning Devices Unit
The aural warning devices box contains The aural warning devices box contains
solid state horn, chime, logic and oscilla- solid state horn, chime, logic and oscilla-
tor circuits, mounted on a printed circuit tor circuits, mounted on a printed circuit
board (module A2), which provide the board (module A2), which provide the
horn audio and chime audio to a loud- horn audio and chime audio to a loud-
speaker whenever the appropriate circuits speaker whenever the appropriate circuits
are keyed. A second printed circuit board are keyed. A second printed circuit board
contains the oscillators and solid-state FWD
contains the oscillators and solid-state FWD
switching circuits used with a mechanical switching circuits used with a mechanical
bell and clacker (module A1). bell and clacker (module A1).
Aural Warning Device Unit Aural Warning Device Unit

and
OCT 99 Systems Introduction 31-5 OCT 99 31-5
UNITED
B737 GENERAL AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
INSTRUMENTS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE INSTRUMENTS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

DIGITAL FLIGHT DATA The system consists of; a Flight Data DIGITAL FLIGHT DATA The system consists of; a Flight Data
RECORDER SYSTEM Acquisition Unit (FDAU), a Flight Data RECORDER SYSTEM Acquisition Unit (FDAU), a Flight Data
The flight data recording system digitally Recorder (FDR) with an underwater loca- The flight data recording system digitally Recorder (FDR) with an underwater loca-
records selected signals received from tor beacon, an accelerometer, and the records selected signals received from var- tor beacon, an accelerometer, and the
various aircraft systems and sensors. The Flight Data Recorder and Mach/Airspeed ious aircraft systems and sensors. The last Flight Data Recorder and Mach/Airspeed
last 25 hours of aircraft operation are Warning Test Module. 25 hours of aircraft operation are recorded Warning Test Module.
recorded on magnetic tape in the Flight The system is turned on automatically on magnetic tape in the Flight Data The system is turned on automatically
Data Recorder (FDR), while the Flight when the airplane is in flight or when any Recorder (FDR), while the Flight Data when the airplane is in flight or when any
Data Acquisition Unit (FDAU) records engine is running. Acquisition Unit (FDAU) records the last engine is running.
the last 50 hours on a diskette. 50 hours on a diskette.

OFF LIGHT
OFF LIGHT
TEST
TEST
MASTER
MASTER CAUTION/MACH
CAUTION/MACH DATA
DATA AIRSPEED
AIRSPEED MODULE
MODULE PLAYBACK
PLAYBACK

DIGITAL
DIGITAL FLIGHT DATA
FLIGHT DATA DIGITAL RECORDER
DIGITAL RECORDER FLIGHT DATA
FLIGHT DATA ACQUISITION
ACQUISITION ANALOG UNIT
ANALOG UNIT FLIGHT TEST
FLIGHT TEST CONNECTOR
CONNECTOR DATA
DATA

DIGITAL ACARS
DIGITAL ACARS MU
MU FLIGHT
FLIGHT DATA
DATA

Flight Data Recorder System Flight Data Recorder System

31-6 and Systems Introduction OCT 99 31-6 OCT 99


UNITED AIRLINES COURSE
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
INSTRUMENTS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE INSTRUMENTS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

Flight Data Acquisition Unit The FDAU may request, receive, and store Flight Data Acquisition Unit The FDAU may request, receive, and store
The Flight Data Acquisition Unit (FDAU) data from the ACARS Management Unit The Flight Data Acquisition Unit (FDAU) data from the ACARS Management Unit
processes and prepares all input signals for (MU), or may be requested to downlink processes and prepares all input signals for (MU), or may be requested to downlink
recording by the Flight Data Recorder data to the ACARS MU. recording by the Flight Data Recorder data to the ACARS MU.
(FDR). Electronic circuits, in the FDAU The front panel has a LED status display, (FDR). Electronic circuits, in the FDAU The front panel has a LED status display,
provide isolation, signal preconditioning, nameplate, a test set plug, and a self-clos- provide isolation, signal preconditioning, nameplate, a test set plug, and a self-clos-
multiplexing, scaling, synchronization, ing door that provides access for loading multiplexing, scaling, synchronization, ing door that provides access for loading
and converting the various input signal and removing the diskette. The test set and converting the various input signal and removing the diskette. The test set
forms to a digital format. Selected signals plug is provided for external test equip- forms to a digital format. Selected signals plug is provided for external test equip-
are then sent to the FDR for recording. ment connection. The LED status display are then sent to the FDR for recording. ment connection. The LED status display
Information is also sent to the ACARS provides four BITE indicator lights; Information is also sent to the ACARS provides four BITE indicator lights;
system. The FDAU is located in the E2-1 DFDAU BITE, DFDR BITE, AIDS BITE, system. The FDAU is located in the E2-1 DFDAU BITE, DFDR BITE, AIDS BITE,
rack. and REPLACE DISK. The BITE displays rack. and REPLACE DISK. The BITE displays
NOTE: The FDAU is also referred to as are actuated by pressing the front panel NOTE: The FDAU is also referred to as are actuated by pressing the front panel
the DFDAU (Digital Flight Data Acqui- STATUS button. Failure indications are the DFDAU (Digital Flight Data Acqui- STATUS button. Failure indications are
sition Unit). sent to the Flight Recorder and Mach/Air- sition Unit). sent to the Flight Recorder and Mach/Air-
speed Warning Test Module in the P5 speed Warning Test Module in the P5
panel. panel.

BITE AIR TUBE BITE AIR TUBE


INDICATOR INDICATOR
PANEL PANEL

FDAU DFDR AIDS DISK STATUS FDAU DFDR AIDS DISK STATUS
BITE BITE BITE MAINT DISPLAY BITE BITE BITE MAINT DISPLAY

JI JI
RTE RTE

DISK ACCESS DISK ACCESS

OPERATING LOCKED OPERATING LOCKED

OPEN OPEN

3.5'' DISK ACCESS 3.5'' DISK ACCESS

Flight Data Acquisition Unit Flight Data Acquisition Unit

and
OCT 99 Systems Introduction 31-7 OCT 99 31-7
UNITED
B737 GENERAL AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
INSTRUMENTS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE INSTRUMENTS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

Digital Flight Data Recorder Digital Flight Data Recorder


The Digital Flight Data Recorder (FDR) The Digital Flight Data Recorder (FDR)
stores data for the last 25 hours of flight stores data for the last 25 hours of flight on
on a 1/4 inch magnetic tape. The front a 1/4 inch magnetic tape. The front panel
panel of the FDR has a test connector and of the FDR has a test connector and an
an Underwater Locator Beacon (ULB). Underwater Locator Beacon (ULB). The
The test connector is for attaching a porta- test connector is for attaching a portable
ble tester or copy recorder. The ULB is a tester or copy recorder. The ULB is a
water activated device used to locate the water activated device used to locate the
FDR underwater. The FDR is located in FDR underwater. The FDR is located in
the passenger cabin ceiling inboard of the the passenger cabin ceiling inboard of the
forward sill of the 2L entry door. forward sill of the 2L entry door.

UNDERWATER UNDERWATER
LOCATOR LOCATOR
BEACON BEACON

Flight Data Recorder Flight Data Recorder

31-8 and Systems Introduction OCT 99 31-8 OCT 99


UNITED AIRLINES COURSE
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
INSTRUMENTS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE INSTRUMENTS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

Accelerometer Accelerometer
The 3 axis accelerometer senses vertical, The 3 axis accelerometer senses vertical,
lateral, and longitudinal acceleration lateral, and longitudinal acceleration
forces. It receives its excitation from the forces. It receives its excitation from the
FDAU. It is a self contained sealed unit FDAU. It is a self contained sealed unit
mounted on the aft side of the right wheel mounted on the aft side of the right wheel
well forward bulkhead, just forward of the well forward bulkhead, just forward of the
B system reservoir. B system reservoir.

SCREWS
SCREWS

ACCELEROMETER
ACCELEROMETER MOUNTED ON SHELF
MOUNTED ON SHELF RIGHT WHEEL WELL
RIGHT WHEEL WELL FORWARD BULKHEAD
FORWARD BULKHEAD

Accelerometer Accelerometer

and
OCT 99 Systems Introduction 31-9 OCT 99 31-9
UNITED
B737 GENERAL AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
INSTRUMENTS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE INSTRUMENTS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

Flight Recorder & Mach/Airspeed Flight Recorder & Mach/Airspeed


Warning Test Module Warning Test Module
The Flight Recorder test module has a The Flight Recorder test module has a
TEST/NORMAL switch and an amber TEST/NORMAL switch and an amber
OFF light. The switch is guarded in the OFF light. The switch is guarded in the
NORMAL position. This switch is used to NORMAL position. This switch is used to
operate the FDR system without starting operate the FDR system without starting
engines. The OFF light will not be illumi- engines. The OFF light will not be illumi-
nated if the FDR is in operation or the nated if the FDR is in operation or the
FDR is not installed. The OFF light will FDR is not installed. The OFF light will
be illuminated if the FDR senses a AC be illuminated if the FDR senses a AC
power loss, the BITE OUT line from the power loss, the BITE OUT line from the
FDAU senses a BITE failure, or the Mas- FDAU senses a BITE failure, or the Mas-
ter Test switch is in the TEST position. ter Test switch is in the TEST position.
The module is located in the right side of The module is located in the right side of
the P5 aft overhead panel. the P5 aft overhead panel.

FLIGHT RECORDER FLIGHT RECORDER

TEST NORMAL TEST NORMAL

OFF OFF

Flight Recorder Test Module Flight Recorder Test Module

31-10 and Systems Introduction OCT 99 31-10 OCT 99


UNITED AIRLINES COURSE
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
INSTRUMENTS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE INSTRUMENTS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
CONTROLS & INDICATIONS CONTROLS & INDICATIONS

CLOCK CLOCK
Location: Captain and F/O Instrument Panel DATE Button (as installed) Location: Captain and F/O Instrument Panel DATE Button (as installed)
Allows display and changing of date Allows display and changing of date
CHR Button (Chronograph) CHR Button (Chronograph) in GMT window.
in GMT window.
Stops, starts and resets the CHR Stops, starts and resets the CHR
indicator and sweep second hand indicator and sweep second hand
with successive pushes. Overrides Sweep Second Hand with successive pushes. Overrides Sweep Second Hand
ET indicator. Indicates elapsed time from 1 to 59 ET indicator. Indicates elapsed time from 1 to 59
seconds when CHR button is pushed seconds when CHR button is pushed to
to start timing. start timing.

GMT Indicator GMT Indicator


Indicates Greenwich Mean Indicates Greenwich Mean Time
CHR DATE Time in 24 hour format. Time in 24 hour format. Time is input
DATE
is input to both the FMC and CHR to both the FMC and the flight
60 the flight recorder from the recorder from the Captain’s
DAY MO/YR Captain’s clock. 60 clock.
DAY MO/YR
50 0 GMT Selector 50 GMT Selector
0
GMT RUN - Starts GMT indi- RUN - Starts GMT indica-
GMT
cator. Continues to count tor. Continues to count
ET/CHR
from HLD time when ET/CHR from HLD time when rese-
40 20 reselected from HLD. lected from HLD.
HLD - Stops GMT indi- 40 20 HLD - Stops GMT indica-
RUN RUN cator and input to FMC tor and input to FMC and
30 RUN
30 RUN
flight recorder.
HLD T HLD and flight recorder. T HLD
ET

M HLD
G SS SS - Sets seconds to zero SS - Sets seconds to zero

ET
M SS
FS G
RESET
and advances hours. RESET
FS
and advances hours.
FS - Freezes minutes and FS - Freezes minutes and
advances hours advances hours

ET/CHR Indicator ET/CHR Indicator


ET Selector (Elapsed Time) ET Selector (Elapsed Time)
ET - Indicates elapsed time from 0 ET - Indicates elapsed time from 0
RUN - Starts ET indicator. Con- RUN - Starts ET indicator. Con-
to 99 hours and 59 minutes since ET to 99 hours and 59 minutes since
tinues to count from HLD time tinues to count from HLD time
selector was moved to RUN. ET selector was moved to RUN.
when reselected from HLD. when reselected from HLD.
CHR - Indicates elapsed time from CHR - Indicates elapsed time from
HLD - Stops ET indicator at HLD - Stops ET indicator at
0 to 99 minutes 59 seconds when 0 to 99 minutes 59 seconds when
existing time. existing time.
CHR button is pushed to start time. CHR button is pushed to start
RESET - Returns the ET display RESET - Returns the ET display
Overrides ET. ET returns when time. Overrides ET. ET returns
to zero time. to zero time.
CHR is reset when CHR is reset

and
OCT 99 Systems Introduction 31-11 OCT 99 31-11
UNITED
B737 GENERAL AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
INSTRUMENTS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE INSTRUMENTS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
CONTROLS & INDICATIONS CONTROLS & INDICATIONS

FLIGHT RECORDER FLIGHT RECORDER


Location: Aft Overhead Panel Location: Aft Overhead Panel

FLIGHT RECORDER FLIGHT RECORDER

TEST NORMAL
TEST NORMAL
Flight Recorder OFF Flight Recorder OFF
OFF Light Light
OFF Indicates recorder power is
Indicates recorder power is
off or tape malfunction.I off or tape malfunction.I

Flight Recorder Test Switch Flight Recorder Test Switch


TEST - Tests recorder operation by apply- TEST - Tests recorder operation by apply-
ing electrical power when airplane is on ing electrical power when airplane is on
the ground and neither engine is running. the ground and neither engine is running.
NORMAL - Allows norma operation of NORMAL - Allows norma operation of
flight recorder. Recorder is on when either flight recorder. Recorder is on when either
engine is running or when the airplane is engine is running or when the airplane is
in flight. in flight.

31-12 and Systems Introduction OCT 99 31-12 OCT 99


UNITED AIRLINES COURSE
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
INSTRUMENTS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE INSTRUMENTS AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
COMPONENT LOCATIONS COMPONENT LOCATIONS

DIGITAL FLIGHT
DIGITAL FLIGHT DATA RECORDER
DATA RECORDER

ACCELEROMETER
ACCELEROMETER (AFT SIDE OF RIGHT
(AFT SIDE OF RIGHT WHEEL WELL FORWARD
WHEEL WELL FORWARD BULKHEAD)
BULKHEAD)

3
1
1
2
2 3
1
3 4
2
1
3
2
3 4
1
4
2

FDAU DFDR AIDS DISK STATUS


BITE BITE BITE MAINT DISPLAY
FDAU DFDR AIDS DISK STATUS
BITE BITE BITE MAINT DISPLAY

JI
RTE
JI
RTE
DISK ACCESS
DISK ACCESS
OPERATING LOCKED
OPERATING LOCKED

OPEN
OPEN

AURAL WARNING DEVICES UNIT FLIGHT DATA ACQUISITION UNIT


AURAL WARNING DEVICES UNIT FLIGHT DATA ACQUISITION UNIT
Instruments Component Locations Instruments Component Locations

and
OCT 99 Systems Introduction 31-13 OCT 99 31-13
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

 
TABLE OF CONTENTS
B737-300/400/500 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION SELF-PACED
ATA-32

LANDING GEAR SYSTEM .................................................................................................................................... 4


Overview..................................................................................................................................................... 4
TIRES AND WHEELS ........................................................................................................................................... 8
Overview..................................................................................................................................................... 8
Nose Gear Wheel and Tire.......................................................................................................................... 8
Nose Wheel Snubber .................................................................................................................................. 9
Main Gear Wheel and Tire........................................................................................................................ 10
NOSE LANDING GEAR ....................................................................................................................................... 12
Overview................................................................................................................................................... 12
Nose Gear Steering Collar ........................................................................................................................ 12
Nose Gear Torsion Links .......................................................................................................................... 12
Nose Gear Drag Brace .............................................................................................................................. 12
Nose Gear Shock Strut ............................................................................................................................. 14
MAIN GEAR ....................................................................................................................................................... 17
Overview................................................................................................................................................... 17
Main Gear Drag Strut ............................................................................................................................... 17
Main Gear Reaction Link .......................................................................................................................... 17
Main Gear Trunnion Link ......................................................................................................................... 17
Main Gear Torsion Links .......................................................................................................................... 18
Main Gear Drag Strut ............................................................................................................................... 18
Main Gear Side Strut................................................................................................................................ 18
Main Gear Shock Strut ............................................................................................................................. 20
Main Gear Damper ................................................................................................................................... 22
NOSE GEAR DOORS .......................................................................................................................................... 24
Overview................................................................................................................................................... 24
Nose Wheel Well Doors ............................................................................................................................ 24
MAIN GEAR SHOCK STRUT DOORS.................................................................................................................. 26
Overview................................................................................................................................................... 26
Center Door .............................................................................................................................................. 26
Outer Door................................................................................................................................................ 26
Inner Door ................................................................................................................................................ 26
LANDING GEAR CONTROL SYSTEM.................................................................................................................. 28
Overview................................................................................................................................................... 28
Landing Gear Selector Valve..................................................................................................................... 30
Landing Gear Control Cable System ......................................................................................................... 31
Landing Gear Control Lever ...................................................................................................................... 32
Landing Gear Control Lever Lock System................................................................................................. 33
Landing Gear Transfer Valve .................................................................................................................... 34
Flow Limiter Bypass Valve ....................................................................................................................... 35

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-32 Page 1


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

 
NOSE GEAR EXTENSION AND RETRACTION..................................................................................................... 36
Overview................................................................................................................................................... 36
Nose Gear Actuator................................................................................................................................... 40
Nose Gear Lock Mechanism ..................................................................................................................... 42
Nose Gear Lock Actuator .......................................................................................................................... 42
Nose Gear Lock Spring Bungee ................................................................................................................ 42
Nose Gear Door Linkage ........................................................................................................................... 44
NOSE GEAR MANUAL EXTENSION SYSTEM..................................................................................................... 45
Overview................................................................................................................................................... 45
Nose Gear Manual Extension Control Cable.............................................................................................. 46
Nose Gear Manual Extension Release Mechanism.................................................................................... 46
MAIN GEAR EXTENSION AND RETRACTION..................................................................................................... 49
Overview................................................................................................................................................... 49
Main Gear Actuator................................................................................................................................... 52
Main Gear Actuator Walking Beam........................................................................................................... 54
Main Gear Lock Mechanism ..................................................................................................................... 56
Main Gear Lock Actuator .......................................................................................................................... 56
Main Gear Lock Springs ........................................................................................................................... 56
MAIN GEAR MANUAL EXTENSION SYSTEM ..................................................................................................... 59
Overview................................................................................................................................................... 59
Main Gear Manual Extension Control Cable.............................................................................................. 60
Main Gear Manual Extension Linkage....................................................................................................... 60
HYDRAULIC BRAKE SYSTEM............................................................................................................................ 62
Overview................................................................................................................................................... 62
Alternate Brake Selector Valve ................................................................................................................. 64
Brake Control Linkage .............................................................................................................................. 65
Brake Metering Valve ............................................................................................................................... 66
Main Gear Brakes..................................................................................................................................... 68
Brake Accumulator System ...................................................................................................................... 70
Main Gear Brake Swivel Assemblies ........................................................................................................ 72
Brake Hydraulic Fuses.............................................................................................................................. 73
Brake Hydraulic Accumulator Servicing ............................................................................................................ 74
PARKING BRAKE SYSTEM ................................................................................................................................ 76
Overview................................................................................................................................................... 76
Parking Brake Linkage ............................................................................................................................. 78
Parking Brake Shutoff Valve..................................................................................................................... 80
ANTISKID SYSTEM........................................................................................................................................... 81
Overview................................................................................................................................................... 81
Antiskid Control Panel.............................................................................................................................. 82
Transducer ............................................................................................................................................... 83
Antiskid Control Unit ................................................................................................................................ 84
Antiskid Control Valve .............................................................................................................................. 85
Air-Ground Sensors .................................................................................................................................. 86
Landing Gear Lever Up Switch ................................................................................................................. 88

ATA-30 Page 2 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

 
AUTOMATIC BRAKING SYSTEM ....................................................................................................................... 89
Overview................................................................................................................................................... 89
Autobrake Pressure Control Module ......................................................................................................... 92
Autobrake Shuttle Valves.......................................................................................................................... 94
Hydraulic Pressure Switches .................................................................................................................... 95
Autobrake Digital Circuits and Test Switch .............................................................................................. 96
NOSE WHEEL STEERING SYSTEM.................................................................................................................... 97
Overview................................................................................................................................................... 97
Steering Metering Valve ......................................................................................................................... 100
Nose Gear Steering Collar ...................................................................................................................... 102
Rudder Pedal Steering Mechanism......................................................................................................... 104
TAIL SKID....................................................................................................................................................... 107
Overview................................................................................................................................................. 107
LANDING GEAR POSITION INDICATING AND WARNING SYSTEM .................................................................. 108
Overview................................................................................................................................................. 108
Landing Gear Mechanical Downlock Indication....................................................................................... 110
Control Lever Position Switch ................................................................................................................ 112
Landing Gear Uplock and Downlock Sensors.......................................................................................... 114

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-32 Page 3


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

LANDING GEAR SYSTEM


Overview

The landing gear consists of two main gear and one nose gear (Fig. 1). Each main gear is located aft of the
rear wing spar inboard of the engine nacelles. The nose gear is located below the aft bulkhead of the control
cabin.

The main and nose gear use air-oil type shock struts to absorb impact on landing and vibrations and shock
from movement of the airplane on the ground. Each nose and main gear is equipped with two tire and wheel
assemblies. Each main gear wheel is fitted with disc-type hydraulic brakes modulated by an antiskid system.
The main gear is hydraulically actuated to retract inboard into the fuselage. Each main gear is locked in the
down position by a folding lock strut and in the up position by an uplock hook and mechanism. Shock strut
doors close the opening in the wing for the main gear shock strut and drag strut. A wheel well seal closes
against the main gear tire circumference when the airplane is in flight with gear retracted.

The nose gear is hydraulically actuated to retract forward into the fuselage. A lock strut assembly locks the
nose gear in the up and down positions. The clamshell-type nose gear doors close to fair with the fuselage
contour when the nose gear is retracted, and remains open when the nose gear is extended. The main and
nose gear manual extension systems are cable operated to release each gear from the up and locked position
and allow the gear to free fall to the down and locked position.

Nose wheel steering is provided for aircraft directional control during ground maneuvers. Normal steering is
accomplished by using a steering wheel located at the captain's position. A reduced range of steering by
rudder pedal is available.

Landing Gear Air-Ground Sensing

Certain systems of the airplane require electrical control depending upon the condition of the airplane
(airborne or on the ground). The condition of the airplane is sensed by the landing gear ground and air safety
sensors (proximity switches). The safety sensors transmit signals to circuits and relays in a landing gear
electrical module to provide "air" or "ground" control of the system or components. The landing gear systems
controlled by air-ground sensing are the control lever lock system and the antiskid system. Other airplane
systems and components controlled by air-ground sensing are:
• APU fire horn system
• thrust reverser
• electrical system static inverter
• drain mast heater
• stall warning system
• flight recorder system
• air conditioning turbofans
• takeoff warning system
• cabin pressurization control system

ATA-30 Page 4 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

 
• voice recorder system
• wing anti-ice system
• electrical system
• flap load limiter system
• automatic braking system

An air sensing test switch and a ground sensing test switch on the electrical module are normally used to
simulate airplane-in-air condition. When the airplane is operating in the ground mode, the air sensing test
switch energizes the air sensing relays and the ground sensing test switch de-energizes the ground sensing
relays. Both switches must be pressed and held down to simulate the airplane-in-air condition. When the
switches are released, the systems return to airplane-on-ground condition. When the airplane-in-air condition
is simulated, certain precautions for safety reasons should be observed.

Landing Gear Extension and Retraction

Extension and retraction of the main and nose gear is by hydraulic power with a manual extension system for
lowering the gear when hydraulic power is not available. The landing gear is controlled by a single control
lever mounted on the pilots' center panel. Cables from a drum are actuated by the control lever transfer
motion to a selector valve that directs hydraulic pressure for gear actuation. A safety lock prevents the control
lever from entering the UP position when conditions are not right for gear retraction.

When the control lever is moved to the UP position, the gear retracts. When the main gears are fully retracted,
a seal closes up against the main gear tire circumference. A special hubcap on the outboard wheel fairs the
retracted wheel. The shock strut aperture in wing is closed by a shock strut door. A movable section of the
shock strut doors carries a section of the seal to close off the upper portion of the tire below the shock strut.
Mechanical linkage operates the shock strut door flap as the gear retracts and extends. Doors operated by a
linkage connected to the nose gear close off the nose wheel well when the gear retracts. Moving the control
lever to the DN position extends all gears. On extension, the nose gear doors open and remain open when the
gear is down. With the control lever in OFF position, hydraulic pressure is released from all landing gear
hydraulic lines and actuators. The gears are then held in the extended or retracted position by the mechanical
locks. A tee handle actuates a crank and cable system for manual extension, which unlocks the gears and
allows them to fall to the extended position by gravity. The nose gear doors are opened by mechanical linkage
as the gear extends. When operated by the manual extension system, the gears free fall to the down and
locked position.

When the landing gear is to be retracted with the airplane on the ground, the airplane must be jacked and
electrical and hydraulic power must be available.

Landing Gear Position Indicating and Warning System

In the landing gear position indicating and warning system, a warning horn and indicator and warning lights
provide indication for landing gear down and locked, landing gear not locked, and landing gear position not in
accordance with control lever position.

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-32 Page 5


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

SHOCK
STRUT
DOOR

RIGHT
MAIN
GEAR

WHEEL
LEFT
WHEEL COVER
MAIN
GEAR WELL NOSE
SEAL GEAR NOSE WHEEL
WELL DOORS

ATA-30 Page 6 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

 
MAIN GEAR

SHOCK STRUT
UPLOCK CHARGING
ACTUATOR VALVE
REACTION
STRUT DOWNLOCK
ACTUATOR
UPLOCK MAIN GEAR
ACTUATOR

RETRACT
POSITION
SEAL

DOWNLOCK SHOCK
STRUT
WHEEL
SIDE DOORS
WELL
SEAL STRUT

NOSE GEAR

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-32 Page 7


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

TIRES AND WHEELS


Overview

Each gear (nose and main) has two tire and wheel assemblies designed to withstand high rolling speeds. All
wheels have provisions for attaching balance weights for dynamic balance. After takeoff, spinning of main
gear wheels and nose gear wheels is stopped by main gear brakes and nose wheel snubbers respectively.

Each outboard main gear wheel and tire is covered with a fairing attached to the outboard main wheel hubcap.
Each inboard wheel is provided with a small hubcap. The wheel and tire assemblies are designated Nos. 1, 2,
3 and 4, counting from the left looking forward.

Nose Gear Wheel and Tire

The nose gear wheel assembly consists of forged aluminum made in separate halves for ease to mount the
tubeless tires. The inner and outer wheel halves are bolted together and the joint between wheel halves is
sealed with an O-ring. An air valve is located in the outer wheel half to permit inflation of mounted tires. A
safety plug is also fitted in the outboard wheel half to protect the tire from high pressure. The diaphragm
within the safety plug will rupture at a predetermined pressure and vent the pressure to atmosphere. The
wheels are installed with an inner and an outer roller bearing assembly on the tapered axle. The inner and
outer bearings are protected against loss of lubricant and the entrance of dirt by grease seals.

737-300 AIRPLANES; The nose gear tires are 27" x 7.75" -15" tubeless tires rated 10 or 12-ply 225 MPH. 737-
400 AND 737-500 AIRPLANES; The nose gear tires are 27" x 7.75" - 15" tubeless tires rated 12-ply 225 MPH.

TIRE
AXLE NUT
LOCK BOLT TIE BOLT

SPACER
AXLE

RETAINING RING

GREASE SEAL

INNER BEARING

OUTER BEARING

SAFETY PLUG AND GREASE SEAL


LOCKING PLATE DETAILS
RETAINING RING

AXLE NUT
O-RING

INFLATION VALVE
INBD
NOSE GEAR WHEEL

ATA-30 Page 8 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Nose Wheel Snubber

Two wheel snubbers are located on the ceiling panel in the nose wheel well to stop wheel rotation and the
attending noises. When the nose gear is retracted after a takeoff, nose wheel rotation will be stopped by tire
contact with the snubbers. Each snubber consists of a spring bar attached to wheel well structure with a
snubbing block of brake lining bolted to the forward (contact) end of the bar.
NOSE LANDING
GEAR SNUBBER
SEE A

FWD

NUT

WASHER

SUPPORT SPRING

SNUBBER BLOCK
SPACER
(2 AT EACH
FASTENER LOCATION)
1

BOLT
(6 LOCATIONS)

NOSE LANDING GEAR SNUBBER


1 TWO SPACERS IS THE STANDARD
CONFIGURATION. HOWEVER, SOME
A
AIRPLANES HAVE EITHER ONE OR
THREE SPACERS THAT SEPARATE
THE PAD AND THE SPRING

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-32 Page 9


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Main Gear Wheel and Tire

The main gear wheel assembly is made of forged aluminum. To facilitate tire installation the assembly
consists of two halves which are bolted together at 18 places around the wheel. The outside half contains a
large bore pneumatic tire valve to service tubeless tires.

A pressure relief valve, which will rupture at 375 to 450 PSI, is provided to protect against over inflation. Air
loss between the wheel halves is prevented by a preformed packing located in an annular groove of the inside
wheel half.

The wheel rotates on tapered roller bearings located in the end of the hubs. A molded rubber grease seal
retains grease in the inside bearing area and keeps out dirt. The outside bearing area is protected by a cover
assembly. Eight rotor drive keys on the inside circumference of the inside wheel half are used to key the
wheel to the rotating elements of the brake. Heat shields consisting of thin steel plates mounted between the
rotor drive keys protect the tire against excessive heat build up during braking. Four thermal fuses located on
the inside wheel half will protect the tire against explosion due to excessive heat build up during abnormal
braking conditions.

The main gear tires are tubeless and are designated H40 x 14.5 -19 rated 24 and/or 26-ply 225 MPH.

ATA-30 Page 10 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

OUTSIDE
INSIDE WHEEL HALF
WHEEL HALF
O-RING

INBD

FWD

THERMAL PLUG
(TORQUE TO 50 LB INCHES)

SEE A

TIRE
INSIDE
WHEEL HALF O-RING BRAKE ROTOR
DRIVE KEY
INFLATION
VALVE

OUTER WHEEL
INNER WHEEL
BEARING
BEARING
AXLE

TRANSDUCER

BRAKE
ASSEMBLY

OUTSIDE
WHEEL HALF
WHEEL BALANCE
WEIGHT
HUBCAP
FAIRING
(OUTBOARD
WHEEL ONLY)

WHEEL
TIE BOLTS
CAMLOCKS INBD
(8 PLACES)

HUBCAP FWD

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-32 Page 11


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

NOSE LANDING GEAR


Overview

The nose gear supports the forward end of the fuselage and provides directional control while the airplane is
on the ground. The nose gear includes a drag brace, shock strut, and torsion links, and is hydraulically
actuated to retract forward and up into a wheel well recessed into the lower nose section of the airplane. The
shock strut consists of inner and outer cylinders. The upper part of the outer cylinder is "Y" shaped with arms
extended to the sidewalls of the wheel well. Trunnion pins connect the gear to airplane structure. The "Y"
arms and pins provide lateral stability. The gear rotates about the trunnion pins during extension and
retraction. Shocks and bumps during taxi, takeoff, and landing are absorbed by the shock strut which contains
oil and is charged with compressed air or nitrogen. Longitudinal stability is provided by a hinged drag brace
which folds upward and aft during gear retraction. For steering, the shock strut inner cylinder turns within the
outer cylinder. Torsion links connected at the upper end to a steering collar and at the lower end to the shock
strut inner cylinder transmit a turning moment supplied by hydraulically actuated steering cylinders.

Nose Gear Steering Collar

The nose gear steering collar is at the middle of the outer cylinder. The collar is held clamped around the
outer cylinder, by a bolt, in an annular recess immediately below the trunnions. Both of the two steering
cylinders are connected to the steering collar and the upper end of the upper torsion link is also connected to
the steering collar. When force is applied to the steering collar, by either steering cylinder, the collar transfers
the force through the torsion links to turn the inner cylinder to the right or left respectively to which cylinder
force is applied to give steering action to the nose wheels.

Nose Gear Torsion Links

The nose gear torsion links allow rotation between the inner and outer shock strut cylinders only when moved
by the steering collar or when disconnected. The upper link is connected to the steering collar, and the lower
link is connected to a lug on the inner cylinder. The upper and lower torsion links are joined together by an
apex pin. This locks the nose wheels in the position assumed by the steering collar without affecting strut
action. Steering forces applied to the steering collar by the nose gear steering system are transmitted to the
inner cylinder by the torsion links.

Nose Gear Drag Brace

The nose gear drag brace, in conjunction with the nose gear lock link assembly, holds the nose gear in the up
or down locked position. The drag brace consists of an upper and lower link. The upper end of the upper link
pivots on pins through support fittings attached to the wheel well sidewalls. During gear retraction, the upper
link rotates upward and aft. The lower end of the lower link pivots about a pin which attaches the lower link
to double lugs on the outer cylinder. These lugs are located just above the steering collar. During gear
retraction, the lower link also rotates upward and aft relative to a pivot point. The upper and lower links are
bolted together forming a hinge.
DRAG LINK
TRUNNION PIN

ATA-30 Page 12 FOR TRAINING PURPOSESSPHERICAL


ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization
and Systems
  Introduction BEARING
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-32 Page 13


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Nose Gear Shock Strut

The nose gear shock strut is the main supporting member of the nose gear. The shock strut includes an inner
cylinder and an outer cylinder, metering pin assembly, upper and lower orifice assemblies, and upper and
lower cam assemblies. The shock strut is attached to the nose wheel well structure by trunnions which are
part of the outer cylinder. Pins are inserted through the trunnion ends into bearings attached to the wheel well
structure. A steering collar clamped around the outer cylinder is connected to the upper torsion link and the
upper torsion link is connected to the lower torsion link by an apex pin.

The inner cylinder and nose wheel axles are machined from a single forging. The fixed centering cam attached
to the top of the inner cylinder mates with a similar cam in the outer cylinder when the inner cylinder extends.
As these cams engage, the nose wheels will attain a straight forward position to ensure proper fit in the wheel
well on retraction. This also ensures the nose wheels to be straight forward when landing. Upper and lower
bearings provide sliding surfaces for movement of the inner cylinder in and out the outer cylinder. Annular
grooves in the lower bearing provide space for the storage of two sets of spare seals. These spare seals are
replacements for like seals installed between the inner cylinder and the lower centering cam, and between the
lower centering cam and the outer cylinder.

Shocks to the nose gear shock strut are absorbed by the restricted flow of hydraulic fluid through the annular
space between the orifice and the tapered metering pin and by the restricted flow of fluid through the rebound
valve piston ring. When the inner cylinder is being compressed, the tapered metering pin, which is attached to
the lower support tube in the inner cylinder, moves through the orifice in the upper support tube. This
movement of the metering pin progressively reduces the area of the annular space between the orifice and
metering pin. The reduction in area results in a diminishing rate of hydraulic fluid flow from the inner
cylinder chamber to the upper side of the piston which produces increasing resistance to compression of the
shock strut. Landing shocks and shocks incurred while taxiing are absorbed by the increasing volume of
hydraulic fluid above the piston which further compresses the volume of compressed air or nitrogen in the
upper end of the outer cylinder.

ATA-30 Page 14 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-32 Page 15


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

ATA-30 Page 16 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

MAIN GEAR
Overview

Each main gear consists of a trunnion link, a shock strut, a drag strut, torsion links, a damper, a side strut,
and a reaction link. In addition, the right main gear carries ground speed brake operating rods and cable.

The shock strut assembly is attached to the trunnion link by a pin joint and the two are mounted between the
rear wing spar and a trunnion support beam. The shock strut is charged with oil and compressed nitrogen to
provide a shock absorbing medium. The main gear axles and the shock strut inner cylinder are machined
from a one piece forging. Replaceable sleeves are assembled over the axles to provide a mounting for wheel
bearings and to protect the axles from damage. The reaction link is connected to the shock strut and to the
upper end of the side strut.

Main Gear Drag Strut

The main gear drag strut stabilizes the shock strut in a fore and aft direction. The drag strut is in two parts.
The upper drag strut is attached to a lug on the trunnion link at the top end, and to the lower drag strut at the
bottom end. The lower drag strut is connected to the upper torsion link lugs on the outer cylinder, and to the
side strut universal attachment on the shock strut (Fig. 1). A special shear bolt is used for the upper
attachment to minimize damage to structure should landing gear receive a severe impact from the front.
Clamps and attachments on the drag strut support linkage for the shock strut door.

Main Gear Reaction Link

The main gear reaction link forms the upper member of a space frame consisting of the shock strut, the side
strut, and the reaction link. Most of the side loads acting on landing gear are transferred through the reaction
link to the upper end of the shock strut. The outboard end of the reaction link is attached through a universal
joint to the trunnion link connection. The inboard end is attached to structure at the main gear uplock
brackets. All the landing gear lock actuating mechanism is mounted on the reaction link.

Main Gear Trunnion Link

The main gear trunnion link provides the forward pin of the hinge for main gear retraction and transmits
landing gear loads from the drag strut into airplane structure. The trunnion link is mounted between the
shock strut and the rear wing spar. The aft end of the trunnion link is pinned to the shock strut and the
forward end pivots in a spherical bearing mounted in the rear wing spar. The top end of the drag strut is
attached to a lug on the underside of the trunnion link near the spherical bearing. A pushrod from a bracket
on the underside of the trunnion link operates a shock strut door hinged to the wing. The door covers part of
the shock strut aperture in the wing when the gear retracts. A swivel fitting for hydraulic lines is mounted on
top of the trunnion link. The trunnion link is machined from a high tensile steel forging.

The trunnion forward bearing bolt is designed to fail if the landing gear receives a severe impact, thus
minimizing damage to structure.

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-32 Page 17


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Main Gear Torsion Links

The main gear torsion links prevent rotation between shock strut inner and outer cylinders without affected the
reciprocating action during normal operation of strut. The upper torsion link and bottom attachment of the
lower drag strut share the same lugs on the shock strut outer cylinder. The lower torsion link is connected to
lugs on the inner cylinder. Upper and lower torsion links are joined at the forward ends by a single bolt.

Main Gear Drag Strut

The main gear drag strut stabilizes the shock strut in a fore and aft direction. The drag strut is in two parts.
The upper drag strut is attached to a lug on the trunnion link at the top end, and to the lower drag strut at the
bottom end. The lower drag strut is connected to the upper torsion link lugs on the outer cylinder, and to the
side strut universal attachment on the shock strut. A special shear bolt is used for the upper attachment to
minimize damage to structure should landing gear receive a severe impact from the front. Clamps and
attachments on the drag strut support linkage for the shock strut door.

Main Gear Side Strut

The main gear side strut gives lateral support to the shock strut. The side strut consists of an upper and a
lower segment hinged near the center. The upper end of the side strut is connected to a lug on the reaction
link. The bottom end of the lower segment is connected to the universal side brace attachment. A lock strut
is mounted between the reaction link and the side strut hinge. The side strut folds about the hinge when the
gear retracts.

ATA-30 Page 18 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

WALKING
BEAM HANGER
WALKING BEAM

MAIN GEAR
ACTUATOR

DOWNLOCK SPRING BUNGEE


GROUND SPEED
BRAKE CABLE
(RIGHT GEAR ONLY) REACTION LINK

TRUNNION UPLOCK ACTUATOR


LINK

UPLOCK
DRAG STRUT
SPRING
BUNGEE

DOWNLOCK
UNIVERSAL SIDE
STRUT FITTING

SIDE STRUT

SHOCK STRUT

UPLOCK ROLLER
DAMPER
HYDRAULIC
LINE

AXLE

MAIN GEAR
DAMPER

TORSION
LINKS FWD INBD

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-32 Page 19


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Main Gear Shock Strut

The main gear shock strut is the primary supporting member of the landing gear. The shock strut is made of
steel and consists of an inner cylinder, an outer cylinder, an orifice support tube, and a metering pin. The
orifice support tube is attached to the top of the outer cylinder. Upper and lower bearings provide sliding
surfaces and locate the inner cylinder concentric with outer cylinder. A snubber valve located below the upper
bearing provides control of shock strut rebound. A packing adaptor with annular grooves is installed between
the lower bearing and a spacer. A channel seal in the packing adaptor is in contact with the inner cylinder.
An O-ring between two backup rings makes contact with the outer cylinder. The channel seal and the O-ring
provide an air-oil seal between the cylinders. Annular grooves in the lower bearing are used to store spare
seals. The spare seals in the lower bearing can be used to replace active seals without removing the inner
cylinder. The shock strut is attached to airplane structure by an extension on the outer cylinder and by the
trunnion link. The lower end of the shock strut is held in position by the side strut and the drag strut.

The outer cylinder is a single piece forging bored to fit the inner cylinder. The upper portion provides an
extension for attachment to airplane structure. A full shock strut width lug on the opposite side provides an
attachment for the trunnion link. Lugs on the lower end provide attachment points for drag strut, torsion links,
and universal side strut attachment. The orifice support tube projects through the top of the outer cylinder
where it is secured by a nut. A charging valve is installed in the top of the orifice support tube.

The inner cylinder, with all lugs and the axle, including brake flanges, is machined from one forging. A
diaphragm integral with the metering pin seals off the inside bore of the inner cylinder. A drain tube attached
to the metering pin is secured by a nut to the underside of the inner cylinder. A check valve is installed at the
bottom of the cylinder for strut servicing. In addition to axles, the lower end of the cylinder has a towing lug
and a jacking pad.

A snubber valve is installed on the inner cylinder just below the upper bearing. The valve consists of an
angular sectioned bronze ring that moves up and down when the shock strut operates to act as a one-way
restrictor. When the shock strut is compressing, the snubber valve allows an unrestricted flow of oil from the
upper chamber into the annular space between inner and outer cylinders. When the shock strut extends, the
snubber valve moves up to close off holes in the upper bearing; this restricts flow from the annular space and
so absorbs shock strut rebound.

With the shock strut compressed and serviced with oil, the outer cylinder contains oil all around the piston rod
and in the space between inner and outer cylinders. The shock strut is then inflated with nitrogen or air to the
specified pressure.

ATA-30 Page 20 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

 
Main Gear Shock Strut (Continued):

Shocks are absorbed by the flow of hydraulic fluid through the annular space between the orifice and the
tapered metering pin. As the shock strut is compressed, oil flows through the orifice and the movement of the
tapered metering pin through the orifice progressively varies the area of the annular space between orifice and
pin. The variation in area results in an adjusted rate of hydraulic flow from the inner cylinder chamber to the
upper side of the piston, thus providing uniform control of the impact loads on the airplane structure when
landing. Landing and taxi shocks are also cushioned by the increasing volume of hydraulic fluid above the
piston further compressing the volume of compressed air or nitrogen in the upper end of the outer cylinder.
As the shock strut extends, there is a reversal of flow through the orifice. The hydraulic fluid now being
forced from the upper to the lower side of the piston must pass through the space around the metering pin
and through holes in the orifice support tube. Also, fluid in the annular space between the inner and outer
cylinders is forced through the snubber valve restriction and through the upper bearing into the upper
chamber. The resulting resistance to hydraulic flow dampens the return movement of the shock strut.
CHARGING
VALVE
TRUNNION
LINK

COMPRESSED
NITROGEN OR AIR

ORIFICE
SUPPORT
TUBE OIL

METERING PIN

ORIFICE

SEE A
UPPER
BEARING INNER
CYLINDER

SNUBBING
VALVE OUTER
CYLINDER
OUTER DRAIN TUBE
CYLINDER
UPPER
BEARING
SPACER

O-RING AND
BACKUP RINGS
CHANNEL SEAL PACKING
ADAPTER

LOWER SNUBBING
BEARING VALVE

SPARE SEALS
A
SCRAPER RING

TORSION GLAND NUT


LINK LUGS
INNER
CYLINDER

AXLE
CHECK VALVE

JACKING PAD

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-32 Page 21


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Main Gear Damper

The main gear damper prevents excessive vibration buildup in landing gear during high speed taxi and under
heavy braking. The damper is a hydraulic unit containing an actuator, a compensator, and relief and check
valves. The main body of the damper is attached to the forward end of the upper torsion link. The actuator
piston rod passes through the forward ends of both upper and lower links to provide an apex bolt. Rotary
oscillation between the shock strut inner and outer cylinders is absorbed by the actuator piston displacing
hydraulic fluid in the cylinder. The rate of displacement is controlled by the damping orifice in the actuator
piston. The compensator is provided to maintain a pressure of 30 to 70 PSI on the fluid contained in the
actuator. A 3000 PSI relief valve protects the actuator from very high pressures caused by thermal expansion
of hydraulic fluid. A 70 PSI relief valve protects the compensator from thermal expansion damage. Two check
valves are provided to allow hydraulic fluid to enter the actuator and make up for slight leakage or to
compensate for fluid contraction. A third check valve permits fluid to enter the unit from the hydraulic system
A return and so keep the damper fully charged with fluid. Bleeder plugs are provided to enable trapped air to
be cleared after disconnection of the hydraulic line or when filling an empty unit.

ATA-30 Page 22 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

SHOCK
STRUT DRAG STRUT

1. UPPER TORSION LINK 4. FLANGED


BUSHING
2. DAMPER BRACKET

WASHER
3. DAMPER
ATTACHMENT BOLT
(EXAMPLE)

5. ELECTRICAL HARNESS
SUPPORT BRACKET

6. CHECKNUT

15. LOWER 7. LOCKWASHER


TORSION LINK
8. APEX NUT
14. HYDRAULIC RETURN 9. LOCKBOLT
LINE SEE B
10. THRUST WASHER

11. APEX THRUST WASHER

12. HYDRAULIC LINE GUIDES

13. DAMPER ASSEMBLY


SEE A

16. BLEEDER PLUG

17. BLEEDER PLUG


0.50 DAMPER
0.10 HOUSING 19. BLEEDER PLUG

HEAD OF
DAMPER
PISTON
CAP

18. MANIFOLD

GLAND PISTON
NUT

A B

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-32 Page 23


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

NOSE GEAR DOORS


Overview

The nose gear doors are clamshell type and consist of two doors that fair with the fuselage contour when
closed. The doors close over the nose wheel well in the lower nose section of the fuselage when the gear is
retracted and open when the gear is extended. The doors remain open at all times when the nose gear is in
the down position.

Nose Wheel Well Doors

The nose wheel well doors are of glass and graphite fabric reinforced epoxy laminate faced honeycomb
construction. Three hinge arms extend to the side of each door to engage hinges at the outer edge of the
wheel well. The lower end of a door actuation rod is connected to a raised lug on the middle hinge of each
door. A link and crank assembly connected to an arm protruding from the nose landing gear trunnion work
with the door actuation rods to open and close the doors for extension and retraction.

UPPER DRAG
BRACE LINK

AFT DOOR
HINGE

DOOR ACTUATION
ROD (ADJUSTABLE)

HINGE
BRACKET

FORWARD
NOSE GEAR
DOOR HINGE

MIDDLE
DOOR HINGE

NOSE WHEEL
WELL DOORS
STEERING
CYLINDER

ATA-30 Page 24 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-32 Page 25


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

MAIN GEAR SHOCK STRUT DOORS


Overview

The main gear shock strut doors close over the opening in the wing for the shock strut and drag strut when
the gear is retracted. The installation consists of three doors. A center door is attached to the shock strut and
the drag strut, an outer door is hinged to the wing, and an inner door is hinged to the inboard edge of the
center door. Linkage from the trunnion link and the universal side strut attachment operate during extension
and retraction to open and close the doors. Shock strut doors remain open when the gear is extended. A
support rod attached to the lowest shock strut clamp prevents center and inner doors from moving out of
adjustment under vibration or heavy air loads.

Center Door

The center door is a built up structure of graphite-reinforced Kevlar and Nomex honeycomb core. Reinforced
points support attachment fittings and the lower edge carries a hinge half for the inner door. The door is
secured by clamps to the shock strut and the drag strut. Adjustable fittings between the door and clamps are
provided to fair the door with the lower surface of the wing. A bulb type seal is mounted along the outboard
edge of the door. A rub strip on the aft edge and an angle riveted on the forward edge contact seals along the
respective edges of the opening in the wing when the door is closed.

Outer Door

The outer door is constructed of graphite-reinforced Kevlar and a Nomex honeycomb core. Two hinge fittings
are bolted between webs on the inner side. The door hinges pivot on the heads of two eyebolts, used to
connect the ends of a stabilizing beam, located between the landing gear beam and the rear wing spar. A bulb
section rubber seal around the door opening in the wing provides an air-tight joint when the door is closed. A
pushrod connects the door to a bracket on the underside of the trunnion link. Trunnion link rotation during
extension and retraction operates the door.

Inner Door

The inner door is a built up structure of graphite-reinforced Kevlar and Nomex honeycomb core. The door is
hinged on the outer edge to the center door. The door is contoured to fair with the body when closed. A light
fairing is attached to the outer skin to line up with the flap track fairing. A pushrod connects the door to the
universal side strut attachment.

ATA-30 Page 26 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

PUSHROD TO
EYEBOLT
TRUNNION LINK

STABILIZING
BEAM

OUTER
DOOR
STOP

OUTER DOOR
TRUNNION
LINK
PUSHROD OUTER DOOR

OUTER DOOR

SIDE STRUT

DRAG STRUT CENTER DOOR


ADJUSTABLE DOOR CLAMPS (TYP)

FLAP TRACK FAIRING


SHOCK STRUT UNIVERSAL SIDE STRUT ATTACHMENT

INNER DOOR

INNER DOOR
PUSHROD

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-32 Page 27


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

LANDING GEAR CONTROL SYSTEM


Overview

The landing gear control system is operated by moving a control lever projecting from the pilots' instrument
panel. A cable system transmits the control lever movement to a selector valve in the left wheel well. When
positioned by the control lever, the selector valve directs hydraulic pressure to the actuators for gear retraction
and extension. The control lever is provided with a lock to prevent the lever from being moved into UP
position when the airplane is supported on the gear. An override trigger in the control lever may be used to
bypass the lock for testing or if the lock system should lose electrical power.

When the control lever is pulled, the inner end is raised from a detent to free the lever for movement into
another position. Moving the lever up or down rotates a cable drum to operate cables running from a quadrant
above the left wheel well ceiling. As the quadrant rotates, it operates the landing gear selector valve on the
underside of the ceiling through a shaft, lever, and an adjustable link. Releasing the landing gear lever when
the desired position has been selected allows the lever end to drop into a detent and so hold the lever in
position. In DN position, the lever end operates a control lever position switch for the indicating and warning
system.

When the right main gear shock strut is compressed by airplane weight on the gear, a circuit opens to de-
energize the landing gear safety relay. When de-energized, the relay opens contacts, cutting off power to the
lock solenoid. The control lever lock then moves into locked position. When the shock strut extends, the
proximity switch closes and the reverse sequence of operations energizes the lock solenoid to release the lock.
The lock solenoid remains energized when gear is retracted and electrical power is on the airplane. An
override trigger permits the lever to bypass the lock if a malfunction of the system causes the lock to engage.

ATA-30 Page 28 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

LANDING GEAR
LANDING GEAR SELECTOR VALVE
CONTROL LEVER

CONTROL
CABLES

GEAR UP
CONTROL
CABLE LGVA
TURNBUCKLES QUADRANT

GEAR DOWN
CONTROL
CABLE LGVB

QUADRANT
SUPPORT
TURNBUCKLE BRACKET
GEAR OFF
CONTROL LEVER DETENT CONTROL
GEAR UP
DETENT POSITION SWITCH LEVER DRUM
PRESSURE UP PORT
PORT
DOWN PORT
RETURN
PORT

LANDING GEAR LANDING GEAR


CONTROL LEVER SELECTOR VALVE
(GEAR DOWN
POSITION)
CONTROL OVERRIDE
GEAR DOWN LEVER LOCK TRIGGER
CONTROL
CABLE LGVB

GEAR UP LOCK
CONTROL SOLENOID
CABLE LGVA

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-32 Page 29


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Landing Gear Selector Valve

The landing gear selector valve directs hydraulic pressure to the landing gear up and down lines. Return fluid
from the landing gear system passes back through the selector valve and on to the hydraulic system A
reservoir. The selector valve is bolted to the ceiling of the left main wheel well. Linkage connects the selector
valve to the control cable system. When the landing gear control handle is operated, motion from the handle is
transferred through the cable system to a shaft passing through the wheel well ceiling. An arm on the end of
shaft below the ceiling positions the selector valve through an adjustable link.

SELECTOR
VALVE
SEE A

SYSTEM A
WHEEL WELL
PRESSURE
CEILING
SYSTEM A
RETURN

SELECTOR ACTUATING LINK


VALVE

INBD

GEAR DOWN GEAR UP


FWD
A

ATA-30 Page 30 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Landing Gear Control Cable System

The landing gear control cable system transfers movement from the control lever to the landing gear selector
valve. The control cable system consists of four cables, two short and two long. Short cables run forward and
down from the control lever drum, then aft under the control cabin floor. Long cables run forward from the
selector valve control drum to meet the control lever cables at a point under the control cabin floor where the
cables are joined by turnbuckles.

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-32 Page 31


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Landing Gear Control Lever

The landing gear control lever runs in a guide as the lever is moved up or down. The guide has detents to
hold the control lever in any one of three positions, UP, OFF, or DN. To change the control lever position, it is
necessary to pull out the lever to release a roller on the inner end from the detent.

The lock override mechanism enables the inner end of the control lever to be pulled clear of the lock stop
when the control lever lock is engaged. The override feature is obtained by making the control lever shaft in
two parts, one sliding inside the other. A trigger connected to the inner part projects through a slot in the
underside of the outer shaft. A compression spring between a flange on the inner shaft and the control handle
quadrant holds the trigger against the bottom of the slot. When the control lever is pulled, both the inner and
outer shafts move together through the quadrant until the inner end clears the detent. At this point, a stop
prevents further movement. To retract the inner end of the lever far enough to pass the lock stop, the trigger
must be operated. Pulling the trigger telescopes the inner shaft into the lever, the additional retraction of the
control lever inner end thus obtained, allows the lever to clear the lock stop.

The control lever position switch is mounted in the control lever support channel behind the control lever. The
switch is actuated by the inner end of the control lever as the inner end drops into the detent.

ATA-30 Page 32 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Landing Gear Control Lever Lock System

The landing gear control lever lock system prevents the control lever moving past OFF position from DN
selection until airplane weight is off landing gear. The control lever lock control consists of a mechanical lock
operated by a lock solenoid. The lock solenoid is controlled by a safety relay operated by solid state circuits
through the air safety sensor. The system operates on 28-volt DC power from a circuit breaker on panel P6.
The control lever is normally released only when the solenoid is energized.

The landing gear safety relay controls the power for the lock solenoid. The relay is installed in the landing gear
electrical module located in the electrical/electronic compartment.

The landing gear air safety proximity switch controls the landing gear relay. When the airplane weight is on
the landing gear, the sensor operates through solid state circuits to de-energize the relay. Spoiler linkage
driven by a Teleflex cable from the extension and compression movement of the shock strut operates the
switch.

ELECTRICAL
CONNECTOR

CONTROL
LEVER
ASSEMBLY

CONTROL
LEVER

LOCK
OVERRIDE
TRIGGER

ELECTRICAL
SLUG LEADS
LOCK
SOLENOID
COIL

SCREWS
SCREW
(2 LOCATIONS) FWD

BASEPLATE
ASSEMBLY

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-32 Page 33


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Landing Gear Transfer Valve

The landing gear transfer valve normally ports hydraulic pressure from system A to the landing gear. Should
hydraulic pressure be lost, the valve will automatically connect hydraulic system B to the landing gear.
Hydraulic operation of the gear may thus be accomplished without manual override.

The transfer valve is installed in the wheel well of the right main gear. It is on the keel beam, near the forward
end of the wheel well.

LANDING
GEAR LANDING
RETURN GEAR
PRESSURE

VALVE
MOUNTING
MOUNTING BOLT
(4 LOCATIONS)
B SYSTEM
PRESSURE

B SYSTEM
RETURN

A SYSTEM
RETURN
A SYSTEM
PRESSURE

ELECTRICAL
SOLENOID CONNECTOR

SUPPORT BRACKET

ATA-30 Page 34 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Flow Limiter Bypass Valve

A flow limiter and a bypass valve are installed in the landing gear hydraulic supply downstream from the
transfer valve. The bypass valve is normally open and permits fluid to bypass the flow limiter. Under certain
air mode conditions with high hydraulic fluid flow requirements, the bypass valve closes to give priority to the
wing leading edge autoslat extension. This limits flow to the landing gear. When the flow requirements
decrease, the bypass valve opens and the landing gear system returns to normal.

SEE A

HYDRAULIC
LINE
BOLTS
(3 LOCATIONS)

BYPASS VALVE

HYDRAULIC
LINE

BONDING
JUMPER

ELECTRICAL
POSITION CONNECTOR
INDICATOR

BYPASS
VALVE
OPERATOR

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-32 Page 35


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

NOSE GEAR EXTENSION AND RETRACTION


Overview

The nose gear retraction and extension system raises and lowers the nose landing gear. The gear retracts or
extends simultaneously with the main gear when the landing gear control handle is moved into the UP or DN
detent. A nose gear actuator applies the force necessary to raise or lower the gear. The nose gear actuator is
attached to airplane structure forward and above the gear and to the lower end of the upper drag brace. A
nose gear lock strut assembly, driven by an actuator and held in position by spring bungees, positively locks
the gear in up or down position. The lock strut consists of a lock link and lock brace assembly located
between the aft bulkhead and the upper drag brace. The lock actuator is mounted on the aft bulkhead
between structure and an extension on the aft end of the lock brace. The spring bungees consist of two
tension springs, one on each side of the lock brace. Bungees are connected to lugs on the lock link and at the
lock brace pivot point on structure.

ATA-30 Page 36 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

NOSE GEAR ACTUATOR

LOCK LINK
LOCK BRACE

UPPER DRAG BRACE LOCK SPRING BUNGEE

LOWER DRAG BRACE

NOSE GEAR
LOCK ACTUATOR

SHOCK STRUT

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-32 Page 37


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Retraction

When the landing gear control lever is moved to the UP position for gear retraction, hydraulic pressure is
directed through the selector valve and the nose gear modular package to the gear and the lock actuators.
Flow to the gear actuator is controlled by a flow limiting valve. Flow leaving the lock actuator is controlled by
a restrictor. The lock actuator starts retracting to apply a downward force to an extension on the lock link.
The downward force pulls the lock link over center and starts both the lock strut and drag brace folding. As
gear retraction proceeds, the lock link assembly swings through 90 degrees from the horizontal to the vertical
position. In so doing, the lock link extension passes across an overcenter position with respect to the lock
actuator. From this point, the lock actuator retracting force is opposed to lock link movement until the gear is
almost retracted. During the opposition period, the larger main gear actuator overpowers the lock actuator.
The unlock force provided by the lock actuator when the gear is down, becomes the locking force when gear is
up. The changeover is caused by the lock link extension moving from the aft to the forward side of the lock
link pivot.

Extension

When the landing gear control lever is moved to DN position, hydraulic pressure is directed to the gear and
lock actuators in the opposite direction to gear retraction and a similar course of events would apply.
However, with the gear up and locked, the weight of the gear applies a high compression load on the lock
strut. The gear load on the lock strut plus the force applied by the pressurized nose gear actuator tends to
make lock release noisy and stiff. Therefore, the transfer cylinder is used to direct down line pressure to the
up side of the nose gear actuator and so equalize pressure on both sides of the piston. The pressure impulse
from the transfer cylinder is supported momentarily by the flow control valves in the modular package. By
this means, the main actuator extension force is reversed during the lock strut unlocking and the initial hinging
of the drag brace. After unlocking, the extension cycle is opposite to retraction.

ATA-30 Page 38 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

TWO WAY RESTRICTOR


(INTERNAL TO ACTUATOR)

NOSE GEAR TWO WAY


ACTUATOR RESTRICTOR
(PORT MOUNTED)
C1 C2 C1 C2 C1 C2

TRANSFER NOSE GEAR LOCK


CYLINDER DOWN UP ACTUATOR

R P R P R P
DOWN OFF UP
FLOW PRIORITY
SELECTOR VALVE LIMITER VALVE

3550

3550
NOSE
GEAR
MODULAR
PACKAGE

TWO WAY
RESTRICTOR
TO NOSE WHEEL NOSE GEAR FUSE
STEERING

DOWN LINE UP LINE


TO MAIN GEAR TO MAIN GEAR

C1 C SELECTOR
R P VALVE
LEGEND: TO MAIN
GEAR
RETURN DAMPER

PRESSURE

LANDING GEAR
SYSTEM
TRANSFER FLOW BYPASS
SYSTEM
VALVE LIMITER VALVE
"B"

RETURN

SYSTEM
"A" PRESSURE

Nose Gear Extension and Retraction Hydraulic System Schmatic

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-32 Page 39


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Nose Gear Actuator

The nose gear actuator converts hydraulic pressure to the mechanical force required to raise or lower the nose
gear. The actuator is a hydraulic piston type with snubbing action to slow movement when limits of travel are
approached. The cylinder head of the actuator is attached to a heavy bracket in the wheel well ceiling. The
piston rod is attached to the upper drag brace. Hydraulic fluid is directed to both ends of the hydraulic
cylinder through flexible hoses.

The nose gear actuator restricts the rate of extension and retraction of the gear just as the gear approaches the
up or the down position. Snubbing effect is obtained by the action of a spring loaded sliding valve snubbing
assembly. After the actuator has extended 0.65 inch, the snubbing valve opens and hydraulic flow is
unrestricted. When the piston is one inch from the fully extended position, a stop on the piston contacts the
snubber valve sleeve. Further movement of the piston pulls the sleeve against a compression spring to close
ports. During the remainder of piston travel, hydraulic flow must pass through a diminishing number of holes.
The increasing restriction to hydraulic flow steadily slows the actuator extension rate until the piston reaches
the end of travel. The sequence repeats in reverse when the actuator retracts.

ATA-30 Page 40 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

SNUB VALVE
SLEEVE

OUTER
CYLINDER

SNUB VALVE

GEAR DOWN
METERED PORT
ORIFICE
GEAR UP NOSE GEAR EXTENDED
PORT
(SNUB VALVE CLOSED)

NOSE GEAR IN TRANSIT


(SNUB VALVE OPEN)

NOSE GEAR RETRACTED


(SNUB VALVE CLOSED)

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-32 Page 41


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Nose Gear Lock Mechanism

The nose gear lock mechanism locks the gear in the gear up and the gear down positions. The mechanism
also releases the lock just before gear retraction or extension. The mechanism includes a lock actuator, lock
spring bungees, and a lock strut consisting of a lock link and a lock brace assembly. The lock strut is
between structure and the drag brace. When the gear is extended, the lock strut prevents the drag strut from
folding when forces tending to retract the gear are applied. When the gear is retracted, the lock strut and the
upper drag brace form a pair of shear legs from which the gear hangs by the lower drag brace. In up or down
positions, the hinge of the lock strut is overcenter to lock the gear in position. The lock actuator moves the
lock strut across the overcenter position to release the gear. The bungee springs are under tension when the
lock strut is in locked position, holding the hinge overcenter even when the lock actuator is depressurized. A
pin inserted through holes drilled through the lock strut hinge provides a ground lock to prevent inadvertent
gear retraction during ground operations.

Nose Gear Lock Actuator

The nose gear lock actuator locks and unlocks the nose gear in either up or down position. The actuator is a
hydraulic piston type and is mounted on the forward face of the aft bulkhead in the wheel well. The actuator
retracts to move the lock strut over center, start the drag brace folding, and so begin the retraction cycle. For
gear extension, the lock actuator extends to unlock the gears. At the end of gear retraction or extension, the
actuator forces the lock strut into the overcenter locked position against the tension of the lock spring
bungees.

Nose Gear Lock Spring Bungee

The nose gear lock spring bungees are arranged to apply a load to hold the lock strut in overcenter position.
Bungees consist of tension springs, with one end attached to the lock brace pivot on structure, and the other
end to a lock link lug beyond the lock strut hinge. Bungees are tensioned to keep gear locked when hydraulic
pressure is off the actuators.

ATA-30 Page 42 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

SEE A

UPPER DRAG LOCK


BRACE BRACE
LOCK SPRING
BUNGEE

GROUND LOCK
PIN HOLE
LOCK LINK LOCK
BRACKET ACTUATOR
1
LOWER
DRAG BRACE BRACKET ON
STRUCTURE

(UNLOCKED)

VISUAL LOCK
INDICATOR

(LOCKED)

1 NOT ON ALL AIRPLANES A

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-32 Page 43


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Nose Gear Door Linkage

The nose gear door linkage transfers motion from the nose gear to open and close the nose gear wheel well
doors. Doors are open when gear is extended and close as the gear retracts. A link assembly connects a lug
on the shock strut outer cylinder near the trunnion with the short arm of a bellcrank. A pushrod between a
long arm on the crank and a fitting on the door completes the linkage. The lugs on the outer cylinder and the
arms on the crank are positioned to pass over an overcenter position for 80 percent of the gear travel.
Therefore, except for a very slight further opening, the doors barely move during gear retraction. When the
gear is moving over the last few inches of retraction, the long arm on the crank is almost at right angles to the
pushrod connected to door. The doors then rapidly close as gear fully retracts. On gear extension, the initial
extension movement opens the doors wide. At this point, lugs and cranks reach overcenter position and the
doors remain open for the rest of the extension cycle.

UPPER DRAG
BRACE

LUG
BELL
CRANK

PUSHROD

DOOR
FITTING
LOWER DRAG
BRACE
RIGHT
DOOR

LEFT
DOOR

ATA-30 Page 44 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

NOSE GEAR MANUAL EXTENSION SYSTEM


Overview

The nose gear manual extension system is used to lower the nose gear when hydraulic system pressure is not
available. Pulling the manual extension handle for the nose gear transmits motion through a drum and cable
to unlock the gear from the up and locked position. When the nose gear is released from the up and locked
position, the gear will free fall to the down and locked position.

Controls for nose gear manual extension are located in the floor of the control cabin immediately aft and to the
right of the aisle stand. Three controls, one for the nose gear and one for each main gear, are installed in the
control cabin floor protected by an access door. The landing gear control handle must be either in neutral or
down position to prevent hydraulic lock during manual extension. A single pull of approximately 80 pounds on
the manual extension handle releases the nose gear lock mechanism to allow the gear to extend. A return
spring attached to the torque tube quadrant assembly and to the structure will return the system to the original
position, when the handle is released. The landing gear position and warning lights function normally during
manual extension operation.

The nose gear manual extension system is operated from the control cabin. To manually extend the nose gear,
proceed as follows:

Place landing gear control lever in neutral or down position.

Open manual extension control access door.

Pull nose gear manual extension handle approximately eight inches and observe that nose gear falls to down
and locked position as indicated by the green light on the pilots' instrument panel.

CAUTION: DO NOT HOLD MANUAL EXTENSION HANDLE IN ANY EXTENDED POSITION DURING
HYDRAULIC OPERATION OF THE LANDING GEAR.

Release manual extension handle.

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-32 Page 45


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Nose Gear Manual Extension Control Cable

The nose gear manual extension control cable is connected to the manual extension control drum installed
beneath the control cabin floor and routed beneath the cabin floor through pulleys and eyeball-type pressure
seals to the nose gear manual extension release mechanism in the nose gear wheel well. When the manual
extension handle is pulled to release the gear, the motion is transmitted by the control cable to the nose gear
manual extension release mechanism. Motion supplied to the release mechanism unlocks the nose gear lock
mechanism to allow the nose gear to fall to down and locked position.

Nose Gear Manual Extension Release Mechanism

The nose gear manual extension release mechanism is located in the aft ceiling area of the nose gear wheel
well. Motion to release the nose gear is transmitted by a cable to a torque tube. A roller is attached
eccentrically to the torque tube. As the torque tube rotates, the roller contacts an extension of the nose gear
lock link. As the roller is forced against the lock link extension, a force is applied to move the lock strut from
the overcenter (locked) position and the nose gear will free fall to the down and locked position. A stop
attached to the torque tube contacts structure to prevent further control cable movement after the torque tube
has been rotated approximately 100 degrees. A return spring attached to the quadrant assembly and to the
structure will return the system to the original position when the handle is released.

ATA-30 Page 46 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

NOSE GEAR
NOSE GEAR NOSE GEAR MANUAL EXTENSION
LEFT MAIN GEAR HANDLE
MANUAL EXTENSION MANUAL EXTENSION MANUAL EXTENSION
CONTROL CABLE RELEASE MECHANISM HANDLE
MANUAL RIGHT MAIN GEAR
EXTENSION MANUAL EXTENSION
CONTROL HANDLE

NOSE GEAR
MANUAL EXTENSION
AISLE NOSE GEAR CONTROL CABLE
STAND WHEEL WELL

NOSE GEAR
MANUAL EXTENSION
CONTROL CABLE

RETURN
SPRING
NOSE GEAR
MANUAL EXTENSION
RELEASE MECHANISM
NOSE GEAR UPPER
DRAG BRACE

NOSE GEAR
LOCK STRUT

NOSE GEAR
LOWER DRAG
BRACE

UP AND LOCKED RELEASED

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-32 Page 47


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

ATA-30 Page 48 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

MAIN GEAR EXTENSION AND RETRACTION


Overview

The main gear extension system raises and lowers the main gear. The main gear retracts or extends
simultaneously with the nose gear when the landing gear control handle is moved into the UP or DN detent. A
main gear actuator applies the force required to raise and lower the gear. The actuator works in conjunction
with a walking beam to apply force to the main gear shock strut and swing the gear inboard. Both the actuator
and the walking beam are connected to lugs on the shock strut. The outboard ends of the actuator and the
walking beam pivot on a beam hanger attached to the airplane structure. A main gear lock mechanism locks
the gear positively in the up or down positions. The lock mechanism is mounted on a reaction link located
between the upper ends of the shock strut and side strut. A lock actuator to engage and disengage the uplock
is mounted on the side strut end of the reaction link. The gear is locked down by a folding lock strut located
between the center of the reaction link and the side strut center hinge. The lock strut is operated by the
downlock actuator, mounted on the shock strut end of the reaction link. Spring bungees between the shock
strut and lock strut serve to hold the lock strut in either the locked or unlocked positions.

BEAM
HANGER WALKING
BEAM

DOWNLOCK
MAIN GEAR ACTUATOR
ACTUATOR
DOWNLOCK
SPRING BUNGEE
TRUNNION
LINK
UPLOCK
ACTUATOR

UPLOCK
SPRING BUNGEE
SHOCK
STRUT
UPLOCK HOOK

DRAG UPLOCK SENSOR


STRUT (PROXIMITY SWITCH)
LOCK STRUT
(DOWNLOCK)
DOWNLOCK SENSOR
(PROXIMITY SWITCH)

SIDE STRUT

UPLOCK ROLLER

FWD INBD

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-32 Page 49


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Retraction

When the control lever is moved to UP position, hydraulic pressure is then directed to the modular package
and to the uplock actuator. After passing through the modular package, pressure reaches the up port of the
main actuator and the uplock port of the downlock actuator. Flow to the main actuator is controlled by flow
limiting valves and pressure relief valves. Flow to the downlock actuator is restricted. Flow from the
downlock actuator is unrestricted. Therefore, the downlock actuator quickly unlocks the gear and starts the
side strut folding before full pressure builds up in the main actuator. When the gear retracts, the uplock
actuator has locking pressure but stop links prevent the uplock hook from moving to locked position. On the
final movement to full retraction, the uplock roller strikes a projection on the uplock hook; this triggers stop
links to flip over and release the hook. The pressurized lock actuator then snaps the hook into final locked
position. In the same movement, the stop links engage in locking detents to hold the hook in position.

Extension

When the control lever is moved to DN position, hydraulic pressure is directed to the main gear actuator, the
lock port of the downlock actuator, and to the modular package. After passing through the modular package,
pressure reaches the unlock port of the uplock actuator. Pressure to and from the uplock actuator is
unrestricted and the actuator moves quickly to unlock the gear. After retraction, as soon as retraction
pressure leaves the main actuator, the full weight of the gear hangs on the uplock hook. To prevent the
possibility of main actuator extension force further loading the hook, and so causing noisy disengagement of
the uplock, the transfer cylinder goes into action. On the first surge of pressure in the main actuator down
line, the cylinder transfers pressure to the main actuator up line. Loss of transfer cylinder pressure from the
up line is delayed by the flow limiting valve in the modular package. For a moment, pressure is equal on both
ends of the main actuator, and the piston differential area creates an up force. The uplock actuator extends to
unlock the hook during the up force period and the gear extends. On extension, the locking pressure on the
downlock actuator pulls the lock strut into the overcenter locked position. Spring bungees apply a force to keep
the strut in the locked position.

ATA-30 Page 50 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

C1 C2 C1 C2 C1 C2

UP LINE

TO NOSE
R P R P R P
LANDING GEAR DOWN OFF UP
DOWN LINE
SELECTOR VALVE
MAIN GEAR
DAMPER

MAIN GEAR
MAIN GEAR
UPLOCK
DOWNLOCK
ACTUATOR
ACTUATOR

CHECK
VALVE

FLOW
LIMITER
3500

3500

3500

3500
RELIEF
VALVE

R R

DOWN
MAIN GEAR PRIORITY
MODULAR PACKAGE VALVE

UP
TRANSFER
CYLINDER

ONE WAY ONE WAY


RESTRICTOR RESTRICTOR
LEFT MAIN GEAR RIGHT MAIN GEAR
MAIN GEAR
C1 C2 SELECTOR ACTUATOR
R P VALVE

RETURN
PRESSURE
PRIORITY VALVE P
LANDING GEAR FLOW BYPASS
SYSTEM LIMITER VALVE
SYSTEM TRANSFER
"B" VALVE

RETURN

SYSTEM
"A" PRESSURE

Main Gear Hydraulic System Schematic

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-32 Page 51


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Main Gear Actuator

The main gear actuator converts hydraulic pressure into mechanical power for retraction and extension of the
main landing gear. The actuator is a hydraulic piston type, with snubbing action to slow movement when
limits of travel are approached. The cylinder head end of the actuator is attached to the beam hanger. The
piston rod is attached to a lug on the shock strut. The actuator and the walking beam are located in the wing
outboard of the shock strut. Hydraulic fluid is directed to the head end of the actuator through two flexible
hoses. Fluid from one hose flows into the cylinder head. A transfer tube built onto the actuator directs fluid
from the second hose to the rod end of the cylinder.

When the main gear actuator is pressurized to extend, opposing forces from the actuator and walking beam act
to rotate the gear. The gear swings inboard and up into the wheel well. When the actuator is pressurized to
retract, the forces rotate the gear in the opposite direction to extend the gear.

The main gear actuator restricts the rate of extension and retraction of the gear just as it approaches the up or
down position. The snubbing effect is obtained by the action of a spring-loaded sliding valve snubbing
assembly. After the actuator has extended 1.10 inches, the snubbing valve opens and hydraulic flow is
unrestricted. When the piston is 1.30 inches from fully extended, a snubber stop on the piston contacts the
snubber valve sleeve. Further movement of the piston pulls the sleeve against a compression spring to close
off ports. For the remainder of piston travel, hydraulic flow must pass through a diminishing number of holes.
The increasing restriction to hydraulic flow steadily slows the actuator extension rate until the piston reaches
the end of travel. The sequence repeats in reverse, when the actuator retracts.

ATA-30 Page 52 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

TRANSFER
TUBE
GEAR
DOWN PORT PISTON

METERED
ORIFICE

SNUB VALVE
SLEEVE

SNUB VALVE
OUTER
CYLINDER
GEAR EXTENDED
GEAR UP PORT (SNUB VALVE CLOSED)

GEAR IN TRANSIT
(SNUB VALVE OPEN)

GEAR RETRACTED
(SNUB VALVE CLOSED)

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-32 Page 53


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Main Gear Actuator Walking Beam

The main gear actuator walking beam works in conjunction with the main gear actuator to retract and lower
the gear. The walking beam serves to reduce the reaction force going into airplane structure from the main
gear actuator. Reaction force from the actuator is transmitted back to the shock strut through the walking
beam. The inboard end of the beam is attached to a lug on the top of the shock strut. The outboard end is
attached to the walking beam hanger. The hanger pivots on a fitting mounted between the landing gear beam
and the rear wing spar. The cylinder end of the actuator is connected to the walking beam. The actuator
piston rod is attached to a lug on the side of the shock strut. On gear retraction, the outboard force from the
actuator piston rod is applied directly to the gear. The inboard reaction force from the cylinder of the actuator
reaches the shock strut through the actuator walking beam. The inboard and outboard forces combined
provide a couple to raise the gear. The resulting reaction to the couple tends to rotate the actuator and
walking beam combination about the gear retraction axis. Force generated by the attempted rotation is taken to
structure through the beam hanger. With the walking beam as a third order lever arm, a much reduced force
reaches structure. The piston rod shock strut movement arm increases as the gear moves up. The walking
beam shock strut movement arm first increases then decreases during retraction.

DOWNLOCK UPLOCK
ACTUATOR ACTUATOR STRUCTURE

UPLOCK
HOOK

RETRACTION
PIVOT LOCK STRUT

SHOCK STRUT
SIDE STRUT
SHOCK STRUT DOOR
OPERATING ARM UPLOCK ROLLER

DOWN AND LOCKED

ATA-30 Page 54 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-32 Page 55


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Main Gear Lock Mechanism

The main gear lock mechanism positively locks the gear in retracted or extended position. The lock consists
of a hook, two hydraulic actuators, spring bungees, a lock strut, and operating linkage. In the retracted
position, the hook engages a roller mounted on the universal side strut fitting. In the down position, the lock
strut assumes an overcenter position to prevent the side strut from folding. The uplock hook and the lock
strut are connected to individual actuators. The actuators are mounted on the reaction link. Sensors for the
position indicating and warning system proximity switches are located in two places. The downlock sensor is
on the side strut, near the lower end of the lock strut. The uplock sensor is mounted between the uplock hook
and the lower end of the uplock spring bungees.

The normal operation of both up and down locks is by hydraulic pressure directed to the lock actuators.
Provision is made to release the uplock in the absence of hydraulic pressure by means of a manual extension
system. Spring bungees provide a force to hold the locks in the locked or unlocked positions. When the
manual extension system releases the gear, the lock strut will swing into locked position as the gear falls. On
the final extension movement, the spring bungees pull the lock strut into overcenter position.

Main Gear Lock Actuator

The main gear lock actuators operate the main gear lock mechanism to permit retraction or normal extension
of the landing gear (Fig. 5). Actuators are the hydraulic piston type. Two actuators are mounted on the
reaction link of each main gear; one on the inboard end to operate the uplock and one on the outboard end to
operate the downlock. The downlock actuator extends to push the lock strut across the overcenter position and
to start the side strut folding. Retraction of the actuator pulls the lock strut into the overcenter locked position
when the gear extends. The uplock actuator extends to swing the uplock hook away from the uplock roller and
release the gear. Uplock actuator retraction pushes the hook outboard to fully engage the uplock roller.

Main Gear Lock Springs

The main gear lock springs are arranged to apply a load to hold the locks in either engaged or disengaged
positions. Lock springs consist of tension springs with one end attached to a fixed pivot point and the other
end to the appropriate lock mechanism. When the locks operate, the spring ends attached to lock mechanism
swing through an arc the highest point of which is in line with the spring fixed pivot point. Therefore, an
overcenter effect keeps locks in position, fully open or closed.

ATA-30 Page 56 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

UPLOCK
SPRING
DOWNLOCK UPLOCK
ACTUATOR UPLOCK CRANK
ACTUATOR
DOWNLOCK UPLOCK
SPRING LINK

UPLOCK
HOOK
STOP LINK
REACTION
LINK

SHOCK
STRUT
L0CK STRUT
(DOWNLOCK)

SIDE STRUT

GEAR DOWN AND LOCKED

UPLOCK
DOWNLOCK UPLOCK UPLOCK
CRANK STOP LINK
ACTUATOR ACTUATOR LINK
DOWNLOCK
UPLOCK
SPRING
SPRING

UPLOCK
HOOK

ROLLER

REACTION
LINK SHOCK L0CK STRUT
STRUT (DOWNLOCK) SIDE STRUT

GEAR IN TRANSIT

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-32 Page 57


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

ATA-30 Page 58 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

MAIN GEAR MANUAL EXTENSION SYSTEM


Overview

The main gear manual extension system is used to lower the main gear when hydraulic system pressure is not
available. Pulling a manual extension handle for the respective gear transmits motion through drums and
cables to unlock the gear from the up and locked position. When the main gear uplock mechanism is released,
the gear will free fall to the down and locked position.

Controls for main gear manual extension are located in the floor of the control cabin immediately aft and to the
right of the aisle stand. Three controls, one for the nose gear and one for each main gear, are installed in the
control cabin floor protected by an access door. The landing gear control handle must be either in neutral or
down position to prevent hydraulic lock during manual extension. A single pull of approximately 60 pounds on
the manual extension handle releases the main gear uplock mechanism to allow the gear to extend. A spring
attached to the manual extension linkage returns the system to the original position. The landing gear position
and warning lights function normally during manual extension operation.

The main gear manual extension system is operated from the control cabin. Each gear is operated ndividually.

To manually extend a main gear, proceed as follows:

Place the landing gear control lever in neutral or down position.

Open manual extension control access door.

Pull the respective main gear manual extension handle approximately 14.4 to 16.1 inches and observe that
main gear falls to down and locked position as indicated by the corresponding green light on the pilots'
instrument panel.

CAUTION: DO NOT HOLD MANUAL EXTENSION HANDLE IN ANY EXTENDED POSITION DURING
HYDRAULIC OPERATION OF THE LANDING GEAR.

Release the manual extension handle.

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-32 Page 59


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Main Gear Manual Extension Control Cable

The main gear manual extension control cables are connected to the manual extension control drums installed
beneath the control cabin floor and routed beneath the cabin floor through pulleys and eyeball type pressure
seals to the main gear uplock release mechanism in the respective main gear wheel well. When the manual
extension handle is pulled to release the gear, the motion is transmitted by the control cables through the
uplock release mechanism to the main gear uplock assembly. Motion supplied to the uplock assembly from
the manual extension system releases the uplock hook from the uplock roller on the main gear to allow the
main gear to fall to down and locked position.

Main Gear Manual Extension Linkage

The main gear manual extension linkage is located in the main gear wheel well adjacent to the main gear
uplock assembly. Motion to release the main gear is transmitted by a cable MLGEA to a quadrant assembly.
As the quadrant moves, it will push a crank which will move the release rod which is attached to the quadrant
assembly crank. Movement of the release rod will move an arm attached to a cam shaft. Rotation of the cam
shaft causes a two-fingered cam to contact rollers on the uplock links. As the cam rotates the uplock links,
the uplock links pull against the return spring and the stop link to pull outboard on the uplock hook. As the
uplock hook moves outboard, the main gear uplock roller is released and the main gear will free fall to the
down and locked position. Further control cable movement is prevented when the uplock link rollers bottom
out on the cam. The return spring attached to the quadrant assembly will return the main gear manual
extension system to the original position when the manual extension handle is released.

ATA-30 Page 60 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

CONTROL
CABLES
MLGEA

LEFT MAIN GEAR


MANUAL EXTENSION
LINKAGE

MANUAL
EXTENSION
CONTROL
WHEEL
WELL

MLGEA CABLE

MANUAL EXTENSION HANDLES

R N L RETURN
SPRING

MANUAL EXTENSION
ACCESS DOOR

FORWARD
STRUCTURE CABLE GUARD

QUADRANT
ASSEMBLY

UPLOCK RELEASE ROD

CAM SHAFT ARM


MLGEA
CABLES
AFT STRUCTURE
CAM

CONTROL
DRUMS

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-32 Page 61


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

HYDRAULIC BRAKE SYSTEM


Overview

The hydraulic braking system aids airplane control during ground operations. The Brakes hold the airplanes
during parking, mooring, and engine run. They stop the wheel spin after takeoff, shorten the landing run, and
assist in turning when the airplane is taxied.

The brake system is manually controlled by the captain's or first officer's rudder pedals through linkage and
cables to the brake metering valve for each main gear. Each brake metering valve directs B system hydraulic
pressure up to 3000 PSI to the brakes of the main gear it serves. An antiskid system and an automatic
braking system are incorporated into the manual braking system.

The hydraulic brake system consists of system control cables and linkages, alternate brake selector valve,
accumulator isolation valve, brake metering valves, brake feel augmenters, related antiskid/autobrake units,
shuttle valves, hydraulic fuses, main gear brake swivels, disk-type brakes, hydraulic pressure accumulator,
transmitters and gages. Automatic braking system components, autobrake control panel, two shuttle valves,
autobrake digital circuits, an autobrake pressure control module and four pressure switches are installed in
the hydraulic system. The rotating, disk-type brakes are self-adjusting. The hydraulic pressure accumulator
is charged to 3000 PSI in order to provide braking pressure for parking or whenever the main hydraulic
systems are depressurized. The accumulator pressure transmitter provides a brake system hydraulic pressure
indication on a remote gage in the control cabin. The brakes are applied automatically to stop the spinning
main gear wheels when the landing gear is retracted. A snubber is provided in the nose wheel well to stop the
spinning nose wheels.

When the captain or first officer depresses the brake pedals, the brake metering valves are opened and
hydraulic fluid is directed to the brakes through antiskid valves. The intensity of pressure established in the
brakes varies directly with the amount of pedal force maintained. Feel at the brake pedals depends on brake
metering valve return springs, brake pressure diverted to oppose metering valve position, and feel augmenter
feedback. Depressing left or right brake pedals allows independent left or right brake operation on the main
landing gear. When pedal force is reduced, fluid in the brakes is released to the hydraulic system return. The
normal brake system and autobrake system are pressurized by hydraulic system B. In the event that hydraulic
system B is lost, the alternate brake select valve opens to apply hydraulic system A pressure to the alternate
brake system, and the accumulator isolation valve closes to prevent the accumulator from discharging into the
normal brake system. If both hydraulic system A and hydraulic system B are lost the accumulator isolation
valve opens and provides accumulator pressure to the normal brake system. The accumulator is pre-charged
with compressed air or nitrogen and contains sufficient fluid for approximately six full brake applications.

When the automatic braking system is operating, the brake metering valves are bypassed and autobrake
control module modulates brake pressure as commanded by circuit cards in the antiskid control module.

ATA-30 Page 62 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE

 
B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization

AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource


SENSE LINE
 

 
 
A SYS
PRESSURE ALT
P/S
SOURCE ACCUM
SELECT ACCUM-
ISOLATE
UP LINE VALVE ULATOR
VALVE
PRESSURE
SENSE LINE
B SYS
PRESSURE
A SYS RETURN

ALTERNATE BRAKE FEEL


METERING AUGMENTOR
DUAL BRAKE BRAKE FEEL
VALVE
CABLES AUGMENTOR RIGHT BRAKE
NORMAL
(TYP) NORMAL CONTROL
METERING
METERING MECHANISM
VALVE
VALVE
FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY

LEFT BRAKE
CONTROL
MECHANISM
AUTO BRAKE
ALTERNATE CONTROL VALVE
METERING
VALVE P/S P/S

AUTOBRAKE
SHUTTLE
VALVE
ALT ALT
(2 PLACES)
ANTISKID ANTISKID
VALVE VALVE

NORMAL NORMAL NORMAL NORMAL


ANTISKID ANTISKID B SYS ANTISKID ANTISKID
VALVE VALVE RETURN VALVE VALVE

FUSE FUSE FUSE PARKING FUSE FUSE FUSE


BRAKE
VALVE

SHUTTLE
VALVE
(4 PLACES)

LEFT GEAR RIGHT GEAR


BRAKE UNITS BRAKE UNITS PRESSURE
ATA-32 Page 63

RELIEF
VALVE
1

1 ON SOME AIRPLANES

and Systems Introduction


 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Alternate Brake Selector Valve

The alternate brake selector valve blocks system A hydraulic pressure to the alternate brake metering valves
when system B pressure is available for normal brake operation. When system B pressure is lost, the valve
will open to apply system A pressure to the alternate brake metering valves.

Under normal operating conditions system B pressure holds the select valve closed preventing system A
pressure from entering the alternate braking system.

Following takeoff when the landing gear is retracted system B pressure continues to hold the selector valve
closed, but landing gear retraction pressure is now available and ported through the selector valve to the
alternate brake metering valves to stop wheel rotation.

When system B pressure is lost the valve opens under system A pressure and simultaneously closes the
alternate braking system to landing gear retraction pressure. At the same time a pressure sensitive switch in
the alternate brake select valve activates when system A pressure to the valve reaches 1900 PSI and sends a
signal to the antiskid control module to annunciate alternate antiskid failures. Autobrake control is not
available to the alternate system.
OVERHEAD

FLOW SEE A FLOW


FUSE AUTOBRAKE FUSE
CONTROL
ACCUMULATOR MODULE
ALT BRAKE
ISOLATION SELECTOR VALVE
VALVE
ANTISKID ANTISKID
BRAKE METERING
SHUTTLE SHUTTLE
VALVE ASSY LEFT
VALVES VALVES
(2 PLACES) ALTERNATE
RIGHT ANTISKID
ALTERNATE PARKING BRAKE LEFT
CONTROL
ANTISKID SHUTOFF VALVE ANTISKID
VALVE
CONTROL OUTBD CONTROL
BRAKE AUTOBRAKE VALVES
VALVE INBD
FLOW SHUTTLE
FUSES VALVES
BRAKE
INBD RIGHT ANTISKID FLOW
OUTBD CONTROL VALVES FUSES

SERVICING GAGE
ACCUMULATOR
WHEEL WELL
BRAKE PRESS AFT BULKHEAD
TRANSMITTER BL 0 STA 727

VIEW LOOKING AFT

HYDRAULIC LINE

ALTERNATE SOURCE
SELECT VALVE

SWITCH

HYDRAULIC LINES

HYDRAULIC LINE

FWD

ATA-30 Page 64 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Brake Control Linkage

The brake pedals as part of the rudder pedal assemblies actuate brake control linkage below the control cabin
floor. Captain's and first officer's brake pedals are interconnected through linkage below the control cabin
floor, to have identical brake operation from both positions. Connected to the control linkage are two
horizontal quadrants. The quadrants are connected to the brake metering valves by dual control cables.
Movement of either right or left brake pedal will actuate the corresponding right or left main gear brake
metering valve and movement of both brake pedals together will apply both main gear brakes.

PARKING BRAKE
HANDLE

SEE A

CAPTAIN'S
BRAKE PEDALS

PARKING BRAKE
VERTICAL AXLE LIGHT SWITCH
PUSH ROD

BELL CRANK

HORIZONTAL
BELL CRANK DUAL BRAKE CABLES
PARKING BRAKE PAWLS
TIE ROD
PARKING BRAKE ADJUSTABLE STOP

HORIZONTAL BELL CRANK


HORIZONTAL QUADRANT

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-32 Page 65


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Brake Metering Valve

For each main gear, identical normal and alternate brake metering valves are fitted in an assembly for
simultaneous operation. Each left and right metering valve assembly is mounted on the wheel well ceiling at
LBL 10 and RBL 10 respectively just forward of the junction of the aft wheel well bulkhead. The assembly
consists of a cable quadrant mounted above the ceiling driving a shaft projecting through the wheel well
ceiling on which adjustable cranks are mounted 180° apart. The metering slide of each brake metering valve
is contacted upon rotation of the crank assembly to meter hydraulic pressure. The normal brake metering
valve is rigged to actuate slightly ahead of the alternate valve.

A brake feel augmenter is mounted on each normal brake metering valve and is used to provide increased
brake pedal feel force at low metered pressure to improve brake pressure control during taxi conditions. The
augmenter consists of a slide attached to a plunger. The slide is hydraulically connected to the output
pressure line of the brake metering valve and the plunger is connected by a roller and lever to the shaft of the
metering valve control quadrant. Operation of the brakes will pressurize the brake metering valve output line
causing fluid to push against the augmenter slide and plunger. This generates a resistance to pedal force
proportional to the amount of metered brake pressure. This feature is not available to the alternate braking
system.

ATA-30 Page 66 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

SEE A

TU RNBUCKLES

BRAKE CONTROL
CABLES

TURNBUCKLES

ALTERNATE BRAKE
METERING VALVE
ASSEMBLY NORMAL BRAKE
METERING VALVE
UNIONS ASSEMBLY

UP MOUNTING
BOLTS

BRAKE FEEL
AUGMENTOR
ASSEMBLY
(REF 32-41-97
FOR REMOVAL/
INSTALLATION)
BOLT
(3 LOCATIONS)

RIGHT INSTALLATION SHOWN


LEFT INSTALLATION SIMILAR
A

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-32 Page 67


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Main Gear Brakes

Tire to surface friction force for stopping the aircraft is controlled through the application of hydraulic pressure
to the multidisc brake. Rotors coupled to wheel/tire assemblies and stators attached to gear structure are
pressed together by the action of hydraulic pistons causing the frictional force required to stop the aircraft.
Automatic adjustment assemblies maintain correct brake element clearances. Wear indicators give visual
warning of time to overhaul brakes. Hydraulic bleed ports are provided to assist in the overhaul.

When the brakes are applied, hydraulic fluid under system pressure enters the inlet port of the brake, through
a disconnect valve, and is distributed to the pistons. As the pistons move out under fluid pressure they push
the pressure plate axially against the stack of stators and rotors so that the stack is compressed between the
pressure plate and the torque tube backing plate, and rotational braking friction is developed.

Separate lining wear indicator pins are provided at two locations. Dimension L is set at brake manufacture or
overhaul. Subsequent lining wear will cause dimension L, with brake pressure applied, to decrease to a point
indicating when the brake must be removed for lining replacement.

ATA-30 Page 68 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

TORQUE TUBE
BACKING PLATE
PRESSURE PORT
LINING BLOCK

ROTOR
(4 PLACES)

RIVET
(TYPICAL)
RELINE INDICATOR PIN
(2 PLACES) STATOR
(5 PLACES)
SEE B
PISTON
(6 PLACES)

BLEEDER VALVES

CARRIER
TORQUE TUBE

PRESSURE CYLINDER
(6 PLACES)

MOUNTING FLANGE
PRESSURE PLATE

AUTOMATIC ADJUSTER
ASSEMBLY
(4 PLACES)
SEE A

NUT
RECESSED
WASHER RETAINING RING

ADJUSTER CARRIER L
BALL

CARRIER
SPRING

RELINE
INDICATOR PIN

TUBE PRESSURE RETAINING PIN


ADJUSTER PIN PLATE
RETAINER
PRESSURE
PLATE
RIVET

A B

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-32 Page 69


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Brake Accumulator System

The brake accumulator stores energy for brake operation and assures instantaneous flow of fluid to the
brakes. When fully charged, the accumulator holds a reserve of fluid under pressure sufficient for
approximately six brake applications and for maintaining parking brake pressure.

The system consists of the following:

1. accumulator, which has:

a) air charging valve


b) air charging gage
c) transmitter and associated wiring to indicator on P2 panel

2. two one way check valves

3. accumulator isolation valve

4. on some airplanes, pressure relief valve

The accumulator is provided with an air or nitrogen charging valve and gage located with the accumulator to
permit pre-charging. The accumulator is located on the lower aft wall of the right wheel well. Also included
with the accumulator is a pressure transmitter connected electrically to the HYD BRAKE PRESS indicator on
the lower P2 panel.

Two one-way check valves allow flow of system B hydraulic fluid into the accumulator but prevent the back
flow of hydraulic pressure.

An accumulator isolation valve is positioned with the check valves to block the flow of hydraulic fluid from the
accumulator when system A pressure is applied to the alternate brake system. Low pressure in system A
opens the accumulator isolation valve to allow accumulator pressure to the normal brake metering valves for
use in an emergency (where System A and B are un-pressurized) or for parking brake operation. System A
pressure would operate the alternate brake system and close the accumulator isolation valve should system B
fail.

On some airplanes, a pressure relief valve is installed between the accumulator and the return line on the left
outboard antiskid valve. This protects the system from pressure build up caused by the warming of a cold
soaked accumulator during airplane descent. The valve opens when pressure in system exceeds 3500 PSI and
passes fluid to the hydraulic system B return lines until pressure drops back to 3500 PSI or below.

ATA-30 Page 70 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

FLOW FLOW
FUSE FUSE
OVERHEAD AUTOBRAKE
CONTROL
ACCUMULATOR MODULE
ALT BRAKE
ISOLATION
SELECTOR VALVE
VALVE
ANTISKID ANTISKID
SHUTTLE BRAKE METERING SHUTTLE
VALVES VALVE ASSY VALVES
(2 LOCATIONS)
RIGHT LEFT LEFT
ALTERNATE PARKING BRAKE ANTISKID ALTERNATE
ANTISKID SHUTOFF VALVE OUTBD CONTROL ANTISKID
CONTROL INBD VALVES CONTROL
AUTOBRAKE
VALVE VALVE
SHUTTLE
BRAKE BRAKE
VALVES
FLOW FLOW
FUSES FUSES

INBD RIGHT ANTISKID


OUTBD CONTROL VALVES

WHEEL WELL
ACCUMULATOR AFT BULKHEAD
STA 727
SEE A

BL 0
VIEW IN THE AFT DIRECTION

BRAKE PRESSURE
TRANSMITTER

PRESSURE GAGE

CHARGING VALVE

CHARGING
LINE
HYDRAULIC
LINE

UNION

FWD
INBD UNION ACCUMULATOR
BRAKE CLAMP
ACCUMULATOR

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-32 Page 71


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Main Gear Brake Swivel Assemblies

The hydraulic brake lines mounted on the structure and on the landing gear of the airplane are connected by
main gear brake swivel assemblies. The swivel assemblies permit continued flow in the hydraulic lines during
retraction or extension of the landing gear. Swivel assemblies are mounted on the trunnion link of each gear.

The swivel assembly consists of two main parts. One is the rotating part or housing mounted on the trunnion
link and the other is the stationary part or body. There is an individual swivel for each brake line.

WALKING BEAM

MAIN GEAR
ACTUATOR

MAIN GEAR
BRAKE SWIVEL
ASSEMBLY

SEE A

TRUNNION
LINK

SHOCK
STRUT

ATA-30 Page 72 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Brake Hydraulic Fuses

A volumetric hydraulic fuse is located on the output line of each antiskid valve. The purpose of the fuse is to
prevent loss of hydraulic fluid in event of a line rupture downstream of the fuse. The fuse will shut off flow
after 40 cubic inches of fluid has passed through.

The fuse contains a bypass valve with a release lever which is lockwired in the closed position. Releasing the
lockwire and holding the lever in the open position will equalize pressure on both sides of the fuse so that it
can reset. It will also allow fluid to flow through to the brakes without setting the fuse during brake bleeding.

AIRPLANES WITH DECOTA HYDRAULIC FUSES; The lever is not lockwired. If you hold the lever in the
open position, the pressure on both sides of the fuse will equalize so the fuse can be reset. Also, this will
allow the fluid to flow through to the brakes during brake bleeding. When the lever is released, it will return
to the closed position.

ANTISKID
VALVE

TO BRAKES

FUSE BYPASS VALVE LEVER


(PNEUDRAULIC (PNEUDRAULIC
FUSES SHOWN) FUSES SHOWN)
SEE A SEE A

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-32 Page 73


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Brake Hydraulic Accumulator Servicing


Access is through the left and right Main Wheel Wells.

Accumulator Servicing

Install chocks on the wheels of the main landing gear and release the parking brake.

Push the captain's or the first officer's brake pedals approximately eight times to remove the pressure from
the brake system.

WARNING: DO NOT LOOSEN THE VALVE BODY. THE INNER PRESSURES CAN BLOW THE VALVE
OUT, WHICH CAN CAUSE INJURIES TO PERSONS.

CHARGING INSTRUCTIONS-
HYDRAULIC ACCUMULATOR
WITH SYSTEM DEPRESSURIZED
CHARGE WITH DRY NITROGEN
TO APPLICABLE PRESSURE PER
CHART BELOW - ± 50 PSI

1400

1200
PRESSURE-
PSI GAGE

1000

800

600
-50 -25 0 +25 +50 +75

AMBIENT TEMP - ° CENTIGRADE

Fill the hydraulic accumulator with dry nitrogen (refer to the instructions on the aluminum foil marker near the
pressure gage in the right main wheel well).

ATA-30 Page 74 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

 
Remove the valve cap.

Loosen the outer hex-swivel nut of the valve and fill to the specified pressure.

Tighten the outer hex-swivel nut of the valve.

Disconnect the pressure source and replace the cap.

Pressurize the applicable hydraulic system.

NOTE: The pressure gage of the hydraulic system should show approximately 3000 PSI.

After 5 to 10 minutes remove the pressure from the applicable hydraulic system.

NOTE: The brake pressure gage of the hydraulic system should show approximately 3000
PSI.

Push the brake pedals approximately six times and do a check on the pre-charge of the accumulator.

Fill the accumulator again if it is necessary.

Make sure swivel hexagon nut is tightened and replace the cap on the charge valve.

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-32 Page 75


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

PARKING BRAKE SYSTEM


Overview

The parking brake system is used to apply and hold brake pressure through the metering valves when the
airplane is parked or moored.

The parking brake system is composed of:

1. Parking brake lever, holding pawls and lever linkage


2. Parking brake lights, switch and associated wiring
3. Parking brake valve, switch and associated wiring

CAUTION: PARKING BRAKES SHOULD NOT BE SET FOLLOWING A HIGH ENERGY STOP. HIGH
ENERGY STOPS ARE DEFINED AS A REFUSED TAKE OFF OR ANY STOP OTHER THAN
NORMAL. UNDER STATIC PRESSURE, HOT BRAKE SURFACES TEND TO FUSE
TOGETHER. THEREFORE, AFTER A HIGH ENERGY STOP, OR FOLLOWING TOUCH AND GO
STOPS, A COOLING PERIOD OF 40 TO 60 MINUTES SHOULD BE ALLOWED BEFORE THE
PARKING BRAKE IS SET.

The parking brake uses the existing brake system. Application is made by foot and hand operated linkage and
utilizes pressure from the B hydraulic system or the accumulator (See Fig. 2). A parking brake shutoff valve
located in brake return flow lines prevents the normal decay of pressure through the antiskid valves. A red
light beside the parking brake lever on the center aisle stand and a secondary light located on the external
power electrical panel both illuminate to indicate when the parking brake is applied.

The parking brakes are set by depressing the brake pedals and lifting the parking brake lever and then
releasing the brake pedals. The parking brake lights will come on and remain on as long as battery power is
on. To release the parking brakes, the brake pedals are depressed and released. Antiskid describes the use of
the parking brake circuit to test air-ground sensor circuits related to antiskid operation.

ATA-30 Page 76 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

L382

CONTROL STAND
PARKING BRAKE LEVER,
LIGHT AND SWITCH
(CONTROL STAND - AFT)

32-60-00
28V DC OFF
BAT BUS
C194 32-30-00
ANTISKID FAIL SET PARK AND SQUAT
WARNING AND RELAY R274
S100 PARKING BRAKE SW
PARKING BRAKE
(CENTER AISLE STAND)
P6-2 CIRCUIT BREAKER
PANEL R

TO GND
MASTER DIM R L1002 PARKING
AND TEST BRAKE LIGHT
M469 DIM AND EXTERNAL POWER
L382 PARKING ANNUNCIATION PANEL
BRAKE LIGHT MODULE (P9)
(CENTER AISLE
STAND)
NOT OPEN
OPEN
PARKING
UP BRAKE CLOSED
NOT CLOSED
FAIL WARN CLOSED
PWR
OPEN
S303 LG M162 ANTISKID CONT
NOT OPEN
LEVER UP UNIT (E3-2)
SW OPEN

V11 PARKING BRAKE


VALVE (MAIN WHEEL
WELL, AFT BULKHEAD)

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-32 Page 77


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Parking Brake Linkage

Application of the parking brake requires a full and simultaneous application of left and right foot pedals.
This allows clearance for the parking brake lever linkage to be moved, rotating a lock-shaft fitted with pawls.
The pawls rotate into a pin holding position with brake pedal linkage. Thus positioned, the pawls hold the
brake metering valves open porting pressure to the brakes.

ATA-30 Page 78 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Parking Brake Light

The red parking brake light on the control stand is illuminated by the closing of a switch caused by the
rotation of an outboard lever on the parking brake jackshaft at parking brake application. The micro-switch
also completes a circuit to actuate the parking brake shutoff valve closed.

The red parking brake repeater light on the external power panel also illuminates when the parking brake
switch is actuated.

PARKING
BRAKE LIGHT

START CONTROL
LEVERS

PARKING
BRAKE LEVER

SEE D

FWD

CONTROL
STAND

FWD

INBD

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-32 Page 79


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Parking Brake Shutoff Valve

The parking brake shutoff valve is installed in a common return line in the main wheel well between the four
antiskid control valves and a system return line and prevents pressure bleed off when parking brakes are set.

The parking brake shutoff valve is a 28-volt DC motor-operated ball-type valve. When parking brakes are set
or released, the parking brake switch will actuate to energize the shutoff valve to closed or open position.

TO RETURN
AFT WHEEL FILTER MODULE
WELL BULKHEAD

MANUAL OVERRIDE
LEVER AND VALVE
POSITION INDICATOR
PARKING BRAKE
SHUTOFF VALVE

ELECTRICAL
CONNECTION ANTISKID
RETURN LINES

ATA-30 Page 80 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

ANTISKID SYSTEM
Overview

The antiskid system is an electro-hydraulic subsystem placed in the hydraulic brake system to prevent manual
or automatic braking action that causes skidding. Under any runway condition or selected brake pressure, the
antiskid system will monitor wheel deceleration rates and maintain maximum wheel adhesion. The antiskid
system is programmed to provide touchdown and locked wheel protection from air-ground and wheel speed
sensing. A landing gear lever operated switch provides a disable function for landing gear retraction braking.
An ON-OFF switch gives the crew control of the antiskid system and an annunciator light gives notice of
defective systems. A built-in-test capability provides continuous self test and fault indication. Further manual
testing is provided to detect component faults. The autobrake system shares air-ground and wheel speed
sensing with the antiskid system and requires a fault free antiskid system to operate.

An alternate antiskid system is automatically scheduled to operate from hydraulic system A pressure when
hydraulic system B pressure fails, transferring command by alternate antiskid to the operation of paired
wheels of each gear.

The antiskid system consists of individual wheel speed transducers, an antiskid control unit, six antiskid
control valves, a main gear squat switch, a nose gear squat switch and a landing gear lever switch. The
system also includes an ON-OFF control switch and an INOP annunciator light. Built-in-testing is provided on
an automatic/ continuous basis supplemented with a manual test capability at the antiskid control unit.

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-32 Page 81


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Antiskid Control Panel

The antiskid control panel is located on the P2 panel and is composed of an ANTISKID ON-OFF switch, and an
ANTISKID INOP light.

The ANTISKID ON-OFF switch is of the guarded type controlling the antiskid wheel circuits. The switch acts
as an arming switch to provide power to antiskid circuits in the antiskid control unit.

The ANTISKID INOP light is mounted above the control switch. The light illuminates as a result of built-in-
test (automatic or manual test) sensing of faults in the antiskid circuits. Faults affecting antiskid control for
the normal brake system will be indicated at all times. Faults affecting antiskid control for the alternate brake
system are only indicated when the alternate system is pressurized. This occurs when the normal brake
system has failed or when the parking brake is set. The INOP light is also used to detect faults in the
touchdown and locked wheel protection circuits when the parking brake is set.

The INOP light is also used in conjunction with the manual built-in-test procedures to troubleshoot at the
antiskid control unit.

ATA-30 Page 82 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Transducer

The transducer is a wheel driven speed sensing device located inside each main gear wheel axle. The
transducer assembly consists of a stator which is attached to the axle and a rotor mounted inside the stator.
The rotor shaft is attached to a drive coupling which meshes with a spider secured to the inside of the hubcap
of the wheel. This allows the rotor to turn inside the stator at a rate equal to the rotational speed of the
wheel.

The rotor has poles, or lobes, extending outward from its outer circumference. The stator has an equal
number of lobes extending inward. The stator also has a coil around it, which is connected to a controlled
source of dc power. When the stator coil is energized, the stator becomes an electromagnet. When the wheel
is turning, the lobes on the rotor pass by the lobes on the stator, thus changing the distance between them.
The change in distance causes a change in the magnetic field of the stator because of the variation of
magnetic coupling (magnetic reluctance) between the stator and the rotor. This change in magnetic field
generates in the stator coil an ac voltage which is superimposed on the controlled dc energizing voltage. The
frequency of the generated voltage is directly proportional to the rotational speed of the wheel. This ac signal
is fed into the antiskid control unit.

The transducer produces a sine wave having 150 pulses for one complete rotation of the wheel. The AC signal
ranges from an output of 1.5-volts minimum at 150 Hz to an output of 3.0-volts minimum at 5000 Hz.

WHEEL

AXLE
DRIVE
COUPLING

OUTBOARD TRANSDUCER
HUBCAP ADAPTER
1

OUTBOARD TRANSDUCER
HUBCAP
FAIRING NUT
1

1 NOT INSTALLED ON
INBOARD WHEEL
TRANSDUCER INSTALLATION OUTBOARD MAIN GEAR
E

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-32 Page 83


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Antiskid Control Unit

The antiskid control unit is located in the electrical/electronic equipment compartment. It contains all the
circuits necessary for antiskid control and autobrake functions. The antiskid control unit contains printed
circuits; two dual main wheel control circuits and built-in test circuits, a digital autobrake circuit and a
multilayer interconnect circuit. Circuitry includes individual wheel control in normal antiskid mode. Alternate
antiskid circuitry controls the wheels in pairs.

Built-in-test features incorporate continuous monitoring of antiskid valve and transducer circuits and their
interfaces. The antiskid control unit front panel includes antiskid system fault isolation provision and an
autobrake test capability in the form of test switches and lights to assist in trouble shooting the antiskid
system.

ABS
RED AMBER RED

GREEN GREEN GREEN

A
L
RI R0 L T
LI R
L0 PB
OFF OFF

WHEEL SELECT

VALVE XDCR

LW SKID

ABS

ATA-30 Page 84 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Antiskid Control Valve

The antiskid control valve is an electrically controlled hydraulic valve which will reduce metered pressure
supplied to the brakes when provided with a signal from the control unit. The amount of pressure reduction is
proportional to the control current provided. Each control valve consists of an electrically controlled 1st-stage
or servo valve, and a hydraulically controlled 2nd-stage spool valve. Each of the normal antiskid control valves
operates independently of the other to control the brake on one wheel. An alternate antiskid control valve
controls paired wheels of each main gear.

FLOW FLOW
FUSE FUSE
OVERHEAD AUTOBRAKE
CONTROL
ACCUMULATOR MODULE
ALT BRAKE
ISOLATION
SELECTOR VALVE
VALVE
ANTISKID ANTISKID
SHUTTLE BRAKE METERING SHUTTLE
VALVES VALVE ASSY VALVES
(2 PLACES)
RIGHT LEFT
ALTERNATE PARKING BRAKE ALTERNATE
ANTISKID SHUTOFF VALVE OUTBD ANTISKID
CONTROL INBD CONTROL
AUTOBRAKE
VALVE VALVE
SHUTTLE
BRAKE BRAKE
RIGHT VALVES
FLOW FLOW LEFT NORMAL
NORMAL
FUSES FUSES ANTISKID
ANTISKID
CONTROL CONTROL
INBD VALVES
VALVES
OUTBD
SEE A
(TYP)
SERVICING GAGE
WHEEL WELL
ACCUMULATOR AFT BULKHEAD
STA 727
BRAKE PRESS TRANSMITTER

BL 0
VIEW LOOKING AFT

ELECTRICAL
CONNECTOR
NORMAL ANTISKID
VALVES
(RIGHT VALVE UNION
INSTALLATION MOUNTING
SHOWN) BOLT

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-32 Page 85


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Air-Ground Sensors

Air-ground sensors are located in the right main gear wheel well and the nose gear torsion link to provide
brake release signals to the antiskid control unit for touchdown protection during landing. Main gear sensing
acts on inboard wheels and the nose gear sensing acts on outboard wheels.

PRIMARY AND SECONDARY


PRIMARY AND SECONDARY
DOWNLOCK SENSOR
DOWNLOCK SENSOR
ACTUATOR
SENSOR
LOCK
LEADS
STRUT

SEE B

SEE A

MOUNTING
BRACKET

FWD INBD
SIDE STRUT

INBD

FLEXIBLE
CONDUIT

UPLOCK
HOOK

UPLOCK
SENSOR

UPLOCK
SENSOR
ACTUATOR

FWD OUTBD

ATA-30 Page 86 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

DOWN SENSOR
SEE A

LOCK SENSOR
SEE B

LBL
16.0
FWD
REF

SENSOR SUPPORT

TARGET
SHIM

SENSOR

SECONDARY
SENSOR

TARGET WL PRIMARY
156.1 SENSOR
LOCK BRACE
REF SHIMS
NUT

CONDUIT

TRUNNION
ASSEMBLY

TARGET
A

LOCK STRUT

SENSOR

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-32 Page 87


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Landing Gear Lever UP Switch

The landing gear lever up switch is located in the lower nose section forward of the nose wheel well. It is a
two pole switch actuated by a cam fastened to the landing gear lever control cable.

One pole of the switch disables the alternate antiskid portion of the antiskid system during the retraction cycle
of the landing gear to allow positive braking action. Disabling prevents antiskid system from sensing a skid
and signaling brake release.

The second pole opens the circuit which senses pressurization of the alternate brake system to prevent a false
antiskid inoperative condition to be registered as landing gear is retracted.

ATA-30 Page 88 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

AUTOMATIC BRAKING SYSTEM


Overview

When selected by the pilot the autobrake (automatic braking) system operates in conjunction with the antiskid
system to automatically control hydraulic pressure to the brakes on landing or during a refused takeoff (RTO).
Using information from air/ground and wheel speed sensing systems, a single electromechanical valve
automatically supplies a modulated pressure to all four brakes. The autobrake control panel (P2-2) contains
the controls by which the crew may choose the deceleration rate. Five deceleration rate positions (1, 2, 3,
MAX, and RTO) are available. Shuttle valves react to autobrake pressure, blocking the normal brake metering
system and porting autobrake pressure through the antiskid valves to wheel brake pistons. The antiskid
system monitors autobrake (or normal brake application) in preventing wheel lock-up.

The pilot can override the autobrake system at any time by moving the autobrake selector switch to OFF,
making manual brake application resulting in more than 750 PSI at either left or right autobrake shuttle valve,
or stowing the speed brakes. Go-around protection is provided from throttle actuated switches to deactivate
autobrake operation. Refused takeoff (RTO) can be implemented at takeoff when throttles are retarded. This
causes autobrake to provide full stopping pressure automatically within the operation of antiskid protection.

The autobrake system consists of an autobrake control panel, an autobrake pressure control module, two
hydraulic pressure switches, two shuttle valves, and an autobrake electronic circuit card located in the M162
Antiskid Control Unit (E3-2 shelf). Additional control inputs are furnished by wheel speed switches, air-ground
sensing relay, speed brake arming switch and engine throttle switches. 28-volt DC power for autobrake
operation is supplied through the AUTOBRAKE CONTR circuit breaker on the P6-3 panel. An operational
antiskid system is required for automatic braking.

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-32 Page 89


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Autobrake Control Panel

The autobrake control panel, located directly below the antiskid ON-OFF switch on the pilot's forward
instrument panel P2-2, consists of an AUTO BRAKE selector switch, and amber AUTO BRAKE DISARM light
and two relays, R289 and R290. The relays are located behind the control panel.

The AUTO BRAKE selector switch (S583) is a rotary, six-position switch. The functions provided by the switch
are to arm the system by providing 28-volt DC autobrake power to the antiskid control unit, select a 1, 2, 3,
MAX or RTO airplane deceleration level, and illuminate the AUTO BRAKE DISARM light.

The AUTO BRAKE DISARM indicator light also illuminates when the automatic braking system is turned on to
the RTO position. The light will remain on until a turn-on self-check (TOSC) initiated by the system is
successfully completed in about one second. The AUTO BRAKE DISARM light also illuminates for both failure
detection (including power loss) and crew-initiated disarming. The light can be extinguished by placing the
AUTO BRAKE selector switch to OFF. However, AUTO BRAKE DISARM if light illumination is caused by
autobrake solenoid valve failure, the light will remain on in all switch positions.

The (A/B DISARM) relay R290 provides switching functions for disarming the system when the arming
requirements for landing or RTO operations are not fully met. The relay will reset when the AUTO BRAKE
selector switch is placed to OFF.

The (A/B ON) relay R289 provides switching functions for supplying 28-volt DC autobrake-on power to the
antiskid control unit and to the solenoid shutoff valve in the autobrake pressure control module (V122). Relay
289 energizes when at least one wheel speed on each main gear is greater than 60 knots.

ATA-30 Page 90 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-32 Page 91


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Autobrake Pressure Control Module

The autobrake pressure control module is connected to system B hydraulic lines, and is located on the center
ceiling of the main gear wheel well just forward of bulkhead station 727. The module consists of an electro
hydraulic pressure control servo valve, a solenoid operated shutoff valve, two hydraulic pressure actuated
switches (one at the output of the solenoid shutoff valve and the other at the output of the pressure control
servo valve), and an inlet pressure fluid filter. The module supplies autobrake pressure to all four of the main
wheel brakes through the autobrake shuttle valves.

The solenoid operated shutoff valve will port hydraulic pressure to the pressure control servo valve when the
autobrake system is armed and then activated by autobrake logic (wheel speed greater than 60 knots and
throttles retarded). With the solenoid valve in the de-energized position pressure is ported to the return line.

The electro hydraulic 2-stage pressure control servo valve receives pressure from the shutoff valve and meters
the output to the brakes. The valve 1st-stage consists of a dc torque motor, a jet pipe and receiver, and a
pressure balance-feedback-piston/spring assembly. The 2nd-stage is a 3-way pressure balance metering
spool that controls pressure to the brakes as modulated by the 1st-stage valve.

The shutoff valve pressure switch is located at the shutoff valve output and monitors the shutoff valve
operation. The switch opens above 1000 PSI to provide a logic "high" with autobrake selected. The switch
goes to the relaxed position to provide a logic "ground" signal when the autobrake selector switch is in any of
the four autobrake selected positions and pressure falls below 1000 PSI. Any incorrect logic will disarm the
autobrake and illuminate the disarm light. The control servo valve pressure switch monitors the servo valve
output pressure to detect control system faults. The switch is connected to the fault monitor logic to indicate
high pressure (above 1000 PSI) with an open circuit and indicates low pressure (below 1000 PSI) with a closed
(logic ground) circuit.

ATA-30 Page 92 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

FLOW OVERHEAD FLOW


FUSE FUSE
AUTOBRAKE SEE D
CONTROL
ACCUMULATOR MODULE V122
ALT BRAKE
ISOLATION
SELECTOR VALVE
VALVE
ANTISKID ANTISKID
SHUTTLE BRAKE METERING SHUTTLE
VALVES VALVE ASSY VALVES
(2 PLACES)
RIGHT LEFT
ALTERNATE LEFT ALTERNATE
PARKING BRAKE ANTISKID
ANTISKID ANTISKID
SHUTOFF VALVE OUTBD CONTROL
CONTROL CONTROL
VALVE AUTOBRAKE INBD VALVES VALVE
SHUTTLE VALVES
FLOW AND PRESSURE BRAKE
FUSES SWITCHES FLOW
BRAKE S763 (RIGHT), FUSES
INBD RIGHT ANTISKID S762 (LEFT)
OUTBD CONTROL VALVES SEE C

SERVICING GAGE
ACCUMULATOR
WHEEL WELL
BRAKE PRESS TRANSMITTER AFT BULHEAD
STA 727
BL 0
VIEW LOOKING AFT

BRAKE PRESSURE
PORT
SERVO VALVE
PRESSURE SWITCH

SOLENOID VALVE
PRESSURE SWITCH

FILTER
SUPPLY
PRESSURE
PORT

PRESSURE CONTROL
SERVO VALVE

RETURN PORT

SOLENOID VALVE

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-32 Page 93


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Autobrake Shuttle Valves

Two shuttle valves, located on the left aft bulkhead of the left gear wheel well, are installed in the autobrake
system, one in each of the two brake pressure lines upstream of the left and right normal antiskid valves. The
valves sense hydraulic pressure from the autobrake pressure control module and from the brake metering
valves. The shuttle valve will port pressure to the antiskid valve from the source (autobrake pressure control
module or brake metering valve) of highest pressure.
FLOW FLOW
FUSE FUSE
OVERHEAD
AUTOBRAKE
CONTROL
ACCUMULATOR MODULE
ALT BRAKE
ISOLATION
SELECTOR VALVE
VALVE
ANTISKID ANTISKID
SHUTTLE BRAKE METERING SHUTTLE
VALVES VALVE ASSY VALVES
(2 PLACES)
RIGHT LEFT
ALTERNATE LEFT ALTERNATE
ANTISKID PARKING BRAKE ANTISKID ANTISKID
SHUTOFF VALVE OUTBD CONTROL
CONTROL CONTROL
VALVE INBD VALVES VALVE
AUTOBRAKE
BRAKE SHUTTLE
BRAKE
FLOW VALVES
FLOW
FUSES SEE A
FUSES

INBD WHEEL WELL


RIGHT ANTISKID
AFT BULKHEAD
OUTBD CONTROL VALVES
STA 727

SERVICING GAGE
ACCUMULATOR

BRAKE PRESS
TRANSMITTER BL 0

VIEW LOOKING AFT

ELECTRICAL
CONNECTORS VALVE HYDRAULIC
FITTINGS
MOUNTING PRESSURE
BOLTS SWITCH

PRESSURE
SWITCH

VALVE

UP
HYDRAULIC
WHEEL WELL FITTINGS
AFT BULKHEAD
A

ATA-30 Page 94 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Hydraulic Pressure Switches

Pressure switches (S762 LH, S763 RH), identified as brake pedal pressure switches, sense the B system brake
pressure downstream from the brake metering valves. The switches are attached to respective autobrake
shuttle valves and actuate when manually metered hydraulic BRAKE pressure is greater than 750 PSI. They
provide a ground signal to the autobrake circuit to deactivate auto braking.

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-32 Page 95


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Autobrake Digital Circuits and Test Switch

The autobrake digital circuits are located in the antiskid control unit (located on the E3-2 electrical shelf). The
microprocessor system consists of a central processing unit and counter-timer circuit driven by a crystal
controlled clock, a non-volatile memory (EPROM), a random access memory (RAM), and input/output
circuitry. Supporting components include a transducer input multiplexer, a valve driver, a disarm control
circuit, and a 5-volt DC power supply. Signals from the autobrake circuit operate the autobrake pressure
control module which initiates and controls the brake pressure as required to meet the selected airplane
deceleration rate. The autobrake system performs a self-check each time the system is turned on.

To test the autobrake system, the antiskid control unit has incorporated an amber autobrake test light and an
autobrake test switch, located on the front face of module. The switch functionally tests the autobrake system.
The test is done with the AUTO BRAKE selector switch in any decel position other than OFF.

ATA-30 Page 96 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

NOSE WHEEL STEERING SYSTEM


Overview

Nose wheel steering is provided for airplane directional control during ground maneuvers and taxiing.
Hydraulic power from system A is used to turn the nose wheels to either side from zero to 78 degrees.
Steering is controlled by a wheel on the left side of the control cabin and by an interconnect mechanism from
the rudder pedals. The steering system is spring-loaded to the center position. The airplane can be towed
through turns up to 78 degrees without disconnecting the torsion links or depressurizing the hydraulic system.
Internal cams in the shock strut center the nose gear when the nose gear shock strut is fully extended,
therefore turning the wheels or towing should not be attempted unless the shock strut is compressed more
than two inches.

Normal steering is achieved by using the steering wheel located on the left sidewall forward of the captain's
position. Movement of the steering wheel in either direction is transmitted by cables to a steering metering
valve which directs 3000 PSI hydraulic fluid to the nose wheel steering actuators for turning the portion of the
nose gear which can be steered. A steering wheel movement of 95 degrees will give 78 degrees of nose wheel
turning.

Rudder pedal steering is available during takeoff, landing, and taxiing when small directional changes are
required. Full deflection of the rudder pedals produces about 7 degrees of nose wheel steering. The rudder
pedal steering mechanism is engaged for steering by the squat switch located on the nose gear shock strut.
When the nose gear is compressed, the movement of the torsion link is transmitted to the squat switch. This
causes the actuator motor to reposition the stops mounted on the clutch crank in the rudder pedal steering
mechanism. In this position, any movement of the rudder pedals will be transmitted into ground directional
control of the nose wheel.

Nose wheel steering is available when the nose gear is in the down position and compressed by weight of the
airplane. Positioning the landing gear control lever to down makes system A hydraulic pressure available from
the landing gear down line to the steering metering valve for steering. The nose gear must be compressed
more than two inches before steering is attempted to avoid damage to the centering cams.

When the steering wheel is rotated for a turn, the steering cables move and displace the steering metering
valve piston. Hydraulic fluid is directed by the metering valve through the swivel valves to the steering
actuators. The steering actuators produce a turning moment on the steering collar which is transmitted by the
torsion links to the lower steerable portion of the nose gear. Continued displacement of the metering valve
piston combined with the steering actuator swivel valves produces 78 degrees of wheel turn for 95 degrees of
steering wheel rotation. During a turn, the metering valve piston is displaced until the required degree of nose
wheel turning is reached and then returned to the center position by the follow-up action of the cable.

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-32 Page 97


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

 
Overview (Continued):

Nose wheel steering is also available through the rudder pedals. The rudder pedal steering mechanism is
actuated by the squat switch/electric actuator system when the nose gear is compressed. The compression
movement is transmitted electrically to move the eccentric and reposition the clutch crank and allow the clutch
arm to contact the stops mounted on the steering crank. In this position, any movement of the rudder pedals
is transmitted from the steering arm to the quadrant. The quadrant moves the nose wheel steering cables
displacing the steering metering valve piston for the required turn.

A
TRUNNION
SWIVEL
FITTING

CABLE NWSB

CABLE NWSA

SWIVEL VALVE
STEERING
STEERING COLLAR
METERING
VALVE
TORSION
LINKS
SWIVEL VALVE
FWD
STEERING ACTUATOR

ATA-30 Page 98 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-32 Page 99


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Steering Metering Valve

The steering metering valve is a piston and sleeve type valve located on the nose gear. A pair of swivel valves
is combined with the metering valve in order to direct hydraulic fluid for turns. The piston and sleeve
assembly is ported to direct 3000 PSI hydraulic fluid through the swivel valves to the steering actuators.
Movement of the control cable positions the valve piston for the required turn. When the wheels reach the
required turn angle, the piston is returned to neutral position by follow-up action of the control cable.

During steering operation, hydraulic fluid is directed by the metering valve to one side of the right actuator
piston and to the opposite side of the left actuator piston producing a push-pull action on the steering collar.
This push-pull action continues as long as the valve piston is displaced or until approximately 33 degrees of
steering. At this point the pulling actuator has reached the end of its stroke and the turning motion of the
actuator has closed off the hydraulic pressure and return lines in the steering actuator swivel valve. Continued
pushing by the other actuator will move the pulling actuator past the null point. Above 33 degrees of steering,
hydraulic pressure for the steering cylinder that is overcenter has been closed off and both ports have been
ported to return. Further turning from 33 degrees to the maximum of 78 degrees is provided by the pushing
actuator only. The steering wheel must be turned 95 degrees to obtain the maximum turning angle of 78
degrees.

Towing may also be accomplished without depressurizing hydraulic system A by actuation of the manually
operated steering depressurization valve. Depressing valve plunger and installing ground lock pin depressurize
the steering valve by blocking pressure and connecting steering valve pressure port to return. After towing is
completed and the tow bar is disconnected, pulling the ground lock pin will allow the valve to open to re-
pressurize the steering valve.

ATA-30 Page 100 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization
and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-32 Page 101
and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Nose Gear Steering Collar

The nose gear steering collar is held clamped around the outer cylinder in an annular recess immediately
below the trunnions. Both of the two steering cylinders are connected to the steering collar and the upper end
of the upper torsion link is also connected to the steering collar. When force is applied to the steering collar,
by either steering cylinder, the collar transfers the force through the torsion links to turn the inner cylinder to
the right or left respectively to which cylinder force is applied to give steering action to the nose wheels.

ATA-30 Page 102 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization
and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-32 Page 103
and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Rudder Pedal Steering Mechanism

The rudder pedal steering mechanism consists of a steering crank, a clutch arm, a cable drum, an eccentric
mounted in the clutch crank, and a rudder pedal steering quadrant. This mechanism connects the rudder
pedals to the nose wheel steering and is actuated by the weight of the airplane compressing the nose gear
shock strut. The compression of the shock strut actuates the squat switch which causes an electric motor
(actuator) to reposition the clutch crank so that stops, mounted on the clutch crank, do not contact the clutch
arm. In this position, the clutch arm contacts the stops on the steering crank and any movement of the rudder
pedals is transmitted from the steering crank to the rudder pedal steering quadrant. This quadrant is
connected to the nose wheel steering cables and is free to move with the cables whenever nose wheel steering
is used, or drive the cables when positioned by the rudder pedal steering mechanism.

When the nose gear is extended, the squat switch/electric actuator system positions the eccentric to move the
stops mounted on the clutch crank into contact with the clutch arm. This prevents any movement of the
rudder pedals from reaching the clutch arm and moving the quadrant.

A time delay circuit delays the disengagement of the nose wheel steering system for ten seconds after the nose
landing gear strut is fully extended. This prevents rudder pedal steering disengagement during takeoff on
rough runways.

ATA-30 Page 104 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization
and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

STEERING
WHEEL

RUDDER PEDAL
CABLE
STEERING
CABLE NWSB
QUADRANT
NWSA
RUDDER
PEDAL
STEERING
ARM
CLUTCH
ARM

CLUTCH
CRANK
ROTARY
ACTUATOR

STEERING
STOPS CRANK TO RUDDER
STEERING CABLE CABLE
METERING NGPPA NGPPB PEDALS

VALVE VALVE
CONTROL
CRANK
SHOCK STRUT COMPRESSED

NOSE GEAR

CONTROL
DRUM AND ROD ASSEMBLY
ECCENTRIC STOPS
WITH SHEAR
FEATURE

SHOCK STRUT EXTENDED

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-32 Page 105
and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

ATA-30 Page 106 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization
and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

TAIL SKID
Overview

On airplanes with a tail skid, the tail skid is provided to protect the lower aft fuselage in the event of over-
rotation during take-off or high nose attitude during landing. The tail skid assembly consists of a frangible
cartridge assembly, a drag link, and a shoe. The tail skid is located aft of the stabilizer trim access door at
BS 1032.

The frangible cartridge assembly is used to absorb loads caused by contact with the runway with the tail skid
shoe. The frangible cartridge is supported by two telescoping rods. The upper rod end is attached to a pivot
link while the lower rod end is attached to the aft end of the drag link.

The drag link is provided as a pivot and as a support for the tail skid. As the frangible cartridge assembly
crushes, the drag link will pivot around the forward drag link bolts and the aft end of the drag link will move
up with the frangible cartridge assembly. The drag link is located at BS 1032, aft of the stabilizer trim access
door 3701.

The tail skid shoe is the part of the tail skid that makes contact with the runway during over-rotation in a take-
off or high nose attitude during landing. The shoe is made out of Inconel and has four wear dimples to warn
when the shoe must be replaced. The shoe is located at BS 1083.58.

SEE A

CARTRIDGE
WEAR DECAL

SHOE

SKIRT FAIRING

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-32 Page 107
and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

LANDING GEAR POSITION INDICATING AND WARNING SYSTEM


Overview

The landing gear position indicating and warning system provides warning and indication for landing gear
down and locked, landing gear not locked, and landing gear position not in accordance with control lever
position. In addition, the down and locked position of each landing gear can be observed through inspection
viewers. Green indicator lights come on when the landing gear are down and locked and the airplane is safe
to land. Red warning lights come on and a warning horn sounds when the airplane is in a landing configuration
and the landing gear are not down and locked. The landing gear position indicating and warning system
consists of the following:

Three green indicator lights, one for each main gear, and one for the nose gear indicate gear down
and locked. The indicator lights are controlled by the landing gear lock and position sensors, in
conjunction with solid-state circuits, to come on when the respective landing gear is down and
locked. The indicator lights are mounted on the pilots' landing gear panel above the landing gear
control lever. A dimmer switch on the center panel is provided to reduce the indicator light intensity
during night operations.

Three additional green indicator lights, one for each main gear, and one for the nose gear are located on the
aft overhead panel. These lights are controlled by the secondary landing gear lock and position sensors, in
conjunction with solid-state circuits, to come on when the respective landing gear is down and locked.

A LIGHTS test switch which tests the landing gear indicator and warning lights is mounted on the center panel.

Three red warning lights, one for each main gear, and one for the nose gear indicate an unsafe-to-land
condition. The warning lights come on when the landing gear and control lever positions do not coincide,
when any landing gear is unlocked, or when the engine thrust levers are in idle range and the landing gear are
not down and locked. The lights are controlled by the landing gear control lever position switch. Additional
control of the lights is provided by the landing gear lock and position sensors on the landing gear and the
solid-state circuits in the landing gear electrical module. The lights will remain on and cannot be turned off if
the landing gear and control lever positions do not coincide or any landing gear is unlocked. A dimmer switch
on the center panel is provided to reduce the indicator light intensity during night operations.

A warning horn sounds when the landing gear position is incorrect for the current operating conditions.

ATA-30 Page 108 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization
and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

NOSE
GEAR R
NOSE
SEE A GEAR G
LEFT RIGHT
GEAR R GEAR R
LEFT RIGHT
FWD GEAR G GEAR G

FORWARD INSTRUMENT PANELS

UP
L
A
N
D
I
N
OFF
G

G
E
A
R
DN
LEFT RIGHT
GEAR G GEAR G

NOSE
GEAR G AUXILIARY DOWNLOCK
INDICATOR LIGHTS
LANDING GEAR
AFT OVERHEAD PANEL LIMIT (IAS)
OPERATING
EXTEND 270K-.82M
RETRACT 235K
EXTENDED 320K-.82M
FLAPS LIMIT (IAS)
1-230K 15-195K
2-230K 25-190K
5-225K 30-185K
10-210K 40-158K
210K ALT FLAP EXT

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-32 Page 109
and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Landing Gear Mechanical Downlock Indication

Mechanical downlock indication of the landing gear is provided by observing the alignment of red paint stripes
or arrows located on locking components of the landing gear. The down and locked position of the landing
gear can be observed from inside the airplane through landing gear downlock viewers.

Red paint stripes are applied to the nose gear lock brace and lock link. When the nose gear is down and
locked, the red arrow on the lock link will align with the red arrow on the lock brace.

Red paint stripes are applied to the main gear lower side strut and the lower downlock link. When a main
gear is down and locked, the red paint stripes on the lower side strut will align with the red paint stripe on the
lower downlock link.

ATA-30 Page 110 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization
and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

SEE A

LOWER
DOWNLOCK
LINK

UPPER SIDE
STRUT
LOWER
SIDE
STRUT

RED STRIP
SEE B

MAIN GEAR VIEWER TARGET AREA


B

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-32 Page 111
and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Control Lever Position Switch

The control lever position switch closes to complete a circuit to the landing gear electrical module when the
control lever is moved to DN position. The position switch is mounted within the control lever support
structure. The switch assembly consists of a low-travel micro switch and roller-type switch actuator. The
roller on the actuator contacts the inner end of the control lever to operate the switch when the lever enters the
DN detent.

SEE A POSITION
SWITCH
SEE B

FORWARD INSTRUMENT PANELS


LANDING GEAR
CONTROL LEVER
(DOWN POSITION)

LEVER LOCK
LEVER SOLENOID
LOCK

FWD

SWITCH POSITION
ACTUATOR SWITCH
CONTROL
LEVER

SWITCH
MOUNTING
BOLTS

FWD
GUIDE

ATA-30 Page 112 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization
and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-32 Page 113
and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Landing Gear Uplock and Downlock Sensors

Six primary lock sensors and four secondary lock sensors provide signals to the landing gear warning system.
These include one primary and one secondary nose gear lock sensor, a primary and secondary nose gear down
sensor, two main gear uplock sensors, two primary main gear downlock sensors and two secondary main gear
downlock sensors.

Each main gear uplock sensor unit is mounted on the forward side of the uplock hook with the actuator
attached to the uplock links. Each main gear downlock sensor unit is mounted on the outboard side of the
side strut and utilizes an actuator fastened to the lock strut. The main landing gear downlock sensors provide
signals to the corresponding solid-state circuits in the landing gear module when the main landing gear is
down and locked. The solid-state circuits will switch to a ground condition when furnished a signal from the
downlock sensor and thus provide a ground to illuminate the green indicator light for the individual main gear.
The downlock and uplock sensors provide signals to the solid-state circuits so that the appropriate circuit will
provide a ground to illuminate the red warning light when the individual main gear is not locked or until the
main gear position agrees with the landing gear control lever position.

Secondary main gear downlock sensors are located beside the primary main gear downlock sensors on the
outboard side of the side strut with actuators fastened to the lock brace.

These sensors provide main gear downlock signals to the aural warning card in the E-11 shelf and the
auxiliary downlock indicator lights on the aft overhead panel through a solid state switch in the M278 module
on the E3-2 shelf.

The nose gear lock sensor is located on the nose gear lock brace assembly with the sensor on one side of the
lock brace hinge pin and the actuator on the other. When the lock brace is fully extended, the sensor is moved
into proximity with the actuator causing the sensor to conduct. This sends a signal to a solid state switch in
the E-11 electrical module, and the switch removes a ground from the nose gear red light turning it off. The
absence of a signal from the sensor will always allow a path to ground for the red light indicating that the nose
gear neither in the up and locked or down and locked position.

It provides a nose gear lock signal to the aural warning card in the E-11 shelf and, in conjunction with the
secondary down sensor, illuminates the auxiliary nose gear downlock light on the aft overhead panel through a
solid state switch in the M278 module in the E3-2 shelf.

The nose gear down sensor is located on a bracket mounted on the side of the nose wheel well above the left
nose gear trunion pin. The actuator is mounted on the trunnion assembly so that the rotation of the trunnion
to the down position brings the actuator into proximity with the sensor causing it to conduct. This, in
conjunction with the nose gear lock sensor, provides a path to ground for the nose gear green light indicating
that the nose gear is in the down and locked position.

The secondary nose gear down sensor is located on the side of the wheel well on a bracket above the right
nose gear trunnion pin.

ATA-30 Page 114 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization
and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

ON AIRPLANES WITH A SECONDARY NOSE GEAR DOWN SENSOR; the sensor is located on the side of the
wheel well on a bracket above the right nose gear trunnion pin.

A toggle switch located on the E-11 shelf can be used to switch the signal source for aural warning and
landing gear downlock indicator lights.

When the switch is moved from the NORMAL position to the SECONDARY position, the signal source for the
landing gear downlock indication lights on the P2 panel will change from the primary sensors to the secondary
sensors.

When the switch is moved from the NORMAL to the PRIMARY position, the signal source for aural warning and
auxiliary landing gear downlock lights changes from the secondary sensors to the primary.

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-32 Page 115
and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

PRIMARY AND SECONDARY


PRIMARY AND SECONDARY
DOWNLOCK SENSOR
DOWNLOCK SENSOR
ACTUATOR
SENSOR
LOCK
LEADS
STRUT

SEE B

SEE A

MOUNTING
BRACKET

FWD INBD
SIDE STRUT

INBD

FLEXIBLE
CONDUIT

UPLOCK
HOOK

UPLOCK
SENSOR

UPLOCK
SENSOR
ACTUATOR

FWD OUTBD

ATA-30 Page 116 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization
and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

 
DOWN SENSOR
SEE A

LOCK SENSOR
SEE B

LBL
16.0
FWD
REF

SENSOR SUPPORT

TARGET
SHIM

SENSOR

SECONDARY
SENSOR

TARGET WL PRIMARY
156.1 SENSOR
LOCK BRACE
REF SHIMS
NUT

CONDUIT

TRUNNION
ASSEMBLY

TARGET
A

LOCK STRUT

SENSOR

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-32 Page 117
and Systems
  Introduction
B737 GENERALUNITED AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
LIGHTING AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE LIGHTING AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
TABLE OF CONTENTS TABLE OF CONTENTS

DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION


CONTROL CABIN LIGHTING................................................................33-2 CONTROL CABIN LIGHTING ............................................................... 33-2
MASTER CAUTION SYSTEM.................................................................33-4 MASTER CAUTION SYSTEM................................................................. 33-4
Master Caution Lights............................................................................33-5 Master Caution Lights ........................................................................... 33-5
Master Caution Annunciators ................................................................33-5 Master Caution Annunciators ................................................................ 33-5
System Indicator Lights .........................................................................33-5 System Indicator Lights......................................................................... 33-5
Annunciation and Dimming Module .....................................................33-5 Annunciation and Dimming Module ..................................................... 33-5
Master Dim Module...............................................................................33-5 Master Dim Module............................................................................... 33-5
Master Caution and Warning .................................................................33-7 Master Caution and Warning................................................................. 33-7
PASSENGER COMPARTMENT LIGHTING ........................................33-8 PASSENGER COMPARTMENT LIGHTING........................................ 33-8
Entry Lights ...........................................................................................33-9 Entry Lights ........................................................................................... 33-9
Ceiling Lights.........................................................................................33-10 Ceiling Lights ........................................................................................ 33-10
Night Lights ...........................................................................................33-10 Night Lights ........................................................................................... 33-10
Window Reveal Lights ..........................................................................33-11 Window Reveal Lights .......................................................................... 33-11
Reading Lights .......................................................................................33-12 Reading Lights....................................................................................... 33-12
Galley Lights..........................................................................................33-13 Galley Lights ......................................................................................... 33-13
LAVATORY LIGHTS ................................................................................33-14 LAVATORY LIGHTS................................................................................ 33-14
Lavatory Dome Lights ...........................................................................33-14 Lavatory Dome Lights........................................................................... 33-14
Lavatory Fluorescent Lights ..................................................................33-14 Lavatory Fluorescent Lights .................................................................. 33-14
Lavatory Occupied Lights......................................................................33-14 Lavatory Occupied Lights ..................................................................... 33-14
Passenger And Lavatory Call Lights .....................................................33-15 Passenger And Lavatory Call Lights ..................................................... 33-15
Passenger Signs......................................................................................33-16 Passenger Signs ..................................................................................... 33-16
CARGO AND SERVICE COMPARTMENT LIGHTING.....................33-17 CARGO AND SERVICE COMPARTMENT LIGHTING .................... 33-17
Cargo Compartment Lights....................................................................33-17 Cargo Compartment Lights ................................................................... 33-17
Service Compartment Lights .................................................................33-18 Service Compartment Lights ................................................................. 33-18
Wheel Well Lights .................................................................................33-19 Wheel Well Lights................................................................................. 33-19
EXTERIOR LIGHTING ............................................................................33-20 EXTERIOR LIGHTING ............................................................................ 33-20
Wing Scanning Lights............................................................................33-20 Wing Scanning Lights ........................................................................... 33-20
Inboard Landing Lights..........................................................................33-21 Inboard Landing Lights ......................................................................... 33-21
Outboard Landing Lights.......................................................................33-21 Outboard Landing Lights....................................................................... 33-21
Runway Turnoff Lights..........................................................................33-21 Runway Turnoff Lights ......................................................................... 33-21
Nose Gear Taxi Light.............................................................................33-21 Nose Gear Taxi Light ............................................................................ 33-21
Navigation Lights (Position Lights).......................................................33-22 Navigation Lights (Position Lights) ...................................................... 33-22
Anti-Collision Lights .............................................................................33-23 Anti-Collision Lights ............................................................................. 33-23
EMERGENCY LIGHTS.............................................................................33-24 EMERGENCY LIGHTS ............................................................................ 33-24
Interior Emergency Lights .....................................................................33-24 Interior Emergency Lights..................................................................... 33-24
Exterior Emergency Lights ....................................................................33-24 Exterior Emergency Lights.................................................................... 33-24
Power Supplies.......................................................................................33-25 Power Supplies ...................................................................................... 33-25

and
OCT 99 Systems Introduction 33-i OCT 99 33-i
UNITED
B737 GENERAL AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
LIGHTING AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE LIGHTING AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
TABLE OF CONTENTS TABLE OF CONTENTS

CONTROLS & INDICATIONS CONTROLS & INDICATIONS


CONTROL CABIN LIGHTS..................................................................... 33-26 CONTROL CABIN LIGHTS..................................................................... 33-26
MASTER CAUTION SYSTEM................................................................. 33-28 MASTER CAUTION SYSTEM................................................................. 33-28
CABIN SIGNS AND LIGHTS CONTROL .............................................. 33-31 CABIN SIGNS AND LIGHTS CONTROL .............................................. 33-31
EXTERIOR LIGHTING ............................................................................ 33-32 EXTERIOR LIGHTING ............................................................................ 33-32
EMERGENCY LIGHTS CONTROLS..................................................... 33-34 EMERGENCY LIGHTS CONTROLS..................................................... 33-34
COMPONENT LOCATIONS COMPONENT LOCATIONS
Flight Compartment Lights.................................................................... 33-35 Flight Compartment Lights.................................................................... 33-35
Master Caution System.......................................................................... 33-36 Master Caution System.......................................................................... 33-36
Cabin Entry Lights................................................................................. 33-37 Cabin Entry Lights................................................................................. 33-37
Ceiling Lights ........................................................................................ 33-38 Ceiling Lights ........................................................................................ 33-38
Window Lights ...................................................................................... 33-39 Window Lights ...................................................................................... 33-39
Reading Lights....................................................................................... 33-40 Reading Lights....................................................................................... 33-40
Galley Lights,Lavatory Lights and Signs .............................................. 33-41 Galley Lights,Lavatory Lights and Signs .............................................. 33-41
Cargo and Service Compartment Lights................................................ 33-42 Cargo and Service Compartment Lights................................................ 33-42
Wing Illumination Lights ...................................................................... 33-43 Wing Illumination Lights ...................................................................... 33-43
Landing Taxi and Turnoff Lights .......................................................... 33-44 Landing Taxi and Turnoff Lights .......................................................... 33-44
Navigation and Strobe Lights ................................................................ 33-45 Navigation and Strobe Lights ................................................................ 33-45
Anticollision Lights ............................................................................... 33-46 Anticollision Lights ............................................................................... 33-46
Exit Indicators........................................................................................ 33-47 Exit Indicators........................................................................................ 33-47
Floor Proximity Lighting ....................................................................... 33-48 Floor Proximity Lighting ....................................................................... 33-48
Overwing and Escape Slide Lights........................................................ 33-49 Overwing and Escape Slide Lights........................................................ 33-49
Emergency Battery Packs ...................................................................... 33-50 Emergency Battery Packs ...................................................................... 33-50
Emergency Exit Light Locations ........................................................... 33-51 Emergency Exit Light Locations ........................................................... 33-51

33-ii and Systems Introduction OCT 99 33-ii OCT 99


B737 GENERALUNITED AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
LIGHTING AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE LIGHTING AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

EXTERIOR E XT E RIO R
LIGHTS L IGHT S

E MERGENCY E ME RGE NCY


L IGHTS L IGHT S

P AS S E NGE R PASSENGER
COMP ART ME NT COM PARTM ENT
L IGHT S LIGHTS

CARGO AND SERVICE CARGO AND SERVICE


COMPARTMENT L IGHT S COM PARTM ENT LIGHTS
MASTER MAS T E R
CAUTION CAUT ION
L IGHTS L IGHT S
FLIGHT F LIGHT
COMPARTMENT C OM PARTM ENT
LIGHTS LIGHTS

Lights Lights

and
OCT 99 Systems Introduction 33-1 OCT 99 33-1
UNITED
B737 GENERAL AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
LIGHTING AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE LIGHTING AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

CONTROL CABIN LIGHTING Indicator lights can be tested or illumi- CONTROL CABIN LIGHTING Indicator lights can be tested or illumi-
The purpose of the flight compartment nated bright or dim by the master dim and The purpose of the flight compartment nated bright or dim by the master dim and
lights is to provide illumination for the test switch. lights is to provide illumination for the test switch.
flight compartment, its instruments, con- Primary electrical power for the flight flight compartment, its instruments, con- Primary electrical power for the flight
trols, and other equipment. compartment lights is 28V AC with 28V trols, and other equipment. compartment lights is 28V AC with 28V
Dome lights supply general illumination DC and 115V AC also used. Dome lights supply general illumination DC and 115V AC also used.
for the cabin. The lightshield provides Operation of the various lights is by for the cabin. The lightshield provides Operation of the various lights is by
background lighting for the pilots. Each switches, mostly of the OFF-BRIGHT background lighting for the pilots. Each switches, mostly of the OFF-BRIGHT
instrument panel has integral lighting. The type for autotransformer control of inten- instrument panel has integral lighting. The type for autotransformer control of inten-
control stand is illuminated from an over- sity. control stand is illuminated from an over- sity.
head floodlight. Circuit breaker panels are head floodlight. Circuit breaker panels are
illuminated by floodlights. There are illuminated by floodlights. There are
lights for the standby compass and for lights for the standby compass and for
map lighting. map lighting.

DOME WHITE DOME WHITE


CONTROL DIM
CONTROL
DIM
L I G HT S CONTROL STAND LIGHTS CONTROL STAND
CABIN DOME OFF FLOODLIGHT CABIN DOME OFF FLOODLIGHT
T E ST TEST
BRT LIGHTS BRT LIGHTS
BRI G H T DI M BRIGHT
DIM
CIRCUIT BREAKER CIRCUIT BREAKER
BR IG HT BR IG HT
MASTER DIM & FLOODLIGHTS, MASTER DIM & FLOODLIGHTS,
TEST SWITCH ON CB PANELS TEST SWITCH ON CB PANELS
6 & 18 OFF 6 & 18 OFF
PANEL PANEL

BR IG HT BR IG HT
OVERHEAD OVERHEAD
PANEL PANEL
OFF
INTEGRAL OFF INTEGRAL
LIGHTS LIGHTS

INSTRUMENT PANEL INSTRUMENT PANEL


INTEGRAL LIGHTS ON INTEGRAL LIGHTS ON
CAPT'S & CENTER PANELS & STANDBY COMPASS CAPT'S & CENTER PANELS & STANDBY COMPASS
ON CAPT'S OXYGEN PANEL LIGHT & CONTROL ON CAPT'S OXYGEN PANEL LIGHT & CONTROL
MAP PANEL MAP PANEL
BR IG HT BR IG HT BR IG HT BR IG HT
MAP PANEL MAP PANEL
BR IG HT BR IG HT BR IG HT BR IG HT

OFF OFF OFF OFF

MAP LIGHT OFF OFF MAP LIGHT OFF OFF


LOCATED IN LOCATED IN
WINDOW NO. 4L MAP LIGHT INSTRUMENT PANEL WINDOW NO. 4L MAP LIGHT INSTRUMENT PANEL
LOCATED IN INTEGRAL LIGHTS LOCATED IN INTEGRAL LIGHTS
WINDOW NO. 4 ON F/O'S PANEL WINDOW NO. 4 ON F/O'S PANEL
AND ON F/O'S & 1ST BACKGROUND AFDS FLOOD
AND ON F/O'S & 1ST
BACKGROUND AFDS FLOOD PANEL FLOOD PANEL OBSERVER'S OXYGEN
BR
IG H
BR
IG H FLOOD OBSERVER'S OXYGEN BR
IG H
BR
IG H
BR
IG H BR IG HT BR
IG H BR IG HT PANELS
T

T
PANELS
T

T
T

OFF OFF OFF OFF


OFF OFF OFF OFF
FLUORESCENT AFDS FLOOD FLUORESCENT AFDS FLOOD
CONTROL FOR CONTROL FOR LIGHTS, P7 CONTROL FOR CONTROL FOR
BACKGROUND LIGHTS LIGHTS, P7 BACKGROUND LIGHTS CONTROL STAND CONTROL STAND
PANEL CONTROL STAND CONTROL STAND LOCATED UNDER PANEL
LOCATED UNDER OVERHEAD FLOOD INTEGRAL LIGHTS OVERHEAD FLOOD INTEGRAL LIGHTS
LIGHT SHIELD LIGHT SHIELD

Flight Compartment Lights Flight Compartment Lights

33-2 and Systems Introduction OCT 99 33-2 OCT 99


B737 GENERALUNITED AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
LIGHTING AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE LIGHTING AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

On the captains sidewall are the flood- The first officer’s sidewall is similar to the On the captains sidewall are the flood- The first officer’s sidewall is similar to the
lights for circuit breaker illumination, captain’s with the addition of spare bulb lights for circuit breaker illumination, captain’s with the addition of spare bulb
flight kit lights and controls, and controls storage flight kit lights and controls, and controls storage
for the map lights; the map lights are for the map lights; the map lights are
located in the #4 window. located in the #4 window.

P6 CIRCUIT BREAKER P6 CIRCUIT BREAKER


PANEL FLOODLIGHTS PANEL FLOODLIGHTS
P18 CIRCUIT BREAKER P18 CIRCUIT BREAKER
PANEL FLOODLIGHTS PANEL FLOODLIGHTS
P6 P6
SPARE BULB CIRCUIT SPARE BULB CIRCUIT
STORAGE BREAKER STORAGE BREAKER
PANEL PANEL
FLOOD FLOOD
LIGHTS LIGHTS

FLIGHT FLIGHT
KIT KIT
P6 CIRCUIT LIGHT P6 CIRCUIT LIGHT
BREAKER PANEL WITH BREAKER PANEL WITH
FLOODLIGHT CONTROL FLOODLIGHT CONTROL
FLIGHT KIT LIGHT LOCATED ON LOCATED ON
THE FLOOR FLIGHT KIT LIGHT
WITH CONTROL THE FLOOR
WITH CONTROL
CAPTAIN'S SIDEWALL FIRST OFFICER'S SIDEWALL CAPTAIN'S SIDEWALL FIRST OFFICER'S SIDEWALL
CONTROL CABIN CONTROL CABIN
DOOR DOOR

SECOND SECOND
DOME OBSERVERS DOME OBSERVERS
LIGHTS READING LIGHTS READING
LIGHT WITH LIGHT WITH
P6 CIRCUIT CONTROL P6 CIRCUIT CONTROL
BREAKER PANEL BREAKER PANEL

P18 P18
FIRST CIRCUIT FIRST CIRCUIT
OBSERVERS BREAKER OBSERVERS BREAKER
READING PANEL READING PANEL
LIGHT WITH LIGHT WITH
CONTROL CONTROL

FIRST OBSERVERS AFT WALL FIRST OBSERVERS


SEAT ACCESS AFT WALL
SEAT ACCESS

Aft and Sidewall Lights Aft and Sidewall Lights

and
OCT 99 Systems Introduction 33-3 OCT 99 33-3
UNITED
B737 GENERAL AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
LIGHTING AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE LIGHTING AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

MASTER CAUTION SYSTEM The master caution system consists of: MASTER CAUTION SYSTEM The master caution system consists of:
A system of lights alerts the crew that a Two DC breakers, located on the load con- A system of lights alerts the crew that a Two DC breakers, located on the load con-
caution condition exists for selected sys- trol center right (P6-3). The Master Test caution condition exists for selected sys- trol center right (P6-3). The Master Test
tems whose caution lights are outside the Relay (R33), the Auxiliary Master Test tems whose caution lights are outside the Relay (R33), the Auxiliary Master Test
normal viewing range of either crew seat Relay (R87) and the background lights normal viewing range of either crew seat Relay (R87) and the background lights
(the forward overhead, aft overhead and and diodes module (M580) are located in (the forward overhead, aft overhead and and diodes module (M580) are located in
fire control panels). Annunciator lights the load control center right (P6-4). The fire control panels). Annunciator lights the load control center right (P6-4). The
(six packs) on the glareshield indicate the annunciation and dimming module (six packs) on the glareshield indicate the annunciation and dimming module
system with the caution condition, and are (M469) located in the forward electronics system with the caution condition, and are (M469) located in the forward electronics
accompanied by master caution lights. panel (P9). The master dim and test switch accompanied by master caution lights. panel (P9). The master dim and test switch
Individual lights on the system panel indi- located on the center instrument panel Individual lights on the system panel indi- located on the center instrument panel
cate which system has the malfunction. (P2). Individual system annunciators cate which system has the malfunction. (P2). Individual system annunciators
which provide inputs to the master caution which provide inputs to the master caution
system located on the forward and aft system located on the forward and aft
overhead panels (P5) and the fire protec- overhead panels (P5) and the fire protec-
tion panel (P8-1). The master caution tion panel (P8-1). The master caution
lights, left and right, and the master cau- lights, left and right, and the master cau-
tion annunciators (six packs), left and tion annunciators (six packs), left and
right, are located on each side of the light right, are located on each side of the light
shield (P7). shield (P7).

FIRE MASTER MASTER FIRE FIRE MASTER MASTER FIRE


WARN CAUTION CAUTION WARN WARN CAUTION CAUTION WARN
PRESS TO PRESS TO PRESS TO
PRESS TO BELL CUTOUT RESET
BELL CUTOUT RESET RESET BELL CUTOUT RESET BELL CUTOUT

FLT CONT ELEC ENG FLT CONT ELEC ANTI-ICE ENG


ANTI-ICE

IRS APU OVERHEAD IRS APU HYD OVERHEAD


HYD

FUEL OVHT DET FUEL OVHT DET DOORS AIR COND


DOORS AIR COND

MASTER MASTER
CAUTION CAUTION
PRESS TO PRESS TO
RESET RESET

FLT CONT ELEC ANTI-ICE ENG FLT CONT ELEC ANTI-ICE ENG

IRS APU HYD OVERHEAD IRS APU HYD OVERHEAD

FUEL OVHT DET DOORS AIR COND FUEL OVHT DET DOORS AIR COND

Master Caution and Warning Lights Master Caution and Warning Lights

33-4 and Systems Introduction OCT 99 33-4 OCT 99


B737 GENERALUNITED AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
LIGHTING AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE LIGHTING AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

Master Caution Lights annunciator. There are keying pins on Master Caution Lights annunciator. There are keying pins on
The two Master Caution lights are amber each annunciator so that they cannot be The two Master Caution lights are amber each annunciator so that they cannot be
annunciators and consist of a light cap installed upside down. The keying for annunciators and consist of a light cap installed upside down. The keying for
labeled MASTER CAUTION - PUSH TO each Master Caution annunciator is differ- labeled MASTER CAUTION - PUSH TO each Master Caution annunciator is differ-
RESET, a bulb and a base with an internal ent to eliminate switching the left and RESET, a bulb and a base with an internal ent to eliminate switching the left and
switch. Each caution lights single incan- right annunciators. switch. Each caution lights single incan- right annunciators.
descent bulb is accessed by pulling the System Indicator Lights descent bulb is accessed by pulling the System Indicator Lights
caution light caps off. The bulb is part of The majority of the system indicator lights caution light caps off. The bulb is part of The majority of the system indicator lights
the panel switch assembly. They both illu- on the various modules throughout the the panel switch assembly. They both illu- on the various modules throughout the
minate whenever one of the annunciators control cabin are composed of a light cap, minate whenever one of the annunciators control cabin are composed of a light cap,
on the Master Caution Annunciators is two bulbs and a base with two diodes, a on the Master Caution Annunciators is two bulbs and a base with two diodes, a
illuminated. Pressing either master caution fuse and a momentary switch. Pressing the illuminated. Pressing either master caution fuse and a momentary switch. Pressing the
light extinguishes both master caution light cap operates the momentary switch light extinguishes both master caution light cap operates the momentary switch
lights and the master caution annunciator which causes the light to illuminate (push- lights and the master caution annunciator which causes the light to illuminate (push-
panels; however, the system fault indicator to-test) panels; however, the system fault indicator to-test)
light on the overhead or fire panel will Annunciation and Dimming Module light on the overhead or fire panel will Annunciation and Dimming Module
remain on until the fault is corrected. The annunciation and dimming module remain on until the fault is corrected. The annunciation and dimming module
Master Caution Annunciators consists of three printed circuit cards, a Master Caution Annunciators consists of three printed circuit cards, a
The master caution annunciator panel transistor circuit and diodes mounted The master caution annunciator panel transistor circuit and diodes mounted
informs the crew which system has the within a box. Two electrical connectors informs the crew which system has the within a box. Two electrical connectors
fault. are on the side of the box and a mounting fault. are on the side of the box and a mounting
Each Master Caution Annunciator is com- plate is on the front. The module is Each Master Caution Annunciator is com- plate is on the front. The module is
posed of six sections with two bulbs in installed with screws on the left side of the posed of six sections with two bulbs in installed with screws on the left side of the
each section, and a light cap divided into P9 control stand panel. each section, and a light cap divided into P9 control stand panel.
six sections. The light cap sections on the Master Dim Module six sections. The light cap sections on the Master Dim Module
left are labeled FLT CONT, ELEC, IRS, The master caution dim module consists left are labeled FLT CONT, ELEC, IRS, The master caution dim module consists
APU, FUEL and OVHT/DET. The light of a printed circuit card with a relay, APU, FUEL and OVHT/DET. The light of a printed circuit card with a relay,
sections on the right side are labeled diodes and a transistor circuit. The card is sections on the right side are labeled diodes and a transistor circuit. The card is
ANTI-ICE, ENG, HYD, OVERHEAD, installed in a card rack in the P6 load con- ANTI-ICE, ENG, HYD, OVERHEAD, installed in a card rack in the P6 load con-
DOORS, and AIR COND. Each section trol center. The diodes provide isolation DOORS, and AIR COND. Each section trol center. The diodes provide isolation
operates independently of the other eleven between dual power sources for the master operates independently of the other eleven between dual power sources for the master
sections. Each section is tied to selected dim and test circuit. The transistor circuit sections. Each section is tied to selected dim and test circuit. The transistor circuit
system fault annunciators on the overhead is not used. system fault annunciators on the overhead is not used.
panels or the fire protection panel. The six annunciator lights on each side are panels or the fire protection panel. The six annunciator lights on each side are
Pressing the light cap operates the connected to six system modules on the Pressing the light cap operates the connected to six system modules on the
momentary switch which applies a ground overhead (P5) panels. The left master cau- momentary switch which applies a ground overhead (P5) panels. The left master cau-
to master caution circuits causing all lights tion annunciator is also connected to the to master caution circuits causing all lights tion annunciator is also connected to the
to illuminate. When released, only those P8-1 fire protection panel. Each P5 mod- to illuminate. When released, only those P8-1 fire protection panel. Each P5 mod-
system(s) with detected faults will have ule contains logic circuits which cause the system(s) with detected faults will have ule contains logic circuits which cause the
indicator lights on and the corresponding master caution light and corresponding indicator lights on and the corresponding master caution light and corresponding
system master caution annunciator on. section of the system master caution system master caution annunciator on. section of the system master caution
This is known as the RECALL feature. annunciator to illuminate when a system This is known as the RECALL feature. annunciator to illuminate when a system
The lights are mounted on the removable indicator light on the P5 module is turned The lights are mounted on the removable indicator light on the P5 module is turned

and
OCT 99 Systems Introduction 33-5 OCT 99 33-5
UNITED
B737 GENERAL AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
LIGHTING AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE LIGHTING AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

on by the system fault detection circuit. Seven separate circuit breakers form the on by the system fault detection circuit. Seven separate circuit breakers form the
Individual system annunciators provide 28V DC battery bus provide power to the Individual system annunciators provide 28V DC battery bus provide power to the
input to the Master Caution system. fault circuit modules that provide the mas- input to the Master Caution system. fault circuit modules that provide the mas-
The Master Caution receives inputs form ter caution controls. The Master Caution receives inputs form ter caution controls.
the various fault annunciators to illumi- Each module senses faults from its various the various fault annunciators to illumi- Each module senses faults from its various
nate two amber Master Caution lights and systems or subsystems to illuminate the nate two amber Master Caution lights and systems or subsystems to illuminate the
one of the twelve sections of the Master individual fault lights. This same fault sig- one of the twelve sections of the Master individual fault lights. This same fault sig-
Caution annunciators. Both push to cancel nal, ground or power, causes a ground Caution annunciators. Both push to cancel nal, ground or power, causes a ground
and push to recall functions are within the through the SCR in each module to the and push to recall functions are within the through the SCR in each module to the
Master Caution System. These cancel and annunciator and dimming module. The Master Caution System. These cancel and annunciator and dimming module. The
recall functions do not affect the system ground is applied to the correct section of recall functions do not affect the system ground is applied to the correct section of
causing the fault. the master caution annunciator and causing the fault. the master caution annunciator and
Power for the Master Caution lights and through a diode to the master caution Power for the Master Caution lights and through a diode to the master caution
annunciators is from a dual power source. lights, Pressing either master caution light annunciators is from a dual power source. lights, Pressing either master caution light
One source is the 28V DC bus number 1 removes power form the master caution One source is the 28V DC bus number 1 removes power form the master caution
and the other is the 28V DC battery bus. circuit breakers causing the SCRs to stop and the other is the 28V DC battery bus. circuit breakers causing the SCRs to stop
Isolation diodes in the background lights conducting. Isolation diodes in the background lights conducting.
and dim module insure power source iso- Pressing either master caution annunciator and dim module insure power source iso- Pressing either master caution annunciator
lation. Power is then supplied through the (six pack) applies a ground to the recall lation. Power is then supplied through the (six pack) applies a ground to the recall
reset switches in the left and right master input of each module which causes all reset switches in the left and right master input of each module which causes all
caution lights to the annunciator and dim- master caution annunciators and lights to caution lights to the annunciator and dim- master caution annunciators and lights to
ming module. A ground from the auxiliary illuminate. Releasing the annuciator cause ming module. A ground from the auxiliary illuminate. Releasing the annuciator cause
master dim relay completes the circuit, the lights to exstingtuish except for those master dim relay completes the circuit, the lights to exstingtuish except for those
providing 28 V DC to both master caution with any module still sensing a fault. The providing 28 V DC to both master caution with any module still sensing a fault. The
lights and to each section of the master light test switch has the same affect as the lights and to each section of the master light test switch has the same affect as the
caution annunciators. When the LIGHTS, recall funtion. caution annunciators. When the LIGHTS, recall funtion.
DIM, BRT, TEST switch is in the dim DIM, BRT, TEST switch is in the dim
position, the ground is removed from Q1 position, the ground is removed from Q1
and the 12 volt zenor diode limits the volt- and the 12 volt zenor diode limits the volt-
age to the master caution annunciators and age to the master caution annunciators and
lights to 12 volts. 28V DC MASTER CAUTION MASTER CAUTION
lights to 12 volts. 28 V D C MASTER CAUTION MASTER CAUTION
BA T B U S MA S T E R PUSH TO RESET PUSH TO RESET
BA T B U S M A S TER PUSH TO RESET PUSH TO RESET
D IM & T E S T D IM
D I M & TES T DIM 28 V D C C IR C U IT
28V DC CIRCUIT BU S 1
BU S 1
D I M & TES T D IM & T E S T FAULT
FAULT CAPTAIN F/O CAPTAIN F/O

P 6 P A N EL P6 PANEL
CAPT'S M/C ANNUNCIATOR CAPT'S M/C ANNUNCIATOR
PUSH TO RECALL BUS PUSH TO RECALL
BUS ELEC & TEST ELEC
OFF & TEST OFF
FAULT LIGHT FAULT LIGHT
P5-4 PANEL P5-4 PANEL

LOGIC PULSER 28VDC .5 LOGIC PULSER


28VDC .5
SCR SCR

P R I N TED C I R C U I T S EN S I N G C A R D P 5 - 4 P A N E L P R IN T E D C IR C U IT S E N S IN G C A R D P 5 -4 P A N E L

Annunciator System Annunciator System

33-6 and Systems Introduction OCT 99 33-6 OCT 99


OCT
and
LIGHTING

M ASTER MASTER
CAUTION CAUTION
PRESS TO
RESET PRE SS T O
RE SE T

F LT CO N T ELEC ANT I-IC E E NG

I RS APU HYD OVE R HE AD

F U EL O V H T D ET DOOR S AIR C OND

99 Systems
MASTER CAUTION ANNUNCIATOR (LEFT) MASTER CAUTION ANNUNCIATOR (RIGHT)
M A ST E R MASTER
C A U T IO N CAUTI ON
P RES S TO ELEC APU FUEL OVHT/DET FLT CONT IRS OVERHEAD DOORS HYD AIR COND ENG ANTI-ICE PR E SS T O
RES ET R E SE T

Introduction
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

12V

BAT BUS MASTER DIM &


IND P6 WARN & TEST
B737 GENERALUNITED

M469 ANNUNCIATOR CONTROL P6


& DIM MODULE P6

28V DC
BAT BUS PWR SUPPLY PWR SUPPLY PWR SUPPLY PWR SUPPLY PWR SUPPLY
MASTER RECALL RECALL RECALL RECALL RECALL ANTI-ICE
CAUTION P6
P5 APU P8 ENG & APU P5 DOOR P5 HYD PUMPS P5 WINDOW &
28V DC MODULE FIRE CONTROL WARNING MODULE PITOT HEAT
BUS 1 MODULE MODULE MODULE
AIRLINES

MASTER
CAUTION

Master Caution and Warning


MASTER
FAMILIARIZATION

PWR SUPPLY PWR SUPPLY PWR SUPPLY CAUTION


BRIGHT ANNUNCIATOR
RECALL RECALL RECALL RECALL (RIGHT)
FUEL
P6 P5 FUEL P5 FLT P5 FLT RECORDER (TYPICAL)
DIM
B737-322/522

SYS MODULE CONTROLS & MACH AIRSPEED RECALL


R87 AUX MODULE WARNING, OXYGEN INPUT
MASTER EQUIP COOLING PWR SUPPLY ENG
DIM RELAY EMERGENCY LIGHTS P5 ENG MODULE P6
MODULES
COURSE

P6 PANEL POWER
PWR SUPPLY PWR SUPPLY SUPPLY
MASTER CAUTION CARD
RECALL RECALL P5 AIR COND MODULE
MASTER CAUTION P5 GEN DRIVE P5 IRS MODE
ANNUNCIATOR (LEFT) & STBY PWR SELECTOR UNIT
MODULE

33-7
AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE

OCT 99
LIGHTING

M ASTER MASTER
CAUTION CAUTION
PRESS TO
RESET PRE SS T O
RE SE T

F LT CO N T ELEC ANT I-IC E E NG

I RS APU HYD OVE R HE AD

F U EL O V H T D ET DOOR S AIR C OND

MASTER CAUTION ANNUNCIATOR (LEFT) MASTER CAUTION ANNUNCIATOR (RIGHT)


M A ST E R MASTER
C A U T IO N CAUTI ON
P RES S TO ELEC APU FUEL OVHT/DET FLT CONT IRS OVERHEAD DOORS HYD AIR COND ENG ANTI-ICE PR E SS T O
RES ET R E SE T
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

12V

BAT BUS MASTER DIM &


IND P6 WARN & TEST
M469 ANNUNCIATOR CONTROL P6
& DIM MODULE P6

28V DC
BAT BUS PWR SUPPLY PWR SUPPLY PWR SUPPLY PWR SUPPLY PWR SUPPLY
MASTER RECALL RECALL RECALL RECALL RECALL ANTI-ICE
CAUTION P6
P5 APU P8 ENG & APU P5 DOOR P5 HYD PUMPS P5 WINDOW &
28V DC MODULE FIRE CONTROL WARNING MODULE PITOT HEAT
BUS 1 MODULE MODULE MODULE
UNITED AIRLINES

MASTER
CAUTION MASTER
Master Caution and Warning

PWR SUPPLY PWR SUPPLY PWR SUPPLY CAUTION


BRIGHT ANNUNCIATOR
RECALL RECALL RECALL RECALL (RIGHT)
FUEL
P6 P5 FUEL P5 FLT P5 FLT RECORDER (TYPICAL)
DIM
B737-322/522

SYS MODULE CONTROLS & MACH AIRSPEED RECALL


R87 AUX MODULE WARNING, OXYGEN INPUT
EQUIP COOLING PWR SUPPLY ENG
MASTER P6
DIM RELAY EMERGENCY LIGHTS P5 ENG MODULE
MODULES POWER
P6 PANEL
PWR SUPPLY PWR SUPPLY SUPPLY
MASTER CAUTION CARD
RECALL RECALL P5 AIR COND MODULE
MASTER CAUTION P5 GEN DRIVE P5 IRS MODE
ANNUNCIATOR (LEFT) & STBY PWR SELECTOR UNIT
MODULE
33-7
AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
UNITED
B737 GENERAL AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
LIGHTING AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE LIGHTING AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

PASSENGER COMPARTMENT Other lights included in the passenger PASSENGER COMPARTMENT Other lights included in the passenger
LIGHTING compartment are night lights, window LIGHTING compartment are night lights, window
Passenger cabin lighting is accomplished reveal, passenger and lavatory call lights, Passenger cabin lighting is accomplished reveal, passenger and lavatory call lights,
by use of white incandescent lights and lavatory occupied lights, passenger load- by use of white incandescent lights and lavatory occupied lights, passenger load-
white fluorescent lights. General cabin ing lights, threshold entry lights, attendant white fluorescent lights. General cabin ing lights, threshold entry lights, attendant
lighting is provided by window lights ceil- work lights, and passenger signs. lighting is provided by window lights ceil- work lights, and passenger signs.
ing lights and entry lights.Relays and ing lights and entry lights.Relays and
transformers for all three types of lights transformers for all three types of lights
are located on the J5 and the J10 shields in are located on the J5 and the J10 shields in
the E/E compartment area. the E/E compartment area.
These are supplemented by reading lights These are supplemented by reading lights
in the passenger service units, lavatory in the passenger service units, lavatory
lights and separately controlled lights in lights and separately controlled lights in
the galley areas. the galley areas.

READING READING
LIGHTS LIGHTS

NO SMOKING FASTEN SEAT BELTS


NO SMOKING FASTEN SEAT BELTS

ATTENDANT ATTENDANT
CALL SWITCH CALL SWITCH

MIRROR NO SMOKING MIRROR


NO SMOKING DOME DOME LIGHT
FASTEN SEAT LIGHT FASTEN SEAT
LIGHT LIGHT
BELTS
BELTS
PSU PSU

CEILING CALL LIGHT CEILING CALL LIGHT


MID AISLE LIGHTS AND RESET MID AISLE LIGHTS AND RESET
SIGN SIGN

WINDOW WINDOW
LIGHTS LIGHTS

LAVATORY LAVATORY

Passenger Compartment Lights Passenger Compartment Lights

33-8 and Systems Introduction OCT 99 33-8 OCT 99


B737 GENERALUNITED AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
LIGHTING AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE LIGHTING AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

Entry Lights In the BRIGHT position, the fluorescent Entry Lights In the BRIGHT position, the fluorescent
The forward entry light is installed in the lamps and the threshold light are on. In the The forward entry light is installed in the lamps and the threshold light are on. In the
forward lowered ceiling. In addition, a DIM position, the fluorescent lamps are forward lowered ceiling. In addition, a DIM position, the fluorescent lamps are
threshold light is mounted on the forward illuminated with a lower voltage. threshold light is mounted on the forward illuminated with a lower voltage.
windscreen. The lights are controlled by a The aft entry light is mounted in the aft windscreen. The lights are controlled by a The aft entry light is mounted in the aft
three-position rotary ENTRY switch on lowered ceiling. In addition, a threshold three-position rotary ENTRY switch on lowered ceiling. In addition, a threshold
the forward attendant’s panel. In the OFF light is mounted on the aft lavatory wall. the forward attendant’s panel. In the OFF light is mounted on the aft lavatory wall.
position, all lights are off unless external Power and control are identical to the for- position, all lights are off unless external Power and control are identical to the for-
power is applied. With external power ward entry lights except the switch is on power is applied. With external power ward entry lights except the switch is on
applied, the dim entry light (incandescent) the aft attendant’s panel.Power is supplied applied, the dim entry light (incandescent) the aft attendant’s panel.Power is supplied
is on. from the P6 and P18 panels at 115V AC, is on. from the P6 and P18 panels at 115V AC,
28V AC, and 28V DC. 28V AC, and 28V DC.
115V AC
GRD SVC OFF 260V
BUS B 115V AC
A GRD SVC OFF 260V
BRIGHT L BUS B
ENTRY DIM L A
A BRIGHT L
S ENTRY DIM L
75V T A
28V AC S
GRD SVC BRIGHT 75V
DIM ENTRY LIGHT 28V AC T
BUS
GRD SVC BRIGHT
WORK & BUS DIM ENTRY LIGHT
THRESHOLD
LIGHTS FWD ENTRY SW WORK &
FWD ENTRY LIGHT THRESHOLD
P18 PANEL P13 FWD ATT PNL ASSEMBLY LIGHTS FWD ENTRY SW FWD ENTRY LIGHT
P18 PANEL P13 FWD ATT PNL ASSEMBLY

28V DC
HOT BAT
BUS 28V DC
HOT BAT
DIM ENTRY BUS
P6 PANEL DIM ENTRY
P6 PANEL

28V DC
28V DC
EXT POWER
EXT PWR SENSING RELAY
EXTERNAL EXT POWER
BUS POWER R47 (P6) EXT PWR
PROTECTION EXTERNAL SENSING RELAY
RECEPTACLE R47 (P6)
PANEL BUS POWER
PROTECTION RECEPTACLE
DIM ENTRY LIGHT PANEL
260V DIM ENTRY LIGHT
B
OFF A 260V
L B
L OFF A
A L
DIM S L
75V T A
DIM S
75V T
BRIGHT AFT ENTRY LIGHT
ASSEMBLY BRIGHT AFT ENTRY LIGHT
ASSEMBLY
AFT ENTRY SW
P14 AFT ATT PNL AFT ENTRY SW
P14 AFT ATT PNL

Entry Lights Entry Lights

and
OCT 99 Systems Introduction 33-9 OCT 99 33-9
UNITED
B737 GENERAL AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
LIGHTING AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE LIGHTING AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

Ceiling Lights Ceiling lights are easily relamped by Ceiling Lights Ceiling lights are easily relamped by
Ceiling lights are fluorescent tubes reaching around the reflector and pressing Ceiling lights are fluorescent tubes reaching around the reflector and pressing
mounted on the outboard edge of each the PUSH button which locks the tube in mounted on the outboard edge of each the PUSH button which locks the tube in
sculptured ceiling panel. The ceiling lights position at one end. sculptured ceiling panel. The ceiling lights position at one end.
ballasts are mounted to selected light Night Lights ballasts are mounted to selected light Night Lights
assemblies. The ceiling lights provide Night lights are incandescent lamps assemblies. The ceiling lights provide Night lights are incandescent lamps
indirect illumination throughout the length mounted on one end of selected ceiling indirect illumination throughout the length mounted on one end of selected ceiling
of the passenger cabin. lights housing. They provide soft low of the passenger cabin. lights housing. They provide soft low
115V AC power is supplied through cir- level illumination throughout the passen- 115V AC power is supplied through cir- level illumination throughout the passen-
cuit breakers on the P18-3 panel. For ceil- ger cabin. 28V AC power is supplied cuit breakers on the P18-3 panel. For ceil- ger cabin. 28V AC power is supplied
ing light operation in the dim mode, 115 through circuit breakers on the P18-3 ing light operation in the dim mode, 115 through circuit breakers on the P18-3
volts ac is applied through contacts of panel. volts ac is applied through contacts of panel.
S599 in P13 forward attendants panel to Night lights are operated by placing the S599 in P13 forward attendants panel to Night lights are operated by placing the
the light ballast. rotary CEILING switch on P13 forward the light ballast. rotary CEILING switch on P13 forward
For bright light operation, transformers attendant panel to the NIGHT position. For bright light operation, transformers attendant panel to the NIGHT position.
T131 and T132 in the J10 shield step up The other 3 positions of the CEILING T131 and T132 in the J10 shield step up The other 3 positions of the CEILING
the 115 volts ac to 280 volts ac. In the switch do not operate the incandescent the 115 volts ac to 280 volts ac. In the switch do not operate the incandescent
DIM position of the CEILING switch only night lights. DIM position of the CEILING switch only night lights.
the II5V AC is applied to the ceiling light Night lights are easily accessed by reach- the II5V AC is applied to the ceiling light Night lights are easily accessed by reach-
ballast. In the BRT position of the CEIL- ing directly above the ceiling panel ballast. In the BRT position of the CEIL- ing directly above the ceiling panel
ING switch the 280V AC is applied to the between the fluorescent tubes. The lamp is ING switch the 280V AC is applied to the between the fluorescent tubes. The lamp is
ceiling light ballast in addition to the released by pressing the miniature bayonet ceiling light ballast in addition to the 115V released by pressing the miniature bayonet
115V AC. The first 2 positions of the mount incandescent lamp down then rotat- AC. The first 2 positions of the CEILING mount incandescent lamp down then rotat-
CEILING switch do not operate the fluo- ing it a quarter turn. switch do not operate the fluorescent ceil- ing it a quarter turn.
rescent ceiling lights. ing lights.

TO OTHER TO OTHER
NIGHT CEILING LIGHTS NIGHT CEILING LIGHTS
115V AC 115V AC
TX BUS 1 OFF TX BUS 1 OFF
DIM DIM
CEILING LT BRIGHT 115V CEILING LT BRIGHT 115V
BRT CONT SINGLE BRT CONT SINGLE
115V AC BALLAST 115V AC BALLAST
GRD SVC UNIT GRD SVC UNIT
BUS GRD SVC CEILING LIGHT 280V BUS GRD SVC CEILING LIGHT 280V
BRT CONT SW TO BRT CONT SW TO
28V AC ON GRD 28V AC ON GRD
TX BUS 1 SVC OTHER TX BUS 1 SVC OTHER
NIGHT LTS OFF BUS CEILING NIGHT LTS OFF BUS CEILING
CONTROL GRD SVC SW LIGHTS CONTROL GRD SVC SW LIGHTS
R122 P13 PANEL R122 P 1 3 P A N EL
GRD SVC CEILING GRD SVC CEILING
BUS GRD SVC/ LT POWER 115V BUS GRD SVC/ LT POWER 115V
CONT RT TRANSFER CONT RT TRANSFER
115V AC LTS RELAY 115V AC LTS RELAY
BUS 2 DUAL BUS 2 DUAL
CEILING 280V CEILING 280V
115V AC LTS LT BALLAST 115V AC LTS LT BALLAST
GRD SVC UNIT GRD SVC UNIT
BUS GRD SVC BUS GRD SVC
CEILING LTS TO CEILING LTS TO
RT OTHER RT OTHER
115V AC 115V AC
GRD SVC CEILING GRD SVC CEILING
BUS CEILING LIGHTS BUS CEILING LIGHTS
LTS LT R120 CEILING LTS LT R120 CEILING
LIGHT RELAY LIGHT RELAY
P18 PANEL J1 0 P 1 8 P ANEL J1 0

Ceiling Lights Ceiling Lights

33-10 and Systems Introduction OCT 99 33-10 OCT 99


B737 GENERALUNITED AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
LIGHTING AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE LIGHTING AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

Window Reveal Lights Power for light operation and control is Window Reveal Lights Power for light operation and control is
Window reveal lights are fluorescent tubes provided from the 115 volt ac ground ser- Window reveal lights are fluorescent tubes provided from the 115 volt ac ground ser-
mounted in each sculptured sidewall panel vice bus through circuit breakers on the mounted in each sculptured sidewall panel vice bus through circuit breakers on the
above the windows. Dual ballasts are P18-3 circuit breaker panel. Two trans- above the windows. Dual ballasts are P18-3 circuit breaker panel. Two trans-
located on every second light. The lights formers on the J5 shield step-up 115V AC located on every second light. The lights formers on the J5 shield step-up 115V AC
provide indirect illumination of the side- to 200V AC which is connected to bal- provide indirect illumination of the side- to 200V AC which is connected to bal-
wall panels throughout the length of the lasts. The lights are controlled with appli- wall panels throughout the length of the lasts. The lights are controlled with appli-
passenger cabin. cation of 115V AC by the WINDOW passenger cabin. cation of 115V AC by the WINDOW
The window reveal lights will be installed switch on P13 forward attendant’s panel. The window reveal lights will be installed switch on P13 forward attendant’s panel.
in either of two places: Placing the WINDOW switch to the DIM in either of two places: Placing the WINDOW switch to the DIM
- In the sidewall panel at the top of the position applies 280V AC to all light bal- - In the sidewall panel at the top of the position applies 280V AC to all light bal-
window. These lights will be referred to lasts causing the lights to illuminate dim. window. These lights will be referred to lasts causing the lights to illuminate dim.
as integral sidewall mounted. Placing the WINDOW switch to BRT as integral sidewall mounted. Placing the WINDOW switch to BRT
- In the A/C extrusion, above the sidewall, applies an additional 115V AC to all light - In the A/C extrusion, above the sidewall, applies an additional 115V AC to all light
between the PSU and the sidewall panel. ballasts causing the lights to illuminate between the PSU and the sidewall panel. ballasts causing the lights to illuminate
These lights will be referred to as above brighter. These lights will be referred to as above brighter.
sidewall mounted. sidewall mounted.

115V AC 115V AC
GRD SVC GRD SVC
BUS TO RIGHT WINDOW LIGHTS BUS RIGHT TO RIGHT WINDOW LIGHTS
RIGHT
WINDOW WINDOW
LIGHTS LIGHTS
115V AC 115V AC
GRD SVC 115V GRD SVC 115V
BUS LEFT BUS LEFT
WINDOW WINDOW
LIGHTS LIGHTS
115V AC 115V AC
GRD SVC GRD SVC
R427 BUS R427
BUS WINDOW WINDOW WINDOW
WINDOW BRIGHT
BRIGHT LTS RELAY LTS RELAY
P18 PANEL P18 PANEL
J5 SHIELD BRT DIM J5 SHIELD BRT DIM
MODE MODE MODE MODE

BRIGHT BRIGHT
CURRENT CURRENT
DIM DIM CIRCUIT
CIRCUIT
CONTROL OFF CONTROL
OFF

BRIGHT BRIGHT
DIM DIM
FLOOR LAMP FLOOR LAMP
OFF ASSY MODULE OFF ASSY MODULE
BALLAST BALLAST

FLOOR LAMP/SINGLE BALLAST P13 FWD ATTENDANT FLOOR LAMP/SINGLE BALLAST


P13 FWD ATTENDANT ASSEMBLY MODULE ASSEMBLY MODULE
PANEL PANEL

Window Lights Window Lights

and
OCT 99 Systems Introduction 33-11 OCT 99 33-11
UNITED
B737 GENERAL AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
LIGHTING AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE LIGHTING AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

Reading Lights The lights are easily relamped by lowering Reading Lights The lights are easily relamped by lowering
The reading lights are located in each of the PSU or ASU. The reflector assembly The reading lights are located in each of the PSU or ASU. The reflector assembly
the PSUs and ASUs. They are controlled and lamp are released by pushing down the PSUs and ASUs. They are controlled and lamp are released by pushing down
by pushbutton switches located adjacent and rotating the reflector assembly. by pushbutton switches located adjacent to and rotating the reflector assembly.
to each reading light. Power is supplied by each reading light. Power is supplied by
the 28V AC bus 1 and 2. Circuit breakers the 28V AC bus 1 and 2. Circuit breakers
on the P18-3 panel connect power to the on the P18-3 panel connect power to the
left and right passenger reading light left and right passenger reading light
switches. switches.

28V AC 28V AC
BUS NO. 1 BUS NO. 1
7 BREAKERS LEFT PSU 7 BREAKERS LEFT PSU
(P18) (P18)
READING READING
LIGHTS LIGHTS
LEFT LEFT

28V AC 28V AC
BUS NO. 2 BUS NO. 2
7 BREAKERS RIGHT PSU 7 BREAKERS RIGHT PSU
(P18) (P18)
READING READING
LIGHTS LIGHTS
RIGHT RIGHT

Passenger Reading Lights Passenger Reading Lights

33-12 and Systems Introduction OCT 99 33-12 OCT 99


B737 GENERALUNITED AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
LIGHTING AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE LIGHTING AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

Galley Lights Each cabin galley light has two fluores- Galley Lights Each cabin galley light has two fluores-
Each cabin galley have fluorescent area cent lamps. Each lamp is driven by its own Each cabin galley have fluorescent area cent lamps. Each lamp is driven by its own
lights above the galley work area and ballast. Operation of all OFF/DIM/BRT lights above the galley work area and ballast. Operation of all OFF/DIM/BRT
counters controlled by 3-position switches switches are the same. 115v ac is applied counters controlled by 3-position switches switches are the same. 115v ac is applied
(OFF-DIM-BRT) mounted on the galley to one ballast to operate one lamp in the (OFF-DIM-BRT) mounted on the galley to one ballast to operate one lamp in the
control panel to provide two levels of DIM position, and to both ballasts to oper- control panel to provide two levels of DIM position, and to both ballasts to oper-
brightness. The galley fluorescent lights ate both lamps in the BRT position. brightness. The galley fluorescent lights ate both lamps in the BRT position.
are powered by 115V AC from the ground are powered by 115V AC from the ground
service bus through a circuit breaker on service bus through a circuit breaker on
the P18-3 panel. the P18-3 panel.

115V AC 115V AC
GND SVC GND SVC
BUS OFF B LIGHT BUS OFF B LIGHT
DIM A DIM A
L L
GALLEY BRIGHT L GALLEY BRIGHT L
LIGHTS A LIGHTS A
S S
T T
P18-3 LOAD P18-3 LOAD
CONTROL CENTER CONTROL CENTER

LIGHT B LIGHT
B
A A
L L
GALLEY L GALLEY L
LIGHT A LIGHT A
SWITCH S SWITCH S
T T
GALLEY PANEL GALLEY PANEL

GALLEY FLOURESCENT GALLEY FLOURESCENT


LIGHTS (TYP) LIGHTS (TYP)

Galley Lights Galley Lights

and
OCT 99 Systems Introduction 33-13 OCT 99 33-13
UNITED
B737 GENERAL AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
LIGHTING AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE LIGHTING AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

LAVATORY LIGHTS When ground power is connected to the LAVATORY LIGHTS When ground power is connected to the
Lavatories are illuminated with incandes- airplane, 115V AC from the external Lavatories are illuminated with incandes- airplane, 115V AC from the external
cent lights in the lavatory ceiling, above power bus is applied through the door cent lights in the lavatory ceiling, above power bus is applied through the door
each lavatory door, and fluorescent lights open contacts of the door latch switch to each lavatory door, and fluorescent lights open contacts of the door latch switch to
near the mirrors. The mirror lights illumi- the mirror lights. near the mirrors. The mirror lights illumi- the mirror lights.
nate automatically when ground power is Lavatory Occupied Lights nate automatically when ground power is Lavatory Occupied Lights
applied to the airplane. Each lavatory has a blue occupiedindica- applied to the airplane. Each lavatory has a blue occupiedindica-
Lavatory Dome Lights tor light. The incandescent lamp is pow- Lavatory Dome Lights tor light. The incandescent lamp is pow-
Incandescent dome lights use 28v dc ered from the 28V DC battery bus. When Incandescent dome lights use 28v dc ered from the 28V DC battery bus. When
Power from the battery bus. There are no the lavatory door is closed and latched, the Power from the battery bus. There are no the lavatory door is closed and latched, the
ON/OFF switches for these lights. The indicator illuminates. ON/OFF switches for these lights. The indicator illuminates.
lights are illuminated when the battery bus The forward lavatory occupied light is lights are illuminated when the battery bus The forward lavatory occupied light is
is powered. mounted on a lowered ceiling panel adja- is powered. mounted on a lowered ceiling panel adja-
Lavatory Fluorescent Lights cent to the lavatory. Lavatory Fluorescent Lights cent to the lavatory.
When airplane power is connected and the The aft lavatory occupied light is mounted When airplane power is connected and the The aft lavatory occupied light is mounted
forward or aft lavatory door is closed and on the forward face of the lowered ceiling forward or aft lavatory door is closed and on the forward face of the lowered ceiling
latched, power from 115V AC bus No. 1 bullnose. latched, power from 115V AC bus No. 1 is bullnose.
is applied through the door closed contacts applied through the door closed contacts
of the door latch switch, to the fluorescent of the door latch switch, to the fluorescent
light ballast unit in the lavatory mirror light ballast unit in the lavatory mirror
light assembly. light assembly.
LAV MIRROR
LAV MIRROR EXT PWR
EXT PWR
1
1
115V AC
115V AC EXT PWR BUS
EXT PWR BUS

ELEC SHELF ELEC SHELF


EXT PWR EXT PWR
2 2

LAV MIRROR LAV MIRROR EMI


EMI
FILTER NOT FILTER
NOT
115V AC LOCKED 115V AC LOCKED
BUS NO. 1 BUS NO. 1

1 1
B B
LOCKED LAV DOME LOCKED A
LAV DOME A
L MIRROR L
MIRROR L
DOOR LIGHTS L DOOR LIGHTS
28V DC A 28V DC BOLT A
BOLT BATT BUS S
BATT BUS SWITCH S SWITCH
T T

P18 LOAD P18 LOAD


CONTROL CENTER CONTROL CENTER
DOME DOME
LIGHT LIGHT

1 TO OTHER LAVATORIES 1 TO OTHER LAVATORIES


LAVATORY (TYP) LAVATORY (TYP)

2 IF INSTALLED 2 IF INSTALLED

LAV OCCUPIED LT LAV OCCUPIED LT

Lavatory Lights Lavatory Lights

33-14 and Systems Introduction OCT 99 33-14 OCT 99


B737 GENERALUNITED AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
LIGHTING AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE LIGHTING AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

Passenger And Lavatory Call Lights Lavatory Call Lights Passenger And Lavatory Call Lights Lavatory Call Lights
The attendant call lights are located on the A lavatory call switch is located in each The attendant call lights are located on the A lavatory call switch is located in each
underside of each exit locator sign. The lavatory. An amber lavatory light is underside of each exit locator sign. The lavatory. An amber lavatory light is
exit locator signs are in the forward and aft installed on the exit locator sign nearest exit locator signs are in the forward and aft installed on the exit locator sign nearest
sections of the airplane. The signs are the lavatory. sections of the airplane. The signs are the lavatory.
mounted to the ceiling in the center of the When the LAVATORY CALL switch in mounted to the ceiling in the center of the When the LAVATORY CALL switch in
aisle. There are four attendant call lights any lavatory module is pressed 28 V DC aisle. There are four attendant call lights any lavatory module is pressed 28 V DC
on each sign and each light is a different from bus No. 1 is applied to the amber call on each sign and each light is a different from bus No. 1 is applied to the amber call
color. Each time a call is made from any light and28V DC from bus No. 1 is color. Each time a call is made from any light and28V DC from bus No. 1 is
location the call light will come on and a applied to the passenger address amplifier. location the call light will come on and a applied to the passenger address amplifier.
high tone chime will sound through the When the LAVATORY CALL switch is high tone chime will sound through the When the LAVATORY CALL switch is
passenger address system. The attendant reset power is removed from the amber passenger address system. The attendant reset power is removed from the amber
call light colors are blue, amber, green and lavatory call light. call light colors are blue, amber, green and lavatory call light.
pink. Each different color alerts the atten- NOTE: The lavatory call can be reset pink. Each different color alerts the atten- NOTE: The lavatory call can be reset
dant to the type and location of the call. from the lavatory making the call or dant to the type and location of the call. from the lavatory making the call or
The color identifications are: from the attendants station. The color identifications are: from the attendants station.
- Blue - a call from a passenger seat. Passenger Call Lights - Blue - a call from a passenger seat. Passenger Call Lights
- Amber - a call from one of the lavatories. Passenger call switches are located on - Amber - a call from one of the lavatories. Passenger call switches are located on
- Green - a call from another attendant PSUs at each seating group. A blue pas- - Green - a call from another attendant PSUs at each seating group. A blue pas-
station. senger call light is located on the exit sign station. senger call light is located on the exit sign
- Pink - a call from the flight crew. nearest the seat group making the call. - Pink - a call from the flight crew. nearest the seat group making the call.
When a PASSENGER CALL switch at When a PASSENGER CALL switch at
any seat group is pressed 28 V DC from any seat group is pressed 28 V DC from
bus No. 1 is applied to the blue call light. bus No. 1 is applied to the blue call light.

28V DC 28V DC
BUS 1 BUS 1
1
1
PASS & CREW PASS & CREW
CALL CALL
P18 PANEL 2
P18 PANEL 2

1 POSITION 1: FORWARD 1 POSITION 1: FORWARD ATT CALL SW


ATT CALL SW
PSU PSU
2 POSITION 2: AFT 2 POSITION 2: AFT

HI TONE HI TONE
AUDIO ACC PA AMPL AUDIO ACC PA AMPL
UNIT (E2-1) UNIT (E2-1)

B B B B
CREW CREW P
P P P CALL
CALL
A A A A

FWD EXIT AFT EXIT FWD EXIT AFT EXIT


LOCATOR LOCATOR LOCATOR LOCATOR
LIGHT LIGHT LIGHT LIGHT

FWD LAV AFT LAV OPTIONAL FWD LAV AFT LAV OPTIONAL
CALL PNL CALL PNL RT AFT LAV CALL PNL CALL PNL CALL PNL RT AFT LAV CALL PNL

Passenger Call System Passenger Call System

and
OCT 99 Systems Introduction 33-15 OCT 99 33-15
UNITED
B737 GENERAL AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
LIGHTING AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE LIGHTING AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

Passenger Signs NO SMOKING signs come on when the Passenger Signs NO SMOKING signs come on when the
The passenger signs in the cabin, NO landing gear is extended and off when the The passenger signs in the cabin, NO landing gear is extended and off when the
SMOKING, FASTEN SEAT BELT and gear is retracted. SMOKING, FASTEN SEAT BELT and gear is retracted.
RETURN TO SEAT, are operated by a FASTEN SEAT BELT and RETURN TO RETURN TO SEAT, are operated by a FASTEN SEAT BELT and RETURN TO
three position switch on the forward over- SEAT signs come on when the flaps or three position switch on the forward over- SEAT signs come on when the flaps or
head panel. With AUTO selected, the gear are extended and go off when the head panel. With AUTO selected, the gear are extended and go off when the
signs are controlled automatically by ref- flaps or gear are retracted. signs are controlled automatically by ref- flaps or gear are retracted.
erence to landing gear and flap positions. Either sign may be manually operated by erence to landing gear and flap positions. Either sign may be manually operated by
positioning the switch to the desired posi- positioning the switch to the desired posi-
tion, OFF or ON. When either sign tion, OFF or ON. When either sign
changes, automatically or manually, a low changes, automatically or manually, a low
tone chime sounds over the P.A. system. tone chime sounds over the P.A. system.

28V AC 28V AC
TRANSFER TRANSFER
BUS 1 BUS 1

NO SMOKING NO SMOKING

P18 PANEL P18 PANEL

NOT NOT
DOWN ON DOWN ON
AUTO AUTO
DOWN DOWN
OFF OFF
LANDING GEAR R25 SEAT BELT FASTEN SEAT BELT NO LANDING GEAR R25 SEAT BELT FASTEN SEAT BELT NO
NO SMOKING SIGN RELAY NO SMOKING SIGN RELAY
LEVER DOWN SW SIGN SWITCH SMOKING LEVER DOWN SW SIGN SWITCH SMOKING
PASSENGER WARNING SIGNS PASSENGER WARNING SIGNS
RIGHT SIDE & LEFT SIDE PSU'S RIGHT SIDE & LEFT SIDE PSU'S
UP ON FWD WINDSCREEN UP ON FWD WINDSCREEN
AUTO AUTO
NOT NOT
UP OFF UP OFF
TRAILING EDGE SEAT BELT TRAILING EDGE SEAT BELT
FLAP UP SW SIGN SWITCH FLAP UP SW SIGN SWITCH
(MAIN WHEEL WELL) (MAIN WHEEL WELL)
P5 PANEL P5 PANEL

28V AC RETURN TO SEAT 28V AC RETURN TO SEAT


TRANSFER TRANSFER
BUS 1 BUS 1
LAV CALL PANEL LAV CALL PANEL
FWD & AFT LAVATORIES FWD & AFT LAVATORIES
SEAT BELT SEAT BELT
LOW LOW
TONE TONE
28V DC 28V DC
BUS 2 BUS 2
PA AMPLIFIER PA AMPLIFIER
R26 SEAT BELT E2-1 R26 SEAT BELT E2-1
SIGN RELAY SIGN RELAY
PASS SIGN P6 PANEL PASS SIGN P6 PANEL
CONTROL CONTROL
P18 PANEL P18 PANEL

Passenger Signs Passenger Signs

33-16 and Systems Introduction OCT 99 33-16 OCT 99


B737 GENERALUNITED AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
LIGHTING AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE LIGHTING AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

CARGO AND SERVICE COMPART- Normal cargo compartment light control is CARGO AND SERVICE COMPART- Normal cargo compartment light control is
MENT LIGHTING provided by a switch located adjacent to MENT LIGHTING provided by a switch located adjacent to
The cargo and service compartment lights the forward edge of each cargo door The cargo and service compartment lights the forward edge of each cargo door
provide the necessary illumination for frame.. When set to ON with the door provide the necessary illumination for frame.. When set to ON with the door
cargo handling and for performing service opened, the cargo light switch connects cargo handling and for performing service opened, the cargo light switch connects
activities. 28V AC through the normally closed con- activities. 28V AC through the normally closed con-
Cargo Compartment Lights tacts of the light relay to turn on the lights. Cargo Compartment Lights tacts of the light relay to turn on the lights.
The forward and aft cargo compartments When the cargo door is closed, the cargo The forward and aft cargo compartments When the cargo door is closed, the cargo
are illuminated by dome lights mounted in light relay energizes through the door are illuminated by dome lights mounted in light relay energizes through the door
the ceiling and single spotlight in the warning circuit to extinguish the lights. the ceiling and single spotlight in the warning circuit to extinguish the lights.
upper door frame. upper door frame.

28V AC 28V AC
GRD SVC BUS GRD SVC BUS
DOOR OPEN DOME DOOR OPEN DOME
LIGHT LIGHT

DOOR CLOSED DOOR CLOSED


FWD CARGO CARGO FWD CARGO CARGO
LIGHTS LT SW LIGHTS LT SW
R31 (FWD) R31 (FWD)
R32 (AFT) R32 (AFT)
P18 PANEL P18 PANEL
CARGO COMPARTMENT CARGO COMPARTMENT
28V DC FWD (FWD OR AFT) 28V DC FWD (FWD OR AFT)
MD&T CARGO MD&T CARGO
DOOR DOOR DOOR DOOR
WARNING CLOSED WARNING CLOSED
28V DC LIGHT 28V DC LIGHT
BUS 2 BUS 2
DOOR DOOR
P5 PANEL OPEN P5 PANEL OPEN
K1 K1
DOOR DOOR
WARNING WARNING

P6 PANEL P6 PANEL
DOOR CLOSED DOOR CLOSED
CARGO DOOR CARGO DOOR
M278 MISC SWITCHING MODULE (E3-2) M278 MISC SWITCHING MODULE (E3-2)

Cargo Compartment Lights Cargo Compartment Lights

and
OCT 99 Systems Introduction 33-17 OCT 99 33-17
UNITED
B737 GENERAL AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
LIGHTING AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE LIGHTING AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

Service Compartment Lights The air conditioning compartments have Service Compartment Lights The air conditioning compartments have
The lower nose compartment, E&E com- exposed bulbs and sockets. In the other The lower nose compartment, E&E com- exposed bulbs and sockets. In the other
partment, left and right air conditioning compartments the lights are dome type. partment, left and right air conditioning compartments the lights are dome type.
compartments, aft accessory compart- The lights are all controlled by two posi- compartments, aft accessory compart- The lights are all controlled by two posi-
ment, APU compartment, and tail cone tion ON - OFF switches. ment, APU compartment, and tail cone tion ON - OFF switches.
compartment all have individual lights The power supply for the service lights compartment all have individual lights and The power supply for the service lights
and switches to provide illumination for operation is 28V AC ground service bus. switches to provide illumination for ser- operation is 28V AC ground service bus.
servicing. vicing.

28V AC 28V AC
GND SVC OFF GND SVC OFF
BUS BUS
ON ON
ELEC LOWER NOSE LOWER NOSE
LOWER NOSE COMPARTMENT ELEC LOWER NOSE
RACK COMP LTS RACK COMPARTMENT
COMP LTS
LIGHTS SWITCH LIGHTS SWITCH

OFF OFF
ON ON
E/E E/E
ELEC RACK COMPARTMENT ELEC RACK COMPARTMENT
LTS SWITCH LTS SWITCH

28V AC 28V AC
GND SVC OFF GND SVC OFF
BUS BUS
AC COMP RIGHT A/C RIGHT A/C
COMPARTMENT AC COMP
LIGHTS LIGHTS COMPARTMENT
ON ON

RIGHT A/C RIGHT A/C


LTS SWITCH LTS SWITCH

OFF OFF

LEFT A/C LEFT A/C


COMPARTMENT COMPARTMENT

ON ON

LEFT A/C LEFT A/C


LTS SWITCH LTS SWITCH

ACCESSORY ACCESSORY
LTS SWITCH AFT ACCESSORY LTS SWITCH AFT ACCESSORY
COMPARTMENT COMPARTMENT

28V AC 28V AC
GND SVC OFF GND SVC OFF
BUS BUS
ON ON
APU APU
ACCESSORY APU COMP COMPARTMENT ACCESSORY APU COMP
COMP COMP COMPARTMENT
LTS SW LTS SW
LIGHTS LIGHTS
OFF OFF
ON ON
TAIL CONE TAIL CONE
COMPARTMENT COMPARTMENT
TAIL CONE TAIL CONE
COMP SW COMP SW

Service Compartment Lights Service Compartment Lights

33-18 and Systems Introduction OCT 99 33-18 OCT 99


B737 GENERALUNITED AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
LIGHTING AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE LIGHTING AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

Wheel Well Lights The 28V AC ground service bus supplies Wheel Well Lights The 28V AC ground service bus supplies
One wheel well dome light and one gear electrical power through the WHEEL One wheel well dome light and one gear electrical power through the WHEEL
inspection floodlight are installed in the WELL’s circuit breaker on the P18 panel. inspection floodlight are installed in the WELL’s circuit breaker on the P18 panel.
nose wheel well and each main wheel Setting the WHEEL WELL light switch to nose wheel well and each main wheel Setting the WHEEL WELL light switch to
well. The main wheel well lights are con- ON from the overhead turns all wheel well well. The main wheel well lights are con- ON from the overhead turns all wheel well
trolled by the WHEEL WELL switch on lights on. Setting either the main or nose trolled by the WHEEL WELL switch on lights on. Setting either the main or nose
the forward overhead panel and switch in wheel well light switch to ON will turn the the forward overhead panel and switch in wheel well light switch to ON will turn the
the forward left main wheel well area. applicable wheel well light on. The switch the forward left main wheel well area. applicable wheel well light on. The switch
Nose wheel well lights are also controlled used to turn the lights on must by used to Nose wheel well lights are also controlled used to turn the lights on must by used to
by the WHEEL WELL switch on the for- turn the lights off. by the WHEEL WELL switch on the for- turn the lights off.
ward overhead panel and a nose wheel ward overhead panel and a nose wheel
well light switch on the external power well light switch on the external power
receptacle panel. receptacle panel.

28V AC NOSE 28V AC NOSE


GRD SVC WHEEL OFF WHEEL GRD SVC WHEEL OFF WHEEL
BUS WELL WELL BUS WELL WELL
LIGHTS DOME FLOOD LIGHTS DOME FLOOD
LIGHT LIGHT LIGHT LIGHT
ON ON

WHEEL WHEEL
WELLS NORMAL WELLS NORMAL

EXT PWR RECEPT EXT PWR RECEPT


(P19) P18 PANEL (P19)
P18 PANEL NOSE GEAR WHEEL WELL NOSE GEAR WHEEL WELL
ON NORMAL DOME FLOOD ON NORMAL DOME FLOOD
P5 PANEL LIGHT LIGHT P5 PANEL LIGHT LIGHT

ON ON

MAIN WHEEL MAIN WHEEL


WELL LIGHTS WELL LIGHTS
LEFT MAIN GEAR LEFT MAIN GEAR
WHEEL WELL WHEEL WELL
ANTI WHEEL ANTI WHEEL
COLLISION WING WELL DOME FLOOD COLLISION WING WELL DOME FLOOD
OFF OFF OFF LIGHT LIGHT OFF OFF OFF LIGHT LIGHT

ON ON ON ON ON ON

RIGHT MAIN GEAR RIGHT MAIN GEAR


WHEEL WELL WHEEL WELL

Wheel Well Lights Wheel Well Lights

and
OCT 99 Systems Introduction 33-19 OCT 99 33-19
UNITED
B737 GENERAL AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
LIGHTING AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE LIGHTING AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

EXTERIOR LIGHTING Wing Scanning Lights EXTERIOR LIGHTING Wing Scanning Lights
Exterior lights include the landing, run- Wing scanning lights, sometimes called Exterior lights include the landing, run- Wing scanning lights, sometimes called
way turnoff, taxi, position, anti-collision, wing illumination lights, are two white way turnoff, taxi, position, anti-collision, wing illumination lights, are two white
strobe, wing and wheel well lights. Con- wing lights mounted flush with the fuse- strobe, wing and wheel well lights. Con- wing lights mounted flush with the fuse-
trols are located on the forward overhead lage forward of the wing. Primarily, they trols are located on the forward overhead lage forward of the wing. Primarily, they
panel. are used to scan the wing leading edge for panel. are used to scan the wing leading edge for
Service lights are located at various work icing. They also provide light to assist in Service lights are located at various work icing. They also provide light to assist in
areas including each wheel well and cargo ground service of the airplane. areas including each wheel well and cargo ground service of the airplane.
compartment. Controls are located at the compartment. Controls are located at the
individual service areas. individual service areas.

28V AC 28V AC
GND OFF GND OFF
SERVICE W
SERVICE W
BUS BUS
EXTERIOR EXTERIOR
LIGHTING LIGHTING
WING SCAN RIGHT WING WING SCAN RIGHT WING
ILLUMINATION ILLUMINATION
LIGHT LIGHT
P18 PANEL P18 PANEL

W W

ON ON

WING LIGHT LEFT WING WING LIGHT LEFT WING


SWITCH ILLUMINATION SWITCH ILLUMINATION
LIGHT LIGHT
P5 PANEL P5 PANEL

Wing Scanning Lights Wing Scanning Lights

33-20 and Systems Introduction OCT 99 33-20 OCT 99


B737 GENERALUNITED AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
LIGHTING AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE LIGHTING AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

Inboard Landing Lights CAUTION: Landing Light ground Inboard Landing Lights CAUTION: Landing Light ground
Two fixed landing lights are in the wing operation should be limited to less than Two fixed landing lights are in the wing operation should be limited to less than
leading edge with the runway turnoff 5 minutes. leading edge with the runway turnoff 5 minutes.
lights. The lights shine forward and down Runway Turnoff Lights lights. The lights shine forward and down Runway Turnoff Lights
in a fixed position. The lights are pro- Runway turnoff lights are adjacent to and in a fixed position. The lights are pro- Runway turnoff lights are adjacent to and
tected by and aerodynamically contoured inboard of the inboard landing lights. The tected by and aerodynamically contoured inboard of the inboard landing lights. The
glass window. lights shine outward approximately 30° glass window. lights shine outward approximately 30°
Outboard Landing Lights and have a beam width of 50°. Outboard Landing Lights and have a beam width of 50°.
Retractable landing lights are installed in Nose Gear Taxi Light Retractable landing lights are installed in Nose Gear Taxi Light
the outboard flap track fairings. The lights The taxi light is mounted on the nose the outboard flap track fairings. The lights The taxi light is mounted on the nose
are designed to extend from the flap track wheel strut and will point in the same are designed to extend from the flap track wheel strut and will point in the same
and shine forward, parallel to the longitu- direction as the nose wheel. The light will and shine forward, parallel to the longitu- direction as the nose wheel. The light will
dinal axis of the airplane, regardless of not go off automatically when the nose dinal axis of the airplane, regardless of not go off automatically when the nose
flap position. The lights may be extended gear is retracted. flap position. The lights may be extended gear is retracted.
at any airplane speed. at any airplane speed.

115V AC 115V AC
BUS 1 OFF BUS 1 OFF
115/28V 115/28V
RIGHT ON W RIGHT ON W
INBOARD INBOARD
LANDING LANDING LT R R INBD LANDING LANDING LT R R INBD
LIGHT INBOARD SWITCH T44 XFMR R LDG LT LIGHT INBOARD SWITCH T44 XFMR R LDG LT
28V AC INBD LDG LT 28V AC OFF INBD LDG LT
OFF XFMR
XFMR W W
BUS 2 BUS 2
ON ON
RUNWAY RUNWAY
RUNWAY RUNWAY TURNOFF
TURNOFF TURNOFF
TURNOFF R RUNWAY TURNOFF LIGHT R RUNWAY TURNOFF LIGHT
LIGHT- R LIGHT- R LT SWITCH
LT SWITCH
28V AC 28V AC
XFMR OFF XFMR OFF
W BUS 1 W
BUS 1 ON
ON
NOSE GEAR NOSE NOSE GEAR NOSE
TAXI LIGHT TAXI TAXI LIGHT TAXI
NOSE TAXI LT LIGHT NOSE TAXI LT LIGHT
SWITCH SWITCH
28V AC 28V AC
XFMR XFMR OFF
OFF BUS 1
BUS 1 W W
ON ON
RUNWAY RUNWAY RUNWAY RUNWAY
TURNOFF TURNOFF TURNOFF TURNOFF
LIGHT- L L RUNWAY TURNOFF LIGHT LIGHT- L L RUNWAY TURNOFF LIGHT
LT SWITCH LT SWITCH

115V AC OFF 115V AC OFF


115/28V BUS 2 115/28V
BUS 2
LEFT ON W LEFT ON W
INBOARD INBOARD
LANDING LANDING LT L L INBD LANDING LANDING LT L L INBD
LIGHT INBOARD SWITCH T43 XFMR L LDG LT LIGHT INBOARD SWITCH T43 XFMR L LDG LT
INB LDG LT INB LDG LT
PLATE ASSY & ADJ ARM FULL 115V AC PLATE ASSY & ADJ ARM FULL
115V AC RETRACT
RETRACT BUS 1
BUS 1 REVERSING SW LIMIT SW THERMOSTATIC REVERSING SW LIMIT SW THERMOSTATIC
LEFT SWITCH LEFT SWITCH
OUTBOARD RETRACT RETRACT OUTBOARD RETRACT RETRACT
LANDING EXTEND EXTEND LANDING EXTEND EXTEND
LIGHT LIGHT
ON FULL ON TRACKING SW FULL
TRACKING SW
115V AC EXTEND 115V AC EXTEND
BUS 2 RIGHT LIMIT SW 16.5V BUS 2 RIGHT LIMIT SW 16.5V
OUTBOARD LAMP SW OUTBOARD LAMP SW
LANDING LANDING
LIGHT ACTUATED OPEN WITHIN 5˚ RETRACTED POSITION LIGHT ACTUATED OPEN WITHIN 5˚ RETRACTED POSITION
P18 PANEL P5 PANEL LANDING LIGHT ASSEMBLY (SHOWN RETRACTED) P18 PANEL P5 PANEL LANDING LIGHT ASSEMBLY (SHOWN RETRACTED)

Landing, Taxi and Turnoff Lights Landing, Taxi and Turnoff Lights

and
OCT 99 Systems Introduction 33-21 OCT 99 33-21
UNITED
B737 GENERAL AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
LIGHTING AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE LIGHTING AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

Navigation Lights (Position Lights) These lights are controlled by two Navigation Lights (Position Lights) These lights are controlled by two
Position lights, mounted in the wing tips switches on the forward overhead panel. Position lights, mounted in the wing tips switches on the forward overhead panel.
and tail cone, indicate airplane position, The strobe light switch controls the three and tail cone, indicate airplane position, The strobe light switch controls the three
direction and attitude. The lights consist white strobe lights. With the switch posi- direction and attitude. The lights consist of white strobe lights. With the switch posi-
of one high intensity white strobe light tioned to ON, the strobe lights will be on. one high intensity white strobe light facing tioned to ON, the strobe lights will be on.
facing forward and either a fixed green or The high intensity strobe lights flash at forward and either a fixed green or red The high intensity strobe lights flash at
red light facing outboard in the right and approximately 60 flashes per minute. The light facing outboard in the right and left approximately 60 flashes per minute. The
left wing tip respectively. position lights are controlled by three wing tip respectively. position lights are controlled by three
An aft facing fixed white light is on each position, ON, OFF, ON BAT switch. Mov- An aft facing fixed white light is on each position, ON, OFF, ON BAT switch. Mov-
wing tip trailing edge. A strobe light is ing the position switch to ON turns on the wing tip trailing edge. A strobe light is ing the position switch to ON turns on the
located on the fuselage tail cone above the colored position lights and the white trail- located on the fuselage tail cone above the colored position lights and the white trail-
APU exhaust. ing edge wing tip lights. In the ON BAT APU exhaust. ing edge wing tip lights. In the ON BAT
position the position lights are powered position the position lights are powered
from the battery bus if no other power is from the battery bus if no other power is
on the airplane. The battery switch must on the airplane. The battery switch must
be ON. be ON.

115V AC OFF 115V AC OFF


TRANSFER LEFT WING TRANSFER LEFT WING
BUS 1 STROBE BUS 1 STROBE
STROBE ON LIGHT STROBE ON LIGHT

28V DC ON BAT 28V DC ON BAT


BAT BUS TAIL BAT BUS TAIL
STROBE STROBE
POS OFF LIGHT POS OFF LIGHT
BAT ON BAT ON
28V AC 28V AC
TRANSFER TRANSFER
BUS 2 BUS 2
POS POS
NORMAL NORMAL
P5 PANEL P5 PANEL
P18 PANEL P18 PANEL

R W W G FLASHTUBE R W W G FLASHTUBE

POWER POWER
SUPPLY SUPPLY
LEFT LEFT RIGHT RIGHT LEFT LEFT RIGHT RIGHT
POSITION TAIL TAIL POSITION POSITION TAIL TAIL POSITION
LIGHT POSITION POSITION LIGHT LIGHT POSITION POSITION LIGHT
LIGHT LIGHT LIGHT LIGHT

TIMING TRIGGER TIMING TRIGGER


CIRCUIT COIL CIRCUIT COIL

POWER SUPPLY ASSY LIGHT ASSY POWER SUPPLY ASSY LIGHT ASSY

RIGHT WING STROBE LIGHT RIGHT WING STROBE LIGHT

Navigation Lights Navigation Lights

33-22 and Systems Introduction OCT 99 33-22 OCT 99


B737 GENERALUNITED AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
LIGHTING AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE LIGHTING AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

Anti-Collision Lights These red flashing lights flash approxi- Anti-Collision Lights These red flashing lights flash approxi-
Two anti collision lights are externally mately once per second. On the ground, Two anti collision lights are externally mately once per second. On the ground,
mounted on the upper and lower fuselage. turning on the lights is an indication to mounted on the upper and lower fuselage. turning on the lights is an indication to
The anti collision lights are high intensity ground personnel that the engines are The anti collision lights are high intensity ground personnel that the engines are
strobe lights. ready for start and/or are operating or strobe lights. ready for start and/or are operating or
The upper light assembly is accessed from ready for pushback. The upper light assembly is accessed from ready for pushback.
the inside of the aircraft by lowering a the inside of the aircraft by lowering a
ceiling panel to access the four mounting ceiling panel to access the four mounting
screws. The lower light assembly is screws. The lower light assembly is
removed and replaced from the outside- removed and replaced from the outside-
bottom of the aircraft. bottom of the aircraft.

XENON XENON
115V AC OFF 115V AC OFF FLASHTUBE
TIMING FLASHTUBE XFR BUS 1 LINE TIMING
XFR BUS 1 LINE
FILTER CIRCUIT FILTER CIRCUIT
60 Hz 60 Hz
ANTI-COLLISION CHARGING ANTI-COLLISION CHARGING
LIGHT UPPER CIRCUIT LIGHT UPPER CIRCUIT

UPPER ANTI-COLLISION LIGHT T226 UPPER ANTI-COLLISION LIGHT


T226
115V AC XENON 115V AC XENON
TIMING FLASHTUBE XFR BUS 2 LINE TIMING FLASHTUBE
XFR BUS 2 LINE CIRCUIT
FILTER CIRCUIT FILTER
60 Hz 60 Hz
ANTI-COLLISION ANTI-COLLISION
CHARGING LIGHT UPPER CHARGING
LIGHT UPPER ANTI-COLLISION ANTI-COLLISION CIRCUIT
CIRCUIT LIGHT SW
LIGHT SW

P18-3 CIRCUIT BREAKER P5 PILOTS OVERHEAD T228 LOWER ANTI-COLLISION LIGHT P18-3 CIRCUIT BREAKER P5 PILOTS OVERHEAD T228 LOWER ANTI-COLLISION LIGHT
PANEL PANEL PANEL PANEL

Anti-Collision Lights Anti-Collision Lights

and
OCT 99 Systems Introduction 33-23 OCT 99 33-23
UNITED
B737 GENERAL AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
LIGHTING AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE LIGHTING AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

EMERGENCY LIGHTS The cockpit aft DOME light contains a EMERGENCY LIGHTS The cockpit aft DOME light contains a
Clearly marked exit lights are located separate bulb that is powered by the emer- Clearly marked exit lights are located separate bulb that is powered by the emer-
throughout the passenger cabin to indicate gency lighting system to provide illumina- throughout the passenger cabin to indicate gency lighting system to provide illumina-
the approved emergency exit routes. All of tion for cockpit evacuation. the approved emergency exit routes. All of tion for cockpit evacuation.
the lights are powered by individual Nicad Interior Emergency Lights the lights are powered by individual Nicad Interior Emergency Lights
batteries with a charging, monitoring, and Interior emergency exit lights are located batteries with a charging, monitoring, and Interior emergency exit lights are located
voltage regulator circuit. in the bullnose of the stowage bins to illu- voltage regulator circuit. in the bullnose of the stowage bins to illu-
The system is controlled by a switch on minate the aisle, over the entry/service and The system is controlled by a switch on minate the aisle, over the entry/service and
the overhead panel. The switch has three overwing emergency hatches to indicate the overhead panel. The switch has three overwing emergency hatches to indicate
positions, OFF, ARMED, and ON and is the door hatch exits, and in the ceiling to positions, OFF, ARMED, and ON and is the door hatch exits, and in the ceiling to
guarded to the ARMED position. With the locate the exits and provide general illu- guarded to the ARMED position. With the locate the exits and provide general illumi-
switch in the ARMED position, the emer- mination in the area of the exits. switch in the ARMED position, the emer- nation in the area of the exits.
gency exit lights will normally be extin- Self illuminating exit locator signs are gency exit lights will normally be extin- Self illuminating exit locator signs are
guished. If electrical power to the 28V DC installed at the forward, the middle, and guished. If electrical power to the 28V DC installed at the forward, the middle, and
bus no. 1 fails or if AC power has been aft end of the passenger compartment. bus no. 1 fails or if AC power has been aft end of the passenger compartment.
turned off, the emergency exit lights illu- Floor proximity emergency escape path turned off, the emergency exit lights illu- Floor proximity emergency escape path
minate automatically. An amber emer- lighting consists of a luminescent strip minate automatically. An amber emer- lighting consists of a luminescent strip
gency exit NOT ARMED indicator light down the left side of the aisle. Lighted gency exit NOT ARMED indicator light down the left side of the aisle. Lighted
and Master Caution Overhead Annuncia- arrows point to overwing exits and lighted and Master Caution Overhead Annuncia- arrows point to overwing exits and lighted
tor will illuminate when the switch is not EXIT indicator is near the floor by each tor will illuminate when the switch is not EXIT indicator is near the floor by each
in the ARMED position. door and overwing exit. Escape path in the ARMED position. door and overwing exit. Escape path
The emergency exit lights may also be markings are provided for visual guidance The emergency exit lights may also be markings are provided for visual guidance
illuminated by a switch on the aft atten- for emergency cabin evacuation when all illuminated by a switch on the aft atten- for emergency cabin evacuation when all
dant’s panel. This switch has two posi- sources of cabin lighting more than four dant’s panel. This switch has two posi- sources of cabin lighting more than four
tions, NORMAL and ON, and is guarded feet above the aisle floor are totally tions, NORMAL and ON, and is guarded feet above the aisle floor are totally
to the NORMAL position. obscured by smoke. to the NORMAL position. obscured by smoke.
With the switch in the NORMAL position, Exterior Emergency Lights With the switch in the NORMAL position, Exterior Emergency Lights
the lights are controlled from the cockpit. Exterior emergency lights illuminate the the lights are controlled from the cockpit. Exterior emergency lights illuminate the
With the switch in the ON position, the escape slides. The fuselage installed With the switch in the ON position, the escape slides. The fuselage installed
cabin attendant may override the cockpit escape slide lights are adjacent to the for- cabin attendant may override the cockpit escape slide lights are adjacent to the for-
controls and illuminate all the emergency ward and aft service and entry doors. Two controls and illuminate all the emergency ward and aft service and entry doors. Two
lights. Control from this panel is available lights are also installed on the fuselage to lights. Control from this panel is available lights are also installed on the fuselage to
in the event of failure of the automatic illuminate the overwing escape routes and in the event of failure of the automatic illuminate the overwing escape routes and
control. ground contact area. control. ground contact area.

33-24 and Systems Introduction OCT 99 33-24 OCT 99


B737 GENERALUNITED AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
LIGHTING AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE LIGHTING AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

Power Supplies Inverters that supply electrical power to Power Supplies Inverters that supply electrical power to
The emergency lights power supplies are exit indicator signs are located above ceil- The emergency lights power supplies are exit indicator signs are located above ceil-
installed on entry light panels and on the ing panels adjacent to the parent battery installed on entry light panels and on the ing panels adjacent to the parent battery
center air conditioning duct. Each supply pack. Inverters used to supply electrical center air conditioning duct. Each supply pack. Inverters used to supply electrical
operates up to eight lights. The power sup- power for the aisle locator lights are operates up to eight lights. The power sup- power for the aisle locator lights are
plies contain battery packs and charging/ installed behind carpet riser panels on the plies contain battery packs and charging/ installed behind carpet riser panels on the
logic circuits. The power supples have the left side of the airplane. logic circuits. The power supples have the left side of the airplane.
capacity to power the lights for at least 15 Power for the emergency light power sup- capacity to power the lights for at least 15 Power for the emergency light power sup-
minutes whenever electrical power is lost, ples comes from the 28V DC bus no. 1 minutes whenever electrical power is lost, ples comes from the 28V DC bus no. 1
or until the electrical power is restored. through a circuit breaker on the P18-3 or until the electrical power is restored. through a circuit breaker on the P18-3
The battery packs require a minumun of panel. The 28V DC is appled to the emer- The battery packs require a minumun of panel. The 28V DC is appled to the emer-
16 hour charging cycle after discharge. gency light power supplies to power the 16 hour charging cycle after discharge. gency light power supplies to power the
Inverters used in the floor proximity emer- charging and control circuits. The battery Inverters used in the floor proximity emer- charging and control circuits. The battery
gency lighting system provide electrical packs are trickle charged when the emer- gency lighting system provide electrical packs are trickle charged when the emer-
power to the electro luminescent aisle gency lights control switch is in OFF or power to the electro luminescent aisle gency lights control switch is in OFF or
locator lights and exit indicator signs by ARMED. locator lights and exit indicator signs by ARMED.
converting battery pack DC voltage to converting battery pack DC voltage to
115V AC. 115V AC.

28V DC 28V DC
BUS 1 BUS 1
TO OTHER TO OTHER
EMERG EXIT LTS TO MASTER BATTERY PACKS EMERG EXIT LTS TO MASTER BATTERY PACKS
CAUTION CAUTION
NOT NOT
ARMED ARMED

ON ON
ARM ARM
OFF OFF

ON ON P5 PANEL
P5 PANEL

NORMAL NORMAL
P14 AFT P14 AFT
PANEL PANEL

PWR CHARGE PWR CHARGE


CONTROL CONTROL

OPEN REGULATOR OPEN REGULATOR


LIGHTS LIGHTS
AT STA AT STA
314R 314R
328L 328L
I MIN 627R I MIN 627R
PIN 2 PIN 3 PIN 4 OUTPUT MODE TEST 627L PIN 2 PIN 3 PIN 4 OUTPUT MODE TEST 627L
ANY OPEN GND ON SWITCH TO ON TIMER 747L ANY OPEN GND ON SWITCH TO ON TIMER 747L
<12V ANY OPEN ON POWER FAILURE 975R <12V ANY OPEN ON POWER FAILURE 975R
975L ANY GRD GND OFF SELECT OFF 975L
ANY GRD GND OFF SELECT OFF
EMERGENCY BATTERY PACK EMERGENCY BATTERY PACK

Emergency Exit Lights Emergency Exit Lights

and
OCT 99 Systems Introduction 33-25 OCT 99 33-25
UNITED
B737 GENERAL AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
LIGHTING AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE LIGHTING AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
CONTROLS & INDICATIONS CONTROLS & INDICATIONS

CONTROL CABIN LIGHTS CONTROL CABIN LIGHTS


Location: Captain and First Officer Panel Location: Captain and First Officer Panel
P1,P3. P1,P3.
MAP LIGHT CONTROL MAP LIGHT CONTROL
PUSH/ROTATE - Regulates brightness of PUSH/ROTATE - Regulates brightness of
the Captain/First Officer map lights. Pull the Captain/First Officer map lights. Pull
MAP PANEL to turn on or push to turn off map lights. MAP PANEL
to turn on or push to turn off map lights.
BR IG HT BR IG HT BR IG HT BR IG HT
PANEL LIGHT CONTROL PANEL LIGHT CONTROL
ROTATE - Captains control regulates the ROTATE - Captains control regulates the
OFF OFF
brightness of the integral instrument light- OFF OFF
brightness of the integral instrument light-
ing in the Captain and center instrument ing in the Captain and center instrument
panels and displays and edge lighting of panels and displays and edge lighting of
the Autopilot Flight Director Mode Con- the Autopilot Flight Director Mode Con-
trol Panel. trol Panel.
First Officers control regulates First Offic- First Officers control regulates First Offic-
ers panel and integral instrument lighting. ers panel and integral instrument lighting.

Location: Captain’s Panel P1. Location: Captain’s Panel P1.


BACKGROUND LIGHT CONTROL BACKGROUND LIGHT CONTROL
ROTATE - Regulates the brightness of the ROTATE - Regulates the brightness of the
fluorescent flood lighting for Captain fluorescent flood lighting for Captain
DOME WHITE panel, First Officer panel, and Center BACKGROUND AFDS FLOOD panel, First Officer panel, and Center
panel. panel.
DIM BR IG HT BR IG HT

AFDS LIGHT CONTROL AFDS LIGHT CONTROL


OFF ROTATE - Regulates the brightness of the
lighting directed at the AFDS control
OFF OFF
ROTATE - Regulates the brightness of the
lighting directed at the AFDS control
panel. panel.
BRIGHT
Location: Aft Overhead Panel P5. Location: Aft Overhead Panel P5.
WHITE DOME LIGHT Switch WHITE DOME LIGHT Switch
DOME WHITE
DIM-OFF-BRIGHT - Controls two over-
DOME WHITE DIM-OFF-BRIGHT - Controls two over-
DIM DIM
head white lights. head white lights.
OFF OFF

BRIGHT BRIGHT

33-26 and Systems Introduction OCT 99 33-26 OCT 99


B737 GENERALUNITED AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
LIGHTING AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE LIGHTING AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
CONTROLS & INDICATIONS CONTROLS & INDICATIONS

CONTROL CABIN LIGHTS CONTROL CABIN LIGHTS


Location: Center Instrument Panel P2 Location: Center Instrument Panel P2
MASTER LIGHTS TEST AND DIM MASTER LIGHTS TEST AND DIM
LIGHTS
MAP PANEL Switch TEST
Switch
BR IG HT BR IG HT
TEST - Lights all system associated lights TEST - Lights all system associated lights
on the forward and aft overhead panels. BRT on the forward and aft overhead panels.
OFF OFF Lights some lights on the Captains and Lights some lights on the Captains and
DIM
First Officer instrument panel. First Officer instrument panel.
BRT-DIM - Controls light intensity. BRT-DIM - Controls light intensity.

Location: Forward Overhead Panel Location: Forward Overhead Panel


CIRCUIT BREAKER LIGHT CON- CIRCUIT BREAKER LIGHT CON-
CIRCUIT BREAKER CIRCUIT BREAKER
TROL TROL
BR IG HT BR IG HT
ROTATE - Regulates the intensity of the ROTATE - Regulates the intensity of the
P6 and P18 circuit breaker panel illumina- P6 and P18 circuit breaker panel illumina-
tion. tion.
OFF OFF
PANEL PANEL
BR IG HT PANEL LIGHT CONTROL BR IG HT PANEL LIGHT CONTROL
ROTATE - Regulates the intensity of the ROTATE - Regulates the intensity of the
forward and aft overhead panel lights. forward and aft overhead panel lights.
OFF OFF

Location: Aft Electronic Panel Location: Aft Electronic Panel


FLOOD LIGHT CONTROL FLOOD LIGHT CONTROL
ROTATE - Regulates the overhead spot- ROTATE - Regulates the overhead spot-
FLOOD PANEL light intensity directed at the thrust lever
FLOOD PANEL light intensity directed at the thrust lever
BR IG HT BR IG HT BR IG HT BR IG HT quadrant.
quadrant.

PANEL LIGHT CONTROL PANEL LIGHT CONTROL


OFF OFF ROTATE - Regulates the intensity of the OFF OFF ROTATE - Regulates the intensity of the
forward and aft electronic control panel forward and aft electronic control panel
lights. lights.

and
OCT 99 Systems Introduction 33-27 OCT 99 33-27
UNITED
B737 GENERAL AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
LIGHTING AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE LIGHTING AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
CONTROLS & INDICATIONS CONTROLS & INDICATIONS

MASTER CAUTION SYSTEM MASTER CAUTION SYSTEM


Location: Glareshield P7 Location: Glareshield P7
Left and Right System Annunciator Left and Right System Annunciator
Panels Panels
Indicate a caution condition exists in the Indicate a caution condition exists in the
associated system. All system annunciator associated system. All system annuncia-
lights go off when either the left or right tor lights go off when either the left or
MASTER CAUTION light is pushed. All right MASTER CAUTION light is
system annunciator lights and both MAS- pushed. All system annunciator lights and
TER CAUTION lights come on when both MASTER CAUTION lights come on
either system annunciator panel is pushed when either system annunciator panel is
and held. When the panel is released, both pushed and held. When the panel is
MASTER CAUTION lights and the asso- released, both MASTER CAUTION lights
ciated system annunciator remain on for and the associated system annunciator
any system caution that exists. The system remain on for any system caution that
annunciator goes off automatically when exists. The system annunciator goes off
no system caution exists for that system. automatically when no system caution
exists for that system.

FIRE MASTER FLT CONT ELEC ANTI-ICE ENG MASTER FIRE


FIRE MASTER FLT CONT ELEC ANTI-ICE ENG MASTER FIRE WARN CAUTION CAUTION WARN
WARN CAUTION CAUTION WARN
IRS APU HYD OVERHEAD
IRS APU HYD OVERHEAD BELL CUTOUT PUSH TO RESET PUSH TO RESET BELL CUTOUT
BELL CUTOUT PUSH TO RESET PUSH TO RESET BELL CUTOUT

FUEL OVHT/DET DOORS AIR COND


FUEL OVHT/DET DOORS AIR COND

FUEL Annunciator Light MASTER CAUTION Lights (Left and FUEL Annunciator Light MASTER CAUTION Lights (Left and
Indicates a caution condition exists in the Right) Indicates a caution condition exists in the Right)
fuel system for one or more of these con- Indicate a caution condition exists in one fuel system for one or more of these con- Indicate a caution condition exists in one
ditions: either no. 1 or no. 2 filter bypass or more systems displayed on either sys- ditions: either no. 1 or no. 2 filter bypass or more systems displayed on either sys-
occurs; low fuel pressure for both pumps tem annunciator panel. Both MASTER occurs; low fuel pressure for both pumps tem annunciator panel. Both MASTER
in tank 1 or 2; low fuel pressure for both CAUTION lights and all system lights on in tank 1 or 2; low fuel pressure for both CAUTION lights and all system lights on
left and right center tank when both pump both the left and right systems annunciator left and right center tank when both pump both the left and right systems annunciator
switches are on or low fuel pressure for panels go off when either MASTER CAU- switches are on or low fuel pressure for panels go off when eitherMASTER CAU-
one center tank pump when only one TION light is pushed. This rearms the sys- one center tank pump when only one TION light is pushed. This rearms the sys-
switch is on. When a low pressure condi- tem for subsequent malfunctions. Both switch is on. When a low pressure condi- tem for subsequent malfunctions. Both
tion exists in only one pump in tank 1 or 2 MASTER CAUTION lights go off auto- tion exists in only one pump in tank 1 or 2 MASTER CAUTION lights go off auto-
or in one center tank pump when both cen- matically when no system caution exists. or in one center tank pump when both cen- matically when no system caution exists.
ter tank pump switch are on, the MAS- ter tank pump switch are on, the MASTER
TER CAUTION lights and the FUEL CAUTION lights and the FUEL annuncia-
annunciator do not come on. However, the tor do not come on. However, the MAS-
MASTER CAUTION lights and FUEL TER CAUTION lights and FUEL
annunciator remain on when either annun- annunciator remain on when either annun-
ciator panel is pushed and released. ciator panel is pushed and released.

33-28 and Systems Introduction OCT 99 33-28 OCT 99


B737 GENERALUNITED AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
LIGHTING AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE LIGHTING AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
CONTROLS & INDICATIONS CONTROLS & INDICATIONS

MASTER CAUTION SYSTEM MASTER CAUTION SYSTEM


Location: Glareshield P7 Location: Glareshield P7
ANTI-ICE Annunciator Light ANTI-ICE Annunciator Light
Indicates a caution condition exists in the Indicates a caution condition exists in the
anti-ice system for one or more of the fol- anti-ice system for one or more of the fol-
lowing conditions: an overheat or loss of lowing conditions: an overheat or loss of
window heat control power to a forward or window heat control power to a forward or
side window; or one or more heaters that side window; or one or more heaters that
are controlled by the pitot-static heat are controlled by the pitot-static heat
switch are not operating. Cowl ANTI-ICE switch are not operating. Cowl ANTI-ICE
high pressure or overheat. high pressure or overheat.

HYD Annunciator Light HYD Annunciator Light


Indicates a caution condition exists in the Indicates a caution condition exists in the
ANTI-ICE ENG MASTER FIRE ANTI-ICE ENG MASTER FIRE
CAUTION WARN CAUTION WARN

hydraulic system for one or more of the hydraulic system for one or more of the
HYD OVERHEAD HYD OVERHEAD
PUSH TO RESET BELL CUTOUT PUSH TO RESET BELL CUTOUT

following conditions: hydraulic pump out- following conditions: hydraulic pump out-
DOORS AIR COND DOORS AIR COND

put pressure is low for the associated put pressure is low for the associated
engine driven or electric pump on the A or engine driven or electric pump on the A or
B hydraulic system; system A or B electric B hydraulic system; system A or B electric
hydraulic pumps have an overheat condi- hydraulic pumps have an overheat condi-
tion. tion.

DOORS Annunciator Light DOORS Annunciator Light


Indicates a caution exists in one or more of Indicates a caution exists in one or more of
these areas: one or more of the following these areas: one or more of the following
doors not locked closed: forward (1L) and doors not locked closed: forward (1L) and
aft (2L) entry, forward and aft cargo, for- AIR COND Annunciator Light aft (2L) entry, forward and aft cargo, for- AIR COND Annunciator Light
ward (1R) and aft (2R) service, lower nose Indicates a caution exists in the air condi- ward (1R) and aft (2R) service, lower nose Indicates a caution exists in the air condi-
compartment, or electronic equipment tioning system, including pneumatics and compartment, or electronic equipment tioning system, including pneumatics and
external access door. pressurization, for one or more of the fol- external access door. pressurization, for one or more of the fol-
lowing conditions: a dual bleed exists lowing conditions: a dual bleed exists
between the APU and an engine; a duct between the APU and an engine; a duct
overheat from the left or right pack; a pack overheat from the left or right pack; a pack
trip off by the left or right pack; a bleed trip off by the left or right pack; a bleed
trip off at engine 1 or 2; a wing body over- trip off at engine 1 or 2; a wing body over-
heat on the left or right side; failure of the heat on the left or right side; failure of the
automatic mode of the pressure controller; automatic mode of the pressure controller;
or an off schedule descent. or an off schedule descent.

and
OCT 99 Systems Introduction 33-29 OCT 99 33-29
UNITED
B737 GENERAL AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
LIGHTING AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE LIGHTING AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
CONTROLS & INDICATIONS CONTROLS & INDICATIONS

MASTER CAUTION SYSTEM FLT CONT Annunciator Light MASTER CAUTION SYSTEM FLT CONT Annunciator Light
Location: Glareshield P7 Indicates a caution condition exists in the Location: Glareshield P7 Indicates a caution condition exists in the
flight control system for one or more of flight control system for one or more of
these conditions: standby hydraulic low these conditions: standby hydraulic low
quantity or pressure; flight control A or B quantity or pressure; flight control A or B
low pressure; feel differential pressure; low pressure; feel differential pressure;
yaw damper off; or Mach trim fail, speed yaw damper off; or Mach trim fail, speed
trim fail, or auto slat fail. trim fail, or auto slat fail.
ELEC Annunciator Light ELEC Annunciator Light
Indicates a caution condition exists in the Indicates a caution condition exists in the
FIRE MASTER FIRE MASTER FLT CONT ELEC
FLT CONT ELEC WARN
WARN CAUTION CAUTION

electrical system for one or more of these electrical system for one or more of these
IRS APU BELL CUTOUT PUSH TO RESET
IRS APU
BELL CUTOUT PUSH TO RESET

FUEL OVHT/DET

conditions: The standby buses are nor


FUEL OVHT/DET

conditions: The standby buses are nor


powered; generator 1 or 2 drive has low powered; generator 1 or 2 drive has low
oil pressure or high oil temperature; either oil pressure or high oil temperature; either
transfer bus relay is in the center nor transfer bus relay is in the center nor
power position; or either generator bus 1 power position; or either generator bus 1
or bus 2 is not powered. or bus 2 is not powered.
APU Annunciator Light APU Annunciator Light
Indicates a caution condition exists in the Indicates a caution condition exists in the
APU or one or more of these conditions APU or one or more of these conditions
IRS Annunciator Light when the APU is at operating speed: low IRS Annunciator Light when the APU is at operating speed: low
Indicates a caution exists in the inertial oil pressure; high oil temperature; or over- Indicates a caution exists in the inertial oil pressure; high oil temperature; or over-
reference system for one or more of these speed. reference system for one or more of these speed.
conditions: an IRS system fault; IRS oper- OVHT DET Annunciator Light conditions: an IRS system fault; IRS oper- OVHT DET Annunciator Light
ating on DC power, DC power for IRS not Indicates engine overheat or APU Fire ating on DC power, DC power for IRS not Indicates engine overheat or APU Fire
normal. Detector inop. normal. Detector inop.

ENG Annunciator Light ENG Annunciator Light


Indicates a caution condition exists in the Indicates a caution condition exists in the
engine area for one or more of the these engine area for one or more of the these
conditions: Thrust reverser caution; PMC conditions: Thrust reverser caution; PMC
is off or failed; low engine rpm. is off or failed; low engine rpm.
OVERHEAD Annunciator Light OVERHEAD Annunciator Light
ANTI-ICE ENG MASTER
CAUTION
FIRE
WARN Indicates a caution condition exists in one ANTI-ICE ENG MASTER
CAUTION
FIRE
WARN Indicates a caution condition exists in one
HYD OVERHEAD
PUSH TO RESET BELL CUTOUT
or more of the miscellaneous system on HYD OVERHEAD
PUSH TO RESET BELL CUTOUT
or more of the miscellaneous system on
the overhead panel as follows: flight the overhead panel as follows: flight
DOORS AIR COND DOORS AIR COND

recorder is off; passenger oxygen system recorder is off; passenger oxygen system
is on; the emergency exit lights are not is on; the emergency exit lights are not
armed; equipment cooling off (supply and/ armed; equipment cooling off (supply and/
or exhaust) or exhaust)

33-30 and Systems Introduction OCT 99 33-30 OCT 99


B737 GENERALUNITED AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
LIGHTING AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE LIGHTING AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
CONTROLS & INDICATIONS CONTROLS & INDICATIONS

CABIN SIGNS AND LIGHTS CON- CABIN SIGNS AND LIGHTS CON-
TROL TROL
Location: Forward Overhead Panel P5
NO FASTEN Location: Forward Overhead Panel P5 NO FASTEN
SMOKING BELTS SMOKING BELTS
NO SMOKING SIGNS Switch NO SMOKING SIGNS Switch
OFF - Turns signs off. OFF OFF - Turns signs off.
OFF
AUTO - Turns signs on when landing gear AUTO AUTO - Turns signs on when landing gear
AUTO
lever is down. ON lever is down.
ON
ON - Turns signs on. ON - Turns signs on.
FASTEN BELTS SIGNS Switch FASTEN BELTS SIGNS Switch
OFF - Turns signs off. OFF - Turns signs off.
AUTO - Turns signs on when landing gear AUTO - Turns signs on when landing gear
lever is down or trailing edge flaps not up. lever is down or trailing edge flaps not up.
ON - Turns signs on. ON - Turns signs on.

Location: Forward and Aft Location: Forward and Aft


Flight Attendants Panels Fight Attendants Panels
WORK LIGHTS Switches WORK LIGHTS Switches
BRT
LIGHTS
ON ON Control flight attendant work BRT
LIGHTS
ON ON
Control flight attendant work
OFF OFF OFF
area lights. OFF OFF OFF
area lights.
ENTRY WORK GROUND ENTRY WORK GROUND
SERVICE DIM BRT SERVICE
DIM BRT BRT
OFF BRT OFF
DIM NIGHT DIM
CALL SYSTEM
NIGHT

CEILING
OFF ENTRY LIGHTS SELEC-
CALL SYSTEM
CEILING
OFF
WINDOW
ENTRY LIGHTS SELEC-
WINDOW 3
2
3 4 IFE
TEST TORS CAPT ATTENDANT
LIGHTS
RESET
1
2
4 IFE
TEST TORS CAPT

BRT
ATTENDANT
LIGHTS
ON
RESET

Control entry lights.


1 BRT ON ON ON

Control entry lights.


ON ON
DIM DIM
OFF/ON/VOLUME OFF/ON/VOLUME OFF
OFF NORM NORM
OFF OFF OFF OFF
CALL SYSTEM CALL SYSTEM
ENTRY WORK EMER EXIT ENTRY WORK EMER EXIT

CAPT ATTENDANT RESET


CEILING LIGHTS CAPT ATTENDANT RESET
CEILING LIGHTS
SELECTORS SELECTORS
Controls ceiling lights. Controls ceiling lights.

and
OCT 99 Systems Introduction 33-31 OCT 99 33-31
UNITED
B737 GENERAL AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
LIGHTING AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE LIGHTING AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
CONTROLS & INDICATIONS CONTROLS & INDICATIONS

EXTERIOR LIGHTING EXTERIOR LIGHTING


Location: Forward Overhead Panel Location: Forward Overhead Panel

STROBE ON BAT
RUNWAY TURNOFF LIGHT Switches RUNWAY TURNOFF LIGHT Switches OFF
RUNWAY TAXI
ON - Illuminates the corresponding run- TURNOFF ON - Illuminates the corresponding runway
way turnoff light located in the leading L R turnoff light located in the leading edge of OFF
edge of the wing root. OFF OFF
the wing root.
ON ON
ON ON

TAXI LIGHT Switch TAXI LIGHT Switch


ON - Illuminates the nose wheel taxi light ON - Illuminates the nose wheel taxi light
located on the nose wheel landing strut. located on the nose wheel landing strut.

OUTBOARD LANDING LIGHTS OUTBOARD LANDING LIGHTS


Switch Switch E
E
(three position) X RETRACT OFF (three position) X RETRACT OFF
RETRACT - Outboard landing lights are T
E
RETRACT - Outboard landing lights are T
E
retracted and extinguished. N retracted and extinguished. N
D
EXTEND - Outboard landing lights are
D
L ON R L ON R
EXTEND - Outboard landing lights are L ON R L ON R
extended and remain extinguished. extended and remain extinguished.
OUTBOARD INBOARD OUTBOARD INBOARD
ON - Outboard landing lights are extended ON - Outboard landing lights are extended
and illuminated. and illuminated.
INBOARD LANDING LIGHTS Switch INBOARD LANDING LIGHTS Switch
ON - Illuminates the corresponding right ON - Illuminates the corresponding right
or left inboard landing light. or left inboard landing light.

33-32 and Systems Introduction OCT 99 33-32 OCT 99


B737 GENERALUNITED AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
LIGHTING AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE LIGHTING AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
CONTROLS & INDICATIONS CONTROLS & INDICATIONS

EXTERIOR LIGHT CONTROLS EXTERIOR LIGHT CONTROLS


Location: Forward Overhead Panel Location: Forward Overhead Panel
STROBE ON BAT STROBE ON BAT
OFF OFF
STROBE LIGHT Switch STROBE LIGHT Switch
ON - Turns on the high intensity strobe OFF ON - Turns on the high intensity strobe OFF
lights located on each wing tip and on the lights located on each wing tip and on the
fuselage tail cone above the APU exhaust. ON ON fuselage tail cone above the APU exhaust. ON ON

POSITION LIGHT Switch POSITION LIGHT Switch


ON BAT - Turns on the position lights ON BAT - Turns on the position lights
form the battery bus if no other power is form the battery bus if no other power is
available. Battery Switch must be posi- available. Battery Switch must be posi-
tioned to ON. tioned to ON.
ON - Turns ON the red and green wing tip ON - Turns ON the red and green wing tip
position lights and the white trailing edge position lights and the white trailing edge
wing tip lights. wing tip lights.

ANTI WHEEL ANTI WHEEL


COLLISION WING WELL COLLISION WING WELL
ANTI COLLISION LIGHT Switch OFF OFF OFF ANTI COLLISION LIGHT Switch OFF OFF OFF
ON - Turns on both red high intensity ON - Turns on both red high intensity
strobe lights located on the upper and strobe lights located on the upper and
lower fuselage. ON ON ON lower fuselage. ON ON ON

WING ILLUMINATION Switch WING ILLUMINATION Switch


ON - Turns on both white wing leading ON - Turns on both white wing leading
edge lights located on the fuselage for- edge lights located on the fuselage for-
ward of the wing. ward of the wing.

WHEEL WELL LIGHT Switch WHEEL WELL LIGHT Switch


ON - Turns on the three wheel well lights ON - Turns on the three wheel well lights
for checking the landing gear down and for checking the landing gear down and
locked stripes. locked stripes.

and
OCT 99 Systems Introduction 33-33 OCT 99 33-33
UNITED
B737 GENERAL AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
LIGHTING AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE LIGHTING AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
CONTROLS & INDICATIONS CONTROLS & INDICATIONS

EMERGENCY LIGHTS CONTROLS EMERGENCY LIGHTS CONTROLS


Location: Forward Overhead Panel (P5) Location: Forward Overhead Panel (P5)

EMER EXIT LIGHTS EMER EXIT LIGHTS


EMER EXIT LIGHTS Switch EMER EXIT LIGHTS Switch
Controls emergency exit lights when bat- OFF Controls emergency exit lights when bat- OFF
tery bus is powered. tery bus is powered.
OFF - Turns off emergency exit lights. OFF - Turns off emergency exit lights.
Recharges batteries if No. 1 DC bus is A ARMED Recharges batteries if No. 1 DC bus is A ARMED
N R N R
powered. O M powered. O M
Armed - Turns on emergency exit lights if T E Armed - Turns on emergency exit lights if T E
D D
No. 1 DC bus loses power. Turns off lights ON No. 1 DC bus loses power. Turns off lights ON
and recharges batteries when No.1 bus is and recharges batteries when No.1 bus is
powered. powered.
ON - Turns on emergency exit lights. Bat- ON - Turns on emergency exit lights. Bat-
teries can not be charged. teries can not be charged.
NOT ARMED Light NOT ARMED Light
Indicates emergency exit lights are not Indicates emergency exit lights are not
armed for automatic operation. OVER- armed for automatic operation. OVER-
HEAD and MASTER CAUTION lights HEAD and MASTER CAUTION lights
also come on. also come on.

Location: Aft Flight Attendant Panel. Location: Aft Flight Attendant Panel.
EMER EXIT Lights Switch EMER EXIT Lights Switch
Provides override control of emergency Provides override control of emergency
exit lights from cabin when battery bus is exit lights from cabin when battery bus is
ON
powered. ON powered.
ON - Overrides control cabin EMER ON - Overrides control cabin EMER
EXIT LIGHTS switch and turns on lights. NORM
EXIT LIGHTS switch and turns on lights. NORM
NORM - Allows the control cabin EMER NORM - Allows the control cabin EMER
EXIT LIGHTS switch to control the EXIT LIGHTS switch to control the
EMER EXIT
lights. EMER EXIT lights.

33-34 and Systems Introduction OCT 99 33-34 OCT 99


B737 GENERALUNITED AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
LIGHTING AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE LIGHTING AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
COMPONENT LOCATIONS COMPONENT LOCATIONS

P6 CIRCUIT BREAKER P6 CIRCUIT BREAKER


PANEL FLOODLIGHTS PANEL FLOODLIGHTS
P18 CIRCUIT BREAKER P18 CIRCUIT BREAKER
PANEL FLOODLIGHTS PANEL FLOODLIGHTS
P6 P6
SPARE BULB CIRCUIT SPARE BULB CIRCUIT
STORAGE BREAKER STORAGE BREAKER
PANEL PANEL
FLOOD FLOOD
LIGHTS LIGHTS

FLIGHT FLIGHT
KIT KIT
P6 CIRCUIT LIGHT LIGHT
WITH P6 CIRCUIT
BREAKER PANEL BREAKER PANEL WITH
FLOODLIGHT CONTROL CONTROL
FLOODLIGHT
FLIGHT KIT LIGHT LOCATED ON LOCATED ON
THE FLOOR FLIGHT KIT LIGHT
WITH CONTROL THE FLOOR
WITH CONTROL
CAPTAIN'S SIDEWALL FIRST OFFICER'S SIDEWALL CAPTAIN'S SIDEWALL FIRST OFFICER'S SIDEWALL
CONTROL CABIN CONTROL CABIN
DOOR DOOR

SECOND SECOND
DOME OBSERVERS DOME OBSERVERS
LIGHTS READING LIGHTS READING
LIGHT WITH LIGHT WITH
P6 CIRCUIT CONTROL P6 CIRCUIT CONTROL
BREAKER PANEL BREAKER PANEL

P18 P18
FIRST CIRCUIT FIRST
OBSERVERS CIRCUIT
BREAKER OBSERVERS BREAKER
READING PANEL READING
LIGHT WITH PANEL
LIGHT WITH
CONTROL CONTROL

FIRST OBSERVERS AFT WALL FIRST OBSERVERS


SEAT ACCESS AFT WALL
SEAT ACCESS

Flight Compartment Lights Flight Compartment Lights

and
OCT 99 Systems Introduction 33-35 OCT 99 33-35
UNITED
B737 GENERAL AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
LIGHTING AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE LIGHTING AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
COMPONENT LOCATIONS COMPONENT LOCATIONS

OVERHEAD OVERHEAD
PANEL (P5) PANEL (P5)
LOAD CONTROL LOAD CONTROL
CENTER (P6-3) CENTER (P6-3)
CENTR INSTRUMENT PANEL CENTR INSTRUMENT PANEL
MASTER DIM AND MASTER DIM AND
TEST SWITCH TEST SWITCH

FORWARD ELECTRONICS FORWARD ELECTRONICS


PANEL PANEL
LOAD CONTROL CENTER (P6-4) ANNUNCIATION AND LOAD CONTROL CENTER (P6-4)
ANNUNCIATION AND
DIMMING MODULE MASTER TEST RELAY DIMMING MODULE MASTER TEST RELAY
(UNDER ELECTRONICS AUX MASTER TEST RELAY (UNDER ELECTRONICS AUX MASTER TEST RELAY
PANEL) BACKGROUND LIGHTS AND PANEL) BACKGROUND LIGHTS AND
DIODES MODULE DIODES MODULE

FIRE PROTECTION FIRE PROTECTION


PANEL P8 PANEL P8

FIRE MASTER FLT CONT ANTI-ICE ENG MASTER FIRE FIRE MASTER FLT CONT ELEC ANTI-ICE ENG MASTER FIRE
ELEC WARN WARN
WARN CAUTION CAUTION WARN CAUTION CAUTION

IRS APU HYD OVERHEAD IRS APU HYD OVERHEAD


BELL CUTOUT PUSH TO RESET PUSH TO RESET BELL CUTOUT BELL CUTOUT PUSH TO RESET PUSH TO RESET BELL CUTOUT

FUEL OVHT/DET DOORS AIR COND FUEL OVHT/DET DOORS AIR COND

MASTER MASTER MASTER MASTER


CAUTION CAUTION CAUTION CAUTION

PUSH TO RESET PUSH TO RESET PUSH TO RESET PUSH TO RESET

MASTER CAUTION MASTER CAUTION MASTER CAUTION MASTER CAUTION


LIGHT LEFT LIGHT RIGHT LIGHT LEFT LIGHT RIGHT

FLT CONT ELEC ANTI-ICE ENG FLT CONT ELEC ANTI-ICE ENG

IRS APU HYD OVERHEAD IRS APU HYD OVERHEAD

FUEL OVHT/DET DOORS AIR COND FUEL OVHT/DET DOORS AIR COND
MASTER CAUTION MASTER CAUTION MASTER CAUTION MASTER CAUTION
ANNUNCIATOR LEFT (CAPTAIN'S) ANNUNCIATOR RIGHT (F/O'S) ANNUNCIATOR LEFT (CAPTAIN'S) ANNUNCIATOR RIGHT (F/O'S)

Master Caution System Master Caution System

33-36 and Systems Introduction OCT 99 33-36 OCT 99


B737 GENERALUNITED AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
LIGHTING AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE LIGHTING AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
COMPONENT LOCATIONS COMPONENT LOCATIONS

AFT ENTRY LIGHT AFT ENTRY LIGHT

LAV LAV

FWD ENTRY THRESHHOLD LIGHT FWD ENTRY THRESHHOLD LIGHT


LIGHT LIGHT
AFT ATT ENDANT AFT ATT ENDANT
PANEL PANEL

THRESHOLD LIGHT THRESHOLD LIGHT

FORWARD ATTENDANT PANEL FORWARD ATTENDANT PANEL


LAV LAV

Cabin Entry Lights Cabin Entry Lights

and
OCT 99 Systems Introduction 33-37 OCT 99 33-37
UNITED
B737 GENERAL AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
LIGHTING AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE LIGHTING AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
COMPONENT LOCATIONS COMPONENT LOCATIONS

CEILING CEILING
LIGHTS LIGHTS

Ceiling Lights Ceiling Lights

33-38 and Systems Introduction OCT 99 33-38 OCT 99


B737 GENERALUNITED AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
LIGHTING AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE LIGHTING AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
COMPONENT LOCATIONS COMPONENT LOCATIONS

L EFT LEFT
WINDOW RIGHT WINDOW RIGHT
L IGHT WINDOW L IGHT W INDOW
L IGHT LIGHT

PSU PSU

FLOOR FLOOR

AIR AIR
CONDIT IONING CONDITIONING
WINDOW E XT RUS ION WINDOW EXTRUSION
LIGHT L IGHT
CUTOUT CUT OUT
BALLAST BALLAST
(REF) (REF)

S IDE AL L SIDEALL
SCREW S P ANE L SCREW S PANEL
(2) (2 )
LAMP LAM P
HOUSING HOUSING
(REF) (REF)

LENS LENS

S CRE W SCREW
(2) (2 )
SIDEWALL PANEL S IDEW ALL PANEL

WINDOW L IGHT CUT OUT W INDOW LIGHT CUTOUT


(W/L IGHT AS S Y) (W /LIGHT ASSY)

Window Lights Window Lights

and
OCT 99 Systems Introduction 33-39 OCT 99 33-39
UNITED
B737 GENERAL AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
LIGHTING AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE LIGHTING AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
COMPONENT LOCATIONS COMPONENT LOCATIONS

FASTENER FASTENER

RAISE RAISE
FOR FOR
CLEANING CLEANING

RETAINING RETAINING
LENS CLIPS LENS CLIPS
FRAME SERVICE FRAME SERVICE
ASSY MODULE ASSY MODULE
READING LIGHT READING LIGHT
SWITCHES SWITCHES
(3 PLACES) (3 PLACES)

PSU (TOP VIEW) PSU (TOP VIEW)

Reading Lights Reading Lights

33-40 and Systems Introduction OCT 99 33-40 OCT 99


B737 GENERALUNITED AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
LIGHTING AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE LIGHTING AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
COMPONENT LOCATIONS COMPONENT LOCATIONS

GALLY GAL L Y
LIGHT L IGHT
SWITCH L AV DOME S WIT CH LAV DOM E
L IGHT & LIGHT &
MIRROR M IRROR
AS S Y ASSY

GALLEY LIGHTS (TYP) GAL L E Y L IGHTS (TYP)

CEILING AF T L AVAT ORY CEILING AFT LAVATORY


(REF) (REF)

L OWE RE D LOW ERED


ATTENDANT EXIT CE IL ING AT T E NDANT EXIT CEILING
CALL LIGHT SIGN AT AF T CAL L L IGHT SIGN AT AFT
(3 PLACES) DOOR (RE F ) (3 P L ACE S ) DOOR (REF)

EMERGENCY EXIT LOCATOR LIGHT EM ERGENCY EXIT LOCATOR LIGHT

PASSENGER & LAVATORY CALL LIGHTS P AS S E NGE R & LAVATORY CALL LIGHTS

RETURN TO RETURN TO
YOUR SEAT YOUR SEAT

LAVATORY CALL LAVATORY CALL


SWITCH SW ITCH
F WD L AVAT ORY FW D LAVATORY

Galley Lights,Lavatory Lights and Signs Galley Lights,Lavatory Lights and Signs

and
OCT 99 Systems Introduction 33-41 OCT 99 33-41
UNITED
B737 GENERAL AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
LIGHTING AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE LIGHTING AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
COMPONENT LOCATIONS COMPONENT LOCATIONS

T AIL TAIL
CONE CONE
COMP ART ME NT COM PARTM ENT
L IGHT LIGHT

AFT ACCESSORY AFT ACCESSORY


COMPARTMENT COM PARTM ENT

APU APU
E LECTRONIC COMPARTMENT E L E CT RONIC COM PARTM ENT
C O MPARTMENT COMP ART ME NT
LIGHT LIGHT
SWITCH SW ITCH

L IGHT S WIT CH LIGHT SW ITCH

LIGHT AF T CARGO L IGHT AFT CARGO


NOSE SWITCH COMP ART ME NT NOS E S WIT CH COM PARTM ENT
WHE EL (6 L IGHT S ) WHE E L (6 LIGHTS)
WE LL WE L L
MAIN WHE E L WE L L M AIN W HEEL W ELL
(2 LIG HT S ) (2 LIGHTS)
A/C COM P ART ME NT A/C COM PARTM ENT
LIGHT (9 LIGHT S ) LIGHT (9 LIGHTS)
SW ITCH SW ITCH
FWD CARGO FW D CARGO
COMPARTMENT COM PARTM ENT

SWI T CH NOSE WHEEL W ELL LIGHT SW IT CH (E XT P WR P NL ) S WIT CH NOSE W HEEL W ELL LIGHT SW ITCH (EXT PW R PNL)
LOWER NOSE COMPARTMENT (3 LIGH T S ) L O W ER NOSE COM PARTM ENT (3 LIGHTS)

Cargo and Service Compartment Lights Cargo and Service Compartment Lights

33-42 and Systems Introduction OCT 99 33-42 OCT 99


B737 GENERALUNITED AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
LIGHTING AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE LIGHTING AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
COMPONENT LOCATIONS COMPONENT LOCATIONS

UPPER LAMP UPPER LAMP


INNER ADJUSTMENT INNER ADJUSTMENT
LAMP SCREWS AND LAMP SCREWS AND
RETAINER NUTPLATES RETAINER NUTPLATES

LAMP LAMP
WIRES LAMP WIRES LAMP
LAMP RETAINER LAMP RETAINER

LAMP LAMP
RETAINER RETAINER
SCREWS SCREWS

LENS ASSEMBLY LENS ASSEMBLY


RETAINING CABLE LENS RETAINING CABLE LENS
ASSEMBLY ASSEMBLY

LAMP ADJUSTMENT LAMP ADJUSTMENT


SCREWS (TYPICAL SCREWS (TYPICAL
TOP AND BOTTOM) TOP AND BOTTOM)
(4 SCREWS) LENS ASSEMBLY (4 SCREWS) LENS ASSEMBLY
MOUNTING SCREW MOUNTING SCREW
(4 PLACES) (4 PLACES)

Wing Illumination Lights Wing Illumination Lights

and
OCT 99 Systems Introduction 33-43 OCT 99 33-43
UNITED
B737 GENERAL AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
LIGHTING AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE LIGHTING AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
COMPONENT LOCATIONS COMPONENT LOCATIONS

FUSELAGE FUSELAGE
STRUCTURE STRUCTURE

WING WING
RETAINER STRUCTURE RETAINER STRUCTURE
SCREWS SCREWS INBOARD
INBOARD (3 PLACES)
(3 PLACES) LANDING LANDING
LIGHT LIGHT

COVER COVER

RETAINER RETAINER
SCREWS SCREWS
TRANSFORMER (6 PLACES) TRANSFORMER (6 PLACES)
(INBD LANDING (INBD LANDING
TAXI LIGHT) RUNWAY ADJUSTMENT TAXI LIGHT) RUNWAY ADJUSTMENT
LIGHT TURNOFF SCREWS LIGHT TURNOFF SCREWS
LIGHT (3 PLACES) LIGHT (3 PLACES)
TOWING TOWING
ATTACHMENT ATTACHMENT
FITTING FITTING

HINGE POINT OUTBOARTD HINGE POINT OUTBOARTD


WING LANDING WING LANDING
FOR FLAP FAIRING FOR FLAP
FAIRING LIGHT FAIRING LIGHT
FIXED FAIRING FIXED
ASSEMBLY ASSEMBLY

CAM CAM
TRACK TRACK
CAM CAM
ARM ARM

FLAP FLAP
FAIRING FAIRING
(MOVEABLE) (MOVEABLE)
INDEXING INDEXING
ROD (RIGGING ROD (RIGGING
ONLY) ONLY)
ADJUSTMENT ADJUSTMENT
ARM ARM
FLAPS DOWN FLAPS DOWN
FLAPS UP FLAPS UP

Landing Taxi and Turnoff Lights Landing Taxi and Turnoff Lights

33-44 and Systems Introduction OCT 99 33-44 OCT 99


B737 GENERALUNITED AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
LIGHTING AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE LIGHTING AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
COMPONENT LOCATIONS COMPONENT LOCATIONS

STROBE STROBE
LIGHT LIGHT
LENS RETAINING LENS RETAINING
SCREW SCREW
(3 PLACES) (3 PLACES)

WHITE WHITE

LIGHT ASSY LIGHT ASSY


MOUNTING SCREW MOUNTING SCREW
(3 PLACES) (3 PLACES)
TAIL LIGHT TAIL LIGHT

STROBE STROBE
LIGHT LIGHT

RED RED

POSITION LIGHT POSITION LIGHT


ACCESS PANEL (GREEN RIGHT SIDE) ACCESS PANEL (GREEN RIGHT SIDE)

POSITION & STROBE POSITION & STROBE


LIGHTS LIGHTS

TUBE ASSEMBLY TUBE ASSEMBLY


LAMP MOUNTING LAMP
MOUNTING
BRACKET BRACKET LENS
LENS
COVER COVER

ELECTRICAL ELECTRICAL
CONNECTOR CONNECTOR

MOUNTING LENS MOUNTING LENS


ELECTRICAL LAMP ELECTRICAL BOLTS LAMP
BOLTS RETAINER CONNECTOR RETAINER
CONNECTOR

LEFT WING STROBE LIGHT TAIL STROBE LIGHT LEFT WING STROBE LIGHT TAIL STROBE LIGHT

Navigation and Strobe Lights Navigation and Strobe Lights

and
OCT 99 Systems Introduction 33-45 OCT 99 33-45
UNITED
B737 GENERAL AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
LIGHTING AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE LIGHTING AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
COMPONENT LOCATIONS COMPONENT LOCATIONS

UPPER UPPER
LIGHT LIGHT

LOWER LIGHT L OWE R L IGHT

TERMINAL TERM INAL


STRIP STRIP

GROUND GROUN D
WIRE WIRE

L IGHT LIGHT

AIR CONDITIONING AIR CONDITIONING


SYSTEM DUCT S YSTEM DUCT
UPPER LIGHT UPPER LIGHT
(CEILING PANEL REMO VE D) (CEILING PANEL REM OVED)

LIGHT LIGHT

MOUNTING MOUNTING
SCREW S CRE W
(4 PLACES) (4 P L ACES)

T E RMINAL TERM INAL


S T RIP STRIP
AERODYNAMIC AE RODYNAM IC
SMOOTHER S MOOT HE R
LENS RE T AINING LENS RETAINING
LENS (RED) BAN D L E NS (RED) BAND

DRAIN PLUG DRAIN PLUG

LOW ER LIGHT LOW ER LIGHT

Anticollision Lights Anticollision Lights

33-46 and Systems Introduction OCT 99 33-46 OCT 99


B737 GENERALUNITED AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
LIGHTING AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE LIGHTING AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
COMPONENT LOCATIONS COMPONENT LOCATIONS

EXIT EXIT
INDICATOR INDICATOR

FORWARD E NT RY FORW ARD ENTRY

E XIT EXIT
INDICAT OR INDICATOR

LEFT HATCH LEFT HATCH

Exit Indicators Exit Indicators

and
OCT 99 Systems Introduction 33-47 OCT 99 33-47
UNITED
B737 GENERAL AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
LIGHTING AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE LIGHTING AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
COMPONENT LOCATIONS COMPONENT LOCATIONS

FLEXIBLE LAMP FL E X I B L E L A M P
T OP H O U S I N G TOP HOUSING

CONNECTOR CLAMP CONNECTOR CLAMP

CABLE ASSY C A B L E A SSY

BOTTOM HOUSING B O T T O M H O U SI N G

TAPE T A PE

TAPE T A PE

PROTECTIVE PR O T E C T I V E
COVER COVER
ENDCAP ENDCAP

SIDEWALL SI D E WA L L
PANEL (REF) PA N E L ( R E F)

INVERTER INVERTER

C A R P E T R IS E R C A R PE T R I SE R
PANEL (REF) PA N E L ( R E F)

FLOOR PROXIMITY LIGHT INVERTER F L O O R PR O X I M I T Y L I G H T I N V E R T E R

Floor Proximity Lighting Floor Proximity Lighting

33-48 and Systems Introduction OCT 99 33-48 OCT 99


B737 GENERALUNITED AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
LIGHTING AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE LIGHTING AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
COMPONENT LOCATIONS COMPONENT LOCATIONS

REFLECTORS REFLECTORS

LAMP LAM P

LENS AS S E MBL Y LENS ASSEM BLY

FORWARD OVERW ING F ORWARD OV ERW ING LAM P


LAMP L IGHT (2 P L A CES)
LIGHT (2 PLACES)
L E NS LENS
AS S E MBL Y ASSEM BLY

RE F L E CT OR REFLECTOR

ESCAPE SLIDE AND AFT ESCAPE SLIDE AND AFT


OVERW ING LIGHT (6 PLAC E S ) OVERW ING LIGHT (6 PLACES)

Overwing and Escape Slide Lights Overwing and Escape Slide Lights

and
OCT 99 Systems Introduction 33-49 OCT 99 33-49
UNITED
B737 GENERAL AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
LIGHTING AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE LIGHTING AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
COMPONENT LOCATIONS COMPONENT LOCATIONS

POWER SUPPLY ON POWER SUPPLY ON


AIR CONDITIONING DUCT AIR CONDITIONING DUCT
(3 PLACES) (3 PLACES)

POWER SUPPLY ON POWER SUPPLY ON


FORWARD ENTRY FORWARD ENTRY
LIGHT (2 PLACES) LIGHT (2 PLACES) POWER SUPPLY ON
POWER SUPPLY ON
AFT ENTRY LIGHT AFT ENTRY LIGHT
(2 PLACES) (2 PLACES)

QUICK RELEASE QUICK RELEASE


FASTENERS FASTENERS
(2 PLACES) (2 PLACES)
ELECTRICAL ELECTRICAL
SOCKETS SOCKETS

POWER POWER
SUPPLY SUPPLY

BATTERY BATTERY
PACK PACK

TEST TEST
SWITCH SWITCH

Emergency Battery Packs Emergency Battery Packs

33-50 and Systems Introduction OCT 99 33-50 OCT 99


B737 GENERALUNITED AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
LIGHTING AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE LIGHTING AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
COMPONENT LOCATIONS COMPONENT LOCATIONS

EXIT INDICATOR
EXIT INDICATOR

STA
STA

860
860

OVERWING HATCH
OVERWING HATCH

AISLE INDICATOR
AISLE INDICATOR

STA STA
STA STA

600 670
600 670

OVERWING HATCH
OVERWING HATCH

EXIT INDICATOR
EXIT INDICATOR

ELECTRICAL
CONNECTOR
ELECTRICAL
CONNECTOR

STA
STA

430
430

EXIT INDICATOR
EXIT INDICATOR

AISLE LIGHT
AISLE LIGHT

Emergency Exit Light Locations Emergency Exit Light Locations

and
OCT 99 Systems Introduction 33-51 OCT 99 33-51
UNITED AIRLINES COURSE
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
TABLE OF CONTENTS TABLE OF CONTENTS

DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION


NAVIGATION SYSTEMS ........................................................................34-2 NAVIGATION SYSTEMS ........................................................................ 34-2
EFIS System...........................................................................................34-2 EFIS System .......................................................................................... 34-2
IRS System.............................................................................................34-2 IRS System ............................................................................................ 34-2
DME System..........................................................................................34-2 DME System.......................................................................................... 34-2
ADF System...........................................................................................34-2 ADF System .......................................................................................... 34-2
TCAS/ATC Transponder System ..........................................................34-2 TCAS/ATC Transponder System .......................................................... 34-2
Weather Radar System...........................................................................34-2 Weather Radar System .......................................................................... 34-2
GPWS System........................................................................................34-2 GPWS System ....................................................................................... 34-2
VOR/ILS System ...................................................................................34-3 VOR/ILS System ................................................................................... 34-3
Marker Beacon System ..........................................................................34-3 Marker Beacon System.......................................................................... 34-3
LRRA System ........................................................................................34-3 LRRA System........................................................................................ 34-3
Pitot/Static Air Data System ..................................................................34-3 Pitot/Static Air Data System.................................................................. 34-3
FMCS.....................................................................................................34-3 FMCS..................................................................................................... 34-3
MAGNETIC STANDBY COMPASS ........................................................34-4 MAGNETIC STANDBY COMPASS ........................................................ 34-4
ELECTRONIC FLIGHT INSTRUMENT SYSTEM ..............................34-6 ELECTRONIC FLIGHT INSTRUMENT SYSTEM .............................. 34-6
Interfaces................................................................................................34-6 Interfaces ............................................................................................... 34-6
Symbol Generators.................................................................................34-6 Symbol Generators ................................................................................ 34-6
EFIS Control Panel ................................................................................34-6 EFIS Control Panel ................................................................................ 34-6
EADI ......................................................................................................34-8 EADI...................................................................................................... 34-8
EHSI.......................................................................................................34-9 EHSI ...................................................................................................... 34-9
Remote Light Sensors ............................................................................34-10 Remote Light Sensors............................................................................ 34-10
EFI Transfer Switch...............................................................................34-10 EFI Transfer Switch............................................................................... 34-10
EFIS Transfer Relay ..............................................................................34-11 EFIS Transfer Relay .............................................................................. 34-11
Instrument Transfer Light ......................................................................34-11 Instrument Transfer Light...................................................................... 34-11
OPERATION ...............................................................................................34-11 OPERATION............................................................................................... 34-11
EXP VOR/ILS Mode .............................................................................34-15 EXP VOR/ILS Mode............................................................................. 34-15
MAP Mode.............................................................................................34-17 MAP Mode ............................................................................................ 34-17
CTR MAP Mode....................................................................................34-19 CTR MAP Mode ................................................................................... 34-19
PLAN Mode...........................................................................................34-21 PLAN Mode .......................................................................................... 34-21
EFI Transfer Switch...............................................................................34-21 EFI Transfer Switch............................................................................... 34-21
EADI and EHSI Maintenance Practices ................................................34-23 EADI and EHSI Maintenance Practices ................................................ 34-23
BITE.......................................................................................................34-23 BITE ...................................................................................................... 34-23
Inflight Faults.........................................................................................34-23 Inflight Faults ........................................................................................ 34-23
Ground Faults.........................................................................................34-23 Ground Faults ........................................................................................ 34-23
Current Status.........................................................................................34-23 Current Status ........................................................................................ 34-23
Discrete Status .......................................................................................34-23 Discrete Status ....................................................................................... 34-23
Self Test .................................................................................................34-23 Self Test ................................................................................................. 34-23
Interface Test .........................................................................................34-23 Interface Test ......................................................................................... 34-23
INERTIAL REFERENCE SYSTEM ........................................................34-25 INERTIAL REFERENCE SYSTEM ........................................................ 34-25
IRU.........................................................................................................34-25 IRU ........................................................................................................ 34-25
Accelerometers ......................................................................................34-25 Accelerometers ...................................................................................... 34-25
Laser Ring Gyro.....................................................................................34-26 Laser Ring Gyro .................................................................................... 34-26

and
OCT 99Systems Introduction 34-i OCT 99 34-i
UNITED
B737 GENERAL AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
TABLE OF CONTENTS TABLE OF CONTENTS

DESCRIPTION & OPERATION continued DESCRIPTION & OPERATION continued


ISDU ...................................................................................................... 34-29 ISDU ...................................................................................................... 34-29
MSU ...................................................................................................... 34-31 MSU ...................................................................................................... 34-31
Master Caution Unit ............................................................................. 34-31 Master Caution Unit ............................................................................. 34-31
DAA....................................................................................................... 34-31 DAA....................................................................................................... 34-31
IRS Transfer Switch .............................................................................. 34-32 IRS Transfer Switch .............................................................................. 34-32
IRS Transfer Relay ................................................................................ 34-32 IRS Transfer Relay ................................................................................ 34-32
Instrument Transfer Light...................................................................... 34-32 Instrument Transfer Light...................................................................... 34-32
VSI ......................................................................................................... 34-32 VSI......................................................................................................... 34-32
RDDMI .................................................................................................. 34-32 RDDMI .................................................................................................. 34-32
OPERATION ............................................................................................... 34-33 OPERATION............................................................................................... 34-33
Align Mode ............................................................................................ 34-33 Align Mode............................................................................................ 34-33
Navigate Mode....................................................................................... 34-33 Navigate Mode....................................................................................... 34-33
Attitude Mode ........................................................................................ 34-33 Attitude Mode........................................................................................ 34-33
OFF Mode.............................................................................................. 34-34 OFF Mode.............................................................................................. 34-34
ALIGN Annunciator Light .................................................................... 34-34 ALIGN Annunciator Light .................................................................... 34-34
ON DC Annunciator Light .................................................................... 34-34 ON DC Annunciator Light .................................................................... 34-34
DC FAIL Annunciator Light ................................................................. 34-34 DC FAIL Annunciator Light ................................................................. 34-34
FAULT Annunciator Light.................................................................... 34-34 FAULT Annunciator Light.................................................................... 34-34
SYS DSPL Switch ................................................................................. 34-34 SYS DSPL Switch ................................................................................. 34-34
DSPL SEL Selector ............................................................................... 34-34 DSPL SEL Selector ............................................................................... 34-34
TEST Position........................................................................................ 34-34 TEST Position........................................................................................ 34-34
TK/GS Position...................................................................................... 34-35 TK/GS Position...................................................................................... 34-35
PPOS Position........................................................................................ 34-35 PPOS Position........................................................................................ 34-35
WIND Position ...................................................................................... 34-35 WIND Position ...................................................................................... 34-35
HDG/STS Position................................................................................. 34-35 HDG/STS Position................................................................................. 34-35
Keypad ................................................................................................... 34-35 Keypad................................................................................................... 34-35
IRS Transfer Switch .............................................................................. 34-35 IRS Transfer Switch .............................................................................. 34-35
IRU Power ............................................................................................. 34-35 IRU Power ............................................................................................. 34-35
Crew Call Horn...................................................................................... 34-35 Crew Call Horn...................................................................................... 34-35
Alignment .............................................................................................. 34-36 Alignment .............................................................................................. 34-36
Alignment Faults ................................................................................... 34-36 Alignment Faults ................................................................................... 34-36
ATT Mode Heading Entry..................................................................... 34-37 ATT Mode Heading Entry..................................................................... 34-37
Present Position Entry............................................................................ 34-37 Present Position Entry............................................................................ 34-37
Maintenance Practices ........................................................................... 34-38 Maintenance Practices ........................................................................... 34-38
BITE ...................................................................................................... 34-38 BITE ...................................................................................................... 34-38
Current Faults ........................................................................................ 34-38 Current Faults ........................................................................................ 34-38
Interface Check ...................................................................................... 34-38 Interface Check...................................................................................... 34-38
Inflight Faults......................................................................................... 34-38 Inflight Faults......................................................................................... 34-38
STANDBY ATITUDE INDICATIR .......................................................... 34-38 STANDBY ATITUDE INDICATIR .......................................................... 34-38
DISTANCE MEASURING EQUIPMENT ............................................... 34-41 DISTANCE MEASURING EQUIPMENT............................................... 34-41
DME Interrogator Unit .......................................................................... 34-41 DME Interrogator Unit .......................................................................... 34-41
NAV Tuning Panel ................................................................................ 34-42 NAV Tuning Panel ................................................................................ 34-42

34-ii and Systems Introduction OCT 99 34-ii OCT 99


UNITED AIRLINES COURSE
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
TABLE OF CONTENTS TABLE OF CONTENTS

DESCRIPTION & OPERATION continued DESCRIPTION & OPERATION continued


Antenna ..................................................................................................34-42 Antenna.................................................................................................. 34-42
RDDMI .................................................................................................34-43 RDDMI ................................................................................................. 34-43
EHSI.......................................................................................................34-43 EHSI ...................................................................................................... 34-43
NCD and Fault Indications ....................................................................34-44 NCD and Fault Indications .................................................................... 34-44
OPERATION ...............................................................................................34-44 OPERATION............................................................................................... 34-44
Auto-Tuning...........................................................................................34-44 Auto-Tuning .......................................................................................... 34-44
Agility Tuning........................................................................................34-44 Agility Tuning ....................................................................................... 34-44
Self Test .................................................................................................34-45 Self Test ................................................................................................. 34-45
AUTOMATIC DIRECTION FINDING SYSTEM .................................34-47 AUTOMATIC DIRECTION FINDING SYSTEM ................................. 34-47
ADF Receiver ........................................................................................34-47 ADF Receiver ........................................................................................ 34-47
Sense Antenna........................................................................................34-47 Sense Antenna ....................................................................................... 34-47
Sense Antenna Coupler..........................................................................34-47 Sense Antenna Coupler ......................................................................... 34-47
Loop Antenna.........................................................................................34-47 Loop Antenna ........................................................................................ 34-47
Quadrantal Error Corrector ....................................................................34-47 Quadrantal Error Corrector.................................................................... 34-47
ADF Control Panel ................................................................................34-48 ADF Control Panel ................................................................................ 34-48
RDDMI Indication .................................................................................34-49 RDDMI Indication................................................................................. 34-49
EHSI Indication .....................................................................................34-49 EHSI Indication ..................................................................................... 34-49
ADF EHSI Bearing Lead Line...............................................................34-49 ADF EHSI Bearing Lead Line .............................................................. 34-49
OPERATION ...............................................................................................34-50 OPERATION............................................................................................... 34-50
Maintenance Practices ...........................................................................34-50 Maintenance Practices ........................................................................... 34-50
Tests .......................................................................................................34-50 Tests....................................................................................................... 34-50
TCAS/AIR TRAFFIC CONTROL TRANSPONDER SYSTEM ..........34-53 TCAS/AIR TRAFFIC CONTROL TRANSPONDER SYSTEM .......... 34-53
TCAS Computer ....................................................................................34-53 TCAS Computer .................................................................................... 34-53
TCAS Directional Antenna....................................................................34-53 TCAS Directional Antenna ................................................................... 34-53
ATC Mode S Transponder.....................................................................34-53 ATC Mode S Transponder .................................................................... 34-53
ATC Antenna .........................................................................................34-53 ATC Antenna......................................................................................... 34-53
TCAS/ATC Control Panel .....................................................................34-54 TCAS/ATC Control Panel..................................................................... 34-54
Fault Indications.....................................................................................34-55 Fault Indications .................................................................................... 34-55
OPERATION ..............................................................................................34-56 OPERATION .............................................................................................. 34-56
Self Test .................................................................................................34-56 Self Test ................................................................................................. 34-56
ATC Transponder Unit BITE ................................................................34-58 ATC Transponder Unit BITE ................................................................ 34-58
TCAS Computer BITE ..........................................................................34-58 TCAS Computer BITE .......................................................................... 34-58
External Test Equipment........................................................................34-58 External Test Equipment ....................................................................... 34-58
WEATHER RADAR SYSTEM .................................................................34-61 WEATHER RADAR SYSTEM ................................................................ 34-61
Receiver/Transmitter Unit .....................................................................34-62 Receiver/Transmitter Unit ..................................................................... 34-62
Antenna Unit..........................................................................................34-62 Antenna Unit.......................................................................................... 34-62
Weather Radar Control Panel ................................................................34-63 Weather Radar Control Panel ................................................................ 34-63
EFIS Control Panel ................................................................................34-64 EFIS Control Panel ................................................................................ 34-64
EHSI Display .........................................................................................34-64 EHSI Display ......................................................................................... 34-64
OPERATION ...............................................................................................34-65 OPERATION............................................................................................... 34-65
Maintenance Practices ...........................................................................34-65 Maintenance Practices ........................................................................... 34-65
Self Test .................................................................................................34-65 Self Test ................................................................................................. 34-65

and
OCT 99Systems Introduction 34-iii OCT 99 34-iii
UNITED
B737 GENERAL AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
TABLE OF CONTENTS TABLE OF CONTENTS

DESCRIPTION & OPERATION continued DESCRIPTION & OPERATION continued


GROUND PROXIMITY WARNING SYSTEM...................................... 34-69 GROUND PROXIMITY WARNING SYSTEM...................................... 34-69
GPWS Computer ................................................................................... 34-70 GPWS Computer ................................................................................... 34-70
PULL UP Warning Lights ..................................................................... 34-70 PULL UP Warning Lights ..................................................................... 34-70
BELOW G/S Warning Light ................................................................. 34-70 BELOW G/S Warning Light ................................................................. 34-70
GPWS Control Module.......................................................................... 34-71 GPWS Control Module.......................................................................... 34-71
Audio Indications................................................................................... 34-71 Audio Indications................................................................................... 34-71
OPERATION ............................................................................................... 34-73 OPERATION............................................................................................... 34-73
Confidence Test ..................................................................................... 34-73 Confidence Test ..................................................................................... 34-73
Full Vocabulary Test ............................................................................. 34-73 Full Vocabulary Test ............................................................................. 34-73
BITE ...................................................................................................... 34-73 BITE ...................................................................................................... 34-73
VOR/ILS SYSTEM ..................................................................................... 34-75 VOR/ILS SYSTEM ..................................................................................... 34-75
NAV Receiver Unit ............................................................................... 34-75 NAV Receiver Unit ............................................................................... 34-75
NAV Control Panel................................................................................ 34-76 NAV Control Panel................................................................................ 34-76
VOR/LOC Antenna ............................................................................... 34-76 VOR/LOC Antenna ............................................................................... 34-76
Glideslope Antenna ............................................................................... 34-77 Glideslope Antenna ............................................................................... 34-77
Localizer Antenna.................................................................................. 34-77 Localizer Antenna.................................................................................. 34-77
ILS Relays ............................................................................................. 34-77 ILS Relays ............................................................................................. 34-77
DFCS Mode Control Panel.................................................................... 34-77 DFCS Mode Control Panel.................................................................... 34-77
EFIS Control Panel ................................................................................ 34-78 EFIS Control Panel ................................................................................ 34-78
EHSI Indication ..................................................................................... 34-78 EHSI Indication ..................................................................................... 34-78
EADI Indication..................................................................................... 34-78 EADI Indication..................................................................................... 34-78
RDDMI Indication................................................................................. 34-78 RDDMI Indication................................................................................. 34-78
OPERATION ............................................................................................... 34-78 OPERATION............................................................................................... 34-78
VOR Self Test........................................................................................ 34-79 VOR Self Test........................................................................................ 34-79
ILS Self Test .......................................................................................... 34-79 ILS Self Test .......................................................................................... 34-79
NAV Tuning Panel ................................................................................ 34-79 NAV Tuning Panel ................................................................................ 34-79
MARKER BEACON SYSTEM ................................................................. 34-81 MARKER BEACON SYSTEM ................................................................. 34-81
Marker Beacon Receiver ....................................................................... 34-81 Marker Beacon Receiver ....................................................................... 34-81
Marker Beacon Light Assemblies ......................................................... 34-81 Marker Beacon Light Assemblies ......................................................... 34-81
Sensitivity Switch .................................................................................. 34-81 Sensitivity Switch .................................................................................. 34-81
Fault Indications .................................................................................... 34-81 Fault Indications .................................................................................... 34-81
OPERATION ............................................................................................... 34-82 OPERATION............................................................................................... 34-82
Maintenance Practices ........................................................................... 34-82 Maintenance Practices ........................................................................... 34-82
Tests....................................................................................................... 34-82 Tests....................................................................................................... 34-82
RADIO ALTIMETER SYSTEM............................................................... 34-85 RADIO ALTIMETER SYSTEM............................................................... 34-85
LRRA Receiver/Transmitter.................................................................. 34-85 LRRA Receiver/Transmitter.................................................................. 34-85
LRRA Antenna ...................................................................................... 34-85 LRRA Antenna ...................................................................................... 34-85
EFIS Control Panel ................................................................................ 34-86 EFIS Control Panel ................................................................................ 34-86
Indications.............................................................................................. 34-86 Indications.............................................................................................. 34-86
OPERATION ............................................................................................... 34-86 OPERATION............................................................................................... 34-86
Maintenance Practices ........................................................................... 34-86 Maintenance Practices ........................................................................... 34-86
Tests....................................................................................................... 34-86 Tests....................................................................................................... 34-86

34-iv and Systems Introduction OCT 99 34-iv OCT 99


UNITED AIRLINES COURSE
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
TABLE OF CONTENTS TABLE OF CONTENTS

DESCRIPTION & OPERATION continued DESCRIPTION & OPERATION continued


AIR DATA SYSTEM ..................................................................................34-89 AIR DATA SYSTEM .................................................................................. 34-89
Digital Air Data Computer.....................................................................34-89 Digital Air Data Computer .................................................................... 34-89
Mach/Airspeed Indicator .......................................................................34-91 Mach/Airspeed Indicator ....................................................................... 34-91
Altimeter ................................................................................................34-91 Altimeter ................................................................................................ 34-91
Temperature Probe.................................................................................34-92 Temperature Probe ................................................................................ 34-92
EADI Indications ...................................................................................34-93 EADI Indications ................................................................................... 34-93
EHSI Indications....................................................................................34-94 EHSI Indications.................................................................................... 34-94
SAT-TAT-TAS Indications ...................................................................34-95 SAT-TAT-TAS Indications ................................................................... 34-95
OPERATION ...............................................................................................34-95 OPERATION............................................................................................... 34-95
Maintenance Practices ...........................................................................34-95 Maintenance Practices ........................................................................... 34-95
BITE.......................................................................................................34-95 BITE ...................................................................................................... 34-95
PITOT/STATIC SYSTEM .........................................................................34-97 PITOT/STATIC SYSTEM ......................................................................... 34-97
Pitot/Static Probes..................................................................................34-98 Pitot/Static Probes.................................................................................. 34-98
Alternate Static Ports .............................................................................34-98 Alternate Static Ports ............................................................................. 34-98
Drain Fittings .........................................................................................34-99 Drain Fittings ......................................................................................... 34-99
Standby Altimeter ..................................................................................34-99 Standby Altimeter.................................................................................. 34-99
Standby Airspeed Indicator....................................................................34-99 Standby Airspeed Indicator ................................................................... 34-99
FLIGHT MANAGEMENT COMPUTER SYSTEM...............................34-101 FLIGHT MANAGEMENT COMPUTER SYSTEM .............................. 34-101
CDU .......................................................................................................34-102 CDU....................................................................................................... 34-102
FMC .......................................................................................................34-102 FMC....................................................................................................... 34-102
Autoflight Status Annunciator ...............................................................34-103 Autoflight Status Annunciator............................................................... 34-103
OPERATION ...............................................................................................34-103 OPERATION............................................................................................... 34-103
Position Updating...................................................................................34-103 Position Updating .................................................................................. 34-103
Auto-tuning ............................................................................................34-103 Auto-tuning............................................................................................ 34-103
Agility tuning .........................................................................................34-103 Agility tuning......................................................................................... 34-103
Maintenance Practices ...........................................................................34-103 Maintenance Practices ........................................................................... 34-103
Database Loading...................................................................................34-103 Database Loading .................................................................................. 34-103
BITE.......................................................................................................34-104 BITE ...................................................................................................... 34-104
Inflt Fault ...............................................................................................34-104 Inflt Fault ............................................................................................... 34-104
CDU Test ...............................................................................................34-104 CDU Test ............................................................................................... 34-104
Discretes.................................................................................................34-104 Discretes ................................................................................................ 34-104
Fixed Outputs.........................................................................................34-104 Fixed Outputs ........................................................................................ 34-104
PERF Factor...........................................................................................34-104 PERF Factor .......................................................................................... 34-104
IRS Monitor ...........................................................................................34-104 IRS Monitor ........................................................................................... 34-104
CONTROLS & INDICATIONS CONTROLS & INDICATIONS
STANDBY ATTITUDE INDICATOR.................................................34-105 STANDBY ATTITUDE INDICATOR................................................. 34-105
STANDBY MAGNETIC COMPASS...................................................34-105 STANDBY MAGNETIC COMPASS................................................... 34-105
RADIO DISTANCE MAGNETIC INDICATOR (RDMI)...................34-106 RADIO DISTANCE MAGNETIC INDICATOR (RDMI)................... 34-106
EFIS CONTROL PANEL......................................................................34-107 EFIS CONTROL PANEL ..................................................................... 34-107
EFIS TRANSFER AND LIGHTING ....................................................34-109 EFIS TRANSFER AND LIGHTING.................................................... 34-109
ELECTRONIC ATTITUDE DIRECTOR INDICATOR (EADI).........34-110 ELECTRONIC ATTITUDE DIRECTOR INDICATOR (EADI) ........ 34-110
ELECTRONIC ATTITUDE DIRECTOR INDICATOR (EADI).........34-111 ELECTRONIC ATTITUDE DIRECTOR INDICATOR (EADI) ........ 34-111

and
OCT 99Systems Introduction 34-v OCT 99 34-v
UNITED
B737 GENERAL AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
TABLE OF CONTENTS TABLE OF CONTENTS

CONTROLS & INDICATIONS continued CONTROLS & INDICATIONS continued


EADI ILS INDICATIONS .................................................................... 34-112 EADI ILS INDICATIONS .................................................................... 34-112
EADI SPEED TAPE DISPLAY............................................................ 34-113 EADI SPEED TAPE DISPLAY............................................................ 34-113
EADI FAILURE FLAGS ...................................................................... 34-115 EADI FAILURE FLAGS ...................................................................... 34-115
EHSI FULL VOR MODE ..................................................................... 34-116 EHSI FULL VOR MODE ..................................................................... 34-116
EHSI FULL ILS MODE........................................................................ 34-117 EHSI FULL ILS MODE........................................................................ 34-117
EHSI EXP VOR MODE........................................................................ 34-118 EHSI EXP VOR MODE........................................................................ 34-118
EHSI EXP ILS MODE .......................................................................... 34-119 EHSI EXP ILS MODE .......................................................................... 34-119
EHSI MAP MODE ................................................................................ 34-120 EHSI MAP MODE ................................................................................ 34-120
EHSI STR MAP MODE........................................................................ 34-121 EHSI STR MAP MODE........................................................................ 34-121
EHSI PLAN MODE .............................................................................. 34-122 EHSI PLAN MODE .............................................................................. 34-122
EHSI FAILURE INDICATIONS AND FLAGS .................................. 34-123 EHSI FAILURE INDICATIONS AND FLAGS .................................. 34-123
EHSI SYMBOLOGY KEY 1................................................................ 34-125 EHSI SYMBOLOGY KEY 1................................................................ 34-125
EHSI SYMBOLOGY KEY 2................................................................ 34-126 EHSI SYMBOLOGY KEY 2................................................................ 34-126
EHSI SYMBOLOGY KEY 3................................................................ 34-127 EHSI SYMBOLOGY KEY 3................................................................ 34-127
EHSI SYMBOLOGY KEY 4................................................................ 34-128 EHSI SYMBOLOGY KEY 4................................................................ 34-128
EHSI SYMBOLOGY KEY 5................................................................ 34-129 EHSI SYMBOLOGY KEY 5................................................................ 34-129
EHSI SYMBOLOGY KEY 6................................................................ 34-130 EHSI SYMBOLOGY KEY 6................................................................ 34-130
INERTIAL SYSTEM DISPLAY UNIT (ISDU)................................... 34-131 INERTIAL SYSTEM DISPLAY UNIT (ISDU)................................... 34-131
IRS MODE SELECTOR UNIT (MSU) ................................................ 34-133 IRS MODE SELECTOR UNIT (MSU) ................................................ 34-133
VHF NAVIGATION TUNING PANEL............................................... 34-136 VHF NAVIGATION TUNING PANEL............................................... 34-136
ADF PANEL ......................................................................................... 34-138 ADF PANEL ......................................................................................... 34-138
MODE S TCAS TRANSPONDER CONTROL PANEL ..................... 34-139 MODE S TCAS TRANSPONDER CONTROL PANEL ..................... 34-139
MODE S TCAS TRANSPONDER CONTROL PANEL ..................... 34-140 MODE S TCAS TRANSPONDER CONTROL PANEL ..................... 34-140
WEATHER RADAR CONTROL PANEL ........................................... 34-141 WEATHER RADAR CONTROL PANEL ........................................... 34-141
GPWS .................................................................................................... 34-142 GPWS .................................................................................................... 34-142
MARKER BEACON............................................................................. 34-144 MARKER BEACON............................................................................. 34-144
STANDBY ALTIMETER..................................................................... 34-145 STANDBY ALTIMETER..................................................................... 34-145
STANDBY AIRSPEED INDICATOR ................................................. 34-145 STANDBY AIRSPEED INDICATOR ................................................. 34-145
MACH/AIRSPEED INDICATOR ........................................................ 34-146 MACH/AIRSPEED INDICATOR ........................................................ 34-146
ALTIMETER......................................................................................... 34-148 ALTIMETER......................................................................................... 34-148
VERTICAL SPEED INDICATOR ....................................................... 34-149 VERTICAL SPEED INDICATOR ....................................................... 34-149
TAT/SAT/TAS INDICATORS ............................................................. 34-149 TAT/SAT/TAS INDICATORS ............................................................. 34-149
MACH/AIRSPEED WARNING TEST PANEL .................................. 34-150 MACH/AIRSPEED WARNING TEST PANEL .................................. 34-150
FLIGHT MANAGEMENT COMPUTER SYSTEM............................ 34-151 FLIGHT MANAGEMENT COMPUTER SYSTEM............................ 34-151
INIT/REF INDEX ................................................................................. 34-155 INIT/REF INDEX ................................................................................. 34-155
IDENT PAGE........................................................................................ 34-156 IDENT PAGE........................................................................................ 34-156
POS INIT PAGE.................................................................................... 34-158 POS INIT PAGE.................................................................................... 34-158
COMPONENT LOCATIONS COMPONENT LOCATIONS
Antenna Locations ................................................................................. 34-160 Antenna Locations ................................................................................. 34-160
Electronic Equipment Racks.................................................................. 34-161 Electronic Equipment Racks.................................................................. 34-161
Pitot Static Components 1 ..................................................................... 34-162 Pitot Static Components 1 ..................................................................... 34-162
Pitot Static Components 2 ..................................................................... 34-163 Pitot Static Components 2 ..................................................................... 34-163

34-vi and Systems Introduction OCT 99 34-vi OCT 99


UNITED AIRLINES COURSE
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

DISTANCE DISTANCE
MEASURING MEASURING
EQUIPMENT EQUIPMENT

VOR/ILS VOR/ILS
NAVIGATION NAVIGATION
TO TO
SYSTEM SYSTEM
GROUND PROXIMITY GROUND PROXIMITY
FLIGHT WARNING SYSTEM FLIGHT WARNING SYSTEM
MANAGEMENT MANAGEMENT
COMPUTER COMPUTER
SYSTEM AUTOMATIC SYSTEM AUTOMATIC
DIRECTION DIRECTION
FINDER FINDER

AIR TRAFFIC PITOT TOTAL AIR AIR TRAFFIC PITOT TOTAL AIR
CONTROL STATIC TEMPERATURE ELECTRONIC CONTROL STATIC TEMPERATURE ELECTRONIC
ATTITUDE ATTITUDE
ELECTRONIC DIRECTOR ELECTRONIC DIRECTOR
FLIGHT INDICATOR FLIGHT INDICATOR
AIR DATA SYSTEM (EADI) AIR DATA SYSTEM (EADI)
INSTRUMENT INSTRUMENT
SYSTEM SYSTEM
GROUND PROXIMITY GROUND PROXIMITY
WARNING SYSTEM WARNING SYSTEM
ELECTRONIC ELECTRONIC
HORIZONTAL HORIZONTAL
LOW RANGE SITUATION LOW RANGE SITUATION
TRAFFIC ALERT TRAFFIC ALERT
RADIO INDICATOR RADIO INDICATOR
& COLLISION & COLLISION
ALTITMETER (EHSI) ALTITMETER (EHSI)
AVOIDANCE AVOIDANCE

INERTIAL INERTIAL
REFERENCE REFERENCE
WEATHER WEATHER
SYSTEM SYSTEM
RADAR RADAR
EXTERNAL EXTERNAL
SYSTEM SYSTEM
INPUTS INPUTS

MARKER MARKER
BEACON BEACON

Navigation Systems Navigation Systems

and
OCT 99 Systems Introduction 34-1 OCT 99 34-1
UNITED
B737 GENERAL AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

NAVIGATION SYSTEMS DME System NAVIGATION SYSTEMS DME System


The navigation systems are a fully inte- The Distance Measuring System (DME) The navigation systems are a fully inte- The Distance Measuring System (DME)
grated digital avionics system. It uses dig- has two systems that provide the flight grated digital avionics system. It uses digi- has two systems that provide the flight
ital and microcomputer technology and crew and Flight Management Computer tal and microcomputer technology and crew and Flight Management Computer
electronic displays to provide the flight (FMC) with distance to specific naviga- electronic displays to provide the flight (FMC) with distance to specific naviga-
crew with full-time performance, naviga- tional aids. It gives the nautical mile dis- crew with full-time performance, naviga- tional aids. It gives the nautical mile dis-
tion, and advisory information. Built In tance in tenths and whole miles. tion, and advisory information. Built In tance in tenths and whole miles.
Test Equipment (BITE)and self tests are ADF System Test Equipment (BITE)and self tests are ADF System
available to aid maintenance personnel The Automatic Direction Finding system available to aid maintenance personnel The Automatic Direction Finding system
troubleshoot and verify system operation. consists of one system for domestic and troubleshoot and verify system operation. consists of one system for domestic and
Components and subsystems are desig- two systems for overwater operations. It Components and subsystems are desig- two systems for overwater operations. It
nated left and right. In most cases the left gives the flight crew bearing information nated left and right. In most cases the left gives the flight crew bearing information
systems support the Captain's instruments to the selected navigational aid and can systems support the Captain's instruments to the selected navigational aid and can
and the right systems support the First provide audio from commercial AM and the right systems support the First provide audio from commercial AM
Officer's, but alternate selection is avail- broadcast stations. Officer's, but alternate selection is avail- broadcast stations.
able for some systems. TCAS/ATC Transponder System able for some systems. TCAS/ATC Transponder System
EFIS System The Traffic Alert and Collision Avoidance EFIS System The Traffic Alert and Collision Avoidance
The Electronic Flight Instrument System System (TCAS) integrates with the Air The Electronic Flight Instrument System System (TCAS) integrates with the Air
(EFIS) consists of a left and right system Traffic Control (ATC) transponder sys- (EFIS) consists of a left and right system Traffic Control (ATC) transponder sys-
that utilize various aircraft systems to pro- tems to provide the flight crew with audio that utilize various aircraft systems to pro- tems to provide the flight crew with audio
vide appropriate visual indications on the and visual indications of conflicting air- vide appropriate visual indications on the and visual indications of conflicting air-
Electronic Attitude Director Indicator craft to avoid mid-air collisions. The ATC Electronic Attitude Director Indicator craft to avoid mid-air collisions. The ATC
(EADI) and Electronic Horizontal Situa- Transponder system consists of two sys- (EADI) and Electronic Horizontal Situa- Transponder system consists of two sys-
tion Indicator (EHSI). The EADI and tems that provides ATC with position, tion Indicator (EHSI). The EADI and tems that provides ATC with position,
EHSI are Cathode Ray Tubes (CRT) that identification and altitude information EHSI are Cathode Ray Tubes (CRT) that identification and altitude information
display navigation, attitude, autopilot, from the aircraft that is depicted on the display navigation, attitude, autopilot, from the aircraft that is depicted on the
autothrottle, and other status information ATC radar screen. autothrottle, and other status information ATC radar screen.
to each pilot. Weather Radar System to each pilot. Weather Radar System
IRS System The Weather Radar System provides the IRS System The Weather Radar System provides the
The Inertial Reference System (IRS) con- flight crew with visual color indications of The Inertial Reference System (IRS) con- flight crew with visual color indications of
sists of a left and right system that contain precipitation ahead of the aircraft to avoid sists of a left and right system that contain precipitation ahead of the aircraft to avoid
laser ring gyros and accelerometers to pro- hazardous weather conditions. The single laser ring gyros and accelerometers to pro- hazardous weather conditions. The single
vide the sole source of aircraft attitude and Weather Radar system also provides tur- vide the sole source of aircraft attitude and Weather Radar system also provides tur-
heading information (except for the bulence detection using Doppler princi- heading information (except for the bulence detection using Doppler princi-
standby instruments). The Standby Atti- ples. standby instruments). The Standby Atti- ples.
tude Indicator (SAI) is covered with the GPWS System tude Indicator (SAI) is covered with the GPWS System
IRS System The single Ground Proximity Warning IRS System The single Ground Proximity Warning
NOTE: The Standby Compass, Standby System (GPWS) provides the flight crew NOTE: The Standby Compass, Standby System (GPWS) provides the flight crew
Attitude Indicator (SAI), and IRS sys- with aural and visual warnings of poten- Attitude Indicator (SAI), and IRS sys- with aural and visual warnings of poten-
tems are entirely independent of each tially dangerous flight situations relative tems are entirely independent of each tially dangerous flight situations relative
other. to the ground and windshear conditions. other. to the ground and windshear conditions.

34-2 and Systems Introduction OCT 99 34-2 OCT 99


UNITED AIRLINES COURSE
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

VOR/ILS System VOR/ILS System


The VHF Omni Range (VOR) and Instru- The VHF Omni Range (VOR) and Instru-
ment Landing System (ILS) consists of ment Landing System (ILS) consists of
two systems that provide the flight crew two systems that provide the flight crew
with information of aircraft position with with information of aircraft position with
respect to and deviation from a selected respect to and deviation from a selected
VOR course and with visual guidance in VOR course and with visual guidance in
azimuth (localizer) and approach path azimuth (localizer) and approach path
(glideslope) for approach to a landing. The (glideslope) for approach to a landing. The
system also provides bearing information system also provides bearing information
to the selected VOR station. The naviga- to the selected VOR station. The naviga-
tion units (NAV Receiver) include VOR tion units (NAV Receiver) include VOR
and Instrument Landing System (ILS) and Instrument Landing System (ILS)
receivers. receivers.
Marker Beacon System Marker Beacon System
The single Marker Beacon System pro- The single Marker Beacon System pro-
vides the flight crew with visual and aural vides the flight crew with visual and aural
indications of passing over navigational indications of passing over navigational
aids associated with an instrument aids associated with an instrument
approach. approach.
LRRA System LRRA System
The Low Range Radio Altimeter (LRRA) The Low Range Radio Altimeter (LRRA)
system consists of two systems that pro- system consists of two systems that pro-
vide the flight crew and other aircraft sys- vide the flight crew and other aircraft sys-
tems with altitude above ground level. tems with altitude above ground level.
Pitot/Static Air Data System Pitot/Static Air Data System
The Pitot/Static Air Data System consists The Pitot/Static Air Data System consists
of two systems that provide the flight crew of two systems that provide the flight crew
and other aircraft systems with air data and other aircraft systems with air data
information. The Standby Altimeter and information. The Standby Altimeter and
Standby Airspeed Indicator are indepen- Standby Airspeed Indicator are indepen-
dent of the main Air Data System. dent of the main Air Data System.
FMCS FMCS
The Flight Management Computer System The Flight Management Computer System
(FMCS) is a single system that provides (FMCS) is a single system that provides
the functions of navigation, lateral guid- the functions of navigation, lateral guid-
ance, vertical guidance, flight planning, ance, vertical guidance, flight planning,
and aircraft performance optimization, and aircraft performance optimization,
this provides the flight crew with flight this provides the flight crew with flight
management and control of the aircraft. management and control of the aircraft.

and
OCT 99 Systems Introduction 34-3 OCT 99 34-3
UNITED
B737 GENERAL AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

MAGNETIC STANDBY COMPASS The magnetic standby compass is installed MAGNETIC STANDBY COMPASS The magnetic standby compass is installed
The magnetic standby compass is a self- forward of the forward overhead panel. At The magnetic standby compass is a self- forward of the forward overhead panel. At
contained unit and indicates the magnetic the bottom of the standby compass under a contained unit and indicates the magnetic the bottom of the standby compass under a
heading of the airplane. It is used prima- cover plate are two compensators labeled heading of the airplane. It is used prima- cover plate are two compensators labeled
rily in cases of emergency when all other N-S and E-W. The purpose of the com- rily in cases of emergency when all other N-S and E-W. The purpose of the com-
heading systems fail. The standby com- pensators is to compensate for magnetic heading systems fail. The standby com- pensators is to compensate for magnetic
pass is a highly sensitive instrument of liq- disturbances in the area of the standby pass is a highly sensitive instrument of liq- disturbances in the area of the standby
uid-filled design. The card assembly, compass. The correction card holder uid-filled design. The card assembly, compass. The correction card holder
which indicates magnetic direction, is illu- mounted below the standby compass holds which indicates magnetic direction, is illu- mounted below the standby compass
minated by a bulb located at the top of the the correction card. minated by a bulb located at the top of the holds the correction card.
compass. The light switch is located near Note: Some aircraft have the compass compass. The light switch is located near Note: Some aircraft have the compass
the compass. mounted on a stowable mount which is the compass. mounted on a stowable mount which is
swung out of view when not in use. swung out of view when not in use.
Note: When reading the compass, be Note: When reading the compass, be
careful not to have magnetic devices careful not to have magnetic devices
near the compass, such as flashlights, near the compass, such as flashlights,
which may cause errors. which may cause errors.

COMPASS COMPASS
CARD CARD
LUBBER LUBBER
LINE LINE
RADIO RECEIVERS ON

RADIO RECEIVERS ON
CARD CARD
HOLDER HOLDER

Magnetic Standby Compass Magnetic Standby Compass

34-4 and Systems Introduction OCT 99 34-4 OCT 99


UNITED AIRLINES COURSE
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

NAV NAV
1 SYSTEM 1 SYSTEM
INPUTS INPUTS
CAPT EADI CAPT EADI

EFIS CONTROL EFIS SYMBOL GEN - EFIS CONTROL EFIS SYMBOL GEN -
PANEL 1 LEFT CAPT EHSI PANEL 1 LEFT CAPT EHSI

CAPT SW ANNUC X-TIE CAPT SW ANNUC X-TIE


BUSSES BUSSES

EFI XFER EFI XFER EFI XFER EFI XFER


SWITCH RELAYS SWITCH RELAYS
F/O SW ANNUC F/O SW ANNUC

F/O EADI F/O EADI


EFIS CONTROL EFIS CONTROL
PANEL 2 PANEL 2

NAV NAV
1 SYSTEM 1 SYSTEM
INPUTS INPUTS

F/O EHSI F/O EHSI


EFIS SYMBOL GEN - EFIS SYMBOL GEN -
RIGHT RIGHT

1 VHF NAV/DME 1 VHF NAV/DME


FLIGHT MANAGEMENT COMPUTER FLIGHT MANAGEMENT COMPUTER
AIR DATA COMPUTER AIR DATA COMPUTER
AUTO THROTTLE AUTO THROTTLE
INERTIAL REFERENCE SYSTEM INERTIAL REFERENCE SYSTEM
DIGITAL FLIGHT CONTROL SYSTEM DIGITAL FLIGHT CONTROL SYSTEM
STALL WARNING COMPUTER STALL WARNING COMPUTER
AUTOMATIC DIRECTION FINDER AUTOMATIC DIRECTION FINDER
WEATHER RADAR WEATHER RADAR
RADIO ALTITMETER RADIO ALTITMETER
GROUND PROXIMITY WARNING SYSTEM GROUND PROXIMITY WARNING SYSTEM
TCAS TCAS

EFIS System EFIS System

and
OCT 99 Systems Introduction 34-5 OCT 99 34-5
UNITED
B737 GENERAL AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

ELECTRONIC FLIGHT INSTRU- Symbol Generators ELECTRONIC FLIGHT INSTRU- Symbol Generators
MENT SYSTEM The left and right Symbol Generators (SG) MENT SYSTEM The left and right Symbol Generators
The Electronic Flight Instrument System receive data from the EFIS Control Panels The Electronic Flight Instrument System (SG) receive data from the EFIS Control
(EFIS) provides displays for most of the and the aircraft's navigation and guidance (EFIS) provides displays for most of the Panels and the aircraft's navigation and
aircraft's navigational systems. The major systems. The SG then processes the data aircraft's navigational systems. The major guidance systems. The SG then processes
displays provided by the EFIS are: color and provides video signals for display on displays provided by the EFIS are: color the data and provides video signals for
displays of pitch and roll; navigational the EADI and EHSI. The SGs are located displays of pitch and roll; navigational display on the EADI and EHSI. The SGs
maps; weather; radio altitude and decision on the E2-1 rack and have a TEST switch maps; weather; radio altitude and decision are located on the E2-1 rack and have a
height; and autopilot, autothrottle and on the front of the unit. The TEST switch height; and autopilot, autothrottle and TEST switch on the front of the unit. The
flight path information. EFIS also pro- initiates a self test of the EFIS, this test flight path information. EFIS also pro- TEST switch initiates a self test of the
vides displays of: airspeeds, ADF/VOR can also be initiated from the Control Dis- vides displays of: airspeeds, ADF/VOR EFIS, this test can also be initiated from
bearings; ILS data; stall warning; TCAS; play Units (CDU). bearings; ILS data; stall warning; TCAS; the Control Display Units (CDU).
and other indications. EFIS Control Panel and other indications. EFIS Control Panel
EFIS consists of the following compo- The EFIS Control Panels provide control EFIS consists of the following compo- The EFIS Control Panels provide control
nents: two Symbol Generators (SG), two of the displays of their respective onside nents: two Symbol Generators (SG), two of the displays of their respective onside
EFIS Control Panels, two Electronic Atti- EADI and EHSI. They are located on the EFIS Control Panels, two Electronic Atti- EADI and EHSI. They are located on the
tude Director Indicators (EADI), two outboard sides of the pedestal aft elec- tude Director Indicators (EADI), two outboard sides of the pedestal aft elec-
Electronic Horizontal Situation Indicators tronic panel. The EADI controls are on the Electronic Horizontal Situation Indicators tronic panel. The EADI controls are on the
(EHSI), two remote light sensors, an Elec- left side of the panel. The EHSI controls (EHSI), two remote light sensors, an Elec- left side of the panel. The EHSI controls
tronic Flight Instrument (EFI) transfer are on the right side of the panel. tronic Flight Instrument (EFI) transfer are on the right side of the panel.
switch, two EFIS transfer relays, and two The EADI controls are the BRT control switch, two EFIS transfer relays, and two The EADI controls are the BRT control
instrument transfer annunciator lights. which changes the brightness level of the instrument transfer annunciator lights. which changes the brightness level of the
Interfaces EADI. The RST button manually resets Interfaces EADI. The RST button manually resets
EFIS interfaces with the following sys- the decision height circuit. The decision EFIS interfaces with the following sys- the decision height circuit. The decision
tems: Inertial Reference System (IRS), height control knob adjusts the decision tems: Inertial Reference System (IRS), height control knob adjusts the decision
Flight Management Computer System height displayed above it and on the Flight Management Computer System height displayed above it and on the
(FMCS), Weather Radar System, VOR/ respective EADI. (FMCS), Weather Radar System, VOR/ respective EADI.
ILS Navigation System, DME System, The EHSI controls are the Mode Selector ILS Navigation System, DME System, Air The EHSI controls are the Mode Selector
Air Data System, Stall Warning System, which selects the type of display depicted Data System, Stall Warning System, which selects the type of display depicted
LRRA System, Digital Flight Control on the EHSI. The modes are labeled; LRRA System, Digital Flight Control Sys- on the EHSI. The modes are labeled;
System (DFCS), Autothrottle System, FULL VOR/ILS, EXP VOR/ILS, MAP, tem (DFCS), Autothrottle System, ADF FULL VOR/ILS, EXP VOR/ILS, MAP,
ADF System, GPWS, and TCAS systems. CTR MAP, and PLAN. The Range Selec- System, GPWS, and TCAS systems. CTR MAP, and PLAN. The Range Selec-
tor selects the range of information tor selects the range of information
depicted in the EXP VOR/ILS, MAP, depicted in the EXP VOR/ILS, MAP,
CTR MAP, and PLAN modes. In the cen- CTR MAP, and PLAN modes. In the cen-
ter of the Range Selector is the TFC button ter of the Range Selector is the TFC but-
for depicting TCAS traffic targets on the ton for depicting TCAS traffic targets on
EHSI. The WXR Switch is a push-on- the EHSI. The WXR Switch is a push-on-
push-off button that controls the weather push-off button that controls the weather
radar system and depictions in the EXP radar system and depictions in the EXP
VOR/ILS, MAP, CTR MAP modes. VOR/ILS, MAP, CTR MAP modes.

34-6 and Systems Introduction OCT 99 34-6 OCT 99


UNITED AIRLINES COURSE
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

CAUTION: Both WXR Switches on There are two concentric brightness CAUTION: Both WXR Switches on There are two concentric brightness
each EFIS Control Panel must be off to knobs, the outer knob is for adjusting the each EFIS Control Panel must be off to knobs, the outer knob is for adjusting the
turn off the weather radar system. brightness of the entire EHSI, the inner turn off the weather radar system. brightness of the entire EHSI, the inner
CAUTION: The weather radar system knob is for adjusting the brightness of the CAUTION: The weather radar system knob is for adjusting the brightness of the
must not be operated with large metal- weather radar returns. The switches on the must not be operated with large metal- weather radar returns. The switches on the
lic objects near the front of the aircraft. bottom of the EFIS Control Panel are lic objects near the front of the aircraft. bottom of the EFIS Control Panel are
WARNING: The weather radar system push-on-push-off switches for selecting WARNING: The weather radar system push-on-push-off switches for selecting
must not be operated when personnel information depicted on the EHSI. must not be operated when personnel information depicted on the EHSI.
are located within 50 feet of the antenna are located within 50 feet of the antenna
or fueling operations are being per- or fueling operations are being per-
formed. formed.

HSI ADI HSI RANGE


ADI RANGE FULL EXP
DH REF
FULL EXP DH REF VOR/ILS VOR/ILS 160 320
VOR/ILS VOR/ILS 160 320 80
80
40 MAP 40
MAP
20 C
20 TF
C CTR TF
CTR 10
MAP 10 MAP
BRT BRT PLAN WXR
PLAN WXR

ON ON
RST RST
MAP MAP
BRT BRT VOR/ADF NAV AID ARPT RTE DATA WPT
VOR/ADF NAV AID ARPT RTE DATA WPT

ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON

EFIS Control Panel EFIS Control Panel

and
OCT 99 Systems Introduction 34-7 OCT 99 34-7
UNITED
B737 GENERAL AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

EADI There is an integral light sensor on the EADI There is an integral light sensor on the
The Electronic Attitude Director Indicator face of the EADI. The Electronic Attitude Director Indicator face of the EADI.
(EADI) provides multi-color displays of There is only one mode of display on the (EADI) provides multi-color displays of There is only one mode of display on the
aircraft attitude, flight director commands, EADI. aircraft attitude, flight director commands, EADI.
autopilot/autothrottle mode annunciation, The equipment cooling system provides autopilot/autothrottle mode annunciation, The equipment cooling system provides
radio altitude and decision height values, air flow to the EADI to prevent overheat- radio altitude and decision height values, air flow to the EADI to prevent overheat-
speed tape displays, ILS indications, pitch ing. speed tape displays, ILS indications, pitch ing.
limits, GPWS, and TCAS annunciations. NOTE: The EADI is not interchange- limits, GPWS, and TCAS annunciations. NOTE: The EADI is not interchange-
The EADI is a Cathode Ray Tube (CRT) able with the EHSI and is ESD sensi- The EADI is a Cathode Ray Tube (CRT) able with the EHSI and is ESD sensi-
with an inclinometer on the bottom of the tive. with an inclinometer on the bottom of the tive.
face. face.

MCP SPD G/S VOR/LOC CMD MCP SPD G/S VOR/LOC CMD

20 20
180 20 180 20

160 10 160 10
10 10
1 1
140 140
9 9
R R

120 120
10 10
10 10
100 DH200 100 DH200
1700 1700

EADI EADI

34-8 and Systems Introduction OCT 99 34-8 OCT 99


UNITED AIRLINES COURSE
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

EHSI There is an integral light sensor on the EHSI There is an integral light sensor on the
The Electronic Horizontal Situation Indi- face of the EHSI. The Electronic Horizontal Situation Indi- face of the EHSI.
cator (EHSI) provides multi-color of vari- There are several types of displays on the cator (EHSI) provides multi-color of vari- There are several types of displays on the
ous navigational, weather data, and TCAS EHSI depending on the selection on the ous navigational, weather data, and TCAS EHSI depending on the selection on the
targets. The principle systems that provide EFIS Control Panel. targets. The principle systems that provide EFIS Control Panel.
data for display on the EHSI include: The equipment cooling system provides data for display on the EHSI include: The equipment cooling system provides
VOR/ILS, DME, Air Data Computer air flow to the EHSI to prevent overheat- VOR/ILS, DME, Air Data Computer air flow to the EHSI to prevent overheat-
(ADC), FMCS, IRS, Weather Radar, ing. (ADC), FMCS, IRS, Weather Radar, ing.
ADF, and TCAS. NOTE: The EHSI is not interchange- ADF, and TCAS. NOTE: The EHSI is not interchange-
able with the EADI and is ESD sensi- able with the EADI and is ESD sensi-
tive. tive.

25.5 NM TRK 136 M


1335.4Z 25.5 NM TRK 136 M
1335.4Z
TAS300 GS290 TAS300 GS290

15 15
12 12
ABCDE ABCDE
10000 10000
14022 14022

ABC FGHIJ ABC FGHIJ


24000 24000
40 15382 40 15382

KLMNO KLMNO
DEF 35000 DEF 35000
13352 13352

NOP NOP

HIJ HIJ

117˚/20 117˚/20
ILS 1 ILS 1
2580 2580

EHSI EHSI

and
OCT 99 Systems Introduction 34-9 OCT 99 34-9
UNITED
B737 GENERAL AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

Remote Light Sensors EFI Transfer Switch Remote Light Sensors EFI Transfer Switch
The remote light sensors are located on The Electronic Flight Instrument (EFI) The remote light sensors are located on the The Electronic Flight Instrument (EFI)
the glareshield and are facing forward to Transfer Switch is located on the left side glareshield and are facing forward to sense Transfer Switch is located on the left side
sense the ambient light entering the flight of the P-5 Overhead Panel. It is used for the ambient light entering the flight com- of the P-5 Overhead Panel. It is used for
compartment to automatically dim or switching the SG providing data to the partment to automatically dim or brighten switching the SG providing data to the
brighten the EADI and EHSI displays. EADIs and EHSIs. The switch has three the EADI and EHSI displays. The EADI EADIs and EHSIs. The switch has three
The EADI and EHSI also have integral positions, the center position is labeled and EHSI also have integral light sensors positions, the center position is labeled
light sensors located on their face. NORMAL where it is normally posi- located on their face. NORMAL where it is normally posi-
NOTE: Placing an object over a remote tioned. In this position the left SG pro- NOTE: Placing an object over a remote tioned. In this position the left SG pro-
light sensor can cause the onside EADI vides data to the Captain's EADI and light sensor can cause the onside EADI vides data to the Captain's EADI and
and EHSI to dim slightly. EHSI and the right SG provides data to the and EHSI to dim slightly. EHSI and the right SG provides data to the
First Officer's EADI and EHSI. The other First Officer's EADI and EHSI. The other
positions are the BOTH ON 1 and BOTH positions are the BOTH ON 1 and BOTH
ON 2. These positions are used by the ON 2. These positions are used by the
flight crew in the event of a SG failure. flight crew in the event of a SG failure.
Maintenance personnel can use this switch Maintenance personnel can use this switch
for troubleshooting. for troubleshooting.

EFI EFI
BOTH BOTH BOTH BOTH
ON 1 ON 2 ON 1 ON 2
Remote Light Sensor Remote Light Sensor
NORMAL NORMAL

INSTR INSTR
SWITCH SWITCH
ALTITUDE ALTITUDE
ALERT ALERT

EFI Transfer Switch and INSTR EFI Transfer Switch and INSTR
Switch Light Switch Light

34-10 and Systems Introduction OCT 99 34-10 OCT 99


UNITED AIRLINES COURSE
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

EFIS Transfer Relay OPERATION EFIS Transfer Relay OPERATION


The EFIS Transfer Relays are located in The primary EFIS components used to The EFIS Transfer Relays are located in The primary EFIS components used to
the E1 rack, each one is separately ener- operate the system are the EFI Transfer the E1 rack, each one is separately ener- operate the system are the EFI Transfer
gized when the EFI Transfer Switch is Switch and the EFIS Control Panel. Dur- gized when the EFI Transfer Switch is Switch and the EFIS Control Panel. Dur-
moved from the NORMAL position. ing normal operations the EFI Transfer moved from the NORMAL position. ing normal operations the EFI Transfer
Instrument Transfer Light Switch is in the NORMAL position. The Instrument Transfer Light Switch is in the NORMAL position. The
The Instrument Transfer Light is located left SG will provide the Captain's EADI The Instrument Transfer Light is located left SG will provide the Captain's EADI
to the right of each EADI. They illuminate and EHSI with video signals and the right to the right of each EADI. They illuminate and EHSI with video signals and the right
amber when the EFI Transfer Switch is SG will provide the First Officer's EADI amber when the EFI Transfer Switch is SG will provide the First Officer's EADI
not in the NORMAL position. and EHSI with video signals. The left not in the NORMAL position. and EHSI with video signals. The left
NOTE: The Instrument Transfer Light EFIS Control Panel controls the left SG NOTE: The Instrument Transfer Light EFIS Control Panel controls the left SG
also illuminates if the IRS Transfer and the depictions on the Captain's EADI also illuminates if the IRS Transfer and the depictions on the Captain's EADI
switch is not in the NORMAL position. and EHSI. The right EFIS Control Panel switch is not in the NORMAL position. and EHSI. The right EFIS Control Panel
controls the right SG and the depictions on controls the right SG and the depictions on
the First Officer's EADI and EHSI. Most the First Officer's EADI and EHSI. Most
of the data provided to the left SG come of the data provided to the left SG come
from the left or No. 1 systems and the from the left or No. 1 systems and the
right or No. 2 systems provide data to the right or No. 2 systems provide data to the
right symbol generator. Those systems right symbol generator. Those systems
that only have a single system usually that only have a single system usually
send data to both SGs. send data to both SGs.
The EFIS Control Panel controls the The EFIS Control Panel controls the
depictions on the onside EADI and EHSI. depictions on the onside EADI and EHSI.
The EHSI can be in one of five selectable The EHSI can be in one of five selectable
modes. The flight crew refers to the FULL modes. The flight crew refers to the FULL
and EXP VOR/ILS modes as Heading-Up and EXP VOR/ILS modes as Heading-Up
Displays and the MAP, CTR MAP, and Displays and the MAP, CTR MAP, and
PLAN modes as Track-Up Displays. PLAN modes as Track-Up Displays.

and
OCT 99 Systems Introduction 34-11 OCT 99 34-11
UNITED
B737 GENERAL AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

DME 13.5 DME 13.5


GS140 TAS 148 GS140
TAS 148
HDG 127 M HDG 127 M

12 15 12 15
9 9

18
18

6
6

21
21

3
3

24
24

0
0

27 33 27
33 30
30

117˚/20 117˚/20
ILS 1 110.10 ILS 1 110.10

FULL VOR/ILS Mode FULL VOR/ILS Mode

34-12 and Systems Introduction OCT 99 34-12 OCT 99


UNITED AIRLINES COURSE
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

The FULL VOR/ILS mode provides a value. In the upper right hand corner is the The FULL VOR/ILS mode provides a value. In the upper right hand corner is the
depiction similar to a mechanical HSI. A Ground Speed (GS) value. The lower left depiction similar to a mechanical HSI. A Ground Speed (GS) value. The lower left
full compass rose is shown with the air- corner contains a depiction and value for full compass rose is shown with the air- corner contains a depiction and value for
craft magnetic heading at the top of the the wind direction and speed. In the lower craft magnetic heading at the top of the the wind direction and speed. In the lower
screen and the actual numerical value right corner is the VOR/ILS frequency. screen and the actual numerical value right corner is the VOR/ILS frequency.
shown. Heading information is from the NOTE: TCAS targets and weather shown. Heading information is from the NOTE: TCAS targets and weather
onside IRS. Inside of the compass rose is returns are not able to be depicted in onside IRS. Inside of the compass rose is returns are not able to be depicted in
the typical HSI depiction of the course this mode. the typical HSI depiction of the course this mode.
select cursor, deviation bar, to-from NOTE: The range switch and map select cursor, deviation bar, to-from NOTE: The range switch and map
arrow, and heading select cursor. In the switches have no effect on this display's arrow, and heading select cursor. In the switches have no effect on this display's
upper left corner of the screen appear the operation. upper left corner of the screen appear the operation.
DME distance and True Air Speed (TAS) DME distance and True Air Speed (TAS)

and
OCT 99 Systems Introduction 34-13 OCT 99 34-13
UNITED
B737 GENERAL AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

DME 13.5 HDG 127 M DME 13.5 HDG 127 M


GS140 GS140
TAS 148 TAS 148

15 15
12 12

+10 +10

117˚/20 117˚/20
ILS 1 110.10 ILS 1 110.10

EXP VOR/ILS Mode EXP VOR/ILS Mode

34-14 and Systems Introduction OCT 99 34-14 OCT 99


UNITED AIRLINES COURSE
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

EXP VOR/ILS Mode EXP VOR/ILS Mode


The EXPanded VOR/ILS Mode provides The EXPanded VOR/ILS Mode provides
a depiction resembling the FULL VOR/ a depiction resembling the FULL VOR/
ILS mode but with only the top 70 degrees ILS mode but with only the top 70 degrees
of the compass rose is shown. This display of the compass rose is shown. This display
is used to have the option of displaying the is used to have the option of displaying the
weather radar returns and TCAS targets. weather radar returns and TCAS targets.
The range select switch is used to select The range select switch is used to select
the range of viewing weather radar returns the range of viewing weather radar returns
and TCAS targets. and TCAS targets.
NOTE: The map switches have no effect NOTE: The map switches have no effect
on the operation in this mode. on the operation in this mode.

and
OCT 99 Systems Introduction 34-15 OCT 99 34-15
UNITED
B737 GENERAL AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

25.5 NM TRK 136 M


1335.4Z 25.5 NM TRK 136 M
1335.4Z
TAS300 GS290 TAS300 GS290

15 15
12 12
ABCDE ABCDE
10000 10000
14022 14022

ABC FGHIJ FGHIJ


24000 ABC
40 24000
15382 40 15382

KLMNO KLMNO
DEF 35000 DEF 35000
13352 13352

NOP NOP

HIJ HIJ

117˚/20 117˚/20
ILS 1 ILS 1
2580 2580

EHSI Map Mode EHSI Map Mode

34-16 and Systems Introduction OCT 99 34-16 OCT 99


UNITED AIRLINES COURSE
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

MAP Mode NOTE: A usable station must be MAP Mode NOTE: A usable station must be
The MAP mode provides information selected and valid data received for the The MAP mode provides information selected and valid data received for the
from the FMC to be depicted on the EHSI. associated vector to appear. from the FMC to be depicted on the EHSI. associated vector to appear.
Weather radar returns and TCAS targets The NAV AID switch is used for display- Weather radar returns and TCAS targets The NAV AID switch is used for display-
can be depicted in this mode. The display ing high altitude navigational displays in can be depicted in this mode. The display ing high altitude navigational displays in
shows the top 70 degrees of a compass the 80, 160, or 320 nm ranges and all nav- shows the top 70 degrees of a compass the 80, 160, or 320 nm ranges and all nav-
arc. The value at the top of the compass igational aids are shown with the lower arc. The value at the top of the compass igational aids are shown with the lower
arc represents the magnetic track of the ranges selected. This information is stored arc represents the magnetic track of the ranges selected. This information is stored
aircraft from the FMC. At the bottom of in the FMC data base. The ARPT switch is aircraft from the FMC. At the bottom of in the FMC data base. The ARPT switch is
the display is a triangle representing the used for displaying airport symbols stored the display is a triangle representing the used for displaying airport symbols stored
aircraft's position. The information pro- in the FMC data base. The RTE DATA is aircraft's position. The information pro- in the FMC data base. The RTE DATA is
vided on the display is dynamic, so it used for displaying route data with active vided on the display is dynamic, so it used for displaying route data with active
moves in relation the aircraft's position. waypoints and any altitude constraints. moves in relation the aircraft's position. waypoints and any altitude constraints.
To select information depicted on the dis- The WPT switch is used for displaying To select information depicted on the dis- The WPT switch is used for displaying
play there are five map switches on the waypoints stored in the FMC data base. play there are five map switches on the waypoints stored in the FMC data base.
bottom of the EFIS Control Panel. They NOTE: The range must be 40 nm or less bottom of the EFIS Control Panel. They NOTE: The range must be 40 nm or less
are push-on-push-off switches that illumi- for displaying non-active waypoints. are push-on-push-off switches that illumi- for displaying non-active waypoints.
nate ON when active. nate ON when active.
The VOR/ADF switch is used for display- The VOR/ADF switch is used for display-
ing vectors to VOR-1, VOR-2, ADF-1, or ing vectors to VOR-1, VOR-2, ADF-1, or
ADF-2. ADF-2.

and
OCT 99 Systems Introduction 34-17 OCT 99 34-17
UNITED
B737 GENERAL AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

25.5 NM TRK 136 M


1335.4Z 25.5 NM TRK 136 M
1335.4Z
TAS300 GS290 TAS300 GS290

15 15
12 12
18 18
40 40
KLM KLM
KLMNO KLMNO
9

9
35000 35000
13352 13352
DEF DEF

HIJ HIJ

XYZ VWXYZ XYZ VWXYZ

QRS 2580 QRS 2580


117˚/20 117˚/20

EHSI Center Map Mode EHSI Center Map Mode

34-18 and Systems Introduction OCT 99 34-18 OCT 99


UNITED AIRLINES COURSE
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

CTR MAP Mode CTR MAP Mode


The CTR (center) MAP mode is similar to The CTR (center) MAP mode is similar to
the MAP mode. The difference is that the the MAP mode. The difference is that the
symbolic airplane symbol is placed near symbolic airplane symbol is placed near
the center of the display which allows the the center of the display which allows the
flight crew to see TCAS targets and other flight crew to see TCAS targets and other
depicted information behind the aircraft. depicted information behind the aircraft.

and
OCT 99 Systems Introduction 34-19 OCT 99 34-19
UNITED
B737 GENERAL AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

25.5 NM TRK 136 M


1335.4Z 25.5 NM TRK 136 M
1335.4Z
TAS300 GS290 TAS300 GS290

15 15
12 12

ABCD ABCD

32R 32R
EFGH N EFGH N

JKL JKL

XYZ XYZ

ABC ABC

EHSI PLAN Mode EHSI PLAN Mode

34-20 and Systems Introduction OCT 99 34-20 OCT 99


UNITED AIRLINES COURSE
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

PLAN Mode EFI Transfer Switch PLAN Mode EFI Transfer Switch
The PLAN mode is used by the flight crew The EFI Transfer Switch controls the The PLAN mode is used by the flight crew The EFI Transfer Switch controls the
to view the entered FMCS flight plan. The EFIS Transfer Relays. There is a separate to view the entered FMCS flight plan. The EFIS Transfer Relays. There is a separate
top portion of the display is similar to the relay for BOTH ON 1 and BOTH ON 2 top portion of the display is similar to the relay for BOTH ON 1 and BOTH ON 2
MAP mode but the remainder of the dis- positions of the EFI Transfer Switch. In MAP mode but the remainder of the dis- positions of the EFI Transfer Switch. In
play is used to show a north-up depiction the NORMAL position the left and right play is used to show a north-up depiction the NORMAL position the left and right
of the entered flight plan. SG provide video signals to their onside of the entered flight plan. SG provide video signals to their onside
NOTE: TCAS targets and weather EADI and EHSI. In the event of a SG fail- NOTE: TCAS targets and weather EADI and EHSI. In the event of a SG fail-
radar returns are not depicted in the ure the flight crew can move the switch to radar returns are not depicted in the ure the flight crew can move the switch to
PLAN mode. the operational SG to provide signals to PLAN mode. the operational SG to provide signals to
both EADIs and EHSIs. When the switch both EADIs and EHSIs. When the switch
is placed to the BOTH ON 1 position, the is placed to the BOTH ON 1 position, the
left SG is providing data to both EADIs left SG is providing data to both EADIs
and EHSIs. When the switch is placed to and EHSIs. When the switch is placed to
the BOTH ON 2 position, the right SG is the BOTH ON 2 position, the right SG is
providing data to both EADIs and EHSIs. providing data to both EADIs and EHSIs.
When the EFI Transfer Switch is out of When the EFI Transfer Switch is out of
the NORMAL position both EFIS Instru- the NORMAL position both EFIS Instru-
ment Transfer Lights should be illumi- ment Transfer Lights should be illumi-
nated. Also, the EFIS Control Panel on the nated. Also, the EFIS Control Panel on the
selected side SG will control both EADIs selected side SG will control both EADIs
and EHSIs, the other EFIS Control Panel and EHSIs, the other EFIS Control Panel
will not be able to control any of the dis- will not be able to control any of the dis-
plays. plays.
Note: The BRT will still control the Note: The BRT will still control the
onside CRT brightness onside CRT brightness

and
OCT 99 Systems Introduction 34-21 OCT 99 34-21
UNITED
B737 GENERAL AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

COOLING SCREENS HINGED COOLING SCREENS HINGED


OUTLET MOUNTING OUTLET MOUNTING
INLET INLET
ASSEMBLY ASSEMBLY

HANDLE HANDLE

REMOVE/INSTALL REMOVE/INSTALL
POSITION POSITION

ELECTRICAL ELECTRICAL
CONNECTOR CONNECTOR
EADI BACK VIEW EADI SIDE VIEW EADI BACK VIEW EADI SIDE VIEW

HINGED HINGED
MOUNTING MESSAGE MOUNTING MESSAGE
ASSEMBLY FASTENING ATTITUDE ASSEMBLY FASTENING ATTITUDE
(TYP) (TYP)
SCREW BALL SCREW BALL
(STROKE) (STROKE)
(RASTER) (RASTER)
HINGED HINGED
FASTENING MOUNTING FASTENING MOUNTING
SCREW ASSEMBLY SCREW ASSEMBLY
WEATHER WEATHER
(RASTER) (RASTER)
COLOR COLOR
CRT CRT

SYMBOL LOCAL SYMBOL LOCAL


(STROKE) LIGHT (STROKE) LIGHT
SENSOR SENSOR
DH200 DH200

EADI EADI

EHSI INCLINOMETER EHSI INCLINOMETER

FRONT VIEW FRONT VIEW

EFIS EADI & EHSI Handles and Screen EFIS EADI & EHSI Handles and Screen

34-22 and Systems Introduction OCT 99 34-22 OCT 99


UNITED AIRLINES COURSE
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

EADI and EHSI Maintenance Practices Inflight Faults EADI and EHSI Maintenance Practices Inflight Faults
The EADI and EHSI have a handle built in This display shows the applicable LRU The EADI and EHSI have a handle built in This display shows the applicable LRU
the front of the unit. There are two quick failure that the EFIS system recorded for the front of the unit. There are two quick failure that the EFIS system recorded for
release screws securing the handle. The the last nine flights. release screws securing the handle. The the last nine flights.
handle is used to assist in the removal and Ground Faults handle is used to assist in the removal and Ground Faults
installation of the CRTs and secures the This display shows the applicable LRU installation of the CRTs and secures the This display shows the applicable LRU
CRT when it is installed. failures found by the EFIS system since CRT when it is installed. failures found by the EFIS system since
NOTE: The CRTs are 14 inch long the last landing. NOTE: The CRTs are 14 inch long the last landing.
units, carefully remove them from the Current Status units, carefully remove them from the Current Status
instrument panel. Shows the current status of applicable instrument panel. Shows the current status of applicable
WARNING: The control column may LRUs found by the EFIS system. Can be WARNING: The control column may LRUs found by the EFIS system. Can be
need to be moved when removing or either, OK, FAIL, or TEST. need to be moved when removing or either, OK, FAIL, or TEST.
replacing a CRT. Discrete Status replacing a CRT. Discrete Status
CAUTION: To prevent damage to the Shows status of analog discrete inputs to CAUTION: To prevent damage to the Shows status of analog discrete inputs to
anti-glare coating on the CRTs, use the the EFIS system. anti-glare coating on the CRTs, use the the EFIS system.
proper cloth and cleaning fluid. After Self Test proper cloth and cleaning fluid. After Self Test
removing a CRT check for damaged Shows various test displays for the EADI removing a CRT check for damaged Shows various test displays for the EADI
electrical pins on the CRT and in the and EHSI, and the different EHSI modes. electrical pins on the CRT and in the and EHSI, and the different EHSI modes.
panel. NOTE: The test displays will only panel. NOTE: The test displays will only
CAUTION: The EADIs and EHSIs are appear on the selected side CRTs. CAUTION: The EADIs and EHSIs are appear on the selected side CRTs.
ESD sensitive units Also, check for Interface Test ESD sensitive units Also, check for Interface Test
clean and clear equipment cooling Shows glideslope deviation scale on EADI clean and clear equipment cooling Shows glideslope deviation scale on EADI
ports. and EHSI if proper ILS frequency is ports. and EHSI if proper ILS frequency is
BITE selected on NAV Tuning Panel. BITE selected on NAV Tuning Panel.
Access to EFIS BITE is accomplished Access to EFIS BITE is accomplished
through the Flight Management Computer through the Flight Management Computer
(FMC) by using the CDUs. To perform (FMC) by using the CDUs. To perform
the BITE access the MAINT BITE the BITE access the MAINT BITE
INDEX page, select EFIS, then select the INDEX page, select EFIS, then select the
LEFT or RIGHT systems to be tested. The LEFT or RIGHT systems to be tested. The
SELF TEST and INTERFACE TEST can SELF TEST and INTERFACE TEST can
also be selected. When a system BITE is also be selected. When a system BITE is
done the following selections can be done the following selections can be
made; INFLIGHT FAULTS, GROUND made; INFLIGHT FAULTS, GROUND
FAULTS, CURRENT STATUS, and DIS- FAULTS, CURRENT STATUS, and DIS-
CRETE STATUS. CRETE STATUS.

and
OCT 99 Systems Introduction 34-23 OCT 99 34-23
STALL WARNING

34-24
SYSTEM - 1

GROUND PROXIMITY
WARNING COMPUTER
NAVIGATION

LEFT IRU

AIR DATA FLIGHT MANAGE-


COMPUTER - 1 MENT COMPUTER
IRS DISPLAY
FLIGHT CONTROL
COMPUTER A
YAW DAMPER
DSPL SEL
PPOS WIND 1 N 3
COMPUTER
TK/GS HDG/STS 2
TEST B RT W H E
FLIGHT CONTROL
4 5 6 COMPUTER B
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

SYS DSPL 7 S 9
B737 GENERAL

L R 8
ENT CLR
IRS

and Systems Introduction


0
TRANSFER AUTOTHROTTLE
SWITCH COMPUTER
INERTIAL SYSTEM
UNITED

DISPLAY UNIT DIGITAL FLIGHT


(ISDU) LEFT DIGITAL ANALOG DATA RECORDER
FLIGHT MANAGEMENT RDDMI-1
ADAPTER (DAA)

IRS System
COMPUTER DISPLAY UNIT VHF NAV-1
R WEATHER RADAR
E RECEIVER
L TRANSMITTER
AIRLINES

A
Y EFIS - 1
ALIGN ON DC ALIGN ON DC
RDDMI-2
FAMILIARIZATION

FAULT DC FAIL FAULT DC FAIL


VHF NAV-2 EFIS - 2
B737-322/522

ALIGN NAV ALIGN NAV


OFF ATT OFF ATT
CAPT'S VERTICAL
SPEED INDICATOR
L IRS R

MODE SELECT UNIT (MSU) RIGHT DIGITAL ANALOG


ADAPTER (DAA) F/O'S VERTICAL
COURSE

AIR DATA SPEED INDICATOR


COMPUTER - 2

RIGHT IRU STALL WARNING


SYSTEM - 2

OCT 99
AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE

34-24
STALL WARNING
SYSTEM - 1

GROUND PROXIMITY
WARNING COMPUTER
NAVIGATION

LEFT IRU

AIR DATA FLIGHT MANAGE-


COMPUTER - 1 MENT COMPUTER
IRS DISPLAY
FLIGHT CONTROL
COMPUTER A
YAW DAMPER
DSPL SEL
PPOS WIND 1 N 3
COMPUTER
TK/GS HDG/STS 2
TEST B RT W H E
FLIGHT CONTROL
4 5 6
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

COMPUTER B
SYS DSPL 7 S 9
L R 8
ENT CLR
IRS
0
TRANSFER AUTOTHROTTLE
SWITCH COMPUTER
INERTIAL SYSTEM
DISPLAY UNIT DIGITAL FLIGHT
(ISDU) LEFT DIGITAL ANALOG DATA RECORDER
FLIGHT MANAGEMENT RDDMI-1
ADAPTER (DAA)
IRS System

COMPUTER DISPLAY UNIT VHF NAV-1


R WEATHER RADAR
E RECEIVER
L TRANSMITTER
UNITED AIRLINES

A
Y EFIS - 1
ALIGN ON DC ALIGN ON DC
RDDMI-2
FAULT DC FAIL FAULT DC FAIL
VHF NAV-2 EFIS - 2
B737-322/522

ALIGN NAV ALIGN NAV


OFF ATT OFF ATT
CAPT'S VERTICAL
SPEED INDICATOR
L IRS R

MODE SELECT UNIT (MSU) RIGHT DIGITAL ANALOG


ADAPTER (DAA) F/O'S VERTICAL
AIR DATA SPEED INDICATOR
COMPUTER - 2

RIGHT IRU STALL WARNING


SYSTEM - 2
OCT 99
AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
UNITED AIRLINES COURSE
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

INERTIAL REFERENCE SYSTEM IRU INERTIAL REFERENCE SYSTEM IRU


The Inertial Reference System (IRS) pro- The main function of the Inertial Refer- The Inertial Reference System (IRS) pro- The main function of the Inertial Refer-
vides inertial navigation data to user sys- ence Units (IRU) is to sense and compute vides inertial navigation data to user sys- ence Units (IRU) is to sense and compute
tems. It uses laser ring gyros, instead of linear accelerations and angular turning tems. It uses laser ring gyros, instead of linear accelerations and angular turning
the conventional spinning gyros, to sense rates about the aircraft's pitch, roll, and the conventional spinning gyros, to sense rates about the aircraft's pitch, roll, and
angular rate about the pitch, roll, and yaw yaw axes. This data is used for pitch and angular rate about the pitch, roll, and yaw yaw axes. This data is used for pitch and
axes. The IRS provides the inertial naviga- roll displays and navigational computa- axes. The IRS provides the inertial naviga- roll displays and navigational computa-
tion data and inertial flight control data to tions. tion data and inertial flight control data to tions.
user systems. CAUTION: The unit contains static user systems. CAUTION: The unit contains static
The IRS includes; two Inertial Reference sensitive devices. Observe precautions The IRS includes; two Inertial Reference sensitive devices. Observe precautions
Units (IRU), a Inertial System Display for handling electrostatic sensitive Units (IRU), a Inertial System Display for handling electrostatic sensitive
Unit (ISDU), a Mode Select Unit (MSU), devices. Unit (ISDU), a Mode Select Unit (MSU), devices.
a Master Caution Unit, two Digital/Ana- Each IRU contains three laser ring gyros a Master Caution Unit, two Digital/Ana- Each IRU contains three laser ring gyros
log Adapters (DAA), a IRU Transfer and three accelerometers. These sense log Adapters (DAA), a IRU Transfer and three accelerometers. These sense
Switch, two IRS transfer relays, two angular rates and linear accelerations, Switch, two IRS transfer relays, two angular rates and linear accelerations,
instrument transfer annunciator lights, two respectively. The sensed data is resolved instrument transfer annunciator lights, two respectively. The sensed data is resolved
Vertical Speed Indicators (VSI), and two to local vertical coordinates and combined Vertical Speed Indicators (VSI), and two to local vertical coordinates and combined
Radio Digital Distance Magnetic Indica- with air data inputs to compute the follow- Radio Digital Distance Magnetic Indica- with air data inputs to compute the follow-
tors (RDDMI). ing: position (latitude/longitude), attitude tors (RDDMI). ing: position (latitude/longitude), attitude
The IRS provides basic heading and atti- (pitch, roll, yaw), true and magnetic head- The IRS provides basic heading and atti- (pitch, roll, yaw), true and magnetic head-
tude reference accomplished through com- ing, windspeed and direction, velocity, tude reference accomplished through com- ing, windspeed and direction, velocity,
putations based on accelerometer and laser accelerations, angular rate data, and alti- putations based on accelerometer and laser accelerations, angular rate data, and alti-
ring gyro sensed signals. Three acceler- tude. ring gyro sensed signals. Three acceler- tude.
ometers and three laser ring gyros are used Accelerometers ometers and three laser ring gyros are used Accelerometers
in each IRU. The accelerometers and laser An accelerometer is arranged along each in each IRU. The accelerometers and laser An accelerometer is arranged along each
ring gyros are of the strap-down type and axis to sense longitudinal, lateral and ver- ring gyros are of the strap-down type and axis to sense longitudinal, lateral and ver-
are oriented along each of the three axes of tical G forces. Capacitive pick-off of the are oriented along each of the three axes of tical G forces. Capacitive pick-off of the
the aircraft. This orientation allows the proof mass converts the acceleration posi- the aircraft. This orientation allows the proof mass converts the acceleration posi-
IRU to sense acceleration along and rota- tion changes to error signals which is used IRU to sense acceleration along and rota- tion changes to error signals which is used
tion about each of the three axes. Com- to position the proof mass to its neutral tion about each of the three axes. Com- to position the proof mass to its neutral
puter manipulation of the signals from all position. The analog output signal is inte- puter manipulation of the signals from all position. The analog output signal is inte-
six sensors provide the basic heading and grated once to give velocity and integrated six sensors provide the basic heading and grated once to give velocity and integrated
attitude reference signals along with a second time to give distance. A tempera- attitude reference signals along with a second time to give distance. A tempera-
present position, accelerations, ground ture sensor for each accelerometer is used present position, accelerations, ground ture sensor for each accelerometer is used
speed, drift angle, and attitude rate infor- to improve accuracy. speed, drift angle, and attitude rate infor- to improve accuracy.
mation. The first requirement which must mation. The first requirement which must
be met for proper IRS operation is align- be met for proper IRS operation is align-
ment. The IRS alignment basically con- ment. The IRS alignment basically con-
sists of determination of local vertical and sists of determination of local vertical and
initial heading. initial heading.

and
OCT 99 Systems Introduction 34-25 OCT 99 34-25
UNITED
B737 GENERAL AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

Laser Ring Gyro Laser Ring Gyro


The two laser ring gyros are located in the The two laser ring gyros are located in the
E3-5 rack. Each of the three laser ring E3-5 rack. Each of the three laser ring
gyros is a triangular shaped, helium-neon gyros is a triangular shaped, helium-neon
laser that produces two light beams, one laser that produces two light beams, one
traveling clockwise and the other traveling traveling clockwise and the other traveling
in a counter-clockwise direction. The light in a counter-clockwise direction. The light
beams are reflected around the triangle by beams are reflected around the triangle by
using mirrors at each corner. When there using mirrors at each corner. When there
is no movement of the laser ring gyro, the is no movement of the laser ring gyro, the
two light beam frequencies are equal. Any two light beam frequencies are equal. Any
angular rotation causes the frequency of angular rotation causes the frequency of
the light beams to shift, causing a shift in the light beams to shift, causing a shift in
the fringe pattern. This change in the the fringe pattern. This change in the
fringe pattern is detected by photo-diodes fringe pattern is detected by photo-diodes
and angular rate signals are produced. At and angular rate signals are produced. At
low rotation rates, the two light beams low rotation rates, the two light beams
tend to lock-on to each other. To compen- tend to lock-on to each other. To compen-
sate for this effect, a piezoelectric dither sate for this effect, a piezoelectric dither
motor is used to vibrate the laser ring motor is used to vibrate the laser ring
gyro. This vibration is felt when the IRU gyro. This vibration is felt when the IRU
is powered and produces an audio hum. is powered and produces an audio hum.

34-26 and Systems Introduction OCT 99 34-26 OCT 99


UNITED
B737 GENERAL AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

IRS DISPLAY IRS DISPLAY

DSPL SEL DSPL SEL


N 1 N 3
PPOS WIND 1 2
3 PPOS WIND
2
TK/GS HDG/STS TK/GS HDG/STS
TEST B TEST B W H E
RT W H E RT
4 5 6 4 5 6

SYS DSPL S SYS DSPL 7 S 9


7 9 8
L R 8 L R
ENT CLR ENT CLR
0 0

ISDU ISDU

34-28 and Systems Introduction OCT 99 34-28 OCT 99


UNITED AIRLINES COURSE
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

ISDU ISDU
The Inertial System Display Unit (ISDU) The Inertial System Display Unit (ISDU)
is located in the left of the P-5 Aft Over- is located in the left of the P-5 Aft Over-
head Panel. The ISDU allows entry of ini- head Panel. The ISDU allows entry of ini-
tialization data and display of track angle, tialization data and display of track angle,
ground speed, present position, wind ground speed, present position, wind
direction and speed, heading, and system direction and speed, heading, and system
status from the IRUs. status from the IRUs.
CAUTION: The unit contains static CAUTION: The unit contains static
sensitive devices. Observe precautions sensitive devices. Observe precautions
for handling electrostatic sensitive for handling electrostatic sensitive
devices. devices.
The ISDU has two sets of seven seg- The ISDU has two sets of seven seg-
mented displays. The Display Select mented displays. The Display Select
(DSPL SEL) Switch has five positions; (DSPL SEL) Switch has five positions;
TEST, TK/GS (Track/Ground Speed), TEST, TK/GS (Track/Ground Speed),
PPOS (Present Position), WIND, and PPOS (Present Position), WIND, and
HDG/STS (Heading/ Status). This switch HDG/STS (Heading/ Status). This switch
is used for selecting the type of data dis- is used for selecting the type of data dis-
played. Inside the DSPL SEL switch is a played. Inside the DSPL SEL switch is a
brightness knob for dimming the ISDU brightness knob for dimming the ISDU
display. The System Display (SYS DSPL) display. The System Display (SYS DSPL)
Switch selects the left or right IRU to have Switch selects the left or right IRU to have
its information displayed. There is a its information displayed. There is a
twelve key keypad which is used to enter twelve key keypad which is used to enter
initialization values into the IRU (longi- initialization values into the IRU (longi-
tude, latitude, heading). An ENTer key is tude, latitude, heading). An ENTer key is
used to enter data typed on the keypad, the used to enter data typed on the keypad, the
key light will illuminate when information key light will illuminate when information
is being entered and should extinguish is being entered and should extinguish
when pressed. If the data entered is unrea- when pressed. If the data entered is unrea-
sonable, the CLR key will illuminate. sonable, the CLR key will illuminate.
Pressing the CLR key will extinguish the Pressing the CLR key will extinguish the
light. light.

and
OCT 99 Systems Introduction 34-29 OCT 99 34-29
UNITED
B737 GENERAL AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

ALIGN ON DC ALIGN ON DC ALIGN ON DC ALIGN ON DC

FAULT DC FAIL FAULT DC FAIL FAULT DC FAIL FAULT DC FAIL

ALIGN NAV ALIGN NAV ALIGN NAV ALIGN NAV


OFF ATT OFF ATT OFF ATT OFF ATT

L IRS R L IRS R

MSU MSU

34-30 and Systems Introduction OCT 99 34-30 OCT 99


UNITED AIRLINES COURSE
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

MSU DAA MSU DAA


The Mode Select Unit (MSU) is located The two Digital Analog Adapters (DAA) The Mode Select Unit (MSU) is located The two Digital Analog Adapters (DAA)
just below the ISDU in the P-5 Aft Over- units are located in the El-2 rack. They just below the ISDU in the P-5 Aft Over- units are located in the El-2 rack. They
head Panel. It is used to select the mode of provide signal conversion from analog to head Panel. It is used to select the mode of provide signal conversion from analog to
operation and to annunciate conditions of digital and digital to analog to interface operation and to annunciate conditions of digital and digital to analog to interface
the IRUs. There is a mode selector switch the IRS, FMCS, DFCS, DME, flight the IRUs. There is a mode selector switch the IRS, FMCS, DFCS, DME, flight
for the left and right IRUs, the positions of recorder, fuel summation, N1 indicating, for the left and right IRUs, the positions of recorder, fuel summation, N1 indicating,
the switches are; OFF, ALIGN, NAV, and VOR/ILS, weather radar and electronic the switches are; OFF, ALIGN, NAV, and VOR/ILS, weather radar and electronic
ATT. flight instrument systems. There are no ATT. flight instrument systems. There are no
CAUTION: The mode selector switches external controls or indicators on the front CAUTION: The mode selector switches external controls or indicators on the front
have detented positions and must be face. have detented positions and must be face.
pulled outward to prevent damage to CAUTION: The unit contains static pulled outward to prevent damage to CAUTION: The unit contains static
the switch. sensitive devices. Observe precautions the switch. sensitive devices. Observe precautions
There are annunciator lights for the left for handling electrostatic sensitive There are annunciator lights for the left for handling electrostatic sensitive
and right systems; a white ALIGN light, devices. and right systems; a white ALIGN light, devices.
an amber ON DC, an amber DC FAIL, an amber ON DC, an amber DC FAIL,
and an amber FAULT light. and an amber FAULT light.
NOTE: The ISDU and MSU are com- NOTE: The ISDU and MSU are com-
monly referred to as the IRU panel. monly referred to as the IRU panel.
Master Caution Unit Master Caution Unit
The IRS Master Caution Unit is located in The IRS Master Caution Unit is located in
the P-10 panel in the flight deck entry the P-10 panel in the flight deck entry
way. It provides an interface between the way. It provides an interface between the
IRS system and the master caution warn- IRS system and the master caution warn-
ing system. The master caution unit senses ing system. The master caution unit senses
abnormal IRS conditions and controls the abnormal IRS conditions and controls the
IRS master caution light on the glareshield IRS master caution light on the glareshield
left six-pack. left six-pack.

and
OCT 99 Systems Introduction 34-31 OCT 99 34-31
UNITED
B737 GENERAL AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

IRS Transfer Switch IRS Transfer Relay IRS Transfer Switch IRS Transfer Relay
The IRS Transfer Switch is located on the The two IRS transfer relays are located on The IRS Transfer Switch is located on the The two IRS transfer relays are located on
left side of the P-5 Overhead Panel, next the E1-2 rack. They are controlled by the left side of the P-5 Overhead Panel, next the E1-2 rack. They are controlled by the
to the EFI Transfer Switch. It controls the IRS Transfer Switch. Two relays and to the EFI Transfer Switch. It controls the IRS Transfer Switch. Two relays and
two IRS transfer relays. The switch has interlock circuits are used to prevent both two IRS transfer relays. The switch has interlock circuits are used to prevent both
three positions; BOTH ON L, BOTH ON relays from being out of their normal posi- three positions; BOTH ON L, BOTH ON relays from being out of their normal posi-
R, and NORMAL. This switch allows the tions at the same time. R, and NORMAL. This switch allows the tions at the same time.
alternate selection of the IRU supplying Instrument Transfer Light alternate selection of the IRU supplying Instrument Transfer Light
data to the respective users of the informa- The Instrument Transfer Lights are data to the respective users of the informa- The Instrument Transfer Lights are
tion. located to the right of each EADI. They tion. located to the right of each EADI. They
illuminate amber when the IRS Transfer illuminate amber when the IRS Transfer
Switch is not in the NORMAL position. Switch is not in the NORMAL position.
NOTE: The Instrument Transfer Light NOTE: The Instrument Transfer Light
IRS also illuminates if the EFI Transfer
IRS also illuminates if the EFI Transfer
switch is not in the NORMAL position. switch is not in the NORMAL position.
BOTH BOTH
BOTH BOTH VSI VSI
ON L ON R
ON L ON R The two Vertical Speed Indicators (VSI) The two Vertical Speed Indicators (VSI)
are located on the P-1 and P-3 panels, just NORMAL are located on the P-1 and P-3 panels, just
NORMAL to the right of the EHSIs. The Captain's to the right of the EHSIs. The Captain's
VSI receives its data from the IRU 1 and VSI receives its data from the IRU 1 and
the First Officer's VSI receives its data the First Officer's VSI receives its data
from IRU 2. The IRUs supply inertial ver- from IRU 2. The IRUs supply inertial ver-
IRS Transfer Switch IRS Transfer Switch
tical speed data in thousands of feet per tical speed data in thousands of feet per
minute rate of climb or descent. minute rate of climb or descent.
The Air Data Computer supplies altitude The Air Data Computer supplies altitude
rate information to the IRU. rate information to the IRU.
RDDMI RDDMI
The two Radio Digital Distance Magnetic The two Radio Digital Distance Magnetic
Indicators (RDDMI) are located on the P- Indicators (RDDMI) are located on the P-
1 and P-3 panels to the left of each EHSI. 1 and P-3 panels to the left of each EHSI.
They display magnetic heading data from They display magnetic heading data from
the offside IRU. The RDDMIs also dis- the offside IRU. The RDDMIs also dis-
play DME distance, VOR bearing, and play DME distance, VOR bearing, and
ADF bearing. ADF bearing.

34-32 and Systems Introduction OCT 99 34-32 OCT 99


UNITED AIRLINES COURSE
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

OPERATION entered longitude is compared to the last OPERATION entered longitude is compared to the last
The primary components for operating the stored longitude. These comparisons must The primary components for operating the stored longitude. These comparisons must
IRS system are the ISDU, MSU and IRU be favorable to complete the alignment IRS system are the ISDU, MSU and IRU be favorable to complete the alignment
Transfer Switch. The IRU Transfer Switch procedure. During the alignment period all Transfer Switch. The IRU Transfer Switch procedure. During the alignment period all
is normally placed in the NORMAL posi- outputs from the IRU, except for present is normally placed in the NORMAL posi- outputs from the IRU, except for present
tion. In this position the left IRU supplies position, are set to No Computed Data tion. In this position the left IRU supplies position, are set to No Computed Data
data to the left systems and the right IRU (NCD). data to the left systems and the right IRU (NCD).
supplies its data to the right systems. The Navigate Mode supplies its data to the right systems. The Navigate Mode
RDDMIs receive their heading informa- In the NAVigate Mode the IRUs provide RDDMIs receive their heading informa- In the NAVigate Mode the IRUs provide
tion from the offside IRU. outputs for attitude, heading, present posi- tion from the offside IRU. outputs for attitude, heading, present posi-
The IRUs must be aligned for proper oper- tion, acceleration, track angle, drift angle, The IRUs must be aligned for proper oper- tion, acceleration, track angle, drift angle,
ation, this procedure takes approximately ground speed, and wind data. These out- ation, this procedure takes approximately ground speed, and wind data. These out-
ten minutes and requires entry of the puts are all derived from gyro and acceler- ten minutes and requires entry of the puts are all derived from gyro and acceler-
present longitude and latitude of the air- ometer sensor data. The initial attitude, present longitude and latitude of the air- ometer sensor data. The initial attitude,
craft in order to complete the procedure. heading, and velocity signals are modified craft in order to complete the procedure. heading, and velocity signals are modified
Align Mode by inputs from the sensors to establish Align Mode by inputs from the sensors to establish
IRS alignment consists of determining real-time present parameters through inte- IRS alignment consists of determining real-time present parameters through inte-
local vertical and initial heading. Both gration and computer calculations. Addi- local vertical and initial heading. Both gration and computer calculations. Addi-
accelerometer and laser ring gyro inputs tional calculations by the computer accelerometer and laser ring gyro inputs tional calculations by the computer
are used for alignment. The alignment establish such parameters as present posi- are used for alignment. The alignment establish such parameters as present posi-
computations use the basic premise that tion, ground speed, and drift angle. Inputs computations use the basic premise that tion, ground speed, and drift angle. Inputs
the only acceleration forces during align- from the air data computers are used for the only acceleration forces during align- from the air data computers are used for
ment are due to the earth's gravity: the inertially smoothed altitude and altitude ment are due to the earth's gravity: the inertially smoothed altitude and altitude
only motion during alignment is due to the rate (baro altitude) and windspeed/direc- only motion during alignment is due to the rate (baro altitude) and windspeed/direc-
earth's rotation. Accelerations due to grav- tion (true airspeed). earth's rotation. Accelerations due to grav- tion (true airspeed).
ity are always perpendicular to the earth's NOTE: The Mode Selector Switch must ity are always perpendicular to the earth's NOTE: The Mode Selector Switch must
surface and define local vertical. This be pulled out to move from the NAV surface and define local vertical. This be pulled out to move from the NAV
local vertical is used to erect the attitude position. local vertical is used to erect the attitude position.
data so that it is accurately referenced to Attitude Mode data so that it is accurately referenced to Attitude Mode
vertical. Initially, only a coarse vertical is The ATTitude Mode places the IRU into a vertical. Initially, only a coarse vertical is The ATTitude Mode places the IRU into a
established. Once vertical is established, reversionary mode of operation. It is used established. Once vertical is established, reversionary mode of operation. It is used
the laser ring gyro sensed earth rate com- when there is a failure or total power loss the laser ring gyro sensed earth rate com- when there is a failure or total power loss
ponents are used to establish the heading when in the NAV mode. In this mode, ponents are used to establish the heading when in the NAV mode. In this mode,
of the aircraft. As the alignment continues, only attitude and heading data is output to of the aircraft. As the alignment continues, only attitude and heading data is output to
both the vertical reference and heading the user systems. Position and ground both the vertical reference and heading the user systems. Position and ground
determinations are fine tuned for maxi- speed information is lost. The Mode determinations are fine tuned for maxi- speed information is lost. The Mode
mum accuracy. During the ten minute Selector must be cycled to the OFF posi- mum accuracy. During the ten minute Selector must be cycled to the OFF posi-
alignment period, the initial present posi- tion and the IRU re-aligned. alignment period, the initial present posi- tion and the IRU re-aligned.
tion entry can be entered. Earth rate sens- NOTE: The Mode Selector must be tion entry can be entered. Earth rate sens- NOTE: The Mode Selector must be
ing by the laser ring gyros allows the IRU pulled out of detent to move it to the ing by the laser ring gyros allows the IRU pulled out of detent to move it to the
to determine initial latitude. This gyro ATT position. to determine initial latitude. This gyro ATT position.
determined latitude is compared to the determined latitude is compared to the
manually entered latitude. The manually manually entered latitude. The manually

and
OCT 99 Systems Introduction 34-33 OCT 99 34-33
UNITED
B737 GENERAL AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

OFF Mode DSPL SEL Selector OFF Mode DSPL SEL Selector
In the OFF mode power is removed from The ISDU DiSPLay SELect Selector In the OFF mode power is removed from The ISDU DiSPLay SELect Selector
the IRU. When the Mode Selector Switch selects the type of information to be dis- the IRU. When the Mode Selector Switch selects the type of information to be dis-
is moved to the OFF position, the IRU played on the ISDU. It has five positions. is moved to the OFF position, the IRU played on the ISDU. It has five positions.
goes through a thirty second shut down TEST Position goes through a thirty second shut down TEST Position
procedure before removing power. When This position is a momentary position, the procedure before removing power. When This position is a momentary position, the
this occurs, all alignment information is selector will return to the TK/GS position this occurs, all alignment information is selector will return to the TK/GS position
lost. when released. If the IRU is in the NAV lost. when released. If the IRU is in the NAV
ALIGN Annunciator Light mode, ground speed less than 20 kts, an ALIGN Annunciator Light mode, ground speed less than 20 kts, an
The white ALIGN light illuminates steady interface test of the IRU selected by the The white ALIGN light illuminates steady interface test of the IRU selected by the
when the IRU is in the alignment mode. SYS DSPL switch will give the following when the IRU is in the alignment mode. SYS DSPL switch will give the following
When the alignment is completed the light results when held in the TEST position. When the alignment is completed the light results when held in the TEST position.
extinguishes. It is also not illuminated First two seconds: all MSU lights illumi- extinguishes. It is also not illuminated First two seconds: all MSU lights illumi-
when the IRU is OFF. The light flashes nated, all ISDU display segments come when the IRU is OFF. The light flashes nated, all ISDU display segments come
when there is an abnormal condition exists on, CLR and ENT key lights illuminate. when there is an abnormal condition exists on, CLR and ENT key lights illuminate.
during alignment. The common causes for From two to ten seconds: Failure indica- during alignment. The common causes for From two to ten seconds: Failure indica-
the light to flash during alignment are; air- tions of, HDG flag in view for onside the light to flash during alignment are; air- tions of, HDG flag in view for onside
craft movement during alignment, signifi- EHSI and offside RDDMI, ATT flag in craft movement during alignment, signifi- EHSI and offside RDDMI, ATT flag in
cant difference between entered and last view on EADI, OFF flag in VSI. cant difference between entered and last view on EADI, OFF flag in VSI.
positions, unreasonable position entry, or After ten seconds: Following values dis- positions, unreasonable position entry, or After ten seconds: Following values dis-
no position entry. played on ISDU and/or flight instruments; no position entry. played on ISDU and/or flight instruments;
ON DC Annunciator Light Drift Angle = -10 degrees left ON DC Annunciator Light Drift Angle = -10 degrees left
The amber ON DC Light illuminates Ground Speed = 200 kts Inertial Vertical The amber ON DC Light illuminates when Ground Speed = 200 kts Inertial Vertical
when AC power is not available to the Speed = -600 ft/min AC power is not available to the IRU and Speed = -600 ft/min
IRU and it is operating on DC power. Magnetic Heading = 15 degrees it is operating on DC power. Magnetic Heading = 15 degrees
DC FAIL Annunciator Light Pitch Angle = 5 degrees up DC FAIL Annunciator Light Pitch Angle = 5 degrees up
The amber DC FAIL Light illuminates Roll Angle 45 degrees right The amber DC FAIL Light illuminates Roll Angle 45 degrees right
when the DC power source to the IRU is Present Position = N22300 E 22300 when the DC power source to the IRU is Present Position = N22300 E 22300
not normal. True Heading = 10 degrees not normal. True Heading = 10 degrees
FAULT Annunciator Light Wind Direction = 30 degrees FAULT Annunciator Light Wind Direction = 30 degrees
The amber FAULT Light illuminates Wind Speed = 100 kts The amber FAULT Light illuminates Wind Speed = 100 kts
when the IRU senses a system fault. True Track Angle = 0 degrees when the IRU senses a system fault. True Track Angle = 0 degrees
NOTE: Upon completion of alignment, When the selector is released from the NOTE: Upon completion of alignment, When the selector is released from the
all lights out on the MSU indicates nor- TEST position the values and indications all lights out on the MSU indicates nor- TEST position the values and indications
mal operation of the IRU. shown should return to their previous val- mal operation of the IRU. shown should return to their previous val-
SYS DSPL Switch ues. SYS DSPL Switch ues.
The ISDU SYStem DiSPLay Switch NOTE: The test results will only be dis- The ISDU SYStem DiSPLay Switch NOTE: The test results will only be dis-
selects the L or R IRU to have its informa- played on the system selected by the selects the L or R IRU to have its informa- played on the system selected by the
tion displayed on the ISDU. Also, it is the SYS DSPL switch. tion displayed on the ISDU. Also, it is the SYS DSPL switch.
IRU that will be tested when moving the NOTE: This test can also be initiated by IRU that will be tested when moving the NOTE: This test can also be initiated by
ISDU Display Select to TEST. pressing the TEST button on the IRU or ISDU Display Select to TEST. pressing the TEST button on the IRU or
by accessing the IRS BITE through the by accessing the IRS BITE through the
CDUs. CDUs.

34-34 and Systems Introduction OCT 99 34-34 OCT 99


UNITED AIRLINES COURSE
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

TK/GS Position IRS Transfer Switch TK/GS Position IRS Transfer Switch
The Track/Ground Speed (TK/GS) posi- When the IRS Transfer Switch is in the The Track/Ground Speed (TK/GS) posi- When the IRS Transfer Switch is in the
tion is used to display present true track NORMAL position, the left IRU supplies tion is used to display present true track NORMAL position, the left IRU supplies
value in the left ISDU display and present data to the left systems and the offside value in the left ISDU display and present data to the left systems and the offside
ground speed in the right display. RDDMI and the right IRU supplies data to ground speed in the right display. RDDMI and the right IRU supplies data to
PPOS Position the right systems and offside RDDMI. PPOS Position the right systems and offside RDDMI.
The Present Position (PPOS) position dis- When the switch is placed in the BOTH The Present Position (PPOS) position dis- When the switch is placed in the BOTH
plays the present latitude and longitude in ON L position all users of IRU data will plays the present latitude and longitude in ON L position all users of IRU data will
the ISDU display. This selector position use the left IRU. When the switch is the ISDU display. This selector position use the left IRU. When the switch is
can be used when initializing the IRUs to placed in the BOTH ON R position, all can be used when initializing the IRUs to placed in the BOTH ON R position, all
enter the present position for alignment. users of IRU data will use the right IRU. enter the present position for alignment. users of IRU data will use the right IRU.
WIND Position IRU Power WIND Position IRU Power
The WIND position is used to display the The primary power source for the IRUs is The WIND position is used to display the The primary power source for the IRUs is
present true wind direction in the ISDU 115 vac and the back-up source is 28 vdc. present true wind direction in the ISDU 115 vac and the back-up source is 28 vdc.
left display and the wind speed in the right The left IRU receives 115 vac from the left display and the wind speed in the right The left IRU receives 115 vac from the
display. 115v AC Standby Bus and 28 vdc from display. 115v AC Standby Bus and 28 vdc from
HDG/STS Position the 28v Switched Hot Battery Bus. The HDG/STS Position the 28v Switched Hot Battery Bus. The
The Heading/Status (HDG/STS) position right IRU receives 115 vac from the 115v The Heading/Status (HDG/STS) position right IRU receives 115 vac from the 115v
is used to display the present true heading AC Electrical Transfer Bus and 28 vdc is used to display the present true heading AC Electrical Transfer Bus and 28 vdc
in the left ISDU display and in the right from the 28v Switched Hot Battery Bus. in the left ISDU display and in the right from the 28v Switched Hot Battery Bus.
display a single digit count-down display When AC power is lost to the IRUs, auto- display a single digit count-down display When AC power is lost to the IRUs, auto-
in the middle and a two digit malfunction matic switching to the DC back-up source in the middle and a two digit malfunction matic switching to the DC back-up source
code in the far right end. occurs. When both IRUs are using DC code in the far right end. occurs. When both IRUs are using DC
Keypad power, the right IRU will automatically Keypad power, the right IRU will automatically
The twelve key keypad is used to enter shut down after approximately five min- The twelve key keypad is used to enter shut down after approximately five min-
position and heading information into the utes. This is to conserve battery power. position and heading information into the utes. This is to conserve battery power.
ISDU. Any entry must be preceded by Whenever the IRU is operating off of DC ISDU. Any entry must be preceded by Whenever the IRU is operating off of DC
using a combination letter/number key. To the associated ON DC annunciator light using a combination letter/number key. To the associated ON DC annunciator light
enter latitude values the N/2 or S/8 key will be illuminated. enter latitude values the N/2 or S/8 key will be illuminated.
must be pressed before the actual value, Crew Call Horn must be pressed before the actual value, Crew Call Horn
for longitude the W/4 or E/6 key must be The Crew Call Horn will be activated by for longitude the W/4 or E/6 key must be The Crew Call Horn will be activated by
pressed. For entering a heading when in the IRS system when the following condi- pressed. For entering a heading when in the IRS system when the following condi-
the Attitude Mode the H/5 key must be tions exist: Equipment Cooling; airplane the Attitude Mode the H/5 key must be tions exist: Equipment Cooling; airplane
pressed first. When a combination letter/ on ground, no cooling to IRUs, IRS is pressed first. When a combination letter/ on ground, no cooling to IRUs, IRS is
number key is pressed, the ENT key illu- operating. IRS on DC Power; airplane on number key is pressed, the ENT key illu- operating. IRS on DC Power; airplane on
minates, this key is pressed when the ground, loss of AC to IRU, IRU operating. minates, this key is pressed when the ground, loss of AC to IRU, IRU operating.
value is to be entered. When an unaccept- value is to be entered. When an unaccept-
able entry is made the CLR key illumi- able entry is made the CLR key illumi-
nates, pressing the key extinguishes the nates, pressing the key extinguishes the
light, press it again to clear the display. light, press it again to clear the display.
NOTE: The order of entry of the lati- NOTE: The order of entry of the lati-
tude and longitude makes no difference. tude and longitude makes no difference.

and
OCT 99 Systems Introduction 34-35 OCT 99 34-35
UNITED
B737 GENERAL AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

Alignment motion sensed could have been caused by Alignment sensed could have been caused by move-
The alignment of the IRUs is started by movement of the aircraft from, loading The alignment of the IRUs is started by ment of the aircraft from, loading passen-
positioning both MSU Mode Selectors to passengers or baggage, hooking up the positioning both MSU Mode Selectors to gers or baggage, hooking up the tug, or
the ALIGN or NAV position. The MSU tug, or winds. When this occurs, the IRUs the ALIGN or NAV position. The MSU winds. When this occurs, the IRUs must
ON DC annunciator light should illumi- must be shut off and the alignment process ON DC annunciator light should illumi- be shut off and the alignment process
nate for five seconds, this is to verify that restarted. nate for five seconds, this is to verify that restarted.
the DC source is available. Then the If the entered present position does not the DC source is available. Then the If the entered present position does not
ALIGN light should illuminate steady agree with the stored last position latitude ALIGN light should illuminate steady agree with the stored last position latitude
until alignment is complete. During the and longitude within 1 degree, the ALIGN until alignment is complete. During the and longitude within 1 degree, the ALIGN
alignment period, the IRU computes local light will flash and a malfunction code of alignment period, the IRU computes local light will flash and a malfunction code of
vertical and determines present latitude. If zero four. This will happen immediately vertical and determines present latitude. If zero four. This will happen immediately
the ISDU DSPL SEL selector is in the after entering the present position. When the ISDU DSPL SEL selector is in the after entering the present position. When
HDG/STS position, the right display will this occurs, re-entering the same present HDG/STS position, the right display will this occurs, re-entering the same present
have the numeral seven displayed. This position values will override and the have the numeral seven displayed. This position values will override and the
indicates seven or more minutes are left in ALIGN lights will stop flashing. indicates seven or more minutes are left in ALIGN lights will stop flashing.
the alignment procedure. During the ten If the entered present position does not the alignment procedure. During the ten If the entered present position does not
minute alignment procedure, present posi- agree with the sensed position at the end minute alignment procedure, present posi- agree with the sensed position at the end
tion must be entered using either the ISDU of the alignment period, the ALIGN light tion must be entered using either the ISDU of the alignment period, the ALIGN light
or one of the Control Display Units will flash. The correct present position can or one of the Control Display Units (CDU) will flash. The correct present position can
(CDU) located on the P-8 Forward Elec- be entered and the IRU will be aligned. If located on the P-8 Forward Electronic be entered and the IRU will be aligned. If
tronic Panel. As the alignment progresses it still does not agree with the sensed posi- Panel. As the alignment progresses the it still does not agree with the sensed posi-
the HDG/STS countdown value will show tion, a malfunction code of zero two will HDG/STS countdown value will show the tion, a malfunction code of zero two will
the appropriate number of minutes be displayed and the amber FAULT light appropriate number of minutes remain- be displayed and the amber FAULT light
remaining. When the alignment process is will illuminate. If this occurs, turn off the ing. When the alignment process is com- will illuminate. If this occurs, turn off the
completed after ten minutes, the Mode IRU for at least thirty seconds and the pleted after ten minutes, the Mode IRU for at least thirty seconds and the
Selector is placed in the NAV position if it alignment procedure restarted. Selector is placed in the NAV position if it alignment procedure restarted.
was in the ALIGN position. The ALIGN If the present position has not been entered was in the ALIGN position. The ALIGN If the present position has not been
annunciator light should extinguish and at the end of the ten minute alignment annunciator light should extinguish and entered at the end of the ten minute align-
the EADI should show the attitude ball period, the ALIGN light will flash and a the EADI should show the attitude ball ment period, the ALIGN light will flash
and the EHSI should show a heading or malfunction code of zero eight will be dis- and the EHSI should show a heading or and a malfunction code of zero eight will
track value. played. When this occurs, enter the track value. be displayed. When this occurs, enter the
NOTE: Do not move the aircraft when present position and the IRU alignment NOTE: Do not move the aircraft when present position and the IRU alignment
in the align mode. This will cause the should be complete. in the align mode. This will cause the should be complete.
alignment to stop and have to be Following is a list of IRS malfunction alignment to stop and have to be Following is a list of IRS malfunction
restarted. codes: restarted. codes:
Alignment Faults 01 = ISDU Fail, 02 = IRU Fail, 03 = Alignment Faults 01 = ISDU Fail, 02 = IRU Fail, 03 =
There are several faults that can occur Excessive Motion, 04 = Align Fault, 05 = There are several faults that can occur Excessive Motion, 04 = Align Fault, 05 =
when aligning the IRUs. If excessive L DAA Fault, 06 = R DAA Fault, 07 = when aligning the IRUs. If excessive L DAA Fault, 06 = R DAA Fault, 07 =
motion of the aircraft occurs, the IRUs ADC Fault, 08 = Enter Present Position, motion of the aircraft occurs, the IRUs ADC Fault, 08 = Enter Present Position,
will not complete alignment. The ALIGN 09 = Enter Heading, 10 = ISDU Power will not complete alignment. The ALIGN 09 = Enter Heading, 10 = ISDU Power
light will start flashing and the ISDU dis- Loss. light will start flashing and the ISDU dis- Loss.
play will show the malfunction code play will show the malfunction code
numerals zero three. The excessive numerals zero three. The excessive motion

34-36 and Systems Introduction OCT 99 34-36 OCT 99


UNITED AIRLINES COURSE
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

ATT Mode Heading Entry Obtain the present position latitude and ATT Mode Heading Entry Obtain the present position latitude and
When the IRU Mode Selector is placed in longitude from a known source. When the IRU Mode Selector is placed in longitude from a known source.
the ATT position, a malfunction code of There are several methods of using the the ATT position, a malfunction code of There are several methods of using the
zero nine will be displayed if the DSPL CDU for entering present position. The zero nine will be displayed if the DSPL CDU for entering present position. The
SEL selector is in the HDG/STS position. CDU must have the POS INIT page 1 of 2 SEL selector is in the HDG/STS position. CDU must have the POS INIT page 1 of 2
The heading of the aircraft is required to displayed. When the IRU is aligning, there The heading of the aircraft is required to displayed. When the IRU is aligning, there
initialize the heading information from the should be SET IRS POS displayed on the initialize the heading information from the should be SET IRS POS displayed on the
IRU. This can be done using the ISDU or right side of the screen with boxes below IRU. This can be done using the ISDU or right side of the screen with boxes below
CDU Position Initialization page 1 of 2. If it. At the upper right of the screen will CDU Position Initialization page 1 of 2. If it. At the upper right of the screen will
the ISDU is used, the DSPL SEL selector appear the last position stored by the IRU. the ISDU is used, the DSPL SEL selector appear the last position stored by the IRU.
should be in the HDG/STS position, then This information can be transferred to the should be in the HDG/STS position, then This information can be transferred to the
press the H/5 key and the heading of the scratch pad of the CDU by pressing the press the H/5 key and the heading of the scratch pad of the CDU by pressing the
aircraft from an operating system or LSK next to the value, then the LSK next aircraft from an operating system or LSK next to the value, then the LSK next
standby compass, then pressing the ENT to the boxes can be pressed to enter in the standby compass, then pressing the ENT to the boxes can be pressed to enter in the
key. The heading information then should last position as the present position. The key. The heading information then should last position as the present position. The
appear on the EHSI. If using the CDU, next method of present position entry can appear on the EHSI. If using the CDU, next method of present position entry can
access the POS INIT page 1 of 2, SET be done by typing the appropriate alpha access the POS INIT page 1 of 2, SET be done by typing the appropriate alpha
HDG should appear in the lower right of and numeric values of the latitude and lon- HDG should appear in the lower right of and numeric values of the latitude and lon-
the screen with dashes below it, type the gitude into the scratch pad and then press- the screen with dashes below it, type the gitude into the scratch pad and then press-
aircraft heading value into the scratch pad ing the LSK next to the SET IRS POS aircraft heading value into the scratch pad ing the LSK next to the SET IRS POS
and press the line select key (LSK) next to boxes. and press the line select key (LSK) next to boxes.
the dashes. NOTE: Do not use spaces when enter- the dashes. NOTE: Do not use spaces when enter-
Present Position Entry ing present position into the scratch Present Position Entry ing present position into the scratch
There are several methods of entering the pad. There are several methods of entering the pad.
present position for IRU initialization dur- Another method is to type the four letter present position for IRU initialization dur- Another method is to type the four letter
ing alignment. The ISDU can be used or international identifier for the airport the ing alignment. The ISDU can be used or international identifier for the airport the
the CDU POS INIT page 1 of 2 can be aircraft is located into the scratch pad, the CDU POS INIT page 1 of 2 can be aircraft is located into the scratch pad,
used. To use the ISDU, the DSPL SEL then press the LSK next to the dashes used. To use the ISDU, the DSPL SEL then press the LSK next to the dashes
selector should be in the PPOS position. below REF AIRPORT. The identifier will selector should be in the PPOS position. below REF AIRPORT. The identifier will
The latitude preceded by the appropriate be displayed with the latitude and longi- The latitude preceded by the appropriate be displayed with the latitude and longi-
letter/number key for N or S should be tude stored by the Flight Management letter/number key for N or S should be tude stored by the Flight Management
entered, the ENT key will illuminate, then Computer (FMC) data base. Then push the entered, the ENT key will illuminate, then Computer (FMC) data base. Then push the
press the ENT key, use the same proce- LSK next to the value, then press the LSK press the ENT key, use the same proce- LSK next to the value, then press the LSK
dure for entering the longitude using the E next to the SET IRS POS boxes. Another dure for entering the longitude using the E next to the SET IRS POS boxes. Another
or W key. method is used once the airport identifier or W key. method is used once the airport identifier
NOTE: The longitude can be entered has been entered, the gate or other stored NOTE: The longitude can be entered has been entered, the gate or other stored
before the latitude. designation is typed into the scratch pad before the latitude. designation is typed into the scratch pad
and then the LSK is pressed next to the and then the LSK is pressed next to the
dashes below GATE, then the LSK next to dashes below GATE, then the LSK next to
the SET IRS POS boxes is pressed. the SET IRS POS boxes is pressed.

and
OCT 99 Systems Introduction 34-37 OCT 99 34-37
UNITED
B737 GENERAL AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

Maintenance Practices STANDBY ATTITUDE INDICATOR Maintenance Practices STANDBY ATTITUDE INDICATOR
When removing IRU 1, the air data pitot/ The Standby Attitude Indicator (SAI) is When removing IRU 1, the air data pitot/ The Standby Attitude Indicator (SAI) is
static lines prevent the unit from being located on the center instrument panel, P- static lines prevent the unit from being located on the center instrument panel, P-
pulled straight out. To facilitate removal, 2, it is independent of the IRS system. The pulled straight out. To facilitate removal, 2, it is independent of the IRS system. The
after the clamps have been removed, the SAI is a back-up system which provides after the clamps have been removed, the SAI is a back-up system which provides
unit is slid inboard, then lift the aft end of pitch and roll attitude information. It also unit is slid inboard, then lift the aft end of pitch and roll attitude information. It also
the IRU up as the aft end is rotated for- provides for back-up glideslope and local- the IRU up as the aft end is rotated for- provides for back-up glideslope and local-
ward, then the unit is removed at an angle. izer deviation. ward, then the unit is removed at an angle. izer deviation.
The reverse of this process is used to The SAI is powered by the Battery Bus The reverse of this process is used to The SAI is powered by the Battery Bus
install the IRU. and has an electric integral spinning gyro. install the IRU. and has an electric integral spinning gyro.
BITE The glideslope and localizer deviation sig- BITE The glideslope and localizer deviation sig-
Access to IRS BITE is accomplished nals come from the No. 1 NAV. system. Access to IRS BITE is accomplished nals come from the No. 1 NAV. system.
through the Flight Management Computer Flags for G/S and LOC are provided for through the Flight Management Computer Flags for G/S and LOC are provided for
(FMC) by using the CDUs. To perform failure indication. (FMC) by using the CDUs. To perform failure indication.
the BITE access the MAINT BITE A caging knob in the lower right corner of the BITE access the MAINT BITE A caging knob in the lower right corner of
INDEX page, select IRS, then select IRS the SAI allows for quick erection of the INDEX page, select IRS, then select IRS the SAI allows for quick erection of the
L, IRS R or IRS L & R. The associated gyro. L, IRS R or IRS L & R. The associated gyro.
system will then show a page with selec- The ILS knob in the lower left corner of system will then show a page with selec- The ILS knob in the lower left corner of
tions of CURRENT FAULTS, INTER- the SAI has three positions, OFF, ILS, and tions of CURRENT FAULTS, INTER- the SAI has three positions, OFF, ILS, and
FACE CHECK, and IN-FLIGHT B/CRS. FACE CHECK, and IN-FLIGHT B/CRS.
FAULTS. The OFF position removes the deviation FAULTS. The OFF position removes the deviation
Current Faults bars from the display, The ILS position Current Faults bars from the display, The ILS position
This display shows the current faults provides for ILS deviation indications. This display shows the current faults provides for ILS deviation indications.
found by the IRS for the IRU, DAA, and The B/CRS position reverses the sensing found by the IRS for the IRU, DAA, and The B/CRS position reverses the sensing
DADC. It will show either FAIL, OK, or of the localizer needle to facilitate the DADC. It will show either FAIL, OK, or of the localizer needle to facilitate the
TEST. monitoring of a back course instrument TEST. monitoring of a back course instrument
Interface Check approach. Interface Check approach.
This display has 4 pages that show the val- This display has 4 pages that show the val-
ues of the Interface Check. On page one is ues of the Interface Check. On page one is
a prompt for TEST START, which is used a prompt for TEST START, which is used
to start the test. To stop the test, the TEST to start the test. To stop the test, the TEST
STOP Line Select Key (LSK) must be STOP Line Select Key (LSK) must be
pushed, this prompt is found on pages 2, pushed, this prompt is found on pages 2, 3,
3, and 4. and 4.
Inflight Faults Inflight Faults
This display shows the failed IRU found This display shows the failed IRU found
by the IRS in the last 9 flights. by the IRS in the last 9 flights.

34-38 and Systems Introduction OCT 99 34-38 OCT 99


UNITED AIRLINES COURSE
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

28V DC D361 28V DC D361


BATTERY 28V DC BATTERY 28V DC
BUS T BUS T
C358 U C358 U
STBY STBY
HRZN HRZN
D STATIC D STATIC
INVERTER INVERTER
B B

MONITOR MONITOR

GLIDE SLOPE G/S G/S FLAG GLIDE SLOPE G/S G/S FLAG
FLAG D357 N VALID FLAG D357 N VALID
A27 28V A27 28V
P DC P DC
OFF OFF
B/CRS B/CRS
ILS ENABLE B38 ILS ENABLE B38
28V DC R 28V DC R

V V
OFF OFF
B/CRS B/CRS
ILS TUNED 30
ILS TUNED 30

G/S UP A8 G/S DEV 20 G/S UP A8 G/S DEV 20


J G J G
DEVIATION DN A9 K S 10 DEVIATION DN A9 K S 10
28V OUT OF 28V OUT OF
DC VIEW BIAS 10 DC VIEW BIAS 10

B/CRS 20 B/CRS 20
30 C 30 C
OFF
ILS LO OFF
ILS LO
RT B39 ILS B/CRS RT B39 ILS B/CRS
LOC G LOC G
DEVIATION DEVIATION
LT B40 H LT B40 H
OFF OFF
ILS 28V ILS 28V
DC ILS DC ILS
OFF QUICK OFF QUICK
B/CRS CAGING B/CRS CAGING
LOC LOC
LOC L VALID KNOB LOC L VALID KNOB
FLAG B50 FLAG B50
M M
ILS TUNED ILS TUNED
M154 VHF NAV OFF 28V M154 VHF NAV OFF 28V
RECEIVER 1 DC LOC FLAG RECEIVER 1 DC LOC FLAG
(E3-4) (E3-4)
E E
+5V +5V
LIGHTING LIGHTING
(34-24-00) (34-24-00)
F F

N33 STANDBY ATTITUDE/ILS INDICATOR (P1) N33 STANDBY ATTITUDE/ILS INDICATOR (P1)

SAI System SAI System

and
OCT 99 Systems Introduction 34-39 OCT 99 34-39
34-40
1250 1558
DME-1 DME-2

INTERROGATION 9
12 15
NAVIGATION

18

3 6
21 24

AD
27

F
30 33

F
AD
REPLY
RDDMI
DME GROUND
DME 13.5 HDG 127 M
GS140
FACILITY TAS 148

15
DIGITAL/ 12
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

EFIS SYMBOL
B737 GENERAL

ANALOG +10
GENERATOR-L

and Systems Introduction


ADAPTER
UNITED

REMOTE
ELECTRONICS 117˚/20
ILS 1 110.10
VHF NAV/DME-1 UNITS

DME System
CONTROL PANEL
AUTO NAV MANUAL FLIGHT CONTROL
DME -1 CAPTAIN'S EHSI
INTERROGATOR COMPUTER "A"
AIRLINES

AUTO
TEST MANUAL

VOR UP/LT
FAMILIARIZATION

DME ON/RT
B737-322/522

FLIGHT
MANAGEMENT
NO. 1 ANTENNA COMPUTERR
COURSE

FIRST OFFICER
SYSTEM SIMILAR

OCT 99
AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE

34-40
1250 1558
DME-1 DME-2

INTERROGATION 9
12 15
18
NAVIGATION

3 6
21 24

AD

27
F

30 33
F
AD

REPLY
RDDMI
DME GROUND
DME 13.5 HDG 127 M
GS140
FACILITY TAS 148

15
DIGITAL/ 12
EFIS SYMBOL
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

ANALOG +10
GENERATOR-L
ADAPTER

REMOTE
ELECTRONICS 117˚/20
ILS 1 110.10
VHF NAV/DME-1 UNITS
CONTROL PANEL
DME System

AUTO NAV MANUAL FLIGHT CONTROL


DME -1 CAPTAIN'S EHSI
INTERROGATOR COMPUTER "A"
AUTO
UNITED AIRLINES

TEST MANUAL

VOR UP/LT

DME ON/RT
B737-322/522

FLIGHT
MANAGEMENT
NO. 1 ANTENNA COMPUTERR

FIRST OFFICER
SYSTEM SIMILAR
OCT 99
AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
UNITED AIRLINES COURSE
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

DISTANCE MEASURING EQUIP- DME Interrogator Unit DISTANCE MEASURING EQUIP- DME Interrogator Unit
MENT The DME Interrogator Units are located in MENT The DME Interrogator Units are located in
The Distance Measuring Equipment the E2-2 rack. They transmit interrogation The Distance Measuring Equipment the E2-2 rack. They transmit interrogation
(DME) system measures the distance signals which are received by a DME (DME) system measures the distance signals which are received by a DME
between the aircraft and a selected ground ground station. The ground station sends between the aircraft and a selected ground ground station. The ground station sends
station in nautical miles. There are two back a reply signal, and the interrogator station in nautical miles. There are two back a reply signal, and the interrogator
systems installed on the aircraft; DME 1 receives the signal and determines the dis- systems installed on the aircraft; DME 1 receives the signal and determines the dis-
and DME 2. The system provides the tance traveled. Connected to the interroga- and DME 2. The system provides the tance traveled. Connected to the interroga-
flight crew and Flight Management Com- tion unit is the suppression bus, this bus is flight crew and Flight Management Com- tion unit is the suppression bus, this bus is
puter (FMC) with distance to station infor- connected to the other DME system and puter (FMC) with distance to station infor- connected to the other DME system and
mation for navigational purposes. the ATC transponders. The suppression mation for navigational purposes. the ATC transponders. The suppression
There are two separate DME systems, bus prevents the transmission signal from There are two separate DME systems, bus prevents the transmission signal from
each consists of; a DME Interrogator Unit interfering with the other systems. each consists of; a DME Interrogator Unit interfering with the other systems.
(receiver/transmitter) and an antenna, and (receiver/transmitter) and an antenna, and
uses the NAV Tuning Panels and the uses the NAV Tuning Panels and the
RDDMIs and EHSIs for indications. RDDMIs and EHSIs for indications.
Audio station identifier signals are sent to Audio station identifier signals are sent to
the Remote Electronics Unit (REU). DME the Remote Electronics Unit (REU). DME
information is also sent to the FMC, Flight information is also sent to the FMC, Flight
Control Computers (FCC), and EFIS Control Computers (FCC), and EFIS
Symbol Generators through the Digital Symbol Generators through the Digital
Analog Adapters (DAA). Automatic tun- Analog Adapters (DAA). Automatic tun-
ing frequencies are received from the ing frequencies are received from the
FMC. FMC.
The DME system operates in the UHF fre- The DME system operates in the UHF fre-
quency range. It can be manually tuned by quency range. It can be manually tuned by
using the NAV Tuning Panel, which is using the NAV Tuning Panel, which is
tuned to a VOR or localizer frequency, tuned to a VOR or localizer frequency,
this automatically tunes the DME to the this automatically tunes the DME to the
proper UHF frequency. The range of proper UHF frequency. The range of
DME is from 0 to 390 nautical miles. A DME is from 0 to 390 nautical miles. A
self test is performed using a switch on the self test is performed using a switch on the
NAV Tuning Panel. NAV Tuning Panel.

and
OCT 99 Systems Introduction 34-41 OCT 99 34-41
UNITED
B737 GENERAL AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

AUTO NAV MANUAL AUTO NAV MANUAL

AUTO AUTO
TEST MANUAL TEST MANUAL

VOR UP/LT VOR UP/LT

DME DN/RT DME DN/RT

NAV Tuning Panel Antenna NAV Tuning Panel Antenna


The NAV Tuning Panel is used to tune to Each DME system has an antenna located The NAV Tuning Panel is used to tune to Each DME system has an antenna located
a VOR or localizer frequency, this auto- on the bottom of the fuselage. These a VOR or localizer frequency, this auto- on the bottom of the fuselage. These
matically tunes the DME to the appropri- antenna are referred to as L band antenna. matically tunes the DME to the appropri- antenna are referred to as L band antenna.
ate paired UHF frequency. This is done by They are the same as the antenna used for ate paired UHF frequency. This is done by They are the same as the antenna used for
using the manual mode of the tuning the ATC Transponder system. using the manual mode of the tuning the ATC Transponder system.
panel. Auto-tuning of the DME can be panel. Auto-tuning of the DME can be
done by the Flight Management Computer
done by the Flight Management Computer
(FMC) when the panel is in the auto (FMC) when the panel is in the auto mode.
mode. A VOR/DME Test switch is A VOR/DME Test switch is located on the
located on the NAV Tuning Panel. This
NAV Tuning Panel. This switch is spring
switch is spring loaded to the center neu- loaded to the center neutral position and
tral position and must be held in the must be held in the appropriate test posi-
appropriate test position. The MANUAL/
tion. The MANUAL/AUTO switch is a
AUTO switch is a alternate action push alternate action push button switch, which
button switch, which illuminates the mode illuminates the mode of the panel.
of the panel.

34-42 and Systems Introduction OCT 99 34-42 OCT 99


UNITED AIRLINES COURSE
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

RDDMI EHSI RDDMI EHSI


Each Radio Digital Distance Magnetic The Electronic Horizontal Situation Indi- Each Radio Digital Distance Magnetic The Electronic Horizontal Situation Indi-
Indicator (RDDMI) has a DME-1 and cators (EHSI) can indicate DME distance Indicator (RDDMI) has a DME-1 and cators (EHSI) can indicate DME distance
DME-2 window for displaying DME dis- in the upper left corner when in the FULL DME-2 window for displaying DME dis- in the upper left corner when in the FULL
tances. or EXP VOR/ILS mode. The Captain's tances. or EXP VOR/ILS mode. The Captain's
EHSI will indicate the DME-1 distance EHSI will indicate the DME-1 distance
and the First Officer's EHSI will indicate and the First Officer's EHSI will indicate
the DME-2 distance. the DME-2 distance.

1250 1558 1250 1558


DME-1 DME-2 DME-1 DME-2

DME 13.5 HDG


DME 13.5 HDG
12 15 TAS 148
12 15 TAS 148
9 9

18
18

3 6
3 6

21 24
21 24

12 12

0
0

27 27
30 33 30 33

AD
AD

F
F

F
F

AD
AD

RDDMI EHSI RDDMI EHSI

and
OCT 99 Systems Introduction 34-43 OCT 99 34-43
UNITED
B737 GENERAL AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

NCD and Fault Indications Agility Tuning NCD and Fault Indications Agility Tuning
No Computed Data (NCD) conditions When The Flight Management System No Computed Data (NCD) conditions When The Flight Management System
appear as a set of dashes on the RDDMIs detects a malfunction in a DME system or appear as a set of dashes on the RDDMIs detects a malfunction in a DME system or
and EHSIs. When invalid conditions exist if one system is being manually tuned, the and EHSIs. When invalid conditions exist if one system is being manually tuned, the
the RDDMIs have a flag over the display other DME system will go into frequency the RDDMIs have a flag over the display other DME system will go into frequency
and the EHSIs are blank in the DME area. agility tuning if the NAV Control Panel is and the EHSIs are blank in the DME area. agility tuning if the NAV Control Panel is
During Auto-tuning, the EHSI DME dis- selected in the Auto-tuning mode. Agility During Auto-tuning, the EHSI DME dis- selected in the Auto-tuning mode. Agility
play area is blank. When in Auto-tuning tuning is where one DME system tunes to play area is blank. When in Auto-tuning tuning is where one DME system tunes to
and agility tuning mode, the RDDMI will the two best stations to triangulate the air- and agility tuning mode, the RDDMI will the two best stations to triangulate the air-
show a set of dashes. craft's position, it switches between the show a set of dashes. craft's position, it switches between the
OPERATION stations in five second intervals. OPERATION stations in five second intervals.
When in the NAV Control Panel is in the To hear the DME audio identifier on the When in the NAV Control Panel is in the To hear the DME audio identifier on the
MANUAL mode, the VHF frequency overhead speakers, the Audio Control MANUAL mode, the VHF frequency overhead speakers, the Audio Control
selected automatically tunes the DME to Panel must have the NAV and SPKR selected automatically tunes the DME to Panel must have the NAV and SPKR
the proper UHF frequency. The Interroga- switches slid forward. With the filter the proper UHF frequency. The Interroga- switches slid forward. With the filter
tor Unit transmits an pulsed interrogation switch in the R position, the VOR identi- tor Unit transmits an pulsed interrogation switch in the R position, the VOR identi-
signal from the antenna. A ground station fier will be heard, the DME identifier will signal from the antenna. A ground station fier will be heard, the DME identifier will
receives the signal and retransmits the sig- be at a slightly higher pitch and about receives the signal and retransmits the sig- be at a slightly higher pitch and about
nal. This signal is received from the same every 25 seconds. nal. This signal is received from the same every 25 seconds.
antenna and the Interrogator Unit calcu- To manually tune to a DME station, place antenna and the Interrogator Unit calcu- To manually tune to a DME station, place
lates the distance to the station based on the NAV Tuning Panel mode switch to the lates the distance to the station based on the NAV Tuning Panel mode switch to the
the elapsed time between transmission and MANUAL position. Adjust to the selected the elapsed time between transmission and MANUAL position. Adjust to the selected
reception. DME distance information is VOR localizer frequency. The DME dis- reception. DME distance information is VOR localizer frequency. The DME dis-
then sent to user systems and indicators. tance to the ground station should be then sent to user systems and indicators. tance to the ground station should be
Auto-Tuning shown on both RDDMIs and the associ- Auto-Tuning shown on both RDDMIs and the associ-
When the NAV Control Panel is selected ated EHSI. When the NAV Control Panel is selected ated EHSI.
in the AUTO-tuning mode, the FMC pro- NOTE: Reception of distant DME sta- in the AUTO-tuning mode, the FMC pro- NOTE: Reception of distant DME sta-
vides the DME with a UHF frequency that tions may be difficult due to antenna vides the DME with a UHF frequency that tions may be difficult due to antenna
it has determined is the best station to location and line-of-sight limitations. it has determined is the best station to location and line-of-sight limitations.
receive DME distance from. The FMC NOTE: Identification of the station receive DME distance from. The FMC NOTE: Identification of the station
chooses the best station to use based on should be accomplished using the audio chooses the best station to use based on should be accomplished using the audio
geometry for triangulation. integrating system. geometry for triangulation. integrating system.

34-44 and Systems Introduction OCT 99 34-44 OCT 99


UNITED AIRLINES COURSE
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

Self Test Self Test


The Self Test for each DME system is ini- The Self Test for each DME system is ini-
tiated using the associated NAV Tuning tiated using the associated NAV Tuning
Panel. The panel must be in the MAN- Panel. The panel must be in the MAN-
UAL mode, and the EFIS Control Panel in UAL mode, and the EFIS Control Panel in
a VOR/ILS display mode. When the a VOR/ILS display mode. When the
VOR/DME Test switch is moved to the VOR/DME Test switch is moved to the
DME position: for the first second, the DME position: for the first second, the
RDDMIs should show a flag in the appro- RDDMIs should show a flag in the appro-
priate window and the EHSI should be priate window and the EHSI should be
blank in the DME area. The next second blank in the DME area. The next second
should show dashes in the RDDMIs' win- should show dashes in the RDDMIs' win-
dows and DME--- on the EHSI. Then the dows and DME--- on the EHSI. Then the
RDDMIs should show 000.0 and the EHSI RDDMIs should show 000.0 and the EHSI
should show DME 00.0. After 11-15 sec- should show DME 00.0. After 11-15 sec-
onds after the test button is released, the onds after the test button is released, the
displays should return to their previous displays should return to their previous
values. values.

TEST TEST

VOR UP/LT VOR UP/LT

DME DN/RT DME DN/RT

DME Test Switch DME Test Switch

and
OCT 99 Systems Introduction 34-45 OCT 99 34-45
34-46
1250 1558
NAVIGATION

DME-1 DME-2

12 15
9

18
NO. 1 ADF LOOP NO. 1 ADF SENSE

3 6
ANTENNA ANTENNA 21 24

AD
27

F
30 33
F
AD
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION
B737 GENERAL

and Systems Introduction


UNITED

DME 13.5
TAS 148 GS140

HDG 127 M

ADF System
AUTOMATIC
12 15
DIRECTION FINDER 9
GROUND RADIO STATION
18

RECEIVER
6
21
AIRLINES

3
0

EFIS SYMBOL
24

TFR
GENERATORS 33 27
FAMILIARIZATION

30

TONE
B737-322/522

A
0362.0 OFF ON
0351.0
D ANT ADF
F
117˚/20
ILS 1 110.10
GAIN
REMOTE
ELECTRONICS
COURSE

ADF CONTROL PANEL UNIT EHSI (CAPT. AND F/O)

OCT 99
AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE

34-46
1250 1558
DME-1 DME-2
NAVIGATION

12 15
9
18

NO. 1 ADF LOOP NO. 1 ADF SENSE


3 6

ANTENNA ANTENNA
21 24

AD

27
F

30 33
F
AD
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

DME 13.5
TAS 148 GS140

HDG 127 M

AUTOMATIC
ADF System

12 15
DIRECTION FINDER 9
GROUND RADIO STATION
18

RECEIVER
6
21

3
UNITED AIRLINES

EFIS SYMBOL
24

TFR
GENERATORS 33 27
30

TONE
B737-322/522

A
0362.0 OFF ON
0351.0
D ANT ADF
F
117˚/20
ILS 1 110.10
GAIN
REMOTE
ELECTRONICS
ADF CONTROL PANEL UNIT EHSI (CAPT. AND F/O)
OCT 99
AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
UNITED AIRLINES COURSE
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

AUTOMATIC DIRECTION FIND- Sense Antenna Coupler AUTOMATIC DIRECTION FIND- Sense Antenna Coupler
ING SYSTEM The sense antenna coupler is located aft of ING SYSTEM The sense antenna coupler is located aft of
The Automatic Direction Finding (ADF) the wheel well aft bulkhead, it matches the The Automatic Direction Finding (ADF) the wheel well aft bulkhead, it matches the
system is used as a navigational aid that capacitance of the sense antenna for opti- system is used as a navigational aid that capacitance of the sense antenna for opti-
receives radio signals and determines the mum performance. It attached the sense receives radio signals and determines the mum performance. It attached the sense
direction of the transmitting station rela- antenna to the transmission line to the direction of the transmitting station rela- antenna to the transmission line to the
tive to the aircraft. Stations used by the receiver. tive to the aircraft. Stations used by the receiver.
ADF system are commercial AM broad- Loop Antenna ADF system are commercial AM broad- Loop Antenna
cast stations and low frequency navigation The ADF loop antenna is located on the cast stations and low frequency navigation The ADF loop antenna is located on the
radio stations. These navigation stations bottom of the fuselage between the AC radio stations. These navigation stations bottom of the fuselage between the AC
are referred to as Non Directional Radio bay doors. It has two coils that are used to are referred to as Non Directional Radio bay doors. It has two coils that are used to
Beacons (NDB). There are provisions for receive signals to determine the direction Beacons (NDB). There are provisions for receive signals to determine the direction
two ADF systems on the aircraft. Domes- of the signal. The antenna is flush two ADF systems on the aircraft. Domes- of the signal. The antenna is flush
tic operating aircraft have only one system mounted behind a cover plate. The No. 2 tic operating aircraft have only one system mounted behind a cover plate. The No. 2
installed in the No. 2 position. antenna is aft of the No. 1 antenna. installed in the No. 2 position. antenna is aft of the No. 1 antenna.
Each ADF system consists of; a receiver, NOTE: The loop antenna is switched Each ADF system consists of; a receiver, NOTE: The loop antenna is switched
sense antenna, sense antenna coupler, a out when the ADF control panel mode sense antenna, sense antenna coupler, a out when the ADF control panel mode
loop antenna, a quadrantal error corrector, switch is in the ANT position. loop antenna, a quadrantal error corrector, switch is in the ANT position.
and a control panel. The ADF bearings are Quadrantal Error Corrector and a control panel. The ADF bearings are Quadrantal Error Corrector
displayed on the RDDMIs and EHSIs. The The quadrantal error connector is mounted displayed on the RDDMIs and EHSIs. The The quadrantal error connector is mounted
audio signal is sent to the Remote Elec- directly on top of the loop antenna, con- audio signal is sent to the Remote Elec- directly on top of the loop antenna, con-
tronics Unit (REU). There is no interfac- necting to the transmission cable to the tronics Unit (REU). There is no interfac- necting to the transmission cable to the
ing with any other system. receiver. Corrections are necessary for ing with any other system. receiver. Corrections are necessary for
ADF Receiver signal pattern distortion caused by the air- ADF Receiver signal pattern distortion caused by the air-
The ADF receiver is located in the E2-4 craft structure. The ADF receiver is located in the E2-4 craft structure.
rack, it has two antenna connectors on the rack, it has two antenna connectors on the
front. It also has a test switch and test indi- front. It also has a test switch and test indi-
cator on the front of the unit. cator on the front of the unit.
Sense Antenna Sense Antenna
The ADF sense antenna is an integral part The ADF sense antenna is an integral part
of the aft wing-to-body fairing panel of the aft wing-to-body fairing panel
located outboard and aft of the wheel well. located outboard and aft of the wheel well.
The No. 2 antenna is on the right side. It is The No. 2 antenna is on the right side. It is
connected to the antenna coupler by an connected to the antenna coupler by an
antenna lead wire. antenna lead wire.
NOTE: This is the antenna used when NOTE: This is the antenna used when
the control panel mode switch is in the the control panel mode switch is in the
ANT position. ANT position.
CAUTION: Care should be taken when CAUTION: Care should be taken when
removing the aft wing-to-body fairing removing the aft wing-to-body fairing
panel to prevent damage of the antenna panel to prevent damage of the antenna
lead wire. lead wire.

and
OCT 99 Systems Introduction 34-47 OCT 99 34-47
UNITED
B737 GENERAL AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

TFR TFR

TONE TONE
A
0362.0 OFF ON
0351.0 A
0362.0 OFF ON
0351.0
D ANT ADF D ANT ADF
F F

GAIN GAIN

ADF Control Panel ADF Control Panel


The ADF Control Panel is located at the tion of the signal, when in this position the The ADF Control Panel is located at the the signal, when in this position the
aft area of the AFT Electronic Panel, the RDDMI bearing pointers will park at the aft area of the AFT Electronic Panel, the RDDMI bearing pointers will park at the
No 2. control panel is located on the right 9:00 position and the EHSI bearing point- No 2. control panel is located on the right 9:00 position and the EHSI bearing point-
side. The control panel has two sets of fre- ers will be removed from view. In the side. The control panel has two sets of fre- ers will be removed from view. In the
quency indicator windows and frequency ADF position, both the loop and sense quency indicator windows and frequency ADF position, both the loop and sense
selection knobs. The active frequency is antenna signals are combined to automati- selection knobs. The active frequency is antenna signals are combined to automati-
selected by the TFR knob, moving the cally determine the location of the station. selected by the TFR knob, moving the cally determine the location of the station.
switch exposing a pointer arrow pointing Inside the mode switch is a GAIN knob, switch exposing a pointer arrow pointing Inside the mode switch is a GAIN knob,
towards a window, selects that frequency. this is used to adjust the level of audio towards a window, selects that frequency. this is used to adjust the level of audio
The TONE switch adds a tone to the sig- from the ADF receiver to the Remote The TONE switch adds a tone to the signal from the ADF receiver to the Remote
nal in the ON position. The mode switch Electronics Unit (REU). in the ON position. The mode switch has Electronics Unit (REU).
has two positions, ANT and ADF. In the NOTE: If the GAIN knob is turned too two positions, ANT and ADF. In the ANT NOTE: If the GAIN knob is turned too
ANT position, just the sense antenna is far left, audio from the ADF may not be position, just the sense antenna is being far left, audio from the ADF may not be
being used, this is for better audio recep- heard. used, this is for better audio reception of heard.

34-48 and Systems Introduction OCT 99 34-48 OCT 99


UNITED AIRLINES COURSE
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

RDDMI Indication EHSI Indication RDDMI Indication EHSI Indication


The RDDMIs are used to indicate the The EHSI can also indicate ADF bearing The RDDMIs are used to indicate the The EHSI can also indicate ADF bearing
bearing to the ADF transmitting station. to the station information. The pointer bearing to the ADF transmitting station. to the station information. The pointer
The No. 1 ADF bearing is represented by ends are shown on the compass card, the The No. 1 ADF bearing is represented by ends are shown on the compass card, the
the narrow pointer and the No. 2 system No. 1 system uses a single line pointer and the narrow pointer and the No. 2 system No. 1 system uses a single line pointer and
by the wide pointer. The ADF/VOR bear- the No. 2 system uses a two line pointer by the wide pointer. The ADF/VOR bear- the No. 2 system uses a two line pointer
ing pointer switches must be pushed to the depiction. ing pointer switches must be pushed to the depiction.
ADF position to view the appropriate NOTE: The ADF bearing pointer is ADF position to view the appropriate NOTE: The ADF bearing pointer is
pointer pointing to the station. removed when the control panel mode pointer pointing to the station. removed when the control panel mode
NOTE: The pointer will point to the switch is in the ANT position. If there is NOTE: The pointer will point to the switch is in the ANT position. If there is
9:00 position when the ADF control a power failure of the ADF system, the 9:00 position when the ADF control a power failure of the ADF system, the
Panel mode switch is in the ANT posi- pointer is removed. Panel mode switch is in the ANT posi- pointer is removed.
tion. If there is an ADF power failure, tion. If there is an ADF power failure,
the arrow flag will appear for the the arrow flag will appear for the
appropriate system. appropriate system. HEAD
HEAD

TAIL
1250 1558 TAIL
1250 1558
DME-1 DME-2
DME-1 DME-2

12 15 12 15
9 9
18

18
3 6

ADF EHSI Pointer ADF EHSI Pointer

3 6
21 24

21 24
0

27

0
30 33 27
AD

30 33
AD
F

F
F
AD

A2
F
AD
A2

RDDMI RDDMI

ADF EHSI Bearing Lead Line ADF EHSI Bearing Lead Line

and
OCT 99 Systems Introduction 34-49 OCT 99 34-49
UNITED
B737 GENERAL AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

OPERATION Maintenance Practices OPERATION Maintenance Practices


When an operating station has been tuned The flight crew may not refer to an ADF When an operating station has been tuned The flight crew may not refer to an ADF
to and is being received, the signals from transmitter station in a write-up. They may to and is being received, the signals from transmitter station in a write-up. They may
the sense antenna and loop antenna are use terms such as NDB (Non Directional the sense antenna and loop antenna are use terms such as NDB (Non Directional
combined to produce a synchro signal that Radio Beacon), compass locator, LOM combined to produce a synchro signal that Radio Beacon), compass locator, LOM
represents the relative position of the (Locator at the Outer Marker), or LMM represents the relative position of the (Locator at the Outer Marker), or LMM
transmitting station to the aircraft. This (locator at the Middle Marker). These are transmitting station to the aircraft. This (locator at the Middle Marker). These are
signal is sent to the RDDMIs and the EFIS terms used for the navigational aids signal is sent to the RDDMIs and the EFIS terms used for the navigational aids
Symbol Generators. The RDDMIs and received by the ADF system. Symbol Generators. The RDDMIs and received by the ADF system.
EHSIs depict the bearing to the stations When using a commercial AM broadcast EHSIs depict the bearing to the stations When using a commercial AM broadcast
with bearing pointers. The No. 1 system station for operational checking of the with bearing pointers. The No. 1 system station for operational checking of the
uses the narrow pointer and the No. 2 sys- ADF system remember that a commercial uses the narrow pointer and the No. 2 sys- ADF system remember that a commercial
tem bearing uses the wide pointers. AM broadcast transmission is many times tem bearing uses the wide pointers. AM broadcast transmission is many times
To operate the No. 2 system, tune to the more powerful than an NDB transmitter. To operate the No. 2 system, tune to the more powerful than an NDB transmitter.
appropriate frequency in one of the fre- If a problem with the ADF occurs, check appropriate frequency in one of the fre- If a problem with the ADF occurs, check
quency windows on the No. 2 ADF Con- the ANT position of the ADF Control quency windows on the No. 2 ADF Con- the ANT position of the ADF Control
trol Panel. Select that window with the Panel, if there is no audio, suspect the trol Panel. Select that window with the Panel, if there is no audio, suspect the
TFR knob. Place the mode switch in the sense antenna, especially if the panel was TFR knob. Place the mode switch in the sense antenna, especially if the panel was
ANT position and turn up the GAIN knob. removed for maintenance. ANT position and turn up the GAIN knob. removed for maintenance.
On the Audio Selector Panel, move the Tests On the Audio Selector Panel, move the Tests
volume slider switches for ADF 2 and A self test of the ADF system can be per- volume slider switches for ADF 2 and A self test of the ADF system can be per-
SPKR forward. The audio identifier formed by using the TEST button on the SPKR forward. The audio identifier formed by using the TEST button on the
should be heard on the overhead speakers. front of the ADF receiver. On the receiver should be heard on the overhead speakers. front of the ADF receiver. On the receiver
On both RDDMIs press the No. 2 VOR/ the test indicator will move to the TEST On both RDDMIs press the No. 2 VOR/ the test indicator will move to the TEST
ADF selector buttons to indicate ADF. On position. The ADF bearing pointer should ADF selector buttons to indicate ADF. On position. The ADF bearing pointer should
the EFIS Control Panels, select FULL move to a position that is 45 degrees to the the EFIS Control Panels, select FULL move to a position that is 45 degrees to the
VOR/ILS. The RDDMI wide pointers left of the top lubber line. A 1020 Hz tone VOR/ILS. The RDDMI wide pointers left of the top lubber line. A 1020 Hz tone
should park at 9:00 and the EHSI wide should be heard on the audio system. should park at 9:00 and the EHSI wide should be heard on the audio system.
pointers should be removed from view. pointers should be removed from view.
Place the ADF Control Panel mode switch Place the ADF Control Panel mode switch
to the ADF position., the wide bearing to the ADF position., the wide bearing
pointers on the RDDMIs and EHSIs pointers on the RDDMIs and EHSIs
should point to the relative direction of the should point to the relative direction of the
station to the nose of the aircraft. station to the nose of the aircraft.

34-50 and Systems Introduction OCT 99 34-50 OCT 99


34-52
TOP TOP
ANTENNA ANTENNA
NAVIGATION

ATC/TCAS ATC/MODE S
CONTROL TRANSPONDER DIGITAL AUDIO
PANEL CONTROL SYSTEM

BOTTOM
ANTENNA
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION
B737 GENERAL

and Systems Introduction


TCAS
COMPUTER
UNITED

EFIS EADI

TCAS System
NAVIGATION
SYSTEMS
AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION
B737-322/522

BOTTOM
COURSE

ANTENNA

OCT 99
AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE

EFIS EHSI

34-52
TOP TOP
ANTENNA ANTENNA
NAVIGATION

ATC/TCAS ATC/MODE S
CONTROL TRANSPONDER DIGITAL AUDIO
PANEL CONTROL SYSTEM

BOTTOM
ANTENNA
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

TCAS
COMPUTER
TCAS System

EFIS EADI

NAVIGATION
SYSTEMS
UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522

BOTTOM
ANTENNA
OCT 99
AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE

EFIS EHSI
UNITED AIRLINES COURSE
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

TCAS/AIR TRAFFIC CONTROL self test represents a problem with that TCAS/AIR TRAFFIC CONTROL self test represents a problem with that
TRANSPONDER SYSTEM part of the system. TRANSPONDER SYSTEM part of the system.
The Traffic Alert and Collision Avoidance TCAS Directional Antenna The Traffic Alert and Collision Avoidance TCAS Directional Antenna
System (TCAS) and the Air Traffic Con- There are two TCAS directional antenna System (TCAS) and the Air Traffic Con- There are two TCAS directional antenna
trol (ATC) Transponder System share the installed on the fuselage centerline, one on trol (ATC) Transponder System share the installed on the fuselage centerline, one on
same concepts of operation and some the top and one on the bottom, both near same concepts of operation and some the top and one on the bottom, both near
components. TCAS is designed to give the front of the aircraft. These antenna components. TCAS is designed to give the front of the aircraft. These antenna
audio and visual warning of other aircraft protrude slightly from the fuselage and are audio and visual warning of other aircraft protrude slightly from the fuselage and are
in the vicinity, and can give an avoidance a squared oval shape. in the vicinity, and can give an avoidance a squared oval shape.
maneuver as determined by the TCAS ATC Mode S Transponder maneuver as determined by the TCAS ATC Mode S Transponder
computer. The ATC Transponder system The ATC Mode S Transponders are computer. The ATC Transponder system The ATC Mode S Transponders are
sends information about the aircraft for located on the E2-2 rack. The Transponder sends information about the aircraft for located on the E2-2 rack. The Transponder
better identification and separation on the responds to interrogation signals sent from better identification and separation on the responds to interrogation signals sent from
ATC radar screens. the ground and responds with information ATC radar screens. the ground and responds with information
There is one TCAS system which is inte- on aircraft altitude and identification code There is one TCAS system which is inte- on aircraft altitude and identification code
grated with the ATC Transponder system. for depiction on the ground radar screen. grated with the ATC Transponder system. for depiction on the ground radar screen.
There are two ATC Transponder systems, The Mode S capabilities allow the data There are two ATC Transponder systems, The Mode S capabilities allow the data
only one operates at a time. The systems link of information between aircraft with only one operates at a time. The systems link of information between aircraft with
consist of; a TCAS Computer, two TCAS TCAS. There is a self test button and LED consist of; a TCAS Computer, two TCAS TCAS. There is a self test button and LED
directional antenna, two ATC Mode S test indicators. The TEST button starts the directional antenna, two ATC Mode S test indicators. The TEST button starts the
Transponders, two ATC antenna, and a self test when pressed. There is a green Transponders, two ATC antenna, and a self test when pressed. There is a green
TCAS/ATC Control Panel. The TCAS PASS and a red FAIL light. There are red; TCAS/ATC Control Panel. The TCAS PASS and a red FAIL light. There are red;
visual indications appear on the EADIs UPPER ANT, LOWER ANT, ALT and visual indications appear on the EADIs UPPER ANT, LOWER ANT, ALT and
and EHSIs, and the audio warnings go to CTL lights. Any illumination of the red and EHSIs, and the audio warnings go to CTL lights. Any illumination of the red
the Remote Electronics Unit (REU). lights during a self test represents a prob- the Remote Electronics Unit (REU). lights during a self test represents a prob-
The TCAS/ATC systems receive informa- lem with that part of the system. The TCAS/ATC systems receive informa- lem with that part of the system.
tion from the Air Data Computers (ADC), ATC Antenna tion from the Air Data Computers (ADC), ATC Antenna
Inertial Reference Units (IRU), air/ground The ATC Antenna are L band antenna Inertial Reference Units (IRU), air/ground The ATC Antenna are L band antenna
sensing, and Low Range Radio Altimeter located along the fuselage centerline, one sensing, and Low Range Radio Altimeter located along the fuselage centerline, one
(LRRA) systems. on top and one on the bottom of the air- (LRRA) systems. on top and one on the bottom of the air-
TCAS Computer craft. The Transponder system uses the TCAS Computer craft. The Transponder system uses the
The TCAS Computer is located in the E3- antenna receiving the stronger signals. The TCAS Computer is located in the E3- antenna receiving the stronger signals.
4 rack. TCAS sends out interrogation sig- The ATC antenna are the same as the 4 rack. TCAS sends out interrogation sig- The ATC antenna are the same as the
nals and receives responses from aircraft DME antenna. nals and receives responses from aircraft DME antenna.
with operating transponders in the area. with operating transponders in the area.
The computer determines the proximity of The computer determines the proximity of
other aircraft and their collision threat. other aircraft and their collision threat.
There is a TEST switch on the front of the There is a TEST switch on the front of the
unit and LED indicator lights. There is a unit and LED indicator lights. There is a
green PASS and a red FAIL light, and red green PASS and a red FAIL light, and red
XPNDR, UPPER ANT, LOWER ANT, XPNDR, UPPER ANT, LOWER ANT,
RAD ANT, HDNG, R/A, and T/A lights. RAD ANT, HDNG, R/A, and T/A lights.
Any illumination of the red lights during a Any illumination of the red lights during a

and
OCT 99 Systems Introduction 34-53 OCT 99 34-53
UNITED
B737 GENERAL AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

ABOVE ABS ABOVE ABS ABOVE ABS ABOVE ABS


N N N N
BELOW REL BELOW REL BELOW REL BELOW REL
XPDR L R XPDR L R
STBY TA FAIL STBY TA FAIL
TEST TA/RA TEST TA/RA
IDENT IDENT

TCAS/ATC TCAS/ATC

TCAS/ATC Control Panel its warm-up cycle. The Traffic Advisory TCAS/ATC Control Panel its warm-up cycle. The Traffic Advisory
The combination TCAS/ATC Control (TA) position allows the TCAS to give The combination TCAS/ATC Control (TA) position allows the TCAS to give
Panel is located in the center of the P8 Aft audio and visual indications of threat air- Panel is located in the center of the P8 Aft audio and visual indications of threat air-
Electronic Control Panel. It has a tran- craft. The Traffic Advisory/Resolution Electronic Control Panel. It has a tran- craft. The Traffic Advisory/Resolution
sponder code window and selector knobs. Advisory (TA/RA) position allows the sponder code window and selector knobs. Advisory (TA/RA) position allows the
The four digit code is issued in the flight TCAS system to also issue audio and The four digit code is issued in the flight TCAS system to also issue audio and
plan or by the Air Traffic Controller, each visual maneuvers to fly that should avoid plan or by the Air Traffic Controller, each visual maneuvers to fly that should avoid
aircraft in the area will have its own code. the threat aircraft. In the upper corners of aircraft in the area will have its own code. the threat aircraft. In the upper corners of
There is a red FAIL light that illuminates the panel are sets of switches, the left set is There is a red FAIL light that illuminates the panel are sets of switches, the left set is
when there is a failure of the selected tran- for the left EHSI display and the right set when there is a failure of the selected tran- for the left EHSI display and the right set
sponder system. There is an IDENT but- is for the right EHSI display. The sponder system. There is an IDENT but- is for the right EHSI display. The
ton that is pressed by the flight crew when ABOVE-N-BELOW switch has three ton that is pressed by the flight crew when ABOVE-N-BELOW switch has three
requested by the Air Traffic Controller, to positions; the N (Normal) position dis- requested by the Air Traffic Controller, to positions; the N (Normal) position dis-
positively identify the aircraft on the radar plays threat aircraft targets on the EHSI positively identify the aircraft on the radar plays threat aircraft targets on the EHSI
screen. On the right side of the TCAS/ that are within 2,700 ft above or below the screen. On the right side of the TCAS/ that are within 2,700 ft above or below the
ATC Control Panel is a selector for the aircraft. The ABOVE position displays ATC Control Panel is a selector for the aircraft. The ABOVE position displays
Left or Right transponder system to be in additional targets that are up to 9,900 ft Left or Right transponder system to be in additional targets that are up to 9,900 ft
operation. On the left side of the panel is above the aircraft. The BELOW position operation. On the left side of the panel is above the aircraft. The BELOW position
the TCAS/ATC Selector, it has five posi- displays additional targets to 9,900 ft the TCAS/ATC Selector, it has five posi- displays additional targets to 9,900 ft
tions. The TEST position is momentary below the aircraft. The ABS/REL (Abso- tions. The TEST position is momentary below the aircraft. The ABS/REL (Abso-
and spring loaded to return to the STBY lute/Relative) switch has two positions. and spring loaded to return to the STBY lute/Relative) switch has two positions.
position when the selector is released. The ABS position displays the targets with position when the selector is released. The ABS position displays the targets
This performs a self test of the TCAS sys- a three digit altitude above sea level. The This performs a self test of the TCAS sys- with a three digit altitude above sea level.
tem. The Standby (STBY) position puts REL position gives a two digit number tem. The Standby (STBY) position puts The REL position gives a two digit num-
the transponders and TCAS in the warm- representing the relative altitude of the tar- the transponders and TCAS in the warm- ber representing the relative altitude of the
up cycle. get to the aircraft, it is preceded by a + or - up cycle. target to the aircraft, it is preceded by a +
The Transponder (XPDR) position allows to represent above or below the aircraft. The Transponder (XPDR) position allows or - to represent above or below the air-
the selected transponder to reply when the selected transponder to reply when craft.
being interrogated, the TCAS system is in being interrogated, the TCAS system is in

34-54 and Systems Introduction OCT 99 34-54 OCT 99


UNITED AIRLINES COURSE
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

Indications The target symbol will change to a solid Indications The target symbol will change to a solid
The ATC Transponder system does not white diamond when the target is within The ATC Transponder system does not white diamond when the target is within
have any primary indications of its opera- about six miles horizontally and 1200 ft have any primary indications of its opera- about six miles horizontally and 1200 ft
tion. The TCAS threat targets are depicted vertically. No audio warnings are given tion. The TCAS threat targets are depicted vertically. No audio warnings are given
on the EHSI in relation to the aircraft. The for this "proximity" traffic. When the on the EHSI in relation to the aircraft. The for this "proximity" traffic. When the
color and shape of the target determine its TCAS computer has determined that the color and shape of the target determine its TCAS computer has determined that the
level of threat. Also altitude information target has become a threat, it changes the level of threat. Also altitude information target has become a threat, it changes the
and climb or descent information is also target to a yellow solid circle and issues an and climb or descent information is also target to a yellow solid circle and issues an
shown. TCAS targets are only depicted audio warning of "Traffic, traffic". This is shown. TCAS targets are only depicted audio warning of "Traffic, traffic". This is
when in the EXP VOR/ILS, MAP or CTR referred to as a TA (Traffic Alert). When when in the EXP VOR/ILS, MAP or CTR referred to as a TA (Traffic Alert). When
MAP display mode of the EHSI and the the TCAS computer has determined that MAP display mode of the EHSI and the the TCAS computer has determined that
TFC (traffic) button in. the target's flight path may lead to a colli- TFC (traffic) button in. the target's flight path may lead to a colli-
A non-threatening target will appear as a sion, the symbol changes to a red solid A non-threatening target will appear as a sion, the symbol changes to a red solid
white diamond outline. If altitude infor- square and an audio warning of a pitch white diamond outline. If altitude infor- square and an audio warning of a pitch
mation is received from the other aircraft, maneuver is given. This is referred to as a mation is received from the other aircraft, maneuver is given. This is referred to as a
it will be shown next to the symbol. If the RA (Resolution Advisory). On the EADI a it will be shown next to the symbol. If the RA (Resolution Advisory). On the EADI a
TCAS/ATC panel has REL (relative) set of red avoidance area outlines will TCAS/ATC panel has REL (relative) set of red avoidance area outlines will
selected, a two digit number representing appear, indicating the pitch attitudes to selected, a two digit number representing appear, indicating the pitch attitudes to
hundreds of feet and a + or - sign will rep- stay out of to avoid the threatening air- hundreds of feet and a + or - sign will rep- stay out of to avoid the threatening air-
resent the target's relative altitude to the craft. When the TCAS computer has resent the target's relative altitude to the craft. When the TCAS computer has
aircraft. If the TCAS/ATC panel has ABS determined that the RA maneuver has aircraft. If the TCAS/ATC panel has ABS determined that the RA maneuver has
(absolute) selected, a three digit number resolved the collision condition, an audio (absolute) selected, a three digit number resolved the collision condition, an audio
will represent the target's altitude above of "Clear of conflict" is heard. will represent the target's altitude above of "Clear of conflict" is heard.
sea level. An arrow pointing up or down Fault Indications sea level. An arrow pointing up or down Fault Indications
will appear next to the target symbol when A fault of the ATC system is annunciated will appear next to the target symbol when A fault of the ATC system is annunciated
the target is climbing or descending at 500 by the red FAIL light on the TCAS/ATC the target is climbing or descending at 500 by the red FAIL light on the TCAS/ATC
ft or more per minute. Control Panel. This indicates a fault in the ft or more per minute. Control Panel. This indicates a fault in the
selected ATC system. A fault in the TCAS selected ATC system. A fault in the TCAS
+09
+09 TCAS Other system is annunciated by "TCAS FAIL" in TCAS Other
Traffic and
system is annunciated by "TCAS FAIL" in
Traffic and blue on the EHSI. Relative blue on the EHSI.
Relative Altitude (White)
Altitude (White)
TCAS Proximate
TCAS Proximate Traffic and
Traffic and Relative Altitude
Relative Altitude (White)
(White) -05
-05
+02 TCAS Traffic
+02 TCAS Traffic Advisory TA)
Advisory TA) and Relative
and Relative Altitude (Amber)
Altitude (Amber)
TCAS Resolution
TCAS Resolution Advisory (RA)
Advisory (RA) and Relative
and Relative -03 Altitude (Red)
-03 Altitude (Red)
TCAS Target Symbols TCAS Target Symbols

and
OCT 99 Systems Introduction 34-55 OCT 99 34-55
UNITED
B737 GENERAL AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

OPERATION Descend, descend now, descend, descend OPERATION Descend, descend now, descend, descend
When the system circuit breakers are now. When the system circuit breakers are now.
closed the units are powered. The tran- Self Test closed the units are powered. The tran- Self Test
sponders systems will be in a warm-up A self test of the system can be initiated by sponders systems will be in a warm-up A self test of the system can be initiated
mode until airborne, when the Transpon- the mode selector switch on the TCAS/ mode until airborne, when the Transpon- by the mode selector switch on the TCAS/
der selected on the control panel will reply ATC Control Panel. When the switch is der selected on the control panel will reply ATC Control Panel. When the switch is
to interrogations. The TCAS system will placed in the TEST position for at least to interrogations. The TCAS system will placed in the TEST position for at least
interrogate when the control panel selector one second. The transponder selected by interrogate when the control panel selector one second. The transponder selected by
is in the TA or TA/RA position. the system select switch will be tested. is in the TA or TA/RA position. the system select switch will be tested.
When the Transponder is being interro- The EHSI should be in a EXP VOR/ILS, When the Transponder is being interro- The EHSI should be in a EXP VOR/ILS,
gated by a ground station or an aircraft MAP or CTR MAP display mode, the gated by a ground station or an aircraft MAP or CTR MAP display mode, the
with TCAS, the Transponder replies with TFC button pushed in, and the ten mile with TCAS, the Transponder replies with TFC button pushed in, and the ten mile
a signal that has the altitude of the aircraft range selected. The code display window a signal that has the altitude of the aircraft range selected. The code display window
encoded on the signal. This altitude comes will show eights, FAIL light illuminates encoded on the signal. This altitude comes will show eights, FAIL light illuminates
from the Air Data Computers (ADC). If momentarily, the EADI will have two red from the Air Data Computers (ADC). If momentarily, the EADI will have two red
both aircraft have Mode S Transponders, avoidance outlines, and the EHSI will both aircraft have Mode S Transponders, avoidance outlines, and the EHSI will
information on aircraft identification and have four depicted targets, TCAS TEST information on aircraft identification and have four depicted targets, TCAS TEST
coordinated avoidance maneuvers can be will appear on the left of the EHSI, and an coordinated avoidance maneuvers can be will appear on the left of the EHSI, and an
transmitted between them. audio of "TCAS System Test OK" will be transmitted between them. audio of "TCAS System Test OK" will be
The TCAS system sends out an interroga- heard. This test should be accomplished The TCAS system sends out an interroga- heard. This test should be accomplished
tion signal that any aircraft in the area for the other transponder system. tion signal that any aircraft in the area with for the other transponder system.
with an operating transponder system will A test failure is indicated by a audio an operating transponder system will A test failure is indicated by a audio
reply. The TCAS computer receives infor- "TCAS System Test Fail" and an appro- reply. The TCAS computer receives infor- "TCAS System Test Fail" and an appro-
mation from the left IRU and ADCs to priate red fail LED on the ATC Transpon- mation from the left IRU and ADCs to priate red fail LED on the ATC Transpon-
determine the aircraft's position and flight der Unit or TCAS Computer. determine the aircraft's position and flight der Unit or TCAS Computer.
path. The threat target's position is sensed path. The threat target's position is sensed
by the directional antennas' reception pat- by the directional antennas' reception pat-
tern of the reply signal. The TCAS com- tern of the reply signal. The TCAS com-
puter determines the flight path of both puter determines the flight path of both
aircraft to determine if a TA or RA is aircraft to determine if a TA or RA is
given. given.
The Audio annunciations for a TA are: The Audio annunciations for a TA are:
Climb, climb, climb. Climb, climb, climb.
Climb, crossing climb, climb, crossing Climb, crossing climb, climb, crossing
climb. climb.
Descend, descend, descend. Descend, descend, descend.
Descend, crossing descend, descend, Descend, crossing descend, descend,
crossing descend. crossing descend.
Reduce climb, reduce climb. Reduce climb, reduce climb.
Reduce decent, reduce descent. Reduce decent, reduce descent.
Increase climb, increase climb. Increase climb, increase climb.
Increase decent, increase descent. Increase decent, increase descent.
Climb, climb now, climb, climb now. Climb, climb now, climb, climb now.

34-56 and Systems Introduction OCT 99 34-56 OCT 99


UNITED AIRLINES COURSE
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

MCP SPD ALT HOLD VOR/LOC CMD MCP SPD ALT HOLD VOR/LOC CMD

20 20
20 20
340 340
10 10
10 10
320 320
31 32 31 32
300 300
10 10
280
10 10
280

.750 .750

0.0 NM TRK 270 M 0000.0 z 0.0 NM TRK 270 M 0000.0 z

27 27
30 30
24 24

TRAFFIC TRAFFIC
3

3
1

1
TCAS TEST 5 5
TCAS TEST
+10 +10
-10 -10

+02 +02
-02 -02

TCAS Test Targets on EHSI & EADI TCAS Test Targets on EHSI & EADI

and
OCT 99 Systems Introduction 34-57 OCT 99 34-57
UNITED
B737 GENERAL AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

ATC Transponder Unit BITE ATC Transponder Unit BITE


The Transponder Unit BITE can be initi- The Transponder Unit BITE can be initi-
ated by pressing the TEST switch on the ated by pressing the TEST switch on the
unit. All LEDs should illuminate, then the unit. All LEDs should illuminate, then the
system will check all components. If the system will check all components. If the
test is satisfactory, the green PASS light test is satisfactory, the green PASS light
will illuminate. If a fault is detected the will illuminate. If a fault is detected the
appropriate red LED will be illuminated. appropriate red LED will be illuminated.
TCAS Computer BITE TCAS Computer BITE
The TCAS Computer BITE can be initi- The TCAS Computer BITE can be initi-
ated by pressing the TEST switch on the ated by pressing the TEST switch on the
unit. All LEDs should illuminate, then the unit. All LEDs should illuminate, then the
system will check all components. If the system will check all components. If the
test is satisfactory, the green PASS light test is satisfactory, the green PASS light
will illuminate. If a fault is detected the will illuminate. If a fault is detected the
appropriate red LED will be illuminated. appropriate red LED will be illuminated.
External Test Equipment External Test Equipment
A T-48 tester unit is used to test the TCAS A T-48 tester unit is used to test the TCAS
system. system.

34-58 and Systems Introduction OCT 99 34-58 OCT 99


34-60
115V AC
ELEC
PWR 2
WEATHER
RADAR R/T
NAVIGATION

ARINC 429
P6-1 CONTROL
WXR BUS
CONTROL ON/OFF
PANEL

ARINC 453
DATA BUS L EFIS
LEFT IRU SYMBOL CAPT'S
EHSI
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

GENERATOR
B737 GENERAL

and Systems Introduction


RIGHT IRU
UNITED

NORMAL ATITUDE WXR


SOURCE BOTH ON 2
R/T
SELECT
NORMAL

Weather Radar System


BOTH ON R BOTH ON 1
AIRLINES

IRS XFER RLY-1 EFI SOURCE


ARINC 429 SEL SW
FAMILIARIZATION

CAPT EFIS CONTROL


B737-322/522

CONTROL BUS ANTENNA


PANEL ASSEMBLY

ARINC 429
COURSE

F/O EFIS CONTROL ARINC 453 R EFIS


CONTROL BUS RANGE DATA BUS SYMBOL F/O'S
PANEL GENERATOR EHSI

OCT 99
AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE

34-60
115V AC
ELEC
PWR 2
WEATHER
RADAR R/T
NAVIGATION

ARINC 429
P6-1 CONTROL
WXR BUS
CONTROL ON/OFF
PANEL

ARINC 453
DATA BUS L EFIS
LEFT IRU SYMBOL CAPT'S
GENERATOR EHSI
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

RIGHT IRU

NORMAL ATITUDE WXR


SOURCE BOTH ON 2
R/T
SELECT
NORMAL
Weather Radar System

BOTH ON R BOTH ON 1
UNITED AIRLINES

IRS XFER RLY-1 EFI SOURCE


ARINC 429 SEL SW
CAPT EFIS CONTROL
BUS ANTENNA
B737-322/522

CONTROL
PANEL ASSEMBLY

ARINC 429
F/O EFIS CONTROL ARINC 453 R EFIS
CONTROL BUS RANGE DATA BUS SYMBOL F/O'S
PANEL GENERATOR EHSI
OCT 99
AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
UNITED AIRLINES COURSE
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

WEATHER RADAR SYSTEM CAUTION: Do not operate the Weather WEATHER RADAR SYSTEM CAUTION: Do not operate the Weather
The Weather Radar System is a naviga- Radar System when there are large The Weather Radar System is a naviga- Radar System when there are large
tional system which uses the reflective metallic objects vehicles, hangars, air- tional system which uses the reflective metallic objects vehicles, hangars, air-
characteristic of water particles on micro- craft, etc.) within 180 degrees of the characteristic of water particles on micro- craft, etc.) within 180 degrees of the
wave pulses. The flight crew uses visual antenna out to 300 ft. wave pulses. The flight crew uses visual antenna out to 300 ft.
representations of precipitation to avoid WARNING: Do not operate the system representations of precipitation to avoid WARNING: Do not operate the system
hazardous weather. The range of operation when fueling operations are being done hazardous weather. The range of operation when fueling operations are being done
can extend to 320 miles and different on the aircraft or within 300 feet of the can extend to 320 miles and different on the aircraft or within 300 feet of the
intensities of precipitation can be depicted antenna. intensities of precipitation can be depicted antenna.
in color on the EHSIs, turbulence can also WARNING: Do not operate the system in color on the EHSIs, turbulence can also WARNING: Do not operate the system
be indicated. if personnel are within 50 feet of the be indicated. if personnel are within 50 feet of the
There is one weather radar system antenna. There is one weather radar system antenna.
installed, the system consists of; a installed, the system consists of; a
Receiver/Transmitter (R/T) Unit, an Receiver/Transmitter (R/T) Unit, an
Antenna Unit, and a Weather Radar Con- Antenna Unit, and a Weather Radar Con-
trol Panel. Some controls for the system trol Panel. Some controls for the system
are located on the EFIS Control Panels. are located on the EFIS Control Panels.
The color depiction of precipitation and The color depiction of precipitation and
turbulence appear on the EHSIs. Inputs turbulence appear on the EHSIs. Inputs
from the IRU are used for antenna stabili- from the IRU are used for antenna stabili-
zation. There are no other interfaces of the zation. There are no other interfaces of the
system. system.

and
OCT 99 Systems Introduction 34-61 OCT 99 34-61
UNITED
B737 GENERAL AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

Receiver/Transmitter Unit Antenna Unit Receiver/Transmitter Unit Antenna Unit


The Receiver/Transmitter (R/T) Unit is The Antenna Unit is located on the front The Receiver/Transmitter (R/T) Unit is The Antenna Unit is located on the front
located on a rack in the forward nose com- of the nose pressure bulkhead in the located on a rack in the forward nose com- of the nose pressure bulkhead in the
partment. It is installed longitudinally with radome area. It consists of a pedestal and partment. It is installed longitudinally with radome area. It consists of a pedestal and
the front of the unit to the left. The R/T antenna plate. The pedestal contains a the front of the unit to the left. The R/T antenna plate. The pedestal contains a
unit transmits, receives, and processes the power supply, motor driver, receiver/mon- unit transmits, receives, and processes the power supply, motor driver, receiver/mon-
radar pulses, it supplies antenna stabiliza- itor driver, incremental and zero monitors, radar pulses, it supplies antenna stabiliza- itor driver, incremental and zero monitors,
tion signals and provides system monitor- and scan and elevation stepper motors. tion signals and provides system monitor- and scan and elevation stepper motors.
ing. The antenna stabilization uses IRU Also, there are scan and elevation disable ing. The antenna stabilization uses IRU Also, there are scan and elevation disable
pitch and roll information. The R/T unit switches inside the pedestal used when pitch and roll information. The R/T unit switches inside the pedestal used when
does not use equipment cooling, there is a performing maintenance. does not use equipment cooling, there is a performing maintenance.
fan mounted in the rack, it has a push but- NOTE: There is no waveguide between fan mounted in the rack, it has a push but- NOTE: There is no waveguide between
ton to test the fan when the R/T unit is the R/T unit and antenna, it is a coax ton to test the fan when the R/T unit is the R/T unit and antenna, it is a coax
removed. cable. removed. cable.

ANTENNA FLAT ANTENNA FLAT


PLATE RADIATOR PLATE RADIATOR
ELEVATION AND ELEVATION AND
AZIMUTH SCAN AZIMUTH SCAN
SWITCHES SWITCHES

ELECTRICAL ELECTRICAL
CONNECTOR CONNECTOR

RECEIVER/ RECEIVER/
TRANSMITTER TRANSMITTER

COAX CABLE COAX CABLE


ASSEMBLY ASSEMBLY

Antenna/Wave Guide Assembly Antenna/Wave Guide Assembly

34-62 and Systems Introduction OCT 99 34-62 OCT 99


UNITED AIRLINES COURSE
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

Weather Radar Control Panel CAUTION: Forcing the TILT knob Weather Radar Control Panel CAUTION: Forcing the TILT knob
The Weather Radar Control Panel is beyond 15 degrees can break the knob. The Weather Radar Control Panel is beyond 15 degrees can break the knob.
located in the center of the P-9 forward The TURB DET (Turbulence Detection) located in the center of the P-9 forward The TURB DET (Turbulence Detection)
electronics panel between the CDUs. It switch has three positions, in the center electronics panel between the CDUs. It switch has three positions, in the center
contains most of the controls for the sys- BOTH position, both precipitation and contains most of the controls for the sys- BOTH position, both precipitation and
tem. The function selector is located on turbulence returns are depicted. When tem. The function selector is located on turbulence returns are depicted. When
the left side of the panel. The TEST posi- moved to the right DOPPLER ONLY the left side of the panel. The TEST posi- moved to the right DOPPLER ONLY
tion performs a self test of the system position, only turbulence returns are tion performs a self test of the system position, only turbulence returns are
which is displayed on the EHSI. The depicted and the DOPPLER ONLY light which is displayed on the EHSI. The depicted and the DOPPLER ONLY light
NORM position allows normal operation illuminates. When moved to the left PRE- NORM position allows normal operation illuminates. When moved to the left PRE-
of the system. The PCIP LEVEL position CIP ONLY, only precipitation returns are of the system. The PCIP LEVEL position CIP ONLY, only precipitation returns are
varies the sensitivity of the system from depicted on the EHSIs and the PRECIP varies the sensitivity of the system from depicted on the EHSIs and the PRECIP
MID to MAX, this only affects returns ONLY light illuminates. MID to MAX, this only affects returns ONLY light illuminates.
within 50 miles. The GND RTN (Ground NOTE: The PRECIP ONLY and DOP- within 50 miles. The GND RTN (Ground NOTE: The PRECIP ONLY and DOP-
Return) switch is spring loaded to the ON PLER ONLY light illumination may not Return) switch is spring loaded to the ON PLER ONLY light illumination may not
position, when moved to the OFF position, be visible in daylight. position, when moved to the OFF position, be visible in daylight.
ground return echoes are suppressed. The ground return echoes are suppressed. The
Tilt Knob allows selection of the angle of Tilt Knob allows selection of the angle of
antenna tilt from fifteen degrees UP or antenna tilt from fifteen degrees UP or
DOWN. DOWN.

WX RADAR WX RADAR
NORM TEST NORM TEST

MID
TILT MID
TILT
5 5
15 15
PCIP PCIP
LEVEL UP LEVEL UP
MAX TURB DET MAX TURB DET
GND RTN 0 PRECIP DOPPLER GND RTN 0 PRECIP DOPPLER

DOWN DOWN
OFF ON 15 ONLY ONLY OFF ON 15 ONLY ONLY
5 BOTH 5 BOTH

Weather Radar Control Panel Weather Radar Control Panel

and
OCT 99 Systems Introduction 34-63 OCT 99 34-63
UNITED
B737 GENERAL AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

EFIS Control Panel EHSI Display EFIS Control Panel EHSI Display
The EFIS Control Panel has the controls The EHSI will display the weather radar The EFIS Control Panel has the controls The EHSI will display the weather radar
for depicting the range of the weather returns in various colors representing for depicting the range of the weather returns in various colors representing
radar depictions on the EHSIs. It also has intensity of precipitation and turbulence. radar depictions on the EHSIs. It also has intensity of precipitation and turbulence.
the WXR switch to turn ON the system. Green indicates precipitation of 0.03 to the WXR switch to turn ON the system. Green indicates precipitation of 0.03 to
WARNING: Both EFIS Control Panels' 0.15 inches per hour, yellow indicates WARNING: Both EFIS Control Panels' 0.15 inches per hour, yellow indicates
WXR switches must be off to turn off from 0.15 to 0.5 in/hr, and red indicates WXR switches must be off to turn off from 0.15 to 0.5 in/hr, and red indicates
the weather radar system. more than 0.5 in/hr. Magenta represents the weather radar system. more than 0.5 in/hr. Magenta represents
The center BRT (Brightness) knob con- areas of detected turbulence. The center BRT (Brightness) knob con- areas of detected turbulence.
trols the intensity of the weather radar trols the intensity of the weather radar
returns on the EHSI. returns on the EHSI.
NOTE: The mode selected must be NOTE: The mode selected must be
either; EXP VOR/ILS, MAP, or CTR either; EXP VOR/ILS, MAP, or CTR
MAP, to see the weather radar returns MAP, to see the weather radar returns
on the EHSI. on the EHSI.

HSI ADI HSI RANGE


ADI RANGE FULL EXP
DH REF
FULL EXP DH REF VOR/ILS VOR/ILS 160 320
VOR/ILS VOR/ILS 160 320 80
80
MAP 40
MAP 40
20 C
20 C TF
CTR TF CTR
10
10 MAP
MAP BRT
BRT PLAN WXR
PLAN WXR

ON ON
RST RST
MAP MAP
BRT BRT VOR/ADF NAV AID ARPT RTE DATA WPT
VOR/ADF NAV AID ARPT RTE DATA WPT

ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON

EFIS Control Panel EFIS Control Panel

34-64 and Systems Introduction OCT 99 34-64 OCT 99


UNITED AIRLINES COURSE
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

OPERATION Maintenance Practices OPERATION Maintenance Practices


CAUTION: Do not operate the Weather CAUTION: Care should be taken when CAUTION: Do not operate the Weather CAUTION: Care should be taken when
Radar System when there are large opening or closing the radome in winds. Radar System when there are large opening or closing the radome in winds.
metallic objects vehicles, hangars, air- Also safe ladder practices should be metallic objects vehicles, hangars, air- Also safe ladder practices should be
craft, etc.) within 180 degrees of the adhered to. craft, etc.) within 180 degrees of the adhered to.
antenna out to 300 ft. When finished working in the radome antenna out to 300 ft. When finished working in the radome
WARNING: Do not operate the system area, wipe any moisture on the radar WARNING: Do not operate the system area, wipe any moisture on the radar
when fueling operations are being done antenna plate. The moisture may reflect when fueling operations are being done antenna plate. The moisture may reflect
on the aircraft or within 300 feet of the the signals causing erratic return signals. on the aircraft or within 300 feet of the the signals causing erratic return signals.
antenna. Water or ice in the honeycomb of the antenna. Water or ice in the honeycomb of the
WARNING: Do not operate the system radome can cause erratic returns on the WARNING: Do not operate the system radome can cause erratic returns on the
if personnel are within 50 feet of the EHSI. if personnel are within 50 feet of the EHSI.
antenna. Self Test antenna. Self Test
To operate the system, the EFIS Control The WXR Self Test is initiated by moving To operate the system, the EFIS Control The WXR Self Test is initiated by moving
Panel must be in EXP VOR/ILS, MAP, or the WXR Control Panel mode selector to Panel must be in EXP VOR/ILS, MAP, or the WXR Control Panel mode selector to
CTR MAP modes and have the WXR the TEST position. Then pushing on the CTR MAP modes and have the WXR the TEST position. Then pushing on the
switch selected to ON. The WXR Control WXR switch on the EFIS Control Panel. switch selected to ON. The WXR Control WXR switch on the EFIS Control Panel.
Panel can be in the NORM, MAX, or MID A test pattern on the EHSI appears. Panel can be in the NORM, MAX, or MID A test pattern on the EHSI appears.
position. The tilt angle is selected. The position. The tilt angle is selected. The
system is turned off by pressing on the system is turned off by pressing on the
WXR switch on the EFIS Control Panel. WXR switch on the EFIS Control Panel.
WARNING: Both EFIS Control Panels' WARNING: Both EFIS Control Panels'
WXR switches must be off to turn off WXR switches must be off to turn off
the weather radar system. the weather radar system.
GREEN
GREEN
MAGENTA
MAGENTA

RED
RED

YELLOW
YELLOW

WXR Return Colors WXR Return Colors

and
OCT 99 Systems Introduction 34-65 OCT 99 34-65
UNITED
B737 GENERAL AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

NORMAL TEST DISPLAY FAILURE DISPLAY


NORMAL TEST DISPLAY FAILURE DISPLAY

TRK M
TRK M TRK 127 M
TRK 127 M

40
40
WXR
WXR TEST FAIL
TEST FAIL

ANT
ANT

WX TEST DEFECTIVE
WX TEST DEFECTIVE WXR TEST
WXR TEST PASS/FAIL LRU(S) CONDITION
PASS/FAIL LRU(S) CONDITION PATTERN
PATTERN (YELLOW) (CYAN)
(YELLOW) (CYAN)

WX TEST BLANK TEST PASS ON


WX TEST BLANK TEST PASS ON

WX FAIL RT RECEIVER/TRANSMITTER OFF


WX FAIL RT RECEIVER/TRANSMITTER OFF
FAULT
FAULT
WX FAIL ANT ANTENNA FAULT OFF
WX FAIL ANT ANTENNA FAULT OFF

WX FAIL CONT CONTROL FAULT OFF


WX FAIL CONT CONTROL FAULT OFF

WX FAIL ATT ATTITUDE INPUT FAULT OFF


WX FAIL ATT ATTITUDE INPUT FAULT OFF

WX FAIL WEAK CALIBRATION FAULT OFF


WX FAIL WEAK CALIBRATION FAULT OFF

WXR Test Pattern WXR Test Pattern

34-66 and Systems Introduction OCT 99 34-66 OCT 99


UNITED
B737 GENERAL AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

115V AC ELEX EFIS L 115V AC ELEX EFIS L


PWR BUS 1 WINDSHEAR PWR BUS 1 WINDSHEAR
WARNING WARNING
GND PROX EFIS R GND PROX EFIS R
WARNING WARNING
TRAFFIC TRAFFIC
DAA NO. 1 PULL UP ALERT DAA NO. 1 PULL UP ALERT
AND AND
PULL UP COLLISION PULL UP COLLISION
AVOIDANCE AVOIDANCE
VHF NAV SYSTEM VHF NAV SYSTEM
RECEIVER NO. 1 RECEIVER NO. 1

BELOW G/S BELOW G/S


RADIO P-INHIBIT RADIO P-INHIBIT
ALTITMETER NO. 1 ALTITMETER NO. 1
BELOW G/S BELOW G/S
GLIDE P-INHIBIT GLIDE P-INHIBIT
RADIO SLOPE RADIO SLOPE
ALTITMETER NO. 2 INHIBIT ALTITMETER NO. 2 INHIBIT
AUDIO DIGITAL AUDIO AUDIO DIGITAL AUDIO
DADC NO. 1 OUTPUT CONTROL SYSTEM DADC NO. 1 OUTPUT CONTROL SYSTEM

TEST GND TEST GND


IRU NO. 1 IRU NO. 1

DIGITAL STALL AIR DIGITAL STALL AIR


WARNING WARNING
COMPUTER NO. 1 AIR/GND COMPUTER NO. 1 AIR/GND
DIGITAL FLIGHT RELAY DIGITAL FLIGHT RELAY
DATA RECORDER DATA RECORDER
DIGITAL STALL SYSTEM DIGITAL STALL SYSTEM
WARNING WARNING
COMPUTER NO. 2 MONITOR INOP COMPUTER NO. 2 MONITOR INOP

FLAP FLAP FLAP FLAP


MODE CONTROL INHIBIT POSITION MODE CONTROL INHIBIT POSITION
PANEL SWITCH SWITCHES PANEL SWITCH SWITCHES

FMC FMC
GEAR GEAR
INHIBIT INHIBIT
SWITCH SWITCH
EFIS CONTROL LANDING EFIS CONTROL LANDING
PANEL GEAR PANEL GEAR
LEVER LEVER
GROUND PROXIMITY SWITCH GROUND PROXIMITY SWITCH
WARNING COMPUTER WARNING COMPUTER

GPWS System GPWS System

34-68 and Systems Introduction OCT 99 34-68 OCT 99


UNITED AIRLINES COURSE
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

GROUND PROXIMITY WARNING GROUND PROXIMITY WARNING


SYSTEM SYSTEM
The Ground Proximity Warning System The Ground Proximity Warning System
(GPWS) provides audio and visual indica- (GPWS) provides audio and visual indica-
tions of potentially dangerous flight paths tions of potentially dangerous flight paths
relative to the ground. There are seven relative to the ground. There are seven
modes that GPWS operates in: modes that GPWS operates in:
Mode 1 - Excessive rate of descent Mode 1 - Excessive rate of descent
Mode 2 - Excessive terrain closure rate Mode 2 - Excessive terrain closure rate
Mode 3 - Altitude loss after takeoff or go Mode 3 - Altitude loss after takeoff or go
around around
Mode 4 - Not in landing configuration at Mode 4 - Not in landing configuration at
too low altitude too low altitude
Mode 5 - Deviation below glideslope Mode 5 - Deviation below glideslope
Mode 6 - Altitude callouts Mode 6 - Altitude callouts
Mode 7 - Windshear Mode 7 - Windshear
The single GPWS consists of; a Ground The single GPWS consists of; a Ground
Proximity Warning Computer, two PULL Proximity Warning Computer, two PULL
UP warning lights, two BELOW G/S UP warning lights, two BELOW G/S
warning light/inhibit switches, and a warning light/inhibit switches, and a
GPWS Control Module. The system pro- GPWS Control Module. The system pro-
cesses signals from DAA 1, VHF NAV 1, cesses signals from DAA 1, VHF NAV 1,
LRRA 1, DADC 1, IRU 1, Stall Warning LRRA 1, DADC 1, IRU 1, Stall Warning
Computers, FMC, flap warning switches, Computers, FMC, flap warning switches,
landing gear logic shelf, and the landing landing gear logic shelf, and the landing
gear handle. Audio messages are sent to gear handle. Audio messages are sent to
the Remote Electronics Unit (REU). the Remote Electronics Unit (REU).
Windshear visual indications appear on Windshear visual indications appear on
the EADIs. the EADIs.

and
OCT 99 Systems Introduction 34-69 OCT 99 34-69
UNITED
B737 GENERAL AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

GPWS Computer PULL UP Warning Lights GPWS Computer PULL UP Warning Lights
The Ground Proximity Warning Computer The two red PULL UP warning lights are The Ground Proximity Warning Computer The two red PULL UP warning lights are
is located in the E2-4 rack, it determines located to the left of each EADI. They is located in the E2-4 rack, it determines located to the left of each EADI. They
the mode of operation and whether a illuminate when Modes 1, 2 or 4 issue a the mode of operation and whether a illuminate when Modes 1, 2 or 4 issue a
warning indication should be given to the audio warning. warning indication should be given to the audio warning.
flight crew. There is a LED readout for BELOW G/S Warning Lights flight crew. There is a LED readout for BELOW G/S Warning Lights
BITE results on the front of the unit. A The two amber BELOW G/S warning BITE results on the front of the unit. A The two amber BELOW G/S warning
STATUS/HISTORY switch starts the lights are located to the left of each EADI STATUS/HISTORY switch starts the lights are located to the left of each EADI
BITE test on the PRESENT STATUS under the PULL UP light. They illuminate BITE test on the PRESENT STATUS under the PULL UP light. They illuminate
position and recalls the fault history in the when Mode 5 issues a audio warning of position and recalls the fault history in the when Mode 5 issues a audio warning of
FLIGHT HISTORY position. being below glideslope 1.3 dots. The light FLIGHT HISTORY position. being below glideslope 1.3 dots. The light
may be pushed to inhibit below glideslope may be pushed to inhibit below glideslope
warnings. warnings.
BITE BITE
DISPLAY DISPLAY
GPWC SUNDSTRAND
GPWC SUNDSTRAND

PULL UP PULL UP

BELOW G/S BELOW G/S


STATUS/HISTORY P-INHIBIT STATUS/HISTORY P-INHIBIT
PRESENT FLIGHT PRESENT FLIGHT
STATUS HISTORY STATUS HISTORY

Warning Lights Warning Lights

STATUS/ STATUS/
HISTORY HISTORY
SWITCH SWITCH

GPWS Computer GPWS Computer

34-70 and Systems Introduction OCT 99 34-70 OCT 99


UNITED AIRLINES COURSE
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

GPWS Control Module GPWS Control Module


The GPWS Control Module is located on The GPWS Control Module is located on
the bottom left of the P3-7 panel. It has a the bottom left of the P3-7 panel. It has a
amber INOP light which illuminates when amber INOP light which illuminates when
there is a GPWS problem. The SYS TEST there is a GPWS problem. The SYS TEST
button initiates a confidence test of the button initiates a confidence test of the
system. system.
Audio Indications Audio Indications
The audio warning messages are sent to The audio warning messages are sent to
the REU. the REU.

GROUND PROXIMITY GROUND PROXIMITY

INOP INOP
FLAP GEAR FLAP GEAR
INHIBIT INHIBIT INHIBIT INHIBIT

SYS TEST SYS TEST


NORMAL NORMAL NORMAL NORMAL

AIRPLANES WITH SEPARATE FLAP AND GEAR INHIBIT SWITCHES AIRPLANES WITH SEPARATE FLAP AND GEAR INHIBIT SWITCHES

GROUND PROXIMITY GROUND PROXIMITY


FLAP/GEAR FLAP/GEAR
INOP INHIBIT INOP INHIBIT

SYS TEST SYS TEST


NORMAL NORMAL

AIRPLANES WITH SINGLE FLAP/GEAR INHIBIT SWITCH AIRPLANES WITH SINGLE FLAP/GEAR INHIBIT SWITCH

GPWS Control Module GPWS Control Module

and
OCT 99 Systems Introduction 34-71 OCT 99 34-71
UNITED
B737 GENERAL AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

GPWS GPWS
AURAL MESSAGE MODE ANNUNCIATIONS AURAL MESSAGE ANNUNCIATIONS
MODE
Glide Slope 5 BELOW G/S lights (amber) Glide Slope 5 BELOW G/S lights (amber)
Whoop, Whoop, Pull Up 1 PULL UP lights (red) Whoop, Whoop, Pull Up 1 PULL UP lights (red)
Two tone siren 7 WINDSHEAR on EADI (red) Two tone siren 7 WINDSHEAR on EADI (red)
Wind Shear 7 WINDSHEAR on EADI (red) Wind Shear 7 WINDSHEAR on EADI (red)
Wind Shear 7 WINDSHEAR on EADI (red) Wind Shear 7 WINDSHEAR on EADI (red)
Wind Shear 7 WINDSHEAR on EADI (red) Wind Shear 7 WINDSHEAR on EADI (red)
Sink Rate 1 Sink Rate 1
Whoop, Whoop, Pull Up 1 Whoop, Whoop, Pull Up 1
Terrain 2 Terrain 2
Whoop, Whoop, Pull Up 2 Whoop, Whoop, Pull Up 2
Don’t Sink 3 Don’t Sink 3
Too Low Terrain 4A Too Low Terrain 4A
Too Low Gear 4A Too Low Gear 4A
Too Low Flaps 4B Too Low Flaps 4B
Too Low Terrain 4B Too Low Terrain 4B
Glide Slope 5 Glide Slope 5
2500, 500, 50, 30, 10 6 2500, 500, 50, 30, 10 6
Two tone siren 7 Two tone siren 7
Wind Shear 7 Wind Shear 7
Wind Shear 7 Wind Shear 7
Wind Shear 7 Wind Shear 7

GPWS Mode Audio/Lite Chart GPWS Mode Audio/Lite Chart

34-72 and Systems Introduction OCT 99 34-72 OCT 99


UNITED AIRLINES COURSE
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

OPERATION BITE OPERATION BITE


Confidence Test The GPWS Computer has front panel Confidence Test The GPWS Computer has front panel
The Confidence Self Test is initiated by BITE. The switch on the GPWS Computer The Confidence Self Test is initiated by BITE. The switch on the GPWS Computer
pressing the SYS TEST button on the is move to the PRESENT STATUS posi- pressing the SYS TEST button on the is move to the PRESENT STATUS posi-
GPWS Control Module for less than 5 sec- tion to perform a self test. The return of GPWS Control Module for less than 5 sec- tion to perform a self test. The return of
onds. The aural message "Glideslope, GPWS OK indicates no faults were found. onds. The aural message "Glideslope, GPWS OK indicates no faults were found.
glideslope" will be heard with the amber If faults are found, the display will show glideslope" will be heard with the amber If faults are found, the display will show
BELOW G/S lights illuminating and the the system and fault. Moving the switch to BELOW G/S lights illuminating and the the system and fault. Moving the switch to
GPWS Control Module INOP light illumi- the FLIGHT HISTORY position shows GPWS Control Module INOP light illumi- the FLIGHT HISTORY position shows
nating. This is followed by the aural warn- the faults for the last ten flights. If faults nating. This is followed by the aural warn- the faults for the last ten flights. If faults
ing "Whoop, whoop, pull up" and the red are recorded, the system, fault and number ing "Whoop, whoop, pull up" and the red are recorded, the system, fault and number
PULL UP lights illuminating. Then all of flights ago shows on the display. PULL UP lights illuminating. Then all of flights ago shows on the display.
lights will be extinguished. If a fault is lights will be extinguished. If a fault is
present, the INOP light will illuminate present, the INOP light will illuminate
with no aural annunciations. with no aural annunciations.
Full Vocabulary Test Full Vocabulary Test
The Full Vocabulary Self Test is initiated The Full Vocabulary Self Test is initiated
by pressing the SYS TEST button on the by pressing the SYS TEST button on the
GPWS Control Module for more than 5 GPWS Control Module for more than 5
seconds. In addition to the Confidence seconds. In addition to the Confidence
Self Test results, the full vocabulary will Self Test results, the full vocabulary will
be heard for the GPWS. be heard for the GPWS.

and
OCT 99 Systems Introduction 34-73 OCT 99 34-73
UNITED
B737 GENERAL AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

VOR/LOC VOR/LOC
ANTENNA ANTENNA
CRUISE CRUISE
BEARING AND BEARING AND
DEVIATION TO DEVIATION TO
LOC NAVIGATION NAVIGATION
SYSTEMS AND LOC
ANTENNA APPROACH ANTENNA APPROACH SYSTEMS AND
INSTRUMENTS INSTRUMENTS
RECEIVERS RECEIVERS
AND AND
PROCESSORS PROCESSORS

GLIDE SLOPE GLIDE SLOPE


ANTENNA ANTENNA
AUDIO TO DIGITAL AUDIO TO DIGITAL
AUDIO CONTROL AUDIO CONTROL
SYSTEM SYSTEM
MANUAL MANUAL
TUNING AND TUNING AND
MODE CONTROL MODE CONTROL
VHF NAV RECEIVER VHF NAV RECEIVER

AUTOMATIC AUTOMATIC
TUNING TUNING

VOR/ILS System VOR/ILS System

34-74 and Systems Introduction OCT 99 34-74 OCT 99


UNITED AIRLINES COURSE
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

VOR/ILS SYSTEM NAV Receiver Unit VOR/ILS SYSTEM NAV Receiver Unit
The VOR/ILS System provides informa- The NAV Receiver Unit is a combination The VOR/ILS System provides informa- The NAV Receiver Unit is a combination
tion of the aircraft's position with respect VOR, localizer, and glide slope receiver, tion of the aircraft's position with respect VOR, localizer, and glide slope receiver,
to, and deviation from selected VOR they are located in the E3-4 rack. The to, and deviation from selected VOR they are located in the E3-4 rack. The
course or localizer and glideslope receiver processes VOR, localizer, and course or localizer and glideslope receiver processes VOR, localizer, and
approach radio signals. In formation is glideslope signals and provide outputs of approach radio signals. In formation is glideslope signals and provide outputs of
also provided indicating the bearing to ground station bearing, course deviation, also provided indicating the bearing to ground station bearing, course deviation,
VOR stations. and warning flag valids for the RDDMIs, VOR stations. and warning flag valids for the RDDMIs,
There are two complete systems. Each DFCS, EFIS, and GPWS. There are two complete systems. Each DFCS, EFIS, and GPWS.
consists of; a NAV Receiver Unit (VOR consists of; a NAV Receiver Unit (VOR
and ILS), a NAV Control Panel a dual and ILS), a NAV Control Panel a dual
VOR/Localizer antenna, a dual glideslope VOR/Localizer antenna, a dual glideslope
antenna, and a dual localizer antenna. The antenna, and a dual localizer antenna. The
system indications appear on the RDD- system indications appear on the RDD-
MIs, EADIs and EHSIs. The Digital Flight MIs, EADIs and EHSIs. The Digital Flight
Control System (DFCS) Mode Control Control System (DFCS) Mode Control
Panel (MCP) has a course selector knob Panel (MCP) has a course selector knob
and window used for course selection. and window used for course selection.
Audio signals from the VOR/ILS are sent Audio signals from the VOR/ILS are sent
to the Remote Electronics Unit (REU). to the Remote Electronics Unit (REU).
Other users of VOR/ILS information are; Other users of VOR/ILS information are;
DFCS and Ground Proximity Warning DFCS and Ground Proximity Warning
System (GPWS). System (GPWS).

and
OCT 99 Systems Introduction 34-75 OCT 99 34-75
UNITED
B737 GENERAL AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

NAV Control Panel NOTE: The manual VOR frequency NAV Control Panel NOTE: The manual VOR frequency
The NAV Control Panel is located on the can still be changed with the red bar The NAV Control Panel is located on the can still be changed with the red bar
forward area of the Aft Electronics Panel. across the window. forward area of the Aft Electronics Panel. across the window.
The No. 1 system panel is on the left side The AUTO window displays the fre- The No. 1 system panel is on the left side The AUTO window displays the fre-
and the No. 2 panel is on the right side. quency used by the FMCS auto-tuning cir- and the No. 2 panel is on the right side. quency used by the FMCS auto-tuning cir-
NOTE: This panel is also referred to as cuit. The window is blank in the MAN NOTE: This panel is also referred to as cuit. The window is blank in the MAN
the NAV Tuning Panel. mode. A set of dashes in the window indi- the NAV Tuning Panel. mode. A set of dashes in the window indi-
The panel contains the controls for tuning, cates the FMCS is in agility tuning mode. The panel contains the controls for tuning, cates the FMCS is in agility tuning mode.
controlling and testing the VOR and ILS The two TEST switches are three position controlling and testing the VOR and ILS The two TEST switches are three position
systems. The right display window shows toggle switches, spring loaded to the cen- systems. The right display window shows toggle switches, spring loaded to the cen-
the manually selected frequency using the ter neutral position. The VOR-DME the manually selected frequency using the ter neutral position. The VOR-DME
frequency selector knobs. The AUTO/ switch performs a self test of the selected frequency selector knobs. The AUTO/ switch performs a self test of the selected
MAN button is an alternate action switch system. The UP/LT-DN/RT switch per- MAN button is an alternate action switch system. The UP/LT-DN/RT switch per-
that selects either manual or automatic forms a test of the ILS indications. that selects either manual or automatic forms a test of the ILS indications.
tuning of the NAV system. The appropri- VOR/LOC Antenna tuning of the NAV system. The appropri- VOR/LOC Antenna
ate mode is illuminated on the switch. In The dual VOR/Localizer Antenna assem- ate mode is illuminated on the switch. In The dual VOR/Localizer Antenna assem-
the MAN position, the manual window bly is integral with the tip of the vertical the MAN position, the manual window bly is integral with the tip of the vertical
frequency is used to tune the NAV sys- stabilizer. It contains the antenna for the frequency is used to tune the NAV system. stabilizer. It contains the antenna for the
tem. In the AUTO position, the Flight No. 1 and No. 2 systems. In the AUTO position, the Flight Manage- No. 1 and No. 2 systems.
Management Computer System (FMCS) NOTE: When tuned to a localizer fre- ment Computer System (FMCS) auto- NOTE: When tuned to a localizer fre-
auto-tunes the NAV frequency. When the quency, this antenna is used unless the tunes the NAV frequency. When the in the quency, this antenna is used unless the
in the AUTO position, a red bar appears DFCS system is in the approach mode. AUTO position, a red bar appears across DFCS system is in the approach mode.
across the manual window. the manual window.

AUTO NAV AUTO NAV MANUAL


MANUAL

AUTO AUTO
TEST TEST MANUAL
MANUAL

VOR UP/LT VOR UP/LT

DME DN/RT DME DN/RT

NAV Tuning Panel NAV Tuning Panel

34-76 and Systems Introduction OCT 99 34-76 OCT 99


UNITED AIRLINES COURSE
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

Glideslope Antenna ILS Relays Glideslope Antenna ILS Relays


The dual glideslope antenna is located The ILS relays are located in the E3-4 The dual glideslope antenna is located The ILS relays are located in the E3-4
above the radar antenna in the radome rack. They are energized by the DFCS above the radar antenna in the radome rack. They are energized by the DFCS
area. It contains the No. 1 and No. 2 system when in the approach mode. area. It contains the No. 1 and No. 2 system when in the approach mode.
antenna. There is a strip of aluminum tape DFCS Mode Control Panel antenna. There is a strip of aluminum tape DFCS Mode Control Panel
adhered to the interior surface of the The MCP located on the glareshield has adhered to the interior surface of the The MCP located on the glareshield has
radome, this increases the antenna's sensi- on the outboard sides a course select win- radome, this increases the antenna's sensi- on the outboard sides a course select win-
tivity, it is called the Glideslope Antenna dow and selector knob. The left side is for tivity, it is called the Glideslope Antenna dow and selector knob. The left side is for
Director Bar. the No. 1 system and the right for the No. Director Bar. the No. 1 system and the right for the No.
NOTE: The Glideslope Antenna Direc- 2 system. NOTE: The Glideslope Antenna Direc- 2 system.
tor Bar must be maintained per MM53- tor Bar must be maintained per MM53-
52-31p400 52-31p400
Localizer Antenna Localizer Antenna
The dual localizer antenna is located The dual localizer antenna is located
below the radar antenna in the radome below the radar antenna in the radome
area. It contains the No. 1 and No. 2 area. It contains the No. 1 and No. 2
antenna. This antenna is used to receive antenna. This antenna is used to receive
the localizer signals when the DFCS is in the localizer signals when the DFCS is in
the approach mode. the approach mode.

COURSE A/T COURSE A/T


ARM ARM

MA MA

ON OFF ON OFF

N1 N1
OFF OFF

Mode Control Panel Mode Control Panel

and
OCT 99 Systems Introduction 34-77 OCT 99 34-77
UNITED
B737 GENERAL AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

EFIS Control Panel EADI Indication EFIS Control Panel EADI Indication
The EFIS Control Panel is used to depict The EADI will show ILS deviation when a The EFIS Control Panel is used to depict The EADI will show ILS deviation when
on the EADI and EHSI, VOR and ILS localizer frequency is tuned to. The white on the EADI and EHSI, VOR and ILS a localizer frequency is tuned to. The
indications. In the FULL and EXP VOR/ glideslope deviation scale is located on the indications. In the FULL and EXP VOR/ white glideslope deviation scale is located
ILS modes, VOR or ILS deviation is right side of the display with a magenta ILS modes, VOR or ILS deviation is on the right side of the display with a
depicted pointer. The localizer deviation scale is depicted magenta pointer. The localizer deviation
EHSI Indication located on the bottom of the display with a EHSI Indication scale is located on the bottom of the dis-
The EHSI will depict the deviation from magenta pointer. The EHSI will depict the deviation from play with a magenta pointer.
course and to/from indication in the FULL NOTE: The glideslope deviation indica- course and to/from indication in the FULL NOTE: The glideslope deviation indica-
and EXP VOR/ILS modes. Course tions will not appear if the course and EXP VOR/ILS modes. Course tions will not appear if the course
selected is from the MCP controls. When selected is more than 90 degrees from selected is from the MCP controls. When selected is more than 90 degrees from
a localizer frequency is tuned, a glideslope the aircraft heading. a localizer frequency is tuned, a glideslope the aircraft heading.
deviation scale appears on the right side of RDDMI Indication deviation scale appears on the right side of RDDMI Indication
the indicator with a magenta pointer. The The RDDMIs can indicate the bearing to a the indicator with a magenta pointer. The The RDDMIs can indicate the bearing to a
VOR or localizer deviation bar is magenta VOR station. The No. 1 narrow needle VOR or localizer deviation bar is magenta VOR station. The No. 1 narrow needle
and moves along the course deviation points to the No. 1 VOR station and the and moves along the course deviation points to the No. 1 VOR station and the
scale. When tuned to a VOR station in No. 2 wide needle points to the No. 2 scale. When tuned to a VOR station in No. 2 wide needle points to the No. 2
FULL VOR/ILS display mode, a to or VOR station. The VOR/ADF bearing nee- FULL VOR/ILS display mode, a to or VOR station. The VOR/ADF bearing nee-
from arrow will be present. In both the dle selectors must be pushed to the VOR from arrow will be present. In both the dle selectors must be pushed to the VOR
FULL and EXP VOR/ILS modes the word position. FULL and EXP VOR/ILS modes the word position.
TO or FROM will appear in the lower NOTE: The needle will point to the 3:00 TO or FROM will appear in the lower NOTE: The needle will point to the 3:00
right corner. The frequency selected will position if a ILS frequency is selected. If right corner. The frequency selected will position if a ILS frequency is selected. If
appear in the lower right corner of the dis- there is a VOR power failure, the arrow appear in the lower right corner of the dis- there is a VOR power failure, the arrow
play. When in the MAP or CTR MAP flag will appear for the appropriate sys- play. When in the MAP or CTR MAP flag will appear for the appropriate sys-
modes, and having the EFIS Control Panel tem modes, and having the EFIS Control Panel tem
VOR/ADF switch selected to ON, green OPERATION VOR/ADF switch selected to ON, green OPERATION
vector lines will point to the received The VOR or ILS frequency is selected in vector lines will point to the received The VOR or ILS frequency is selected in
VOR stations. V1 is for VOR No. 1 and the manual window of the NAV Tuning VOR stations. V1 is for VOR No. 1 and the manual window of the NAV Tuning
V2 is for VOR No. 2. Panel. The station Morse code should be V2 is for VOR No. 2. Panel. The station Morse code should be
verified. The course selector is positioned verified. The course selector is positioned
to the appropriate course on the MCP. The to the appropriate course on the MCP. The
indications on the EHSI, EADI and RDD- indications on the EHSI, EADI and RDD-
V1

V1
MIs should be verified.
V2

V2
MIs should be verified.

EHSI VOR Indications EHSI VOR Indications

34-78 and Systems Introduction OCT 99 34-78 OCT 99


UNITED AIRLINES COURSE
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

VOR Self Test ILS Self Test VOR Self Test ILS Self Test
A self test of the VOR system is per- The ILS Self Test is initiated by using the A self test of the VOR system is per- The ILS Self Test is initiated by using the
formed by the appropriate NAV Control UP/LT-DN/RT TEST switch on the NAV formed by the appropriate NAV Control UP/LT-DN/RT TEST switch on the NAV
Panel TEST switch moved to the VOR Tuning Panel. A localizer frequency must Panel TEST switch moved to the VOR Tuning Panel. A localizer frequency must
position. The NAV Tuning Panel must be be selected on the NAV Tuning Panel, and position. The NAV Tuning Panel must be be selected on the NAV Tuning Panel, and
tuned to a valid VOR frequency and a a course selected that is within 90 degrees tuned to a valid VOR frequency and a a course selected that is within 90 degrees
course selected of 000 degrees. The EFIS of the aircraft heading. With a localizer course selected of 000 degrees. The EFIS of the aircraft heading. With a localizer
Control Panel should have the FULL or frequency selected, the RDDMIs needles Control Panel should have the FULL or frequency selected, the RDDMIs needles
EXP VOR/ILS mode selected. For the should park at the 3:00 position. When the EXP VOR/ILS mode selected. For the should park at the 3:00 position. When the
first three seconds, the RDDMIs should TEST switch is positioned to the UP/LT first three seconds, the RDDMIs should TEST switch is positioned to the UP/LT
show an arrow flag and the deviation bar position, the EADI and EHSI localizer and show an arrow flag and the deviation bar position, the EADI and EHSI localizer and
on the EHSI should not show. Then, the glideslope deviation pointers should not on the EHSI should not show. Then, the glideslope deviation pointers should not
next 23 seconds, the EHSI should show a be in view for 3 seconds. For 23 seconds, next 23 seconds, the EHSI should show a be in view for 3 seconds. For 23 seconds,
centered deviation bar and a from arrow the localizer should show one dot left centered deviation bar and a from arrow the localizer should show one dot left
indication, and the RDDMIs needles deviation and the glideslope should show indication, and the RDDMIs needles deviation and the glideslope should show
should point to 180 degrees. one dot up deviation. When the TEST should point to 180 degrees. one dot up deviation. When the TEST
NOTE: of the TEST switch is held for switch is positioned to the DN/RT posi- NOTE: of the TEST switch is held for switch is positioned to the DN/RT posi-
more than 30 seconds, the RDDMIs tion, the EADI and EHSI localizer and more than 30 seconds, the RDDMIs tion, the EADI and EHSI localizer and
flags will show and the deviation bar on glideslope deviation pointers should not flags will show and the deviation bar on glideslope deviation pointers should not
the EHSI will not show. be in view for three seconds. For 23 sec- the EHSI will not show. be in view for three seconds. For 23 sec-
onds, the localizer deviation should be one onds, the localizer deviation should be one
dot right and the glideslope should be one dot right and the glideslope should be one
dot down. dot down.
NOTE: When performing the test for NOTE: When performing the test for
the No. 1 system, verify the same indica- the No. 1 system, verify the same indica-
tions on the Standby Attitude Indicator tions on the Standby Attitude Indicator
(SAI). (SAI).

AUTO NAV MANUAL AUTO NAV MANUAL

AUTO AUTO
TEST MANUAL TEST MANUAL

VOR UP/LT VOR UP/LT

DME ON/RT DME ON/RT

NAV Tuning Panel Test Switch NAV Tuning Panel Test Switch

and
OCT 99 Systems Introduction 34-79 OCT 99 34-79
UNITED
B737 GENERAL AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

MARKER MARKER
BEACON BEACON

28V 28V POWER INPUT


POWER INPUT DC
DC

HIGH/LOW HIGH/LOW AIRWAYS CAPTAIN'S


MARKER AIRWAYS CAPTAIN'S SENSITIVITY MARKER
SENSITIVITY MIDDLE PANEL MIDDLE PANEL
SWITCH OUTPUTS SWITCH OUTPUTS
OUTER LIGHTS OUTER LIGHTS

MKR MKR
ANTENNA ANTENNA F/O'S
F/O'S
PANEL PANEL
LIGHTS LIGHTS

RF INPUT RF INPUT
TO REMOTE TO REMOTE
AUDIO OUTPUT ELECTRONICS AUDIO OUTPUT ELECTRONICS
UNIT UNIT
MARKER BEACON MARKER BEACON
RECEIVER RECEIVER

Marker Beacon System Marker Beacon System

34-80 and Systems Introduction OCT 99 34-80 OCT 99


UNITED AIRLINES COURSE
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

MARKER BEACON SYSTEM Sensitivity Switch MARKER BEACON SYSTEM Sensitivity Switch
The Marker Beacon System provides the A sensitivity switch is located in the P-1 The Marker Beacon System provides the A sensitivity switch is located in the P-1
flight crew with visual and audio indica- panel next to the marker beacon lights. flight crew with visual and audio indica- panel next to the marker beacon lights.
tions of passing over a maker beacon The switch has two positions; HIGH and tions of passing over a maker beacon The switch has two positions; HIGH and
transmitter. The transmitters are usually LOW. transmitter. The transmitters are usually LOW.
associated with an instrument approach. Fault Indications associated with an instrument approach. Fault Indications
These indications are used to confirm the There are no fault indications for the These indications are used to confirm the There are no fault indications for the
aircraft's position on an instrument Marker Beacon System. aircraft's position on an instrument Marker Beacon System.
approach. approach.
NOTE: When a compass locator is col- NOTE: When a compass locator is col-
located with a marker beacon it is located with a marker beacon it is
referred to as LOM or LMM. MARKER referred to as LOM or LMM. MARKER
The is one Marker Beacon System HIGH The is one Marker Beacon System HIGH
installed consisting of; a receiver unit, an installed consisting of; a receiver unit, an
antenna, two indicator light assemblies, antenna, two indicator light assemblies,
and a sensitivity switch. and a sensitivity switch.
LOW
Marker Beacon Receiver Marker Beacon Receiver LOW
The marker beacon receiver receives the The marker beacon receiver receives the
marker beacon transmitted signals on a marker beacon transmitted signals on a
frequency of 75 MHz. It determines the frequency of 75 MHz. It determines the
specific marker beacon by filtering out the A specific marker beacon by filtering out the
audio frequency of 400, 1300, or 3000 Hz IG HT
I audio frequency of 400, 1300, or 3000 Hz A
IG HT
I
BR

R
and turns on the appropriate marker bea- and turns on the appropriate marker bea-

BR
W R
AIRWAYS A W
con light. It also sends the audio signal to Y con light. It also sends the audio signal to AIRWAYS A
Y
the Remote Electronics Unit (REU). S the Remote Electronics Unit (REU). S
Antenna IG HT
M Antenna
I IG HT
M
BR

The antenna is located on the bottom of The antenna is located on the bottom of I

BR
D
MIDDLE D D
the fuselage between the AC bay doors. It L the fuselage between the AC bay doors. It MIDDLE D
L
is longer longitudinally than it protrudes. E is longer longitudinally than it protrudes. E
Marker Beacon Light Assemblies IG HT O Marker Beacon Light Assemblies
IG HT
BR

There are two sets of marker beacon light U There are two sets of marker beacon light O

BR
OUTER T U
assemblies located at the outboard side of E assemblies located at the outboard side of OUTER T
E
R
the P-1 and P-3 panels. They have three the P-1 and P-3 panels. They have three R
lights; a white AIRWAYS light, an amber lights; a white AIRWAYS light, an amber
MIDDLE marker light, and a blue MIDDLE marker light, and a blue
OUTER marker light. They are wired in OUTER marker light. They are wired in
parallel. The lights push-to-test and the parallel. The lights push-to-test and the
lens caps are rotated to dim the light with Marker Beacon Lights and Switch lens caps are rotated to dim the light with Marker Beacon Lights and Switch
shutters. shutters.

and
OCT 99 Systems Introduction 34-81 OCT 99 34-81
UNITED
B737 GENERAL AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

OPERATION Maintenance Practices OPERATION Maintenance Practices


Tuning of the Marker Beacon receiver is The lights for the Marker Beacon System Tuning of the Marker Beacon receiver is The lights for the Marker Beacon System
not necessary because all the transmitters are push-to-test, if the lamp fails to illumi- not necessary because all the transmitters are push-to-test, if the lamp fails to illumi-
have a carrier frequency of 75 MHz. The nate but the push-to-test works, the bulb have a carrier frequency of 75 MHz. The nate but the push-to-test works, the bulb
outer marker is located about four to five base contact may be worn out. Replace the outer marker is located about four to five base contact may be worn out. Replace the
miles from the runway, it has an audio fre- bulb with a new one and retest. miles from the runway, it has an audio fre- bulb with a new one and retest.
quency of 400 Hz. The middle marker is Tests quency of 400 Hz. The middle marker is Tests
located about five tenths of a mile from There is no aircraft test of the Marker Bea- located about five tenths of a mile from There is no aircraft test of the Marker Bea-
the runway and has an audio frequency of con System. Each marker beacon light the runway and has an audio frequency of con System. Each marker beacon light
1300 Hz. The inner marker is located lamp can be pushed-to-test, these lights do 1300 Hz. The inner marker is located lamp can be pushed-to-test, these lights do
about one tenth of a mile from the runway not test with the Master Lights Dim Test about one tenth of a mile from the runway not test with the Master Lights Dim Test
and has an audio frequency of 3000 Hz. switch. The TIC T-30 tester unit may be and has an audio frequency of 3000 Hz. switch. The TIC T-30 tester unit may be
When the aircraft is over the outer marker, used to check for Marker Beacon opera- When the aircraft is over the outer marker, used to check for Marker Beacon opera-
the receiver filters out the 400 Hz audio to tion. the receiver filters out the 400 Hz audio to tion.
determine it is over the outer marker, turns NOTE: The antenna of the T-30 tester determine it is over the outer marker, turns NOTE: The antenna of the T-30 tester
on the blue OUTER marker lights and may have to be put out the flight deck on the blue OUTER marker lights and may have to be put out the flight deck
sends the audio to the Remote Electronics window for proper reception of the sig- sends the audio to the Remote Electronics window for proper reception of the sig-
Unit (REU). The audio is heard as a series nal by the Marker Beacon Antenna. Unit (REU). The audio is heard as a series nal by the Marker Beacon Antenna.
of dashes at a frequency of 400 Hz. When of dashes at a frequency of 400 Hz. When
the aircraft is over the middle marker the aircraft is over the middle marker
transmitter, the amber MIDDLE marker transmitter, the amber MIDDLE marker
lights illuminate, and a series of dot- lights illuminate, and a series of dot-
dashes are heard at a frequency of 1300 dashes are heard at a frequency of 1300
Hz. When the aircraft is over the inner Hz. When the aircraft is over the inner
marker, the white AIRWAYS lights illu- marker, the white AIRWAYS lights illu-
minate and a series of quick dots at 3000 minate and a series of quick dots at 3000
Hz is heard. Hz is heard.
The sensitivity switch is used to adjust the The sensitivity switch is used to adjust the
sensitivity of the receiver. In the HIGH sensitivity of the receiver. In the HIGH
position, there is maximum sensitivity to position, there is maximum sensitivity to
signals. The LOW position is used to pro- signals. The LOW position is used to pro-
vide over station indications when directly vide over station indications when directly
over the transmitter. over the transmitter.
To hear the Marker Beacon audio signals To hear the Marker Beacon audio signals
on the overhead speakers, the Audio Con- on the overhead speakers, the Audio Con-
trol Panel must have the MKR and SPKR trol Panel must have the MKR and SPKR
switches slid forward. switches slid forward.

34-82 and Systems Introduction OCT 99 34-82 OCT 99


NO. 2 SYSTEM ANTENNAS

34-84
NO. 1 SYSTEM ANTENNAS

CAPTAIN'S EADI
NAVIGATION

(FIRST OFFICER'S MCP SPD G/S VOR/LOC CMD

SIMILAR)
20
180 20

160 10
10
1
140
9
R

120
10
10
100 DH200
1700
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION
B737 GENERAL

and Systems Introduction


TCAS
COMPUTER
UNITED

EFIS SYMBOL
GROUND GENERATOR
PROXIMITY

Radio Altimeter System


WARNING
COMPUTER
AIRLINES

TRANSMIT ANTENNA ADI HSI RANGE


FULL EXP
DH REF VOR/ILS VOR/ILS 160 320
RADIO 80
FAMILIARIZATION

MAP 40
ALTIMETER FLIGHT CONTROL 20 C
TF
B737-322/522

RECEIVER/ COMPUTER A CTR


MAP 10
TRANSMITTER BRT PLAN WXR

ON
AUTOTHROTTLE RST
COMPUTER MAP
BRT VOR/ADF NAV AID ARPT RTE DATA WPT
COURSE

ON ON ON ON ON
RECEIVE ANTENNA
YAW DAMPER

OCT 99
AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE

NO. 2 SYSTEM ANTENNAS

34-84
NO. 1 SYSTEM ANTENNAS
NAVIGATION

CAPTAIN'S EADI
(FIRST OFFICER'S MCP SPD G/S VOR/LOC CMD

SIMILAR)
20
180 20

160 10
10
1
140
9
R

120
10
10
100 DH200
1700
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

TCAS
COMPUTER

EFIS SYMBOL
GROUND GENERATOR
PROXIMITY
Radio Altimeter System

WARNING
UNITED AIRLINES

COMPUTER
TRANSMIT ANTENNA ADI HSI RANGE
FULL EXP
DH REF VOR/ILS VOR/ILS 160 320
RADIO 80
MAP 40
ALTIMETER FLIGHT CONTROL
B737-322/522

20 C
CTR TF
RECEIVER/ COMPUTER A MAP 10
TRANSMITTER BRT PLAN WXR

ON
AUTOTHROTTLE RST
COMPUTER MAP
BRT VOR/ADF NAV AID ARPT RTE DATA WPT

ON ON ON ON ON
RECEIVE ANTENNA
YAW DAMPER
OCT 99
AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
UNITED AIRLINES COURSE
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

RADIO ALTIMETER SYSTEM LRRA Receiver/Transmitter RADIO ALTIMETER SYSTEM LRRA Receiver/Transmitter
The Low Range Radio Altimeter (LRRA) The two LRRA Receiver/Transmitters The Low Range Radio Altimeter (LRRA) The two LRRA Receiver/Transmitters
System is used to indicate the aircraft's (RT) are located on the E2-4 rack. They System is used to indicate the aircraft's (RT) are located on the E2-4 rack. They
height above ground level, the system is provide the continuous wave variable fre- height above ground level, the system is provide the continuous wave variable fre-
only usable up to a radio altitude of 2,500 quency signal that is transmitted from the only usable up to a radio altitude of 2,500 quency signal that is transmitted from the
ft. In addition to indicating the radio alti- transmit antenna, reflected off the ground ft. In addition to indicating the radio alti- transmit antenna, reflected off the ground
tude (RA) to the flight crew, the LRRA and received through the receive antenna. tude (RA) to the flight crew, the LRRA and received through the receive antenna.
system sends signals to other aircraft sys- The RT determines from the frequency system sends signals to other aircraft sys- The RT determines from the frequency
tems. shift the altitude above ground level in tems. shift the altitude above ground level in
Two complete LRRA systems are feet. There is a test receptacle on the front Two complete LRRA systems are feet. There is a test receptacle on the front
installed, each consists of; a receiver/ of the RT unit. installed, each consists of; a receiver/ of the RT unit.
transmitter, a transmit antenna, and a LRRA Antenna transmitter, a transmit antenna, and a LRRA Antenna
receive antenna. Display of radio altitude The LRRA antenna are located on the bot- receive antenna. Display of radio altitude The LRRA antenna are located on the bot-
appears on the EADIs. The radio altitude tom of the fuselage and are flush mounted. appears on the EADIs. The radio altitude tom of the fuselage and are flush mounted.
value and altitude trips are sent to the The receive and transmit antenna are iden- value and altitude trips are sent to the The receive and transmit antenna are iden-
Flight Management Computer (FMC), tical. Flight Management Computer (FMC), tical.
Flight Control Computers (FCC), Auto- NOTE: The No. 1 antenna are located Flight Control Computers (FCC), Auto- NOTE: The No. 1 antenna are located
throttle System, Yaw Damp System, in the aft positions and the No. 2 throttle System, Yaw Damp System, in the aft positions and the No. 2
TCAS, GPWS and thrust reverser system. antenna are the forward two antenna. TCAS, GPWS and thrust reverser system. antenna are the forward two antenna.

and
OCT 99 Systems Introduction 34-85 OCT 99 34-85
UNITED
B737 GENERAL AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

EFIS Control Panel OPERATION EFIS Control Panel OPERATION


On the left side of the EFIS Control Panel The two radio altimeter systems are oper- On the left side of the EFIS Control Panel The two radio altimeter systems are oper-
is a display window and knob to adjust the ating when the circuit breakers are closed. is a display window and knob to adjust the ating when the circuit breakers are closed.
Decision Height (DH). This value also The RT unit transmits a frequency modu- Decision Height (DH). This value also The RT unit transmits a frequency modu-
appears on the EADI under the Radio alti- lated continuous wave signal out the trans- appears on the EADI under the Radio alti- lated continuous wave signal out the trans-
tude value. The DH value is preceded by mit antenna. The signal reflects off the tude value. The DH value is preceded by mit antenna. The signal reflects off the
DH and is in green. earth's surface and is received by the DH and is in green. earth's surface and is received by the
Indications receive antenna. The RT unit determines Indications receive antenna. The RT unit determines
The radio altitude value is shown on the the distance traveled by the signal by com- The radio altitude value is shown on the the distance traveled by the signal by com-
EADI in white above the green Decision paring the frequency shift. EADI in white above the green Decision paring the frequency shift.
Height (DH) value. The radio altitude When the radio altitude descends down to Height (DH) value. The radio altitude When the radio altitude descends down to
value appears when the aircraft is below the decision height altitude, the radio alti- value appears when the aircraft is below the decision height altitude, the radio alti-
2,500 ft radio altitude. The value will be tude value turns from white to yellow and 2,500 ft radio altitude. The value will be tude value turns from white to yellow and
approximately -04 ft when on the ground. the DH value changes to a yellow DH with approximately -04 ft when on the ground. the DH value changes to a yellow DH
On the EADI is a rising runway symbol in no value. The yellow indications flash for On the EADI is a rising runway symbol in with no value. The yellow indications
green associated with the localizer devia- three seconds then are steady yellow. green associated with the localizer devia- flash for three seconds then are steady yel-
tion pointer. It starts rising at 200 ft radio When the aircraft lands, climbs 75 ft tion pointer. It starts rising at 200 ft radio low.
altitude. above DH value during go around, or altitude. When the aircraft lands, climbs 75 ft
The radio altitude value is blank when when the RST button is pressed on the The radio altitude value is blank when above DH value during go around, or
above 2,500 ft radio altitude or a No Com- EFIS Control Panel, the radio altitude above 2,500 ft radio altitude or a No Com- when the RST button is pressed on the
puted Data (NCD) condition exists. The value changes back to white and the DH puted Data (NCD) condition exists. The EFIS Control Panel, the radio altitude
DH value is blank when a negative DH value reappears in green. At 200 ft radio DH value is blank when a negative DH value changes back to white and the DH
value is selected. For a invalid signal, the altitude the rising runway symbol on the value is selected. For a invalid signal, the value reappears in green. At 200 ft radio
radio altitude will show a yellow RA in a EADI starts to rise and will touch the air- radio altitude will show a yellow RA in a altitude the rising runway symbol on the
box and the decision height will show a plane symbol at zero radio altitude. box and the decision height will show a EADI starts to rise and will touch the air-
yellow DH in a box. Maintenance Practices yellow DH in a box. plane symbol at zero radio altitude.
Whenever a LRRA RT unit is installed a Maintenance Practices
test per MM78-31-00 p536 must be Whenever a LRRA RT unit is installed a
accomplished. This is the Altimeter test per MM78-31-00 p536 must be
Enable Portion of the Thrust Reverser accomplished. This is the Altimeter
System Adjustment and Test. Enable Portion of the Thrust Reverser
Tests System Adjustment and Test.
There is no aircraft test of the LRRA sys- Tests
tem. The only aircraft test performed, is There is no aircraft test of the LRRA sys-
the decision height test, reference MM34- tem. The only aircraft test performed, is
48-02. the decision height test, reference MM34-
External test equipment used to test the 48-02.
system is the Atlantis Radio Altimeter External test equipment used to test the
Tester. system is the Atlantis Radio Altimeter
CAUTION: Be sure to use the proper Tester.
interface kit, reference Service Tip CAUTION: Be sure to use the proper
MM34-48-02 interface kit, reference Service Tip
MM34-48-02

34-86 and Systems Introduction OCT 99 34-86 OCT 99


UNITED AIRLINES COURSE
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

ADI HSI RANGE ADI HSI


FULL EXP FULL EXP RANGE
DH REF VOR/ILS VOR/ILS 160 320 DH REF 160 320
80 VOR/ILS VOR/ILS 80
MAP 40 40
MAP
20 C C
CTR TF CTR
20 TF
MAP 10 MAP 10
BRT PLAN WXR BRT WXR
PLAN

ON ON
RST RST
MAP MAP
BRT VOR/ADF NAV AID ARPT RTE DATA WPT BRT VOR/ADF NAV AID ARPT RTE DATA WPT
ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON

EFIS Control Panel EFIS Control Panel

MCP SPD G/S VOR/LOC CMD MCP SPD G/S VOR/LOC CMD

20 20
180 20 180 20

160 10 160 10
10 10
1 1
140 140
9 9
R R

120 120
10 10
10 10
100 DH200 100 DH200
1700 1700

EADI EADI

and
OCT 99 Systems Introduction 34-87 OCT 99 34-87
34-88
CAPTAIN'S CAPTAIN'S CAPTAIN'S
PITOT STATIC MACH/AIRSPEED
SYSTEM SYSTEM CAPTAIN'S INDICATOR
ALTIMETER
M 0
NAVIGATION

60
100 0 FT 80
9 1 400 MACH
MCP SPD G/S VOR/LOC CMD
78 100
8 31 7 00 2 350 7
20
180 20 120
EFIS SYMBOL 7 MB ALT IN HG 3 300 1
160 10 1013 2992
10 27 0 140
GENERATOR 1 6 250 KNOTS
140 5 0
9 160
R
BARO 200 180
120
10
DIGITAL 10 PULL TO SET
100 DH200
AIR DATA 1700

COMPUTER - 1
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION
B737 GENERAL

and Systems Introduction


EADI OVERSPEED
INERTIAL REFERENCE UNIT-1 WARNING
FLIGHT CONTROL
CAPTAIN'S
UNITED

COMPUTER A
DIGITAL STALL WARNING WARNING
AIR COMPUTER-2 CLACKER
TEMPERATURE YAW DAMPER COUPLER

Air Data System


PROBE GROUND PROXIMITY
WARNING SYSTEM FLIGHT DATA
FLIGHT DATA RECORDER RECORDER
AIRLINES

(IN AFT CABIN)


CAPTAIN'S
FLIGHT MANAGEMENT AND FIRST
FAMILIARIZATION

COMPUTER OFFICER'S
B737-322/522

FORWARD FUSELAGE
AUTOTHROTTLE COMPUTER SYSTEM ARE
SIMILAR
ATC 1 AND 2
CABIN PRESSURE CONTROLLER
COURSE

INERTIAL REFERENCE UNIT-2


FLIGHT CONTROL COMPUTER B
DIGITAL STALL WARNING
COMPUTER-2

OCT 99
AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE

34-88
CAPTAIN'S CAPTAIN'S CAPTAIN'S
PITOT STATIC MACH/AIRSPEED
SYSTEM SYSTEM CAPTAIN'S INDICATOR
ALTIMETER
M 0

60
NAVIGATION

100 0 FT 80
9 1 400 MACH
MCP SPD G/S VOR/LOC CMD
78 100
8 31 7 00 2 350 7
20
180 20 120
EFIS SYMBOL 7 MB ALT IN HG 3 300 1
160 10 1013 2992
10 27 0 140
GENERATOR 1 6 250 KNOTS
140 5 0
9 160
R
BARO 200 180
120
10
DIGITAL 10 PULL TO SET
100 DH200
AIR DATA 1700

COMPUTER - 1
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

EADI OVERSPEED
INERTIAL REFERENCE UNIT-1 WARNING
FLIGHT CONTROL
COMPUTER A CAPTAIN'S
DIGITAL STALL WARNING WARNING
AIR COMPUTER-2 CLACKER
TEMPERATURE YAW DAMPER COUPLER
PROBE GROUND PROXIMITY
Air Data System

WARNING SYSTEM FLIGHT DATA


FLIGHT DATA RECORDER RECORDER
(IN AFT CABIN)
UNITED AIRLINES

CAPTAIN'S
FLIGHT MANAGEMENT AND FIRST
COMPUTER OFFICER'S
FORWARD FUSELAGE
SYSTEM ARE
B737-322/522

AUTOTHROTTLE COMPUTER
SIMILAR
ATC 1 AND 2
CABIN PRESSURE CONTROLLER
INERTIAL REFERENCE UNIT-2
FLIGHT CONTROL COMPUTER B
DIGITAL STALL WARNING
COMPUTER-2
OCT 99
AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
UNITED AIRLINES COURSE
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

AIR DATA SYSTEM Digital Air Data Computer AIR DATA SYSTEM Digital Air Data Computer
The Air Data System takes Pitot/Static The two Digital Air Data Computers The Air Data System takes Pitot/Static The two Digital Air Data Computers
System inputs and temperature probe (DADC) are located at the outboard ends System inputs and temperature probe (DADC) are located at the outboard ends
inputs and converts them to electrical sig- of the E1-1 rack. The ADC processes inputs and converts them to electrical sig- of the E1-1 rack. The ADC processes
nals representing, airspeed, mach speed, inputs from the pitot/static system, the nals representing, airspeed, mach speed, inputs from the pitot/static system, the
altitude, and temperatures. The No. 1 sys- total air temperature probe, and baromet- altitude, and temperatures. The No. 1 sys- total air temperature probe, and baromet-
tem supplies outputs to the Captain's ric correction from the altimeters to pro- tem supplies outputs to the Captain's ric correction from the altimeters to pro-
instruments and the No. 2 system supplies vide outputs which include functions of instruments and the No. 2 system supplies vide outputs which include functions of
outputs to the First Officer's instruments. altitude, barometric corrected altitude, outputs to the First Officer's instruments. altitude, barometric corrected altitude,
The Air Data Systems consists of; two altitude rate, computed airspeed, true air- The Air Data Systems consists of; two altitude rate, computed airspeed, true air-
Digital Air Data Computers (DADC), two speed, Mach, static air temperature, digital Digital Air Data Computers (DADC), two speed, Mach, static air temperature, digital
Mach/Airspeed Indicators, and two Altim- encoded altitude, static pressure, total Mach/Airspeed Indicators, and two Altim- encoded altitude, static pressure, total
eters. The Static Air Temperature (SAT), pressure, impact pressure, and maximum eters. The Static Air Temperature (SAT), pressure, impact pressure, and maximum
Total Air Temperature (TAT), and True allowable airspeed. On the front of the Total Air Temperature (TAT), and True allowable airspeed. On the front of the
Airspeed (TAS) is sent to an indicator ADC are two quick hose connectors for Airspeed (TAS) is sent to an indicator ADC are two quick hose connectors for
above the engine instruments or the the pitot and static lines, and a switch that above the engine instruments or the the pitot and static lines, and a switch that
Engine Indicating System (EIS). Informa- selects the performance of the self test or Engine Indicating System (EIS). Informa- selects the performance of the self test or
tion from the DADCs are sent to the; EFIS view fault history. There is a display next tion from the DADCs are sent to the; EFIS view fault history. There is a display next
Symbol Generators, DFCS, mach trim, to the switch for test results. Symbol Generators, DFCS, mach trim, to the switch for test results.
IRS, Stall Warning Computers, FMC, CAUTION: To avoid ADC damage, the IRS, Stall Warning Computers, FMC, CAUTION: To avoid ADC damage, the
Autothrottle System, Flight Data Record- pitot and static system must be at ambi- Autothrottle System, Flight Data Record- pitot and static system must be at ambi-
ing System, GPWS, Yaw Damp System, ent before disconnecting any lines. ing System, GPWS, Yaw Damp System, ent before disconnecting any lines.
TCAS/ATC, and cabin pressure control- CAUTION: A low range leak test must TCAS/ATC, and cabin pressure control- CAUTION: A low range leak test must
ler. be performed if more than one pitot/ ler. be performed if more than one pitot/
static system has been broken into or if static system has been broken into or if
the results of a one system visual inspec- the results of a one system visual inspec-
tion is in doubt. tion is in doubt.

and
OCT 99 Systems Introduction 34-89 OCT 99 34-89
UNITED
B737 GENERAL AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

AIR DATA HONEYWELL AIR DATA


HONEYWELL COMPUTER
COMPUTER

PITOT STATIC PITOT STATIC

TEST HISTORY TEST HISTORY

BIT TEST HISTORY BIT TEST HISTORY


SET TO TEST AND RELEASE SET TO HISTORY AND RELEASE SET TO TEST AND RELEASE SET TO HISTORY AND RELEASE
88=DISPLAY TEST RESELECT FOR PREVIOUS FLIGHT 88=DISPLAY TEST RESELECT FOR PREVIOUS FLIGHT
AA=TEST OK LH DISPLAY= FLIGHT NO. AA=TEST OK LH DISPLAY= FLIGHT NO.
F1-F9 FAIL SEE CODE F1-F9 FAIL SEE CODE RH DISPLAY=FAULT CODE
RH DISPLAY=FAULT CODE
FLASHING = TEST ENDING FLASHING = TEST ENDING (RH=0=NO FAULT
(RH=0=NO FAULT RESELECT TO CONTINUE
RESELECT TO CONTINUE
FAULT CODES FAULT CODES
1 = ADC FAULT 5 = BARO RESOLVER #1 1 = ADC FAULT 5 = BARO RESOLVER #1
2 = TEMP PROBE 6 = BARO RESOLVER #2 2 = TEMP PROBE 6 = BARO RESOLVER #2
3 = BARO REF #1 7 = 26V SYNCHRO REF 3 = BARO REF #1 7 = 26V SYNCHRO REF
4 = BARO REF #2 8 = CABIN PRESSURE REF 4 = BARO REF #2 8 = CABIN PRESSURE REF
9 = AIRCRAFT PROGRAM PINS 9 = AIRCRAFT PROGRAM PINS

ADC Computer ADC Computer

34-90 and Systems Introduction OCT 99 34-90 OCT 99


UNITED AIRLINES COURSE
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

Mach/Airspeed Indicator Altimeter Mach/Airspeed Indicator Altimeter


The two Mach/Airspeed Indictors are The two Altimeters are located in the P1 The two Mach/Airspeed Indictors are The two Altimeters are located in the P1
located in the P1 and P3 panels to the left and P3 panels to the right of each EADI. located in the P1 and P3 panels to the left and P3 panels to the right of each EADI.
of each EADI. The airspeed markings on The altimeters receive their signals from of each EADI. The airspeed markings on The altimeters receive their signals from
the indicator range from 60 to 450 knots. the ADC. There is a window at the top of the indicator range from 60 to 450 knots. the ADC. There is a window at the top of
There are 5 knot increments from 60 to the indicator that shows the sea level alti- There are 5 knot increments from 60 to the indicator that shows the sea level alti-
100 knots, 2 knot increments from 100 to tude of the aircraft. The drum display is in 100 knots, 2 knot increments from 100 to tude of the aircraft. The drum display is in
160, and five knot increments from 160 to increments of 20 ft. The pointer revolves 160, and five knot increments from 160 to increments of 20 ft. The pointer revolves
450 knots. There are two pointers; the nar- around the dial which is marked in 100 ft 450 knots. There are two pointers; the nar- around the dial which is marked in 100 ft
row pointer points to the airspeed on the increments with unmarked increments of row pointer points to the airspeed on the increments with unmarked increments of
dial, the two colored pointer indicates the 20 ft. One revolution of the pointer repre- dial, the two colored pointer indicates the 20 ft. One revolution of the pointer repre-
maximum operating speed determined by sents 1000 ft. There is a cursor which is maximum operating speed determined by sents 1000 ft. There is a cursor which is
the air data system. The airspeed is also controlled by a knob in the lower right the air data system. The airspeed is also controlled by a knob in the lower right
indicated in the lower window of the indi- corner of the indicator. This cursor is used indicated in the lower window of the indi- corner of the indicator. This cursor is used
cator, it is covered by a amber A/S flag just for reference and has no electrical cator, it is covered by a amber A/S flag just for reference and has no electrical
when a fault exists. inputs or outputs. The lower left knob when a fault exists. inputs or outputs. The lower left knob
NOTE: The lowest number in the air- adjusts the barometric altimeter setting. NOTE: The lowest number in the air- adjusts the barometric altimeter setting.
speed window display drum is 45 knots. The windows at the bottom of the indica- speed window display drum is 45 knots. The windows at the bottom of the indica-
The Mach speed is indicated in the tor show the altimeter setting in HG The Mach speed is indicated in the tor show the altimeter setting in HG
upper window of the indicator, it is cov- (inches of Mercury) and MB (millibars). upper window of the indicator, it is cov- (inches of Mercury) and MB (millibars).
ered by a amber MACH flag when their The signal for barometric correction is ered by a amber MACH flag when their The signal for barometric correction is
is a fault. sent to the ADC and cabin pressurization is a fault. sent to the ADC and cabin pressurization
NOTE: The lowest number in the Mach system. NOTE: The lowest number in the Mach system.
window display drum is.40. window display drum is.40.
An amber VMO flag appears in the left An amber VMO flag appears in the left
window when a fault occurs with the max- window when a fault occurs with the max-
imum speed pointer circuit. A amber imum speed pointer circuit. A amber
INOP flag appears in the right window INOP flag appears in the right window
when a fault occurs with the airspeed cur- when a fault occurs with the airspeed cur-
sor. The amber airspeed cursor is normally sor. The amber airspeed cursor is normally
positioned by the FMCS, if the airspeed positioned by the FMCS, if the airspeed
cursor control knob at the bottom left of cursor control knob at the bottom left of
the indicator is pushed in. When the knob the indicator is pushed in. When the knob
is pulled out, the cursor is manually posi- is pulled out, the cursor is manually posi-
tioned by the knob, in this mode there are tioned by the knob, in this mode there are
no electrical inputs or outputs from the no electrical inputs or outputs from the
knob. Also a white flag appears at the top knob. Also a white flag appears at the top
of the indictor when the knob is pulled of the indictor when the knob is pulled
out. The five white plastic bugs are man- out. The five white plastic bugs are man-
ually placed around the indicator bezel by ually placed around the indicator bezel by
the flight crew for reference airspeeds dur- the flight crew for reference airspeeds dur-
ing takeoff. ing takeoff.

and
OCT 99 Systems Introduction 34-91 OCT 99 34-91
UNITED
B737 GENERAL AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

Temperature Probe Temperature Probe


The Total Air Temperature Probe is The Total Air Temperature Probe is
located on the left side of the fuselage located on the left side of the fuselage
below the left pitot/static probes. below the left pitot/static probes.
CAUTION: The Total Air Temperature CAUTION: The Total Air Tempera-
probe is heated with the left probe anti- ture probe is heated with the left probe
ice system. anti-ice system.

GASKET ELECTRICAL GASKET ELECTRICAL


CONNECTOR CONNECTOR

TOTAL AIR TOTAL AIR


TEMPERATURE TEMPERATURE
PROBE MOUNTING PROBE MOUNTING
SCREWS SCREWS
(6 PLACES) (6 PLACES)

Temperature Probe Temperature Probe

34-92 and Systems Introduction OCT 99 34-92 OCT 99


UNITED AIRLINES COURSE
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

EADI Indications EADI Indications


The EADI shows airspeed as a vertical The EADI shows airspeed as a vertical
tape on the left side of the indicator. This tape on the left side of the indicator. This
is a moving tape with various reference is a moving tape with various reference
speeds also marked on the tape. The Mach speeds also marked on the tape. The Mach
number appears in white in the lower left number appears in white in the lower left
corner of the display. corner of the display.

MCP SPD G/S VOR/LOC CMD MCP SPD G/S VOR/LOC CMD

20 20
180 20
180 20

10 160 10
160
10 10
1 1
140 140
9 9
R
R
120
120 10
10
10 10
DH200 100 DH200
100
1700 1700

EADI EADI

and
OCT 99 Systems Introduction 34-93 OCT 99 34-93
UNITED
B737 GENERAL AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

EHSI Indications EHSI Indications


The EHSI shows the TAS (True Air The EHSI shows the TAS (True Air
Speed) in white in the upper left corner of Speed) in white in the upper left corner of
the display. If there is No Computed Data the display. If there is No Computed Data
(NCD), TAS--- will appear, if a fault (NCD), TAS--- will appear, if a fault
exists the area will be blank. exists the area will be blank.

DME 13.5 HDG 127 M


DME 13.5 HDG 127 M GS290
GS290 TAS 300
TAS 300

15 15
12 12

40
40

FROM
FROM
117˚/20 117˚/20
110.10 ILS 1 110.10
ILS 1

EHSI EHSI

34-94 and Systems Introduction OCT 99 34-94 OCT 99


UNITED AIRLINES COURSE
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

SAT-TAT-TAS Indications Maintenance Practices SAT-TAT-TAS Indications Maintenance Practices


On airplanes without EIS (Engine Indicat- CAUTION: The pitot/static and tem- On airplanes without EIS (Engine Indicat- CAUTION: The pitot/static and tem-
ing System), a TAT (Total Air Tempera- perature probes are heated by the anti- ing System), a TAT (Total Air Tempera- perature probes are heated by the anti-
ture) /SAT (Static Air Temperature)/TAS ice system. ture) /SAT (Static Air Temperature)/TAS ice system.
(True Air Speed) indicator is located to the CAUTION: To avoid ADC damage, the (True Air Speed) indicator is located to the CAUTION: To avoid ADC damage, the
left of the First Officer's Mach/Airspeed pitot and static system must be at ambi- left of the First Officer's Mach/Airspeed pitot and static system must be at ambi-
Indicator. There is a selector button, when ent pressure before disconnecting any Indicator. There is a selector button, when ent pressure before disconnecting any
pressed, it cycles the display through the lines. pressed, it cycles the display through the lines.
values for the three parameters. On air- NOTE: A low range leak test must be values for the three parameters. On air- NOTE: A low range leak test must be
plane with EIS, the Secondary Engine performed if more than one pitot/static plane with EIS, the Secondary Engine performed if more than one pitot/static
Display has at the top a display for TAT. system has been broken into or if the Display has at the top a display for TAT. system has been broken into or if the
NOTE: The temperature displays are in results of a one system visual inspection NOTE: The temperature displays are in results of a one system visual inspection
Centigrade and the TAS is in knots. is in doubt. Centigrade and the TAS is in knots. is in doubt.
OPERATION BITE OPERATION BITE
Pitot and static pressures are supplied to BITE tests are initiated from the front of Pitot and static pressures are supplied to BITE tests are initiated from the front of
the ADC by the lines of the Pitot/Static the ADC, the test switch can be moved to the ADC by the lines of the Pitot/Static the ADC, the test switch can be moved to
system. Total Air Temperature Probe sup- one of two positions, TEST and HIS- system. Total Air Temperature Probe sup- one of two positions, TEST and HIS-
plies a resistance signal. The ADC uses TORY. plies a resistance signal. The ADC uses TORY.
two identical pressure transducers to con- The TEST position initiates a BITE test. two identical pressure transducers to con- The TEST position initiates a BITE test.
vert to an electrical signal. The ADC uses The read out displays all LCD segments, vert to an electrical signal. The ADC uses The read out displays all LCD segments,
TAT and barometric corrections from the then AA for test OK. Fault codes are given TAT and barometric corrections from the then AA for test OK. Fault codes are given
Altimeters to provide analog and digital if a fault is sensed. Altimeters to provide analog and digital if a fault is sensed.
outputs. Most of the analog outputs are in The HISTORY shows the faults stored for outputs. Most of the analog outputs are in The HISTORY shows the faults stored for
the form of synchro type signals. the last ten flights. the form of synchro type signals. the last ten flights.
NOTE: The fault codes are placarded NOTE: The fault codes are placarded
on the front of the ADC. on the front of the ADC.

TAT TAT ˚C TAT TAT ˚C


˚C ˚C
KT KT
SAT TAS PSI SAT TAS PSI

100 100 100 100


50 50 50 50

EIS Display EIS Display

and
OCT 99 Systems Introduction 34-95 OCT 99 34-95
UNITED
B737 GENERAL AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

ELECTRIC ELECTRIC STANDBY STANDBY ELECTRIC ELECTRIC ELECTRIC ELECTRIC STANDBY STANDBY ELECTRIC ELECTRIC
MACH ALTIMETER PNEUMATIC PNEUMATIC MACH ALTIMETER MACH ALTIMETER PNEUMATIC PNEUMATIC MACH ALTIMETER
AIRSPEED AIRSPEED ALTIMETER AIRSPEED AIRSPEED AIRSPEED ALTIMETER AIRSPEED

AIR DATA AIR DATA AIR DATA AIR DATA


COMPUTER NO. 1 COMPUTER NO. 2 COMPUTER NO. 1 COMPUTER NO. 2

CAPT CAPT
PITOT PITOT
F/O F/O
PITOT PITOT

CAPT STATIC CAPT STATIC

F/O STATIC F/O STATIC


NO. 1 AUX STATIC NO. 1 AUX STATIC

NO. 2 AUX STATIC NO. 2 AUX STATIC


NO. 2 AUX NO. 1 AUX NO. 2 AUX NO. 1 AUX
PITOT PITOT PITOT PITOT

FLAP LOAD LIMIT FLAP LOAD LIMIT FLAP LOAD LIMIT FLAP LOAD LIMIT
AIRSPEED SWITCH AIRSPEED SWITCH AIRSPEED SWITCH AIRSPEED SWITCH

PRESSURIZATION PRESSURIZATION
CONTROL CONTROL

PITOT PITOT
CABIN ALTIMETER CABIN ALTIMETER
CAPT & F/O STATIC AND CAPT & F/O STATIC AND
NO.1 & NO. 2 AUX STATIC DIFFERENTIAL PRESSURE NO.1 & NO. 2 AUX STATIC DIFFERENTIAL PRESSURE
ALTERNATE STATIC ALTERNATE STATIC

ALTERNATE STATIC ALTERNATE STATIC

Pitot-Static System Pitot-Static System

34-96 and Systems Introduction OCT 99 34-96 OCT 99


UNITED AIRLINES COURSE
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

PITOT/STATIC SYSTEM PITOT/STATIC SYSTEM


The Pitot/Static System provides dynamic The Pitot/Static System provides dynamic
ram (pitot) and ambient (static) air pres- ram (pitot) and ambient (static) air pres-
sures to connected aircraft equipment and sures to connected aircraft equipment and
indicators. These pressures are used to indicators. These pressures are used to
determine the aircraft's altitude, airspeed, determine the aircraft's altitude, airspeed,
and mach number. The primary users of and mach number. The primary users of
this information are the Air Data Comput- this information are the Air Data Comput-
ers (ADC), other users are, cabin pressur- ers (ADC), other users are, cabin pressur-
ization, flap load limiting, and the Standby ization, flap load limiting, and the Standby
Altimeter and Airspeed Indicator. The Altimeter and Airspeed Indicator. The
Pitot/Static system includes four com- Pitot/Static system includes four com-
bined heated pitot/static probes, two alter- bined heated pitot/static probes, two alter-
nate flush static ports and connected nate flush static ports and connected
tubing with drain fittings. tubing with drain fittings.

LOCATOR PIN HOLE LOCATOR PIN HOLE


GASKET GASKET
SHIM SHIM
(AS REQUIRED) (AS REQUIRED)

AUXILIARY STATIC AUXILIARY STATIC


LINE LINE

CAPT'S OR F/O'S CAPT'S OR F/O'S


STATIC LINE STATIC LINE
PITOT LINE PITOT LINE

HEATER HEATER
CONNECTION CONNECTION

LOCATOR PIN LOCATOR PIN


PITOT STATIC PROBE PITOT STATIC PROBE

Pitot Tube Pitot Tube

and
OCT 99 Systems Introduction 34-97 OCT 99 34-97
UNITED
B737 GENERAL AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

Pitot/Static Probes NOTE: The probes on the vertical sta- Pitot/Static Probes NOTE: The probes on the vertical sta-
There are four Pitot/Static Probes located bilizer are for elevator feel. There are four Pitot/Static Probes located bilizer are for elevator feel.
below the No. 3 control cabin windows, Alternate Static ports below the No. 3 control cabin windows, Alternate Static ports
two on each side. Each probe is heated The Alternate Static ports are located on two on each side. Each probe is heated and The Alternate Static ports are located on
and has a single pitot tube, and two static each side of the fuselage at station 406. has a single pitot tube, and two static ports each side of the fuselage at station 406.
ports on its sides. The static ports are cross They are cross connected and supply on its sides. The static ports are cross con- They are cross connected and supply
connected to each side of the aircraft. ambient pressure to the standby static nected to each side of the aircraft. ambient pressure to the standby static
WARNING: When pitot heat is on the instruments. These ports are not heated. WARNING: When pitot heat is on the instruments. These ports are not heated.
probes are very hot. CAUTION: Do not insert any objects probes are very hot. CAUTION: Do not insert any objects
CAUTION: Do not insert any objects into the static ports that may damage CAUTION: Do not insert any objects into the static ports that may damage
into the pitot tube or static ports that the opening. into the pitot tube or static ports that the opening.
may damage the opening. may damage the opening.

STATIC HOSE STATIC HOSE

ELBOW ELBOW

JAMNUT JAMNUT
O-RING O-RING

STATIC PORT STATIC PORT


RETAINING RETAINING
NUT AND WASHER NUT AND WASHER

STATIC PORT STATIC PORT

AIRPLANE SKIN AIRPLANE SKIN

Alternate Static ports Alternate Static ports

34-98 and Systems Introduction OCT 99 34-98 OCT 99


UNITED AIRLINES COURSE
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

Drain Fittings pointer represents hundreds of feet. One Drain Fittings pointer represents hundreds of feet. One
There are several drain fittings located in complete revolution is one thousand feet There are several drain fittings located in complete revolution is one thousand feet
the nose wheel well and the E&E compart- and the dial is scaled in twenty feet incre- the nose wheel well and the E&E compart- and the dial is scaled in twenty feet incre-
ment. These are used to drain excess water ments. There is a Altimeter Vibrator for ment. These are used to drain excess water ments. There is a Altimeter Vibrator for
that may be trapped in the pitot/static the Standby Altimeter, it is on when the C/ that may be trapped in the pitot/static the Standby Altimeter, it is on when the C/
lines. They are anodized fittings in which B is closed. When the BARO knob is set lines. They are anodized fittings in which B is closed. When the BARO knob is set
the caps are used to cover a check valve, to the current pressure setting, the altime- the caps are used to cover a check valve, to the current pressure setting, the altime-
the end of the cap can be used to unseat ter should read airport altitude above sea the end of the cap can be used to unseat ter should read airport altitude above sea
the check valve to release any moisture level. the check valve to release any moisture level.
trapped. NOTE: There are no fault flags on the trapped. NOTE: There are no fault flags on the
CAUTION: Do not depress the check Standby Altimeter. CAUTION: Do not depress the check Standby Altimeter.
valve with a sharp tool, it may damage Standby Airspeed Indicator valve with a sharp tool, it may damage Standby Airspeed Indicator
the seal. The Standby Airspeed Indicator is located the seal. The Standby Airspeed Indicator is located
CAUTION: Do not depress the check in the P1 panel between the Captain's CAUTION: Do not depress the check in the P1 panel between the Captain's
valve when performing an air data test, Altimeter and the Standby Attitude Indica- valve when performing an air data test, Altimeter and the Standby Attitude Indica-
damage to the instruments may result. tor (SAI). It is connected to the Alternate damage to the instruments may result. tor (SAI). It is connected to the Alternate
Standby Altimeter Static Ports and the No. 2 Aux Pitot probe Standby Altimeter Static Ports and the No. 2 Aux Pitot probe
The Standby Altimeter is located in the P1 (lower left), to indicate airspeed of the air- The Standby Altimeter is located in the P1 (lower left), to indicate airspeed of the air-
panel to the right of the Captain's Vertical craft. The indicator reads out in knots with panel to the right of the Captain's Vertical craft. The indicator reads out in knots with
Speed Indicator. It uses the Alternate the scale starting at 60 and ending at 470 Speed Indicator. It uses the Alternate the scale starting at 60 and ending at 470
Static ports to indicate the barometric alti- knots. Static ports to indicate the barometric alti- knots.
tude. The indicator has a BARO knob to NOTE: There are no fault flags for the tude. The indicator has a BARO knob to NOTE: There are no fault flags for the
adjust the altimeter for the atmospheric Standby Airspeed Indicator. adjust the altimeter for the atmospheric Standby Airspeed Indicator.
pressure setting. There is a window for NOTE: The scale changes increments pressure setting. There is a window for NOTE: The scale changes increments
inches of mercury (IN/HG) and millibar on the Standby Airspeed Indicator, care inches of mercury (IN/HG) and millibar on the Standby Airspeed Indicator, care
(MB) barometric settings. A number drum should be taken when reading the indi- (MB) barometric settings. A number drum should be taken when reading the indi-
represents thousands of feet and the cation. represents thousands of feet and the cation.

IDENTIFICATION
PLACARD IDENTIFICATION
PLACARD

CAP BAYONET
FITTING CAP BAYONET
FITTING

RETAINING
LANYARD RETAINING
LANYARD

Drain Fittings
Drain Fittings

and
OCT 99 Systems Introduction 34-99 OCT 99 34-99
UNITED
B737 GENERAL AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

AFDS HDG SEL


AFDS
HDG SEL

CAPT CAPT
CLOCK A/T FCCs MACH CLOCK A/T FCCs MACH
AIRSPEEDs AIRSPEEDs

TOTAL TOTAL
FUEL FUEL

AIR DATA AIR DATA


COMPUTERS
FMC EADIs
COMPUTERS
FMC EADIs

VHF RADIOS VHF RADIOS


VOR/DME/ILS VOR/DME/ILS
NAVIGATION PERFORMANCE NAVIGATION PERFORMANCE
DATA DATA DATA DATA
PNEUMATIC PNEUMATIC
SWITCH BASES BASE SWITCH BASES BASE
EHSIs EHSIs
POSITIONS POSITIONS

PERMANENT PERMANENT
AIR/GROUND AIR/GROUND SUPPLEMENTAL
SUPPLEMENTAL
SENSING TEMPORARY SENSING TEMPORARY

PMC ON/OFF N1s PMC ON/OFF N1s


LOGIC LOGIC

FLAP FLAP
VOR/DME VOR/DME
POSITION POSITION
AUTO TUNE AUTO TUNE

IRUs IRUs
THRUST MODE THRUST MODE
ANNUNCIATOR ANNUNCIATOR

EFIS EFIS
CONTROL CAPT F/O CONTROL CAPT F/O
PANELS CDU CDU PANELS CDU CDU

Flight Management Computer System Flight Management Computer System

34-100and Systems Introduction OCT 99 34-100 OCT 99


UNITED AIRLINES COURSE
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

FLIGHT MANAGEMENT COM- The system consists of a Flight Manage- FLIGHT MANAGEMENT COM- The system consists of a Flight Manage-
PUTER SYSTEM ment Computer (FMC) and two Control PUTER SYSTEM ment Computer (FMC) and two Control
The Flight Management Computer System Display Units (CDU). The principle air- The Flight Management Computer System Display Units (CDU). The principle air-
(FMCS) provides the functions of naviga- craft systems that interface with the FMCS (FMCS) provides the functions of naviga- craft systems that interface with the FMCS
tion, lateral navigation (LNAV), vertical are: tion, lateral navigation (LNAV), vertical are:
guidance (VNAV), flight planning, and Engine Bleed Air Compression Control guidance (VNAV), flight planning, and Engine Bleed Air Compression Control
aircraft performance optimization. The System aircraft performance optimization. The System
FMCS calculates the minimum cost flight Autopilot/Flight Director System FMCS calculates the minimum cost flight Autopilot/Flight Director System
profiles for climb, cruise, and descent, Auto throttle System profiles for climb, cruise, and descent, Auto throttle System
which may be used by the DFCS and the Digital Stall Warning System which may be used by the DFCS and the Digital Stall Warning System
autothrottle for automatic flight control. Ground Proximity Warning System autothrottle for automatic flight control. Ground Proximity Warning System
The Flight Management Computer (FMC) Fuel Quantity Indicating System The Flight Management Computer (FMC) Fuel Quantity Indicating System
performs most of these functions and is Wing Thermal Anti-ice System performs most of these functions and is Wing Thermal Anti-ice System
used to perform BITE tests of the FMC, Nose Cowl Anti-ice System used to perform BITE tests of the FMC, Nose Cowl Anti-ice System
EFIS, DFCS, IRS and Autothrottle sys- Variable Bleed Valve System EFIS, DFCS, IRS and Autothrottle sys- Variable Bleed Valve System
tems. Engine Tachometer System tems. Engine Tachometer System
Air Data System Air Data System
Electronic Flight Instrument System Electronic Flight Instrument System
Inertial Reference System Inertial Reference System
VOR/ILS Navigation System VOR/ILS Navigation System
Distance Measuring System Distance Measuring System

and
OCT 99 Systems Introduction 34-101 OCT 99 34-101
UNITED
B737 GENERAL AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

PERF INIT PERF INIT


GROSS WT TRIP/CRZ ALT GROSS WT TRIP/CRZ ALT
FL190/ FL190/
FUEL CRZ WIND FUEL CRZ WIND
15.0
ZFW
--- /---
ISA DEV
˚ 15.0
ZFW
--- /---
ISA DEV
˚
--- C ˚ --- C ˚
RESERVES T/C OAT RESERVES T/C OAT
--- C ˚ --- C ˚
COST INDEX TRANS ALT COST INDEX TRANS ALT
18000 18000
<INDEX TAKEOFF> <INDEX TAKEOFF>

INIT RTE CLB CRZ DES BRT INIT RTE CLB CRZ DES BRT
REF REF

DIR LEGS DEP HOLD PROG EXEC DIR LEGS DEP HOLD PROG EXEC
INTC ARR INTC ARR

N1 N1
LIMIT FIX A B C D E LIMIT FIX A B C D E
PREV NEXT PREV NEXT
PAGE PAGE F G H I J PAGE PAGE F G H I J

1 2 3 K L M N O 1 2 3 K L M N O

4 5 6 P Q R S T 4 5 6 P Q R S T

7 8 9 U V W X Y 7 8 9 U V W X Y
. 0 + /- Z DEL / CLR . 0 + /- Z DEL / CLR

CDU FMC CDU FMC


The two Control Display Units (CDU) are The Flight Management Computer is The two Control Display Units (CDU) are The Flight Management Computer is
located in the P9 forward electronics located in the E1-2 rack. The FMC per- located in the P9 forward electronics located in the E1-2 rack. The FMC per-
panel, one on each side. The CDUs are forms the computations required to gener- panel, one on each side. The CDUs are forms the computations required to gener-
identical and either may be used to enter ate N1 limits, and airspeed commands, as identical and either may be used to enter ate N1 limits, and airspeed commands, as
or obtain information from the FMCS. well as lateral (LNAV) and vertical or obtain information from the FMCS. well as lateral (LNAV) and vertical
The unit has a CRT screen and a keyboard (VNAV) steering inputs to the autopilot. The unit has a CRT screen and a keyboard (VNAV) steering inputs to the autopilot.
with alpha, numeric and function keys. The FMC also includes a navigational with alpha, numeric and function keys. The FMC also includes a navigational
Along each side of the CRT are Line database, a performance database, and an Along each side of the CRT are Line database, a performance database, and an
Select Keys (LSK) which are used to operational program. Select Keys (LSK) which are used to operational program.
select and enter information. select and enter information.

34-102and Systems Introduction OCT 99 34-102 OCT 99


UNITED AIRLINES COURSE
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

Autoflight Status Annunciator OPERATION Autoflight Status Annunciator OPERATION


The Autoflight Status Annunciators are Position Updating The Autoflight Status Annunciators are Position Updating
located on the P1 and P3 panels inboard of The FMC determines its position on the located on the P1 and P3 panels inboard of The FMC determines its position on the
each EADI. It has three warning lights earth by using DME distances to triangu- each EADI. It has three warning lights earth by using DME distances to triangu-
with push-to-reset feature. A TEST switch late its position. The FMC can automati- with push-to-reset feature. A TEST switch late its position. The FMC can automati-
has three positions, a neutral spring loaded cally tune to the best DME stations for has three positions, a neutral spring loaded cally tune to the best DME stations for
center position, and positions 1 and 2. triangulation based on the geometry. center position, and positions 1 and 2. triangulation based on the geometry.
These test positions check the amber lights Auto-tuning These test positions check the amber lights Auto-tuning
(1) and red lights (2). The FMC light is When the NAV Tuning Panel is selected (1) and red lights (2). The FMC light is When the NAV Tuning Panel is selected
amber and illuminates if there is an alert to the AUTO mode, the FMC provides the amber and illuminates if there is an alert to the AUTO mode, the FMC provides the
message on the CDU or a FMC failure. DME and VOR system with frequencies message on the CDU or a FMC failure. DME and VOR system with frequencies
to tune to, which it has determined are the to tune to, which it has determined are the
best stations to tune to for DME position best stations to tune to for DME position
updating. The FMC chooses the best sta- updating. The FMC chooses the best sta-
tions to use based on geometry for triangu- tions to use based on geometry for triangu-
1 lation. 1 lation.
A/P A/T FMC Agility tuning A/P A/T FMC Agility tuning
2 2
P/RST P/RST P/RST
TEST When the FMC detects a malfunction in a P/RST P/RST P/RST
TEST When the FMC detects a malfunction in a
DME system or if one system is being DME system or if one system is being
manually tuned, the other DME system manually tuned, the other DME system
will go into agility tuning is selected in the will go into agility tuning is selected in the
AUTO mode. Agility tuning is where one AUTO mode. Agility tuning is where one
Status Annunciator Status Annunciator
DME system tunes to two or more stations DME system tunes to two or more stations
to best triangulate the aircraft's position, it to best triangulate the aircraft's position, it
switches between DME stations at 5 sec- switches between DME stations at 5 sec-
ond intervals. The FMC provides the ond intervals. The FMC provides the
DME system with the proper frequencies DME system with the proper frequencies
to use. to use.
Maintenance Practices Maintenance Practices
Database Loading Database Loading
Loading of the Navigational Database Loading of the Navigational Database
occurs every 28 days. The use of a Data occurs every 28 days. The use of a Data
Base Loader (DBL) is necessary. The Base Loader (DBL) is necessary. The
DBL has a floppy disk with the database DBL has a floppy disk with the database
information on it. The DBL is connected information on it. The DBL is connected
to a connector in the flight deck and the to a connector in the flight deck and the
information is down loaded into the FMC. information is down loaded into the FMC.
NOTE: Power must be removed from NOTE: Power must be removed from
the FMC when connecting or discon- the FMC when connecting or discon-
necting the DBL. necting the DBL.

and
OCT 99 Systems Introduction 34-103 OCT 99 34-103
UNITED
B737 GENERAL AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

BITE Inflt Fault BITE Inflt Fault


The BITE tests for DFCS, A/T, EFIS, IRS This display provides failure history for The BITE tests for DFCS, A/T, EFIS, IRS This display provides failure history for
and the FMC go through the FMC by applicable LRUs for the past nine flights and the FMC go through the FMC by applicable LRUs for the past nine flights
using the CDUs. The FMC BITE is and since landing. using the CDUs. The FMC BITE is and since landing.
accessed by going to the MAINT BITE CDU Test accessed by going to the MAINT BITE CDU Test
INDEX page on the CDU, then selecting Provides selection of CDU keyboard test INDEX page on the CDU, then selecting Provides selection of CDU keyboard test
FMCS. The selections of the FMCS BITE and CDU display test. FMCS. The selections of the FMCS BITE and CDU display test.
are INFLT FAULTS, CDU TEST, SEN- Sensors are INFLT FAULTS, CDU TEST, SEN- Sensors
SORS, DISCRETES, FIXED OUTPUTS, Provides sensor status of all sensor inputs SORS, DISCRETES, FIXED OUTPUTS, Provides sensor status of all sensor inputs
PERF FACTOR, and IRS MONITOR. to the FMC. Can show OK, FAIL or PERF FACTOR, and IRS MONITOR. to the FMC. Can show OK, FAIL or
NOTE: Engineering codes 100 and 300 TEST. NOTE: Engineering codes 100 and 300 TEST.
may be used with some of the FMCS Discretes may be used with some of the FMCS Discretes
BITE information. Provides the analog discrete inputs into BITE information. Provides the analog discrete inputs into
the FMC. the FMC.
Fixed Outputs Fixed Outputs
Provides specified parameters to Thrust Provides specified parameters to Thrust
Mode Annunciator Panel. Mode Annunciator Panel.
PERF Factor PERF Factor
Provides information on the Performance Provides information on the Performance
Factors page. Factors page.
IRS Monitor IRS Monitor
Provides the IRS position error rate in Provides the IRS position error rate in
nautical miles. nautical miles.

34-104and Systems Introduction OCT 99 34-104 OCT 99


UNITED AIRLINES COURSE
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
CONTROLS & INDICATIONS CONTROLS & INDICATIONS

STANDBY ATTITUDE INDICATOR STANDBY ATTITUDE INDICATOR


Location: Center Instrument Panel Location: Center Instrument Panel
G/S Flag Gyro Flag G/S Flag Gyro Flag
Indicates glide slope input is unreliable. Indicates attitude is unreliable. Indicates glide slope input is unreliable. Indicates attitude is unreliable.

Glide Slope Bar and Scale Glide Slope Bar and Scale
Indicates glide slope position with Indicates glide slope position with respect
respect to airplane. to airplane.
30 30

20 20
G
S
Airplane Symbol G
S
Airplane Symbol
Indicates airplane attitude in relation to Indicates airplane attitude in relation to the
10 10

10 the horizon. 10 horizon.


20 20
30 C Caging Knob 30 C Caging Knob
OFF
ILS LO OFF
ILS LO
ILS B/CRS Erects gyro in pitch and roll when ILS B/CRS Erects gyro in pitch and roll when pulled
pulled
Localizer Bar and Scale
LOC Flag Localizer Bar and Scale Indicates localizer position with respect to
LOC Flag
Indicates localizer input is unreliable Indicates localizer position with
Indicates localizer input is unreliable airplane. No VOR information available.
respect to airplane. No VOR informa-
OFF/ILS/BCRS Selector tion available. OFF/ILS/BCRS Selector
OFF - Retracts glide slope and localizer OFF - Retracts glide slope and localizer
bars from view. bars from view.
ILS - Activates glide slope and localizer ILS - Activates glide slope and localizer
bars and flags. ILS signals re provided bars and flags. ILS signals re provided
by the No. 1 VHF NAV receiver. by the No. 1 VHF NAV receiver.
B/CRS - Reverses sensing of localizer B/CRS - Reverses sensing of localizer
bar for back course approach. bar for back course approach.

STANDBY MAGNETIC COMPASS STANDBY MAGNETIC COMPASS


Location: Windshield Center Post Location: Windshield Center Post

Compass Card Compass Card


Indicates heading of airplane relative to Indicates heading of airplane relative to
magnetic north. magnetic north.
30 W 24 2 30 W 24 2
Light Switch Light Switch
Turns on Compass Light Turns on Compass Light

and
OCT 99 Systems Introduction 34-105 OCT 99 34-105
UNITED
B737 GENERAL AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
CONTROLS & INDICATIONS CONTROLS & INDICATIONS

RADIO DISTANCE MAGNETIC RADIO DISTANCE MAGNETIC


INDICATOR (RDMI) INDICATOR (RDMI)
Location: Capt. and F/O Instrument Panel Location: Capt. and F/O Instrument Panel

DME Indicators DME Indicators


Searches maximum of 300 nm for all Searches maximum of 300 nm for all
DME stations. DME stations.
Warning Flag - Indicates electrical power Warning Flag - Indicates electrical power
lost, or invalid DME receiver. lost, or invalid DME receiver.
Dashes - Indicates DME receiver powered Dashes - Indicates DME receiver powered
but not receiving a DME station, or FMC but not receiving a DME station, or FMC
is agility tuning. is agility tuning.

Bearing Pointer No. Bearing Pointer No.


2 Warning Flag 2 Warning Flag
HDG Warning Flag 1250 1558 VOR Mode - Indi- HDG Warning Flag VOR Mode - Indicates
Indicates invalid Indicates invalid 1250 1558
DME-1 DME-2 cates unreliable VHF unreliable VHF NAV
compass signal or compass signal or
G
HD DME-1 DME-2
NAV signal or power signal or power fail-
G
HD
power failure. 12 15 failure. power failure. ure.
9 12 15
ADF Mode - Indi- 9 ADF Mode - Indicates
18

18
cates power failure. power failure.
3 6

3 6
21 24

Bearing Pointer Bearing Pointer

21 24
No. 1 Warning Flag No. 1 Warning Flag
VOR Mode - Indi- VOR Mode - Indi-
0

27

0
27
cates VHF NAV sig- 30 33 cates VHF NAV sig-
AD

30 33

AD
F

nal unreliable or nal unreliable or

F
F
AD

F
power failure. power failure.

AD
Bearing Pointers Bearing Pointers
Narrow Pointer - Narrow Pointer - Uses
ADF/VOR Bearing Pointer Switches ADF/VOR Bearing Pointer Switches
Uses signals from the signals from the VHF
Push to select bearing pointer source as Push to select bearing pointer source as
VHF Nav 1. Nav 1.
ADF or VOR. Selection annunciated ADF or VOR. Selection annunciated
Wide Pointer - Uses Wide Pointer - Uses
above switch. No. 1 switch operates even above switch. No. 1 switch operates even
signals from the VHF signals from the VHF
though a No. 1 ADF is not installed though a No. 1 ADF is not installed
Nav 2 or ADF 2. Nav 2 or ADF 2.
(except on overwater airplanes). (except on overwater airplanes).

34-106and Systems Introduction OCT 99 34-106 OCT 99


UNITED AIRLINES COURSE
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
CONTROLS & INDICATIONS CONTROLS & INDICATIONS

EFIS CONTROL PANEL EFIS CONTROL PANEL


Location: Control Pedestal Location: Control Pedestal
DH REF Indicator DH REF Indicator
Dispays selected deci- ADI HSI RANGE Dispays selected deci- ADI HSI RANGE
FULL EXP FULL EXP
sion height. DH REF VOR/ILS VOR/ILS 80
160 320 sion height. DH REF VOR/ILS VOR/ILS 80
160 320
Defaults to 200 feet. MAP 40 Defaults to 200 feet. MAP 40
Selected DH is also dis- 20 TF
C Selected DH is also dis- 20 TF
C
CTR CTR
played on ADI (unless a MAP 10 played on ADI (unless MAP 10
BRT BRT
negative number is PLAN WXR a negative number is PLAN WXR

selected). selected).
ON ON
RST RST
DH Selector MAP DH Selector MAP
BRT BRT
Selects desired decision VOR/ADF NAV AID ARPT RTE DATA WPT
Selects desired decision VOR/ADF NAV AID ARPT RTE DATA WPT

height for DH alerting. ON ON ON ON ON height for DH alerting. ON ON ON ON ON

DH RST (Reset) But- DH RST (Reset) But-


ton ADI BRT Knob ton
When pushed: Adjusts brightness of When pushed:
ADI BRT Knob
ADI display Adjusts brightness of
Resets DH alert when Resets DH alert when
ADI display
pushed. Changes RA RANGE Selector pushed. Changes RA
display from yellow to Selects range dis- display from yellow to
RANGE Selector
played in HSI in nauti- Selects range dis-
white. white.
cal miles. played in HSI in nauti-
In MAP, CTR MAP cal miles.
HSI Brightness Knobs HSI Brightness Knobs
and PLAN: selects In MAP, CTR MAP
Outer Knob - Adjusts Outer Knob - Adjusts
map range. and PLAN: selects
HSI brightness. HSI brightness.
In EXP FOR/ILS, map range.
Inner Knob - Adjusts Inner Knob - Adjusts
MAP, and CTR MAP: In EXP FOR/ILS,
weather radar bright- weather radar bright-
selects radar range and MAP, and CTR MAP:
ness. ness.
map range if applica- selects radar range and
ble. map range if applica-
ADI
FULL EXP
HSI
RANGE ADI
FULL EXP
HSI
RANGE ble.
DH REF VOR/ILS VOR/ILS 160 320 DH REF VOR/ILS VOR/ILS 160 320
80 80
MAP 40 MAP 40
20 C 20 C
CTR TF CTR TF
MAP 10 MAP 10
BRT WXR
WXR Radar Switch BRT WXR
PLAN PLAN
Displays detected WXR Radar Switch
ON weather or test pattern ON
Displays detected
RST
on HSIs when pushed
RST weather or test pattern
BRT
MAP
in depending on posi- BRT
MAP on HSIs when pushed
VOR/ADF NAV AID ARPT RTE DATA WPT VOR/ADF NAV AID ARPT RTE DATA WPT
tion of the WX radar in depending on posi-
ON ON ON ON ON
function selector.
ON ON ON ON ON tion of the WX radar
function selector.

and
OCT 99 Systems Introduction 34-107 OCT 99 34-107
UNITED
B737 GENERAL AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
CONTROLS & INDICATIONS CONTROLS & INDICATIONS

EFIS CONTROL PANEL TFC EFIS CONTROL PANEL TFC


Location: Control Pedestal Pushing the TFC Location: Control Pedestal Pushing the TFC
button enables or button enables or
inhibits the dis- inhibits the dis-
HSI play of traffic on HSI
play of traffic on
ADI ADI
DH REF
FULL EXP RANGE the HSI DH REF
FULL EXP RANGE the HSI
VOR/ILS VOR/ILS 160 320 VOR/ILS VOR/ILS 160 320
80 80
MAP 40 MAP 40
20 C 20 C
CTR TF CTR TF
MAP 10 MAP 10
BRT PLAN WXR BRT PLAN WXR

ON ON
RST RST
MAP MAP
BRT VOR/ADF NAV AID ARPT RTE DATA WPT BRT VOR/ADF NAV AID ARPT RTE DATA WPT

ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON ON

MAP Switches MAP Switches


Displays respective background data/symbols on HSI when Displays respective background data/symbols on HSI when selected.
selected. Multiple options can be selected simultaneously. White Multiple options can be selected simultaneously. White "ON" light (in
"ON" light (in switch) illuminates when selected. switch) illuminates when selected.

VOR/ADF - Displays vectors to VOR-1, VOR-2, ADF-2. A usable VOR/ADF - Displays vectors to VOR-1, VOR-2, ADF-2. A usable sta-
station must be selected and valid data received for the ADF vector tion must be selected and valid data received for the ADF vector to
to appear. appear.

NAV AID (Nav aids) - Displays high altitude navigation aids if in NAV AID (Nav aids) - Displays high altitude navigation aids if in
MAP mode with ranges 80, 160, or 320 nm selected, and displays MAP mode with ranges 80, 160, or 320 nm selected, and displays all
all nav aids with ranges 10, 20, or 40 nm selected. nav aids with ranges 10, 20, or 40 nm selected.

ARPT (Airports) - Displays all airports stored in FMC data base ARPT (Airports) - Displays all airports stored in FMC data base and
and within HSI MAP mode viewing area. Depicted airports have a within HSI MAP mode viewing area. Depicted airports have a mini-
minimum of one runway that is at least 5000 feet long. mum of one runway that is at least 5000 feet long.

RTE DATA (Route data) - Displays altitude constraint (if applica- RTE DATA (Route data) - Displays altitude constraint (if applicable)
ble) and ETA for each waypoint along active route. and ETA for each waypoint along active route.

WPT (Waypoints) - Displays the waypoints in FMC data base WPT (Waypoints) - Displays the waypoints in FMC data base which
which are not in flight plan route if selected range is 40 nm or less. are not in flight plan route if selected range is 40 nm or less.

34-108and Systems Introduction OCT 99 34-108 OCT 99


UNITED AIRLINES COURSE
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
CONTROLS & INDICATIONS CONTROLS & INDICATIONS

EFIS TRANSFER AND LIGHTING EFIS TRANSFER AND LIGHTING


Location: Forward Overhead Panel Location: Forward Overhead Panel
EFI Switch EFI Switch
Provides a means to switch Provides a means to switch
either Electronic Flight Instru- either Electronic Flight Instru-
ment displays to the opposite EFI ment displays to the opposite
EFI symbol generator should the symbol generator should the
BOTH BOTH normal symbol generator fail. BOTH BOTH normal symbol generator fail.
ON 1 ON 2 Only the respective EFIS con- ON 1 ON 2 Only the respective EFIS con-
trol panel will be operative. trol panel will be operative.
NORMAL
NORMAL

Location: Capt. and F/O Instrument Panel Location: Capt. and F/O Instrument Panel

INSTR SWITCH Light INSTR SWITCH Light


INSTR INSTR
ON - Indicates one or both of ON - Indicates one or both of
SWITCH SWITCH
the instrument transfer switches the instrument transfer
ALTITUDE ALTITUDE
(EFI or IRS) has been moved switches (EFI or IRS) has been
ALERT ALERT
out to the normal position. moved out to the normal posi-
tion.
Integral Light Sensors
Provide automatic control of Integral Light Sensors
EFIS ADI and HSI display Provide automatic control of
ADI HSI brightness as a function of ADI HSI EFIS ADI and HSI display
ambient light striking the face brightness as a function of
of the display unit. ambient light striking the face
of the display unit.

Location: Glare Shield Location: Glare Shield

Remote Light Sensor


Provides automatic adjustment Remote Light Sensor
of EFIS ADI and HSI display Provides automatic adjustment
brightness, as a function of of EFIS ADI and HSI display
ambient light coming through brightness, as a function of
the forward windows, ambient light coming through
the forward windows,

and
OCT 99 Systems Introduction 34-109 OCT 99 34-109
UNITED
B737 GENERAL AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
CONTROLS & INDICATIONS CONTROLS & INDICATIONS

ELECTRONIC ATTITUDE DIRECTOR ELECTRONIC ATTITUDE DIRECTOR


INDICATOR (EADI) INDICATOR (EADI)
Location: Captain and F/O Instrument Panel Location: Captain and F/O Instrument Panel

Bank Indicator and Scale (White) Airplane Symbol (Gray) Bank Indicator and Scale (White) Airplane Symbol (Gray)
From fixed pointer reference, scale marks Indicates airplane attitude From fixed pointer reference, scale marks Indicates airplane attitude
are at 0, 10, 20, 30, 45, and 60 degrees. with reference to the IRS are at 0, 10, 20, 30, 45, and 60 degrees. with reference to the IRS
horizon. horizon.

TCAS Pitch Guidance TCAS Pitch Guidance


Presentation Presentation
Indicates with red outlines Indicates with red outlines
areas of possible conflict to areas of possible conflict to
be avoided. MCP SPD ALT HOLD VOR/LOC CMD be avoided. MCP SPD ALT HOLD VOR/LOC CMD
Controlling the airplane Controlling the airplane
pitch, to avoid these areas, pitch, to avoid these areas, 20
20
provides adequate vertical 20 provides adequate vertical 20
separation from conflicting separation from conflict-
340
340
10
traffic. 10
10 ing traffic. 10
320
320
31 32 31 32
300
300
10
10 10
10 280
280

.750 .750

Current Mach (White) Horizon and Pitch Scale (White) Current Mach (White) Horizon and Pitch Scale (White)
Displayed when Mach increases above Indicates the IRS horizon relative the air- Displayed when Mach increases above .40 Indicates the IRS horizon relative the air-
.40 Mach. plane symbol. Pitch scale is in 2.5 degree Mach. plane symbol. Pitch scale is in 2.5 degree
Display is blanked when Mach decreases increments Display is blanked when Mach decreases increments
below .38 Mach. below .38 Mach.

34-111and Systems Introduction OCT 99 34-111 OCT 99


UNITED AIRLINES COURSE
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
CONTROLS & INDICATIONS CONTROLS & INDICATIONS

ELECTRONIC ATTITUDE DIRECTOR ELECTRONIC ATTITUDE DIRECTOR


INDICATOR (EADI) INDICATOR (EADI)
Location: Captain and F/O Instrument Panel Location: Captain and F/O Instrument Panel

DH (Decision Height) (Green) DH (Decision Height) (Green)


Displays selected decision height as set on the EFIS control Displays selected decision height as set on the EFIS control
panel. panel.
Blank when negative DH is selected. Blank when negative DH is selected.
Display changes to large yellow DH that momentarily Display changes to large yellow DH that momentarily flashes
flashes when descending through the decision height. when descending through the decision height.
Alert is reset automatically if airplane climbs 75 feet or more Alert is reset automatically if airplane climbs 75 feet or more
above selected DH, after landing, or manually by pressing above selected DH, after landing, or manually by pressing the
the RST switch on the EFIS control panel. RST switch on the EFIS control panel.

MCP SPD G/S VOR/LOC CMD


Pitch Limit Symbol MCP SPD G/S VOR/LOC CMD
(Yellow) Pitch Limit Symbol
20
Indicates pitch attitude 180
20 (Yellow) 180 20
corresponding to stick
20
Indicates pitch attitude
10
corresponding to stick
160
shaker activation. Dis- 160
10
10 10
shaker activation. Dis-
1
played with the flaps 1
140
140
extended. 9 played with the flaps 9
R

120
R
extended. 120
10
10 10
10 100 DH200
100 DH200
Flight Director Com- 1700
1700
mand Bars (Magenta) Flight Director Com-
Displays flight director mand Bars (Magenta)
pitch and roll commands. Displays flight director
pitch and roll commands.
Slip Indicator Slip Indicator

Radio Altitude (White) Radio Altitude (White)


Displays radio altitude below 2500 feet AGL. Displays radio altitude below 2500 feet AGL.
Blank above 2500 feet AGL. Blank above 2500 feet AGL.
Changes color from white to yellow when below Changes color from white to yellow when below
selected DH on descent. selected DH on descent.
Changes to white when passing selected DH plus 75 Changes to white when passing selected DH plus 75
feet during go-around, after touchdown, or after feet during go-around, after touchdown, or after press-
pressing RST Switch on EFIS Control Panel. ing RST Switch on EFIS Control Panel.

and
OCT 99 Systems Introduction 34-112 OCT 99 34-112
UNITED
B737 GENERAL AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
CONTROLS & INDICATIONS CONTROLS & INDICATIONS

EADI ILS INDICATIONS EADI ILS INDICATIONS


Location: Captain and F/O Instrument Panels Location: Captain and F/O Instrument Panels

Rising Runway Symbol (Green) Rising Runway Symbol (Green)


Displayed when localizer pointer is in view Displayed when localizer pointer is in
and radio altitude is valid. view and radio altitude is valid.
Rises towards airplane when radio altitude Rises towards airplane when radio altitude
is below 200 feet AGL. is below 200 feet AGL.

MCP SPD G/S VOR/LOC CMD MCP SPD G/S VOR/LOC CMD

20 20
180 20 180 20

160 10 160 10
10 10
1 1
140 140
9 9
R R

120 120
10 10
10 10
100 DH200 100 DH200
1700 1700

Localizer Pointer and Deviation Scale Glide Slope Pointer and Deviation Localizer Pointer and Deviation Scale Glide Slope Pointer and Deviation Scale
(Magenta/White) Scale (Magenta/White) (Magenta/White) (Magenta/White)
Pointer indicates localizer position. Pointer indicates glideslope position. Pointer indicates localizer position. Pointer indicates glideslope position.
Scale indicates deviation. Scale indicates deviation. Scale indicates deviation. Scale indicates deviation.
When LOC is engaged and deviation is Pointer is not displayed when the glide When LOC is engaged and deviation is Pointer is not displayed when the glide
slightly more than one half dot, scale slope signal is unusable or when track slightly more than one half dot, scale slope signal is unusable or when track and
expands. and the front course on the MCP differ expands. the front course on the MCP differ by
Pointer is blanked when ILS LOC signal by more than 90°. Pointer is blanked when ILS LOC signal is more than 90°.
is too weak to be usable. too weak to be usable.

34-113and Systems Introduction OCT 99 34-113 OCT 99


UNITED AIRLINES COURSE
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
CONTROLS & INDICATIONS CONTROLS & INDICATIONS

EADI SPEED TAPE DISPLAY EADI SPEED TAPE DISPLAY


Location: Captain and F/O Instrument Panels Location: Captain and F/O Instrument Panels

V1 (Decision speed) (Green) V1 (Decision speed) (Green)


Displayed after manual entry on the FMC/ Displayed after manual entry on the FMC/
CDU TAKEOFF REF page. CDU TAKEOFF REF page.
160 V1 Displayed in this location during initial Displayed in this location during initial
takeoff roll when V1 is beyond the dis- 160 V1 takeoff roll when V1 is beyond the dis-
128 128
played range. played range.
140 140
FMC/MCP Command Speed (Magenta) FMC/MCP Command Speed (Magenta)
R R
1
12 32 VR (Rotation speed) (Green)
Displayed after manual entry on the FMC/ 12 32
1 VR (Rotation speed) (Green)
Displayed after manual entry on the FMC/
CDU TAKEOFF REF page. CDU TAKEOFF REF page.
100 100
V1 (Decision speed) (Green) V1 (Decision speed) (Green)
Symbol replaces digital V1 display when Symbol replaces digital V1 display when
the V1 speed is within the displayed range. the V1 speed is within the displayed range.
90 90
Speed Tape Scale (White) Speed Tape Scale (White)
Scrolls up and down in response to the Air Scrolls up and down in response to the Air
Data Computer Calibrated airspeed. Data Computer Calibrated airspeed.
Range is 45 to 420 knots. Range is 45 to 420 knots.

Flaps Up Maneuvering Speed (Green) Flaps Up Maneuvering Speed (Green)


220 Displayed when flaps are up. Displayed when flaps are up.
220
Rolling Digits Display (White) Rolling Digits Display (White)
200 Indicates current airspeed. Indicates current airspeed.
Position is fixed relative to EADI display. 200 Position is fixed relative to EADI display.

18 32 Airspeed Trend Arrow (Green)


Tip of arrow depicts predicted airspeed 18 32
Airspeed Trend Arrow (Green)
Tip of arrow depicts predicted airspeed
within the next ten seconds based on within the next ten seconds based on
160 present airspeed and acceleration. present airspeed and acceleration.
160
FMC/MCP Command Speed (Magenta) FMC/MCP Command Speed (Magenta)
140 Displayed in this location when the FMC/ Displayed in this location when the FMC/
MCP command speed is below displayed 140 MCP command speed is below displayed
134 range. 134 range.

and
OCT 99 Systems Introduction 34-114 OCT 99 34-114
UNITED
B737 GENERAL AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
CONTROLS & INDICATIONS CONTROLS & INDICATIONS

EADI SPEED TAPE DISPLAY EADI SPEED TAPE DISPLAY


Location: Captain and F/O Instrument Panel Location: Captain and F/O Instrument Panel

250 FMC/MCP Command Speed (Magenta) 250 FMC/MCP Command Speed (Magenta)
Displayed in this location when the FMC/MCP Displayed in this location when the FMC/MCP
Command speed is above displayed range. Command speed is above displayed range.
180 180
F F
Minimum Flap Retraction Speed (Green) Minimum Flap Retraction Speed (Green)
160 Display on speed tape during takeoff or go- 160 Display on speed tape during takeoff or go-
around. around.
15 32 15 32
140 Minimum Maneuver Speed (Yellow) 140 Minimum Maneuver Speed (Yellow)
Top of yellow bar indicates minimum maneuver Top of yellow bar indicates minimum maneuver
120 speed. 120 speed.

Stick Shaker Speed (Red and Black) Stick Shaker Speed (Red and Black)
Top of barber pole indicates speed at which stick Top of barber pole indicates speed at which stick
shaker is activated. shaker is activated.
180 180
Placard Speed (Red and Black) Placard Speed (Red and Black)
Indicates gear placard speed or flap extended Indicates gear placard speed or flap extended
160 placard speed for selected flap position, as appli- 160 placard speed for selected flap position, as appli-
cable. cable.
15 32 15 32
140 Next Flap Position Placard Speed (Yellow) 140 Next Flap Position Placard Speed (Yellow)
R R
Bottom of hollow yellow bar indicates the flap Bottom of hollow yellow bar indicates the flap
120 extended placard speed for the next normal flap 120 extended placard speed for the next normal flap
position. position.
Displayed during flap extension. Displayed during flap extension.
134 134
VREF Speed (Green) VREF Speed (Green)
Indicates the VREF speed fro the landing flap Indicates the VREF speed fro the landing flap
340 configuration as selected on the FMC/CDU 340 configuration as selected on the FMC/CDU
APPROACH REF page. APPROACH REF page.

320 MAX Operating Speed (Red and Black) 320 MAX Operating Speed (Red and Black)
31 32 Indicates Vmo/Mmo. 31 32 Indicates Vmo/Mmo.
300 300
High Speed Buffet Limit High Speed Buffet Limit
Bottom of hollow yellow bar indicates speed that Bottom of hollow yellow bar indicates speed that
280 provides .3G maneuver margin to high speed buf- 280 provides .3G maneuver margin to high speed buf-
fet at high altitudes. fet at high altitudes.

34-115and Systems Introduction OCT 99 34-115 OCT 99


UNITED AIRLINES COURSE
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
CONTROLS & INDICATIONS CONTROLS & INDICATIONS

EADI FAILURE FLAGS EADI FAILURE FLAGS


Location: Captain and F/O Instrument Panel Location: Captain and F/O Instrument Panel

ATT Flag ATT Flag


Attitude display Attitude display
has failed. has failed.
FD Flag FD Flag
Pitch and/or roll flight Pitch and/or roll flight
SEL SPD director commands SEL SPD director commands
Command speed symbol and have failed. Command speed symbol and have failed.
displays are inopertive. displays are inopertive.

SEL SPD SEL SPD


V1 INOP V1 V1 INOP V1
INOP FD INOP FD
V1 display is V1 display is
inopertive. inopertive.
ATT ATT
S S
P P
D SG FAIL D SG FAIL
SPD Flag SPD Flag
Fast/ Slow associated Fast/ Slow associated
with stick shaker, and with stick shaker, and
maximum operating SPD
LIM DH
maximum operating SPD
LIM DH
speeds have failed. speeds have failed.
RA RA
MACH LOC MACH LOC

MACH Flag MACH Flag


Mach number Mach number
display has failed. RA Flag display has failed. RA Flag
Radio altitude Radio altitude
display has failed. display has failed.

DH Flag DH Flag
Selected decision height Selected decision height
display has failed. display has failed.

SG FAIL LOC Flag SG FAIL LOC Flag


The selected synbol Localizer deviation display on The selected synbol Localizer deviation display on
generator has failed. the ADI has failed. generator has failed. the ADI has failed.

and
OCT 99 Systems Introduction 34-116 OCT 99 34-116
UNITED
B737 GENERAL AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
CONTROLS & INDICATIONS CONTROLS & INDICATIONS

EHSI FULL VOR MODE EHSI FULL VOR MODE


Location: Captain and F/O Instrument Panel Location: Captain and F/O Instrument Panel

Drift Angle Pointer Drift Angle Pointer

Course Deviation Indication Course Deviation Indication


and Scale and Scale

DME 13.5
DME 13.5 13.5
DME 13.5
DME
TAS 148
TAS 300 GS 140
GS140 148
TAS 300
TAS 140
GS140
GS

HDG
HDG 127
127 M
M HDG
HDG 127
127 M
M

Airplane Symbol Airplane Symbol


1122 1155 1122 1155
99 99
18

18
66

66
21

21
33

33
Heading Bug Heading Bug
24

24
00

00
3333 2277 3333 2277
3300 3300

FROM FROM
117˚/20
117˚/20 117˚/20
117˚/20
ILS 11
ILS 110.10
110.10 ILS 11
ILS 110.10
110.10

TO/FROM Indicators TO/FROM Indicators

34-117and Systems Introduction OCT 99 34-117 OCT 99


UNITED AIRLINES COURSE
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
CONTROLS & INDICATIONS CONTROLS & INDICATIONS

EHSI FULL ILS MODE EHSI FULL ILS MODE


Location: Captain and F/O Instrument Panel Location: Captain and F/O Instrument Panel

Reference ILS DME Distance Reference ILS DME Distance

True Airspeed True Airspeed

Current Heading Drift Angle Pointer Current Heading Drift Angle Pointer

Groundspeed Groundspeed

DME 13.5
DME
DME 13.5
DME TAS 148
TAS GS140
GS 140
TAS 148
TAS GS140
GS 140
HDG 127 M
M
HDG 127 M
M

12 15
12 15
9
9 Glide Slope Pointer

18
Glide Slope Pointer
18

6
and Scale
6

and Scale

21
21

3
3

2244
00
2244
00

33 27
33 27 30
30

117˚/20
117˚/20
117˚/20
117˚/20 ILS 11
ILS 110.10
110.10
ILS 11
ILS 110.10
110.10

Reference ILS Reference ILS


Frequency Frequency

Wind Arrow/Speed Wind Arrow/Speed


and Direction and Direction

and
OCT 99 Systems Introduction 34-118 OCT 99 34-118
UNITED
B737 GENERAL AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
CONTROLS & INDICATIONS CONTROLS & INDICATIONS

EHSI EXP VOR MODE EHSI EXP VOR MODE


Location: Captain and F/O Instrument Panel Location: Captain and F/O Instrument Panel

Reference VOR DME Distance Reference VOR DME Distance

True Airspeed True Airspeed


Current Heading Weather Radar Return Current Heading Weather Radar Return

Groundspeed Groundspeed

DME 13.5 HDG 127 M


GS290
ADF 2 Pointer DME 13.5 HDG 127 M
GS290
ADF 2 Pointer
TAS 300 TAS 300

Selected Course Selected Course


12
15 Pointer 12
15 Pointer

40 40
Course Deviation Course Deviation
Indication and Scale Indication and Scale
TO/FROM TO/FROM
Indication Indication

FROM FROM
117˚/20 117˚/20
VOR 2 113.90 VOR 2 113.90

Reference VOR Reference VOR


Frequency Frequency

Airplane Symbol Airplane Symbol


Wind Arrow/Speed Wind Arrow/Speed
and Direction and Direction

34-119and Systems Introduction OCT 99 34-119 OCT 99


UNITED AIRLINES COURSE
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
CONTROLS & INDICATIONS CONTROLS & INDICATIONS

EHSI EXP ILS MODE EHSI EXP ILS MODE


Location: Captain and F/O Instrument Panel Location: Captain and F/O Instrument Panel

Reference ILS DME Distance Reference ILS DME Distance

True Airspeed True Airspeed


Current Heading Current Heading

Groundspeed Groundspeed

DME 13.5 HDG 127 M DME 13.5 HDG 127 M


GS140 GS140
TAS 148 TAS 148

Selected Course Selected Course


12
15 Pointer 12
15 Pointer
Course Deviation Course Deviation
Indication and Scale Indication and Scale

40 40

Glide Slope Pointer Glide Slope Pointer


and Scale and Scale

117˚/20 117˚/20
ILS 1 110.10 ILS 1 110.10

Reference ILS Reference ILS


Frequency Frequency

Wind Arrow/Speed Wind Arrow/Speed


and Direction and Direction

and
OCT 99 Systems Introduction 34-120 OCT 99 34-120
UNITED
B737 GENERAL AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
CONTROLS & INDICATIONS CONTROLS & INDICATIONS

EHSI MAP MODE EHSI MAP MODE


Location: Captain and F/O Instrument Panel Location: Captain and F/O Instrument Panel

Current Heading Pointer Current Heading Pointer


Current Magnetic Track Current Magnetic Track
Active Waypoint Groundspeed Active Waypoint Groundspeed
Distance Distance

True Airspeed ADF Pointer 2 True Airspeed ADF Pointer 2

25.5 NM TRK 136 M


1335.4Z 25.5 NM TRK 136 M
1335.4Z
Weather Radar 300
TAS GS290
Weather Radar 300
TAS GS290
Returns Returns
15 15
12 12
ABCDE ABCDE
10000 10000
Track Line and 14022
Track Line and 14022

Range Scale Range Scale


ABC FGHIJ ABC FGHIJ
24000 24000
40 15382 40 15382

KLMNO KLMNO
DEF 35000 DEF 35000
13352 13352

NOP NOP

HIJ HIJ

117˚/20 117˚/20
ILS 1 ILS 1
2580 2580

Wind Arrow/Speed Wind Arrow/Speed


Direction VNAV Deviation Direction VNAV Deviation
Scale and Pointer Scale and Pointer
Airplane Symbol Airplane Symbol

34-121and Systems Introduction OCT 99 34-121 OCT 99


UNITED AIRLINES COURSE
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
CONTROLS & INDICATIONS CONTROLS & INDICATIONS

EHSI CTR MAP MODE EHSI CTR MAP MODE


Location: Captain and F/O Instrument Panel Location: Captain and F/O Instrument Panel

Active Waypoint Distance Active Waypoint Distance

Current Heading Pointer Active Waypoint ETA Current Heading Pointer Active Waypoint ETA

25.5 NM TRK 136 M


1335.4Z 25.5 NM TRK 136 M
1335.4Z
300
TAS GS290 Selected Heading Bug 300
TAS GS290 Selected Heading Bug
15 and Reference Line 15 and Reference Line
12 12
18 18
40 40
KLM KLM
KLMNO KLMNO
9

9
35000 35000
13352 13352
DEF DEF
Active Route Active Route
HIJ HIJ

XYZ VWXYZ XYZ VWXYZ

QRS 2580 QRS 2580


117˚/20 117˚/20
ILS 1 ILS 1

and
OCT 99 Systems Introduction 34-122 OCT 99 34-122
UNITED
B737 GENERAL AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
CONTROLS & INDICATIONS CONTROLS & INDICATIONS

EHSI PLAN MODE EHSI PLAN MODE


Location: Captain and F/O Instrument Panel Location: Captain and F/O Instrument Panel

Active Waypoint Information Active Waypoint Information


Time and distance to the active Time and distance to the active
waypoint. waypoint.

25.5 NM TRK 136 M


1335.4Z 25.5 NM TRK 136 M
1335.4Z
TAS300 GS290 TAS300 GS290

15 Present Track 15 Present Track


12 12

ABCD Active Compass Rose ABCD Active Compass Rose


32R 32R
EFGH N EFGH N

JKL True North Pointer JKL True North Pointer


Plan mode always depicts Plan mode always depicts
XYZ XYZ
true north up. true north up.

ABC ABC

34-123and Systems Introduction OCT 99 34-123 OCT 99


UNITED AIRLINES COURSE
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
CONTROLS & INDICATIONS CONTROLS & INDICATIONS

EHSI FAILURE INDICATIONS AND FLAGS EHSI FAILURE INDICATIONS AND FLAGS
Location: Captain and F/O Instrument Panel Location: Captain and F/O Instrument Panel

EXCESS DATA Annunciation EXCESS DATA Annunciation


Refresh rate of MAP display has Refresh rate of MAP display has
dropped below limit dropped below limit
TRK/HDG Flag TRK/HDG Flag
MAP Flag (CTR MAP mode) MAP Flag (CTR MAP mode)

TRK TRK
HDG HDG

SG Fail SG Fail
Annunciator Annunciator

MAP MAP

VOR 1 VOR 2 VOR 1 VOR 2


EXCESS MAP EXCESS MAP
DATA DATA V
V XXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXX T
XXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXX T
XXXXXXXXXXXX K XXXXXXXXXXXX K
XXXXXXXXXXXX XXXXXXXXXXXX VTK Flag
VTK Flag
FMC vertical track VOR FMC vertical track
VOR
LOC has failed LOC has failed

VOR or LOC VOR or LOC


Flag (EXP VOR/ Flag (EXP VOR/
ILS mode) ILS mode)

WXR Annunciations WXR Annunciations


WX FAIL - Weather radar has failed. WX FAIL - Weather radar has failed.
WXR WEAK - Weather radar calibration fault. WXR WEAK - Weather radar calibration fault.
WX ATT - Attitude stabilization is inoperative. WX ATT - Attitude stabilization is inoperative.
WX STAB - Antenna stabilization is off. WX STAB - Antenna stabilization is off.
WX DSPY - Loss of cooling or overheat condition has caused WX DSPY - Loss of cooling or overheat condition has caused
weather display to blank weather display to blank

and
OCT 99 Systems Introduction 34-124 OCT 99 34-124
UNITED
B737 GENERAL AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
CONTROLS & INDICATIONS CONTROLS & INDICATIONS

EHSI FAILURE INDICATIONS AND FLAGS EHSI FAILURE INDICATIONS AND FLAGS
Location: Captain and F/O Instrument Panel Location: Captain and F/O Instrument Panel

VOR 1/2 (MAP or CTR MAP mode VOR 1/2 (MAP or CTR MAP mode
with VOR/ADF map switch on. with VOR/ADF map switch on.

TRK TRK
HDG HDG

MAP MAP

VOR 1 VOR 2 VOR 1 VOR 2


EXCESS MAP EXCESS MAP
DATA DATA V
V XXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXX T
XXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXX T
XXXXXXXXXXXX K XXXXXXXXXXXX K
XXXXXXXXXXXX XXXXXXXXXXXX

VOR VOR
LOC LOC

Range Disagreement Annunciations MAP Flag (Map modes) Range Disagreement Annunciations MAP Flag (Map modes)
MAP/WXR RANGE DISAGREE - MAP/WXR RANGE DISAGREE - Indi-
Indicates selected range on the EFIS Con- cates selected range on the EFIS Control
trol Panel is different than the MAP and Panel is different than the MAP and WXR
WXR display range. display range.
MAP RANGE DISAGREE - Indicates MAP RANGE DISAGREE - Indicates
selected range on the EFIS Control Panel selected range on the EFIS Control Panel
is different than the MAP display range. is different than the MAP display range.
WXR RANGE DISAGREE - Indicates WXR RANGE DISAGREE - Indicates
selected range on the EFIS Control Panel selected range on the EFIS Control Panel
is different than the WXR display range. is different than the WXR display range.

34-125and Systems Introduction OCT 99 34-125 OCT 99


UNITED AIRLINES COURSE
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
CONTROLS & INDICATIONS CONTROLS & INDICATIONS
EHSI SYMBOLOGY KEY EHSI SYMBOLOGY KEY
The following symbols can be displayed on each HSI. General color presentation is as The following symbols can be displayed on each HSI. General color presentation is as
follows: follows:
Green (G) - Engaged flight mode displays, dynamic conditions. Green (G) - Engaged flight mode displays, dynamic conditions.
White (W) - Present status situation, scales, armed flight mode displays. White (W) - Present status situation, scales, armed flight mode displays.
Magenta (M) (pink) - Command information, pointers, symbols, fly-to condition Magenta (M) (pink) - Command information, pointers, symbols, fly-to condition
Blue (B) - Non-active or background information. Blue (B) - Non-active or background information.
Red (R) - Warning. Red (R) - Warning.
Amber (A) - Caution information, faults, flags. Amber (A) - Caution information, faults, flags.

SYMBOL NAME, COLOR MODE DESCRIPTION SYMBOL NAME, COLOR MODE DESCRIPTION
200 NM Distance Display Indicates distance to next FMC 200 NM Distance Display Indicates distance to next FMC
OR ALL waypoint (NM) or tuned navaid OR ALL waypoint (NM) or tuned navaid
(W) (DME). (W) (DME).
DME 124 DME 124
Track- MAP Indicates number under indicator Track- MAP Indicates number under indicator
TRK 062 M Orientation (G) CTR pointer is a track. Box displays TRK 062 M Orientation (G) CTR pointer is a track. Box displays
Indicator (W) MAP actual magnetic track. Indicator (W) MAP actual magnetic track.
and Reference (G) PLAN and Reference (G) PLAN
Track- Indicates number under indicator Track- Indicates number under indicator
HDG 263 M Orientation (G) VOR pointer is a heading. Box displays HDG 263 M Orientation (G) VOR pointer is a heading. Box displays
Indicator (W) ILS actual magnetic heading. Indicator (W) ILS actual magnetic heading.
and Reference (G) and Reference (G)
MAP Indicates FMC-calculated ETA for MAP Indicates FMC-calculated ETA for
0835.4Z ETA Display CTR the active waypoint based on 0835.4Z ETA Display CTR the active waypoint based on
(W) MAP present groundspeed. (W) MAP present groundspeed.
PLAN PLAN
Indicates the heading set in the MCP. Indicates the heading set in the MCP.
Selected Heading A dashed line extends from the Selected Heading A dashed line extends from the
Marker ALL marker to the airplane symbol for Marker ALL marker to the airplane symbol for
(M) ease in tracking the marker when it (M) ease in tracking the marker when it
is out of view. is out of view.
EXP EXP
VOR/ VOR/
12 15
Expanded ILS Indicates approximately 70 degrees 12 15
Expanded ILS Indicates approximately 70 degrees
Compass Rose MAP of available 360 degree scale. Compass Rose MAP of available 360 degree scale.
(W) CTR (W) CTR
MAP MAP
PLAN PLAN
12 15 12 15

FULL FULL Indicates a full 360 degree scale. FULL FULL Indicates a full 360 degree scale.
18

18
9

9
21

21
5

Compass Rose VOR/ Fixed reference marks are evenly Compass Rose VOR/ Fixed reference marks are evenly
24

24
3

(W) ILS spaced at 45 degree intervals. (W) ILS spaced at 45 degree intervals.
0

27 27
33 30 33 30

Heading Pointer MAP Heading Pointer MAP


CTR Indicates airplane heading when CTR Indicates airplane heading when
(W) MAP selected mode has TRK orientation. (W) MAP selected mode has TRK orientation.
PLAN PLAN
Drift Angle Pointer FULL Indicates airplane’s present track. Drift Angle Pointer FULL Indicates airplane’s present track.
(W) VOR/ Replaces track lilne when Full Rose (W) VOR/ Replaces track lilne when Full Rose
ILS VOR/ILS is selected. ILS VOR/ILS is selected.

and
OCT 99 Systems Introduction 34-126 OCT 99 34-126
UNITED
B737 GENERAL AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
CONTROLS & INDICATIONS CONTROLS & INDICATIONS
EHSI SYMBOLOGY KEY EHSI SYMBOLOGY KEY

SYMBOL NAME, COLOR MODE DESCRIPTION SYMBOL NAME, COLOR MODE DESCRIPTION

Present Track EXP Predicts ground track that will Present Track EXP Predicts ground track that will
VOR/ VOR/
Line and ILS result with present heading and Line and ILS result with present heading and
40 Range Scale MAP winds. Displayed range value us 1/2 40 Range Scale MAP winds. Displayed range value us 1/2
(W) CTR the actual selected range. (W) CTR the actual selected range.
MAP MAP
MAP Active - Represents the waypoint MAP Active - Represents the waypoint
Waypoint airplane is currently navigating to. Waypoint airplane is currently navigating to.
Active(M) CTR Active(M) CTR
MAP Inactive - Represents a navigation MAP Inactive - Represents a navigation
AMBOY Inactive (W) point making up the selected active AMBOY Inactive (W) point making up the selected active
PLAN PLAN
route. route.
MAP When intersected with the track MAP When intersected with the track
Altitude Range Arc CTR line, predicts the point where the Altitude Range Arc CTR line, predicts the point where the
(G) MAP reference altitude will be reached (G) MAP reference altitude will be reached
assuming current vertical speed. assuming current vertical speed.
EXP EXP
Airplane Symbol VOR/ Airplane Symbol VOR/
ILS Indicates current airplane position ILS Indicates current airplane position
(Expanded Rose) at the apex of the triangle. (Expanded Rose) at the apex of the triangle.
(W) MAP (W) MAP
CTR CTR
MAP MAP
PLAN PLAN
Airplane Symbol FULL Indicates current airplane position Airplane Symbol FULL Indicates current airplane position
(Expanded Rose) VOR/ at the center of the airplane (Expanded Rose) VOR/ at the center of the airplane
(W) ILS symbol. (W) ILS symbol.
Predicts airplane directional trend Predicts airplane directional trend
at the end of 30, 60 and 90 second at the end of 30, 60 and 90 second
MAP intervals. Based on bank angle and MAP intervals. Based on bank angle and
Trend Vector CTR ground speed. Three segments are Trend Vector CTR ground speed. Three segments are
(W) MAP displayed when selected range is (W) MAP displayed when selected range is
greater than 20 NM; two segments greater than 20 NM; two segments
displayed on the 20 NM scale, and displayed on the 20 NM scale, and
one on the ten NM scale. one on the ten NM scale.
2850
Vertical Pointer Displays vertical deviation from 2850
Vertical Pointer Displays vertical deviation from
(M) MAP selected vertical profile during (M) MAP selected vertical profile during
Deviation Scale CTR descent only. Scale indicates Deviation Scale CTR descent only. Scale indicates
(W) MAP +/- 400 feet deviation. Numeric (W) MAP +/- 400 feet deviation. Numeric
Numeric Display value is displayed when pointer Numeric Display value is displayed when pointer
(W) moves beyond the scale limits. (W) moves beyond the scale limits.
1740 Pointer represents path, center of 1740 Pointer represents path, center of
scale represents aiplane position. scale represents aiplane position.

FULL Displays glideslope position and FULL Displays glideslope position and
Glideslope Pointer deviation in ILS mode. Pointer not Glideslope Pointer deviation in ILS mode. Pointer not
(M) and EXP displayed when track and front (M) and EXP displayed when track and front
Deviation Scale VOR/ course on the ILS panel differ by Deviation Scale VOR/ course on the ILS panel differ by
(W) ILS more than 90 degrees. (W) ILS more than 90 degrees.

34-127and Systems Introduction OCT 99 34-127 OCT 99


UNITED AIRLINES COURSE
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
CONTROLS & INDICATIONS CONTROLS & INDICATIONS
EHSI SYMBOLOGY KEY EHSI SYMBOLOGY KEY

SYMBOL NAME, COLOR MODE DESCRIPTION SYMBOL NAME, COLOR MODE DESCRIPTION
N North Pointer Indicates map background is N North Pointer Indicates map background is
(G) PLAN oriented and referenced true north. (G) PLAN oriented and referenced true north.
Wind Direction Indicates magnetic wind direction Wind Direction Indicates magnetic wind direction
Arrow (W) with respect to the map display Arrow (W) with respect to the map display
Wind Direction/ ALL orientation, and wind speed in knots. Wind Direction/ ALL orientation, and wind speed in knots.
165˚/45 Speed (W) 165˚/45 Speed (W)
Represents an FMC-calculated Represents an FMC-calculated
T/C point and is labeled on the flight T/C point and is labeled on the flight
S/C Vertical Profile MAP plan path as follows: S/C Vertical Profile MAP plan path as follows:
Points and CTR T/C - Top of Climb Points and CTR T/C - Top of Climb
T/D Indentifiers MAP S/C - Step Climb T/D Indentifiers MAP S/C - Step Climb
(G) PLAN T/D - Top of Descent (G) PLAN T/D - Top of Descent
E/D E/D - End of Descent E/D E/D - End of Descent
Deceleration points have no identifier. Deceleration points have no identifier.
HEAD
Indicates relative bearing to tuned HEAD
Indicates relative bearing to tuned
ADF Bearing ALL ADF station as received from the ADF Bearing ALL ADF station as received from the
TAIL Pointers (G) respective ADF radio (ADF 1 on TAIL Pointers (G) respective ADF radio (ADF 1 on
overwater airplanes only). overwater airplanes only).

EXP Multicolored returns are presented EXP Multicolored returns are presented
Weather Radar when either WXR ON switch is Weather Radar when either WXR ON switch is
Returns VOR/ pushed. Most intense areas are Returns VOR/ pushed. Most intense areas are
(G, Y, R, M) ILS displayed in red, lesser intensity in (G, Y, R, M) ILS displayed in red, lesser intensity in
MAP amber, and least intense in green. MAP amber, and least intense in green.
CTR Areas of turbulence displayed in CTR Areas of turbulence displayed in
MAP magenta. MAP magenta.
A fixed-size holding pattern appears A fixed-size holding pattern appears
Holding Pattern MAP when it is part of the displayed FMC Holding Pattern MAP when it is part of the displayed FMC
Active (M) CTR route. When the holding waypoint Active (M) CTR route. When the holding waypoint
Modification (W) MAP is active and the HSI range is 80 or Modification (W) MAP is active and the HSI range is 80 or
Inactive (B) PLAN less and within 3 minutes, the dis- Inactive (B) PLAN less and within 3 minutes, the dis-
played holding pattern changes to the played holding pattern changes to the
correct scale size. correct scale size.
Airport Identifier MAP Appears when selected on CDU. Airport Identifier MAP Appears when selected on CDU.
KABC
and Runway CTR Available when HSI range is 80, KABC
and Runway CTR Available when HSI range is 80,
22L (W) MAP 160 or 320 NM. 22L (W) MAP 160 or 320 NM.
PLAN PLAN
MAP Appears when selected on CDU. MAP Appears when selected on CDU.
Airport Runway CTR Available when HSI range is 10, Airport Runway CTR Available when HSI range is 10,
Identifier MAP 20 or 40 NM. Dashed centerlines Identifier MAP 20 or 40 NM. Dashed centerlines
22L
(W) PLAN extend outward 14.2 NM. 22L
(W) PLAN extend outward 14.2 NM.
A fix reference radial is displayed A fix reference radial is displayed
04
5
Selected Fix MAP for each downtrack bearing 04
5
Selected Fix MAP for each downtrack bearing
Radial (G) CTR entered on the FMC/CDU FIX Radial (G) CTR entered on the FMC/CDU FIX
Selected Fix MAP INFO Page. A DME reference Selected Fix MAP INFO Page. A DME reference
DME Circle (G) PLAN circle is displayed for each distance DME Circle (G) PLAN circle is displayed for each distance
ABC entered on the FMC/CDU FIX ABC entered on the FMC/CDU FIX
INFO Page INFO Page
40 40

and
OCT 99 Systems Introduction 34-128 OCT 99 34-128
UNITED
B737 GENERAL AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
CONTROLS & INDICATIONS CONTROLS & INDICATIONS
EHSI SYMBOLOGY KEY EHSI SYMBOLOGY KEY

SYMBOL NAME, COLOR MODE DESCRIPTION SYMBOL NAME, COLOR MODE DESCRIPTION
Presents a selected reference point Presents a selected reference point
Selected Fix Circle MAP (fix) via the CDU FIX key. Can Selected Fix Circle MAP (fix) via the CDU FIX key. Can
(G) CTR appear with special map symbols (G) CTR appear with special map symbols
Symbol and MAP (ie. VOR, VORTAC, airport or Symbol and MAP (ie. VOR, VORTAC, airport or
Indentifier PLAN waypoint) if contained in the existing Indentifier PLAN waypoint) if contained in the existing
(B or G) data base (B or G) data base
When NAVAID switch is on, all When NAVAID switch is on, all
appropriate navaids in range appear appropriate navaids in range appear
in addition to those navaids which in addition to those navaids which
VOR (B, G) MAP are standard or active. Tuned navaids VOR (B, G) MAP are standard or active. Tuned navaids
DME/TACAN CTR are displayed regardless of the DME/TACAN CTR are displayed regardless of the
(B, G) MAP NAVAID switch and appear green. (B, G) MAP NAVAID switch and appear green.
VORTAC (B, G) PLAN When in 80, 160 or 320 NM range, VORTAC (B, G) PLAN When in 80, 160 or 320 NM range,
only high altitude navaids are dis- only high altitude navaids are dis-
played. Otherwise, both high and low played. Otherwise, both high and low
altitude navaids are displayed. altitude navaids are displayed.
070 Manually Tuned MAP Displays selected course and 070 Manually Tuned MAP Displays selected course and
250 Navaid CTR reciprical when a navaid is manually 250 Navaid CTR reciprical when a navaid is manually
(G) MAP tuned. (G) MAP tuned.
MAP When the ARPT switch is on, MAP When the ARPT switch is on,
Airport CTR displays airports within the map Airport CTR displays airports within the map
(B) MAP area. Origin and destination (B) MAP area. Origin and destination
KTEB PLAN airports are always displayed KTEB PLAN airports are always displayed
independent of ARPT switch. independent of ARPT switch.
MAP When the RTE DATA switch is on, MAP When the RTE DATA switch is on,
AMBOY Route Data CTR displays altitude constraints and AMBOY Route Data CTR displays altitude constraints and
12000 (M, W) MAP ETA for route waypoints. 12000 (M, W) MAP ETA for route waypoints.
0835Z PLAN 0835Z PLAN
Off Route MAP When the WPT switch is on, Off Route MAP When the WPT switch is on,
Waypoint CTR displays base waypoints not on the Waypoint CTR displays base waypoints not on the
MLF (B) MAP selected route when using ranges MLF (B) MAP selected route when using ranges
PLAN 10, 20 or 40. PLAN 10, 20 or 40.
Active route is displayed with con- Active route is displayed with con-
tinuous lines between waypoints. tinuous lines between waypoints.
AMBOY Route - MAP Active route modifications are dis- AMBOY Route - MAP Active route modifications are dis-
Active (M) CTR played with short dashes between Active (M) CTR played with short dashes between
Active Modifications MAP waypoints. When a change is activat- Active Modifications MAP waypoints. When a change is activat-
KILMR (W) PLAN ed in the FMC, dashes replaced by KILMR (W) PLAN ed in the FMC, dashes replaced by
Inactive (B) continuous line. Inactive routes are Inactive (B) continuous line. Inactive routes are
displayed with long dashes. displayed with long dashes.
Course Indicator Displays ILS, VOR or FMC course Course Indicator FULL, Displays ILS, VOR or FMC course
(M) FULL, (M)
EXP deviation. EXP deviation.
and ILS - 1 dot = 1 degree and VOR/ ILS - 1 dot = 1 degree
Deviation Scale VOR/ Deviation Scale
ILS VOR -1 dot = 5 degree ILS VOR -1 dot = 5 degree
(W) (W)
FULL, FULL,
TO TO/FROM Display EXP Indicates direction relative to VOR. TO TO/FROM Display EXP Indicates direction relative to VOR.
FROM (W) VOR/ FROM (W) VOR/
ILS ILS

34-129and Systems Introduction OCT 99 34-129 OCT 99


UNITED AIRLINES COURSE
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
CONTROLS & INDICATIONS CONTROLS & INDICATIONS
EHSI SYMBOLOGY KEY EHSI SYMBOLOGY KEY

SYMBOL NAME, COLOR MODE DESCRIPTION SYMBOL NAME, COLOR MODE DESCRIPTION
FULL, FULL,
VOR L/R Nav Data Source EXP Displays source of nav radio data VOR L/R Nav Data Source EXP Displays source of nav radio data
ILS (G) VOR/ based on HSI control selection. ILS (G) VOR/ based on HSI control selection.
ILS ILS
Selected Course EXP Displays selected course as Selected Course EXP Displays selected course as
Pointer (W) VOR/ appropriately set by the MCP Pointer (W) VOR/ appropriately set by the MCP
and ILS Course Selector. and ILS Course Selector.
Line (M) Line (M)
Selected Course FULL Displays selected course as Selected Course FULL Displays selected course as
Pointer (W) VOR/ appropriately set by the MCP Pointer (W) VOR/ appropriately set by the MCP
and ILS Course Selector. TO/FROM symbol and ILS Course Selector. TO/FROM symbol
TO/FROM is displayed when VOR navigation TO/FROM is displayed when VOR navigation
Pointer (W) is being used. Pointer (W) is being used.

VOR/ILS FULL, Displays frequency of manually VOR/ILS FULL, Displays frequency of manually
Frequency EXP tuned navaid. The word "AUTO" is Frequency EXP tuned navaid. The word "AUTO" is
110.10 VOR/ displayed in place of the frequency 110.10 VOR/ displayed in place of the frequency
Display (G) if the VHF NAV radio is in the auto Display (G) if the VHF NAV radio is in the auto
ILS ILS
tune mode. tune mode.

MAP Displayed when the position MAP Displayed when the position
4.5 L Position Difference difference of the L or R IRS exceeds 4.5 L Position Difference difference of the L or R IRS exceeds
4.3 R Display (W) CTR 4.3 R Display (W) CTR
MAP a difference from the FMC position, MAP a difference from the FMC position,
Numeric values are in nautical miles. Numeric values are in nautical miles.
The VOR/ADF switch on the EFIS The VOR/ADF switch on the EFIS
V1

V1
V2

V2
VOR Radials (G) MAP Control Panel must be ON and a MAP Control Panel must be ON and a
CTR valid VOR signal must be received. VOR Radials (G) CTR valid VOR signal must be received.
MAP Displays relative bearing to the MAP Displays relative bearing to the
tuned VOR station(s). tuned VOR station(s).
A2

A2
The VOR/ADF switch on the EFIS The VOR/ADF switch on the EFIS
ADF Bearing (G) MAP Control Panel must be ON and a ADF Bearing (G) MAP Control Panel must be ON and a
CTR valid ADF signal must be received. CTR valid ADF signal must be received.
MAP Displays relative bearing to the MAP Displays relative bearing to the
tuned ADF station. tuned ADF station.
These symbols are displayed only These symbols are displayed only
TCAS Resolution when the TFC button is pushed TCAS Resolution when the TFC button is pushed
Advisory (RA) Advisory (RA)
and Relative The arrow indicates traffic climbing and Relative The arrow indicates traffic climbing
-03 Altitude (R) or descending at a rate greater -03 Altitude (R) or descending at a rate greater
MAP than or equal to 500 fpm. No arrow MAP than or equal to 500 fpm. No arrow
VOR indicates the traffic is relatively level. VOR indicates the traffic is relatively level.
ILS For relative altitude symbols, the ILS For relative altitude symbols, the
TCAS Traffic numeric and associated signs TCAS Traffic numeric and associated signs
+02 Advisory (TA) indicate altitude of traffic in +02 Advisory (TA) indicate altitude of traffic in
and Relative hundreds of feet relative to the and Relative hundreds of feet relative to the
Altitude (A) airplane. Altitude (A) airplane.
(Continued) (Continued)

and
OCT 99 Systems Introduction 34-130 OCT 99 34-130
UNITED
B737 GENERAL AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
CONTROLS & INDICATIONS CONTROLS & INDICATIONS
EHSI SYMBOLOGY KEY EHSI SYMBOLOGY KEY

SYMBOL NAME, COLOR MODE DESCRIPTION SYMBOL NAME, COLOR MODE DESCRIPTION
TCAS Proximate (Continued) TCAS Proximate (Continued)
Traffic and Traffic and
Relative Altitude For absolute altitude symbols, the Relative Altitude For absolute altitude symbols, the
-05 (W) numeric indicates altitude of traffic -05 (W) numeric indicates altitude of traffic
in thousands and hundreds of feet. in thousands and hundreds of feet.
Relative versus absolute altitude Relative versus absolute altitude
display is selected on the display is selected on the
+09 TCAS Other MAP transponder/TCAS control panel. +09 TCAS Other MAP transponder/TCAS control panel.
Traffic and VOR Traffic and VOR
Relative Altitude ILS For both relative and absolute Relative Altitude ILS For both relative and absolute
(W) altitude, the numeric is below the (W) altitude, the numeric is below the
traffic symbol when the traffic is traffic symbol when the traffic is
belew, and above the traffic symbol belew, and above the traffic symbol
TCAS Traffic when the traffic is above the TCAS Traffic when the traffic is above the
Advisory and airplane. Advisory and airplane.
128 Absolute Altitude 128 Absolute Altitude
(R, A, W) Absence of the numeric implies (R, A, W) Absence of the numeric implies
altitude unknown. altitude unknown.
TCAS No Bearing MAP Displayed when no bearing TCAS No Bearing MAP Displayed when no bearing
TA 11.5 +17 Data information is available. Displays TA 11.5 +17 Data information is available. Displays
RA 3.6 -11 VOR RA 3.6 -11 VOR
(A for TA) ILS traffic type, distance in NM, altitude (A for TA) ILS traffic type, distance in NM, altitude
(R for RA) and vertical direction. (R for RA) and vertical direction.
MAP Indicates TFC button is selected MAP Indicates TFC button is selected
TFC TCAS Display On VOR TFC TCAS Display On VOR
(B) on. TCAS display is active. (B) on. TCAS display is active.
ILS ILS
TCAS Test MAP Indicates TCAS is operating in the TCAS Test MAP Indicates TCAS is operating in the
TCAS TEST Indication (B) VOR test mode. TCAS TEST Indication (B) VOR test mode.
ILS ILS
TCAS Failure MAP TCAS Failure MAP
TCAS FAIL Indication (B) VOR Indicates TCAS failure. TCAS FAIL Indication (B) VOR Indicates TCAS failure.
ILS ILS
Indicates TCAS/ATC mode switch Indicates TCAS/ATC mode switch
TCAS Off MAP is not in TA ONLY or TA/RA, TCAS Off MAP is not in TA ONLY or TA/RA,
TCAS OFF Indication (A) VOR whether TFC button selected on or TCAS OFF Indication (A) VOR whether TFC button selected on or
ILS off. Not displayed if TCAS is failed. ILS off. Not displayed if TCAS is failed.
MAP Indicates TCAS/ATC computer is MAP Indicates TCAS/ATC computer is
TCAS TA Only VOR not computing RAs. Displayed TCAS TA Only VOR not computing RAs. Displayed
TA ONLY Indication (B) TA ONLY Indication (B)
ILS whether the TFC button is selected ILS whether the TFC button is selected
on or off. on or off.
Displayed whenever a TCAS TA TCAS Traffic Alert Displayed whenever a TCAS TA
TCAS Traffic Alert MAP or RA is active. Displayed whether MAP or RA is active. Displayed whether
TRAFFIC TA (A) VOR the TFC button is selected on or TRAFFIC TA (A) VOR the TFC button is selected on or
RA (R) ILS off. RA (R) ILS off.
Displayed whenever a RA or TA TCAS Offscale Displayed whenever a RA or TA
TCAS Offscale MAP traffic is outside the traffic area MAP traffic is outside the traffic area
Indication VOR covered by the selected HSI range. Indication VOR covered by the selected HSI range.
OFFSCALE TA (A) OFFSCALE TA (A)
ILS Displayed only if the TFC button is RA (R) ILS Displayed only if the TFC button is
RA (R) selected on. selected on.

34-131and Systems Introduction OCT 99 34-131 OCT 99


UNITED AIRLINES COURSE
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
CONTROLS & INDICATIONS CONTROLS & INDICATIONS

INERTIAL SYSTEM DISPLAY UNIT (ISDU) Data Displays INERTIAL SYSTEM DISPLAY UNIT (ISDU) Data Displays
Location: Aft Overhead Panel Display data from IRU Location: Aft Overhead Panel Display data from IRU
selected by SYS DSPL selected by SYS DSPL
BRT Control Knob (Inner Knob) selector. Information dis- BRT Control Knob (Inner Knob) selector. Information dis-
Adjusts brightness of the data displays played is normally deter- Adjusts brightness of the data displays played is normally deter-
mined by display selector; mined by display selector;
IRS DISPLAY however, keyboard entry IRS DISPLAY however, keyboard entry of
of present position or mag- present position or mag-
netic heading overrides netic heading overrides
DSPL SEL
N
selected display. Last digit DSPL SEL
N
selected display. Last digit
of each window is for a
1 3 1 3
of each window is for a
PPOS WIND PPOS WIND
TK/GS HDG/STS 2 TK/GS HDG/STS 2
TEST TEST
decimal place (tenths). decimal place (tenths).
B RT W H E B RT W H E
4 5 6 4 5 6

SYS DSPL 7 S 9 SYS DSPL 7 S 9


L R 8 L R 8
ENT CLR ENT CLR
0 0

DISPL SEL (Outer Knob) DISPL SEL (Outer Knob)


Display Selector. Selects desired function or data for data displays. Displays are Display Selector. Selects desired function or data for data displays. Displays are
for IRU selected by SYS DSPL selector. for IRU selected by SYS DSPL selector.

TEST (spring loaded to TK/GS) - Use only during alignment. All lights in the data TEST (spring loaded to TK/GS) - Use only during alignment. All lights in the data
displays and on mode selector unit come on momentarily, followed by a 10 sec- displays and on mode selector unit come on momentarily, followed by a 10 sec-
ond internal self-test. ond internal self-test.

TK/GS - Displays present true track in left window and present ground speed in TK/GS - Displays present true track in left window and present ground speed in
right window. right window.

PPOS - Displays present latitude and longitude. PPOS - Displays present latitude and longitude.

WIND - Displays present inflight true wind direction in left window and present WIND - Displays present inflight true wind direction in left window and present
inflight wind speed in right window. inflight wind speed in right window.

HDG/STS (Heading status) - Displays present true heading in the left window and HDG/STS (Heading status) - Displays present true heading in the left window and
any applicable maintenance status codes (last two digits) in right window. During any applicable maintenance status codes (last two digits) in right window. During
alignment right window displays minutes remaining until alignment complete alignment right window displays minutes remaining until alignment complete
(displays 7 until 6 minutes remaining then counts down in one minute intervals). (displays 7 until 6 minutes remaining then counts down in one minute intervals).

SYS DSPL Selector SYS DSPL Selector


System display selector. Selects the System display selector. Selects the left
left (L) or right (R) IRU fro the data (L) or right (R) IRU fro the data dis-
displays. plays.

and
OCT 99 Systems Introduction 34-132 OCT 99 34-132
UNITED
B737 GENERAL AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
CONTROLS & INDICATIONS CONTROLS & INDICATIONS

INERTIAL SYSTEM DISPLAY UNIT INERTIAL SYSTEM DISPLAY UNIT


(ISDU) (ISDU)
Location: Aft Overhead Panel Location: Aft Overhead Panel

Alpha Keys (N,S,E,W,H) Alpha Keys (N,S,E,W,H)


Control the data displays by the keyboard Control the data displays by the keyboard
when the N,S,E, or W (latitude/longitude), when the N,S,E, or W (latitude/longi-
or H (heading) key is pushed. Turns on tude), or H (heading) key is pushed. Turns
cue light in ENT key and arms keyboard on cue light in ENT key and arms key-
for numeric entries. board for numeric entries.

Numeric Keys Numeric Keys


IRS DISPLAY Permits manual entry of IRS DISPLAY Permits manual entry of
present position (latitude present position (latitude and
and longitude) when either longitude) when either
ALIGN light is on (nor- ALIGN light is on (normally
mally entered on CDU POS
DSPL SEL
DSPL SEL
entered on CDU POS INIT
PPOS WIND 1 N 3 N
2 PPOS WIND 1 3
TK/GS
TEST B
HDG/STS
W H E
INIT page). Permit manual TK/GS HDG/STS 2
page). Permit manual entry
RT TEST
entry of present magnetic
B RT W H E
4 5 6 4 5 6
of present magnetic heading
SYS DSPL 7 S
8
9 heading when either mode SYS DSPL 7 S 9 when either mode selector is
selector is in ATT.
L R
L R 8
ENT
0
CLR
ENT CLR in ATT.
0

CLR Key ENT Key CLR Key


ENT Key
Two integral cue lights illu- Two integral cue light illuminate when Two integral cue lights illu-
Two integral cue light illuminate when
minate following an entry if N,S,E,W, or H entries are being keyed. minate following an entry if
N,S,E,W, or H entries are being keyed.
self-test determines entered When keying is completed push ENT key, self-test determines entered
When keying is completed push ENT key,
data to be of an unreason- and cue lights go off and keyed data is
and cue lights go off and keyed data is data to be of an unreasonable
able value (entry not simultaneously entered into each IRU fol- value (entry not accepted by
simultaneously entered into each IRU fol-
accepted by IRU’s). Press- lowing completion of a valid self-test for IRU’s). Pressing CLR key
lowing completion of a valid self-test for
ing CLR key extinguishes data reasonableness.
data reasonableness. extinguishes cue lights and
cue lights and clears data clears data display of data
display of data that was that was keyed in but not
keyed in but not accepted.
accepted. CLR key may also
CLR key may also be used be used to clear data display
to clear data display before before pressing ENT key.
pressing ENT key.

34-133and Systems Introduction OCT 99 34-133 OCT 99


UNITED AIRLINES COURSE
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
CONTROLS & INDICATIONS CONTROLS & INDICATIONS

IRS MODE SELECTOR UNIT (MSU) IRS MODE SELECTOR UNIT (MSU)
Location: Aft Overhead Panel Location: Aft Overhead Panel

ALIGN ON DC ALIGN ON DC ALIGN ON DC ALIGN ON DC

FAULT DC FAIL FAULT DC FAIL FAULT DC FAIL FAULT DC FAIL

ALIGN NAV ALIGN NAV ALIGN NAV ALIGN NAV


OFF ATT OFF ATT OFF ATT OFF ATT

L IRS R L IRS R

IRS Mode Selectors IRS Mode Selectors


Controls the operating mode of the respective IRU (left or right). Controls the operating mode of the respective IRU (left or right).

OFF - Removes all electrical power from respective IRU after a 30 second shutdown OFF - Removes all electrical power from respective IRU after a 30 second shutdown
cycle. Alignment is lost. cycle. Alignment is lost.

ALIGN - Power is applied to respective IRU which enters a 10 minute alignment pro- ALIGN - Power is applied to respective IRU which enters a 10 minute alignment pro-
cess. After 10 minutes IRU remains in ALIGN mode until NAV is selected. If placed in cess. After 10 minutes IRU remains in ALIGN mode until NAV is selected. If placed in
ALIGN from NAV, a fast realignment is initiated. ALIGN from NAV, a fast realignment is initiated.

NAV - (Detented position) When moved directly from OFF, respective IRU enters a 10 NAV - (Detented position) When moved directly from OFF, respective IRU enters a 10
minute alignment process when automatically enters NAV mode if present position has minute alignment process when automatically enters NAV mode if present position has
been entered. After IRU enters NAV mode, full IRS data is provided to respective air- been entered. After IRU enters NAV mode, full IRS data is provided to respective air-
plane systems for normal operations. plane systems for normal operations.

ATT - Initiates a 30 second alignment process in the attitude mode. Recommend flying ATT - Initiates a 30 second alignment process in the attitude mode. Recommend flying
straight and level in unaccelerated flight during alignment. Provides attitude information straight and level in unaccelerated flight during alignment. Provides attitude information
to respective ADI and heading information (after heading is manually entered) to respec- to respective ADI and heading information (after heading is manually entered) to respec-
tive HSI and opposite RDMI. Navigation information (present position and ground tive HSI and opposite RDMI. Navigation information (present position and ground
speed) is not available from respective IRU in ATT. speed) is not available from respective IRU in ATT.

and
OCT 99 Systems Introduction 34-134 OCT 99 34-134
UNITED
B737 GENERAL AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
CONTROLS & INDICATIONS CONTROLS & INDICATIONS

IRS MODE SELECTOR UNIT (MSU) IRS MODE SELECTOR UNIT (MSU)
Location: Aft Overhead Panel Location: Aft Overhead Panel

ALIGN ON DC ALIGN ON DC ALIGN ON DC ALIGN ON DC

FAULT DC FAIL FAULT DC FAIL FAULT DC FAIL FAULT DC FAIL

ALIGN NAV ALIGN NAV ALIGN NAV ALIGN NAV


OFF ATT OFF ATT OFF ATT OFF ATT

L IRS R L IRS R

ALIGN Light ALIGN Light


On (Steady) - Indicates respective IRU is: On (Steady) - Indicates respective IRU is:
Aligning (if associated IRS mode selector is in ALIGN, NAV OR ATT). Aligning (if associated IRS mode selector is in ALIGN, NAV OR ATT).
In a 30 second shutdown cycle (if associated IRS mode selector is in OFF). In a 30 second shutdown cycle (if associated IRS mode selector is in OFF).

On (Flashing) - Indicates alignment cannot be completed due to one of the following: On (Flashing) - Indicates alignment cannot be completed due to one of the following:
Airplane movement. Airplane movement.
Significant difference between previous and entered present positions. Significant difference between previous and entered present positions.
An unreasonable entry. An unreasonable entry.
10 Minutes has elapsed and no present position has been entered. 10 Minutes has elapsed and no present position has been entered.

Off - Indicates one of the following: Off - Indicates one of the following:
Respective IRU is not in the align mode. Respective IRU is not in the align mode.
Alignment is complete and IRS data is being provided to respective airplane systems (if Alignment is complete and IRS data is being provided to respective airplane systems
associated IRS mode selector is in NAV). (if associated IRS mode selector is in NAV).
Alignment is complete and attitude information available (if associated IRS mode Alignment is complete and attitude information available (if associated IRS mode
selector is in ATT); headings also available if it has been manually entered. selector is in ATT); headings also available if it has been manually entered.

34-135and Systems Introduction OCT 99 34-135 OCT 99


UNITED AIRLINES COURSE
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
CONTROLS & INDICATIONS CONTROLS & INDICATIONS

IRS MODE SELECTOR UNIT (MSU) IRS MODE SELECTOR UNIT (MSU)
Location: Aft Overhead Panel Location: Aft Overhead Panel

ON DC Light ON DC Light
Indicates respective IRU is Indicates respective IRU is
operating on DC (backup) operating on DC (backup)
power from the switched power from the switched
hot battery bus; AC power hot battery bus; AC power
source is not normal. On source is not normal. On
ground a horn sounds in ground a horn sounds in
wheel well. Light comes wheel well. Light comes on
on momentarily during momentarily during self-
self-test when respective test when respective mode
mode selector is moved selector is moved out of
out of OFF position. OFF position.

ALIGN ON DC ALIGN ON DC
ALIGN ON DC ALIGN ON DC

FAULT DC FAIL FAULT DC FAIL


FAULT DC FAIL FAULT DC FAIL

ALIGN NAV ALIGN NAV


ALIGN NAV ALIGN NAV
OFF ATT OFF ATT
OFF ATT OFF ATT

L IRS R
L IRS R

DC FAIL Light DC FAIL Light


FAULT Light Indicates backup DC FAULT Light Indicates backup DC power
Indicates a system fault that power is not available fro Indicates a system fault that is not available fro respec-
affects respective IRU NAV respective IRU. Both DC affects respective IRU NAV tive IRU. Both DC FAIL
and/or ATT mode(s). FAIL lights illuminate and/or ATT mode(s). lights illuminate when bat-
when battery voltage is tery voltage is less than 18
less than 18 volts. If other volts. If other IRS lights are
IRS lights are OFF, OFF, respective IRU is
respective IRU is operat- operating normally on AC
ing normally on AC power.
power.

and
OCT 99 Systems Introduction 34-136 OCT 99 34-136
UNITED
B737 GENERAL AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
CONTROLS & INDICATIONS CONTROLS & INDICATIONS

VHF NAVIGATION TUNING PANEL VHF NAVIGATION TUNING PANEL


Location: Center Pedestal Location: Center Pedestal

AUTO-MAN Switch AUTO-MAN Switch


AUTO: Respective nav receiver is tuned automatically by FMC. A bar AUTO: Respective nav receiver is tuned automatically by FMC. A bar
appears over the MANUAL frequency indicator. A frequency can still b appears over the MANUAL frequency indicator. A frequency can still b
e selected under the bar to prepare for future manual tuning. Pushing e selected under the bar to prepare for future manual tuning. Pushing
the switch changes function from AUTO to MAN. the switch changes function from AUTO to MAN.

MAN: Allows nav receiver to be tuned manually by rotating frequency MAN: Allows nav receiver to be tuned manually by rotating frequency
selector. Inhibits FMC auto tuning. Blanks AUTO frequency indicator. selector. Inhibits FMC auto tuning. Blanks AUTO frequency indicator.

AUTO NAV MANUAL AUTO NAV MANUAL

AUTO AUTO
TEST MANUAL TEST MANUAL

VOR UP/LT VOR UP/LT

DME DN/RT DME DN/RT

AUTO Frequency Indicator Frequency Selector AUTO Frequency Indicator Frequency Selector
Displays the frequency which has been Manually selects the desired frequency. Displays the frequency which has been Manually selects the desired frequency.
tuned automatically by the FMC. tuned automatically by the FMC.
Displays dashes during agility tuning. MANUAL Frequency Indicator Displays dashes during agility tuning. MANUAL Frequency Indicator
(Nav receiver is being cyclic-tuned by Indicates frequency selected by rotating (Nav receiver is being cyclic-tuned by Indicates frequency selected by rotating
FMC between two frequencies at five frequency selector. A bar appears over fre- FMC between two frequencies at five frequency selector. A bar appears over fre-
second intervals.) quency when nav receiver is in AUTO second intervals.) quency when nav receiver is in AUTO
Displays are blank when nav receiver is mode. Displays are blank when nav receiver is mode.
in manual mode. in manual mode.

34-137and Systems Introduction OCT 99 34-137 OCT 99


UNITED AIRLINES COURSE
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
CONTROLS & INDICATIONS CONTROLS & INDICATIONS

VHF NAVIGATION TUNING PANEL VHF NAVIGATION TUNING PANEL


Location: Center Pedestal Location: Center Pedestal

AUTO NAV MANUAL AUTO NAV MANUAL

AUTO AUTO
TEST MANUAL TEST MANUAL

VOR UP/LT VOR UP/LT

DME DN/RT DME DN/RT

VOR/DME TEST Switch ILS TEST Switch VOR/DME TEST Switch ILS TEST Switch
Spring loaded to center position. Position- Spring loaded to center position. Spring loaded to center position. Position- Spring loaded to center position.
ing to DME causes the following to occur Used to perform ILS test. ing to DME causes the following to occur Used to perform ILS test.
in the order listed: in the order listed:
A warning flag appears in respective A warning flag appears in respective
RDMI for one second. RDMI for one second.
Dashes appear for one second. Dashes appear for one second.
All zeroes appear (not to exceed 000.3) All zeroes appear (not to exceed 000.3)
until switch is released. until switch is released.
Positioning to VOR performs VOR self- Positioning to VOR performs VOR self-
test. test.

and
OCT 99 Systems Introduction 34-138 OCT 99 34-138
UNITED
B737 GENERAL AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
CONTROLS & INDICATIONS CONTROLS & INDICATIONS

ADF PANEL ADF PANEL


Location: Aft Control Pedestal Location: Aft Control Pedestal

Frequency Selector Frequency Selector


Selects indicated frequency. TFR Switch
Selects indicated frequency. TFR Switch
Selects the left or right dis- Selects the left or right dis-
play as the ADF receiver play as the ADF receiver
frequency. frequency.

Frequency Indicator Frequency Indicator


Indicates frequencies Indicates frequencies
selected. selected.
TFR TFR

TONE Switch TONE Switch


TONE Adds tone to facilitate TONE
Adds tone to facilitate
0362.0 0351.0 reception of unmodulated
0362.0 0351.0
reception of unmodulated
A OFF ON A OFF ON
D
F
ANT ADF beacons. D
F
ANT ADF
beacons.
GAIN GAIN

Function Selector Function Selector


ANT - Increases clarity of audio recep- ANT - Increases clarity of audio recep-
tion. Pointers on RDMI’s and HSI’s (in tion. Pointers on RDMI’s and HSI’s (in
FULL VOR/ILS, EXP VOR/ILS, and FULL VOR/ILS, EXP VOR/ILS, and
PLAN) move to 9 o’clock position PLAN) move to 9 o’clock position
(Pointer out of view in EXP VOR/ILS, (Pointer out of view in EXP VOR/ILS,
MAP, CTR MAP and PLAN modes). MAP, CTR MAP and PLAN modes).
ADF - Activates automatic direction ADF - Activates automatic direction
finding function. Bearing information is finding function. Bearing information is
sent to the RDMI’s and HSI’s. sent to the RDMI’s and HSI’s.
GAIN - Controls ADF receiver volume. GAIN - Controls ADF receiver volume.

34-139and Systems Introduction OCT 99 34-139 OCT 99


UNITED AIRLINES COURSE
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
CONTROLS & INDICATIONS CONTROLS & INDICATIONS

MODE S TCAS TRANSPONDER CONTROL PANEL MODE S TCAS TRANSPONDER CONTROL PANEL
Location: Captain and F/O’s Instrument Panel Location: Captain and F/O’s Instrument Panel

ABS, REL Altitude Switches ABS, REL Altitude Switches


Left switch control Captain’s HSI display and right switch con- Left switch control Captain’s HSI display and right switch control
trol First Officer’s HSI display. First Officer’s HSI display.
ABS - Target altitude information is displayed on EHSI as abso- ABS - Target altitude information is displayed on EHSI as abso-
lute altitude above sea level (3 digits). lute altitude above sea level (3 digits).
REL - Target altitude information is displayed on EHSI as rela- REL - Target altitude information is displayed on EHSI as rela-
tive to your altitude (+/-2 digits) or 00 for co-altitude. tive to your altitude (+/-2 digits) or 00 for co-altitude.

ABOVE ABS ABOVE ABS ABOVE ABS ABOVE ABS


N N N N
BELOW REL BELOW REL BELOW REL BELOW REL
XPDR L R XPDR L R
STBY TA FAIL STBY TA FAIL
TEST TA/RA TEST TA/RA
IDENT IDENT

TCAS/ATC TCAS/ATC

TCAS/XPDR Selector TCAS/XPDR Selector


TEST - Selector is spring loaded to STBY. Momentarily moving selector to TEST acti- TEST - Selector is spring loaded to STBY. Momentarily moving selector to TEST acti-
vates TCAS system test sequence. Holding selector in TEST allows failed systems to be vates TCAS system test sequence. Holding selector in TEST allows failed systems to
listed on HSI. TCAS test sequence interrupts transponder output for a few seconds. be listed on HSI. TCAS test sequence interrupts transponder output for a few seconds.

STBY - TCAS and XPDRs are in warm-up cycle. STBY - TCAS and XPDRs are in warm-up cycle.

XPDR - XPDR is ON and TCAS is in warm-up cycle. XPDR - XPDR is ON and TCAS is in warm-up cycle.

TA - The XPDR is ON but only "Traffic Advisory" function of TCAS is operational. TA - The XPDR is ON but only "Traffic Advisory" function of TCAS is operational.
Both "Resolution Advisories" and pitch guidance are inhibited. The message "TA Both "Resolution Advisories" and pitch guidance are inhibited. The message "TA
ONLY" appears on the HSI display. ONLY" appears on the HSI display.

TA/RA - XPDR is ON and all "Traffic Advisory" and "Resolution Advisory" functions TA/RA - XPDR is ON and all "Traffic Advisory" and "Resolution Advisory" functions
of TCAS are operable. of TCAS are operable.

and
OCT 99 Systems Introduction 34-140 OCT 99 34-140
UNITED
B737 GENERAL AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
CONTROLS & INDICATIONS CONTROLS & INDICATIONS

MODE S TCAS TRANSPONDER CONTROL PANEL MODE S TCAS TRANSPONDER CONTROL PANEL
Location: Captain and F/O’s Instrument Panel Location: Captain and F/O’s Instrument Panel

FAIL Light Transponder Selector Switch FAIL Light Transponder Selector Switch
Illluminates to indicate a fault in Enables selection of left or right Illluminates to indicate a fault in the Enables selection of left or right
the selected transponder system. transponder. selected transponder system. transponder.

ATC Code Selector ATC Code Selector

ABOVE ABS ABOVE ABS ABOVE ABS ABOVE ABS


N N N N
BELOW REL BELOW REL BELOW REL BELOW REL
XPDR L R XPDR L R
STBY TA FAIL STBY TA FAIL
TEST TA/RA TEST TA/RA
IDENT IDENT

TCAS/ATC TCAS/ATC

ABOVE, N, BELOW Switches IDENT Button ABOVE, N, BELOW Switches IDENT Button
Left switch controls Captain’s HSI Tansmits identification sig- Left switch controls Captain’s HSI Tansmits identification signal.
display and right switch controls F/ nal. display and right switch controls F/
O’s HSI display. O’s HSI display.

ABOVE - Displays altitude report- ABOVE - Displays altitude report-


ing traffic from 2,700 feet below to ing traffic from 2,700 feet below to
9,900 feet above your altitude. 9,900 feet above your altitude.

NORMAL - Displays altitude NORMAL - Displays altitude


reporting traffic from 2,700 feet reporting traffic from 2,700 feet
below to 2,700 feet above your alti- below to 2,700 feet above your alti-
tude. tude.

BELOW - Displays altitude report- BELOW - Displays altitude report-


ing traffic from 9,900 feet below to ing traffic from 9,900 feet below to
2,700 feet above your altitude. 2,700 feet above your altitude.

34-141and Systems Introduction OCT 99 34-141 OCT 99


UNITED
B737 GENERAL AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

WEATHER RADAR CONTROL PANEL WEATHER RADAR CONTROL PANEL


Location: Center Pedestal Location: Center Pedestal

Mode Select Switch Mode Select Switch


NORM - Selects the weather detec- NORM - Selects the weather detec-
tion mode. tion mode.
TEST - Displays maintenance test TEST - Displays maintenance test
pattern. TILT pattern.
TILT
PCIP LEVEL - Selects desired pre- Manually controls antenna tilt position PCIP LEVEL - Selects desired pre-
Manually controls antenna tilt position
cipitation return. from 15 degrees up to 15 degrees down. cipitation return.
from 15 degrees up to 15 degrees down.

WX RADAR WX RADAR
NORM TEST
NORM TEST

TILT
MID
5 MID
TILT
15 5
PCIP 15
LEVEL UP PCIP
LEVEL UP
MAX TURB DET MAX TURB DET
GND RTN 0 PRECIP DOPPLER
GND RTN 0 PRECIP DOPPLER
DOWN
DOWN
OFF ON 15 ONLY ONLY
5 BOTH OFF ON 15 ONLY ONLY
5 BOTH

GND RTN TURB DET GND RTN


OFF - Provides ground return signal sup- PRECIP ONLY (amber) - Inhibits dis- OFF - Provides ground return signal sup-
pression. play of turbulence information. PRECIP pression.
ON - Ground return signals are dis- ONLY mode indicator light illuminates. ON - Ground return signals are dis-
played. (Spring loaded to ON position.) BOTH - Displays both precipitation and played. (Spring loaded to ON position.) TURB DET
turbulence data. Both indicator lights are PRECIP ONLY (amber) - Inhibits dis-
off. play of turbulence information. PRECIP
DOPPLER ONLY (amber) - Inhibits ONLY mode indicator light illuminates.
display of precipitation data. DOPPLER BOTH - Displays both precipitation and
ONLY mode indicator light illuminates. turbulence data. Both indicator lights are
off.
DOPPLER ONLY (amber) - Inhibits
display of precipitation data. DOPPLER
ONLY mode indicator light illuminates.

34-142and Systems Introduction OCT 99 34-142 OCT 99


UNITED
B737 GENERAL AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
CONTROLS & INDICATIONS CONTROLS & INDICATIONS

GPWS GPWS
Location: First Officer’s Instrument Panel FLAP INHIBIT Switch Location: First Officer’s Instrument Panel FLAP INHIBIT Switch
INOP Light NORMAL (guarded posi- NORMAL (guarded posi-
tion) - Provides flap position INOP Light tion) - Provides flap position
Indicates: Indicates:
GPWS computer inoperative. logic. logic.
FLAP INHIBIT - Inhibits or GPWS computer inoperative. FLAP INHIBIT - Inhibits or
Invalid inputs received from VHF NAV Invalid inputs received from VHF NAV
receiver, air data computer, or radio altim- cancels warnings/ alerts cancels warnings/ alerts
caused by the flaps not in a receiver, air data computer, or radio altim- caused by the flaps not in a
eter. eter.
SYS TEST button has been pushed. landing position. landing position.
SYS TEST button has been pushed.

GROUND PROXIMITY GROUND PROXIMITY

INOP INOP
FLAP GEAR FLAP GEAR
INHIBIT INHIBIT INHIBIT INHIBIT

SYS TEST SYS TEST


NORMAL NORMAL NORMAL NORMAL

SYS TEST Switch GEAR INHIBIT Switch SYS TEST Switch GEAR INHIBIT Switch
Causes the PULL UP, BELOW G/S and NORMAL (guarded position) - Provides Causes the PULL UP, BELOW G/S and NORMAL (guarded position) - Provides
INOP lights to come on and causes "pull landing gear position logic. INOP lights to come on and causes "pull landing gear position logic.
up" and "below glide slope" aurals to GEAR INHIBIT - Inhibits or cancels up" and "below glide slope" aurals to GEAR INHIBIT - Inhibits or cancels
sound, windshear aural to sound, and warnings/alerts caused by the landing sound, windshear aural to sound, and warnings/alerts caused by the landing
windshear alert on ADI to illuminate. The gear not down. windshear alert on ADI to illuminate. The gear not down.
system cannot be tested between liftoff system cannot be tested between liftoff
and 1000 feet radio altitude, or with land- and 1000 feet radio altitude, or with land-
ing flaps selected. If pushed and held for ing flaps selected. If pushed and held for
more than 5 seconds all aurals will sound. more than 5 seconds all aurals will sound.

Some early model 737-300’s D PROXIMITY Some early model 737-300’s D PROXIMITY
FLAP/GEAR FLAP/GEAR
FLAP/GEAR INHIBIT Switch INHIBIT FLAP/GEAR INHIBIT Switch INHIBIT
NORMAL (guarded position) - Provides NORMAL (guarded position) - Provides
flap and landing gear position logic. flap and landing gear position logic.
FLAP/GEAR INHIBIT - Inhibits or can- FLAP/GEAR INHIBIT - Inhibits or can-
cels warnings/alerts caused by the flaps cels warnings/alerts caused by the flaps
not in a landing position, or the landing NORMAL not in a landing position, or the landing NORMAL
gear not down. gear not down.

34-143and Systems Introduction OCT 99 34-143 OCT 99


UNITED AIRLINES COURSE
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
CONTROLS & INDICATIONS CONTROLS & INDICATIONS

GPWS GPWS
Location: Captain and First Officer’s Location: Captain and First Officer’s
Instrument Panel Instrument Panel

PULL UP Warning Light PULL UP Warning Light


Indicates that one or more of the follow- Indicates that one or more of the follow-
ing conditions exists: ing conditions exists:
PULL UP Excessive descent rate. Excessive descent rate.
Excessive terrain closure rate.
PULL UP Excessive terrain closure rate.
BELOW G/S Altitude loss after takeoff or go-around. Altitude loss after takeoff or go-around.
Unsafe terrain clearance when not in the BELOW G/S Unsafe terrain clearance when not in the
P-INHIBIT P-INHIBIT
landing configuration. landing configuration.

BELOW G/S Alert Light BELOW G/S Alert Light


Indicates airplane is more than 1.3 dots Indicates airplane is more than 1.3 dots
below the glideslope. below the glideslope.
Inhibits or cancels below glide slope Inhibits or cancels below glide slope
alerting if pushed when below 1000 feet alerting if pushed when below 1000 feet
radio altitude. radio altitude.
Rearmed by climbing above 1000 feet Rearmed by climbing above 1000 feet
radio altitude. radio altitude.

and
OCT 99 Systems Introduction 34-144 OCT 99 34-144
UNITED
B737 GENERAL AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
CONTROLS & INDICATIONS CONTROLS & INDICATIONS

MARKER BEACON MARKER BEACON


Location: Captain and First Officer’s Location: Captain and First Officer’s
Instrument Panel Instrument Panel

MARKER MARKER Sensitivity Switch MARKER Sensitivity Switch


HIGH - Selects high sensitivity to ensure MARKER HIGH - Selects high sensitivity to ensure
HIGH
reception of marker beacon. HIGH reception of marker beacon.
LOW - Selects low sensitivity to more LOW - Selects low sensitivity to more
accurately determine marker beacon accurately determine marker beacon
position. position.
LOW LOW

A
A
IG HT
I
IG HT
I
BR

BR
W R
AIRWAYS A W
AIRWAYS A
Y
S Y
S
IG HT
M
I IG HT
M
BR

BR
D
MIDDLE D D
MIDDLE D
L
E L
E
IG HT O IG HT
BR

U O

BR
OUTER T U
E OUTER T
R E
R

Marker Beacon Lights Marker Beacon Lights


The appropriate marker beacon light The appropriate marker beacon light
flashes when over one of the marker bea- flashes when over one of the marker bea-
con transmitters: con transmitters:
IM (white) - airway or inner marker. IM (white) - airway or inner marker.
MM (amber) - middle marker. MM (amber) - middle marker.
OM (blue) - outer marker OM (blue) - outer marker

34-145and Systems Introduction OCT 99 34-145 OCT 99


UNITED AIRLINES COURSE
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
CONTROLS & INDICATIONS CONTROLS & INDICATIONS

STANDBY ALTIMETER STANDBY ALTIMETER


Location: Center Instrument Panel Location: Center Instrument Panel

Altimeter Setting Indicator Altimeter Setting Indicator


Indicates selected altimeter setting Indicates selected altimeter setting
in millibars. in millibars.

1000 FT Indicator
1000 FT Indicator
Indicates uncorrected altitude in thousands Indicates uncorrected altitude in thousands
of feet. of feet.
100 0 FT 100 0 FT
9 1 01 3 1 9 1 01 3 1
MB MB
1000FT 1000FT Altimeter Setting Indicator
8 33 2 Altimeter Setting Indicator 8 33 2 Indicates selected altimeter setting in
ALT 32 Indicates selected altimeter setting in ALT 32
50,000
inches of mercury.
50,000 inches of mercury.
31 31
7 30 3 7 30 3
2992 2992
IN HG IN HG
6 4 BARO Knob 6 4 BARO Knob
5 Adjusts altimeter setting.
5 Adjusts altimeter setting.
BARO BARO

100 Foot Pointer 100 Foot Pointer


Indicates uncorrected altitude in Indicates uncorrected altitude in hun-
hundreds of feet. One full rotation dreds of feet. One full rotation equals
equals 1000 feet. 0 1000 feet. 0
An electric vibrator is installed to 60 80 An electric vibrator is installed to 60 80
reduce mechanical friction errors 400 reduce mechanical friction errors and 400
100 100
and improve instrument response. improve instrument response.
350 IAS 350 IAS
120 120
STANDBY AIRSPEED INDICATOR 300 STANDBY AIRSPEED INDICATOR 300
KNOTS 140 KNOTS 140
Location: Center Instrument Panel Location: Center Instrument Panel
250 250
240 160 240 160
220 180 220 180
Standby Airspeed Pointer 200 Standby Airspeed Pointer 200
Indicates airspeed derived from uncor- Indicates airspeed derived from uncor-
rected pitot-static inputs. Connected rected pitot-static inputs. Connected
directly to the No. 2 AUX pitot and alter- directly to the No. 2 AUX pitot and alter-
nate static sources. nate static sources.

and
OCT 99 Systems Introduction 34-146 OCT 99 34-146
UNITED
B737 GENERAL AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
CONTROLS & INDICATIONS CONTROLS & INDICATIONS

MACH/AIRSPEED INDICATOR MACH/AIRSPEED INDICATOR


Location: Captain and First Officer’s Instrument Panel Location: Captain and First Officer’s Instrument Panel

Airspeed Pointer Airspeed Pointer


Indicates airspeed computed by the Indicates airspeed computed by the
associated air data computer. Indi- associated air data computer. Indi-
cates zero when input is unreliable. cates zero when input is unreliable.

Airspeed Cursor Airspeed Cursor


Flag Flag
M 0 M 0
Indicates input to Indicates input to
60 airspeed cursor is 60 airspeed cursor is
80 unreliable. 80 unreliable.
400 MACH 400 MACH
78 100 78 100
350 7 VMO Flag 350 7 VMO Flag
Indicates VMO Indicates VMO
VMO IN
120 VMO IN
120 pointer is inopera-
pointer is inopera-
OP OP

300 1 tive. 300 1 tive.


27 0 140 27 0 140
250 KNOTS 250 KNOTS
0 160 0 160
200 180 200 180

PULL TO SET PULL TO SET

KNOTS Indicator KNOTS Indicator


Indicates airspeed computed by associated Indicates airspeed computed by associated
air data computer in digital from. A/S flag air data computer in digital from. A/S flag
replaces digits when input to the indicator replaces digits when input to the indicator
and the airspeed pointer is unreliable. and the airspeed pointer is unreliable.
Indicates 45 knots when airplane is not Indicates 45 knots when airplane is not
moving. moving.
Airspeed Cursor Control Knob Airspeed Cursor Control Knob
PUSHED IN - Allows cursor to be PUSHED IN - Allows cursor to be
positioned automatically by inputs positioned automatically by inputs
from the AFDS FCC. from the AFDS FCC.
PULLED OUT - Positioned manu- PULLED OUT - Positioned manu-
ally by rotating the control knob. ally by rotating the control knob.
Cursor is reference information Cursor is reference information
only. Airspeed Cursor Mode only. Airspeed Cursor Mode
Annunciator flag will be in view. Annunciator flag will be in view.

34-147and Systems Introduction OCT 99 34-147 OCT 99


UNITED AIRLINES COURSE
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
CONTROLS & INDICATIONS CONTROLS & INDICATIONS

MACH/AIRSPEED INDICATOR MACH/AIRSPEED INDICATOR


Location: Captain and First Officer’s Instrument Panel Location: Captain and First Officer’s Instrument Panel

Airspeed Cursor Mode Annunciator Airspeed Cursor Mode Annunciator


AUTO MODE - Removes flag from AUTO MODE - Removes flag from
view. view.
MANUAL MODE - Places flag in view. Airspeed Cursor MANUAL MODE - Places flag in view. Airspeed Cursor
Indicates target airspeed. Posi- Indicates target airspeed. Posi-
tioned manually or automatically, tioned manually or automati-
as selected by the airspeed cursor cally, as selected by the airspeed
control Knob cursor control Knob

External Airspeed External Airspeed


M 0 M 0
Bugs Bugs
60 Remind pilot of speci- 60 Remind pilot of speci-
80 fied airspeeds 80 fied airspeeds
400 MACH 400 MACH
78 100 78 100
350 7 350 7
MACH Indicator MACH Indicator
120 Indicates Mach com-
120 Indicates Mach com-
300 1 puted by associated are 300 1 puted by associated are
27 0 140 data computer. Blank 27 0 140 data computer. Blank
250 KNOTS below .40 Mach. Flag 250 KNOTS below .40 Mach. Flag
0 160 replaces digits when 0 160 replaces digits when
200 180 associated air data com- 200 180 associated air data com-
puter fails. puter fails.
PULL TO SET PULL TO SET

VMO Pointer VMO Pointer


Indicates maximum Indicates maximum oper-
operating speed. ating speed.

and
OCT 99 Systems Introduction 34-148 OCT 99 34-148
UNITED
B737 GENERAL AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
CONTROLS & INDICATIONS CONTROLS & INDICATIONS

ALTIMETER ALTIMETER
Location: Captain and First Officer’s Instrument Panel Location: Captain and First Officer’s Instrument Panel

100 Foot Pointer ALT Indicator 100 Foot Pointer ALT Indicator
Indicates altitude in hundreds of feet. Indicates corrected altitude in incre- Indicates altitude in hundreds of Indicates corrected altitude in incre-
One full rotation of pointer equals ments of 20 feet as computed by the feet. One full rotation of pointer ments of 20 feet as computed by the
1000 feet. associated air data computer. A NEG equals 1000 feet. associated air data computer. A NEG
flag indicates altitude is below zero, flag indicates altitude is below zero,
and an OFF flag indicates input from and an OFF flag indicates input from
the air data computer is unreliable. the air data computer is unreliable.

100 0 FT 100 0 FT

9 1 9 1

8 31 7 00 2 8 31 7 00 2
Altitude Reference Bug Altitude Reference Bug
7 MBALT 3 IN HG Reminds pilot of specified alti- 7 MB ALT IN HG 3 Reminds pilot of specified alti-
1013 2992 tude. 1013 2992 tude.
6 6
5 5
Altitude Bug Set Knob BARO Altitude Bug Set Knob
BARO
Sets altitude reference bug. Sets altitude reference bug.

BARO Knob Altimeter Setting Indicators BARO Knob Altimeter Setting Indicators
Adjusts altimeter setting. Indicate selected altimeter setting in Adjusts altimeter setting. Indicate selected altimeter setting in
millibars and inches of mercury. millibars and inches of mercury.

34-149and Systems Introduction OCT 99 34-149 OCT 99


UNITED AIRLINES COURSE
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
CONTROLS & INDICATIONS CONTROLS & INDICATIONS

VERTICAL SPEED INDICATOR VERTICAL SPEED INDICATOR


Location: Captain and F/O Instrument Panels Location: Captain and F/O Instrument Panels

Vertical Speed Pointer Vertical Speed Pointer


Indicates vertical speed in feet per Indicates vertical speed in feet per
minute as computed by the associ- minute as computed by the associ-
ated IRU. ated IRU.

1 2 OFF Flag 1 2 OFF Flag


5 VERTICAL 4 Indicates vertical speed 5 VERTICAL 4 Indicates vertical speed
SPEED input from the associ- SPEED input from the associ-
0 OFF 6 ated IRU is unreliable. 0 OFF 6 ated IRU is unreliable.
1000 FPM 1000 FPM
5 4 5 4
1 1
2 2

TAT/SAT/TAS INDICATORS Location: Center Instrument Panel TAT/SAT/TAS INDICATORS Location: Center Instrument Panel
Location: F/O’s Instrument Panel Location: F/O’s Instrument Panel
TAT/SAT/TAS Annunciators Digital Display (EIS) TAT/SAT/TAS Annunciators Digital Display (EIS)
Indicates type of data displayed. Displays TAT in °C. Indicates type of data displayed. Displays TAT in °C.

TAT TAT ˚C TAT TAT ˚C


˚C ˚C
KT KT
SAT TAS PSI SAT TAS PSI

100 100 100 100


50 50 50 50

Selector Button Selector Button


Sequences the display from TAT
Digital Display (Electromechani- to SAT to TAS. Digital Display (Electromechani- Sequences the display from TAT to
cal) cal) SAT to TAS.
Displays TAT or SAT in °C, or Displays TAT or SAT in °C, or
TAS in knots. TAS in knots.

and
OCT 99 Systems Introduction 34-150 OCT 99 34-150
UNITED
B737 GENERAL AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
CONTROLS & INDICATIONS CONTROLS & INDICATIONS

MACH/AIRSPEED WARNING TEST PANEL MACH/AIRSPEED WARNING TEST PANEL


Location: Aft Overhead Panel Location: Aft Overhead Panel

MACH MACH
AIRSPEED AIRSPEED
WARNING WARNING
TEST TEST
NO. 1 NO. 2 NO. 1 NO. 2

MACH AIRSPEED WARNING TEST MACH AIRSPEED WARNING TEST


Switches Switches
Push - Tests the respective Mach/airspeed Push - Tests the respective Mach/airspeed
warning system, and the clacker sounds. warning system, and the clacker sounds.

34-151and Systems Introduction OCT 99 34-151 OCT 99


UNITED AIRLINES COURSE
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
CONTROLS & INDICATIONS CONTROLS & INDICATIONS

FLIGHT MANAGEMENT COMPUTER SYSTEM FLIGHT MANAGEMENT COMPUTER SYSTEM


CONTROL DISPLAY UNIT (CDU) CONTROL DISPLAY UNIT (CDU)
Location: Forward Control Pedestal Location: Forward Control Pedestal
Page Title Page Number Page Title Page Number
Identifies subject or title of data Identifies page number an number of Identifies subject or title of data Identifies page number an number of
displayed on page pages in series, e.g., 1/2 identifies page displayed on page pages in series, e.g., 1/2 identifies page
ACT or MOD may be displayed if as first in series of two pages. ACT or MOD may be displayed if as first in series of two pages.
page contains active or modified page contains active or modified
data. Box Prompts data. Box Prompts
Indicate data entry required for nor- Indicate data entry required for
CDU Display mal FMC operation. Data may be CDU Display normal FMC operation. Data may
Displays pages of FMC data con- entered by the FMC at appropriate Displays pages of FMC data con- be entered by the FMC at appro-
taining up to 6 full or 12 half lines time or can be entered or changed taining up to 6 full or 12 half lines priate time or can be entered or
of data as selected with CDU keys through the scratch pad. of data as selected with CDU keys changed through the scratch pad.
or by FMC logic. or by FMC logic.

Dash Prompts Dash Prompts


Indicate data entry is
Indicate data entry is
PERF INIT 1/1
optional. Data can be PERF INIT 1/1 optional. Data can be
GROSS WT
FL190/
TRIP/CRZ ALT
entered through the scratch GROSS WT TRIP/CRZ ALT entered through the scratch
FL190/ pad.
FUEL CRZ WIND pad. FUEL
15.0 --- /--- ˚ CRZ WIND
ZFW ISA DEV 15.0 --- /---
ISA DEV
˚
---
C ˚ Line Select Keys
ZFW Line Select Keys
RESERVES T/C OAT --- ˚C (1 through 6 Left and
--- C ˚ (1 through 6 Left and RESERVES T/C OAT
COST INDEX TRANS ALT Right Sides --- C ˚ Right Sides
18000
Transfer data from scratch
COST INDEX TRANS ALT Transfer data from
18000
INDEX scratch pad to line next to
pad to line next to key if
TAKEOFF
123.4/ABCDEF INDEX TAKEOFF
acceptable to FMC. 123.4/ABCDEF key if acceptable to FMC.
Duplicate data from line Duplicate data from line
INIT RTE CLB CRZ DES BRT next to key to scratch pad
REF
next to key to scratch pad INIT RTE CLB CRZ DES BRT
DIR DEP EXEC if scratch pad is blank and
REF
if scratch pad is blank
LEGS HOLD PROG
INTC ARR
data is acceptable to
DIR
INTC
LEGS DEP
ARR
HOLD PROG
EXEC
and data is acceptable to
N1
LIMIT FIX A B C D E FMC. N1
FMC.
Call up first page in series
LIMIT FIX A B C D E Call up first page in series
PREV NEXT
PAGE PAGE F G H I J
corresponding to subject
PREV NEXT
F G H I J corresponding to subject
PAGE PAGE

K L M N O on line next to key if entry on line next to key if


1 2 3
is preceded or followed by
1 2 3 K L M N O entry is preceded or fol-
4 5 6 P Q R S T
caret (< >). lowed by caret (< >).
4 5 6 P Q R S T
7 8 9 U V W X Y
BRT Knob 7 8 9 U V W X Y BRT Knob
. 0 + /- Z DEL / CLR
Control intensity of CDU Control intensity of CDU
. /
display.
0 + /- Z DEL CLR
display.

and
OCT 99 Systems Introduction 34-152 OCT 99 34-152
UNITED
B737 GENERAL AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
CONTROLS & INDICATIONS CONTROLS & INDICATIONS

CONTROL DISPLAY UNIT (CDU) CONTROL DISPLAY UNIT (CDU)


Location: Forward Control Pedestal Location: Forward Control Pedestal

Scratch Pad (Bottom Line)


Scratch Pad (Bottom Line)
Displays alphanumeric data PERF INIT Displays alphanumeric data PERF INIT

or messages. Data can be GROSS WT TRIP/CRZ ALT or messages. Data can be GROSS WT TRIP/CRZ ALT
FL190/ entered with alphanumeric FL190/
entered with alphanumeric
keys or line select keys or by
FUEL CRZ WIND FUEL CRZ WIND
keys or line select keys or by 15.0 --- /--- ˚ 15.0 --- /--- ˚
the FMC. Messages are gen-
ZFW ISA DEV
the FMC. Messages are gen- ZFW ISA DEV
--- C ˚ --- C ˚
erated only by the FMC and
erated only by the FMC and RESERVES T/C OAT RESERVES T/C OAT

can be alerting, preempting --- C ˚ can be alerting, preempting --- C ˚


data entries, or advisory
COST INDEX TRANS ALT COST INDEX TRANS ALT
data entries, or advisory mes- 18000 18000
messages appearing only if
sages appearing only if and INDEX TAKEOFF INDEX TAKEOFF

when the scratch is blank.


123.4/ABCDEF and when the scratch is 123.4/ABCDEF

Scratch pad entries are inde- blank.


Scratch pad entries are inde-
pendent of page selection, INIT RTE CLB CRZ DES BRT
INIT RTE CLB CRZ DES BRT
pendent of page selection,
REF REF
and remain until cleared,
even when page changes
DIR
INTC
LEGS DEP
ARR
HOLD PROG
EXEC
and remain until cleared, DIR
INTC
LEGS DEP
ARR
HOLD PROG
EXEC

even when page changes


occur. Scratch pad data N1 N1
FIX A B C D E
A B C D E occur. Scratch pad data
LIMIT FIX LIMIT
entries and erasures affect
only the associated CDU.
PREV
PAGE
NEXT
PAGE F G H I J entries and erasures affect PREV
PAGE
NEXT
PAGE F G H I J
Messages can appear and be only the associated CDU.
erased on both CDUs simul-
1 2 3 K L M N O Messages can appear and be 1 2 3 K L M N O

taneously. erased on both CDUs simul- P Q R S T


4 5 6 P Q R S T 4 5 6
taneously.
7 8 9 U V W X Y 7 8 9 U V W X Y
Numeric Keys Numeric Keys
. . + /- /
Enter numeric characters in / Enter numeric characters in scratch 0 Z
+ /- Z DEL CLR
0 DEL CLR

scratch pad, if scratch pad is pad, if scratch pad is blank. First


blank. First push of +/- key enters push of +/- key enters -. Subse-
-. Subsequent pushes change entry quent pushes change entry alter-
alternately from - to +. CLR Key nately from - to +. CLR Key
Alpha Keys Erases last character of Alpha Keys Erases last character of
Enter alpha characters in scratch scratch pad line or complete Enter alpha characters in scratch scratch pad line or com-
pad, if scratch pad is blank. / key message when pushed pad, if scratch pad is blank. / key plete message when
used to separate speed/altitude, momentarily. Erases entire used to separate speed/altitude, pushed momentarily.
wind speed/direction, and similar scratch pad data entry when wind speed/direction, and similar Erases entire scratch pad
type entries held. type entries data entry when held.
DEL Key With message displayed in DEL Key With message displayed
Enters DELETE on scratch pad if scratch pad, momentary Enters DELETE on scratch pad if in scratch pad, momentary
scratch pad is blank. Subsequent push clears message, and scratch pad is blank. Subsequent push clears message, and
line selection deletes data on adja- turns off MSG and FMC line selection deletes data on adja- turns off MSG and FMC
cent line if the data is deletable. lights. cent line if the data is deletable. lights.

34-153and Systems Introduction OCT 99 34-153 OCT 99


UNITED AIRLINES COURSE
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
CONTROLS & INDICATIONS CONTROLS & INDICATIONS

CONTROL DISPLAY UNIT (CDU) CRZ Key CONTROL DISPLAY UNIT (CDU) CRZ Key
Location: Forward Control Pedestal Calls up first page of series relating Location: Forward Control Pedestal Calls up first page of series relating
to cruise. to cruise.
CLB Key DES Key CLB Key DES Key
Calls up first page of series relating to Calls up first page of series Calls up first page of series relating to Calls up first page of series
climb. relating to descent. climb. relating to descent.
EXEC Key EXEC Key
RTE Key RTE Key
Activates flight plan, and Activates flight plan, and
Calls up first page of series related to Calls up first page of series related to
changes to active flight changes to active flight
flight plan route on which data is dis- flight plan route on which data is dis-
plan and performance plan and performance
played and entered. played and entered.
mode, when light bar is mode, when light bar is
illuminated. Light bar illuminated. Light bar
INIT REF Key INIT REF Key
indicates modification to indicates modification to
Calls up first page of series used Calls up first page of series used to
active route or perfor- active route or perfor-
to initialize FMC and IRS, plus initialize FMC and IRS, plus vari-
mance mode has been mance mode has been
various pages of reference data. ous pages of reference data.
entered but not executed. entered but not executed.

INIT RTE CLB CRZ DES BRT


REF INIT RTE CLB CRZ DES BRT
REF
DIR LEGS DEP HOLD PROG EXEC
INTC ARR DIR LEGS DEP HOLD PROG EXEC
INTC ARR
N1
LIMIT FIX N1
LIMIT FIX

DIR INTC Key PROG Key DIR INTC Key PROG Key
Calls up LEGS page with Calls up first page of series display- Calls up LEGS page with Calls up first page of series displaying
prompts used to enter route ing dynamic flight and navigation prompts used to enter route dynamic flight and navigation data,
from present position direct to data, including ETAs and fuel from present position direct to including ETAs and fuel remaining for
waypoint, or to intercept desig- remaining for downline waypoints. waypoint, or to intercept desig- downline waypoints.
nated course to waypoint nated course to waypoint
HOLD Key HOLD Key
Calls up page for entering holding Calls up page for entering holding pro-
LEGS Key procedure into route, or for modify- LEGS Key cedure into route, or for modifying
Calls up first page of series display- ing pre-planned holding pattern. Calls up first page of series display- pre-planned holding pattern.
ing details of each leg or route and ing details of each leg or route and
list of all route waypoints with DEP ARR Key list of all route waypoints with speed/ DEP ARR Key
speed/altitude crossing restrictions. Calls up first page of series listing altitude crossing restrictions. LEGS Calls up first page of series listing all
LEGS page controls route segment all terminal are procedures in data page controls route segment dis- terminal are procedures in data base
displayed on associated HSI when base for departure of arrival. played on associated HSI when HSI for departure of arrival.
HSI is in PLAN mode. is in PLAN mode.

and
OCT 99 Systems Introduction 34-154 OCT 99 34-154
UNITED
B737 GENERAL AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
CONTROLS & INDICATIONS CONTROLS & INDICATIONS

CONTROL DISPLAY UNIT (CDU) CONTROL DISPLAY UNIT (CDU)


Location: Forward Control Pedestal Location: Forward Control Pedestal

FIX Key FIX Key


Calls up first page of series PERF INIT Calls up first page of series PERF INIT
used to establish bearings and GROSS WT TRIP/CRZ ALT used to establish bearings and GROSS WT TRIP/CRZ ALT
distances from off route nav FL190/ distances from off route nav FL190/
aids as waypoints, and to dis- FUEL CRZ WIND aids as waypoints, and to dis- FUEL CRZ WIND
15.0 --- /--- ˚ 15.0 --- /--- ˚
play ETAs and distances. ZFW ISA DEV play ETAs and distances. ZFW ISA DEV
--- C ˚ --- C ˚
RESERVES T/C OAT RESERVES T/C OAT
N1 LIMIT Key --- C ˚ N1 LIMIT Key --- C ˚
Displays a page with engine COST INDEX TRANS ALT Displays a page with engine COST INDEX TRANS ALT
18000 18000
N1 limit values. Allows pilot N1 limit values. Allows pilot
INDEX INDEX
selection of thrust limits if selection of thrust limits if
TAKEOFF TAKEOFF
123.4/ABCDEF 123.4/ABCDEF
automatic selection is not automatic selection is not
desired. The active limit is INIT
desired. The active limit is INIT
RTE CLB CRZ DES BRT RTE CLB CRZ DES BRT
always available for display REF
always available for display on REF

on the N1 indicators and for DIR


INTC
LEGS DEP
ARR
HOLD PROG
EXEC the N1 indicators and for use DIR
INTC
LEGS DEP
ARR
HOLD PROG
EXEC

use by the autothrottle. N1


by the autothrottle. N1
LIMIT FIX A B C D E LIMIT FIX A B C D E
FAIL Light PREV NEXT
F G H I J M
FAIL Light PREV NEXT
F G H I J M
Indicates fault in associated
PAGE PAGE PAGE PAGE
Indicates fault in associated S
G
S
G
CDU or in FMC. 1 2 3 K L M N O CDU or in FMC. 1 2 3 K L M N O
F F
A 4 5 6 P Q R S T A 4 5 6 P Q R S T
I I
L L
PREV PAGE Key 7 8 9 U V W X Y PREV PAGE Key 7 8 9 U V W X Y
Changes display to next lower Changes display to next lower
page number in multiple page . 0 + /- Z DEL / CLR page number in multiple page . 0 + /- Z DEL / CLR

series, or, except for LEGS and series, or, except for LEGS and
ROUTE pages, from first page in ROUTE pages, from first page in
series to last page, when pushed series to last page, when pushed
momentarily. Changes pages at MSG Light momentarily. Changes pages at MSG Light
rate of one per second when held. Indicates FMC-generated rate of one per second when held. Indicates FMC-gener-
message is displayed on ated message is dis-
NEXT PAGE Key scratch pad, or waiting to NEXT PAGE Key played on scratch pad,
Changes display to next higher be displayed when scratch Changes display to next higher or waiting to be dis-
page number multiple page pad is clear. page number multiple page played when scratch
series, or except LEGS and series, or except LEGS and pad is clear.
ROUTE pages, from last page in ROUTE pages, from last page in
series to first page, when pushed series to first page, when pushed
momentarily. Changes pages at momentarily. Changes pages at
rate of one per second when held. rate of one per second when held.

34-155and Systems Introduction OCT 99 34-155 OCT 99


UNITED
B737 GENERAL AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
DESCRIPTION & OPERATION DESCRIPTION & OPERATION

INIT/REF INDEX INIT/REF INDEX


Location: CDU Location: CDU

Provides access to pages used for preflight initialization of the FMC and IRS. Also pro- Provides access to pages used for preflight initialization of the FMC and IRS. Also pro-
vides access to various pages of reference data. Accessed by: INIT REF button or any vides access to various pages of reference data. Accessed by: INIT REF button or any
INDEX prompt. INDEX prompt.

IDENT POS IDENT POS


Displays the IDENT page which Displays the POS INIT page which Displays the IDENT page which is Displays the POS INIT page which
is the first page referred to during is used to enter initialization infor- the first page referred to during is used to enter initialization infor-
preflight. mation into the IRSs. preflight. mation into the IRSs.
NAV DATA NAV DATA
Displays the REF NAV DATA page Displays the REF NAV DATA page
which allows waypoint, navaid, or which allows waypoint, navaid, or
airport identifier entry. airport identifier entry.

INIT/REF INDEX
INIT/REF INDEX
< IDENT NAV DATA >
PERF < IDENT NAV DATA >
PERF
Displays the PERF
< POS Displays the PERF
INIT page which is
< POS INIT page which is
< PERF
used to enter perfor- used to enter perfor-
< PERF
mance information for
mance information for
< TAKEOFF
VNAV calculations. < TAKEOFF VNAV calculations.
< APPROACH MAINT MAINT
< APPROACH
For use by mainte-
For use by mainte-
MAINT >
nance personnel only. MAINT > nance personnel only.
APPROACH
SUPP
SUPP

TAKEOFF TAKEOFF
Displays the TAKEOFF REF Displays the TAKEOFF REF
PAGE which is used to enter tem- PAGE which is used to enter tem-
perature data for takeoff compu- perature data for takeoff computa-
tations. APPROACH tions. Displays the APPROACH REF
Displays the APPROACH REF page page which provides speeds for
which provides speeds for approach approach and landing.
and landing.

34-156and Systems Introduction OCT 99 34-156 OCT 99


UNITED
B737 GENERAL AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
CONTROLS & INDICATIONS CONTROLS & INDICATIONS

IDENT PAGE IDENT PAGE


Location: CDU Location: CDU

Allows verification of the installed performance and navigation data base. Also allows Allows verification of the installed performance and navigation data base. Also allows
selection of the active navigation data base. Assessed by: Automatically on power-up, or selection of the active navigation data base. Assessed by: Automatically on power-up, or
by the IDENT prompt on the INIT/REF INDEX page. by the IDENT prompt on the INIT/REF INDEX page.

MODEL
Displays the airplane
MODEL ENG RATING model contained in the ENG RATING
Displays the airplane Identifies the engine rating con- performance data base. Identifies the engine rating con-
model contained in the tained in the performance data tained in the performance data
performance data base. base. base.

NAV DATA
NAV DATA
Displays the navigation
Displays the navigation
data base identifier.
data base identifier. ACTIVE ACTIVE
Displays the range of Displays the range of
effective dates for the effective dates for the
active navigation data active navigation data
base IDENT 1/1 base
IDENT 1/1
MODEL ENG RATING
Inactive Data Line MODEL ENG RATING
Inactive Data Line
737-300 20K
737-300 20K Displays the range of NAV DATA ACTIVE Displays the range of
NAV DATA ACTIVE
UAL 1930801 JUN 29 JUL 27 / 97 effective dates for the UAL 1930801 JUN 29 JUL 27 / 97
effective dates for the
inactive navigation data JUL 28 AUG 25 / 97 inactive navigation data
JUL 28 AUG 25 / 97
base. OP PROGRAM base.
OP PROGRAM 548925-08-01 (U5.0)
548925-08-01 (U5.0)
SUPP DATA
SUPP DATA SUPP DATA JAN 21 / 94 SUPP DATA
JAN 21 / 94
Displays the effective Displays the effective
dates from the supple- INDEX POS INIT >
dates from the supple-
INDEX POS INIT >
mental navigation data mental navigation data
base. base.

INDEX INDEX POS INIT


Allows selection of the INIT/ POS INIT Allows selection of the INIT/REF INDEX Allows selection of the POS INIT
REF INDEX page. Allows selection of the POS INIT page. page. Used to continue the pre-
page. Used to continue the preflight flight sequence.
sequence.
OP PROGRAM OP PROGRAM
Displays the FMC operational Displays the FMC operational program
program identifier. identifier.

34-157and Systems Introduction OCT 99 34-157 OCT 99


UNITED AIRLINES COURSE
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
CONTROLS & INDICATIONS CONTROLS & INDICATIONS

POS INIT PAGE POS INIT PAGE


Location: CDU Location: CDU

Allows entry of present position for FMC initialization and IRS alignment during pre- Allows entry of present position for FMC initialization and IRS alignment during pre-
flight. Also used to verify the FMC time reference. Accessed by: INIT/REF INDEX flight. Also used to verify the FMC time reference. Accessed by: INIT/REF INDEX
page, POS prompt or and POS INIT prompt. page, POS prompt or and POS INIT prompt.

REF AIRPORT REF AIRPORT


Allows entry of the origin airport. Valid entry is the four Allows entry of the origin airport. Valid entry is the four
character ICAO airport identifier. Entry automatically dis- character ICAO airport identifier. Entry automatically dis-
plays the airport reference point latitude and longitude on plays the airport reference point latitude and longitude on
line 2R. The lines blank at liftoff. line 2R. The lines blank at liftoff.

POS INIT 1/3 POS INIT 1/3


LAST POS LAST POS
N 33˚ 56.9 W 118˚ 24.3 N 33˚ 56.9 W 118˚ 24.3
REF AIRPORT REF AIRPORT
KLAX N 33˚ 56.5 W 118˚ 24.5 KLAX N 33˚ 56.5 W 118˚ 24.5
GATE GATE
ALL N 33˚ 56.4 W 118˚ 23.9 ALL N 33˚ 56.4 W 118˚ 23.9
SET IRS POS SET IRS POS
˚ ˚

GMT - MON / DY SET IRS HDG GMT - MON / DY SET IRS HDG
1432 . 0 z ---˚ 1432 . 0 z ---˚

INDEX ROUTE > INDEX ROUTE >

LAST POS LAST POS


Displays the last FMC posi- Displays the last FMC position
tion anytime both IRUs are anytime both IRUs are not in
not in the NAV mode and cur- the NAV mode and current
GATE GATE
rent FMC position when FMC position when IRS(s) are
Used for entry and display of the air- Used for entry and display of
IRS(s) are in the NAV mode. in the NAV mode. The last
port gate position. Entry automati- the airport gate position. Entry
The last position is retained by position is retained by the FMC
cally displays gate latitude and automatically displays gate lati-
the FMC when power is when power is removed.
longitude on line 3R. The lines clear tude and longitude on line 3R.
removed.
at liftoff. The lines clear at liftoff.
ROUTE
ROUTE
Displays the RTE page. Used to
Displays the RTE page. Used to
continue the preflight sequence.
continue the preflight sequence.

and
OCT 99 Systems Introduction 34-158 OCT 99 34-158
UNITED
B737 GENERAL AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
CONTROLS & INDICATIONS CONTROLS & INDICATIONS

POS INIT PAGE POS INIT PAGE


Location: CDU Location: CDU

SET IRS POS SET IRS POS


Allows entry of present position latitude and longi- Allows entry of present position latitude and longitude.
tude. Entry can be via the keyboard or by line select- Entry can be via the keyboard or by line selecting
ing LAST POS, REF AIRPORT (SR) or GATE (3R). LAST POS, REF AIRPORT (SR) or GATE (3R).
Boxes are displayed when any IRU is in the ALIGN Boxes are displayed when any IRU is in the ALIGN
mode and the present position has not yet been mode and the present position has not yet been entered.
entered. When both IRUs enter the NAV mode, the When both IRUs enter the NAV mode, the Data Line
Data Line and Title clear. and Title clear.

POS INIT 1/3 POS INIT 1/3


LAST POS LAST POS
N 33˚ 56.9 W 118˚ 24.3 N 33˚ 56.9 W 118˚ 24.3
REF AIRPORT REF AIRPORT
KLAX N 33˚ 56.5 W 118˚ 24.5 KLAX N 33˚ 56.5 W 118˚ 24.5
GATE GATE
ALL N 33˚ 56.4 W 118˚ 23.9 ALL N 33˚ 56.4 W 118˚ 23.9
SET IRS POS SET IRS POS
˚ ˚

GMT - MON / DY SET IRS HDG GMT - MON / DY SET IRS HDG
1432 . 0 z ---˚ 1432 . 0 z ---˚

INDEX ROUTE > INDEX ROUTE >

GMT SET IRS HDG GMT SET IRS HDG


Displays time from the Captain’s clock. If Allows entry of present magnetic heading. Displays time from the Captain’s clock. If Allows entry of present magnetic heading.
the time is not valid, GMT must be Blank except when an IRS is in the ATT the time is not valid, GMT must be Blank except when an IRS is in the ATT
entered to initialize the FMC internal time mode. Entering heading updates any IRU entered to initialize the FMC internal time mode. Entering heading updates any IRU
reference. Month and day cannot be in the ATT mode. reference. Month and day cannot be in the ATT mode.
entered. If the Captain’s clock is not set to entered. If the Captain’s clock is not set to
GMT, then GMT hours should be entered GMT, then GMT hours should be entered
to ensure correct FMC reference. Minutes to ensure correct FMC reference. Minutes
will still follow the Captain’s clock. Fol- will still follow the Captain’s clock. Fol-
lowing power interruption, the displayed lowing power interruption, the displayed
time resynchronizes with the Captain’s time resynchronizes with the Captain’s
clock. clock.

34-159and Systems Introduction OCT 99 34-159 OCT 99


OCT
and
DUAL
VOR/LOC
NAVIGATION

DUAL ADF ADF

99 Systems
GLIDESLOPE LOOP-1 LOOP-2 MARKER
BEACON HF COMM

UPPER
TCAS VHF
SKY RADIO
COMPONENT LOCATIONS

UPPER COMM-1
WEATHER

Introduction
RADAR ATC

Antenna Locations
DUAL
DME-2 VHF COMM-3
LOCALIZER
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION

LOWER ADF SENSE


ANTENNA DME-1
ATC VHF AIRFONE L & R LH AND RH
COMM-2 1 2
B737-322/522

RADIO RADIO
ALTIMETER-2 ALTIMETER-1
UNITED AIRLINES COURSE

LOWER
TCAS

34-160
AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE

OCT 99
DUAL
NAVIGATION

VOR/LOC

DUAL ADF ADF


GLIDESLOPE LOOP-1 LOOP-2 MARKER
BEACON HF COMM

UPPER
COMPONENT LOCATIONS

TCAS VHF
COMM-1 SKY RADIO
WEATHER UPPER
RADAR ATC
Antenna Locations
UNITED AIRLINES

DUAL
DME-2 VHF COMM-3
LOCALIZER
LOWER ADF SENSE
ANTENNA DME-1
ATC VHF AIRFONE L & R LH AND RH
B737-322/522

COMM-2 1 2
RADIO RADIO
ALTIMETER-2 ALTIMETER-1
LOWER
TCAS
34-160
AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
AIR DATA AUTO DGIL DGIL AUTO AUTO EXEX AIR DATA WXR
CMPTR THROTTLE STALL STALL SLAT SLAT PRESS CMPTR
NO. 1 CMPTR WRN WRN CMPTR CMPTR CONT NO. 2 TRANSCEIVER
CMPTR CMPTR NO. 1 NO. 2

(M345)
NO. 1 NO. 2

CBN TEMP CONT


(M196) (M917) (M1222) (M1223) (M325) (M368)

34-161 and
E1-1
NAVIGATION

IRS EFIS
FLIGHT FLIGHT RLY TXFR DIGITAL ENG DIGITAL
MANAGEMENT INST NO. 1 RLY 1 ANALOG VIB ANALOG
VOICE COMPUTER ACCESS ADAPTER SIG ADAPTER
RCDR IRS EFIS NO. 1 COND NO. 2 E1
RLY TXFR
(M1175) (M160) NO. 2 RLY 2 (M1163) (M1240) (M1163) STA 322.9
E1-2
E2 E3
ACARS FLIGHT CONT CMPTR YAW AFC FLIGHT CONT CMPTR
CHANNEL "A" DAMPER ACCESS CHANNEL "B"
CPLR UNIT
COMPONENT LOCATIONS

E6 RACK
STA 887 - STA 907, AFT CARGO COMP. (M1109) (M924) (M177) (M1194) (M923)
E1-3
B737 GENERAL

E1 RACK

Systems Introduction
UNITED

TRANS TRANS TRANS BATTERY STATIC


P/A REU VHF VHF VHF FORMER FORMER FORMER CHARGER INVERTER
AMPL COMM COMM COMM RECT RECT RECT
NO. 3 NO. 1 NO. 2 IFIER IFIER IFIER
NO. 1 NO. 2 NO. 3
(M63) (M411) (M149) (M150) (T11) (T12) (T13) (M5) (M9)
E2-1 E3-1

AUTO ANTI AIR ENG


ATC ATC FDAU DME DME SPEED SKID COND ACCESS
NO. 1 NO. 2 NO. 1 NO. 2 ELECTRONIC BRAKE TION
DET
MISC
AIRLINES

Electronic Equipment Racks


BOX EXTRACTOR RLY
SWITCHES
POSITION

OVERHEAT
SWITCHES
FLAP & SLAT

(M163) (M381) (M675) (M164) (M165)


IN BRACKET ON (M980) (M316)(M324) (M528) (M237) (M278) (M229)
FWD INBD STANCHION E3-2
E2-2
FAMILIARIZATION

IRU IRU
NO. 1 NO. 2 APU FIRE WINDOW WINDOW WINDOW WINDOW
ENT MULTI EFIS EFIS CONT DETECTOR CONT CONT CONT CONT
B737-322/522

TAPE PLEXER SYMBOL SYMBOL NO. 1 NO. 2 NO. 3 NO. 4


REPRO GENERATOR GENERATOR (M1161) (M1162)
RELAYS
NO. 1 NO. 2 R10
(R280)

(M1319) (M1321) BLACK BOX (M279) R11 (M320) (M321) (M322) (M323)
E3-3
E2-3 EXTRACTOR
BATTERY VHF VHF VHF VOR AFCS
RADIO RADIO GND ADF ADF NAV NAV NAV ILS ILS
COURSE

ALTIMETER ALTIMETER PROX NO. NO. NO. 1 SW NO. 2 NAV RLYS


NO. 1 NO. 2 2 1 NO.1 REL NO.1
(PROV) MKR
ELECTROSTATIC NO.2 (REF) NO.2
BKN
GROUND JACK (M154) (REF) (M155)
(M50) (M415)
INTERPHONE E3-4
E2-4
SERVICE
E2 RACK E3 RACK

OCT 99
AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE

AIR DATA AUTO DGIL DGIL AUTO AUTO EXEX AIR DATA WXR
CMPTR THROTTLE STALL STALL SLAT SLAT PRESS CMPTR

34-161
NO. 1 CMPTR WRN WRN CMPTR CMPTR CONT NO. 2 TRANSCEIVER
CMPTR CMPTR NO. 1 NO. 2
(M345)

NO. 1 NO. 2
CBN TEMP CONT

(M196) (M917) (M1222) (M1223) (M325) (M368)


E1-1
NAVIGATION

IRS EFIS
FLIGHT FLIGHT RLY TXFR DIGITAL ENG DIGITAL
MANAGEMENT INST NO. 1 RLY 1 ANALOG VIB ANALOG
VOICE COMPUTER ACCESS ADAPTER SIG ADAPTER
RCDR IRS EFIS NO. 1 COND NO. 2 E1
RLY TXFR
(M1175) (M160) NO. 2 RLY 2 (M1163) (M1240) (M1163) STA 322.9
E1-2
E2 E3
ACARS FLIGHT CONT CMPTR YAW AFC FLIGHT CONT CMPTR
CHANNEL "A" DAMPER ACCESS CHANNEL "B"
CPLR UNIT
COMPONENT LOCATIONS

E6 RACK
STA 887 - STA 907, AFT CARGO COMP. (M1109) (M924) (M177) (M1194) (M923)
E1-3
E1 RACK

TRANS TRANS TRANS BATTERY STATIC


P/A REU VHF VHF VHF FORMER FORMER FORMER CHARGER INVERTER
AMPL COMM COMM COMM RECT RECT RECT
NO. 3 NO. 1 NO. 2 IFIER IFIER IFIER
NO. 1 NO. 2 NO. 3
(M63) (M411) (M149) (M150) (T11) (T12) (T13) (M5) (M9)
E2-1 E3-1

AUTO ANTI AIR ENG


ATC ATC FDAU DME DME SPEED SKID COND ACCESS
NO. 1 NO. 2 NO. 1 NO. 2 ELECTRONIC BRAKE TION
DET
MISC
UNITED AIRLINES

Electronic Equipment Racks

BOX EXTRACTOR RLY


SWITCHES
POSITION

OVERHEAT
SWITCHES
FLAP & SLAT

(M163) (M381) (M675) (M164) (M165)


IN BRACKET ON (M980) (M316)(M324) (M528) (M237) (M278) (M229)
FWD INBD STANCHION E3-2
E2-2 IRU IRU
NO. 1 NO. 2 APU FIRE WINDOW WINDOW WINDOW WINDOW
ENT MULTI EFIS EFIS CONT DETECTOR CONT CONT CONT CONT
B737-322/522

TAPE PLEXER SYMBOL SYMBOL NO. 1 NO. 2 NO. 3 NO. 4


REPRO GENERATOR GENERATOR (M1161) (M1162)
RELAYS
NO. 1 NO. 2 R10
(R280)

(M1319) (M1321) BLACK BOX (M279) R11 (M320) (M321) (M322) (M323)
E3-3
E2-3 EXTRACTOR
BATTERY VHF VHF VHF VOR AFCS
RADIO RADIO GND ADF ADF NAV NAV NAV ILS ILS
ALTIMETER ALTIMETER PROX NO. NO. NO. 1 SW NO. 2 NAV RLYS
NO. 1 NO. 2 2 1 NO.1 REL NO.1
(PROV) MKR
ELECTROSTATIC NO.2 (REF) NO.2
BKN
GROUND JACK (M154) (REF) (M155)
(M50) (M415)
INTERPHONE E3-4
E2-4
SERVICE
OCT 99

E2 RACK E3 RACK
AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
UNITED AIRLINES COURSE
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
COMPONENT LOCATIONS COMPONENT LOCATIONS

NOSE WHEEL WELL,


NOSE WHEEL WELL, FORWARD BULKHEAD
FORWARD BULKHEAD RIGHT FWD - DRAIN
RIGHT FWD - DRAIN FITTINGS: 13, 14, 15 AND 16
FITTINGS: 13, 14, 15 AND 16

RIGHT - DRAIN
RIGHT - DRAIN FITTINGS: 6, 7, AND 8
FITTINGS: 6, 7, AND 8

LEFT - DRAIN
LEFT - DRAIN FITTINGS: 11 AND 12
FITTINGS: 11 AND 12

ELECTRICAL AND ELECTRONIC


ELECTRICAL AND ELECTRONIC COMPARTMENT
COMPARTMENT
E1 RACK, RIGHT SIDE
E1 RACK, RIGHT SIDE DRAIN FITTINGS:
DRAIN FITTINGS: 3, 4, 5, 9 AND 10
3, 4, 5, 9 AND 10

E1 RACK LEFT SIDE


E1 RACK LEFT SIDE DRAIN FITTINGS:
DRAIN FITTINGS: 1 AND 2
1 AND 2

Pitot Static Components 1 Pitot Static Components 1

and
OCT 99 Systems Introduction 34-162 OCT 99 34-162
UNITED
B737 GENERAL AIRLINES
FAMILIARIZATION COURSE UNITED AIRLINES
B737-322/522 B737-322/522
NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE NAVIGATION AIRCRAFT REFERENCE GUIDE
COMPONENT LOCATIONS COMPONENT LOCATIONS

UPPER RIGHT UPPER RIGHT


PROBE PROBE
(STA 248) (STA 248)

LOWER RIGHT LOWER RIGHT


PROBE PROBE
(STA 248) (STA 248)
ALTERNATE ALTERNATE
STATIC PORT STATIC PORT
(STA 406) (STA 406)

UPPER LEFT UPPER LEFT


PROBE PROBE
(STA 248) (STA 248)

LOWER LEFT LOWER LEFT


PROBE PROBE
(STA 248) (STA 248)

TAT ALTERNATE TAT ALTERNATE


PROBE STATIC PORT PROBE STATIC PORT
(STA 268) (STA 406) (STA 268) (STA 406)

Pitot Static Components 2 Pitot Static Components 2

34-163 and Systems Introduction OCT 99 34-163 OCT 99


 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

 
TABLE OF CONTENTS
B737-300/400/500 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION SELF-PACED
ATA-35

OXYGEN SYSTEMS ............................................................................................................................................. 2


Overview..................................................................................................................................................... 2
FLIGHT CREW OXYGEN SYSTEM ........................................................................................................................ 3
Overview..................................................................................................................................................... 3
Crew Oxygen Cylinder Assembly................................................................................................................. 6
Cylinder Coupling Assembly ....................................................................................................................... 6
Pressure Regulator ..................................................................................................................................... 6
Pressure Transducer .................................................................................................................................. 6
External Fill Panel ...................................................................................................................................... 6
System Shutoff Valve ................................................................................................................................. 9
Mask Storage Box (crew stations so equipped) ....................................................................................... 10
Mask/Regulator (Crew Stations with Mask/Storage boxes) .................................................................... 10
Oxygen Pressure Indicators ...................................................................................................................... 12
Overboard Vent and Discharge Indicator .................................................................................................. 13
PASSENGER OXYGEN SYSTEM......................................................................................................................... 14
Overview................................................................................................................................................... 14
Chemical Oxygen Generator ...................................................................................................................... 16
Passenger Oxygen Mask........................................................................................................................... 17
Door Latch Actuator.................................................................................................................................. 18
PORTABLE OXYGEN EQUIPMENT ..................................................................................................................... 21
Overview................................................................................................................................................... 21

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-35 Page 1


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

OXYGEN SYSTEMS
Overview

The oxygen systems supply low pressure oxygen in gaseous form to the crew and passengers.

Two separate oxygen systems are included, the flight crew oxygen system and the passenger oxygen system.
In addition, emergency oxygen is supplied by portable oxygen cylinder assemblies.

The flight crew oxygen system has a supply of high pressure gaseous oxygen and distributes and delivers it at
low pressure to the crew. High pressure oxygen is kept in an oxygen cylinder assembly. The oxygen cylinder
assembly includes a safety discharge device to protect against too much pressure. Oxygen cylinder pressure is
reduced through a pressure regulator. Low pressure oxygen is distributed through individual control panels
and mask stowage boxes.

The passenger oxygen system automatically releases oxygen masks to the passengers and attendants whenever
the cabin pressure falls to a value equivalent to an altitude of 14,000 feet. Oxygen is kept in chemical oxygen
generators and oxygen flow is started by the action of the passenger or attendant pulling the oxygen mask
down to the face. Mask deployment also can be operated by a switch on the P5 aft overhead panel.

The portable oxygen equipment includes portable oxygen cylinder assemblies and protective breathing
equipment (when installed). The portable cylinders supply oxygen for emergency, first aid or sustaining
oxygen for the passengers and/or crew. The smoke hood (PBE), emergency escape breathing device (EEBD)
and the crew protective breathing equipment (CPBE) supply portable emergency respiratory and eye protection
for the crew in an oxygen-deficient, smoke filled or other toxic atmosphere.

ATA-35 Page 2 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

FLIGHT CREW OXYGEN SYSTEM


Overview

The flight crew oxygen system is a diluter-demand type system which supplies supplemental and protective
breathing oxygen to the flight crew stations.

Oxygen is supplied by a high pressure cylinder with a pressure regulator and a pressure transducer that is
close-coupled to the cylinder, a system shutoff valve, a distribution manifold, and individual breathing devices.
The individual breathing devices include mask/regulators and mask storage boxes at the captain's and first
officer's stations and oxygen control panels with mask-mounted regulators at the first and second observer's
stations. The first and second observer's masks are available to the captain and first officer and may be used
with the portable oxygen bottle.

A high pressure indicator on the aft overhead panel receives an electrical signal from the pressure transducer.

The flow of low pressure oxygen to each individual mask is controlled by the individual breathing devices. The
system can be used at any altitude.

The system includes pressure relief devices for protection against too much pressure.

Oxygen servicing is accomplished by attachment of an external pressure source to a filler port on the external
fill panel. A second high pressure indicator is found on the external fill panel.

Oxygen servicing can also be accomplished by cylinder replacement with a fully charged cylinder.

The crew oxygen system keeps gaseous oxygen under high pressure and supplies oxygen to each crewmember
at low pressure. High pressure oxygen flows from the crew oxygen cylinder into the cylinder coupling
assembly, then into the attached pressure regulator. The pressure regulator takes an input pressure range of
60 to 1850 PSI and reduces it to an output pressure range of 60 to 85 PSI. Also connected to the cylinder
coupling assembly is a pressure transducer which transmits an electrical signal to control the high pressure
indicator on the aft overhead panel and on the external fill panel.

A system shutoff valve that is manually operated is installed in the line to control flow to the crew oxygen
outlets. The shutoff valve is a slow opening type and is normally open. Operation of the system is automatic
when the cylinder shutoff and system shutoff valves are open and the mask/regulator is removed from the
mask storage box or oxygen control panel supply lever is in the ON position. Each individual crew member
uses a mask/regulator to control the operation of the system.

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-35 Page 3


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

OXYGEN CONTROL PANEL WITH


A MASK-MOUNTED REGULATOR
(FIRST OBSERVER'S AND FIRST
OFFICER'S STATION)

CREW OXYGEN
CYLINDER

SYSTEM
SHUTOFF VALVE

MASK STORAGE BOX WITH


MASK/REGULATOR
OXYGEN CONTROL PANEL WITH
(FIRST OFFICER'S STATION)
A MASK-MOUNTED REGULATOR
(SECOND OBSERVER'S AND
CAPTAIN'S STATION)

MASK STORAGE BOX WITH


MASK/REGULATOR
(CAPTAIN'S STATION)

ATA-35 Page 4 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE

 
 
 
 

CREW PASS OXYGEN


OXYGEN

NORMAL
10 RESET OXYGEN
5 15 TEST MASK
ON
100%
PUSH
28V DC 0 20
OXY PRESS PASS OXY
BAT. BUS
C156 PSI X 100 ON a
OXYGEN
SYSTEM IND

P18 CIRCUIT BREAKER PANEL


T404 PRESSURE TRANSDUCER N20 OXYGEN
(FORWARD CARGO COMPARTMENT) PRESSURE INDICATOR

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


P5-14 OXYGEN SYSTEM MODULE
(ON AFT OVERHEAD PANEL)
MASK STORAGE BOX
A

SYSTEM
SHUTOFF VALVE MASK/REGUALATOR
MICROPHONE
(P6 PANEL) (CHAPTER 23)
MASK STORAGE BOX
100%
(CAPTAIN'S STATION) PUSH

SEE A
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource

EMERGENCY
OVERBOARD PRESS
TO
TEST

REGULATOR

CABIN
CREW OXYGEN CYLINDER AIR MASK/REGUALATOR
(FORWARD CARGO COMPARTMENT)
MASK STORAGE BOX MASK STORAGE BOX
(FIRST OFFICER'S STATION) AND MASK/REGULATOR
PRESSURE REGULATOR
(FORWARD CARGO COMPARTMENT) SEE A

FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY


CREW OXYGEN
FILL PRESSURE
CONNECTION INDICATOR

CREW TEMPERATURE/
OXYGEN
PRESSURE
SELECTOR OXYGEN
M A S K / R E G U L A T O R1
CONTROL PANEL
WARNING: N21 (FIRST OBSERVER'S STATION)
OXYGEN PRESSURE OXYGEN CONTROL PANEL
SUPPLY
INDICATOR SEE B ON
CAUTION:

OFF

EXTERNAL SERVICING PANEL FILLER PORT OXYGEN CONTROL PANEL


FILLER VALVE
B
P24 EXTERNAL FILL PANEL LEGEND
M A S K / R E G U L A T O R2
(SECOND OBSERVER'S STATION) LOW PRESSURE OXYGEN
1 ALSO AVAILABLE TO FIRST OFFICER
OXYGEN CONTROL PANEL
2 ALSO AVAILABLE TO CAPTAIN SEE HIGH PRESSURE OXYGEN
B

ATA-35 Page 5
and Systems Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Crew Oxygen Cylinder Assembly

The crew oxygen cylinder assembly supplies the gaseous oxygen for the crew oxygen system. The cylinder is
installed on the forward right sidewall of the forward cargo compartment. The cylinder, when filled to a
pressure of 1850 PSIG, has a capacity equal to 76 or 114 cubic feet of gaseous oxygen at 760 millimeters HG
absolute and 70°F.

The cylinder assembly includes a slow-opening shutoff valve, an oxygen pressure indicator, and a safety relief
device which breaks before pressure can damage a valve or the cylinder, tubing, or components. The safety
relief device has an outlet port with a frangible disk that will break, in the event of too much pressure. This
permits the cylinder to vent the oxygen overboard through a vent in the airplane skin.

Cylinder Coupling Assembly

A cylinder coupling assembly is installed on the outlet fitting of the cylinder. It has mounting connections that
are close coupled for the pressure transducer and pressure regulator.

A brush-like wire element that is approximately 3 inches long is inserted tightly into the coupling assembly.
This wire element functions as a thermal compensator to prevent oxygen temperature extremes when the
system is being used.

Pressure Regulator

The pressure regulator connects to the cylinder coupling assembly and decreases cylinder pressure of 60 to
1850 PSI to an outlet pressure of 60 to 85 PSI. A pressure relief valve is included in the regulator to protect
the system downstream from the regulator. The relief valve is set to relieve at approximately 100 PSI and
discharges into the forward cargo compartment.

Pressure Transducer

High pressure indication is received from a pressure transducer which is a component of the cylinder coupling
assembly. The transducer takes system pressure and changes it to a variable electrical signal which controls
the oxygen pressure indicators on the aft overhead panel and on the external fill panel.

External Fill Panel

External servicing of the crew oxygen cylinder is done through an external fill panel installed under a latched
door on the right side of the lower fuselage section. The panel contains a filler valve, filler connection, and a
pressure indicator. These components are accessible slightly above the crew oxygen cylinder assembly.

ATA-35 Page 6 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

 
OXYGEN
PRESSURE EXTERNAL FILL
INDICATOR PANEL

FILLER
VALVE

CYLINDER CONNECTIONS
SEE A

CREW OXYGEN
CYLINDER PRESSURE
REGULATOR

CYLINDER SUPPLY
SHUTOFF CYLINDER LINE TO
VALVE COUPLING CONTROL
NUT CABIN

OVERBOARD OXYGEN
VENT PRESSURE
INDICATOR
PRESSURE
TRANSDUCER

CYLINDER COUPLI
OVERBOARD
ASSEMBLY
VENT
(WITH INTEGRAL
LINE
THERMAL
COMPENSATOR)
SEE B

TO EXTERNAL
CYLINDER FILL PANEL
COUPLING CYLINDER CONNECTIONS
NUT
A

THERMAL COUPLING
COMPENSATOR HEX NUT

CYLINDER COUPLING ASSEMBLY


(WITH INTEGRAL THERMAL COMPENSATOR)
B

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-35 Page 7


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

ATA-35 Page 8 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

System Shutoff Valve

The system shutoff valve for the crew oxygen system is a manually operated, slow opening valve that controls
the supply of oxygen to the individual breathing devices. The valve has a valve body, inlet and outlet ports, a
control handle, and a mounting flange that contains four holes for attachment. The valve is operated by
rotation of the control handle. The valve is installed on the P6 panel.

SEE A

ELBOW SWIVEL
CONNECTOR

ELBOW
SWIVEL
CONNECTOR
TRIM PANEL ANGLE ATTACHING
ATTACHING
SCREWS (4 PLACES)
SCREWS
(5 PLACES)

ANGLE B

TRIM CREW OXYGEN


PANEL DISTRIBUTION
LINES (OUTLET)

VALVE
MOUNTING
SCREWS
(4 PLACES)
STRUCTURE

SEE B

SHUTOFF
VALVE KNOB

CREW OXYGEN
VALVE INLET LINE
SUPPORT

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-35 Page 9


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Mask Storage Box


(Crew Stations so equipped)

A mask storage box is installed at the captain's and first officer's stations. The box supplies storage for the
mask/regulator and controls the flow of oxygen to the mask/regulator.

The box contains a sliding control, a shutoff valve, left and right lids, and a flow blinker.

The sliding control automatically keeps the shutoff valve in the closed position when the mask/regulator is
stored and both lids are closed. Hold the sliding control in TEST. This permits the mask/regulator to be
tested when in the stored position. The inner part of the sliding control has a white flag marked OXY-ON.

The left lid controls the shutoff valve when the mask/regulator is removed from the box. The left lid also
moves the sliding control's white flag to the exposed position when the mask/regulator is removed and the left
lid is closed.

The flow blinker contains a yellow diaphragm and a black diaphragm. When oxygen flow occurs, the yellow
diaphragm is pushed up against the black diaphragm. This causes a yellow cross to appear.

Mask/Regulator (Crew Stations with Mask/Storage boxes)

A mask/regulator is installed at the captain's and first officer's stations and is kept in a mask storage box.

The mask/regulator contains an oxygen mask with a microphone, an inflatable harness, and a diluter demand
regulator.

The mask harness is inflated with oxygen when the harness inflation ears on the regulator are pressed. The
harness inflates rapidly to a large, round, and rigid shape. This permits the mask/regulator to be put on
rapidly. Release the inflation ears and the harness deflates which permits it to conform to the shape of the
head.

The regulator has three manual controls - harness inflation ears, an oxygen dilution control, and a PRESS TO
TEST knob.

The harness inflation ears are used to inflate and deflate the mask harness.

The oxygen dilution control is used to select a flow of 100% oxygen.

The PRESS TO TEST knob has two functions. First, turn the knob for a positive flow of oxygen under pressure.
Second, depress the knob. This permits the regulator to be tested when the mask/regulator is in the mask
storage box. The oxygen dilution control must be at 100% for this to occur.

ATA-35 Page 10 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

STORAGE BOX
STORAGE BOX
SEE A
SEE A

CAPTAIN'S SIDEWALL

FIRST OFFICER'S SIDEWALL


MASK/REGULATOR FLOW
BLINKER
SEE B

SHUTOFF
VALVE
FLOW
SLIDING BLINKER
RESET OXYGEN
TEST
MASK
CONTROL
100%
PUSH

REGULATOR
SLIDING MASK
CONTROL

STORAGE BOX (DOORS CLOSED) STORAGE BOX (DOORS OPEN)


A A

PNEUMATIC
HARNESS HARNESS HARNESS
INFLATION INFLATION
EAR EAR

OXYGEN
DILUTION
REGULATOR CONTROL

SEE C
PRESS TO
TEST KNOB
EMERGENCY
PRESS
TO
TEST

MASK/REGULATOR
(SHOWN INFLATED) REGULATOR

B C

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-35 Page 11


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Oxygen Pressure Indicators

Oxygen pressure indicators are installed on the aft overhead panel and on the external fill panel. The
indicators supply high pressure indication for the flight crew oxygen system. Each pressure indicator dial is
calibrated to read pressure from 0 to 2000 PSI. The indicators contain a unit which takes a voltage output
signal from the pressure transducer and changes it to a calibrated pressure value that is shown on the dial.

COCKPIT INDICATION

ATA-35 Page 12 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Overboard Vent and Discharge Indicator

The discharge indicator is a green plastic disk installed in the overboard vent which is adjacent to the crew
oxygen cylinder. The indicator will break if the frangible disk in the crew oxygen cylinder breaks. This causes
pressure in the overboard vent line to build and this causes the green plastic disk to break. The purpose of
the indicator is to permit a visual indication of loss of oxygen through the overboard vent, and prevent entry of
foreign objects, insects, etc.

OXYGEN
DISCHARGE
TUBING

AIRPLANE
SKIN

SNAP RING

GREEN
INDICATOR
DISK

INBOARD DISCHARGE
FITTING

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-35 Page 13


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

PASSENGER OXYGEN SYSTEM


Overview

The passenger oxygen system supplies emergency oxygen to the passengers and attendants. The system
contains service units, various control relays, altitude pressure (automatic) switch, passenger oxygen (manual)
switch, and indicator lights.

Each passenger service unit (PSU) contains a chemical oxygen generator and an oxygen mask box. The mask
box contains four oxygen masks and a door latch actuator.

Each lavatory and attendant's oxygen mask box contains a chemical oxygen generator, two oxygen masks and a
door latch actuator.

Chemical oxygen generators are used to supply oxygen to each passenger and attendant. Oxygen flow to the
masks is started when the mask is pulled downward. This causes the chemical oxygen generator to start a
chemical reaction one product of which is oxygen.

Mask deployment occurs automatically by an altitude pressure switch when cabin pressure decreases to that
equal to an altitude of 14,000 feet. The pressure switch energizes the door latch actuator which causes the
mask box door to open and the masks to fall free. Mask deployment can also occur manually by moving the
passenger oxygen switch on the aft overhead panel to ON.

Mask deployment (automatic or manual) energizes the R324 oxygen indicator relay. This relay supplies a
ground for the PASS OXY ON light on the aft overhead panel, the OVERHEAD annunciator light on the P7 light
shield, the passenger address emergency announcement, emergency signs, and cabin interior lights. This
causes these lights and the emergency signs to come ON, and the emergency announcement to be broadcast.

ATA-35 Page 14 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-35 Page 15


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Chemical Oxygen Generator

The generator supplies gaseous oxygen to the oxygen masks by rapid thermal decomposition of sodium
chlorate and iron into salt, iron oxide, and oxygen.

The generator has a release pin which holds a cocked firing pin in position. Each oxygen mask lanyard in a
mask box is attached to a common release cable. The release cable is attached to the release pin. When any
mask lanyard is pulled, the firing pin is released and strikes the primer. This starts the chemical reaction in
the generator. Once started, the reaction cannot be stopped until all of the chemicals have been used. A color
band that is sensitive to heat is installed around the oxygen generator. The chemical reaction that occurs
when the generator is fired gives off heat and turns the color of the band black. A black band is an indication
that the generator has fired and the generator must be replaced.

A filter removes all unwanted elements of the chemical reaction. A relief valve vents pressure above 90 PSI.
Oxygen flows through the filter and manifold to the mask.

Each oxygen generator in the passenger service unit has a single oxygen outlet which is connected to the
manifold of the oxygen supply line for that passenger service unit. The generator is installed adjacent to the
mask box in the service unit.

Each chemical oxygen generator in the attendant's and lavatory mask boxes has two oxygen outlets to which
the oxygen masks are directly connected. A generator is installed inside each lavatory and attendant's mask
box.

GENERATOR RELIEF
CORE FILTER VALVE
FIRING
PIN
RELEASE
PIN

RELEASE
CABLE TO OXYGEN
MASK

ATA-35 Page 16 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Passenger Oxygen Mask

The passenger oxygen mask assembly is a continuous flow unit of cup-shaped design with an oronasal type
mask. A reservoir bag with a capacity of one liter is attached to the face piece with a check valve at the mask.
The mask is designed to conform to facial contours and may be held in position with an elastic head strap.

Each oxygen mask in the passenger service unit is connected to a common manifold in the oxygen supply line.
The supply line manifold is connected to a generator outlet nozzle.

Each attendant and lavatory mask is connected directly to the generator outlet nozzle.

CHEMICAL
RELEASE
OXYGEN GENERATOR
CABLE
SEE C

MASK BOX DOOR MASK


(OPEN POSITION) LANYARD

NOTE: PULL THE MASK LANYARD. THIS REMOVES


____
THE RELEASE PIN FROM THE FIRING PIN.
THE GENERATOR CORE IGNITES AND
PRODUCES OXYGEN.

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-35 Page 17


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Door Latch Actuator

Each oxygen mask box has a door latch actuator. The actuator has a solenoid switch with a plunger.

When the passenger oxygen system is actuated either automatically or manually, the solenoid is energized.
This causes the plunger to strike the latch lever. This action releases the mask box door and the masks fall
free. After operation, the actuator must be reset by pushing upwards on the test stop button.

During normal flight conditions, the solenoid is not energized and springs hold the latches in the latched
position. This keeps the mask box door open. The masks are held in the stored position by the latched door.

The door latch can be operated manually for maintenance access. A latch actuation tab that is normally
hidden from view is installed adjacent to the test stop button.

Mask box doors in the passenger service unit and at the attendants’ stations are manually opened. A 0.125-
inch pin punch is inserted into the hole adjacent to the test stop button. The pin punch is then pushed to
operate the door latch.

Mask box doors in the lavatory are manually opened by the insertion of a thin flat tool into the gap between
the mask box door and the ceiling panel (adjacent to test stop button). The thin flat tool is then pushed to
operate the door latch.

ATA-35 Page 18 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-35 Page 19


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

ATA-35 Page 20 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

PORTABLE OXYGEN EQUIPMENT


Overview

Oxygen for First Aid and sustaining purposes is kept in portable oxygen cylinders. These cylinders are
installed at easily reached locations throughout the airplane.

There are two types of portable oxygen cylinders, those with a demand regulator and those without a demand
regulator. The basic cylinder assembly contains these parts: high pressure oxygen cylinder, constant flow
pressure regulator, ON-OFF valve, relief valve, safety plug, charging valve, outlet assemblies, and pressure
gage. A demand-type mask can be attached to cylinders with a demand regulator.

The pressure gage shows the oxygen pressure in the cylinder and thereby the quantity of oxygen available.
Cylinder pressure should be 1800 PSIG at 70°F. The safety plug contains a fusible alloy which melts in case
of too much heat. This permits the cylinder to vent into the atmosphere. The ON-OFF valve controls the flow
of high pressure oxygen into the pressure regulator.

The pressure regulator contains a pressure reducing mechanism which reduces the oxygen pressure before it
is supplied to the outlet assembly or the demand regulator. The oxygen pressure is reduced because low
pressure oxygen is required for the masks. The pressure regulator also has a recharging valve assembly
which permits the cylinder to be refilled.

An oxygen mask and hose is attached to each portable oxygen cylinder assembly. In order to use, the hose
must be connected to the oxygen outlet on the cylinder.

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-35 Page 21


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

 
POSSIBLE PLACEMENT OF OXYGEN CYLINDERS IN THE CABIN

ATA-35 Page 22 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-35 Page 23


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

 
TABLE OF CONTENTS
B737-300/400/500 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION SELF-PACED
ATA-36

PNEUMATIC SYSTEM ......................................................................................................................................... 3


Overview..................................................................................................................................................... 3
ENGINE BLEED & AIR DISTRIBUTION SYSTEM ................................................................................................. 7
Overview..................................................................................................................................................... 7
Pneumatic Manifold.................................................................................................................................. 10
5th-Stage Bleed Air Check Valve .............................................................................................................. 12
Pressure Regulator and Shutoff Valve ...................................................................................................... 14
Bleed Air Regulator .................................................................................................................................. 16
450°F Thermostat..................................................................................................................................... 17
High Stage Valve ...................................................................................................................................... 18
High Stage Regulator................................................................................................................................ 20
Pneumatic Ground Service Connection ..................................................................................................... 21
APU Check Valve ...................................................................................................................................... 22
APU Bleed Air (Shutoff) Valve.................................................................................................................. 22
APU Pressure Relief Valve........................................................................................................................ 22
Bleed Air Isolation Valve .......................................................................................................................... 24
Dual Bleed Light....................................................................................................................................... 25
BLEED AIR PRECOOLER SYSTEM..................................................................................................................... 26
Overview................................................................................................................................................... 26
Precooler Control Valve ............................................................................................................................ 28
Precooler Control Valve Sensor ................................................................................................................ 29
ENGINE BLEED PRESSURE INDICATING SYSTEM ............................................................................................ 30
Overview................................................................................................................................................... 30

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-36 Page 1


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

ATA-36 Page 2 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

PNEUMATIC SYSTEM
Overview

The purpose of the pneumatic system is to supply bleed air from the 5th and 9th stage of the engine
compressor or from the APU or from a ground cart. Air is distributed by a pneumatic manifold from the above
sources to the air conditioning packs, wing and cowl Thermal Anti-Ice (TAI) systems, the engine starting
system, potable water system and the hydraulic reservoir. The systems using air from the pneumatic manifold
are covered in their respective chapters.

The main supply of bleed air to the manifold is obtained from the engine 5th stage compressor. 5th stage air
is supplied to the pneumatic manifold at all times except at engine idle or at low engine thrust settings. When
this occurs 9th stage bleed air is automatically used. Air from the 5th and 9th stage bleed ports is controlled
by the engine bleed control system. APU bleed air or pneumatic ground cart bleed air is primarily used for
engine starting and for air conditioning pack operation on the ground. The APU can be used as an alternate
bleed air source up to airplane altitudes of 17,000 ft.

The pneumatic manifold interconnects the engine bleed system and APU and distributes bleed air to the
systems. The pneumatic manifold contains the necessary valves to shut off bleed air at each engine, APU and
to isolate the left and right hand systems.

Each engine bleed system contains a bleed air temperature control sub-system. This consists of a precooler,
precooler control valve and precooler control valve sensor. The engine bleed air temperature is automatically
controlled to a preset temperature whenever the engine is operating and the Pressure Regulator and Shutoff
Valve (PRSOV) is open. The temperature is sensed in the precooler bleed air discharge. The sensor will cause
the precooler control valve to modulate open/closed as required to maintain this temperature. Engine fan air
is used as the heat sink for the bleed air.

Two pressure transmitters are provided for pressure indication of the bleed air. One transmitter is used for
each engine. Both pressure transmitters are connected to a dual pressure indicator on the overhead panel.
The engine bleed air overtemperature indication consists of overtemperature switches located in the ducting
system, which are connected to the overhead panel trip lights. The temperature switches illuminate the trip
lights and the corresponding engine PRSOV closes when the bleed air temperature exceeds approximately
490°F. Also, the bleed trip light will illuminate if there is excessive pressure at the bleed valve inlet.

The engine bleed air is used to aspirate the total air temperature (TAT) probe when the airplane is on the
ground or in flight with the flaps extended. The aspirator causes airflow past the sensing element to provide
reliable temperature indication during ground operation. The aspirated TAT probe compensates for the
heating effects of bright sunlight or hot ramp heat radiation. TAT probe deicing is provided by a hermetically
sealed, coaxial type electrical heating element. Pneumatic system air for TAT probe aspiration is bled off
downstream of the turbofan control valve. Make sure the valves are installed downstream of each turbofan
drive air duct to prevent bleed air loss through a non-operating turbofan.

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-36 Page 3


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

 
Overview (Continued):

The high-stage manifold duct on the engine has a bleed air pressure tap provision to supply pneumatic
pressure to airplanes equipped with potable water engine pressurization system.

On airplanes with potable water engine pressurization system, make sure that the potable water pressure line
is connected to the pressure tap on engine 1.

On airplanes without potable water engine pressurization system, make sure that the pressure tap provision on
the replacement engines is sealed.

APU

PRESSURE
RELIEF VALVE

FLOW CONTROL
AND SHUTOFF
WING VALVE APU
ANTI-ICE
CHECK
VALVE
VALVE APU BLEED
VALVE

PNEUMATIC
GROUND SERVICE
CONNECTION

ISOLATION WING ANTI-ICE


VALVE VALVE

ATA-36 Page 4 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE

 
 
 
 

DUAL RAM DOOR RAM DOOR


BLEED FULL OPEN FULL OPEN

L RECIRC FAN R RECIRC FAN


OFF OFF

AUTO
AUTO
2
40 60
OVHT
80
PSI
0 100
TEST

L PACK ISOLATION R PACK


OFF VALVE OFF
AUTO CLOSE AUTO
HIGH AUTO HIGH

WING WING
TO CABIN TEMPERATURE CONTROL VALVES AND
PACK PACK

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


ANTI OPEN ANTI PRIMARY HEAT EXCHANGERS
TRIP OFF TRIP OFF
ICE ICE
WING-BODY TRIP WING-BODY
OVERHEAT OVERHEAT
BLEED BLEED APU
TRIP OFF TRIP OFF
RESET

OFF OFF

ON ON APU BLEED
1 APU 2
BLEED AIR VALVE
PACK FLOW PACK FLOW
AUTO OFF SCHED
STANDBY MANUAL CONTROL AND CONTROL AND
FAIL DESCENT
SHUTOFF VALVE RELIEF SHUTOFF VALVE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource

P5-10 AIR CONDITIONING MODULE VALVE

GROUND WTAI APU BLEED GROUND WTAI


SOLENOID VALVE AIR CHECK SOLENOID VALVE
VALVE PRECOOLER
PRECOOLER
CONTROL
CONTROL TO TURBOFAN TO TURBOFAN VALVE
VALVE CONTROL VALVE CONTROL VALVE

FAN TO WING TO WING FAN


HYDRAULIC
TAI VALVE TAI VALVE
TO COWL RESERVOIR TO COWL
TAI VALVE PRESSURE TAP TAI VALVE
PRECOOLER PRECOOLER
BLEED AIR 490° F CONTROL PNEUMATIC PNEUMATIC CONTROL 490° F BLEED AIR
POTABLE

FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY


5TH- CHECK VALVE PRESSURE OVERHEAT VALVE PRESSURE PRESSURE VALVE OVERHEAT PRESSURE CHECK VALVE 5TH-
REGULATOR AND SWITCH SENSOR WATER TAP REGULATOR AND
STAGE TRANSMITTER TRANSMITTER SENSOR SWITCH STAGE
SHUTOFF VALVE SHUTOFF VALVE

PRE- PRE-
9TH- 450° F BLEED AIR 450° F 9TH-
COOLER COOLER
STAGE THERMOSTAT ISOLATION THERMOSTAT STAGE
VALVE
BLEED AIR GROUND
HYDRAULIC BLEED AIR
HIGH-STAGE REGULATOR PNEUMATIC HIGH-STAGE
RESERVOIR REGULATOR
ENGINE 1 REGULATOR CONNECTION REGULATOR ENGINE 2
ENGINE PRESSURE TAP ENGINE
START START
TO POTABLE HIGH-STAGE ENGINE
ENGINE SYSTEM SYSTEM
WATER SYSTEM VALVE CORE HIGH-STAGE
CORE
1 CAVITY VALVE
CAVITY LEGEND
HOT BLEED AIR
COLD AIR

1 AIRPLANES AFTER LINE NO. 1527. DISCHARGE AIR

2 737-400 ONLY PRECOOLED AIR

ATA-36 Page 5
and Systems Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

ATA-36 Page 6 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

ENGINE BLEED & AIR DISTRIBUTION SYSTEM


Overview

The engine bleed air distribution system is a manifold of ducts and valves which carries hot compressed air
from the engine compressor to the air conditioning packs and to the air-dependent units and subsystems in
other systems. Air source, pressure, and temperature controlling components are part of the system. Ducts
from the engines pass through control components and join the respective left or right wing manifolds. A
crossover duct, forward and below the center wing section front spar joins the left and right wing manifold
sections to form the complete cross-ship pneumatic manifold. The air control components connecting the
pneumatic manifold to related systems are covered as part of the systems they serve.

The primary supply of pneumatic air is from the mid (5th) compressor stage of each engine, through a check
valve. When 5th-stage bleed air pressure is not high enough, high (9th) stage bleed air is used. Switching
from mid to high stage bleed on each engine is controlled automatically by the high stage valve and regulator.
The pressure regulating and shutoff valve (PRSOV) controls the pressure of air supplied to the precooler within
the range of 34 and 50 PSIG. The high stage air is controlled to within the range between 25 and 33 psig (25
and 35 PSIG on airplanes with improved regulators) by the high stage regulator. Air from either stage is
routed through a precooler on each engine before entering the pneumatic manifold. The precooler control
valve, controlled by a downstream temperature sensor, regulates manifold air temperature by controlling the
amount of fan air flow through the precooler.

The pneumatic manifold is separated into left and right sections by an isolation valve. A center section
contains the APU duct. Flow of APU air into the center section is controlled by the APU bleed air valve. A
ground service pneumatic connector is in the right section. Ground pneumatic sources bypass the pressure
regulating valve and must have pressure regulation equipment.

Switches on the pilot's forward overhead panel control solenoids in the pneumatically operated bleed air
regulators and APU bleed air valve. The engine fire switches, when actuated, cause the regulators and valve
to close.

Normally the APU check valve prevents engine bleed pressure from backing into the APU bleed system.
Should the check valve fail open, with the APU bleed valve open, engine bleed pressure could be detrimental
to the APU. The DUAL BLEED light on the overhead panel illuminates when the APU bleed valve is open and
either Engine No. 1 PRSOV or Engine No. 2 PRSOV and isolation valve are open. The light would be on during
an APU engine start. After engine start and the APU bleed valve switch is placed to OFF, the light goes out
indicating that the APU bleed valve has closed.

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-36 Page 7


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Overview (Continued):

The pneumatic system is used to start the engines on the airplane. Bleed air from a pneumatic source flows
in the reverse direction through the pneumatic system to the engine start system.

The bleed air is diverted to the engine start system by the pressure regulating and shutoff valve (PRSOV).
Each engine uses a bleed air regulator to pneumatically control the PRSOV. The bleed air regulator eliminates
the control pressure to the PRSOV actuator which ensures the PRSOV will remain closed during starting.

PRECOOLER CONTROL
VALVE SENSOR
450°F
PRECOOLER THERMOSTAT
CONTROL VALVE

5TH-STAGE
BLEED AIR
TO TO WING
CHECK VALVE
STARTER PNEUMATIC DUCT

PRECOOLER

5TH-STAGE 9TH-STAGE
FWD MANIFOLD MANIFOLD
PRESSURE REGULATOR
AND SHUTOFF VALVE
(PRSOV)

LEFT VIEW

ATA-36 Page 8 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

PRECOOLER CONTROL
VALVE SENSOR
PRESSURE
490°F
450°F THERMOSTAT REGULATOR
OVERHEAT
AND SHUTOFF
SWITCH
VALVE (PRSOV) HIGH-
STAGE
REGULATOR

9TH-STAGE
FWD MANIFOLD HIGH
STAGE BLEED AIR
VALVE REGULATOR

RIGHT VIEW

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-36 Page 9


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Pneumatic Manifold

The pneumatic distribution system connects air supply sources from the APU, engines, and ground air source
to user systems through the pneumatic manifold system and their appropriate control valves. The pneumatic
manifold system extends from the engine at one wing to the crossover duct in the air conditioning bay below
the center wing section to the other engine at the opposite wing. An electrically actuated isolation valve in the
crossover duct separates the left and right side system. The APU bleed air duct is connected to the crossover
duct on the left side of the isolation valve and the pneumatic ground service connection is connected to the
crossover duct on the right side of the isolation valve.

From the engine, bleed air source is ducted primarily from the 5th-stage port where it passes through the 5th-
stage check valve before it is ducted together with the 9th-stage (high pressure) duct. Air for nose cowl
thermal anti-ice (TAI) is tapped off downstream of the 5th-stage check valve. Bleed air from the 9th-stage
ports are ducted through the 9th-stage manifold and high stage valve before it is joined together with the 5th-
stage duct. The air is then ducted through the PRSOV to regulate the pressure and the precooler heat
exchanger to regulate the temperature before it is discharged into the strut duct. The strut duct is connected
to the engine starter duct and to the wing leading edge duct. Air for wing thermal anti-ice (TAI) is tapped off
from the wing leading edge duct through the wing thermal anti-ice valve. The left and right wing leading edge
ducts are routed inboard inside the wing leading edge fairings where the ducts are joined to the crossover duct
in the air conditioning bay.

Bleed air source can also be supplied with use of the APU. The APU bleed air duct runs under the passenger
floor from the APU along the left side of the aft cargo compartment, then inside the keel beam through the
wheel well to the air conditioning bay where it joins the crossover duct on left side of the isolation valve. The
APU bleed air (shutoff) valve, a pneumatically actuated solenoid controlled valve installed in the duct
downstream of the APU, controls the airflow from the APU. A reverse flow APU check valve installed in the
duct section downstream of the APU bleed air (shutoff) valve prevents damage to the APU compressor from
bleed air backflows from the engine(s) or ground air source. A pressure relief valve is installed in the duct
section between the APU bleed air valve and APU check valve to relief excess pressure in the pneumatic
manifold.

A three-inch diameter tap with an integral check valve for pneumatic ground service connection is installed on
the right side of the crossover duct to allow system pressurization from an external ground air source.

There are two duct pressure transmitters installed in the crossover duct to monitor duct pressure on either
side of the isolation valve.

The pneumatic manifold serves as the central reservoir for the supply of pressurized air for air conditioning,
hydraulic system pressurization, water tank pressurization, turbofans and TAT probe aspiration through their
applicable control valves from pressure taps in the pneumatic duct.

ATA-36 Page 10 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

DUCT PRESSURE DUCT PRESSURE


TRANSMITTER TRANSMITTER
HYDRAULIC
SYSTEM PNEUMATIC
PRESSURIZATION GROUND
WING SERVICE
ANTI-ICE ISOLATION CONNECTION
VALVE VALVE

TO
LEADING
EDGE
RIGHT
SLATS
TURBOFAN
VALVE
450°F
PRECOOLER
THERMOSTAT
CONTROL
VALVE SENSOR
TO PRECOOLER
PRECOOLER CONTROL VALVE 490°F
STARTER
OVERTEMP
SWITCH

FAN FAN

LEFT RIGHT
1 5TH- PACK 5TH- 1
STAGE PACK STAGE
VALVE VALVE

9TH- 9TH-
STAGE STAGE

HIGH POTABLE WATER


STAGE SYSTEM 5TH-STAGE
PRESSURE
VALVE PRESSURIZATION BLEED AIR
REGULATOR
LEFT CHECK VALVE
AND SHUTOFF
TURBOFAN
VALVE (PRSOV)
VALVE HYDRAULIC
SYSTEM
APU PRESSURIZATION
CHECK
ENGINE 1 VALVE ENGINE 2

APU
1 TO NOSE COWL TAI BLEED
PRESSURE
VALVE
RELIEF
VALVE

FROM APU

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-36 Page 11


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

5th-Stage Bleed Air Check Valve

The 5th-stage bleed air check valve is installed in the 5th-stage bleed air duct to prevent bleed air return to
the 5th-stage engine compressor.

The check valve has two semi-circular flappers which are hinged about a pin that runs through the center of
the valve body. The check valve flappers and pin are assembled into a one-piece valve body cast. The valve
body is flanged to mate with the pneumatic duct. The arrow markers on the side of the valve show the airflow
direction through the valve.

SEE A
PRSOV REGULATOR AND
PRECOOLER CONTROL
VALVE SUPPLY LINE

NOSE COWL
ANTI-ICE DUCT

5TH-STAGE
BLEED AIR
CHECK VALVE

FWD
A

ATA-36 Page 12 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-36 Page 13


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Pressure Regulator and Shutoff Valve

The pressure regulator and shutoff valve (PRSOV) is a pneumatically actuated, spring loaded closed, butterfly
type valve. The valve, in conjunction with a remotely mounted bleed air regulator, provides pneumatic signals
to open, close, and regulate pressure for downstream bleed air.

The valve consists basically of an actuator, manual override with closed position lock, and flow body with a
butterfly plate.

The valve may be manually locked in closed position by rotating the manual wrenching hex (butterfly shaft) so
that the lock screw/position indicator aligns with closed position, loosening lock screw/position indicator and
then sliding the detented locking knob into the recess in the retainer plate. The manual lock is retained in the
override position by retightening the lock screw/position indicator. Also the valve may be unlocked by
loosening the lock screw/position indicator, centering detented locking knob in the retainer plate, sliding
detented locking knob out of the recess in the retainer plate, and then retightening the lock screw/position
indicator.

ATA-36 Page 14 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-36 Page 15


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Bleed Air Regulator

The bleed air regulator is a pneumatic controller designed to provide regulated control pressure, with
electrically controlled shutoff, from a bleed air source. Other functions incorporated are electrical indication of
excessive bleed air supply pressure, automatic electrical shutoff of regulated control pressure in the event that
downstream pressure exceeds bleed air supply pressure, and a relief valve to maintain regulation of control
pressure in the event of pressure regulator failure.

The bleed air regulator contains a pneumatic pressure switch, reference pressure regulator, reverse flow
switch assembly, relief valve assembly, and solenoid valve assembly mounted in or on a metal housing.

ATA-36 Page 16 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

450°F Thermostat

The thermostat is located downstream of the precooler and precooler control valve sensor. The purpose of the
thermostat is to control the PRSOV position above 450°F air temperature. The sensor is a bleed-off pneumatic
thermostat which provides a pneumatic output signal that varies inversely with the sensed temperature. As
sensed temperature increases, the result is a closing of the PRSOV. As the sensed temperature decreases
below 450ºF, the PRSOV will begin to open.
SEE A

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-36 Page 17


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

High Stage Valve

The high stage valve is a pneumatically actuated, spring-loaded closed, butterfly type valve used with the high
stage regulator.

The high stage valve has two major components, a valve body assembly and a pneumatic actuator assembly.

The position indicator and manual override mechanism are mounted on the bottom of the valve body.

A relief valve assembly is installed in the downstream port.

The valve may be manually locked in the closed position by loosening the position indicator/retaining screw
and sliding the lock up into the recess in the cover plate. Retightening the position indicator/retaining screw
will hold the lock in position.

The valve is unlocked by loosening the position indicator/retaining screw, sliding the lock down the shaft until
contact is made with the top pin, and retightening the position indicator/retaining screw.

The relief valve assembly is provided to relieve excess downstream pressure caused by normal port leakage
past the closed butterfly plate when no consumption of air exists downstream. The relief valve assembly may
be removed to expose a test port.

ATA-36 Page 18 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-36 Page 19


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

High Stage Regulator

The high stage regulator is a device that functions to provide for regulation and shutoff of the high stage valve.

The high stage regulator includes a reference pressure regulator, reverse flow check mechanism, pneumatic
shutoff, and a relief valve assembly.

A relief valve assembly provides pressure regulation in the event of a reference pressure regulator failure.

ATA-36 Page 20 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Pneumatic Ground Service Connection

A pneumatic ground service connection is provided to allow pressurization of the pneumatic manifold by
ground service carts. The connection is accessible through a hinged panel on the underside of the fuselage.
The pressurized air supplied through this connection can be used for engine starts, the air conditioning system
and other user systems. The connection also includes a check valve to prevent excessive pneumatic system
leakage or reverse flow into the ground air source.

Before air is supplied, the battery switch must be selected ON and the air conditioning pack valves selected
OFF. AC power must be available for air conditioning use. The maximum pressure and temperature of the air
supply provided to the ground service connection must not exceed 60 PSI and 450°F, respectively.

The check valve installed inside the connector housing prevents loss of pressurized air through the connector
during operation of the airplane pneumatic system. Caution must be used in the removal and replacement of
connector so that the two gaskets are not damaged or misaligned during operation.

SEE A

DUCT

BOLT SEE B
(EXAMPLE)

FWD
GASKET NO. 1

A
BRACKET

GASKET NO. 2

CONNECTOR
NUT CONNECTOR
SEE C

PNEUMATIC GROUND
SERVICE CONNECTION
_A
W _R
_N_I
_N_SWITCH
_!
G
BATTERY PWR. ON AND
SWITCH AIR COND. PACKS
OFF BEFORE SUPPLYING
AIR. LATCH

PNEUMATIC GROUND
SERVICE CONNECTOR
_A
C _U
_T_I
_O_N
_ ACCESS DOOR
MAX. AIR PRESS: 60 PSIG
MAX. AIR TEMP : 450°F SEE D
LATCH
FWD
D B

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-36 Page 21


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

APU Check Valve

A check valve is installed in the APU bleed air duct just downstream of the APU bleed air valve. The check
valve prevents backflow of air from the pneumatic crossover duct to the APU.

APU Bleed Air (Shutoff) Valve

The APU bleed air valve is a modulating valve that is used to control bleed air flow from the APU to the
airplane pneumatic system. The valve is located at the bleed air duct on the aft side of the APU compartment
forward bulkhead. The pneumatically operated solenoid-controlled valve is controlled by a switch on the
pilot's forward overhead panel.

When the APU is in operation at or above 95 percent, APU bleed air can be obtained with the APU bleed switch
put to the ON position. The air from the APU is automatically regulated by APU components and by APU bleed
valve modulation. This is to make sure that maximum APU bleed air is available without overloading the APU.
A pressure relief valve provides safety relief at 80 PSI.

APU Pressure Relief Valve

The APU pressure relief valve is a spring loaded closed, bleed-off type regulator, which contain a poppet valve,
valve seat, and spring. Its purpose is to vent off excess pressure in the pneumatic duct to prevent an
overpressure condition which can cause the ducting to rupture. The relief valve is mounted to a boss on the
APU pneumatic duct in the tail compartment and is set to relieve at approximately 80 PSIG. The pressure
relief valve can be accessed through the stabilizer trim access door.

ATA-36 Page 22 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

APU CHECK
VALVE
APU MANIFOLD
DUCT

APU CHECK
VALVE
SEE A
SEE B

FWD
V-BAND CLAMP HINGE PIN
(2 LOCATIONS) BOSS

APU PRESSURE
RELIEF VALVE

PACKING RING
LOCKWIRE

MOUNTING BOSS

APU PRESSURE
RELIEF
VALVE
SEE C

APU MANIFOLD
DUCT

APU BLEED INBD


AIR (SHUTOFF)
VALVE
FWD FWD
C
B

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-36 Page 23


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Bleed Air Isolation Valve

The bleed air isolation valve is installed in the center of the crossover duct to separate the left and right
pneumatic systems or to connect them when necessary. The isolation valve is a 115-volt, single-phase, motor-
operated butterfly valve. The valve normally stays closed unless a cross-feed of bleed air is necessary.

The valve is controlled by a three-position (OPEN-AUTO-CLOSE) switch on the P5 panel. It is connected


electrically through the left and right pack switches and also through the No. 1 and No. 2 engine bleed
switches.

With the isolation valve switch in AUTO, engine bleed switches ON and pack switches in AUTO or HIGH, the
isolation valve will stay closed. If any of the four switches is put to the OFF position, power is transferred to
turn open the isolation valve. This operation must be manually performed as the circuit passes through the
switch, not the affected valve.

The other two positions, OPEN and CLOSE, function as a conventional switch regardless of pack and bleed
switch positions.

ISOLATION
ELECTRICAL VALVE
CONNECTOR, ACTUATOR
D398

ISOLATION VALVE
SEE A
OVERHEAT
DETECTOR
LOOP

CROSSOVER
BONDING FWD
ISOLATION DUCT
WIRE
KEEL BEAM VALVE
STRUCTURE

ATA-36 Page 24 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Dual Bleed Light

The DUAL BLEED light on the P5 pilot's overhead panel indicates that the pneumatic system is pressurized by
engine(s) and APU at the same time.

The DUAL BLEED light circuit is completed by a combination of Engine No. 1 bleed switch ON and the APU
bleed valve open. A combination of Engine No. 2 bleed switch ON, isolation valve open, and APU bleed valve
open will also complete the circuit.

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-36 Page 25


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

BLEED AIR PRECOOLER SYSTEM


Overview

The purpose of the bleed air precooler system is to control the temperature of the high pressure bleed air
which is supplied to the manifold system to approximately 415°F. Two precooler systems are provided, one
for engine No. 1 and one for engine No. 2. Each precooler system consists of an air-to-air heat exchanger,
four-inch-diameter precooler control valve, a precooler control valve sensor and a solenoid valve installed in
the sense line between the valve and sensor.

CLOSED TO BLEED
AIR REGULATOR

OPEN

FAN
PRECOOLER CONTROL VALVE

PRSOV
5TH-
STAGE
5TH-STAGE BLEED
AIR CHECK VALVE PRECOOLER
TO COWL PRECOOLER
9TH-
ANTI-ICE CONTROL VALVE
STAGE
SENSOR
OVERBOARD (390-440°F/
199-227°C)
TO STARTER
490°F/254°C
OVERHEAT
SWITCH

HIGH-STAGE
VALVE

ATA-36 Page 26 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Precooler

The precooler is an air-to-air heat exchanger located at top right center of each engine and is of the plate-fin
single pass crossflow type. The heat collected from the hot air ducted from the engine is absorbed by the cool
air ducted from the engine fan after passing through the precooler control valve. The cooling air is then
discharged overboard.

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-36 Page 27


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Precooler Control Valve

The precooler valve is attached to the discharge port of the engine fan. The purpose of the valve is to control
the flow of cooling air through the heat exchanger to regulate the temperature of the bleed air. This is a
pneumatically actuated, temperature controlled, spring loaded open butterfly modulating valve. A remote
pneumatic temperature sensor is used to produce a valve position that is proportional to the sensed
temperature. The valve is closed at low sensed temperature and open at high sensed temperatures.
PRECOOLER
PRECOOLER CONTROL VALVE
(REF) SEE A

THRUST
LINK

FWD

ATA-36 Page 28 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Precooler Control Valve Sensor

The sensor is located downstream of the precooler. The purpose of the sensor is to control the precooler
control valve butterfly position. The sensor is a bleed-off pneumatic thermostat which provides a pneumatic
output signal that varies inversely with the sensed temperature. Therefore, the metering valve is modulated to
provide a discrete output signal pressure for each sensed temperature which in turn modulates the precooler
valve open and closed.

SEE A

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-36 Page 29


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

ENGINE BLEED PRESSURE INDICATING SYSTEM


Overview

A pressure indication system, consisting of two transmitters and a dual pressure indicator, is provided for the
pressure indication of the engine bleed system. Each transmitter is connected to a sensing line which is
connected to the pneumatic manifold downstream from the bleed air heat exchanger. Both transmitters are
electrically connected to the dual pressure indicator on the overhead panel which has two pointers marked L
and R for the left and right system respectively. One transmitter is sensing engine No. 1 bleed air pressure
and the other senses engine No. 2 bleed air pressure.

Each transmitter has two ports. One port is for the pressure sensing line from the pneumatic manifold and
the other port is the vent to ambient. Next to the ports there is a zero set hex nut. The zero set hex nut is
used to adjust the transmitter to obtain a zero indication on the indicator with no pressure in the ducts.

ATA-36 Page 30 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

SEE A

SEE B

FWD

DUCT PRESSURE
DUCT PRESSURE
TRANSMITTER
TRANSMITTER SHOCK
SHOCK
MOUNT
MOUNT
AMBIENT
AMBIENT
VENT
VENT
ZERO RESET
ZERO RESET
ADJUSTMENT CAP
ADJUSTMENT CAP
PRESSURE
PRESSURE SENSING LINE
SENSING LINE
DRAIN PLUG
DRAIN PLUG

737-300/-500 INBD FWD 737-400

B
NOTE: RIGHT INSTALLATION IS SHOWN,
____
LEFT INSTALLATION IS EQUIVALENT.

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-36 Page 31


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

 
TABLE OF CONTENTS
B737-300/400/500 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION SELF-PACED
ATA-38

WATER AND WASTE ........................................................................................................................................... 3


Overview..................................................................................................................................................... 3
POTABLE WATER SYSTEM................................................................................................................................. 4
Overview..................................................................................................................................................... 4
Water Tank................................................................................................................................................. 6
Service Panel.............................................................................................................................................. 7
Fill and Overflow Valve............................................................................................................................... 8
Water Tank Drain Valve.............................................................................................................................. 9
Lavatory Drain Valve................................................................................................................................. 10
Lavatory Washbasin Faucet ...................................................................................................................... 11
Water Heaters........................................................................................................................................... 12
Water Quantity Transmitter ...................................................................................................................... 13
Water Quantity Indicator........................................................................................................................... 14
WATER TANK PRESSURIZATION SYSTEM ....................................................................................................... 15
Overview................................................................................................................................................... 15
Air Compressor ........................................................................................................................................ 16
Pressure Regulator ................................................................................................................................... 17
Air Filter................................................................................................................................................... 18
Pressure Relief Valve................................................................................................................................ 19
Pressure Switch ....................................................................................................................................... 20
WASTE WATER SYSTEM .................................................................................................................................. 21
Overview................................................................................................................................................... 21
TOILET SYSTEM............................................................................................................................................... 23
Overview................................................................................................................................................... 23
Toilet Tank Shroud Assemblies ............................................................................................................... 26
Toilet Flushing Components ..................................................................................................................... 27
Toilet Flush Motor-Pump-Filter Assembly................................................................................................ 28
Toilet Waste Tank .................................................................................................................................... 30
Toilet Service Panels................................................................................................................................ 32

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-38 Page 1


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

ATA-38 Page 2 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

WATER AND WASTE


Overview

The water and waste system is composed of four independent but related systems. The passenger water
system stores, delivers, monitors and controls drinkable (potable) water for the galley units and lavatory sink
basins. This system contains electric water heaters that heat the water supplied to the hot water taps in the
lavatory sinks. The water tank pressurization system causes the passenger water to be evenly pressurized at
all times. The toilet system provides sanitary toilets in the lavatory compartments and a means to dispose of
toilet waste. The waste water system disposes of waste water.

AIR
SOURCE WATER PRESSURIZATION SYSTEM

WATER
SERVICE PASSENGER WATER SYSTEM
PANEL

LAVATORY COMPT GALLEY UNIT

GALLEY
LAVATORY LAVATORY SINK DRAINS
SINK FLOOR
DRAINS DRAINS

WASTE WATER SYSTEM TOILET SYSTEM

TOILET
DRAIN SERVICE
MAST PANEL

AIR

FRESH WATER

WASTE

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-38 Page 3


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

POTABLE WATER SYSTEM


Overview

The passenger water system has a water tank which stores fresh water. The system supplies water to the
galley units and lavatory washbasins.

The storage and distribution components of the passenger water system, store, pressurize, distribute, and
drain fresh water. The potable water tank is in the compartment aft of the bulk cargo compartment.

Each lavatory has a drain valve located below the cylindrical water heater in the lower part of the sink cabinet.
The drain valve controls potable water drainage and supply in the lavatory compartment. The lavatory
washbasins each have a faucet with hot and cold water. The faucets are self-venting. This allows automatic
bleeding of air from the system, and allows draining the system without opening the faucet.

On some airplanes a secondary drain valve is fitted to prevent overboard discharge of water during flight when
the valve is inadvertently moved to the drain position.

Most of the water distribution system is flexible Teflon hose with reinforced fiber covering. Metal fittings and
connectors are used at junctions and line replaceable units. Distribution lines route from below the water tank
to above the cabin ceiling and enter galleys and lavatories from above.

Each lavatory has a water heater in the supply line to the washbasin faucet.

The passenger water system quantity indicator shows the flight crew the amount of water in the passenger
water tank. The water quantity transmitter sends quantity signals to the water quantity indicator.

The passenger water tank is normally pressurized by engine bleed air taken from the pneumatic manifold
which pressurizes the APU manifold to move fresh water from the water tank to the lavatories and galleys. An
air compressor augments normal pressurization when pressure within the tank is below 18 PSI. The water
tank pressurization system includes the compressor, pressure switch, check valves, air filter, pressure
regulator, and pressure relief valve.

Operation of the potable water system is automatic and requires no action by the crew other than manually
resetting the lavatory water heater overheat switches.

ATA-38 Page 4 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE

 
B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization

AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource


 

 
 
28V DC
BUS 1
C138 WATER QTY IND FAUCET WITH
115V AC MECHANICAL LAV
BUS 1 TIMER DRAIN
C105 LAVATORY WATER SAME AS
HEATER - R AFT M91 AFT GALLEY FWD GALLEY VALVE
115V AC THERMOSTAT
BUS 2 M92 R AFT LAV
C106 LAVATORY WATER
115V AC HEATER - L AFT WATER HEATER SEE WASTE TO DRAIN
M60 R AFT LAVATORY SAMES AS WATER SYSTEM FITTING ON
BUS 1
C104 LAVATORY WATER M91 38-31-00 FUSELAGE
HEATER - FWD
M93 L AFT LAV
P18-4 CIRCUIT BREAKER PANEL P WATER HEATER MANUAL
D1990 OFF RESET
D1990 M61 L AFT LAVATORY
2
3
M753 4P
D1988
D1988 D1986 POTABLE S692 OVERHEAT SW
A2 WATER
A1 1 WATER WATER ON HEATER
115V AC B2 AIR CMPRSR PRESSURE 1/2
CONTROL
B1 2 CUTOUT SW 1/4 3/4
SWITCH
BUS 2 WATER
C2 E F CYCLING SW
C873 C1 3
X1 PUSH
POTABLE NEON LIGHT
X2 QUANTITY
WATER AIR
COMPRESSOR R184 AIR M91 FORWARD LAVATORY WATER HEATER
FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY

COMPRESSOR M59 FORWARD LAVATORY


P6-4
CONTROL RLY

RELIEF WATER HEATER OVERHEAT INDICATOR


MAGNET ELECTRICAL PRESS SWITCH LIGHT
VALVE
CONNECTOR COLD WATER TO RESET
S945 WATER PRESSURE (OPENS AT SUPPLY LINE AFTER
PROX SWITCH 50 PSI)
CONTROL SUFFICIENT
FULL FULL SWITCH COOLING
WATER HEATER
HOT WATER COVER
FILTER OVERFLOW LINE OUTLET 115V AC
PRESSURE 3/4 3/4 SEE A
PRESSURIZED REGULATOR HEATER
AIR FROM (25 PSI) CONTROL
PNEUMATIC FILL LINE 1/2 1/2 SWITCH
MANIFOLD
WATER HEATER
PRESSURE
1/4 1/4 (COVER REMOVED)
RELIEF
VALVE A
POTABLE WATER
TANK EMPTY EMPTY AIR
LAVATORY PRESSURIZATION
FILL AND PUSH DRAIN VALVE LINE
TANK QUANTITY
OVER FLOW
VALVE DRAIN INDICATION
VALVE T408 WATER QUANTITY XMTR SWITCH
SERVICE WATER HEATER
PANEL WATER QUANTITY
SKIN N17 WATER QUANTITY TRANSMITTER
POTABLE WATER
INDICATOR DRAIN LINE
(STA 975 RBL 44 WL 282)
TANK DRAIN
FILL OVERFLOW
VALVE HANDLE
FITTING LINE

AIR VALVE FILL VALVE


OVERFLOW HANDLE FILL LINE
FITTING

P25 WATER DISTRIBUTION


SERVICE PANEL LINE
POTABLE WATER
AIR PRESSURE
DRAIN LINE POTABLE WATER TANK
Potable Water System Schematic
ATA-38 Page 5

and Systems Introduction


 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Water Tank

The water tank is aft of the bulk cargo compartment on the right side of the airplane. Vertical support
members attach the tank to the fuselage frame.

The water tank is cylindrical with rounded ends. The tank is nonmetallic filament wound fiberglass. Two
bands reinforce the tank and provide mounting support.

737-400 AIRPLANES; The volume of the potable water tank is 40 gallons. The water capacity limit is 40
gallons. If the water is filled more than the capacity limit, the overflow line will remove the added water.

ALL EXCEPT 737-400 AIRPLANES; the volume of the potable water tank is 34 gallons. The water capacity
limit is 30 gallons. If the water is filled more than the capacity limit the overflow line will remove the added
water.

The water tank is protected from freezing by a 3-piece fiberglass blanket. The blanket is installed using
Velcro fasteners.

ATA-38 Page 6 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Service Panel

The passenger water system service panel is on the fuselage below the aft entry door. The service panel has
both inlet and outlet ports for the fill/overflow valve. Also on the service panel is a control handle for the
fill/overflow valve, a drain handle to operate the potable water drain valve, and a fitting for ground service air.

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-38 Page 7


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Fill and Overflow Valve

The fill/overflow valve is a four-port valve used to fill the potable water tank. The fill/overflow valve attaches
to an intercostal between floor beams to the left of the potable water tank. The fill/overflow valve handle is
on the potable water service panel. In the open or service position, the fill/overflow valve allows the potable
water tank to be filled. In the closed position, the fill/overflow valve seals the potable water tank so it can be
pressurized.

FILL AND
OVERFLOW
VALVE

SEE A
SEE B

SERVICE
PANEL FWD INBD

OUTBOARD
MOUNTING
BRACKET OUTBOARD
STOP NUT
WASHER INBOARD
MOUNTING BOLT
(2 LOCATIONS)

INBOARD
MOUNTING
BRACKET

INBOARD FILL LINE


STOP NUT

FILL AND
OVERFLOW ADAPTER
VALVE OVERFLOW
TAB
LINE
FILL LINE CONNECTING
PIN FWD INBD
ADAPTER

OVERFLOW LINE SHAFT

VALVE SHOWN IN CLOSED POSITION


B

ATA-38 Page 8 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Water Tank Drain Valve

The passenger water tank drain valve is two-port valve located behind the aft cargo compartment, below the
passenger water tank and controls draining of the passenger water tank. A drain valve control handle is
accessible on the water service panel.

SEE A

WATER TANK

ACCESS
PANEL

WATER TANK
DRAIN VALVE
SEE B

O-RING A

WATER TANK
TANK BOSS
JAMNUT

DRAIN VALVE ADAPTER

CLAMP ADAPTER MOUNTING


SCREW AND WASHER

SHAFT
COUPLING

ADAPTER SHROUD
CONNECTING
DRAIN
PIN
LINE

VALVE ACTUATOR SHAFT


(SHOWN IN THE CLOSED
POSITION)

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-38 Page 9


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Lavatory Drain Valve

One, four-port (with one port capped), manually operated drain valve is installed in the potable water supply
line located below the cylindrical water heater, inside each sink cabinet. The valve has 3 positions: SHUTOFF
or OFF, DRAIN, and SUPPLY or ON. In the SHUTOFF or OFF position, all lines are completely closed. In the
DRAIN position, all lines are completely open. In the SUPPLY or ON (normal) position, the water inlet and
outlet lines are open and the drain line is closed.

ATA-38 Page 10 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Lavatory Washbasin Faucet

Each lavatory washbasin has a mechanically timed faucet. The faucet provides warm water thru a single
spigot for 10 to 30 seconds each time the actuator is pressed. The duration of flow is adjusted by setting the
spring within the actuator. The temperature is adjusted by setting the adjustable mixing valve in the sink
cabinet. The faucets are self-venting so they need not be opened to drain the potable water system. The
washbasin is spring-loaded closed. The stopper control lever must be held open until the basin is empty. The
basin overflow drain is not stoppered.

A muffler in the overflow line quiets the sound of cabin air through the drain masts to atmosphere.

ADJUSTING SCREW
(2 LOCATIONS)

SHOULDER SCREW
(2 LOCATIONS)

CARTRIDGE O-RINGS
VALVE ASSEMBLY

ACTUATOR
DRAIN BUTTON
SILICONE SEAL

CARTRIDGE

SPIGOT

BODY
DECORATIVE COVER

SINK CABINET

Washbasin Faucet Assembly

RUMBOLD OR YRC MODULAR LAVATORIES Washbasin Faucet Assembly

TYPICAL LAVATORY

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-38 Page 11


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Water Heaters

The ON-OFF switch is normally ON. This lights the indicator light and lets the water heater cycle on and off
automatically until the switch is turned OFF.

WATER HEATERS WITH THE TEMPERATURE SELECT SWITCH; The temperature select switch is on the
bottom of the water heater. The temperature select switch adjusts the control thermostat to give water that
can be heated to one of these temperature ranges. The ranges are: 101°F to 109°F (LOW), 111°F to 119°F
(MED) and 121°F to 129°F (HIGH). If the control thermostat fails in the closed position, the overheat switch
will cut power to the heater circuit when the temperature reaches approximately 170°F.

WATER HEATERS WITHOUT THE TEMPERATURE SELECT SWITCH; The water heater will automatically
heat the water to the temperature of approximately 125°F. The control thermostat opens the heater circuit
when the temperature goes above 125°F and closes when the temperature goes below 125°F. If the control
thermostat does not open at 125°F, the overheat switch will cut power to the heater circuit when the
temperature reaches approximately 195°F.

An overheat condition requires manually resetting the overheat switch. The overheat switch is beneath the
water heater top cover. If the pressure in the heater reaches 140 PSI, a pressure relief valve opens. The relief
valve closes again at about 130 PSI.

POTABLE WATER SUPPLY

WATER HEATER COVER

WATER HEATER WATER HEATER SWITCH


ELECTRICAL
CONNECTOR HOT WATER TUBING
OUTLET CONNECTOR

MOUNTING BRACKET

MOUNTING CLAMP
WATER HEATER

PRESSURE WATER SUPPLY


RELIEF VALVE INLET CONNECTOR

LAVATORY DRAIN VALVE

ATA-38 Page 12 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Water Quantity Transmitter

The water quantity transmitter attaches to the top of the water tank. The transmitter receives a signal from a
float-type sensor inside the water tank. Changes in the water level cause different switches in the transmitter
to be energized, controlling illumination of water quantity indicator bulbs.

WATER QUANTITY
TRANSMITTER
SEE C

SEE A

SEE B

FWD INBD

ELECTRICAL
CONNECTOR

RECEPTACLE
BONDING
LUG FITTING
O-RING
BOSS O-RING
END
CLOSURE
TOP FLOAT STOP
OF
TANK

TUBE

FLOAT

RETAINING
RING

COTTER PIN
WATER
TANK

TANK END CLOSURE WATER QUANTITY TRANSMITT


B C

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-38 Page 13


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Water Quantity Indicator

The water quantity indicator is above the aft service door. When the pushbutton on the indicator is pushed,
the applicable bulb(s) illuminate to show water quantity in 1/4-tank increments.

WATER
1/2

1/4 3/4

WATER
E F

PUSH
QUANTITY

ATA-38 Page 14 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

WATER TANK PRESSURIZATION SYSTEM


Overview

The potable water tank uses air pressure from the pneumatic manifold to move the water to the lavatories and
the galleys. The pneumatic manifold supplies bleed air from engine number one, engine number two, and the
APU. On some airplanes the ninth stage bleed air from the engine number one is the primary air supply. The
pneumatic manifold is the secondary air supply. On some airplanes an electrical air compressor supplies air
pressure when engine bleed air is decreased less than 18 PSI. The potable water tank and the electrical air
compressor are located aft of the aft cargo compartment.

An alternate way of pressurizing the water tank on the ground is by connecting a nitrogen source to the air
valve on the water service panel.

All water tank pressurization system air passes through an air filter and pressure regulator on way to the
water tank. The air is filtered to prevent contamination. The pressure regulator reduces the air pressure and
maintains 25 PSI in the water tank. Check valves in the system prevent reverse pressurization.
ENGINE NO. 1
BLEED AIR
ENGINE NO. 2
1 BLEED AIR 1
PNEUMATIC
MANIFOLD ENGINE BLEED
ISOLATION AIR VALVE
VALVE 1
1 1

ENGINE NO. 1 HIGH AIR FLOW


STAGE BLEED AIR RESTRICTOR
1 2
CHECK VALVE

GROUND
APU CHECK PNEUMATIC
VALVE CONNECTOR
1 1

AIR FILTER

PRESSURE
REGULATOR
APU BLEED AIR
MANIFOLD

CHECK VALVE
AIR FILTER
AIR
VALVE

PRESSURE
WATER RELIEF
SERVICE VALVE
PANEL COMPRESSOR

PRESSURE
SWITCH
WATER
TANK

1 REFER TO CHAPTER 36, PNEUMATICS


2 NOT ON ALL AIRPLANES

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-38 Page 15


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Air Compressor

An electrical motor-driven air compressor is installed above the water tank. The air compressor furnishes
pressurization to the water system when the pneumatic system pressure drops to 18 PSI or less. Incoming air
to the compressor is filtered. Air from the compressor is supplied to the water tank through a check valve.

SEE A

ATTACH NUT
(4 PLACES)

INTAKE AIR
FILTER

COMPRESSOR

ATA-38 Page 16 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Pressure Regulator

The pressure regulator is installed above the water tank aft of the aft cargo compartment. The pressure
regulator reduces the air pressure from the pneumatic manifold to 25 ± 2 PSI if the 1552-002-9 pressure
regulator is installed. The pneumatic manifold is 35 ± 2 PSI if the 1552-002-19 pressure regulator is installed.

PRESSURE
REGULATOR
SEE A

AIR PRESSURE
SUPPLY LINE

WATER SERVICE
WATER PANEL (REF)
TANK
(REF)

PRESSURE
REGULATOR

FWD

A 1

PRESSURE
REGULATOR

FWD

A 2

1 ALTERNATIVE CONFIGURATION
2 RECOMMENDED CONFIGURATION

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-38 Page 17


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Air Filter

The air filter is installed above the water tank aft of the aft cargo compartment. The filter contains a
replaceable 10-micron filtration cellulose element. It filters all air entering the air pressure regulator.

BLEED AIR FILTER


SEE B

WATER
TANK

FWD

INBD

SEE A

FILTER
MOUNTING
HOLES

FILTER
HEAD

0-RING

0-RING

LOCKWIRE

FILTER
ELEMENT

FILTER
CASE

ATA-38 Page 18 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Pressure Relief Valve

The pressure relief valve is installed above the water tank aft of the aft cargo compartment. The relief valve
prevents the water tank from being damaged by over-pressurization. It is set to relieve at 50 ± 2.5 PSI. Reset
pressure is 37 PSI minimum.

PRESSURE
RELIEF
VALVE
SEE A

AIR PRESSURE
SUPPLY LINE

WATER SERVICE
WATER PANEL (REF)
TANK
(REF)

FWD PRESSURE
RELIEF VALVE

A 1

PRESSURE
RELIEF
VALVE

FWD

A 2

1 ALTERNATIVE CONFIGURATION
2 RECOMMENDED CONFIGURATION

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-38 Page 19


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Pressure Switch

The pressure switch in the water pressurization system is air pressure operated and initiates operation of the
air compressor when system pressure drops to 18 PSI or less. The pressure switch, when operated,
completes a circuit to the compressor relay which, in turn, actuates to complete the power circuit to the air
compressor. When system pressure is raised to approximately 23 PSI, the pressure switch opens to de-
energize the relay and compressor.

SEE A

AIR
PRESSURE
PRESSURE SWITCH LINE
ACCESS
PANELS SEE B

WATER TANK

WATER TANK
A

WATER TANK
PRESSURE
SWITCH

AIR
PRESSURE
LINE

INBD

FWD

PRESSURE SWITCH
B

ATA-38 Page 20 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

WASTE WATER SYSTEM


Overview

The waste water system will drain the waste water from the lavatory sinks and from the galley compartments.
The system has the plumbing that is necessary to drain the waste water overboard through the drain mast.

NON MODULAR LAVATORIES; the lavatory floor drain that is installed under the toilet tank is also a
component of the waste water system.

MODULAR LAVATORIES; the moisture condensation and the water leakage from the toilet tank are collected
in the enclosure for the toilet tank. Holes are made in the enclosure adjacent to the lavatory floor. The
leakage from the holes gives the indication that the waste water has collected and must be removed.

Lavatory Sink

The lavatory sink material is stainless steel. The sink has these properties: On some airplanes, the water
valves will shut off automatically 10 to 30 seconds after you push the actuator.

Lavatory Floor Drain


(All except airplanes with modular lavatories)

A lavatory floor drain in the catch basin under the toilet tank will collect condensation and leakage from the
toilet tank area. It has a floor drain fitting, a strainer, a check valve, and a hose. The check valve in the hose
allows the liquid to drain in the toilet drain tube and prevents the waste from entering the lavatory
compartment.

Waste Water Plumbing

The waste water plumb lines in the lavatory compartments are flexible hose. (For specific material of any
hose assembly, refer to Boeing Illustrated Parts Catalog.)

Waste Water Drain Masts

Locate the forward drain mast on the bottom of the fuselage in the left air conditioning fairing. Locate the aft
drain mast on the bottom of the fuselage forward of the aft entry door. The drain masts will drain waste water
from the system while the airplane is in flight. The primary anti-ice for the drain mast is the cabin air. The
secondary anti-ice is the electrical heating elements wrapped around the inner drain mast line.

Threshold Drain

A threshold drain is installed at the opening for each cabin entry door. The water that is collected by the
threshold drain goes out of the airplane through the drain mast.

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-38 Page 21


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

 
Drain Vents

Drain vents are installed on some drain lines that go to the drain mast. The drain vents help to control the air
noises that come from the galley and threshold drains. The drain vents also help to remove the odors from
the lavatories.

POTABLE WATER
SUPPLY LINE (REF)

DRAIN
VENT
GALLEY
1

RIGHT DOOR FORWARD


THRESHOLD LAVATORY
DRAIN

SINK DRAIN MAST


OVERFLOW
WASTE WATER
DRAIN LINE

DRAIN VENT 2
TO LEFT DOOR
THRESHOLD DRAIN

DRAIN FITTING (REF)

DRAIN VENT 2 AIR VENT


GALLEY DRAIN
POTABLE WATER LINE (REF)
DRAIN VALVE
SUPPLY LINE
LINES (REF)
(REF)
POTABLE WATER AFT LEFT
DRAIN LINE (REF) LAVATORY

AFT RIGHT SINK OVERFLOW


LAVATORY

TO RIGHT DOOR TOILET VENT


THRESHOLD DRAIN LINE (REF)

DRAIN VENT MUFFLER

WASTE WATER
GALLEY 3 DRAIN DRAIN LINE
1
POTABLE WATER
DRAIN DRAIN LINE (REF)
MAST

TO LEFT DOOR
GALLEY THRESHOLD DRAIN
DRAIN VENT 6 DRAIN
1 NOT INSTALLED ON ALL AIRPLANES
2 ALTERNATIVE LOCATION

ATA-38 Page 22 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

TOILET SYSTEM
Overview

Separate independent toilet systems are provided in the forward lavatory compartment and the aft lavatory
compartment. The toilet flushing unit is electrically operated. The waste material collects in a waste tank.
The unit uses filtered waste liquid as the flushing liquid. The primary flushing liquid is a strong solution of
disinfectant, deodorant, dye, and water.

The toilet unit is installed in each lavatory compartment entirely above the lavatory compartment floor. Each
unit consists of a toilet shroud assembly, flushing components and a waste tank.

Servicing components in the toilet systems allow ground draining and rinsing of the toilet units.

Turn the toilet flush handle to initiate the toilet flush procedure. The flushing liquid flows through a filter to
the flush ring in the toilet bowl. The waste material and the flushing liquid will flow out the bottom of the
bowl into the waste tank.

A separator between the tank and the bowl prevents splash and vision of tank contents. Should mechanical or
power failure occur the toilet can be operated as a conventional static unit.

Toilet Operation

When the flush handle is rotated 15-degrees, it initiates toilet flushing by setting the toilet timer. The timer
allows 115-volt AC power to the toilet flush motor for 10 (± 2) seconds. The flush motor operates the flush
pump, which draws fluid through the filter, and pumps approximately 2-gallons of liquid through the toilet in
each cycle. At the end of the cycle the motor stops and the liquid drains into the waste tank.

Drain the waste tank by following these steps:

(1) Attach the service cart to the drain outlet


(2) Open the flapper valve
(3) Pull the drain valve handle located on the service panel

Use the flush connection on the service panel to flush the waste tank walls with pressurized water. The water
enters the tank through spray nozzles that turn. The flush water will drain through the drain line.

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-38 Page 23


and Systems
  Introduction
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE

 
ATA-38 Page 24
 

 
 
CABIN TO OVERBOARD TO POWER FORWARD LAVATORY
AIR VENT TOILET BACK SOURCE COMPARTMENT
SHROUD TOILET FLUSH HANDLE
FORWARD
TOILET
FLUSH
MOTOR TO LAVATORY FLUSH TIMER SWITCH
115V AC VACUUM VENT LINE
BUS 1
GROUND FLUSH LINE
C814 SEE A
CHANGE TANK OVERBOARD
FWD TOILET 10 SEC VENT LINE
OVER TOILET
FLUSH MOTOR TIMER
CONTROL TOILET FLUSH SERVICE TOILET TANK
PUMP MOTOR WASTE WATER PANEL VENT NOZZLE
P18-4 CIRCUIT BREAKER FORWARD FLUSH TIMER DRAIN LINE
FILTER SEE B
PANEL
TANK DRAIN VALVE SPRAY NOZZLE TOILET TANK
CATCH BASIN
6 TOILET
FLUSH PORT DRAIN VALVE BALL VALVE FORWARD TOILET TANK WASTE
CONTROL TANK
TIEDOWN RODS TANK DRAIN
(4 LOCATIONS) VALVE
SEE C
FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY

PUSH-TO-OPEN FLUSH PORT


LEVER FLOOR FORWARD TOILET
DRAIN VALVE
DRAIN VALVE
HINGED DRAIN PLUG FORWARD TOILET CONTROL CABLE
CONTROL
(FLAPPER VALVE) HINGED DRAIN LINE
DRAIN
CAP

FORWARD TOILET
GROUND FLUSH
PUSH-TO-OPEN LINE
LEVER
FORWARD TOILET SERVICE PANEL

AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource


FWD FORWARD TOILET
4
SERVICE PANEL

A 1
HINGE DRAIN PLUG
(FLAPPER VALVE) TOILET TANK
SHROUD
OPEN DRAIN VALVE
DRAIN VALVE 1
LEVER CONTROL DRAIN PLUG
FLUSH PORT FORWARD TOILET FLUSH PORT CONTROL
DRAIN HEATER
(REF 30-71-00,/001)
1 ALL EXCEPT AIRPLANES WITH MODULAR LAVATORIES CLOSE
B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization

OPEN LEVER LEVER


2 AIRPLANES WITH RUMBOLD MODULAR LAVATORIES
HINGED HINGED
3 AIRPLANES WITH WEBER MODULAR LAVATORIES DRAIN CAP DRAIN CAP
FORWARD TOILET
DRAIN HEATER
4 RECOMMENDED CONFIGURATION
(REF 30-71-00,/001)
CLOSE
5 ALTERNATIVE CONFIGURATION LEVER

6 TOILETS WITH CATCH BASIN HINGED


HINGED DRAIN CAP
DRAIN CAP

FORWARD TOILET SERVICE PANEL FORWARD TOILET SERVICE PANEL


5 5

Forward Toilet System

and Systems Introduction


B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE

 
B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization

AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource


 

 
 
TO POWER SOURCE TOILET
CABIN AIR TO DRAIN MAST
FLUSH
TIMER
M105 (S54)
RIGHT AFT TOILET
TOILET
FLUSH BACK TANK AND
MOTOR SHROUD BOWL VACUUM
VENT LINE
115V AC
BUS 1 RIGHT AFT LAVATORY
TANK OVERBOARD COMPARTMENT
VENT LINE
TOILET FLUSH
C834 MOTOR
RIGHT AFT GROUND
10 SEC CHANGE FLUSH LINE LEFT AFT LAVATORY
TOILET
TIMER OV E R PUMP COMPARTMENT
FLUSH
CONTROL
MOTOR SPRAY NOZZLE (EXAMPLE)
TANK DRAIN VALVE FORWARD
S55 RIGHT AFT FLUSH TIMER FILTER TIEDOWN ROD
SWITCH AFT TOILET
TOILET TANK SERVICE
CATCH BASIN TOILET FLUSH PANEL
M60 RIGHT AFT LAV CABINET ASSY
LINE

TOILET WASTE
FLOOR TANK
TANK DRAIN
FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY

VALVE
FLUSH PORT RH
INBOARD
DRAIN VALVE CONTROL RH TO DRAIN MAST TIEDOWN TOILET DRAIN LINE
RODS
DRAIN VALVE
M106
LEFT AFT
CONTROL CABLE
TOILET
FLUSH
GROUND FLUSH LINE GROUND FLUSH LINE
MOTOR
- RIGHT AFT TOILET
115V AC DRAIN VALVE CONTROL
BUS 2
CABLE - RIGHT AFT TOILET
24-00-01

C835
LEFT AFT TOILET TANK
10 SEC CHANGE
TOILET
FWD SHROUD
TIMER OV E R PUMP TOILET SERVICE PANEL
FLUSH
CONTROL 1
MOTOR SPRAY NOZZLE (EXAMPLE)
P18- 4 CIRCUIT BREAKER S56 LEFT AFT FLUSH TIMER FILTER AFT TOILET EXAMPLE
PANEL SWITCH
( L E F T A F T T O I L E T S H O W1N
M61 LEFT AFT LAV CABINET ASSY RIGHT AFT TOILET OPP 1 ) FLUSH PORT
RINSE WATER (2 LOCATIONS)
HINGED OPEN
AFT TOILET DRAIN HEATER
WASTE WATER RIGHT FLUSH LEVER
(REF 30-71-00,/001) DRAIN CAP
FLUSH PORT CLOSED
(2 LOCATIONS) LEVER
RIGHT DRAIN
REMOVABLE DRAIN PLUG DRAIN VALVE
VALVE CONTROL OR HINGED FLAPPER VALVE _O
N _T
__E: FOR TOILET FLUSH MOTOR AND TANK DRAIN HANDLE DRAIN VALVE
LEFT FLUSH PORT VA L V E C OM P O NE N T I L LU S TR AT I ON S (2 LOCATIONS) HANDLE
SEE FIG. 1 (2 LOCATIONS)
HINGED
RIGHT DRAIN
FLUSH PORT
LEFT FLUSH
CAP 1 ALL EXCEPT AIRPLANES WITH 6 NOT INSTALLED
MODULAR LAVATORIES ON ALL AIRPLANES
LEFT HINGED
FLUSH PORT LEFT DRAIN PUSH-TO-OPEN DRAIN CAP
2 AIRPLANES WITH RUMBOLD
VALVE CONTROL LEVER
MODULAR LAVATORIES
RIGHT
3 AIRPLANES WITH WEBER TOILET
MODULAR LAVATORIES LEFT
4 RECOMMENDED CONFIGURATION TOILET
FWD
A F T T O I L E T S E R V I C E P A N E5 L 5 ALTERNATIVE CONFIGURATION A F T T O I L E T S E R V I C E P A N E4L A F T T O I L E T S E R V I C E P A N E5L
ATA-38 Page 25

Aft Toilet System

and Systems Introduction


 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Toilet Tank Shroud Assemblies

Each toilet tank shroud assembly consists of a standard commercial seat and cover attached to a shroud which
covers the flushing components mounted on the tank top. The tank shroud is attached to the upper and lower
ends of the tank shroud support angles.

COLLAR

TOILET TANK
SHROUD

ATA-38 Page 26 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Toilet Flushing Components

The flushing components include a flush handle, timer, flush motor and the required tubing. The flush motor
and tubing are on the tank top. The flush handle and timer are on the toilet back shroud located above the
toilet unit.

Toilet Flush Handle

The flush handle is rotated to start the timer for the flushing cycle.

Toilet Timer

The timer is mounted behind the flush handle. Rotating the flush handle 15 degrees provides power to the
flush motor for 10 ± 2 seconds.
FACEPLATE
TIMER TIMER

TIMER SEE A SEE A

5 SPRING CLIP
3

LATCH
4 ACCESS PANEL
4

BOTTOM RIGHT
SCREW
3 SCREW
(7 LOCATIONS)
3

ACCESS PANEL
FASTENERS
TOILET TANK 4
SHROUD

L A V A T O R Y1 L A V A T O R Y2
(EXAMPLE) (EXAMPLE)

TIMER
PANEL

TIMER

TIMER HANDLE
MOUNTING NUT
(4 LOCATIONS)
(2 LOCATIONS)
6

TIMER HANDLE ATTACHMENT SCREW


(BELOW THE TIMER HANDLE)

ELECTRICAL CONNECTOR

1 AIRPLANES WITH THE MODULAR LAVATORIES


2 AIRPLANES WITHOUT THE MODULAR LAVATORIES

3 AFT LAVATORIES A
4 FORWARD LAVATORIES
5 DIFFERENT LOCATION
6 NOT ON ALL AIRPLANES

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-38 Page 27


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Toilet Flush Motor-Pump-Filter Assembly

The motor-pump-filter assembly has a motor, a pump, and a filter.

The motor for the pump impeller is direct drive. The impeller drains the fluid from the toilet tank to a filter.
The fluid then flows to a spray ring in the toilet bow.

An overheat switch is installed in the motor. The overheat switch will open when the motor temperature is
more than the safe operating limit. When the motor temperature cools to the operating limit, the overheat
switch will close to operate the motor.

The filter is a cylindrically shaped basket with holes to allow flush fluid to be drawn from the tank and prevent
debris from clogging the pump.

TO TOILET
FLUSH TIMER
TANK FLUSH
INLET TUBE
TOILET
FLUSH TOILET FLUSH
MOTOR LINE

BONDING
JUMPER MOUNTING BOLT
(6 LOCATIONS)

TANK TOP
MOUNTING
CARTRIDGE PLATE
MOUNTING
ASSEMBLY
SPRAY NOZZLE
IMPELLER
FILTER
DRIVE SHAFT

TOILET FLUSH
MOTOR-PUMP-FILTER ASSEMBLY

ATA-38 Page 28 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-38 Page 29


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Toilet Waste Tank

Each toilet waste tank assembly includes a fiberglass tank fitted with a toilet bowl, motor-pump-filter
assembly and tank drain valve. The capacity of the forward lavatory compartment tank is 16 gallons and the
aft lavatory compartment tank 17 gallons. The drain valve is operated by a cable from the toilet service panel.
The toilet bowl has a hinged separator that can be held open for limited access to the tank interior through the
bowl.

In lavatories equipped with a catch basin, the toilet tank is installed in the catch basin. The catch basin will
drain the water leakage and the moisture condensation to prevent tank corrosion. The water in the catch basin
will drain to the toilet drain line.

The drain valve permits flow of the toilet tank waste to a service cart. The drain valve gives a positive seal
when closed. It is a spring-loaded valve, primarily closed, that does not require lubrication. Pull the valve
cable handle found on the service panel to open the drain valve. When the valve cable handle is in the extend
position, you turn the handle to latch it. The drain plug found in the drain line is opened by an attachment on
the service cart. The drain plug stops waste leakage when you open the drain cap. On some airplanes a ball
valve and a flapper valve are installed in the drain line. The ball valve is installed in the drain line 4 to 6 feet
above the forward service panel. The ball valve operates with the drain valve to permit flow of the toilet waste
to a service cart. The valve cable is a push-and-pull type found between the service panel and the ball valve.
The valve cable is a pull type found between the ball valve and the drain valve. The flapper valve found at the
drain line outlet stops the waste leakage because of a faulty drain valve. Open the flapper valve after you
open the drain cap. On airplanes with a flapper valve, a flapper valve replaces the drain plug.

Quick disconnect (V-type) clamps are used to secure the toilet bowl, tank drain valve and motor-pump-filter
assembly to the top of the tank.

Three cleansing spray nozzles are mounted within the perforated filter. When connected to pressurized water
source during servicing, the nozzles rotate and spray rinse water on the insides of the filter and tank.

A check valve, installed in the ground flush line, prevents air leakage and prevents waste fluid from entering
the ground flush line. The valve is mounted on the tank top at the point where the flush line changes from
tubing to flexible hose.

An overboard vent line is connected at the top of the tank and routed through a muffler to the overboard drain
mast. A lavatory compartment vent line is also connected to the muffler.

A vacuum vent line equalizes the pressure in the lavatory compartment, the waste tank, and the inside of the
toilet bowl.

ATA-38 Page 30 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

SCREW

AFT RIGHT
LAVATORY
COMPARTMENT

AFT LEFT
LAVATORY
COMPARTMENT
SEE A
AFT TOILET
SERVICE TOILET
PANEL TANK SHROUD

SPRING CLIP
ACCESS PANEL

TIMER

TOILET BACK
SHROUD

SCREW VACUM VENT LINE

TO TOILET TANK OVERBOARD


FLUSH TIMER VENT LINE

GROUND FLUSH LINE


TIEDOWN STRAP

BONDING JUMPER
WASTE WATER
DRAIN LINE
CENTERLINE
PARTITION NUT
(5 LOCATIONS)
TOILET FLUSH FORWARD
MOTOR TIEDOWN ROD

DRIP PAN
TOILET WASTE TANK

DRAIN VALVE CONTROL


CABLE QUICK-DISCONNECT

FLOOR CATCH BASIN


INBOARD
1 ALL EXCEPT AIRPLANES WITH TIEDOWN ROD
MODULAR LAVATORIES
AFT LEFT TOILET SHOWN
2 AIRPLANES WITH MODULAR
AFT RIGHT TOILET OPPOSITE INBD FWD
LAVATORIES
A F T T O I L E T S Y S T E M1
3 NOT ON ALL AIRPLANES
A

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-38 Page 31


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Toilet Service Panels

Each toilet service panel includes one 4-inch drain valve, a flush line fitting, and a flush cable handle for each
waste tank. The anti-ice feature for the waste drain valve on the aft service panel is supplied by a heating
element in the drain gasket.

The service panels for the forward and aft toilet systems are on the airplane right side. The forward service
panel is located right of the nose wheel well door. The aft service panel is located near the airplane
centerline, forward of the APU access door.

ATA-38 Page 32 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-38 Page 33


and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

 
TABLE OF CONTENTS
B737-300/400/500 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION SELF-PACED
ATA-49 (GTCP85-129)

AIRBORNE AUXILIARY POWER............................................................................................................................ 4


Overview..................................................................................................................................................... 4
APU SHROUD .................................................................................................................................................... 10
Overview................................................................................................................................................... 10
APU MOUNTS ................................................................................................................................................... 13
Overview................................................................................................................................................... 13
Shroud Mounts......................................................................................................................................... 13
Shroud Rings............................................................................................................................................ 13
APU Engine Mounts.................................................................................................................................. 13
APU AIR INLET ................................................................................................................................................. 17
Overview................................................................................................................................................... 17
Air Inlet Ducts .......................................................................................................................................... 17
Air Inlet Door............................................................................................................................................ 18
Air Inlet Door Actuator ............................................................................................................................. 18
APU ENGINE...................................................................................................................................................... 21
Overview................................................................................................................................................... 21
APU FUEL SYSTEM........................................................................................................................................... 24
Overview................................................................................................................................................... 24
APU Fuel Valve ......................................................................................................................................... 24
Low Pressure Fuel Filter .......................................................................................................................... 24
Fuel Control Unit ...................................................................................................................................... 24
APU IGNITION AND START SYSTEM................................................................................................................ 29
Overview................................................................................................................................................... 29
Starter Motor............................................................................................................................................ 29
Start Relay R5........................................................................................................................................... 29
Ignition Unit.............................................................................................................................................. 29
Igniter Plug............................................................................................................................................... 30
Igniter Cable............................................................................................................................................. 30
APU COOLING AIR SYSTEM.............................................................................................................................. 33
Overview................................................................................................................................................... 33
Cooling Air Inlet Duct ............................................................................................................................... 33
Cooling Air Shutoff Valve.......................................................................................................................... 33
Pneumatic Actuator .................................................................................................................................. 33
Cooling Fan .............................................................................................................................................. 34
Cooling Air Crossover Duct....................................................................................................................... 34

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-49 GTCP Page 1
and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

 
APU BLEED AIR SYSTEM ................................................................................................................................. 36
Overview................................................................................................................................................... 36
Bleed Air Valve......................................................................................................................................... 36
Bleed Air Duct.......................................................................................................................................... 37
APU Control Thermostat (Airplanes without the ETC).............................................................................. 38
Proportional Control Valve (Airplanes with the ETC)................................................................................ 40
Differential Air Pressure Regulator........................................................................................................... 41
Surge Bleed Valve .................................................................................................................................... 42
APU CONTROLS................................................................................................................................................ 44
Overview................................................................................................................................................... 44
APU Control Unit ...................................................................................................................................... 44
Electronic Speed Switch ........................................................................................................................... 46
Sequencing Oil Pressure Switch............................................................................................................... 47
Low Oil Pressure Switch .......................................................................................................................... 48
Oil Temperature Switch............................................................................................................................ 49
Compressor Inlet Temperature Sensor (Airplanes with the ETC)............................................................. 50
Electronic Temperature Control (Airplanes with the ETC)........................................................................ 51
EXHAUST GAS TEMPERATURE INDICATING SYSTEM (AIRPLANES WITHOUT THE ETC) ............................... 52
Overview................................................................................................................................................... 52
Thermocouple Probe ................................................................................................................................ 52
Harness Balancing Resistor...................................................................................................................... 52
EGT Resistor............................................................................................................................................. 54
EGT Indicator............................................................................................................................................ 55
EXHAUST GAS TEMPERATURE INDICATING SYSTEM (AIRPLANES WITH THE ETC) ...................................... 56
Overview................................................................................................................................................... 56
ETC Thermocouple Probe......................................................................................................................... 56
EGT Resistor............................................................................................................................................. 58
EGT Indicator............................................................................................................................................ 59
APU INDICATING SYSTEM................................................................................................................................ 60
Overview................................................................................................................................................... 60
OVER SPEED Light.................................................................................................................................... 60
Elapsed Time Indicator ............................................................................................................................ 61
APU EXHAUST SYSTEM ................................................................................................................................... 64
Overview................................................................................................................................................... 64
Exhaust Duct ............................................................................................................................................ 64
Aft Fairing ................................................................................................................................................ 64
APU LUBRICATION SYSTEM............................................................................................................................. 66
Overview................................................................................................................................................... 66
Oil Pump .................................................................................................................................................. 68
Oil Cooler ................................................................................................................................................. 70
Oil Tank ................................................................................................................................................... 71
Lube Service Panel................................................................................................................................... 72

ATA-49 GTCP Page 2 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization
and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

 
APU OIL TANK SERVICING................................................................................................................................ 73
Overview................................................................................................................................................... 73
Fill the APU Oil Tank - Manual Procedure ............................................................................................... 73
Fill the APU Oil Tank - Pressure Procedure............................................................................................. 76
APU OIL INDICATING SYSTEM ......................................................................................................................... 78
Overview................................................................................................................................................... 78
HIGH OIL TEMP or FAULT Light............................................................................................................... 78
LOW OIL PRESSURE Light........................................................................................................................ 79
LOW OIL QUANTITY or MAINT Light ....................................................................................................... 79
Lube Service Lights.................................................................................................................................. 79
Low Oil Quantity Switch ........................................................................................................................... 81

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-49 GTCP Page 3
and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

AIRBORNE AUXILIARY POWER


Overview

The airborne auxiliary power for the airplane is supplied by a gas turbine auxiliary power unit (referred to as
the APU). The APU can supply pneumatic bleed air and electrical power to the airplane while the airplane is
on the ground or in flight. The APU operation is controlled by the APU control unit. The APU control unit is
found on the E3-3 electrical shelf.

The APU has a gas turbine engine (referred to as the APU engine), APU electrical generator and electronic
controls. The APU engine turns the APU electrical generator through the gearbox assembly. The electronic
controls make sure that the APU operates safely and continuously. The airplane pneumatic system connects to
the APU bleed system. The APU electrical generator supplies the electrical power to the airplane electrical
system. The APU has a fire protection system.

The APU is found in a compartment in the airplane tail section. To get to the APU, the APU cowl door must be
opened and the lower shroud must be removed.

The No. 1 fuel tank supplies the fuel for the APU operation. The airplane battery supplies the electrical power
for the APU. To start the APU operation, the APU master switch is moved to the START position and released
to the ON position. The APU fuel valve and the air inlet door open. The fuel, ignition, and acceleration are
controlled to permit the APU engine to operate safely and quickly. When the APU speed gets to 100%,
pneumatic power and electrical power are available for the airplane operation. If a large quantity of pneumatic
power is necessary, the electrical load must be decreased.

The APU stops when the APU master switch is moved to the OFF position. The APU will stop automatically
because of an engine overspeed, low oil pressure, high oil temperature, or APU fire.

Airplanes with the Electronic Temperature Control (ETC)

Some of the airplanes have a later configuration APU. This APU has the electronic temperature control (ETC).
It is not easy to see the differences with this later configuration APU. To do the maintenance on the APU, you
must correctly identify the APU. In the Maintenance Manual, the procedures that are not common between the
APUs have an effectivity of AIRPLANES WITH THE ETC and AIRPLANES WITHOUT THE ETC.

To identify the airplanes with the ETC, open the APU cowl door and remove the lower shroud. Find the APU
model number on the side of the combustion chamber. The APUs that use the ETC have a model number of
GTCP85-129(H), (J), or (K). All the other model numbers do not use the ETC.

The ETC is found on the ceiling in the right side of the aft cargo compartment.

ATA-49 GTCP Page 4 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization
and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

COMPRESSOR
AIR DUCT
COOLING
TORQUE AIR DUCT
BOX LINER

AIR
DIFFUSER
DUCT
EXHAUST DUCT

AUXILIARY
POWER UNIT
(SHROUDED) AIR INLET
DOOR

FUEL
LINE BLEED AIR
VALVE
BLEED
AIR DUCT

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-49 GTCP Page 5
and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

ATA-49 GTCP Page 6 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization
and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

 
APU Shroud

The APU power plant is sealed in a fire-resistant shroud. The APU shroud decreased the noise from the APU.
The APU shroud has two parts; the lower shroud and the upper shroud. The upper shroud is attached to the
airplane structure. The upper shroud has the APU engine mounts, fuel lines, fuel heater, electrical
connections, air inlet ducts, and bleed air ducts. The lower shroud attaches to the upper shroud. The lower
shroud has the shroud drains, the oil service door, and the port for the cooling air exhaust.

APU Mounts

The APU mounts support the APU power plant and isolate the airplane from the vibrations of the APU engine.
The APU mounts include the ring mounts, shroud rings, and APU engine mounts. The shroud rings give
support for the APU engine mounts and the upper shroud. The shroud rings are attached to the airplane
structure with the ring mounts and the brackets.

APU Air Inlet

The air inlet door is installed on the right side of the airplane tail section. The air inlet door and the air inlet
ducts supply the air to the APU. The APU air inlet supplies compressor air to the APU engine compressor and
it supplies cooling air to the cooling fan. The air inlet system has the air diffuser duct, compressor air duct,
cooling air duct, vortex generator, torque box liner, and air inlet door.

APU Engine

The APU engine is a gas turbine engine that operates on a continuous cycle. The APU engine has a
compressor section, turbine section and gearbox assembly. The APU engine supplies the bleed air for
pneumatic power and the shaft power to turn the APU electrical generator.

APU Fuel

The APU fuel system supplies the fuel to the APU engine from the No. 1 fuel tank of the airplane. The APU
fuel system monitors the supply of fuel to the combustion chamber of the APU. This lets the APU operate at a
constant speed and safe turbine temperature under different load conditions.

APU Ignition and Start System

The APU ignition and start system turns the APU engine and supplies the ignition to the fuel-air mixture in the
combustor unit. The ignition system has the ignition unit, igniter cable, and igniter plug. The start system
has the starter motor and start relay R5.

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-49 GTCP Page 7
and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

 
APU Air

The APU air system has two subsystems: the accessory cooling air system (AC air system) and the bleed air
system. The AC air system supplies the air to decrease the temperature of the APU electrical generator, APU
lubrication system, APU engine parts, and APU shroud. The bleed air system supplies the pneumatic power
for the airplane pneumatic system.

APU Controls

The APU controls have switches that are automatically and manually controlled. These switches start, operate,
and stop the APU engine. The components for the APU controls are found on the APU engine, in the APU
control unit, and on the P5 forward overhead panel.

The main components of the APU controls are the APU master switch and APU control unit.

APU Indicating

The APU indicating system has the exhaust gas temperature (EGT) indicating system and the APU indicating
system.

The EGT indicating system monitors the exhaust gas temperature of the APU engine. The EGT indicating
system has the thermocouples, EGT indicator, and EGT resistor.

The APU indicating system monitors the APU condition and the APU operation. The APU indicating system has
the indicator lights and elapsed time indicator.

APU Exhaust

The APU exhaust system sends the exhaust gases from the APU engine out of the airplane. The APU exhaust
system also decreases the noise level of the APU engine. The exhaust duct and the aft fairing are the parts of
the APU exhaust system.

APU Lubrication

The APU lubrication system pressurizes the oil for the APU engine. The APU lubrication system supplies the
oil to the gears and the bearings in the APU engine. The APU lubrication system has the oil pump, oil tank, oil
cooler, and oil lines.

APU Oil Indicating

The APU oil indicating system monitors the temperature, pressure, and quantity of the APU oil. The indicating
lights for the APU oil indicating system are on the P5 forward overhead panel.

ATA-49 GTCP Page 8 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization
and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

BLEED AIR
VALVE
BLEED AIR

FLOW
OIL CONTROL
LEVEL VALVE
INTERSTAGE SWITCH SHUTOFF
TURBINE DUCT COOLING VALVE
COMPRESSOR
WHEEL AIR FAN FOR THE
PLENUM OIL
TURBINE COOLING
PLENUM SURGE COOLER AIR
BLEED
VALVE COMPRESSOR
TURBINE APU ELECTRICAL
INLET AIR
TORUS GENERATOR

COOLING
AIR
OIL
EXHAUST OIL PRESSURE

ACCESSORY GEARBOX
PORT PUMP SWITCHES
ASSEMBLY
TURBINE OIL
EXHAUST TEMPERATURE
THERMO- TACHOMETER SWITCH
COUPLE GENERATOR
PROBE
APU ELECTRONIC
CONTROL SPEED SWITCH
THERMOSTAT
ELAPSED
FUEL DRAIN
SECOND STAGE FIRST STAGE STARTER TIME
COMPRESSOR COMPRESSOR MOTOR INDICATOR
COMBUSTION
CHAMBER FUEL CONTROL
IGNITION UNIT FLOW CONTROL
ATOMIZER
UNIT VALVE
FUEL
PUMP
IGNITER
PLUG LOW-PRESSURE
HIGH-PRESSURE FUEL FILTER
FUEL FILTER
GOVERNOR

BLEED FUEL HEATER


OVERBOARD
FUEL
ACCELERATION
SOLENOID CHECK
LIMITER OVERBOARD
VALVE VALVE SHROUD DRAIN
FOR THE
FUEL FUEL LINE
HEATER SHROUD
3-WAY
SOLENOID VALVE
AIRPLANE
FUEL TANK,
FUEL PRESSURE INLET AIR NO. 1 APU FUEL
VALVE
FUEL SUPPLY COMPRESSED AIR
CONTROL AIR TURBINE GAS

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-49 GTCP Page 9
and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

APU SHROUD
Overview

The APU shroud is a titanium compartment that fully protects the APU power plant. The APU shroud gives the
protection from an APU fire and decrease the noise from the APU power plant. The APU shroud includes the
upper shroud and the lower shroud. The upper shroud attaches to the airplane structure and holds the
forward end of the APU exhaust duct. The upper shroud and the lower shroud connect to one another with the
shroud latches on the lower shroud.

Upper Shroud

The upper shroud is installed in the APU compartment. The upper shroud attaches to the shroud rings. The
shroud rings attach to the APU compartment with eight ring mounts. When the APU is removed from the
airplane, the upper shroud will stay in the APU compartment. The upper shroud has openings for the fuel
lines, air inlet ducts and bleed air duct. The upper shroud has the fittings for the electrical connections and
plumbing connections. Three mounting brackets for the APU engine attach to the shroud rings. The fuel
heater is installed on the inner surface of the upper shroud.

Lower Shroud

The lower shroud attaches to the upper shroud with ten shroud latches. The lower shroud has the openings to
the filler port for the oil tank and to the overboard exhaust for the APU cooling air. Also, there is an access
panel that is removed to read the elapsed time indicator. When the lower shroud is removed, you can get
access to do maintenance on the APU control thermostat (Airplanes without the ETC) or the proportional
control valve (Airplanes with the ETC), EGT probes, overtemperature control thermocouple, combustor unit,
fuel lines, igniter plug, ignition unit, oil tank, oil quantity transmitter, oil line, APU electrical generator, cooling
fan, fuel control unit, tachometer generator, starter motor and oil pump.

APU Shroud Drains

The APU shroud drains remove the extra fuel from the combustion chamber that is not burned during the APU
operation. Also, the APU shroud drains remove all the fuel and the oil that leaks from the APU engine. The
APU shroud drains have two drain lines, two drain cups, standpipe, drain reservoir and shroud drains.

At the aft end of the lower shroud, a drain cup with a standpipe collects all the extra fuel that comes out of the
turbine exhaust port. A different drain cup on the lower shroud connects with the fuel drain on the APU
engine. This drain cup helps remove the extra fuel from the combustion chamber that is not burned during
the APU operation. Both of the drain cups are connected to the drain lines on the lower shroud. These drain
lines flow to the drain reservoir and a shroud drain on the forward end of the lower shroud. A different
shroud drain is found on the forward end of the lower shroud. This shroud drain removes the fuel and the oil
that leaks from the APU engine directly on the lower shroud. Both of these shroud drains connect to separate
drain cups on the APU cowl door.

ATA-49 GTCP Page 10 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization
and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

UPPER
SHROUD CUTOUT
FUEL
HEATER FOR THE
BLEED AIR
DUCT
SHROUD RING
LATCH
RING MOUNT
INLET DUCT
FOR THE
ACCESSORY
COOLING AIR

SEE A
RING MOUNT

FUEL LINE
INLET LOCK
INLET FLANGE HANDLE
FOR THE ACCESSORY
COOLING AIR FUEL HOSE
SEE B

LATCH

OVERBOARD
EXHAUST FOR
THE ACCESSORY
DRAIN COOLING AIR
LINE

ACCESS PANEL
FOR THE LOWER
DRAIN SHROUD
ELAPSED TIME
LINES FWD DRAIN
INDICATOR
FITTING
CUTOUT FOR
THE OIL A
FILLER CUP

LOWER
SHROUD

STAND PIPE

DRAIN CUP
SHROUD DRAIN

DRAIN RESERVIOR DRAIN LINE

DRAIN
CUP

SEE C FWD

B C

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-49 GTCP Page 11
and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

ATA-49 GTCP Page 12 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization
and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

APU MOUNTS
Overview

The APU mounts hold the APU engine and isolate the airplane from all bad vibrations of the APU engine. The
APU mounts have the shroud mounts, shroud rings, and APU engine mounts. The shroud mounts attach the
shroud rings to the airplane structure. The APU engine mounts attach the APU engine to the shroud rings.

Shroud Mounts

The shroud mounts attach the shroud rings to the airplane structure. The shroud mounts have the airplane
mounting brackets and the struts for the ring mounts. Each shroud ring is held vertically by two struts and
laterally by one strut. Also, the aft shroud ring is held axially by two struts. The struts for the ring mounts
are attached to the airplane mounting brackets and the ring mounts with bolts and nuts.

Shroud Rings

Two shroud rings supply the installation base for the upper shroud and the APU engine mounts. The shroud
rings have the ring mounts. The shroud mounts are connected to the shroud rings at the ring mounts. To
make the installation easy, the shroud rings are part of the upper shroud.

APU Engine Mounts

The APU engine mounts attach the APU engine to the shroud rings. There are three APU engine mounts. Two
of the APU engine mounts are found on the right side of the APU engine. One of the APU engine mounts is
found on the left side of the APU. The APU engine mounts give the APU maximum support in all directions.
Each of the APU engine mounts has two mounting brackets, a vibration isolator and a cap. The mounting
brackets that attach to the shroud have the vibration isolators. The mounting brackets that attach to the APU
engine flanges have the caps. The caps make the removal of the APU and the installation of the APU quick
and easy.

The vibration isolators do not permit the vibrations from the APU engine to be transmitted to the airplane
structure. A vibration isolator has a resilient material that is bonded to a metal core. This material is in a
tubular metal case. The vibration isolator is found between the mounting bracket on the APU engine and the
mounting bracket on the shroud. As the APU engine shakes, the resilient material absorbs the vibrations.

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-49 GTCP Page 13
and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

 
AIRPLANE APU COMPARTMENT
MOUNTING STRUCTURE
AIRPLANE
BRACKET MOUNTING
BRACKET

RING MOUNT STRUT


RING MOUNT STRUT
(VERTICAL)
(AXIAL)

AIRPLANE
MOUNTING
BRACKET
RING MOUNT
SHROUD RING

RING MOUNT STRUT


MOUNTING BRACKETS (LATERAL)
FOR THE APU
ENGINE MOUNT
CAP
ENGINE
FLANGE
VIBRATION
ISOLATOR

SEE
RIGHT AFT MOUNT
A
A

APU COMPARTMENT
STRUCTURE

AIRPLANE MOUNTING
BRACKET

RING MOUNT STRUT


SEE C
(VERTICAL)
UPPER
SHROUD
RING MOUNT
SEE D
SHROUD
RING
AIRPLANE MOUNTING
BRACKET
SEE B

CAP RING MOUNT STRUT


(LATERAL)

VIBRATION
ISOLATOR
FWD
MOUNTING BRACKETS
FOR THE APU
ENGINE ENGINE MOUNT
FLANGE
RIGHT FORWARD MOUNT
B

ATA-49 GTCP Page 14 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization
and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

 
APU COMPARTMENT
STRUCTURE

AIRPLANE
MOUNTING
BRACKET

RING MOUNT STRUT


RING MOUNT STRUT (AXIAL)
(VERTICAL)

FWD
RING MOUNT
UPPER
SHROUD
SHROUD RING
CAP

MOUNTING BRACKETS
FOR THE APU
ENGINE MOUNT

VIBRATION
ENGINE
ISOLATOR
FLANGE

LEFT AFT MOUNT


C

APU COMPARTMENT
STRUCTURE

AIRPLANE
MOUNTING
BRACKET

RING MOUNT STRUT


(VERTICAL)

FWD
RING MOUNT

SHROUD RING

LEFT FORWARD MOUNT


D

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-49 GTCP Page 15
and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

ATA-49 GTCP Page 16 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization
and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

APU AIR INLET


Overview

The air inlet system for the APU supplies the air for the APU. The air inlet system has the air inlet ducts,
vortex generator, air inlet door, and the actuator for the air inlet door. The vortex generator and air inlet door
are found on the right side of the fuselage. They are forward of the APU. The inlet air goes through the air
inlet ducts to the APU compressor plenum and cooling fan.

When the APU master switch is moved to the START position, the APU control unit transmits a 28-volt DC
signal through the ON position of the APU master switch. This 28-volt DC signal goes to the APU fuel valve
and through the APU control unit. The 28-volt DC signal energizes the open coil for the APU fuel valve and
opens the APU fuel valve. When the APU fuel valve is opened, the 28-volt DC signal energizes the open coil
for the inlet door actuator and opens the air inlet door. After the air inlet door opens, the APU engine will
start.

If the air inlet door does not fully open, a 28-volt DC signal from the APU control unit moves through the door
open switch for the air inlet door. This 28-volt DC signal returns to the APU control unit and energizes the K1
start-stop relay. The APU will not start.

When the APU master switch is moved to the OFF position, the APU control unit transmits a 28-volt DC signal
through the OFF position of the APU master switch. This 28-volt DC signal goes to the APU fuel valve, through
the APU control unit. The 28-volt DC signal energizes the close coil for the APU fuel valve and closes the APU
fuel valve. When the APU fuel valve is closed, the APU engine stops and the 28-volt DC signal will energize
the close coil for the inlet door actuator. The air inlet door closes.

Air Inlet Ducts

The air inlet ducts supply stable air to the APU while the airplane is on the ground. When the airplane is in
flight, the air inlet ducts supply ram air to the APU. The air inlet ducts include:

1. The air diffuser duct


2. The compressor air duct
3. The cooling air duct

The air diffuser duct is found in the fuselage behind the rear pressure bulkhead on the right side of the
airplane. The forward end of the air diffuser duct attaches to the fuselage near the air inlet door. The aft end
of the air diffuser duct connects to the torque box liner on the right side of the airplane. The torque box liner
operates as an air collector. From the torque box liner, the air supply goes into two ducts. These two ducts
are the compressor air duct and the cooling air duct. These air ducts are connected to the torque box liner.
The compressor air duct attaches to the flange of the APU compressor plenum.

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-49 GTCP Page 17
and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Air Inlet Ducts (Continued):

The torque box liner has acoustically treated panels. One panel is the splitter panel. These panels keep the
APU compressor noise to a minimum during ground operations. The acoustically treated panels are made
from a sandwich type construction with a honeycomb bonded material. These panels attach to the inner wall
of the torque box liner with a bonding material and rivets.

Air Inlet Door

The air inlet door controls the air supply to the APU. The air inlet door is found on the right side of the
fuselage in front of the right horizontal stabilizer. A vortex generator is found on the surface of the air inlet
door. The vortex generator supplies an increase in ram air flow to the air diffuser duct during flight. The air
inlet door operates with two pushrods and an actuator. The actuator is an electrical unit. The air inlet door
does not fully close. This permits the inlet air pressure to always be more than the tailpipe pressure.

Air Inlet Door Actuator

The inlet door actuator opens and closes the air inlet door with a rotary type mechanism. This mechanism has
a gear train and a worm gear. The inlet door actuator is in a housing. Two output shafts are a part of the
worm gear. Two actuator arms operate the pushrods and attach to the output shafts of the actuator. The inlet
door actuator is energized by a dc motor that has a magnetic brake. The APU master switch starts the dc
motor operation. The dc motor operation is stopped by one of the two limit switches in the inlet door actuator.
One limit switch controls the opening cycle and the other limit switch controls the closing cycle. Located inside
of the fuselage, the inlet door actuator is aft of the rear pressure bulkhead.

ATA-49 GTCP Page 18 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization
and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

COMPRESSOR
AIR DUCT

AIR SEE A
DIFFUSER
DUCT

SEE B

COOLING
AIR DUCT VORTEX
GENERATOR

AIR INLET
DOOR
FWD
A

PRESSURE
BULKHEAD
ACTUATOR
ARM

AIR INLET
DOOR

AIR
DIFFUSER
DUCT

ACTUATOR PUSHROD

OUTPUT SHAFT

FWD

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-49 GTCP Page 19
and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

ATA-49 GTCP Page 20 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization
and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

APU ENGINE
Overview

The APU engine supplies the bleed air for pneumatic power and the shaft power to turn the APU electrical
generator. The APU engine is a gas turbine. The APU engine has a compressor section, turbine section and
gearbox section.

Static air or ram air comes in the compressor plenum. An impeller compresses the air and sends it to the
turbine plenum. From the turbine plenum, the compressed air goes into the combustion chamber. In the
combustion chamber, the air is mixed with fuel. A spark from the igniter plug supplies the ignition of the fuel-
air mixture. The gases from combustion flow to the turbine. The energy from the combustion causes the
turbine wheel to turn and make mechanical power. The mechanical power turns the compressor and the APU
electrical generator. When it is necessary, the turbine plenum supplies the bleed air for pneumatic power.

Compressor Section

The compressor section is the source of the compressed air for the turbine. The compressor section has a
two-stage compressor and the compressor plenum. The compressor is a centrifugal compressor. The two
compressor stages are connected by crossover ducts. One impeller and one diffuser make a compressor
stage. The first-stage impeller is a double-entry impeller. It has two impellers that are back-to-back. The
second-stage impeller is a single-entry impeller. Both of these impellers have a common shaft. The shaft is
installed on two bearings that are pressure lubricated. The gearbox end of the shaft connects with a quill
shaft in the gearbox. Seals keep the lubrication system isolated from the turbine gases.

Turbine Section

The turbine section burns the air-fuel mixture and supplies the mechanical power from the combustion. The
turbine section has a turbine wheel, torus assembly, nozzle assembly, turbine plenum, and combustion
chamber. The turbine wheel is a radial-type wheel. The turbine wheel connects to the shaft that turns the
compressor impellers. The turbine plenum gets the compressed air from the compressor impellers. Also, the
turbine plenum is a heat shield for the aft end of the APU. The torus assembly connects with the aft end of
the combustion chamber. The torus assembly moves the combustion gases to the nozzle assembly. The
nozzle assembly moves the combustion gases from the torus assembly to the turbine wheel. A single
combustion chamber is made with the inner part of the turbine plenum and torus assembly. The combustion
chamber has a combustion liner and cap. The combustion chamber liner supplies the combustion area. The
combustion chamber liner has holes to control the location and rate of combustion. The igniter plug and fuel
atomizer are installed on the cap of the combustion chamber.

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-49 GTCP Page 21
and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

 
Gearbox Section

The gearbox section changes the high turbine speed of the APU to a lower speed to turn the necessary
components of the APU. The gearbox section is found at the forward end of the APU. The gearbox section has
the accessory drive. The accessory drive has a gear train that is installed in a housing. The gear train is
turned by a quill shaft. The quill shaft is connected to the shaft that turns the compressor impeller and
turbine wheel. The gears in the gearbox section are lubricated by spray from the oil in the gearbox.

The gearbox section has the mounting pads for the fuel control unit, starter motor, cooling fan, tachometer
generator, oil pump, and APU electrical generator. For a more detailed description of these components, refer
to the following:

APU Fuel System


APU Ignition and Start System
APU Cooling Air System
APU Controls
APU Lubrication System
AC Generation System

ATA-49 GTCP Page 22 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization
and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

 
TURBINE
PLENUM TURBINE
SECTION

BLEED AIR COMPRESSOR


PORT SECTION

EXHAUST
PORT

ACCESSORY
GEARBOX SEE A
SECTION
SEE B

AIR INLET
FLANGE
COMBUSTION
CHAMBER SENSOR
ELEMENT FOR
OIL COOLER
THE FIRE
DETECTOR
OIL
COMPRESSOR
TANK
FIRST STAGE COMPRESSOR FWD
PLENUM
A

FUEL CONTROL
UNIT OIL
PUMP

APU ELECTRICAL
GENERATOR
OIL
TANK
CROSSOVER
DUCT FOR THE
COOLING AIR

STARTER
MOTOR

FWD
ACCESSORY GEARBOX SECTION
B

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-49 GTCP Page 23
and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

APU FUEL SYSTEM


Overview

The APU fuel system supplies the fuel for the APU from the airplane fuel system. The No. 1 fuel tank of the
airplane is the source for the fuel to the APU. The APU fuel system automatically monitors the fuel flow rate
to keep the APU at a constant speed for different load conditions.

The components of the APU fuel system are:

• The APU fuel valve


• The low-pressure fuel filter
• The fuel control unit
• The APU control thermostat (Airplanes without the ETC)
• The fuel solenoid valve
• The combustor unit
• The fuel drain
• The fuel heater

APU Fuel Valve

The APU fuel valve connects the APU fuel system to the No. 1 fuel tank of the airplane. The APU fuel valve is
on the rear spar of the left wing. The APU fuel valve is controlled by the APU master switch.

Low Pressure Fuel Filter

The low-pressure fuel filter keeps unwanted material from the fuel control unit. The low-pressure fuel filter is
a full-flow filter with a filter element. The filter element can be replaced. A bypass valve in the filter permits
fuel to be supplied to the fuel control unit when the filter element is clogged. The bypass valve opens when
the differential pressure across the low-pressure fuel filter is approximately 14 PSI (96.5 kPa). The low-
pressure fuel filter is installed on the fuel control unit.

Fuel Control Unit

The fuel control unit supplies the pressurized fuel to the combustion chamber. The fuel control unit has a fuel
pump, low-pressure fuel filter, acceleration limiter valve, flyweight governor, bypass valve, and two relief
valves. The fuel control unit also has the fuel inlet ports, fuel outlet port, seal drain line, and control air
connection. The fuel control unit is installed on the gearbox. The gear train in the gearbox turns the fuel
control unit at approximately 10% of the APU engine speed.

ATA-49 GTCP Page 24 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization
and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

 
Fuel Control Unit (Continued):

The fuel pump in the fuel control unit is a gear-type pump that supplies the fuel pressure for the APU fuel
system. The fuel pump housing has a pressure relief valve that is spring loaded. When the fuel pressure is
too high, the pressure relief valve permits fuel to go back to the fuel inlet port. The high-pressure fuel filter is
found downstream of the fuel outlet port. The high-pressure fuel filter keeps all unwanted material from the
flyweight governor.

AIRPLANES WITHOUT THE TAFCU; The acceleration limiter valve controls the quantity of fuel for
acceleration during the APU start. The acceleration limiter valve has a diaphragm, piston and guide assembly,
bypass valve, spring, adjustment screw, nut, and bypass filter. Air supplied by the compressor controls the
acceleration limiter valve. The air is supplied from an orificed tee. The orificed tee is found forward of the
combustor unit on the lower right side of the diffuser housing.

AIRPLANES WITH THE TAFCU; The acceleration limiter valve controls the quantity of fuel for acceleration
when the APU speed is less than 20%. The acceleration limiter valve has a diaphragm, piston and guide
assembly, bypass valve, spring, adjustment screw, nut, and bypass filter. Air supplied by the compressor
controls the acceleration limiter valve. The air is supplied from an orificed tee. The orificed tee is found
forward of the combustor unit on the lower right side of the diffuser housing. When the APU speed is more
than 20%, the timed-acceleration head on the fuel control unit supplies a specified quantity of fuel. The
timed-acceleration head is made to supply a specified quantity of fuel for a specified APU speed during the
acceleration.

The governor controls the fuel flow to the fuel atomizer during the APU usual operation. The governor
supplies the fuel to keep a constant APU speed during different load conditions. The governor has a shaft and
sleeve assembly, governor cage, flyweights, spring, adjustment screw, and nut. High-pressure fuel is on all
sides of the flyweights. The flyweights move the sleeve to cover the shaft ports for control of the bypass of
the fuel. This will give the correct quantity of fuel to the fuel atomizer.

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-49 GTCP Page 25
and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

LOW-PRESSURE CHECK VALVE FOR


FUEL LINE THE FUEL HEATER
FUEL FUEL HEATER
CONTROL
UNIT LOW-PRESSURE
FUEL FILTER

FUEL CONTROL AIR


SEE B SOLENOID LINE
SEE A
VALVE

SEAL DRAIN
FOR THE
DRIVE SHAFT

FWD

A 1 HIGH-PRESSURE
HIGH-PRESSURE FUEL FILTER
CHECK VALVE FOR
LOW-PRESSURE FUEL LINE
THE FUEL HEATER
FUEL LINE
FUEL HEATER
FUEL
CONTROL LOW-PRESSURE
UNIT FUEL FILTER

FUEL
HIGH-PRESSURE
SOLENOID
FUEL FILTER
VALVE

HIGH-PRESSURE
FUEL LINE

FWD

1 AIRPLANES WITHOUT THE TAFCU


A 2
2 AIRPLANES WITH THE TAFCU

ATA-49 GTCP Page 26 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization
and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

 
UPPER SHROUD

EXHAUST PORT

APU CONTROL
THERMOSTAT
CONTROL LINE
FOR THE BLEED AIR

BLEED AIR LINE TO THE


APU CONTROL THERMOSTAT

PRESSURE LINE FOR THE


COMPRESSOR DISCHARGE

3-WAY SOLENOID VALVE

FUEL DRAIN HOUSING

DRAIN REDUCER
DRAIN LINE FWD

B 1

UPPER SHROUD

EXHAUST PORT

FUEL DRAIN HOUSING

DRAIN REDUCER
DRAIN LINE

FWD
B 2

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-49 GTCP Page 27
and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

ATA-49 GTCP Page 28 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization
and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

APU IGNITION AND START SYSTEM


Overview

The APU ignition and start system turns the APU engine to the start speed and supplies the spark for
combustion. The APU ignition and start system operates automatically. The APU start system has the starter
motor and start relay R5. The APU ignition system has the ignition unit, igniter plug and igniter cable.

Starter Motor

The starter motor supplies the initial power to turn the APU engine until the APU engine speed is sufficient to
supply good airflow for combustion. The starter motor is installed on the gearbox. The starter motor has an
electrical motor, spring-loaded friction clutch, and pawl-engagement mechanism. When the starter motor
speed increases, the centrifugal force moves the pawls to engage with the ratchet on the accessory drive shaft.
The shock of the engagement is absorbed by the spring-loaded friction clutch. The spring-loaded friction
clutch also controls the starting torque. The starting torque uses the current from the battery during the initial
phase of the APU start. When the electrical power is removed from the starter motor, the APU engine speed
will be greater than the starter motor speed. The ratchet will override the pawls until the starter motor speed
decreases sufficiently to permit the spring to retract the pawls.

Start Relay R5

The start relay R5 transmits the heavy electrical load during the operation of the starter motor. The start relay
R5 is found on a floor beam to the right of the E3-1 electrical shelf. To get to the start relay R5, you must
remove the right panel between the forward cargo compartment and the electronics bay.

Ignition Unit

The ignition unit supplies the high voltage current to the igniter cable. The ignition unit has a transformer,
vibrator, rectifier, booster coil, and a series of capacitors. The ignition unit is in a hermetically-sealed metal
container. The ignition unit is installed on the turbine plenum at approximately the six o'clock position.

When the ignition unit is energized, the vibrator is supplied with 28-volts DC. The vibrator changes the input
current to a pulse. The pulse is transmitted to the transformer. The transformer increases the voltage and
sends it through the rectifier into the storage capacitors. When the storage capacitors are fully charged, they
will let out a surge of high intensity current to the primary winding of the booster coil. The secondary winding
of the booster coil supplies a surge current to the igniter cable. The igniter cable transmits the current to the
center electrode of the igniter plug.

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-49 GTCP Page 29
and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Igniter Plug

The igniter plug supplies the high energy spark for the ignition of the fuel-air mixture in the combustion
chamber. The igniter plug is installed on the forward side of the combustion chamber. The igniter plug has
the outer casing, center electrode, and ceramic insulator. The energy from the spark is sufficiently high to
break down the air distance between the center electrode and the outer casing. This permits the spark to
cause the ignition of the fuel-air mixture in the combustion chamber.

Igniter Cable

The igniter cable supplies a low-resistance path between the ignition unit and the igniter plug. The igniter
cable has an insulated electrical conductor that is closed in a metal braided conduit. At each end of the
igniter cable, there are threaded connectors that are insulated. The igniter cable and connectors are shielded
to prevent radio interference.
SEE A

START
RELAY R5

FWD

SEE B

SEE C

ATA-49 GTCP Page 30 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization
and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

FWD

IGNITER CABLE FWD

IGNITION UNIT IGNITER


IGNITION UNIT CABLE
IGNITER PLUG IGNITER PLUG

B 1
B 2

FWD
STARTER
MOTOR
1 AIRPLANES WITHOUT THE ETC
C
2 AIRPLANES WITH THE ETC

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-49 GTCP Page 31
and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

ATA-49 GTCP Page 32 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization
and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

APU COOLING AIR SYSTEM


Overview

The cooling air system for the APU supplies the air to control the temperature of the APU electrical generator.
It also supplies the air to control the temperature of the APU lubrication system, APU engine parts and APU
shroud.
The cooling air system has these components:

• The cooling air duct


• The shutoff valve
• The pneumatic actuator
• The cooling fan
• The crossover duct

Cooling Air Inlet Duct

The cooling air duct supplies the stable air to the cooling fan when the airplane is on the ground. When the
airplane is in flight, the cooling air duct supplies the ram air to the cooling fan. The cooling air duct is found
between the torque box and the inlet flange of the cooling fan. The cooling air duct is connected to the upper
shroud with rivets.

A cooling fan inlet screen (referred to as the fan inlet screen) attaches to the cooling fan inlet. An inspection
tube and a cap assembly are attached to the cooling air duct for the inspection of the fan inlet screen. The
inspection tube goes through a lightning hole in the horizontal web above the upper shroud.

Cooling Air Shutoff Valve

The shutoff valve stops the airflow through the cooling air duct when the APU is stopped. Also, the shutoff
valve will keep all flames in the APU shroud if an APU fire occurs. The shutoff valve has a butterfly that is
installed on a shaft. The shutoff valve is installed in the cooling air duct. The pneumatic actuator controls the
shutoff valve.

Pneumatic Actuator

The pneumatic actuator controls the shutoff valve. The pneumatic actuator has a cylinder, piston and rod
assembly, spring, and cap. The pneumatic actuator is installed on the flange of the cooling air duct. The
pneumatic actuator rod extends when the pneumatic pressure from the bleed air duct is more than the spring
force. A filter in the pneumatic keeps all unwanted materials from the pneumatic actuator. The filter can be
replaced or used again.

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-49 GTCP Page 33
and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Cooling Fan

The cooling fan supplies a positive, cool airflow through the oil cooler and the APU electrical generator. The
cooling fan is an axial-flow fan that is installed in a T-shaped housing. The accessory gear train turns the
cooling fan. One arm of the housing gives the support for the cooling fan bearings and the mounting flange for
the gearbox. The other arm of the housing is part of the cooling air duct. The fan inlet screen is attached to
the top of the housing for the cooling fan. The leg of the T-shaped housing is the cooling fan outlet. The leg
supplies the mounting pad for the crossover duct.

Cooling Air Crossover Duct

The airflow from the cooling fan moves through the crossover duct to the oil cooler and the APU electrical
generator.
SEE C

BLEED AIR
DUCT

SEE A
SEE B BLEED AIR
VALVE

PNEUMATIC
ACTUATOR CAP INLET DUCT HORIZONTAL WEB
FOR THE
SHUTOFF VALVE COOLING AIR

UPPER SHROUD

CROSSOVER
DUCT FOR
THE COOLING
AIR

COOLING AIR
FAN

FWD

OIL COOLER B

ATA-49 GTCP Page 34 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization
and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

UPPER SHROUD

PNEUMATIC LINE TO
THE PNEUMATIC ACTUATOR

PNEUMATIC LINE
FILTER
SEE D

CHECK VALVE
(TO FUEL
HEATER)
(REF)
FWD BLEED AIR
DUCT
C

PNEUMATIC LINE TO THE


PNEUMATIC ACTUATOR

REDUCER

BLEED AIR GASKET


DUCT
FILTER

GASKET

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-49 GTCP Page 35
and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

APU BLEED AIR SYSTEM


Overview

The bleed air system for the APU supplies the compressed air for the air conditioning system, engine start
system, and other pneumatic components of the airplane. The bleed air system also decreases compressor
surge when the airplane is in flight and there in no bleed load. The bleed air system has these components:

• The bleed air valve


• The bleed air duct
• AIRPLANES WITHOUT THE ETC; the APU control thermostat
• AIRPLANES WITH THE ETC; the proportional control valve
• The differential pressure regulator
• The surge bleed valve

Bleed Air Valve

The bleed air valve controls the bleed airflow from the APU turbine plenum to the airplane pneumatic ducts.
The bleed air valve is installed on the bleed air duct at the front of the APU compartment. The bleed air valve
has a main valve, actuator, rate control valve, and switcher valve. A housing contains the main valve. The
main valve is a butterfly valve that is usually in the closed position. The housing for the main valve has a port
for a control air connection that is upstream of the butterfly valve. The actuator has a spring-loaded
diaphragm and a linkage that closes the switcher valve. The switcher valve is a two-ball selector valve that is
operated by a solenoid. The switcher valve controls the airflow to the two sides of the actuator diaphragm.
One ball of the switcher valve is a check valve for the control air pressure. The other ball is the check valve
for the switcher. The rate control valve controls a poppet-valve that is contained in the housing.

When the APU engine speed is more than 95%, the solenoid for the bleed air valve is energized. When the
solenoid for the bleed air valve is not energized, the switcher valve moves the control air to the bottom of the
actuator diaphragm. This keeps the main valve closed. Control air from upstream of the main valve moves to
the two sides of the diaphragm of the rate control valve. The pressure of the two sides of the diaphragm is
the same. This keeps the poppet valve closed. When the BLEED AIR switch is moved to the ON position, the
solenoid for the bleed air valve is energized. This opens the check valve and closes the switcher valve. Also,
the control air from the bottom of the actuator diaphragm moves to the top of the actuator diaphragm and
opens the main valve. When the main valve opens, the pressure at the rate control valve will decrease in
proportion to the quantity of bleed air from the APU. Since the adjustable orifice keeps to a limit the bleed air
from the top of the rate control diaphragm, the rate control diaphragm will move down and open the poppet
valve. Control air will bleed from the actuator to control the rate that the main valve opens. Also, this
controls how much the main valve opens to prevent an overload on the APU. While the pressure of the control
air bleeds from the top of the rate control diaphragm, the poppet valve will close slowly. While the poppet
valve closes, the pressure from the control air in the actuator will increase and open the main valve more.
When the poppet valve is fully closed, the main valve is fully open. The adjustable orifice is usually set to
make the main valve open in 12 to 14 seconds.

ATA-49 GTCP Page 36 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization
and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Bleed Air Duct

The bleed air duct is found in the APU compartment between the upper shroud and the bleed air valve. The
bleed air duct is attached to the upper shroud and the bleed air valve with support clamps. The pneumatic
line filter for the cooling air shutoff valve, and the check valve for the fuel sensing flow control, are installed
on the bleed air duct.

SEE C

SEE A
UPPER
SHROUD
CONTROL LINE
FOR THE BLEED AIR

BLEED
AIR DUCT

FWD

SEE B
TURBINE
PLENUM

CONTROL LINE BLEED AIR


FOR THE BLEED AIR VALVE
SOLENOID

ELECTRICAL
BLEED PLUG
AIR DUCT

CONTROL AIR LINE

BLEED AIR
VALVE AIRPLANE
PNEUMATIC
DUCT

AIR INLET LINE INBD

DIFFERENTIAL
FWD
PRESSURE
REGULATOR
B

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-49 GTCP Page 37
and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

APU Control Thermostat


(Airplanes without the ETC)

The APU control thermostat is installed in the turbine exhaust port. The APU control thermostat has a steel
housing, spring-loaded ball valve, thermostatic core, and pneumatic line connection. The APU control
thermostat is part of a single thermostat control system. The single thermostat control system also has the 3-
way solenoid valve. The APU control thermostat operates as an acceleration control thermostat and a load
control thermostat.

When the APU engine speed is less than 95%, the APU control thermostat is an acceleration control
thermostat. With the 95% contact in the speed switch open, no electrical power is supplied to the bleed air
valve or the 3-way solenoid valve. When the APU speed is more than 95%, the APU control thermostat is a
load control thermostat. Electrical power is supplied to the 3-way solenoid valve. When the 3-way solenoid
valve closes, the APU control thermostat operates in the load control mode. In this mode, the APU control
thermostat is an overload protection for the APU.

The 3-way solenoid valve is found below the surge bleed valve on the lower right side of the APU. During the
APU start and operation, the APU control thermostat controls the acceleration limiter valve on the fuel control
unit. The APU control thermostat bleeds the compressor air through the 3-way solenoid valve. The 3-way
solenoid valve is usually in the open position. When the APU engine speed is 95%, the 3-way solenoid valve
stops the compressed air from the acceleration limiter valve. The EGT is controlled by the APU control
thermostat. The APU control thermostat bleeds the compressed air from the bleed air valve to close the bleed
air valve if the EGT is too high.

ATA-49 GTCP Page 38 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization
and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

SEE A

APU CONTROL
THERMOSTAT

TURBINE
EXHAUST
PORT

SEE B AIR LINE


FOR THE
BLEED LOAD
CONTROL
MOUNTING
FLANGE

MOUNTING
FLANGE

FWD

RETAINER
A

CONTROL WASHER
THERMOSTAT

BOLT
AIR LINE
NUT

CONTROL AIR
LINE B

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-49 GTCP Page 39
and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Proportional Control Valve (Airplanes with the ETC)

The proportional control valve is installed on the bottom of the APU near the turbine exhaust port. The
proportional control valve is a part of the electronic temperature control system. The electronic temperature
control uses the proportional control valve for overload protection of the APU. During an overload condition,
the electronic temperature control sends a signal to the proportional control valve to move the bleed air valve
to the closed position. This will remove the pneumatic load from the APU and permit the EGT to decrease.
When the EGT decreases, the electronic temperature control sends a signal to the proportional control valve to
open the surge bleed valve.

SEE A

ELECTRICAL
CONNECTOR

BOLT
WASHER
(2 LOCATIONS)

PROPORTIONAL
CONTROL
VALVE (PCV) CONTROL
AIR LINE
A

ATA-49 GTCP Page 40 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization
and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Differential Air Pressure Regulator

The differential pressure regulator supplies a constant air pressure to the bleed air valve. This permits the
bleed air valve to operate independently of the ambient temperature and ambient pressure. The differential
pressure regulator is installed on the bleed air valve. The differential pressure regulator has a cover with an
inlet fitting and air filter. Also, the differential pressure regulator has a main housing with a spring-loaded
diaphragm assembly, metering valve, and relief valve. The differential pressure regulator is set to
approximately 19 PSIG (131 kPa).

SEE A

BLEED AIR
AIR INLET VALVE
LINE

CLAMP

COVER

CLAMP
SCREW
ELEMENT

PACKING

PRESSURE
REGULATOR
LOCK-O-SEAL HOUSING
(AIRESEARCH
P/N X-050554-2)

INBD
A

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-49 GTCP Page 41
and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Surge Bleed Valve

The surge bleed valve is installed on the turbine plenum directly below the bleed air duct. The surge bleed
valve operates when the APU engine speed is more than 95%, the airplane is in flight and the bleed air valve
is closed. The surge bleed valve prevents a compressor surge at high altitudes.

SEE A
UPPER
SHROUD
FWD

ELECTRICAL
CONNECTOR

SURGE BLEED
VALVE
SEE B

A 1

UPPER
SHROUD

ELECTRICAL
CONNECTOR

TURBINE
PLENUM
LOCKWIRE

SURGE BLEED
VALVE
SEE B SURGE
BLEED
VALVE

PACKING
SCREW
A 2 WASHER

1 AIRPLANES WITHOUT THE ETC B


2 AIRPLANES WITH THE ETC

ATA-49 GTCP Page 42 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization
and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-49 GTCP Page 43
and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

APU CONTROLS
Overview

The APU controls supply the manual and automatic control to start, to stop and to operate the APU. The APU
controls keep the APU operation below very important APU engine limits. When the APU starts, the control of
the APU is fully automatic. The APU controls are:

• The APU control unit


• The electronic speed switch
• The sequencing oil pressure switch (referred to as the sequencing switch for the oil pressure)
• The low oil pressure switch (referred to as the oil pressure switch)
• The high oil temperature switch (referred to as the oil temperature switch)
• The compressor inlet temperature sensor (Airplanes with the ETC)
• The electronic temperature control (referred to as the ETC) (Airplanes with the ETC)

AIRPLANES WITHOUT THE ETC; The APU control thermostat supplies additional control. AIRPLANES
WITH THE ETC; The proportional control valve supplies additional control. The APU control unit is the main
control for the APU operation. The APU control unit is found on the E3-3 electrical shelf in the electronics bay.
The APU control unit has a sequence of events for the APU start and the APU operation. The APU control unit
gives protection to the APU for overspeed, high oil temperature and low oil pressure.

The sequencing switch for the oil pressure permits the fuel and ignition to be supplied to the APU engine at
the correct time during the APU start. The electronic speed switch stops the operation of the starter motor
and ignition at the correct time during the APU start. Also, the electronic speed switch prevents the use of
bleed air until the APU engine speed is 95% and keeps the APU engine from an overspeed. The oil pressure
switch and oil temperature switch stop the APU if the oil temperature or oil pressures do not stay in the limits.

APU Control Unit

The APU control unit starts, operates and stops the APU. The APU control unit is installed in the lower
section on the E3-3 electrical shelf. There is a circuit breaker on the face of the APU control unit. ON APU
CONTROL UNIT WITH THE "TEST PASS" AND "TEST FAIL" LIGHTS; There is an overspeed reset/test
switch on the face of the APU control unit to do a check for internal BITE problems.

ATA-49 GTCP Page 44 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization
and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

E3 ELECTRONIC
SHELF

SEE A

CIRCUIT
BREAKER

"TEST PASS"
LIGHT
"TEST FAIL"
LIGHT

CIRCUIT
BREAKER

OVERSPEED
RESET SWITCH

OVERSPEED
RESET/TEST
APU CONTROL UNIT SWITCH

A 1

APU CONTROL UNIT


A 2

1 APU CONTROL UNIT WITHOUT


THE "TEST PASS" AND "TEST FAIL"
LIGHTS
2 APU CONTROL UNIT WITH THE
"TEST PASS" AND "TEST FAIL"
LIGHTS

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-49 GTCP Page 45
and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Electronic Speed Switch

The electronic speed switch controls the APU start, APU usual operation and overspeed protection. The
electronic speed switch is found in the aft passenger compartment in the ceiling area. The tachometer
generator sends the signal to the electronic speed switch for the APU engine speed. The electronic speed
switch has the 50% starter cutout, 95% load relay and 110% overspeed relay.

STA
947
CEILING
PANEL
NO. 2

FLIGHT
RECORDER

ELECTRONIC
SPEED SWITCH
SEE A

FLIGHT
RECORDER
(REF)
STA
967

MOUNTING TRAY

FWD
ELECTRICAL
CONNECTOR

ELECTRONIC
SPEED SWITCH
SEE B
A

ATA-49 GTCP Page 46 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization
and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Sequencing Oil Pressure Switch

The sequencing switch for the oil pressure makes sure the combustion does not start until the APU engine has
4.0 PSIG (27.6 kPa) oil pressure. The sequencing switch is found on the APU engine directly below the starter
motor. The sequencing switch has an electrical connector, a connector for the oil pressure line and 2 micro
switches. When the oil pressure increases to approximately 4.0 PSIG (27.6 kPa), the two micro switches close.
One micro switch completes the circuit to the ignition coil, and the other micro switch completes the circuit to
the fuel solenoid valve. When both micro switches are closed this permits the initial combustion to occur.
When the APU rpm reaches 95%, the circuit to the ignition coil is opened by the speed switch. Above 95%
RPM, the micro switch in the ignition coil circuit has no effect on APU operation. Above 95% RPM, the micro
switch in the fuel solenoid valve circuit keeps the fuel solenoid valve energized as long as oil pressure remains
above 4 PSIG (27.6 kPa).

SEE A

SEE B FWD

MANIFOLD
FITTING

PACKING

OIL PRESSURE
SWITCH

ELECTRICAL
CONNECTOR

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-49 GTCP Page 47
and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Low Oil Pressure Switch

The oil pressure switch operates when the oil pressure in the APU engine goes below approximately 45 PSIG
(310 kPa). The oil pressure switch is found on the APU engine adjacent to the sequencing switch. The oil
pressure switch has an electrical connector, a connector for the oil pressure line and a switch.

FWD

MANIFOLD
FITTING

PACKING

LOW OIL
PRESSURE
SWITCH

ELECTRICAL
CONNECTOR

ATA-49 GTCP Page 48 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization
and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Oil Temperature Switch

The oil temperature switch operates when the oil temperature is greater than approximately 285°F (140°C).
The oil temperature switch is installed on the oil pump housing.

FWD

INLET LINE
ACCESSORY
OF THE
DRIVE
OIL COOLER
GEARBOX

SEE A

ELECTRICAL
CABLE OF
THE OIL
TEMPERATURE
SWITCH

INLET LINE
OF THE
FWD OIL PUMP
OIL
STARTER TEMPERATURE
MOTOR OIL FILTER SWITCH

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-49 GTCP Page 49
and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Compressor Inlet Temperature Sensor (Airplanes with the ETC)

The temperature sensor for the compressor inlet gives the compressor inlet temperatures to the ETC. The
temperature sensor T2 is a resistive transmitter which sends a signal to the ETC when the APU speed is above
95%. This signal is used by the ETC to control the EGT during acceleration and loaded conditions. The
temperature sensor is installed on the compressor plenum.

SEE A

FWD

COMPRESSOR
PLENUM

SEE B

FWD

INLET
TEMPERATURE
SENSOR

ELECTRICAL
CONNECTOR

ATA-49 GTCP Page 50 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization
and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Electronic Temperature Control (Airplanes with the ETC)

The electronic temperature control (ETC) does a check of the exhaust gas temperature directly from the two
ETC thermocouple probes. The ETC thermocouple probes are installed in the turbine exhaust port. The ETC
also supplies the overload protection for the APU. When an overload condition occurs, the ETC sends a signal
to the proportional control valve to close the bleed air valve. This will permit the EGT to decrease to the
correct limit. After the EGT decreases to the correct limit, the ETC sends a signal to the proportional control
valve to open the bleed air valve. During the APU operation, the ETC sends a signal to the EGT indicator on
the P5 forward overhead panel. On some airplanes, the ETC also sends the signal to the EGT indicator after
the APU stops.

SEE A
AFT CARGO
COMPARTMENT
DOOR

OUTBD

FWD

ETC ADJUSTMENT NUT ETC COVER

ETC ADJUSTMENT SCREW ELECTRONIC


TEMPERATURE
CONTROL (ETC)
ETC MOUNTING BOLTS
(4 LOCATIONS)

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-49 GTCP Page 51
and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

EXHAUST GAS TEMPERATURE INDICATING SYSTEM


(AIRPLANES WITHOUT THE ETC)
Overview

The EGT indicating system measures the temperature of the APU engine exhaust. This temperature is shown
on the EGT indicator on the P5 forward overhead panel. The EGT indicating system has a thermocouple probe,
an EGT resistor, a harness balancing resistor, and an EGT indicator. The airplane wires are copper and
constantan. The wires in the APU shroud are chromel and alumel because of the high temperatures.

The thermocouple probe measures the EGT of the APU engine. The heat of the exhaust gases makes the
thermocouple probe send a dc signal to the EGT indicator, on the P5 forward overhead panel, to show the
correct temperature. The EGT resistor is part of the circuit. The EGT resistor and the harness balancing
resistor adjust the EGT indicating system.

Thermocouple Probe

The thermocouple probe measures the temperature of the exhaust gases from the APU engine. The
thermocouple probe is installed in the turbine exhaust port. The thermocouple probe has two stud terminals, a
head, and a measurement junction. The thermocouple leads and studs are made of chromel and alumel
materials. The alumel stud terminal (-) is larger than the chromel stud terminal (+).

Harness Balancing Resistor

ON AIRPLANES WITH THE HARNESS BALANCING RESISTOR; The harness balancing resistor has a
specified resistance value. The harness balancing resistor is installed for each APU engine. Do not replace
the harness balancing resistor with any other resistance value.

ON AIRPLANES WITHOUT THE HARNESS BALANCING RESISTOR; A set length of chromel-alumel wire
causes the thermocouple harness resistance.

ATA-49 GTCP Page 52 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization
and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

SEE B

SEE A

THERMOCOUPLE
PROBE FOR THE
EXHAUST GAS
TEMPERATURE

TURBINE
EXHAUST
PORT
FLANGE ON THE
TURBINE EXHAUST
PORT

ATTACH HARNESS
BOLTS BALANCE
RESISTOR
1
THERMOCOUPLE LEADS

FWD

B
1 NOT ON ALL AIRPLANES

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-49 GTCP Page 53
and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

EGT Resistor

The EGT resistor permits the adjustment of the circuit for the EGT indicating system. The EGT resistor has a
spool of No. 24 constantan wire, coarse adjustment terminals, and vernier adjustment terminals. The primary
adjustment for the resistance removes wire from the resistance spool. Because of this, the EGT resistor has
an extra spool of wire.

SEE A

ATA-49 GTCP Page 54 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization
and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

EGT Indicator

The EGT indicator is a millivoltmeter in a hermetically sealed case. The EGT indicator has an electrical plug
on the rear side. The electrical plug connects the EGT indicator to the circuit for the EGT indicating system.
The dial of the EGT indicator shows temperatures from 0 to 850°C. There are color bands to show the usual
and dangerous temperature ranges.
FORWARD OVERHEAD
PANEL, P5
SEE B

FLIGHT COMPARTMENT

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-49 GTCP Page 55
and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

EXHAUST GAS TEMPERATURE INDICATING SYSTEM


(AIRPLANES WITH THE ETC)
Overview

The EGT indicating system measures the temperature of the APU engine exhaust. This temperature is shown
on the EGT indicator on the P5 forward overhead panel. The EGT indicating system has two ETC thermocouple
probes, an EGT resistor, and an EGT indicator. The airplane wires are copper and constantan. The wires in
the APU shroud are chromel and alumel because of the high temperatures.

The two ETC thermocouple probes measure the EGT of the APU engine. The heat of the exhaust gases makes
the ETC thermocouple probes send DC signals to the ETC. The ETC sends a signal to the EGT indicator, on
the P5 forward overhead panel, to show the correct temperature. The EGT resistor is part of the circuit. The
EGT resistor adjusts the EGT indicating system.

The electronic temperature control (ETC) is part of the circuit between the two ETC thermocouple probes and
the EGT indicator. The ETC is not a part of the EGT indicating system.

ETC Thermocouple Probe

The two ETC thermocouple probes measure the temperature of the exhaust gases from the APU engine. The
ETC thermocouple probes are installed in the turbine exhaust port. The two ETC thermocouple probes have
four stud terminals and four measurement junctions. The thermocouple leads and studs are made of chromel
and alumel materials.

ATA-49 GTCP Page 56 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization
and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

SEE D

SEE C

ETC
THERMOCOUPLE
PROBE

PROPORTIONAL
CONTROL
VALVE (PCV)

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-49 GTCP Page 57
and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

EGT Resistor

The EGT resistor permits the adjustment of the circuit for the EGT indicating system. The EGT resistor has a
spool of No. 24 constantan wire, coarse adjustment terminals, and vernier adjustment terminals. The primary
adjustment for the resistance removes wire from the resistance spool. Because of this, the EGT resistor has
an extra spool of wire. The EGT indicator is found in the control cabin directly below the right No. 3 window.
The total resistance is 13.5 ohms without the EGT indicator, ETC thermocouple probes and APU engine
harness.

SEE A

ATA-49 GTCP Page 58 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization
and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

EGT Indicator

The EGT indicator is a millivoltmeter in a hermetically sealed case. The EGT indicator has an electrical plug
on the rear side. The electrical plug connects the EGT indicator to the circuit for the EGT indicating system.
The dial of the EGT indicator shows temperatures from 0 to 850°C. There are color bands to show the usual
and dangerous temperature ranges.

FORWARD OVERHEAD
PANEL, P5
SEE B

FLIGHT COMPARTMENT

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-49 GTCP Page 59
and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

APU INDICATING SYSTEM


Overview

The APU indicating system monitors the condition of the APU engine. The APU indicating system has the
OVER SPEED light and the elapsed time indicator. The OVER SPEED light is found on the P5 forward overhead
panel. The elapsed time indicator is found on the APU engine.

OVER SPEED Light

The OVER SPEED light supplies the indication when the APU engine speed is too high. The OVER SPEED light
is amber. The OVER SPEED light is energized when the APU engine speed is 110%. The 110% contact in the
electronic speed switch is energized. The circuit to the OVER SPEED light is completed and the APU stops.

The OVER SPEED light is connected to the APU annunciator and the MASTER CAUTION lights. When the OVER
SPEED light comes on, the APU annunciator and MASTER CAUTION lights also come on. For a more detailed
description of the APU annunciator and MASTER CAUTION lights, refer to AMM 33-15-00/001. To conduct a
test of the OVER SPEED light, the OVER SPEED light can be pushed or the master test switch can be pushed.

ATA-49 GTCP Page 60 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization
and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

 
Elapsed Time Indicator

The elapsed time indicator keeps a record of the hours of APU operation. The elapsed time indicator is an
electrical clock that is closed in a hermetically sealed case. The elapsed time indicator shows the total hours
of APU operation with a digital counter. The digital counter shows hours and tenths of hours. The elapsed
time indicator is installed on the oil cooler.

When the APU engine speed is 95%, the signal from the 95% contact in the electronic speed switch energizes
the elapsed time indicator. The elapsed time indicator keeps a record of the APU operation when the APU
engine speed is more than 95%. The circuit for the elapsed time indicator has a circuit breaker. The circuit
breaker prevents damage to the elapsed time indicator from a surge of current. When the circuit breaker
opens, it can be closed with the reset button.

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-49 GTCP Page 61
and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

 
Elapsed Time Indicator (Continued):

If elapsed time indicator is not installed on the oil cooler the elapsed time indicator will be located on the top
left corner of the P5 forward overhead panel. The elapsed time indicator is also referred to as the hourmeter.

ATA-49 GTCP Page 62 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization
and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-49 GTCP Page 63
and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

APU EXHAUST SYSTEM


Overview

The APU exhaust system sends the exhaust gases overboard from the APU engine. The APU exhaust system
also decreases the noise level of the exhaust gases. The APU exhaust system has an exhaust duct and an aft
fairing assembly. The aft fairing assembly includes the aft fairing, exhaust duct heat shield (referred to as the
heat shield), and exhaust duct muffler. The exhaust duct and the aft fairing assembly are installed in the tail
compartment of the airplane.

Exhaust Duct

The exhaust duct has a heat shield and the exhaust duct muffler. The exhaust duct muffler is installed in the
heat shield. There is a cylindrical air space between the exhaust duct muffler and the heat shield. A felt
metal lining is installed on the inner surface of the exhaust duct muffler to decrease the noise level of the
exhaust gases. Two fire detection elements attach to the exhaust duct. One fire detection element goes along
the forward end of the exhaust duct muffler. The second fire detection element goes laterally along the heat
shield. This second fire detection element is attached to the top and the bottom of the heat shield. The
forward end of the heat shield is held by the APU shroud. A drip pan attaches to the heat shield to keep the
heat shield from all hydraulic leaks. A bonding jumper is attached to the heat shield. The bonding jumper
supplies a positive electrical ground to the airplane structure. The exhaust duct muffler does not touch the
exhaust port of the APU turbine section. There is a clearance between the exhaust port and the exhaust duct
muffler. The aft end of the exhaust duct is held by the aft fairing. A duct alignment assembly is installed on
the heat shield to align the exhaust duct with the exhaust port of the APU turbine section.

Aft Fairing

The aft fairing holds the aft end of the exhaust duct. It has a machined casting that moves with the airplane
tail cone. The aft fairing has two short cylindrical ducts. The outer duct connects to the heat shield of the
exhaust duct. The inner duct connects to the exhaust duct muffler. The aft fairing has holes to decrease the
temperature of the air intake for the exhaust duct. The aft fairing attaches to the airplane tail cone and to the
heat shield of the exhaust duct with bolts.

ATA-49 GTCP Page 64 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization
and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

SEE A

COOLING AIR INTAKE


FOR THE EXHAUST DUCT

FELT METAL
LINER
AFT
FAIRING FIRE DETECTION
ELEMENT FOR
THE HEAT SHIELD

EXHAUST
DUCT
MUFFLER
DRIP PAN
CAP FOR THE
DRIP PAN DUCT
ALIGNMENT
ASSEMBLY

HEAT SHIELD APU SHROUD

FWD

FIRE DETECTION
ELEMENT FOR THE
EXHAUST DUCT
EXHAUST PORT MUFFLER

BONDING
JUMPER

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-49 GTCP Page 65
and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

APU LUBRICATION SYSTEM


Overview

The APU engine is lubricated by the APU lubrication system. The APU lubrication system keeps oil on all
gears and bearings of the APU engine. Also, the oil decreases the temperature of the APU engine parts. The
components of the APU lubrication system are the oil pump, oil cooler, oil tank, and lube service panel.

To fill the APU oil tank, oil can be added through the oil filler port on the APU oil tank. Also, the oil can be
added at the lube service panel through the pressure re-oil system.

When the APU engine starts, the oil is supplied to the APU engine through the pressure pump and oil filter. If
the oil filter element is clogged, the bypass valve opens to permit the oil flow to continue. From the oil pump,
the oil goes to the accessory drive, the front compressor bearings, and the bearings between the compressor
impeller and the turbine wheel. This will supply the lubrication to all the gears and bearing of the APU engine.
The oil pressure regulator opens if the oil pressure increases to more than 90 PSIG (620 kPa).

The oil in the APU engine drains into the oil sump of the accessory drive and the bearing cavity between the
compressor impeller and the turbine wheel. The scavenge pump moves the oil through the oil cooler to the oil
tank. The air-oil separator removes the air from the oil in the oil tank. This air goes through the vent line for
the oil tank to the turbine exhaust port.

ATA-49 GTCP Page 66 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization
and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

OIL COOLER
SWITCH FOR THE
SEQUENCING SWITCH FOR
LOW OIL PRESSURE
THE OIL PRESSURE COOLING AIR OUTLET
FOR THE OIL COOLER

OIL
TEMPERATURE FILTER
SWITCH BYPASS
VALVE COMBUSTION
OIL PUMP CHAMBER
COOLING
FILTER FAN
COMPRESSOR
SECTION EXHAUST
PRESSURE PORT
REGULATOR
VALVE ACCESSORY
DRIVE TURBINE
GEARBOX SECTION

PRESSURE COOLING
PUMP AIR INLET

OIL PUMP
VENT LINE
FOR THE
TURBINE
SCAVENGE BEARING
PUMP CAVITY

OIL PRESSURE
VENT LINE
LINE
FOR THE
OIL TANK
LEGEND

OIL VENT
OIL RETURN
SOLENOID S OIL TANK
OIL PUMP SUCTION
VALVE
SWITCH FOR OIL PUMP PRESSURE
THE LOW OIL
LUBE SCAVENGE PUMP SUCTION
QUANTITY
SERVICE SCAVENGE PUMP PRESSURE
PANEL

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-49 GTCP Page 67
and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Oil Pump

The oil pump has two pumps: the pressure pump and the scavenge pump. The oil pump also has a pressure
regulator valve, oil filter, and filter bypass valve. The oil pump is installed on the gearbox.

The same shaft turns the pressure pump and scavenge pump. The pressure pump has two gears that supply
the oil to the bearings, gears, and shafts of the APU engine. The scavenge pump has three gears. The
scavenge pump collects the oil from the oil sump of the accessory drive and from the bearing cavity between
the compressor impeller and the turbine wheel. The scavenge pump sends the oil through the oil cooler to the
oil tank. The oil inlet lines and oil outlet lines are connected to the body of the oil pump with threaded ports.
The scavenge line from the accessory drive to the oil pump is an internal line between the gearbox and the oil
pump.

The pressure regulator valve is a spring-loaded valve in the oil pump. The pressure regulator valve opens
when the oil pressure is more than 90 PSIG (620 kPa). This permits the oil to go back to the inlet of the
pressure pump and keep a constant pressure in the APU lubrication system.

The oil filter is found on the oil pump. The oil filter keeps the unwanted material from the pressure pump.
The base of the oil filter is part of the body of the oil pump. The oil filter element is closed in the case. The
case can be removed from the oil filter.

The filter bypass valve is a spring-loaded valve that is found in the oil pump. The filter bypass valve opens
when the oil filter element is clogged to permit oil to go by the filter. This will continue the flow oil to the APU
engine.

ATA-49 GTCP Page 68 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization
and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

SEE B

SEE A

FWD

TACHOMETER
INLET LINE FOR
GENERATOR ACCESSORY
THE OIL COOLER
CONNECTOR OIL PUMP DRIVE
SEE C ASSEMBLY GEARBOX

WASHER
(3 LOCATIONS)

CONNECTOR CABLE
FOR THE OIL NUT
TEMPERATURE (3 LOCATIONS)
SWITCH

INLET LINE FOR


FWD
THE OIL PUMP

STARTER
MOTOR OIL FILTER

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-49 GTCP Page 69
and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Oil Cooler

The oil cooler is a cylindrical unit that is closed in a shell. The oil cooler has mechanically bonded tubes
made of aluminum. The oil cooler is installed on the lower front side of the APU. The oil from the scavenge
pump passes through the oil cooler before it goes back to the oil tank. The oil cooler uses the cool air from the
cooling fan to decrease the temperature of the oil.

SEE A

SEE B
FWD

CROSSOVER DUCT FOR


THE COOLING AIR

ELAPSED TIME
INDICATOR

INLET LINE FOR


THE OIL COOLER

CIRCUIT
BREAKER
OUTLET LINE FOR
CLAMP
THE OIL COOLER

GASKET

OIL COOLER

CLAMP BRACKET
B

ATA-49 GTCP Page 70 FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization
and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Oil Tank

The oil tank has the oil supply for the APU engine. The oil tank is installed on the left side of the APU engine.
The oil tank has a vent to the turbine exhaust port. An air-oil separator in the oil tank removes the air from
the oil in the oil tank. This air goes through the vent line for the oil tank to the turbine exhaust port. An oil
level switch in the oil tank sends a signal for a low oil quantity to the control cabin. A float switch for the oil
quantity in the oil tank sends a signal for a low oil quantity to the lube service panel.

SEE B

SEE A

OIL TANK

DRAIN PLUG
FILLER
NECK
FILLER CAP
FWD

BOLT
A

OIL SCREEN

FILLER PORT

OIL TANK

WASHER

NUT

FWD

B737-300/400/500 General Familiarization FOR TRAINING PURPOSES ONLY ATA-49 GTCP Page 71
and Systems
  Introduction
 
B737 GENERAL FAMILIARIZATION COURSE
AeroEd LLC – Aviation Education Resource
 
 

Lube Service Panel

Oil can be added to the APU oil tank through the lube service panel. The lube service panel is installed
forward of the stabilizer trim door. The lube service panel has two indicator lights, a door proximity switch,
and a pressure fill connection. The amber ADD light comes on when the quantity of oil in the oil tank is less
than 1-2 quarts (0.9-1.9 liters). With the ADD light on, the solenoid valve opens to permit oil to go into the oil
tank through the pressure re-oil system. The green FULL light comes on when the oil quantity in the oil tank
is 6 quarts (5.6 liters). When the FULL light is on, the solenoid valve closes and the oil cannot be added to the
oil tank through the pressure re-oil system.

STABILIZER ACCESS
DOOR, 3701

SOLENOID
VALVE

LUBE SERVICE
PANEL
SEE E

FULL LIGHT

FULL DOOR SWITCH

You might also like